summaryrefslogtreecommitdiffstats
path: root/bin
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
authorrgrimes <rgrimes@FreeBSD.org>1994-05-26 06:18:55 +0000
committerrgrimes <rgrimes@FreeBSD.org>1994-05-26 06:18:55 +0000
commite3cfc8ce61f788739c66445d903f8beacb40c93d (patch)
treeba7beef9ee9289c4383bad976f88710e44c98b4d /bin
parent862fdf11a2ede45dec0da01ed575525d79468981 (diff)
downloadFreeBSD-src-e3cfc8ce61f788739c66445d903f8beacb40c93d.zip
FreeBSD-src-e3cfc8ce61f788739c66445d903f8beacb40c93d.tar.gz
BSD 4.4 Lite bin Sources
Diffstat (limited to 'bin')
-rw-r--r--bin/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/Makefile.inc3
-rw-r--r--bin/cat/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/cat/cat.1121
-rw-r--r--bin/cat/cat.c251
-rw-r--r--bin/chmod/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/chmod/chmod.1294
-rw-r--r--bin/chmod/chmod.c201
-rw-r--r--bin/cp/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/cp/cp.1211
-rw-r--r--bin/cp/cp.c441
-rw-r--r--bin/cp/extern.h55
-rw-r--r--bin/cp/utils.c285
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/Makefile44
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/Makefile7
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.11012
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.21305
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.3650
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.4178
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.a95
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.g1721
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/USD.doc/tabs34
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/alloc.c124
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/char.c311
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/char.h96
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/const.c160
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/csh.12175
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/csh.c1352
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/csh.h552
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/dir.c930
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/dir.h45
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/dol.c985
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/err.c407
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/exec.c736
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/exp.c711
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/extern.h338
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/file.c684
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/func.c1498
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/glob.c939
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/hist.c184
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/init.c135
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/lex.c1639
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/misc.c420
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/parse.c698
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/pathnames.h41
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/proc.c1356
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/proc.h101
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/sem.c645
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/set.c844
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/str.c467
-rw-r--r--bin/csh/time.c316
-rw-r--r--bin/date/Makefile8
-rw-r--r--bin/date/date.1230
-rw-r--r--bin/date/date.c237
-rw-r--r--bin/date/extern.h36
-rw-r--r--bin/date/netdate.c182
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/args.c386
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/conv.c260
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/conv_tab.c357
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/dd.1348
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/dd.c395
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/dd.h96
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/extern.h65
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/misc.c100
-rw-r--r--bin/dd/position.c166
-rw-r--r--bin/df/Makefile7
-rw-r--r--bin/df/df.1116
-rw-r--r--bin/df/df.c420
-rw-r--r--bin/echo/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/echo/echo.170
-rw-r--r--bin/echo/echo.c71
-rw-r--r--bin/hostname/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/hostname/hostname.165
-rw-r--r--bin/hostname/hostname.c87
-rw-r--r--bin/kill/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/kill/kill.1120
-rw-r--r--bin/kill/kill.c144
-rw-r--r--bin/ln/Makefile7
-rw-r--r--bin/ln/ln.1131
-rw-r--r--bin/ln/ln.c164
-rw-r--r--bin/ln/symlink.7432
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/cmp.c104
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/extern.h50
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/ls.1333
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/ls.c506
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/ls.h72
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/print.c293
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/stat_flags.c148
-rw-r--r--bin/ls/util.c71
-rw-r--r--bin/mkdir/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/mkdir/mkdir.192
-rw-r--r--bin/mkdir/mkdir.c169
-rw-r--r--bin/mv/Makefile8
-rw-r--r--bin/mv/mv.1129
-rw-r--r--bin/mv/mv.c300
-rw-r--r--bin/mv/pathnames.h37
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/Makefile32
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/ar_io.c1288
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/ar_subs.c1238
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/buf_subs.c1083
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/cache.c479
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/cache.h74
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/cpio.c1278
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/cpio.h151
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/extern.h285
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/file_subs.c1055
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/ftree.c543
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/ftree.h50
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/gen_subs.c487
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/options.c1140
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/options.h113
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/pat_rep.c1196
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/pat_rep.h54
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/pax.11169
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/pax.c405
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/pax.h238
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/sel_subs.c657
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/sel_subs.h73
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/tables.c1426
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/tables.h172
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/tar.c1192
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/tar.h148
-rw-r--r--bin/pax/tty_subs.c245
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/Makefile11
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/devname.c80
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/extern.h85
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/fmt.c115
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/keyword.c354
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/nlist.c136
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/print.c741
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/ps.1502
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/ps.c504
-rw-r--r--bin/ps/ps.h88
-rw-r--r--bin/pwd/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/pwd/pwd.168
-rw-r--r--bin/pwd/pwd.c92
-rw-r--r--bin/rcp/Makefile13
-rw-r--r--bin/rcp/extern.h50
-rw-r--r--bin/rcp/pathnames.h39
-rw-r--r--bin/rcp/rcp.1159
-rw-r--r--bin/rcp/rcp.c924
-rw-r--r--bin/rcp/util.c167
-rw-r--r--bin/rm/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/rm/rm.1150
-rw-r--r--bin/rm/rm.c378
-rw-r--r--bin/rmail/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/rmail/rmail.871
-rw-r--r--bin/rmail/rmail.c359
-rw-r--r--bin/rmdir/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/rmdir/rmdir.192
-rw-r--r--bin/rmdir/rmdir.c86
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/Makefile49
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/TOUR356
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/alias.c251
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/alias.h48
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/arith.y169
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/arith_lex.l86
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/bltin/bltin.h74
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/bltin/echo.1111
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/bltin/echo.c104
-rwxr-xr-xbin/sh/builtins90
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/cd.c372
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/errmsg.c127
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/errmsg.h47
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/error.c249
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/error.h113
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/eval.c933
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/eval.h65
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/exec.c828
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/exec.h75
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/expand.c1160
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/expand.h73
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/cmv49
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/dirs73
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/kill49
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/login38
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/newgrp37
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/popd73
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/pushd73
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/funcs/suspend41
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/histedit.c442
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/init.h47
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/input.c474
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/input.h78
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/jobs.c1046
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/jobs.h99
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/machdep.h51
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mail.c114
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mail.h43
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/main.c304
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/main.h48
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/memalloc.c292
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/memalloc.h95
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/miscbltin.c166
-rwxr-xr-xbin/sh/mkbuiltins87
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mkinit.c547
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mknodes.c431
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mksignames.c197
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mksyntax.c373
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mktokens94
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/myhistedit.h40
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mystring.c136
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/mystring.h54
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/nodes.c.pat177
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/nodetypes143
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/options.c433
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/options.h114
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/output.c554
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/output.h94
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/parser.c1363
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/parser.h80
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/redir.c343
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/redir.h56
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/sh.11307
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/shell.h84
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/show.c378
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/trap.c348
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/trap.h55
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/var.c670
-rw-r--r--bin/sh/var.h127
-rw-r--r--bin/sleep/Makefile5
-rw-r--r--bin/sleep/sleep.1116
-rw-r--r--bin/sleep/sleep.c80
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/cchar.c145
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/extern.h48
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/gfmt.c129
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/key.c299
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/modes.c230
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/print.c266
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/stty.1580
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/stty.c161
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/stty.h58
-rw-r--r--bin/stty/util.c64
-rw-r--r--bin/sync/Makefile6
-rw-r--r--bin/sync/sync.873
-rw-r--r--bin/sync/sync.c48
-rw-r--r--bin/test/Makefile8
-rw-r--r--bin/test/TEST.csh137
-rw-r--r--bin/test/operators.c148
-rw-r--r--bin/test/operators.h77
-rw-r--r--bin/test/test.1255
-rw-r--r--bin/test/test.c560
245 files changed, 75315 insertions, 0 deletions
diff --git a/bin/Makefile b/bin/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3ae43c4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+SUBDIR= cat chmod cp csh date dd df echo ed expr hostname kill ln ls \
+ mkdir mv pax ps pwd rcp rm rmail rmdir sh sleep stty sync test
+
+.include <bsd.subdir.mk>
diff --git a/bin/Makefile.inc b/bin/Makefile.inc
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b569b70
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/Makefile.inc
@@ -0,0 +1,3 @@
+# @(#)Makefile.inc 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+BINDIR?= /bin
diff --git a/bin/cat/Makefile b/bin/cat/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c2d7cb5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cat/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= cat
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/cat/cat.1 b/bin/cat/cat.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..102b22e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cat/cat.1
@@ -0,0 +1,121 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)cat.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/29/93
+.\"
+.Dd June 29, 1993
+.Dt CAT 1
+.Os BSD 3
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm cat
+.Nd concatenate and print files
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm cat
+.Op Fl benstuv
+.Op Fl
+.Op Ar
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm cat
+utility reads files sequentially, writing them to the standard output.
+The
+.Ar file
+operands are processed in command line order.
+A single dash represents the standard input.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Fl b
+Implies the
+.Fl n
+option but doesn't number blank lines.
+.It Fl e
+Implies the
+.Fl v
+option, and displays a dollar sign
+.Pq Ql \&$
+at the end of each line
+as well.
+.It Fl n
+Number the
+.Ar output
+lines, starting at 1.
+.It Fl s
+Squeeze multiple adjacent empty lines, causing the output to be
+single spaced.
+.It Fl t
+Implies the
+.Fl v
+option, and displays tab characters as
+.Pq Ql ^I
+as well.
+.It Fl u
+The
+.Fl u
+option guarantees that the output is unbuffered.
+.It Fl v
+Displays non-printing characters so they are visible.
+Control characters print as
+.Ql ^X
+for control-X; the delete
+character (octal 0177) prints as
+.Ql ^?
+Non-ascii characters (with the high bit set) are printed as
+.Ql M-
+(for meta) followed by the character for the low 7 bits.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm cat
+utility exits 0 on success, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh BUGS
+Because of the shell language mechanism used to perform output
+redirection, the command
+.Dq Li cat file1 file 2 > file1
+will cause the original data in file1 to be destroyed!
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr head 1 ,
+.Xr more 1 ,
+.Xr pr 1 ,
+.Xr tail 1
+.Rs
+.%A Rob Pike
+.%T "UNIX Style, or cat -v Considered Harmful"
+.%J "USENIX Summer Conference Proceedings"
+.%D 1983
+.Re
+.Sh HISTORY
+A
+.Nm
+command appeared in Version 6 AT&T UNIX.
diff --git a/bin/cat/cat.c b/bin/cat/cat.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..30e5bfc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cat/cat.c
@@ -0,0 +1,251 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kevin Fall.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1989, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cat.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 7/19/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+int bflag, eflag, nflag, sflag, tflag, vflag;
+int rval;
+char *filename;
+
+void cook_args __P((char *argv[]));
+void cook_buf __P((FILE *));
+void raw_args __P((char *argv[]));
+void raw_cat __P((int));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ extern int optind;
+ int ch;
+
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "benstuv")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'b':
+ bflag = nflag = 1; /* -b implies -n */
+ break;
+ case 'e':
+ eflag = vflag = 1; /* -e implies -v */
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ nflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ sflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ tflag = vflag = 1; /* -t implies -v */
+ break;
+ case 'u':
+ setbuf(stdout, (char *)NULL);
+ break;
+ case 'v':
+ vflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage: cat [-benstuv] [-] [file ...]\n");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (bflag || eflag || nflag || sflag || tflag || vflag)
+ cook_args(argv);
+ else
+ raw_args(argv);
+ if (fclose(stdout))
+ err(1, "stdout");
+ exit(rval);
+}
+
+void
+cook_args(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ register FILE *fp;
+
+ fp = stdin;
+ filename = "stdin";
+ do {
+ if (*argv) {
+ if (!strcmp(*argv, "-"))
+ fp = stdin;
+ else if ((fp = fopen(*argv, "r")) == NULL) {
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ ++argv;
+ continue;
+ }
+ filename = *argv++;
+ }
+ cook_buf(fp);
+ if (fp != stdin)
+ (void)fclose(fp);
+ } while (*argv);
+}
+
+void
+cook_buf(fp)
+ register FILE *fp;
+{
+ register int ch, gobble, line, prev;
+
+ line = gobble = 0;
+ for (prev = '\n'; (ch = getc(fp)) != EOF; prev = ch) {
+ if (prev == '\n') {
+ if (ch == '\n') {
+ if (sflag) {
+ if (!gobble && putchar(ch) == EOF)
+ break;
+ gobble = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (nflag && !bflag) {
+ (void)fprintf(stdout, "%6d\t", ++line);
+ if (ferror(stdout))
+ break;
+ }
+ } else if (nflag) {
+ (void)fprintf(stdout, "%6d\t", ++line);
+ if (ferror(stdout))
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ gobble = 0;
+ if (ch == '\n') {
+ if (eflag)
+ if (putchar('$') == EOF)
+ break;
+ } else if (ch == '\t') {
+ if (tflag) {
+ if (putchar('^') == EOF || putchar('I') == EOF)
+ break;
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if (vflag) {
+ if (!isascii(ch)) {
+ if (putchar('M') == EOF || putchar('-') == EOF)
+ break;
+ ch = toascii(ch);
+ }
+ if (iscntrl(ch)) {
+ if (putchar('^') == EOF ||
+ putchar(ch == '\177' ? '?' :
+ ch | 0100) == EOF)
+ break;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ if (putchar(ch) == EOF)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (ferror(fp)) {
+ warn("%s", filename);
+ clearerr(fp);
+ }
+ if (ferror(stdout))
+ err(1, "stdout");
+}
+
+void
+raw_args(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ register int fd;
+
+ fd = fileno(stdin);
+ filename = "stdin";
+ do {
+ if (*argv) {
+ if (!strcmp(*argv, "-"))
+ fd = fileno(stdin);
+ else if ((fd = open(*argv, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ ++argv;
+ continue;
+ }
+ filename = *argv++;
+ }
+ raw_cat(fd);
+ if (fd != fileno(stdin))
+ (void)close(fd);
+ } while (*argv);
+}
+
+void
+raw_cat(rfd)
+ register int rfd;
+{
+ register int nr, nw, off, wfd;
+ static int bsize;
+ static char *buf;
+ struct stat sbuf;
+
+ wfd = fileno(stdout);
+ if (buf == NULL) {
+ if (fstat(wfd, &sbuf))
+ err(1, "%s", filename);
+ bsize = MAX(sbuf.st_blksize, 1024);
+ if ((buf = malloc((u_int)bsize)) == NULL)
+ err(1, "");
+ }
+ while ((nr = read(rfd, buf, bsize)) > 0)
+ for (off = 0; nr; nr -= nw, off += nw)
+ if ((nw = write(wfd, buf + off, nr)) < 0)
+ err(1, "stdout");
+ if (nr < 0)
+ warn("%s", filename);
+}
diff --git a/bin/chmod/Makefile b/bin/chmod/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f28bcfe
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/chmod/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= chmod
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/chmod/chmod.1 b/bin/chmod/chmod.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ce92124
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/chmod/chmod.1
@@ -0,0 +1,294 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)chmod.1 8.4 (Berkeley) 3/31/94
+.\"
+.Dd March 31, 1994
+.Dt CHMOD 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm chmod
+.Nd change file modes
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm chmod
+.Oo
+.Fl R
+.Op Fl H | Fl L | Fl P
+.Oc
+.Ar mode
+.Ar file ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm chmod
+utility modifies the file mode bits of the listed files
+as specified by the
+.Ar mode
+operand.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Fl H
+If the
+.Fl R
+option is specified, symbolic links on the command line are followed.
+(Symbolic links encountered in the tree traversal are not followed.)
+.It Fl L
+If the
+.Fl R
+option is specified, all symbolic links are followed.
+.It Fl P
+If the
+.Fl R
+option is specified, no symbolic links are followed.
+.It Fl R
+Change the modes of the file hierarchies rooted in the files
+instead of just the files themselves.
+.El
+.Pp
+Symbolic links do not have modes, so unless the
+.Fl H
+or
+.Fl L
+option is set,
+.Nm chmod
+on a symbolic link always succeeds and has no effect.
+The
+.Fl H ,
+.Fl L
+and
+.Fl P
+options are ignored unless the
+.Fl R
+option is specified.
+In addition, these options override each other and the
+command's actions are determined by the last one specified.
+.Pp
+Only the owner of a file or the super-user is permitted to change
+the mode of a file.
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm chmod
+utility exits 0 on success, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh MODES
+Modes may be absolute or symbolic.
+An absolute mode is an octal number constructed by
+.Ar or-ing
+the following values:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width 6n -compact -offset indent
+.It Li 4000
+set-user-ID-on-execution
+.It Li 2000
+set-group-ID-on-execution
+.It Li 1000
+sticky bit, see chmod(2)
+.It Li 0400
+read by owner
+.It Li 0200
+write by owner
+.It Li 0100
+execute (or search for directories) by owner
+.It Li 0070
+read, write, execute/search by group
+.It Li 0007
+read, write, execute/search by others
+.El
+.Pp
+The read, write, and execute/search values for group and others
+are encoded as described for owner.
+.Pp
+The symbolic mode is described by the following grammar:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+mode ::= clause [, clause ...]
+clause ::= [who ...] [action ...] last_action
+action ::= op [perm ...]
+last_action ::= op [perm ...]
+who ::= a | u | g | o
+op ::= + | \- | =
+perm ::= r | s | t | w | x | X | u | g | o
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar who
+symbols ``u'', ``g'', and ``o'' specify the user, group, and other parts
+of the mode bits, respectively.
+The
+.Ar who
+symbol ``a'' is equivalent to ``ugo''.
+.Pp
+.ne 1i
+The
+.Ar perm
+symbols represent the portions of the mode bits as follows:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It r
+The read bits.
+.It s
+The set-user-ID-on-execution and set-group-ID-on-execution bits.
+.It t
+The sticky bit.
+.It w
+The write bits.
+.It x
+The execute/search bits.
+.It X
+The execute/search bits if the file is a directory or any of the
+execute/search bits are set in the original (unmodified) mode.
+Operations with the
+.Ar perm
+symbol ``X'' are only meaningful in conjunction with the
+.Ar op
+symbol ``+'', and are ignored in all other cases.
+.It u
+The user permission bits in the mode of the original file.
+.It g
+The group permission bits in the mode of the original file.
+.It o
+The other permission bits in the mode of the original file.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar op
+symbols represent the operation performed, as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width 4n
+.It +
+If no value is supplied for
+.Ar perm ,
+the ``+'' operation has no effect.
+If no value is supplied for
+.Ar who ,
+each permission bit specified in
+.Ar perm ,
+for which the corresponding bit in the file mode creation mask
+is clear, is set.
+Otherwise, the mode bits represented by the specified
+.Ar who
+and
+.Ar perm
+values are set.
+.It \&\-
+If no value is supplied for
+.Ar perm ,
+the ``\-'' operation has no effect.
+If no value is supplied for
+.Ar who ,
+each permission bit specified in
+.Ar perm ,
+for which the corresponding bit in the file mode creation mask
+is clear, is cleared.
+Otherwise, the mode bits represented by the specified
+.Ar who
+and
+.Ar perm
+values are cleared.
+.It =
+The mode bits specified by the
+.Ar who
+value are cleared, or, if no who value is specified, the owner, group
+and other mode bits are cleared.
+Then, if no value is supplied for
+.Ar who ,
+each permission bit specified in
+.Ar perm ,
+for which the corresponding bit in the file mode creation mask
+is clear, is set.
+Otherwise, the mode bits represented by the specified
+.Ar who
+and
+.Ar perm
+values are set.
+.El
+.Pp
+Each
+.Ar clause
+specifies one or more operations to be performed on the mode
+bits, and each operation is applied to the mode bits in the
+order specified.
+.Pp
+Operations upon the other permissions only (specified by the symbol
+``o'' by itself), in combination with the
+.Ar perm
+symbols ``s'' or ``t'', are ignored.
+.Sh EXAMPLES
+.Bl -tag -width "u=rwx,go=u-w" -compact
+.It Li 644
+make a file readable by anyone and writable by the owner only.
+.Pp
+.It Li go-w
+deny write permission to group and others.
+.Pp
+.It Li =rw,+X
+set the read and write permissions to the usual defaults, but
+retain any execute permissions that are currently set.
+.Pp
+.It Li +X
+make a directory or file searchable/executable by everyone if it is
+already searchable/executable by anyone.
+.Pp
+.It Li 755
+.It Li u=rwx,go=rx
+.It Li u=rwx,go=u-w
+make a file readable/executable by everyone and writable by the owner only.
+.Pp
+.It Li go=
+clear all mode bits for group and others.
+.Pp
+.It Li g=u-w
+set the group bits equal to the user bits, but clear the group write bit.
+.El
+.Sh BUGS
+There's no
+.Ar perm
+option for the naughty bits.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr install 1 ,
+.Xr chmod 2 ,
+.Xr stat 2 ,
+.Xr umask 2 ,
+.Xr fts 3 ,
+.Xr setmode 3 ,
+.Xr symlink 7 ,
+.Xr chown 8
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm chmod
+utility is expected to be POSIX 1003.2
+compatible with the exception of the
+.Ar perm
+symbols
+.Dq t
+and
+.Dq X
+which are not included in that standard.
diff --git a/bin/chmod/chmod.c b/bin/chmod/chmod.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f6251a3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/chmod/chmod.c
@@ -0,0 +1,201 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)chmod.c 8.8 (Berkeley) 4/1/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ FTS *ftsp;
+ FTSENT *p;
+ mode_t *set;
+ long val;
+ int oct, omode;
+ int Hflag, Lflag, Pflag, Rflag, ch, fflag, fts_options, hflag, rval;
+ char *ep, *mode;
+
+ Hflag = Lflag = Pflag = Rflag = fflag = hflag = 0;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "HLPRXfgorstuwx")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'H':
+ Hflag = 1;
+ Lflag = Pflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'L':
+ Lflag = 1;
+ Hflag = Pflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'P':
+ Pflag = 1;
+ Hflag = Lflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'R':
+ Rflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'f': /* XXX: undocumented. */
+ fflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'h':
+ /*
+ * In System V (and probably POSIX.2) the -h option
+ * causes chmod to change the mode of the symbolic
+ * link. 4.4BSD's symbolic links don't have modes,
+ * so it's an undocumented noop. Do syntax checking,
+ * though.
+ */
+ hflag = 1;
+ break;
+ /*
+ * XXX
+ * "-[rwx]" are valid mode commands. If they are the entire
+ * argument, getopt has moved past them, so decrement optind.
+ * Regardless, we're done argument processing.
+ */
+ case 'g': case 'o': case 'r': case 's':
+ case 't': case 'u': case 'w': case 'X': case 'x':
+ if (argv[optind - 1][0] == '-' &&
+ argv[optind - 1][1] == ch &&
+ argv[optind - 1][2] == '\0')
+ --optind;
+ goto done;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+done: argv += optind;
+ argc -= optind;
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ usage();
+
+ fts_options = FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ if (Rflag) {
+ if (hflag)
+ errx(1,
+ "the -R and -h options may not be specified together.");
+ if (Hflag)
+ fts_options |= FTS_COMFOLLOW;
+ if (Lflag) {
+ fts_options &= ~FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ fts_options |= FTS_LOGICAL;
+ }
+ }
+
+ mode = *argv;
+ if (*mode >= '0' && *mode <= '7') {
+ errno = 0;
+ val = strtol(mode, &ep, 8);
+ if (val > INT_MAX || val < 0)
+ errno = ERANGE;
+ if (errno)
+ err(1, "invalid file mode: %s", mode);
+ if (*ep)
+ errx(1, "invalid file mode: %s", mode);
+ omode = val;
+ oct = 1;
+ } else {
+ if ((set = setmode(mode)) == NULL)
+ errx(1, "invalid file mode: %s", mode);
+ oct = 0;
+ }
+
+ if ((ftsp = fts_open(++argv, fts_options, 0)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ for (rval = 0; (p = fts_read(ftsp)) != NULL;) {
+ switch (p->fts_info) {
+ case FTS_D:
+ if (Rflag) /* Change it at FTS_DP. */
+ continue;
+ fts_set(ftsp, p, FTS_SKIP);
+ break;
+ case FTS_DNR: /* Warn, chmod, continue. */
+ warnx("%s: %s", p->fts_path, strerror(p->fts_errno));
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ case FTS_ERR: /* Warn, continue. */
+ case FTS_NS:
+ warnx("%s: %s", p->fts_path, strerror(p->fts_errno));
+ rval = 1;
+ continue;
+ case FTS_SL: /* Ignore. */
+ case FTS_SLNONE:
+ /*
+ * The only symlinks that end up here are ones that
+ * don't point to anything and ones that we found
+ * doing a physical walk.
+ */
+ continue;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ if (chmod(p->fts_accpath, oct ? omode :
+ getmode(set, p->fts_statp->st_mode)) && !fflag) {
+ warn(p->fts_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ if (errno)
+ err(1, "fts_read");
+ exit(rval);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage: chmod [-R [-H | -L | -P]] mode file ...\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/cp/Makefile b/bin/cp/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ad07b68
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cp/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= cp
+SRCS= cp.c utils.c
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/cp/cp.1 b/bin/cp/cp.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f04d37b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cp/cp.1
@@ -0,0 +1,211 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)cp.1 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt CP 1
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm cp
+.Nd copy files
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm cp
+.Oo
+.Fl R
+.Op Fl H | Fl L | Fl P
+.Oc
+.Op Fl fip
+.Ar source_file target_file
+.Nm cp
+.Oo
+.Fl R
+.Op Fl H | Fl L | Fl P
+.Oc
+.Op Fl fip
+.Ar source_file ... target_directory
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+In the first synopsis form, the
+.Nm cp
+utility copies the contents of the
+.Ar source_file
+to the
+.Ar target_file .
+In the second synopsis form,
+the contents of each named
+.Ar source_file
+is copied to the destination
+.Ar target_directory .
+The names of the files themselves are not changed.
+If
+.Nm cp
+detects an attempt to copy a file to itself, the copy will fail.
+.Pp
+The following options are available:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl H
+If the
+.Fl R
+option is specified, symbolic links on the command line are followed.
+(Symbolic links encountered in the tree traversal are not followed.)
+.It Fl L
+If the
+.Fl R
+option is specified, all symbolic links are followed.
+.It Fl P
+If the
+.Fl R
+option is specified, no symbolic links are followed.
+.It Fl R
+If
+.Ar source_file
+designates a directory,
+.Nm cp
+copies the directory and the entire subtree connected at that point.
+This option also causes symbolic links to be copied, rather than
+indirected through, and for
+.Nm cp
+to create special files rather than copying them as normal files.
+Created directories have the same mode as the corresponding source
+directory, unmodified by the process' umask.
+.It Fl f
+For each existing destination pathname, remove it and
+create a new file, without prompting for confirmation
+regardless of its permissions.
+(The
+.Fl i
+option is ignored if the
+.Fl f
+option is specified.)
+.It Fl i
+Causes
+.Nm cp
+to write a prompt to the standard error output before copying a file
+that would overwrite an existing file.
+If the response from the standard input begins with the character
+.Sq Li y ,
+the file copy is attempted.
+.It Fl p
+Causes
+.Nm cp
+to preserve in the copy as many of the modification time, access time,
+file flags, file mode, user ID, and group ID as allowed by permissions.
+.Pp
+If the user ID and group ID cannot be preserved, no error message
+is displayed and the exit value is not altered.
+.Pp
+If the source file has its set user ID bit on and the user ID cannot
+be preserved, the set user ID bit is not preserved
+in the copy's permissions.
+If the source file has its set group ID bit on and the group ID cannot
+be preserved, the set group ID bit is not preserved
+in the copy's permissions.
+If the source file has both its set user ID and set group ID bits on,
+and either the user ID or group ID cannot be preserved, neither
+the set user ID or set group ID bits are preserved in the copy's
+permissions.
+.El
+.Pp
+For each destination file that already exists, its contents are
+overwritten if permissions allow, but its mode, user ID, and group
+ID are unchanged.
+.Pp
+In the second synopsis form,
+.Ar target_directory
+must exist unless there is only one named
+.Ar source_file
+which is a directory and the
+.Fl R
+flag is specified.
+.Pp
+If the destination file does not exist, the mode of the source file is
+used as modified by the file mode creation mask
+.Pf ( Ic umask ,
+see
+.Xr csh 1 ) .
+If the source file has its set user ID bit on, that bit is removed
+unless both the source file and the destination file are owned by the
+same user.
+If the source file has its set group ID bit on, that bit is removed
+unless both the source file and the destination file are in the same
+group and the user is a member of that group.
+If both the set user ID and set group ID bits are set, all of the above
+conditions must be fulfilled or both bits are removed.
+.Pp
+Appropriate permissions are required for file creation or overwriting.
+.Pp
+Symbolic links are always followed unless the
+.Fl R
+flag is set, in which case symbolic links are not followed, by default.
+The
+.Fl H
+or
+.Fl L
+flags (in conjunction with the
+.Fl R
+flag) cause symbolic links to be followed as described above.
+The
+.Fl H ,
+.Fl L
+and
+.Fl P
+options are ignored unless the
+.Fl R
+option is specified.
+In addition, these options override each other and the
+command's actions are determined by the last one specified.
+.Pp
+.Nm Cp
+exits 0 on success, >0 if an error occurred.
+.Sh COMPATIBILITY
+Historic versions of the
+.Nm cp
+utility had a
+.Fl r
+option.
+This implementation supports that option, however, its use is strongly
+discouraged, as it does not correctly copy special files, symbolic links
+or fifo's.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr mv 1 ,
+.Xr rcp 1 ,
+.Xr umask 2 ,
+.Xr fts 3 ,
+.Xr symlink 7
+.Sh HISTORY
+The
+.Nm cp
+command is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/cp/cp.c b/bin/cp/cp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b58bb99
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cp/cp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,441 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * David Hitz of Auspex Systems Inc.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1988, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cp.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/1/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Cp copies source files to target files.
+ *
+ * The global PATH_T structure "to" always contains the path to the
+ * current target file. Since fts(3) does not change directories,
+ * this path can be either absolute or dot-realative.
+ *
+ * The basic algorithm is to initialize "to" and use fts(3) to traverse
+ * the file hierarchy rooted in the argument list. A trivial case is the
+ * case of 'cp file1 file2'. The more interesting case is the case of
+ * 'cp file1 file2 ... fileN dir' where the hierarchy is traversed and the
+ * path (relative to the root of the traversal) is appended to dir (stored
+ * in "to") to form the final target path.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/mman.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#define STRIP_TRAILING_SLASH(p) { \
+ while ((p).p_end > (p).p_path && (p).p_end[-1] == '/') \
+ *--(p).p_end = 0; \
+}
+
+PATH_T to = { to.p_path, "" };
+
+uid_t myuid;
+int Rflag, iflag, pflag, rflag;
+int myumask;
+
+enum op { FILE_TO_FILE, FILE_TO_DIR, DIR_TO_DNE };
+
+int copy __P((char *[], enum op, int));
+int mastercmp __P((const FTSENT **, const FTSENT **));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct stat to_stat, tmp_stat;
+ enum op type;
+ int Hflag, Lflag, Pflag, ch, fts_options, r;
+ char *target;
+
+ Hflag = Lflag = Pflag = Rflag = 0;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "HLPRfipr")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'H':
+ Hflag = 1;
+ Lflag = Pflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'L':
+ Lflag = 1;
+ Hflag = Pflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'P':
+ Pflag = 1;
+ Hflag = Lflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'R':
+ Rflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ iflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'i':
+ iflag = isatty(fileno(stdin));
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ pflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ rflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ usage();
+
+ fts_options = FTS_NOCHDIR | FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ if (rflag) {
+ if (Rflag)
+ errx(1,
+ "the -R and -r options may not be specified together.");
+ if (Hflag || Lflag || Pflag)
+ errx(1,
+ "the -H, -L, and -P options may not be specified with the -r option.");
+ fts_options &= ~FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ fts_options |= FTS_LOGICAL;
+ }
+ if (Rflag) {
+ if (Hflag)
+ fts_options |= FTS_COMFOLLOW;
+ if (Lflag) {
+ fts_options &= ~FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ fts_options |= FTS_LOGICAL;
+ }
+ } else {
+ fts_options &= ~FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ fts_options |= FTS_LOGICAL;
+ }
+
+ myuid = getuid();
+
+ /* Copy the umask for explicit mode setting. */
+ myumask = umask(0);
+ (void)umask(myumask);
+
+ /* Save the target base in "to". */
+ target = argv[--argc];
+ if (strlen(target) > MAXPATHLEN)
+ errx(1, "%s: name too long", target);
+ (void)strcpy(to.p_path, target);
+ to.p_end = to.p_path + strlen(to.p_path);
+ if (to.p_path == to.p_end) {
+ *to.p_end++ = '.';
+ *to.p_end = 0;
+ }
+ STRIP_TRAILING_SLASH(to);
+ to.target_end = to.p_end;
+
+ /* Set end of argument list for fts(3). */
+ argv[argc] = NULL;
+
+ /*
+ * Cp has two distinct cases:
+ *
+ * cp [-R] source target
+ * cp [-R] source1 ... sourceN directory
+ *
+ * In both cases, source can be either a file or a directory.
+ *
+ * In (1), the target becomes a copy of the source. That is, if the
+ * source is a file, the target will be a file, and likewise for
+ * directories.
+ *
+ * In (2), the real target is not directory, but "directory/source".
+ */
+ r = stat(to.p_path, &to_stat);
+ if (r == -1 && errno != ENOENT)
+ err(1, "%s", to.p_path);
+ if (r == -1 || !S_ISDIR(to_stat.st_mode)) {
+ /*
+ * Case (1). Target is not a directory.
+ */
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ usage();
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ /*
+ * Need to detect the case:
+ * cp -R dir foo
+ * Where dir is a directory and foo does not exist, where
+ * we want pathname concatenations turned on but not for
+ * the initial mkdir().
+ */
+ if (r == -1) {
+ if (rflag || (Rflag && (Lflag || Hflag)))
+ stat(*argv, &tmp_stat);
+ else
+ lstat(*argv, &tmp_stat);
+
+ if (S_ISDIR(tmp_stat.st_mode) && (Rflag || rflag))
+ type = DIR_TO_DNE;
+ else
+ type = FILE_TO_FILE;
+ } else
+ type = FILE_TO_FILE;
+ } else
+ /*
+ * Case (2). Target is a directory.
+ */
+ type = FILE_TO_DIR;
+
+ exit (copy(argv, type, fts_options));
+}
+
+int
+copy(argv, type, fts_options)
+ char *argv[];
+ enum op type;
+ int fts_options;
+{
+ struct stat to_stat;
+ FTS *ftsp;
+ FTSENT *curr;
+ int base, dne, nlen, rval;
+ char *p;
+
+ if ((ftsp = fts_open(argv, fts_options, mastercmp)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ for (rval = 0; (curr = fts_read(ftsp)) != NULL;) {
+ switch (curr->fts_info) {
+ case FTS_NS:
+ case FTS_ERR:
+ warnx("%s: %s",
+ curr->fts_path, strerror(curr->fts_errno));
+ rval = 1;
+ continue;
+ case FTS_DC: /* Warn, continue. */
+ warnx("%s: directory causes a cycle", curr->fts_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ continue;
+ case FTS_DP: /* Ignore, continue. */
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If we are in case (2) or (3) above, we need to append the
+ * source name to the target name.
+ */
+ if (type != FILE_TO_FILE) {
+ if ((curr->fts_namelen +
+ to.target_end - to.p_path + 1) > MAXPATHLEN) {
+ warnx("%s/%s: name too long (not copied)",
+ to.p_path, curr->fts_name);
+ rval = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Need to remember the roots of traversals to create
+ * correct pathnames. If there's a directory being
+ * copied to a non-existent directory, e.g.
+ * cp -R a/dir noexist
+ * the resulting path name should be noexist/foo, not
+ * noexist/dir/foo (where foo is a file in dir), which
+ * is the case where the target exists.
+ *
+ * Also, check for "..". This is for correct path
+ * concatentation for paths ending in "..", e.g.
+ * cp -R .. /tmp
+ * Paths ending in ".." are changed to ".". This is
+ * tricky, but seems the easiest way to fix the problem.
+ *
+ * XXX
+ * Since the first level MUST be FTS_ROOTLEVEL, base
+ * is always initialized.
+ */
+ if (curr->fts_level == FTS_ROOTLEVEL)
+ if (type != DIR_TO_DNE) {
+ p = strrchr(curr->fts_path, '/');
+ base = (p == NULL) ? 0 :
+ (int)(p - curr->fts_path + 1);
+
+ if (!strcmp(&curr->fts_path[base],
+ ".."))
+ base += 1;
+ } else
+ base = curr->fts_pathlen;
+
+ if (to.target_end[-1] != '/') {
+ *to.target_end = '/';
+ *(to.target_end + 1) = 0;
+ }
+ p = &curr->fts_path[base];
+ nlen = curr->fts_pathlen - base;
+
+ (void)strncat(to.target_end + 1, p, nlen);
+ to.p_end = to.target_end + nlen + 1;
+ *to.p_end = 0;
+ STRIP_TRAILING_SLASH(to);
+ }
+
+ /* Not an error but need to remember it happened */
+ if (stat(to.p_path, &to_stat) == -1)
+ dne = 1;
+ else {
+ if (to_stat.st_dev == curr->fts_statp->st_dev &&
+ to_stat.st_ino == curr->fts_statp->st_ino) {
+ warnx("%s and %s are identical (not copied).",
+ to.p_path, curr->fts_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ if (S_ISDIR(curr->fts_statp->st_mode))
+ (void)fts_set(ftsp, curr, FTS_SKIP);
+ continue;
+ }
+ dne = 0;
+ }
+
+ switch (curr->fts_statp->st_mode & S_IFMT) {
+ case S_IFLNK:
+ if (copy_link(curr, !dne))
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ case S_IFDIR:
+ if (!Rflag && !rflag) {
+ warnx("%s is a directory (not copied).",
+ curr->fts_path);
+ (void)fts_set(ftsp, curr, FTS_SKIP);
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ /*
+ * If the directory doesn't exist, create the new
+ * one with the from file mode plus owner RWX bits,
+ * modified by the umask. Trade-off between being
+ * able to write the directory (if from directory is
+ * 555) and not causing a permissions race. If the
+ * umask blocks owner writes, we fail..
+ */
+ if (dne) {
+ if (mkdir(to.p_path,
+ curr->fts_statp->st_mode | S_IRWXU) < 0)
+ err(1, "%s", to.p_path);
+ } else if (!S_ISDIR(to_stat.st_mode)) {
+ errno = ENOTDIR;
+ err(1, "%s: %s", to.p_path);
+ }
+ /*
+ * If not -p and directory didn't exist, set it to be
+ * the same as the from directory, umodified by the
+ * umask; arguably wrong, but it's been that way
+ * forever.
+ */
+ if (pflag && setfile(curr->fts_statp, 0))
+ rval = 1;
+ else if (dne)
+ (void)chmod(to.p_path,
+ curr->fts_statp->st_mode);
+ break;
+ case S_IFBLK:
+ case S_IFCHR:
+ if (Rflag) {
+ if (copy_special(curr->fts_statp, !dne))
+ rval = 1;
+ } else
+ if (copy_file(curr, dne))
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ case S_IFIFO:
+ if (Rflag)
+ if (copy_fifo(curr->fts_statp, !dne))
+ rval = 1;
+ else
+ if (copy_file(curr, dne))
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (copy_file(curr, dne))
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (errno)
+ err(1, "fts_read");
+ return (rval);
+}
+
+/*
+ * mastercmp --
+ * The comparison function for the copy order. The order is to copy
+ * non-directory files before directory files. The reason for this
+ * is because files tend to be in the same cylinder group as their
+ * parent directory, whereas directories tend not to be. Copying the
+ * files first reduces seeking.
+ */
+int
+mastercmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT **a, **b;
+{
+ int a_info, b_info;
+
+ a_info = (*a)->fts_info;
+ if (a_info == FTS_ERR || a_info == FTS_NS || a_info == FTS_DNR)
+ return (0);
+ b_info = (*b)->fts_info;
+ if (b_info == FTS_ERR || b_info == FTS_NS || b_info == FTS_DNR)
+ return (0);
+ if (a_info == FTS_D)
+ return (-1);
+ if (b_info == FTS_D)
+ return (1);
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/cp/extern.h b/bin/cp/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6c7c6e2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cp/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/1/94
+ */
+
+typedef struct {
+ char *p_end; /* pointer to NULL at end of path */
+ char *target_end; /* pointer to end of target base */
+ char p_path[MAXPATHLEN + 1]; /* pointer to the start of a path */
+} PATH_T;
+
+extern PATH_T to;
+extern uid_t myuid;
+extern int iflag, pflag, myumask;
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+
+__BEGIN_DECLS
+int copy_fifo __P((struct stat *, int));
+int copy_file __P((FTSENT *, int));
+int copy_link __P((FTSENT *, int));
+int copy_special __P((struct stat *, int));
+int setfile __P((struct stat *, int));
+void usage __P((void));
+__END_DECLS
diff --git a/bin/cp/utils.c b/bin/cp/utils.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5a5edcb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/cp/utils.c
@@ -0,0 +1,285 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)utils.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/1/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/mman.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "extern.h"
+
+int
+copy_file(entp, dne)
+ FTSENT *entp;
+ int dne;
+{
+ static char buf[MAXBSIZE];
+ struct stat to_stat, *fs;
+ int ch, checkch, from_fd, rcount, rval, to_fd, wcount;
+#ifdef VM_AND_BUFFER_CACHE_SYNCHRONIZED
+ char *p;
+#endif
+
+ if ((from_fd = open(entp->fts_path, O_RDONLY, 0)) == -1) {
+ warn("%s", entp->fts_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+
+ fs = entp->fts_statp;
+
+ /*
+ * If the file exists and we're interactive, verify with the user.
+ * If the file DNE, set the mode to be the from file, minus setuid
+ * bits, modified by the umask; arguably wrong, but it makes copying
+ * executables work right and it's been that way forever. (The
+ * other choice is 666 or'ed with the execute bits on the from file
+ * modified by the umask.)
+ */
+ if (!dne) {
+ if (iflag) {
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "overwrite %s? ", to.p_path);
+ checkch = ch = getchar();
+ while (ch != '\n' && ch != EOF)
+ ch = getchar();
+ if (checkch != 'y') {
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+ to_fd = open(to.p_path, O_WRONLY | O_TRUNC, 0);
+ } else
+ to_fd = open(to.p_path, O_WRONLY | O_TRUNC | O_CREAT,
+ fs->st_mode & ~(S_ISUID | S_ISGID));
+
+ if (to_fd == -1) {
+ warn("%s", to.p_path);
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+ return (1);;
+ }
+
+ rval = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * Mmap and write if less than 8M (the limit is so we don't totally
+ * trash memory on big files. This is really a minor hack, but it
+ * wins some CPU back.
+ */
+#ifdef VM_AND_BUFFER_CACHE_SYNCHRONIZED
+ if (fs->st_size <= 8 * 1048576) {
+ if ((p = mmap(NULL, (size_t)fs->st_size, PROT_READ,
+ 0, from_fd, (off_t)0)) == (char *)-1) {
+ warn("%s", entp->fts_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ } else {
+ if (write(to_fd, p, fs->st_size) != fs->st_size) {
+ warn("%s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ /* Some systems don't unmap on close(2). */
+ if (munmap(p, fs->st_size) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", entp->fts_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ } else
+#endif
+ {
+ while ((rcount = read(from_fd, buf, MAXBSIZE)) > 0) {
+ wcount = write(to_fd, buf, rcount);
+ if (rcount != wcount || wcount == -1) {
+ warn("%s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (rcount < 0) {
+ warn("%s", entp->fts_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If the copy went bad, lose the file. */
+ if (rval == 1) {
+ (void)unlink(to.p_path);
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+ (void)close(to_fd);
+ return (1);
+ }
+
+ if (pflag && setfile(fs, to_fd))
+ rval = 1;
+ /*
+ * If the source was setuid or setgid, lose the bits unless the
+ * copy is owned by the same user and group.
+ */
+#define RETAINBITS \
+ (S_ISUID | S_ISGID | S_ISVTX | S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO)
+ else if (fs->st_mode & (S_ISUID | S_ISGID) && fs->st_uid == myuid)
+ if (fstat(to_fd, &to_stat)) {
+ warn("%s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ } else if (fs->st_gid == to_stat.st_gid &&
+ fchmod(to_fd, fs->st_mode & RETAINBITS & ~myumask)) {
+ warn("%s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+ if (close(to_fd)) {
+ warn("%s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ return (rval);
+}
+
+int
+copy_link(p, exists)
+ FTSENT *p;
+ int exists;
+{
+ int len;
+ char link[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ if ((len = readlink(p->fts_path, link, sizeof(link))) == -1) {
+ warn("readlink: %s", p->fts_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ link[len] = '\0';
+ if (exists && unlink(to.p_path)) {
+ warn("unlink: %s", to.p_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (symlink(link, to.p_path)) {
+ warn("symlink: %s", link);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+copy_fifo(from_stat, exists)
+ struct stat *from_stat;
+ int exists;
+{
+ if (exists && unlink(to.p_path)) {
+ warn("unlink: %s", to.p_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (mkfifo(to.p_path, from_stat->st_mode)) {
+ warn("mkfifo: %s", to.p_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (pflag ? setfile(from_stat, 0) : 0);
+}
+
+int
+copy_special(from_stat, exists)
+ struct stat *from_stat;
+ int exists;
+{
+ if (exists && unlink(to.p_path)) {
+ warn("unlink: %s", to.p_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (mknod(to.p_path, from_stat->st_mode, from_stat->st_rdev)) {
+ warn("mknod: %s", to.p_path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (pflag ? setfile(from_stat, 0) : 0);
+}
+
+
+int
+setfile(fs, fd)
+ register struct stat *fs;
+ int fd;
+{
+ static struct timeval tv[2];
+ int rval;
+
+ rval = 0;
+ fs->st_mode &= S_ISUID | S_ISGID | S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO;
+
+ TIMESPEC_TO_TIMEVAL(&tv[0], &fs->st_atimespec);
+ TIMESPEC_TO_TIMEVAL(&tv[1], &fs->st_mtimespec);
+ if (utimes(to.p_path, tv)) {
+ warn("utimes: %s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ /*
+ * Changing the ownership probably won't succeed, unless we're root
+ * or POSIX_CHOWN_RESTRICTED is not set. Set uid/gid before setting
+ * the mode; current BSD behavior is to remove all setuid bits on
+ * chown. If chown fails, lose setuid/setgid bits.
+ */
+ if (fd ? fchown(fd, fs->st_uid, fs->st_gid) :
+ chown(to.p_path, fs->st_uid, fs->st_gid)) {
+ if (errno != EPERM) {
+ warn("chown: %s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ fs->st_mode &= ~(S_ISUID | S_ISGID);
+ }
+ if (fd ? fchmod(fd, fs->st_mode) : chmod(to.p_path, fs->st_mode)) {
+ warn("chown: %s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+
+ if (fd ?
+ fchflags(fd, fs->st_flags) : chflags(to.p_path, fs->st_flags)) {
+ warn("chflags: %s", to.p_path);
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ return (rval);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s\n%s\n",
+"usage: cp [-R [-H | -L | -P] [-fip] src target",
+" cp [-R [-H | -L | -P] [-fip] src1 ... srcN directory");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/Makefile b/bin/csh/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e29f549
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,44 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+#
+# C Shell with process control; VM/UNIX VAX Makefile
+# Bill Joy UC Berkeley; Jim Kulp IIASA, Austria
+#
+# To profile, put -DPROF in DEFS and -pg in CFLAGS, and recompile.
+
+PROG= csh
+DFLAGS=-DBUILTIN -DFILEC -DNLS -DSHORT_STRINGS
+#CFLAGS+=-g
+#CFLAGS+=-Wall -ansi -pedantic
+CFLAGS+=-I${.CURDIR} -I. ${DFLAGS}
+SRCS= alloc.c char.c const.c csh.c dir.c dol.c err.c exec.c exp.c file.c \
+ func.c glob.c hist.c init.c lex.c misc.c parse.c printf.c proc.c \
+ sem.c set.c str.c time.c
+.PATH: ${.CURDIR}/../../usr.bin/printf
+
+MAN1= csh.0
+MLINKS= csh.1 limit.1 csh.1 alias.1 csh.1 bg.1 csh.1 dirs.1 csh.1 fg.1 \
+ csh.1 foreach.1 csh.1 history.1 csh.1 jobs.1 csh.1 popd.1 \
+ csh.1 pushd.1 csh.1 rehash.1 csh.1 repeat.1 csh.1 suspend.1 \
+ csh.1 stop.1 csh.1 source.1
+CLEANFILES+=err.h const.h
+
+const.h: err.h
+
+err.h: err.c
+ @rm -f $@
+ @echo '/* Do not edit this file, make creates it. */' > $@
+ @echo '#ifndef _h_sh_err' >> $@
+ @echo '#define _h_sh_err' >> $@
+ egrep 'ERR_' ${.CURDIR}/$*.c | egrep '^#define' >> $@
+ @echo '#endif /* _h_sh_err */' >> $@
+
+const.h: const.c
+ @rm -f $@
+ @echo '/* Do not edit this file, make creates it. */' > $@
+ ${CC} -E ${CFLAGS} ${.CURDIR}/$*.c | egrep 'Char STR' | \
+ sed -e 's/Char \([a-zA-Z0-9_]*\)\(.*\)/extern Char \1[];/' | \
+ sort >> $@
+
+.depend: const.h err.h
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/Makefile b/bin/csh/USD.doc/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e73be63
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,7 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 8/14/93
+
+DIR= usd/04.csh
+SRCS= tabs csh.1 csh.2 csh.3 csh.4 csh.a csh.g
+MACROS= -ms
+
+.include <bsd.doc.mk>
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.1 b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9b8e394
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.1
@@ -0,0 +1,1012 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.EH 'USD:4-%''An Introduction to the C shell'
+.OH 'An Introduction to the C shell''USD:4-%'
+.\".RP
+.TL
+An Introduction to the C shell
+.AU
+William Joy
+(revised for 4.3BSD by Mark Seiden)
+.AI
+Computer Science Division
+.br
+Department of Electrical Engineering and Computer Science
+.br
+University of California, Berkeley
+.br
+Berkeley, California 94720
+.AB
+.I Csh
+is a new command language interpreter for
+.UX
+systems.
+It incorporates good features of other shells and a
+.I history
+mechanism similar to the
+.I redo
+of \s-2INTERLISP\s0.
+While incorporating many features of other shells which make
+writing shell programs (shell scripts) easier,
+most of the features unique to
+.I csh
+are designed more for the interactive \s-2UNIX\s0 user.
+.PP
+\s-2UNIX\s0
+users who have read a general introduction to the system
+will find a valuable basic explanation of the shell here.
+Simple terminal interaction with
+.I csh
+is possible after reading just the first section of this document.
+The second section describes the shell's capabilities which you can
+explore after you have begun to become acquainted with the shell.
+Later sections introduce features which are useful, but not necessary
+for all users of the shell.
+.PP
+Additional information includes an appendix listing special characters of the shell
+and a glossary of terms and commands introduced in this manual.
+.AE
+.SH
+.if n .ND
+Introduction
+.PP
+A
+.I shell
+is a command language interpreter.
+.I Csh
+is the name of one particular command interpreter on
+\s-2UNIX\s0.
+The primary purpose of
+.I csh
+is to translate command lines typed at a terminal into
+system actions, such as invocation of other programs.
+.I Csh
+is a user program just like any you might write.
+Hopefully,
+.I csh
+will be a very useful program for you
+in interacting with the \s-2UNIX\s0 system.
+.PP
+In addition to this document, you will want to refer to a copy
+of the \s-2UNIX\s0 User Reference Manual.
+The
+.I csh
+documentation in section 1 of the manual provides a full description of all
+features of the shell and is the definitive reference for questions
+about the shell.
+.PP
+Many words in this document are shown in
+.I italics.
+These are important words;
+names of commands, and words which have special meaning in discussing
+the shell and \s-2UNIX\s0.
+Many of the words are defined in a glossary at the end of this document.
+If you don't know what is meant by a word, you should look
+for it in the glossary.
+.SH
+Acknowledgements
+.PP
+Numerous people have provided good input about previous versions
+of
+.I csh
+and aided in its debugging and in the debugging of its documentation.
+I would especially like to thank Michael Ubell
+who made the crucial observation that history commands could be
+done well over the word structure of input text, and implemented
+a prototype history mechanism in an older version of the shell.
+Eric Allman has also provided a large number of useful comments on the
+shell, helping to unify those concepts which are present and to identify
+and eliminate useless and marginally useful features.
+Mike O'Brien suggested the pathname hashing
+mechanism which speeds command execution.
+Jim Kulp added the job control and directory stack primitives and
+added their documentation to this introduction.
+.br
+.bp
+.NH
+Terminal usage of the shell
+.NH 2
+The basic notion of commands
+.PP
+A
+.I shell
+in
+\s-2UNIX\s0
+acts mostly as a medium through which other
+.I programs
+are invoked.
+While it has a set of
+.I builtin
+functions which it performs directly,
+most commands cause execution of programs that are, in fact,
+external to the shell.
+The shell is thus distinguished from the command interpreters of other
+systems both by the fact that it is just a user program, and by the fact
+that it is used almost exclusively as a mechanism for invoking other programs.
+.PP
+.I Commands
+in the \s-2UNIX\s0 system consist of a list of strings or
+.I words
+interpreted as a
+.I "command name"
+followed by
+.I arguments.
+Thus the command
+.DS
+mail bill
+.DE
+consists of two words.
+The first word
+.I mail
+names the command to be executed, in this case the
+mail program which sends messages to other users.
+The shell uses the name of the command in attempting to execute it for you.
+It will look in a number of
+.I directories
+for a file with the name
+.I mail
+which is expected to contain the mail program.
+.PP
+The rest of the words of the command are given as
+.I arguments
+to the command itself when it is executed.
+In this case we specified also the argument
+.I bill
+which is interpreted by the
+.I mail
+program to be the name of a user to whom mail is to be sent.
+In normal terminal usage we might use the
+.I mail
+command as follows.
+.DS
+% mail bill
+I have a question about the csh documentation.
+My document seems to be missing page 5.
+Does a page five exist?
+ Bill
+EOT
+%
+.DE
+.PP
+Here we typed a message to send to
+.I bill
+and ended this message with a ^D which sent an end-of-file to
+the mail program.
+(Here and throughout this document, the notation ``^\fIx\fR''
+is to be read ``control-\fIx\fR'' and represents the striking of the \fIx\fR
+key while the control key is held down.)
+The mail program
+then echoed the characters `EOT' and transmitted our message.
+The characters `% ' were printed before and after the mail command
+by the shell to indicate that input was needed.
+.PP
+After typing the `% ' prompt the shell was reading command input from
+our terminal.
+We typed a complete command `mail bill'.
+The shell then executed the
+.I mail
+program with argument
+.I bill
+and went dormant waiting for it to complete.
+The mail program then read input from our terminal until we signalled
+an end-of-file via typing a ^D after which the shell noticed
+that mail had completed
+and signaled us that it was ready to read from the terminal again by
+printing another `% ' prompt.
+.PP
+This is the essential pattern of all interaction with \s-2UNIX\s0
+through the shell.
+A complete command is typed at the terminal, the shell executes
+the command and when this execution completes, it prompts for a new command.
+If you run the editor for an hour, the shell will patiently wait for
+you to finish editing and obediently prompt you again whenever you finish
+editing.
+.PP
+An example of a useful command you can execute now is the
+.I tset
+command, which sets the default
+.I erase
+and
+.I kill
+characters on your terminal \- the erase character erases the last
+character you typed and the kill character erases the entire line you
+have entered so far.
+By default, the erase character is the delete key (equivalent to `^?')
+and the kill character is `^U'. Some people prefer to make the erase character
+the backspace key (equivalent to `^H').
+You can make this be true by typing
+.DS
+tset \-e
+.DE
+which tells the program
+.I tset
+to set the erase character to tset's default setting for this character
+(a backspace).
+.NH 2
+Flag arguments
+.PP
+A useful notion in \s-2UNIX\s0 is that of a
+.I flag
+argument.
+While many arguments to commands specify file names or user names,
+some arguments rather specify an optional capability of the command
+which you wish to invoke.
+By convention, such arguments begin with the character `\-' (hyphen).
+Thus the command
+.DS
+ls
+.DE
+will produce a list of the files in the current
+.I "working directory" .
+The option
+.I \-s
+is the size option, and
+.DS
+ls \-s
+.DE
+causes
+.I ls
+to also give, for each file the size of the file in blocks of 512
+characters.
+The manual section for each command in the \s-2UNIX\s0 reference manual
+gives the available options for each command.
+The
+.I ls
+command has a large number of useful and interesting options.
+Most other commands have either no options or only one or two options.
+It is hard to remember options of commands which are not used very
+frequently, so most \s-2UNIX\s0 utilities perform only one or two functions
+rather than having a large number of hard to remember options.
+.NH 2
+Output to files
+.PP
+Commands that normally read input or write output on the terminal
+can also be executed with this input and/or output done to
+a file.
+.PP
+Thus suppose we wish to save the current date in a file called `now'.
+The command
+.DS
+date
+.DE
+will print the current date on our terminal.
+This is because our terminal is the default
+.I "standard output"
+for the date command and the date command prints the date on its
+standard output.
+The shell lets us
+.I redirect
+the
+.I "standard output"
+of a command through a
+notation using the
+.I metacharacter
+`>' and the name of the file where output is to be placed.
+Thus the command
+.DS
+date > now
+.DE
+runs the
+.I date
+command such that its standard output is
+the file `now' rather than the terminal.
+Thus this command places the current date and time into the file `now'.
+It is important to know that the
+.I date
+command was unaware that its output was going to a file rather than
+to the terminal.
+The shell performed this
+.I redirection
+before the command began executing.
+.PP
+One other thing to note here is that the file `now'
+need not have existed before the
+.I date
+command was executed; the shell would have created the file if it did
+not exist.
+And if the file did exist?
+If it had existed previously these previous contents would have been discarded!
+A shell option
+.I noclobber
+exists to prevent this from happening accidentally;
+it is discussed in section 2.2.
+.PP
+The system normally keeps files which you create with `>' and all other files.
+Thus the default is for files to be permanent. If you wish to create a file
+which will be removed automatically, you can begin its name with a `#'
+character, this `scratch' character denotes the fact that the file will
+be a scratch file.*
+.FS
+*Note that if your erase character is a `#', you will have to precede the
+`#' with a `\e'. The fact that the `#' character is the old (pre-\s-2CRT\s0)
+standard erase character means that it seldom appears in a file name, and
+allows this convention to be used for scratch files. If you are using a
+\s-2CRT\s0, your erase character should be a ^H, as we demonstrated
+in section 1.1 how this could be set up.
+.FE
+The system will remove such files after a couple of days,
+or sooner if file space becomes very tight.
+Thus, in running the
+.I date
+command above, we don't really want to save the output forever, so we
+would more likely do
+.DS
+date > #now
+.DE
+.NH 2
+Metacharacters in the shell
+.PP
+The shell has a large number of
+special characters (like `>')
+which indicate special functions.
+We say that these notations have
+.I syntactic
+and
+.I semantic
+meaning to the shell.
+In general, most characters which are neither letters nor digits
+have special meaning to the shell.
+We shall shortly learn a means of
+.I quotation
+which allows us to use
+.I metacharacters
+without the shell treating them in any special way.
+.PP
+Metacharacters normally have effect only when the shell is reading
+our input.
+We need not worry about placing shell metacharacters in a letter
+we are sending via
+.I mail,
+or when we are typing in text or data to some other program.
+Note that the shell is only reading input when it has prompted with
+`% ' (although we can type our input even before it prompts).
+.NH 2
+Input from files; pipelines
+.PP
+We learned above how to
+.I redirect
+the
+.I "standard output"
+of a command
+to a file.
+It is also possible to redirect the
+.I "standard input"
+of a command from a file.
+This is not often necessary since most commands will read from
+a file whose name is given as an argument.
+We can give the command
+.DS
+sort < data
+.DE
+to run the
+.I sort
+command with standard input, where the command normally
+reads its input, from the file
+`data'.
+We would more likely say
+.DS
+sort data
+.DE
+letting the
+.I sort
+command open the file
+`data'
+for input itself since this is less to type.
+.PP
+We should note that if we just typed
+.DS
+sort
+.DE
+then the sort program would sort lines from its
+.I "standard input."
+Since we did not
+.I redirect
+the standard input, it would sort lines as we typed them on the terminal
+until we typed a ^D to indicate an end-of-file.
+.PP
+A most useful capability is the ability to combine the standard output
+of one command with the standard input of another, i.e. to run the
+commands in a sequence known as a
+.I pipeline.
+For instance the command
+.DS
+ls \-s
+.DE
+normally produces a list of the files in our directory with the size
+of each in blocks of 512 characters.
+If we are interested in learning which of our files is largest we
+may wish to have this sorted by size rather than by name, which is
+the default way in which
+.I ls
+sorts.
+We could look at the many options of
+.I ls
+to see if there was an option to do this but would eventually discover
+that there is not.
+Instead we can use a couple of simple options of the
+.I sort
+command, combining it with
+.I ls
+to get what we want.
+.PP
+The
+.I \-n
+option of sort specifies a numeric sort rather than an alphabetic sort.
+Thus
+.DS
+ls \-s | sort \-n
+.DE
+specifies that the output of the
+.I ls
+command run with the option
+.I \-s
+is to be
+.I piped
+to the command
+.I sort
+run with the numeric sort option.
+This would give us a sorted list of our files by size, but with the
+smallest first.
+We could then use the
+.I \-r
+reverse sort option and the
+.I head
+command in combination with the previous command doing
+.DS
+ls \-s | sort \-n \-r | head \-5
+.DE
+Here we have taken a list of our files sorted alphabetically,
+each with the size in blocks.
+We have run this to the standard input of the
+.I sort
+command asking it to sort numerically in reverse order (largest first).
+This output has then been run into the command
+.I head
+which gives us the first few lines.
+In this case we have asked
+.I head
+for the first 5 lines.
+Thus this command gives us the names and sizes of our 5 largest files.
+.PP
+The notation introduced above is called the
+.I pipe
+mechanism.
+Commands separated by `\||\|' characters are connected together by the
+shell and the standard output of each is run into the standard input of the
+next.
+The leftmost command in a pipeline will normally take its standard
+input from the terminal and the rightmost will place its standard
+output on the terminal.
+Other examples of pipelines will be given later when we discuss the
+history mechanism;
+one important use of pipes which is illustrated there is in the
+routing of information to the line printer.
+.NH 2
+Filenames
+.PP
+Many commands to be executed will need the names of files as arguments.
+\s-2UNIX\s0
+.I pathnames
+consist of a number of
+.I components
+separated by `/'.
+Each component except the last names a directory in which the next
+component resides, in effect specifying the
+.I path
+of directories to follow to reach the file.
+Thus the pathname
+.DS
+/etc/motd
+.DE
+specifies a file in the directory
+`etc'
+which is a subdirectory of the
+.I root
+directory `/'.
+Within this directory the file named is `motd' which stands
+for `message of the day'.
+A
+.I pathname
+that begins with a slash is said to be an
+.I absolute
+pathname since it is specified from the absolute top of the entire
+directory hierarchy of the system (the
+.I root ).
+.I Pathnames
+which do not begin with `/' are interpreted as starting in the current
+.I "working directory" ,
+which is, by default, your
+.I home
+directory and can be changed dynamically by the
+.I cd
+change directory command.
+Such pathnames are said to be
+.I relative
+to the working directory since they are found by starting
+in the working directory and descending to lower levels of directories
+for each
+.I component
+of the pathname. If the pathname contains no slashes at all then the
+file is contained in the working directory itself and the pathname is merely
+the name of the file in this directory.
+Absolute pathnames have no relation
+to the working directory.
+.PP
+Most filenames consist of a number of alphanumeric characters and
+`.'s (periods).
+In fact, all printing characters except `/' (slash) may appear in filenames.
+It is inconvenient to have most non-alphabetic characters in filenames
+because many of these have special meaning to the shell.
+The character `.' (period) is not a shell-metacharacter and is often used
+to separate the
+.I extension
+of a file name from the base of the name.
+Thus
+.DS
+prog.c prog.o prog.errs prog.output
+.DE
+are four related files.
+They share a
+.I base
+portion of a name
+(a base portion being that part of the name that is left when a trailing
+`.' and following characters which are not `.' are stripped off).
+The file
+`prog.c'
+might be the source for a C program,
+the file `prog.o' the corresponding object file,
+the file
+`prog.errs' the errors resulting from a compilation of the program
+and the file
+`prog.output' the output of a run of the program.
+.PP
+If we wished to refer to all four of these files in a command, we could
+use the notation
+.DS
+prog.*
+.DE
+This expression is expanded by the shell, before the command to which it is
+an argument is executed, into a list of names which begin with `prog.'.
+The character `*' here matches any sequence (including the empty sequence)
+of characters in a file name.
+The names which match are alphabetically sorted and placed in the
+.I "argument list"
+of the command.
+Thus the command
+.DS
+echo prog.*
+.DE
+will echo the names
+.DS
+prog.c prog.errs prog.o prog.output
+.DE
+Note that the names are in sorted order here, and a different
+order than we listed them above.
+The
+.I echo
+command receives four words as arguments, even though we only typed
+one word as as argument directly.
+The four words were generated by
+.I "filename expansion"
+of the one input word.
+.PP
+Other notations for
+.I "filename expansion"
+are also available.
+The character `?' matches any single character in a filename.
+Thus
+.DS
+echo ? \|?? \|???
+.DE
+will echo a line of filenames; first those with one character names,
+then those with two character names, and finally those with three
+character names.
+The names of each length will be independently sorted.
+.PP
+Another mechanism consists of a sequence of characters between `[' and `]'.
+This metasequence matches any single character from the enclosed set.
+Thus
+.DS
+prog.[co]
+.DE
+will match
+.DS
+prog.c prog.o
+.DE
+in the example above.
+We can also place two characters around a `\-' in this notation to denote
+a range.
+Thus
+.DS
+chap.[1\-5]
+.DE
+might match files
+.DS
+chap.1 chap.2 chap.3 chap.4 chap.5
+.DE
+if they existed.
+This is shorthand for
+.DS
+chap.[12345]
+.DE
+and otherwise equivalent.
+.PP
+An important point to note is that if a list of argument words to
+a command (an
+.I "argument list)"
+contains filename expansion syntax, and if this filename expansion syntax
+fails to match any existing file names, then the shell considers this
+to be an error and prints a diagnostic
+.DS
+No match.
+.DE
+and does not execute the command.
+.PP
+Another very important point is that files with the character `.' at the
+beginning are treated specially.
+Neither `*' or `?' or the `[' `]' mechanism will match it.
+This prevents accidental matching of the filenames `.' and `..'
+in the working directory which have special meaning to the system,
+as well as other files such as
+.I \&.cshrc
+which are not normally
+visible.
+We will discuss the special role of the file
+.I \&.cshrc
+later.
+.PP
+Another filename expansion mechanism gives access to the pathname of
+the
+.I home
+directory of other users.
+This notation consists of the character `~' (tilde) followed by another user's
+login name.
+For instance the word `~bill' would map to the pathname `/usr/bill'
+if the home directory for `bill' was `/usr/bill'.
+Since, on large systems, users may have login directories scattered over
+many different disk volumes with different prefix directory names,
+this notation provides a convenient way of accessing the files
+of other users.
+.PP
+A special case of this notation consists of a `~' alone, e.g. `~/mbox'.
+This notation is expanded by the shell into the file `mbox' in your
+.I home
+directory, i.e. into `/usr/bill/mbox' for me on Ernie Co-vax, the UCB
+Computer Science Department VAX machine, where this document was prepared.
+This can be very useful if you have used
+.I cd
+to change to another directory and have found a file you wish to
+copy using
+.I cp.
+If I give the command
+.DS
+cp thatfile ~
+.DE
+the shell will expand this command to
+.DS
+cp thatfile /usr/bill
+.DE
+since my home directory is /usr/bill.
+.PP
+There also exists a mechanism using the characters `{' and `}' for
+abbreviating a set of words which have common parts but cannot
+be abbreviated by the above mechanisms because they are not files,
+are the names of files which do not yet exist,
+are not thus conveniently described.
+This mechanism will be described much later,
+in section 4.2,
+as it is used less frequently.
+.NH 2
+Quotation
+.PP
+We have already seen a number of metacharacters used by the shell.
+These metacharacters pose a problem in that we cannot use them directly
+as parts of words.
+Thus the command
+.DS
+echo *
+.DE
+will not echo the character `*'.
+It will either echo an sorted list of filenames in the
+current
+.I "working directory,"
+or print the message `No match' if there are
+no files in the working directory.
+.PP
+The recommended mechanism for placing characters which are neither numbers,
+digits, `/', `.' or `\-' in an argument word to a command is to enclose
+it with single quotation characters `\'', i.e.
+.DS
+echo \'*\'
+.DE
+There is one special character `!' which is used by the
+.I history
+mechanism of the shell and which cannot be
+.I escaped
+by placing it within `\'' characters.
+It and the character `\'' itself can be preceded by a single `\e'
+to prevent their special meaning.
+Thus
+.DS
+echo \e\'\e!
+.DE
+prints
+.DS
+\'!
+.DE
+These two mechanisms suffice to place any printing character into a word
+which is an argument to a shell command. They can be combined, as in
+.DS
+echo \e\'\'*\'
+.DE
+which prints
+.DS
+\'*
+.DE
+since the first `\e' escaped the first `\'' and the `*' was enclosed
+between `\'' characters.
+.NH 2
+Terminating commands
+.PP
+When you are executing a command and the shell is
+waiting for it to complete there are several ways
+to force it to stop.
+For instance if you type the command
+.DS
+cat /etc/passwd
+.DE
+the system will print a copy of a list of all users of the system
+on your terminal.
+This is likely to continue for several minutes unless you stop it.
+You can send an
+\s-2INTERRUPT\s0
+.I signal
+to the
+.I cat
+command by typing ^C on your terminal.*
+.FS
+*On some older Unix systems the \s-2DEL\s0 or \s-2RUBOUT\s0 key
+has the same effect. "stty all" will tell you the INTR key value.
+.FE
+Since
+.I cat
+does not take any precautions to avoid or otherwise handle this signal
+the
+\s-2INTERRUPT\s0
+will cause it to terminate.
+The shell notices that
+.I cat
+has terminated and prompts you again with `% '.
+If you hit \s-2INTERRUPT\s0 again, the shell will just
+repeat its prompt since it handles \s-2INTERRUPT\s0 signals
+and chooses to continue to execute commands rather than terminating
+like
+.I cat
+did, which would have the effect of logging you out.
+.PP
+Another way in which many programs terminate is when they get an end-of-file
+from their standard input.
+Thus the
+.I mail
+program in the first example above was terminated when we typed a ^D
+which generates an end-of-file from the standard input.
+The shell also terminates when it gets an end-of-file printing `logout';
+\s-2UNIX\s0 then logs you off the system.
+Since this means that typing too many ^D's can accidentally log us off,
+the shell has a mechanism for preventing this.
+This
+.I ignoreeof
+option will be discussed in section 2.2.
+.PP
+If a command has its standard input redirected from a file, then it will
+normally terminate when it reaches the end of this file.
+Thus if we execute
+.DS
+mail bill < prepared.text
+.DE
+the mail command will terminate without our typing a ^D.
+This is because it read to the end-of-file of our file
+`prepared.text' in which we placed a message for `bill' with an editor program.
+We could also have done
+.DS
+cat prepared.text \||\| mail bill
+.DE
+since the
+.I cat
+command would then have written the text through the pipe to the
+standard input of the mail command.
+When the
+.I cat
+command completed it would have terminated,
+closing down the pipeline
+and the
+.I mail
+command would have received an end-of-file from it and terminated.
+Using a pipe here is more complicated than redirecting input
+so we would more likely use the first form.
+These commands could also have been stopped by sending an \s-2INTERRUPT\s0.
+.PP
+Another possibility for stopping a command is to suspend its execution
+temporarily, with the possibility of continuing execution later. This is
+done by sending a \s-2STOP\s0 signal via typing a ^Z.
+This signal causes all commands running on the terminal
+(usually one but more if a pipeline is executing) to become suspended.
+The shell notices that the command(s) have been suspended, types
+`Stopped' and then prompts for a new command.
+The previously executing command has been suspended, but otherwise
+unaffected by the \s-2STOP\s0 signal. Any other commands can be executed
+while the original command remains suspended. The suspended command can
+be continued using the
+.I fg
+command with no arguments. The shell will then retype the command
+to remind you which command is being continued, and cause the command
+to resume execution. Unless any input files in use by the suspended
+command have been changed in the meantime, the suspension has no effect
+whatsoever on the execution of the command. This feature can be very useful
+during editing, when you need to look at another file before continuing. An
+example of command suspension follows.
+.DS
+% mail harold
+Someone just copied a big file into my directory and its name is
+^Z
+Stopped
+% ls
+funnyfile
+prog.c
+prog.o
+% jobs
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] + Stopped mail harold
+% fg
+mail harold
+funnyfile. Do you know who did it?
+EOT
+%
+.so tabs
+.DE
+In this example someone was sending a message to Harold and forgot the
+name of the file he wanted to mention. The mail command was suspended
+by typing ^Z. When the shell noticed that the mail program was
+suspended, it typed `Stopped' and prompted for a new command. Then the
+.I ls
+command was typed to find out the name of the file. The
+.I jobs
+command was run to find out which command was suspended. At this time the
+.I fg
+command was typed to continue execution of the mail program. Input
+to the mail program was then continued and ended with a ^D
+which indicated the end of the message at which time the mail
+program typed EOT. The
+.I jobs
+command will show which commands are suspended.
+The ^Z should only be typed at the beginning of a line since
+everything typed on the current line is discarded when a signal is sent
+from the keyboard. This also happens on \s-2INTERRUPT\s0, and \s-2QUIT\s0
+signals. More information on
+suspending jobs and controlling them is given in
+section 2.6.
+.PP
+If you write or run programs which are not fully debugged then it may
+be necessary to stop them somewhat ungracefully.
+This can be done by sending them a \s-2QUIT\s0
+signal, sent by typing a ^\e.
+This will usually provoke the shell to produce a message like:
+.DS
+Quit (Core dumped)
+.DE
+indicating that a file
+`core' has been created containing information about the running program's
+state when it terminated due to the \s-2QUIT\s0 signal.
+You can examine this file yourself, or forward information to the
+maintainer of the program telling him/her where the
+.I "core file"
+is.
+.PP
+If you run background commands (as explained in section 2.6) then these
+commands will ignore \s-2INTERRUPT\s0 and \s-2QUIT\s0 signals at the
+terminal. To stop them you must use the
+.I kill
+command. See section 2.6 for an example.
+.PP
+If you want to examine the output of a command without having it move
+off the screen as the output of the
+.DS
+cat /etc/passwd
+.DE
+command will, you can use the command
+.DS
+more /etc/passwd
+.DE
+The
+.I more
+program pauses after each complete screenful and types `\-\-More\-\-'
+at which point you can hit a space to get another screenful, a return
+to get another line, a `?' to get some help on other commands, or a `q' to end the
+.I more
+program. You can also use more as a filter, i.e.
+.DS
+cat /etc/passwd | more
+.DE
+works just like the more simple more command above.
+.PP
+For stopping output of commands not involving
+.I more
+you can use the
+^S key to stop the typeout. The typeout will resume when you
+hit ^Q or any other key, but ^Q is normally used because
+it only restarts the output and does not become input to the program
+which is running. This works well on low-speed terminals, but at 9600
+baud it is hard to type ^S and ^Q fast enough to paginate
+the output nicely, and a program like
+.I more
+is usually used.
+.PP
+An additional possibility is to use the ^O flush output
+character; when this character is typed, all output from the current
+command is thrown away (quickly) until the next input read occurs
+or until the next shell prompt. This can be used to allow a command
+to complete without having to suffer through the output on a slow
+terminal; ^O is a toggle, so flushing can be turned off by
+typing ^O again while output is being flushed.
+.NH 2
+What now?
+.PP
+We have so far seen a number of mechanisms of the shell and learned a lot
+about the way in which it operates.
+The remaining sections will go yet further into the internals of the
+shell, but you will surely want to try using the
+shell before you go any further.
+To try it you can log in to \s-2UNIX\s0 and type the following
+command to the system:
+.DS
+chsh myname /bin/csh
+.DE
+Here `myname' should be replaced by the name you typed to
+the system prompt of `login:' to get onto the system.
+Thus I would use `chsh bill /bin/csh'.
+.B
+You only have to do this once; it takes effect at next login.
+.R
+You are now ready to try using
+.I csh.
+.PP
+Before you do the `chsh' command, the shell you are using when
+you log into the system is `/bin/sh'.
+In fact, much of the above discussion is applicable to `/bin/sh'.
+The next section will introduce many features particular to
+.I csh
+so you should change your shell to
+.I csh
+before you begin reading it.
+.bp
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.2 b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.2
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..610105c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.2
@@ -0,0 +1,1305 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.2 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.nr H1 1
+.NH
+Details on the shell for terminal users
+.NH 2
+Shell startup and termination
+.PP
+When you login, the shell is started by the system in your
+.I home
+directory and begins by reading commands from a file
+.I \&.cshrc
+in this directory.
+All shells which you may start during your terminal session will
+read from this file.
+We will later see what kinds of commands are usefully placed there.
+For now we need not have this file and the shell does not complain about
+its absence.
+.PP
+A
+.I "login shell" ,
+executed after you login to the system,
+will, after it reads commands from
+.I \&.cshrc,
+read commands from a file
+.I \&.login
+also in your home directory.
+This file contains commands which you wish to do each time you login
+to the \s-2UNIX\s0 system.
+My
+.I \&.login
+file looks something like:
+.DS
+set ignoreeof
+set mail=(/usr/spool/mail/bill)
+echo "${prompt}users" ; users
+alias ts \e
+ \'set noglob ; eval \`tset \-s \-m dialup:c100rv4pna \-m plugboard:?hp2621nl \!*\`\';
+ts; stty intr ^C kill ^U crt
+set time=15 history=10
+msgs \-f
+if (\-e $mail) then
+ echo "${prompt}mail"
+ mail
+endif
+.DE
+.PP
+This file contains several commands to be executed by \s-2UNIX\s0
+each time I login.
+The first is a
+.I set
+command which is interpreted directly by the shell. It sets the shell
+variable
+.I ignoreeof
+which causes the shell to not log me off if I hit ^D. Rather,
+I use the
+.I logout
+command to log off of the system.
+By setting the
+.I mail
+variable, I ask the shell to watch for incoming mail to me. Every 5 minutes
+the shell looks for this file and tells me if more mail has arrived there.
+An alternative to this is to put the command
+.DS
+biff y
+.DE
+in place of this
+.I set;
+this will cause me to be notified immediately when mail arrives, and to
+be shown the first few lines of the new message.
+.PP
+Next I set the shell variable `time' to `15' causing the shell to automatically
+print out statistics lines for commands which execute for at least 15 seconds
+of \s-2CPU\s+2 time. The variable `history' is set to 10 indicating that
+I want the shell to remember the last 10 commands I type in its
+.I "history list" ,
+(described later).
+.PP
+I create an
+.I alias
+``ts'' which executes a
+\fItset\fR\|(1) command setting up the modes of the terminal.
+The parameters to
+.I tset
+indicate the kinds of terminal which I usually use when not on a hardwired
+port. I then execute ``ts'' and also use the
+.I stty
+command to change the interrupt character to ^C and the line kill
+character to ^U.
+.PP
+I then run the `msgs' program, which provides me with any
+system messages which I have not seen before; the `\-f' option here prevents
+it from telling me anything if there are no new messages.
+Finally, if my mailbox file exists, then I run the `mail' program to
+process my mail.
+.PP
+When the `mail' and `msgs' programs finish, the shell will finish
+processing my
+.I \&.login
+file and begin reading commands from the terminal, prompting for each with
+`% '.
+When I log off (by giving the
+.I logout
+command) the shell
+will print `logout' and execute commands from the file `.logout'
+if it exists in my home directory.
+After that the shell will terminate and \s-2UNIX\s0 will log
+me off the system.
+If the system is not going down, I will receive a new login message.
+In any case, after the `logout' message the shell is committed to terminating
+and will take no further input from my terminal.
+.NH 2
+Shell variables
+.PP
+The shell maintains a set of
+.I variables.
+We saw above the variables
+.I history
+and
+.I time
+which had values `10' and `15'.
+In fact, each shell variable has as value an array of
+zero or more
+.I strings.
+Shell variables may be assigned values by the set command. It has
+several forms, the most useful of which was given above and is
+.DS
+set name=value
+.DE
+.PP
+Shell variables may be used to store values which are to
+be used in commands later through a substitution mechanism.
+The shell variables most commonly referenced are, however, those which the
+shell itself refers to.
+By changing the values of these variables one can directly affect the
+behavior of the shell.
+.PP
+One of the most important variables is the variable
+.I path.
+This variable contains a sequence of directory names where the shell
+searches for commands.
+The
+.I set
+command with no arguments
+shows the value of all variables currently defined (we usually say
+.I set)
+in the shell.
+The default value for path will be shown by
+.I set
+to be
+.DS
+% set
+.ta .75i
+argv ()
+cwd /usr/bill
+home /usr/bill
+path (. /usr/ucb /bin /usr/bin)
+prompt %
+shell /bin/csh
+status 0
+term c100rv4pna
+user bill
+%
+.so tabs
+.DE
+This output indicates that the variable path points to the current
+directory `.' and then `/usr/ucb', `/bin' and `/usr/bin'.
+Commands which you may write might be in `.' (usually one of
+your directories).
+Commands developed at Berkeley, live in `/usr/ucb'
+while commands developed at Bell Laboratories live in `/bin' and `/usr/bin'.
+.PP
+A number of locally developed programs on the system live in the directory
+`/usr/local'.
+If we wish that all shells which we invoke to have
+access to these new programs we can place the command
+.DS
+set path=(. /usr/ucb /bin /usr/bin /usr/local)
+.DE
+in our file
+.I \&.cshrc
+in our home directory.
+Try doing this and then logging out and back in and do
+.DS
+set
+.DE
+again to see that the value assigned to
+.I path
+has changed.
+.FS \(dg
+Another directory that might interest you is /usr/new, which contains
+many useful user-contributed programs provided with Berkeley Unix.
+.FE
+.PP
+One thing you should be aware of is that the shell examines each directory
+which you insert into your path and determines which commands are contained
+there. Except for the current directory `.', which the shell treats specially,
+this means that if commands are added to a directory in your search path after
+you have started the shell, they will not necessarily be found by the shell.
+If you wish to use a command which has been added in this way, you should
+give the command
+.DS
+rehash
+.DE
+to the shell, which will cause it to recompute its internal table of command
+locations, so that it will find the newly added command.
+Since the shell has to look in the current directory `.' on each command,
+placing it at the end of the path specification usually works equivalently
+and reduces overhead.
+.PP
+Other useful built in variables are the variable
+.I home
+which shows your home directory,
+.I cwd
+which contains your current working directory,
+the variable
+.I ignoreeof
+which can be set in your
+.I \&.login
+file to tell the shell not to exit when it receives an end-of-file from
+a terminal (as described above).
+The variable `ignoreeof'
+is one of several variables which the shell does not care about the
+value of, only whether they are
+.I set
+or
+.I unset.
+Thus to set this variable you simply do
+.DS
+set ignoreeof
+.DE
+and to unset it do
+.DS
+unset ignoreeof
+.DE
+These give the variable `ignoreeof' no value, but none is desired or required.
+.PP
+Finally, some other built-in shell variables of use are the
+variables
+.I noclobber
+and
+.I mail.
+The metasyntax
+.DS
+> filename
+.DE
+which redirects the standard output of a command
+will overwrite and destroy the previous contents of the named file.
+In this way you may accidentally overwrite a file which is valuable.
+If you would prefer that the shell not overwrite files in this
+way you can
+.DS
+set noclobber
+.DE
+in your
+.I \&.login
+file.
+Then trying to do
+.DS
+date > now
+.DE
+would cause a diagnostic if `now' existed already.
+You could type
+.DS
+date >! now
+.DE
+if you really wanted to overwrite the contents of `now'.
+The `>!' is a special metasyntax indicating that clobbering the
+file is ok.\(dg
+.FS
+\(dgThe space between the `!' and the word `now' is critical here, as `!now'
+would be an invocation of the
+.I history
+mechanism, and have a totally different effect.
+.FE
+.NH 2
+The shell's history list
+.PP
+The shell can maintain a
+.I "history list"
+into which it places the words
+of previous commands.
+It is possible to use a notation to reuse commands or words
+from commands in forming new commands.
+This mechanism can be used to repeat previous commands or to
+correct minor typing mistakes in commands.
+.PP
+The following figure gives a sample session involving typical usage of the
+history mechanism of the shell.
+.KF
+.DS
+% cat bug.c
+main()
+
+{
+ printf("hello);
+}
+% cc !$
+cc bug.c
+"bug.c", line 4: newline in string or char constant
+"bug.c", line 5: syntax error
+% ed !$
+ed bug.c
+29
+4s/);/"&/p
+ printf("hello");
+w
+30
+q
+% !c
+cc bug.c
+% a.out
+hello% !e
+ed bug.c
+30
+4s/lo/lo\e\en/p
+ printf("hello\en");
+w
+32
+q
+% !c \-o bug
+cc bug.c \-o bug
+% size a.out bug
+a.out: 2784+364+1028 = 4176b = 0x1050b
+bug: 2784+364+1028 = 4176b = 0x1050b
+% ls \-l !*
+ls \-l a.out bug
+\(mirwxr\(mixr\(mix 1 bill 3932 Dec 19 09:41 a.out
+\(mirwxr\(mixr\(mix 1 bill 3932 Dec 19 09:42 bug
+% bug
+hello
+% num bug.c | spp
+spp: Command not found.
+% ^spp^ssp
+num bug.c | ssp
+ 1 main()
+ 3 {
+ 4 printf("hello\en");
+ 5 }
+% !! | lpr
+num bug.c | ssp | lpr
+%
+.DE
+.KE
+In this example we have a very simple C program which has a bug (or two)
+in it in the file `bug.c', which we `cat' out on our terminal. We then
+try to run the C compiler on it, referring to the file again as `!$',
+meaning the last argument to the previous command. Here the `!' is the
+history mechanism invocation metacharacter, and the `$' stands for the last
+argument, by analogy to `$' in the editor which stands for the end of the line.
+The shell echoed the command, as it would have been typed without use of
+the history mechanism, and then executed it.
+The compilation yielded error diagnostics so we now run the editor on the
+file we were trying to compile, fix the bug, and run the C compiler again,
+this time referring to this command simply as `!c', which repeats the last
+command which started with the letter `c'. If there were other
+commands starting with `c' done recently we could have said `!cc' or even
+`!cc:p' which would have printed the last command starting with `cc'
+without executing it.
+.PP
+After this recompilation, we ran the resulting `a.out' file, and then
+noting that there still was a bug, ran the editor again. After fixing
+the program we ran the C compiler again, but tacked onto the command
+an extra `\-o bug' telling the compiler to place the resultant binary in
+the file `bug' rather than `a.out'. In general, the history mechanisms
+may be used anywhere in the formation of new commands and other characters
+may be placed before and after the substituted commands.
+.PP
+We then ran the `size' command to see how large the binary program images
+we have created were, and then an `ls \-l' command with the same argument
+list, denoting the argument list `\!*'.
+Finally we ran the program `bug' to see that its output is indeed correct.
+.PP
+To make a numbered listing of the program we ran the `num' command on the file `bug.c'.
+In order to compress out blank lines in the output of `num' we ran the
+output through the filter `ssp', but misspelled it as spp. To correct this
+we used a shell substitute, placing the old text and new text between `^'
+characters. This is similar to the substitute command in the editor.
+Finally, we repeated the same command with `!!', but sent its output to the
+line printer.
+.PP
+There are other mechanisms available for repeating commands. The
+.I history
+command prints out a number of previous commands with numbers by which
+they can be referenced. There is a way to refer to a previous command
+by searching for a string which appeared in it, and there are other,
+less useful, ways to select arguments to include in a new command.
+A complete description of all these mechanisms
+is given in the C shell manual pages in the \s-2UNIX\s0 Programmer's Manual.
+.NH 2
+Aliases
+.PP
+The shell has an
+.I alias
+mechanism which can be used to make transformations on input commands.
+This mechanism can be used to simplify the commands you type,
+to supply default arguments to commands,
+or to perform transformations on commands and their arguments.
+The alias facility is similar to a macro facility.
+Some of the features obtained by aliasing can be obtained also
+using shell command files, but these take place in another instance
+of the shell and cannot directly affect the current shells environment
+or involve commands such as
+.I cd
+which must be done in the current shell.
+.PP
+As an example, suppose that there is a new version of the mail program
+on the system called `newmail'
+you wish to use, rather than the standard mail program which is called
+`mail'.
+If you place the shell command
+.DS
+alias mail newmail
+.DE
+in your
+.I \&.cshrc
+file, the shell will transform an input line of the form
+.DS
+mail bill
+.DE
+into a call on `newmail'.
+More generally, suppose we wish the command `ls' to always show
+sizes of files, that is to always do `\-s'.
+We can do
+.DS
+alias ls ls \-s
+.DE
+or even
+.DS
+alias dir ls \-s
+.DE
+creating a new command syntax `dir'
+which does an `ls \-s'.
+If we say
+.DS
+dir ~bill
+.DE
+then the shell will translate this to
+.DS
+ls \-s /mnt/bill
+.DE
+.PP
+Thus the
+.I alias
+mechanism can be used to provide short names for commands,
+to provide default arguments,
+and to define new short commands in terms of other commands.
+It is also possible to define aliases which contain multiple
+commands or pipelines, showing where the arguments to the original
+command are to be substituted using the facilities of the
+history mechanism.
+Thus the definition
+.DS
+alias cd \'cd \e!* ; ls \'
+.DE
+would do an
+.I ls
+command after each change directory
+.I cd
+command.
+We enclosed the entire alias definition in `\'' characters to prevent
+most substitutions from occurring and the character `;' from being
+recognized as a metacharacter.
+The `!' here is escaped with a `\e' to prevent it from being interpreted
+when the alias command is typed in.
+The `\e!*' here substitutes the entire argument list to the pre-aliasing
+.I cd
+command, without giving an error if there were no arguments.
+The `;' separating commands is used here
+to indicate that one command is to be done and then the next.
+Similarly the definition
+.DS
+alias whois \'grep \e!^ /etc/passwd\'
+.DE
+defines a command which looks up its first argument in the password file.
+.PP
+.B Warning:
+The shell currently reads the
+.I \&.cshrc
+file each time it starts up. If you place a large number of commands
+there, shells will tend to start slowly. A mechanism for saving the shell
+environment after reading the \fI\&.cshrc\fR file and quickly restoring it is
+under development, but for now you should try to limit the number of
+aliases you have to a reasonable number... 10 or 15 is reasonable,
+50 or 60 will cause a noticeable delay in starting up shells, and make
+the system seem sluggish when you execute commands from within the editor
+and other programs.
+.NH 2
+More redirection; >> and >&
+.PP
+There are a few more notations useful to the terminal user
+which have not been introduced yet.
+.PP
+In addition to the standard output, commands also have a
+.I "diagnostic output"
+which is normally directed to the terminal even when the standard output
+is redirected to a file or a pipe.
+It is occasionally desirable to direct the diagnostic output along with
+the standard output.
+For instance if you want to redirect the output of a long running command
+into a file and wish to have a record of any error diagnostic it produces
+you can do
+.DS
+command >& file
+.DE
+The `>&' here tells the shell to route both the diagnostic output and the
+standard output into `file'.
+Similarly you can give the command
+.DS
+command |\|& lpr
+.DE
+to route both standard and diagnostic output through the pipe
+to the line printer daemon
+.I lpr.\(dd
+.FS
+\(dd A command of the form
+.br
+.ti +5
+command >&! file
+.br
+exists, and is used when
+.I noclobber
+is set and
+.I file
+already exists.
+.FE
+.PP
+Finally, it is possible to use the form
+.DS
+command >> file
+.DE
+to place output at the end of an existing file.\(dg
+.FS
+\(dg If
+.I noclobber
+is set, then an error will result if
+.I file
+does not exist, otherwise the shell will create
+.I file
+if it doesn't exist.
+A form
+.br
+.ti +5
+command >>! file
+.br
+makes it not be an error for file to not exist when
+.I noclobber
+is set.
+.FE
+.NH 2
+Jobs; Background, Foreground, or Suspended
+.PP
+When one or more commands
+are typed together as a pipeline or as a sequence of commands separated by
+semicolons, a single
+.I job
+is created by the shell consisting of these commands together as a unit.
+Single commands without pipes or semicolons create the simplest jobs.
+Usually, every line typed to the shell creates a job.
+Some lines that create jobs (one per line) are
+.DS
+sort < data
+ls \-s | sort \-n | head \-5
+mail harold
+.DE
+.PP
+If the metacharacter `&' is typed
+at the end of the commands, then the job is started as a
+.I background
+job. This means that the shell does not wait for it to complete but
+immediately prompts and is ready for another command. The job runs
+.I "in the background"
+at the same time that normal jobs, called
+.I foreground
+jobs, continue to be read and executed by the shell one at a time.
+Thus
+.DS
+du > usage &
+.DE
+would run the
+.I du
+program, which reports on the disk usage of your working directory (as well as
+any directories below it), put the output into the file `usage' and return
+immediately with a prompt for the next command without out waiting for
+.I du
+to finish. The
+.I du
+program would continue executing in the background
+until it finished, even though you can type and execute more commands in the
+mean time.
+When a background
+job terminates, a message is typed by the shell just before the next prompt
+telling you that the job has completed.
+In the following example the
+.I du
+job finishes sometime during the
+execution of the
+.I mail
+command and its completion is reported just before
+the prompt after the
+.I mail
+job is finished.
+.DS
+% du > usage &
+[1] 503
+% mail bill
+How do you know when a background job is finished?
+EOT
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] \- Done du > usage
+%
+.so tabs
+.DE
+If the job did not terminate normally the `Done' message might say
+something else like `Killed'.
+If you want the
+terminations of background jobs to be reported at the time they occur
+(possibly interrupting the output of other foreground jobs), you can set
+the
+.I notify
+variable. In the previous example this would mean that the
+`Done' message might have come right in the middle of the message to
+Bill.
+Background jobs are unaffected by any signals from the keyboard like
+the \s-2STOP\s0, \s-2INTERRUPT\s0, or \s-2QUIT\s0 signals mentioned earlier.
+.PP
+Jobs are recorded in a table inside the shell until they terminate.
+In this table, the shell remembers the command names, arguments and the
+.I "process numbers"
+of all commands in the job as well as the working directory where the job was
+started.
+Each job in the table is either running
+.I "in the foreground"
+with the shell waiting for it to terminate, running
+.I "in the background,"
+or
+.I suspended.
+Only one job can be running in the foreground at one time, but several
+jobs can be suspended or running in the background at once. As each job
+is started, it is assigned a small identifying
+number called the
+.I "job number"
+which can be used later to refer to the job in the commands described below.
+Job numbers remain
+the same until the job terminates and then are re-used.
+.PP
+When a job is started in the backgound using `&', its number, as well
+as the process numbers of all its (top level) commands, is typed by the shell
+before prompting you for another command. For example,
+.DS
+% ls \-s | sort \-n > usage &
+[2] 2034 2035
+%
+.DE
+runs the `ls' program with the `\-s' options, pipes this output into
+the `sort' program with the `\-n' option which puts its output into the
+file `usage'.
+Since the `&' was at the end of the line, these two programs were started
+together as a background job. After starting the job, the shell prints
+the job number in brackets (2 in this case) followed by the process number
+of each program started in the job. Then the shell immediates prompts for
+a new command, leaving the job running simultaneously.
+.PP
+As mentioned in section 1.8, foreground jobs become
+.I suspended
+by typing ^Z
+which sends a \s-2STOP\s0 signal to the currently running
+foreground job. A background job can become suspended by using the
+.I stop
+command described below. When jobs are suspended they merely stop
+any further progress until started again, either in the foreground
+or the backgound. The shell notices when a job becomes stopped and
+reports this fact, much like it reports the termination of background jobs.
+For foreground jobs this looks like
+.DS
+% du > usage
+^Z
+Stopped
+%
+.DE
+`Stopped' message is typed by the shell when it notices that the
+.I du
+program stopped.
+For background jobs, using the
+.I stop
+command, it is
+.DS
+% sort usage &
+[1] 2345
+% stop %1
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] + Stopped (signal) sort usage
+%
+.so tabs
+.DE
+Suspending foreground jobs can be very useful when you need to temporarily
+change what you are doing (execute other commands) and then return to
+the suspended job. Also, foreground jobs can be suspended and then
+continued as background jobs using the
+.I bg
+command, allowing you to continue other work and
+stop waiting for the foreground job to finish. Thus
+.DS
+% du > usage
+^Z
+Stopped
+% bg
+[1] du > usage &
+%
+.DE
+starts `du' in the foreground, stops it before it finishes, then continues
+it in the background allowing more foreground commands to be executed.
+This is especially helpful
+when a foreground job ends up taking longer than you expected and you
+wish you had started it in the backgound in the beginning.
+.PP
+All
+.I "job control"
+commands can take an argument that identifies a particular
+job.
+All job name arguments begin with the character `%', since some of the
+job control commands also accept process numbers (printed by the
+.I ps
+command.)
+The default job (when no argument is given) is called the
+.I current
+job and is identified by a `+' in the output of the
+.I jobs
+command, which shows you which jobs you have.
+When only one job is stopped or running in the background (the usual case)
+it is always the current job thus no argument is needed.
+If a job is stopped while running in the foreground it becomes the
+.I current
+job and the existing current job becomes the
+.I previous
+job \- identified by a `\-' in the output of
+.I jobs.
+When the current job terminates, the previous job becomes the current job.
+When given, the argument is either `%\-' (indicating
+the previous job); `%#', where # is the job number;
+`%pref' where pref is some unique prefix of the command name
+and arguments of one of the jobs; or `%?' followed by some string found
+in only one of the jobs.
+.PP
+The
+.I jobs
+command types the table of jobs, giving the job number,
+commands and status (`Stopped' or `Running') of each backgound or
+suspended job. With the `\-l' option the process numbers are also
+typed.
+.DS
+% du > usage &
+[1] 3398
+% ls \-s | sort \-n > myfile &
+[2] 3405
+% mail bill
+^Z
+Stopped
+% jobs
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] \(mi Running du > usage
+[2] Running ls \-s | sort \-n > myfile
+[3] \(pl Stopped mail bill
+% fg %ls
+ls \-s | sort \-n > myfile
+% more myfile
+.so tabs
+.DE
+.PP
+The
+.I fg
+command runs a suspended or background job in the foreground. It is
+used to restart a previously suspended job or change a background job
+to run in the foreground (allowing signals or input from the terminal).
+In the above example we used
+.I fg
+to change the `ls' job from the
+background to the foreground since we wanted to wait for it to
+finish before looking at its output file.
+The
+.I bg
+command runs a suspended job in the background. It is usually used
+after stopping the currently running foreground job with the
+\s-2STOP\s0 signal. The combination of the \s-2STOP\s0 signal and the
+.I bg
+command changes a foreground job into a background job.
+The
+.I stop
+command suspends a background job.
+.PP
+The
+.I kill
+command terminates a background or suspended job immediately.
+In addition to jobs, it may be given process numbers as arguments,
+as printed by
+.I ps.
+Thus, in the example above, the running
+.I du
+command could have been terminated by the command
+.DS
+% kill %1
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] Terminated du > usage
+%
+.so tabs
+.DE
+.PP
+The
+.I notify
+command (not the variable mentioned earlier) indicates that the termination
+of a specific job should be
+reported at the time it finishes instead of waiting for the next prompt.
+.PP
+If a job running in the background tries to read input from the terminal
+it is automatically stopped. When such a job is then run in the
+foreground, input can be given to the job. If desired, the job can
+be run in the background again until it requests input again.
+This is illustrated in the following sequence where the `s' command in the
+text editor might take a long time.
+.ID
+.nf
+% ed bigfile
+120000
+1,$s/thisword/thatword/
+^Z
+Stopped
+% bg
+[1] ed bigfile &
+%
+ . . . some foreground commands
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] Stopped (tty input) ed bigfile
+% fg
+ed bigfile
+w
+120000
+q
+%
+.so tabs
+.DE
+So after the `s' command was issued, the `ed' job was stopped with ^Z
+and then put in the background using
+.I bg.
+Some time later when the `s' command was finished,
+.I ed
+tried to read another command and was stopped because jobs
+in the backgound cannot read from the terminal. The
+.I fg
+command returned the `ed' job to the foreground where it could once again
+accept commands from the terminal.
+.PP
+The command
+.DS
+stty tostop
+.DE
+causes all background jobs run on your terminal to stop
+when they are about to
+write output to the terminal. This prevents messages from background
+jobs from interrupting foreground job output and allows you to run
+a job in the background without losing terminal output. It also
+can be used for interactive programs that sometimes have long
+periods without interaction. Thus each time it outputs a prompt for more
+input it will stop before the prompt. It can then be run in the
+foreground using
+.I fg,
+more input can be given and, if necessary stopped and returned to
+the background. This
+.I stty
+command might be a good thing to put in your
+.I \&.login
+file if you do not like output from background jobs interrupting
+your work. It also can reduce the need for redirecting the output
+of background jobs if the output is not very big:
+.DS
+% stty tostop
+% wc hugefile &
+[1] 10387
+% ed text
+\&. . . some time later
+q
+.ta 1.75i
+[1] Stopped (tty output) wc hugefile
+% fg wc
+wc hugefile
+ 13371 30123 302577
+% stty \-tostop
+.so tabs
+.DE
+Thus after some time the `wc' command, which counts the lines, words
+and characters in a file, had one line of output. When it tried to
+write this to the terminal it stopped. By restarting it in the
+foreground we allowed it to write on the terminal exactly when we were
+ready to look at its output.
+Programs which attempt to change the mode of the terminal will also
+block, whether or not
+.I tostop
+is set, when they are not in the foreground, as
+it would be very unpleasant to have a background job change the state
+of the terminal.
+.PP
+Since the
+.I jobs
+command only prints jobs started in the currently executing shell,
+it knows nothing about background jobs started in other login sessions
+or within shell files. The
+.I ps
+can be used in this case to find out about background jobs not started
+in the current shell.
+.NH 2
+Working Directories
+.PP
+As mentioned in section 1.6, the shell is always in a particular
+.I "working directory."
+The `change directory' command
+.I chdir
+(its
+short form
+.I cd
+may also be used)
+changes the working directory of the shell,
+that is, changes the directory you
+are located in.
+.PP
+It is useful to make a directory for each project you wish to work on
+and to place all files related to that project in that directory.
+The `make directory' command,
+.I mkdir,
+creates a new directory.
+The
+.I pwd
+(`print working directory') command
+reports the absolute pathname of the working directory of the shell,
+that is, the directory you are
+located in.
+Thus in the example below:
+.DS
+% pwd
+/usr/bill
+% mkdir newpaper
+% chdir newpaper
+% pwd
+/usr/bill/newpaper
+%
+.DE
+the user has created and moved to the
+directory
+.I newpaper.
+where, for example, he might
+place a group of related files.
+.PP
+No matter where you have moved to in a directory hierarchy,
+you can return to your `home' login directory by doing just
+.DS
+cd
+.DE
+with no arguments.
+The name `..' always means the directory above the current one in
+the hierarchy, thus
+.DS
+cd ..
+.DE
+changes the shell's working directory to the one directly above the
+current one.
+The name `..' can be used in any
+pathname, thus,
+.DS
+cd ../programs
+.DE
+means
+change to the directory `programs' contained in the directory
+above the current one.
+If you have several directories for different
+projects under, say, your home directory,
+this shorthand notation
+permits you to switch easily between them.
+.PP
+The shell always remembers the pathname of its current working directory in
+the variable
+.I cwd.
+The shell can also be requested to remember the previous directory when
+you change to a new working directory. If the `push directory' command
+.I pushd
+is used in place of the
+.I cd
+command, the shell saves the name of the current working directory
+on a
+.I "directory stack"
+before changing to the new one.
+You can see this list at any time by typing the `directories'
+command
+.I dirs.
+.ID
+.nf
+% pushd newpaper/references
+~/newpaper/references ~
+% pushd /usr/lib/tmac
+/usr/lib/tmac ~/newpaper/references ~
+% dirs
+/usr/lib/tmac ~/newpaper/references ~
+% popd
+~/newpaper/references ~
+% popd
+~
+%
+.DE
+The list is printed in a horizontal line, reading left to right,
+with a tilde (~) as
+shorthand for your home directory\(emin this case `/usr/bill'.
+The directory stack is printed whenever there is more than one
+entry on it and it changes.
+It is also printed by a
+.I dirs
+command.
+.I Dirs
+is usually faster and more informative than
+.I pwd
+since it shows the current working directory as well as any
+other directories remembered in the stack.
+.PP
+The
+.I pushd
+command with no argument
+alternates the current directory with the first directory in the
+list.
+The `pop directory'
+.I popd
+command without an argument returns you to the directory you were in prior to
+the current one, discarding the previous current directory from the
+stack (forgetting it).
+Typing
+.I popd
+several times in a series takes you backward through the directories
+you had been in (changed to) by
+.I pushd
+command.
+There are other options to
+.I pushd
+and
+.I popd
+to manipulate the contents of the directory stack and to change
+to directories not at the top of the stack; see the
+.I csh
+manual page for details.
+.PP
+Since the shell remembers the working directory in which each job
+was started, it warns you when you might be confused by restarting
+a job in the foreground which has a different working directory than the
+current working directory of the shell. Thus if you start a background
+job, then change the shell's working directory and then cause the
+background job to run in the foreground, the shell warns you that the
+working directory of the currently running foreground job is different
+from that of the shell.
+.DS
+% dirs \-l
+/mnt/bill
+% cd myproject
+% dirs
+~/myproject
+% ed prog.c
+1143
+^Z
+Stopped
+% cd ..
+% ls
+myproject
+textfile
+% fg
+ed prog.c (wd: ~/myproject)
+.DE
+This way the shell warns you when there
+is an implied change of working directory, even though no cd command was
+issued. In the above example the `ed' job was still in `/mnt/bill/project'
+even though the shell had changed to `/mnt/bill'.
+A similar warning is given when such a foreground job
+terminates or is suspended (using the \s-2STOP\s0 signal) since
+the return to the shell again implies a change of working directory.
+.DS
+% fg
+ed prog.c (wd: ~/myproject)
+ . . . after some editing
+q
+(wd now: ~)
+%
+.DE
+These messages are sometimes confusing if you use programs that change
+their own working directories, since the shell only remembers which
+directory a job is started in, and assumes it stays there.
+The `\-l' option of
+.I jobs
+will type the working directory
+of suspended or background jobs when it is different
+from the current working directory of the shell.
+.NH 2
+Useful built-in commands
+.PP
+We now give a few of the useful built-in commands of the shell describing
+how they are used.
+.PP
+The
+.I alias
+command described above is used to assign new aliases and to show the
+existing aliases.
+With no arguments it prints the current aliases.
+It may also be given only one argument such as
+.DS
+alias ls
+.DE
+to show the current alias for, e.g., `ls'.
+.PP
+The
+.I echo
+command prints its arguments.
+It is often used in
+.I "shell scripts"
+or as an interactive command
+to see what filename expansions will produce.
+.PP
+The
+.I history
+command will show the contents of the history list.
+The numbers given with the history events can be used to reference
+previous events which are difficult to reference using the
+contextual mechanisms introduced above.
+There is also a shell variable called
+.I prompt.
+By placing a `!' character in its value the shell will there substitute
+the number of the current command in the history list.
+You can use this number to refer to this command in a history substitution.
+Thus you could
+.DS
+set prompt=\'\e! % \'
+.DE
+Note that the `!' character had to be
+.I escaped
+here even within `\'' characters.
+.PP
+The
+.I limit
+command is used to restrict use of resources.
+With no arguments it prints the current limitations:
+.DS
+.ta 1i
+cputime unlimited
+filesize unlimited
+datasize 5616 kbytes
+stacksize 512 kbytes
+coredumpsize unlimited
+.so tabs
+.DE
+Limits can be set, e.g.:
+.DS
+limit coredumpsize 128k
+.DE
+Most reasonable units abbreviations will work; see the
+.I csh
+manual page for more details.
+.PP
+The
+.I logout
+command can be used to terminate a login shell which has
+.I ignoreeof
+set.
+.PP
+The
+.I rehash
+command causes the shell to recompute a table of where commands are
+located. This is necessary if you add a command to a directory
+in the current shell's search path and wish the shell to find it,
+since otherwise the hashing algorithm may tell the shell that the
+command wasn't in that directory when the hash table was computed.
+.PP
+The
+.I repeat
+command can be used to repeat a command several times.
+Thus to make 5 copies of the file
+.I one
+in the file
+.I five
+you could do
+.DS
+repeat 5 cat one >> five
+.DE
+.PP
+The
+.I setenv
+command can be used
+to set variables in the environment.
+Thus
+.DS
+setenv TERM adm3a
+.DE
+will set the value of the environment variable \s-2TERM\s0
+to
+`adm3a'.
+A user program
+.I printenv
+exists which will print out the environment.
+It might then show:
+.DS
+% printenv
+HOME=/usr/bill
+SHELL=/bin/csh
+PATH=:/usr/ucb:/bin:/usr/bin:/usr/local
+TERM=adm3a
+USER=bill
+%
+.DE
+.PP
+The
+.I source
+command can be used to force the current shell to read commands from
+a file.
+Thus
+.DS
+source .cshrc
+.DE
+can be used after editing in a change to the
+.I \&.cshrc
+file which you wish to take effect right away.
+.PP
+The
+.I time
+command can be used to cause a command to be timed no matter how much
+\s-2CPU\s0 time it takes.
+Thus
+.DS
+% time cp /etc/rc /usr/bill/rc
+0.0u 0.1s 0:01 8% 2+1k 3+2io 1pf+0w
+% time wc /etc/rc /usr/bill/rc
+ 52 178 1347 /etc/rc
+ 52 178 1347 /usr/bill/rc
+ 104 356 2694 total
+0.1u 0.1s 0:00 13% 3+3k 5+3io 7pf+0w
+%
+.DE
+indicates that the
+.I cp
+command used a negligible amount of user time (u)
+and about 1/10th of a system time (s); the elapsed time was 1 second (0:01),
+there was an average memory usage of 2k bytes of program space and 1k
+bytes of data space over the cpu time involved (2+1k); the program
+did three disk reads and two disk writes (3+2io), and took one page fault
+and was not swapped (1pf+0w).
+The word count command
+.I wc
+on the other hand used 0.1 seconds of user time and 0.1 seconds of system
+time in less than a second of elapsed time.
+The percentage `13%' indicates that over the period when it was active
+the command `wc' used an average of 13 percent of the available \s-2CPU\s0
+cycles of the machine.
+.PP
+The
+.I unalias
+and
+.I unset
+commands can be used
+to remove aliases and variable definitions from the shell, and
+.I unsetenv
+removes variables from the environment.
+.NH 2
+What else?
+.PP
+This concludes the basic discussion of the shell for terminal users.
+There are more features of the shell to be discussed here, and all
+features of the shell are discussed in its manual pages.
+One useful feature which is discussed later is the
+.I foreach
+built-in command which can be used to run the same command
+sequence with a number of different arguments.
+.PP
+If you intend to use \s-2UNIX\s0 a lot you you should look through
+the rest of this document and the csh manual pages (section1) to become familiar
+with the other facilities which are available to you.
+.bp
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.3 b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.3
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cf8af73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.3
@@ -0,0 +1,650 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.3 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.nr H1 2
+.NH
+Shell control structures and command scripts
+.NH 2
+Introduction
+.PP
+It is possible to place commands in files and to cause shells to be
+invoked to read and execute commands from these files,
+which are called
+.I "shell scripts."
+We here detail those features of the shell useful to the writers of such
+scripts.
+.NH 2
+Make
+.PP
+It is important to first note what shell scripts are
+.I not
+useful for.
+There is a program called
+.I make
+which is very useful for maintaining a group of related files
+or performing sets of operations on related files.
+For instance a large program consisting of one or more files
+can have its dependencies described in a
+.I makefile
+which contains definitions of the commands used to create these
+different files when changes occur.
+Definitions of the means for printing listings, cleaning up the directory
+in which the files reside, and installing the resultant programs
+are easily, and most appropriately placed in this
+.I makefile.
+This format is superior and preferable to maintaining a group of shell
+procedures to maintain these files.
+.PP
+Similarly when working on a document a
+.I makefile
+may be created which defines how different versions of the document
+are to be created and which options of
+.I nroff
+or
+.I troff
+are appropriate.
+.NH 2
+Invocation and the argv variable
+.PP
+A
+.I csh
+command script may be interpreted by saying
+.DS
+% csh script ...
+.DE
+where
+.I script
+is the name of the file containing a group of
+.I csh
+commands and
+`\&...' is replaced by a sequence of arguments.
+The shell places these arguments in the variable
+.I argv
+and then begins to read commands from the script.
+These parameters are then available through the same mechanisms
+which are used to reference any other shell variables.
+.PP
+If you make the file
+`script'
+executable by doing
+.DS
+chmod 755 script
+.DE
+and place a shell comment at the beginning of the shell script
+(i.e. begin the file with a `#' character)
+then a `/bin/csh' will automatically be invoked to execute `script' when
+you type
+.DS
+script
+.DE
+If the file does not begin with a `#' then the standard shell
+`/bin/sh' will be used to execute it.
+This allows you to convert your older shell scripts to use
+.I csh
+at your convenience.
+.NH 2
+Variable substitution
+.PP
+After each input line is broken into words and history substitutions
+are done on it, the input line is parsed into distinct commands.
+Before each command is executed a mechanism know as
+.I "variable substitution"
+is done on these words.
+Keyed by the character `$' this substitution replaces the names
+of variables by their values.
+Thus
+.DS
+echo $argv
+.DE
+when placed in a command script would cause the current value of the
+variable
+.I argv
+to be echoed to the output of the shell script.
+It is an error for
+.I argv
+to be unset at this point.
+.PP
+A number of notations are provided for accessing components and attributes
+of variables.
+The notation
+.DS
+$?name
+.DE
+expands to `1' if name is
+.I set
+or to `0'
+if name is not
+.I set.
+It is the fundamental mechanism used for checking whether particular
+variables have been assigned values.
+All other forms of reference to undefined variables cause errors.
+.PP
+The notation
+.DS
+$#name
+.DE
+expands to the number of elements in the variable
+.I name.
+Thus
+.DS
+% set argv=(a b c)
+% echo $?argv
+1
+% echo $#argv
+3
+% unset argv
+% echo $?argv
+0
+% echo $argv
+Undefined variable: argv.
+%
+.DE
+.PP
+It is also possible to access the components of a variable
+which has several values.
+Thus
+.DS
+$argv[1]
+.DE
+gives the first component of
+.I argv
+or in the example above `a'.
+Similarly
+.DS
+$argv[$#argv]
+.DE
+would give `c',
+and
+.DS
+$argv[1\-2]
+.DE
+would give `a b'. Other notations useful in shell scripts are
+.DS
+$\fIn\fR
+.DE
+where
+.I n
+is an integer as a shorthand for
+.DS
+$argv[\fIn\fR\|]
+.DE
+the
+.I n\|th
+parameter and
+.DS
+$*
+.DE
+which is a shorthand for
+.DS
+$argv
+.DE
+The form
+.DS
+$$
+.DE
+expands to the process number of the current shell.
+Since this process number is unique in the system it can
+be used in generation of unique temporary file names.
+The form
+.DS
+$<
+.DE
+is quite special and is replaced by the next line of input read from
+the shell's standard input (not the script it is reading). This is
+useful for writing shell scripts that are interactive, reading
+commands from the terminal, or even writing a shell script that
+acts as a filter, reading lines from its input file. Thus the sequence
+.DS
+echo 'yes or no?\ec'
+set a=($<)
+.DE
+would write out the prompt `yes or no?' without a newline and then
+read the answer into the variable `a'. In this case `$#a' would be
+`0' if either a blank line or end-of-file (^D) was typed.
+.PP
+One minor difference between `$\fIn\fR\|' and `$argv[\fIn\fR\|]'
+should be noted here.
+The form
+`$argv[\fIn\fR\|]'
+will yield an error if
+.I n
+is not in the range
+`1\-$#argv'
+while `$n'
+will never yield an out of range subscript error.
+This is for compatibility with the way older shells handled parameters.
+.PP
+Another important point is that it is never an error to give a subrange
+of the form `n\-'; if there are less than
+.I n
+components of the given variable then no words are substituted.
+A range of the form `m\-n' likewise returns an empty vector without giving
+an error when \fIm\fR exceeds the number of elements of the given variable,
+provided the subscript \fIn\fR is in range.
+.NH 2
+Expressions
+.PP
+In order for interesting shell scripts to be constructed it
+must be possible to evaluate expressions in the shell based on the
+values of variables.
+In fact, all the arithmetic operations of the language C are available
+in the shell
+with the same precedence that they have in C.
+In particular, the operations `==' and `!=' compare strings
+and the operators `&&' and `|\|\||' implement the boolean and/or operations.
+The special operators `=~' and `!~' are similar to `==' and `!=' except
+that the string on the right side can have pattern matching characters
+(like *, ? or []) and the test is whether the string on the left matches
+the pattern on the right.
+.PP
+The shell also allows file enquiries of the form
+.DS
+\-? filename
+.DE
+where `?' is replace by a number of single characters.
+For instance the expression primitive
+.DS
+\-e filename
+.DE
+tell whether the file
+`filename'
+exists.
+Other primitives test for read, write and execute access to the file,
+whether it is a directory, or has non-zero length.
+.PP
+It is possible to test whether a command terminates normally,
+by a primitive of the
+form `{ command }' which returns true, i.e. `1' if the command
+succeeds exiting normally with exit status 0, or `0' if the command
+terminates abnormally or with exit status non-zero.
+If more detailed information about the execution status of a command
+is required, it can be executed and the variable `$status' examined
+in the next command.
+Since `$status' is set by every command, it is very transient.
+It can be saved if it is inconvenient to use it only in the single
+immediately following command.
+.PP
+For a full list of expression components available see the manual
+section for the shell.
+.NH 2
+Sample shell script
+.PP
+A sample shell script which makes use of the expression mechanism
+of the shell and some of its control structure follows:
+.DS
+% cat copyc
+#
+# Copyc copies those C programs in the specified list
+# to the directory ~/backup if they differ from the files
+# already in ~/backup
+#
+set noglob
+foreach i ($argv)
+
+ if ($i !~ *.c) continue # not a .c file so do nothing
+
+ if (! \-r ~/backup/$i:t) then
+ echo $i:t not in backup... not cp\e\'ed
+ continue
+ endif
+
+ cmp \-s $i ~/backup/$i:t # to set $status
+
+ if ($status != 0) then
+ echo new backup of $i
+ cp $i ~/backup/$i:t
+ endif
+end
+.DE
+.PP
+This script makes use of the
+.I foreach
+command, which causes the shell to execute the commands between the
+.I foreach
+and the matching
+.I end
+for each of the values given between `(' and `)' with the named
+variable, in this case `i' set to successive values in the list.
+Within this loop we may use the command
+.I break
+to stop executing the loop
+and
+.I continue
+to prematurely terminate one iteration
+and begin the next.
+After the
+.I foreach
+loop the iteration variable
+(\fIi\fR in this case)
+has the value at the last iteration.
+.PP
+We set the variable
+.I noglob
+here to prevent filename expansion of the members of
+.I argv.
+This is a good idea, in general, if the arguments to a shell script
+are filenames which have already been expanded or if the arguments
+may contain filename expansion metacharacters.
+It is also possible to quote each use of a `$' variable expansion,
+but this is harder and less reliable.
+.PP
+The other control construct used here is a statement of the form
+.DS
+\fBif\fR ( expression ) \fBthen\fR
+ command
+ ...
+\fBendif\fR
+.DE
+The placement of the keywords here is
+.B not
+flexible due to the current implementation of the shell.\(dg
+.FS
+\(dgThe following two formats are not currently acceptable to the shell:
+.sp
+.in +5
+.nf
+\fBif\fR ( expression ) # \fBWon't work!\fR
+\fBthen\fR
+ command
+ ...
+\fBendif\fR
+.fi
+.in -5
+.sp
+and
+.sp
+.in +5
+.nf
+\fBif\fR ( expression ) \fBthen\fR command \fBendif\fR # \fBWon't work\fR
+.in -5
+.fi
+.FE
+.PP
+The shell does have another form of the if statement of the form
+.DS
+\fBif\fR ( expression ) \fBcommand\fR
+.DE
+which can be written
+.DS
+\fBif\fR ( expression ) \e
+ command
+.DE
+Here we have escaped the newline for the sake of appearance.
+The command must not involve `\||\|', `&' or `;'
+and must not be another control command.
+The second form requires the final `\e' to
+.B immediately
+precede the end-of-line.
+.PP
+The more general
+.I if
+statements above also admit a sequence of
+.I else\-if
+pairs followed by a single
+.I else
+and an
+.I endif,
+e.g.:
+.DS
+\fBif\fR ( expression ) \fBthen\fR
+ commands
+\fBelse\fR \fBif\fR (expression ) \fBthen\fR
+ commands
+\&...
+
+\fBelse\fR
+ commands
+\fBendif\fR
+.DE
+.PP
+Another important mechanism used in shell scripts is the `:' modifier.
+We can use the modifier `:r' here to extract a root of a filename or
+`:e' to extract the
+.I extension.
+Thus if the variable
+.I i
+has the value
+`/mnt/foo.bar'
+then
+.sp
+.in +5
+.nf
+% echo $i $i:r $i:e
+/mnt/foo.bar /mnt/foo bar
+%
+.sp
+.in -5
+.fi
+shows how the `:r' modifier strips off the trailing `.bar' and the
+the `:e' modifier leaves only the `bar'.
+Other modifiers will take off the last component of a pathname leaving
+the head `:h' or all but the last component of a pathname leaving the
+tail `:t'.
+These modifiers are fully described in the
+.I csh
+manual pages in the User's Reference Manual.
+It is also possible to use the
+.I "command substitution"
+mechanism described in the next major section to perform modifications
+on strings to then reenter the shell's environment.
+Since each usage of this mechanism involves the creation of a new process,
+it is much more expensive to use than the `:' modification mechanism.\(dd
+.FS
+\(dd It is also important to note that
+the current implementation of the shell limits the number of `:' modifiers
+on a `$' substitution to 1.
+Thus
+.sp
+.nf
+.in +5
+% echo $i $i:h:t
+/a/b/c /a/b:t
+%
+.in -5
+.fi
+.sp
+does not do what one would expect.
+.FE
+Finally, we note that the character `#' lexically introduces a shell
+comment in shell scripts (but not from the terminal).
+All subsequent characters on the input line after a `#' are discarded
+by the shell.
+This character can be quoted using `\'' or `\e' to place it in
+an argument word.
+.NH 2
+Other control structures
+.PP
+The shell also has control structures
+.I while
+and
+.I switch
+similar to those of C.
+These take the forms
+.DS
+\fBwhile\fR ( expression )
+ commands
+\fBend\fR
+.DE
+and
+.DS
+\fBswitch\fR ( word )
+
+\fBcase\fR str1:
+ commands
+ \fBbreaksw\fR
+
+\& ...
+
+\fBcase\fR strn:
+ commands
+ \fBbreaksw\fR
+
+\fBdefault:\fR
+ commands
+ \fBbreaksw\fR
+
+\fBendsw\fR
+.DE
+For details see the manual section for
+.I csh.
+C programmers should note that we use
+.I breaksw
+to exit from a
+.I switch
+while
+.I break
+exits a
+.I while
+or
+.I foreach
+loop.
+A common mistake to make in
+.I csh
+scripts is to use
+.I break
+rather than
+.I breaksw
+in switches.
+.PP
+Finally,
+.I csh
+allows a
+.I goto
+statement, with labels looking like they do in C, i.e.:
+.DS
+loop:
+ commands
+ \fBgoto\fR loop
+.DE
+.NH 2
+Supplying input to commands
+.PP
+Commands run from shell scripts receive by default the standard
+input of the shell which is running the script.
+This is different from previous shells running
+under \s-2UNIX\s0. It allows shell scripts to fully participate
+in pipelines, but mandates extra notation for commands which are to take
+inline data.
+.PP
+Thus we need a metanotation for supplying inline data to commands in
+shell scripts.
+As an example, consider this script which runs the editor to
+delete leading blanks from the lines in each argument file:
+.DS
+% cat deblank
+# deblank \-\- remove leading blanks
+foreach i ($argv)
+ed \- $i << \'EOF\'
+1,$s/^[ ]*//
+w
+q
+\&\'EOF\'
+end
+%
+.DE
+The notation `<< \'EOF\''
+means that the standard input for the
+.I ed
+command is to come from the text in the shell script file
+up to the next line consisting of exactly `\'EOF\''.
+The fact that the `EOF' is enclosed in `\'' characters, i.e. quoted,
+causes the shell to not perform variable substitution on the
+intervening lines.
+In general, if any part of the word following the `<<' which the
+shell uses to terminate the text to be given to the command is quoted
+then these substitutions will not be performed.
+In this case since we used the form `1,$' in our editor script
+we needed to insure that this `$' was not variable substituted.
+We could also have insured this by preceding the `$' here with a `\e',
+i.e.:
+.DS
+1,\e$s/^[ ]*//
+.DE
+but quoting the `EOF' terminator is a more reliable way of achieving the
+same thing.
+.NH 2
+Catching interrupts
+.PP
+If our shell script creates temporary files, we may wish to catch
+interruptions of the shell script so that we can clean up
+these files.
+We can then do
+.DS
+onintr label
+.DE
+where
+.I label
+is a label in our program.
+If an interrupt is received the shell will do a
+`goto label'
+and we can remove the temporary files and then do an
+.I exit
+command (which is built in to the shell)
+to exit from the shell script.
+If we wish to exit with a non-zero status we can do
+.DS
+exit(1)
+.DE
+e.g. to exit with status `1'.
+.NH 2
+What else?
+.PP
+There are other features of the shell useful to writers of shell
+procedures.
+The
+.I verbose
+and
+.I echo
+options and the related
+.I \-v
+and
+.I \-x
+command line options can be used to help trace the actions of the shell.
+The
+.I \-n
+option causes the shell only to read commands and not to execute
+them and may sometimes be of use.
+.PP
+One other thing to note is that
+.I csh
+will not execute shell scripts which do not begin with the
+character `#', that is shell scripts that do not begin with a comment.
+Similarly, the `/bin/sh' on your system may well defer to `csh'
+to interpret shell scripts which begin with `#'.
+This allows shell scripts for both shells to live in harmony.
+.PP
+There is also another quotation mechanism using `"' which allows
+only some of the expansion mechanisms we have so far discussed to occur
+on the quoted string and serves to make this string into a single word
+as `\'' does.
+.bp
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.4 b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.4
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ee862df
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.4
@@ -0,0 +1,178 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.4 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.nr H1 3
+.NH
+Other, less commonly used, shell features
+.NH 2
+Loops at the terminal; variables as vectors
+.PP
+It is occasionally useful to use the
+.I foreach
+control structure at the terminal to aid in performing a number
+of similar commands.
+For instance, there were at one point three shells in use on the Cory \s-2UNIX\s0
+system at Cory Hall,
+`/bin/sh',
+`/bin/nsh',
+and
+`/bin/csh'.
+To count the number of persons using each shell one could have issued
+the commands
+.DS
+% grep \-c csh$ /etc/passwd
+27
+% grep \-c nsh$ /etc/passwd
+128
+% grep \-c \-v sh$ /etc/passwd
+430
+%
+.DE
+Since these commands are very similar we can use
+.I foreach
+to do this more easily.
+.DS
+% foreach i (\'sh$\' \'csh$\' \'\-v sh$\')
+? grep \-c $i /etc/passwd
+? end
+27
+128
+430
+%
+.DE
+Note here that the shell prompts for
+input with `? ' when reading the body of the loop.
+.PP
+Very useful with loops are variables which contain lists of filenames
+or other words.
+You can, for example, do
+.DS
+% set a=(\`ls\`)
+% echo $a
+csh.n csh.rm
+% ls
+csh.n
+csh.rm
+% echo $#a
+2
+%
+.DE
+The
+.I set
+command here gave the variable
+.I a
+a list of all the filenames in the current directory as value.
+We can then iterate over these names to perform any chosen function.
+.PP
+The output of a command within `\`' characters is converted by
+the shell to a list of words.
+You can also place the `\`' quoted string within `"' characters
+to take each (non-empty) line as a component of the variable;
+preventing the lines from being split into words at blanks and tabs.
+A modifier `:x' exists which can be used later to expand each component
+of the variable into another variable splitting it into separate words
+at embedded blanks and tabs.
+.NH 2
+Braces { ... } in argument expansion
+.PP
+Another form of filename expansion, alluded
+to before involves the characters `{' and `}'.
+These characters specify that the contained strings, separated by `,'
+are to be consecutively substituted into the containing characters
+and the results expanded left to right.
+Thus
+.DS
+A{str1,str2,...strn}B
+.DE
+expands to
+.DS
+Astr1B Astr2B ... AstrnB
+.DE
+This expansion occurs before the other filename expansions, and may
+be applied recursively (i.e. nested).
+The results of each expanded string are sorted separately, left
+to right order being preserved.
+The resulting filenames are not required to exist if no other expansion
+mechanisms are used.
+This means that this mechanism can be used to generate arguments which are
+not filenames, but which have common parts.
+.PP
+A typical use of this would be
+.DS
+mkdir ~/{hdrs,retrofit,csh}
+.DE
+to make subdirectories `hdrs', `retrofit' and `csh'
+in your home directory.
+This mechanism is most useful when the common prefix is longer
+than in this example, i.e.
+.DS
+chown root /usr/{ucb/{ex,edit},lib/{ex?.?*,how_ex}}
+.DE
+.NH 2
+Command substitution
+.PP
+A command enclosed in `\`' characters is replaced, just before
+filenames are expanded, by the output from that command.
+Thus it is possible to do
+.DS
+set pwd=\`pwd\`
+.DE
+to save the current directory in the variable
+.I pwd
+or to do
+.DS
+ex \`grep \-l TRACE *.c\`
+.DE
+to run the editor
+.I ex
+supplying as arguments those files whose names end in `.c'
+which have the string `TRACE' in them.*
+.FS
+*Command expansion also occurs in input redirected with `<<'
+and within `"' quotations.
+Refer to the shell manual section for full details.
+.FE
+.NH 2
+Other details not covered here
+.PP
+In particular circumstances it may be necessary to know the exact
+nature and order of different substitutions performed by the shell.
+The exact meaning of certain combinations of quotations is also
+occasionally important.
+These are detailed fully in its manual section.
+.PP
+The shell has a number of command line option flags mostly of use
+in writing \s-2UNIX\s0 programs,
+and debugging shell scripts.
+See the csh(1) manual section for a list of these options.
+.bp
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.a b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.a
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1026faf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.a
@@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.a 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.SH
+Appendix \- Special characters
+.LP
+The following table lists the special characters of
+.I csh
+and the \s-2UNIX\s0 system, giving for each the section(s) in which it
+is discussed.
+A number of these characters also have special meaning in expressions.
+See the
+.I csh
+manual section
+for a complete list.
+.ta .75i 1.5i 2.25i
+.LP
+Syntactic metacharacters
+.DS
+; 2.4 separates commands to be executed sequentially
+| 1.5 separates commands in a pipeline
+( ) 2.2,3.6 brackets expressions and variable values
+& 2.5 follows commands to be executed without waiting for completion
+.DE
+.LP
+Filename metacharacters
+.DS
+/ 1.6 separates components of a file's pathname
+\. 1.6 separates root parts of a file name from extensions
+? 1.6 expansion character matching any single character
+* 1.6 expansion character matching any sequence of characters
+[ ] 1.6 expansion sequence matching any single character from a set
+~ 1.6 used at the beginning of a filename to indicate home directories
+{ } 4.2 used to specify groups of arguments with common parts
+.DE
+.LP
+Quotation metacharacters
+.DS
+\e 1.7 prevents meta-meaning of following single character
+\' 1.7 prevents meta-meaning of a group of characters
+" 4.3 like \', but allows variable and command expansion
+.DE
+.LP
+Input/output metacharacters
+.DS
+< 1.5 indicates redirected input
+> 1.3 indicates redirected output
+.DE
+.LP
+Expansion/substitution metacharacters
+.DS
+$ 3.4 indicates variable substitution
+! 2.3 indicates history substitution
+: 3.6 precedes substitution modifiers
+^ 2.3 used in special forms of history substitution
+\` 4.3 indicates command substitution
+.DE
+.LP
+Other metacharacters
+.DS
+# 1.3,3.6 begins scratch file names; indicates shell comments
+\- 1.2 prefixes option (flag) arguments to commands
+% 2.6 prefixes job name specifications
+.DE
+.bp
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.g b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.g
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0641769
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/csh.g
@@ -0,0 +1,1721 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.g 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.SH
+Glossary
+.PP
+This glossary lists the most important terms introduced in the
+introduction to the
+shell and gives references to sections of the shell
+document for further information about them.
+References of the form
+`pr (1)'
+indicate that the command
+.I pr
+is in the \s-2UNIX\s0 User Reference manual in section 1.
+You can look at an online copy of its manual page by doing
+.DS
+man 1 pr
+.DE
+References of the form (2.5)
+indicate that more information can be found in section 2.5 of this
+manual.
+.IP \&\fB.\fR 15n
+Your current directory has the name `.' as well as the name printed
+by the command
+.I pwd;
+see also
+.I dirs.
+The current directory `.' is usually the first
+.I component
+of the search path contained in the variable
+.I path ,
+thus commands which are in `.' are found first (2.2).
+The character `.' is also used in separating
+.I components
+of filenames
+(1.6).
+The character `.' at the beginning of a
+.I component
+of a
+.I pathname
+is treated specially and not matched by the
+.I "filename expansion"
+metacharacters `?', `*', and `[' `]' pairs (1.6).
+.IP \&\fB..\fR
+Each directory has a file `..' in it which is a reference to its
+parent directory.
+After changing into the directory with
+.I chdir ,
+i.e.
+.DS
+chdir paper
+.DE
+you can return to the parent directory by doing
+.DS
+chdir ..
+.DE
+The current directory is printed by
+.I pwd
+(2.7).
+.IP a.out
+Compilers which create executable images create them, by default, in the
+file
+.I a.out.
+for historical reasons (2.3).
+.IP "absolute pathname"
+.br
+A
+.I pathname
+which begins with a `/' is
+.I absolute
+since it specifies the
+.I path
+of directories from the beginning
+of the entire directory system \- called the
+.I root
+directory.
+.I Pathname s
+which are not
+.I absolute
+are called
+.I relative
+(see definition of
+.I "relative pathname" )
+(1.6).
+.IP alias
+An
+.I alias
+specifies a shorter or different name for a \s-2UNIX\s0
+command, or a transformation on a command to be performed in
+the shell.
+The shell has a command
+.I alias
+which establishes
+.I aliases
+and can print their current values.
+The command
+.I unalias
+is used to remove
+.I aliases
+(2.4).
+.IP argument
+Commands in \s-2UNIX\s0 receive a list of
+.I argument
+words.
+Thus the command
+.DS
+echo a b c
+.DE
+consists of the
+.I "command name"
+`echo' and three
+.I argument
+words `a', `b' and `c'.
+The set of
+.I arguments
+after the
+.I "command name"
+is said to be the
+.I "argument list"
+of the command (1.1).
+.IP argv
+The list of arguments to a command written in the shell language
+(a shell script or shell procedure) is stored in a variable called
+.I argv
+within the shell.
+This name is taken from the conventional name in the
+C programming language (3.4).
+.IP background
+Commands started without waiting for them to complete are called
+.I background
+commands (2.6).
+.IP base
+A filename is sometimes thought of as consisting of a
+.I base
+part, before any `.' character, and an
+.I extension
+\- the part after
+the `.'. See
+.I filename
+and
+.I extension
+(1.6) and basename (1).
+.IP bg
+The
+.I bg
+command causes a
+.I suspended
+job to continue execution in the
+.I background
+(2.6).
+.IP bin
+A directory containing binaries of programs and shell scripts to be
+executed is typically called a
+.I bin
+directory.
+The standard system
+.I bin
+directories are `/bin' containing the most
+heavily used commands and `/usr/bin' which contains most other user
+programs.
+Programs developed at UC Berkeley live in `/usr/ucb', while locally
+written programs live in `/usr/local'. Games are kept in the directory
+`/usr/games'.
+You can place binaries in any directory.
+If you wish to execute them often, the name of the directories
+should be a
+.I component
+of the variable
+.I path .
+.IP break
+.I Break
+is a builtin command used to exit from loops within the control
+structure of the shell (3.7).
+.IP breaksw
+The
+.I breaksw
+builtin command is used to exit from a
+.I switch
+control structure, like a
+.I break
+exits from loops (3.7).
+.IP builtin
+A command executed directly by the shell is called a
+.I builtin
+command.
+Most commands in \s-2UNIX\s0 are not built into the shell,
+but rather exist as files in
+.I bin
+directories.
+These commands are accessible because the directories in which
+they reside are named in the
+.I path
+variable.
+.IP case
+A
+.I case
+command is used as a label in a
+.I switch
+statement in the shell's control structure, similar to that of the
+language C.
+Details are given in the shell documentation `csh (1)' (3.7).
+.IP cat
+The
+.I cat
+program catenates a list of specified files on the
+.I "standard output" .
+It is usually used to look at the contents of a single file on the terminal,
+to `cat a file' (1.8, 2.3).
+.IP cd
+The
+.I cd
+command is used to change the
+.I "working directory" .
+With no arguments,
+.I cd
+changes your
+.I "working directory"
+to be your
+.I home
+directory (2.4, 2.7).
+.IP chdir
+The
+.I chdir
+command is a synonym for
+.I cd .
+.I Cd
+is usually used because it is easier to type.
+.IP chsh
+The
+.I chsh
+command is used to change the shell which you use on \s-2UNIX\s0.
+By default, you use an different version of the shell
+which resides in `/bin/sh'.
+You can change your shell to `/bin/csh' by doing
+.DS
+chsh your-login-name /bin/csh
+.DE
+Thus I would do
+.DS
+chsh bill /bin/csh
+.DE
+It is only necessary to do this once.
+The next time you log in to \s-2UNIX\s0 after doing this command,
+you will be using
+.I csh
+rather than the shell in `/bin/sh' (1.9).
+.IP cmp
+.I Cmp
+is a program which compares files.
+It is usually used on binary files, or to see if two files are identical (3.6).
+For comparing text files the program
+.I diff ,
+described in `diff (1)' is used.
+.IP command
+A function performed by the system, either by the shell
+(a builtin
+.I command )
+or by a program residing in a file in
+a directory within the \s-2UNIX\s0 system, is called a
+.I command
+(1.1).
+.IP "command name"
+.br
+When a command is issued, it consists of a
+.I "command name" ,
+which is the first word of the command,
+followed by arguments.
+The convention on \s-2UNIX\s0 is that the first word of a
+command names the function to be performed (1.1).
+.IP "command substitution"
+.br
+The replacement of a command enclosed in `\`' characters
+by the text output by that command
+is called
+.I "command substitution"
+(4.3).
+.IP component
+A part of a
+.I pathname
+between `/' characters is called a
+.I component
+of that
+.I pathname .
+A variable
+which has multiple strings as value is said to have
+several
+.I component s;
+each string is a
+.I component
+of the variable.
+.IP continue
+A builtin command which causes execution of the enclosing
+.I foreach
+or
+.I while
+loop to cycle prematurely.
+Similar to the
+.I continue
+command in the programming language C (3.6).
+.IP control-
+Certain special characters, called
+.I control
+characters, are produced by holding down the \s-2CONTROL\s0 key
+on your terminal and simultaneously pressing another character, much like
+the \s-2SHIFT\s0 key is used to produce upper case characters. Thus
+.I control- c
+is produced by holding down the \s-2CONTROL\s0 key while pressing the
+`c' key. Usually \s-2UNIX\s0 prints an caret (^) followed by the
+corresponding letter when you type a
+.I control
+character (e.g. `^C' for
+.I control- c
+(1.8).
+.IP "core\ dump"
+When a program terminates abnormally, the system places an image
+of its current state in a file named `core'.
+This
+.I "core dump"
+can be examined with the system debugger `adb (1)'
+or `sdb (1)' in order to determine what went wrong with the program (1.8).
+If the shell produces a message of the form
+.DS
+Illegal instruction (core dumped)
+.DE
+(where `Illegal instruction' is only one of several possible
+messages), you should report this to the author of the program
+or a system administrator,
+saving the `core' file.
+.IP cp
+The
+.I cp
+(copy) program is used to copy the contents of one file into another
+file.
+It is one of the most commonly used \s-2UNIX\s0 commands (1.6).
+.IP csh
+The name of the shell
+program that this document describes.
+.IP \&.cshrc
+The file
+.I \&.cshrc
+in your
+.I home
+directory is read by each shell as it begins execution.
+It is usually used to change the setting of the variable
+.I path
+and to set
+.I alias
+parameters which are to take effect globally (2.1).
+.IP cwd
+The
+.I cwd
+variable in the shell holds the
+.I "absolute pathname"
+of the current
+.I "working directory" \&.
+It is changed by the shell whenever your current
+.I "working directory"
+changes and should not be changed otherwise (2.2).
+.IP date
+The
+.I date
+command prints the current date and time (1.3).
+.IP debugging
+.I Debugging
+is the process of correcting mistakes in programs and shell scripts.
+The shell has several options and variables which may be used
+to aid in shell
+.I debugging
+(4.4).
+.IP default:
+The label
+.I default:
+is used within shell
+.I switch
+statements, as it is in the C language
+to label the code to be executed if none of the
+.I case
+labels matches the value switched on (3.7).
+.IP \s-2DELETE\s0
+The
+\s-2DELETE\s0
+or
+\s-2RUBOUT\s0
+key on the terminal normally causes an interrupt to be sent to the current job.
+Many users change the interrupt character to be ^C.
+.IP detached
+A command that continues running in the
+.I background
+after you logout is said to be
+.I detached .
+.IP diagnostic
+An error message produced by a program is often referred to as a
+.I diagnostic .
+Most error messages are not written to the
+.I "standard output" ,
+since that is often directed away from the terminal (1.3, 1.5).
+Error messsages are instead written to the
+.I "diagnostic output"
+which may be directed away from the terminal, but usually is not.
+Thus
+.I diagnostics
+will usually appear on the terminal (2.5).
+.IP directory
+A structure which contains files.
+At any time you are in one particular
+.I directory
+whose names can be printed by the command
+.I pwd .
+The
+.I chdir
+command will change you to another
+.I directory ,
+and make the files
+in that
+.I directory
+visible. The
+.I directory
+in which you are when you first login is your
+.I home
+directory (1.1, 2.7).
+.IP "directory\ stack"
+The shell saves the names of previous
+.I "working directories"
+in the
+.I "directory stack"
+when you change your current
+.I "working directory"
+via the
+.I pushd
+command. The
+.I "directory stack"
+can be printed by using the
+.I dirs
+command, which includes your current
+.I "working directory"
+as the first directory name on the left (2.7).
+.IP dirs
+The
+.I dirs
+command prints the shell's
+.I "directory stack"
+(2.7).
+.IP du
+The
+.I du
+command is a program (described in `du (1)') which
+prints the number of disk blocks is all directories below
+and including your current
+.I "working directory"
+(2.6).
+.IP echo
+The
+.I echo
+command prints its arguments (1.6, 3.6).
+.IP else
+The
+.I else
+command is part of the `if-then-else-endif' control
+command construct (3.6).
+.IP endif
+If an
+.I if
+statement is ended with the word
+.I then ,
+all lines following the
+.I if
+up to a line starting with the word
+.I endif
+or
+.I else
+are executed if the condition between parentheses after the
+.I if
+is true (3.6).
+.IP \s-2EOF\s0
+An
+.I "end\f1-\fPof\f1-\fPfile"
+is generated by the terminal by a control-d,
+and whenever a command reads to the end of a file which
+it has been given as input.
+Commands receiving input from a
+.I pipe
+receive an
+.I "end\f1-\fPof\f1-\fPfile"
+when the command sending them input completes.
+Most commands terminate when they receive an
+.I "end\f1-\fPof\f1-\fPfile" .
+The shell has an option to ignore
+.I "end\f1-\fPof\f1-\fPfile"
+from a terminal
+input which may help you keep from logging out accidentally
+by typing too many control-d's (1.1, 1.8, 3.8).
+.IP escape
+A character `\e' used to prevent the special meaning of a metacharacter
+is said to
+.I escape
+the character from its special meaning.
+Thus
+.DS
+echo \e*
+.DE
+will echo the character `*' while just
+.DS
+echo *
+.DE
+will echo the names of the file in the current directory.
+In this example, \e
+.I escape s
+`*' (1.7).
+There is also a non-printing character called
+.I escape ,
+usually labelled
+\s-2ESC\s0
+or
+\s-2ALTMODE\s0
+on terminal keyboards.
+Some older \s-2UNIX\s0 systems use this character to indicate that
+output is to be
+.I suspended .
+Most systems use control-s to stop the output and control-q to start it.
+.IP /etc/passwd
+This file contains information about the accounts currently on the
+system.
+It consists of a line for each account with fields separated by
+`:' characters (1.8).
+You can look at this file by saying
+.DS
+cat /etc/passwd
+.DE
+The commands
+.I finger
+and
+.I grep
+are often used to search for information in this file.
+See `finger (1)', `passwd(5)', and `grep (1)' for more details.
+.IP exit
+The
+.I exit
+command is used to force termination of a shell script,
+and is built into the shell (3.9).
+.IP "exit\ status"
+A command which discovers a problem may reflect this back to the command
+(such as a shell) which invoked (executed) it.
+It does this by returning a non-zero number as its
+.I "exit status" ,
+a status of zero being considered
+`normal termination'.
+The
+.I exit
+command can be used to force a shell command script to give a non-zero
+.I "exit status"
+(3.6).
+.IP expansion
+The replacement of strings in the shell input which contain metacharacters
+by other strings is referred to as the process of
+.I expansion .
+Thus the replacement of the word `*' by a sorted list of files
+in the current directory is a `filename expansion'.
+Similarly the replacement of the characters `!!' by the text of
+the last command is a `history expansion'.
+.I Expansions
+are also referred to as
+.I substitutions
+(1.6, 3.4, 4.2).
+.IP expressions
+.I Expressions
+are used in the shell
+to control the conditional structures used in the writing of shell
+scripts and in calculating values for these scripts.
+The operators available in shell
+.I expressions
+are those of the language
+C (3.5).
+.IP extension
+Filenames often consist of a
+.I base
+name and an
+.I extension
+separated by the character `.'.
+By convention, groups of related files often share the same
+.I root
+name.
+Thus if `prog.c' were a C program, then the object file for this
+program would be stored in `prog.o'.
+Similarly a paper written with the
+`\-me'
+nroff macro package might be stored in
+`paper.me'
+while a formatted version of this paper might be kept in
+`paper.out' and a list of spelling errors in
+`paper.errs' (1.6).
+.IP fg
+The
+.I "job control"
+command
+.I fg
+is used to run a
+.I background
+or
+.I suspended
+job in the
+.I foreground
+(1.8, 2.6).
+.IP filename
+Each file in \s-2UNIX\s0 has a name consisting of up to 14 characters
+and not including the character `/' which is used in
+.I pathname
+building. Most
+.I filenames
+do not begin with the character `.', and contain
+only letters and digits with perhaps a `.' separating the
+.I base
+portion of the
+.I filename
+from an
+.I extension
+(1.6).
+.IP "filename expansion"
+.br
+.I "Filename expansion"
+uses the metacharacters `*', `?' and `[' and `]'
+to provide a convenient mechanism for naming files.
+Using
+.I "filename expansion"
+it is easy to name all the files in
+the current directory, or all files which have a common
+.I root
+name. Other
+.I "filename expansion"
+mechanisms use the metacharacter `~' and allow
+files in other users' directories to be named easily (1.6, 4.2).
+.IP flag
+Many \s-2UNIX\s0 commands accept arguments which are not the names
+of files or other users but are used to modify the action of the commands.
+These are referred to as
+.I flag
+options, and by convention consist of one or more letters preceded by
+the character `\-' (1.2).
+Thus the
+.I ls
+(list files) command has an option
+`\-s' to list the sizes of files.
+This is specified
+.DS
+ls \-s
+.DE
+.IP foreach
+The
+.I foreach
+command is used in shell scripts and at the terminal to specify
+repetition of a sequence of commands while the value of a certain
+shell variable ranges through a specified list (3.6, 4.1).
+.IP foreground
+When commands are executing in the normal way such that the
+shell is waiting for them to finish before prompting for another
+command they are said to be
+.I "foreground jobs"
+or
+.I "running in the foreground" \&.
+This is as opposed to
+.I background .
+.I Foreground
+jobs can be stopped by signals
+from the terminal caused by typing different
+control characters at the keyboard (1.8, 2.6).
+.IP goto
+The shell has a command
+.I goto
+used in shell scripts to transfer control to a given label (3.7).
+.IP grep
+The
+.I grep
+command searches through a list of argument files for a specified string.
+Thus
+.DS
+grep bill /etc/passwd
+.DE
+will print each line in the file
+.I "/etc/passwd"
+which contains the string `bill'.
+Actually,
+.I grep
+scans for
+.I "regular expressions"
+in the sense of the editors
+`ed (1)' and `ex (1)'.
+.I Grep
+stands for
+`globally find
+.I "regular expression"
+and print' (2.4).
+.IP head
+The
+.I head
+command prints the first few lines of one or more files.
+If you have a bunch of files containing text which you are wondering
+about it is sometimes useful to run
+.I head
+with these files as arguments.
+This will usually show enough of what is in these files to let you decide
+which you are interested in (1.5).
+.br
+.I Head
+is also used to describe the part of a
+.I pathname
+before and including the last `/' character. The
+.I tail
+of a
+.I pathname
+is the part after the last `/'. The `:h' and `:t' modifiers allow the
+.I head
+or
+.I tail
+of a
+.I pathname
+stored in a shell variable to be used (3.6).
+.IP history
+The
+.I history
+mechanism of the shell allows previous commands to be repeated,
+possibly after modification to correct typing mistakes or to change
+the meaning of the command.
+The shell has a
+.I "history list"
+where these commands are kept, and a
+.I history
+variable which controls how large this list is (2.3).
+.IP "home\ directory"
+.br
+Each user has a
+.I "home directory" ,
+which is given in your entry
+in the password file,
+.I /etc/passwd .
+This is the directory which you are placed in when you first login.
+The
+.I cd
+or
+.I chdir
+command with no arguments takes you back to this directory, whose
+name is recorded in the shell variable
+.I home .
+You can also access the
+.I "home directories"
+of other users in forming
+filenames using a
+.I "filename expansion"
+notation and the character `~' (1.6).
+.IP if
+A conditional command within the shell, the
+.I if
+command is used in shell command scripts to make decisions
+about what course of action to take next (3.6).
+.IP ignoreeof
+Normally, your shell will exit, printing
+`logout'
+if you type a control-d at a prompt of `% '.
+This is the way you usually log off the system.
+You can
+.I set
+the
+.I ignoreeof
+variable if you wish in your
+.I \&.login
+file and then use the command
+.I logout
+to logout.
+This is useful if you sometimes accidentally type too many control-d
+characters, logging yourself off
+(2.2).
+.IP input
+Many commands on \s-2UNIX\s0 take information from the terminal or from
+files which they then act on.
+This information is called
+.I input .
+Commands normally read for
+.I input
+from their
+.I "standard input"
+which is, by default, the terminal.
+This
+.I "standard input"
+can be redirected from a file using a shell metanotation
+with the character `<'.
+Many commands will also read from a file specified as argument.
+Commands placed in
+.I pipelines
+will read from the output of the previous
+command in the
+.I pipeline .
+The leftmost command in a
+.I pipeline
+reads from the terminal if
+you neither redirect its
+.I input
+nor give it a filename to use as
+.I "standard input" .
+Special mechanisms exist for supplying input to commands in shell
+scripts (1.5, 3.8).
+.IP interrupt
+An
+.I interrupt
+is a signal to a program that is generated by typing ^C. (On older versions
+of UNIX the \s-2RUBOUT\s0 or \s-2DELETE\s0 key were used for this purpose.)
+It causes most programs to stop execution.
+Certain programs, such as the shell and the editors,
+handle an
+.I interrupt
+in special ways, usually by stopping what they
+are doing and prompting for another command.
+While the shell is executing another command and waiting for it
+to finish, the shell does not listen to
+.I interrupts.
+The shell often wakes up when you hit
+.I interrupt
+because many commands
+die when they receive an
+.I interrupt
+(1.8, 3.9).
+.IP job
+One or more commands
+typed on the same input line separated by `|' or `;' characters
+are run together and are called a
+.I job \&.
+Simple commands run by themselves without any `|' or `;' characters
+are the simplest
+.I jobs.
+.I Jobs
+are classified as
+.I foreground ,
+.I background ,
+or
+.I suspended
+(2.6).
+.IP "job\ control"
+The builtin functions that control the execution of
+jobs are called
+.I "job control"
+commands. These are
+.I "bg, fg, stop, kill"
+(2.6).
+.IP "job\ number"
+When each job
+is started it is assigned a small number called a
+.I "job number"
+which is printed next to the job in the output of the
+.I jobs
+command. This number, preceded by a `%' character, can be used as an argument
+to
+.I "job control"
+commands to indicate
+a specific job (2.6).
+.IP jobs
+The
+.I jobs
+command prints a table showing
+jobs that are either running in the
+.I background
+or are
+.I suspended
+(2.6).
+.IP kill
+A command which sends a
+signal
+to a job causing it to terminate (2.6).
+.IP \&.login
+The file
+.I \&.login
+in your
+.I home
+directory is read by the shell each time you login to \s-2UNIX\s0
+and the commands there are executed.
+There are a number of commands which are usefully placed here,
+especially
+.I set
+commands to the shell itself (2.1).
+.IP "login\ shell"
+The shell that is started on your terminal when you login is called
+your
+.I "login shell" .
+It is different from other shells which you may run (e.g. on
+shell scripts)
+in that it reads the
+.I \&.login
+file before reading commands from the terminal and it reads the
+.I \&.logout
+file after you logout
+(2.1).
+.IP logout
+The
+.I logout
+command causes a login shell to exit.
+Normally, a login shell will exit when you hit control-d
+generating an
+.I end\f1-\fPof\f1-\fPfile,
+but if you have set
+.I ignoreeof
+in you
+.I \&.login
+file then this will not work and you must use
+.I logout
+to log off the \s-2UNIX\s0 system (2.8).
+.IP \&.logout
+When you log off of \s-2UNIX\s0 the shell will execute commands from
+the file
+.I \&.logout
+in your
+.I home
+directory after it prints `logout'.
+.IP lpr
+The command
+.I lpr
+is the line printer daemon.
+The standard input of
+.I lpr
+spooled and printed on the \s-2UNIX\s0 line printer.
+You can also give
+.I lpr
+a list of filenames as arguments to be printed.
+It is most common to use
+.I lpr
+as the last component of a
+.I pipeline
+(2.3).
+.IP ls
+The
+.I ls
+(list files) command is one of the most commonly used \s-2UNIX\s0
+commands.
+With no argument filenames it prints the names of the files in the
+current directory.
+It has a number of useful
+.I flag
+arguments, and can also be given the names of directories
+as arguments, in which case it lists the names of the files in these
+directories (1.2).
+.IP mail
+The
+.I mail
+program is used to send and receive messages from other \s-2UNIX\s0
+users (1.1, 2.1), whether they are logged on or not.
+.IP make
+The
+.I make
+command is used to maintain one or more related files and to
+organize functions to be performed on these files.
+In many ways
+.I make
+is easier to use, and more helpful than
+shell command scripts (3.2).
+.IP makefile
+The file containing commands for
+.I make
+is called
+.I makefile
+or
+.I Makefile
+(3.2).
+.IP manual
+The
+.I manual
+often referred to is the
+`\s-2UNIX\s0 manual'.
+It contains 8 numbered sections with a description of each \s-2UNIX\s0
+program (section 1), system call (section 2), subroutine (section 3),
+device (section 4), special data structure (section 5), game (section 6),
+miscellaneous item (section 7) and system administration program (section 8).
+There are also supplementary documents (tutorials and reference guides)
+for individual programs which require explanation in more detail.
+An online version of the
+.I manual
+is accessible through the
+.I man
+command.
+Its documentation can be obtained online via
+.DS
+man man
+.DE
+If you can't decide what manual page to look in, try the
+.I apropos (1)
+command.
+The supplementary documents are in subdirectories of /usr/doc.
+.IP metacharacter
+.br
+Many characters which are neither letters nor digits have special meaning
+either to the shell or to \s-2UNIX\s0.
+These characters are called
+.I metacharacters .
+If it is necessary to place these characters in arguments to commands
+without them having their special meaning then they must be
+.I quoted .
+An example of a
+.I metacharacter
+is the character `>' which is used
+to indicate placement of output into a file.
+For the purposes of the
+.I history
+mechanism,
+most unquoted
+.I metacharacters
+form separate words (1.4).
+The appendix to this user's manual lists the
+.I metacharacters
+in groups by their function.
+.IP mkdir
+The
+.I mkdir
+command is used to create a new directory.
+.IP modifier
+Substitutions with the
+.I history
+mechanism, keyed by the character `!'
+or of variables using the metacharacter `$', are often subjected
+to modifications, indicated by placing the character `:' after the
+substitution and following this with the
+.I modifier
+itself.
+The
+.I "command substitution"
+mechanism can also be used to perform modification in a similar way,
+but this notation is less clear (3.6).
+.IP more
+The program
+.I more
+writes a file on your terminal allowing you to control how much text
+is displayed at a time.
+.I More
+can move through the file screenful by screenful, line by line,
+search forward for a string, or start again at the beginning of the file.
+It is generally the easiest way of viewing a file (1.8).
+.IP noclobber
+The shell has a variable
+.I noclobber
+which may be set in the file
+.I \&.login
+to prevent accidental destruction of files by the `>' output redirection
+metasyntax of the shell (2.2, 2.5).
+.IP noglob
+The shell variable
+.I noglob
+is set to suppress the
+.I "filename expansion"
+of arguments containing the metacharacters `~', `*', `?', `[' and `]' (3.6).
+.IP notify
+The
+.I notify
+command tells the shell to report on the termination of a specific
+.I "background job"
+at the exact time it occurs as opposed to waiting
+until just before the next prompt to report the termination.
+The
+.I notify
+variable, if set, causes the shell to always report the termination
+of
+.I background
+jobs exactly when they occur (2.6).
+.IP onintr
+The
+.I onintr
+command is built into the shell and is used to control the action
+of a shell command script when an
+.I interrupt
+signal is received (3.9).
+.IP output
+Many commands in \s-2UNIX\s0 result in some lines of text which are
+called their
+.I output.
+This
+.I output
+is usually placed on what is known as the
+.I "standard output"
+which is normally connected to the user's terminal.
+The shell has a syntax using the metacharacter `>' for redirecting
+the
+.I "standard output"
+of a command to a file (1.3).
+Using the
+.I pipe
+mechanism and the metacharacter `|' it is also possible for
+the
+.I "standard output"
+of one command to become the
+.I "standard input"
+of another command (1.5).
+Certain commands such as the line printer daemon
+.I p
+do not place their results on the
+.I "standard output"
+but rather in more
+useful places such as on the line printer (2.3).
+Similarly the
+.I write
+command places its output on another user's terminal rather than its
+.I "standard output"
+(2.3).
+Commands also have a
+.I "diagnostic output"
+where they write their error messages.
+Normally these go to the terminal even if the
+.I "standard output"
+has been sent to a file or another command, but it is possible
+to direct error diagnostics along with
+.I "standard output"
+using a special metanotation (2.5).
+.IP path
+The shell has a variable
+.I path
+which gives the names of the directories in which it searches for
+the commands which it is given.
+It always checks first to see if the command it is given is
+built into the shell.
+If it is, then it need not search for the command as it can do it internally.
+If the command is not builtin, then the shell searches for a file
+with the name given in each of the directories in the
+.I path
+variable, left to right.
+Since the normal definition of the
+.I path
+variable is
+.DS
+path (. /usr/ucb /bin /usr/bin)
+.DE
+the shell normally looks in the current directory, and then in
+the standard system directories `/usr/ucb', `/bin' and `/usr/bin' for the named
+command (2.2).
+If the command cannot be found the shell will print an error diagnostic.
+Scripts of shell commands will be executed using another shell to interpret
+them if they have `execute' permission set.
+This is normally true because a command of the form
+.DS
+chmod 755 script
+.DE
+was executed to turn this execute permission on (3.3).
+If you add new commands to a directory in the
+.I path ,
+you should issue
+the command
+.I rehash
+(2.2).
+.IP pathname
+A list of names, separated by `/' characters, forms a
+.I pathname.
+Each
+.I component,
+between successive `/' characters, names a directory
+in which the next
+.I component
+file resides.
+.I Pathnames
+which begin with the character `/' are interpreted relative
+to the
+.I root
+directory in the filesystem.
+Other
+.I pathnames
+are interpreted relative to the current directory
+as reported by
+.I pwd.
+The last component of a
+.I pathname
+may name a directory, but
+usually names a file.
+.IP pipeline
+A group of commands which are connected together, the
+.I "standard output"
+of each connected to the
+.I "standard input"
+of the next,
+is called a
+.I pipeline.
+The
+.I pipe
+mechanism used to connect these commands is indicated by
+the shell metacharacter `|' (1.5, 2.3).
+.IP popd
+The
+.I popd
+command changes the shell's
+.I "working directory"
+to the directory you most recently left using the
+.I pushd
+command. It returns to the directory without having to type its name,
+forgetting the name of the current
+.I "working directory"
+before doing so (2.7).
+.IP port
+The part of a computer system to which each terminal is
+connected is called a
+.I port .
+Usually the system has a fixed number of
+.I ports ,
+some of which are connected to telephone lines
+for dial-up access, and some of which are permanently
+wired directly to specific terminals.
+.IP pr
+The
+.I pr
+command is used to prepare listings of the contents of files
+with headers giving the name of the file and the date and
+time at which the file was last modified (2.3).
+.IP printenv
+The
+.I printenv
+command is used
+to print the current setting of variables in the environment
+(2.8).
+.IP process
+An instance of a running program is called a
+.I process
+(2.6).
+\s-2UNIX\s0 assigns each
+.I process
+a unique number when it is
+started \- called the
+.I "process number" .
+.I "Process numbers"
+can be used to stop individual
+.I processes
+using the
+.I kill
+or
+.I stop
+commands when the
+.I processes
+are part of a detached
+.I background
+job.
+.IP program
+Usually synonymous with
+.I command ;
+a binary file or shell command script
+which performs a useful function is often
+called a
+.I program .
+.IP prompt
+Many programs will print a
+.I prompt
+on the terminal when they expect input.
+Thus the editor
+`ex (1)' will print a `:' when it expects input.
+The shell
+.I prompts
+for input with `% ' and occasionally with `? ' when
+reading commands from the terminal (1.1).
+The shell has a variable
+.I prompt
+which may be set to a different value to change the shell's main
+.I prompt .
+This is mostly used when debugging the shell (2.8).
+.IP pushd
+The
+.I pushd
+command, which means `push directory', changes the shell's
+.I "working directory"
+and also remembers the current
+.I "working directory"
+before the change is made, allowing you to return to the same
+directory via the
+.I popd
+command later without retyping its name (2.7).
+.IP ps
+The
+.I ps
+command is used to show the processes you are currently running.
+Each process is shown with its unique process number,
+an indication of the terminal name it is attached to,
+an indication of the state of the process (whether it is running,
+stopped, awaiting some event (sleeping), and whether it is swapped out),
+and the amount of \s-2CPU\s0 time it has used so far.
+The command is identified by printing some of the words used
+when it was invoked (2.6).
+Shells, such as the
+.I csh
+you use to run the
+.I ps
+command, are not normally shown in the output.
+.IP pwd
+The
+.I pwd
+command prints the full
+.I pathname
+of the current
+.I "working directory" \&.
+The
+.I dirs
+builtin command is usually a better and faster choice.
+.IP quit
+The
+.I quit
+signal, generated by a control-\e,
+is used to terminate programs which are behaving unreasonably.
+It normally produces a core image file (1.8).
+.IP quotation
+The process by which metacharacters are prevented their special
+meaning, usually by using the character `\' in pairs, or by
+using the character `\e', is referred to as
+.I quotation
+(1.7).
+.IP redirection
+The routing of input or output from or to a file is known
+as
+.I redirection
+of input or output (1.3).
+.IP rehash
+The
+.I rehash
+command tells the shell to rebuild its internal table of which commands
+are found in which directories in your
+.I path .
+This is necessary when a new program is installed in one of these
+directories (2.8).
+.IP "relative pathname"
+.br
+A
+.I pathname
+which does not begin with a `/' is called a
+.I "relative pathname"
+since it is interpreted
+.I relative
+to the current
+.I "working directory" .
+The first
+.I component
+of such a
+.I pathname
+refers to some file or directory in the
+.I "working directory" ,
+and subsequent
+.I components
+between `/' characters refer to directories below the
+.I "working directory" .
+.I Pathnames
+that are not
+.I relative
+are called
+.I "absolute pathnames"
+(1.6).
+.IP repeat
+The
+.I repeat
+command iterates another command a specified number of times.
+.IP root
+The directory
+that is at the top of the entire directory structure is called the
+.I root
+directory since it is the `root' of the entire tree structure of
+directories. The name used in
+.I pathnames
+to indicate the
+.I root
+is `/'.
+.I Pathnames
+starting with `/' are said to be
+.I absolute
+since they start at the
+.I root
+directory.
+.I Root
+is also used as the part of a
+.I pathname
+that is left after removing
+the
+.I extension .
+See
+.I filename
+for a further explanation (1.6).
+.IP \s-2RUBOUT\s0
+The \s-2RUBOUT\s0 or \s-2DELETE\s0
+key is often used to erase the previously typed character; some users
+prefer the \s-2BACKSPACE\s0 for this purpose. On older versions of \s-2UNIX\s0
+this key served as the \s-2INTR\s0 character.
+.IP "scratch file"
+Files whose names begin with a `#' are referred to as
+.I "scratch files" ,
+since they are automatically removed by the system after a couple of
+days of non-use, or more frequently if disk space becomes tight (1.3).
+.IP script
+Sequences of shell commands placed in a file are called shell command
+.I scripts .
+It is often possible to perform simple tasks using these
+.I scripts
+without writing a program in a language such as C, by
+using the shell to selectively run other programs (3.3, 3.10).
+.IP set
+The builtin
+.I set
+command is used to assign new values to shell variables
+and to show the values of the current variables.
+Many shell variables have special meaning to the shell itself.
+Thus by using the
+.I set
+command the behavior of the shell can be affected (2.1).
+.IP setenv
+Variables in the environment `environ (5)'
+can be changed by using the
+.I setenv
+builtin command (2.8).
+The
+.I printenv
+command can be used to print the value of the variables in the environment.
+.IP shell
+A
+.I shell
+is a command language interpreter.
+It is possible to write and run your own
+.I shell ,
+as
+.I shells
+are no different than any other programs as far as the
+system is concerned.
+This manual deals with the details of one particular
+.I shell ,
+called
+.I csh.
+.IP "shell script"
+See
+.I script
+(3.3, 3.10).
+.IP signal
+A
+.I signal
+in \s-2UNIX\s0 is a short message that is sent to a running program
+which causes something to happen to that process.
+.I Signals
+are sent either by typing special
+.I control
+characters on the keyboard or by using the
+.I kill
+or
+.I stop
+commands (1.8, 2.6).
+.IP sort
+The
+.I sort
+program sorts a sequence of lines in ways that can be controlled
+by argument
+.I flags
+(1.5).
+.IP source
+The
+.I source
+command causes the shell to read commands from a specified file.
+It is most useful for reading files such as
+.I \&.cshrc
+after changing them (2.8).
+.IP "special character"
+.br
+See
+.I metacharacters
+and the
+appendix to this manual.
+.IP standard
+We refer often to the
+.I "standard input"
+and
+.I "standard output"
+of commands.
+See
+.I input
+and
+.I output
+(1.3, 3.8).
+.IP status
+A command normally returns a
+.I status
+when it finishes.
+By convention a
+.I status
+of zero indicates that the command succeeded.
+Commands may return non-zero
+.I status
+to indicate that some abnormal event has occurred.
+The shell variable
+.I status
+is set to the
+.I status
+returned by the last command.
+It is most useful in shell commmand scripts (3.6).
+.IP stop
+The
+.I stop
+command causes a
+.I background
+job to become
+.I suspended
+(2.6).
+.IP string
+A sequential group of characters taken together is called a
+.I string \&.
+.I Strings
+can contain any printable characters (2.2).
+.IP stty
+The
+.I stty
+program changes certain parameters inside \s-2UNIX\s0 which determine
+how your terminal is handled. See `stty (1)' for a complete description (2.6).
+.IP substitution
+The shell implements a number of
+.I substitutions
+where sequences indicated by metacharacters are replaced by other sequences.
+Notable examples of this are history
+.I substitution
+keyed by the
+metacharacter `!' and variable
+.I substitution
+indicated by `$'.
+We also refer to
+.I substitutions
+as
+.I expansions
+(3.4).
+.IP suspended
+A job becomes
+.I suspended
+after a \s-2STOP\s0 signal is sent to it, either by typing a
+.I control -z
+at the terminal (for
+.I foreground
+jobs) or by using the
+.I stop
+command (for
+.I background
+jobs). When
+.I suspended ,
+a job temporarily stops running until it is restarted by either the
+.I fg
+or
+.I bg
+command (2.6).
+.IP switch
+The
+.I switch
+command of the shell allows the shell
+to select one of a number of sequences of commands based on an
+argument string.
+It is similar to the
+.I switch
+statement in the language C (3.7).
+.IP termination
+When a command which is being executed finishes we say it undergoes
+.I termination
+or
+.I terminates.
+Commands normally terminate when they read an
+.I end\f1-\fPof\f1-\fPfile
+from their
+.I "standard input" .
+It is also possible to terminate commands by sending them
+an
+.I interrupt
+or
+.I quit
+signal (1.8).
+The
+.I kill
+program terminates specified jobs (2.6).
+.IP then
+The
+.I then
+command is part of the shell's
+`if-then-else-endif' control construct used in command scripts (3.6).
+.IP time
+The
+.I time
+command can be used to measure the amount of \s-2CPU\s0
+and real time consumed by a specified command as well
+as the amount of disk i/o, memory utilized, and number
+of page faults and swaps taken by the command (2.1, 2.8).
+.IP tset
+The
+.I tset
+program is used to set standard erase and kill characters
+and to tell the system what kind of terminal you are using.
+It is often invoked in a
+.I \&.login
+file (2.1).
+.IP tty
+The word
+.I tty
+is a historical abbreviation for `teletype' which is frequently used
+in \s-2UNIX\s0 to indicate the
+.I port
+to which a given terminal is connected. The
+.I tty
+command will print the name of the
+.I tty
+or
+.I port
+to which your terminal is presently connected.
+.IP unalias
+The
+.I unalias
+command removes aliases (2.8).
+.IP \s-2UNIX\s0
+\s-2UNIX\s0 is an operating system on which
+.I csh
+runs.
+\s-2UNIX\s0 provides facilities which allow
+.I csh
+to invoke other programs such as editors and text formatters which
+you may wish to use.
+.IP unset
+The
+.I unset
+command removes the definitions of shell variables (2.2, 2.8).
+.IP "variable expansion"
+.br
+See
+.I variables
+and
+.I expansion
+(2.2, 3.4).
+.IP variables
+.I Variables
+in
+.I csh
+hold one or more strings as value.
+The most common use of
+.I variables
+is in controlling the behavior
+of the shell.
+See
+.I path ,
+.I noclobber ,
+and
+.I ignoreeof
+for examples.
+.I Variables
+such as
+.I argv
+are also used in writing shell programs (shell command scripts)
+(2.2).
+.IP verbose
+The
+.I verbose
+shell variable can be set to cause commands to be echoed
+after they are history expanded.
+This is often useful in debugging shell scripts.
+The
+.I verbose
+variable is set by the shell's
+.I \-v
+command line option (3.10).
+.IP wc
+The
+.I wc
+program calculates the number of characters, words, and lines in the
+files whose names are given as arguments (2.6).
+.IP while
+The
+.I while
+builtin control construct is used in shell command scripts (3.7).
+.IP word
+A sequence of characters which forms an argument to a command is called
+a
+.I word .
+Many characters which are neither letters, digits, `\-', `.' nor `/'
+form
+.I words
+all by themselves even if they are not surrounded
+by blanks.
+Any sequence of characters may be made into a
+.I word
+by surrounding it
+with `\'' characters
+except for the characters `\'' and `!' which require special treatment
+(1.1).
+This process of placing special characters in
+.I words
+without their special meaning is called
+.I quoting .
+.IP "working directory"
+.br
+At any given time you are in one particular directory, called
+your
+.I "working directory" .
+This directory's name is printed by the
+.I pwd
+command and the files listed by
+.I ls
+are the ones in this directory.
+You can change
+.I "working directories"
+using
+.I chdir .
+.IP write
+The
+.I write
+command is an obsolete way of communicating with other users who are logged in to
+\s-2UNIX\s0 (you have to take turns typing). If you are both using display
+terminals, use \fItalk\fP(1), which is much more pleasant.
diff --git a/bin/csh/USD.doc/tabs b/bin/csh/USD.doc/tabs
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9d274a1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/USD.doc/tabs
@@ -0,0 +1,34 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)tabs 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+.\"
+.ta 5n 10n 15n 20n 25n 30n 35n 40n 45n 50n 55n 60n 65n 70n 75n 80n
diff --git a/bin/csh/alloc.c b/bin/csh/alloc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6fc8cf5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/alloc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,124 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1983, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)alloc.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+char *memtop = NULL; /* PWP: top of current memory */
+char *membot = NULL; /* PWP: bottom of allocatable memory */
+
+ptr_t
+Malloc(n)
+ size_t n;
+{
+ ptr_t ptr;
+
+ if (membot == NULL)
+ memtop = membot = sbrk(0);
+ if ((ptr = malloc(n)) == (ptr_t) 0) {
+ child++;
+ stderror(ERR_NOMEM);
+ }
+ return (ptr);
+}
+
+ptr_t
+Realloc(p, n)
+ ptr_t p;
+ size_t n;
+{
+ ptr_t ptr;
+
+ if (membot == NULL)
+ memtop = membot = sbrk(0);
+ if ((ptr = realloc(p, n)) == (ptr_t) 0) {
+ child++;
+ stderror(ERR_NOMEM);
+ }
+ return (ptr);
+}
+
+ptr_t
+Calloc(s, n)
+ size_t s, n;
+{
+ ptr_t ptr;
+
+ if (membot == NULL)
+ memtop = membot = sbrk(0);
+ if ((ptr = calloc(s, n)) == (ptr_t) 0) {
+ child++;
+ stderror(ERR_NOMEM);
+ }
+
+ return (ptr);
+}
+
+void
+Free(p)
+ ptr_t p;
+{
+ if (p)
+ free(p);
+}
+
+/*
+ * mstats - print out statistics about malloc
+ *
+ * Prints two lines of numbers, one showing the length of the free list
+ * for each size category, the second showing the number of mallocs -
+ * frees for each size category.
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+showall(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ memtop = (char *) sbrk(0);
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "Allocated memory from 0x%lx to 0x%lx (%ld).\n",
+ (unsigned long) membot, (unsigned long) memtop, memtop - membot);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/char.c b/bin/csh/char.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7da611f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/char.c
@@ -0,0 +1,311 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)char.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "char.h"
+
+unsigned short _cmap[256] = {
+/* nul soh stx etx */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* eot enq ack bel */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* bs ht nl vt */
+ _CTR, _CTR|_SP|_META, _CTR|_NL|_META, _CTR,
+
+/* np cr so si */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* dle dc1 dc2 dc3 */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* dc4 nak syn etb */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* can em sub esc */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* fs gs rs us */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* sp ! " # */
+ _SP|_META, 0, _QF, _META,
+
+/* $ % & ' */
+ _DOL, 0, _META|_CMD, _QF,
+
+/* ( ) * + */
+ _META|_CMD, _META, _GLOB, 0,
+
+/* , - . / */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* 0 1 2 3 */
+ _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD,
+
+/* 4 5 6 7 */
+ _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD,
+
+/* 8 9 : ; */
+ _DIG|_XD, _DIG|_XD, 0, _META|_CMD,
+
+/* < = > ? */
+ _META, 0, _META, _GLOB,
+
+/* @ A B C */
+ 0, _LET|_UP|_XD, _LET|_UP|_XD, _LET|_UP|_XD,
+
+/* D E F G */
+ _LET|_UP|_XD, _LET|_UP|_XD, _LET|_UP|_XD, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* H I J K */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* L M N O */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* P Q R S */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* T U V W */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* X Y Z [ */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _GLOB,
+
+/* \ ] ^ _ */
+ _ESC, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* ` a b c */
+ _QB|_GLOB|_META, _LET|_LOW|_XD, _LET|_LOW|_XD, _LET|_LOW|_XD,
+
+/* d e f g */
+ _LET|_LOW|_XD, _LET|_LOW|_XD, _LET|_LOW|_XD, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* h i j k */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* l m n o */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* p q r s */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* t u v w */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* x y z { */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _GLOB,
+
+/* | } ~ del */
+ _META|_CMD, 0, 0, _CTR,
+
+#if defined(SHORT_STRINGS) && !defined(KANJI)
+/****************************************************************/
+/* 128 - 255 The below is supposedly ISO 8859/1 */
+/****************************************************************/
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* (undef) (undef) (undef) (undef) */
+ _CTR, _CTR, _CTR, _CTR,
+
+/* nobreakspace exclamdown cent sterling */
+ _SP, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* currency yen brokenbar section */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* diaeresis copyright ordfeminine guillemotleft */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* notsign hyphen registered macron */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* degree plusminus twosuperior threesuperior */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* acute mu paragraph periodcentered */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* cedilla onesuperior masculine guillemotright */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* onequarter onehalf threequarters questiondown */
+ 0, 0, 0, 0,
+
+/* Agrave Aacute Acircumflex Atilde */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* Adiaeresis Aring AE Ccedilla */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* Egrave Eacute Ecircumflex Ediaeresis */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* Igrave Iacute Icircumflex Idiaeresis */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* ETH Ntilde Ograve Oacute */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* Ocircumflex Otilde Odiaeresis multiply */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, 0,
+
+/* Ooblique Ugrave Uacute Ucircumflex */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP,
+
+/* Udiaeresis Yacute THORN ssharp */
+ _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_UP, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* agrave aacute acircumflex atilde */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* adiaeresis aring ae ccedilla */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* egrave eacute ecircumflex ediaeresis */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* igrave iacute icircumflex idiaeresis */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* eth ntilde ograve oacute */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* ocircumflex otilde odiaeresis division */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, 0,
+
+/* oslash ugrave uacute ucircumflex */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+
+/* udiaeresis yacute thorn ydiaeresis */
+ _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW, _LET|_LOW,
+#endif /* SHORT_STRINGS && !KANJI */
+};
+
+#ifndef NLS
+/* _cmap_lower, _cmap_upper for ISO 8859/1 */
+
+unsigned char _cmap_lower[256] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007,
+ 0010, 0011, 0012, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017,
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0024, 0025, 0026, 0027,
+ 0030, 0031, 0032, 0033, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037,
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0045, 0046, 0047,
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0055, 0056, 0057,
+ 0060, 0061, 0062, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0067,
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0074, 0075, 0076, 0077,
+ 0100, 0141, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147,
+ 0150, 0151, 0152, 0153, 0154, 0155, 0156, 0157,
+ 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, 0166, 0167,
+ 0170, 0171, 0172, 0133, 0134, 0135, 0136, 0137,
+ 0140, 0141, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147,
+ 0150, 0151, 0152, 0153, 0154, 0155, 0156, 0157,
+ 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, 0166, 0167,
+ 0170, 0171, 0172, 0173, 0174, 0175, 0176, 0177,
+ 0200, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207,
+ 0210, 0211, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, 0216, 0217,
+ 0220, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, 0227,
+ 0230, 0231, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, 0237,
+ 0240, 0241, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, 0247,
+ 0250, 0251, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257,
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267,
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277,
+ 0340, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, 0347,
+ 0350, 0351, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, 0356, 0357,
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0327,
+ 0370, 0371, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0337,
+ 0340, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, 0347,
+ 0350, 0351, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, 0356, 0357,
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367,
+ 0370, 0371, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377,
+};
+
+unsigned char _cmap_upper[256] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007,
+ 0010, 0011, 0012, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017,
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0024, 0025, 0026, 0027,
+ 0030, 0031, 0032, 0033, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037,
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0045, 0046, 0047,
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0055, 0056, 0057,
+ 0060, 0061, 0062, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0067,
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0074, 0075, 0076, 0077,
+ 0100, 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107,
+ 0110, 0111, 0112, 0113, 0114, 0115, 0116, 0117,
+ 0120, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127,
+ 0130, 0131, 0132, 0133, 0134, 0135, 0136, 0137,
+ 0140, 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107,
+ 0110, 0111, 0112, 0113, 0114, 0115, 0116, 0117,
+ 0120, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127,
+ 0130, 0131, 0132, 0173, 0174, 0175, 0176, 0177,
+ 0200, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207,
+ 0210, 0211, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, 0216, 0217,
+ 0220, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, 0227,
+ 0230, 0231, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, 0237,
+ 0240, 0241, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, 0247,
+ 0250, 0251, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257,
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267,
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277,
+ 0300, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307,
+ 0310, 0311, 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317,
+ 0320, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, 0327,
+ 0330, 0331, 0332, 0333, 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337,
+ 0300, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307,
+ 0310, 0311, 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317,
+ 0320, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, 0367,
+ 0330, 0331, 0332, 0333, 0334, 0335, 0336, 0377,
+};
+#endif /* NLS */
diff --git a/bin/csh/char.h b/bin/csh/char.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a791de4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/char.h
@@ -0,0 +1,96 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)char.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+
+extern unsigned short _cmap[];
+
+#ifndef NLS
+extern unsigned char _cmap_lower[], _cmap_upper[];
+
+#endif
+
+#define _QF 0x0001 /* '" (Forward quotes) */
+#define _QB 0x0002 /* ` (Backquote) */
+#define _SP 0x0004 /* space and tab */
+#define _NL 0x0008 /* \n */
+#define _META 0x0010 /* lex meta characters, sp #'`";&<>()|\t\n */
+#define _GLOB 0x0020 /* glob characters, *?{[` */
+#define _ESC 0x0040 /* \ */
+#define _DOL 0x0080 /* $ */
+#define _DIG 0x0100 /* 0-9 */
+#define _LET 0x0200 /* a-z, A-Z, _ */
+#define _UP 0x0400 /* A-Z */
+#define _LOW 0x0800 /* a-z */
+#define _XD 0x1000 /* 0-9, a-f, A-F */
+#define _CMD 0x2000 /* lex end of command chars, ;&(|` */
+#define _CTR 0x4000 /* control */
+
+#define cmap(c, bits) \
+ (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : (_cmap[(unsigned char)(c)] & (bits)))
+
+#define isglob(c) cmap(c, _GLOB)
+#define isspc(c) cmap(c, _SP)
+#define ismeta(c) cmap(c, _META)
+#define iscmdmeta(c) cmap(c, _CMD)
+#define letter(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : \
+ (isalpha((unsigned char) (c)) || (c) == '_'))
+#define alnum(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : \
+ (isalnum((unsigned char) (c)) || (c) == '_'))
+#ifdef NLS
+#define Isspace(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isspace((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Isdigit(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isdigit((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Isalpha(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isalpha((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Islower(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : islower((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Isupper(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isupper((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Tolower(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : tolower((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Toupper(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : toupper((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Isxdigit(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isxdigit((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Isalnum(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isalnum((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Iscntrl(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : iscntrl((unsigned char) (c)))
+#define Isprint(c) (((c) & QUOTE) ? 0 : isprint((unsigned char) (c)))
+#else
+#define Isspace(c) cmap(c, _SP|_NL)
+#define Isdigit(c) cmap(c, _DIG)
+#define Isalpha(c) (cmap(c,_LET) && !(((c) & META) && AsciiOnly))
+#define Islower(c) (cmap(c,_LOW) && !(((c) & META) && AsciiOnly))
+#define Isupper(c) (cmap(c, _UP) && !(((c) & META) && AsciiOnly))
+#define Tolower(c) (_cmap_lower[(unsigned char)(c)])
+#define Toupper(c) (_cmap_upper[(unsigned char)(c)])
+#define Isxdigit(c) cmap(c, _XD)
+#define Isalnum(c) (cmap(c, _DIG|_LET) && !(((c) & META) && AsciiOnly))
+#define Iscntrl(c) (cmap(c,_CTR) && !(((c) & META) && AsciiOnly))
+#define Isprint(c) (!cmap(c,_CTR) && !(((c) & META) && AsciiOnly))
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/csh/const.c b/bin/csh/const.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..25a02e0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/const.c
@@ -0,0 +1,160 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)const.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * tc.const.c: String constants for csh.
+ */
+
+#include "csh.h"
+
+Char STR0[] = { '0', '\0' };
+Char STR1[] = { '1', '\0' };
+Char STRHOME[] = { 'H', 'O', 'M', 'E', '\0' };
+Char STRLANG[] = { 'L', 'A', 'N', 'G', '\0' };
+Char STRLC_CTYPE[] = { 'L', 'C', '_', 'C', 'T', 'Y', 'P', 'E' ,'\0' };
+Char STRLOGNAME[] = { 'L', 'O', 'G', 'N', 'A', 'M', 'E', '\0' };
+Char STRLbrace[] = { '{', '\0' };
+Char STRLparen[] = { '(', '\0' };
+Char STRLparensp[] = { '(', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRNULL[] = { '\0' };
+Char STRPATH[] = { 'P', 'A', 'T', 'H', '\0' };
+Char STRPWD[] = { 'P', 'W', 'D', '\0' };
+Char STRQNULL[] = { '\0' | QUOTE, '\0' };
+Char STRRbrace[] = { '}', '\0' };
+Char STRspRparen[] = { ' ', ')', '\0' };
+Char STRTERM[] = { 'T', 'E', 'R', 'M', '\0' };
+Char STRUSER[] = { 'U', 'S', 'E', 'R', '\0' };
+Char STRalias[] = { 'a', 'l', 'i', 'a', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRand[] = { '&', '\0' };
+Char STRand2[] = { '&', '&', '\0' };
+Char STRaout[] = { 'a', '.', 'o', 'u', 't', '\0' };
+Char STRargv[] = { 'a', 'r', 'g', 'v', '\0' };
+Char STRbang[] = { '!', '\0' };
+Char STRcaret[] = { '^', '\0' };
+Char STRcdpath[] = { 'c', 'd', 'p', 'a', 't', 'h', '\0' };
+Char STRcent2[] = { '%', '%', '\0' };
+Char STRcenthash[] = { '%', '#', '\0' };
+Char STRcentplus[] = { '%', '+', '\0' };
+Char STRcentminus[] = { '%', '-', '\0' };
+Char STRchase_symlinks[] = { 'c', 'h', 'a', 's', 'e', '_', 's', 'y', 'm', 'l',
+ 'i', 'n', 'k', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRchild[] = { 'c', 'h', 'i', 'l', 'd', '\0' };
+Char STRcolon[] = { ':', '\0' };
+Char STRcwd[] = { 'c', 'w', 'd', '\0' };
+Char STRdefault[] = { 'd', 'e', 'f', 'a', 'u', 'l', 't', '\0' };
+Char STRdot[] = { '.', '\0' };
+Char STRdotdotsl[] = { '.', '.', '/', '\0' };
+Char STRdotsl[] = { '.', '/', '\0' };
+Char STRecho[] = { 'e', 'c', 'h', 'o', '\0' };
+Char STRequal[] = { '=', '\0' };
+Char STRfakecom[] = { '{', ' ', '.', '.', '.', ' ', '}', '\0' };
+Char STRfakecom1[] = { '`', ' ', '.', '.', '.', ' ', '`', '\0' };
+Char STRfignore[] = { 'f', 'i', 'g', 'n', 'o', 'r', 'e', '\0' };
+#ifdef FILEC
+Char STRfilec[] = { 'f', 'i', 'l', 'e', 'c', '\0' };
+#endif /* FILEC */
+Char STRhistchars[] = { 'h', 'i', 's', 't', 'c', 'h', 'a', 'r', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRtildothist[] = { '~', '/', '.', 'h', 'i', 's', 't', 'o', 'r',
+ 'y', '\0' };
+Char STRhistfile[] = { 'h', 'i', 's', 't', 'f', 'i', 'l', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRhistory[] = { 'h', 'i', 's', 't', 'o', 'r', 'y', '\0' };
+Char STRhome[] = { 'h', 'o', 'm', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRignore_symlinks[] = { 'i', 'g', 'n', 'o', 'r', 'e', '_', 's', 'y', 'm',
+ 'l', 'i', 'n', 'k', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRignoreeof[] = { 'i', 'g', 'n', 'o', 'r', 'e', 'e', 'o', 'f', '\0' };
+Char STRjobs[] = { 'j', 'o', 'b', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRlistjobs[] = { 'l', 'i', 's', 't', 'j', 'o', 'b', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRlogout[] = { 'l', 'o', 'g', 'o', 'u', 't', '\0' };
+Char STRlong[] = { 'l', 'o', 'n', 'g', '\0' };
+Char STRmail[] = { 'm', 'a', 'i', 'l', '\0' };
+Char STRmh[] = { '-', 'h', '\0' };
+Char STRminus[] = { '-', '\0' };
+Char STRml[] = { '-', 'l', '\0' };
+Char STRmn[] = { '-', 'n', '\0' };
+Char STRmquestion[] = { '?' | QUOTE, ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRnice[] = { 'n', 'i', 'c', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRnoambiguous[] = { 'n', 'o', 'a', 'm', 'b', 'i', 'g', 'u', 'o', 'u',
+ 's', '\0' };
+Char STRnobeep[] = { 'n', 'o', 'b', 'e', 'e', 'p', '\0' };
+Char STRnoclobber[] = { 'n', 'o', 'c', 'l', 'o', 'b', 'b', 'e', 'r', '\0' };
+Char STRnoglob[] = { 'n', 'o', 'g', 'l', 'o', 'b', '\0' };
+Char STRnohup[] = { 'n', 'o', 'h', 'u', 'p', '\0' };
+Char STRnonomatch[] = { 'n', 'o', 'n', 'o', 'm', 'a', 't', 'c', 'h', '\0' };
+Char STRnormal[] = { 'n', 'o', 'r', 'm', 'a', 'l', '\0' };
+Char STRnotify[] = { 'n', 'o', 't', 'i', 'f', 'y', '\0' };
+Char STRor[] = { '|', '\0' };
+Char STRor2[] = { '|', '|', '\0' };
+Char STRpath[] = { 'p', 'a', 't', 'h', '\0' };
+Char STRprintexitvalue[] = { 'p', 'r', 'i', 'n', 't', 'e', 'x', 'i', 't', 'v',
+ 'a', 'l', 'u', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRprompt[] = { 'p', 'r', 'o', 'm', 'p', 't', '\0' };
+Char STRprompt2[] = { 'p', 'r', 'o', 'm', 'p', 't', '2', '\0' };
+Char STRpushdsilent[] = { 'p', 'u', 's', 'h', 'd', 's', 'i', 'l', 'e', 'n',
+ 't', '\0' };
+Char STRret[] = { '\n', '\0' };
+Char STRsavehist[] = { 's', 'a', 'v', 'e', 'h', 'i', 's', 't', '\0' };
+Char STRsemisp[] = { ';', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRshell[] = { 's', 'h', 'e', 'l', 'l', '\0' };
+Char STRslash[] = { '/', '\0' };
+Char STRsldotcshrc[] = { '/', '.', 'c', 's', 'h', 'r', 'c', '\0' };
+Char STRsldotlogin[] = { '/', '.', 'l', 'o', 'g', 'i', 'n', '\0' };
+Char STRsldthist[] = { '/', '.', 'h', 'i', 's', 't', 'o', 'r', 'y', '\0' };
+Char STRsldtlogout[] = { '/', '.', 'l', 'o', 'g', 'o', 'u', 't', '\0' };
+Char STRsource[] = { 's', 'o', 'u', 'r', 'c', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRsp3dots[] = { ' ', '.', '.', '.', '\0' };
+Char STRspLarrow2sp[] = { ' ', '<', '<', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRspLarrowsp[] = { ' ', '<', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRspRarrow[] = { ' ', '>', '\0' };
+Char STRspRarrow2[] = { ' ', '>', '>', '\0' };
+Char STRRparen[] = { ')', '\0' };
+Char STRspace[] = { ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRspand2sp[] = { ' ', '&', '&', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRspor2sp[] = { ' ', '|', '|', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRsporsp[] = { ' ', '|', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRstar[] = { '*', '\0' };
+Char STRstatus[] = { 's', 't', 'a', 't', 'u', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRsymcent[] = { '%', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRsymhash[] = { '#', ' ', '\0' };
+Char STRterm[] = { 't', 'e', 'r', 'm', '\0' };
+Char STRthen[] = { 't', 'h', 'e', 'n', '\0' };
+Char STRtilde[] = { '~', '\0' };
+Char STRtime[] = { 't', 'i', 'm', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRtmpsh[] = { '/', 't', 'm', 'p', '/', 's', 'h', '\0' };
+Char STRunalias[] = { 'u', 'n', 'a', 'l', 'i', 'a', 's', '\0' };
+Char STRuser[] = { 'u', 's', 'e', 'r', '\0' };
+Char STRverbose[] = { 'v', 'e', 'r', 'b', 'o', 's', 'e', '\0' };
+Char STRwordchars[] = { 'w', 'o', 'r', 'd', 'c', 'h', 'a', 'r', 's', '\0' };
diff --git a/bin/csh/csh.1 b/bin/csh/csh.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..58a9ddb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/csh.1
@@ -0,0 +1,2175 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)csh.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 1/21/94
+.\"
+.Dd January 21, 1994
+.Dt CSH 1
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm csh
+.Nd a shell (command interpreter) with C-like syntax
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm csh
+.Op Fl bcefinstvVxX
+.Op arg ...
+.Nm csh
+.Op Fl l
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm csh
+is a command language interpreter
+incorporating a history mechanism (see
+.Nm History Substitutions ) ,
+job control facilities (see
+.Nm Jobs ) ,
+interactive file name
+and user name completion (see
+.Nm File Name Completion ) ,
+and a C-like syntax. It is used both as an interactive
+login shell and a shell script command processor.
+.Ss Argument list processing
+If the first argument (argument 0) to the shell is
+.Ql Fl \& ,
+then this is a login shell.
+A login shell also can be specified by invoking the shell with the
+.Ql Fl l
+flag as the only argument.
+.Pp
+The rest of the flag arguments are interpreted as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width 5n
+.It Fl b
+This flag forces a ``break'' from option processing, causing any further
+shell arguments to be treated as non-option arguments.
+The remaining arguments will not be interpreted as shell options.
+This may be used to pass options to a shell script without confusion
+or possible subterfuge.
+The shell will not run a set-user ID script without this option.
+.It Fl c
+Commands are read from the (single) following argument which must
+be present.
+Any remaining arguments are placed in
+.Ar argv .
+.It Fl e
+The shell exits if any invoked command terminates abnormally
+or yields a non-zero exit status.
+.It Fl f
+The shell will start faster, because it will neither search for nor
+execute commands from the file
+.Pa \&.cshrc
+in the invoker's home directory.
+.It Fl i
+The shell is interactive and prompts for its top-level input,
+even if it appears not to be a terminal.
+Shells are interactive without this option if their inputs
+and outputs are terminals.
+.It Fl l
+The shell is a login shell (only applicable if
+.Fl l
+is the only flag specified).
+.It Fl n
+Commands are parsed, but not executed.
+This aids in syntactic checking of shell scripts.
+.It Fl s
+Command input is taken from the standard input.
+.It Fl t
+A single line of input is read and executed.
+A
+.Ql \e
+may be used to escape the newline at the end of this
+line and continue onto another line.
+.It Fl v
+Causes the
+.Ar verbose
+variable to be set, with the effect
+that command input is echoed after history substitution.
+.It Fl x
+Causes the
+.Ar echo
+variable to be set, so that commands are echoed immediately before execution.
+.It Fl V
+Causes the
+.Ar verbose
+variable to be set even before
+.Pa .cshrc
+is executed.
+.It Fl X
+Is to
+.Fl x
+as
+.Fl V
+is to
+.Fl v .
+.El
+.Pp
+After processing of flag arguments, if arguments remain but none of the
+.Fl c ,
+.Fl i ,
+.Fl s ,
+or
+.Fl t
+options were given, the first argument is taken as the name of a file of
+commands to be executed.
+The shell opens this file, and saves its name for possible resubstitution
+by `$0'.
+Since many systems use either the standard version 6 or version 7 shells
+whose shell scripts are not compatible with this shell, the shell will
+execute such a `standard' shell if the first character of a script
+is not a `#', i.e., if the script does not start with a comment.
+Remaining arguments initialize the variable
+.Ar argv .
+.Pp
+An instance of
+.Nm csh
+begins by executing commands from the file
+.Pa /etc/csh.cshrc
+and,
+if this is a login shell,
+.Pa \&/etc/csh.login .
+It then executes
+commands from
+.Pa \&.cshrc
+in the
+.Ar home
+directory of the invoker, and, if this is a login shell, the file
+.Pa \&.login
+in the same location.
+It is typical for users on crt's to put the command ``stty crt''
+in their
+.Pa \&.login
+file, and to also invoke
+.Xr tset 1
+there.
+.Pp
+In the normal case, the shell will begin reading commands from the
+terminal, prompting with `% '.
+Processing of arguments and the use of the shell to process files
+containing command scripts will be described later.
+.Pp
+The shell repeatedly performs the following actions:
+a line of command input is read and broken into
+.Ar words .
+This sequence of words is placed on the command history list and parsed.
+Finally each command in the current line is executed.
+.Pp
+When a login shell terminates it executes commands from the files
+.Pa .logout
+in the user's
+.Ar home
+directory and
+.Pa /etc/csh.logout .
+.Ss Lexical structure
+The shell splits input lines into words at blanks and tabs with the
+following exceptions.
+The characters
+`&' `\&|' `;' `<' `>' `(' `)'
+form separate words.
+If doubled in `&&', `\&|\&|', `<<' or `>>' these pairs form single words.
+These parser metacharacters may be made part of other words, or prevented their
+special meaning, by preceding them with `\e'.
+A newline preceded by a `\e' is equivalent to a blank.
+.Pp
+Strings enclosed in matched pairs of quotations,
+`'\|', `\*(ga' or `"',
+form parts of a word; metacharacters in these strings, including blanks
+and tabs, do not form separate words.
+These quotations have semantics to be described later.
+Within pairs of `\'' or `"' characters, a newline preceded by a `\e' gives
+a true newline character.
+.Pp
+When the shell's input is not a terminal,
+the character `#' introduces a comment that continues to the end of the
+input line.
+It is prevented this special meaning when preceded by `\e'
+and in quotations using `\`', `\'', and `"'.
+.Ss Commands
+A simple command is a sequence of words, the first of which
+specifies the command to be executed.
+A simple command or
+a sequence of simple commands separated by `\&|' characters
+forms a pipeline.
+The output of each command in a pipeline is connected to the input of the next.
+Sequences of pipelines may be separated by `;', and are then executed
+sequentially.
+A sequence of pipelines may be executed without immediately
+waiting for it to terminate by following it with an `&'.
+.Pp
+Any of the above may be placed in `(' `)' to form a simple command (that
+may be a component of a pipeline, etc.).
+It is also possible to separate pipelines with `\&|\&|' or `&&' showing,
+as in the C language,
+that the second is to be executed only if the first fails or succeeds
+respectively. (See
+.Em Expressions . )
+.Ss Jobs
+The shell associates a
+.Ar job
+with each pipeline. It keeps
+a table of current jobs, printed by the
+.Ar jobs
+command, and assigns them small integer numbers. When
+a job is started asynchronously with `&', the shell prints a line that looks
+like:
+.Bd -filled -offset indent
+.Op 1
+1234
+.Ed
+.Pp
+showing that the job which was started asynchronously was job number
+1 and had one (top-level) process, whose process id was 1234.
+.Pp
+If you are running a job and wish to do something else you may hit the key
+.Nm ^Z
+(control-Z) which sends a STOP signal to the current job.
+The shell will then normally show that the job has been `Stopped',
+and print another prompt. You can then manipulate the state of this job,
+putting it in the
+.Em background
+with the
+.Ar bg
+command, or run some other
+commands and eventually bring the job back into the foreground with
+the
+.Em foreground
+command
+.Ar fg .
+A
+.Nm ^Z
+takes effect immediately and
+is like an interrupt in that pending output and unread input are discarded
+when it is typed. There is another special key
+.Nm ^Y
+that does not generate a STOP signal until a program attempts to
+.Xr read 2
+it.
+This request can usefully be typed ahead when you have prepared some commands
+for a job that you wish to stop after it has read them.
+.Pp
+A job being run in the background will stop if it tries to read
+from the terminal. Background jobs are normally allowed to produce output,
+but this can be disabled by giving the command ``stty tostop''.
+If you set this
+tty option, then background jobs will stop when they try to produce
+output like they do when they try to read input.
+.Pp
+There are several ways to refer to jobs in the shell. The character
+`%' introduces a job name. If you wish to refer to job number 1, you can
+name it as `%1'. Just naming a job brings it to the foreground; thus
+`%1' is a synonym for `fg %1', bringing job number 1 back into the foreground.
+Similarly saying `%1 &' resumes job number 1 in the background.
+Jobs can also be named by prefixes of the string typed in to start them,
+if these prefixes are unambiguous, thus `%ex' would normally restart
+a suspended
+.Xr ex 1
+job, if there were only one suspended job whose name began with
+the string `ex'. It is also possible to say `%?string'
+which specifies a job whose text contains
+.Ar string ,
+if there is only one such job.
+.Pp
+The shell maintains a notion of the current and previous jobs.
+In output about jobs, the current job is marked with a `+'
+and the previous job with a `\-'. The abbreviation `%+' refers
+to the current job and `%\-' refers to the previous job. For close
+analogy with the syntax of the
+.Ar history
+mechanism (described below),
+`%%' is also a synonym for the current job.
+.Pp
+The job control mechanism requires that the
+.Xr stty 1
+option
+.Ic new
+be set. It is an artifact from a
+.Em new
+implementation
+of the
+tty driver that allows generation of interrupt characters from
+the keyboard to tell jobs to stop. See stty(1) for details
+on setting options in the new tty driver.
+.Ss Status reporting
+This shell learns immediately whenever a process changes state.
+It normally informs you whenever a job becomes blocked so that
+no further progress is possible, but only just before it prints
+a prompt. This is done so that it does not otherwise disturb your work.
+If, however, you set the shell variable
+.Ar notify ,
+the shell will notify you immediately of changes of status in background
+jobs.
+There is also a shell command
+.Ar notify
+that marks a single process so that its status changes will be immediately
+reported. By default
+.Ar notify
+marks the current process;
+simply say `notify' after starting a background job to mark it.
+.Pp
+When you try to leave the shell while jobs are stopped, you will
+be warned that `You have stopped jobs.' You may use the
+.Ar jobs
+command to see what they are. If you do this or immediately try to
+exit again, the shell will not warn you a second time, and the suspended
+jobs will be terminated.
+.Ss File Name Completion
+When the file name completion feature is enabled by setting
+the shell variable
+.Ar filec
+(see
+.Ic set ) ,
+.Nm csh
+will
+interactively complete file names and user names from unique
+prefixes, when they are input from the terminal followed by
+the escape character (the escape key, or control-[)
+For example,
+if the current directory looks like
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+DSC.OLD bin cmd lib xmpl.c
+DSC.NEW chaosnet cmtest mail xmpl.o
+bench class dev mbox xmpl.out
+.Ed
+.Pp
+and the input is
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi ch<escape>
+.Pp
+.Nm csh
+will complete the prefix ``ch''
+to the only matching file name ``chaosnet'', changing the input
+line to
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi chaosnet
+.Pp
+However, given
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi D<escape>
+.Pp
+.Nm csh
+will only expand the input to
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi DSC.
+.Pp
+and will sound the terminal bell to indicate that the expansion is
+incomplete, since there are two file names matching the prefix ``D''.
+.Pp
+If a partial file name is followed by the end-of-file character
+(usually control-D), then, instead of completing the name,
+.Nm csh
+will list all file names matching the prefix. For example,
+the input
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi D<control-D>
+.Pp
+causes all files beginning with ``D'' to be listed:
+.Pp
+.Dl DSC.NEW DSC.OLD
+.Pp
+while the input line remains unchanged.
+.Pp
+The same system of escape and end-of-file can also be used to
+expand partial user names, if the word to be completed
+(or listed) begins with the character ``~''. For example,
+typing
+.Pp
+.Dl cd ~ro<escape>
+.Pp
+may produce the expansion
+.Pp
+.Dl cd ~root
+.Pp
+The use of the terminal bell to signal errors or multiple matches
+can be inhibited by setting the variable
+.Ar nobeep .
+.Pp
+Normally, all files in the particular directory are candidates
+for name completion. Files with certain suffixes can be excluded
+from consideration by setting the variable
+.Ar fignore
+to the
+list of suffixes to be ignored. Thus, if
+.Ar fignore
+is set by
+the command
+.Pp
+.Dl % set fignore = (.o .out)
+.Pp
+then typing
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi x<escape>
+.Pp
+would result in the completion to
+.Pp
+.Dl % vi xmpl.c
+.Pp
+ignoring the files "xmpl.o" and "xmpl.out".
+However, if the only completion possible requires not ignoring these
+suffixes, then they are not ignored. In addition,
+.Ar fignore
+does not affect the listing of file names by control-D. All files
+are listed regardless of their suffixes.
+.Ss Substitutions
+We now describe the various transformations the shell performs on the
+input in the order in which they occur.
+.Ss History substitutions
+History substitutions place words from previous command input as portions
+of new commands, making it easy to repeat commands, repeat arguments
+of a previous command in the current command, or fix spelling mistakes
+in the previous command with little typing and a high degree of confidence.
+History substitutions begin with the character `!' and may begin
+.Ar anywhere
+in the input stream (with the proviso that they
+.Nm "do not"
+nest.)
+This `!' may be preceded by a `\e' to prevent its special meaning; for
+convenience, an `!' is passed unchanged when it is followed by a blank,
+tab, newline, `=' or `('.
+(History substitutions also occur when an input line begins with `\*(ua'.
+This special abbreviation will be described later.)
+Any input line that contains history substitution is echoed on the terminal
+before it is executed as it could have been typed without history substitution.
+.Pp
+Commands input from the terminal that consist of one or more words
+are saved on the history list.
+The history substitutions reintroduce sequences of words from these
+saved commands into the input stream.
+The size of the history list is controlled by the
+.Ar history
+variable; the previous command is always retained,
+regardless of the value of the history variable.
+Commands are numbered sequentially from 1.
+.Pp
+For definiteness, consider the following output from the
+.Ar history
+command:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+\09 write michael
+10 ex write.c
+11 cat oldwrite.c
+12 diff *write.c
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The commands are shown with their event numbers.
+It is not usually necessary to use event numbers, but the current event
+number can be made part of the
+.Ar prompt
+by placing an `!' in the prompt string.
+.Pp
+With the current event 13 we can refer to previous events by event
+number `!11', relatively as in `!\-2' (referring to the same event),
+by a prefix of a command word
+as in `!d' for event 12 or `!wri' for event 9, or by a string contained in
+a word in the command as in `!?mic?' also referring to event 9.
+These forms, without further change, simply reintroduce the words
+of the specified events, each separated by a single blank.
+As a special case, `!!' refers to the previous command; thus `!!'
+alone is a
+.Ar redo .
+.Pp
+To select words from an event we can follow the event specification by
+a `:' and a designator for the desired words.
+The words of an input line are numbered from 0,
+the first (usually command) word being 0, the second word (first argument)
+being 1, etc.
+The basic word designators are:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It \&0
+first (command) word
+.It Ar n
+.Ar n Ns 'th
+argument
+.It \*(ua
+first argument, i.e., `1'
+.It $
+last argument
+.It %
+word matched by (immediately preceding)
+.No \&? Ns Ar s Ns \&?
+search
+.It Ar \&x\-y
+range of words
+.It Ar \&\-y
+abbreviates
+.Ar `\&0\-y\'
+.It *
+abbreviates `\*(ua\-$', or nothing if only 1 word in event
+.It Ar x*
+abbreviates
+.Ar `x\-$\'
+.It Ar x\-
+like
+.Ar `x*\'
+but omitting word `$'
+.El
+.Pp
+The `:' separating the event specification from the word designator
+can be omitted if the argument selector begins with a `\*(ua', `$', `*'
+`\-' or `%'.
+After the optional word designator can be
+placed a sequence of modifiers, each preceded by a `:'.
+The following modifiers are defined:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It h
+Remove a trailing pathname component, leaving the head.
+.It r
+Remove a trailing `.xxx' component, leaving the root name.
+.It e
+Remove all but the extension `.xxx' part.
+.It s Ns Ar /l/r/
+Substitute
+.Ar l
+for
+.Ar r
+.It t
+Remove all leading pathname components, leaving the tail.
+.It \&&
+Repeat the previous substitution.
+.It g
+Apply the change once on each word, prefixing the above, e.g., `g&'.
+.It a
+Apply the change as many times as possible on a single word, prefixing
+the above. It can be used together with `g' to apply a substitution
+globally.
+.It p
+Print the new command line but do not execute it.
+.It q
+Quote the substituted words, preventing further substitutions.
+.It x
+Like q, but break into words at blanks, tabs and newlines.
+.El
+.Pp
+Unless preceded by a `g' the change is applied only to the first
+modifiable word. With substitutions, it is an error for no word to be
+applicable.
+.Pp
+The left hand side of substitutions are not regular expressions in the sense
+of the editors, but instead strings.
+Any character may be used as the delimiter in place of `/';
+a `\e' quotes the delimiter into the
+.Ar l " "
+and
+.Ar r " "
+strings.
+The character `&' in the right hand side is replaced by the text from
+the left.
+A `\e' also quotes `&'.
+A null
+.Ar l
+(`//')
+uses the previous string either from an
+.Ar l
+or from a
+contextual scan string
+.Ar s
+in
+.No \&`!? Ns Ar s Ns \e?' .
+The trailing delimiter in the substitution may be omitted if a newline
+follows immediately as may the trailing `?' in a contextual scan.
+.Pp
+A history reference may be given without an event specification, e.g., `!$'.
+Here, the reference is to the previous command unless a previous
+history reference occurred on the same line in which case this form repeats
+the previous reference.
+Thus `!?foo?\*(ua !$' gives the first and last arguments
+from the command matching `?foo?'.
+.Pp
+A special abbreviation of a history reference occurs when the first
+non-blank character of an input line is a `\*(ua'.
+This is equivalent to `!:s\*(ua' providing a convenient shorthand for substitutions
+on the text of the previous line.
+Thus `\*(ualb\*(ualib' fixes the spelling of
+`lib'
+in the previous command.
+Finally, a history substitution may be surrounded with `{' and `}'
+if necessary to insulate it from the characters that follow.
+Thus, after `ls \-ld ~paul' we might do `!{l}a' to do `ls \-ld ~paula',
+while `!la' would look for a command starting with `la'.
+.Pp
+.Ss Quotations with \' and \&"
+The quotation of strings by `\'' and `"' can be used
+to prevent all or some of the remaining substitutions.
+Strings enclosed in `\'' are prevented any further interpretation.
+Strings enclosed in `"' may be expanded as described below.
+.Pp
+In both cases the resulting text becomes (all or part of) a single word;
+only in one special case (see
+.Em Command Substitution
+below) does a `"' quoted string yield parts of more than one word;
+`\'' quoted strings never do.
+.Ss Alias substitution
+The shell maintains a list of aliases that can be established, displayed
+and modified by the
+.Ar alias
+and
+.Ar unalias
+commands.
+After a command line is scanned, it is parsed into distinct commands and
+the first word of each command, left-to-right, is checked to see if it
+has an alias.
+If it does, then the text that is the alias for that command is reread
+with the history mechanism available
+as though that command were the previous input line.
+The resulting words replace the
+command and argument list.
+If no reference is made to the history list, then the argument list is
+left unchanged.
+.Pp
+Thus if the alias for `ls' is `ls \-l' the command `ls /usr' would map to
+`ls \-l /usr', the argument list here being undisturbed.
+Similarly if the alias for `lookup' was `grep !\*(ua /etc/passwd' then
+`lookup bill' would map to `grep bill /etc/passwd'.
+.Pp
+If an alias is found, the word transformation of the input text
+is performed and the aliasing process begins again on the reformed input line.
+Looping is prevented if the first word of the new text is the same as the old
+by flagging it to prevent further aliasing.
+Other loops are detected and cause an error.
+.Pp
+Note that the mechanism allows aliases to introduce parser metasyntax.
+Thus, we can `alias print \'pr \e!* \&| lpr\'' to make a command that
+.Ar pr Ns 's
+its arguments to the line printer.
+.Ss Variable substitution
+The shell maintains a set of variables, each of which has as value a list
+of zero or more words.
+Some of these variables are set by the shell or referred to by it.
+For instance, the
+.Ar argv
+variable is an image of the shell's argument list, and words of this
+variable's value are referred to in special ways.
+.Pp
+The values of variables may be displayed and changed by using the
+.Ar set
+and
+.Ar unset
+commands.
+Of the variables referred to by the shell a number are toggles;
+the shell does not care what their value is,
+only whether they are set or not.
+For instance, the
+.Ar verbose
+variable is a toggle that causes command input to be echoed.
+The setting of this variable results from the
+.Fl v
+command line option.
+.Pp
+Other operations treat variables numerically.
+The `@' command permits numeric calculations to be performed and the result
+assigned to a variable.
+Variable values are, however, always represented as (zero or more) strings.
+For the purposes of numeric operations, the null string is considered to be
+zero, and the second and additional words of multiword values are ignored.
+.Pp
+After the input line is aliased and parsed, and before each command
+is executed, variable substitution
+is performed keyed by `$' characters.
+This expansion can be prevented by preceding the `$' with a `\e' except
+within `"'s where it
+.Em always
+occurs, and within `\''s where it
+.Em never
+occurs.
+Strings quoted by `\*(ga' are interpreted later (see
+.Nm "Command substitution"
+below) so `$' substitution does not occur there until later, if at all.
+A `$' is passed unchanged if followed by a blank, tab, or end-of-line.
+.Pp
+Input/output redirections are recognized before variable expansion,
+and are variable expanded separately.
+Otherwise, the command name and entire argument list are expanded together.
+It is thus possible for the first (command) word (to this point) to generate
+more than one word, the first of which becomes the command name,
+and the rest of which become arguments.
+.Pp
+Unless enclosed in `"' or given the `:q' modifier the results of variable
+substitution may eventually be command and filename substituted.
+Within `"', a variable whose value consists of multiple words expands to a
+(portion of) a single word, with the words of the variables value
+separated by blanks.
+When the `:q' modifier is applied to a substitution
+the variable will expand to multiple words with each word separated
+by a blank and quoted to prevent later command or filename substitution.
+.Pp
+The following metasequences are provided for introducing variable values into
+the shell input.
+Except as noted, it is an error to reference a variable that is not set.
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It $name
+.It ${name}
+Are replaced by the words of the value of variable
+.Ar name ,
+each separated by a blank.
+Braces insulate
+.Ar name
+from following characters that would otherwise be part of it.
+Shell variables have names consisting of up to 20 letters and digits
+starting with a letter. The underscore character is considered a letter.
+If
+.Ar name
+is not a shell variable, but is set in the environment, then
+that value is returned (but
+.Nm :
+modifiers and the other forms
+given below are not available here).
+.It $name Ns Op selector
+.It ${name Ns [ selector ] }
+May be used to select only some of the words from the value of
+.Ar name .
+The selector is subjected to `$' substitution and may consist of a single
+number or two numbers separated by a `\-'.
+The first word of a variables value is numbered `1'.
+If the first number of a range is omitted it defaults to `1'.
+If the last number of a range is omitted it defaults to `$#name'.
+The selector `*' selects all words.
+It is not an error for a range to be empty if the second argument is omitted
+or in range.
+.It $#name
+.It ${#name}
+Gives the number of words in the variable.
+This is useful for later use in a
+`$argv[selector]'.
+.It $0
+Substitutes the name of the file from which command input is being read.
+An error occurs if the name is not known.
+.It $number
+.It ${number}
+Equivalent to
+`$argv[number]'.
+.It $*
+Equivalent to
+`$argv[*]'.
+The modifiers `:e', `:h', `:t', `:r', `:q' and `:x' may be applied to
+the substitutions above as may `:gh', `:gt' and `:gr'.
+If braces `{' '}' appear in the command form then the modifiers
+must appear within the braces.
+The current implementation allows only one `:' modifier on each `$' expansion.
+.El
+.Pp
+The following substitutions may not be modified with `:' modifiers.
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It $?name
+.It ${?name}
+Substitutes the string `1' if name is set, `0' if it is not.
+.It $?0
+Substitutes `1' if the current input filename is known, `0' if it is not.
+.It \&$\&$\&
+Substitute the (decimal) process number of the (parent) shell.
+.It $!
+Substitute the (decimal) process number of the last background process
+started by this shell.
+.It $<
+Substitutes a line from the standard
+input, with no further interpretation.
+It can be used to read from the keyboard in a shell script.
+.El
+.Ss Command and filename substitution
+The remaining substitutions, command and filename substitution,
+are applied selectively to the arguments of builtin commands.
+By selectively, we mean that portions of expressions which are
+not evaluated are not subjected to these expansions.
+For commands that are not internal to the shell, the command
+name is substituted separately from the argument list.
+This occurs very late,
+after input-output redirection is performed, and in a child
+of the main shell.
+.Ss Command substitution
+Command substitution is shown by a command enclosed in `\*(ga'.
+The output from such a command is normally broken into separate words
+at blanks, tabs and newlines, with null words being discarded;
+this text then replaces the original string.
+Within `"'s, only newlines force new words; blanks and tabs are preserved.
+.Pp
+In any case, the single final newline does not force a new word.
+Note that it is thus possible for a command substitution to yield
+only part of a word, even if the command outputs a complete line.
+.Ss Filename substitution
+If a word contains any of the characters `*', `?', `[' or `{'
+or begins with the character `~', then that word is a candidate for
+filename substitution, also known as `globbing'.
+This word is then regarded as a pattern, and replaced with an alphabetically
+sorted list of file names that match the pattern.
+In a list of words specifying filename substitution it is an error for
+no pattern to match an existing file name, but it is not required
+for each pattern to match.
+Only the metacharacters `*', `?' and `[' imply pattern matching,
+the characters `~' and `{' being more akin to abbreviations.
+.Pp
+In matching filenames, the character `.' at the beginning of a filename
+or immediately following a `/', as well as the character `/' must
+be matched explicitly.
+The character `*' matches any string of characters, including the null
+string.
+The character `?' matches any single character.
+The sequence
+.Sq Op ...
+matches any one of the characters enclosed.
+Within
+.Sq Op ... ,
+a pair of characters separated by `\-' matches any character lexically between
+the two (inclusive).
+.Pp
+The character `~' at the beginning of a filename refers to home
+directories.
+Standing alone, i.e., `~' it expands to the invokers home directory as reflected
+in the value of the variable
+.Ar home .
+When followed by a name consisting of letters, digits and `\-' characters,
+the shell searches for a user with that name and substitutes their
+home directory; thus `~ken' might expand to `/usr/ken' and `~ken/chmach'
+to `/usr/ken/chmach'.
+If the character `~' is followed by a character other than a letter or `/'
+or does not appear at the beginning of a word,
+it is left undisturbed.
+.Pp
+The metanotation `a{b,c,d}e' is a shorthand for `abe ace ade'.
+Left to right order is preserved, with results of matches being sorted
+separately at a low level to preserve this order.
+This construct may be nested.
+Thus, `~source/s1/{oldls,ls}.c' expands to
+`/usr/source/s1/oldls.c /usr/source/s1/ls.c'
+without chance of error
+if the home directory for `source' is `/usr/source'.
+Similarly `../{memo,*box}' might expand to `../memo ../box ../mbox'.
+(Note that `memo' was not sorted with the results of the match to `*box'.)
+As a special case `{', `}' and `{}' are passed undisturbed.
+.Ss Input/output
+The standard input and the standard output of a command may be redirected
+with the following syntax:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It < name
+Open file
+.Ar name
+(which is first variable, command and filename expanded) as the standard
+input.
+.It << word
+Read the shell input up to a line that is identical to
+.Ar word .
+.Ar Word
+is not subjected to variable, filename or command substitution,
+and each input line is compared to
+.Ar word
+before any substitutions are done on the input line.
+Unless a quoting `\e', `"', `\*(aa' or `\*(ga' appears in
+.Ar word ,
+variable and command substitution is performed on the intervening lines,
+allowing `\e' to quote `$', `\e' and `\*(ga'.
+Commands that are substituted have all blanks, tabs, and newlines
+preserved, except for the final newline which is dropped.
+The resultant text is placed in an anonymous temporary file that
+is given to the command as its standard input.
+.It > name
+.It >! name
+.It >& name
+.It >&! name
+The file
+.Ar name
+is used as the standard output.
+If the file does not exist then it is created;
+if the file exists, it is truncated; its previous contents are lost.
+.Pp
+If the variable
+.Ar noclobber
+is set, then the file must not exist or be a character special file (e.g., a
+terminal or `/dev/null') or an error results.
+This helps prevent accidental destruction of files.
+Here, the `!' forms can be used to suppress this check.
+.Pp
+The forms involving `&' route the standard error output into the specified
+file as well as the standard output.
+.Ar Name
+is expanded in the same way as `<' input filenames are.
+.It >> name
+.It >>& name
+.It >>! name
+.It >>&! name
+Uses file
+.Ar name
+as the standard output;
+like `>' but places output at the end of the file.
+If the variable
+.Ar noclobber
+is set, then it is an error for the file not to exist unless
+one of the `!' forms is given.
+Otherwise similar to `>'.
+.El
+.Pp
+A command receives the environment in which the shell was
+invoked as modified by the input-output parameters and
+the presence of the command in a pipeline.
+Thus, unlike some previous shells, commands run from a file of shell commands
+have no access to the text of the commands by default;
+instead they receive the original standard input of the shell.
+The `<<' mechanism should be used to present inline data.
+This permits shell command scripts to function as components of pipelines
+and allows the shell to block read its input.
+Note that the default standard input for a command run detached is
+.Ar not
+modified to be the empty file
+.Pa /dev/null ;
+instead the standard input
+remains as the original standard input of the shell. If this is a terminal
+and if the process attempts to read from the terminal, then the process
+will block and the user will be notified (see
+.Sx Jobs
+above).
+.Pp
+The standard error output may be directed through
+a pipe with the standard output.
+Simply use the form `\&|&' instead of just `\&|'.
+.Ss Expressions
+Several of the builtin commands (to be described later)
+take expressions, in which the operators are similar to those of C, with
+the same precedence.
+These expressions appear in the
+.Nm @,
+.Ar exit ,
+.Ar if ,
+and
+.Ar while
+commands.
+The following operators are available:
+.Bd -ragged -offset indent
+\&|\&| && \&| \*(ua & == != =~ !~ <= >=
+< > << >> + \- * / % ! ~ ( )
+.Ed
+.Pp
+Here the precedence increases to the right,
+`==' `!=' `=~' and `!~', `<=' `>=' `<' and `>', `<<' and `>>', `+' and `\-',
+`*' `/' and `%' being, in groups, at the same level.
+The `==' `!=' `=~' and `!~' operators compare their arguments as strings;
+all others operate on numbers.
+The operators `=~' and `!~' are like `!=' and `==' except that the right
+hand side is a
+.Ar pattern
+(containing, e.g., `*'s, `?'s and instances of `[...]')
+against which the left hand operand is matched. This reduces the
+need for use of the
+.Ar switch
+statement in shell scripts when all that is really needed is pattern matching.
+.Pp
+Strings that begin with `0' are considered octal numbers.
+Null or missing arguments are considered `0'.
+The result of all expressions are strings,
+which represent decimal numbers.
+It is important to note that no two components of an expression can appear
+in the same word; except when adjacent to components of expressions that
+are syntactically significant to the parser (`&' `\&|' `<' `>' `(' `)'),
+they should be surrounded by spaces.
+.Pp
+Also available in expressions as primitive operands are command executions
+enclosed in `{' and `}'
+and file enquiries of the form
+.Fl l
+.Ar name
+where
+.Ic l
+is one of:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+r read access
+w write access
+x execute access
+e existence
+o ownership
+z zero size
+f plain file
+d directory
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The specified name is command and filename expanded and then tested
+to see if it has the specified relationship to the real user.
+If the file does not exist or is inaccessible then all enquiries return
+false, i.e., `0'.
+Command executions succeed, returning true, i.e., `1',
+if the command exits with status 0, otherwise they fail, returning
+false, i.e., `0'.
+If more detailed status information is required then the command
+should be executed outside an expression and the variable
+.Ar status
+examined.
+.Ss Control flow
+The shell contains several commands that can be used to regulate the
+flow of control in command files (shell scripts) and
+(in limited but useful ways) from terminal input.
+These commands all operate by forcing the shell to reread or skip in its
+input and, because of the implementation, restrict the placement of some
+of the commands.
+.Pp
+The
+.Ic foreach ,
+.Ic switch ,
+and
+.Ic while
+statements, as well as the
+.Ic if\-then\-else
+form of the
+.Ic if
+statement require that the major keywords appear in a single simple command
+on an input line as shown below.
+.Pp
+If the shell's input is not seekable,
+the shell buffers up input whenever a loop is being read
+and performs seeks in this internal buffer to accomplish the rereading
+implied by the loop.
+(To the extent that this allows, backward goto's will succeed on
+non-seekable inputs.)
+.Ss Builtin commands
+Builtin commands are executed within the shell.
+If a builtin command occurs as any component of a pipeline
+except the last then it is executed in a subshell.
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It Ic alias
+.It Ic alias Ar name
+.It Ic alias Ar name wordlist
+The first form prints all aliases.
+The second form prints the alias for name.
+The final form assigns the specified
+.Ar wordlist
+as the alias of
+.Ar name ;
+.Ar wordlist
+is command and filename substituted.
+.Ar Name
+is not allowed to be
+.Ar alias
+or
+.Ar unalias .
+.Pp
+.It Ic alloc
+Shows the amount of dynamic memory acquired, broken down into used and
+free memory.
+With an argument shows the number of free and used blocks in each size
+category. The categories start at size 8 and double at each step.
+This command's output may vary across system types, since
+systems other than the VAX may use a different memory allocator.
+.Pp
+.It Ic bg
+.It Ic bg \&% Ns Ar job ...
+Puts the current or specified jobs into the background, continuing them
+if they were stopped.
+.Pp
+.It Ic break
+Causes execution to resume after the
+.Ic end
+of the nearest enclosing
+.Ic foreach
+or
+.Ic while .
+The remaining commands on the current line are executed.
+Multi-level breaks are thus possible by writing them all on one line.
+.Pp
+.It Ic breaksw
+Causes a break from a
+.Ic switch ,
+resuming after the
+.Ic endsw .
+.Pp
+.It Ic case Ar label :
+A label in a
+.Ic switch
+statement as discussed below.
+.Pp
+.It Ic cd
+.It Ic cd Ar name
+.It Ic chdir
+.It Ic chdir Ar name
+Change the shell's working directory to directory
+.Ar name .
+If no argument is given then change to the home directory of the user.
+If
+.Ar name
+is not found as a subdirectory of the current directory (and does not begin
+with `/', `./' or `../'), then each
+component of the variable
+.Ic cdpath
+is checked to see if it has a subdirectory
+.Ar name .
+Finally, if all else fails but
+.Ar name
+is a shell variable whose value begins with `/', then this
+is tried to see if it is a directory.
+.Pp
+.It Ic continue
+Continue execution of the nearest enclosing
+.Ic while
+or
+.Ic foreach .
+The rest of the commands on the current line are executed.
+.Pp
+.It Ic default :
+Labels the default case in a
+.Ic switch
+statement.
+The default should come after all
+.Ic case
+labels.
+.Pp
+.It Ic dirs
+Prints the directory stack; the top of the stack is at the left,
+the first directory in the stack being the current directory.
+.Pp
+.It Ic echo Ar wordlist
+.It Ic echo Fl n Ar wordlist
+The specified words are written to the shell's standard output, separated
+by spaces, and terminated with a newline unless the
+.Fl n
+option is specified.
+.Pp
+.It Ic else
+.It Ic end
+.It Ic endif
+.It Ic endsw
+See the description of the
+.Ic foreach ,
+.Ic if ,
+.Ic switch ,
+and
+.Ic while
+statements below.
+.Pp
+.It Ic eval Ar arg ...
+(As in
+.Xr sh 1 . )
+The arguments are read as input to the shell and the resulting
+command(s) executed in the context of the current shell.
+This is usually used to execute commands
+generated as the result of command or variable substitution, since
+parsing occurs before these substitutions. See
+.Xr tset 1
+for an example of using
+.Ic eval .
+.Pp
+.It Ic exec Ar command
+The specified command is executed in place of the current shell.
+.Pp
+.It Ic exit
+.It Ic exit Ar (expr )
+The shell exits either with the value of the
+.Ic status
+variable (first form) or with the value of the specified
+.Ic expr
+(second form).
+.Pp
+.It Ic fg
+.It Ic fg % Ns Ar job ...
+Brings the current or specified jobs into the foreground, continuing them if
+they were stopped.
+.Pp
+.It Ic foreach Ar name (wordlist)
+.It ...
+.It Ic end
+The variable
+.Ic name
+is successively set to each member of
+.Ic wordlist
+and the sequence of commands between this command and the matching
+.Ic end
+are executed.
+(Both
+.Ic foreach
+and
+.Ic end
+must appear alone on separate lines.)
+The builtin command
+.Ic continue
+may be used to continue the loop prematurely and the builtin
+command
+.Ic break
+to terminate it prematurely.
+When this command is read from the terminal, the loop is read once
+prompting with `?' before any statements in the loop are executed.
+If you make a mistake typing in a loop at the terminal you can rub it out.
+.Pp
+.It Ic glob Ar wordlist
+Like
+.Ic echo
+but no `\e' escapes are recognized and words are delimited
+by null characters in the output.
+Useful for programs that wish to use the shell to filename expand a list
+of words.
+.Pp
+.It Ic goto Ar word
+The specified
+.Ic word
+is filename and command expanded to yield a string of the form `label'.
+The shell rewinds its input as much as possible
+and searches for a line of the form `label:'
+possibly preceded by blanks or tabs.
+Execution continues after the specified line.
+.Pp
+.It Ic hashstat
+Print a statistics line showing how effective the internal hash
+table has been at locating commands (and avoiding
+.Ic exec Ns \'s ) .
+An
+.Ic exec
+is attempted for each component of the
+.Em path
+where the hash function indicates a possible hit, and in each component
+that does not begin with a `/'.
+.Pp
+.It Ic history
+.It Ic history Ar n
+.It Ic history Fl r Ar n
+.It Ic history Fl h Ar n
+Displays the history event list; if
+.Ar n
+is given only the
+.Ar n
+most recent events are printed.
+The
+.Fl r
+option reverses the order of printout to be most recent first
+instead of oldest first.
+The
+.Fl h
+option causes the history list to be printed without leading numbers.
+This format produces files suitable for sourcing using the \-h
+option to
+.Ic source .
+.Pp
+.It Ic if ( Ar expr ) No command
+If the specified expression evaluates true, then the single
+.Ar command
+with arguments is executed.
+Variable substitution on
+.Ar command
+happens early, at the same
+time it does for the rest of the
+.Ic if
+command.
+.Ar Command
+must be a simple command, not
+a pipeline, a command list, or a parenthesized command list.
+Input/output redirection occurs even if
+.Ar expr
+is false, i.e., when command is
+.Sy not
+executed (this is a bug).
+.Pp
+.It Ic if ( Ar expr ) Ic then
+.It ...
+.It Ic else if ( Ar expr2 ) Ic then
+.It ...
+.It Ic else
+.It ...
+.It Ic endif
+If the specified
+.Ar expr
+is true then the commands up to the first
+.Ic else
+are executed; otherwise if
+.Ar expr2
+is true then the commands up to the
+second
+.Ic else
+are executed, etc.
+Any number of
+.Ic else-if
+pairs are possible; only one
+.Ic endif
+is needed.
+The
+.Ic else
+part is likewise optional.
+(The words
+.Ic else
+and
+.Ic endif
+must appear at the beginning of input lines;
+the
+.Ic if
+must appear alone on its input line or after an
+.Ic else . )
+.Pp
+.It Ic jobs
+.It Ic jobs Fl l
+Lists the active jobs; the
+.Fl l
+option lists process id's in addition to the normal information.
+.Pp
+.It Ic kill % Ns Ar job
+.It Ic kill Ar pid
+.It Ic kill Fl sig Ar pid ...
+.It Ic kill Fl l
+Sends either the TERM (terminate) signal or the
+specified signal to the specified jobs or processes.
+Signals are either given by number or by names (as given in
+.Pa /usr/include/signal.h,
+stripped of the prefix ``SIG'').
+The signal names are listed by ``kill \-l''.
+There is no default, just saying `kill' does not
+send a signal to the current job.
+If the signal being sent is TERM (terminate) or HUP (hangup),
+then the job or process will be sent a CONT (continue) signal as well.
+.Pp
+.It Ic limit
+.It Ic limit Ar resource
+.It Ic limit Ar resource maximum-use
+.It Ic limit Fl h
+.It Ic limit Fl h Ar resource
+.It Ic limit Fl h Ar resource maximum-use
+Limits the consumption by the current process and each process
+it creates to not individually exceed
+.Ar maximum-use
+on the
+specified
+.Ar resource .
+If no
+.Ar maximum-use
+is given, then
+the current limit is printed; if no
+.Ar resource
+is given, then
+all limitations are given. If the
+.Fl h
+flag is given, the hard limits are used instead of the current
+limits. The hard limits impose a ceiling on the values of
+the current limits. Only the super-user may raise the hard limits,
+but a user may lower or raise the current limits within the legal range.
+.Pp
+Resources controllable currently include
+.Ar cputime
+(the maximum
+number of cpu-seconds to be used by each process),
+.Ar filesize
+(the largest single file that can be created),
+.Ar datasize
+(the maximum growth of the data+stack region via
+.Xr sbrk 2
+beyond the end of the program text),
+.Ar stacksize
+(the maximum
+size of the automatically-extended stack region), and
+.Ar coredumpsize
+(the size of the largest core dump that will be created).
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar maximum-use
+may be given as a (floating point or integer)
+number followed by a scale factor. For all limits other than
+.Ar cputime
+the default scale is `k' or `kilobytes' (1024 bytes);
+a scale factor of `m' or `megabytes' may also be used.
+For
+.Ar cputime
+the default scale is `seconds';
+a scale factor of `m' for minutes
+or `h' for hours, or a time of the form `mm:ss' giving minutes
+and seconds also may be used.
+.Pp
+For both
+.Ar resource
+names and scale factors, unambiguous prefixes
+of the names suffice.
+.Pp
+.It Ic login
+Terminate a login shell, replacing it with an instance of
+.Pa /bin/login.
+This is one way to log off, included for compatibility with
+.Xr sh 1 .
+.Pp
+.It Ic logout
+Terminate a login shell.
+Especially useful if
+.Ic ignoreeof
+is set.
+.Pp
+.It Ic nice
+.It Ic nice Ar +number
+.It Ic nice Ar command
+.It Ic nice Ar +number command
+The first form sets the
+scheduling priority
+for this shell to 4.
+The second form sets the
+priority
+to the given
+.Ar number .
+The final two forms run command at priority 4 and
+.Ar number
+respectively.
+The greater the number, the less cpu the process will get.
+The super-user may specify negative priority by using `nice \-number ...'.
+.Ar Command
+is always executed in a sub-shell, and the restrictions
+placed on commands in simple
+.Ic if
+statements apply.
+.Pp
+.It Ic nohup
+.It Ic nohup Ar command
+The first form can be used in shell scripts to cause hangups to be
+ignored for the remainder of the script.
+The second form causes the specified command to be run with hangups
+ignored.
+All processes detached with `&' are effectively
+.Ic nohup Ns \'ed .
+.Pp
+.It Ic notify
+.It Ic notify % Ns Ar job ...
+Causes the shell to notify the user asynchronously when the status of the
+current or specified jobs change; normally notification is presented
+before a prompt. This is automatic if the shell variable
+.Ic notify
+is set.
+.Pp
+.It Ic onintr
+.It Ic onintr Fl
+.It Ic onintr Ar label
+Control the action of the shell on interrupts.
+The first form restores the default action of the shell on interrupts
+which is to terminate shell scripts or to return to the terminal command
+input level.
+The second form `onintr \-' causes all interrupts to be ignored.
+The final form causes the shell to execute a `goto label' when
+an interrupt is received or a child process terminates because
+it was interrupted.
+.Pp
+In any case, if the shell is running detached and interrupts are
+being ignored, all forms of
+.Ic onintr
+have no meaning and interrupts
+continue to be ignored by the shell and all invoked commands.
+Finally
+.Ic onintr
+statements are ignored in the system startup files where interrupts
+are disabled (/etc/csh.cshrc, /etc/csh.login).
+.Pp
+.It Ic popd
+.It Ic popd Ar +n
+Pops the directory stack, returning to the new top directory.
+With an argument
+.Ns \`+ Ar n Ns \'
+discards the
+.Ar n Ns \'th
+entry in the stack.
+The members of the directory stack are numbered from the top starting at 0.
+.Pp
+.It Ic pushd
+.It Ic pushd Ar name
+.It Ic pushd Ar n
+With no arguments,
+.Ic pushd
+exchanges the top two elements of the directory stack.
+Given a
+.Ar name
+argument,
+.Ic pushd
+changes to the new directory (ala
+.Ic cd )
+and pushes the old current working directory
+(as in
+.Ic csw )
+onto the directory stack.
+With a numeric argument,
+.Ic pushd
+rotates the
+.Ar n Ns \'th
+argument of the directory
+stack around to be the top element and changes to it. The members
+of the directory stack are numbered from the top starting at 0.
+.Pp
+.It Ic rehash
+Causes the internal hash table of the contents of the directories in
+the
+.Ic path
+variable to be recomputed. This is needed if new commands are added
+to directories in the
+.Ic path
+while you are logged in. This should only be necessary if you add
+commands to one of your own directories, or if a systems programmer
+changes the contents of a system directory.
+.Pp
+.It Ic repeat Ar count command
+The specified
+.Ar command
+which is subject to the same restrictions
+as the
+.Ar command
+in the one line
+.Ic if
+statement above,
+is executed
+.Ar count
+times.
+I/O redirections occur exactly once, even if
+.Ar count
+is 0.
+.Pp
+.It Ic set
+.It Ic set Ar name
+.It Ic set Ar name Ns =word
+.It Ic set Ar name[index] Ns =word
+.It Ic set Ar name Ns =(wordlist)
+The first form of the command shows the value of all shell variables.
+Variables that have other than a single word as their
+value print as a parenthesized word list.
+The second form sets
+.Ar name
+to the null string.
+The third form sets
+.Ar name
+to the single
+.Ar word .
+The fourth form sets
+the
+.Ar index Ns 'th
+component of
+.Ar name
+to
+.Ar word ;
+this component must already exist.
+The final form sets
+.Ar name
+to the list of words in
+.Ar wordlist .
+The value is always command and filename expanded.
+.Pp
+These arguments may be repeated to set multiple values in a single set command.
+Note however, that variable expansion happens for all arguments before any
+setting occurs.
+.Pp
+.It Ic setenv
+.It Ic setenv Ar name
+.It Ic setenv Ar name value
+The first form lists all current environment variables.
+It is equivalent to
+.Xr printenv 1 .
+The last form sets the value of environment variable
+.Ar name
+to be
+.Ar value ,
+a single string. The second form sets
+.Ar name
+to an empty string.
+The most commonly used environment variables
+.Ev USER ,
+.Ev TERM ,
+and
+.Ev PATH
+are automatically imported to and exported from the
+.Nm csh
+variables
+.Ar user ,
+.Ar term ,
+and
+.Ar path ;
+there is no need to use
+.Ic setenv
+for these.
+.Pp
+.It Ic shift
+.It Ic shift Ar variable
+The members of
+.Ic argv
+are shifted to the left, discarding
+.Ic argv Ns Bq 1 .
+It is an error for
+.Ic argv
+not to be set or to have less than one word as value.
+The second form performs the same function on the specified variable.
+.Pp
+.It Ic source Ar name
+.It Ic source Fl h Ar name
+The shell reads commands from
+.Ar name .
+.Ic Source
+commands may be nested; if they are nested too deeply the shell may
+run out of file descriptors.
+An error in a
+.Ic source
+at any level terminates all nested
+.Ic source
+commands.
+Normally input during
+.Ic source
+commands is not placed on the history list;
+the \-h option causes the commands to be placed on the
+history list without being executed.
+.Pp
+.It Ic stop
+.It Ic stop % Ns Ar job ...
+Stops the current or specified jobs that are executing in the background.
+.Pp
+.It Ic suspend
+Causes the shell to stop in its tracks, much as if it had been sent a stop
+signal with
+.Ic ^Z .
+This is most often used to stop shells started by
+.Xr su 1 .
+.Pp
+.It Ic switch Ar (string)
+.It Ic case Ar str1 :
+.It \ \ \ \ \&...
+.It Ic \ \ \ \ breaksw
+.It \ \ \ \ \&...
+.It Ic default :
+.It \ \ \ \ \&...
+.It Ic \ \ \ \ breaksw
+.It Ic endsw
+Each case label is successively matched against the specified
+.Ar string
+which is first command and filename expanded.
+The file metacharacters `*', `?' and `[...]'
+may be used in the case labels,
+which are variable expanded.
+If none of the labels match before the `default' label is found, then
+the execution begins after the default label.
+Each case label and the default label must appear at the beginning of a line.
+The command
+.Ic breaksw
+causes execution to continue after the
+.Ic endsw .
+Otherwise control may fall through case labels and the default label as in C.
+If no label matches and there is no default, execution continues after
+the
+.Ic endsw .
+.Pp
+.It Ic time
+.It Ic time Ar command
+With no argument, a summary of time used by this shell and its children
+is printed.
+If arguments are given
+the specified simple command is timed and a time summary
+as described under the
+.Ic time
+variable is printed. If necessary, an extra shell is created to print the time
+statistic when the command completes.
+.Pp
+.It Ic umask
+.It Ic umask Ar value
+The file creation mask is displayed (first form) or set to the specified
+value (second form). The mask is given in octal. Common values for
+the mask are 002 giving all access to the group and read and execute
+access to others or 022 giving all access except write access for
+users in the group or others.
+.Pp
+.It Ic unalias Ar pattern
+All aliases whose names match the specified pattern are discarded.
+Thus all aliases are removed by `unalias *'.
+It is not an error for nothing to be
+.Ic unaliased .
+.Pp
+.It Ic unhash
+Use of the internal hash table to speed location of executed programs
+is disabled.
+.Pp
+.It Ic unlimit
+.It Ic unlimit Ar resource
+.It Ic unlimit Fl h
+.It Ic unlimit Fl h Ar resource
+Removes the limitation on
+.Ar resource .
+If no
+.Ar resource
+is specified, then all
+.Ar resource
+limitations are removed. If
+.Fl h
+is given, the corresponding hard limits are removed. Only the
+super-user may do this.
+.Pp
+.It Ic unset Ar pattern
+All variables whose names match the specified pattern are removed.
+Thus all variables are removed by `unset *'; this has noticeably
+distasteful side-effects.
+It is not an error for nothing to be
+.Ic unset .
+.Pp
+.It Ic unsetenv Ar pattern
+Removes all variables whose name match the specified pattern from the
+environment. See also the
+.Ic setenv
+command above and
+.Xr printenv 1 .
+.Pp
+.It Ic wait
+Wait for all background jobs.
+If the shell is interactive, then an interrupt can disrupt the wait.
+After the interrupt, the shell prints names and job numbers of all jobs
+known to be outstanding.
+.It Ic which Ar command
+Displays the resolved command that will be executed by the shell.
+.Pp
+.It Ic while Ar (expr)
+.It \&...
+.It Ic end
+While the specified expression evaluates non-zero, the commands between
+the
+.Ic while
+and the matching
+.Ic end
+are evaluated.
+.Ic Break
+and
+.Ic continue
+may be used to terminate or continue the loop prematurely.
+(The
+.Ic while
+and
+.Ic end
+must appear alone on their input lines.)
+Prompting occurs here the first time through the loop as for the
+.Ic foreach
+statement if the input is a terminal.
+.Pp
+.It Ic % Ns Ar job
+Brings the specified job into the foreground.
+.Pp
+.It Ic % Ns Ar job Ic &
+Continues the specified job in the background.
+.Pp
+.It Ic @
+.It Ic @ Ns Ar name Ns = expr
+.It Ic @ Ns Ar name[index] Ns = expr
+The first form prints the values of all the shell variables.
+The second form sets the specified
+.Ar name
+to the value of
+.Ar expr .
+If the expression contains `<', `>', `&' or `|' then at least
+this part of the expression must be placed within `(' `)'.
+The third form assigns the value of
+.Ar expr
+to the
+.Ar index Ns 'th
+argument of
+.Ar name .
+Both
+.Ar name
+and its
+.Ar index Ns 'th
+component must already exist.
+.El
+.Pp
+The operators `*=', `+=', etc are available as in C.
+The space separating the name from the assignment operator is optional.
+Spaces are, however, mandatory in separating components of
+.Ar expr
+which would otherwise be single words.
+.Pp
+Special postfix `+\|+' and `\-\|\-' operators increment and decrement
+.Ar name
+respectively, i.e., `@ i++'.
+.Ss Pre-defined and environment variables
+The following variables have special meaning to the shell.
+Of these,
+.Ar argv ,
+.Ar cwd,
+.Ar home ,
+.Ar path,
+.Ar prompt ,
+.Ar shell
+and
+.Ar status
+are always set by the shell.
+Except for
+.Ar cwd
+and
+.Ar status ,
+this setting occurs only at initialization;
+these variables will not then be modified unless done
+explicitly by the user.
+.Pp
+The shell copies the environment variable
+.Ev USER
+into the variable
+.Ar user ,
+.Ev TERM
+into
+.Ar term ,
+and
+.Ev HOME
+into
+.Ar home ,
+and copies these back into the environment whenever the normal
+shell variables are reset.
+The environment variable
+.Ev PATH
+is likewise handled; it is not
+necessary to worry about its setting other than in the file
+.Ar \&.cshrc
+as inferior
+.Nm csh
+processes will import the definition of
+.Ar path
+from the environment, and re-export it if you then change it.
+.Bl -tag -width histchars
+.It Ic argv
+Set to the arguments to the shell, it is from this variable that
+positional parameters are substituted, i.e., `$1' is replaced by
+`$argv[1]',
+etc.
+.It Ic cdpath
+Gives a list of alternate directories searched to find subdirectories
+in
+.Ar chdir
+commands.
+.It Ic cwd
+The full pathname of the current directory.
+.It Ic echo
+Set when the
+.Fl x
+command line option is given.
+Causes each command and its arguments
+to be echoed just before it is executed.
+For non-builtin commands all expansions occur before echoing.
+Builtin commands are echoed before command and filename substitution,
+since these substitutions are then done selectively.
+.It Ic filec
+Enable file name completion.
+.It Ic histchars
+Can be given a string value to change the characters used in history
+substitution. The first character of its value is used as the
+history substitution character, replacing the default character `!'.
+The second character of its value replaces the character `\(ua' in
+quick substitutions.
+.It Ic histfile
+Can be set to the pathname where history is going to be saved/restored.
+.It Ic history
+Can be given a numeric value to control the size of the history list.
+Any command that has been referenced in this many events will not be
+discarded.
+Too large values of
+.Ar history
+may run the shell out of memory.
+The last executed command is always saved on the history list.
+.It Ic home
+The home directory of the invoker, initialized from the environment.
+The filename expansion of
+.Sq Pa ~
+refers to this variable.
+.It Ic ignoreeof
+If set the shell ignores
+end-of-file from input devices which are terminals.
+This prevents shells from accidentally being killed by control-D's.
+.It Ic mail
+The files where the shell checks for mail.
+This checking is done after each command completion that will
+result in a prompt,
+if a specified interval has elapsed.
+The shell says `You have new mail.'
+if the file exists with an access time not greater than its modify time.
+.Pp
+If the first word of the value of
+.Ar mail
+is numeric it specifies a different mail checking interval, in seconds,
+than the default, which is 10 minutes.
+.Pp
+If multiple mail files are specified, then the shell says
+`New mail in
+.Ar name Ns '
+when there is mail in the file
+.Ar name .
+.It Ic noclobber
+As described in the section on
+.Sx input/output ,
+restrictions are placed on output redirection to insure that
+files are not accidentally destroyed, and that `>>' redirections
+refer to existing files.
+.It Ic noglob
+If set, filename expansion is inhibited.
+This inhibition is most useful in shell scripts that
+ are not dealing with filenames,
+or after a list of filenames has been obtained and further expansions
+are not desirable.
+.It Ic nonomatch
+If set, it is not an error for a filename expansion to not match any
+existing files; instead the primitive pattern is returned.
+It is still an error for the primitive pattern to be malformed, i.e.,
+`echo ['
+still gives an error.
+.It Ic notify
+If set, the shell notifies asynchronously of job completions;
+the default is to present job completions just before printing
+a prompt.
+.It Ic path
+Each word of the path variable specifies a directory in which
+commands are to be sought for execution.
+A null word specifies the current directory.
+If there is no
+.Ar path
+variable then only full path names will execute.
+The usual search path is `.', `/bin' and `/usr/bin', but this
+may vary from system to system.
+For the super-user the default search path is `/etc', `/bin' and `/usr/bin'.
+A shell that is given neither the
+.Fl c
+nor the
+.Fl t
+option will normally hash the contents of the directories in the
+.Ar path
+variable after reading
+.Ar \&.cshrc ,
+and each time the
+.Ar path
+variable is reset. If new commands are added to these directories
+while the shell is active, it may be necessary to do a
+.Ic rehash
+or the commands may not be found.
+.It Ic prompt
+The string that is printed before each command is read from
+an interactive terminal input.
+If a `!' appears in the string it will be replaced by the current event number
+unless a preceding `\e' is given.
+Default is `% ', or `# ' for the super-user.
+.It Ic savehist
+Is given a numeric value to control the number of entries of the
+history list that are saved in ~/.history when the user logs out.
+Any command that has been referenced in this many events will be saved.
+During start up the shell sources ~/.history into the history list
+enabling history to be saved across logins.
+Too large values of
+.Ar savehist
+will slow down the shell during start up.
+If
+.Ar savehist
+is just set, the shell will use the value of
+.Ar history.
+.It Ic shell
+The file in which the shell resides.
+This variable is used in forking shells to interpret files that have execute
+bits set, but which are not executable by the system.
+(See the description of
+.Sx Non-builtin Command Execution
+below.)
+Initialized to the (system-dependent) home of the shell.
+.It Ic status
+The status returned by the last command.
+If it terminated abnormally, then 0200 is added to the status.
+Builtin commands that fail return exit status `1',
+all other builtin commands set status to `0'.
+.It Ic time
+Controls automatic timing of commands.
+If set, then any command that takes more than this many cpu seconds
+will cause a line giving user, system, and real times and a utilization
+percentage which is the ratio of user plus system times to real time
+to be printed when it terminates.
+.It Ic verbose
+Set by the
+.Fl v
+command line option, causes the words of each command to be printed
+after history substitution.
+.El
+.Ss Non-builtin command execution
+When a command to be executed is found to not be a builtin command
+the shell attempts to execute the command via
+.Xr execve 2 .
+Each word in the variable
+.Ar path
+names a directory from which the shell will attempt to execute the command.
+If it is given neither a
+.Fl c
+nor a
+.Fl t
+option, the shell will hash the names in these directories into an internal
+table so that it will only try an
+.Ic exec
+in a directory if there is a possibility that the command resides there.
+This shortcut greatly speeds command location when many directories
+are present in the search path.
+If this mechanism has been turned off (via
+.Ic unhash ) ,
+or if the shell was given a
+.Fl c
+or
+.Fl t
+argument, and in any case for each directory component of
+.Ar path
+that does not begin with a `/',
+the shell concatenates with the given command name to form a path name
+of a file which it then attempts to execute.
+.Pp
+Parenthesized commands are always executed in a subshell.
+Thus
+.Pp
+.Dl (cd ; pwd) ; pwd
+.Pp
+prints the
+.Ar home
+directory; leaving you where you were (printing this after the home directory),
+while
+.Pp
+.Dl cd ; pwd
+.Pp
+leaves you in the
+.Ar home
+directory.
+Parenthesized commands are most often used to prevent
+.Ic chdir
+from affecting the current shell.
+.Pp
+If the file has execute permissions but is not an
+executable binary to the system, then it is assumed to be a
+file containing shell commands and a new shell is spawned to read it.
+.Pp
+If there is an
+.Ic alias
+for
+.Ic shell
+then the words of the alias will be prepended to the argument list to form
+the shell command.
+The first word of the
+.Ic alias
+should be the full path name of the shell
+(e.g., `$shell').
+Note that this is a special, late occurring, case of
+.Ic alias
+substitution,
+and only allows words to be prepended to the argument list without change.
+.Ss Signal handling
+The shell normally ignores
+.Ar quit
+signals.
+Jobs running detached (either by
+.Ic \&&
+or the
+.Ic bg
+or
+.Ic %... &
+commands) are immune to signals generated from the keyboard, including
+hangups.
+Other signals have the values which the shell inherited from its parent.
+The shell's handling of interrupts and terminate signals
+in shell scripts can be controlled by
+.Ic onintr .
+Login shells catch the
+.Ar terminate
+signal; otherwise this signal is passed on to children from the state in the
+shell's parent.
+Interrupts are not allowed when a login shell is reading the file
+.Pa \&.logout .
+.Sh AUTHOR
+William Joy.
+Job control and directory stack features first implemented by J.E. Kulp of
+IIASA, Laxenburg, Austria,
+with different syntax than that used now.
+File name completion code written by Ken Greer, HP Labs.
+Eight-bit implementation Christos S. Zoulas, Cornell University.
+.Sh FILES
+.Bl -tag -width /etc/passwd -compact
+.It Pa ~/.cshrc
+Read at beginning of execution by each shell.
+.It Pa ~/.login
+Read by login shell, after `.cshrc' at login.
+.It Pa ~/.logout
+Read by login shell, at logout.
+.It Pa /bin/sh
+Standard shell, for shell scripts not starting with a `#'.
+.It Pa /tmp/sh*
+Temporary file for `<<'.
+.It Pa /etc/passwd
+Source of home directories for `~name'.
+.El
+.Sh LIMITATIONS
+Word lengths \-
+Words can be no longer than 1024 characters.
+The system limits argument lists to 10240 characters.
+The number of arguments to a command that involves filename expansion
+is limited to 1/6'th the number of characters allowed in an argument list.
+Command substitutions may substitute no more characters than are
+allowed in an argument list.
+To detect looping, the shell restricts the number of
+.Ic alias
+substitutions on a single line to 20.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr sh 1 ,
+.Xr access 2 ,
+.Xr execve 2 ,
+.Xr fork 2 ,
+.Xr killpg 2 ,
+.Xr pipe 2 ,
+.Xr sigvec 2 ,
+.Xr umask 2 ,
+.Xr setrlimit 2 ,
+.Xr wait 2 ,
+.Xr tty 4 ,
+.Xr a.out 5 ,
+.Xr environ 7 ,
+.br
+.Em An introduction to the C shell
+.Sh HISTORY
+.Nm Csh
+appeared in
+.Bx 3 .
+It
+was a first implementation of a command language interpreter
+incorporating a history mechanism (see
+.Sx History Substitutions ) ,
+job control facilities (see
+.Sx Jobs ) ,
+interactive file name
+and user name completion (see
+.Sx File Name Completion ) ,
+and a C-like syntax.
+There are now many shells that also have these mechanisms, plus
+a few more (and maybe some bugs too), which are available through the
+usenet.
+.Sh BUGS
+When a command is restarted from a stop,
+the shell prints the directory it started in if this is different
+from the current directory; this can be misleading (i.e., wrong)
+as the job may have changed directories internally.
+.Pp
+Shell builtin functions are not stoppable/restartable.
+Command sequences of the form `a ; b ; c' are also not handled gracefully
+when stopping is attempted. If you suspend `b', the shell will
+immediately execute `c'. This is especially noticeable if this
+expansion results from an
+.Ar alias .
+It suffices to place the sequence of commands in ()'s to force it to
+a subshell, i.e., `( a ; b ; c )'.
+.Pp
+Control over tty output after processes are started is primitive;
+perhaps this will inspire someone to work on a good virtual
+terminal interface. In a virtual terminal interface much more
+interesting things could be done with output control.
+.Pp
+Alias substitution is most often used to clumsily simulate shell procedures;
+shell procedures should be provided instead of aliases.
+.Pp
+Commands within loops, prompted for by `?', are not placed on the
+.Ic history
+list.
+Control structure should be parsed instead of being recognized as built-in
+commands. This would allow control commands to be placed anywhere,
+to be combined with `\&|', and to be used with `&' and `;' metasyntax.
+.Pp
+It should be possible to use the `:' modifiers on the output of command
+substitutions.
+.Pp
+The way the
+.Ic filec
+facility is implemented is ugly and expensive.
diff --git a/bin/csh/csh.c b/bin/csh/csh.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8f70d32
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/csh.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1352 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)csh.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 10/12/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <locale.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <vis.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "proc.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+#include "pathnames.h"
+
+extern bool MapsAreInited;
+extern bool NLSMapsAreInited;
+
+/*
+ * C Shell
+ *
+ * Bill Joy, UC Berkeley, California, USA
+ * October 1978, May 1980
+ *
+ * Jim Kulp, IIASA, Laxenburg, Austria
+ * April 1980
+ *
+ * Christos Zoulas, Cornell University
+ * June, 1991
+ */
+
+Char *dumphist[] = {STRhistory, STRmh, 0, 0};
+Char *loadhist[] = {STRsource, STRmh, STRtildothist, 0};
+
+int nofile = 0;
+bool reenter = 0;
+bool nverbose = 0;
+bool nexececho = 0;
+bool quitit = 0;
+bool fast = 0;
+bool batch = 0;
+bool mflag = 0;
+bool prompt = 1;
+bool enterhist = 0;
+bool tellwhat = 0;
+
+extern char **environ;
+
+static int readf __P((void *, char *, int));
+static fpos_t seekf __P((void *, fpos_t, int));
+static int writef __P((void *, const char *, int));
+static int closef __P((void *));
+static int srccat __P((Char *, Char *));
+static int srcfile __P((char *, bool, bool));
+static void phup __P((int));
+static void srcunit __P((int, bool, bool));
+static void mailchk __P((void));
+static Char **defaultpath __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+ register char *tcp;
+ register int f;
+ register char **tempv;
+ struct sigvec osv;
+
+ cshin = stdin;
+ cshout = stdout;
+ csherr = stderr;
+
+ settimes(); /* Immed. estab. timing base */
+
+ /*
+ * Initialize non constant strings
+ */
+#ifdef _PATH_BSHELL
+ STR_BSHELL = SAVE(_PATH_BSHELL);
+#endif
+#ifdef _PATH_CSHELL
+ STR_SHELLPATH = SAVE(_PATH_CSHELL);
+#endif
+ STR_environ = blk2short(environ);
+ environ = short2blk(STR_environ); /* So that we can free it */
+ STR_WORD_CHARS = SAVE(WORD_CHARS);
+
+ HIST = '!';
+ HISTSUB = '^';
+ word_chars = STR_WORD_CHARS;
+
+ tempv = argv;
+ if (eq(str2short(tempv[0]), STRaout)) /* A.out's are quittable */
+ quitit = 1;
+ uid = getuid();
+ gid = getgid();
+ euid = geteuid();
+ egid = getegid();
+ /*
+ * We are a login shell if: 1. we were invoked as -<something> and we had
+ * no arguments 2. or we were invoked only with the -l flag
+ */
+ loginsh = (**tempv == '-' && argc == 1) ||
+ (argc == 2 && tempv[1][0] == '-' && tempv[1][1] == 'l' &&
+ tempv[1][2] == '\0');
+
+ if (loginsh && **tempv != '-') {
+ /*
+ * Mangle the argv space
+ */
+ tempv[1][0] = '\0';
+ tempv[1][1] = '\0';
+ tempv[1] = NULL;
+ for (tcp = *tempv; *tcp++;)
+ continue;
+ for (tcp--; tcp >= *tempv; tcp--)
+ tcp[1] = tcp[0];
+ *++tcp = '-';
+ argc--;
+ }
+ if (loginsh)
+ (void) time(&chktim);
+
+ AsciiOnly = 1;
+#ifdef NLS
+ (void) setlocale(LC_ALL, "");
+ {
+ int k;
+
+ for (k = 0200; k <= 0377 && !Isprint(k); k++)
+ continue;
+ AsciiOnly = k > 0377;
+ }
+#else
+ AsciiOnly = getenv("LANG") == NULL && getenv("LC_CTYPE") == NULL;
+#endif /* NLS */
+
+ /*
+ * Move the descriptors to safe places. The variable didfds is 0 while we
+ * have only FSH* to work with. When didfds is true, we have 0,1,2 and
+ * prefer to use these.
+ */
+ initdesc();
+ /*
+ * XXX: This is to keep programs that use stdio happy.
+ * what we really want is freunopen() ....
+ * Closing cshin cshout and csherr (which are really stdin stdout
+ * and stderr at this point and then reopening them in the same order
+ * gives us again stdin == cshin stdout == cshout and stderr == csherr.
+ * If that was not the case builtins like printf that use stdio
+ * would break. But in any case we could fix that with memcpy and
+ * a bit of pointer manipulation...
+ * Fortunately this is not needed under the current implementation
+ * of stdio.
+ */
+ (void) fclose(cshin);
+ (void) fclose(cshout);
+ (void) fclose(csherr);
+ if (!(cshin = funopen((void *) &SHIN, readf, writef, seekf, closef)))
+ exit(1);
+ if (!(cshout = funopen((void *) &SHOUT, readf, writef, seekf, closef)))
+ exit(1);
+ if (!(csherr = funopen((void *) &SHERR, readf, writef, seekf, closef)))
+ exit(1);
+ (void) setvbuf(cshin, NULL, _IOLBF, 0);
+ (void) setvbuf(cshout, NULL, _IOLBF, 0);
+ (void) setvbuf(csherr, NULL, _IOLBF, 0);
+
+ /*
+ * Initialize the shell variables. ARGV and PROMPT are initialized later.
+ * STATUS is also munged in several places. CHILD is munged when
+ * forking/waiting
+ */
+ set(STRstatus, Strsave(STR0));
+
+ if ((tcp = getenv("HOME")) != NULL)
+ cp = SAVE(tcp);
+ else
+ cp = NULL;
+
+ if (cp == NULL)
+ fast = 1; /* No home -> can't read scripts */
+ else
+ set(STRhome, cp);
+ dinit(cp); /* dinit thinks that HOME == cwd in a login
+ * shell */
+ /*
+ * Grab other useful things from the environment. Should we grab
+ * everything??
+ */
+ if ((tcp = getenv("LOGNAME")) != NULL ||
+ (tcp = getenv("USER")) != NULL)
+ set(STRuser, SAVE(tcp));
+ if ((tcp = getenv("TERM")) != NULL)
+ set(STRterm, SAVE(tcp));
+
+ /*
+ * Re-initialize path if set in environment
+ */
+ if ((tcp = getenv("PATH")) == NULL)
+ set1(STRpath, defaultpath(), &shvhed);
+ else
+ importpath(SAVE(tcp));
+
+ set(STRshell, Strsave(STR_SHELLPATH));
+
+ doldol = putn((int) getpid()); /* For $$ */
+ shtemp = Strspl(STRtmpsh, doldol); /* For << */
+
+ /*
+ * Record the interrupt states from the parent process. If the parent is
+ * non-interruptible our hand must be forced or we (and our children) won't
+ * be either. Our children inherit termination from our parent. We catch it
+ * only if we are the login shell.
+ */
+ /* parents interruptibility */
+ (void) sigvec(SIGINT, NULL, &osv);
+ parintr = (void (*) ()) osv.sv_handler;
+ (void) sigvec(SIGTERM, NULL, &osv);
+ parterm = (void (*) ()) osv.sv_handler;
+
+ if (loginsh) {
+ (void) signal(SIGHUP, phup); /* exit processing on HUP */
+ (void) signal(SIGXCPU, phup); /* ...and on XCPU */
+ (void) signal(SIGXFSZ, phup); /* ...and on XFSZ */
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Process the arguments.
+ *
+ * Note that processing of -v/-x is actually delayed till after script
+ * processing.
+ *
+ * We set the first character of our name to be '-' if we are a shell
+ * running interruptible commands. Many programs which examine ps'es
+ * use this to filter such shells out.
+ */
+ argc--, tempv++;
+ while (argc > 0 && (tcp = tempv[0])[0] == '-' && *++tcp != '\0' && !batch) {
+ do
+ switch (*tcp++) {
+
+ case 0: /* - Interruptible, no prompt */
+ prompt = 0;
+ setintr = 1;
+ nofile = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'b': /* -b Next arg is input file */
+ batch = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'c': /* -c Command input from arg */
+ if (argc == 1)
+ xexit(0);
+ argc--, tempv++;
+ arginp = SAVE(tempv[0]);
+ prompt = 0;
+ nofile = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'e': /* -e Exit on any error */
+ exiterr = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'f': /* -f Fast start */
+ fast = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'i': /* -i Interactive, even if !intty */
+ intact = 1;
+ nofile = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'm': /* -m read .cshrc (from su) */
+ mflag = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'n': /* -n Don't execute */
+ noexec = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'q': /* -q (Undoc'd) ... die on quit */
+ quitit = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 's': /* -s Read from std input */
+ nofile = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 't': /* -t Read one line from input */
+ onelflg = 2;
+ prompt = 0;
+ nofile = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'v': /* -v Echo hist expanded input */
+ nverbose = 1; /* ... later */
+ break;
+
+ case 'x': /* -x Echo just before execution */
+ nexececho = 1; /* ... later */
+ break;
+
+ case 'V': /* -V Echo hist expanded input */
+ setNS(STRverbose); /* NOW! */
+ break;
+
+ case 'X': /* -X Echo just before execution */
+ setNS(STRecho); /* NOW! */
+ break;
+
+ } while (*tcp);
+ tempv++, argc--;
+ }
+
+ if (quitit) /* With all due haste, for debugging */
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_DFL);
+
+ /*
+ * Unless prevented by -, -c, -i, -s, or -t, if there are remaining
+ * arguments the first of them is the name of a shell file from which to
+ * read commands.
+ */
+ if (nofile == 0 && argc > 0) {
+ nofile = open(tempv[0], O_RDONLY);
+ if (nofile < 0) {
+ child = 1; /* So this doesn't return */
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tempv[0], strerror(errno));
+ }
+ ffile = SAVE(tempv[0]);
+ /*
+ * Replace FSHIN. Handle /dev/std{in,out,err} specially
+ * since once they are closed we cannot open them again.
+ * In that case we use our own saved descriptors
+ */
+ if ((SHIN = dmove(nofile, FSHIN)) < 0)
+ switch(nofile) {
+ case 0:
+ SHIN = FSHIN;
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ SHIN = FSHOUT;
+ break;
+ case 2:
+ SHIN = FSHERR;
+ break;
+ default:
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tempv[0], strerror(errno));
+ break;
+ }
+ (void) ioctl(SHIN, FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ prompt = 0;
+ /* argc not used any more */ tempv++;
+ }
+
+ intty = isatty(SHIN);
+ intty |= intact;
+ if (intty || (intact && isatty(SHOUT))) {
+ if (!batch && (uid != euid || gid != egid)) {
+ errno = EACCES;
+ child = 1; /* So this doesn't return */
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, "csh", strerror(errno));
+ }
+ }
+ /*
+ * Decide whether we should play with signals or not. If we are explicitly
+ * told (via -i, or -) or we are a login shell (arg0 starts with -) or the
+ * input and output are both the ttys("csh", or "csh</dev/ttyx>/dev/ttyx")
+ * Note that in only the login shell is it likely that parent may have set
+ * signals to be ignored
+ */
+ if (loginsh || intact || (intty && isatty(SHOUT)))
+ setintr = 1;
+ settell();
+ /*
+ * Save the remaining arguments in argv.
+ */
+ setq(STRargv, blk2short(tempv), &shvhed);
+
+ /*
+ * Set up the prompt.
+ */
+ if (prompt) {
+ set(STRprompt, Strsave(uid == 0 ? STRsymhash : STRsymcent));
+ /* that's a meta-questionmark */
+ set(STRprompt2, Strsave(STRmquestion));
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If we are an interactive shell, then start fiddling with the signals;
+ * this is a tricky game.
+ */
+ shpgrp = getpgrp();
+ opgrp = tpgrp = -1;
+ if (setintr) {
+ **argv = '-';
+ if (!quitit) /* Wary! */
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, pintr);
+ (void) sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ (void) signal(SIGTERM, SIG_IGN);
+ if (quitit == 0 && arginp == 0) {
+ (void) signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTIN, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTOU, SIG_IGN);
+ /*
+ * Wait till in foreground, in case someone stupidly runs csh &
+ * dont want to try to grab away the tty.
+ */
+ if (isatty(FSHERR))
+ f = FSHERR;
+ else if (isatty(FSHOUT))
+ f = FSHOUT;
+ else if (isatty(OLDSTD))
+ f = OLDSTD;
+ else
+ f = -1;
+ retry:
+ if ((tpgrp = tcgetpgrp(f)) != -1) {
+ if (tpgrp != shpgrp) {
+ sig_t old = signal(SIGTTIN, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) kill(0, SIGTTIN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTIN, old);
+ goto retry;
+ }
+ opgrp = shpgrp;
+ shpgrp = getpid();
+ tpgrp = shpgrp;
+ /*
+ * Setpgid will fail if we are a session leader and
+ * mypid == mypgrp (POSIX 4.3.3)
+ */
+ if (opgrp != shpgrp)
+ if (setpgid(0, shpgrp) == -1)
+ goto notty;
+ /*
+ * We do that after we set our process group, to make sure
+ * that the process group belongs to a process in the same
+ * session as the tty (our process and our group) (POSIX 7.2.4)
+ */
+ if (tcsetpgrp(f, shpgrp) == -1)
+ goto notty;
+ (void) ioctl(dcopy(f, FSHTTY), FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ }
+ if (tpgrp == -1) {
+notty:
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "Warning: no access to tty (%s).\n",
+ strerror(errno));
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "Thus no job control in this shell.\n");
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if ((setintr == 0) && (parintr == SIG_DFL))
+ setintr = 1;
+ (void) signal(SIGCHLD, pchild); /* while signals not ready */
+
+ /*
+ * Set an exit here in case of an interrupt or error reading the shell
+ * start-up scripts.
+ */
+ reenter = setexit(); /* PWP */
+ haderr = 0; /* In case second time through */
+ if (!fast && reenter == 0) {
+ /* Will have value(STRhome) here because set fast if don't */
+ {
+ int osetintr = setintr;
+ sig_t oparintr = parintr;
+ sigset_t omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+
+ setintr = 0;
+ parintr = SIG_IGN; /* Disable onintr */
+#ifdef _PATH_DOTCSHRC
+ (void) srcfile(_PATH_DOTCSHRC, 0, 0);
+#endif
+ if (!fast && !arginp && !onelflg)
+ dohash(NULL, NULL);
+#ifdef _PATH_DOTLOGIN
+ if (loginsh)
+ (void) srcfile(_PATH_DOTLOGIN, 0, 0);
+#endif
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ setintr = osetintr;
+ parintr = oparintr;
+ }
+ (void) srccat(value(STRhome), STRsldotcshrc);
+
+ if (!fast && !arginp && !onelflg && !havhash)
+ dohash(NULL, NULL);
+ /*
+ * Source history before .login so that it is available in .login
+ */
+ if ((cp = value(STRhistfile)) != STRNULL)
+ loadhist[2] = cp;
+ dosource(loadhist, NULL);
+ if (loginsh)
+ (void) srccat(value(STRhome), STRsldotlogin);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Now are ready for the -v and -x flags
+ */
+ if (nverbose)
+ setNS(STRverbose);
+ if (nexececho)
+ setNS(STRecho);
+
+ /*
+ * All the rest of the world is inside this call. The argument to process
+ * indicates whether it should catch "error unwinds". Thus if we are a
+ * interactive shell our call here will never return by being blown past on
+ * an error.
+ */
+ process(setintr);
+
+ /*
+ * Mop-up.
+ */
+ if (intty) {
+ if (loginsh) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "logout\n");
+ (void) close(SHIN);
+ child = 1;
+ goodbye();
+ }
+ else {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "exit\n");
+ }
+ }
+ rechist();
+ exitstat();
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+untty()
+{
+ if (tpgrp > 0) {
+ (void) setpgid(0, opgrp);
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, opgrp);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+importpath(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ register int i = 0;
+ register Char *dp;
+ register Char **pv;
+ int c;
+
+ for (dp = cp; *dp; dp++)
+ if (*dp == ':')
+ i++;
+ /*
+ * i+2 where i is the number of colons in the path. There are i+1
+ * directories in the path plus we need room for a zero terminator.
+ */
+ pv = (Char **) xcalloc((size_t) (i + 2), sizeof(Char **));
+ dp = cp;
+ i = 0;
+ if (*dp)
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((c = *dp) == ':' || c == 0) {
+ *dp = 0;
+ if ((*cp != '/' || *cp == '\0') && (euid == 0 || uid == 0))
+ (void) fprintf(csherr,
+ "Warning: imported path contains relative components\n");
+ pv[i++] = Strsave(*cp ? cp : STRdot);
+ if (c) {
+ cp = dp + 1;
+ *dp = ':';
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ dp++;
+ }
+ pv[i] = 0;
+ set1(STRpath, pv, &shvhed);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Source to the file which is the catenation of the argument names.
+ */
+static int
+srccat(cp, dp)
+ Char *cp, *dp;
+{
+ register Char *ep = Strspl(cp, dp);
+ char *ptr = short2str(ep);
+
+ xfree((ptr_t) ep);
+ return srcfile(ptr, mflag ? 0 : 1, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Source to a file putting the file descriptor in a safe place (> 2).
+ */
+static int
+srcfile(f, onlyown, flag)
+ char *f;
+ bool onlyown, flag;
+{
+ register int unit;
+
+ if ((unit = open(f, O_RDONLY)) == -1)
+ return 0;
+ unit = dmove(unit, -1);
+
+ (void) ioctl(unit, FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ srcunit(unit, onlyown, flag);
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Source to a unit. If onlyown it must be our file or our group or
+ * we don't chance it. This occurs on ".cshrc"s and the like.
+ */
+int insource;
+static void
+srcunit(unit, onlyown, hflg)
+ register int unit;
+ bool onlyown, hflg;
+{
+ /* We have to push down a lot of state here */
+ /* All this could go into a structure */
+ int oSHIN = -1, oldintty = intty, oinsource = insource;
+ struct whyle *oldwhyl = whyles;
+ Char *ogointr = gointr, *oarginp = arginp;
+ Char *oevalp = evalp, **oevalvec = evalvec;
+ int oonelflg = onelflg;
+ bool oenterhist = enterhist;
+ char OHIST = HIST;
+ bool otell = cantell;
+
+ struct Bin saveB;
+ volatile sigset_t omask;
+ jmp_buf oldexit;
+
+ /* The (few) real local variables */
+ int my_reenter;
+
+ if (unit < 0)
+ return;
+ if (didfds)
+ donefds();
+ if (onlyown) {
+ struct stat stb;
+
+ if (fstat(unit, &stb) < 0) {
+ (void) close(unit);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * There is a critical section here while we are pushing down the input
+ * stream since we have stuff in different structures. If we weren't
+ * careful an interrupt could corrupt SHIN's Bin structure and kill the
+ * shell.
+ *
+ * We could avoid the critical region by grouping all the stuff in a single
+ * structure and pointing at it to move it all at once. This is less
+ * efficient globally on many variable references however.
+ */
+ insource = 1;
+ getexit(oldexit);
+ omask = 0;
+
+ if (setintr)
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ /* Setup the new values of the state stuff saved above */
+ bcopy((char *) &B, (char *) &(saveB), sizeof(B));
+ fbuf = NULL;
+ fseekp = feobp = fblocks = 0;
+ oSHIN = SHIN, SHIN = unit, arginp = 0, onelflg = 0;
+ intty = isatty(SHIN), whyles = 0, gointr = 0;
+ evalvec = 0;
+ evalp = 0;
+ enterhist = hflg;
+ if (enterhist)
+ HIST = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * Now if we are allowing commands to be interrupted, we let ourselves be
+ * interrupted.
+ */
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ settell();
+
+ if ((my_reenter = setexit()) == 0)
+ process(0); /* 0 -> blow away on errors */
+
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ if (oSHIN >= 0) {
+ register int i;
+
+ /* We made it to the new state... free up its storage */
+ /* This code could get run twice but xfree doesn't care */
+ for (i = 0; i < fblocks; i++)
+ xfree((ptr_t) fbuf[i]);
+ xfree((ptr_t) fbuf);
+
+ /* Reset input arena */
+ bcopy((char *) &(saveB), (char *) &B, sizeof(B));
+
+ (void) close(SHIN), SHIN = oSHIN;
+ arginp = oarginp, onelflg = oonelflg;
+ evalp = oevalp, evalvec = oevalvec;
+ intty = oldintty, whyles = oldwhyl, gointr = ogointr;
+ if (enterhist)
+ HIST = OHIST;
+ enterhist = oenterhist;
+ cantell = otell;
+ }
+
+ resexit(oldexit);
+ /*
+ * If process reset() (effectively an unwind) then we must also unwind.
+ */
+ if (my_reenter)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+ insource = oinsource;
+}
+
+void
+rechist()
+{
+ Char buf[BUFSIZ], hbuf[BUFSIZ], *hfile;
+ int fp, ftmp, oldidfds;
+ struct varent *shist;
+
+ if (!fast) {
+ /*
+ * If $savehist is just set, we use the value of $history
+ * else we use the value in $savehist
+ */
+ if ((shist = adrof(STRsavehist)) != NULL) {
+ if (shist->vec[0][0] != '\0')
+ (void) Strcpy(hbuf, shist->vec[0]);
+ else if ((shist = adrof(STRhistory)) && shist->vec[0][0] != '\0')
+ (void) Strcpy(hbuf, shist->vec[0]);
+ else
+ return;
+ }
+ else
+ return;
+
+ if ((hfile = value(STRhistfile)) == STRNULL) {
+ hfile = Strcpy(buf, value(STRhome));
+ (void) Strcat(buf, STRsldthist);
+ }
+
+ if ((fp = creat(short2str(hfile), 0600)) == -1)
+ return;
+
+ oldidfds = didfds;
+ didfds = 0;
+ ftmp = SHOUT;
+ SHOUT = fp;
+ dumphist[2] = hbuf;
+ dohist(dumphist, NULL);
+ SHOUT = ftmp;
+ (void) close(fp);
+ didfds = oldidfds;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+goodbye()
+{
+ rechist();
+
+ if (loginsh) {
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTERM, SIG_IGN);
+ setintr = 0; /* No interrupts after "logout" */
+ if (!(adrof(STRlogout)))
+ set(STRlogout, STRnormal);
+#ifdef _PATH_DOTLOGOUT
+ (void) srcfile(_PATH_DOTLOGOUT, 0, 0);
+#endif
+ if (adrof(STRhome))
+ (void) srccat(value(STRhome), STRsldtlogout);
+ }
+ exitstat();
+}
+
+void
+exitstat()
+{
+ Char *s;
+#ifdef PROF
+ monitor(0);
+#endif
+ /*
+ * Note that if STATUS is corrupted (i.e. getn bombs) then error will exit
+ * directly because we poke child here. Otherwise we might continue
+ * unwarrantedly (sic).
+ */
+ child = 1;
+ s = value(STRstatus);
+ xexit(s ? getn(s) : 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * in the event of a HUP we want to save the history
+ */
+static void
+phup(sig)
+int sig;
+{
+ rechist();
+
+ /*
+ * We kill the last foreground process group. It then becomes
+ * responsible to propagate the SIGHUP to its progeny.
+ */
+ {
+ struct process *pp, *np;
+
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp; pp = pp->p_next) {
+ np = pp;
+ /*
+ * Find if this job is in the foreground. It could be that
+ * the process leader has exited and the foreground flag
+ * is cleared for it.
+ */
+ do
+ /*
+ * If a process is in the foreground; we try to kill
+ * it's process group. If we succeed, then the
+ * whole job is gone. Otherwise we keep going...
+ * But avoid sending HUP to the shell again.
+ */
+ if ((np->p_flags & PFOREGND) != 0 && np->p_jobid != shpgrp &&
+ killpg(np->p_jobid, SIGHUP) != -1) {
+ /* In case the job was suspended... */
+ (void) killpg(np->p_jobid, SIGCONT);
+ break;
+ }
+ while ((np = np->p_friends) != pp);
+ }
+ }
+ _exit(sig);
+}
+
+Char *jobargv[2] = {STRjobs, 0};
+
+/*
+ * Catch an interrupt, e.g. during lexical input.
+ * If we are an interactive shell, we reset the interrupt catch
+ * immediately. In any case we drain the shell output,
+ * and finally go through the normal error mechanism, which
+ * gets a chance to make the shell go away.
+ */
+/* ARGSUSED */
+void
+pintr(notused)
+ int notused;
+{
+ pintr1(1);
+}
+
+void
+pintr1(wantnl)
+ bool wantnl;
+{
+ Char **v;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ omask = sigblock((sigset_t) 0);
+ if (setintr) {
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+ if (pjobs) {
+ pjobs = 0;
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "\n");
+ dojobs(jobargv, NULL);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_INTR);
+ }
+ }
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask & ~sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ (void) fpurge(cshout);
+ (void) endpwent();
+
+ /*
+ * If we have an active "onintr" then we search for the label. Note that if
+ * one does "onintr -" then we shan't be interruptible so we needn't worry
+ * about that here.
+ */
+ if (gointr) {
+ gotolab(gointr);
+ timflg = 0;
+ if ((v = pargv) != NULL)
+ pargv = 0, blkfree(v);
+ if ((v = gargv) != NULL)
+ gargv = 0, blkfree(v);
+ reset();
+ }
+ else if (intty && wantnl) {
+ (void) fputc('\r', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Process is the main driving routine for the shell.
+ * It runs all command processing, except for those within { ... }
+ * in expressions (which is run by a routine evalav in sh.exp.c which
+ * is a stripped down process), and `...` evaluation which is run
+ * also by a subset of this code in sh.glob.c in the routine backeval.
+ *
+ * The code here is a little strange because part of it is interruptible
+ * and hence freeing of structures appears to occur when none is necessary
+ * if this is ignored.
+ *
+ * Note that if catch is not set then we will unwind on any error.
+ * If an end-of-file occurs, we return.
+ */
+static struct command *savet = NULL;
+void
+process(catch)
+ bool catch;
+{
+ jmp_buf osetexit;
+ struct command *t = savet;
+
+ savet = NULL;
+ getexit(osetexit);
+ for (;;) {
+ pendjob();
+ paraml.next = paraml.prev = &paraml;
+ paraml.word = STRNULL;
+ (void) setexit();
+ justpr = enterhist; /* execute if not entering history */
+
+ /*
+ * Interruptible during interactive reads
+ */
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(sigblock((sigset_t) 0) & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+
+ /*
+ * For the sake of reset()
+ */
+ freelex(&paraml);
+ if (savet)
+ freesyn(savet), savet = NULL;
+
+ if (haderr) {
+ if (!catch) {
+ /* unwind */
+ doneinp = 0;
+ resexit(osetexit);
+ savet = t;
+ reset();
+ }
+ haderr = 0;
+ /*
+ * Every error is eventually caught here or the shell dies. It is
+ * at this point that we clean up any left-over open files, by
+ * closing all but a fixed number of pre-defined files. Thus
+ * routines don't have to worry about leaving files open due to
+ * deeper errors... they will get closed here.
+ */
+ closem();
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (doneinp) {
+ doneinp = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (chkstop)
+ chkstop--;
+ if (neednote)
+ pnote();
+ if (intty && prompt && evalvec == 0) {
+ mailchk();
+ /*
+ * If we are at the end of the input buffer then we are going to
+ * read fresh stuff. Otherwise, we are rereading input and don't
+ * need or want to prompt.
+ */
+ if (aret == F_SEEK && fseekp == feobp)
+ printprompt();
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+ }
+ if (seterr) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) seterr);
+ seterr = NULL;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Echo not only on VERBOSE, but also with history expansion. If there
+ * is a lexical error then we forego history echo.
+ */
+ if ((lex(&paraml) && !seterr && intty) || adrof(STRverbose)) {
+ prlex(csherr, &paraml);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * The parser may lose space if interrupted.
+ */
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+
+ /*
+ * Save input text on the history list if reading in old history, or it
+ * is from the terminal at the top level and not in a loop.
+ *
+ * PWP: entry of items in the history list while in a while loop is done
+ * elsewhere...
+ */
+ if (enterhist || (catch && intty && !whyles))
+ savehist(&paraml);
+
+ /*
+ * Print lexical error messages, except when sourcing history lists.
+ */
+ if (!enterhist && seterr)
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+
+ /*
+ * If had a history command :p modifier then this is as far as we
+ * should go
+ */
+ if (justpr)
+ reset();
+
+ alias(&paraml);
+
+ /*
+ * Parse the words of the input into a parse tree.
+ */
+ savet = syntax(paraml.next, &paraml, 0);
+ if (seterr)
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+
+ execute(savet, (tpgrp > 0 ? tpgrp : -1), NULL, NULL);
+
+ /*
+ * Made it!
+ */
+ freelex(&paraml);
+ freesyn((struct command *) savet), savet = NULL;
+ }
+ resexit(osetexit);
+ savet = t;
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dosource(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+
+{
+ register Char *f;
+ bool hflg = 0;
+ Char buf[BUFSIZ];
+
+ v++;
+ if (*v && eq(*v, STRmh)) {
+ if (*++v == NULL)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_HFLAG);
+ hflg++;
+ }
+ (void) Strcpy(buf, *v);
+ f = globone(buf, G_ERROR);
+ (void) strcpy((char *) buf, short2str(f));
+ xfree((ptr_t) f);
+ if (!srcfile((char *) buf, 0, hflg) && !hflg)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, (char *) buf, strerror(errno));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Check for mail.
+ * If we are a login shell, then we don't want to tell
+ * about any mail file unless its been modified
+ * after the time we started.
+ * This prevents us from telling the user things he already
+ * knows, since the login program insists on saying
+ * "You have mail."
+ */
+static void
+mailchk()
+{
+ register struct varent *v;
+ register Char **vp;
+ time_t t;
+ int intvl, cnt;
+ struct stat stb;
+ bool new;
+
+ v = adrof(STRmail);
+ if (v == 0)
+ return;
+ (void) time(&t);
+ vp = v->vec;
+ cnt = blklen(vp);
+ intvl = (cnt && number(*vp)) ? (--cnt, getn(*vp++)) : MAILINTVL;
+ if (intvl < 1)
+ intvl = 1;
+ if (chktim + intvl > t)
+ return;
+ for (; *vp; vp++) {
+ if (stat(short2str(*vp), &stb) < 0)
+ continue;
+ new = stb.st_mtime > time0.tv_sec;
+ if (stb.st_size == 0 || stb.st_atime > stb.st_mtime ||
+ (stb.st_atime < chktim && stb.st_mtime < chktim) ||
+ (loginsh && !new))
+ continue;
+ if (cnt == 1)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "You have %smail.\n", new ? "new " : "");
+ else
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s in %s.\n", new ? "New mail" : "Mail",
+ vis_str(*vp));
+ }
+ chktim = t;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Extract a home directory from the password file
+ * The argument points to a buffer where the name of the
+ * user whose home directory is sought is currently.
+ * We write the home directory of the user back there.
+ */
+int
+gethdir(home)
+ Char *home;
+{
+ Char *h;
+ struct passwd *pw;
+
+ /*
+ * Is it us?
+ */
+ if (*home == '\0') {
+ if ((h = value(STRhome)) != NULL) {
+ (void) Strcpy(home, h);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else
+ return 1;
+ }
+
+ if ((pw = getpwnam(short2str(home))) != NULL) {
+ (void) Strcpy(home, str2short(pw->pw_dir));
+ return 0;
+ }
+ else
+ return 1;
+}
+
+/*
+ * When didfds is set, we do I/O from 0, 1, 2 otherwise from 15, 16, 17
+ * We also check if the shell has already changed the decriptor to point to
+ * 0, 1, 2 when didfds is set.
+ */
+#define DESC(a) (*((int *) (a)) - (didfds && *((int *) a) >= FSHIN ? FSHIN : 0))
+
+static int
+readf(oreo, buf, siz)
+ void *oreo;
+ char *buf;
+ int siz;
+{
+ return read(DESC(oreo), buf, siz);
+}
+
+
+static int
+writef(oreo, buf, siz)
+ void *oreo;
+ const char *buf;
+ int siz;
+{
+ return write(DESC(oreo), buf, siz);
+}
+
+static fpos_t
+seekf(oreo, off, whence)
+ void *oreo;
+ fpos_t off;
+ int whence;
+{
+ return lseek(DESC(oreo), off, whence);
+}
+
+
+static int
+closef(oreo)
+ void *oreo;
+{
+ return close(DESC(oreo));
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Print the visible version of a string.
+ */
+int
+vis_fputc(ch, fp)
+ int ch;
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ char uenc[5]; /* 4 + NULL */
+
+ if (ch & QUOTE)
+ return fputc(ch & TRIM, fp);
+ /*
+ * XXX: When we are in AsciiOnly we want all characters >= 0200 to
+ * be encoded, but currently there is no way in vis to do that.
+ */
+ (void) vis(uenc, ch & TRIM, VIS_NOSLASH, 0);
+ return fputs(uenc, fp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Move the initial descriptors to their eventual
+ * resting places, closin all other units.
+ */
+void
+initdesc()
+{
+
+ didfds = 0; /* 0, 1, 2 aren't set up */
+ (void) ioctl(SHIN = dcopy(0, FSHIN), FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ (void) ioctl(SHOUT = dcopy(1, FSHOUT), FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ (void) ioctl(SHERR = dcopy(2, FSHERR), FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ (void) ioctl(OLDSTD = dcopy(SHIN, FOLDSTD), FIOCLEX, NULL);
+ closem();
+}
+
+
+void
+#ifdef PROF
+done(i)
+#else
+xexit(i)
+#endif
+ int i;
+{
+ untty();
+ _exit(i);
+}
+
+static Char **
+defaultpath()
+{
+ char *ptr;
+ Char **blk, **blkp;
+ struct stat stb;
+
+ blkp = blk = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(Char *) * 10);
+
+#define DIRAPPEND(a) \
+ if (stat(ptr = a, &stb) == 0 && (stb.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFDIR) \
+ *blkp++ = SAVE(ptr)
+
+ DIRAPPEND(_PATH_BIN);
+ DIRAPPEND(_PATH_USRBIN);
+
+#undef DIRAPPEND
+
+ if (euid != 0 && uid != 0)
+ *blkp++ = Strsave(STRdot);
+ *blkp = NULL;
+ return (blk);
+}
+
+void
+printprompt()
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+
+ if (!whyles) {
+ for (cp = value(STRprompt); *cp; cp++)
+ if (*cp == HIST)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d", eventno + 1);
+ else {
+ if (*cp == '\\' && cp[1] == HIST)
+ cp++;
+ (void) vis_fputc(*cp | QUOTE, cshout);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ /*
+ * Prompt for forward reading loop body content.
+ */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "? ");
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/csh.h b/bin/csh/csh.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..367b51e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/csh.h
@@ -0,0 +1,552 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)csh.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Fundamental definitions which may vary from system to system.
+ *
+ * BUFSIZ The i/o buffering size; also limits word size
+ * MAILINTVL How often to mailcheck; more often is more expensive
+ */
+#ifndef BUFSIZ
+#define BUFSIZ 1024 /* default buffer size */
+#endif /* BUFSIZ */
+
+#define FORKSLEEP 10 /* delay loop on non-interactive fork failure */
+#define MAILINTVL 600 /* 10 minutes */
+
+/*
+ * The shell moves std in/out/diag and the old std input away from units
+ * 0, 1, and 2 so that it is easy to set up these standards for invoked
+ * commands.
+ */
+#define FSHTTY 15 /* /dev/tty when manip pgrps */
+#define FSHIN 16 /* Preferred desc for shell input */
+#define FSHOUT 17 /* ... shell output */
+#define FSHERR 18 /* ... shell diagnostics */
+#define FOLDSTD 19 /* ... old std input */
+
+#ifdef PROF
+#define xexit(n) done(n)
+#endif
+
+#ifdef SHORT_STRINGS
+typedef short Char;
+
+#define SAVE(a) (Strsave(str2short(a)))
+#else
+typedef char Char;
+
+#define SAVE(a) (strsave(a))
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Make sure a variable is not stored in a register by taking its address
+ * This is used where variables might be clobbered by longjmp.
+ */
+#define UNREGISTER(a) (void) &a
+
+typedef void *ioctl_t; /* Third arg of ioctl */
+
+typedef void *ptr_t;
+
+#include "const.h"
+#include "char.h"
+#include "err.h"
+
+#define xmalloc(i) Malloc(i)
+#define xrealloc(p, i) Realloc(p, i)
+#define xcalloc(n, s) Calloc(n, s)
+#define xfree(p) Free(p)
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+FILE *cshin, *cshout, *csherr;
+
+#define isdir(d) ((d.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFDIR)
+
+typedef int bool;
+
+#define eq(a, b) (Strcmp(a, b) == 0)
+
+/* globone() flags */
+#define G_ERROR 0 /* default action: error if multiple words */
+#define G_IGNORE 1 /* ignore the rest of the words */
+#define G_APPEND 2 /* make a sentence by cat'ing the words */
+
+/*
+ * Global flags
+ */
+bool chkstop; /* Warned of stopped jobs... allow exit */
+bool didfds; /* Have setup i/o fd's for child */
+bool doneinp; /* EOF indicator after reset from readc */
+bool exiterr; /* Exit if error or non-zero exit status */
+bool child; /* Child shell ... errors cause exit */
+bool haderr; /* Reset was because of an error */
+bool intty; /* Input is a tty */
+bool intact; /* We are interactive... therefore prompt */
+bool justpr; /* Just print because of :p hist mod */
+bool loginsh; /* We are a loginsh -> .login/.logout */
+bool neednote; /* Need to pnotify() */
+bool noexec; /* Don't execute, just syntax check */
+bool pjobs; /* want to print jobs if interrupted */
+bool setintr; /* Set interrupts on/off -> Wait intr... */
+bool timflg; /* Time the next waited for command */
+bool havhash; /* path hashing is available */
+
+#ifdef FILEC
+bool filec; /* doing filename expansion */
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Global i/o info
+ */
+Char *arginp; /* Argument input for sh -c and internal `xx` */
+int onelflg; /* 2 -> need line for -t, 1 -> exit on read */
+Char *ffile; /* Name of shell file for $0 */
+
+char *seterr; /* Error message from scanner/parser */
+Char *shtemp; /* Temp name for << shell files in /tmp */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+
+struct timeval time0; /* Time at which the shell started */
+struct rusage ru0;
+
+/*
+ * Miscellany
+ */
+Char *doldol; /* Character pid for $$ */
+int backpid; /* Pid of the last background process */
+int uid, euid; /* Invokers uid */
+int gid, egid; /* Invokers gid */
+time_t chktim; /* Time mail last checked */
+int shpgrp; /* Pgrp of shell */
+int tpgrp; /* Terminal process group */
+
+/* If tpgrp is -1, leave tty alone! */
+int opgrp; /* Initial pgrp and tty pgrp */
+
+
+/*
+ * To be able to redirect i/o for builtins easily, the shell moves the i/o
+ * descriptors it uses away from 0,1,2.
+ * Ideally these should be in units which are closed across exec's
+ * (this saves work) but for version 6, this is not usually possible.
+ * The desired initial values for these descriptors are F{SHIN,...}.
+ */
+int SHIN; /* Current shell input (script) */
+int SHOUT; /* Shell output */
+int SHERR; /* Diagnostic output... shell errs go here */
+int OLDSTD; /* Old standard input (def for cmds) */
+
+/*
+ * Error control
+ *
+ * Errors in scanning and parsing set up an error message to be printed
+ * at the end and complete. Other errors always cause a reset.
+ * Because of source commands and .cshrc we need nested error catches.
+ */
+
+#include <setjmp.h>
+jmp_buf reslab;
+
+#define setexit() (setjmp(reslab))
+#define reset() longjmp(reslab, 1)
+ /* Should use structure assignment here */
+#define getexit(a) bcopy((char *)reslab, ((char *)(a)), sizeof reslab)
+#define resexit(a) bcopy((char *)(a), (char *)reslab, sizeof reslab)
+
+Char *gointr; /* Label for an onintr transfer */
+
+#include <signal.h>
+sig_t parintr; /* Parents interrupt catch */
+sig_t parterm; /* Parents terminate catch */
+
+/*
+ * Lexical definitions.
+ *
+ * All lexical space is allocated dynamically.
+ * The eighth/sixteenth bit of characters is used to prevent recognition,
+ * and eventually stripped.
+ */
+#define META 0200
+#define ASCII 0177
+#ifdef SHORT_STRINGS
+#define CHAR 0377
+#define QUOTE 0100000 /* 16nth char bit used for 'ing */
+#define TRIM 0077777 /* Mask to strip quote bit */
+#else
+#define CHAR 0177
+#define QUOTE 0200 /* Eighth char bit used for 'ing */
+#define TRIM 0177 /* Mask to strip quote bit */
+#endif
+
+int AsciiOnly; /* If set only 7 bits is expected in characters */
+
+/*
+ * Each level of input has a buffered input structure.
+ * There are one or more blocks of buffered input for each level,
+ * exactly one if the input is seekable and tell is available.
+ * In other cases, the shell buffers enough blocks to keep all loops
+ * in the buffer.
+ */
+struct Bin {
+ off_t Bfseekp; /* Seek pointer */
+ off_t Bfbobp; /* Seekp of beginning of buffers */
+ off_t Bfeobp; /* Seekp of end of buffers */
+ int Bfblocks; /* Number of buffer blocks */
+ Char **Bfbuf; /* The array of buffer blocks */
+} B;
+
+/*
+ * This structure allows us to seek inside aliases
+ */
+struct Ain {
+ int type;
+#define I_SEEK -1 /* Invalid seek */
+#define A_SEEK 0 /* Alias seek */
+#define F_SEEK 1 /* File seek */
+#define E_SEEK 2 /* Eval seek */
+ union {
+ off_t _f_seek;
+ Char* _c_seek;
+ } fc;
+#define f_seek fc._f_seek
+#define c_seek fc._c_seek
+ Char **a_seek;
+} ;
+extern int aret; /* What was the last character returned */
+#define SEEKEQ(a, b) ((a)->type == (b)->type && \
+ (a)->f_seek == (b)->f_seek && \
+ (a)->a_seek == (b)->a_seek)
+
+#define fseekp B.Bfseekp
+#define fbobp B.Bfbobp
+#define feobp B.Bfeobp
+#define fblocks B.Bfblocks
+#define fbuf B.Bfbuf
+
+/*
+ * The shell finds commands in loops by reseeking the input
+ * For whiles, in particular, it reseeks to the beginning of the
+ * line the while was on; hence the while placement restrictions.
+ */
+struct Ain lineloc;
+
+bool cantell; /* Is current source tellable ? */
+
+/*
+ * Input lines are parsed into doubly linked circular
+ * lists of words of the following form.
+ */
+struct wordent {
+ Char *word;
+ struct wordent *prev;
+ struct wordent *next;
+};
+
+/*
+ * During word building, both in the initial lexical phase and
+ * when expanding $ variable substitutions, expansion by `!' and `$'
+ * must be inhibited when reading ahead in routines which are themselves
+ * processing `!' and `$' expansion or after characters such as `\' or in
+ * quotations. The following flags are passed to the getC routines
+ * telling them which of these substitutions are appropriate for the
+ * next character to be returned.
+ */
+#define DODOL 1
+#define DOEXCL 2
+#define DOALL DODOL|DOEXCL
+
+/*
+ * Labuf implements a general buffer for lookahead during lexical operations.
+ * Text which is to be placed in the input stream can be stuck here.
+ * We stick parsed ahead $ constructs during initial input,
+ * process id's from `$$', and modified variable values (from qualifiers
+ * during expansion in sh.dol.c) here.
+ */
+Char *lap;
+
+/*
+ * Parser structure
+ *
+ * Each command is parsed to a tree of command structures and
+ * flags are set bottom up during this process, to be propagated down
+ * as needed during the semantics/exeuction pass (sh.sem.c).
+ */
+struct command {
+ short t_dtyp; /* Type of node */
+#define NODE_COMMAND 1 /* t_dcom <t_dlef >t_drit */
+#define NODE_PAREN 2 /* ( t_dspr ) <t_dlef >t_drit */
+#define NODE_PIPE 3 /* t_dlef | t_drit */
+#define NODE_LIST 4 /* t_dlef ; t_drit */
+#define NODE_OR 5 /* t_dlef || t_drit */
+#define NODE_AND 6 /* t_dlef && t_drit */
+ short t_dflg; /* Flags, e.g. F_AMPERSAND|... */
+#define F_SAVE (F_NICE|F_TIME|F_NOHUP) /* save these when re-doing */
+
+#define F_AMPERSAND (1<<0) /* executes in background */
+#define F_APPEND (1<<1) /* output is redirected >> */
+#define F_PIPEIN (1<<2) /* input is a pipe */
+#define F_PIPEOUT (1<<3) /* output is a pipe */
+#define F_NOFORK (1<<4) /* don't fork, last ()ized cmd */
+#define F_NOINTERRUPT (1<<5) /* should be immune from intr's */
+/* spare */
+#define F_STDERR (1<<7) /* redirect unit 2 with unit 1 */
+#define F_OVERWRITE (1<<8) /* output was ! */
+#define F_READ (1<<9) /* input redirection is << */
+#define F_REPEAT (1<<10) /* reexec aft if, repeat,... */
+#define F_NICE (1<<11) /* t_nice is meaningful */
+#define F_NOHUP (1<<12) /* nohup this command */
+#define F_TIME (1<<13) /* time this command */
+ union {
+ Char *T_dlef; /* Input redirect word */
+ struct command *T_dcar; /* Left part of list/pipe */
+ } L;
+ union {
+ Char *T_drit; /* Output redirect word */
+ struct command *T_dcdr; /* Right part of list/pipe */
+ } R;
+#define t_dlef L.T_dlef
+#define t_dcar L.T_dcar
+#define t_drit R.T_drit
+#define t_dcdr R.T_dcdr
+ Char **t_dcom; /* Command/argument vector */
+ struct command *t_dspr; /* Pointer to ()'d subtree */
+ int t_nice;
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * These are declared here because they want to be
+ * initialized in sh.init.c (to allow them to be made readonly)
+ */
+
+extern struct biltins {
+ char *bname;
+ void (*bfunct) __P((Char **, struct command *));
+ short minargs, maxargs;
+} bfunc[];
+extern int nbfunc;
+
+extern struct srch {
+ char *s_name;
+ short s_value;
+} srchn[];
+extern int nsrchn;
+
+/*
+ * The keywords for the parser
+ */
+#define T_BREAK 0
+#define T_BRKSW 1
+#define T_CASE 2
+#define T_DEFAULT 3
+#define T_ELSE 4
+#define T_END 5
+#define T_ENDIF 6
+#define T_ENDSW 7
+#define T_EXIT 8
+#define T_FOREACH 9
+#define T_GOTO 10
+#define T_IF 11
+#define T_LABEL 12
+#define T_LET 13
+#define T_SET 14
+#define T_SWITCH 15
+#define T_TEST 16
+#define T_THEN 17
+#define T_WHILE 18
+
+/*
+ * Structure defining the existing while/foreach loops at this
+ * source level. Loops are implemented by seeking back in the
+ * input. For foreach (fe), the word list is attached here.
+ */
+struct whyle {
+ struct Ain w_start; /* Point to restart loop */
+ struct Ain w_end; /* End of loop (0 if unknown) */
+ Char **w_fe, **w_fe0; /* Current/initial wordlist for fe */
+ Char *w_fename; /* Name for fe */
+ struct whyle *w_next; /* Next (more outer) loop */
+} *whyles;
+
+/*
+ * Variable structure
+ *
+ * Aliases and variables are stored in AVL balanced binary trees.
+ */
+struct varent {
+ Char **vec; /* Array of words which is the value */
+ Char *v_name; /* Name of variable/alias */
+ struct varent *v_link[3]; /* The links, see below */
+ int v_bal; /* Balance factor */
+} shvhed, aliases;
+
+#define v_left v_link[0]
+#define v_right v_link[1]
+#define v_parent v_link[2]
+
+struct varent *adrof1();
+
+#define adrof(v) adrof1(v, &shvhed)
+#define value(v) value1(v, &shvhed)
+
+/*
+ * The following are for interfacing redo substitution in
+ * aliases to the lexical routines.
+ */
+struct wordent *alhistp; /* Argument list (first) */
+struct wordent *alhistt; /* Node after last in arg list */
+Char **alvec, *alvecp; /* The (remnants of) alias vector */
+
+/*
+ * Filename/command name expansion variables
+ */
+int gflag; /* After tglob -> is globbing needed? */
+
+#define MAXVARLEN 30 /* Maximum number of char in a variable name */
+
+/*
+ * Variables for filename expansion
+ */
+extern Char **gargv; /* Pointer to the (stack) arglist */
+extern long gargc; /* Number args in gargv */
+
+/*
+ * Variables for command expansion.
+ */
+extern Char **pargv; /* Pointer to the argv list space */
+extern long pargc; /* Count of arguments in pargv */
+Char *pargs; /* Pointer to start current word */
+long pnleft; /* Number of chars left in pargs */
+Char *pargcp; /* Current index into pargs */
+
+/*
+ * History list
+ *
+ * Each history list entry contains an embedded wordlist
+ * from the scanner, a number for the event, and a reference count
+ * to aid in discarding old entries.
+ *
+ * Essentially "invisible" entries are put on the history list
+ * when history substitution includes modifiers, and thrown away
+ * at the next discarding since their event numbers are very negative.
+ */
+struct Hist {
+ struct wordent Hlex;
+ int Hnum;
+ int Href;
+ struct Hist *Hnext;
+} Histlist;
+
+struct wordent paraml; /* Current lexical word list */
+int eventno; /* Next events number */
+int lastev; /* Last event reference (default) */
+
+Char HIST; /* history invocation character */
+Char HISTSUB; /* auto-substitute character */
+
+/*
+ * strings.h:
+ */
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+#define Strchr(a, b) strchr(a, b)
+#define Strrchr(a, b) strrchr(a, b)
+#define Strcat(a, b) strcat(a, b)
+#define Strncat(a, b, c) strncat(a, b, c)
+#define Strcpy(a, b) strcpy(a, b)
+#define Strncpy(a, b, c) strncpy(a, b, c)
+#define Strlen(a) strlen(a)
+#define Strcmp(a, b) strcmp(a, b)
+#define Strncmp(a, b, c) strncmp(a, b, c)
+
+#define Strspl(a, b) strspl(a, b)
+#define Strsave(a) strsave(a)
+#define Strend(a) strend(a)
+#define Strstr(a, b) strstr(a, b)
+
+#define str2short(a) (a)
+#define blk2short(a) saveblk(a)
+#define short2blk(a) saveblk(a)
+#define short2str(a) strip(a)
+#else
+#define Strchr(a, b) s_strchr(a, b)
+#define Strrchr(a, b) s_strrchr(a, b)
+#define Strcat(a, b) s_strcat(a, b)
+#define Strncat(a, b, c) s_strncat(a, b, c)
+#define Strcpy(a, b) s_strcpy(a, b)
+#define Strncpy(a, b, c) s_strncpy(a, b, c)
+#define Strlen(a) s_strlen(a)
+#define Strcmp(a, b) s_strcmp(a, b)
+#define Strncmp(a, b, c) s_strncmp(a, b, c)
+
+#define Strspl(a, b) s_strspl(a, b)
+#define Strsave(a) s_strsave(a)
+#define Strend(a) s_strend(a)
+#define Strstr(a, b) s_strstr(a, b)
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * setname is a macro to save space (see sh.err.c)
+ */
+char *bname;
+
+#define setname(a) (bname = (a))
+
+Char *Vsav;
+Char *Vdp;
+Char *Vexpath;
+char **Vt;
+
+Char **evalvec;
+Char *evalp;
+
+/* word_chars is set by default to WORD_CHARS but can be overridden by
+ the worchars variable--if unset, reverts to WORD_CHARS */
+
+Char *word_chars;
+
+#define WORD_CHARS "*?_-.[]~=" /* default chars besides alnums in words */
+
+Char *STR_SHELLPATH;
+
+#include <paths.h>
+#ifdef _PATH_BSHELL
+Char *STR_BSHELL;
+#endif
+Char *STR_WORD_CHARS;
+Char **STR_environ;
diff --git a/bin/csh/dir.c b/bin/csh/dir.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..04efd3f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/dir.c
@@ -0,0 +1,930 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)dir.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "dir.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/* Directory management. */
+
+static struct directory
+ *dfind __P((Char *));
+static Char *dfollow __P((Char *));
+static void printdirs __P((void));
+static Char *dgoto __P((Char *));
+static void dnewcwd __P((struct directory *));
+static void dset __P((Char *));
+
+struct directory dhead; /* "head" of loop */
+int printd; /* force name to be printed */
+
+static int dirflag = 0;
+
+/*
+ * dinit - initialize current working directory
+ */
+void
+dinit(hp)
+ Char *hp;
+{
+ register char *tcp;
+ register Char *cp;
+ register struct directory *dp;
+ char path[MAXPATHLEN];
+ static char *emsg = "csh: Trying to start from \"%s\"\n";
+
+ /* Don't believe the login shell home, because it may be a symlink */
+ tcp = getwd(path); /* see ngetwd.c for System V version */
+ if (tcp == NULL || *tcp == '\0') {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "csh: %s\n", path);
+ if (hp && *hp) {
+ tcp = short2str(hp);
+ if (chdir(tcp) == -1)
+ cp = NULL;
+ else
+ cp = hp;
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, emsg, vis_str(hp));
+ }
+ else
+ cp = NULL;
+ if (cp == NULL) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, emsg, "/");
+ if (chdir("/") == -1)
+ /* I am not even try to print an error message! */
+ xexit(1);
+ cp = SAVE("/");
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ struct stat swd, shp;
+
+ /*
+ * See if $HOME is the working directory we got and use that
+ */
+ if (hp && *hp &&
+ stat(tcp, &swd) != -1 && stat(short2str(hp), &shp) != -1 &&
+ swd.st_dev == shp.st_dev && swd.st_ino == shp.st_ino)
+ cp = hp;
+ else {
+ char *cwd;
+
+ /*
+ * use PWD if we have it (for subshells)
+ */
+ if ((cwd = getenv("PWD")) != NULL) {
+ if (stat(cwd, &shp) != -1 && swd.st_dev == shp.st_dev &&
+ swd.st_ino == shp.st_ino)
+ tcp = cwd;
+ }
+ cp = dcanon(SAVE(tcp), STRNULL);
+ }
+ }
+
+ dp = (struct directory *) xcalloc(sizeof(struct directory), 1);
+ dp->di_name = Strsave(cp);
+ dp->di_count = 0;
+ dhead.di_next = dhead.di_prev = dp;
+ dp->di_next = dp->di_prev = &dhead;
+ printd = 0;
+ dnewcwd(dp);
+}
+
+static void
+dset(dp)
+Char *dp;
+{
+ /*
+ * Don't call set() directly cause if the directory contains ` or
+ * other junk characters glob will fail.
+ */
+ register Char **vec = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) (2 * sizeof(Char **)));
+
+ vec[0] = Strsave(dp);
+ vec[1] = 0;
+ setq(STRcwd, vec, &shvhed);
+ Setenv(STRPWD, dp);
+}
+
+#define DIR_LONG 1
+#define DIR_VERT 2
+#define DIR_LINE 4
+
+static void
+skipargs(v, str)
+ Char ***v;
+ char *str;
+{
+ Char **n = *v, *s;
+
+ dirflag = 0;
+ for (n++; *n != NULL && (*n)[0] == '-'; n++)
+ for (s = &((*n)[1]); *s; s++)
+ switch (*s) {
+ case 'l':
+ dirflag |= DIR_LONG;
+ break;
+ case 'v':
+ dirflag |= DIR_VERT;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ dirflag |= DIR_LINE;
+ break;
+ default:
+ stderror(ERR_DIRUS, vis_str(**v), str);
+ break;
+ }
+ *v = n;
+}
+
+/*
+ * dodirs - list all directories in directory loop
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dodirs(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ skipargs(&v, "");
+
+ if (*v != NULL)
+ stderror(ERR_DIRUS, "dirs", "");
+ printdirs();
+}
+
+static void
+printdirs()
+{
+ register struct directory *dp;
+ Char *s, *hp = value(STRhome);
+ int idx, len, cur;
+
+ if (*hp == '\0')
+ hp = NULL;
+ dp = dcwd;
+ idx = 0;
+ cur = 0;
+ do {
+ if (dp == &dhead)
+ continue;
+ if (dirflag & DIR_VERT) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d\t", idx++);
+ cur = 0;
+ }
+ if (!(dirflag & DIR_LONG) && hp != NULL && !eq(hp, STRslash) &&
+ (len = Strlen(hp), Strncmp(hp, dp->di_name, len) == 0) &&
+ (dp->di_name[len] == '\0' || dp->di_name[len] == '/'))
+ len = Strlen(s = (dp->di_name + len)) + 2;
+ else
+ len = Strlen(s = dp->di_name) + 1;
+
+ cur += len;
+ if ((dirflag & DIR_LINE) && cur >= 80 - 1 && len < 80) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "\n");
+ cur = len;
+ }
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, s != dp->di_name ? "~%s%c" : "%s%c",
+ vis_str(s), (dirflag & DIR_VERT) ? '\n' : ' ');
+ } while ((dp = dp->di_prev) != dcwd);
+ if (!(dirflag & DIR_VERT))
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "\n");
+}
+
+void
+dtildepr(home, dir)
+ register Char *home, *dir;
+{
+
+ if (!eq(home, STRslash) && prefix(home, dir))
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "~%s", vis_str(dir + Strlen(home)));
+ else
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s", vis_str(dir));
+}
+
+void
+dtilde()
+{
+ struct directory *d = dcwd;
+
+ do {
+ if (d == &dhead)
+ continue;
+ d->di_name = dcanon(d->di_name, STRNULL);
+ } while ((d = d->di_prev) != dcwd);
+
+ dset(dcwd->di_name);
+}
+
+
+/* dnormalize():
+ * If the name starts with . or .. then we might need to normalize
+ * it depending on the symbolic link flags
+ */
+Char *
+dnormalize(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+
+#define UC (unsigned char)
+#define ISDOT(c) (UC(c)[0] == '.' && ((UC(c)[1] == '\0') || (UC(c)[1] == '/')))
+#define ISDOTDOT(c) (UC(c)[0] == '.' && ISDOT(&((c)[1])))
+
+ if ((unsigned char) cp[0] == '/')
+ return (Strsave(cp));
+
+ if (adrof(STRignore_symlinks)) {
+ int dotdot = 0;
+ Char *dp, *cwd;
+
+ cwd = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t) ((Strlen(dcwd->di_name) + 3) *
+ sizeof(Char)));
+ (void) Strcpy(cwd, dcwd->di_name);
+
+ /*
+ * Ignore . and count ..'s
+ */
+ while (*cp) {
+ if (ISDOT(cp)) {
+ if (*++cp)
+ cp++;
+ }
+ else if (ISDOTDOT(cp)) {
+ dotdot++;
+ cp += 2;
+ if (*cp)
+ cp++;
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ while (dotdot > 0)
+ if ((dp = Strrchr(cwd, '/'))) {
+ *dp = '\0';
+ dotdot--;
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+
+ if (*cp) {
+ cwd[dotdot = Strlen(cwd)] = '/';
+ cwd[dotdot + 1] = '\0';
+ dp = Strspl(cwd, cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cwd);
+ return dp;
+ }
+ else {
+ if (!*cwd) {
+ cwd[0] = '/';
+ cwd[1] = '\0';
+ }
+ return cwd;
+ }
+ }
+ return Strsave(cp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dochngd - implement chdir command.
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dochngd(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+ register struct directory *dp;
+
+ skipargs(&v, " [<dir>]");
+ printd = 0;
+ if (*v == NULL) {
+ if ((cp = value(STRhome)) == NULL || *cp == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOHOMEDIR);
+ if (chdir(short2str(cp)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_CANTCHANGE);
+ cp = Strsave(cp);
+ }
+ else if (v[1] != NULL) {
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TOOMANY);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return;
+ }
+ else if ((dp = dfind(*v)) != 0) {
+ char *tmp;
+
+ printd = 1;
+ if (chdir(tmp = short2str(dp->di_name)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ dcwd->di_prev->di_next = dcwd->di_next;
+ dcwd->di_next->di_prev = dcwd->di_prev;
+ dfree(dcwd);
+ dnewcwd(dp);
+ return;
+ }
+ else
+ cp = dfollow(*v);
+ dp = (struct directory *) xcalloc(sizeof(struct directory), 1);
+ dp->di_name = cp;
+ dp->di_count = 0;
+ dp->di_next = dcwd->di_next;
+ dp->di_prev = dcwd->di_prev;
+ dp->di_prev->di_next = dp;
+ dp->di_next->di_prev = dp;
+ dfree(dcwd);
+ dnewcwd(dp);
+}
+
+static Char *
+dgoto(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ Char *dp;
+
+ if (*cp != '/') {
+ register Char *p, *q;
+ int cwdlen;
+
+ for (p = dcwd->di_name; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ if ((cwdlen = p - dcwd->di_name - 1) == 1) /* root */
+ cwdlen = 0;
+ for (p = cp; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ dp = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)((cwdlen + (p - cp) + 1) * sizeof(Char)));
+ for (p = dp, q = dcwd->di_name; (*p++ = *q++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ if (cwdlen)
+ p[-1] = '/';
+ else
+ p--; /* don't add a / after root */
+ for (q = cp; (*p++ = *q++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = dp;
+ dp += cwdlen;
+ }
+ else
+ dp = cp;
+
+ cp = dcanon(cp, dp);
+ return cp;
+}
+
+/*
+ * dfollow - change to arg directory; fall back on cdpath if not valid
+ */
+static Char *
+dfollow(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ register Char *dp;
+ struct varent *c;
+ char ebuf[MAXPATHLEN];
+ int serrno;
+
+ cp = globone(cp, G_ERROR);
+ /*
+ * if we are ignoring symlinks, try to fix relatives now.
+ */
+ dp = dnormalize(cp);
+ if (chdir(short2str(dp)) >= 0) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ return dgoto(dp);
+ }
+ else {
+ xfree((ptr_t) dp);
+ if (chdir(short2str(cp)) >= 0)
+ return dgoto(cp);
+ serrno = errno;
+ }
+
+ if (cp[0] != '/' && !prefix(STRdotsl, cp) && !prefix(STRdotdotsl, cp)
+ && (c = adrof(STRcdpath))) {
+ Char **cdp;
+ register Char *p;
+ Char buf[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ for (cdp = c->vec; *cdp; cdp++) {
+ for (dp = buf, p = *cdp; (*dp++ = *p++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ dp[-1] = '/';
+ for (p = cp; (*dp++ = *p++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ if (chdir(short2str(buf)) >= 0) {
+ printd = 1;
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = Strsave(buf);
+ return dgoto(cp);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ dp = value(cp);
+ if ((dp[0] == '/' || dp[0] == '.') && chdir(short2str(dp)) >= 0) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = Strsave(dp);
+ printd = 1;
+ return dgoto(cp);
+ }
+ (void) strcpy(ebuf, short2str(cp));
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, ebuf, strerror(serrno));
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * dopushd - push new directory onto directory stack.
+ * with no arguments exchange top and second.
+ * with numeric argument (+n) bring it to top.
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dopushd(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct directory *dp;
+
+ skipargs(&v, " [<dir>|+<n>]");
+ printd = 1;
+ if (*v == NULL) {
+ char *tmp;
+
+ if ((dp = dcwd->di_prev) == &dhead)
+ dp = dhead.di_prev;
+ if (dp == dcwd)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NODIR);
+ if (chdir(tmp = short2str(dp->di_name)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ dp->di_prev->di_next = dp->di_next;
+ dp->di_next->di_prev = dp->di_prev;
+ dp->di_next = dcwd->di_next;
+ dp->di_prev = dcwd;
+ dcwd->di_next->di_prev = dp;
+ dcwd->di_next = dp;
+ }
+ else if (v[1] != NULL) {
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TOOMANY);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return;
+ }
+ else if ((dp = dfind(*v)) != NULL) {
+ char *tmp;
+
+ if (chdir(tmp = short2str(dp->di_name)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ else {
+ register Char *ccp;
+
+ ccp = dfollow(*v);
+ dp = (struct directory *) xcalloc(sizeof(struct directory), 1);
+ dp->di_name = ccp;
+ dp->di_count = 0;
+ dp->di_prev = dcwd;
+ dp->di_next = dcwd->di_next;
+ dcwd->di_next = dp;
+ dp->di_next->di_prev = dp;
+ }
+ dnewcwd(dp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dfind - find a directory if specified by numeric (+n) argument
+ */
+static struct directory *
+dfind(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ register struct directory *dp;
+ register int i;
+ register Char *ep;
+
+ if (*cp++ != '+')
+ return (0);
+ for (ep = cp; Isdigit(*ep); ep++)
+ continue;
+ if (*ep)
+ return (0);
+ i = getn(cp);
+ if (i <= 0)
+ return (0);
+ for (dp = dcwd; i != 0; i--) {
+ if ((dp = dp->di_prev) == &dhead)
+ dp = dp->di_prev;
+ if (dp == dcwd)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_DEEP);
+ }
+ return (dp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dopopd - pop a directory out of the directory stack
+ * with a numeric argument just discard it.
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dopopd(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct directory *dp, *p = NULL;
+
+ skipargs(&v, " [+<n>]");
+ printd = 1;
+ if (*v == NULL)
+ dp = dcwd;
+ else if (v[1] != NULL) {
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TOOMANY);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return;
+ }
+ else if ((dp = dfind(*v)) == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_BADDIR);
+ if (dp->di_prev == &dhead && dp->di_next == &dhead)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EMPTY);
+ if (dp == dcwd) {
+ char *tmp;
+
+ if ((p = dp->di_prev) == &dhead)
+ p = dhead.di_prev;
+ if (chdir(tmp = short2str(p->di_name)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ dp->di_prev->di_next = dp->di_next;
+ dp->di_next->di_prev = dp->di_prev;
+ if (dp == dcwd)
+ dnewcwd(p);
+ else {
+ printdirs();
+ }
+ dfree(dp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dfree - free the directory (or keep it if it still has ref count)
+ */
+void
+dfree(dp)
+ register struct directory *dp;
+{
+
+ if (dp->di_count != 0) {
+ dp->di_next = dp->di_prev = 0;
+ }
+ else {
+ xfree((char *) dp->di_name);
+ xfree((ptr_t) dp);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * dcanon - canonicalize the pathname, removing excess ./ and ../ etc.
+ * we are of course assuming that the file system is standardly
+ * constructed (always have ..'s, directories have links)
+ */
+Char *
+dcanon(cp, p)
+ register Char *cp, *p;
+{
+ register Char *sp;
+ register Char *p1, *p2; /* general purpose */
+ bool slash;
+
+ Char link[MAXPATHLEN];
+ char tlink[MAXPATHLEN];
+ int cc;
+ Char *newcp;
+
+ /*
+ * christos: if the path given does not start with a slash prepend cwd. If
+ * cwd does not start with a path or the result would be too long abort().
+ */
+ if (*cp != '/') {
+ Char tmpdir[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ p1 = value(STRcwd);
+ if (p1 == NULL || *p1 != '/')
+ abort();
+ if (Strlen(p1) + Strlen(cp) + 1 >= MAXPATHLEN)
+ abort();
+ (void) Strcpy(tmpdir, p1);
+ (void) Strcat(tmpdir, STRslash);
+ (void) Strcat(tmpdir, cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = p = Strsave(tmpdir);
+ }
+
+ while (*p) { /* for each component */
+ sp = p; /* save slash address */
+ while (*++p == '/') /* flush extra slashes */
+ continue;
+ if (p != ++sp)
+ for (p1 = sp, p2 = p; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ p = sp; /* save start of component */
+ slash = 0;
+ while (*++p) /* find next slash or end of path */
+ if (*p == '/') {
+ slash = 1;
+ *p = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (*sp == '\0') /* if component is null */
+ if (--sp == cp) /* if path is one char (i.e. /) */
+ break;
+ else
+ *sp = '\0';
+ else if (sp[0] == '.' && sp[1] == 0) {
+ if (slash) {
+ for (p1 = sp, p2 = p + 1; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ p = --sp;
+ }
+ else if (--sp != cp)
+ *sp = '\0';
+ }
+ else if (sp[0] == '.' && sp[1] == '.' && sp[2] == 0) {
+ /*
+ * We have something like "yyy/xxx/..", where "yyy" can be null or
+ * a path starting at /, and "xxx" is a single component. Before
+ * compressing "xxx/..", we want to expand "yyy/xxx", if it is a
+ * symbolic link.
+ */
+ *--sp = 0; /* form the pathname for readlink */
+ if (sp != cp && !adrof(STRignore_symlinks) &&
+ (cc = readlink(short2str(cp), tlink,
+ sizeof tlink)) >= 0) {
+ (void) Strcpy(link, str2short(tlink));
+ link[cc] = '\0';
+
+ if (slash)
+ *p = '/';
+ /*
+ * Point p to the '/' in "/..", and restore the '/'.
+ */
+ *(p = sp) = '/';
+ /*
+ * find length of p
+ */
+ for (p1 = p; *p1++;)
+ continue;
+ if (*link != '/') {
+ /*
+ * Relative path, expand it between the "yyy/" and the
+ * "/..". First, back sp up to the character past "yyy/".
+ */
+ while (*--sp != '/')
+ continue;
+ sp++;
+ *sp = 0;
+ /*
+ * New length is "yyy/" + link + "/.." and rest
+ */
+ p1 = newcp = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)
+ (((sp - cp) + cc + (p1 - p)) *
+ sizeof(Char)));
+ /*
+ * Copy new path into newcp
+ */
+ for (p2 = cp; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p1--, p2 = link; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p1--, p2 = p; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * Restart canonicalization at expanded "/xxx".
+ */
+ p = sp - cp - 1 + newcp;
+ }
+ else {
+ /*
+ * New length is link + "/.." and rest
+ */
+ p1 = newcp = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)
+ ((cc + (p1 - p)) * sizeof(Char)));
+ /*
+ * Copy new path into newcp
+ */
+ for (p2 = link; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p1--, p2 = p; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * Restart canonicalization at beginning
+ */
+ p = newcp;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = newcp;
+ continue; /* canonicalize the link */
+ }
+ *sp = '/';
+ if (sp != cp)
+ while (*--sp != '/')
+ continue;
+ if (slash) {
+ for (p1 = sp + 1, p2 = p + 1; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ p = sp;
+ }
+ else if (cp == sp)
+ *++sp = '\0';
+ else
+ *sp = '\0';
+ }
+ else { /* normal dir name (not . or .. or nothing) */
+
+ if (sp != cp && adrof(STRchase_symlinks) &&
+ !adrof(STRignore_symlinks) &&
+ (cc = readlink(short2str(cp), tlink,
+ sizeof tlink)) >= 0) {
+ (void) Strcpy(link, str2short(tlink));
+ link[cc] = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * restore the '/'.
+ */
+ if (slash)
+ *p = '/';
+
+ /*
+ * point sp to p (rather than backing up).
+ */
+ sp = p;
+
+ /*
+ * find length of p
+ */
+ for (p1 = p; *p1++;)
+ continue;
+ if (*link != '/') {
+ /*
+ * Relative path, expand it between the "yyy/" and the
+ * remainder. First, back sp up to the character past
+ * "yyy/".
+ */
+ while (*--sp != '/')
+ continue;
+ sp++;
+ *sp = 0;
+ /*
+ * New length is "yyy/" + link + "/.." and rest
+ */
+ p1 = newcp = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)
+ (((sp - cp) + cc + (p1 - p))
+ * sizeof(Char)));
+ /*
+ * Copy new path into newcp
+ */
+ for (p2 = cp; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p1--, p2 = link; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p1--, p2 = p; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * Restart canonicalization at expanded "/xxx".
+ */
+ p = sp - cp - 1 + newcp;
+ }
+ else {
+ /*
+ * New length is link + the rest
+ */
+ p1 = newcp = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)
+ ((cc + (p1 - p)) * sizeof(Char)));
+ /*
+ * Copy new path into newcp
+ */
+ for (p2 = link; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p1--, p2 = p; (*p1++ = *p2++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * Restart canonicalization at beginning
+ */
+ p = newcp;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = newcp;
+ continue; /* canonicalize the link */
+ }
+ if (slash)
+ *p = '/';
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * fix home...
+ */
+ p1 = value(STRhome);
+ cc = Strlen(p1);
+ /*
+ * See if we're not in a subdir of STRhome
+ */
+ if (p1 && *p1 == '/' &&
+ (Strncmp(p1, cp, cc) != 0 || (cp[cc] != '/' && cp[cc] != '\0'))) {
+ static ino_t home_ino = -1;
+ static dev_t home_dev = -1;
+ static Char *home_ptr = NULL;
+ struct stat statbuf;
+
+ /*
+ * Get dev and ino of STRhome
+ */
+ if (home_ptr != p1 &&
+ stat(short2str(p1), &statbuf) != -1) {
+ home_dev = statbuf.st_dev;
+ home_ino = statbuf.st_ino;
+ home_ptr = p1;
+ }
+ /*
+ * Start comparing dev & ino backwards
+ */
+ p2 = Strcpy(link, cp);
+ for (sp = NULL; *p2 && stat(short2str(p2), &statbuf) != -1;) {
+ if (statbuf.st_dev == home_dev &&
+ statbuf.st_ino == home_ino) {
+ sp = (Char *) - 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ if ((sp = Strrchr(p2, '/')) != NULL)
+ *sp = '\0';
+ }
+ /*
+ * See if we found it
+ */
+ if (*p2 && sp == (Char *) -1) {
+ /*
+ * Use STRhome to make '~' work
+ */
+ newcp = Strspl(p1, cp + Strlen(p2));
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = newcp;
+ }
+ }
+ return cp;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * dnewcwd - make a new directory in the loop the current one
+ */
+static void
+dnewcwd(dp)
+ register struct directory *dp;
+{
+ dcwd = dp;
+ dset(dcwd->di_name);
+ if (printd && !(adrof(STRpushdsilent)))
+ printdirs();
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/dir.h b/bin/csh/dir.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dcd155b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/dir.h
@@ -0,0 +1,45 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)dir.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Structure for entries in directory stack.
+ */
+struct directory {
+ struct directory *di_next; /* next in loop */
+ struct directory *di_prev; /* prev in loop */
+ unsigned short *di_count; /* refcount of processes */
+ Char *di_name; /* actual name */
+};
+struct directory *dcwd; /* the one we are in now */
diff --git a/bin/csh/dol.c b/bin/csh/dol.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fcd4c65
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/dol.c
@@ -0,0 +1,985 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)dol.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * These routines perform variable substitution and quoting via ' and ".
+ * To this point these constructs have been preserved in the divided
+ * input words. Here we expand variables and turn quoting via ' and " into
+ * QUOTE bits on characters (which prevent further interpretation).
+ * If the `:q' modifier was applied during history expansion, then
+ * some QUOTEing may have occurred already, so we dont "trim()" here.
+ */
+
+static int Dpeekc, Dpeekrd; /* Peeks for DgetC and Dreadc */
+static Char *Dcp, **Dvp; /* Input vector for Dreadc */
+
+#define DEOF -1
+
+#define unDgetC(c) Dpeekc = c
+
+#define QUOTES (_QF|_QB|_ESC) /* \ ' " ` */
+
+/*
+ * The following variables give the information about the current
+ * $ expansion, recording the current word position, the remaining
+ * words within this expansion, the count of remaining words, and the
+ * information about any : modifier which is being applied.
+ */
+#define MAXWLEN (BUFSIZ - 4)
+#define MAXMOD MAXWLEN /* This cannot overflow */
+static Char *dolp; /* Remaining chars from this word */
+static Char **dolnxt; /* Further words */
+static int dolcnt; /* Count of further words */
+static Char dolmod[MAXMOD]; /* : modifier character */
+static int dolnmod; /* Number of modifiers */
+static int dolmcnt; /* :gx -> 10000, else 1 */
+static int dolwcnt; /* :wx -> 10000, else 1 */
+
+static void Dfix2 __P((Char **));
+static Char *Dpack __P((Char *, Char *));
+static int Dword __P((void));
+static void dolerror __P((Char *));
+static int DgetC __P((int));
+static void Dgetdol __P((void));
+static void fixDolMod __P((void));
+static void setDolp __P((Char *));
+static void unDredc __P((int));
+static int Dredc __P((void));
+static void Dtestq __P((int));
+
+
+/*
+ * Fix up the $ expansions and quotations in the
+ * argument list to command t.
+ */
+void
+Dfix(t)
+ register struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char **pp;
+ register Char *p;
+
+ if (noexec)
+ return;
+ /* Note that t_dcom isn't trimmed thus !...:q's aren't lost */
+ for (pp = t->t_dcom; (p = *pp++) != NULL;)
+ for (; *p; p++) {
+ if (cmap(*p, _DOL | QUOTES)) { /* $, \, ', ", ` */
+ Dfix2(t->t_dcom); /* found one */
+ blkfree(t->t_dcom);
+ t->t_dcom = gargv;
+ gargv = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * $ substitute one word, for i/o redirection
+ */
+Char *
+Dfix1(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ Char *Dv[2];
+
+ if (noexec)
+ return (0);
+ Dv[0] = cp;
+ Dv[1] = NULL;
+ Dfix2(Dv);
+ if (gargc != 1) {
+ setname(vis_str(cp));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_AMBIG);
+ }
+ cp = Strsave(gargv[0]);
+ blkfree(gargv), gargv = 0;
+ return (cp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Subroutine to do actual fixing after state initialization.
+ */
+static void
+Dfix2(v)
+ Char **v;
+{
+ ginit(); /* Initialize glob's area pointers */
+ Dvp = v;
+ Dcp = STRNULL; /* Setup input vector for Dreadc */
+ unDgetC(0);
+ unDredc(0); /* Clear out any old peeks (at error) */
+ dolp = 0;
+ dolcnt = 0; /* Clear out residual $ expands (...) */
+ while (Dword())
+ continue;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Pack up more characters in this word
+ */
+static Char *
+Dpack(wbuf, wp)
+ Char *wbuf, *wp;
+{
+ register int c;
+ register int i = MAXWLEN - (wp - wbuf);
+
+ for (;;) {
+ c = DgetC(DODOL);
+ if (c == '\\') {
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ if (c == DEOF) {
+ unDredc(c);
+ *wp = 0;
+ Gcat(STRNULL, wbuf);
+ return (NULL);
+ }
+ if (c == '\n')
+ c = ' ';
+ else
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ }
+ if (c == DEOF) {
+ unDredc(c);
+ *wp = 0;
+ Gcat(STRNULL, wbuf);
+ return (NULL);
+ }
+ if (cmap(c, _SP | _NL | _QF | _QB)) { /* sp \t\n'"` */
+ unDgetC(c);
+ if (cmap(c, QUOTES))
+ return (wp);
+ *wp++ = 0;
+ Gcat(STRNULL, wbuf);
+ return (NULL);
+ }
+ if (--i <= 0)
+ stderror(ERR_WTOOLONG);
+ *wp++ = c;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Get a word. This routine is analogous to the routine
+ * word() in sh.lex.c for the main lexical input. One difference
+ * here is that we don't get a newline to terminate our expansion.
+ * Rather, DgetC will return a DEOF when we hit the end-of-input.
+ */
+static int
+Dword()
+{
+ register int c, c1;
+ Char wbuf[BUFSIZ];
+ register Char *wp = wbuf;
+ register int i = MAXWLEN;
+ register bool dolflg;
+ bool sofar = 0, done = 0;
+
+ while (!done) {
+ done = 1;
+ c = DgetC(DODOL);
+ switch (c) {
+
+ case DEOF:
+ if (sofar == 0)
+ return (0);
+ /* finish this word and catch the code above the next time */
+ unDredc(c);
+ /* fall into ... */
+
+ case '\n':
+ *wp = 0;
+ Gcat(STRNULL, wbuf);
+ return (1);
+
+ case ' ':
+ case '\t':
+ done = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case '`':
+ /* We preserve ` quotations which are done yet later */
+ *wp++ = c, --i;
+ case '\'':
+ case '"':
+ /*
+ * Note that DgetC never returns a QUOTES character from an
+ * expansion, so only true input quotes will get us here or out.
+ */
+ c1 = c;
+ dolflg = c1 == '"' ? DODOL : 0;
+ for (;;) {
+ c = DgetC(dolflg);
+ if (c == c1)
+ break;
+ if (c == '\n' || c == DEOF)
+ stderror(ERR_UNMATCHED, c1);
+ if ((c & (QUOTE | TRIM)) == ('\n' | QUOTE))
+ --wp, ++i;
+ if (--i <= 0)
+ stderror(ERR_WTOOLONG);
+ switch (c1) {
+
+ case '"':
+ /*
+ * Leave any `s alone for later. Other chars are all
+ * quoted, thus `...` can tell it was within "...".
+ */
+ *wp++ = c == '`' ? '`' : c | QUOTE;
+ break;
+
+ case '\'':
+ /* Prevent all further interpretation */
+ *wp++ = c | QUOTE;
+ break;
+
+ case '`':
+ /* Leave all text alone for later */
+ *wp++ = c;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (c1 == '`')
+ *wp++ = '`' /* i--; eliminated */;
+ sofar = 1;
+ if ((wp = Dpack(wbuf, wp)) == NULL)
+ return (1);
+ else {
+ i = MAXWLEN - (wp - wbuf);
+ done = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case '\\':
+ c = DgetC(0); /* No $ subst! */
+ if (c == '\n' || c == DEOF) {
+ done = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ if (done) {
+ unDgetC(c);
+ sofar = 1;
+ if ((wp = Dpack(wbuf, wp)) == NULL)
+ return (1);
+ else {
+ i = MAXWLEN - (wp - wbuf);
+ done = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ /* Really NOTREACHED */
+ return (0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Get a character, performing $ substitution unless flag is 0.
+ * Any QUOTES character which is returned from a $ expansion is
+ * QUOTEd so that it will not be recognized above.
+ */
+static int
+DgetC(flag)
+ register int flag;
+{
+ register int c;
+
+top:
+ if ((c = Dpeekc) != '\0') {
+ Dpeekc = 0;
+ return (c);
+ }
+ if (lap) {
+ c = *lap++ & (QUOTE | TRIM);
+ if (c == 0) {
+ lap = 0;
+ goto top;
+ }
+quotspec:
+ if (cmap(c, QUOTES))
+ return (c | QUOTE);
+ return (c);
+ }
+ if (dolp) {
+ if ((c = *dolp++ & (QUOTE | TRIM)) != '\0')
+ goto quotspec;
+ if (dolcnt > 0) {
+ setDolp(*dolnxt++);
+ --dolcnt;
+ return (' ');
+ }
+ dolp = 0;
+ }
+ if (dolcnt > 0) {
+ setDolp(*dolnxt++);
+ --dolcnt;
+ goto top;
+ }
+ c = Dredc();
+ if (c == '$' && flag) {
+ Dgetdol();
+ goto top;
+ }
+ return (c);
+}
+
+static Char *nulvec[] = {0};
+static struct varent nulargv = {nulvec, STRargv, { NULL, NULL, NULL }, 0};
+
+static void
+dolerror(s)
+ Char *s;
+{
+ setname(vis_str(s));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_RANGE);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Handle the multitudinous $ expansion forms.
+ * Ugh.
+ */
+static void
+Dgetdol()
+{
+ register Char *np;
+ register struct varent *vp = NULL;
+ Char name[4 * MAXVARLEN + 1];
+ int c, sc;
+ int subscr = 0, lwb = 1, upb = 0;
+ bool dimen = 0, bitset = 0;
+ char tnp;
+ Char wbuf[BUFSIZ];
+ static Char *dolbang = NULL;
+
+ dolnmod = dolmcnt = dolwcnt = 0;
+ c = sc = DgetC(0);
+ if (c == '{')
+ c = DgetC(0); /* sc is { to take } later */
+ if ((c & TRIM) == '#')
+ dimen++, c = DgetC(0); /* $# takes dimension */
+ else if (c == '?')
+ bitset++, c = DgetC(0); /* $? tests existence */
+ switch (c) {
+
+ case '!':
+ if (dimen || bitset)
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ if (backpid != 0) {
+ if (dolbang)
+ xfree((ptr_t) dolbang);
+ setDolp(dolbang = putn(backpid));
+ }
+ goto eatbrac;
+
+ case '$':
+ if (dimen || bitset)
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ setDolp(doldol);
+ goto eatbrac;
+
+ case '<' | QUOTE:
+ if (bitset)
+ stderror(ERR_NOTALLOWED, "$?<");
+ if (dimen)
+ stderror(ERR_NOTALLOWED, "$?#");
+ for (np = wbuf; read(OLDSTD, &tnp, 1) == 1; np++) {
+ *np = (unsigned char) tnp;
+ if (np >= &wbuf[BUFSIZ - 1])
+ stderror(ERR_LTOOLONG);
+ if (tnp == '\n')
+ break;
+ }
+ *np = 0;
+ /*
+ * KLUDGE: dolmod is set here because it will cause setDolp to call
+ * domod and thus to copy wbuf. Otherwise setDolp would use it
+ * directly. If we saved it ourselves, no one would know when to free
+ * it. The actual function of the 'q' causes filename expansion not to
+ * be done on the interpolated value.
+ */
+ dolmod[dolnmod++] = 'q';
+ dolmcnt = 10000;
+ setDolp(wbuf);
+ goto eatbrac;
+
+ case DEOF:
+ case '\n':
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ break;
+
+ case '*':
+ (void) Strcpy(name, STRargv);
+ vp = adrof(STRargv);
+ subscr = -1; /* Prevent eating [...] */
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ np = name;
+ if (Isdigit(c)) {
+ if (dimen)
+ stderror(ERR_NOTALLOWED, "$#<num>");
+ subscr = 0;
+ do {
+ subscr = subscr * 10 + c - '0';
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ } while (Isdigit(c));
+ unDredc(c);
+ if (subscr < 0) {
+ dolerror(vp->v_name);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (subscr == 0) {
+ if (bitset) {
+ dolp = ffile ? STR1 : STR0;
+ goto eatbrac;
+ }
+ if (ffile == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_DOLZERO);
+ fixDolMod();
+ setDolp(ffile);
+ goto eatbrac;
+ }
+ if (bitset)
+ stderror(ERR_DOLQUEST);
+ vp = adrof(STRargv);
+ if (vp == 0) {
+ vp = &nulargv;
+ goto eatmod;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ if (!alnum(c))
+ stderror(ERR_VARALNUM);
+ for (;;) {
+ *np++ = c;
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ if (!alnum(c))
+ break;
+ if (np >= &name[MAXVARLEN])
+ stderror(ERR_VARTOOLONG);
+ }
+ *np++ = 0;
+ unDredc(c);
+ vp = adrof(name);
+ }
+ if (bitset) {
+ dolp = (vp || getenv(short2str(name))) ? STR1 : STR0;
+ goto eatbrac;
+ }
+ if (vp == 0) {
+ np = str2short(getenv(short2str(name)));
+ if (np) {
+ fixDolMod();
+ setDolp(np);
+ goto eatbrac;
+ }
+ udvar(name);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ upb = blklen(vp->vec);
+ if (dimen == 0 && subscr == 0 && c == '[') {
+ np = name;
+ for (;;) {
+ c = DgetC(DODOL); /* Allow $ expand within [ ] */
+ if (c == ']')
+ break;
+ if (c == '\n' || c == DEOF)
+ stderror(ERR_INCBR);
+ if (np >= &name[sizeof(name) / sizeof(Char) - 2])
+ stderror(ERR_VARTOOLONG);
+ *np++ = c;
+ }
+ *np = 0, np = name;
+ if (dolp || dolcnt) /* $ exp must end before ] */
+ stderror(ERR_EXPORD);
+ if (!*np)
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ if (Isdigit(*np)) {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; Isdigit(*np); i = i * 10 + *np++ - '0')
+ continue;
+ if ((i < 0 || i > upb) && !any("-*", *np)) {
+ dolerror(vp->v_name);
+ return;
+ }
+ lwb = i;
+ if (!*np)
+ upb = lwb, np = STRstar;
+ }
+ if (*np == '*')
+ np++;
+ else if (*np != '-')
+ stderror(ERR_MISSING, '-');
+ else {
+ register int i = upb;
+
+ np++;
+ if (Isdigit(*np)) {
+ i = 0;
+ while (Isdigit(*np))
+ i = i * 10 + *np++ - '0';
+ if (i < 0 || i > upb) {
+ dolerror(vp->v_name);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ if (i < lwb)
+ upb = lwb - 1;
+ else
+ upb = i;
+ }
+ if (lwb == 0) {
+ if (upb != 0) {
+ dolerror(vp->v_name);
+ return;
+ }
+ upb = -1;
+ }
+ if (*np)
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ }
+ else {
+ if (subscr > 0)
+ if (subscr > upb)
+ lwb = 1, upb = 0;
+ else
+ lwb = upb = subscr;
+ unDredc(c);
+ }
+ if (dimen) {
+ Char *cp = putn(upb - lwb + 1);
+
+ addla(cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ }
+ else {
+eatmod:
+ fixDolMod();
+ dolnxt = &vp->vec[lwb - 1];
+ dolcnt = upb - lwb + 1;
+ }
+eatbrac:
+ if (sc == '{') {
+ c = Dredc();
+ if (c != '}')
+ stderror(ERR_MISSING, '}');
+ }
+}
+
+static void
+fixDolMod()
+{
+ register int c;
+
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ if (c == ':') {
+ do {
+ c = DgetC(0), dolmcnt = 1, dolwcnt = 1;
+ if (c == 'g' || c == 'a') {
+ if (c == 'g')
+ dolmcnt = 10000;
+ else
+ dolwcnt = 10000;
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ }
+ if ((c == 'g' && dolmcnt != 10000) ||
+ (c == 'a' && dolwcnt != 10000)) {
+ if (c == 'g')
+ dolmcnt = 10000;
+ else
+ dolwcnt = 10000;
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ }
+
+ if (c == 's') { /* [eichin:19910926.0755EST] */
+ int delimcnt = 2;
+ int delim = DgetC(0);
+ dolmod[dolnmod++] = c;
+ dolmod[dolnmod++] = delim;
+
+ if (!delim || letter(delim)
+ || Isdigit(delim) || any(" \t\n", delim)) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ break;
+ }
+ while ((c = DgetC(0)) != (-1)) {
+ dolmod[dolnmod++] = c;
+ if(c == delim) delimcnt--;
+ if(!delimcnt) break;
+ }
+ if(delimcnt) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ break;
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (!any("htrqxes", c))
+ stderror(ERR_BADMOD, c);
+ dolmod[dolnmod++] = c;
+ if (c == 'q')
+ dolmcnt = 10000;
+ }
+ while ((c = DgetC(0)) == ':');
+ unDredc(c);
+ }
+ else
+ unDredc(c);
+}
+
+static void
+setDolp(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ register Char *dp;
+ int i;
+
+ if (dolnmod == 0 || dolmcnt == 0) {
+ dolp = cp;
+ return;
+ }
+ dp = cp = Strsave(cp);
+ for (i = 0; i < dolnmod; i++) {
+ /* handle s// [eichin:19910926.0510EST] */
+ if(dolmod[i] == 's') {
+ int delim;
+ Char *lhsub, *rhsub, *np;
+ size_t lhlen = 0, rhlen = 0;
+ int didmod = 0;
+
+ delim = dolmod[++i];
+ if (!delim || letter(delim)
+ || Isdigit(delim) || any(" \t\n", delim)) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ break;
+ }
+ lhsub = &dolmod[++i];
+ while(dolmod[i] != delim && dolmod[++i]) {
+ lhlen++;
+ }
+ dolmod[i] = 0;
+ rhsub = &dolmod[++i];
+ while(dolmod[i] != delim && dolmod[++i]) {
+ rhlen++;
+ }
+ dolmod[i] = 0;
+
+ do {
+ dp = Strstr(cp, lhsub);
+ if (dp) {
+ np = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)
+ ((Strlen(cp) + 1 - lhlen + rhlen) *
+ sizeof(Char)));
+ (void) Strncpy(np, cp, dp - cp);
+ (void) Strcpy(np + (dp - cp), rhsub);
+ (void) Strcpy(np + (dp - cp) + rhlen, dp + lhlen);
+
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ dp = cp = np;
+ didmod = 1;
+ } else {
+ /* should this do a seterror? */
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ while (dolwcnt == 10000);
+ /*
+ * restore dolmod for additional words
+ */
+ dolmod[i] = rhsub[-1] = delim;
+ if (didmod)
+ dolmcnt--;
+ else
+ break;
+ } else {
+ int didmod = 0;
+
+ do {
+ if ((dp = domod(cp, dolmod[i]))) {
+ didmod = 1;
+ if (Strcmp(cp, dp) == 0) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = dp;
+ break;
+ }
+ else {
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ cp = dp;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ while (dolwcnt == 10000);
+ dp = cp;
+ if (didmod)
+ dolmcnt--;
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (dp) {
+ addla(dp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) dp);
+ }
+ else
+ addla(cp);
+
+ dolp = STRNULL;
+ if (seterr)
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+}
+
+static void
+unDredc(c)
+ int c;
+{
+
+ Dpeekrd = c;
+}
+
+static int
+Dredc()
+{
+ register int c;
+
+ if ((c = Dpeekrd) != '\0') {
+ Dpeekrd = 0;
+ return (c);
+ }
+ if (Dcp && (c = *Dcp++))
+ return (c & (QUOTE | TRIM));
+ if (*Dvp == 0) {
+ Dcp = 0;
+ return (DEOF);
+ }
+ Dcp = *Dvp++;
+ return (' ');
+}
+
+static void
+Dtestq(c)
+ register int c;
+{
+
+ if (cmap(c, QUOTES))
+ gflag = 1;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Form a shell temporary file (in unit 0) from the words
+ * of the shell input up to EOF or a line the same as "term".
+ * Unit 0 should have been closed before this call.
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+heredoc(term)
+ Char *term;
+{
+ register int c;
+ Char *Dv[2];
+ Char obuf[BUFSIZ], lbuf[BUFSIZ], mbuf[BUFSIZ];
+ int ocnt, lcnt, mcnt;
+ register Char *lbp, *obp, *mbp;
+ Char **vp;
+ bool quoted;
+ char *tmp;
+
+ if (creat(tmp = short2str(shtemp), 0600) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ (void) close(0);
+ if (open(tmp, O_RDWR) < 0) {
+ int oerrno = errno;
+
+ (void) unlink(tmp);
+ errno = oerrno;
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ (void) unlink(tmp); /* 0 0 inode! */
+ Dv[0] = term;
+ Dv[1] = NULL;
+ gflag = 0;
+ trim(Dv);
+ rscan(Dv, Dtestq);
+ quoted = gflag;
+ ocnt = BUFSIZ;
+ obp = obuf;
+ for (;;) {
+ /*
+ * Read up a line
+ */
+ lbp = lbuf;
+ lcnt = BUFSIZ - 4;
+ for (;;) {
+ c = readc(1); /* 1 -> Want EOF returns */
+ if (c < 0 || c == '\n')
+ break;
+ if ((c &= TRIM) != '\0') {
+ *lbp++ = c;
+ if (--lcnt < 0) {
+ setname("<<");
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_OVERFLOW);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ *lbp = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * Check for EOF or compare to terminator -- before expansion
+ */
+ if (c < 0 || eq(lbuf, term)) {
+ (void) write(0, short2str(obuf), (size_t) (BUFSIZ - ocnt));
+ (void) lseek(0, 0l, L_SET);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If term was quoted or -n just pass it on
+ */
+ if (quoted || noexec) {
+ *lbp++ = '\n';
+ *lbp = 0;
+ for (lbp = lbuf; (c = *lbp++) != '\0';) {
+ *obp++ = c;
+ if (--ocnt == 0) {
+ (void) write(0, short2str(obuf), BUFSIZ);
+ obp = obuf;
+ ocnt = BUFSIZ;
+ }
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Term wasn't quoted so variable and then command expand the input
+ * line
+ */
+ Dcp = lbuf;
+ Dvp = Dv + 1;
+ mbp = mbuf;
+ mcnt = BUFSIZ - 4;
+ for (;;) {
+ c = DgetC(DODOL);
+ if (c == DEOF)
+ break;
+ if ((c &= TRIM) == 0)
+ continue;
+ /* \ quotes \ $ ` here */
+ if (c == '\\') {
+ c = DgetC(0);
+ if (!any("$\\`", c))
+ unDgetC(c | QUOTE), c = '\\';
+ else
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ }
+ *mbp++ = c;
+ if (--mcnt == 0) {
+ setname("<<");
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_OVERFLOW);
+ }
+ }
+ *mbp++ = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * If any ` in line do command substitution
+ */
+ mbp = mbuf;
+ if (any(short2str(mbp), '`')) {
+ /*
+ * 1 arg to dobackp causes substitution to be literal. Words are
+ * broken only at newlines so that all blanks and tabs are
+ * preserved. Blank lines (null words) are not discarded.
+ */
+ vp = dobackp(mbuf, 1);
+ }
+ else
+ /* Setup trivial vector similar to return of dobackp */
+ Dv[0] = mbp, Dv[1] = NULL, vp = Dv;
+
+ /*
+ * Resurrect the words from the command substitution each separated by
+ * a newline. Note that the last newline of a command substitution
+ * will have been discarded, but we put a newline after the last word
+ * because this represents the newline after the last input line!
+ */
+ for (; *vp; vp++) {
+ for (mbp = *vp; *mbp; mbp++) {
+ *obp++ = *mbp & TRIM;
+ if (--ocnt == 0) {
+ (void) write(0, short2str(obuf), BUFSIZ);
+ obp = obuf;
+ ocnt = BUFSIZ;
+ }
+ }
+ *obp++ = '\n';
+ if (--ocnt == 0) {
+ (void) write(0, short2str(obuf), BUFSIZ);
+ obp = obuf;
+ ocnt = BUFSIZ;
+ }
+ }
+ if (pargv)
+ blkfree(pargv), pargv = 0;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/err.c b/bin/csh/err.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..745adc8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/err.c
@@ -0,0 +1,407 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)err.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+char *seterr = NULL; /* Holds last error if there was one */
+
+#define ERR_FLAGS 0xf0000000
+#define ERR_NAME 0x10000000
+#define ERR_SILENT 0x20000000
+#define ERR_OLD 0x40000000
+
+static char *errorlist[] =
+{
+#define ERR_SYNTAX 0
+ "Syntax Error",
+#define ERR_NOTALLOWED 1
+ "%s is not allowed",
+#define ERR_WTOOLONG 2
+ "Word too long",
+#define ERR_LTOOLONG 3
+ "$< line too long",
+#define ERR_DOLZERO 4
+ "No file for $0",
+#define ERR_DOLQUEST 5
+ "$? not allowed here",
+#define ERR_INCBR 6
+ "Incomplete [] modifier",
+#define ERR_EXPORD 7
+ "$ expansion must end before ]",
+#define ERR_BADMOD 8
+ "Bad : modifier in $ (%c)",
+#define ERR_SUBSCRIPT 9
+ "Subscript error",
+#define ERR_BADNUM 10
+ "Badly formed number",
+#define ERR_NOMORE 11
+ "No more words",
+#define ERR_FILENAME 12
+ "Missing file name",
+#define ERR_GLOB 13
+ "Internal glob error",
+#define ERR_COMMAND 14
+ "Command not found",
+#define ERR_TOOFEW 15
+ "Too few arguments",
+#define ERR_TOOMANY 16
+ "Too many arguments",
+#define ERR_DANGER 17
+ "Too dangerous to alias that",
+#define ERR_EMPTYIF 18
+ "Empty if",
+#define ERR_IMPRTHEN 19
+ "Improper then",
+#define ERR_NOPAREN 20
+ "Words not parenthesized",
+#define ERR_NOTFOUND 21
+ "%s not found",
+#define ERR_MASK 22
+ "Improper mask",
+#define ERR_LIMIT 23
+ "No such limit",
+#define ERR_TOOLARGE 24
+ "Argument too large",
+#define ERR_SCALEF 25
+ "Improper or unknown scale factor",
+#define ERR_UNDVAR 26
+ "Undefined variable",
+#define ERR_DEEP 27
+ "Directory stack not that deep",
+#define ERR_BADSIG 28
+ "Bad signal number",
+#define ERR_UNKSIG 29
+ "Unknown signal; kill -l lists signals",
+#define ERR_VARBEGIN 30
+ "Variable name must begin with a letter",
+#define ERR_VARTOOLONG 31
+ "Variable name too long",
+#define ERR_VARALNUM 32
+ "Variable name must contain alphanumeric characters",
+#define ERR_JOBCONTROL 33
+ "No job control in this shell",
+#define ERR_EXPRESSION 34
+ "Expression Syntax",
+#define ERR_NOHOMEDIR 35
+ "No home directory",
+#define ERR_CANTCHANGE 36
+ "Can't change to home directory",
+#define ERR_NULLCOM 37
+ "Invalid null command",
+#define ERR_ASSIGN 38
+ "Assignment missing expression",
+#define ERR_UNKNOWNOP 39
+ "Unknown operator",
+#define ERR_AMBIG 40
+ "Ambiguous",
+#define ERR_EXISTS 41
+ "%s: File exists",
+#define ERR_INTR 42
+ "Interrupted",
+#define ERR_RANGE 43
+ "Subscript out of range",
+#define ERR_OVERFLOW 44
+ "Line overflow",
+#define ERR_VARMOD 45
+ "Unknown variable modifier",
+#define ERR_NOSUCHJOB 46
+ "No such job",
+#define ERR_TERMINAL 47
+ "Can't from terminal",
+#define ERR_NOTWHILE 48
+ "Not in while/foreach",
+#define ERR_NOPROC 49
+ "No more processes",
+#define ERR_NOMATCH 50
+ "No match",
+#define ERR_MISSING 51
+ "Missing %c",
+#define ERR_UNMATCHED 52
+ "Unmatched %c",
+#define ERR_NOMEM 53
+ "Out of memory",
+#define ERR_PIPE 54
+ "Can't make pipe",
+#define ERR_SYSTEM 55
+ "%s: %s",
+#define ERR_STRING 56
+ "%s",
+#define ERR_JOBS 57
+ "Usage: jobs [ -l ]",
+#define ERR_JOBARGS 58
+ "Arguments should be jobs or process id's",
+#define ERR_JOBCUR 59
+ "No current job",
+#define ERR_JOBPREV 60
+ "No previous job",
+#define ERR_JOBPAT 61
+ "No job matches pattern",
+#define ERR_NESTING 62
+ "Fork nesting > %d; maybe `...` loop",
+#define ERR_JOBCTRLSUB 63
+ "No job control in subshells",
+#define ERR_BADPLPS 64
+ "Badly placed ()'s",
+#define ERR_STOPPED 65
+ "%sThere are suspended jobs",
+#define ERR_NODIR 66
+ "No other directory",
+#define ERR_EMPTY 67
+ "Directory stack empty",
+#define ERR_BADDIR 68
+ "Bad directory",
+#define ERR_DIRUS 69
+ "Usage: %s [-lvn]%s",
+#define ERR_HFLAG 70
+ "No operand for -h flag",
+#define ERR_NOTLOGIN 71
+ "Not a login shell",
+#define ERR_DIV0 72
+ "Division by 0",
+#define ERR_MOD0 73
+ "Mod by 0",
+#define ERR_BADSCALE 74
+ "Bad scaling; did you mean \"%s\"?",
+#define ERR_SUSPLOG 75
+ "Can't suspend a login shell (yet)",
+#define ERR_UNKUSER 76
+ "Unknown user: %s",
+#define ERR_NOHOME 77
+ "No $home variable set",
+#define ERR_HISTUS 78
+ "Usage: history [-rh] [# number of events]",
+#define ERR_SPDOLLT 79
+ "$, ! or < not allowed with $# or $?",
+#define ERR_NEWLINE 80
+ "Newline in variable name",
+#define ERR_SPSTAR 81
+ "* not allowed with $# or $?",
+#define ERR_DIGIT 82
+ "$?<digit> or $#<digit> not allowed",
+#define ERR_VARILL 83
+ "Illegal variable name",
+#define ERR_NLINDEX 84
+ "Newline in variable index",
+#define ERR_EXPOVFL 85
+ "Expansion buffer overflow",
+#define ERR_VARSYN 86
+ "Variable syntax",
+#define ERR_BADBANG 87
+ "Bad ! form",
+#define ERR_NOSUBST 88
+ "No previous substitute",
+#define ERR_BADSUBST 89
+ "Bad substitute",
+#define ERR_LHS 90
+ "No previous left hand side",
+#define ERR_RHSLONG 91
+ "Right hand side too long",
+#define ERR_BADBANGMOD 92
+ "Bad ! modifier: %c",
+#define ERR_MODFAIL 93
+ "Modifier failed",
+#define ERR_SUBOVFL 94
+ "Substitution buffer overflow",
+#define ERR_BADBANGARG 95
+ "Bad ! arg selector",
+#define ERR_NOSEARCH 96
+ "No prev search",
+#define ERR_NOEVENT 97
+ "%s: Event not found",
+#define ERR_TOOMANYRP 98
+ "Too many )'s",
+#define ERR_TOOMANYLP 99
+ "Too many ('s",
+#define ERR_BADPLP 100
+ "Badly placed (",
+#define ERR_MISRED 101
+ "Missing name for redirect",
+#define ERR_OUTRED 102
+ "Ambiguous output redirect",
+#define ERR_REDPAR 103
+ "Can't << within ()'s",
+#define ERR_INRED 104
+ "Ambiguous input redirect",
+#define ERR_ALIASLOOP 105
+ "Alias loop",
+#define ERR_HISTLOOP 106
+ "!# History loop",
+#define ERR_ARCH 107
+ "%s: %s. Wrong Architecture",
+#define ERR_FILEINQ 108
+ "Malformed file inquiry",
+#define ERR_SELOVFL 109
+ "Selector overflow",
+#define ERR_INVALID 110
+ "Invalid Error"
+};
+
+/*
+ * The parser and scanner set up errors for later by calling seterr,
+ * which sets the variable err as a side effect; later to be tested,
+ * e.g. in process.
+ */
+void
+#if __STDC__
+seterror(int id, ...)
+#else
+seterror(id, va_alist)
+ int id;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ if (seterr == 0) {
+ char berr[BUFSIZ];
+ va_list va;
+
+#if __STDC__
+ va_start(va, id);
+#else
+ va_start(va);
+#endif
+ if (id < 0 || id > sizeof(errorlist) / sizeof(errorlist[0]))
+ id = ERR_INVALID;
+ vsprintf(berr, errorlist[id], va);
+ va_end(va);
+
+ seterr = strsave(berr);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Print the error with the given id.
+ *
+ * Special ids:
+ * ERR_SILENT: Print nothing.
+ * ERR_OLD: Print the previously set error if one was there.
+ * otherwise return.
+ * ERR_NAME: If this bit is set, print the name of the function
+ * in bname
+ *
+ * This routine always resets or exits. The flag haderr
+ * is set so the routine who catches the unwind can propogate
+ * it if they want.
+ *
+ * Note that any open files at the point of error will eventually
+ * be closed in the routine process in sh.c which is the only
+ * place error unwinds are ever caught.
+ */
+void
+#if __STDC__
+stderror(int id, ...)
+#else
+stderror(id, va_alist)
+ int id;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list va;
+ register Char **v;
+ int flags = id & ERR_FLAGS;
+
+ id &= ~ERR_FLAGS;
+
+ if ((flags & ERR_OLD) && seterr == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ if (id < 0 || id > sizeof(errorlist) / sizeof(errorlist[0]))
+ id = ERR_INVALID;
+
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+ (void) fflush(csherr);
+ haderr = 1; /* Now to diagnostic output */
+ timflg = 0; /* This isn't otherwise reset */
+
+
+ if (!(flags & ERR_SILENT)) {
+ if (flags & ERR_NAME)
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s: ", bname);
+ if ((flags & ERR_OLD))
+ /* Old error. */
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s.\n", seterr);
+ else {
+#if __STDC__
+ va_start(va, id);
+#else
+ va_start(va);
+#endif
+ (void) vfprintf(csherr, errorlist[id], va);
+ va_end(va);
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, ".\n");
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (seterr) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) seterr);
+ seterr = NULL;
+ }
+
+ if ((v = pargv) != NULL)
+ pargv = 0, blkfree(v);
+ if ((v = gargv) != NULL)
+ gargv = 0, blkfree(v);
+
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+ (void) fflush(csherr);
+ didfds = 0; /* Forget about 0,1,2 */
+ /*
+ * Go away if -e or we are a child shell
+ */
+ if (exiterr || child)
+ xexit(1);
+
+ /*
+ * Reset the state of the input. This buffered seek to end of file will
+ * also clear the while/foreach stack.
+ */
+ btoeof();
+
+ set(STRstatus, Strsave(STR1));
+ if (tpgrp > 0)
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, tpgrp);
+ reset(); /* Unwind */
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/exec.c b/bin/csh/exec.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c9799cb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/exec.c
@@ -0,0 +1,736 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)exec.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * System level search and execute of a command. We look in each directory
+ * for the specified command name. If the name contains a '/' then we
+ * execute only the full path name. If there is no search path then we
+ * execute only full path names.
+ */
+extern char **environ;
+
+/*
+ * As we search for the command we note the first non-trivial error
+ * message for presentation to the user. This allows us often
+ * to show that a file has the wrong mode/no access when the file
+ * is not in the last component of the search path, so we must
+ * go on after first detecting the error.
+ */
+static char *exerr; /* Execution error message */
+static Char *expath; /* Path for exerr */
+
+/*
+ * Xhash is an array of HSHSIZ bits (HSHSIZ / 8 chars), which are used
+ * to hash execs. If it is allocated (havhash true), then to tell
+ * whether ``name'' is (possibly) present in the i'th component
+ * of the variable path, you look at the bit in xhash indexed by
+ * hash(hashname("name"), i). This is setup automatically
+ * after .login is executed, and recomputed whenever ``path'' is
+ * changed.
+ * The two part hash function is designed to let texec() call the
+ * more expensive hashname() only once and the simple hash() several
+ * times (once for each path component checked).
+ * Byte size is assumed to be 8.
+ */
+#define HSHSIZ 8192 /* 1k bytes */
+#define HSHMASK (HSHSIZ - 1)
+#define HSHMUL 243
+static char xhash[HSHSIZ / 8];
+
+#define hash(a, b) (((a) * HSHMUL + (b)) & HSHMASK)
+#define bit(h, b) ((h)[(b) >> 3] & 1 << ((b) & 7)) /* bit test */
+#define bis(h, b) ((h)[(b) >> 3] |= 1 << ((b) & 7)) /* bit set */
+static int hits, misses;
+
+/* Dummy search path for just absolute search when no path */
+static Char *justabs[] = {STRNULL, 0};
+
+static void pexerr __P((void));
+static void texec __P((Char *, Char **));
+static int hashname __P((Char *));
+static void tellmewhat __P((struct wordent *));
+static int executable __P((Char *, Char *, bool));
+static int iscommand __P((Char *));
+
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doexec(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *dp, **pv, **av, *sav;
+ register struct varent *pathv;
+ register bool slash;
+ register int hashval = 0, hashval1, i;
+ Char *blk[2];
+
+ /*
+ * Glob the command name. We will search $path even if this does something,
+ * as in sh but not in csh. One special case: if there is no PATH, then we
+ * execute only commands which start with '/'.
+ */
+ blk[0] = t->t_dcom[0];
+ blk[1] = 0;
+ gflag = 0, tglob(blk);
+ if (gflag) {
+ pv = globall(blk);
+ if (pv == 0) {
+ setname(vis_str(blk[0]));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ }
+ gargv = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ pv = saveblk(blk);
+
+ trim(pv);
+
+ exerr = 0;
+ expath = Strsave(pv[0]);
+ Vexpath = expath;
+
+ pathv = adrof(STRpath);
+ if (pathv == 0 && expath[0] != '/') {
+ blkfree(pv);
+ pexerr();
+ }
+ slash = any(short2str(expath), '/');
+
+ /*
+ * Glob the argument list, if necessary. Otherwise trim off the quote bits.
+ */
+ gflag = 0;
+ av = &t->t_dcom[1];
+ tglob(av);
+ if (gflag) {
+ av = globall(av);
+ if (av == 0) {
+ blkfree(pv);
+ setname(vis_str(expath));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ }
+ gargv = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ av = saveblk(av);
+
+ blkfree(t->t_dcom);
+ t->t_dcom = blkspl(pv, av);
+ xfree((ptr_t) pv);
+ xfree((ptr_t) av);
+ av = t->t_dcom;
+ trim(av);
+
+ if (*av == NULL || **av == '\0')
+ pexerr();
+
+ xechoit(av); /* Echo command if -x */
+ /*
+ * Since all internal file descriptors are set to close on exec, we don't
+ * need to close them explicitly here. Just reorient ourselves for error
+ * messages.
+ */
+ SHIN = 0;
+ SHOUT = 1;
+ SHERR = 2;
+ OLDSTD = 0;
+ /*
+ * We must do this AFTER any possible forking (like `foo` in glob) so that
+ * this shell can still do subprocesses.
+ */
+ (void) sigsetmask((sigset_t) 0);
+ /*
+ * If no path, no words in path, or a / in the filename then restrict the
+ * command search.
+ */
+ if (pathv == 0 || pathv->vec[0] == 0 || slash)
+ pv = justabs;
+ else
+ pv = pathv->vec;
+ sav = Strspl(STRslash, *av);/* / command name for postpending */
+ Vsav = sav;
+ if (havhash)
+ hashval = hashname(*av);
+ i = 0;
+ hits++;
+ do {
+ /*
+ * Try to save time by looking at the hash table for where this command
+ * could be. If we are doing delayed hashing, then we put the names in
+ * one at a time, as the user enters them. This is kinda like Korn
+ * Shell's "tracked aliases".
+ */
+ if (!slash && pv[0][0] == '/' && havhash) {
+ hashval1 = hash(hashval, i);
+ if (!bit(xhash, hashval1))
+ goto cont;
+ }
+ if (pv[0][0] == 0 || eq(pv[0], STRdot)) /* don't make ./xxx */
+ texec(*av, av);
+ else {
+ dp = Strspl(*pv, sav);
+ Vdp = dp;
+ texec(dp, av);
+ Vdp = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) dp);
+ }
+ misses++;
+cont:
+ pv++;
+ i++;
+ } while (*pv);
+ hits--;
+ Vsav = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) sav);
+ pexerr();
+}
+
+static void
+pexerr()
+{
+ /* Couldn't find the damn thing */
+ if (expath) {
+ setname(vis_str(expath));
+ Vexpath = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) expath);
+ expath = 0;
+ }
+ else
+ setname("");
+ if (exerr)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_STRING, exerr);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_COMMAND);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Execute command f, arg list t.
+ * Record error message if not found.
+ * Also do shell scripts here.
+ */
+static void
+texec(sf, st)
+ Char *sf;
+ register Char **st;
+{
+ register char **t;
+ register char *f;
+ register struct varent *v;
+ register Char **vp;
+ Char *lastsh[2];
+ int fd;
+ unsigned char c;
+ Char *st0, **ost;
+
+ /* The order for the conversions is significant */
+ t = short2blk(st);
+ f = short2str(sf);
+ Vt = t;
+ errno = 0; /* don't use a previous error */
+ (void) execve(f, t, environ);
+ Vt = 0;
+ blkfree((Char **) t);
+ switch (errno) {
+
+ case ENOEXEC:
+ /*
+ * From: casper@fwi.uva.nl (Casper H.S. Dik) If we could not execute
+ * it, don't feed it to the shell if it looks like a binary!
+ */
+ if ((fd = open(f, O_RDONLY)) != -1) {
+ if (read(fd, (char *) &c, 1) == 1) {
+ if (!Isprint(c) && (c != '\n' && c != '\t')) {
+ (void) close(fd);
+ /*
+ * We *know* what ENOEXEC means.
+ */
+ stderror(ERR_ARCH, f, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ }
+#ifdef _PATH_BSHELL
+ else
+ c = '#';
+#endif
+ (void) close(fd);
+ }
+ /*
+ * If there is an alias for shell, then put the words of the alias in
+ * front of the argument list replacing the command name. Note no
+ * interpretation of the words at this point.
+ */
+ v = adrof1(STRshell, &aliases);
+ if (v == 0) {
+ vp = lastsh;
+ vp[0] = adrof(STRshell) ? value(STRshell) : STR_SHELLPATH;
+ vp[1] = NULL;
+#ifdef _PATH_BSHELL
+ if (fd != -1 && c != '#')
+ vp[0] = STR_BSHELL;
+#endif
+ }
+ else
+ vp = v->vec;
+ st0 = st[0];
+ st[0] = sf;
+ ost = st;
+ st = blkspl(vp, st); /* Splice up the new arglst */
+ ost[0] = st0;
+ sf = *st;
+ /* The order for the conversions is significant */
+ t = short2blk(st);
+ f = short2str(sf);
+ xfree((ptr_t) st);
+ Vt = t;
+ (void) execve(f, t, environ);
+ Vt = 0;
+ blkfree((Char **) t);
+ /* The sky is falling, the sky is falling! */
+
+ case ENOMEM:
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, f, strerror(errno));
+
+ case ENOENT:
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if (exerr == 0) {
+ exerr = strerror(errno);
+ if (expath)
+ xfree((ptr_t) expath);
+ expath = Strsave(sf);
+ Vexpath = expath;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+void
+execash(t, kp)
+ Char **t;
+ register struct command *kp;
+{
+ int saveIN, saveOUT, saveDIAG, saveSTD;
+ int oSHIN;
+ int oSHOUT;
+ int oSHERR;
+ int oOLDSTD;
+ jmp_buf osetexit;
+ int my_reenter;
+ int odidfds;
+ sig_t osigint, osigquit, osigterm;
+
+ if (chkstop == 0 && setintr)
+ panystop(0);
+ /*
+ * Hmm, we don't really want to do that now because we might
+ * fail, but what is the choice
+ */
+ rechist();
+
+ osigint = signal(SIGINT, parintr);
+ osigquit = signal(SIGQUIT, parintr);
+ osigterm = signal(SIGTERM, parterm);
+
+ odidfds = didfds;
+ oSHIN = SHIN;
+ oSHOUT = SHOUT;
+ oSHERR = SHERR;
+ oOLDSTD = OLDSTD;
+
+ saveIN = dcopy(SHIN, -1);
+ saveOUT = dcopy(SHOUT, -1);
+ saveDIAG = dcopy(SHERR, -1);
+ saveSTD = dcopy(OLDSTD, -1);
+
+ lshift(kp->t_dcom, 1);
+
+ getexit(osetexit);
+
+ if ((my_reenter = setexit()) == 0) {
+ SHIN = dcopy(0, -1);
+ SHOUT = dcopy(1, -1);
+ SHERR = dcopy(2, -1);
+ didfds = 0;
+ doexec(t, kp);
+ }
+
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, osigint);
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, osigquit);
+ (void) signal(SIGTERM, osigterm);
+
+ doneinp = 0;
+ didfds = odidfds;
+ (void) close(SHIN);
+ (void) close(SHOUT);
+ (void) close(SHERR);
+ (void) close(OLDSTD);
+ SHIN = dmove(saveIN, oSHIN);
+ SHOUT = dmove(saveOUT, oSHOUT);
+ SHERR = dmove(saveDIAG, oSHERR);
+ OLDSTD = dmove(saveSTD, oOLDSTD);
+
+ resexit(osetexit);
+ if (my_reenter)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+}
+
+void
+xechoit(t)
+ Char **t;
+{
+ if (adrof(STRecho)) {
+ (void) fflush(csherr);
+ blkpr(csherr, t);
+ (void) fputc('\n', csherr);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dohash(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ DIR *dirp;
+ register struct dirent *dp;
+ register int cnt;
+ int i = 0;
+ struct varent *pathv = adrof(STRpath);
+ Char **pv;
+ int hashval;
+
+ havhash = 1;
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < sizeof xhash; cnt++)
+ xhash[cnt] = 0;
+ if (pathv == 0)
+ return;
+ for (pv = pathv->vec; *pv; pv++, i++) {
+ if (pv[0][0] != '/')
+ continue;
+ dirp = opendir(short2str(*pv));
+ if (dirp == NULL)
+ continue;
+ while ((dp = readdir(dirp)) != NULL) {
+ if (dp->d_ino == 0)
+ continue;
+ if (dp->d_name[0] == '.' &&
+ (dp->d_name[1] == '\0' ||
+ (dp->d_name[1] == '.' && dp->d_name[2] == '\0')))
+ continue;
+ hashval = hash(hashname(str2short(dp->d_name)), i);
+ bis(xhash, hashval);
+ /* tw_add_comm_name (dp->d_name); */
+ }
+ (void) closedir(dirp);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dounhash(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ havhash = 0;
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+hashstat(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ if (hits + misses)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d hits, %d misses, %d%%\n",
+ hits, misses, 100 * hits / (hits + misses));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Hash a command name.
+ */
+static int
+hashname(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ register long h = 0;
+
+ while (*cp)
+ h = hash(h, *cp++);
+ return ((int) h);
+}
+
+static int
+iscommand(name)
+ Char *name;
+{
+ register Char **pv;
+ register Char *sav;
+ register struct varent *v;
+ register bool slash = any(short2str(name), '/');
+ register int hashval = 0, hashval1, i;
+
+ v = adrof(STRpath);
+ if (v == 0 || v->vec[0] == 0 || slash)
+ pv = justabs;
+ else
+ pv = v->vec;
+ sav = Strspl(STRslash, name); /* / command name for postpending */
+ if (havhash)
+ hashval = hashname(name);
+ i = 0;
+ do {
+ if (!slash && pv[0][0] == '/' && havhash) {
+ hashval1 = hash(hashval, i);
+ if (!bit(xhash, hashval1))
+ goto cont;
+ }
+ if (pv[0][0] == 0 || eq(pv[0], STRdot)) { /* don't make ./xxx */
+ if (executable(NULL, name, 0)) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) sav);
+ return i + 1;
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ if (executable(*pv, sav, 0)) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) sav);
+ return i + 1;
+ }
+ }
+cont:
+ pv++;
+ i++;
+ } while (*pv);
+ xfree((ptr_t) sav);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/* Also by:
+ * Andreas Luik <luik@isaak.isa.de>
+ * I S A GmbH - Informationssysteme fuer computerintegrierte Automatisierung
+ * Azenberstr. 35
+ * D-7000 Stuttgart 1
+ * West-Germany
+ * is the executable() routine below and changes to iscommand().
+ * Thanks again!!
+ */
+
+/*
+ * executable() examines the pathname obtained by concatenating dir and name
+ * (dir may be NULL), and returns 1 either if it is executable by us, or
+ * if dir_ok is set and the pathname refers to a directory.
+ * This is a bit kludgy, but in the name of optimization...
+ */
+static int
+executable(dir, name, dir_ok)
+ Char *dir, *name;
+ bool dir_ok;
+{
+ struct stat stbuf;
+ Char path[MAXPATHLEN + 1], *dp, *sp;
+ char *strname;
+
+ if (dir && *dir) {
+ for (dp = path, sp = dir; *sp; *dp++ = *sp++)
+ if (dp == &path[MAXPATHLEN + 1]) {
+ *--dp = '\0';
+ break;
+ }
+ for (sp = name; *sp; *dp++ = *sp++)
+ if (dp == &path[MAXPATHLEN + 1]) {
+ *--dp = '\0';
+ break;
+ }
+ *dp = '\0';
+ strname = short2str(path);
+ }
+ else
+ strname = short2str(name);
+ return (stat(strname, &stbuf) != -1 &&
+ ((S_ISREG(stbuf.st_mode) &&
+ /* save time by not calling access() in the hopeless case */
+ (stbuf.st_mode & (S_IXOTH | S_IXGRP | S_IXUSR)) &&
+ access(strname, X_OK) == 0) ||
+ (dir_ok && S_ISDIR(stbuf.st_mode))));
+}
+
+/* The dowhich() is by:
+ * Andreas Luik <luik@isaak.isa.de>
+ * I S A GmbH - Informationssysteme fuer computerintegrierte Automatisierung
+ * Azenberstr. 35
+ * D-7000 Stuttgart 1
+ * West-Germany
+ * Thanks!!
+ */
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+void
+dowhich(v, c)
+ register Char **v;
+ struct command *c;
+{
+ struct wordent lex[3];
+ struct varent *vp;
+
+ lex[0].next = &lex[1];
+ lex[1].next = &lex[2];
+ lex[2].next = &lex[0];
+
+ lex[0].prev = &lex[2];
+ lex[1].prev = &lex[0];
+ lex[2].prev = &lex[1];
+
+ lex[0].word = STRNULL;
+ lex[2].word = STRret;
+
+ while (*++v) {
+ if ((vp = adrof1(*v, &aliases)) != NULL) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s: \t aliased to ", vis_str(*v));
+ blkpr(cshout, vp->vec);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+ else {
+ lex[1].word = *v;
+ tellmewhat(lex);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+static void
+tellmewhat(lex)
+ struct wordent *lex;
+{
+ register int i;
+ register struct biltins *bptr;
+ register struct wordent *sp = lex->next;
+ bool aliased = 0;
+ Char *s0, *s1, *s2;
+ Char qc;
+
+ if (adrof1(sp->word, &aliases)) {
+ alias(lex);
+ sp = lex->next;
+ aliased = 1;
+ }
+
+ s0 = sp->word; /* to get the memory freeing right... */
+
+ /* handle quoted alias hack */
+ if ((*(sp->word) & (QUOTE | TRIM)) == QUOTE)
+ (sp->word)++;
+
+ /* do quoting, if it hasn't been done */
+ s1 = s2 = sp->word;
+ while (*s2)
+ switch (*s2) {
+ case '\'':
+ case '"':
+ qc = *s2++;
+ while (*s2 && *s2 != qc)
+ *s1++ = *s2++ | QUOTE;
+ if (*s2)
+ s2++;
+ break;
+ case '\\':
+ if (*++s2)
+ *s1++ = *s2++ | QUOTE;
+ break;
+ default:
+ *s1++ = *s2++;
+ }
+ *s1 = '\0';
+
+ for (bptr = bfunc; bptr < &bfunc[nbfunc]; bptr++) {
+ if (eq(sp->word, str2short(bptr->bname))) {
+ if (aliased)
+ prlex(cshout, lex);
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s: shell built-in command.\n",
+ vis_str(sp->word));
+ sp->word = s0; /* we save and then restore this */
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if ((i = iscommand(strip(sp->word))) != 0) {
+ register Char **pv;
+ register struct varent *v;
+ bool slash = any(short2str(sp->word), '/');
+
+ v = adrof(STRpath);
+ if (v == 0 || v->vec[0] == 0 || slash)
+ pv = justabs;
+ else
+ pv = v->vec;
+
+ while (--i)
+ pv++;
+ if (pv[0][0] == 0 || eq(pv[0], STRdot)) {
+ sp->word = Strspl(STRdotsl, sp->word);
+ prlex(cshout, lex);
+ xfree((ptr_t) sp->word);
+ sp->word = s0; /* we save and then restore this */
+ return;
+ }
+ s1 = Strspl(*pv, STRslash);
+ sp->word = Strspl(s1, sp->word);
+ xfree((ptr_t) s1);
+ prlex(cshout, lex);
+ xfree((ptr_t) sp->word);
+ }
+ else {
+ if (aliased)
+ prlex(cshout, lex);
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s: Command not found.\n", vis_str(sp->word));
+ }
+ sp->word = s0; /* we save and then restore this */
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/exp.c b/bin/csh/exp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..59b6964
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/exp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,711 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)exp.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+#include <string.h>
+#endif /* SHORT_STRINGS */
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#define IGNORE 1 /* in ignore, it means to ignore value, just parse */
+#define NOGLOB 2 /* in ignore, it means not to globone */
+
+#define ADDOP 1
+#define MULOP 2
+#define EQOP 4
+#define RELOP 8
+#define RESTOP 16
+#define ANYOP 31
+
+#define EQEQ 1
+#define GTR 2
+#define LSS 4
+#define NOTEQ 6
+#define EQMATCH 7
+#define NOTEQMATCH 8
+
+static int exp1 __P((Char ***, bool));
+static int exp2 __P((Char ***, bool));
+static int exp2a __P((Char ***, bool));
+static int exp2b __P((Char ***, bool));
+static int exp2c __P((Char ***, bool));
+static Char * exp3 __P((Char ***, bool));
+static Char * exp3a __P((Char ***, bool));
+static Char * exp4 __P((Char ***, bool));
+static Char * exp5 __P((Char ***, bool));
+static Char * exp6 __P((Char ***, bool));
+static void evalav __P((Char **));
+static int isa __P((Char *, int));
+static int egetn __P((Char *));
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+static void etracc __P((char *, Char *, Char ***));
+static void etraci __P((char *, int, Char ***));
+#endif
+
+int
+expr(vp)
+ register Char ***vp;
+{
+ return (exp0(vp, 0));
+}
+
+int
+exp0(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register int p1 = exp1(vp, ignore);
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp0 p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (**vp && eq(**vp, STRor2)) {
+ register int p2;
+
+ (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp0(vp, (ignore & IGNORE) || p1);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp0 p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ return (p1 || p2);
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static int
+exp1(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register int p1 = exp2(vp, ignore);
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp1 p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (**vp && eq(**vp, STRand2)) {
+ register int p2;
+
+ (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp1(vp, (ignore & IGNORE) || !p1);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp1 p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ return (p1 && p2);
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static int
+exp2(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register int p1 = exp2a(vp, ignore);
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp3 p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (**vp && eq(**vp, STRor)) {
+ register int p2;
+
+ (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp2(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp3 p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ return (p1 | p2);
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static int
+exp2a(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register int p1 = exp2b(vp, ignore);
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp2a p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (**vp && eq(**vp, STRcaret)) {
+ register int p2;
+
+ (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp2a(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp2a p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ return (p1 ^ p2);
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static int
+exp2b(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register int p1 = exp2c(vp, ignore);
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp2b p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (**vp && eq(**vp, STRand)) {
+ register int p2;
+
+ (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp2b(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp2b p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ return (p1 & p2);
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static int
+exp2c(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register Char *p1 = exp3(vp, ignore);
+ register Char *p2;
+ register int i;
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp2c p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if ((i = isa(**vp, EQOP)) != 0) {
+ (*vp)++;
+ if (i == EQMATCH || i == NOTEQMATCH)
+ ignore |= NOGLOB;
+ p2 = exp3(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp2c p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ if (!(ignore & IGNORE))
+ switch (i) {
+
+ case EQEQ:
+ i = eq(p1, p2);
+ break;
+
+ case NOTEQ:
+ i = !eq(p1, p2);
+ break;
+
+ case EQMATCH:
+ i = Gmatch(p1, p2);
+ break;
+
+ case NOTEQMATCH:
+ i = !Gmatch(p1, p2);
+ break;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p2);
+ return (i);
+ }
+ i = egetn(p1);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1);
+ return (i);
+}
+
+static Char *
+exp3(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register Char *p1, *p2;
+ register int i;
+
+ p1 = exp3a(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp3 p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if ((i = isa(**vp, RELOP)) != 0) {
+ (*vp)++;
+ if (**vp && eq(**vp, STRequal))
+ i |= 1, (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp3(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp3 p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ if (!(ignore & IGNORE))
+ switch (i) {
+
+ case GTR:
+ i = egetn(p1) > egetn(p2);
+ break;
+
+ case GTR | 1:
+ i = egetn(p1) >= egetn(p2);
+ break;
+
+ case LSS:
+ i = egetn(p1) < egetn(p2);
+ break;
+
+ case LSS | 1:
+ i = egetn(p1) <= egetn(p2);
+ break;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p2);
+ return (putn(i));
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static Char *
+exp3a(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register Char *p1, *p2, *op;
+ register int i;
+
+ p1 = exp4(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp3a p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ op = **vp;
+ if (op && any("<>", op[0]) && op[0] == op[1]) {
+ (*vp)++;
+ p2 = exp3a(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp3a p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ if (op[0] == '<')
+ i = egetn(p1) << egetn(p2);
+ else
+ i = egetn(p1) >> egetn(p2);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p2);
+ return (putn(i));
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static Char *
+exp4(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register Char *p1, *p2;
+ register int i = 0;
+
+ p1 = exp5(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp4 p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (isa(**vp, ADDOP)) {
+ register Char *op = *(*vp)++;
+
+ p2 = exp4(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp4 p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ if (!(ignore & IGNORE))
+ switch (op[0]) {
+
+ case '+':
+ i = egetn(p1) + egetn(p2);
+ break;
+
+ case '-':
+ i = egetn(p1) - egetn(p2);
+ break;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p2);
+ return (putn(i));
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static Char *
+exp5(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ register Char *p1, *p2;
+ register int i = 0;
+
+ p1 = exp6(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp5 p1", p1, vp);
+#endif
+ if (isa(**vp, MULOP)) {
+ register Char *op = *(*vp)++;
+
+ p2 = exp5(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp5 p2", p2, vp);
+#endif
+ if (!(ignore & IGNORE))
+ switch (op[0]) {
+
+ case '*':
+ i = egetn(p1) * egetn(p2);
+ break;
+
+ case '/':
+ i = egetn(p2);
+ if (i == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_DIV0);
+ i = egetn(p1) / i;
+ break;
+
+ case '%':
+ i = egetn(p2);
+ if (i == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_MOD0);
+ i = egetn(p1) % i;
+ break;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p2);
+ return (putn(i));
+ }
+ return (p1);
+}
+
+static Char *
+exp6(vp, ignore)
+ register Char ***vp;
+ bool ignore;
+{
+ int ccode, i = 0;
+ register Char *cp, *dp, *ep;
+
+ if (**vp == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EXPRESSION);
+ if (eq(**vp, STRbang)) {
+ (*vp)++;
+ cp = exp6(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp6 ! cp", cp, vp);
+#endif
+ i = egetn(cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ return (putn(!i));
+ }
+ if (eq(**vp, STRtilde)) {
+ (*vp)++;
+ cp = exp6(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp6 ~ cp", cp, vp);
+#endif
+ i = egetn(cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ return (putn(~i));
+ }
+ if (eq(**vp, STRLparen)) {
+ (*vp)++;
+ ccode = exp0(vp, ignore);
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp6 () ccode", ccode, vp);
+#endif
+ if (*vp == 0 || **vp == 0 || ***vp != ')')
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EXPRESSION);
+ (*vp)++;
+ return (putn(ccode));
+ }
+ if (eq(**vp, STRLbrace)) {
+ register Char **v;
+ struct command faket;
+ Char *fakecom[2];
+
+ faket.t_dtyp = NODE_COMMAND;
+ faket.t_dflg = 0;
+ faket.t_dcar = faket.t_dcdr = faket.t_dspr = NULL;
+ faket.t_dcom = fakecom;
+ fakecom[0] = STRfakecom;
+ fakecom[1] = NULL;
+ (*vp)++;
+ v = *vp;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (!**vp)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_MISSING, '}');
+ if (eq(*(*vp)++, STRRbrace))
+ break;
+ }
+ if (ignore & IGNORE)
+ return (Strsave(STRNULL));
+ psavejob();
+ if (pfork(&faket, -1) == 0) {
+ *--(*vp) = 0;
+ evalav(v);
+ exitstat();
+ }
+ pwait();
+ prestjob();
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp6 {} status", egetn(value(STRstatus)), vp);
+#endif
+ return (putn(egetn(value(STRstatus)) == 0));
+ }
+ if (isa(**vp, ANYOP))
+ return (Strsave(STRNULL));
+ cp = *(*vp)++;
+ if (*cp == '-' && any("erwxfdzopls", cp[1])) {
+ struct stat stb;
+
+ if (cp[2] != '\0')
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_FILEINQ);
+ /*
+ * Detect missing file names by checking for operator in the file name
+ * position. However, if an operator name appears there, we must make
+ * sure that there's no file by that name (e.g., "/") before announcing
+ * an error. Even this check isn't quite right, since it doesn't take
+ * globbing into account.
+ */
+ if (isa(**vp, ANYOP) && stat(short2str(**vp), &stb))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_FILENAME);
+
+ dp = *(*vp)++;
+ if (ignore & IGNORE)
+ return (Strsave(STRNULL));
+ ep = globone(dp, G_ERROR);
+ switch (cp[1]) {
+
+ case 'r':
+ i = !access(short2str(ep), R_OK);
+ break;
+
+ case 'w':
+ i = !access(short2str(ep), W_OK);
+ break;
+
+ case 'x':
+ i = !access(short2str(ep), X_OK);
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if (
+#ifdef S_IFLNK
+ cp[1] == 'l' ? lstat(short2str(ep), &stb) :
+#endif
+ stat(short2str(ep), &stb)) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) ep);
+ return (Strsave(STR0));
+ }
+ switch (cp[1]) {
+
+ case 'f':
+ i = S_ISREG(stb.st_mode);
+ break;
+
+ case 'd':
+ i = S_ISDIR(stb.st_mode);
+ break;
+
+ case 'p':
+#ifdef S_ISFIFO
+ i = S_ISFIFO(stb.st_mode);
+#else
+ i = 0;
+#endif
+ break;
+
+ case 'l':
+#ifdef S_ISLNK
+ i = S_ISLNK(stb.st_mode);
+#else
+ i = 0;
+#endif
+ break;
+
+ case 's':
+#ifdef S_ISSOCK
+ i = S_ISSOCK(stb.st_mode);
+#else
+ i = 0;
+#endif
+ break;
+
+ case 'z':
+ i = stb.st_size == 0;
+ break;
+
+ case 'e':
+ i = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case 'o':
+ i = stb.st_uid == uid;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etraci("exp6 -? i", i, vp);
+#endif
+ xfree((ptr_t) ep);
+ return (putn(i));
+ }
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+ etracc("exp6 default", cp, vp);
+#endif
+ return (ignore & NOGLOB ? Strsave(cp) : globone(cp, G_ERROR));
+}
+
+static void
+evalav(v)
+ register Char **v;
+{
+ struct wordent paraml1;
+ register struct wordent *hp = &paraml1;
+ struct command *t;
+ register struct wordent *wdp = hp;
+
+ set(STRstatus, Strsave(STR0));
+ hp->prev = hp->next = hp;
+ hp->word = STRNULL;
+ while (*v) {
+ register struct wordent *new =
+ (struct wordent *) xcalloc(1, sizeof *wdp);
+
+ new->prev = wdp;
+ new->next = hp;
+ wdp->next = new;
+ wdp = new;
+ wdp->word = Strsave(*v++);
+ }
+ hp->prev = wdp;
+ alias(&paraml1);
+ t = syntax(paraml1.next, &paraml1, 0);
+ if (seterr)
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+ execute(t, -1, NULL, NULL);
+ freelex(&paraml1), freesyn(t);
+}
+
+static int
+isa(cp, what)
+ register Char *cp;
+ register int what;
+{
+ if (cp == 0)
+ return ((what & RESTOP) != 0);
+ if (cp[1] == 0) {
+ if (what & ADDOP && (*cp == '+' || *cp == '-'))
+ return (1);
+ if (what & MULOP && (*cp == '*' || *cp == '/' || *cp == '%'))
+ return (1);
+ if (what & RESTOP && (*cp == '(' || *cp == ')' || *cp == '!' ||
+ *cp == '~' || *cp == '^' || *cp == '"'))
+ return (1);
+ }
+ else if (cp[2] == 0) {
+ if (what & RESTOP) {
+ if (cp[0] == '|' && cp[1] == '&')
+ return (1);
+ if (cp[0] == '<' && cp[1] == '<')
+ return (1);
+ if (cp[0] == '>' && cp[1] == '>')
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (what & EQOP) {
+ if (cp[0] == '=') {
+ if (cp[1] == '=')
+ return (EQEQ);
+ if (cp[1] == '~')
+ return (EQMATCH);
+ }
+ else if (cp[0] == '!') {
+ if (cp[1] == '=')
+ return (NOTEQ);
+ if (cp[1] == '~')
+ return (NOTEQMATCH);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if (what & RELOP) {
+ if (*cp == '<')
+ return (LSS);
+ if (*cp == '>')
+ return (GTR);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static int
+egetn(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ if (*cp && *cp != '-' && !Isdigit(*cp))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EXPRESSION);
+ return (getn(cp));
+}
+
+/* Phew! */
+
+#ifdef EDEBUG
+static void
+etraci(str, i, vp)
+ char *str;
+ int i;
+ Char ***vp;
+{
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s=%d\t", str, i);
+ blkpr(csherr, *vp);
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "\n");
+}
+static void
+etracc(str, cp, vp)
+ char *str;
+ Char *cp;
+ Char ***vp;
+{
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s=%s\t", str, vis_str(cp));
+ blkpr(csherr, *vp);
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "\n");
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/csh/extern.h b/bin/csh/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..db37b8a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,338 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+
+/*
+ * csh.c
+ */
+int gethdir __P((Char *));
+void dosource __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void exitstat __P((void));
+void goodbye __P((void));
+void importpath __P((Char *));
+void initdesc __P((void));
+void pintr __P((int));
+void pintr1 __P((bool));
+void printprompt __P((void));
+void process __P((bool));
+void rechist __P((void));
+void untty __P((void));
+int vis_fputc __P((int, FILE *));
+
+#ifdef PROF
+void done __P((int));
+#else
+void xexit __P((int));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * dir.c
+ */
+void dinit __P((Char *));
+void dodirs __P((Char **, struct command *));
+Char *dcanon __P((Char *, Char *));
+void dtildepr __P((Char *, Char *));
+void dtilde __P((void));
+void dochngd __P((Char **, struct command *));
+Char *dnormalize __P((Char *));
+void dopushd __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dopopd __P((Char **, struct command *));
+struct directory;
+void dfree __P((struct directory *));
+
+/*
+ * dol.c
+ */
+void Dfix __P((struct command *));
+Char *Dfix1 __P((Char *));
+void heredoc __P((Char *));
+
+/*
+ * err.c
+ */
+void seterror __P((int, ...));
+void stderror __P((int, ...));
+
+/*
+ * exec.c
+ */
+void doexec __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dohash __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dounhash __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dowhich __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void execash __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void hashstat __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void xechoit __P((Char **));
+
+/*
+ * exp.c
+ */
+int expr __P((Char ***));
+int exp0 __P((Char ***, bool));
+
+/*
+ * file.c
+ */
+#ifdef FILEC
+int tenex __P((Char *, int));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * func.c
+ */
+void Setenv __P((Char *, Char *));
+void doalias __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dobreak __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void docontin __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doecho __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doelse __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doend __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doeval __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doexit __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doforeach __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doglob __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dogoto __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doif __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dolimit __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dologin __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dologout __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void donohup __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doonintr __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doprintf __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dorepeat __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dosetenv __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dosuspend __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doswbrk __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doswitch __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void doumask __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dounlimit __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dounsetenv __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dowhile __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dozip __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void func __P((struct command *, struct biltins *));
+struct biltins *
+ isbfunc __P((struct command *));
+void prvars __P((void));
+void gotolab __P((Char *));
+int srchx __P((Char *));
+void unalias __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void wfree __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * glob.c
+ */
+Char **dobackp __P((Char *, bool));
+void Gcat __P((Char *, Char *));
+Char *globone __P((Char *, int));
+int Gmatch __P((Char *, Char *));
+void ginit __P((void));
+Char **globall __P((Char **));
+void rscan __P((Char **, void (*)()));
+void tglob __P((Char **));
+void trim __P((Char **));
+#ifdef FILEC
+int sortscmp __P((const ptr_t, const ptr_t));
+#endif /* FILEC */
+
+/*
+ * hist.c
+ */
+void dohist __P((Char **, struct command *));
+struct Hist *
+ enthist __P((int, struct wordent *, bool));
+void savehist __P((struct wordent *));
+
+/*
+ * lex.c
+ */
+void addla __P((Char *));
+void bseek __P((struct Ain *));
+void btell __P((struct Ain *));
+void btoeof __P((void));
+void copylex __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *));
+Char *domod __P((Char *, int));
+void freelex __P((struct wordent *));
+int lex __P((struct wordent *));
+void prlex __P((FILE *, struct wordent *));
+int readc __P((bool));
+void settell __P((void));
+void unreadc __P((int));
+
+/*
+ * misc.c
+ */
+int any __P((char *, int));
+Char **blkcat __P((Char **, Char **));
+Char **blkcpy __P((Char **, Char **));
+Char **blkend __P((Char **));
+void blkfree __P((Char **));
+int blklen __P((Char **));
+void blkpr __P((FILE *, Char **));
+Char **blkspl __P((Char **, Char **));
+void closem __P((void));
+Char **copyblk __P((Char **));
+int dcopy __P((int, int));
+int dmove __P((int, int));
+void donefds __P((void));
+Char lastchr __P((Char *));
+void lshift __P((Char **, int));
+int number __P((Char *));
+int prefix __P((Char *, Char *));
+Char **saveblk __P((Char **));
+void setzero __P((char *, int));
+Char *strip __P((Char *));
+char *strsave __P((char *));
+char *strspl __P((char *, char *));
+void udvar __P((Char *));
+
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+# ifdef NOTUSED
+char *strstr __P((const char *, const char *));
+# endif /* NOTUSED */
+char *strend __P((char *));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * parse.c
+ */
+void alias __P((struct wordent *));
+void freesyn __P((struct command *));
+struct command *
+ syntax __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+
+
+/*
+ * proc.c
+ */
+void dobg __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dobg1 __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dofg __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dofg1 __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dojobs __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dokill __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void donotify __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dostop __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dowait __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void palloc __P((int, struct command *));
+void panystop __P((bool));
+void pchild __P((int));
+void pendjob __P((void));
+struct process *
+ pfind __P((Char *));
+int pfork __P((struct command *, int));
+void pgetty __P((int, int));
+void pjwait __P((struct process *));
+void pnote __P((void));
+void prestjob __P((void));
+void psavejob __P((void));
+void pstart __P((struct process *, int));
+void pwait __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * sem.c
+ */
+void execute __P((struct command *, int, int *, int *));
+void mypipe __P((int *));
+
+/*
+ * set.c
+ */
+struct varent
+ *adrof1 __P((Char *, struct varent *));
+void doset __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dolet __P((Char **, struct command *));
+Char *putn __P((int));
+int getn __P((Char *));
+Char *value1 __P((Char *, struct varent *));
+void set __P((Char *, Char *));
+void set1 __P((Char *, Char **, struct varent *));
+void setq __P((Char *, Char **, struct varent *));
+void unset __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void unset1 __P((Char *[], struct varent *));
+void unsetv __P((Char *));
+void setNS __P((Char *));
+void shift __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void plist __P((struct varent *));
+
+/*
+ * time.c
+ */
+void donice __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void dotime __P((Char **, struct command *));
+void prusage __P((struct rusage *, struct rusage *,
+ struct timeval *, struct timeval *));
+void ruadd __P((struct rusage *, struct rusage *));
+void settimes __P((void));
+void tvadd __P((struct timeval *, struct timeval *));
+void tvsub __P((struct timeval *, struct timeval *, struct timeval *));
+void pcsecs __P((long));
+void psecs __P((long));
+
+/*
+ * alloc.c
+ */
+void Free __P((ptr_t));
+ptr_t Malloc __P((size_t));
+ptr_t Realloc __P((ptr_t, size_t));
+ptr_t Calloc __P((size_t, size_t));
+void showall __P((Char **, struct command *));
+
+/*
+ * str.c:
+ */
+#ifdef SHORT_STRINGS
+Char *s_strchr __P((Char *, int));
+Char *s_strrchr __P((Char *, int));
+Char *s_strcat __P((Char *, Char *));
+#ifdef NOTUSED
+Char *s_strncat __P((Char *, Char *, size_t));
+#endif
+Char *s_strcpy __P((Char *, Char *));
+Char *s_strncpy __P((Char *, Char *, size_t));
+Char *s_strspl __P((Char *, Char *));
+size_t s_strlen __P((Char *));
+int s_strcmp __P((Char *, Char *));
+int s_strncmp __P((Char *, Char *, size_t));
+Char *s_strsave __P((Char *));
+Char *s_strend __P((Char *));
+Char *s_strstr __P((Char *, Char *));
+Char *str2short __P((char *));
+Char **blk2short __P((char **));
+char *short2str __P((Char *));
+char **short2blk __P((Char **));
+#endif
+char *short2qstr __P((Char *));
+char *vis_str __P((Char *));
diff --git a/bin/csh/file.c b/bin/csh/file.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..523844d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/file.c
@@ -0,0 +1,684 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)file.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 3/19/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifdef FILEC
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <termios.h>
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+#include <string.h>
+#endif /* SHORT_STRINGS */
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Tenex style file name recognition, .. and more.
+ * History:
+ * Author: Ken Greer, Sept. 1975, CMU.
+ * Finally got around to adding to the Cshell., Ken Greer, Dec. 1981.
+ */
+
+#define ON 1
+#define OFF 0
+#ifndef TRUE
+#define TRUE 1
+#endif
+#ifndef FALSE
+#define FALSE 0
+#endif
+
+#define ESC '\033'
+
+typedef enum {
+ LIST, RECOGNIZE
+} COMMAND;
+
+static void setup_tty __P((int));
+static void back_to_col_1 __P((void));
+static void pushback __P((Char *));
+static void catn __P((Char *, Char *, int));
+static void copyn __P((Char *, Char *, int));
+static Char filetype __P((Char *, Char *));
+static void print_by_column __P((Char *, Char *[], int));
+static Char *tilde __P((Char *, Char *));
+static void retype __P((void));
+static void beep __P((void));
+static void print_recognized_stuff __P((Char *));
+static void extract_dir_and_name __P((Char *, Char *, Char *));
+static Char *getentry __P((DIR *, int));
+static void free_items __P((Char **));
+static int tsearch __P((Char *, COMMAND, int));
+static int recognize __P((Char *, Char *, int, int));
+static int is_prefix __P((Char *, Char *));
+static int is_suffix __P((Char *, Char *));
+static int ignored __P((Char *));
+
+/*
+ * Put this here so the binary can be patched with adb to enable file
+ * completion by default. Filec controls completion, nobeep controls
+ * ringing the terminal bell on incomplete expansions.
+ */
+bool filec = 0;
+
+static void
+setup_tty(on)
+ int on;
+{
+ static struct termios tchars;
+
+ (void) tcgetattr(SHIN, &tchars);
+
+ if (on) {
+ tchars.c_cc[VEOL] = ESC;
+ if (tchars.c_lflag & ICANON)
+ on = TCSANOW;
+ else {
+ on = TCSAFLUSH;
+ tchars.c_lflag |= ICANON;
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ tchars.c_cc[VEOL] = _POSIX_VDISABLE;
+ on = TCSANOW;
+ }
+
+ (void) tcsetattr(SHIN, TCSANOW, &tchars);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Move back to beginning of current line
+ */
+static void
+back_to_col_1()
+{
+ struct termios tty, tty_normal;
+ int omask;
+
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ (void) tcgetattr(SHOUT, &tty);
+ tty_normal = tty;
+ tty.c_iflag &= ~INLCR;
+ tty.c_oflag &= ~ONLCR;
+ (void) tcsetattr(SHOUT, TCSANOW, &tty);
+ (void) write(SHOUT, "\r", 1);
+ (void) tcsetattr(SHOUT, TCSANOW, &tty_normal);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Push string contents back into tty queue
+ */
+static void
+pushback(string)
+ Char *string;
+{
+ register Char *p;
+ struct termios tty, tty_normal;
+ int omask;
+ char c;
+
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ (void) tcgetattr(SHOUT, &tty);
+ tty_normal = tty;
+ tty.c_lflag &= ~(ECHOKE | ECHO | ECHOE | ECHOK | ECHONL | ECHOPRT | ECHOCTL);
+ (void) tcsetattr(SHOUT, TCSANOW, &tty);
+
+ for (p = string; (c = *p) != '\0'; p++)
+ (void) ioctl(SHOUT, TIOCSTI, (ioctl_t) & c);
+ (void) tcsetattr(SHOUT, TCSANOW, &tty_normal);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Concatenate src onto tail of des.
+ * Des is a string whose maximum length is count.
+ * Always null terminate.
+ */
+static void
+catn(des, src, count)
+ register Char *des, *src;
+ register int count;
+{
+ while (--count >= 0 && *des)
+ des++;
+ while (--count >= 0)
+ if ((*des++ = *src++) == 0)
+ return;
+ *des = '\0';
+}
+
+/*
+ * Like strncpy but always leave room for trailing \0
+ * and always null terminate.
+ */
+static void
+copyn(des, src, count)
+ register Char *des, *src;
+ register int count;
+{
+ while (--count >= 0)
+ if ((*des++ = *src++) == 0)
+ return;
+ *des = '\0';
+}
+
+static Char
+filetype(dir, file)
+ Char *dir, *file;
+{
+ Char path[MAXPATHLEN];
+ struct stat statb;
+
+ catn(Strcpy(path, dir), file, sizeof(path) / sizeof(Char));
+ if (lstat(short2str(path), &statb) == 0) {
+ switch (statb.st_mode & S_IFMT) {
+ case S_IFDIR:
+ return ('/');
+
+ case S_IFLNK:
+ if (stat(short2str(path), &statb) == 0 && /* follow it out */
+ S_ISDIR(statb.st_mode))
+ return ('>');
+ else
+ return ('@');
+
+ case S_IFSOCK:
+ return ('=');
+
+ default:
+ if (statb.st_mode & 0111)
+ return ('*');
+ }
+ }
+ return (' ');
+}
+
+static struct winsize win;
+
+/*
+ * Print sorted down columns
+ */
+static void
+print_by_column(dir, items, count)
+ Char *dir, *items[];
+ int count;
+{
+ register int i, rows, r, c, maxwidth = 0, columns;
+
+ if (ioctl(SHOUT, TIOCGWINSZ, (ioctl_t) & win) < 0 || win.ws_col == 0)
+ win.ws_col = 80;
+ for (i = 0; i < count; i++)
+ maxwidth = maxwidth > (r = Strlen(items[i])) ? maxwidth : r;
+ maxwidth += 2; /* for the file tag and space */
+ columns = win.ws_col / maxwidth;
+ if (columns == 0)
+ columns = 1;
+ rows = (count + (columns - 1)) / columns;
+ for (r = 0; r < rows; r++) {
+ for (c = 0; c < columns; c++) {
+ i = c * rows + r;
+ if (i < count) {
+ register int w;
+
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s", vis_str(items[i]));
+ (void) fputc(dir ? filetype(dir, items[i]) : ' ', cshout);
+ if (c < columns - 1) { /* last column? */
+ w = Strlen(items[i]) + 1;
+ for (; w < maxwidth; w++)
+ (void) fputc(' ', cshout);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ (void) fputc('\r', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Expand file name with possible tilde usage
+ * ~person/mumble
+ * expands to
+ * home_directory_of_person/mumble
+ */
+static Char *
+tilde(new, old)
+ Char *new, *old;
+{
+ register Char *o, *p;
+ register struct passwd *pw;
+ static Char person[40];
+
+ if (old[0] != '~')
+ return (Strcpy(new, old));
+
+ for (p = person, o = &old[1]; *o && *o != '/'; *p++ = *o++)
+ continue;
+ *p = '\0';
+ if (person[0] == '\0')
+ (void) Strcpy(new, value(STRhome));
+ else {
+ pw = getpwnam(short2str(person));
+ if (pw == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+ (void) Strcpy(new, str2short(pw->pw_dir));
+ }
+ (void) Strcat(new, o);
+ return (new);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Cause pending line to be printed
+ */
+static void
+retype()
+{
+ struct termios tty;
+
+ (void) tcgetattr(SHOUT, &tty);
+ tty.c_lflag |= PENDIN;
+ (void) tcsetattr(SHOUT, TCSANOW, &tty);
+}
+
+static void
+beep()
+{
+ if (adrof(STRnobeep) == 0)
+ (void) write(SHOUT, "\007", 1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Erase that silly ^[ and
+ * print the recognized part of the string
+ */
+static void
+print_recognized_stuff(recognized_part)
+ Char *recognized_part;
+{
+ /* An optimized erasing of that silly ^[ */
+ (void) fputc('\b', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\b', cshout);
+ switch (Strlen(recognized_part)) {
+
+ case 0: /* erase two Characters: ^[ */
+ (void) fputc(' ', cshout);
+ (void) fputc(' ', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\b', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\b', cshout);
+ break;
+
+ case 1: /* overstrike the ^, erase the [ */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s", vis_str(recognized_part));
+ (void) fputc(' ', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\b', cshout);
+ break;
+
+ default: /* overstrike both Characters ^[ */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s", vis_str(recognized_part));
+ break;
+ }
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Parse full path in file into 2 parts: directory and file names
+ * Should leave final slash (/) at end of dir.
+ */
+static void
+extract_dir_and_name(path, dir, name)
+ Char *path, *dir, *name;
+{
+ register Char *p;
+
+ p = Strrchr(path, '/');
+ if (p == NULL) {
+ copyn(name, path, MAXNAMLEN);
+ dir[0] = '\0';
+ }
+ else {
+ copyn(name, ++p, MAXNAMLEN);
+ copyn(dir, path, p - path);
+ }
+}
+
+static Char *
+getentry(dir_fd, looking_for_lognames)
+ DIR *dir_fd;
+ int looking_for_lognames;
+{
+ register struct passwd *pw;
+ register struct dirent *dirp;
+
+ if (looking_for_lognames) {
+ if ((pw = getpwent()) == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+ return (str2short(pw->pw_name));
+ }
+ if ((dirp = readdir(dir_fd)) != NULL)
+ return (str2short(dirp->d_name));
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+static void
+free_items(items)
+ register Char **items;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; items[i]; i++)
+ xfree((ptr_t) items[i]);
+ xfree((ptr_t) items);
+}
+
+#define FREE_ITEMS(items) { \
+ int omask;\
+\
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));\
+ free_items(items);\
+ items = NULL;\
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);\
+}
+
+/*
+ * Perform a RECOGNIZE or LIST command on string "word".
+ */
+static int
+tsearch(word, command, max_word_length)
+ Char *word;
+ COMMAND command;
+ int max_word_length;
+{
+ static Char **items = NULL;
+ register DIR *dir_fd;
+ register numitems = 0, ignoring = TRUE, nignored = 0;
+ register name_length, looking_for_lognames;
+ Char tilded_dir[MAXPATHLEN + 1], dir[MAXPATHLEN + 1];
+ Char name[MAXNAMLEN + 1], extended_name[MAXNAMLEN + 1];
+ Char *entry;
+
+#define MAXITEMS 1024
+
+ if (items != NULL)
+ FREE_ITEMS(items);
+
+ looking_for_lognames = (*word == '~') && (Strchr(word, '/') == NULL);
+ if (looking_for_lognames) {
+ (void) setpwent();
+ copyn(name, &word[1], MAXNAMLEN); /* name sans ~ */
+ dir_fd = NULL;
+ }
+ else {
+ extract_dir_and_name(word, dir, name);
+ if (tilde(tilded_dir, dir) == 0)
+ return (0);
+ dir_fd = opendir(*tilded_dir ? short2str(tilded_dir) : ".");
+ if (dir_fd == NULL)
+ return (0);
+ }
+
+again: /* search for matches */
+ name_length = Strlen(name);
+ for (numitems = 0; (entry = getentry(dir_fd, looking_for_lognames)) != NULL;) {
+ if (!is_prefix(name, entry))
+ continue;
+ /* Don't match . files on null prefix match */
+ if (name_length == 0 && entry[0] == '.' &&
+ !looking_for_lognames)
+ continue;
+ if (command == LIST) {
+ if (numitems >= MAXITEMS) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "\nYikes!! Too many %s!!\n",
+ looking_for_lognames ?
+ "names in password file" : "files");
+ break;
+ }
+ if (items == NULL)
+ items = (Char **) xcalloc(sizeof(items[0]), MAXITEMS);
+ items[numitems] = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t) (Strlen(entry) + 1) *
+ sizeof(Char));
+ copyn(items[numitems], entry, MAXNAMLEN);
+ numitems++;
+ }
+ else { /* RECOGNIZE command */
+ if (ignoring && ignored(entry))
+ nignored++;
+ else if (recognize(extended_name,
+ entry, name_length, ++numitems))
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (ignoring && numitems == 0 && nignored > 0) {
+ ignoring = FALSE;
+ nignored = 0;
+ if (looking_for_lognames)
+ (void) setpwent();
+ else
+ rewinddir(dir_fd);
+ goto again;
+ }
+
+ if (looking_for_lognames)
+ (void) endpwent();
+ else
+ (void) closedir(dir_fd);
+ if (numitems == 0)
+ return (0);
+ if (command == RECOGNIZE) {
+ if (looking_for_lognames)
+ copyn(word, STRtilde, 1);
+ else
+ /* put back dir part */
+ copyn(word, dir, max_word_length);
+ /* add extended name */
+ catn(word, extended_name, max_word_length);
+ return (numitems);
+ }
+ else { /* LIST */
+ qsort((ptr_t) items, numitems, sizeof(items[0]),
+ (int (*) __P((const void *, const void *))) sortscmp);
+ print_by_column(looking_for_lognames ? NULL : tilded_dir,
+ items, numitems);
+ if (items != NULL)
+ FREE_ITEMS(items);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Object: extend what user typed up to an ambiguity.
+ * Algorithm:
+ * On first match, copy full entry (assume it'll be the only match)
+ * On subsequent matches, shorten extended_name to the first
+ * Character mismatch between extended_name and entry.
+ * If we shorten it back to the prefix length, stop searching.
+ */
+static int
+recognize(extended_name, entry, name_length, numitems)
+ Char *extended_name, *entry;
+ int name_length, numitems;
+{
+ if (numitems == 1) /* 1st match */
+ copyn(extended_name, entry, MAXNAMLEN);
+ else { /* 2nd & subsequent matches */
+ register Char *x, *ent;
+ register int len = 0;
+
+ x = extended_name;
+ for (ent = entry; *x && *x == *ent++; x++, len++)
+ continue;
+ *x = '\0'; /* Shorten at 1st Char diff */
+ if (len == name_length) /* Ambiguous to prefix? */
+ return (-1); /* So stop now and save time */
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Return true if check matches initial Chars in template.
+ * This differs from PWB imatch in that if check is null
+ * it matches anything.
+ */
+static int
+is_prefix(check, template)
+ register Char *check, *template;
+{
+ do
+ if (*check == 0)
+ return (TRUE);
+ while (*check++ == *template++);
+ return (FALSE);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Return true if the Chars in template appear at the
+ * end of check, I.e., are it's suffix.
+ */
+static int
+is_suffix(check, template)
+ Char *check, *template;
+{
+ register Char *c, *t;
+
+ for (c = check; *c++;)
+ continue;
+ for (t = template; *t++;)
+ continue;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (t == template)
+ return 1;
+ if (c == check || *--t != *--c)
+ return 0;
+ }
+}
+
+int
+tenex(inputline, inputline_size)
+ Char *inputline;
+ int inputline_size;
+{
+ register int numitems, num_read;
+ char tinputline[BUFSIZ];
+
+
+ setup_tty(ON);
+
+ while ((num_read = read(SHIN, tinputline, BUFSIZ)) > 0) {
+ int i;
+ static Char delims[] = {' ', '\'', '"', '\t', ';', '&', '<',
+ '>', '(', ')', '|', '^', '%', '\0'};
+ register Char *str_end, *word_start, last_Char, should_retype;
+ register int space_left;
+ COMMAND command;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < num_read; i++)
+ inputline[i] = (unsigned char) tinputline[i];
+ last_Char = inputline[num_read - 1] & ASCII;
+
+ if (last_Char == '\n' || num_read == inputline_size)
+ break;
+ command = (last_Char == ESC) ? RECOGNIZE : LIST;
+ if (command == LIST)
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ str_end = &inputline[num_read];
+ if (last_Char == ESC)
+ --str_end; /* wipeout trailing cmd Char */
+ *str_end = '\0';
+ /*
+ * Find LAST occurence of a delimiter in the inputline. The word start
+ * is one Character past it.
+ */
+ for (word_start = str_end; word_start > inputline; --word_start)
+ if (Strchr(delims, word_start[-1]))
+ break;
+ space_left = inputline_size - (word_start - inputline) - 1;
+ numitems = tsearch(word_start, command, space_left);
+
+ if (command == RECOGNIZE) {
+ /* print from str_end on */
+ print_recognized_stuff(str_end);
+ if (numitems != 1) /* Beep = No match/ambiguous */
+ beep();
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Tabs in the input line cause trouble after a pushback. tty driver
+ * won't backspace over them because column positions are now
+ * incorrect. This is solved by retyping over current line.
+ */
+ should_retype = FALSE;
+ if (Strchr(inputline, '\t')) { /* tab Char in input line? */
+ back_to_col_1();
+ should_retype = TRUE;
+ }
+ if (command == LIST) /* Always retype after a LIST */
+ should_retype = TRUE;
+ if (should_retype)
+ printprompt();
+ pushback(inputline);
+ if (should_retype)
+ retype();
+ }
+ setup_tty(OFF);
+ return (num_read);
+}
+
+static int
+ignored(entry)
+ register Char *entry;
+{
+ struct varent *vp;
+ register Char **cp;
+
+ if ((vp = adrof(STRfignore)) == NULL || (cp = vp->vec) == NULL)
+ return (FALSE);
+ for (; *cp != NULL; cp++)
+ if (is_suffix(entry, *cp))
+ return (TRUE);
+ return (FALSE);
+}
+#endif /* FILEC */
diff --git a/bin/csh/func.c b/bin/csh/func.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..82664c6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/func.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1498 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)func.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <locale.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+#include "pathnames.h"
+
+extern char **environ;
+
+static int zlast = -1;
+static void islogin __P((void));
+static void reexecute __P((struct command *));
+static void preread __P((void));
+static void doagain __P((void));
+static void search __P((int, int, Char *));
+static int getword __P((Char *));
+static int keyword __P((Char *));
+static void toend __P((void));
+static void xecho __P((int, Char **));
+static void Unsetenv __P((Char *));
+
+struct biltins *
+isbfunc(t)
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp = t->t_dcom[0];
+ register struct biltins *bp, *bp1, *bp2;
+ static struct biltins label = {"", dozip, 0, 0};
+ static struct biltins foregnd = {"%job", dofg1, 0, 0};
+ static struct biltins backgnd = {"%job &", dobg1, 0, 0};
+
+ if (lastchr(cp) == ':') {
+ label.bname = short2str(cp);
+ return (&label);
+ }
+ if (*cp == '%') {
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND) {
+ t->t_dflg &= ~F_AMPERSAND;
+ backgnd.bname = short2str(cp);
+ return (&backgnd);
+ }
+ foregnd.bname = short2str(cp);
+ return (&foregnd);
+ }
+ /*
+ * Binary search Bp1 is the beginning of the current search range. Bp2 is
+ * one past the end.
+ */
+ for (bp1 = bfunc, bp2 = bfunc + nbfunc; bp1 < bp2;) {
+ register i;
+
+ bp = bp1 + ((bp2 - bp1) >> 1);
+ if ((i = *cp - *bp->bname) == 0 &&
+ (i = Strcmp(cp, str2short(bp->bname))) == 0)
+ return bp;
+ if (i < 0)
+ bp2 = bp;
+ else
+ bp1 = bp + 1;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+func(t, bp)
+ register struct command *t;
+ register struct biltins *bp;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ xechoit(t->t_dcom);
+ setname(bp->bname);
+ i = blklen(t->t_dcom) - 1;
+ if (i < bp->minargs)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TOOFEW);
+ if (i > bp->maxargs)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TOOMANY);
+ (*bp->bfunct) (t->t_dcom, t);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doonintr(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+ register Char *vv = v[1];
+
+ if (parintr == SIG_IGN)
+ return;
+ if (setintr && intty)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TERMINAL);
+ cp = gointr;
+ gointr = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ if (vv == 0) {
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ else
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, SIG_DFL);
+ gointr = 0;
+ }
+ else if (eq((vv = strip(vv)), STRminus)) {
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ gointr = Strsave(STRminus);
+ }
+ else {
+ gointr = Strsave(vv);
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, pintr);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+donohup(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ if (intty)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_TERMINAL);
+ if (setintr == 0) {
+ (void) signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dozip(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ ;
+}
+
+void
+prvars()
+{
+ plist(&shvhed);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doalias(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct varent *vp;
+ register Char *p;
+
+ v++;
+ p = *v++;
+ if (p == 0)
+ plist(&aliases);
+ else if (*v == 0) {
+ vp = adrof1(strip(p), &aliases);
+ if (vp) {
+ blkpr(cshout, vp->vec);
+ fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ if (eq(p, STRalias) || eq(p, STRunalias)) {
+ setname(vis_str(p));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_DANGER);
+ }
+ set1(strip(p), saveblk(v), &aliases);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+unalias(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ unset1(v, &aliases);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dologout(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ islogin();
+ goodbye();
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dologin(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ islogin();
+ rechist();
+ (void) signal(SIGTERM, parterm);
+ (void) execl(_PATH_LOGIN, "login", short2str(v[1]), NULL);
+ untty();
+ xexit(1);
+}
+
+static void
+islogin()
+{
+ if (chkstop == 0 && setintr)
+ panystop(0);
+ if (loginsh)
+ return;
+ stderror(ERR_NOTLOGIN);
+}
+
+void
+doif(v, kp)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *kp;
+{
+ register int i;
+ register Char **vv;
+
+ v++;
+ i = expr(&v);
+ vv = v;
+ if (*vv == NULL)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EMPTYIF);
+ if (eq(*vv, STRthen)) {
+ if (*++vv)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_IMPRTHEN);
+ setname(vis_str(STRthen));
+ /*
+ * If expression was zero, then scan to else, otherwise just fall into
+ * following code.
+ */
+ if (!i)
+ search(T_IF, 0, NULL);
+ return;
+ }
+ /*
+ * Simple command attached to this if. Left shift the node in this tree,
+ * munging it so we can reexecute it.
+ */
+ if (i) {
+ lshift(kp->t_dcom, vv - kp->t_dcom);
+ reexecute(kp);
+ donefds();
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Reexecute a command, being careful not
+ * to redo i/o redirection, which is already set up.
+ */
+static void
+reexecute(kp)
+ register struct command *kp;
+{
+ kp->t_dflg &= F_SAVE;
+ kp->t_dflg |= F_REPEAT;
+ /*
+ * If tty is still ours to arbitrate, arbitrate it; otherwise dont even set
+ * pgrp's as the jobs would then have no way to get the tty (we can't give
+ * it to them, and our parent wouldn't know their pgrp, etc.
+ */
+ execute(kp, (tpgrp > 0 ? tpgrp : -1), NULL, NULL);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doelse(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ search(T_ELSE, 0, NULL);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dogoto(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ Char *lp;
+
+ gotolab(lp = globone(v[1], G_ERROR));
+ xfree((ptr_t) lp);
+}
+
+void
+gotolab(lab)
+ Char *lab;
+{
+ register struct whyle *wp;
+ /*
+ * While we still can, locate any unknown ends of existing loops. This
+ * obscure code is the WORST result of the fact that we don't really parse.
+ */
+ zlast = T_GOTO;
+ for (wp = whyles; wp; wp = wp->w_next)
+ if (wp->w_end.type == F_SEEK && wp->w_end.f_seek == 0) {
+ search(T_BREAK, 0, NULL);
+ btell(&wp->w_end);
+ }
+ else
+ bseek(&wp->w_end);
+ search(T_GOTO, 0, lab);
+ /*
+ * Eliminate loops which were exited.
+ */
+ wfree();
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doswitch(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp, *lp;
+
+ v++;
+ if (!*v || *(*v++) != '(')
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ cp = **v == ')' ? STRNULL : *v++;
+ if (*(*v++) != ')')
+ v--;
+ if (*v)
+ stderror(ERR_SYNTAX);
+ search(T_SWITCH, 0, lp = globone(cp, G_ERROR));
+ xfree((ptr_t) lp);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dobreak(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ if (whyles)
+ toend();
+ else
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTWHILE);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doexit(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ if (chkstop == 0 && (intty || intact) && evalvec == 0)
+ panystop(0);
+ /*
+ * Don't DEMAND parentheses here either.
+ */
+ v++;
+ if (*v) {
+ set(STRstatus, putn(expr(&v)));
+ if (*v)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EXPRESSION);
+ }
+ btoeof();
+ if (intty)
+ (void) close(SHIN);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doforeach(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp, *sp;
+ register struct whyle *nwp;
+
+ v++;
+ sp = cp = strip(*v);
+ if (!letter(*sp))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARBEGIN);
+ while (*cp && alnum(*cp))
+ cp++;
+ if (*cp)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARALNUM);
+ if ((cp - sp) > MAXVARLEN)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARTOOLONG);
+ cp = *v++;
+ if (v[0][0] != '(' || v[blklen(v) - 1][0] != ')')
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOPAREN);
+ v++;
+ gflag = 0, tglob(v);
+ v = globall(v);
+ if (v == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ nwp = (struct whyle *) xcalloc(1, sizeof *nwp);
+ nwp->w_fe = nwp->w_fe0 = v;
+ gargv = 0;
+ btell(&nwp->w_start);
+ nwp->w_fename = Strsave(cp);
+ nwp->w_next = whyles;
+ nwp->w_end.type = F_SEEK;
+ whyles = nwp;
+ /*
+ * Pre-read the loop so as to be more comprehensible to a terminal user.
+ */
+ zlast = T_FOREACH;
+ if (intty)
+ preread();
+ doagain();
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dowhile(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register int status;
+ register bool again = whyles != 0 && SEEKEQ(&whyles->w_start, &lineloc) &&
+ whyles->w_fename == 0;
+
+ v++;
+ /*
+ * Implement prereading here also, taking care not to evaluate the
+ * expression before the loop has been read up from a terminal.
+ */
+ if (intty && !again)
+ status = !exp0(&v, 1);
+ else
+ status = !expr(&v);
+ if (*v)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EXPRESSION);
+ if (!again) {
+ register struct whyle *nwp =
+ (struct whyle *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*nwp));
+
+ nwp->w_start = lineloc;
+ nwp->w_end.type = F_SEEK;
+ nwp->w_end.f_seek = 0;
+ nwp->w_next = whyles;
+ whyles = nwp;
+ zlast = T_WHILE;
+ if (intty) {
+ /*
+ * The tty preread
+ */
+ preread();
+ doagain();
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ if (status)
+ /* We ain't gonna loop no more, no more! */
+ toend();
+}
+
+static void
+preread()
+{
+ whyles->w_end.type = I_SEEK;
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(sigblock((sigset_t) 0) & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+
+ search(T_BREAK, 0, NULL); /* read the expression in */
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ btell(&whyles->w_end);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doend(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ if (!whyles)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTWHILE);
+ btell(&whyles->w_end);
+ doagain();
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+docontin(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ if (!whyles)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTWHILE);
+ doagain();
+}
+
+static void
+doagain()
+{
+ /* Repeating a while is simple */
+ if (whyles->w_fename == 0) {
+ bseek(&whyles->w_start);
+ return;
+ }
+ /*
+ * The foreach variable list actually has a spurious word ")" at the end of
+ * the w_fe list. Thus we are at the of the list if one word beyond this
+ * is 0.
+ */
+ if (!whyles->w_fe[1]) {
+ dobreak(NULL, NULL);
+ return;
+ }
+ set(whyles->w_fename, Strsave(*whyles->w_fe++));
+ bseek(&whyles->w_start);
+}
+
+void
+dorepeat(v, kp)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *kp;
+{
+ register int i;
+ register sigset_t omask = 0;
+
+ i = getn(v[1]);
+ if (setintr)
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT)) & ~sigmask(SIGINT);
+ lshift(v, 2);
+ while (i > 0) {
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ reexecute(kp);
+ --i;
+ }
+ donefds();
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doswbrk(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ search(T_BRKSW, 0, NULL);
+}
+
+int
+srchx(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ register struct srch *sp, *sp1, *sp2;
+ register i;
+
+ /*
+ * Binary search Sp1 is the beginning of the current search range. Sp2 is
+ * one past the end.
+ */
+ for (sp1 = srchn, sp2 = srchn + nsrchn; sp1 < sp2;) {
+ sp = sp1 + ((sp2 - sp1) >> 1);
+ if ((i = *cp - *sp->s_name) == 0 &&
+ (i = Strcmp(cp, str2short(sp->s_name))) == 0)
+ return sp->s_value;
+ if (i < 0)
+ sp2 = sp;
+ else
+ sp1 = sp + 1;
+ }
+ return (-1);
+}
+
+static Char Stype;
+static Char *Sgoal;
+
+/*VARARGS2*/
+static void
+search(type, level, goal)
+ int type;
+ register int level;
+ Char *goal;
+{
+ Char wordbuf[BUFSIZ];
+ register Char *aword = wordbuf;
+ register Char *cp;
+
+ Stype = type;
+ Sgoal = goal;
+ if (type == T_GOTO) {
+ struct Ain a;
+ a.type = F_SEEK;
+ a.f_seek = 0;
+ bseek(&a);
+ }
+ do {
+ if (intty && fseekp == feobp && aret == F_SEEK)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "? "), (void) fflush(cshout);
+ aword[0] = 0;
+ (void) getword(aword);
+ switch (srchx(aword)) {
+
+ case T_ELSE:
+ if (level == 0 && type == T_IF)
+ return;
+ break;
+
+ case T_IF:
+ while (getword(aword))
+ continue;
+ if ((type == T_IF || type == T_ELSE) &&
+ eq(aword, STRthen))
+ level++;
+ break;
+
+ case T_ENDIF:
+ if (type == T_IF || type == T_ELSE)
+ level--;
+ break;
+
+ case T_FOREACH:
+ case T_WHILE:
+ if (type == T_BREAK)
+ level++;
+ break;
+
+ case T_END:
+ if (type == T_BREAK)
+ level--;
+ break;
+
+ case T_SWITCH:
+ if (type == T_SWITCH || type == T_BRKSW)
+ level++;
+ break;
+
+ case T_ENDSW:
+ if (type == T_SWITCH || type == T_BRKSW)
+ level--;
+ break;
+
+ case T_LABEL:
+ if (type == T_GOTO && getword(aword) && eq(aword, goal))
+ level = -1;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if (type != T_GOTO && (type != T_SWITCH || level != 0))
+ break;
+ if (lastchr(aword) != ':')
+ break;
+ aword[Strlen(aword) - 1] = 0;
+ if ((type == T_GOTO && eq(aword, goal)) ||
+ (type == T_SWITCH && eq(aword, STRdefault)))
+ level = -1;
+ break;
+
+ case T_CASE:
+ if (type != T_SWITCH || level != 0)
+ break;
+ (void) getword(aword);
+ if (lastchr(aword) == ':')
+ aword[Strlen(aword) - 1] = 0;
+ cp = strip(Dfix1(aword));
+ if (Gmatch(goal, cp))
+ level = -1;
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ break;
+
+ case T_DEFAULT:
+ if (type == T_SWITCH && level == 0)
+ level = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+ (void) getword(NULL);
+ } while (level >= 0);
+}
+
+static int
+getword(wp)
+ register Char *wp;
+{
+ register int found = 0;
+ register int c, d;
+ int kwd = 0;
+ Char *owp = wp;
+
+ c = readc(1);
+ d = 0;
+ do {
+ while (c == ' ' || c == '\t')
+ c = readc(1);
+ if (c == '#')
+ do
+ c = readc(1);
+ while (c >= 0 && c != '\n');
+ if (c < 0)
+ goto past;
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ if (wp)
+ break;
+ return (0);
+ }
+ unreadc(c);
+ found = 1;
+ do {
+ c = readc(1);
+ if (c == '\\' && (c = readc(1)) == '\n')
+ c = ' ';
+ if (c == '\'' || c == '"')
+ if (d == 0)
+ d = c;
+ else if (d == c)
+ d = 0;
+ if (c < 0)
+ goto past;
+ if (wp) {
+ *wp++ = c;
+ *wp = 0; /* end the string b4 test */
+ }
+ } while ((d || (!(kwd = keyword(owp)) && c != ' '
+ && c != '\t')) && c != '\n');
+ } while (wp == 0);
+
+ /*
+ * if we have read a keyword ( "if", "switch" or "while" ) then we do not
+ * need to unreadc the look-ahead char
+ */
+ if (!kwd) {
+ unreadc(c);
+ if (found)
+ *--wp = 0;
+ }
+
+ return (found);
+
+past:
+ switch (Stype) {
+
+ case T_IF:
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTFOUND, "then/endif");
+
+ case T_ELSE:
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTFOUND, "endif");
+
+ case T_BRKSW:
+ case T_SWITCH:
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTFOUND, "endsw");
+
+ case T_BREAK:
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTFOUND, "end");
+
+ case T_GOTO:
+ setname(vis_str(Sgoal));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOTFOUND, "label");
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * keyword(wp) determines if wp is one of the built-n functions if,
+ * switch or while. It seems that when an if statement looks like
+ * "if(" then getword above sucks in the '(' and so the search routine
+ * never finds what it is scanning for. Rather than rewrite doword, I hack
+ * in a test to see if the string forms a keyword. Then doword stops
+ * and returns the word "if" -strike
+ */
+
+static int
+keyword(wp)
+ Char *wp;
+{
+ static Char STRif[] = {'i', 'f', '\0'};
+ static Char STRwhile[] = {'w', 'h', 'i', 'l', 'e', '\0'};
+ static Char STRswitch[] = {'s', 'w', 'i', 't', 'c', 'h', '\0'};
+
+ if (!wp)
+ return (0);
+
+ if ((Strcmp(wp, STRif) == 0) || (Strcmp(wp, STRwhile) == 0)
+ || (Strcmp(wp, STRswitch) == 0))
+ return (1);
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static void
+toend()
+{
+ if (whyles->w_end.type == F_SEEK && whyles->w_end.f_seek == 0) {
+ search(T_BREAK, 0, NULL);
+ btell(&whyles->w_end);
+ whyles->w_end.f_seek--;
+ }
+ else
+ bseek(&whyles->w_end);
+ wfree();
+}
+
+void
+wfree()
+{
+ struct Ain o;
+ struct whyle *nwp;
+
+ btell(&o);
+
+ for (; whyles; whyles = nwp) {
+ register struct whyle *wp = whyles;
+ nwp = wp->w_next;
+
+ /*
+ * We free loops that have different seek types.
+ */
+ if (wp->w_end.type != I_SEEK && wp->w_start.type == wp->w_end.type &&
+ wp->w_start.type == o.type) {
+ if (wp->w_end.type == F_SEEK) {
+ if (o.f_seek >= wp->w_start.f_seek &&
+ (wp->w_end.f_seek == 0 || o.f_seek < wp->w_end.f_seek))
+ break;
+ }
+ else {
+ if (o.a_seek >= wp->w_start.a_seek &&
+ (wp->w_end.a_seek == 0 || o.a_seek < wp->w_end.a_seek))
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (wp->w_fe0)
+ blkfree(wp->w_fe0);
+ if (wp->w_fename)
+ xfree((ptr_t) wp->w_fename);
+ xfree((ptr_t) wp);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doecho(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ xecho(' ', v);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doglob(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ xecho(0, v);
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+}
+
+static void
+xecho(sep, v)
+ int sep;
+ register Char **v;
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+ int nonl = 0;
+
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(sigblock((sigset_t) 0) & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+ v++;
+ if (*v == 0)
+ return;
+ gflag = 0, tglob(v);
+ if (gflag) {
+ v = globall(v);
+ if (v == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ }
+ else {
+ v = gargv = saveblk(v);
+ trim(v);
+ }
+ if (sep == ' ' && *v && eq(*v, STRmn))
+ nonl++, v++;
+ while ((cp = *v++) != NULL) {
+ register int c;
+
+ while ((c = *cp++) != '\0')
+ (void) vis_fputc(c | QUOTE, cshout);
+
+ if (*v)
+ (void) vis_fputc(sep | QUOTE, cshout);
+ }
+ if (sep && nonl == 0)
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ else
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigblock(sigmask(SIGINT));
+ if (gargv)
+ blkfree(gargv), gargv = 0;
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dosetenv(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ Char *vp, *lp;
+
+ v++;
+ if ((vp = *v++) == 0) {
+ register Char **ep;
+
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(sigblock((sigset_t) 0) & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+ for (ep = STR_environ; *ep; ep++)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s\n", vis_str(*ep));
+ return;
+ }
+ if ((lp = *v++) == 0)
+ lp = STRNULL;
+ Setenv(vp, lp = globone(lp, G_APPEND));
+ if (eq(vp, STRPATH)) {
+ importpath(lp);
+ dohash(NULL, NULL);
+ }
+ else if (eq(vp, STRLANG) || eq(vp, STRLC_CTYPE)) {
+#ifdef NLS
+ int k;
+
+ (void) setlocale(LC_ALL, "");
+ for (k = 0200; k <= 0377 && !Isprint(k); k++)
+ continue;
+ AsciiOnly = k > 0377;
+#else
+ AsciiOnly = 0;
+#endif /* NLS */
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) lp);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dounsetenv(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ Char **ep, *p, *n;
+ int i, maxi;
+ static Char *name = NULL;
+
+ if (name)
+ xfree((ptr_t) name);
+ /*
+ * Find the longest environment variable
+ */
+ for (maxi = 0, ep = STR_environ; *ep; ep++) {
+ for (i = 0, p = *ep; *p && *p != '='; p++, i++)
+ continue;
+ if (i > maxi)
+ maxi = i;
+ }
+
+ name = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t) (maxi + 1) * sizeof(Char));
+
+ while (++v && *v)
+ for (maxi = 1; maxi;)
+ for (maxi = 0, ep = STR_environ; *ep; ep++) {
+ for (n = name, p = *ep; *p && *p != '='; *n++ = *p++)
+ continue;
+ *n = '\0';
+ if (!Gmatch(name, *v))
+ continue;
+ maxi = 1;
+ if (eq(name, STRLANG) || eq(name, STRLC_CTYPE)) {
+#ifdef NLS
+ int k;
+
+ (void) setlocale(LC_ALL, "");
+ for (k = 0200; k <= 0377 && !Isprint(k); k++)
+ continue;
+ AsciiOnly = k > 0377;
+#else
+ AsciiOnly = getenv("LANG") == NULL &&
+ getenv("LC_CTYPE") == NULL;
+#endif /* NLS */
+ }
+ /*
+ * Delete name, and start again cause the environment changes
+ */
+ Unsetenv(name);
+ break;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) name);
+ name = NULL;
+}
+
+void
+Setenv(name, val)
+ Char *name, *val;
+{
+ register Char **ep = STR_environ;
+ register Char *cp, *dp;
+ Char *blk[2];
+ Char **oep = ep;
+
+
+ for (; *ep; ep++) {
+ for (cp = name, dp = *ep; *cp && *cp == *dp; cp++, dp++)
+ continue;
+ if (*cp != 0 || *dp != '=')
+ continue;
+ cp = Strspl(STRequal, val);
+ xfree((ptr_t) * ep);
+ *ep = strip(Strspl(name, cp));
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ blkfree((Char **) environ);
+ environ = short2blk(STR_environ);
+ return;
+ }
+ cp = Strspl(name, STRequal);
+ blk[0] = strip(Strspl(cp, val));
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ blk[1] = 0;
+ STR_environ = blkspl(STR_environ, blk);
+ blkfree((Char **) environ);
+ environ = short2blk(STR_environ);
+ xfree((ptr_t) oep);
+}
+
+static void
+Unsetenv(name)
+ Char *name;
+{
+ register Char **ep = STR_environ;
+ register Char *cp, *dp;
+ Char **oep = ep;
+
+ for (; *ep; ep++) {
+ for (cp = name, dp = *ep; *cp && *cp == *dp; cp++, dp++)
+ continue;
+ if (*cp != 0 || *dp != '=')
+ continue;
+ cp = *ep;
+ *ep = 0;
+ STR_environ = blkspl(STR_environ, ep + 1);
+ environ = short2blk(STR_environ);
+ *ep = cp;
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) oep);
+ return;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doumask(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp = v[1];
+ register int i;
+
+ if (cp == 0) {
+ i = umask(0);
+ (void) umask(i);
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%o\n", i);
+ return;
+ }
+ i = 0;
+ while (Isdigit(*cp) && *cp != '8' && *cp != '9')
+ i = i * 8 + *cp++ - '0';
+ if (*cp || i < 0 || i > 0777)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_MASK);
+ (void) umask(i);
+}
+
+typedef quad_t RLIM_TYPE;
+
+static struct limits {
+ int limconst;
+ char *limname;
+ int limdiv;
+ char *limscale;
+} limits[] = {
+ { RLIMIT_CPU, "cputime", 1, "seconds" },
+ { RLIMIT_FSIZE, "filesize", 1024, "kbytes" },
+ { RLIMIT_DATA, "datasize", 1024, "kbytes" },
+ { RLIMIT_STACK, "stacksize", 1024, "kbytes" },
+ { RLIMIT_CORE, "coredumpsize", 1024, "kbytes" },
+ { RLIMIT_RSS, "memoryuse", 1024, "kbytes" },
+ { RLIMIT_MEMLOCK, "memorylocked", 1024, "kbytes" },
+ { RLIMIT_NPROC, "maxproc", 1, "" },
+ { RLIMIT_NOFILE, "openfiles", 1, "" },
+ { -1, NULL, 0, NULL }
+};
+
+static struct limits *findlim();
+static RLIM_TYPE getval();
+static void limtail();
+static void plim();
+static int setlim();
+
+static struct limits *
+findlim(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ register struct limits *lp, *res;
+
+ res = (struct limits *) NULL;
+ for (lp = limits; lp->limconst >= 0; lp++)
+ if (prefix(cp, str2short(lp->limname))) {
+ if (res)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_AMBIG);
+ res = lp;
+ }
+ if (res)
+ return (res);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_LIMIT);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dolimit(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct limits *lp;
+ register RLIM_TYPE limit;
+ char hard = 0;
+
+ v++;
+ if (*v && eq(*v, STRmh)) {
+ hard = 1;
+ v++;
+ }
+ if (*v == 0) {
+ for (lp = limits; lp->limconst >= 0; lp++)
+ plim(lp, hard);
+ return;
+ }
+ lp = findlim(v[0]);
+ if (v[1] == 0) {
+ plim(lp, hard);
+ return;
+ }
+ limit = getval(lp, v + 1);
+ if (setlim(lp, hard, limit) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+}
+
+static RLIM_TYPE
+getval(lp, v)
+ register struct limits *lp;
+ Char **v;
+{
+ register float f;
+ double atof();
+ Char *cp = *v++;
+
+ f = atof(short2str(cp));
+
+ while (Isdigit(*cp) || *cp == '.' || *cp == 'e' || *cp == 'E')
+ cp++;
+ if (*cp == 0) {
+ if (*v == 0)
+ return ((RLIM_TYPE) ((f + 0.5) * lp->limdiv));
+ cp = *v;
+ }
+ switch (*cp) {
+ case ':':
+ if (lp->limconst != RLIMIT_CPU)
+ goto badscal;
+ return ((RLIM_TYPE) (f * 60.0 + atof(short2str(cp + 1))));
+ case 'h':
+ if (lp->limconst != RLIMIT_CPU)
+ goto badscal;
+ limtail(cp, "hours");
+ f *= 3600.0;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ if (lp->limconst == RLIMIT_CPU) {
+ limtail(cp, "minutes");
+ f *= 60.0;
+ break;
+ }
+ *cp = 'm';
+ limtail(cp, "megabytes");
+ f *= 1024.0 * 1024.0;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ if (lp->limconst != RLIMIT_CPU)
+ goto badscal;
+ limtail(cp, "seconds");
+ break;
+ case 'M':
+ if (lp->limconst == RLIMIT_CPU)
+ goto badscal;
+ *cp = 'm';
+ limtail(cp, "megabytes");
+ f *= 1024.0 * 1024.0;
+ break;
+ case 'k':
+ if (lp->limconst == RLIMIT_CPU)
+ goto badscal;
+ limtail(cp, "kbytes");
+ f *= 1024.0;
+ break;
+ case 'u':
+ limtail(cp, "unlimited");
+ return (RLIM_INFINITY);
+ default:
+badscal:
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_SCALEF);
+ }
+ f += 0.5;
+ if (f > (float) RLIM_INFINITY)
+ return RLIM_INFINITY;
+ else
+ return ((RLIM_TYPE) f);
+}
+
+static void
+limtail(cp, str)
+ Char *cp;
+ char *str;
+{
+ while (*cp && *cp == *str)
+ cp++, str++;
+ if (*cp)
+ stderror(ERR_BADSCALE, str);
+}
+
+
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+static void
+plim(lp, hard)
+ register struct limits *lp;
+ Char hard;
+{
+ struct rlimit rlim;
+ RLIM_TYPE limit;
+
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s \t", lp->limname);
+
+ (void) getrlimit(lp->limconst, &rlim);
+ limit = hard ? rlim.rlim_max : rlim.rlim_cur;
+
+ if (limit == RLIM_INFINITY)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "unlimited");
+ else if (lp->limconst == RLIMIT_CPU)
+ psecs((long) limit);
+ else
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld %s", (long) (limit / lp->limdiv),
+ lp->limscale);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dounlimit(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct limits *lp;
+ int lerr = 0;
+ Char hard = 0;
+
+ v++;
+ if (*v && eq(*v, STRmh)) {
+ hard = 1;
+ v++;
+ }
+ if (*v == 0) {
+ for (lp = limits; lp->limconst >= 0; lp++)
+ if (setlim(lp, hard, (RLIM_TYPE) RLIM_INFINITY) < 0)
+ lerr++;
+ if (lerr)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+ return;
+ }
+ while (*v) {
+ lp = findlim(*v++);
+ if (setlim(lp, hard, (RLIM_TYPE) RLIM_INFINITY) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+ }
+}
+
+static int
+setlim(lp, hard, limit)
+ register struct limits *lp;
+ Char hard;
+ RLIM_TYPE limit;
+{
+ struct rlimit rlim;
+
+ (void) getrlimit(lp->limconst, &rlim);
+
+ if (hard)
+ rlim.rlim_max = limit;
+ else if (limit == RLIM_INFINITY && geteuid() != 0)
+ rlim.rlim_cur = rlim.rlim_max;
+ else
+ rlim.rlim_cur = limit;
+
+ if (setrlimit(lp->limconst, &rlim) < 0) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s: %s: Can't %s%s limit\n", bname, lp->limname,
+ limit == RLIM_INFINITY ? "remove" : "set",
+ hard ? " hard" : "");
+ return (-1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dosuspend(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ int ctpgrp;
+
+ void (*old) ();
+
+ if (loginsh)
+ stderror(ERR_SUSPLOG);
+ untty();
+
+ old = signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) kill(0, SIGTSTP);
+ /* the shell stops here */
+ (void) signal(SIGTSTP, old);
+
+ if (tpgrp != -1) {
+ ctpgrp = tcgetpgrp(FSHTTY);
+ while (ctpgrp != opgrp) {
+ old = signal(SIGTTIN, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) kill(0, SIGTTIN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTIN, old);
+ }
+ (void) setpgid(0, shpgrp);
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, shpgrp);
+ }
+}
+
+/* This is the dreaded EVAL built-in.
+ * If you don't fiddle with file descriptors, and reset didfds,
+ * this command will either ignore redirection inside or outside
+ * its aguments, e.g. eval "date >x" vs. eval "date" >x
+ * The stuff here seems to work, but I did it by trial and error rather
+ * than really knowing what was going on. If tpgrp is zero, we are
+ * probably a background eval, e.g. "eval date &", and we want to
+ * make sure that any processes we start stay in our pgrp.
+ * This is also the case for "time eval date" -- stay in same pgrp.
+ * Otherwise, under stty tostop, processes will stop in the wrong
+ * pgrp, with no way for the shell to get them going again. -IAN!
+ */
+static Char **gv = NULL;
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doeval(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ Char **oevalvec;
+ Char *oevalp;
+ int odidfds;
+ jmp_buf osetexit;
+ int my_reenter;
+ Char **savegv = gv;
+ int saveIN;
+ int saveOUT;
+ int saveERR;
+ int oSHIN;
+ int oSHOUT;
+ int oSHERR;
+
+ UNREGISTER(v);
+
+ oevalvec = evalvec;
+ oevalp = evalp;
+ odidfds = didfds;
+ oSHIN = SHIN;
+ oSHOUT = SHOUT;
+ oSHERR = SHERR;
+
+ v++;
+ if (*v == 0)
+ return;
+ gflag = 0, tglob(v);
+ if (gflag) {
+ gv = v = globall(v);
+ gargv = 0;
+ if (v == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NOMATCH);
+ v = copyblk(v);
+ }
+ else {
+ gv = NULL;
+ v = copyblk(v);
+ trim(v);
+ }
+
+ saveIN = dcopy(SHIN, -1);
+ saveOUT = dcopy(SHOUT, -1);
+ saveERR = dcopy(SHERR, -1);
+
+ getexit(osetexit);
+
+ if ((my_reenter = setexit()) == 0) {
+ evalvec = v;
+ evalp = 0;
+ SHIN = dcopy(0, -1);
+ SHOUT = dcopy(1, -1);
+ SHERR = dcopy(2, -1);
+ didfds = 0;
+ process(0);
+ }
+
+ evalvec = oevalvec;
+ evalp = oevalp;
+ doneinp = 0;
+ didfds = odidfds;
+ (void) close(SHIN);
+ (void) close(SHOUT);
+ (void) close(SHERR);
+ SHIN = dmove(saveIN, oSHIN);
+ SHOUT = dmove(saveOUT, oSHOUT);
+ SHERR = dmove(saveERR, oSHERR);
+ if (gv)
+ blkfree(gv), gv = NULL;
+ resexit(osetexit);
+ gv = savegv;
+ if (my_reenter)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doprintf(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ char **c;
+ extern int progprintf __P((int, char **));
+ int ret;
+
+ ret = progprintf(blklen(v), c = short2blk(v));
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+ (void) fflush(csherr);
+
+ blkfree((Char **) c);
+ if (ret)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/glob.c b/bin/csh/glob.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bdbebad
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/glob.c
@@ -0,0 +1,939 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)glob.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <glob.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int noglob;
+static int pargsiz, gargsiz;
+
+/*
+ * Values for gflag
+ */
+#define G_NONE 0 /* No globbing needed */
+#define G_GLOB 1 /* string contains *?[] characters */
+#define G_CSH 2 /* string contains ~`{ characters */
+
+#define GLOBSPACE 100 /* Alloc increment */
+
+#define LBRC '{'
+#define RBRC '}'
+#define LBRK '['
+#define RBRK ']'
+#define EOS '\0'
+
+Char **gargv = NULL;
+long gargc = 0;
+Char **pargv = NULL;
+long pargc = 0;
+
+/*
+ * globbing is now done in two stages. In the first pass we expand
+ * csh globbing idioms ~`{ and then we proceed doing the normal
+ * globbing if needed ?*[
+ *
+ * Csh type globbing is handled in globexpand() and the rest is
+ * handled in glob() which is part of the 4.4BSD libc.
+ *
+ */
+static Char *globtilde __P((Char **, Char *));
+static Char **libglob __P((Char **));
+static Char **globexpand __P((Char **));
+static int globbrace __P((Char *, Char *, Char ***));
+static void expbrace __P((Char ***, Char ***, int));
+static int pmatch __P((Char *, Char *));
+static void pword __P((void));
+static void psave __P((int));
+static void backeval __P((Char *, bool));
+
+
+static Char *
+globtilde(nv, s)
+ Char **nv, *s;
+{
+ Char gbuf[MAXPATHLEN], *gstart, *b, *u, *e;
+
+ gstart = gbuf;
+ *gstart++ = *s++;
+ u = s;
+ for (b = gstart, e = &gbuf[MAXPATHLEN - 1];
+ *s && *s != '/' && *s != ':' && b < e;
+ *b++ = *s++)
+ continue;
+ *b = EOS;
+ if (gethdir(gstart)) {
+ blkfree(nv);
+ if (*gstart)
+ stderror(ERR_UNKUSER, vis_str(gstart));
+ else
+ stderror(ERR_NOHOME);
+ }
+ b = &gstart[Strlen(gstart)];
+ while (*s)
+ *b++ = *s++;
+ *b = EOS;
+ --u;
+ xfree((ptr_t) u);
+ return (Strsave(gstart));
+}
+
+static int
+globbrace(s, p, bl)
+ Char *s, *p, ***bl;
+{
+ int i, len;
+ Char *pm, *pe, *lm, *pl;
+ Char **nv, **vl;
+ Char gbuf[MAXPATHLEN];
+ int size = GLOBSPACE;
+
+ nv = vl = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(Char *) * size);
+ *vl = NULL;
+
+ len = 0;
+ /* copy part up to the brace */
+ for (lm = gbuf, p = s; *p != LBRC; *lm++ = *p++)
+ continue;
+
+ /* check for balanced braces */
+ for (i = 0, pe = ++p; *pe; pe++)
+ if (*pe == LBRK) {
+ /* Ignore everything between [] */
+ for (++pe; *pe != RBRK && *pe != EOS; pe++)
+ continue;
+ if (*pe == EOS) {
+ blkfree(nv);
+ return (-RBRK);
+ }
+ }
+ else if (*pe == LBRC)
+ i++;
+ else if (*pe == RBRC) {
+ if (i == 0)
+ break;
+ i--;
+ }
+
+ if (i != 0 || *pe == '\0') {
+ blkfree(nv);
+ return (-RBRC);
+ }
+
+ for (i = 0, pl = pm = p; pm <= pe; pm++)
+ switch (*pm) {
+ case LBRK:
+ for (++pm; *pm != RBRK && *pm != EOS; pm++)
+ continue;
+ if (*pm == EOS) {
+ *vl = NULL;
+ blkfree(nv);
+ return (-RBRK);
+ }
+ break;
+ case LBRC:
+ i++;
+ break;
+ case RBRC:
+ if (i) {
+ i--;
+ break;
+ }
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case ',':
+ if (i && *pm == ',')
+ break;
+ else {
+ Char savec = *pm;
+
+ *pm = EOS;
+ (void) Strcpy(lm, pl);
+ (void) Strcat(gbuf, pe + 1);
+ *pm = savec;
+ *vl++ = Strsave(gbuf);
+ len++;
+ pl = pm + 1;
+ if (vl == &nv[size]) {
+ size += GLOBSPACE;
+ nv = (Char **) xrealloc((ptr_t) nv, (size_t)
+ size * sizeof(Char *));
+ vl = &nv[size - GLOBSPACE];
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ *vl = NULL;
+ *bl = nv;
+ return (len);
+}
+
+
+static void
+expbrace(nvp, elp, size)
+ Char ***nvp, ***elp;
+ int size;
+{
+ Char **vl, **el, **nv, *s;
+
+ vl = nv = *nvp;
+ if (elp != NULL)
+ el = *elp;
+ else
+ for (el = vl; *el; el++)
+ continue;
+
+ for (s = *vl; s; s = *++vl) {
+ Char *b;
+ Char **vp, **bp;
+
+ /* leave {} untouched for find */
+ if (s[0] == '{' && (s[1] == '\0' || (s[1] == '}' && s[2] == '\0')))
+ continue;
+ if ((b = Strchr(s, '{')) != NULL) {
+ Char **bl;
+ int len;
+
+ if ((len = globbrace(s, b, &bl)) < 0) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) nv);
+ stderror(ERR_MISSING, -len);
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) s);
+ if (len == 1) {
+ *vl-- = *bl;
+ xfree((ptr_t) bl);
+ continue;
+ }
+ len = blklen(bl);
+ if (&el[len] >= &nv[size]) {
+ int l, e;
+
+ l = &el[len] - &nv[size];
+ size += GLOBSPACE > l ? GLOBSPACE : l;
+ l = vl - nv;
+ e = el - nv;
+ nv = (Char **) xrealloc((ptr_t) nv, (size_t)
+ size * sizeof(Char *));
+ vl = nv + l;
+ el = nv + e;
+ }
+ vp = vl--;
+ *vp = *bl;
+ len--;
+ for (bp = el; bp != vp; bp--)
+ bp[len] = *bp;
+ el += len;
+ vp++;
+ for (bp = bl + 1; *bp; *vp++ = *bp++)
+ continue;
+ xfree((ptr_t) bl);
+ }
+
+ }
+ if (elp != NULL)
+ *elp = el;
+ *nvp = nv;
+}
+
+static Char **
+globexpand(v)
+ Char **v;
+{
+ Char *s;
+ Char **nv, **vl, **el;
+ int size = GLOBSPACE;
+
+
+ nv = vl = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(Char *) * size);
+ *vl = NULL;
+
+ /*
+ * Step 1: expand backquotes.
+ */
+ while ((s = *v++) != NULL) {
+ if (Strchr(s, '`')) {
+ int i;
+
+ (void) dobackp(s, 0);
+ for (i = 0; i < pargc; i++) {
+ *vl++ = pargv[i];
+ if (vl == &nv[size]) {
+ size += GLOBSPACE;
+ nv = (Char **) xrealloc((ptr_t) nv,
+ (size_t) size * sizeof(Char *));
+ vl = &nv[size - GLOBSPACE];
+ }
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) pargv);
+ pargv = NULL;
+ }
+ else {
+ *vl++ = Strsave(s);
+ if (vl == &nv[size]) {
+ size += GLOBSPACE;
+ nv = (Char **) xrealloc((ptr_t) nv, (size_t)
+ size * sizeof(Char *));
+ vl = &nv[size - GLOBSPACE];
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ *vl = NULL;
+
+ if (noglob)
+ return (nv);
+
+ /*
+ * Step 2: expand braces
+ */
+ el = vl;
+ expbrace(&nv, &el, size);
+
+ /*
+ * Step 3: expand ~
+ */
+ vl = nv;
+ for (s = *vl; s; s = *++vl)
+ if (*s == '~')
+ *vl = globtilde(nv, s);
+ vl = nv;
+ return (vl);
+}
+
+static Char *
+handleone(str, vl, action)
+ Char *str, **vl;
+ int action;
+{
+
+ Char *cp, **vlp = vl;
+
+ switch (action) {
+ case G_ERROR:
+ setname(vis_str(str));
+ blkfree(vl);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_AMBIG);
+ break;
+ case G_APPEND:
+ trim(vlp);
+ str = Strsave(*vlp++);
+ do {
+ cp = Strspl(str, STRspace);
+ xfree((ptr_t) str);
+ str = Strspl(cp, *vlp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ }
+ while (*++vlp);
+ blkfree(vl);
+ break;
+ case G_IGNORE:
+ str = Strsave(strip(*vlp));
+ blkfree(vl);
+ break;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ return (str);
+}
+
+static Char **
+libglob(vl)
+ Char **vl;
+{
+ int gflgs = GLOB_QUOTE | GLOB_NOMAGIC;
+ glob_t globv;
+ char *ptr;
+ int nonomatch = adrof(STRnonomatch) != 0, magic = 0, match = 0;
+
+ if (!vl || !vl[0])
+ return (vl);
+
+ globv.gl_offs = 0;
+ globv.gl_pathv = 0;
+ globv.gl_pathc = 0;
+
+ if (nonomatch)
+ gflgs |= GLOB_NOCHECK;
+
+ do {
+ ptr = short2qstr(*vl);
+ switch (glob(ptr, gflgs, 0, &globv)) {
+ case GLOB_ABEND:
+ setname(vis_str(*vl));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_GLOB);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ case GLOB_NOSPACE:
+ stderror(ERR_NOMEM);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ if (globv.gl_flags & GLOB_MAGCHAR) {
+ match |= (globv.gl_matchc != 0);
+ magic = 1;
+ }
+ gflgs |= GLOB_APPEND;
+ }
+ while (*++vl);
+ vl = (globv.gl_pathc == 0 || (magic && !match && !nonomatch)) ?
+ NULL : blk2short(globv.gl_pathv);
+ globfree(&globv);
+ return (vl);
+}
+
+Char *
+globone(str, action)
+ Char *str;
+ int action;
+{
+ Char *v[2], **vl, **vo;
+ int gflg;
+
+ noglob = adrof(STRnoglob) != 0;
+ gflag = 0;
+ v[0] = str;
+ v[1] = 0;
+ tglob(v);
+ gflg = gflag;
+ if (gflg == G_NONE)
+ return (strip(Strsave(str)));
+
+ if (gflg & G_CSH) {
+ /*
+ * Expand back-quote, tilde and brace
+ */
+ vo = globexpand(v);
+ if (noglob || (gflg & G_GLOB) == 0) {
+ if (vo[0] == NULL) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) vo);
+ return (Strsave(STRNULL));
+ }
+ if (vo[1] != NULL)
+ return (handleone(str, vo, action));
+ else {
+ str = strip(vo[0]);
+ xfree((ptr_t) vo);
+ return (str);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else if (noglob || (gflg & G_GLOB) == 0)
+ return (strip(Strsave(str)));
+ else
+ vo = v;
+
+ vl = libglob(vo);
+ if ((gflg & G_CSH) && vl != vo)
+ blkfree(vo);
+ if (vl == NULL) {
+ setname(vis_str(str));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ }
+ if (vl[0] == NULL) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) vl);
+ return (Strsave(STRNULL));
+ }
+ if (vl[1] != NULL)
+ return (handleone(str, vl, action));
+ else {
+ str = strip(*vl);
+ xfree((ptr_t) vl);
+ return (str);
+ }
+}
+
+Char **
+globall(v)
+ Char **v;
+{
+ Char **vl, **vo;
+ int gflg = gflag;
+
+ if (!v || !v[0]) {
+ gargv = saveblk(v);
+ gargc = blklen(gargv);
+ return (gargv);
+ }
+
+ noglob = adrof(STRnoglob) != 0;
+
+ if (gflg & G_CSH)
+ /*
+ * Expand back-quote, tilde and brace
+ */
+ vl = vo = globexpand(v);
+ else
+ vl = vo = saveblk(v);
+
+ if (!noglob && (gflg & G_GLOB)) {
+ vl = libglob(vo);
+ if ((gflg & G_CSH) && vl != vo)
+ blkfree(vo);
+ }
+ else
+ trim(vl);
+
+ gargc = vl ? blklen(vl) : 0;
+ return (gargv = vl);
+}
+
+void
+ginit()
+{
+ gargsiz = GLOBSPACE;
+ gargv = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(Char *) * gargsiz);
+ gargv[0] = 0;
+ gargc = 0;
+}
+
+void
+rscan(t, f)
+ register Char **t;
+ void (*f) ();
+{
+ register Char *p;
+
+ while ((p = *t++) != NULL)
+ while (*p)
+ (*f) (*p++);
+}
+
+void
+trim(t)
+ register Char **t;
+{
+ register Char *p;
+
+ while ((p = *t++) != NULL)
+ while (*p)
+ *p++ &= TRIM;
+}
+
+void
+tglob(t)
+ register Char **t;
+{
+ register Char *p, c;
+
+ while ((p = *t++) != NULL) {
+ if (*p == '~' || *p == '=')
+ gflag |= G_CSH;
+ else if (*p == '{' &&
+ (p[1] == '\0' || (p[1] == '}' && p[2] == '\0')))
+ continue;
+ while ((c = *p++) != '\0') {
+ /*
+ * eat everything inside the matching backquotes
+ */
+ if (c == '`') {
+ gflag |= G_CSH;
+ while (*p && *p != '`')
+ if (*p++ == '\\') {
+ if (*p) /* Quoted chars */
+ p++;
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ if (*p) /* The matching ` */
+ p++;
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ else if (c == '{')
+ gflag |= G_CSH;
+ else if (isglob(c))
+ gflag |= G_GLOB;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Command substitute cp. If literal, then this is a substitution from a
+ * << redirection, and so we should not crunch blanks and tabs, separating
+ * words only at newlines.
+ */
+Char **
+dobackp(cp, literal)
+ Char *cp;
+ bool literal;
+{
+ register Char *lp, *rp;
+ Char *ep, word[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ if (pargv) {
+#ifdef notdef
+ abort();
+#endif
+ blkfree(pargv);
+ }
+ pargsiz = GLOBSPACE;
+ pargv = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(Char *) * pargsiz);
+ pargv[0] = NULL;
+ pargcp = pargs = word;
+ pargc = 0;
+ pnleft = MAXPATHLEN - 4;
+ for (;;) {
+ for (lp = cp; *lp != '`'; lp++) {
+ if (*lp == 0) {
+ if (pargcp != pargs)
+ pword();
+ return (pargv);
+ }
+ psave(*lp);
+ }
+ lp++;
+ for (rp = lp; *rp && *rp != '`'; rp++)
+ if (*rp == '\\') {
+ rp++;
+ if (!*rp)
+ goto oops;
+ }
+ if (!*rp)
+ oops: stderror(ERR_UNMATCHED, '`');
+ ep = Strsave(lp);
+ ep[rp - lp] = 0;
+ backeval(ep, literal);
+ cp = rp + 1;
+ }
+}
+
+static void
+backeval(cp, literal)
+ Char *cp;
+ bool literal;
+{
+ register int icnt, c;
+ register Char *ip;
+ struct command faket;
+ bool hadnl;
+ int pvec[2], quoted;
+ Char *fakecom[2], ibuf[BUFSIZ];
+ char tibuf[BUFSIZ];
+
+ hadnl = 0;
+ icnt = 0;
+ quoted = (literal || (cp[0] & QUOTE)) ? QUOTE : 0;
+ faket.t_dtyp = NODE_COMMAND;
+ faket.t_dflg = 0;
+ faket.t_dlef = 0;
+ faket.t_drit = 0;
+ faket.t_dspr = 0;
+ faket.t_dcom = fakecom;
+ fakecom[0] = STRfakecom1;
+ fakecom[1] = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * We do the psave job to temporarily change the current job so that the
+ * following fork is considered a separate job. This is so that when
+ * backquotes are used in a builtin function that calls glob the "current
+ * job" is not corrupted. We only need one level of pushed jobs as long as
+ * we are sure to fork here.
+ */
+ psavejob();
+
+ /*
+ * It would be nicer if we could integrate this redirection more with the
+ * routines in sh.sem.c by doing a fake execute on a builtin function that
+ * was piped out.
+ */
+ mypipe(pvec);
+ if (pfork(&faket, -1) == 0) {
+ struct wordent paraml;
+ struct command *t;
+
+ (void) close(pvec[0]);
+ (void) dmove(pvec[1], 1);
+ (void) dmove(SHERR, 2);
+ initdesc();
+ /*
+ * Bugfix for nested backquotes by Michael Greim <greim@sbsvax.UUCP>,
+ * posted to comp.bugs.4bsd 12 Sep. 1989.
+ */
+ if (pargv) /* mg, 21.dec.88 */
+ blkfree(pargv), pargv = 0, pargsiz = 0;
+ /* mg, 21.dec.88 */
+ arginp = cp;
+ while (*cp)
+ *cp++ &= TRIM;
+
+ /*
+ * In the child ``forget'' everything about current aliases or
+ * eval vectors.
+ */
+ alvec = NULL;
+ evalvec = NULL;
+ alvecp = NULL;
+ evalp = NULL;
+ (void) lex(&paraml);
+ if (seterr)
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+ alias(&paraml);
+ t = syntax(paraml.next, &paraml, 0);
+ if (seterr)
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+ if (t)
+ t->t_dflg |= F_NOFORK;
+ (void) signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTIN, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTOU, SIG_IGN);
+ execute(t, -1, NULL, NULL);
+ exitstat();
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ (void) close(pvec[1]);
+ c = 0;
+ ip = NULL;
+ do {
+ int cnt = 0;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ if (icnt == 0) {
+ int i;
+
+ ip = ibuf;
+ do
+ icnt = read(pvec[0], tibuf, BUFSIZ);
+ while (icnt == -1 && errno == EINTR);
+ if (icnt <= 0) {
+ c = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+ for (i = 0; i < icnt; i++)
+ ip[i] = (unsigned char) tibuf[i];
+ }
+ if (hadnl)
+ break;
+ --icnt;
+ c = (*ip++ & TRIM);
+ if (c == 0)
+ break;
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ /*
+ * Continue around the loop one more time, so that we can eat
+ * the last newline without terminating this word.
+ */
+ hadnl = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (!quoted && (c == ' ' || c == '\t'))
+ break;
+ cnt++;
+ psave(c | quoted);
+ }
+ /*
+ * Unless at end-of-file, we will form a new word here if there were
+ * characters in the word, or in any case when we take text literally.
+ * If we didn't make empty words here when literal was set then we
+ * would lose blank lines.
+ */
+ if (c != -1 && (cnt || literal))
+ pword();
+ hadnl = 0;
+ } while (c >= 0);
+ (void) close(pvec[0]);
+ pwait();
+ prestjob();
+}
+
+static void
+psave(c)
+ int c;
+{
+ if (--pnleft <= 0)
+ stderror(ERR_WTOOLONG);
+ *pargcp++ = c;
+}
+
+static void
+pword()
+{
+ psave(0);
+ if (pargc == pargsiz - 1) {
+ pargsiz += GLOBSPACE;
+ pargv = (Char **) xrealloc((ptr_t) pargv,
+ (size_t) pargsiz * sizeof(Char *));
+ }
+ pargv[pargc++] = Strsave(pargs);
+ pargv[pargc] = NULL;
+ pargcp = pargs;
+ pnleft = MAXPATHLEN - 4;
+}
+
+int
+Gmatch(string, pattern)
+ Char *string, *pattern;
+{
+ Char **blk, **p;
+ int gpol = 1, gres = 0;
+
+ if (*pattern == '^') {
+ gpol = 0;
+ pattern++;
+ }
+
+ blk = (Char **) xmalloc(GLOBSPACE * sizeof(Char *));
+ blk[0] = Strsave(pattern);
+ blk[1] = NULL;
+
+ expbrace(&blk, NULL, GLOBSPACE);
+
+ for (p = blk; *p; p++)
+ gres |= pmatch(string, *p);
+
+ blkfree(blk);
+ return(gres == gpol);
+}
+
+static int
+pmatch(string, pattern)
+ register Char *string, *pattern;
+{
+ register Char stringc, patternc;
+ int match, negate_range;
+ Char rangec;
+
+ for (;; ++string) {
+ stringc = *string & TRIM;
+ patternc = *pattern++;
+ switch (patternc) {
+ case 0:
+ return (stringc == 0);
+ case '?':
+ if (stringc == 0)
+ return (0);
+ break;
+ case '*':
+ if (!*pattern)
+ return (1);
+ while (*string)
+ if (Gmatch(string++, pattern))
+ return (1);
+ return (0);
+ case '[':
+ match = 0;
+ if ((negate_range = (*pattern == '^')) != 0)
+ pattern++;
+ while ((rangec = *pattern++) != '\0') {
+ if (rangec == ']')
+ break;
+ if (match)
+ continue;
+ if (rangec == '-' && *(pattern-2) != '[' && *pattern != ']') {
+ match = (stringc <= (*pattern & TRIM) &&
+ (*(pattern-2) & TRIM) <= stringc);
+ pattern++;
+ }
+ else
+ match = (stringc == (rangec & TRIM));
+ }
+ if (rangec == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_MISSING, ']');
+ if (match == negate_range)
+ return (0);
+ break;
+ default:
+ if ((patternc & TRIM) != stringc)
+ return (0);
+ break;
+
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+void
+Gcat(s1, s2)
+ Char *s1, *s2;
+{
+ register Char *p, *q;
+ int n;
+
+ for (p = s1; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ for (q = s2; *q++;)
+ continue;
+ n = (p - s1) + (q - s2) - 1;
+ if (++gargc >= gargsiz) {
+ gargsiz += GLOBSPACE;
+ gargv = (Char **) xrealloc((ptr_t) gargv,
+ (size_t) gargsiz * sizeof(Char *));
+ }
+ gargv[gargc] = 0;
+ p = gargv[gargc - 1] = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t) n * sizeof(Char));
+ for (q = s1; (*p++ = *q++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p--, q = s2; (*p++ = *q++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+}
+
+#ifdef FILEC
+int
+sortscmp(a, b)
+ register const ptr_t a, b;
+{
+#if defined(NLS) && !defined(NOSTRCOLL)
+ char buf[2048];
+#endif
+
+ if (!a) /* check for NULL */
+ return (b ? 1 : 0);
+ if (!b)
+ return (-1);
+
+ if (!*(Char **)a) /* check for NULL */
+ return (*(Char **)b ? 1 : 0);
+ if (!*(Char **)b)
+ return (-1);
+
+#if defined(NLS) && !defined(NOSTRCOLL)
+ (void) strcpy(buf, short2str(*(Char **)a));
+ return ((int) strcoll(buf, short2str(*(Char **)b)));
+#else
+ return ((int) Strcmp(*(Char **)a, *(Char **)b));
+#endif
+}
+#endif /* FILEC */
diff --git a/bin/csh/hist.c b/bin/csh/hist.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d55a416
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/hist.c
@@ -0,0 +1,184 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)hist.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void hfree __P((struct Hist *));
+static void dohist1 __P((struct Hist *, int *, int, int));
+static void phist __P((struct Hist *, int));
+
+void
+savehist(sp)
+ struct wordent *sp;
+{
+ register struct Hist *hp, *np;
+ register int histlen = 0;
+ Char *cp;
+
+ /* throw away null lines */
+ if (sp->next->word[0] == '\n')
+ return;
+ cp = value(STRhistory);
+ if (*cp) {
+ register Char *p = cp;
+
+ while (*p) {
+ if (!Isdigit(*p)) {
+ histlen = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ histlen = histlen * 10 + *p++ - '0';
+ }
+ }
+ for (hp = &Histlist; (np = hp->Hnext) != NULL;)
+ if (eventno - np->Href >= histlen || histlen == 0)
+ hp->Hnext = np->Hnext, hfree(np);
+ else
+ hp = np;
+ (void) enthist(++eventno, sp, 1);
+}
+
+struct Hist *
+enthist(event, lp, docopy)
+ int event;
+ register struct wordent *lp;
+ bool docopy;
+{
+ register struct Hist *np;
+
+ np = (struct Hist *) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(*np));
+ np->Hnum = np->Href = event;
+ if (docopy) {
+ copylex(&np->Hlex, lp);
+ }
+ else {
+ np->Hlex.next = lp->next;
+ lp->next->prev = &np->Hlex;
+ np->Hlex.prev = lp->prev;
+ lp->prev->next = &np->Hlex;
+ }
+ np->Hnext = Histlist.Hnext;
+ Histlist.Hnext = np;
+ return (np);
+}
+
+static void
+hfree(hp)
+ register struct Hist *hp;
+{
+
+ freelex(&hp->Hlex);
+ xfree((ptr_t) hp);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dohist(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ int n, rflg = 0, hflg = 0;
+
+ if (getn(value(STRhistory)) == 0)
+ return;
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(sigblock((sigset_t) 0) & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+ while (*++v && **v == '-') {
+ Char *vp = *v;
+
+ while (*++vp)
+ switch (*vp) {
+ case 'h':
+ hflg++;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ rflg++;
+ break;
+ case '-': /* ignore multiple '-'s */
+ break;
+ default:
+ stderror(ERR_HISTUS);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (*v)
+ n = getn(*v);
+ else {
+ n = getn(value(STRhistory));
+ }
+ dohist1(Histlist.Hnext, &n, rflg, hflg);
+}
+
+static void
+dohist1(hp, np, rflg, hflg)
+ struct Hist *hp;
+ int *np, rflg, hflg;
+{
+ bool print = (*np) > 0;
+
+ for (; hp != 0; hp = hp->Hnext) {
+ (*np)--;
+ hp->Href++;
+ if (rflg == 0) {
+ dohist1(hp->Hnext, np, rflg, hflg);
+ if (print)
+ phist(hp, hflg);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (*np >= 0)
+ phist(hp, hflg);
+ }
+}
+
+static void
+phist(hp, hflg)
+ register struct Hist *hp;
+ int hflg;
+{
+ if (hflg == 0)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%6d\t", hp->Hnum);
+ prlex(cshout, &hp->Hlex);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/init.c b/bin/csh/init.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..906eea3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/init.c
@@ -0,0 +1,135 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+/*###9 [cc] warning: `sccsid' defined but not used%%%*/
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)init.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#define INF 1000
+
+struct biltins bfunc[] =
+{
+ { "@", dolet, 0, INF },
+ { "alias", doalias, 0, INF },
+ { "alloc", showall, 0, 1 },
+ { "bg", dobg, 0, INF },
+ { "break", dobreak, 0, 0 },
+ { "breaksw", doswbrk, 0, 0 },
+ { "case", dozip, 0, 1 },
+ { "cd", dochngd, 0, INF },
+ { "chdir", dochngd, 0, INF },
+ { "continue", docontin, 0, 0 },
+ { "default", dozip, 0, 0 },
+ { "dirs", dodirs, 0, INF },
+ { "echo", doecho, 0, INF },
+ { "else", doelse, 0, INF },
+ { "end", doend, 0, 0 },
+ { "endif", dozip, 0, 0 },
+ { "endsw", dozip, 0, 0 },
+ { "eval", doeval, 0, INF },
+ { "exec", execash, 1, INF },
+ { "exit", doexit, 0, INF },
+ { "fg", dofg, 0, INF },
+ { "foreach", doforeach, 3, INF },
+ { "glob", doglob, 0, INF },
+ { "goto", dogoto, 1, 1 },
+ { "hashstat", hashstat, 0, 0 },
+ { "history", dohist, 0, 2 },
+ { "if", doif, 1, INF },
+ { "jobs", dojobs, 0, 1 },
+ { "kill", dokill, 1, INF },
+ { "limit", dolimit, 0, 3 },
+ { "linedit", doecho, 0, INF },
+ { "login", dologin, 0, 1 },
+ { "logout", dologout, 0, 0 },
+ { "nice", donice, 0, INF },
+ { "nohup", donohup, 0, INF },
+ { "notify", donotify, 0, INF },
+ { "onintr", doonintr, 0, 2 },
+ { "popd", dopopd, 0, INF },
+ { "printf", doprintf, 1, INF },
+ { "pushd", dopushd, 0, INF },
+ { "rehash", dohash, 0, 0 },
+ { "repeat", dorepeat, 2, INF },
+ { "set", doset, 0, INF },
+ { "setenv", dosetenv, 0, 2 },
+ { "shift", shift, 0, 1 },
+ { "source", dosource, 1, 2 },
+ { "stop", dostop, 1, INF },
+ { "suspend", dosuspend, 0, 0 },
+ { "switch", doswitch, 1, INF },
+ { "time", dotime, 0, INF },
+ { "umask", doumask, 0, 1 },
+ { "unalias", unalias, 1, INF },
+ { "unhash", dounhash, 0, 0 },
+ { "unlimit", dounlimit, 0, INF },
+ { "unset", unset, 1, INF },
+ { "unsetenv", dounsetenv, 1, INF },
+ { "wait", dowait, 0, 0 },
+ { "which", dowhich, 1, INF },
+ { "while", dowhile, 1, INF }
+};
+int nbfunc = sizeof bfunc / sizeof *bfunc;
+
+struct srch srchn[] =
+{
+ { "@", T_LET },
+ { "break", T_BREAK },
+ { "breaksw", T_BRKSW },
+ { "case", T_CASE },
+ { "default", T_DEFAULT },
+ { "else", T_ELSE },
+ { "end", T_END },
+ { "endif", T_ENDIF },
+ { "endsw", T_ENDSW },
+ { "exit", T_EXIT },
+ { "foreach", T_FOREACH },
+ { "goto", T_GOTO },
+ { "if", T_IF },
+ { "label", T_LABEL },
+ { "set", T_SET },
+ { "switch", T_SWITCH },
+ { "while", T_WHILE }
+};
+int nsrchn = sizeof srchn / sizeof *srchn;
+
diff --git a/bin/csh/lex.c b/bin/csh/lex.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..21f50d3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/lex.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1639 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)lex.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <termios.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * These lexical routines read input and form lists of words.
+ * There is some involved processing here, because of the complications
+ * of input buffering, and especially because of history substitution.
+ */
+
+static Char *word __P((void));
+static int getC1 __P((int));
+static void getdol __P((void));
+static void getexcl __P((int));
+static struct Hist
+ *findev __P((Char *, bool));
+static void setexclp __P((Char *));
+static int bgetc __P((void));
+static void bfree __P((void));
+static struct wordent
+ *gethent __P((int));
+static int matchs __P((Char *, Char *));
+static int getsel __P((int *, int *, int));
+static struct wordent
+ *getsub __P((struct wordent *));
+static Char *subword __P((Char *, int, bool *));
+static struct wordent
+ *dosub __P((int, struct wordent *, bool));
+
+/*
+ * Peekc is a peek character for getC, peekread for readc.
+ * There is a subtlety here in many places... history routines
+ * will read ahead and then insert stuff into the input stream.
+ * If they push back a character then they must push it behind
+ * the text substituted by the history substitution. On the other
+ * hand in several places we need 2 peek characters. To make this
+ * all work, the history routines read with getC, and make use both
+ * of ungetC and unreadc. The key observation is that the state
+ * of getC at the call of a history reference is such that calls
+ * to getC from the history routines will always yield calls of
+ * readc, unless this peeking is involved. That is to say that during
+ * getexcl the variables lap, exclp, and exclnxt are all zero.
+ *
+ * Getdol invokes history substitution, hence the extra peek, peekd,
+ * which it can ungetD to be before history substitutions.
+ */
+static Char peekc = 0, peekd = 0;
+static Char peekread = 0;
+
+/* (Tail of) current word from ! subst */
+static Char *exclp = NULL;
+
+/* The rest of the ! subst words */
+static struct wordent *exclnxt = NULL;
+
+/* Count of remaining words in ! subst */
+static int exclc = 0;
+
+/* "Globp" for alias resubstitution */
+Char *alvecp = NULL;
+int aret = F_SEEK;
+
+/*
+ * Labuf implements a general buffer for lookahead during lexical operations.
+ * Text which is to be placed in the input stream can be stuck here.
+ * We stick parsed ahead $ constructs during initial input,
+ * process id's from `$$', and modified variable values (from qualifiers
+ * during expansion in sh.dol.c) here.
+ */
+static Char labuf[BUFSIZ];
+
+/*
+ * Lex returns to its caller not only a wordlist (as a "var" parameter)
+ * but also whether a history substitution occurred. This is used in
+ * the main (process) routine to determine whether to echo, and also
+ * when called by the alias routine to determine whether to keep the
+ * argument list.
+ */
+static bool hadhist = 0;
+
+/*
+ * Avoid alias expansion recursion via \!#
+ */
+int hleft;
+
+static Char getCtmp;
+
+#define getC(f) ((getCtmp = peekc) ? (peekc = 0, getCtmp) : getC1(f))
+#define ungetC(c) peekc = c
+#define ungetD(c) peekd = c
+
+int
+lex(hp)
+ register struct wordent *hp;
+{
+ register struct wordent *wdp;
+ int c;
+
+ btell(&lineloc);
+ hp->next = hp->prev = hp;
+ hp->word = STRNULL;
+ hadhist = 0;
+ do
+ c = readc(0);
+ while (c == ' ' || c == '\t');
+ if (c == HISTSUB && intty)
+ /* ^lef^rit from tty is short !:s^lef^rit */
+ getexcl(c);
+ else
+ unreadc(c);
+ wdp = hp;
+ /*
+ * The following loop is written so that the links needed by freelex will
+ * be ready and rarin to go even if it is interrupted.
+ */
+ do {
+ register struct wordent *new;
+
+ new = (struct wordent *) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(*wdp));
+ new->word = 0;
+ new->prev = wdp;
+ new->next = hp;
+ wdp->next = new;
+ wdp = new;
+ wdp->word = word();
+ } while (wdp->word[0] != '\n');
+ hp->prev = wdp;
+ return (hadhist);
+}
+
+void
+prlex(fp, sp0)
+ FILE *fp;
+ struct wordent *sp0;
+{
+ register struct wordent *sp = sp0->next;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ (void) fprintf(fp, "%s", vis_str(sp->word));
+ sp = sp->next;
+ if (sp == sp0)
+ break;
+ if (sp->word[0] != '\n')
+ (void) fputc(' ', fp);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+copylex(hp, fp)
+ register struct wordent *hp;
+ register struct wordent *fp;
+{
+ register struct wordent *wdp;
+
+ wdp = hp;
+ fp = fp->next;
+ do {
+ register struct wordent *new;
+
+ new = (struct wordent *) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(*wdp));
+ new->prev = wdp;
+ new->next = hp;
+ wdp->next = new;
+ wdp = new;
+ wdp->word = Strsave(fp->word);
+ fp = fp->next;
+ } while (wdp->word[0] != '\n');
+ hp->prev = wdp;
+}
+
+void
+freelex(vp)
+ register struct wordent *vp;
+{
+ register struct wordent *fp;
+
+ while (vp->next != vp) {
+ fp = vp->next;
+ vp->next = fp->next;
+ xfree((ptr_t) fp->word);
+ xfree((ptr_t) fp);
+ }
+ vp->prev = vp;
+}
+
+static Char *
+word()
+{
+ register Char c, c1;
+ register Char *wp;
+ Char wbuf[BUFSIZ];
+ register bool dolflg;
+ register int i;
+
+ wp = wbuf;
+ i = BUFSIZ - 4;
+loop:
+ while ((c = getC(DOALL)) == ' ' || c == '\t')
+ continue;
+ if (cmap(c, _META | _ESC))
+ switch (c) {
+ case '&':
+ case '|':
+ case '<':
+ case '>':
+ *wp++ = c;
+ c1 = getC(DOALL);
+ if (c1 == c)
+ *wp++ = c1;
+ else
+ ungetC(c1);
+ goto ret;
+
+ case '#':
+ if (intty)
+ break;
+ c = 0;
+ do {
+ c1 = c;
+ c = getC(0);
+ } while (c != '\n');
+ if (c1 == '\\')
+ goto loop;
+ /* fall into ... */
+
+ case ';':
+ case '(':
+ case ')':
+ case '\n':
+ *wp++ = c;
+ goto ret;
+
+ case '\\':
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ if (onelflg == 1)
+ onelflg = 2;
+ goto loop;
+ }
+ if (c != HIST)
+ *wp++ = '\\', --i;
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ }
+ c1 = 0;
+ dolflg = DOALL;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (c1) {
+ if (c == c1) {
+ c1 = 0;
+ dolflg = DOALL;
+ }
+ else if (c == '\\') {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == HIST)
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ else {
+ if (c == '\n')
+ /*
+ * if (c1 == '`') c = ' '; else
+ */
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ ungetC(c);
+ c = '\\';
+ }
+ }
+ else if (c == '\n') {
+ seterror(ERR_UNMATCHED, c1);
+ ungetC(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else if (cmap(c, _META | _QF | _QB | _ESC)) {
+ if (c == '\\') {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ if (onelflg == 1)
+ onelflg = 2;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c != HIST)
+ *wp++ = '\\', --i;
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ }
+ else if (cmap(c, _QF | _QB)) { /* '"` */
+ c1 = c;
+ dolflg = c == '"' ? DOALL : DOEXCL;
+ }
+ else if (c != '#' || !intty) {
+ ungetC(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (--i > 0) {
+ *wp++ = c;
+ c = getC(dolflg);
+ }
+ else {
+ seterror(ERR_WTOOLONG);
+ wp = &wbuf[1];
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ret:
+ *wp = 0;
+ return (Strsave(wbuf));
+}
+
+static int
+getC1(flag)
+ register int flag;
+{
+ register Char c;
+
+ while (1) {
+ if ((c = peekc) != '\0') {
+ peekc = 0;
+ return (c);
+ }
+ if (lap) {
+ if ((c = *lap++) == 0)
+ lap = 0;
+ else {
+ if (cmap(c, _META | _QF | _QB))
+ c |= QUOTE;
+ return (c);
+ }
+ }
+ if ((c = peekd) != '\0') {
+ peekd = 0;
+ return (c);
+ }
+ if (exclp) {
+ if ((c = *exclp++) != '\0')
+ return (c);
+ if (exclnxt && --exclc >= 0) {
+ exclnxt = exclnxt->next;
+ setexclp(exclnxt->word);
+ return (' ');
+ }
+ exclp = 0;
+ exclnxt = 0;
+ }
+ if (exclnxt) {
+ exclnxt = exclnxt->next;
+ if (--exclc < 0)
+ exclnxt = 0;
+ else
+ setexclp(exclnxt->word);
+ continue;
+ }
+ c = readc(0);
+ if (c == '$' && (flag & DODOL)) {
+ getdol();
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (c == HIST && (flag & DOEXCL)) {
+ getexcl(0);
+ continue;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ return (c);
+}
+
+static void
+getdol()
+{
+ register Char *np, *ep;
+ Char name[4 * MAXVARLEN + 1];
+ register int c;
+ int sc;
+ bool special = 0, toolong;
+
+ np = name, *np++ = '$';
+ c = sc = getC(DOEXCL);
+ if (any("\t \n", c)) {
+ ungetD(c);
+ ungetC('$' | QUOTE);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (c == '{')
+ *np++ = c, c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ if (c == '#' || c == '?')
+ special++, *np++ = c, c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ *np++ = c;
+ switch (c) {
+
+ case '<':
+ case '$':
+ case '!':
+ if (special)
+ seterror(ERR_SPDOLLT);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+
+ case '\n':
+ ungetD(c);
+ np--;
+ seterror(ERR_NEWLINE);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+
+ case '*':
+ if (special)
+ seterror(ERR_SPSTAR);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+
+ default:
+ toolong = 0;
+ if (Isdigit(c)) {
+#ifdef notdef
+ /* let $?0 pass for now */
+ if (special) {
+ seterror(ERR_DIGIT);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+#endif
+ /* we know that np < &name[4] */
+ ep = &np[MAXVARLEN];
+ while ((c = getC(DOEXCL)) != '\0'){
+ if (!Isdigit(c))
+ break;
+ if (np < ep)
+ *np++ = c;
+ else
+ toolong = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ else if (letter(c)) {
+ /* we know that np < &name[4] */
+ ep = &np[MAXVARLEN];
+ toolong = 0;
+ while ((c = getC(DOEXCL)) != '\0') {
+ /* Bugfix for ${v123x} from Chris Torek, DAS DEC-90. */
+ if (!letter(c) && !Isdigit(c))
+ break;
+ if (np < ep)
+ *np++ = c;
+ else
+ toolong = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ *np = 0;
+ seterror(ERR_VARILL);
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (toolong) {
+ seterror(ERR_VARTOOLONG);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == '[') {
+ *np++ = c;
+ /*
+ * Name up to here is a max of MAXVARLEN + 8.
+ */
+ ep = &np[2 * MAXVARLEN + 8];
+ do {
+ /*
+ * Michael Greim: Allow $ expansion to take place in selector
+ * expressions. (limits the number of characters returned)
+ */
+ c = getC(DOEXCL | DODOL);
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ ungetD(c);
+ np--;
+ seterror(ERR_NLINDEX);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (np < ep)
+ *np++ = c;
+ } while (c != ']');
+ *np = '\0';
+ if (np >= ep) {
+ seterror(ERR_SELOVFL);
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+ c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ }
+ /*
+ * Name up to here is a max of 2 * MAXVARLEN + 8.
+ */
+ if (c == ':') {
+ /*
+ * if the :g modifier is followed by a newline, then error right away!
+ * -strike
+ */
+
+ int gmodflag = 0, amodflag = 0;
+
+ do {
+ *np++ = c, c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ if (c == 'g' || c == 'a') {
+ if (c == 'g')
+ gmodflag++;
+ else
+ amodflag++;
+ *np++ = c; c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ }
+ if ((c == 'g' && !gmodflag) || (c == 'a' && !amodflag)) {
+ if (c == 'g')
+ gmodflag++;
+ else
+ amodflag++;
+ *np++ = c; c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ }
+ *np++ = c;
+ /* scan s// [eichin:19910926.0512EST] */
+ if (c == 's') {
+ int delimcnt = 2;
+ int delim = getC(0);
+ *np++ = delim;
+
+ if (!delim || letter(delim)
+ || Isdigit(delim) || any(" \t\n", delim)) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ break;
+ }
+ while ((c = getC(0)) != (-1)) {
+ *np++ = c;
+ if(c == delim) delimcnt--;
+ if(!delimcnt) break;
+ }
+ if(delimcnt) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ break;
+ }
+ c = 's';
+ }
+ if (!any("htrqxes", c)) {
+ if ((amodflag || gmodflag) && c == '\n')
+ stderror(ERR_VARSYN); /* strike */
+ seterror(ERR_VARMOD, c);
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ while ((c = getC(DOEXCL)) == ':');
+ ungetD(c);
+ }
+ else
+ ungetD(c);
+ if (sc == '{') {
+ c = getC(DOEXCL);
+ if (c != '}') {
+ ungetD(c);
+ seterror(ERR_MISSING, '}');
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+ }
+ *np++ = c;
+ }
+ *np = 0;
+ addla(name);
+ return;
+}
+
+void
+addla(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ Char buf[BUFSIZ];
+
+ if (Strlen(cp) + (lap ? Strlen(lap) : 0) >=
+ (sizeof(labuf) - 4) / sizeof(Char)) {
+ seterror(ERR_EXPOVFL);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (lap)
+ (void) Strcpy(buf, lap);
+ (void) Strcpy(labuf, cp);
+ if (lap)
+ (void) Strcat(labuf, buf);
+ lap = labuf;
+}
+
+static Char lhsb[32];
+static Char slhs[32];
+static Char rhsb[64];
+static int quesarg;
+
+static void
+getexcl(sc)
+ int sc;
+{
+ register struct wordent *hp, *ip;
+ int left, right, dol;
+ register int c;
+
+ if (sc == 0) {
+ sc = getC(0);
+ if (sc != '{') {
+ ungetC(sc);
+ sc = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ quesarg = -1;
+ lastev = eventno;
+ hp = gethent(sc);
+ if (hp == 0)
+ return;
+ hadhist = 1;
+ dol = 0;
+ if (hp == alhistp)
+ for (ip = hp->next->next; ip != alhistt; ip = ip->next)
+ dol++;
+ else
+ for (ip = hp->next->next; ip != hp->prev; ip = ip->next)
+ dol++;
+ left = 0, right = dol;
+ if (sc == HISTSUB) {
+ ungetC('s'), unreadc(HISTSUB), c = ':';
+ goto subst;
+ }
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (!any(":^$*-%", c))
+ goto subst;
+ left = right = -1;
+ if (c == ':') {
+ c = getC(0);
+ unreadc(c);
+ if (letter(c) || c == '&') {
+ c = ':';
+ left = 0, right = dol;
+ goto subst;
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ ungetC(c);
+ if (!getsel(&left, &right, dol))
+ return;
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == '*')
+ ungetC(c), c = '-';
+ if (c == '-') {
+ if (!getsel(&left, &right, dol))
+ return;
+ c = getC(0);
+ }
+subst:
+ exclc = right - left + 1;
+ while (--left >= 0)
+ hp = hp->next;
+ if (sc == HISTSUB || c == ':') {
+ do {
+ hp = getsub(hp);
+ c = getC(0);
+ } while (c == ':');
+ }
+ unreadc(c);
+ if (sc == '{') {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c != '}')
+ seterror(ERR_BADBANG);
+ }
+ exclnxt = hp;
+}
+
+static struct wordent *
+getsub(en)
+ struct wordent *en;
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+ int delim;
+ register int c;
+ int sc;
+ bool global;
+ Char orhsb[sizeof(rhsb) / sizeof(Char)];
+
+ do {
+ exclnxt = 0;
+ global = 0;
+ sc = c = getC(0);
+ if (c == 'g' || c == 'a') {
+ global |= (c == 'g') ? 1 : 2;
+ sc = c = getC(0);
+ }
+ if (((c =='g') && !(global & 1)) || ((c == 'a') && !(global & 2))) {
+ global |= (c == 'g') ? 1 : 2;
+ sc = c = getC(0);
+ }
+
+ switch (c) {
+ case 'p':
+ justpr++;
+ return (en);
+
+ case 'x':
+ case 'q':
+ global |= 1;
+
+ /* fall into ... */
+
+ case 'h':
+ case 'r':
+ case 't':
+ case 'e':
+ break;
+
+ case '&':
+ if (slhs[0] == 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_NOSUBST);
+ return (en);
+ }
+ (void) Strcpy(lhsb, slhs);
+ break;
+
+#ifdef notdef
+ case '~':
+ if (lhsb[0] == 0)
+ goto badlhs;
+ break;
+#endif
+
+ case 's':
+ delim = getC(0);
+ if (letter(delim) || Isdigit(delim) || any(" \t\n", delim)) {
+ unreadc(delim);
+ lhsb[0] = 0;
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ return (en);
+ }
+ cp = lhsb;
+ for (;;) {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ unreadc(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == delim)
+ break;
+ if (cp > &lhsb[sizeof(lhsb) / sizeof(Char) - 2]) {
+ lhsb[0] = 0;
+ seterror(ERR_BADSUBST);
+ return (en);
+ }
+ if (c == '\\') {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c != delim && c != '\\')
+ *cp++ = '\\';
+ }
+ *cp++ = c;
+ }
+ if (cp != lhsb)
+ *cp++ = 0;
+ else if (lhsb[0] == 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_LHS);
+ return (en);
+ }
+ cp = rhsb;
+ (void) Strcpy(orhsb, cp);
+ for (;;) {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ unreadc(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == delim)
+ break;
+#ifdef notdef
+ if (c == '~') {
+ if (&cp[Strlen(orhsb)] > &rhsb[sizeof(rhsb) /
+ sizeof(Char) - 2])
+ goto toorhs;
+ (void) Strcpy(cp, orhsb);
+ cp = Strend(cp);
+ continue;
+ }
+#endif
+ if (cp > &rhsb[sizeof(rhsb) / sizeof(Char) - 2]) {
+ seterror(ERR_RHSLONG);
+ return (en);
+ }
+ if (c == '\\') {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c != delim /* && c != '~' */ )
+ *cp++ = '\\';
+ }
+ *cp++ = c;
+ }
+ *cp++ = 0;
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if (c == '\n')
+ unreadc(c);
+ seterror(ERR_BADBANGMOD, c);
+ return (en);
+ }
+ (void) Strcpy(slhs, lhsb);
+ if (exclc)
+ en = dosub(sc, en, global);
+ }
+ while ((c = getC(0)) == ':');
+ unreadc(c);
+ return (en);
+}
+
+static struct wordent *
+dosub(sc, en, global)
+ int sc;
+ struct wordent *en;
+ bool global;
+{
+ struct wordent lexi;
+ bool didsub = 0, didone = 0;
+ struct wordent *hp = &lexi;
+ register struct wordent *wdp;
+ register int i = exclc;
+
+ wdp = hp;
+ while (--i >= 0) {
+ register struct wordent *new =
+ (struct wordent *) xcalloc(1, sizeof *wdp);
+
+ new->word = 0;
+ new->prev = wdp;
+ new->next = hp;
+ wdp->next = new;
+ wdp = new;
+ en = en->next;
+ if (en->word) {
+ Char *tword, *otword;
+
+ if ((global & 1) || didsub == 0) {
+ tword = subword(en->word, sc, &didone);
+ if (didone)
+ didsub = 1;
+ if (global & 2) {
+ while (didone && tword != STRNULL) {
+ otword = tword;
+ tword = subword(otword, sc, &didone);
+ if (Strcmp(tword, otword) == 0) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) otword);
+ break;
+ }
+ else
+ xfree((ptr_t) otword);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ tword = Strsave(en->word);
+ wdp->word = tword;
+ }
+ }
+ if (didsub == 0)
+ seterror(ERR_MODFAIL);
+ hp->prev = wdp;
+ return (&enthist(-1000, &lexi, 0)->Hlex);
+}
+
+static Char *
+subword(cp, type, adid)
+ Char *cp;
+ int type;
+ bool *adid;
+{
+ Char wbuf[BUFSIZ];
+ register Char *wp, *mp, *np;
+ register int i;
+
+ *adid = 0;
+ switch (type) {
+
+ case 'r':
+ case 'e':
+ case 'h':
+ case 't':
+ case 'q':
+ case 'x':
+ wp = domod(cp, type);
+ if (wp == 0)
+ return (Strsave(cp));
+ *adid = 1;
+ return (wp);
+
+ default:
+ wp = wbuf;
+ i = BUFSIZ - 4;
+ for (mp = cp; *mp; mp++)
+ if (matchs(mp, lhsb)) {
+ for (np = cp; np < mp;)
+ *wp++ = *np++, --i;
+ for (np = rhsb; *np; np++)
+ switch (*np) {
+
+ case '\\':
+ if (np[1] == '&')
+ np++;
+ /* fall into ... */
+
+ default:
+ if (--i < 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_SUBOVFL);
+ return (STRNULL);
+ }
+ *wp++ = *np;
+ continue;
+
+ case '&':
+ i -= Strlen(lhsb);
+ if (i < 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_SUBOVFL);
+ return (STRNULL);
+ }
+ *wp = 0;
+ (void) Strcat(wp, lhsb);
+ wp = Strend(wp);
+ continue;
+ }
+ mp += Strlen(lhsb);
+ i -= Strlen(mp);
+ if (i < 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_SUBOVFL);
+ return (STRNULL);
+ }
+ *wp = 0;
+ (void) Strcat(wp, mp);
+ *adid = 1;
+ return (Strsave(wbuf));
+ }
+ return (Strsave(cp));
+ }
+}
+
+Char *
+domod(cp, type)
+ Char *cp;
+ int type;
+{
+ register Char *wp, *xp;
+ register int c;
+
+ switch (type) {
+
+ case 'x':
+ case 'q':
+ wp = Strsave(cp);
+ for (xp = wp; (c = *xp) != '\0'; xp++)
+ if ((c != ' ' && c != '\t') || type == 'q')
+ *xp |= QUOTE;
+ return (wp);
+
+ case 'h':
+ case 't':
+ if (!any(short2str(cp), '/'))
+ return (type == 't' ? Strsave(cp) : 0);
+ wp = Strend(cp);
+ while (*--wp != '/')
+ continue;
+ if (type == 'h')
+ xp = Strsave(cp), xp[wp - cp] = 0;
+ else
+ xp = Strsave(wp + 1);
+ return (xp);
+
+ case 'e':
+ case 'r':
+ wp = Strend(cp);
+ for (wp--; wp >= cp && *wp != '/'; wp--)
+ if (*wp == '.') {
+ if (type == 'e')
+ xp = Strsave(wp + 1);
+ else
+ xp = Strsave(cp), xp[wp - cp] = 0;
+ return (xp);
+ }
+ return (Strsave(type == 'e' ? STRNULL : cp));
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static int
+matchs(str, pat)
+ register Char *str, *pat;
+{
+ while (*str && *pat && *str == *pat)
+ str++, pat++;
+ return (*pat == 0);
+}
+
+static int
+getsel(al, ar, dol)
+ register int *al, *ar;
+ int dol;
+{
+ register int c = getC(0);
+ register int i;
+ bool first = *al < 0;
+
+ switch (c) {
+
+ case '%':
+ if (quesarg == -1) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADBANGARG);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ if (*al < 0)
+ *al = quesarg;
+ *ar = quesarg;
+ break;
+
+ case '-':
+ if (*al < 0) {
+ *al = 0;
+ *ar = dol - 1;
+ unreadc(c);
+ }
+ return (1);
+
+ case '^':
+ if (*al < 0)
+ *al = 1;
+ *ar = 1;
+ break;
+
+ case '$':
+ if (*al < 0)
+ *al = dol;
+ *ar = dol;
+ break;
+
+ case '*':
+ if (*al < 0)
+ *al = 1;
+ *ar = dol;
+ if (*ar < *al) {
+ *ar = 0;
+ *al = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ if (Isdigit(c)) {
+ i = 0;
+ while (Isdigit(c)) {
+ i = i * 10 + c - '0';
+ c = getC(0);
+ }
+ if (i < 0)
+ i = dol + 1;
+ if (*al < 0)
+ *al = i;
+ *ar = i;
+ }
+ else if (*al < 0)
+ *al = 0, *ar = dol;
+ else
+ *ar = dol - 1;
+ unreadc(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (first) {
+ c = getC(0);
+ unreadc(c);
+ if (any("-$*", c))
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (*al > *ar || *ar > dol) {
+ seterror(ERR_BADBANGARG);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (1);
+
+}
+
+static struct wordent *
+gethent(sc)
+ int sc;
+{
+ register struct Hist *hp;
+ register Char *np;
+ register int c;
+ int event;
+ bool back = 0;
+
+ c = sc == HISTSUB ? HIST : getC(0);
+ if (c == HIST) {
+ if (alhistp)
+ return (alhistp);
+ event = eventno;
+ }
+ else
+ switch (c) {
+
+ case ':':
+ case '^':
+ case '$':
+ case '*':
+ case '%':
+ ungetC(c);
+ if (lastev == eventno && alhistp)
+ return (alhistp);
+ event = lastev;
+ break;
+
+ case '#': /* !# is command being typed in (mrh) */
+ if (--hleft == 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_HISTLOOP);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ else
+ return (&paraml);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+
+ case '-':
+ back = 1;
+ c = getC(0);
+ /* FALLSTHROUGH */
+
+ default:
+ if (any("(=~", c)) {
+ unreadc(c);
+ ungetC(HIST);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ np = lhsb;
+ event = 0;
+ while (!cmap(c, _ESC | _META | _QF | _QB) && !any("${}:", c)) {
+ if (event != -1 && Isdigit(c))
+ event = event * 10 + c - '0';
+ else
+ event = -1;
+ if (np < &lhsb[sizeof(lhsb) / sizeof(Char) - 2])
+ *np++ = c;
+ c = getC(0);
+ }
+ unreadc(c);
+ if (np == lhsb) {
+ ungetC(HIST);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ *np++ = 0;
+ if (event != -1) {
+ /*
+ * History had only digits
+ */
+ if (back)
+ event = eventno + (alhistp == 0) - (event ? event : 0);
+ break;
+ }
+ hp = findev(lhsb, 0);
+ if (hp)
+ lastev = hp->Hnum;
+ return (&hp->Hlex);
+
+ case '?':
+ np = lhsb;
+ for (;;) {
+ c = getC(0);
+ if (c == '\n') {
+ unreadc(c);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == '?')
+ break;
+ if (np < &lhsb[sizeof(lhsb) / sizeof(Char) - 2])
+ *np++ = c;
+ }
+ if (np == lhsb) {
+ if (lhsb[0] == 0) {
+ seterror(ERR_NOSEARCH);
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+ else
+ *np++ = 0;
+ hp = findev(lhsb, 1);
+ if (hp)
+ lastev = hp->Hnum;
+ return (&hp->Hlex);
+ }
+
+ for (hp = Histlist.Hnext; hp; hp = hp->Hnext)
+ if (hp->Hnum == event) {
+ hp->Href = eventno;
+ lastev = hp->Hnum;
+ return (&hp->Hlex);
+ }
+ np = putn(event);
+ seterror(ERR_NOEVENT, vis_str(np));
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static struct Hist *
+findev(cp, anyarg)
+ Char *cp;
+ bool anyarg;
+{
+ register struct Hist *hp;
+
+ for (hp = Histlist.Hnext; hp; hp = hp->Hnext) {
+ Char *dp;
+ register Char *p, *q;
+ register struct wordent *lp = hp->Hlex.next;
+ int argno = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * The entries added by alias substitution don't have a newline but do
+ * have a negative event number. Savehist() trims off these entries,
+ * but it happens before alias expansion, too early to delete those
+ * from the previous command.
+ */
+ if (hp->Hnum < 0)
+ continue;
+ if (lp->word[0] == '\n')
+ continue;
+ if (!anyarg) {
+ p = cp;
+ q = lp->word;
+ do
+ if (!*p)
+ return (hp);
+ while (*p++ == *q++);
+ continue;
+ }
+ do {
+ for (dp = lp->word; *dp; dp++) {
+ p = cp;
+ q = dp;
+ do
+ if (!*p) {
+ quesarg = argno;
+ return (hp);
+ }
+ while (*p++ == *q++);
+ }
+ lp = lp->next;
+ argno++;
+ } while (lp->word[0] != '\n');
+ }
+ seterror(ERR_NOEVENT, vis_str(cp));
+ return (0);
+}
+
+
+static void
+setexclp(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ if (cp && cp[0] == '\n')
+ return;
+ exclp = cp;
+}
+
+void
+unreadc(c)
+ int c;
+{
+ peekread = c;
+}
+
+int
+readc(wanteof)
+ bool wanteof;
+{
+ register int c;
+ static sincereal;
+
+ aret = F_SEEK;
+ if ((c = peekread) != '\0') {
+ peekread = 0;
+ return (c);
+ }
+top:
+ aret = F_SEEK;
+ if (alvecp) {
+ aret = A_SEEK;
+ if ((c = *alvecp++) != '\0')
+ return (c);
+ if (alvec && *alvec) {
+ alvecp = *alvec++;
+ return (' ');
+ }
+ else {
+ aret = F_SEEK;
+ alvecp = NULL;
+ return('\n');
+ }
+ }
+ if (alvec) {
+ if ((alvecp = *alvec) != '\0') {
+ alvec++;
+ goto top;
+ }
+ /* Infinite source! */
+ return ('\n');
+ }
+ if (evalp) {
+ aret = E_SEEK;
+ if ((c = *evalp++) != '\0')
+ return (c);
+ if (evalvec && *evalvec) {
+ evalp = *evalvec++;
+ return (' ');
+ }
+ aret = F_SEEK;
+ evalp = 0;
+ }
+ if (evalvec) {
+ if (evalvec == (Char **) 1) {
+ doneinp = 1;
+ reset();
+ }
+ if ((evalp = *evalvec) != '\0') {
+ evalvec++;
+ goto top;
+ }
+ evalvec = (Char **) 1;
+ return ('\n');
+ }
+ do {
+ if (arginp == (Char *) 1 || onelflg == 1) {
+ if (wanteof)
+ return (-1);
+ exitstat();
+ }
+ if (arginp) {
+ if ((c = *arginp++) == 0) {
+ arginp = (Char *) 1;
+ return ('\n');
+ }
+ return (c);
+ }
+reread:
+ c = bgetc();
+ if (c < 0) {
+ struct termios tty;
+ if (wanteof)
+ return (-1);
+ /* was isatty but raw with ignoreeof yields problems */
+ if (tcgetattr(SHIN, &tty) == 0 && (tty.c_lflag & ICANON))
+ {
+ /* was 'short' for FILEC */
+ int ctpgrp;
+
+ if (++sincereal > 25)
+ goto oops;
+ if (tpgrp != -1 &&
+ (ctpgrp = tcgetpgrp(FSHTTY)) != -1 &&
+ tpgrp != ctpgrp) {
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, tpgrp);
+ (void) killpg((pid_t) ctpgrp, SIGHUP);
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "Reset tty pgrp from %d to %d\n",
+ ctpgrp, tpgrp);
+ goto reread;
+ }
+ if (adrof(STRignoreeof)) {
+ if (loginsh)
+ (void) fprintf(csherr,"\nUse \"logout\" to logout.\n");
+ else
+ (void) fprintf(csherr,"\nUse \"exit\" to leave csh.\n");
+ reset();
+ }
+ if (chkstop == 0)
+ panystop(1);
+ }
+ oops:
+ doneinp = 1;
+ reset();
+ }
+ sincereal = 0;
+ if (c == '\n' && onelflg)
+ onelflg--;
+ } while (c == 0);
+ return (c);
+}
+
+static int
+bgetc()
+{
+ register int buf, off, c;
+
+#ifdef FILEC
+ register int numleft = 0, roomleft;
+ Char ttyline[BUFSIZ];
+#endif
+ char tbuf[BUFSIZ + 1];
+
+ if (cantell) {
+ if (fseekp < fbobp || fseekp > feobp) {
+ fbobp = feobp = fseekp;
+ (void) lseek(SHIN, fseekp, L_SET);
+ }
+ if (fseekp == feobp) {
+ int i;
+
+ fbobp = feobp;
+ do
+ c = read(SHIN, tbuf, BUFSIZ);
+ while (c < 0 && errno == EINTR);
+ if (c <= 0)
+ return (-1);
+ for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
+ fbuf[0][i] = (unsigned char) tbuf[i];
+ feobp += c;
+ }
+ c = fbuf[0][fseekp - fbobp];
+ fseekp++;
+ return (c);
+ }
+
+again:
+ buf = (int) fseekp / BUFSIZ;
+ if (buf >= fblocks) {
+ register Char **nfbuf =
+ (Char **) xcalloc((size_t) (fblocks + 2),
+ sizeof(Char **));
+
+ if (fbuf) {
+ (void) blkcpy(nfbuf, fbuf);
+ xfree((ptr_t) fbuf);
+ }
+ fbuf = nfbuf;
+ fbuf[fblocks] = (Char *) xcalloc(BUFSIZ, sizeof(Char));
+ fblocks++;
+ if (!intty)
+ goto again;
+ }
+ if (fseekp >= feobp) {
+ buf = (int) feobp / BUFSIZ;
+ off = (int) feobp % BUFSIZ;
+ roomleft = BUFSIZ - off;
+
+#ifdef FILEC
+ roomleft = BUFSIZ - off;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (filec && intty) {
+ c = numleft ? numleft : tenex(ttyline, BUFSIZ);
+ if (c > roomleft) {
+ /* start with fresh buffer */
+ feobp = fseekp = fblocks * BUFSIZ;
+ numleft = c;
+ goto again;
+ }
+ if (c > 0)
+ bcopy(ttyline, fbuf[buf] + off, c * sizeof(Char));
+ numleft = 0;
+ }
+ else {
+#endif
+ c = read(SHIN, tbuf, roomleft);
+ if (c > 0) {
+ int i;
+ Char *ptr = fbuf[buf] + off;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < c; i++)
+ ptr[i] = (unsigned char) tbuf[i];
+ }
+#ifdef FILEC
+ }
+#endif
+ if (c >= 0)
+ break;
+ if (errno == EWOULDBLOCK) {
+ int off = 0;
+
+ (void) ioctl(SHIN, FIONBIO, (ioctl_t) & off);
+ }
+ else if (errno != EINTR)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c <= 0)
+ return (-1);
+ feobp += c;
+#ifndef FILEC
+ goto again;
+#else
+ if (filec && !intty)
+ goto again;
+#endif
+ }
+ c = fbuf[buf][(int) fseekp % BUFSIZ];
+ fseekp++;
+ return (c);
+}
+
+static void
+bfree()
+{
+ register int sb, i;
+
+ if (cantell)
+ return;
+ if (whyles)
+ return;
+ sb = (int) (fseekp - 1) / BUFSIZ;
+ if (sb > 0) {
+ for (i = 0; i < sb; i++)
+ xfree((ptr_t) fbuf[i]);
+ (void) blkcpy(fbuf, &fbuf[sb]);
+ fseekp -= BUFSIZ * sb;
+ feobp -= BUFSIZ * sb;
+ fblocks -= sb;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+bseek(l)
+ struct Ain *l;
+{
+ switch (aret = l->type) {
+ case E_SEEK:
+ evalvec = l->a_seek;
+ evalp = l->c_seek;
+ return;
+ case A_SEEK:
+ alvec = l->a_seek;
+ alvecp = l->c_seek;
+ return;
+ case F_SEEK:
+ fseekp = l->f_seek;
+ return;
+ default:
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "Bad seek type %d\n", aret);
+ abort();
+ }
+}
+
+void
+btell(l)
+ struct Ain *l;
+{
+ switch (l->type = aret) {
+ case E_SEEK:
+ l->a_seek = evalvec;
+ l->c_seek = evalp;
+ return;
+ case A_SEEK:
+ l->a_seek = alvec;
+ l->c_seek = alvecp;
+ return;
+ case F_SEEK:
+ l->f_seek = fseekp;
+ l->a_seek = NULL;
+ return;
+ default:
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "Bad seek type %d\n", aret);
+ abort();
+ }
+}
+
+void
+btoeof()
+{
+ (void) lseek(SHIN, (off_t) 0, L_XTND);
+ aret = F_SEEK;
+ fseekp = feobp;
+ alvec = NULL;
+ alvecp = NULL;
+ evalvec = NULL;
+ evalp = NULL;
+ wfree();
+ bfree();
+}
+
+void
+settell()
+{
+ cantell = 0;
+ if (arginp || onelflg || intty)
+ return;
+ if (lseek(SHIN, (off_t) 0, L_INCR) < 0 || errno == ESPIPE)
+ return;
+ fbuf = (Char **) xcalloc(2, sizeof(Char **));
+ fblocks = 1;
+ fbuf[0] = (Char *) xcalloc(BUFSIZ, sizeof(Char));
+ fseekp = fbobp = feobp = lseek(SHIN, (off_t) 0, L_INCR);
+ cantell = 1;
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/misc.c b/bin/csh/misc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bd84253
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/misc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,420 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)misc.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int renum __P((int, int));
+
+int
+any(s, c)
+ register char *s;
+ register int c;
+{
+ if (!s)
+ return (0); /* Check for nil pointer */
+ while (*s)
+ if (*s++ == c)
+ return (1);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+setzero(cp, i)
+ char *cp;
+ int i;
+{
+ if (i != 0)
+ do
+ *cp++ = 0;
+ while (--i);
+}
+
+char *
+strsave(s)
+ register char *s;
+{
+ char *n;
+ register char *p;
+
+ if (s == NULL)
+ s = "";
+ for (p = s; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ n = p = (char *) xmalloc((size_t) ((p - s) * sizeof(char)));
+ while ((*p++ = *s++) != '\0')
+ continue;
+ return (n);
+}
+
+Char **
+blkend(up)
+ register Char **up;
+{
+
+ while (*up)
+ up++;
+ return (up);
+}
+
+
+void
+blkpr(fp, av)
+ FILE *fp;
+ register Char **av;
+{
+
+ for (; *av; av++) {
+ (void) fprintf(fp, "%s", vis_str(*av));
+ if (av[1])
+ (void) fprintf(fp, " ");
+ }
+}
+
+int
+blklen(av)
+ register Char **av;
+{
+ register int i = 0;
+
+ while (*av++)
+ i++;
+ return (i);
+}
+
+Char **
+blkcpy(oav, bv)
+ Char **oav;
+ register Char **bv;
+{
+ register Char **av = oav;
+
+ while ((*av++ = *bv++) != NULL)
+ continue;
+ return (oav);
+}
+
+Char **
+blkcat(up, vp)
+ Char **up, **vp;
+{
+
+ (void) blkcpy(blkend(up), vp);
+ return (up);
+}
+
+void
+blkfree(av0)
+ Char **av0;
+{
+ register Char **av = av0;
+
+ if (!av0)
+ return;
+ for (; *av; av++)
+ xfree((ptr_t) * av);
+ xfree((ptr_t) av0);
+}
+
+Char **
+saveblk(v)
+ register Char **v;
+{
+ register Char **newv =
+ (Char **) xcalloc((size_t) (blklen(v) + 1), sizeof(Char **));
+ Char **onewv = newv;
+
+ while (*v)
+ *newv++ = Strsave(*v++);
+ return (onewv);
+}
+
+#ifdef NOTUSED
+char *
+strstr(s, t)
+ register char *s, *t;
+{
+ do {
+ register char *ss = s;
+ register char *tt = t;
+
+ do
+ if (*tt == '\0')
+ return (s);
+ while (*ss++ == *tt++);
+ } while (*s++ != '\0');
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+#endif /* NOTUSED */
+
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+char *
+strspl(cp, dp)
+ char *cp, *dp;
+{
+ char *ep;
+ register char *p, *q;
+
+ if (!cp)
+ cp = "";
+ if (!dp)
+ dp = "";
+ for (p = cp; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ for (q = dp; *q++;)
+ continue;
+ ep = (char *) xmalloc((size_t) (((p - cp) + (q - dp) - 1) * sizeof(char)));
+ for (p = ep, q = cp; *p++ = *q++;)
+ continue;
+ for (p--, q = dp; *p++ = *q++;)
+ continue;
+ return (ep);
+}
+
+#endif
+
+Char **
+blkspl(up, vp)
+ register Char **up, **vp;
+{
+ register Char **wp =
+ (Char **) xcalloc((size_t) (blklen(up) + blklen(vp) + 1),
+ sizeof(Char **));
+
+ (void) blkcpy(wp, up);
+ return (blkcat(wp, vp));
+}
+
+Char
+lastchr(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+
+ if (!cp)
+ return (0);
+ if (!*cp)
+ return (0);
+ while (cp[1])
+ cp++;
+ return (*cp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * This routine is called after an error to close up
+ * any units which may have been left open accidentally.
+ */
+void
+closem()
+{
+ register int f;
+
+ for (f = 0; f < NOFILE; f++)
+ if (f != SHIN && f != SHOUT && f != SHERR && f != OLDSTD &&
+ f != FSHTTY)
+ (void) close(f);
+}
+
+void
+donefds()
+{
+ (void) close(0);
+ (void) close(1);
+ (void) close(2);
+
+ didfds = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Move descriptor i to j.
+ * If j is -1 then we just want to get i to a safe place,
+ * i.e. to a unit > 2. This also happens in dcopy.
+ */
+int
+dmove(i, j)
+ register int i, j;
+{
+
+ if (i == j || i < 0)
+ return (i);
+ if (j >= 0) {
+ (void) dup2(i, j);
+ if (j != i)
+ (void) close(i);
+ return (j);
+ }
+ j = dcopy(i, j);
+ if (j != i)
+ (void) close(i);
+ return (j);
+}
+
+int
+dcopy(i, j)
+ register int i, j;
+{
+
+ if (i == j || i < 0 || (j < 0 && i > 2))
+ return (i);
+ if (j >= 0) {
+ (void) dup2(i, j);
+ return (j);
+ }
+ (void) close(j);
+ return (renum(i, j));
+}
+
+static int
+renum(i, j)
+ register int i, j;
+{
+ register int k = dup(i);
+
+ if (k < 0)
+ return (-1);
+ if (j == -1 && k > 2)
+ return (k);
+ if (k != j) {
+ j = renum(k, j);
+ (void) close(k);
+ return (j);
+ }
+ return (k);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Left shift a command argument list, discarding
+ * the first c arguments. Used in "shift" commands
+ * as well as by commands like "repeat".
+ */
+void
+lshift(v, c)
+ register Char **v;
+ register int c;
+{
+ register Char **u;
+
+ for (u = v; *u && --c >= 0; u++)
+ xfree((ptr_t) *u);
+ (void) blkcpy(v, u);
+}
+
+int
+number(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ if (!cp)
+ return(0);
+ if (*cp == '-') {
+ cp++;
+ if (!Isdigit(*cp))
+ return (0);
+ cp++;
+ }
+ while (*cp && Isdigit(*cp))
+ cp++;
+ return (*cp == 0);
+}
+
+Char **
+copyblk(v)
+ register Char **v;
+{
+ Char **nv = (Char **) xcalloc((size_t) (blklen(v) + 1), sizeof(Char **));
+
+ return (blkcpy(nv, v));
+}
+
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+char *
+strend(cp)
+ register char *cp;
+{
+ if (!cp)
+ return (cp);
+ while (*cp)
+ cp++;
+ return (cp);
+}
+
+#endif /* SHORT_STRINGS */
+
+Char *
+strip(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ register Char *dp = cp;
+
+ if (!cp)
+ return (cp);
+ while ((*dp++ &= TRIM) != '\0')
+ continue;
+ return (cp);
+}
+
+void
+udvar(name)
+ Char *name;
+{
+
+ setname(vis_str(name));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_UNDVAR);
+}
+
+int
+prefix(sub, str)
+ register Char *sub, *str;
+{
+
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*sub == 0)
+ return (1);
+ if (*str == 0)
+ return (0);
+ if (*sub++ != *str++)
+ return (0);
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/parse.c b/bin/csh/parse.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..18b9fc0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/parse.c
@@ -0,0 +1,698 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)parse.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void asyntax __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *));
+static void asyn0 __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *));
+static void asyn3 __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *));
+static struct wordent
+ *freenod __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *));
+static struct command
+ *syn0 __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+static struct command
+ *syn1 __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+static struct command
+ *syn1a __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+static struct command
+ *syn1b __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+static struct command
+ *syn2 __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+static struct command
+ *syn3 __P((struct wordent *, struct wordent *, int));
+
+#define ALEFT 21 /* max of 20 alias expansions */
+#define HLEFT 11 /* max of 10 history expansions */
+/*
+ * Perform aliasing on the word list lex
+ * Do a (very rudimentary) parse to separate into commands.
+ * If word 0 of a command has an alias, do it.
+ * Repeat a maximum of 20 times.
+ */
+static int aleft;
+extern int hleft;
+void
+alias(lex)
+ register struct wordent *lex;
+{
+ jmp_buf osetexit;
+
+ aleft = ALEFT;
+ hleft = HLEFT;
+ getexit(osetexit);
+ (void) setexit();
+ if (haderr) {
+ resexit(osetexit);
+ reset();
+ }
+ if (--aleft == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_ALIASLOOP);
+ asyntax(lex->next, lex);
+ resexit(osetexit);
+}
+
+static void
+asyntax(p1, p2)
+ register struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+{
+ while (p1 != p2)
+ if (any(";&\n", p1->word[0]))
+ p1 = p1->next;
+ else {
+ asyn0(p1, p2);
+ return;
+ }
+}
+
+static void
+asyn0(p1, p2)
+ struct wordent *p1;
+ register struct wordent *p2;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p;
+ register int l = 0;
+
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ if (l < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_TOOMANYRP);
+ continue;
+
+ case '>':
+ if (p->next != p2 && eq(p->next->word, STRand))
+ p = p->next;
+ continue;
+
+ case '&':
+ case '|':
+ case ';':
+ case '\n':
+ if (l != 0)
+ continue;
+ asyn3(p1, p);
+ asyntax(p->next, p2);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (l == 0)
+ asyn3(p1, p2);
+}
+
+static void
+asyn3(p1, p2)
+ struct wordent *p1;
+ register struct wordent *p2;
+{
+ register struct varent *ap;
+ struct wordent alout;
+ register bool redid;
+
+ if (p1 == p2)
+ return;
+ if (p1->word[0] == '(') {
+ for (p2 = p2->prev; p2->word[0] != ')'; p2 = p2->prev)
+ if (p2 == p1)
+ return;
+ if (p2 == p1->next)
+ return;
+ asyn0(p1->next, p2);
+ return;
+ }
+ ap = adrof1(p1->word, &aliases);
+ if (ap == 0)
+ return;
+ alhistp = p1->prev;
+ alhistt = p2;
+ alvec = ap->vec;
+ redid = lex(&alout);
+ alhistp = alhistt = 0;
+ alvec = 0;
+ if (seterr) {
+ freelex(&alout);
+ stderror(ERR_OLD);
+ }
+ if (p1->word[0] && eq(p1->word, alout.next->word)) {
+ Char *cp = alout.next->word;
+
+ alout.next->word = Strspl(STRQNULL, cp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ }
+ p1 = freenod(p1, redid ? p2 : p1->next);
+ if (alout.next != &alout) {
+ p1->next->prev = alout.prev->prev;
+ alout.prev->prev->next = p1->next;
+ alout.next->prev = p1;
+ p1->next = alout.next;
+ xfree((ptr_t) alout.prev->word);
+ xfree((ptr_t) (alout.prev));
+ }
+ reset(); /* throw! */
+}
+
+static struct wordent *
+freenod(p1, p2)
+ register struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+{
+ register struct wordent *retp = p1->prev;
+
+ while (p1 != p2) {
+ xfree((ptr_t) p1->word);
+ p1 = p1->next;
+ xfree((ptr_t) (p1->prev));
+ }
+ retp->next = p2;
+ p2->prev = retp;
+ return (retp);
+}
+
+#define PHERE 1
+#define PIN 2
+#define POUT 4
+#define PERR 8
+
+/*
+ * syntax
+ * empty
+ * syn0
+ */
+struct command *
+syntax(p1, p2, flags)
+ register struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+
+ while (p1 != p2)
+ if (any(";&\n", p1->word[0]))
+ p1 = p1->next;
+ else
+ return (syn0(p1, p2, flags));
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * syn0
+ * syn1
+ * syn1 & syntax
+ */
+static struct command *
+syn0(p1, p2, flags)
+ struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p;
+ register struct command *t, *t1;
+ int l;
+
+ l = 0;
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ if (l < 0)
+ seterror(ERR_TOOMANYRP);
+ continue;
+
+ case '|':
+ if (p->word[1] == '|')
+ continue;
+ /* fall into ... */
+
+ case '>':
+ if (p->next != p2 && eq(p->next->word, STRand))
+ p = p->next;
+ continue;
+
+ case '&':
+ if (l != 0)
+ break;
+ if (p->word[1] == '&')
+ continue;
+ t1 = syn1(p1, p, flags);
+ if (t1->t_dtyp == NODE_LIST ||
+ t1->t_dtyp == NODE_AND ||
+ t1->t_dtyp == NODE_OR) {
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_PAREN;
+ t->t_dflg = F_AMPERSAND | F_NOINTERRUPT;
+ t->t_dspr = t1;
+ t1 = t;
+ }
+ else
+ t1->t_dflg |= F_AMPERSAND | F_NOINTERRUPT;
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_LIST;
+ t->t_dflg = 0;
+ t->t_dcar = t1;
+ t->t_dcdr = syntax(p, p2, flags);
+ return (t);
+ }
+ if (l == 0)
+ return (syn1(p1, p2, flags));
+ seterror(ERR_TOOMANYLP);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * syn1
+ * syn1a
+ * syn1a ; syntax
+ */
+static struct command *
+syn1(p1, p2, flags)
+ struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p;
+ register struct command *t;
+ int l;
+
+ l = 0;
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ continue;
+
+ case ';':
+ case '\n':
+ if (l != 0)
+ break;
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_LIST;
+ t->t_dcar = syn1a(p1, p, flags);
+ t->t_dcdr = syntax(p->next, p2, flags);
+ if (t->t_dcdr == 0)
+ t->t_dcdr = t->t_dcar, t->t_dcar = 0;
+ return (t);
+ }
+ return (syn1a(p1, p2, flags));
+}
+
+/*
+ * syn1a
+ * syn1b
+ * syn1b || syn1a
+ */
+static struct command *
+syn1a(p1, p2, flags)
+ struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p;
+ register struct command *t;
+ register int l = 0;
+
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ continue;
+
+ case '|':
+ if (p->word[1] != '|')
+ continue;
+ if (l == 0) {
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_OR;
+ t->t_dcar = syn1b(p1, p, flags);
+ t->t_dcdr = syn1a(p->next, p2, flags);
+ t->t_dflg = 0;
+ return (t);
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+ return (syn1b(p1, p2, flags));
+}
+
+/*
+ * syn1b
+ * syn2
+ * syn2 && syn1b
+ */
+static struct command *
+syn1b(p1, p2, flags)
+ struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p;
+ register struct command *t;
+ register int l = 0;
+
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ continue;
+
+ case '&':
+ if (p->word[1] == '&' && l == 0) {
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_AND;
+ t->t_dcar = syn2(p1, p, flags);
+ t->t_dcdr = syn1b(p->next, p2, flags);
+ t->t_dflg = 0;
+ return (t);
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+ return (syn2(p1, p2, flags));
+}
+
+/*
+ * syn2
+ * syn3
+ * syn3 | syn2
+ * syn3 |& syn2
+ */
+static struct command *
+syn2(p1, p2, flags)
+ struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p, *pn;
+ register struct command *t;
+ register int l = 0;
+ int f;
+
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ continue;
+
+ case '|':
+ if (l != 0)
+ continue;
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ f = flags | POUT;
+ pn = p->next;
+ if (pn != p2 && pn->word[0] == '&') {
+ f |= PERR;
+ t->t_dflg |= F_STDERR;
+ }
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_PIPE;
+ t->t_dcar = syn3(p1, p, f);
+ if (pn != p2 && pn->word[0] == '&')
+ p = pn;
+ t->t_dcdr = syn2(p->next, p2, flags | PIN);
+ return (t);
+ }
+ return (syn3(p1, p2, flags));
+}
+
+static char RELPAR[] = {'<', '>', '(', ')', '\0'};
+
+/*
+ * syn3
+ * ( syn0 ) [ < in ] [ > out ]
+ * word word* [ < in ] [ > out ]
+ * KEYWORD ( word* ) word* [ < in ] [ > out ]
+ *
+ * KEYWORD = (@ exit foreach if set switch test while)
+ */
+static struct command *
+syn3(p1, p2, flags)
+ struct wordent *p1, *p2;
+ int flags;
+{
+ register struct wordent *p;
+ struct wordent *lp, *rp;
+ register struct command *t;
+ register int l;
+ Char **av;
+ int n, c;
+ bool specp = 0;
+
+ if (p1 != p2) {
+ p = p1;
+again:
+ switch (srchx(p->word)) {
+
+ case T_ELSE:
+ p = p->next;
+ if (p != p2)
+ goto again;
+ break;
+
+ case T_EXIT:
+ case T_FOREACH:
+ case T_IF:
+ case T_LET:
+ case T_SET:
+ case T_SWITCH:
+ case T_WHILE:
+ specp = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ n = 0;
+ l = 0;
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next)
+ switch (p->word[0]) {
+
+ case '(':
+ if (specp)
+ n++;
+ l++;
+ continue;
+
+ case ')':
+ if (specp)
+ n++;
+ l--;
+ continue;
+
+ case '>':
+ case '<':
+ if (l != 0) {
+ if (specp)
+ n++;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (p->next == p2)
+ continue;
+ if (any(RELPAR, p->next->word[0]))
+ continue;
+ n--;
+ continue;
+
+ default:
+ if (!specp && l != 0)
+ continue;
+ n++;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (n < 0)
+ n = 0;
+ t = (struct command *) xcalloc(1, sizeof(*t));
+ av = (Char **) xcalloc((size_t) (n + 1), sizeof(Char **));
+ t->t_dcom = av;
+ n = 0;
+ if (p2->word[0] == ')')
+ t->t_dflg = F_NOFORK;
+ lp = 0;
+ rp = 0;
+ l = 0;
+ for (p = p1; p != p2; p = p->next) {
+ c = p->word[0];
+ switch (c) {
+
+ case '(':
+ if (l == 0) {
+ if (lp != 0 && !specp)
+ seterror(ERR_BADPLP);
+ lp = p->next;
+ }
+ l++;
+ goto savep;
+
+ case ')':
+ l--;
+ if (l == 0)
+ rp = p;
+ goto savep;
+
+ case '>':
+ if (l != 0)
+ goto savep;
+ if (p->word[1] == '>')
+ t->t_dflg |= F_APPEND;
+ if (p->next != p2 && eq(p->next->word, STRand)) {
+ t->t_dflg |= F_STDERR, p = p->next;
+ if (flags & (POUT | PERR)) {
+ seterror(ERR_OUTRED);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ if (p->next != p2 && eq(p->next->word, STRbang))
+ t->t_dflg |= F_OVERWRITE, p = p->next;
+ if (p->next == p2) {
+ seterror(ERR_MISRED);
+ continue;
+ }
+ p = p->next;
+ if (any(RELPAR, p->word[0])) {
+ seterror(ERR_MISRED);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if ((flags & POUT) && ((flags & PERR) == 0 || t->t_drit))
+ seterror(ERR_OUTRED);
+ else
+ t->t_drit = Strsave(p->word);
+ continue;
+
+ case '<':
+ if (l != 0)
+ goto savep;
+ if (p->word[1] == '<')
+ t->t_dflg |= F_READ;
+ if (p->next == p2) {
+ seterror(ERR_MISRED);
+ continue;
+ }
+ p = p->next;
+ if (any(RELPAR, p->word[0])) {
+ seterror(ERR_MISRED);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if ((flags & PHERE) && (t->t_dflg & F_READ))
+ seterror(ERR_REDPAR);
+ else if ((flags & PIN) || t->t_dlef)
+ seterror(ERR_INRED);
+ else
+ t->t_dlef = Strsave(p->word);
+ continue;
+
+ savep:
+ if (!specp)
+ continue;
+ default:
+ if (l != 0 && !specp)
+ continue;
+ if (seterr == 0)
+ av[n] = Strsave(p->word);
+ n++;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ if (lp != 0 && !specp) {
+ if (n != 0)
+ seterror(ERR_BADPLPS);
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_PAREN;
+ t->t_dspr = syn0(lp, rp, PHERE);
+ }
+ else {
+ if (n == 0)
+ seterror(ERR_NULLCOM);
+ t->t_dtyp = NODE_COMMAND;
+ }
+ return (t);
+}
+
+void
+freesyn(t)
+ register struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char **v;
+
+ if (t == 0)
+ return;
+ switch (t->t_dtyp) {
+
+ case NODE_COMMAND:
+ for (v = t->t_dcom; *v; v++)
+ xfree((ptr_t) * v);
+ xfree((ptr_t) (t->t_dcom));
+ xfree((ptr_t) t->t_dlef);
+ xfree((ptr_t) t->t_drit);
+ break;
+ case NODE_PAREN:
+ freesyn(t->t_dspr);
+ xfree((ptr_t) t->t_dlef);
+ xfree((ptr_t) t->t_drit);
+ break;
+
+ case NODE_AND:
+ case NODE_OR:
+ case NODE_PIPE:
+ case NODE_LIST:
+ freesyn(t->t_dcar), freesyn(t->t_dcdr);
+ break;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) t);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/pathnames.h b/bin/csh/pathnames.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..391f40d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/pathnames.h
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)pathnames.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#define _PATH_BIN "/bin"
+#define _PATH_DOTCSHRC "/etc/csh.cshrc"
+#define _PATH_DOTLOGIN "/etc/csh.login"
+#define _PATH_DOTLOGOUT "/etc/csh.logout"
+#define _PATH_LOGIN "/usr/bin/login"
+#define _PATH_USRBIN "/usr/bin"
diff --git a/bin/csh/proc.c b/bin/csh/proc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8a85fdc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/proc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1356 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)proc.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/wait.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "dir.h"
+#include "proc.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#define BIGINDEX 9 /* largest desirable job index */
+
+static struct rusage zru;
+
+static void pflushall __P((void));
+static void pflush __P((struct process *));
+static void pclrcurr __P((struct process *));
+static void padd __P((struct command *));
+static int pprint __P((struct process *, int));
+static void ptprint __P((struct process *));
+static void pads __P((Char *));
+static void pkill __P((Char **v, int));
+static struct process
+ *pgetcurr __P((struct process *));
+static void okpcntl __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * pchild - called at interrupt level by the SIGCHLD signal
+ * indicating that at least one child has terminated or stopped
+ * thus at least one wait system call will definitely return a
+ * childs status. Top level routines (like pwait) must be sure
+ * to mask interrupts when playing with the proclist data structures!
+ */
+/* ARGUSED */
+void
+pchild(notused)
+ int notused;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+ register struct process *fp;
+ register int pid;
+ extern int insource;
+ union wait w;
+ int jobflags;
+ struct rusage ru;
+
+loop:
+ errno = 0; /* reset, just in case */
+ pid = wait3(&w.w_status,
+ (setintr && (intty || insource) ? WNOHANG | WUNTRACED : WNOHANG), &ru);
+
+ if (pid <= 0) {
+ if (errno == EINTR) {
+ errno = 0;
+ goto loop;
+ }
+ pnoprocesses = pid == -1;
+ return;
+ }
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp != NULL; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pid == pp->p_pid)
+ goto found;
+ goto loop;
+found:
+ if (pid == atoi(short2str(value(STRchild))))
+ unsetv(STRchild);
+ pp->p_flags &= ~(PRUNNING | PSTOPPED | PREPORTED);
+ if (WIFSTOPPED(w)) {
+ pp->p_flags |= PSTOPPED;
+ pp->p_reason = w.w_stopsig;
+ }
+ else {
+ if (pp->p_flags & (PTIME | PPTIME) || adrof(STRtime))
+ (void) gettimeofday(&pp->p_etime, NULL);
+
+ pp->p_rusage = ru;
+ if (WIFSIGNALED(w)) {
+ if (w.w_termsig == SIGINT)
+ pp->p_flags |= PINTERRUPTED;
+ else
+ pp->p_flags |= PSIGNALED;
+ if (w.w_coredump)
+ pp->p_flags |= PDUMPED;
+ pp->p_reason = w.w_termsig;
+ }
+ else {
+ pp->p_reason = w.w_retcode;
+ if (pp->p_reason != 0)
+ pp->p_flags |= PAEXITED;
+ else
+ pp->p_flags |= PNEXITED;
+ }
+ }
+ jobflags = 0;
+ fp = pp;
+ do {
+ if ((fp->p_flags & (PPTIME | PRUNNING | PSTOPPED)) == 0 &&
+ !child && adrof(STRtime) &&
+ fp->p_rusage.ru_utime.tv_sec + fp->p_rusage.ru_stime.tv_sec
+ >= atoi(short2str(value(STRtime))))
+ fp->p_flags |= PTIME;
+ jobflags |= fp->p_flags;
+ } while ((fp = fp->p_friends) != pp);
+ pp->p_flags &= ~PFOREGND;
+ if (pp == pp->p_friends && (pp->p_flags & PPTIME)) {
+ pp->p_flags &= ~PPTIME;
+ pp->p_flags |= PTIME;
+ }
+ if ((jobflags & (PRUNNING | PREPORTED)) == 0) {
+ fp = pp;
+ do {
+ if (fp->p_flags & PSTOPPED)
+ fp->p_flags |= PREPORTED;
+ } while ((fp = fp->p_friends) != pp);
+ while (fp->p_pid != fp->p_jobid)
+ fp = fp->p_friends;
+ if (jobflags & PSTOPPED) {
+ if (pcurrent && pcurrent != fp)
+ pprevious = pcurrent;
+ pcurrent = fp;
+ }
+ else
+ pclrcurr(fp);
+ if (jobflags & PFOREGND) {
+ if (jobflags & (PSIGNALED | PSTOPPED | PPTIME) ||
+#ifdef IIASA
+ jobflags & PAEXITED ||
+#endif
+ !eq(dcwd->di_name, fp->p_cwd->di_name)) {
+ ; /* print in pjwait */
+ }
+ /* PWP: print a newline after ^C */
+ else if (jobflags & PINTERRUPTED) {
+ (void) vis_fputc('\r' | QUOTE, cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ if (jobflags & PNOTIFY || adrof(STRnotify)) {
+ (void) vis_fputc('\r' | QUOTE, cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ (void) pprint(pp, NUMBER | NAME | REASON);
+ if ((jobflags & PSTOPPED) == 0)
+ pflush(pp);
+ }
+ else {
+ fp->p_flags |= PNEEDNOTE;
+ neednote++;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ goto loop;
+}
+
+void
+pnote()
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+ int flags;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ neednote = 0;
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp != NULL; pp = pp->p_next) {
+ if (pp->p_flags & PNEEDNOTE) {
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ pp->p_flags &= ~PNEEDNOTE;
+ flags = pprint(pp, NUMBER | NAME | REASON);
+ if ((flags & (PRUNNING | PSTOPPED)) == 0)
+ pflush(pp);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * pwait - wait for current job to terminate, maintaining integrity
+ * of current and previous job indicators.
+ */
+void
+pwait()
+{
+ register struct process *fp, *pp;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ /*
+ * Here's where dead procs get flushed.
+ */
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ for (pp = (fp = &proclist)->p_next; pp != NULL; pp = (fp = pp)->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_pid == 0) {
+ fp->p_next = pp->p_next;
+ xfree((ptr_t) pp->p_command);
+ if (pp->p_cwd && --pp->p_cwd->di_count == 0)
+ if (pp->p_cwd->di_next == 0)
+ dfree(pp->p_cwd);
+ xfree((ptr_t) pp);
+ pp = fp;
+ }
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ pjwait(pcurrjob);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * pjwait - wait for a job to finish or become stopped
+ * It is assumed to be in the foreground state (PFOREGND)
+ */
+void
+pjwait(pp)
+ register struct process *pp;
+{
+ register struct process *fp;
+ int jobflags, reason;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ while (pp->p_pid != pp->p_jobid)
+ pp = pp->p_friends;
+ fp = pp;
+
+ do {
+ if ((fp->p_flags & (PFOREGND | PRUNNING)) == PRUNNING)
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "BUG: waiting for background job!\n");
+ } while ((fp = fp->p_friends) != pp);
+ /*
+ * Now keep pausing as long as we are not interrupted (SIGINT), and the
+ * target process, or any of its friends, are running
+ */
+ fp = pp;
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ for (;;) {
+ (void) sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ jobflags = 0;
+ do
+ jobflags |= fp->p_flags;
+ while ((fp = (fp->p_friends)) != pp);
+ if ((jobflags & PRUNNING) == 0)
+ break;
+#ifdef JOBDEBUG
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "starting to sigpause for SIGCHLD on %d\n",
+ fp->p_pid);
+#endif /* JOBDEBUG */
+ (void) sigpause(omask & ~sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ }
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ if (tpgrp > 0) /* get tty back */
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, tpgrp);
+ if ((jobflags & (PSIGNALED | PSTOPPED | PTIME)) ||
+ !eq(dcwd->di_name, fp->p_cwd->di_name)) {
+ if (jobflags & PSTOPPED) {
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ if (adrof(STRlistjobs)) {
+ Char *jobcommand[3];
+
+ jobcommand[0] = STRjobs;
+ if (eq(value(STRlistjobs), STRlong))
+ jobcommand[1] = STRml;
+ else
+ jobcommand[1] = NULL;
+ jobcommand[2] = NULL;
+
+ dojobs(jobcommand, NULL);
+ (void) pprint(pp, SHELLDIR);
+ }
+ else
+ (void) pprint(pp, AREASON | SHELLDIR);
+ }
+ else
+ (void) pprint(pp, AREASON | SHELLDIR);
+ }
+ if ((jobflags & (PINTERRUPTED | PSTOPPED)) && setintr &&
+ (!gointr || !eq(gointr, STRminus))) {
+ if ((jobflags & PSTOPPED) == 0)
+ pflush(pp);
+ pintr1(0);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ reason = 0;
+ fp = pp;
+ do {
+ if (fp->p_reason)
+ reason = fp->p_flags & (PSIGNALED | PINTERRUPTED) ?
+ fp->p_reason | META : fp->p_reason;
+ } while ((fp = fp->p_friends) != pp);
+ if ((reason != 0) && (adrof(STRprintexitvalue))) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "Exit %d\n", reason);
+ }
+ set(STRstatus, putn(reason));
+ if (reason && exiterr)
+ exitstat();
+ pflush(pp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dowait - wait for all processes to finish
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dowait(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ pjobs++;
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+loop:
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_pid && /* pp->p_pid == pp->p_jobid && */
+ pp->p_flags & PRUNNING) {
+ (void) sigpause((sigset_t) 0);
+ goto loop;
+ }
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ pjobs = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+ * pflushall - flush all jobs from list (e.g. at fork())
+ */
+static void
+pflushall()
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp != NULL; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_pid)
+ pflush(pp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pflush - flag all process structures in the same job as the
+ * the argument process for deletion. The actual free of the
+ * space is not done here since pflush is called at interrupt level.
+ */
+static void
+pflush(pp)
+ register struct process *pp;
+{
+ register struct process *np;
+ register int idx;
+
+ if (pp->p_pid == 0) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "BUG: process flushed twice");
+ return;
+ }
+ while (pp->p_pid != pp->p_jobid)
+ pp = pp->p_friends;
+ pclrcurr(pp);
+ if (pp == pcurrjob)
+ pcurrjob = 0;
+ idx = pp->p_index;
+ np = pp;
+ do {
+ np->p_index = np->p_pid = 0;
+ np->p_flags &= ~PNEEDNOTE;
+ } while ((np = np->p_friends) != pp);
+ if (idx == pmaxindex) {
+ for (np = proclist.p_next, idx = 0; np; np = np->p_next)
+ if (np->p_index > idx)
+ idx = np->p_index;
+ pmaxindex = idx;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * pclrcurr - make sure the given job is not the current or previous job;
+ * pp MUST be the job leader
+ */
+static void
+pclrcurr(pp)
+ register struct process *pp;
+{
+
+ if (pp == pcurrent)
+ if (pprevious != NULL) {
+ pcurrent = pprevious;
+ pprevious = pgetcurr(pp);
+ }
+ else {
+ pcurrent = pgetcurr(pp);
+ pprevious = pgetcurr(pp);
+ }
+ else if (pp == pprevious)
+ pprevious = pgetcurr(pp);
+}
+
+/* +4 here is 1 for '\0', 1 ea for << >& >> */
+static Char command[PMAXLEN + 4];
+static int cmdlen;
+static Char *cmdp;
+
+/*
+ * palloc - allocate a process structure and fill it up.
+ * an important assumption is made that the process is running.
+ */
+void
+palloc(pid, t)
+ int pid;
+ register struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+ int i;
+
+ pp = (struct process *) xcalloc(1, (size_t) sizeof(struct process));
+ pp->p_pid = pid;
+ pp->p_flags = t->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND ? PRUNNING : PRUNNING | PFOREGND;
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_TIME)
+ pp->p_flags |= PPTIME;
+ cmdp = command;
+ cmdlen = 0;
+ padd(t);
+ *cmdp++ = 0;
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_PIPEOUT) {
+ pp->p_flags |= PPOU;
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_STDERR)
+ pp->p_flags |= PERR;
+ }
+ pp->p_command = Strsave(command);
+ if (pcurrjob) {
+ struct process *fp;
+
+ /* careful here with interrupt level */
+ pp->p_cwd = 0;
+ pp->p_index = pcurrjob->p_index;
+ pp->p_friends = pcurrjob;
+ pp->p_jobid = pcurrjob->p_pid;
+ for (fp = pcurrjob; fp->p_friends != pcurrjob; fp = fp->p_friends)
+ continue;
+ fp->p_friends = pp;
+ }
+ else {
+ pcurrjob = pp;
+ pp->p_jobid = pid;
+ pp->p_friends = pp;
+ pp->p_cwd = dcwd;
+ dcwd->di_count++;
+ if (pmaxindex < BIGINDEX)
+ pp->p_index = ++pmaxindex;
+ else {
+ struct process *np;
+
+ for (i = 1;; i++) {
+ for (np = proclist.p_next; np; np = np->p_next)
+ if (np->p_index == i)
+ goto tryagain;
+ pp->p_index = i;
+ if (i > pmaxindex)
+ pmaxindex = i;
+ break;
+ tryagain:;
+ }
+ }
+ if (pcurrent == NULL)
+ pcurrent = pp;
+ else if (pprevious == NULL)
+ pprevious = pp;
+ }
+ pp->p_next = proclist.p_next;
+ proclist.p_next = pp;
+ (void) gettimeofday(&pp->p_btime, NULL);
+}
+
+static void
+padd(t)
+ register struct command *t;
+{
+ Char **argp;
+
+ if (t == 0)
+ return;
+ switch (t->t_dtyp) {
+
+ case NODE_PAREN:
+ pads(STRLparensp);
+ padd(t->t_dspr);
+ pads(STRspRparen);
+ break;
+
+ case NODE_COMMAND:
+ for (argp = t->t_dcom; *argp; argp++) {
+ pads(*argp);
+ if (argp[1])
+ pads(STRspace);
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case NODE_OR:
+ case NODE_AND:
+ case NODE_PIPE:
+ case NODE_LIST:
+ padd(t->t_dcar);
+ switch (t->t_dtyp) {
+ case NODE_OR:
+ pads(STRspor2sp);
+ break;
+ case NODE_AND:
+ pads(STRspand2sp);
+ break;
+ case NODE_PIPE:
+ pads(STRsporsp);
+ break;
+ case NODE_LIST:
+ pads(STRsemisp);
+ break;
+ }
+ padd(t->t_dcdr);
+ return;
+ }
+ if ((t->t_dflg & F_PIPEIN) == 0 && t->t_dlef) {
+ pads((t->t_dflg & F_READ) ? STRspLarrow2sp : STRspLarrowsp);
+ pads(t->t_dlef);
+ }
+ if ((t->t_dflg & F_PIPEOUT) == 0 && t->t_drit) {
+ pads((t->t_dflg & F_APPEND) ? STRspRarrow2 : STRspRarrow);
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_STDERR)
+ pads(STRand);
+ pads(STRspace);
+ pads(t->t_drit);
+ }
+}
+
+static void
+pads(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ /*
+ * Avoid the Quoted Space alias hack! Reported by:
+ * sam@john-bigboote.ICS.UCI.EDU (Sam Horrocks)
+ */
+ if (cp[0] == STRQNULL[0])
+ cp++;
+
+ i = Strlen(cp);
+
+ if (cmdlen >= PMAXLEN)
+ return;
+ if (cmdlen + i >= PMAXLEN) {
+ (void) Strcpy(cmdp, STRsp3dots);
+ cmdlen = PMAXLEN;
+ cmdp += 4;
+ return;
+ }
+ (void) Strcpy(cmdp, cp);
+ cmdp += i;
+ cmdlen += i;
+}
+
+/*
+ * psavejob - temporarily save the current job on a one level stack
+ * so another job can be created. Used for { } in exp6
+ * and `` in globbing.
+ */
+void
+psavejob()
+{
+
+ pholdjob = pcurrjob;
+ pcurrjob = NULL;
+}
+
+/*
+ * prestjob - opposite of psavejob. This may be missed if we are interrupted
+ * somewhere, but pendjob cleans up anyway.
+ */
+void
+prestjob()
+{
+
+ pcurrjob = pholdjob;
+ pholdjob = NULL;
+}
+
+/*
+ * pendjob - indicate that a job (set of commands) has been completed
+ * or is about to begin.
+ */
+void
+pendjob()
+{
+ register struct process *pp, *tp;
+
+ if (pcurrjob && (pcurrjob->p_flags & (PFOREGND | PSTOPPED)) == 0) {
+ pp = pcurrjob;
+ while (pp->p_pid != pp->p_jobid)
+ pp = pp->p_friends;
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "[%d]", pp->p_index);
+ tp = pp;
+ do {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " %d", pp->p_pid);
+ pp = pp->p_friends;
+ } while (pp != tp);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+ pholdjob = pcurrjob = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+ * pprint - print a job
+ */
+static int
+pprint(pp, flag)
+ register struct process *pp;
+ bool flag;
+{
+ register status, reason;
+ struct process *tp;
+ int jobflags, pstatus;
+ bool hadnl = 1; /* did we just have a newline */
+ char *format;
+
+ (void) fpurge(cshout);
+
+ while (pp->p_pid != pp->p_jobid)
+ pp = pp->p_friends;
+ if (pp == pp->p_friends && (pp->p_flags & PPTIME)) {
+ pp->p_flags &= ~PPTIME;
+ pp->p_flags |= PTIME;
+ }
+ tp = pp;
+ status = reason = -1;
+ jobflags = 0;
+ do {
+ jobflags |= pp->p_flags;
+ pstatus = pp->p_flags & PALLSTATES;
+ if (tp != pp && !hadnl && !(flag & FANCY) &&
+ ((pstatus == status && pp->p_reason == reason) ||
+ !(flag & REASON))) {
+ (void) fputc(' ', cshout);
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ else {
+ if (tp != pp && !hadnl) {
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ hadnl = 1;
+ }
+ if (flag & NUMBER) {
+ if (pp == tp)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "[%d]%s %c ", pp->p_index,
+ pp->p_index < 10 ? " " : "",
+ pp == pcurrent ? '+' :
+ (pp == pprevious ? '-' : ' '));
+ else
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " ");
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ if (flag & FANCY) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%5d ", pp->p_pid);
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ if (flag & (REASON | AREASON)) {
+ if (flag & NAME)
+ format = "%-23s";
+ else
+ format = "%s";
+ if (pstatus == status)
+ if (pp->p_reason == reason) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, format, "");
+ hadnl = 0;
+ goto prcomd;
+ }
+ else
+ reason = pp->p_reason;
+ else {
+ status = pstatus;
+ reason = pp->p_reason;
+ }
+ switch (status) {
+
+ case PRUNNING:
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, format, "Running ");
+ hadnl = 0;
+ break;
+
+ case PINTERRUPTED:
+ case PSTOPPED:
+ case PSIGNALED:
+ /*
+ * tell what happened to the background job
+ * From: Michael Schroeder
+ * <mlschroe@immd4.informatik.uni-erlangen.de>
+ */
+ if ((flag & REASON)
+ || ((flag & AREASON)
+ && reason != SIGINT
+ && (reason != SIGPIPE
+ || (pp->p_flags & PPOU) == 0))) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, format,
+ sys_siglist[(unsigned char)
+ pp->p_reason]);
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case PNEXITED:
+ case PAEXITED:
+ if (flag & REASON) {
+ if (pp->p_reason)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "Exit %-18d", pp->p_reason);
+ else
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, format, "Done");
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "BUG: status=%-9o", status);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+prcomd:
+ if (flag & NAME) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s", vis_str(pp->p_command));
+ if (pp->p_flags & PPOU)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " |");
+ if (pp->p_flags & PERR)
+ (void) fputc('&', cshout);
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ if (flag & (REASON | AREASON) && pp->p_flags & PDUMPED) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " (core dumped)");
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ if (tp == pp->p_friends) {
+ if (flag & AMPERSAND) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " &");
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ if (flag & JOBDIR &&
+ !eq(tp->p_cwd->di_name, dcwd->di_name)) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " (wd: ");
+ dtildepr(value(STRhome), tp->p_cwd->di_name);
+ (void) fputc(')', cshout);
+ hadnl = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ if (pp->p_flags & PPTIME && !(status & (PSTOPPED | PRUNNING))) {
+ if (!hadnl)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "\n\t");
+ prusage(&zru, &pp->p_rusage, &pp->p_etime,
+ &pp->p_btime);
+ hadnl = 1;
+ }
+ if (tp == pp->p_friends) {
+ if (!hadnl) {
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ hadnl = 1;
+ }
+ if (flag & SHELLDIR && !eq(tp->p_cwd->di_name, dcwd->di_name)) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "(wd now: ");
+ dtildepr(value(STRhome), dcwd->di_name);
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, ")\n");
+ hadnl = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ } while ((pp = pp->p_friends) != tp);
+ if (jobflags & PTIME && (jobflags & (PSTOPPED | PRUNNING)) == 0) {
+ if (jobflags & NUMBER)
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, " ");
+ ptprint(tp);
+ hadnl = 1;
+ }
+ (void) fflush(cshout);
+ return (jobflags);
+}
+
+static void
+ptprint(tp)
+ register struct process *tp;
+{
+ struct timeval tetime, diff;
+ static struct timeval ztime;
+ struct rusage ru;
+ static struct rusage zru;
+ register struct process *pp = tp;
+
+ ru = zru;
+ tetime = ztime;
+ do {
+ ruadd(&ru, &pp->p_rusage);
+ tvsub(&diff, &pp->p_etime, &pp->p_btime);
+ if (timercmp(&diff, &tetime, >))
+ tetime = diff;
+ } while ((pp = pp->p_friends) != tp);
+ prusage(&zru, &ru, &tetime, &ztime);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dojobs - print all jobs
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dojobs(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+ register int flag = NUMBER | NAME | REASON;
+ int i;
+
+ if (chkstop)
+ chkstop = 2;
+ if (*++v) {
+ if (v[1] || !eq(*v, STRml))
+ stderror(ERR_JOBS);
+ flag |= FANCY | JOBDIR;
+ }
+ for (i = 1; i <= pmaxindex; i++)
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_index == i && pp->p_pid == pp->p_jobid) {
+ pp->p_flags &= ~PNEEDNOTE;
+ if (!(pprint(pp, flag) & (PRUNNING | PSTOPPED)))
+ pflush(pp);
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * dofg - builtin - put the job into the foreground
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dofg(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ okpcntl();
+ ++v;
+ do {
+ pp = pfind(*v);
+ pstart(pp, 1);
+ pjwait(pp);
+ } while (*v && *++v);
+}
+
+/*
+ * %... - builtin - put the job into the foreground
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dofg1(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ okpcntl();
+ pp = pfind(v[0]);
+ pstart(pp, 1);
+ pjwait(pp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dobg - builtin - put the job into the background
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dobg(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ okpcntl();
+ ++v;
+ do {
+ pp = pfind(*v);
+ pstart(pp, 0);
+ } while (*v && *++v);
+}
+
+/*
+ * %... & - builtin - put the job into the background
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dobg1(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ pp = pfind(v[0]);
+ pstart(pp, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dostop - builtin - stop the job
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dostop(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ pkill(++v, SIGSTOP);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dokill - builtin - superset of kill (1)
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dokill(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register int signum = SIGTERM;
+ register char *name;
+
+ v++;
+ if (v[0] && v[0][0] == '-') {
+ if (v[0][1] == 'l') {
+ for (signum = 1; signum < NSIG; signum++) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s ", sys_signame[signum]);
+ if (signum == NSIG / 2)
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ }
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (Isdigit(v[0][1])) {
+ signum = atoi(short2str(v[0] + 1));
+ if (signum < 0 || signum > NSIG)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_BADSIG);
+ }
+ else {
+ name = short2str(&v[0][1]);
+ if (!strncasecmp(name, "sig", 3))
+ name += 3;
+
+ for (signum = 1; signum < NSIG; signum++)
+ if (!strcasecmp(sys_signame[signum], name))
+ break;
+
+ if (signum == NSIG) {
+ setname(vis_str(&v[0][1]));
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_UNKSIG);
+ }
+ }
+ v++;
+ }
+ pkill(v, signum);
+}
+
+static void
+pkill(v, signum)
+ Char **v;
+ int signum;
+{
+ register struct process *pp, *np;
+ register int jobflags = 0;
+ int pid, err1 = 0;
+ sigset_t omask;
+ Char *cp;
+
+ omask = sigmask(SIGCHLD);
+ if (setintr)
+ omask |= sigmask(SIGINT);
+ omask = sigblock(omask) & ~omask;
+ gflag = 0, tglob(v);
+ if (gflag) {
+ v = globall(v);
+ if (v == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ }
+ else {
+ v = gargv = saveblk(v);
+ trim(v);
+ }
+
+ while (v && (cp = *v)) {
+ if (*cp == '%') {
+ np = pp = pfind(cp);
+ do
+ jobflags |= np->p_flags;
+ while ((np = np->p_friends) != pp);
+ switch (signum) {
+
+ case SIGSTOP:
+ case SIGTSTP:
+ case SIGTTIN:
+ case SIGTTOU:
+ if ((jobflags & PRUNNING) == 0) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s: Already suspended\n",
+ vis_str(cp));
+ err1++;
+ goto cont;
+ }
+ break;
+ /*
+ * suspend a process, kill -CONT %, then type jobs; the shell
+ * says it is suspended, but it is running; thanks jaap..
+ */
+ case SIGCONT:
+ pstart(pp, 0);
+ goto cont;
+ }
+ if (killpg((pid_t) pp->p_jobid, signum) < 0) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%s: %s\n", vis_str(cp),
+ strerror(errno));
+ err1++;
+ }
+ if (signum == SIGTERM || signum == SIGHUP)
+ (void) killpg((pid_t) pp->p_jobid, SIGCONT);
+ }
+ else if (!(Isdigit(*cp) || *cp == '-'))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_JOBARGS);
+ else {
+ pid = atoi(short2str(cp));
+ if (kill((pid_t) pid, signum) < 0) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "%d: %s\n", pid, strerror(errno));
+ err1++;
+ goto cont;
+ }
+ if (signum == SIGTERM || signum == SIGHUP)
+ (void) kill((pid_t) pid, SIGCONT);
+ }
+cont:
+ v++;
+ }
+ if (gargv)
+ blkfree(gargv), gargv = 0;
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ if (err1)
+ stderror(ERR_SILENT);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pstart - start the job in foreground/background
+ */
+void
+pstart(pp, foregnd)
+ register struct process *pp;
+ int foregnd;
+{
+ register struct process *np;
+ sigset_t omask;
+ long jobflags = 0;
+
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ np = pp;
+ do {
+ jobflags |= np->p_flags;
+ if (np->p_flags & (PRUNNING | PSTOPPED)) {
+ np->p_flags |= PRUNNING;
+ np->p_flags &= ~PSTOPPED;
+ if (foregnd)
+ np->p_flags |= PFOREGND;
+ else
+ np->p_flags &= ~PFOREGND;
+ }
+ } while ((np = np->p_friends) != pp);
+ if (!foregnd)
+ pclrcurr(pp);
+ (void) pprint(pp, foregnd ? NAME | JOBDIR : NUMBER | NAME | AMPERSAND);
+ if (foregnd)
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, pp->p_jobid);
+ if (jobflags & PSTOPPED)
+ (void) killpg((pid_t) pp->p_jobid, SIGCONT);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+}
+
+void
+panystop(neednl)
+ bool neednl;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ chkstop = 2;
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_flags & PSTOPPED)
+ stderror(ERR_STOPPED, neednl ? "\n" : "");
+}
+
+struct process *
+pfind(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ register struct process *pp, *np;
+
+ if (cp == 0 || cp[1] == 0 || eq(cp, STRcent2) || eq(cp, STRcentplus)) {
+ if (pcurrent == NULL)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_JOBCUR);
+ return (pcurrent);
+ }
+ if (eq(cp, STRcentminus) || eq(cp, STRcenthash)) {
+ if (pprevious == NULL)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_JOBPREV);
+ return (pprevious);
+ }
+ if (Isdigit(cp[1])) {
+ int idx = atoi(short2str(cp + 1));
+
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_index == idx && pp->p_pid == pp->p_jobid)
+ return (pp);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOSUCHJOB);
+ }
+ np = NULL;
+ for (pp = proclist.p_next; pp; pp = pp->p_next)
+ if (pp->p_pid == pp->p_jobid) {
+ if (cp[1] == '?') {
+ register Char *dp;
+
+ for (dp = pp->p_command; *dp; dp++) {
+ if (*dp != cp[2])
+ continue;
+ if (prefix(cp + 2, dp))
+ goto match;
+ }
+ }
+ else if (prefix(cp + 1, pp->p_command)) {
+ match:
+ if (np)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_AMBIG);
+ np = pp;
+ }
+ }
+ if (np)
+ return (np);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | cp[1] == '?' ? ERR_JOBPAT : ERR_NOSUCHJOB);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ return (0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * pgetcurr - find most recent job that is not pp, preferably stopped
+ */
+static struct process *
+pgetcurr(pp)
+ register struct process *pp;
+{
+ register struct process *np;
+ register struct process *xp = NULL;
+
+ for (np = proclist.p_next; np; np = np->p_next)
+ if (np != pcurrent && np != pp && np->p_pid &&
+ np->p_pid == np->p_jobid) {
+ if (np->p_flags & PSTOPPED)
+ return (np);
+ if (xp == NULL)
+ xp = np;
+ }
+ return (xp);
+}
+
+/*
+ * donotify - flag the job so as to report termination asynchronously
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+donotify(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct process *pp;
+
+ pp = pfind(*++v);
+ pp->p_flags |= PNOTIFY;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Do the fork and whatever should be done in the child side that
+ * should not be done if we are not forking at all (like for simple builtin's)
+ * Also do everything that needs any signals fiddled with in the parent side
+ *
+ * Wanttty tells whether process and/or tty pgrps are to be manipulated:
+ * -1: leave tty alone; inherit pgrp from parent
+ * 0: already have tty; manipulate process pgrps only
+ * 1: want to claim tty; manipulate process and tty pgrps
+ * It is usually just the value of tpgrp.
+ */
+
+int
+pfork(t, wanttty)
+ struct command *t; /* command we are forking for */
+ int wanttty;
+{
+ register int pid;
+ bool ignint = 0;
+ int pgrp;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ /*
+ * A child will be uninterruptible only under very special conditions.
+ * Remember that the semantics of '&' is implemented by disconnecting the
+ * process from the tty so signals do not need to ignored just for '&'.
+ * Thus signals are set to default action for children unless: we have had
+ * an "onintr -" (then specifically ignored) we are not playing with
+ * signals (inherit action)
+ */
+ if (setintr)
+ ignint = (tpgrp == -1 && (t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT))
+ || (gointr && eq(gointr, STRminus));
+ /*
+ * Check for maximum nesting of 16 processes to avoid Forking loops
+ */
+ if (child == 16)
+ stderror(ERR_NESTING, 16);
+ /*
+ * Hold SIGCHLD until we have the process installed in our table.
+ */
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ while ((pid = fork()) < 0)
+ if (setintr == 0)
+ (void) sleep(FORKSLEEP);
+ else {
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ stderror(ERR_NOPROC);
+ }
+ if (pid == 0) {
+ settimes();
+ pgrp = pcurrjob ? pcurrjob->p_jobid : getpid();
+ pflushall();
+ pcurrjob = NULL;
+ child++;
+ if (setintr) {
+ setintr = 0; /* until I think otherwise */
+ /*
+ * Children just get blown away on SIGINT, SIGQUIT unless "onintr
+ * -" seen.
+ */
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, ignint ? SIG_IGN : SIG_DFL);
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, ignint ? SIG_IGN : SIG_DFL);
+ if (wanttty >= 0) {
+ /* make stoppable */
+ (void) signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTIN, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTOU, SIG_DFL);
+ }
+ (void) signal(SIGTERM, parterm);
+ }
+ else if (tpgrp == -1 && (t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT)) {
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ }
+ pgetty(wanttty, pgrp);
+ /*
+ * Nohup and nice apply only to NODE_COMMAND's but it would be nice
+ * (?!?) if you could say "nohup (foo;bar)" Then the parser would have
+ * to know about nice/nohup/time
+ */
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_NOHUP)
+ (void) signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN);
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_NICE)
+ (void) setpriority(PRIO_PROCESS, 0, t->t_nice);
+ }
+ else {
+ if (wanttty >= 0)
+ (void) setpgid(pid, pcurrjob ? pcurrjob->p_jobid : pid);
+ palloc(pid, t);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ }
+
+ return (pid);
+}
+
+static void
+okpcntl()
+{
+ if (tpgrp == -1)
+ stderror(ERR_JOBCONTROL);
+ if (tpgrp == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_JOBCTRLSUB);
+}
+
+/*
+ * if we don't have vfork(), things can still go in the wrong order
+ * resulting in the famous 'Stopped (tty output)'. But some systems
+ * don't permit the setpgid() call, (these are more recent secure
+ * systems such as ibm's aix). Then we'd rather print an error message
+ * than hang the shell!
+ * I am open to suggestions how to fix that.
+ */
+void
+pgetty(wanttty, pgrp)
+ int wanttty, pgrp;
+{
+ sigset_t omask = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * christos: I am blocking the tty signals till I've set things
+ * correctly....
+ */
+ if (wanttty > 0)
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGTSTP)|sigmask(SIGTTIN)|sigmask(SIGTTOU));
+ /*
+ * From: Michael Schroeder <mlschroe@immd4.informatik.uni-erlangen.de>
+ * Don't check for tpgrp >= 0 so even non-interactive shells give
+ * background jobs process groups Same for the comparison in the other part
+ * of the #ifdef
+ */
+ if (wanttty >= 0)
+ if (setpgid(0, pgrp) == -1) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr, "csh: setpgid error.\n");
+ xexit(0);
+ }
+
+ if (wanttty > 0) {
+ (void) tcsetpgrp(FSHTTY, pgrp);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ }
+
+ if (tpgrp > 0)
+ tpgrp = 0; /* gave tty away */
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/proc.h b/bin/csh/proc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fcbf96a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/proc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,101 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)proc.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Structure for each process the shell knows about:
+ * allocated and filled by pcreate.
+ * flushed by pflush; freeing always happens at top level
+ * so the interrupt level has less to worry about.
+ * processes are related to "friends" when in a pipeline;
+ * p_friends links makes a circular list of such jobs
+ */
+struct process {
+ struct process *p_next; /* next in global "proclist" */
+ struct process *p_friends; /* next in job list (or self) */
+ struct directory *p_cwd; /* cwd of the job (only in head) */
+ short unsigned p_flags; /* various job status flags */
+ char p_reason; /* reason for entering this state */
+ int p_index; /* shorthand job index */
+ int p_pid;
+ int p_jobid; /* pid of job leader */
+ /* if a job is stopped/background p_jobid gives its pgrp */
+ struct timeval p_btime; /* begin time */
+ struct timeval p_etime; /* end time */
+ struct rusage p_rusage;
+ Char *p_command; /* first PMAXLEN chars of command */
+};
+
+/* flag values for p_flags */
+#define PRUNNING (1<<0) /* running */
+#define PSTOPPED (1<<1) /* stopped */
+#define PNEXITED (1<<2) /* normally exited */
+#define PAEXITED (1<<3) /* abnormally exited */
+#define PSIGNALED (1<<4) /* terminated by a signal != SIGINT */
+
+#define PALLSTATES (PRUNNING|PSTOPPED|PNEXITED|PAEXITED|PSIGNALED|PINTERRUPTED)
+#define PNOTIFY (1<<5) /* notify async when done */
+#define PTIME (1<<6) /* job times should be printed */
+#define PAWAITED (1<<7) /* top level is waiting for it */
+#define PFOREGND (1<<8) /* started in shells pgrp */
+#define PDUMPED (1<<9) /* process dumped core */
+#define PERR (1<<10) /* diagnostic output also piped out */
+#define PPOU (1<<11) /* piped output */
+#define PREPORTED (1<<12) /* status has been reported */
+#define PINTERRUPTED (1<<13) /* job stopped via interrupt signal */
+#define PPTIME (1<<14) /* time individual process */
+#define PNEEDNOTE (1<<15) /* notify as soon as practical */
+
+#define PMAXLEN 80
+
+/* defines for arguments to pprint */
+#define NUMBER 01
+#define NAME 02
+#define REASON 04
+#define AMPERSAND 010
+#define FANCY 020
+#define SHELLDIR 040 /* print shell's dir if not the same */
+#define JOBDIR 0100 /* print job's dir if not the same */
+#define AREASON 0200
+
+struct process proclist; /* list head of all processes */
+bool pnoprocesses; /* pchild found nothing to wait for */
+
+struct process *pholdjob; /* one level stack of current jobs */
+
+struct process *pcurrjob; /* current job */
+struct process *pcurrent; /* current job in table */
+struct process *pprevious; /* previous job in table */
+
+int pmaxindex; /* current maximum job index */
diff --git a/bin/csh/sem.c b/bin/csh/sem.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..584d3fb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/sem.c
@@ -0,0 +1,645 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)sem.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "proc.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void vffree __P((int));
+static Char *splicepipe __P((struct command *t, Char *));
+static void doio __P((struct command *t, int *, int *));
+static void chkclob __P((char *));
+
+void
+execute(t, wanttty, pipein, pipeout)
+ register struct command *t;
+ int wanttty, *pipein, *pipeout;
+{
+ bool forked = 0;
+ struct biltins *bifunc;
+ int pid = 0;
+ int pv[2];
+
+ static sigset_t csigmask;
+
+ static sigset_t ocsigmask;
+ static int onosigchld = 0;
+ static int nosigchld = 0;
+
+ UNREGISTER(forked);
+ UNREGISTER(bifunc);
+ UNREGISTER(wanttty);
+
+ if (t == 0)
+ return;
+
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND)
+ wanttty = 0;
+ switch (t->t_dtyp) {
+
+ case NODE_COMMAND:
+ if ((t->t_dcom[0][0] & (QUOTE | TRIM)) == QUOTE)
+ (void) Strcpy(t->t_dcom[0], t->t_dcom[0] + 1);
+ if ((t->t_dflg & F_REPEAT) == 0)
+ Dfix(t); /* $ " ' \ */
+ if (t->t_dcom[0] == 0)
+ return;
+ /* fall into... */
+
+ case NODE_PAREN:
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_PIPEOUT)
+ mypipe(pipeout);
+ /*
+ * Must do << early so parent will know where input pointer should be.
+ * If noexec then this is all we do.
+ */
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_READ) {
+ (void) close(0);
+ heredoc(t->t_dlef);
+ if (noexec)
+ (void) close(0);
+ }
+
+ set(STRstatus, Strsave(STR0));
+
+ /*
+ * This mess is the necessary kludge to handle the prefix builtins:
+ * nice, nohup, time. These commands can also be used by themselves,
+ * and this is not handled here. This will also work when loops are
+ * parsed.
+ */
+ while (t->t_dtyp == NODE_COMMAND)
+ if (eq(t->t_dcom[0], STRnice))
+ if (t->t_dcom[1])
+ if (strchr("+-", t->t_dcom[1][0]))
+ if (t->t_dcom[2]) {
+ setname("nice");
+ t->t_nice =
+ getn(t->t_dcom[1]);
+ lshift(t->t_dcom, 2);
+ t->t_dflg |= F_NICE;
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ else {
+ t->t_nice = 4;
+ lshift(t->t_dcom, 1);
+ t->t_dflg |= F_NICE;
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ else if (eq(t->t_dcom[0], STRnohup))
+ if (t->t_dcom[1]) {
+ t->t_dflg |= F_NOHUP;
+ lshift(t->t_dcom, 1);
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ else if (eq(t->t_dcom[0], STRtime))
+ if (t->t_dcom[1]) {
+ t->t_dflg |= F_TIME;
+ lshift(t->t_dcom, 1);
+ }
+ else
+ break;
+ else
+ break;
+
+ /* is it a command */
+ if (t->t_dtyp == NODE_COMMAND) {
+ /*
+ * Check if we have a builtin function and remember which one.
+ */
+ bifunc = isbfunc(t);
+ if (noexec) {
+ /*
+ * Continue for builtins that are part of the scripting language
+ */
+ if (bifunc->bfunct != dobreak && bifunc->bfunct != docontin &&
+ bifunc->bfunct != doelse && bifunc->bfunct != doend &&
+ bifunc->bfunct != doforeach && bifunc->bfunct != dogoto &&
+ bifunc->bfunct != doif && bifunc->bfunct != dorepeat &&
+ bifunc->bfunct != doswbrk && bifunc->bfunct != doswitch &&
+ bifunc->bfunct != dowhile && bifunc->bfunct != dozip)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else { /* not a command */
+ bifunc = NULL;
+ if (noexec)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * We fork only if we are timed, or are not the end of a parenthesized
+ * list and not a simple builtin function. Simple meaning one that is
+ * not pipedout, niced, nohupped, or &'d. It would be nice(?) to not
+ * fork in some of these cases.
+ */
+ /*
+ * Prevent forking cd, pushd, popd, chdir cause this will cause the
+ * shell not to change dir!
+ */
+ if (bifunc && (bifunc->bfunct == dochngd ||
+ bifunc->bfunct == dopushd ||
+ bifunc->bfunct == dopopd))
+ t->t_dflg &= ~(F_NICE);
+ if (((t->t_dflg & F_TIME) || ((t->t_dflg & F_NOFORK) == 0 &&
+ (!bifunc || t->t_dflg &
+ (F_PIPEOUT | F_AMPERSAND | F_NICE | F_NOHUP)))) ||
+ /*
+ * We have to fork for eval too.
+ */
+ (bifunc && (t->t_dflg & (F_PIPEIN | F_PIPEOUT)) != 0 &&
+ bifunc->bfunct == doeval))
+ if (t->t_dtyp == NODE_PAREN ||
+ t->t_dflg & (F_REPEAT | F_AMPERSAND) || bifunc) {
+ forked++;
+ /*
+ * We need to block SIGCHLD here, so that if the process does
+ * not die before we can set the process group
+ */
+ if (wanttty >= 0 && !nosigchld) {
+ csigmask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ nosigchld = 1;
+ }
+
+ pid = pfork(t, wanttty);
+ if (pid == 0 && nosigchld) {
+ (void) sigsetmask(csigmask);
+ nosigchld = 0;
+ }
+ else if (pid != 0 && (t->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND))
+ backpid = pid;
+
+ }
+ else {
+ int ochild, osetintr, ohaderr, odidfds;
+ int oSHIN, oSHOUT, oSHERR, oOLDSTD, otpgrp;
+ sigset_t omask;
+
+ /*
+ * Prepare for the vfork by saving everything that the child
+ * corrupts before it exec's. Note that in some signal
+ * implementations which keep the signal info in user space
+ * (e.g. Sun's) it will also be necessary to save and restore
+ * the current sigvec's for the signals the child touches
+ * before it exec's.
+ */
+ if (wanttty >= 0 && !nosigchld && !noexec) {
+ csigmask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD));
+ nosigchld = 1;
+ }
+ omask = sigblock(sigmask(SIGCHLD) | sigmask(SIGINT));
+ ochild = child;
+ osetintr = setintr;
+ ohaderr = haderr;
+ odidfds = didfds;
+ oSHIN = SHIN;
+ oSHOUT = SHOUT;
+ oSHERR = SHERR;
+ oOLDSTD = OLDSTD;
+ otpgrp = tpgrp;
+ ocsigmask = csigmask;
+ onosigchld = nosigchld;
+ Vsav = Vdp = 0;
+ Vexpath = 0;
+ Vt = 0;
+ pid = vfork();
+
+ if (pid < 0) {
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ stderror(ERR_NOPROC);
+ }
+ forked++;
+ if (pid) { /* parent */
+ child = ochild;
+ setintr = osetintr;
+ haderr = ohaderr;
+ didfds = odidfds;
+ SHIN = oSHIN;
+ SHOUT = oSHOUT;
+ SHERR = oSHERR;
+ OLDSTD = oOLDSTD;
+ tpgrp = otpgrp;
+ csigmask = ocsigmask;
+ nosigchld = onosigchld;
+
+ xfree((ptr_t) Vsav);
+ Vsav = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) Vdp);
+ Vdp = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) Vexpath);
+ Vexpath = 0;
+ blkfree((Char **) Vt);
+ Vt = 0;
+ /* this is from pfork() */
+ palloc(pid, t);
+ (void) sigsetmask(omask);
+ }
+ else { /* child */
+ /* this is from pfork() */
+ int pgrp;
+ bool ignint = 0;
+
+ if (nosigchld) {
+ (void) sigsetmask(csigmask);
+ nosigchld = 0;
+ }
+
+ if (setintr)
+ ignint =
+ (tpgrp == -1 &&
+ (t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT))
+ || (gointr && eq(gointr, STRminus));
+ pgrp = pcurrjob ? pcurrjob->p_jobid : getpid();
+ child++;
+ if (setintr) {
+ setintr = 0;
+ if (ignint) {
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ }
+ else {
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, vffree);
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_DFL);
+ }
+
+ if (wanttty >= 0) {
+ (void) signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTIN, SIG_DFL);
+ (void) signal(SIGTTOU, SIG_DFL);
+ }
+
+ (void) signal(SIGTERM, parterm);
+ }
+ else if (tpgrp == -1 &&
+ (t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT)) {
+ (void) signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ (void) signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ }
+
+ pgetty(wanttty, pgrp);
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_NOHUP)
+ (void) signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN);
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_NICE)
+ (void) setpriority(PRIO_PROCESS, 0, t->t_nice);
+ }
+
+ }
+ if (pid != 0) {
+ /*
+ * It would be better if we could wait for the whole job when we
+ * knew the last process had been started. Pwait, in fact, does
+ * wait for the whole job anyway, but this test doesn't really
+ * express our intentions.
+ */
+ if (didfds == 0 && t->t_dflg & F_PIPEIN) {
+ (void) close(pipein[0]);
+ (void) close(pipein[1]);
+ }
+ if ((t->t_dflg & F_PIPEOUT) == 0) {
+ if (nosigchld) {
+ (void) sigsetmask(csigmask);
+ nosigchld = 0;
+ }
+ if ((t->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND) == 0)
+ pwait();
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ doio(t, pipein, pipeout);
+ if (t->t_dflg & F_PIPEOUT) {
+ (void) close(pipeout[0]);
+ (void) close(pipeout[1]);
+ }
+ /*
+ * Perform a builtin function. If we are not forked, arrange for
+ * possible stopping
+ */
+ if (bifunc) {
+ func(t, bifunc);
+ if (forked)
+ exitstat();
+ break;
+ }
+ if (t->t_dtyp != NODE_PAREN) {
+ doexec(NULL, t);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+ /*
+ * For () commands must put new 0,1,2 in FSH* and recurse
+ */
+ OLDSTD = dcopy(0, FOLDSTD);
+ SHOUT = dcopy(1, FSHOUT);
+ SHERR = dcopy(2, FSHERR);
+ (void) close(SHIN);
+ SHIN = -1;
+ didfds = 0;
+ wanttty = -1;
+ t->t_dspr->t_dflg |= t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT;
+ execute(t->t_dspr, wanttty, NULL, NULL);
+ exitstat();
+
+ case NODE_PIPE:
+ t->t_dcar->t_dflg |= F_PIPEOUT |
+ (t->t_dflg & (F_PIPEIN | F_AMPERSAND | F_STDERR | F_NOINTERRUPT));
+ execute(t->t_dcar, wanttty, pipein, pv);
+ t->t_dcdr->t_dflg |= F_PIPEIN | (t->t_dflg &
+ (F_PIPEOUT | F_AMPERSAND | F_NOFORK | F_NOINTERRUPT));
+ if (wanttty > 0)
+ wanttty = 0; /* got tty already */
+ execute(t->t_dcdr, wanttty, pv, pipeout);
+ break;
+
+ case NODE_LIST:
+ if (t->t_dcar) {
+ t->t_dcar->t_dflg |= t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT;
+ execute(t->t_dcar, wanttty, NULL, NULL);
+ /*
+ * In strange case of A&B make a new job after A
+ */
+ if (t->t_dcar->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND && t->t_dcdr &&
+ (t->t_dcdr->t_dflg & F_AMPERSAND) == 0)
+ pendjob();
+ }
+ if (t->t_dcdr) {
+ t->t_dcdr->t_dflg |= t->t_dflg &
+ (F_NOFORK | F_NOINTERRUPT);
+ execute(t->t_dcdr, wanttty, NULL, NULL);
+ }
+ break;
+
+ case NODE_OR:
+ case NODE_AND:
+ if (t->t_dcar) {
+ t->t_dcar->t_dflg |= t->t_dflg & F_NOINTERRUPT;
+ execute(t->t_dcar, wanttty, NULL, NULL);
+ if ((getn(value(STRstatus)) == 0) !=
+ (t->t_dtyp == NODE_AND))
+ return;
+ }
+ if (t->t_dcdr) {
+ t->t_dcdr->t_dflg |= t->t_dflg &
+ (F_NOFORK | F_NOINTERRUPT);
+ execute(t->t_dcdr, wanttty, NULL, NULL);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ /*
+ * Fall through for all breaks from switch
+ *
+ * If there will be no more executions of this command, flush all file
+ * descriptors. Places that turn on the F_REPEAT bit are responsible for
+ * doing donefds after the last re-execution
+ */
+ if (didfds && !(t->t_dflg & F_REPEAT))
+ donefds();
+}
+
+static void
+vffree(i)
+int i;
+{
+ register Char **v;
+
+ if ((v = gargv) != NULL) {
+ gargv = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) v);
+ }
+ if ((v = pargv) != NULL) {
+ pargv = 0;
+ xfree((ptr_t) v);
+ }
+ _exit(i);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Expand and glob the words after an i/o redirection.
+ * If more than one word is generated, then update the command vector.
+ *
+ * This is done differently in all the shells:
+ * 1. in the bourne shell and ksh globbing is not performed
+ * 2. Bash/csh say ambiguous
+ * 3. zsh does i/o to/from all the files
+ * 4. itcsh concatenates the words.
+ *
+ * I don't know what is best to do. I think that Ambiguous is better
+ * than restructuring the command vector, because the user can get
+ * unexpected results. In any case, the command vector restructuring
+ * code is present and the user can choose it by setting noambiguous
+ */
+static Char *
+splicepipe(t, cp)
+ register struct command *t;
+ Char *cp; /* word after < or > */
+{
+ Char *blk[2];
+
+ if (adrof(STRnoambiguous)) {
+ Char **pv;
+
+ blk[0] = Dfix1(cp); /* expand $ */
+ blk[1] = NULL;
+
+ gflag = 0, tglob(blk);
+ if (gflag) {
+ pv = globall(blk);
+ if (pv == NULL) {
+ setname(vis_str(blk[0]));
+ xfree((ptr_t) blk[0]);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ }
+ gargv = NULL;
+ if (pv[1] != NULL) { /* we need to fix the command vector */
+ Char **av = blkspl(t->t_dcom, &pv[1]);
+ xfree((ptr_t) t->t_dcom);
+ t->t_dcom = av;
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) blk[0]);
+ blk[0] = pv[0];
+ xfree((ptr_t) pv);
+ }
+ }
+ else {
+ blk[0] = globone(blk[1] = Dfix1(cp), G_ERROR);
+ xfree((ptr_t) blk[1]);
+ }
+ return(blk[0]);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Perform io redirection.
+ * We may or maynot be forked here.
+ */
+static void
+doio(t, pipein, pipeout)
+ register struct command *t;
+ int *pipein, *pipeout;
+{
+ register int fd;
+ register Char *cp;
+ register int flags = t->t_dflg;
+
+ if (didfds || (flags & F_REPEAT))
+ return;
+ if ((flags & F_READ) == 0) {/* F_READ already done */
+ if (t->t_dlef) {
+ char tmp[MAXPATHLEN+1];
+
+ /*
+ * so < /dev/std{in,out,err} work
+ */
+ (void) dcopy(SHIN, 0);
+ (void) dcopy(SHOUT, 1);
+ (void) dcopy(SHERR, 2);
+ cp = splicepipe(t, t->t_dlef);
+ (void) strncpy(tmp, short2str(cp), MAXPATHLEN);
+ tmp[MAXPATHLEN] = '\0';
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ if ((fd = open(tmp, O_RDONLY)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ (void) dmove(fd, 0);
+ }
+ else if (flags & F_PIPEIN) {
+ (void) close(0);
+ (void) dup(pipein[0]);
+ (void) close(pipein[0]);
+ (void) close(pipein[1]);
+ }
+ else if ((flags & F_NOINTERRUPT) && tpgrp == -1) {
+ (void) close(0);
+ (void) open(_PATH_DEVNULL, O_RDONLY);
+ }
+ else {
+ (void) close(0);
+ (void) dup(OLDSTD);
+ (void) ioctl(0, FIONCLEX, NULL);
+ }
+ }
+ if (t->t_drit) {
+ char tmp[MAXPATHLEN+1];
+
+ cp = splicepipe(t, t->t_drit);
+ (void) strncpy(tmp, short2str(cp), MAXPATHLEN);
+ tmp[MAXPATHLEN] = '\0';
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ /*
+ * so > /dev/std{out,err} work
+ */
+ (void) dcopy(SHOUT, 1);
+ (void) dcopy(SHERR, 2);
+ if ((flags & F_APPEND) &&
+#ifdef O_APPEND
+ (fd = open(tmp, O_WRONLY | O_APPEND)) >= 0);
+#else
+ (fd = open(tmp, O_WRONLY)) >= 0)
+ (void) lseek(1, (off_t) 0, L_XTND);
+#endif
+ else {
+ if (!(flags & F_OVERWRITE) && adrof(STRnoclobber)) {
+ if (flags & F_APPEND)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ chkclob(tmp);
+ }
+ if ((fd = creat(tmp, 0666)) < 0)
+ stderror(ERR_SYSTEM, tmp, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ (void) dmove(fd, 1);
+ }
+ else if (flags & F_PIPEOUT) {
+ (void) close(1);
+ (void) dup(pipeout[1]);
+ }
+ else {
+ (void) close(1);
+ (void) dup(SHOUT);
+ (void) ioctl(1, FIONCLEX, NULL);
+ }
+
+ (void) close(2);
+ if (flags & F_STDERR) {
+ (void) dup(1);
+ }
+ else {
+ (void) dup(SHERR);
+ (void) ioctl(2, FIONCLEX, NULL);
+ }
+ didfds = 1;
+}
+
+void
+mypipe(pv)
+ register int *pv;
+{
+
+ if (pipe(pv) < 0)
+ goto oops;
+ pv[0] = dmove(pv[0], -1);
+ pv[1] = dmove(pv[1], -1);
+ if (pv[0] >= 0 && pv[1] >= 0)
+ return;
+oops:
+ stderror(ERR_PIPE);
+}
+
+static void
+chkclob(cp)
+ register char *cp;
+{
+ struct stat stb;
+
+ if (stat(cp, &stb) < 0)
+ return;
+ if (S_ISCHR(stb.st_mode))
+ return;
+ stderror(ERR_EXISTS, cp);
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/set.c b/bin/csh/set.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b7b7ff1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/set.c
@@ -0,0 +1,844 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)set.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#ifndef SHORT_STRINGS
+#include <string.h>
+#endif /* SHORT_STRINGS */
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static Char *getinx __P((Char *, int *));
+static void asx __P((Char *, int, Char *));
+static struct varent
+ *getvx __P((Char *, int));
+static Char *xset __P((Char *, Char ***));
+static Char *operate __P((int, Char *, Char *));
+static void putn1 __P((int));
+static struct varent
+ *madrof __P((Char *, struct varent *));
+static void unsetv1 __P((struct varent *));
+static void exportpath __P((Char **));
+static void balance __P((struct varent *, int, int));
+
+
+/*
+ * C Shell
+ */
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+doset(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *p;
+ Char *vp, op;
+ Char **vecp;
+ bool hadsub;
+ int subscr;
+
+ v++;
+ p = *v++;
+ if (p == 0) {
+ prvars();
+ return;
+ }
+ do {
+ hadsub = 0;
+ vp = p;
+ if (letter(*p))
+ for (; alnum(*p); p++)
+ continue;
+ if (vp == p || !letter(*vp))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARBEGIN);
+ if ((p - vp) > MAXVARLEN) {
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARTOOLONG);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (*p == '[') {
+ hadsub++;
+ p = getinx(p, &subscr);
+ }
+ if ((op = *p) != '\0') {
+ *p++ = 0;
+ if (*p == 0 && *v && **v == '(')
+ p = *v++;
+ }
+ else if (*v && eq(*v, STRequal)) {
+ op = '=', v++;
+ if (*v)
+ p = *v++;
+ }
+ if (op && op != '=')
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_SYNTAX);
+ if (eq(p, STRLparen)) {
+ register Char **e = v;
+
+ if (hadsub)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_SYNTAX);
+ for (;;) {
+ if (!*e)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_MISSING, ')');
+ if (**e == ')')
+ break;
+ e++;
+ }
+ p = *e;
+ *e = 0;
+ vecp = saveblk(v);
+ set1(vp, vecp, &shvhed);
+ *e = p;
+ v = e + 1;
+ }
+ else if (hadsub)
+ asx(vp, subscr, Strsave(p));
+ else
+ set(vp, Strsave(p));
+ if (eq(vp, STRpath)) {
+ exportpath(adrof(STRpath)->vec);
+ dohash(NULL, NULL);
+ }
+ else if (eq(vp, STRhistchars)) {
+ register Char *pn = value(STRhistchars);
+
+ HIST = *pn++;
+ HISTSUB = *pn;
+ }
+ else if (eq(vp, STRuser)) {
+ Setenv(STRUSER, value(vp));
+ Setenv(STRLOGNAME, value(vp));
+ }
+ else if (eq(vp, STRwordchars)) {
+ word_chars = value(vp);
+ }
+ else if (eq(vp, STRterm))
+ Setenv(STRTERM, value(vp));
+ else if (eq(vp, STRhome)) {
+ register Char *cp;
+
+ cp = Strsave(value(vp)); /* get the old value back */
+
+ /*
+ * convert to cononical pathname (possibly resolving symlinks)
+ */
+ cp = dcanon(cp, cp);
+
+ set(vp, Strsave(cp)); /* have to save the new val */
+
+ /* and now mirror home with HOME */
+ Setenv(STRHOME, cp);
+ /* fix directory stack for new tilde home */
+ dtilde();
+ xfree((ptr_t) cp);
+ }
+#ifdef FILEC
+ else if (eq(vp, STRfilec))
+ filec = 1;
+#endif
+ } while ((p = *v++) != NULL);
+}
+
+static Char *
+getinx(cp, ip)
+ register Char *cp;
+ register int *ip;
+{
+
+ *ip = 0;
+ *cp++ = 0;
+ while (*cp && Isdigit(*cp))
+ *ip = *ip * 10 + *cp++ - '0';
+ if (*cp++ != ']')
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_SUBSCRIPT);
+ return (cp);
+}
+
+static void
+asx(vp, subscr, p)
+ Char *vp;
+ int subscr;
+ Char *p;
+{
+ register struct varent *v = getvx(vp, subscr);
+
+ xfree((ptr_t) v->vec[subscr - 1]);
+ v->vec[subscr - 1] = globone(p, G_APPEND);
+}
+
+static struct varent *
+getvx(vp, subscr)
+ Char *vp;
+ int subscr;
+{
+ register struct varent *v = adrof(vp);
+
+ if (v == 0)
+ udvar(vp);
+ if (subscr < 1 || subscr > blklen(v->vec))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_RANGE);
+ return (v);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dolet(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *p;
+ Char *vp, c, op;
+ bool hadsub;
+ int subscr;
+
+ v++;
+ p = *v++;
+ if (p == 0) {
+ prvars();
+ return;
+ }
+ do {
+ hadsub = 0;
+ vp = p;
+ if (letter(*p))
+ for (; alnum(*p); p++)
+ continue;
+ if (vp == p || !letter(*vp))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARBEGIN);
+ if ((p - vp) > MAXVARLEN)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_VARTOOLONG);
+ if (*p == '[') {
+ hadsub++;
+ p = getinx(p, &subscr);
+ }
+ if (*p == 0 && *v)
+ p = *v++;
+ if ((op = *p) != '\0')
+ *p++ = 0;
+ else
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_ASSIGN);
+
+ if (*p == '\0' && *v == NULL)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_ASSIGN);
+
+ vp = Strsave(vp);
+ if (op == '=') {
+ c = '=';
+ p = xset(p, &v);
+ }
+ else {
+ c = *p++;
+ if (any("+-", c)) {
+ if (c != op || *p)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_UNKNOWNOP);
+ p = Strsave(STR1);
+ }
+ else {
+ if (any("<>", op)) {
+ if (c != op)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_UNKNOWNOP);
+ c = *p++;
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_SYNTAX);
+ }
+ if (c != '=')
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_UNKNOWNOP);
+ p = xset(p, &v);
+ }
+ }
+ if (op == '=')
+ if (hadsub)
+ asx(vp, subscr, p);
+ else
+ set(vp, p);
+ else if (hadsub) {
+ struct varent *gv = getvx(vp, subscr);
+
+ asx(vp, subscr, operate(op, gv->vec[subscr - 1], p));
+ }
+ else
+ set(vp, operate(op, value(vp), p));
+ if (eq(vp, STRpath)) {
+ exportpath(adrof(STRpath)->vec);
+ dohash(NULL, NULL);
+ }
+ xfree((ptr_t) vp);
+ if (c != '=')
+ xfree((ptr_t) p);
+ } while ((p = *v++) != NULL);
+}
+
+static Char *
+xset(cp, vp)
+ Char *cp, ***vp;
+{
+ register Char *dp;
+
+ if (*cp) {
+ dp = Strsave(cp);
+ --(*vp);
+ xfree((ptr_t) ** vp);
+ **vp = dp;
+ }
+ return (putn(expr(vp)));
+}
+
+static Char *
+operate(op, vp, p)
+ int op;
+ Char *vp, *p;
+{
+ Char opr[2];
+ Char *vec[5];
+ register Char **v = vec;
+ Char **vecp = v;
+ register int i;
+
+ if (op != '=') {
+ if (*vp)
+ *v++ = vp;
+ opr[0] = op;
+ opr[1] = 0;
+ *v++ = opr;
+ if (op == '<' || op == '>')
+ *v++ = opr;
+ }
+ *v++ = p;
+ *v++ = 0;
+ i = expr(&vecp);
+ if (*vecp)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_EXPRESSION);
+ return (putn(i));
+}
+
+static Char *putp;
+
+Char *
+putn(n)
+ register int n;
+{
+ int num;
+ static Char number[15];
+
+ putp = number;
+ if (n < 0) {
+ n = -n;
+ *putp++ = '-';
+ }
+ num = 2; /* confuse lint */
+ if (sizeof(int) == num && ((unsigned int) n) == 0x8000) {
+ *putp++ = '3';
+ n = 2768;
+#ifdef pdp11
+ }
+#else
+ }
+ else {
+ num = 4; /* confuse lint */
+ if (sizeof(int) == num && ((unsigned int) n) == 0x80000000) {
+ *putp++ = '2';
+ n = 147483648;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ putn1(n);
+ *putp = 0;
+ return (Strsave(number));
+}
+
+static void
+putn1(n)
+ register int n;
+{
+ if (n > 9)
+ putn1(n / 10);
+ *putp++ = n % 10 + '0';
+}
+
+int
+getn(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ register int n;
+ int sign;
+
+ sign = 0;
+ if (cp[0] == '+' && cp[1])
+ cp++;
+ if (*cp == '-') {
+ sign++;
+ cp++;
+ if (!Isdigit(*cp))
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_BADNUM);
+ }
+ n = 0;
+ while (Isdigit(*cp))
+ n = n * 10 + *cp++ - '0';
+ if (*cp)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_BADNUM);
+ return (sign ? -n : n);
+}
+
+Char *
+value1(var, head)
+ Char *var;
+ struct varent *head;
+{
+ register struct varent *vp;
+
+ vp = adrof1(var, head);
+ return (vp == 0 || vp->vec[0] == 0 ? STRNULL : vp->vec[0]);
+}
+
+static struct varent *
+madrof(pat, vp)
+ Char *pat;
+ register struct varent *vp;
+{
+ register struct varent *vp1;
+
+ for (; vp; vp = vp->v_right) {
+ if (vp->v_left && (vp1 = madrof(pat, vp->v_left)))
+ return vp1;
+ if (Gmatch(vp->v_name, pat))
+ return vp;
+ }
+ return vp;
+}
+
+struct varent *
+adrof1(name, v)
+ register Char *name;
+ register struct varent *v;
+{
+ register cmp;
+
+ v = v->v_left;
+ while (v && ((cmp = *name - *v->v_name) ||
+ (cmp = Strcmp(name, v->v_name))))
+ if (cmp < 0)
+ v = v->v_left;
+ else
+ v = v->v_right;
+ return v;
+}
+
+/*
+ * The caller is responsible for putting value in a safe place
+ */
+void
+set(var, val)
+ Char *var, *val;
+{
+ register Char **vec = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) (2 * sizeof(Char **)));
+
+ vec[0] = val;
+ vec[1] = 0;
+ set1(var, vec, &shvhed);
+}
+
+void
+set1(var, vec, head)
+ Char *var, **vec;
+ struct varent *head;
+{
+ register Char **oldv = vec;
+
+ gflag = 0;
+ tglob(oldv);
+ if (gflag) {
+ vec = globall(oldv);
+ if (vec == 0) {
+ blkfree(oldv);
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMATCH);
+ return;
+ }
+ blkfree(oldv);
+ gargv = 0;
+ }
+ setq(var, vec, head);
+}
+
+
+void
+setq(name, vec, p)
+ Char *name, **vec;
+ register struct varent *p;
+{
+ register struct varent *c;
+ register f;
+
+ f = 0; /* tree hangs off the header's left link */
+ while ((c = p->v_link[f]) != NULL) {
+ if ((f = *name - *c->v_name) == 0 &&
+ (f = Strcmp(name, c->v_name)) == 0) {
+ blkfree(c->vec);
+ goto found;
+ }
+ p = c;
+ f = f > 0;
+ }
+ p->v_link[f] = c = (struct varent *) xmalloc((size_t) sizeof(struct varent));
+ c->v_name = Strsave(name);
+ c->v_bal = 0;
+ c->v_left = c->v_right = 0;
+ c->v_parent = p;
+ balance(p, f, 0);
+found:
+ trim(c->vec = vec);
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+unset(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ unset1(v, &shvhed);
+#ifdef FILEC
+ if (adrof(STRfilec) == 0)
+ filec = 0;
+#endif
+ if (adrof(STRhistchars) == 0) {
+ HIST = '!';
+ HISTSUB = '^';
+ }
+ if (adrof(STRwordchars) == 0)
+ word_chars = STR_WORD_CHARS;
+}
+
+void
+unset1(v, head)
+ register Char *v[];
+ struct varent *head;
+{
+ register struct varent *vp;
+ register int cnt;
+
+ while (*++v) {
+ cnt = 0;
+ while ((vp = madrof(*v, head->v_left)) != NULL)
+ unsetv1(vp), cnt++;
+ if (cnt == 0)
+ setname(vis_str(*v));
+ }
+}
+
+void
+unsetv(var)
+ Char *var;
+{
+ register struct varent *vp;
+
+ if ((vp = adrof1(var, &shvhed)) == 0)
+ udvar(var);
+ unsetv1(vp);
+}
+
+static void
+unsetv1(p)
+ register struct varent *p;
+{
+ register struct varent *c, *pp;
+ register f;
+
+ /*
+ * Free associated memory first to avoid complications.
+ */
+ blkfree(p->vec);
+ xfree((ptr_t) p->v_name);
+ /*
+ * If p is missing one child, then we can move the other into where p is.
+ * Otherwise, we find the predecessor of p, which is guaranteed to have no
+ * right child, copy it into p, and move it's left child into it.
+ */
+ if (p->v_right == 0)
+ c = p->v_left;
+ else if (p->v_left == 0)
+ c = p->v_right;
+ else {
+ for (c = p->v_left; c->v_right; c = c->v_right)
+ continue;
+ p->v_name = c->v_name;
+ p->vec = c->vec;
+ p = c;
+ c = p->v_left;
+ }
+ /*
+ * Move c into where p is.
+ */
+ pp = p->v_parent;
+ f = pp->v_right == p;
+ if ((pp->v_link[f] = c) != NULL)
+ c->v_parent = pp;
+ /*
+ * Free the deleted node, and rebalance.
+ */
+ xfree((ptr_t) p);
+ balance(pp, f, 1);
+}
+
+void
+setNS(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ set(cp, Strsave(STRNULL));
+}
+
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+shift(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register struct varent *argv;
+ register Char *name;
+
+ v++;
+ name = *v;
+ if (name == 0)
+ name = STRargv;
+ else
+ (void) strip(name);
+ argv = adrof(name);
+ if (argv == 0)
+ udvar(name);
+ if (argv->vec[0] == 0)
+ stderror(ERR_NAME | ERR_NOMORE);
+ lshift(argv->vec, 1);
+}
+
+static void
+exportpath(val)
+ Char **val;
+{
+ Char exppath[BUFSIZ];
+
+ exppath[0] = 0;
+ if (val)
+ while (*val) {
+ if (Strlen(*val) + Strlen(exppath) + 2 > BUFSIZ) {
+ (void) fprintf(csherr,
+ "Warning: ridiculously long PATH truncated\n");
+ break;
+ }
+ if ((**val != '/' || **val == '\0') && (euid == 0 || uid == 0))
+ (void) fprintf(csherr,
+ "Warning: exported path contains relative components.\n");
+ (void) Strcat(exppath, *val++);
+ if (*val == 0 || eq(*val, STRRparen))
+ break;
+ (void) Strcat(exppath, STRcolon);
+ }
+ Setenv(STRPATH, exppath);
+}
+
+#ifndef lint
+ /*
+ * Lint thinks these have null effect
+ */
+ /* macros to do single rotations on node p */
+#define rright(p) (\
+ t = (p)->v_left,\
+ (t)->v_parent = (p)->v_parent,\
+ ((p)->v_left = t->v_right) ? (t->v_right->v_parent = (p)) : 0,\
+ (t->v_right = (p))->v_parent = t,\
+ (p) = t)
+#define rleft(p) (\
+ t = (p)->v_right,\
+ (t)->v_parent = (p)->v_parent,\
+ ((p)->v_right = t->v_left) ? (t->v_left->v_parent = (p)) : 0,\
+ (t->v_left = (p))->v_parent = t,\
+ (p) = t)
+#else
+struct varent *
+rleft(p)
+ struct varent *p;
+{
+ return (p);
+}
+struct varent *
+rright(p)
+ struct varent *p;
+{
+ return (p);
+}
+
+#endif /* ! lint */
+
+
+/*
+ * Rebalance a tree, starting at p and up.
+ * F == 0 means we've come from p's left child.
+ * D == 1 means we've just done a delete, otherwise an insert.
+ */
+static void
+balance(p, f, d)
+ register struct varent *p;
+ register int f, d;
+{
+ register struct varent *pp;
+
+#ifndef lint
+ register struct varent *t; /* used by the rotate macros */
+
+#endif
+ register ff;
+
+ /*
+ * Ok, from here on, p is the node we're operating on; pp is it's parent; f
+ * is the branch of p from which we have come; ff is the branch of pp which
+ * is p.
+ */
+ for (; (pp = p->v_parent) != NULL; p = pp, f = ff) {
+ ff = pp->v_right == p;
+ if (f ^ d) { /* right heavy */
+ switch (p->v_bal) {
+ case -1: /* was left heavy */
+ p->v_bal = 0;
+ break;
+ case 0: /* was balanced */
+ p->v_bal = 1;
+ break;
+ case 1: /* was already right heavy */
+ switch (p->v_right->v_bal) {
+ case 1: /* sigle rotate */
+ pp->v_link[ff] = rleft(p);
+ p->v_left->v_bal = 0;
+ p->v_bal = 0;
+ break;
+ case 0: /* single rotate */
+ pp->v_link[ff] = rleft(p);
+ p->v_left->v_bal = 1;
+ p->v_bal = -1;
+ break;
+ case -1: /* double rotate */
+ (void) rright(p->v_right);
+ pp->v_link[ff] = rleft(p);
+ p->v_left->v_bal =
+ p->v_bal < 1 ? 0 : -1;
+ p->v_right->v_bal =
+ p->v_bal > -1 ? 0 : 1;
+ p->v_bal = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ else { /* left heavy */
+ switch (p->v_bal) {
+ case 1: /* was right heavy */
+ p->v_bal = 0;
+ break;
+ case 0: /* was balanced */
+ p->v_bal = -1;
+ break;
+ case -1: /* was already left heavy */
+ switch (p->v_left->v_bal) {
+ case -1: /* single rotate */
+ pp->v_link[ff] = rright(p);
+ p->v_right->v_bal = 0;
+ p->v_bal = 0;
+ break;
+ case 0: /* signle rotate */
+ pp->v_link[ff] = rright(p);
+ p->v_right->v_bal = -1;
+ p->v_bal = 1;
+ break;
+ case 1: /* double rotate */
+ (void) rleft(p->v_left);
+ pp->v_link[ff] = rright(p);
+ p->v_left->v_bal =
+ p->v_bal < 1 ? 0 : -1;
+ p->v_right->v_bal =
+ p->v_bal > -1 ? 0 : 1;
+ p->v_bal = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ /*
+ * If from insert, then we terminate when p is balanced. If from
+ * delete, then we terminate when p is unbalanced.
+ */
+ if ((p->v_bal == 0) ^ d)
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+plist(p)
+ register struct varent *p;
+{
+ register struct varent *c;
+ register len;
+
+ if (setintr)
+ (void) sigsetmask(sigblock((sigset_t) 0) & ~sigmask(SIGINT));
+
+ for (;;) {
+ while (p->v_left)
+ p = p->v_left;
+x:
+ if (p->v_parent == 0) /* is it the header? */
+ return;
+ len = blklen(p->vec);
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%s\t", short2str(p->v_name));
+ if (len != 1)
+ (void) fputc('(', cshout);
+ blkpr(cshout, p->vec);
+ if (len != 1)
+ (void) fputc(')', cshout);
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+ if (p->v_right) {
+ p = p->v_right;
+ continue;
+ }
+ do {
+ c = p;
+ p = p->v_parent;
+ } while (p->v_right == c);
+ goto x;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/csh/str.c b/bin/csh/str.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..15fe874
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/str.c
@@ -0,0 +1,467 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)str.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#define MALLOC_INCR 128
+
+/*
+ * tc.str.c: Short string package
+ * This has been a lesson of how to write buggy code!
+ */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+#include <vis.h>
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#ifdef SHORT_STRINGS
+
+Char **
+blk2short(src)
+ register char **src;
+{
+ size_t n;
+ register Char **sdst, **dst;
+
+ /*
+ * Count
+ */
+ for (n = 0; src[n] != NULL; n++)
+ continue;
+ sdst = dst = (Char **) xmalloc((size_t) ((n + 1) * sizeof(Char *)));
+
+ for (; *src != NULL; src++)
+ *dst++ = SAVE(*src);
+ *dst = NULL;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+char **
+short2blk(src)
+ register Char **src;
+{
+ size_t n;
+ register char **sdst, **dst;
+
+ /*
+ * Count
+ */
+ for (n = 0; src[n] != NULL; n++)
+ continue;
+ sdst = dst = (char **) xmalloc((size_t) ((n + 1) * sizeof(char *)));
+
+ for (; *src != NULL; src++)
+ *dst++ = strsave(short2str(*src));
+ *dst = NULL;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+Char *
+str2short(src)
+ register char *src;
+{
+ static Char *sdst;
+ static size_t dstsize = 0;
+ register Char *dst, *edst;
+
+ if (src == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ if (sdst == (NULL)) {
+ dstsize = MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t) dstsize * sizeof(Char));
+ }
+
+ dst = sdst;
+ edst = &dst[dstsize];
+ while (*src) {
+ *dst++ = (Char) ((unsigned char) *src++);
+ if (dst == edst) {
+ dstsize += MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (Char *) xrealloc((ptr_t) sdst,
+ (size_t) dstsize * sizeof(Char));
+ edst = &sdst[dstsize];
+ dst = &edst[-MALLOC_INCR];
+ }
+ }
+ *dst = 0;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+char *
+short2str(src)
+ register Char *src;
+{
+ static char *sdst = NULL;
+ static size_t dstsize = 0;
+ register char *dst, *edst;
+
+ if (src == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ if (sdst == NULL) {
+ dstsize = MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (char *) xmalloc((size_t) dstsize * sizeof(char));
+ }
+ dst = sdst;
+ edst = &dst[dstsize];
+ while (*src) {
+ *dst++ = (char) *src++;
+ if (dst == edst) {
+ dstsize += MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (char *) xrealloc((ptr_t) sdst,
+ (size_t) dstsize * sizeof(char));
+ edst = &sdst[dstsize];
+ dst = &edst[-MALLOC_INCR];
+ }
+ }
+ *dst = 0;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strcpy(dst, src)
+ register Char *dst, *src;
+{
+ register Char *sdst;
+
+ sdst = dst;
+ while ((*dst++ = *src++) != '\0')
+ continue;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strncpy(dst, src, n)
+ register Char *dst, *src;
+ register size_t n;
+{
+ register Char *sdst;
+
+ if (n == 0)
+ return(dst);
+
+ sdst = dst;
+ do
+ if ((*dst++ = *src++) == '\0') {
+ while (--n != 0)
+ *dst++ = '\0';
+ return(sdst);
+ }
+ while (--n != 0);
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strcat(dst, src)
+ register Char *dst, *src;
+{
+ register short *sdst;
+
+ sdst = dst;
+ while (*dst++)
+ continue;
+ --dst;
+ while ((*dst++ = *src++) != '\0')
+ continue;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+#ifdef NOTUSED
+Char *
+s_strncat(dst, src, n)
+ register Char *dst, *src;
+ register size_t n;
+{
+ register Char *sdst;
+
+ if (n == 0)
+ return (dst);
+
+ sdst = dst;
+
+ while (*dst++)
+ continue;
+ --dst;
+
+ do
+ if ((*dst++ = *src++) == '\0')
+ return(sdst);
+ while (--n != 0)
+ continue;
+
+ *dst = '\0';
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+#endif
+
+Char *
+s_strchr(str, ch)
+ register Char *str;
+ int ch;
+{
+ do
+ if (*str == ch)
+ return (str);
+ while (*str++);
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strrchr(str, ch)
+ register Char *str;
+ int ch;
+{
+ register Char *rstr;
+
+ rstr = NULL;
+ do
+ if (*str == ch)
+ rstr = str;
+ while (*str++);
+ return (rstr);
+}
+
+size_t
+s_strlen(str)
+ register Char *str;
+{
+ register size_t n;
+
+ for (n = 0; *str++; n++)
+ continue;
+ return (n);
+}
+
+int
+s_strcmp(str1, str2)
+ register Char *str1, *str2;
+{
+ for (; *str1 && *str1 == *str2; str1++, str2++)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * The following case analysis is necessary so that characters which look
+ * negative collate low against normal characters but high against the
+ * end-of-string NUL.
+ */
+ if (*str1 == '\0' && *str2 == '\0')
+ return (0);
+ else if (*str1 == '\0')
+ return (-1);
+ else if (*str2 == '\0')
+ return (1);
+ else
+ return (*str1 - *str2);
+}
+
+int
+s_strncmp(str1, str2, n)
+ register Char *str1, *str2;
+ register size_t n;
+{
+ if (n == 0)
+ return (0);
+ do {
+ if (*str1 != *str2) {
+ /*
+ * The following case analysis is necessary so that characters
+ * which look negative collate low against normal characters
+ * but high against the end-of-string NUL.
+ */
+ if (*str1 == '\0')
+ return (-1);
+ else if (*str2 == '\0')
+ return (1);
+ else
+ return (*str1 - *str2);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (*str1 == '\0')
+ return(0);
+ str1++, str2++;
+ } while (--n != 0);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strsave(s)
+ register Char *s;
+{
+ Char *n;
+ register Char *p;
+
+ if (s == 0)
+ s = STRNULL;
+ for (p = s; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ n = p = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t) ((p - s) * sizeof(Char)));
+ while ((*p++ = *s++) != '\0')
+ continue;
+ return (n);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strspl(cp, dp)
+ Char *cp, *dp;
+{
+ Char *ep;
+ register Char *p, *q;
+
+ if (!cp)
+ cp = STRNULL;
+ if (!dp)
+ dp = STRNULL;
+ for (p = cp; *p++;)
+ continue;
+ for (q = dp; *q++;)
+ continue;
+ ep = (Char *) xmalloc((size_t)
+ (((p - cp) + (q - dp) - 1) * sizeof(Char)));
+ for (p = ep, q = cp; (*p++ = *q++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ for (p--, q = dp; (*p++ = *q++) != '\0';)
+ continue;
+ return (ep);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strend(cp)
+ register Char *cp;
+{
+ if (!cp)
+ return (cp);
+ while (*cp)
+ cp++;
+ return (cp);
+}
+
+Char *
+s_strstr(s, t)
+ register Char *s, *t;
+{
+ do {
+ register Char *ss = s;
+ register Char *tt = t;
+
+ do
+ if (*tt == '\0')
+ return (s);
+ while (*ss++ == *tt++);
+ } while (*s++ != '\0');
+ return (NULL);
+}
+#endif /* SHORT_STRINGS */
+
+char *
+short2qstr(src)
+ register Char *src;
+{
+ static char *sdst = NULL;
+ static size_t dstsize = 0;
+ register char *dst, *edst;
+
+ if (src == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ if (sdst == NULL) {
+ dstsize = MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (char *) xmalloc((size_t) dstsize * sizeof(char));
+ }
+ dst = sdst;
+ edst = &dst[dstsize];
+ while (*src) {
+ if (*src & QUOTE) {
+ *dst++ = '\\';
+ if (dst == edst) {
+ dstsize += MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (char *) xrealloc((ptr_t) sdst,
+ (size_t) dstsize * sizeof(char));
+ edst = &sdst[dstsize];
+ dst = &edst[-MALLOC_INCR];
+ }
+ }
+ *dst++ = (char) *src++;
+ if (dst == edst) {
+ dstsize += MALLOC_INCR;
+ sdst = (char *) xrealloc((ptr_t) sdst,
+ (size_t) dstsize * sizeof(char));
+ edst = &sdst[dstsize];
+ dst = &edst[-MALLOC_INCR];
+ }
+ }
+ *dst = 0;
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
+/*
+ * XXX: Should we worry about QUOTE'd chars?
+ */
+char *
+vis_str(cp)
+ Char *cp;
+{
+ static char *sdst = NULL;
+ static size_t dstsize = 0;
+ size_t n;
+ Char *dp;
+
+ if (cp == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+
+ for (dp = cp; *dp++;)
+ continue;
+ n = ((dp - cp) << 2) + 1; /* 4 times + NULL */
+ if (dstsize < n) {
+ sdst = (char *) (dstsize ?
+ xrealloc(sdst, (size_t) n * sizeof(char)) :
+ xmalloc((size_t) n * sizeof(char)));
+ dstsize = n;
+ }
+ /*
+ * XXX: When we are in AsciiOnly we want all characters >= 0200 to
+ * be encoded, but currently there is no way in vis to do that.
+ */
+ (void) strvis(sdst, short2str(cp), VIS_NOSLASH);
+ return (sdst);
+}
+
diff --git a/bin/csh/time.c b/bin/csh/time.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..32113ac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/csh/time.c
@@ -0,0 +1,316 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)time.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#if __STDC__
+# include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+# include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#include "csh.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * C Shell - routines handling process timing and niceing
+ */
+static void pdeltat __P((struct timeval *, struct timeval *));
+
+void
+settimes()
+{
+ struct rusage ruch;
+
+ (void) gettimeofday(&time0, NULL);
+ (void) getrusage(RUSAGE_SELF, &ru0);
+ (void) getrusage(RUSAGE_CHILDREN, &ruch);
+ ruadd(&ru0, &ruch);
+}
+
+/*
+ * dotime is only called if it is truly a builtin function and not a
+ * prefix to another command
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+dotime(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ struct timeval timedol;
+ struct rusage ru1, ruch;
+
+ (void) getrusage(RUSAGE_SELF, &ru1);
+ (void) getrusage(RUSAGE_CHILDREN, &ruch);
+ ruadd(&ru1, &ruch);
+ (void) gettimeofday(&timedol, NULL);
+ prusage(&ru0, &ru1, &timedol, &time0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * donice is only called when it on the line by itself or with a +- value
+ */
+void
+/*ARGSUSED*/
+donice(v, t)
+ Char **v;
+ struct command *t;
+{
+ register Char *cp;
+ int nval = 0;
+
+ v++, cp = *v++;
+ if (cp == 0)
+ nval = 4;
+ else if (*v == 0 && any("+-", cp[0]))
+ nval = getn(cp);
+ (void) setpriority(PRIO_PROCESS, 0, nval);
+}
+
+void
+ruadd(ru, ru2)
+ register struct rusage *ru, *ru2;
+{
+ tvadd(&ru->ru_utime, &ru2->ru_utime);
+ tvadd(&ru->ru_stime, &ru2->ru_stime);
+ if (ru2->ru_maxrss > ru->ru_maxrss)
+ ru->ru_maxrss = ru2->ru_maxrss;
+
+ ru->ru_ixrss += ru2->ru_ixrss;
+ ru->ru_idrss += ru2->ru_idrss;
+ ru->ru_isrss += ru2->ru_isrss;
+ ru->ru_minflt += ru2->ru_minflt;
+ ru->ru_majflt += ru2->ru_majflt;
+ ru->ru_nswap += ru2->ru_nswap;
+ ru->ru_inblock += ru2->ru_inblock;
+ ru->ru_oublock += ru2->ru_oublock;
+ ru->ru_msgsnd += ru2->ru_msgsnd;
+ ru->ru_msgrcv += ru2->ru_msgrcv;
+ ru->ru_nsignals += ru2->ru_nsignals;
+ ru->ru_nvcsw += ru2->ru_nvcsw;
+ ru->ru_nivcsw += ru2->ru_nivcsw;
+}
+
+void
+prusage(r0, r1, e, b)
+ register struct rusage *r0, *r1;
+ struct timeval *e, *b;
+{
+ register time_t t =
+ (r1->ru_utime.tv_sec - r0->ru_utime.tv_sec) * 100 +
+ (r1->ru_utime.tv_usec - r0->ru_utime.tv_usec) / 10000 +
+ (r1->ru_stime.tv_sec - r0->ru_stime.tv_sec) * 100 +
+ (r1->ru_stime.tv_usec - r0->ru_stime.tv_usec) / 10000;
+ register char *cp;
+ register long i;
+ register struct varent *vp = adrof(STRtime);
+
+ int ms =
+ (e->tv_sec - b->tv_sec) * 100 + (e->tv_usec - b->tv_usec) / 10000;
+
+ cp = "%Uu %Ss %E %P %X+%Dk %I+%Oio %Fpf+%Ww";
+
+ if (vp && vp->vec[0] && vp->vec[1])
+ cp = short2str(vp->vec[1]);
+
+ for (; *cp; cp++)
+ if (*cp != '%')
+ (void) fputc(*cp, cshout);
+ else if (cp[1])
+ switch (*++cp) {
+
+ case 'U': /* user CPU time used */
+ pdeltat(&r1->ru_utime, &r0->ru_utime);
+ break;
+
+ case 'S': /* system CPU time used */
+ pdeltat(&r1->ru_stime, &r0->ru_stime);
+ break;
+
+ case 'E': /* elapsed (wall-clock) time */
+ pcsecs((long) ms);
+ break;
+
+ case 'P': /* percent time spent running */
+ /* check if it did not run at all */
+ i = (ms == 0) ? 0 : (t * 1000 / ms);
+ /* nn.n% */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld.%01ld%%", i / 10, i % 10);
+ break;
+
+ case 'W': /* number of swaps */
+ i = r1->ru_nswap - r0->ru_nswap;
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", i);
+ break;
+
+ case 'X': /* (average) shared text size */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", t == 0 ? 0L :
+ (r1->ru_ixrss - r0->ru_ixrss) / t);
+ break;
+
+ case 'D': /* (average) unshared data size */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", t == 0 ? 0L :
+ (r1->ru_idrss + r1->ru_isrss -
+ (r0->ru_idrss + r0->ru_isrss)) / t);
+ break;
+
+ case 'K': /* (average) total data memory used */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", t == 0 ? 0L :
+ ((r1->ru_ixrss + r1->ru_isrss + r1->ru_idrss) -
+ (r0->ru_ixrss + r0->ru_idrss + r0->ru_isrss)) / t);
+ break;
+
+ case 'M': /* max. Resident Set Size */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_maxrss / 2L);
+ break;
+
+ case 'F': /* page faults */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_majflt - r0->ru_majflt);
+ break;
+
+ case 'R': /* page reclaims */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_minflt - r0->ru_minflt);
+ break;
+
+ case 'I': /* FS blocks in */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_inblock - r0->ru_inblock);
+ break;
+
+ case 'O': /* FS blocks out */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_oublock - r0->ru_oublock);
+ break;
+
+ case 'r': /* socket messages recieved */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_msgrcv - r0->ru_msgrcv);
+ break;
+
+ case 's': /* socket messages sent */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_msgsnd - r0->ru_msgsnd);
+ break;
+
+ case 'k': /* number of signals recieved */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_nsignals-r0->ru_nsignals);
+ break;
+
+ case 'w': /* num. voluntary context switches (waits) */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_nvcsw - r0->ru_nvcsw);
+ break;
+
+ case 'c': /* num. involuntary context switches */
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%ld", r1->ru_nivcsw - r0->ru_nivcsw);
+ break;
+ }
+ (void) fputc('\n', cshout);
+}
+
+static void
+pdeltat(t1, t0)
+ struct timeval *t1, *t0;
+{
+ struct timeval td;
+
+ tvsub(&td, t1, t0);
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d.%01d", td.tv_sec, td.tv_usec / 100000);
+}
+
+void
+tvadd(tsum, t0)
+ struct timeval *tsum, *t0;
+{
+
+ tsum->tv_sec += t0->tv_sec;
+ tsum->tv_usec += t0->tv_usec;
+ if (tsum->tv_usec > 1000000)
+ tsum->tv_sec++, tsum->tv_usec -= 1000000;
+}
+
+void
+tvsub(tdiff, t1, t0)
+ struct timeval *tdiff, *t1, *t0;
+{
+
+ tdiff->tv_sec = t1->tv_sec - t0->tv_sec;
+ tdiff->tv_usec = t1->tv_usec - t0->tv_usec;
+ if (tdiff->tv_usec < 0)
+ tdiff->tv_sec--, tdiff->tv_usec += 1000000;
+}
+
+#define P2DIG(i) (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d%d", (i) / 10, (i) % 10)
+
+void
+psecs(l)
+ long l;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ i = l / 3600;
+ if (i) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d:", i);
+ i = l % 3600;
+ P2DIG(i / 60);
+ goto minsec;
+ }
+ i = l;
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d", i / 60);
+minsec:
+ i %= 60;
+ (void) fputc(':', cshout);
+ P2DIG(i);
+}
+
+void
+pcsecs(l) /* PWP: print mm:ss.dd, l is in sec*100 */
+ long l;
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ i = l / 360000;
+ if (i) {
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d:", i);
+ i = (l % 360000) / 100;
+ P2DIG(i / 60);
+ goto minsec;
+ }
+ i = l / 100;
+ (void) fprintf(cshout, "%d", i / 60);
+minsec:
+ i %= 60;
+ (void) fputc(':', cshout);
+ P2DIG(i);
+ (void) fputc('.', cshout);
+ P2DIG((int) (l % 100));
+}
diff --git a/bin/date/Makefile b/bin/date/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7dfc15e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/date/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= date
+SRCS= date.c netdate.c
+DPADD= ${LIBUTIL}
+LDADD= -lutil
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/date/date.1 b/bin/date/date.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0eb6c7b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/date/date.1
@@ -0,0 +1,230 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)date.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 11/17/93
+.\"
+.Dd November 17, 1993
+.Dt DATE 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm date
+.Nd display or set date and time
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm date
+.Op Fl d Ar dst
+.Op Fl r Ar seconds
+.Op Fl t Ar minutes_west
+.Op Fl nu
+.Op Cm + Ns Ar format
+.Op [yy[mm[dd[hh]]]]mm[\&.ss]
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Date
+displays the current date and time when invoked without arguments.
+Providing arguments will format the date and time in a user-defined
+way or set the date.
+Only the superuser may set the date.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Fl d
+Set the kernel's value for daylight savings time.
+If
+.Ar dst
+is non-zero, future calls
+to
+.Xr gettimeofday 2
+will return a non-zero
+.Ql tz_dsttime .
+.It Fl n
+The utility
+.Xr timed 8
+is used to synchronize the clocks on groups of machines.
+By default, if
+.Xr timed
+is running,
+.Nm date
+will set the time on all of the machines in the local group.
+The
+.Fl n
+option stops
+.Nm date
+from setting the time for other than the current machine.
+.It Fl r
+Print out the date and time in
+.Ar seconds
+from the Epoch.
+.It Fl t
+Set the kernel's value for minutes west of
+.Tn GMT .
+.Ar Minutes_west
+specifies the number of minutes returned in
+.Ql tz_minuteswest
+by future calls to
+.Xr gettimeofday 2 .
+.It Fl u
+Display or set the date in
+.Tn UCT
+(universal) time.
+.El
+.Pp
+An operand with a leading plus (``+'') sign signals a user-defined format
+string which specifies the format in which to display the date and time.
+The format string may contain any of the conversion specifications described
+in the
+.Xr strftime 3
+manual page, as well as any arbitrary text.
+The format string for the default display is:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+``%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z n''.
+.Ed
+.Pp
+If an operand does not have a leading plus sign, it is interpreted as
+a value for setting the system's notion of the current date and time.
+The canonical representation for setting the date and time is:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds -compact -offset indent
+.It Ar yy
+Year in abbreviated form (.e.g 89 for 1989).
+.It Ar mm
+Numeric month.
+A number from 1 to 12.
+.It Ar dd
+Day, a number from 1 to 31.
+.It Ar hh
+Hour, a number from 0 to 23.
+.It Ar mm
+Minutes, a number from 0 to 59.
+.It Ar .ss
+Seconds, a number from 0 to 61 (59 plus a a maximum of two leap seconds).
+.El
+.Pp
+Everything but the minutes is optional.
+.Pp
+Time changes for Daylight Saving and Standard time and leap seconds
+and years are handled automatically.
+.Sh EXAMPLES
+The command:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+date ``+DATE: %m/%d/%y%nTIME: %H:%M:0n''
+.Ed
+.Pp
+will display:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+DATE: 11/21/87
+TIME: 13:36:16
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+date 8506131627
+.Ed
+.Pp
+sets the date to
+.Dq Li "June 13, 1985, 4:27 PM" .
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+date 1432
+.Ed
+.Pp
+sets the time to
+.Li "2:32 PM" ,
+without modifying the date.
+.Sh ENVIRONMENTAL VARIABLES
+The following environment variables affect the execution of
+.Nm date :
+.Bl -tag -width TZ
+.It Ev TZ
+The timezone to use when displaying dates.
+See
+.Xr environ 7
+for more information.
+.El
+.Sh FILES
+.Bl -tag -width /var/log/messages -compact
+.It Pa /var/log/wtmp
+A record of date resets and time changes.
+.It Pa /var/log/messages
+A record of the user setting the time.
+.El
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr gettimeofday 2 ,
+.Xr strftime 3 ,
+.Xr utmp 5 ,
+.Xr timed 8
+.Rs
+.%T "TSP: The Time Synchronization Protocol for UNIX 4.3BSD"
+.%A R. Gusella
+.%A S. Zatti
+.Re
+.Sh DIAGNOSTICS
+Exit status is 0 on success, 1 if unable to set the date, and 2
+if able to set the local date, but unable to set it globally.
+.Pp
+Occasionally, when
+.Xr timed
+synchronizes the time on many hosts, the setting of a new time value may
+require more than a few seconds.
+On these occasions,
+.Nm date
+prints:
+.Ql Network time being set .
+The message
+.Ql Communication error with timed
+occurs when the communication
+between
+.Nm date
+and
+.Xr timed
+fails.
+.Sh BUGS
+The system attempts to keep the date in a format closely compatible
+with
+.Tn VMS .
+.Tn VMS ,
+however, uses local time (rather than
+.Tn GMT )
+and does not understand daylight-savings time.
+Thus, if you use both
+.Tn UNIX
+and
+.Tn VMS ,
+.Tn VMS
+will be running on
+.Tn GMT .
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm date
+command is expected to be compatible with
+.St -p1003.2 .
diff --git a/bin/date/date.c b/bin/date/date.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3563bac
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/date/date.c
@@ -0,0 +1,237 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1985, 1987, 1988, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1985, 1987, 1988, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)date.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <syslog.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "extern.h"
+
+time_t tval;
+int retval, nflag;
+
+static void setthetime __P((char *));
+static void badformat __P((void));
+static void usage __P((void));
+
+int logwtmp __P((char *, char *, char *));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+{
+ extern int optind;
+ extern char *optarg;
+ struct timezone tz;
+ int ch, rflag;
+ char *format, buf[1024];
+
+ tz.tz_dsttime = tz.tz_minuteswest = 0;
+ rflag = 0;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "d:nr:ut:")) != EOF)
+ switch((char)ch) {
+ case 'd': /* daylight savings time */
+ tz.tz_dsttime = atoi(optarg) ? 1 : 0;
+ break;
+ case 'n': /* don't set network */
+ nflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r': /* user specified seconds */
+ rflag = 1;
+ tval = atol(optarg);
+ break;
+ case 'u': /* do everything in GMT */
+ (void)setenv("TZ", "GMT0", 1);
+ break;
+ case 't': /* minutes west of GMT */
+ /* error check; don't allow "PST" */
+ if (isdigit(*optarg)) {
+ tz.tz_minuteswest = atoi(optarg);
+ break;
+ }
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ /*
+ * If -d or -t, set the timezone or daylight savings time; this
+ * doesn't belong here, there kernel should not know about either.
+ */
+ if ((tz.tz_minuteswest || tz.tz_dsttime) &&
+ settimeofday(NULL, &tz))
+ err(1, "settimeofday");
+
+ if (!rflag && time(&tval) == -1)
+ err(1, "time");
+
+ format = "%a %b %e %H:%M:%S %Z %Y\n";
+
+ /* allow the operands in any order */
+ if (*argv && **argv == '+') {
+ format = *argv + 1;
+ ++argv;
+ }
+
+ if (*argv) {
+ setthetime(*argv);
+ ++argv;
+ }
+
+ if (*argv && **argv == '+')
+ format = *argv + 1;
+
+ (void)strftime(buf, sizeof(buf), format, localtime(&tval));
+ (void)printf("%s", buf);
+ exit(retval);
+}
+
+#define ATOI2(ar) ((ar)[0] - '0') * 10 + ((ar)[1] - '0'); (ar) += 2;
+void
+setthetime(p)
+ register char *p;
+{
+ register struct tm *lt;
+ struct timeval tv;
+ char *dot, *t;
+
+ for (t = p, dot = NULL; *t; ++t) {
+ if (isdigit(*t))
+ continue;
+ if (*t == '.' && dot == NULL) {
+ dot = t;
+ continue;
+ }
+ badformat();
+ }
+
+ lt = localtime(&tval);
+
+ if (dot != NULL) { /* .ss */
+ *dot++ = '\0';
+ if (strlen(dot) != 2)
+ badformat();
+ lt->tm_sec = ATOI2(dot);
+ if (lt->tm_sec > 61)
+ badformat();
+ } else
+ lt->tm_sec = 0;
+
+ switch (strlen(p)) {
+ case 10: /* yy */
+ lt->tm_year = ATOI2(p);
+ if (lt->tm_year < 69) /* hack for 2000 ;-} */
+ lt->tm_year += 100;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 8: /* mm */
+ lt->tm_mon = ATOI2(p);
+ if (lt->tm_mon > 12)
+ badformat();
+ --lt->tm_mon; /* time struct is 0 - 11 */
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 6: /* dd */
+ lt->tm_mday = ATOI2(p);
+ if (lt->tm_mday > 31)
+ badformat();
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 4: /* hh */
+ lt->tm_hour = ATOI2(p);
+ if (lt->tm_hour > 23)
+ badformat();
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 2: /* mm */
+ lt->tm_min = ATOI2(p);
+ if (lt->tm_min > 59)
+ badformat();
+ break;
+ default:
+ badformat();
+ }
+
+ /* convert broken-down time to GMT clock time */
+ if ((tval = mktime(lt)) == -1)
+ badformat();
+
+ /* set the time */
+ if (nflag || netsettime(tval)) {
+ logwtmp("|", "date", "");
+ tv.tv_sec = tval;
+ tv.tv_usec = 0;
+ if (settimeofday(&tv, NULL)) {
+ perror("date: settimeofday");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ logwtmp("{", "date", "");
+ }
+
+ if ((p = getlogin()) == NULL)
+ p = "???";
+ syslog(LOG_AUTH | LOG_NOTICE, "date set by %s", p);
+}
+
+static void
+badformat()
+{
+ warnx("illegal time format");
+ usage();
+}
+
+static void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage: date [-nu] [-d dst] [-r seconds] [-t west] [+format]\n");
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, " [yy[mm[dd[hh]]]]mm[.ss]]\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/date/extern.h b/bin/date/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ed0e7d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/date/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,36 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+int netsettime __P((time_t));
diff --git a/bin/date/netdate.c b/bin/date/netdate.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2dca0f7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/date/netdate.c
@@ -0,0 +1,182 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)netdate.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/socket.h>
+
+#include <netinet/in.h>
+#include <netdb.h>
+#define TSPTYPES
+#include <protocols/timed.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#define WAITACK 2 /* seconds */
+#define WAITDATEACK 5 /* seconds */
+
+extern int retval;
+
+/*
+ * Set the date in the machines controlled by timedaemons by communicating the
+ * new date to the local timedaemon. If the timedaemon is in the master state,
+ * it performs the correction on all slaves. If it is in the slave state, it
+ * notifies the master that a correction is needed.
+ * Returns 0 on success. Returns > 0 on failure, setting retval to 2;
+ */
+int
+netsettime(tval)
+ time_t tval;
+{
+ struct timeval tout;
+ struct servent *sp;
+ struct tsp msg;
+ struct sockaddr_in sin, dest, from;
+ fd_set ready;
+ long waittime;
+ int s, length, port, timed_ack, found, err;
+ char hostname[MAXHOSTNAMELEN];
+
+ if ((sp = getservbyname("timed", "udp")) == NULL) {
+ warnx("udp/timed: unknown service");
+ return (retval = 2);
+ }
+
+ dest.sin_port = sp->s_port;
+ dest.sin_family = AF_INET;
+ dest.sin_addr.s_addr = htonl((u_long)INADDR_ANY);
+ s = socket(AF_INET, SOCK_DGRAM, 0);
+ if (s < 0) {
+ if (errno != EPROTONOSUPPORT)
+ warn("timed");
+ return (retval = 2);
+ }
+
+ memset(&sin, 0, sizeof(sin));
+ sin.sin_family = AF_INET;
+ for (port = IPPORT_RESERVED - 1; port > IPPORT_RESERVED / 2; port--) {
+ sin.sin_port = htons((u_short)port);
+ if (bind(s, (struct sockaddr *)&sin, sizeof(sin)) >= 0)
+ break;
+ if (errno == EADDRINUSE)
+ continue;
+ if (errno != EADDRNOTAVAIL)
+ warn("bind");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ if (port == IPPORT_RESERVED / 2) {
+ warnx("all ports in use");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ msg.tsp_type = TSP_SETDATE;
+ msg.tsp_vers = TSPVERSION;
+ if (gethostname(hostname, sizeof(hostname))) {
+ warn("gethostname");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ (void)strncpy(msg.tsp_name, hostname, sizeof(hostname));
+ msg.tsp_seq = htons((u_short)0);
+ msg.tsp_time.tv_sec = htonl((u_long)tval);
+ msg.tsp_time.tv_usec = htonl((u_long)0);
+ length = sizeof(struct sockaddr_in);
+ if (connect(s, (struct sockaddr *)&dest, length) < 0) {
+ warn("connect");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ if (send(s, (char *)&msg, sizeof(struct tsp), 0) < 0) {
+ if (errno != ECONNREFUSED)
+ warn("send");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+
+ timed_ack = -1;
+ waittime = WAITACK;
+loop:
+ tout.tv_sec = waittime;
+ tout.tv_usec = 0;
+
+ FD_ZERO(&ready);
+ FD_SET(s, &ready);
+ found = select(FD_SETSIZE, &ready, (fd_set *)0, (fd_set *)0, &tout);
+
+ length = sizeof(err);
+ if (!getsockopt(s,
+ SOL_SOCKET, SO_ERROR, (char *)&err, &length) && err) {
+ if (err != ECONNREFUSED)
+ warn("send (delayed error)");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+
+ if (found > 0 && FD_ISSET(s, &ready)) {
+ length = sizeof(struct sockaddr_in);
+ if (recvfrom(s, &msg, sizeof(struct tsp), 0,
+ (struct sockaddr *)&from, &length) < 0) {
+ if (errno != ECONNREFUSED)
+ warn("recvfrom");
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ msg.tsp_seq = ntohs(msg.tsp_seq);
+ msg.tsp_time.tv_sec = ntohl(msg.tsp_time.tv_sec);
+ msg.tsp_time.tv_usec = ntohl(msg.tsp_time.tv_usec);
+ switch (msg.tsp_type) {
+ case TSP_ACK:
+ timed_ack = TSP_ACK;
+ waittime = WAITDATEACK;
+ goto loop;
+ case TSP_DATEACK:
+ (void)close(s);
+ return (0);
+ default:
+ warnx("wrong ack received from timed: %s",
+ tsptype[msg.tsp_type]);
+ timed_ack = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (timed_ack == -1)
+ warnx("can't reach time daemon, time set locally");
+
+bad:
+ (void)close(s);
+ return (retval = 2);
+}
diff --git a/bin/dd/Makefile b/bin/dd/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fc4965b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= dd
+SRCS= args.c conv.c conv_tab.c dd.c misc.c position.c
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/dd/args.c b/bin/dd/args.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3c2f3a2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/args.c
@@ -0,0 +1,386 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)args.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "dd.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int c_arg __P((const void *, const void *));
+static int c_conv __P((const void *, const void *));
+static void f_bs __P((char *));
+static void f_cbs __P((char *));
+static void f_conv __P((char *));
+static void f_count __P((char *));
+static void f_files __P((char *));
+static void f_ibs __P((char *));
+static void f_if __P((char *));
+static void f_obs __P((char *));
+static void f_of __P((char *));
+static void f_seek __P((char *));
+static void f_skip __P((char *));
+static u_long get_bsz __P((char *));
+
+static struct arg {
+ char *name;
+ void (*f) __P((char *));
+ u_int set, noset;
+} args[] = {
+ { "bs", f_bs, C_BS, C_BS|C_IBS|C_OBS|C_OSYNC },
+ { "cbs", f_cbs, C_CBS, C_CBS },
+ { "conv", f_conv, 0, 0 },
+ { "count", f_count, C_COUNT, C_COUNT },
+ { "files", f_files, C_FILES, C_FILES },
+ { "ibs", f_ibs, C_IBS, C_BS|C_IBS },
+ { "if", f_if, C_IF, C_IF },
+ { "obs", f_obs, C_OBS, C_BS|C_OBS },
+ { "of", f_of, C_OF, C_OF },
+ { "seek", f_seek, C_SEEK, C_SEEK },
+ { "skip", f_skip, C_SKIP, C_SKIP },
+};
+
+static char *oper;
+
+/*
+ * args -- parse JCL syntax of dd.
+ */
+void
+jcl(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ struct arg *ap, tmp;
+ char *arg;
+
+ in.dbsz = out.dbsz = 512;
+
+ while (oper = *++argv) {
+ if ((arg = strchr(oper, '=')) == NULL)
+ errx(1, "unknown operand %s", oper);
+ *arg++ = '\0';
+ if (!*arg)
+ errx(1, "no value specified for %s", oper);
+ tmp.name = oper;
+ if (!(ap = (struct arg *)bsearch(&tmp, args,
+ sizeof(args)/sizeof(struct arg), sizeof(struct arg),
+ c_arg)))
+ errx(1, "unknown operand %s", tmp.name);
+ if (ddflags & ap->noset)
+ errx(1, "%s: illegal argument combination or already set",
+ tmp.name);
+ ddflags |= ap->set;
+ ap->f(arg);
+ }
+
+ /* Final sanity checks. */
+
+ if (ddflags & C_BS) {
+ /*
+ * Bs is turned off by any conversion -- we assume the user
+ * just wanted to set both the input and output block sizes
+ * and didn't want the bs semantics, so we don't warn.
+ */
+ if (ddflags & (C_BLOCK|C_LCASE|C_SWAB|C_UCASE|C_UNBLOCK))
+ ddflags &= ~C_BS;
+
+ /* Bs supersedes ibs and obs. */
+ if (ddflags & C_BS && ddflags & (C_IBS|C_OBS))
+ warnx("bs supersedes ibs and obs");
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Ascii/ebcdic and cbs implies block/unblock.
+ * Block/unblock requires cbs and vice-versa.
+ */
+ if (ddflags & (C_BLOCK|C_UNBLOCK)) {
+ if (!(ddflags & C_CBS))
+ errx(1, "record operations require cbs");
+ if (cbsz == 0)
+ errx(1, "cbs cannot be zero");
+ cfunc = ddflags & C_BLOCK ? block : unblock;
+ } else if (ddflags & C_CBS) {
+ if (ddflags & (C_ASCII|C_EBCDIC)) {
+ if (ddflags & C_ASCII) {
+ ddflags |= C_UNBLOCK;
+ cfunc = unblock;
+ } else {
+ ddflags |= C_BLOCK;
+ cfunc = block;
+ }
+ } else
+ errx(1, "cbs meaningless if not doing record operations");
+ if (cbsz == 0)
+ errx(1, "cbs cannot be zero");
+ } else
+ cfunc = def;
+
+ if (in.dbsz == 0 || out.dbsz == 0)
+ errx(1, "buffer sizes cannot be zero");
+
+ /*
+ * Read, write and seek calls take ints as arguments. Seek sizes
+ * could be larger if we wanted to do it in stages or check only
+ * regular files, but it's probably not worth it.
+ */
+ if (in.dbsz > INT_MAX || out.dbsz > INT_MAX)
+ errx(1, "buffer sizes cannot be greater than %d", INT_MAX);
+ if (in.offset > INT_MAX / in.dbsz || out.offset > INT_MAX / out.dbsz)
+ errx(1, "seek offsets cannot be larger than %d", INT_MAX);
+}
+
+static int
+c_arg(a, b)
+ const void *a, *b;
+{
+
+ return (strcmp(((struct arg *)a)->name, ((struct arg *)b)->name));
+}
+
+static void
+f_bs(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ in.dbsz = out.dbsz = (int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static void
+f_cbs(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ cbsz = (int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static void
+f_count(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ cpy_cnt = (u_int)get_bsz(arg);
+ if (!cpy_cnt)
+ terminate(0);
+}
+
+static void
+f_files(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ files_cnt = (int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static void
+f_ibs(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ if (!(ddflags & C_BS))
+ in.dbsz = (int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static void
+f_if(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ in.name = arg;
+}
+
+static void
+f_obs(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ if (!(ddflags & C_BS))
+ out.dbsz = (int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static void
+f_of(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ out.name = arg;
+}
+
+static void
+f_seek(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ out.offset = (u_int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static void
+f_skip(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+
+ in.offset = (u_int)get_bsz(arg);
+}
+
+static struct conv {
+ char *name;
+ u_int set, noset;
+ u_char *ctab;
+} clist[] = {
+ { "ascii", C_ASCII, C_EBCDIC, e2a_POSIX },
+ { "block", C_BLOCK, C_UNBLOCK, NULL },
+ { "ebcdic", C_EBCDIC, C_ASCII, a2e_POSIX },
+ { "ibm", C_EBCDIC, C_ASCII, a2ibm_POSIX },
+ { "lcase", C_LCASE, C_UCASE, NULL },
+ { "noerror", C_NOERROR, 0, NULL },
+ { "notrunc", C_NOTRUNC, 0, NULL },
+ { "oldascii", C_ASCII, C_EBCDIC, e2a_32V },
+ { "oldebcdic", C_EBCDIC, C_ASCII, a2e_32V },
+ { "oldibm", C_EBCDIC, C_ASCII, a2ibm_32V },
+ { "osync", C_OSYNC, C_BS, NULL },
+ { "swab", C_SWAB, 0, NULL },
+ { "sync", C_SYNC, 0, NULL },
+ { "ucase", C_UCASE, C_LCASE, NULL },
+ { "unblock", C_UNBLOCK, C_BLOCK, NULL },
+};
+
+static void
+f_conv(arg)
+ char *arg;
+{
+ struct conv *cp, tmp;
+
+ while (arg != NULL) {
+ tmp.name = strsep(&arg, ",");
+ if (!(cp = (struct conv *)bsearch(&tmp, clist,
+ sizeof(clist)/sizeof(struct conv), sizeof(struct conv),
+ c_conv)))
+ errx(1, "unknown conversion %s", tmp.name);
+ if (ddflags & cp->noset)
+ errx(1, "%s: illegal conversion combination", tmp.name);
+ ddflags |= cp->set;
+ if (cp->ctab)
+ ctab = cp->ctab;
+ }
+}
+
+static int
+c_conv(a, b)
+ const void *a, *b;
+{
+
+ return (strcmp(((struct conv *)a)->name, ((struct conv *)b)->name));
+}
+
+/*
+ * Convert an expression of the following forms to an unsigned long.
+ * 1) A positive decimal number.
+ * 2) A positive decimal number followed by a b (mult by 512).
+ * 3) A positive decimal number followed by a k (mult by 1024).
+ * 4) A positive decimal number followed by a m (mult by 512).
+ * 5) A positive decimal number followed by a w (mult by sizeof int)
+ * 6) Two or more positive decimal numbers (with/without k,b or w).
+ * seperated by x (also * for backwards compatibility), specifying
+ * the product of the indicated values.
+ */
+static u_long
+get_bsz(val)
+ char *val;
+{
+ u_long num, t;
+ char *expr;
+
+ num = strtoul(val, &expr, 0);
+ if (num == ULONG_MAX) /* Overflow. */
+ err(1, "%s", oper);
+ if (expr == val) /* No digits. */
+ errx(1, "%s: illegal numeric value", oper);
+
+ switch(*expr) {
+ case 'b':
+ t = num;
+ num *= 512;
+ if (t > num)
+ goto erange;
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ case 'k':
+ t = num;
+ num *= 1024;
+ if (t > num)
+ goto erange;
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ t = num;
+ num *= 1048576;
+ if (t > num)
+ goto erange;
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ case 'w':
+ t = num;
+ num *= sizeof(int);
+ if (t > num)
+ goto erange;
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ switch(*expr) {
+ case '\0':
+ break;
+ case '*': /* Backward compatible. */
+ case 'x':
+ t = num;
+ num *= get_bsz(expr + 1);
+ if (t > num)
+erange: errx(1, "%s: %s", oper, strerror(ERANGE));
+ break;
+ default:
+ errx(1, "%s: illegal numeric value", oper);
+ }
+ return (num);
+}
diff --git a/bin/dd/conv.c b/bin/dd/conv.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..69fa8cf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/conv.c
@@ -0,0 +1,260 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)conv.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "dd.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * def --
+ * Copy input to output. Input is buffered until reaches obs, and then
+ * output until less than obs remains. Only a single buffer is used.
+ * Worst case buffer calculation is (ibs + obs - 1).
+ */
+void
+def()
+{
+ int cnt;
+ u_char *inp, *t;
+
+ if (t = ctab)
+ for (inp = in.dbp - (cnt = in.dbrcnt); cnt--; ++inp)
+ *inp = t[*inp];
+
+ /* Make the output buffer look right. */
+ out.dbp = in.dbp;
+ out.dbcnt = in.dbcnt;
+
+ if (in.dbcnt >= out.dbsz) {
+ /* If the output buffer is full, write it. */
+ dd_out(0);
+
+ /*
+ * Ddout copies the leftover output to the beginning of
+ * the buffer and resets the output buffer. Reset the
+ * input buffer to match it.
+ */
+ in.dbp = out.dbp;
+ in.dbcnt = out.dbcnt;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+def_close()
+{
+ /* Just update the count, everything is already in the buffer. */
+ if (in.dbcnt)
+ out.dbcnt = in.dbcnt;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Copy variable length newline terminated records with a max size cbsz
+ * bytes to output. Records less than cbs are padded with spaces.
+ *
+ * max in buffer: MAX(ibs, cbsz)
+ * max out buffer: obs + cbsz
+ */
+void
+block()
+{
+ static int intrunc;
+ int ch, cnt, maxlen;
+ u_char *inp, *outp, *t;
+
+ /*
+ * Record truncation can cross block boundaries. If currently in a
+ * truncation state, keep tossing characters until reach a newline.
+ * Start at the beginning of the buffer, as the input buffer is always
+ * left empty.
+ */
+ if (intrunc) {
+ for (inp = in.db, cnt = in.dbrcnt;
+ cnt && *inp++ != '\n'; --cnt);
+ if (!cnt) {
+ in.dbcnt = 0;
+ in.dbp = in.db;
+ return;
+ }
+ intrunc = 0;
+ /* Adjust the input buffer numbers. */
+ in.dbcnt = cnt - 1;
+ in.dbp = inp + cnt - 1;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Copy records (max cbsz size chunks) into the output buffer. The
+ * translation is done as we copy into the output buffer.
+ */
+ for (inp = in.dbp - in.dbcnt, outp = out.dbp; in.dbcnt;) {
+ maxlen = MIN(cbsz, in.dbcnt);
+ if (t = ctab)
+ for (cnt = 0;
+ cnt < maxlen && (ch = *inp++) != '\n'; ++cnt)
+ *outp++ = t[ch];
+ else
+ for (cnt = 0;
+ cnt < maxlen && (ch = *inp++) != '\n'; ++cnt)
+ *outp++ = ch;
+ /*
+ * Check for short record without a newline. Reassemble the
+ * input block.
+ */
+ if (ch != '\n' && in.dbcnt < cbsz) {
+ memmove(in.db, in.dbp - in.dbcnt, in.dbcnt);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Adjust the input buffer numbers. */
+ in.dbcnt -= cnt;
+ if (ch == '\n')
+ --in.dbcnt;
+
+ /* Pad short records with spaces. */
+ if (cnt < cbsz)
+ (void)memset(outp, ctab ? ctab[' '] : ' ', cbsz - cnt);
+ else {
+ /*
+ * If the next character wouldn't have ended the
+ * block, it's a truncation.
+ */
+ if (!in.dbcnt || *inp != '\n')
+ ++st.trunc;
+
+ /* Toss characters to a newline. */
+ for (; in.dbcnt && *inp++ != '\n'; --in.dbcnt);
+ if (!in.dbcnt)
+ intrunc = 1;
+ else
+ --in.dbcnt;
+ }
+
+ /* Adjust output buffer numbers. */
+ out.dbp += cbsz;
+ if ((out.dbcnt += cbsz) >= out.dbsz)
+ dd_out(0);
+ outp = out.dbp;
+ }
+ in.dbp = in.db + in.dbcnt;
+}
+
+void
+block_close()
+{
+ /*
+ * Copy any remaining data into the output buffer and pad to a record.
+ * Don't worry about truncation or translation, the input buffer is
+ * always empty when truncating, and no characters have been added for
+ * translation. The bottom line is that anything left in the input
+ * buffer is a truncated record. Anything left in the output buffer
+ * just wasn't big enough.
+ */
+ if (in.dbcnt) {
+ ++st.trunc;
+ memmove(out.dbp, in.dbp - in.dbcnt, in.dbcnt);
+ (void)memset(out.dbp + in.dbcnt,
+ ctab ? ctab[' '] : ' ', cbsz - in.dbcnt);
+ out.dbcnt += cbsz;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Convert fixed length (cbsz) records to variable length. Deletes any
+ * trailing blanks and appends a newline.
+ *
+ * max in buffer: MAX(ibs, cbsz) + cbsz
+ * max out buffer: obs + cbsz
+ */
+void
+unblock()
+{
+ int cnt;
+ u_char *inp, *t;
+
+ /* Translation and case conversion. */
+ if (t = ctab)
+ for (cnt = in.dbrcnt, inp = in.dbp; cnt--;)
+ *--inp = t[*inp];
+ /*
+ * Copy records (max cbsz size chunks) into the output buffer. The
+ * translation has to already be done or we might not recognize the
+ * spaces.
+ */
+ for (inp = in.db; in.dbcnt >= cbsz; inp += cbsz, in.dbcnt -= cbsz) {
+ for (t = inp + cbsz - 1; t >= inp && *t == ' '; --t);
+ if (t >= inp) {
+ cnt = t - inp + 1;
+ memmove(out.dbp, inp, cnt);
+ out.dbp += cnt;
+ out.dbcnt += cnt;
+ }
+ ++out.dbcnt;
+ *out.dbp++ = '\n';
+ if (out.dbcnt >= out.dbsz)
+ dd_out(0);
+ }
+ if (in.dbcnt)
+ memmove(in.db, in.dbp - in.dbcnt, in.dbcnt);
+ in.dbp = in.db + in.dbcnt;
+}
+
+void
+unblock_close()
+{
+ int cnt;
+ u_char *t;
+
+ if (in.dbcnt) {
+ warnx("%s: short input record", in.name);
+ for (t = in.db + in.dbcnt - 1; t >= in.db && *t == ' '; --t);
+ if (t >= in.db) {
+ cnt = t - in.db + 1;
+ memmove(out.dbp, in.db, cnt);
+ out.dbp += cnt;
+ out.dbcnt += cnt;
+ }
+ ++out.dbcnt;
+ *out.dbp++ = '\n';
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/dd/conv_tab.c b/bin/dd/conv_tab.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5d238d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/conv_tab.c
@@ -0,0 +1,357 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)conv_tab.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+/*
+ * There are currently eight tables:
+ *
+ * lower-case -> upper-case conv=upper
+ * upper-case -> lower-case conv=lower
+ *
+ * ebcdic -> ascii 32V conv=oldascii
+ * ascii -> ebcdic 32V conv=oldebcdic
+ * ascii -> ibm ebcdic 32V conv=oldibm
+ *
+ * ebcdic -> ascii POSIX/S5 conv=ascii
+ * ascii -> ebcdic POSIX/S5 conv=ebcdic
+ * ascii -> ibm ebcdic POSIX/S5 conv=ibm
+ *
+ * Other tables are built from these if multiple conversions are being
+ * done.
+ *
+ * Tables used for conversions to/from IBM and EBCDIC to support an extension
+ * to POSIX P1003.2/D11. The tables referencing POSIX contain data extracted
+ * from tables 4-3 and 4-4 in P1003.2/Draft 11. The historic tables were
+ * constructed by running against a file with all possible byte values.
+ *
+ * More information can be obtained in "Correspondences of 8-Bit and Hollerith
+ * Codes for Computer Environments-A USASI Tutorial", Communications of the
+ * ACM, Volume 11, Number 11, November 1968, pp. 783-789.
+ */
+
+/* Lower-case to upper-case */
+u_char l2u[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007, /* 0000 */
+ 0010, 0011, 0012, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0024, 0025, 0026, 0027, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0032, 0033, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0045, 0046, 0047, /* 0040 */
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0055, 0056, 0057, /* 0050 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0062, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0067, /* 0060 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0074, 0075, 0076, 0077, /* 0070 */
+ 0100, 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, /* 0100 */
+ 0110, 0111, 0112, 0113, 0114, 0115, 0116, 0117, /* 0110 */
+ 0120, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, /* 0120 */
+ 0130, 0131, 0132, 0133, 0134, 0135, 0136, 0137, /* 0130 */
+ 0140, 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, /* 0140 */
+ 0110, 0111, 0112, 0113, 0114, 0115, 0116, 0117, /* 0150 */
+ 0120, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, /* 0160 */
+ 0130, 0131, 0132, 0173, 0174, 0175, 0176, 0177, /* 0170 */
+ 0200, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207, /* 0200 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, 0216, 0217, /* 0210 */
+ 0220, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, 0227, /* 0220 */
+ 0230, 0231, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, 0237, /* 0230 */
+ 0240, 0241, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, 0247, /* 0240 */
+ 0250, 0251, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0250 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0260 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, /* 0270 */
+ 0300, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, /* 0300 */
+ 0310, 0311, 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, /* 0310 */
+ 0320, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, 0327, /* 0320 */
+ 0330, 0331, 0332, 0333, 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, /* 0330 */
+ 0340, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, 0347, /* 0340 */
+ 0350, 0351, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, 0356, 0357, /* 0350 */
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, /* 0360 */
+ 0370, 0371, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* Upper-case to lower-case */
+u_char u2l[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0004, 0005, 0006, 0007, /* 0000 */
+ 0010, 0011, 0012, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0024, 0025, 0026, 0027, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0032, 0033, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0045, 0046, 0047, /* 0040 */
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0055, 0056, 0057, /* 0050 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0062, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0067, /* 0060 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0074, 0075, 0076, 0077, /* 0070 */
+ 0100, 0141, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0100 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0152, 0153, 0154, 0155, 0156, 0157, /* 0110 */
+ 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, 0166, 0167, /* 0120 */
+ 0170, 0171, 0172, 0133, 0134, 0135, 0136, 0137, /* 0130 */
+ 0140, 0141, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0140 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0152, 0153, 0154, 0155, 0156, 0157, /* 0150 */
+ 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, 0166, 0167, /* 0160 */
+ 0170, 0171, 0172, 0173, 0174, 0175, 0176, 0177, /* 0170 */
+ 0200, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207, /* 0200 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, 0216, 0217, /* 0210 */
+ 0220, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, 0227, /* 0220 */
+ 0230, 0231, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, 0237, /* 0230 */
+ 0240, 0241, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, 0247, /* 0240 */
+ 0250, 0251, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0250 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0260 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, /* 0270 */
+ 0300, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, /* 0300 */
+ 0310, 0311, 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, /* 0310 */
+ 0320, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, 0327, /* 0320 */
+ 0330, 0331, 0332, 0333, 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, /* 0330 */
+ 0340, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, 0347, /* 0340 */
+ 0350, 0351, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, 0356, 0357, /* 0350 */
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, /* 0360 */
+ 0370, 0371, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* EBCDIC to ASCII -- 32V compatible. */
+u_char e2a_32V[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0234, 0011, 0206, 0177, /* 0000 */
+ 0227, 0215, 0216, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0235, 0205, 0010, 0207, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0222, 0217, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0200, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0012, 0027, 0033, /* 0040 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0005, 0006, 0007, /* 0050 */
+ 0220, 0221, 0026, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, 0004, /* 0060 */
+ 0230, 0231, 0232, 0233, 0024, 0025, 0236, 0032, /* 0070 */
+ 0040, 0240, 0241, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, /* 0100 */
+ 0247, 0250, 0133, 0056, 0074, 0050, 0053, 0041, /* 0110 */
+ 0046, 0251, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0120 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0135, 0044, 0052, 0051, 0073, 0136, /* 0130 */
+ 0055, 0057, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0140 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0174, 0054, 0045, 0137, 0076, 0077, /* 0150 */
+ 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, 0300, 0301, /* 0160 */
+ 0302, 0140, 0072, 0043, 0100, 0047, 0075, 0042, /* 0170 */
+ 0303, 0141, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0200 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, 0310, 0311, /* 0210 */
+ 0312, 0152, 0153, 0154, 0155, 0156, 0157, 0160, /* 0220 */
+ 0161, 0162, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, 0320, /* 0230 */
+ 0321, 0176, 0163, 0164, 0165, 0166, 0167, 0170, /* 0240 */
+ 0171, 0172, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, 0327, /* 0250 */
+ 0330, 0331, 0332, 0333, 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, /* 0260 */
+ 0340, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, 0347, /* 0270 */
+ 0173, 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, /* 0300 */
+ 0110, 0111, 0350, 0351, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, /* 0310 */
+ 0175, 0112, 0113, 0114, 0115, 0116, 0117, 0120, /* 0320 */
+ 0121, 0122, 0356, 0357, 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, /* 0330 */
+ 0134, 0237, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, 0130, /* 0340 */
+ 0131, 0132, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, 0370, 0371, /* 0350 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0062, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0067, /* 0360 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* ASCII to EBCDIC -- 32V compatible. */
+u_char a2e_32V[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0067, 0055, 0056, 0057, /* 0000 */
+ 0026, 0005, 0045, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0074, 0075, 0062, 0046, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0077, 0047, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0100, 0117, 0177, 0173, 0133, 0154, 0120, 0175, /* 0040 */
+ 0115, 0135, 0134, 0116, 0153, 0140, 0113, 0141, /* 0050 */
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, /* 0060 */
+ 0370, 0371, 0172, 0136, 0114, 0176, 0156, 0157, /* 0070 */
+ 0174, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, /* 0100 */
+ 0310, 0311, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, /* 0110 */
+ 0327, 0330, 0331, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, /* 0120 */
+ 0347, 0350, 0351, 0112, 0340, 0132, 0137, 0155, /* 0130 */
+ 0171, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207, /* 0140 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, /* 0150 */
+ 0227, 0230, 0231, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, /* 0160 */
+ 0247, 0250, 0251, 0300, 0152, 0320, 0241, 0007, /* 0170 */
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0025, 0006, 0027, /* 0200 */
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0011, 0012, 0033, /* 0210 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0032, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0010, /* 0220 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0004, 0024, 0076, 0341, /* 0230 */
+ 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, 0110, /* 0240 */
+ 0111, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, /* 0250 */
+ 0130, 0131, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0260 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, /* 0270 */
+ 0166, 0167, 0170, 0200, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, /* 0300 */
+ 0216, 0217, 0220, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, /* 0310 */
+ 0237, 0240, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0320 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0330 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, /* 0340 */
+ 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, 0332, 0333, /* 0350 */
+ 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, /* 0360 */
+ 0356, 0357, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* ASCII to IBM EBCDIC -- 32V compatible. */
+u_char a2ibm_32V[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0067, 0055, 0056, 0057, /* 0000 */
+ 0026, 0005, 0045, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0074, 0075, 0062, 0046, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0077, 0047, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0100, 0132, 0177, 0173, 0133, 0154, 0120, 0175, /* 0040 */
+ 0115, 0135, 0134, 0116, 0153, 0140, 0113, 0141, /* 0050 */
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, /* 0060 */
+ 0370, 0371, 0172, 0136, 0114, 0176, 0156, 0157, /* 0070 */
+ 0174, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, /* 0100 */
+ 0310, 0311, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, /* 0110 */
+ 0327, 0330, 0331, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, /* 0120 */
+ 0347, 0350, 0351, 0255, 0340, 0275, 0137, 0155, /* 0130 */
+ 0171, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207, /* 0140 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, /* 0150 */
+ 0227, 0230, 0231, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, /* 0160 */
+ 0247, 0250, 0251, 0300, 0117, 0320, 0241, 0007, /* 0170 */
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0025, 0006, 0027, /* 0200 */
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0011, 0012, 0033, /* 0210 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0032, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0010, /* 0220 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0004, 0024, 0076, 0341, /* 0230 */
+ 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, 0110, /* 0240 */
+ 0111, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, /* 0250 */
+ 0130, 0131, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0260 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, /* 0270 */
+ 0166, 0167, 0170, 0200, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, /* 0300 */
+ 0216, 0217, 0220, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, /* 0310 */
+ 0237, 0240, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0320 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0330 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, /* 0340 */
+ 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, 0332, 0333, /* 0350 */
+ 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, /* 0360 */
+ 0356, 0357, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* EBCDIC to ASCII -- POSIX and System V compatible. */
+u_char e2a_POSIX[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0234, 0011, 0206, 0177, /* 0000 */
+ 0227, 0215, 0216, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0235, 0205, 0010, 0207, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0222, 0217, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0200, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0012, 0027, 0033, /* 0040 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0005, 0006, 0007, /* 0050 */
+ 0220, 0221, 0026, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, 0004, /* 0060 */
+ 0230, 0231, 0232, 0233, 0024, 0025, 0236, 0032, /* 0070 */
+ 0040, 0240, 0241, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, /* 0100 */
+ 0247, 0250, 0325, 0056, 0074, 0050, 0053, 0174, /* 0110 */
+ 0046, 0251, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0120 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0041, 0044, 0052, 0051, 0073, 0176, /* 0130 */
+ 0055, 0057, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0140 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0313, 0054, 0045, 0137, 0076, 0077, /* 0150 */
+ 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, 0300, 0301, /* 0160 */
+ 0302, 0140, 0072, 0043, 0100, 0047, 0075, 0042, /* 0170 */
+ 0303, 0141, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0200 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, 0310, 0311, /* 0210 */
+ 0312, 0152, 0153, 0154, 0155, 0156, 0157, 0160, /* 0220 */
+ 0161, 0162, 0136, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, 0320, /* 0230 */
+ 0321, 0345, 0163, 0164, 0165, 0166, 0167, 0170, /* 0240 */
+ 0171, 0172, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0133, 0326, 0327, /* 0250 */
+ 0330, 0331, 0332, 0333, 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, /* 0260 */
+ 0340, 0341, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0135, 0346, 0347, /* 0270 */
+ 0173, 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, /* 0300 */
+ 0110, 0111, 0350, 0351, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, /* 0310 */
+ 0175, 0112, 0113, 0114, 0115, 0116, 0117, 0120, /* 0320 */
+ 0121, 0122, 0356, 0357, 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, /* 0330 */
+ 0134, 0237, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, 0130, /* 0340 */
+ 0131, 0132, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, 0370, 0371, /* 0350 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0062, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0067, /* 0360 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* ASCII to EBCDIC -- POSIX and System V compatible. */
+u_char a2e_POSIX[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0067, 0055, 0056, 0057, /* 0000 */
+ 0026, 0005, 0045, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0074, 0075, 0062, 0046, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0077, 0047, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0100, 0132, 0177, 0173, 0133, 0154, 0120, 0175, /* 0040 */
+ 0115, 0135, 0134, 0116, 0153, 0140, 0113, 0141, /* 0050 */
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, /* 0060 */
+ 0370, 0371, 0172, 0136, 0114, 0176, 0156, 0157, /* 0070 */
+ 0174, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, /* 0100 */
+ 0310, 0311, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, /* 0110 */
+ 0327, 0330, 0331, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, /* 0120 */
+ 0347, 0350, 0351, 0255, 0340, 0275, 0232, 0155, /* 0130 */
+ 0171, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207, /* 0140 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, /* 0150 */
+ 0227, 0230, 0231, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, /* 0160 */
+ 0247, 0250, 0251, 0300, 0117, 0320, 0137, 0007, /* 0170 */
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0025, 0006, 0027, /* 0200 */
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0011, 0012, 0033, /* 0210 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0032, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0010, /* 0220 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0004, 0024, 0076, 0341, /* 0230 */
+ 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, 0110, /* 0240 */
+ 0111, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, /* 0250 */
+ 0130, 0131, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0260 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, /* 0270 */
+ 0166, 0167, 0170, 0200, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, /* 0300 */
+ 0216, 0217, 0220, 0152, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, /* 0310 */
+ 0237, 0240, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0112, 0256, 0257, /* 0320 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0330 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0241, 0276, 0277, /* 0340 */
+ 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, 0332, 0333, /* 0350 */
+ 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, /* 0360 */
+ 0356, 0357, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
+
+/* ASCII to IBM EBCDIC -- POSIX and System V compatible. */
+u_char a2ibm_POSIX[] = {
+ 0000, 0001, 0002, 0003, 0067, 0055, 0056, 0057, /* 0000 */
+ 0026, 0005, 0045, 0013, 0014, 0015, 0016, 0017, /* 0010 */
+ 0020, 0021, 0022, 0023, 0074, 0075, 0062, 0046, /* 0020 */
+ 0030, 0031, 0077, 0047, 0034, 0035, 0036, 0037, /* 0030 */
+ 0100, 0132, 0177, 0173, 0133, 0154, 0120, 0175, /* 0040 */
+ 0115, 0135, 0134, 0116, 0153, 0140, 0113, 0141, /* 0050 */
+ 0360, 0361, 0362, 0363, 0364, 0365, 0366, 0367, /* 0060 */
+ 0370, 0371, 0172, 0136, 0114, 0176, 0156, 0157, /* 0070 */
+ 0174, 0301, 0302, 0303, 0304, 0305, 0306, 0307, /* 0100 */
+ 0310, 0311, 0321, 0322, 0323, 0324, 0325, 0326, /* 0110 */
+ 0327, 0330, 0331, 0342, 0343, 0344, 0345, 0346, /* 0120 */
+ 0347, 0350, 0351, 0255, 0340, 0275, 0137, 0155, /* 0130 */
+ 0171, 0201, 0202, 0203, 0204, 0205, 0206, 0207, /* 0140 */
+ 0210, 0211, 0221, 0222, 0223, 0224, 0225, 0226, /* 0150 */
+ 0227, 0230, 0231, 0242, 0243, 0244, 0245, 0246, /* 0160 */
+ 0247, 0250, 0251, 0300, 0117, 0320, 0241, 0007, /* 0170 */
+ 0040, 0041, 0042, 0043, 0044, 0025, 0006, 0027, /* 0200 */
+ 0050, 0051, 0052, 0053, 0054, 0011, 0012, 0033, /* 0210 */
+ 0060, 0061, 0032, 0063, 0064, 0065, 0066, 0010, /* 0220 */
+ 0070, 0071, 0072, 0073, 0004, 0024, 0076, 0341, /* 0230 */
+ 0101, 0102, 0103, 0104, 0105, 0106, 0107, 0110, /* 0240 */
+ 0111, 0121, 0122, 0123, 0124, 0125, 0126, 0127, /* 0250 */
+ 0130, 0131, 0142, 0143, 0144, 0145, 0146, 0147, /* 0260 */
+ 0150, 0151, 0160, 0161, 0162, 0163, 0164, 0165, /* 0270 */
+ 0166, 0167, 0170, 0200, 0212, 0213, 0214, 0215, /* 0300 */
+ 0216, 0217, 0220, 0232, 0233, 0234, 0235, 0236, /* 0310 */
+ 0237, 0240, 0252, 0253, 0254, 0255, 0256, 0257, /* 0320 */
+ 0260, 0261, 0262, 0263, 0264, 0265, 0266, 0267, /* 0330 */
+ 0270, 0271, 0272, 0273, 0274, 0275, 0276, 0277, /* 0340 */
+ 0312, 0313, 0314, 0315, 0316, 0317, 0332, 0333, /* 0350 */
+ 0334, 0335, 0336, 0337, 0352, 0353, 0354, 0355, /* 0360 */
+ 0356, 0357, 0372, 0373, 0374, 0375, 0376, 0377, /* 0370 */
+};
diff --git a/bin/dd/dd.1 b/bin/dd/dd.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0b20781
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/dd.1
@@ -0,0 +1,348 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)dd.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 1/13/94
+.\"
+.Dd January 13, 1994
+.Dt DD 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm dd
+.Nd convert and copy a file
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm dd
+.Op operands ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm
+utility copies the standard input to the standard output.
+Input data is read and written in 512-byte blocks.
+If input reads are short, input from multiple reads are aggregated
+to form the output block.
+When finished,
+.Nm dd
+displays the number of complete and partial input and output blocks
+and truncated input records to the standard error output.
+.Pp
+The following operands are available:
+.Bl -tag -width of=file
+.It Cm bs= Ns Ar n
+Set both input and output block size, superseding the
+.Cm ibs
+and
+.Cm obs
+operands.
+If no conversion values other than
+.Cm noerror ,
+.Cm notrunc
+or
+.Cm sync
+are specified, then each input block is copied to the output as a
+single block without any aggregation of short blocks.
+.It Cm cbs= Ns Ar n
+Set the conversion record size to
+.Va n
+bytes.
+The conversion record size is required by the record oriented conversion
+values.
+.It Cm count= Ns Ar n
+Copy only
+.Va n
+input blocks.
+.It Cm files= Ns Ar n
+Copy
+.Va n
+input files before terminating.
+This operand is only applicable when the input device is a tape.
+.It Cm ibs= Ns Ar n
+Set the input block size to
+.Va n
+bytes instead of the default 512.
+.It Cm if= Ns Ar file
+Read input from
+.Ar file
+instead of the standard input.
+.It Cm obs= Ns Ar n
+Set the output block size to
+.Va n
+bytes instead of the default 512.
+.It Cm of= Ns Ar file
+Write output to
+.Ar file
+instead of the standard output.
+Any regular output file is truncated unless the
+.Cm notrunc
+conversion value is specified.
+If an initial portion of the output file is skipped (see the
+.Cm seek
+operand)
+the output file is truncated at that point.
+.It Cm seek= Ns Ar n
+Seek
+.Va n
+blocks from the beginning of the output before copying.
+On non-tape devices, a
+.Xr lseek 2
+operation is used.
+Otherwise, existing blocks are read and the data discarded.
+If the user does not have read permission for the tape, it is positioned
+using the tape
+.Xr ioctl 2
+function calls.
+If the seek operation is past the end of file, space from the current
+end of file to the specified offset is filled with blocks of
+.Tn NUL
+bytes.
+.It Cm skip= Ns Ar n
+Skip
+.Va n
+blocks from the beginning of the input before copying.
+On input which supports seeks, a
+.Xr lseek 2
+operation is used.
+Otherwise, input data is read and discarded.
+For pipes, the correct number of bytes is read.
+For all other devices, the correct number of blocks is read without
+distinguishing between a partial or complete block being read.
+.It Xo
+.Cm conv=
+.Ns Cm value Ns Op \&, Cm value \&...
+.Xc
+Where
+.Cm value
+is one of the symbols from the following list.
+.Bl -tag -width unblock
+.It Cm ascii , oldascii
+The same as the
+.Cm unblock
+value except that characters are translated from
+.Tn ECBDIC
+to
+.Tn ASCII
+before the
+records are converted.
+(These values imply
+.Cm unblock
+if the operand
+.Cm cbs
+is also specified.)
+There are two conversion maps for
+.Tn ASCII .
+The value
+.Cm ascii
+specifies the recommended one which is compatible with System V.
+The value
+.Cm oldascii
+specifies the one used in historic
+.Tn AT&T
+and pre-4.3BSD-reno systems.
+.It Cm block
+Treats the input as a sequence of newline or end-of-file terminated variable
+length records independent of input and output block boundaries.
+Any trailing newline character is discarded.
+Each input record is converted to a fixed length output record where the
+length is specified by the
+.Cm cbs
+operand.
+Input records shorter than the conversion record size are padded with spaces.
+Input records longer than the conversion record size are truncated.
+The number of truncated input records, if any, are reported to the standard
+error output at the completion of the copy.
+.It Cm ebcdic , ibm , oldebcdic , oldibm
+The same as the
+.Cm block
+value except that characters are translated from
+.Tn ASCII
+to
+.Tn EBCDIC
+after the
+records are converted.
+(These values imply
+.Cm block
+if the operand
+.Cm cbs
+is also specified.)
+There are four conversion maps for
+.Tn EBCDIC .
+The value
+.Cm ebcdic
+specifies the recommended one which is compatible with
+.At V .
+The value
+.Cm ibm
+is a slightly different mapping, which is compatible with the
+.At V
+.Cm ibm
+value.
+The values
+.Cm oldebcdic
+and
+.Cm oldibm
+are maps used in historic
+.Tn AT&T
+and pre-4.3BSD-reno systems.
+.It Cm lcase
+Transform uppercase characters into lowercase characters.
+.It Cm noerror
+Do not stop processing on an input error.
+When an input error occurs, a diagnostic message followed by the current
+input and output block counts will be written to the standard error output
+in the same format as the standard completion message.
+If the
+.Cm sync
+conversion is also specified, any missing input data will be replaced
+with
+.Tn NUL
+bytes (or with spaces if a block oriented conversion value was
+specified) and processed as a normal input buffer.
+If the
+.Cm sync
+conversion is not specified, the input block is omitted from the output.
+On input files which are not tapes or pipes, the file offset
+will be positioned past the block in which the error occurred using
+.Xr lseek 2 .
+.It Cm notrunc
+Do not truncate the output file.
+This will preserve any blocks in the output file not explicitly written
+by
+.Nm dd .
+The
+.Cm notrunc
+value is not supported for tapes.
+.It Cm osync
+Pad the final output block to the full output block size.
+If the input file is not a multiple of the output block size
+after conversion, this conversion forces the final output block
+to be the same size as preceding blocks for use on devices that require
+regularly sized blocks to be written.
+This option is incompatible with use of the
+.Cm bs= Ns Ar n
+block size specification.
+.It Cm swab
+Swap every pair of input bytes.
+If an input buffer has an odd number of bytes, the last byte will be
+ignored during swapping.
+.It Cm sync
+Pad every input block to the input buffer size.
+Spaces are used for pad bytes if a block oriented conversion value is
+specified, otherwise
+.Tn NUL
+bytes are used.
+.It Cm ucase
+Transform lowercase characters into uppercase characters.
+.It Cm unblock
+Treats the input as a sequence of fixed length records independent of input
+and output block boundaries.
+The length of the input records is specified by the
+.Cm cbs
+operand.
+Any trailing space characters are discarded and a newline character is
+appended.
+.El
+.El
+.Pp
+Where sizes are specified, a decimal number of bytes is expected.
+If the number ends with a ``b'', ``k'', ``m'' or ``w'', the number
+is multiplied by 512, 1024 (1K), 1048576 (1M) or the number of bytes
+in an integer, respectively.
+Two or more numbers may be separated by an ``x'' to indicate a product.
+.Pp
+When finished,
+.Nm dd
+displays the number of complete and partial input and output blocks,
+truncated input records and odd-length byte-swapping blocks to the
+standard error output.
+A partial input block is one where less than the input block size
+was read.
+A partial output block is one where less than the output block size
+was written.
+Partial output blocks to tape devices are considered fatal errors.
+Otherwise, the rest of the block will be written.
+Partial output blocks to character devices will produce a warning message.
+A truncated input block is one where a variable length record oriented
+conversion value was specified and the input line was too long to
+fit in the conversion record or was not newline terminated.
+.Pp
+Normally, data resulting from input or conversion or both are aggregated
+into output blocks of the specified size.
+After the end of input is reached, any remaining output is written as
+a block.
+This means that the final output block may be shorter than the output
+block size.
+.Pp
+If
+.Nm dd
+receives a
+.Dv SIGINFO
+(see the ``status'' argument for
+.Xr stty 1 )
+signal, the current input and output block counts will
+be written to the standard error output
+in the same format as the standard completion message.
+If
+.Nm dd
+receives a
+.Dv SIGINT
+signal, the current input and output block counts will
+be written to the standard error output
+in the same format as the standard completion message and
+.Nm dd
+will exit.
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm dd
+utility exits 0 on success and >0 if an error occurred.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr cp 1 ,
+.Xr mt 1 ,
+.Xr tr 1
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm dd
+utility is expected to be a superset of the
+.St -p1003.2
+standard.
+The
+.Cm files
+operand and the
+.Cm ascii ,
+.Cm ebcdic ,
+.Cm ibm ,
+.Cm oldascii ,
+.Cm oldebcdic
+and
+.Cm oldibm
+values are extensions to the
+.Tn POSIX
+standard.
diff --git a/bin/dd/dd.c b/bin/dd/dd.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..05ac7a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/dd.c
@@ -0,0 +1,395 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)dd.c 8.5 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/mtio.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "dd.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void dd_close __P((void));
+static void dd_in __P((void));
+static void getfdtype __P((IO *));
+static void setup __P((void));
+
+IO in, out; /* input/output state */
+STAT st; /* statistics */
+void (*cfunc) __P((void)); /* conversion function */
+u_long cpy_cnt; /* # of blocks to copy */
+u_int ddflags; /* conversion options */
+u_int cbsz; /* conversion block size */
+u_int files_cnt = 1; /* # of files to copy */
+u_char *ctab; /* conversion table */
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ jcl(argv);
+ setup();
+
+ (void)signal(SIGINFO, summaryx);
+ (void)signal(SIGINT, terminate);
+
+ atexit(summary);
+
+ while (files_cnt--)
+ dd_in();
+
+ dd_close();
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+static void
+setup()
+{
+ u_int cnt;
+
+ if (in.name == NULL) {
+ in.name = "stdin";
+ in.fd = STDIN_FILENO;
+ } else {
+ in.fd = open(in.name, O_RDONLY, 0);
+ if (in.fd < 0)
+ err(1, "%s", in.name);
+ }
+
+ getfdtype(&in);
+
+ if (files_cnt > 1 && !(in.flags & ISTAPE))
+ errx(1, "files is not supported for non-tape devices");
+
+ if (out.name == NULL) {
+ /* No way to check for read access here. */
+ out.fd = STDOUT_FILENO;
+ out.name = "stdout";
+ } else {
+#define OFLAGS \
+ (O_CREAT | (ddflags & (C_SEEK | C_NOTRUNC) ? 0 : O_TRUNC))
+ out.fd = open(out.name, O_RDWR | OFLAGS, DEFFILEMODE);
+ /*
+ * May not have read access, so try again with write only.
+ * Without read we may have a problem if output also does
+ * not support seeks.
+ */
+ if (out.fd < 0) {
+ out.fd = open(out.name, O_WRONLY | OFLAGS, DEFFILEMODE);
+ out.flags |= NOREAD;
+ }
+ if (out.fd < 0)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+ }
+
+ getfdtype(&out);
+
+ /*
+ * Allocate space for the input and output buffers. If not doing
+ * record oriented I/O, only need a single buffer.
+ */
+ if (!(ddflags & (C_BLOCK|C_UNBLOCK))) {
+ if ((in.db = malloc(out.dbsz + in.dbsz - 1)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ out.db = in.db;
+ } else if ((in.db =
+ malloc((u_int)(MAX(in.dbsz, cbsz) + cbsz))) == NULL ||
+ (out.db = malloc((u_int)(out.dbsz + cbsz))) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ in.dbp = in.db;
+ out.dbp = out.db;
+
+ /* Position the input/output streams. */
+ if (in.offset)
+ pos_in();
+ if (out.offset)
+ pos_out();
+
+ /*
+ * Truncate the output file; ignore errors because it fails on some
+ * kinds of output files, tapes, for example.
+ */
+ if (ddflags & (C_OF | C_SEEK | C_NOTRUNC) == (C_OF | C_SEEK))
+ (void)ftruncate(out.fd, (off_t)out.offset * out.dbsz);
+
+ /*
+ * If converting case at the same time as another conversion, build a
+ * table that does both at once. If just converting case, use the
+ * built-in tables.
+ */
+ if (ddflags & (C_LCASE|C_UCASE))
+ if (ddflags & C_ASCII)
+ if (ddflags & C_LCASE) {
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < 0377; ++cnt)
+ if (isupper(ctab[cnt]))
+ ctab[cnt] = tolower(ctab[cnt]);
+ } else {
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < 0377; ++cnt)
+ if (islower(ctab[cnt]))
+ ctab[cnt] = toupper(ctab[cnt]);
+ }
+ else if (ddflags & C_EBCDIC)
+ if (ddflags & C_LCASE) {
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < 0377; ++cnt)
+ if (isupper(cnt))
+ ctab[cnt] = ctab[tolower(cnt)];
+ } else {
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < 0377; ++cnt)
+ if (islower(cnt))
+ ctab[cnt] = ctab[toupper(cnt)];
+ }
+ else
+ ctab = ddflags & C_LCASE ? u2l : l2u;
+ (void)time(&st.start); /* Statistics timestamp. */
+}
+
+static void
+getfdtype(io)
+ IO *io;
+{
+ struct mtget mt;
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ if (fstat(io->fd, &sb))
+ err(1, "%s", io->name);
+ if (S_ISCHR(sb.st_mode))
+ io->flags |= ioctl(io->fd, MTIOCGET, &mt) ? ISCHR : ISTAPE;
+ else if (lseek(io->fd, (off_t)0, SEEK_CUR) == -1 && errno == ESPIPE)
+ io->flags |= ISPIPE; /* XXX fixed in 4.4BSD */
+}
+
+static void
+dd_in()
+{
+ int flags, n;
+
+ for (flags = ddflags;;) {
+ if (cpy_cnt && (st.in_full + st.in_part) >= cpy_cnt)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * Zero the buffer first if trying to recover from errors so
+ * lose the minimum amount of data. If doing block operations
+ * use spaces.
+ */
+ if ((flags & (C_NOERROR|C_SYNC)) == (C_NOERROR|C_SYNC))
+ if (flags & (C_BLOCK|C_UNBLOCK))
+ memset(in.dbp, ' ', in.dbsz);
+ else
+ memset(in.dbp, 0, in.dbsz);
+
+ n = read(in.fd, in.dbp, in.dbsz);
+ if (n == 0) {
+ in.dbrcnt = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* Read error. */
+ if (n < 0) {
+ /*
+ * If noerror not specified, die. POSIX requires that
+ * the warning message be followed by an I/O display.
+ */
+ if (!(flags & C_NOERROR))
+ err(1, "%s", in.name);
+ warn("%s", in.name);
+ summary();
+
+ /*
+ * If it's not a tape drive or a pipe, seek past the
+ * error. If your OS doesn't do the right thing for
+ * raw disks this section should be modified to re-read
+ * in sector size chunks.
+ */
+ if (!(in.flags & (ISPIPE|ISTAPE)) &&
+ lseek(in.fd, (off_t)in.dbsz, SEEK_CUR))
+ warn("%s", in.name);
+
+ /* If sync not specified, omit block and continue. */
+ if (!(ddflags & C_SYNC))
+ continue;
+
+ /* Read errors count as full blocks. */
+ in.dbcnt += in.dbrcnt = in.dbsz;
+ ++st.in_full;
+
+ /* Handle full input blocks. */
+ } else if (n == in.dbsz) {
+ in.dbcnt += in.dbrcnt = n;
+ ++st.in_full;
+
+ /* Handle partial input blocks. */
+ } else {
+ /* If sync, use the entire block. */
+ if (ddflags & C_SYNC)
+ in.dbcnt += in.dbrcnt = in.dbsz;
+ else
+ in.dbcnt += in.dbrcnt = n;
+ ++st.in_part;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * POSIX states that if bs is set and no other conversions
+ * than noerror, notrunc or sync are specified, the block
+ * is output without buffering as it is read.
+ */
+ if (ddflags & C_BS) {
+ out.dbcnt = in.dbcnt;
+ dd_out(1);
+ in.dbcnt = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (ddflags & C_SWAB) {
+ if ((n = in.dbcnt) & 1) {
+ ++st.swab;
+ --n;
+ }
+ swab(in.dbp, in.dbp, n);
+ }
+
+ in.dbp += in.dbrcnt;
+ (*cfunc)();
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Cleanup any remaining I/O and flush output. If necesssary, output file
+ * is truncated.
+ */
+static void
+dd_close()
+{
+ if (cfunc == def)
+ def_close();
+ else if (cfunc == block)
+ block_close();
+ else if (cfunc == unblock)
+ unblock_close();
+ if (ddflags & C_OSYNC && out.dbcnt < out.dbsz) {
+ memset(out.dbp, 0, out.dbsz - out.dbcnt);
+ out.dbcnt = out.dbsz;
+ }
+ if (out.dbcnt)
+ dd_out(1);
+}
+
+void
+dd_out(force)
+ int force;
+{
+ static int warned;
+ int cnt, n, nw;
+ u_char *outp;
+
+ /*
+ * Write one or more blocks out. The common case is writing a full
+ * output block in a single write; increment the full block stats.
+ * Otherwise, we're into partial block writes. If a partial write,
+ * and it's a character device, just warn. If a tape device, quit.
+ *
+ * The partial writes represent two cases. 1: Where the input block
+ * was less than expected so the output block was less than expected.
+ * 2: Where the input block was the right size but we were forced to
+ * write the block in multiple chunks. The original versions of dd(1)
+ * never wrote a block in more than a single write, so the latter case
+ * never happened.
+ *
+ * One special case is if we're forced to do the write -- in that case
+ * we play games with the buffer size, and it's usually a partial write.
+ */
+ outp = out.db;
+ for (n = force ? out.dbcnt : out.dbsz;; n = out.dbsz) {
+ for (cnt = n;; cnt -= nw) {
+ nw = write(out.fd, outp, cnt);
+ if (nw <= 0) {
+ if (nw == 0)
+ errx(1, "%s: end of device", out.name);
+ if (errno != EINTR)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+ nw = 0;
+ }
+ outp += nw;
+ st.bytes += nw;
+ if (nw == n) {
+ if (n != out.dbsz)
+ ++st.out_part;
+ else
+ ++st.out_full;
+ break;
+ }
+ ++st.out_part;
+ if (nw == cnt)
+ break;
+ if (out.flags & ISCHR && !warned) {
+ warned = 1;
+ warnx("%s: short write on character device",
+ out.name);
+ }
+ if (out.flags & ISTAPE)
+ errx(1, "%s: short write on tape device", out.name);
+ }
+ if ((out.dbcnt -= n) < out.dbsz)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Reassemble the output block. */
+ if (out.dbcnt)
+ memmove(out.db, out.dbp - out.dbcnt, out.dbcnt);
+ out.dbp = out.db + out.dbcnt;
+}
diff --git a/bin/dd/dd.h b/bin/dd/dd.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3b790a7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/dd.h
@@ -0,0 +1,96 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)dd.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94
+ */
+
+/* Input/output stream state. */
+typedef struct {
+ u_char *db; /* buffer address */
+ u_char *dbp; /* current buffer I/O address */
+ u_long dbcnt; /* current buffer byte count */
+ int dbrcnt; /* last read byte count */
+ u_long dbsz; /* buffer size */
+
+#define ISCHR 0x01 /* character device (warn on short) */
+#define ISPIPE 0x02 /* pipe (not truncatable) */
+#define ISTAPE 0x04 /* tape (not seekable) */
+#define NOREAD 0x08 /* not readable */
+ u_int flags;
+
+ char *name; /* name */
+ int fd; /* file descriptor */
+ u_long offset; /* # of blocks to skip */
+
+ u_long f_stats; /* # of full blocks processed */
+ u_long p_stats; /* # of partial blocks processed */
+ u_long s_stats; /* # of odd swab blocks */
+ u_long t_stats; /* # of truncations */
+} IO;
+
+typedef struct {
+ u_long in_full; /* # of full input blocks */
+ u_long in_part; /* # of partial input blocks */
+ u_long out_full; /* # of full output blocks */
+ u_long out_part; /* # of partial output blocks */
+ u_long trunc; /* # of truncated records */
+ u_long swab; /* # of odd-length swab blocks */
+ u_long bytes; /* # of bytes written */
+ time_t start; /* start time of dd */
+} STAT;
+
+/* Flags (in ddflags). */
+#define C_ASCII 0x00001
+#define C_BLOCK 0x00002
+#define C_BS 0x00004
+#define C_CBS 0x00008
+#define C_COUNT 0x00010
+#define C_EBCDIC 0x00020
+#define C_FILES 0x00040
+#define C_IBS 0x00080
+#define C_IF 0x00100
+#define C_LCASE 0x00200
+#define C_NOERROR 0x00400
+#define C_NOTRUNC 0x00800
+#define C_OBS 0x01000
+#define C_OF 0x02000
+#define C_SEEK 0x04000
+#define C_SKIP 0x08000
+#define C_SWAB 0x10000
+#define C_SYNC 0x20000
+#define C_UCASE 0x40000
+#define C_UNBLOCK 0x80000
+#define C_OSYNC 0x100000
diff --git a/bin/dd/extern.h b/bin/dd/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e8fde63
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94
+ */
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+
+void block __P((void));
+void block_close __P((void));
+void dd_out __P((int));
+void def __P((void));
+void def_close __P((void));
+void jcl __P((char **));
+void pos_in __P((void));
+void pos_out __P((void));
+void summary __P((void));
+void summaryx __P((int));
+void terminate __P((int));
+void unblock __P((void));
+void unblock_close __P((void));
+
+extern IO in, out;
+extern STAT st;
+extern void (*cfunc)();
+extern u_long cpy_cnt;
+extern u_int cbsz;
+extern u_int ddflags;
+extern u_int files_cnt;
+extern u_char *ctab;
+extern u_char a2e_32V[], a2e_POSIX[], a2ibm_32V[], a2ibm_POSIX[], e2a_32V[];
+extern u_char e2a_POSIX[], l2u[], u2l[];
diff --git a/bin/dd/misc.c b/bin/dd/misc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..db90352
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/misc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,100 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)misc.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <time.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "dd.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+void
+summary()
+{
+ time_t secs;
+ char buf[100];
+
+ (void)time(&secs);
+ if ((secs -= st.start) == 0)
+ secs = 1;
+ /* Use snprintf(3) so that we don't reenter stdio(3). */
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf),
+ "%u+%u records in\n%u+%u records out\n",
+ st.in_full, st.in_part, st.out_full, st.out_part);
+ (void)write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, strlen(buf));
+ if (st.swab) {
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%u odd length swab %s\n",
+ st.swab, (st.swab == 1) ? "block" : "blocks");
+ (void)write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, strlen(buf));
+ }
+ if (st.trunc) {
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%u truncated %s\n",
+ st.trunc, (st.trunc == 1) ? "block" : "blocks");
+ (void)write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, strlen(buf));
+ }
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf),
+ "%u bytes transferred in %u secs (%u bytes/sec)\n",
+ st.bytes, secs, st.bytes / secs);
+ (void)write(STDERR_FILENO, buf, strlen(buf));
+}
+
+/* ARGSUSED */
+void
+summaryx(notused)
+ int notused;
+{
+
+ summary();
+}
+
+/* ARGSUSED */
+void
+terminate(notused)
+ int notused;
+{
+
+ exit(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/dd/position.c b/bin/dd/position.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9375b1e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/dd/position.c
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego and Lance
+ * Visser of Convex Computer Corporation.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)position.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/mtio.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "dd.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Position input/output data streams before starting the copy. Device type
+ * dependent. Seekable devices use lseek, and the rest position by reading.
+ * Seeking past the end of file can cause null blocks to be written to the
+ * output.
+ */
+void
+pos_in()
+{
+ int bcnt, cnt, nr, warned;
+
+ /* If not a character, pipe or tape device, try to seek on it. */
+ if (!(in.flags & (ISCHR|ISPIPE|ISTAPE))) {
+ if (lseek(in.fd, (off_t)(in.offset * in.dbsz), SEEK_CUR) == -1)
+ err(1, "%s", in.name);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Read the data. If a pipe, read until satisfy the number of bytes
+ * being skipped. No differentiation for reading complete and partial
+ * blocks for other devices.
+ */
+ for (bcnt = in.dbsz, cnt = in.offset, warned = 0; cnt;) {
+ if ((nr = read(in.fd, in.db, bcnt)) > 0) {
+ if (in.flags & ISPIPE) {
+ if (!(bcnt -= nr)) {
+ bcnt = in.dbsz;
+ --cnt;
+ }
+ } else
+ --cnt;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (nr == 0) {
+ if (files_cnt > 1) {
+ --files_cnt;
+ continue;
+ }
+ errx(1, "skip reached end of input");
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Input error -- either EOF with no more files, or I/O error.
+ * If noerror not set die. POSIX requires that the warning
+ * message be followed by an I/O display.
+ */
+ if (ddflags & C_NOERROR) {
+ if (!warned) {
+ warn("%s", in.name);
+ warned = 1;
+ summary();
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+ err(1, "%s", in.name);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+pos_out()
+{
+ struct mtop t_op;
+ int cnt, n;
+
+ /*
+ * If not a tape, try seeking on the file. Seeking on a pipe is
+ * going to fail, but don't protect the user -- they shouldn't
+ * have specified the seek operand.
+ */
+ if (!(out.flags & ISTAPE)) {
+ if (lseek(out.fd,
+ (off_t)out.offset * out.dbsz, SEEK_SET) == -1)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* If no read access, try using mtio. */
+ if (out.flags & NOREAD) {
+ t_op.mt_op = MTFSR;
+ t_op.mt_count = out.offset;
+
+ if (ioctl(out.fd, MTIOCTOP, &t_op) < 0)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* Read it. */
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < out.offset; ++cnt) {
+ if ((n = read(out.fd, out.db, out.dbsz)) > 0)
+ continue;
+
+ if (n < 0)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+
+ /*
+ * If reach EOF, fill with NUL characters; first, back up over
+ * the EOF mark. Note, cnt has not yet been incremented, so
+ * the EOF read does not count as a seek'd block.
+ */
+ t_op.mt_op = MTBSR;
+ t_op.mt_count = 1;
+ if (ioctl(out.fd, MTIOCTOP, &t_op) == -1)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+
+ while (cnt++ < out.offset)
+ if ((n = write(out.fd, out.db, out.dbsz)) != out.dbsz)
+ err(1, "%s", out.name);
+ break;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/df/Makefile b/bin/df/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e3f54d7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/df/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,7 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/1/94
+
+PROG= df
+BINGRP= operator
+BINMODE=2555
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/df/df.1 b/bin/df/df.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bf461d6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/df/df.1
@@ -0,0 +1,116 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)df.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 1/13/94
+.\"
+.Dd January 13, 1994
+.Dt DF 1
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm df
+.Nd display free disk space
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm df
+.Op Fl in
+.Op Fl t Ar type
+.Op Ar file | Ar filesystem ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Df
+displays statistics about the amount of free disk space on the specified
+.Ar filesystem
+or on the filesystem of which
+.Ar file
+is a part.
+Values are displayed in 512-byte per block block counts.
+If neither a file or a filesystem operand is specified,
+statistics for all mounted filesystems are displayed
+(subject to the
+.Fl t
+option below).
+.Pp
+The following options are available:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Fl i
+Include statistics on the number of free inodes.
+.It Fl n
+Print out the previously obtained statistics from the filesystems.
+This option should be used if it is possible that one or more
+filesystems are in a state such that they will not be able to provide
+statistics without a long delay.
+When this option is specified,
+.Nm df
+will not request new statistics from the filesystems, but will respond
+with the possibly stale statistics that were previously obtained.
+.It Fl t
+Only print out statistics for filesystems of the specified types.
+The recognized types are:
+ufs, nfs, mfs, lfs, msdos, fdesc, portal, kernfs, procfs, afs and isofs.
+along with the aggregates:
+all (the default),
+local (ufs, mfs, lfs, msdos, isofs),
+and misc (fdesc, portal, kernfs, procfs).
+The string ``no'' may be prepending to a type to get its complement
+(e.g. ``nonfs'' to get non-NFS filesystems). The first
+.Fl t
+option overrides the default, additional such options will add to
+(or subtract from) the current set of types; e.g. either
+``df -t ufs -t lfs''
+or
+``df -t local -t nomfs''
+will display statistics for UFS and LFS filesystems.
+.El
+.Sh ENVIRONMENTAL VARIABLES
+.Bl -tag -width BLOCKSIZE
+.It Ev BLOCKSIZE
+If the environmental variable
+.Ev BLOCKSIZE
+is set, the block counts will be displayed in units of that size block.
+.El
+.Sh BUGS
+The
+.Fl n
+and
+.Fl t
+flags are ignored if a file or filesystem is specified.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr quota 1 ,
+.Xr statfs 2 ,
+.Xr fstatfs 2 ,
+.Xr getfsstat 2 ,
+.Xr getmntinfo 3 ,
+.Xr fstab 5 ,
+.Xr mount 8 ,
+.Xr quot 8
+.Sh HISTORY
+A
+.Nm df
+command appeared in
+.At v6 .
diff --git a/bin/df/df.c b/bin/df/df.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..eb6ee81
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/df/df.c
@@ -0,0 +1,420 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ * (c) UNIX System Laboratories, Inc.
+ * All or some portions of this file are derived from material licensed
+ * to the University of California by American Telephone and Telegraph
+ * Co. or Unix System Laboratories, Inc. and are reproduced herein with
+ * the permission of UNIX System Laboratories, Inc.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)df.c 8.7 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/mount.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+/* XXX assumes MOUNT_MAXTYPE < 32 */
+#define MT(m) (1 << (m))
+
+/* fixed values */
+#define MT_NONE (0)
+#define MT_ALL (MT(MOUNT_MAXTYPE+1)-1)
+
+/* subject to change */
+#define MT_LOCAL \
+ (MT(MOUNT_UFS)|MT(MOUNT_MFS)|MT(MOUNT_LFS)|MT(MOUNT_MSDOS)|MT(MOUNT_CD9660))
+#define MT_DEFAULT MT_ALL
+
+struct typetab {
+ char *str;
+ long types;
+} typetab[] = {
+ "ufs", MT(MOUNT_UFS),
+ "local", MT_LOCAL,
+ "all", MT_ALL,
+ "nfs", MT(MOUNT_NFS),
+ "mfs", MT(MOUNT_MFS),
+ "lfs", MT(MOUNT_LFS),
+ "msdos", MT(MOUNT_MSDOS),
+ "fdesc", MT(MOUNT_FDESC),
+ "portal", MT(MOUNT_PORTAL),
+#if 0
+ /* return fsid of underlying FS */
+ "lofs", MT(MOUNT_LOFS),
+ "null", MT(MOUNT_NULL),
+ "umap", MT(MOUNT_UMAP),
+#endif
+ "kernfs", MT(MOUNT_KERNFS),
+ "procfs", MT(MOUNT_PROCFS),
+ "afs", MT(MOUNT_AFS),
+ "iso9660fs", MT(MOUNT_CD9660),
+ "cdfs", MT(MOUNT_CD9660),
+ "misc", MT(MOUNT_LOFS)|MT(MOUNT_FDESC)|MT(MOUNT_PORTAL)|
+ MT(MOUNT_KERNFS)|MT(MOUNT_PROCFS),
+ NULL, 0
+};
+
+long addtype __P((long, char *));
+long regetmntinfo __P((struct statfs **, long, long));
+int bread __P((off_t, void *, int));
+char *getmntpt __P((char *));
+void prtstat __P((struct statfs *, int));
+void ufs_df __P((char *, int));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int iflag, nflag, tflag;
+struct ufs_args mdev;
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct stat stbuf;
+ struct statfs statfsbuf, *mntbuf;
+ long fsmask, mntsize;
+ int ch, err, i, maxwidth, width;
+ char *mntpt;
+
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "int:")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'i':
+ iflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ nflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ fsmask = addtype(fsmask, optarg);
+ tflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ mntsize = getmntinfo(&mntbuf, MNT_NOWAIT);
+ maxwidth = 0;
+ for (i = 0; i < mntsize; i++) {
+ width = strlen(mntbuf[i].f_mntfromname);
+ if (width > maxwidth)
+ maxwidth = width;
+ }
+
+ if (!*argv) {
+ if (!tflag)
+ fsmask = MT_DEFAULT;
+ mntsize = regetmntinfo(&mntbuf, mntsize, fsmask);
+ if (fsmask != MT_ALL) {
+ maxwidth = 0;
+ for (i = 0; i < mntsize; i++) {
+ width = strlen(mntbuf[i].f_mntfromname);
+ if (width > maxwidth)
+ maxwidth = width;
+ }
+ }
+ for (i = 0; i < mntsize; i++)
+ prtstat(&mntbuf[i], maxwidth);
+ exit(0);
+ }
+
+ for (; *argv; argv++) {
+ if (stat(*argv, &stbuf) < 0) {
+ err = errno;
+ if ((mntpt = getmntpt(*argv)) == 0) {
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if ((stbuf.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFCHR) {
+ ufs_df(*argv, maxwidth);
+ continue;
+ } else if ((stbuf.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFBLK) {
+ if ((mntpt = getmntpt(*argv)) == 0) {
+ mntpt = mktemp(strdup("/tmp/df.XXXXXX"));
+ mdev.fspec = *argv;
+ if (mkdir(mntpt, DEFFILEMODE) != 0) {
+ warn("%s", mntpt);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (mount(MOUNT_UFS, mntpt, MNT_RDONLY,
+ &mdev) != 0) {
+ ufs_df(*argv, maxwidth);
+ (void)rmdir(mntpt);
+ continue;
+ } else if (statfs(mntpt, &statfsbuf)) {
+ statfsbuf.f_mntonname[0] = '\0';
+ prtstat(&statfsbuf, maxwidth);
+ } else
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ (void)unmount(mntpt, 0);
+ (void)rmdir(mntpt);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else
+ mntpt = *argv;
+ /*
+ * Statfs does not take a `wait' flag, so we cannot
+ * implement nflag here.
+ */
+ if (statfs(mntpt, &statfsbuf) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", mntpt);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (argc == 1)
+ maxwidth = strlen(statfsbuf.f_mntfromname) + 1;
+ prtstat(&statfsbuf, maxwidth);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+char *
+getmntpt(name)
+ char *name;
+{
+ long mntsize, i;
+ struct statfs *mntbuf;
+
+ mntsize = getmntinfo(&mntbuf, MNT_NOWAIT);
+ for (i = 0; i < mntsize; i++) {
+ if (!strcmp(mntbuf[i].f_mntfromname, name))
+ return (mntbuf[i].f_mntonname);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+long
+addtype(omask, str)
+ long omask;
+ char *str;
+{
+ struct typetab *tp;
+
+ /*
+ * If it is one of our known types, add it to the current mask
+ */
+ for (tp = typetab; tp->str; tp++)
+ if (strcmp(str, tp->str) == 0)
+ return (tp->types | (tflag ? omask : MT_NONE));
+ /*
+ * See if it is the negation of one of the known values
+ */
+ if (strlen(str) > 2 && str[0] == 'n' && str[1] == 'o')
+ for (tp = typetab; tp->str; tp++)
+ if (strcmp(str+2, tp->str) == 0)
+ return (~tp->types & (tflag ? omask : MT_ALL));
+ errx(1, "unknown type `%s'", str);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Make a pass over the filesystem info in ``mntbuf'' filtering out
+ * filesystem types not in ``fsmask'' and possibly re-stating to get
+ * current (not cached) info. Returns the new count of valid statfs bufs.
+ */
+long
+regetmntinfo(mntbufp, mntsize, fsmask)
+ struct statfs **mntbufp;
+ long mntsize, fsmask;
+{
+ int i, j;
+ struct statfs *mntbuf;
+
+ if (fsmask == MT_ALL)
+ return (nflag ? mntsize : getmntinfo(mntbufp, MNT_WAIT));
+
+ mntbuf = *mntbufp;
+ j = 0;
+ for (i = 0; i < mntsize; i++) {
+ if (fsmask & MT(mntbuf[i].f_type)) {
+ if (!nflag)
+ (void)statfs(mntbuf[i].f_mntonname,&mntbuf[j]);
+ else if (i != j)
+ mntbuf[j] = mntbuf[i];
+ j++;
+ }
+ }
+ return (j);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Convert statfs returned filesystem size into BLOCKSIZE units.
+ * Attempts to avoid overflow for large filesystems.
+ */
+#define fsbtoblk(num, fsbs, bs) \
+ (((fsbs) != 0 && (fsbs) < (bs)) ? \
+ (num) / ((bs) / (fsbs)) : (num) * ((fsbs) / (bs)))
+
+/*
+ * Print out status about a filesystem.
+ */
+void
+prtstat(sfsp, maxwidth)
+ struct statfs *sfsp;
+ int maxwidth;
+{
+ static long blocksize;
+ static int headerlen, timesthrough;
+ static char *header;
+ long used, availblks, inodes;
+
+ if (maxwidth < 11)
+ maxwidth = 11;
+ if (++timesthrough == 1) {
+ header = getbsize(&headerlen, &blocksize);
+ (void)printf("%-*.*s %s Used Avail Capacity",
+ maxwidth, maxwidth, "Filesystem", header);
+ if (iflag)
+ (void)printf(" iused ifree %%iused");
+ (void)printf(" Mounted on\n");
+ }
+ (void)printf("%-*.*s", maxwidth, maxwidth, sfsp->f_mntfromname);
+ used = sfsp->f_blocks - sfsp->f_bfree;
+ availblks = sfsp->f_bavail + used;
+ (void)printf(" %*ld %8ld %8ld", headerlen,
+ fsbtoblk(sfsp->f_blocks, sfsp->f_bsize, blocksize),
+ fsbtoblk(used, sfsp->f_bsize, blocksize),
+ fsbtoblk(sfsp->f_bavail, sfsp->f_bsize, blocksize));
+ (void)printf(" %5.0f%%",
+ availblks == 0 ? 100.0 : (double)used / (double)availblks * 100.0);
+ if (iflag) {
+ inodes = sfsp->f_files;
+ used = inodes - sfsp->f_ffree;
+ (void)printf(" %7ld %7ld %5.0f%% ", used, sfsp->f_ffree,
+ inodes == 0 ? 100.0 : (double)used / (double)inodes * 100.0);
+ } else
+ (void)printf(" ");
+ (void)printf(" %s\n", sfsp->f_mntonname);
+}
+
+/*
+ * This code constitutes the pre-system call Berkeley df code for extracting
+ * information from filesystem superblocks.
+ */
+#include <ufs/ffs/fs.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fstab.h>
+
+union {
+ struct fs iu_fs;
+ char dummy[SBSIZE];
+} sb;
+#define sblock sb.iu_fs
+
+int rfd;
+
+void
+ufs_df(file, maxwidth)
+ char *file;
+ int maxwidth;
+{
+ struct statfs statfsbuf;
+ struct statfs *sfsp;
+ char *mntpt;
+ static int synced;
+
+ if (synced++ == 0)
+ sync();
+
+ if ((rfd = open(file, O_RDONLY)) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", file);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (bread((off_t)SBOFF, &sblock, SBSIZE) == 0) {
+ (void)close(rfd);
+ return;
+ }
+ sfsp = &statfsbuf;
+ sfsp->f_type = MOUNT_UFS;
+ sfsp->f_flags = 0;
+ sfsp->f_bsize = sblock.fs_fsize;
+ sfsp->f_iosize = sblock.fs_bsize;
+ sfsp->f_blocks = sblock.fs_dsize;
+ sfsp->f_bfree = sblock.fs_cstotal.cs_nbfree * sblock.fs_frag +
+ sblock.fs_cstotal.cs_nffree;
+ sfsp->f_bavail = (sblock.fs_dsize * (100 - sblock.fs_minfree) / 100) -
+ (sblock.fs_dsize - sfsp->f_bfree);
+ if (sfsp->f_bavail < 0)
+ sfsp->f_bavail = 0;
+ sfsp->f_files = sblock.fs_ncg * sblock.fs_ipg;
+ sfsp->f_ffree = sblock.fs_cstotal.cs_nifree;
+ sfsp->f_fsid.val[0] = 0;
+ sfsp->f_fsid.val[1] = 0;
+ if ((mntpt = getmntpt(file)) == 0)
+ mntpt = "";
+ memmove(&sfsp->f_mntonname[0], mntpt, MNAMELEN);
+ memmove(&sfsp->f_mntfromname[0], file, MNAMELEN);
+ prtstat(sfsp, maxwidth);
+ (void)close(rfd);
+}
+
+int
+bread(off, buf, cnt)
+ off_t off;
+ void *buf;
+ int cnt;
+{
+ int nr;
+
+ (void)lseek(rfd, off, SEEK_SET);
+ if ((nr = read(rfd, buf, cnt)) != cnt) {
+ /* Probably a dismounted disk if errno == EIO. */
+ if (errno != EIO)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "\ndf: %qd: %s\n",
+ off, strerror(nr > 0 ? EIO : errno));
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (1);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: df [-in] [file | file_system ...]\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/echo/Makefile b/bin/echo/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..05caa3b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/echo/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= echo
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/echo/echo.1 b/bin/echo/echo.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dc86b7c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/echo/echo.1
@@ -0,0 +1,70 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)echo.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 7/22/93
+.\"
+.Dd July 22, 1993
+.Dt ECHO 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm echo
+.Nd write arguments to the standard output
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm echo
+.Op Fl n
+.Op "string ..."
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm echo
+utility writes any specified operands, separated by single blank (`` '')
+characters and followed by a newline (``\en'') character, to the standard
+output.
+.Pp
+The following option is available:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl n
+Do not print the trailing newline character.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm echo
+utility exits 0 on success, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr printf 1
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm echo
+utility is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/echo/echo.c b/bin/echo/echo.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..560e10a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/echo/echo.c
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1989, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)echo.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int nflag;
+
+ /* This utility may NOT do getopt(3) option parsing. */
+ if (*++argv && !strcmp(*argv, "-n")) {
+ ++argv;
+ nflag = 1;
+ }
+ else
+ nflag = 0;
+
+ while (*argv) {
+ (void)printf("%s", *argv);
+ if (*++argv)
+ putchar(' ');
+ }
+ if (!nflag)
+ putchar('\n');
+ exit(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/hostname/Makefile b/bin/hostname/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d16477e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/hostname/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= hostname
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/hostname/hostname.1 b/bin/hostname/hostname.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..98bcb7e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/hostname/hostname.1
@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1983, 1988, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)hostname.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt HOSTNAME 1
+.Os BSD 4.2
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm hostname
+.Nd set or print name of current host system
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm hostname
+.Op Fl s
+.Op Ar nameofhost
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Hostname
+prints the name of the current host. The super-user can
+set the hostname by supplying an argument; this is usually done in the
+network initialization script
+.Pa /etc/netstart ,
+normally run at boot
+time.
+.Pp
+Options:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl s
+Trims off any domain information from the printed
+name.
+.El
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr gethostname 2
+.Sh HISTORY
+The
+.Nm hostname
+command appeared in
+.Bx 4.2 .
diff --git a/bin/hostname/hostname.c b/bin/hostname/hostname.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..afee46a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/hostname/hostname.c
@@ -0,0 +1,87 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1988, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)hostname.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+int
+main(argc,argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ extern int optind;
+ int ch, sflag;
+ char *p, hostname[MAXHOSTNAMELEN];
+
+ sflag = 0;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "s")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 's':
+ sflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage: hostname [-s] [hostname]\n");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (*argv) {
+ if (sethostname(*argv, strlen(*argv)))
+ err(1, "sethostname");
+ } else {
+ if (gethostname(hostname, sizeof(hostname)))
+ err(1, "gethostname");
+ if (sflag && (p = strchr(hostname, '.')))
+ *p = '\0';
+ (void)printf("%s\n", hostname);
+ }
+ exit(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/kill/Makefile b/bin/kill/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0cea87a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/kill/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= kill
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/kill/kill.1 b/bin/kill/kill.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bffef49
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/kill/kill.1
@@ -0,0 +1,120 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)kill.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt KILL 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm kill
+.Nd terminate or signal a process
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm kill
+.Op Fl signal_name
+.Ar pid
+\&...
+.Nm kill
+.Op Fl signal_number
+.Ar pid
+\&...
+.Nm kill
+.Op Fl l
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The kill utility sends the
+.Dv TERM
+signal to the processes specified
+by the pid operand(s).
+.Pp
+Only the super-user may send signals to other users' processes.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Fl l
+List the signal names.
+.It Fl signal_name
+A symbolic signal name specifying the signal to be sent instead of the
+default
+.Dv TERM .
+The
+.Fl l
+option displays the signal names.
+.It Fl signal_number
+A non-negative decimal integer, specifying the signal to be sent instead
+of the default
+.Dv TERM .
+.El
+.Pp
+Some of the more commonly used signals:
+.Bd -ragged -offset indent -compact
+.Bl -column XXX TERM
+.It -1 -1 (super-user broadcast to all processes, or user broadcast
+to user's processes)
+.It 0 0 (sh(1) only, signals all members of process group)
+.It 2 INT (interrupt)
+.It 3 QUIT (quit)
+.It 6 ABRT (abort)
+.It 9 KILL (non-catchable, non-ignorable kill)
+.It 14 ALRM (alarm clock)
+.It 15 TERM (software termination signal)
+.El
+.Ed
+.Pp
+.Nm Kill
+is a built-in to
+.Xr csh 1 ;
+it allows job specifiers of the form ``%...'' as arguments
+so process id's are not as often used as
+.Nm kill
+arguments.
+See
+.Xr csh 1
+for details.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr csh 1 ,
+.Xr ps 1 ,
+.Xr kill 2 ,
+.Xr sigvec 2
+.Sh HISTORY
+A
+.Nm kill
+command appeared in
+.At v6 .
+.Sh BUGS
+A replacement for the command
+.Dq Li kill 0
+for
+.Xr csh 1
+users should be provided.
diff --git a/bin/kill/kill.c b/bin/kill/kill.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..00daeaf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/kill/kill.c
@@ -0,0 +1,144 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1988, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)kill.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+void nosig __P((char *));
+void printsig __P((FILE *));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ const char *const *p;
+ int errors, numsig, pid;
+ char *ep;
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ usage();
+
+ if (!strcmp(*++argv, "-l")) {
+ printsig(stdout);
+ exit(0);
+ }
+
+ numsig = SIGTERM;
+ if (**argv == '-') {
+ ++*argv;
+ if (isalpha(**argv)) {
+ if (!strncasecmp(*argv, "sig", 3))
+ *argv += 3;
+ for (numsig = NSIG, p = sys_signame + 1; --numsig; ++p)
+ if (!strcasecmp(*p, *argv)) {
+ numsig = p - sys_signame;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (!numsig)
+ nosig(*argv);
+ } else if (isdigit(**argv)) {
+ numsig = strtol(*argv, &ep, 10);
+ if (!*argv || *ep)
+ errx(1, "illegal signal number: %s", *argv);
+ if (numsig <= 0 || numsig > NSIG)
+ nosig(*argv);
+ } else
+ nosig(*argv);
+ ++argv;
+ }
+
+ if (!*argv)
+ usage();
+
+ for (errors = 0; *argv; ++argv) {
+ pid = strtol(*argv, &ep, 10);
+ if (!*argv || *ep) {
+ warnx("illegal process id: %s", *argv);
+ errors = 1;
+ } else if (kill(pid, numsig) == -1) {
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ errors = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ exit(errors);
+}
+
+void
+nosig(name)
+ char *name;
+{
+
+ warnx("unknown signal %s; valid signals:", name);
+ printsig(stderr);
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+void
+printsig(fp)
+ FILE *fp;
+{
+ const char *const *p;
+ int cnt;
+
+ for (cnt = NSIG, p = sys_signame + 1; --cnt; ++p) {
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "%s ", *p);
+ if (cnt == NSIG / 2)
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "\n");
+ }
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "\n");
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: kill [-l] [-sig] pid ...\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ln/Makefile b/bin/ln/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b1929c6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ln/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,7 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.2 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= ln
+MAN1= ln.0
+MAN7= symlink.0
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/ln/ln.1 b/bin/ln/ln.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fd85a6b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ln/ln.1
@@ -0,0 +1,131 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)ln.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 12/30/93
+.\"
+.Dd December 30, 1993
+.Dt LN 1
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm ln
+.Nd make links
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm ln
+.Op Fl fs
+.Ar source_file
+.Op target_file
+.Nm ln
+.Op Fl fs
+.Ar source_file ...
+.Op target_dir
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm ln
+utility creates a new directory entry (linked file) which has the
+same modes as the original file.
+It is useful for maintaining multiple copies of a file in many places
+at once without using up storage for the
+.Dq copies ;
+instead, a link
+.Dq points
+to the original copy.
+There are two types of links; hard links and symbolic links.
+How a link
+.Dq points
+to a file is one of the differences between a hard or symbolic link.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl f
+Unlink any already existing file, permitting the link to occur.
+.It Fl s
+Create a symbolic link.
+.El
+.Pp
+By default
+.Nm ln
+makes
+.Em hard
+links.
+A hard link to a file is indistinguishable from the original directory entry;
+any changes to a file are effective independent of the name used to reference
+the file.
+Hard links may not normally refer to directories and may not span file systems.
+.Pp
+A symbolic link contains the name of the file to
+which it is linked. The referenced file is used when an
+.Xr open 2
+operation is performed on the link.
+A
+.Xr stat 2
+on a symbolic link will return the linked-to file; an
+.Xr lstat 2
+must be done to obtain information about the link.
+The
+.Xr readlink 2
+call may be used to read the contents of a symbolic link.
+Symbolic links may span file systems and may refer to directories.
+.Pp
+Given one or two arguments,
+.Nm ln
+creates a link to an existing file
+.Ar source_file .
+If
+.Ar target_file
+is given, the link has that name;
+.Ar target_file
+may also be a directory in which to place the link;
+otherwise it is placed in the current directory.
+If only the directory is specified, the link will be made
+to the last component of
+.Ar source_file .
+.Pp
+Given more than two arguments,
+.Nm ln
+makes links in
+.Ar target_dir
+to all the named source files.
+The links made will have the same name as the files being linked to.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr link 2 ,
+.Xr lstat 2 ,
+.Xr readlink 2 ,
+.Xr stat 2 ,
+.Xr symlink 2 ,
+.Xr symlink 7
+.Sh HISTORY
+A
+.Nm ln
+command appeared in
+.At v6 .
diff --git a/bin/ln/ln.c b/bin/ln/ln.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b39e710
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ln/ln.c
@@ -0,0 +1,164 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1987, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1987, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)ln.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 3/31/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+int dirflag; /* Undocumented directory flag. */
+int fflag; /* Unlink existing files. */
+int sflag; /* Symbolic, not hard, link. */
+ /* System link call. */
+int (*linkf) __P((const char *, const char *));
+
+int linkit __P((char *, char *, int));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ extern int optind;
+ struct stat sb;
+ int ch, exitval;
+ char *sourcedir;
+
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "Ffs")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'F':
+ dirflag = 1; /* XXX: deliberately undocumented. */
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ fflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ sflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+
+ argv += optind;
+ argc -= optind;
+
+ linkf = sflag ? symlink : link;
+
+ switch(argc) {
+ case 0:
+ usage();
+ case 1: /* ln target */
+ exit(linkit(argv[0], ".", 1));
+ case 2: /* ln target source */
+ exit(linkit(argv[0], argv[1], 0));
+ }
+ /* ln target1 target2 directory */
+ sourcedir = argv[argc - 1];
+ if (stat(sourcedir, &sb))
+ err(1, "%s", sourcedir);
+ if (!S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode))
+ usage();
+ for (exitval = 0; *argv != sourcedir; ++argv)
+ exitval |= linkit(*argv, sourcedir, 1);
+ exit(exitval);
+}
+
+int
+linkit(target, source, isdir)
+ char *target, *source;
+ int isdir;
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+ int exists;
+ char *p, path[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ if (!sflag) {
+ /* If target doesn't exist, quit now. */
+ if (stat(target, &sb)) {
+ warn("%s", target);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ /* Only symbolic links to directories, unless -F option used. */
+ if (!dirflag && (sb.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFDIR) {
+ warnx("%s: is a directory", target);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* If the source is a directory, append the target's name. */
+ if (isdir || (exists = !stat(source, &sb)) && S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) {
+ if ((p = strrchr(target, '/')) == NULL)
+ p = target;
+ else
+ ++p;
+ (void)snprintf(path, sizeof(path), "%s/%s", source, p);
+ source = path;
+ exists = !stat(source, &sb);
+ } else
+ exists = !stat(source, &sb);
+
+ /*
+ * If the file exists, and -f was specified, unlink it.
+ * Attempt the link.
+ */
+ if (fflag && exists && unlink(source) || (*linkf)(target, source)) {
+ warn("%s", source);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage:\tln [-fs] file1 file2\n\tln [-fs] file ... directory\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ln/symlink.7 b/bin/ln/symlink.7
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0f4887d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ln/symlink.7
@@ -0,0 +1,432 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1992, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)symlink.7 8.3 (Berkeley) 3/31/94
+.\"
+.Dd March 31, 1994
+.Dt SYMLINK 7
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm symlink
+.Nd symbolic link handling
+.Sh SYMBOLIC LINK HANDLING
+Symbolic links are files that act as pointers to other files.
+To understand their behavior, you must first understand how hard links
+work.
+A hard link to a file is indistinguishable from the original file because
+it is a reference to the object underlying the original file name.
+Changes to a file are independent of the name used to reference the
+file.
+Hard links may not refer to directories and may not reference files
+on different file systems.
+A symbolic link contains the name of the file to which it is linked,
+i.e. it is a pointer to another name, and not to an underlying object.
+For this reason, symbolic links may reference directories and may span
+file systems.
+.Pp
+Because a symbolic link and its referenced object coexist in the filesystem
+name space, confusion can arise in distinguishing between the link itself
+and the referenced object.
+Historically, commands and system calls have adopted their own link
+following conventions in a somewhat ad-hoc fashion.
+Rules for more a uniform approach, as they are implemented in this system,
+are outlined here.
+It is important that local applications conform to these rules, too,
+so that the user interface can be as consistent as possible.
+.Pp
+Symbolic links are handled either by operating on the link itself,
+or by operating on the object referenced by the link.
+In the latter case,
+an application or system call is said to
+.Dq follow
+the link.
+Symbolic links may reference other symbolic links,
+in which case the links are dereferenced until an object that is
+not a symbolic link is found,
+a symbolic link which references a file which doesn't exist is found,
+or a loop is detected.
+(Loop detection is done by placing an upper limit on the number of
+links that may be followed, and an error results if this limit is
+exceeded.)
+.Pp
+There are three separate areas that need to be discussed.
+They are as follows:
+.sp
+.Bl -enum -compact -offset indent
+.It
+Symbolic links used as file name arguments for system calls.
+.It
+Symbolic links specified as command line arguments to utilities that
+are not traversing a file tree.
+.It
+Symbolic links encountered by utilities that are traversing a file tree
+(either specified on the command line or encountered as part of the
+file hierarchy walk).
+.El
+.Ss System calls.
+The first area is symbolic links used as file name arguments for
+system calls.
+.Pp
+Except as noted below, all system calls follow symbolic links.
+For example, if there were a symbolic link
+.Dq Li slink
+which pointed to a file named
+.Dq Li afile ,
+the system call
+.Dq Li open("slink" ...)
+would return a file descriptor to the file
+.Dq afile .
+.Pp
+There are four system calls that do not follow links, and which operate
+on the symbolic link itself.
+They are:
+.Xr lstat 2 ,
+.Xr readlink 2 ,
+.Xr rename 2 ,
+and
+.Xr unlink 2 .
+Because
+.Xr remove 3
+is an alias for
+.Xr unlink 2 ,
+it also does not follow symbolic links.
+.Pp
+Unlike other filesystem objects, symbolic links do not have an owner,
+group, permissions, access and modification times, etc.
+The only attributes returned from an
+.Xr lstat 2
+that refer to the symbolic link itself are the file type (S_IFLNK),
+size, blocks, and link count (always 1).
+The other attributes are filled in from the directory that contains
+the link.
+For portability reasons, you should be aware that other implementations
+(including historic implementations of 4BSD), implement symbolic links
+such that they have the same attributes as any other file.
+.Pp
+The
+.Bx 4.4
+system differs from historical 4BSD systems in that the system call
+.Xr chown 2
+has been changed to follow symbolic links.
+.Ss Commands not traversing a file tree.
+The second area is symbolic links, specified as command line file
+name arguments, to commands which are not traversing a file tree.
+.Pp
+Except as noted below, commands follow symbolic links named as command
+line arguments.
+For example, if there were a symbolic link
+.Dq Li slink
+which pointed to a file named
+.Dq Li afile ,
+the command
+.Dq Li cat slink
+would display the contents of the file
+.Dq Li afile .
+.Pp
+It is important to realize that this rule includes commands which may
+optionally traverse file trees, e.g. the command
+.Dq Li "chown file"
+is included in this rule, while the command
+.Dq Li "chown -R file"
+is not.
+(The latter is described in the third area, below.)
+.Pp
+If it is explicitly intended that the command operate on the symbolic
+link instead of following the symbolic link, e.g., it is desired that
+.Dq Li "file slink"
+display the type of file that
+.Dq Li slink
+is, whether it is a symbolic link or not, the
+.Fl h
+option should be used.
+In the above example,
+.Dq Li "file slink"
+would report the type of the file referenced by
+.Dq Li slink ,
+while
+.Dq Li "file -h slink"
+would report that
+.Dq Li slink
+was a symbolic link.
+.Pp
+There are three exceptions to this rule.
+The
+.Xr mv 1
+and
+.Xr rm 1
+commands do not follow symbolic links named as arguments,
+but respectively attempt to rename and delete them.
+(Note, if the symbolic link references a file via a relative path,
+moving it to another directory may very well cause it to stop working,
+since the path may no longer be correct.)
+.Pp
+The
+.Xr ls 1
+command is also an exception to this rule.
+For compatibility with historic systems (when
+.Nm ls
+is not doing a tree walk, i.e. the
+.Fl R
+option is not specified),
+the
+.Nm ls
+command follows symbolic links named as arguments if the
+.Fl L
+option is specified,
+or if the
+.Fl F ,
+.Fl d
+or
+.Fl l
+options are not specified.
+(If the
+.Fl L
+option is specified,
+.Nm ls
+always follows symbolic links.
+.Nm Ls
+is the only command where the
+.Fl L
+option affects its behavior even though it is not doing a walk of
+a file tree.)
+.Pp
+The
+.Bx 4.4
+system differs from historical 4BSD systems in that the
+.Nm chown ,
+.Nm chgrp
+and
+.Nm file
+commands follow symbolic links specified on the command line.
+.Ss Commands traversing a file tree.
+The following commands either optionally or always traverse file trees:
+.Xr chflags 1 ,
+.Xr chgrp 1 ,
+.Xr chmod 1 ,
+.Xr cp 1 ,
+.Xr du 1 ,
+.Xr find 1 ,
+.Xr ls 1 ,
+.Xr pax 1 ,
+.Xr rm 1 ,
+.Xr tar 1
+and
+.Xr chown 8 .
+.Pp
+It is important to realize that the following rules apply equally to
+symbolic links encountered during the file tree traversal and symbolic
+links listed as command line arguments.
+.Pp
+The first rule applies to symbolic links that reference files that are
+not of type directory.
+Operations that apply to symbolic links are performed on the links
+themselves, but otherwise the links are ignored.
+.Pp
+For example, the command
+.Dq Li "chown -R user slink directory"
+will ignore
+.Dq Li slink ,
+because symbolic links in this system do not have owners.
+Any symbolic links encountered during the tree traversal will also be
+ignored.
+The command
+.Dq Li "rm -r slink directory"
+will remove
+.Dq Li slink ,
+as well as any symbolic links encountered in the tree traversal of
+.Dq Li directory ,
+because symbolic links may be removed.
+In no case will either
+.Nm chown
+or
+.Nm rm
+affect the file which
+.Dq Li slink
+references in any way.
+.Pp
+The second rule applies to symbolic links that reference files of type
+directory.
+Symbolic links which reference files of type directory are never
+.Dq followed
+by default.
+This is often referred to as a
+.Dq physical
+walk, as opposed to a
+.Dq logical
+walk (where symbolic links referencing directories are followed).
+.Pp
+As consistently as possible, you can make commands doing a file tree
+walk follow any symbolic links named on the command line, regardless
+of the type of file they reference, by specifying the
+.Fl H
+(for
+.Dq half\-logical )
+flag.
+This flag is intended to make the command line name space look
+like the logical name space.
+(Note, for commands that do not always do file tree traversals, the
+.Fl H
+flag will be ignored if the
+.Fl R
+flag is not also specified.)
+.Pp
+For example, the command
+.Dq Li "chown -HR user slink"
+will traverse the file hierarchy rooted in the file pointed to by
+.Dq Li slink .
+Note, the
+.Fl H
+is not the same as the previously discussed
+.Fl h
+flag.
+The
+.Fl H
+flag causes symbolic links specified on the command line to be
+dereferenced both for the purposes of the action to be performed
+and the tree walk, and it is as if the user had specified the
+name of the file to which the symbolic link pointed.
+.Pp
+As consistently as possible, you can make commands doing a file tree
+walk follow any symbolic links named on the command line, as well as
+any symbolic links encountered during the traversal, regardless of
+the type of file they reference, by specifying the
+.Fl L
+(for
+.Dq logical )
+flag.
+This flag is intended to make the entire name space look like
+the logical name space.
+(Note, for commands that do not always do file tree traversals, the
+.Fl L
+flag will be ignored if the
+.Fl R
+flag is not also specified.)
+.Pp
+For example, the command
+.Dq Li "chown -LR user slink"
+will change the owner of the file referenced by
+.Dq Li slink .
+If
+.Dq Li slink
+references a directory,
+.Nm chown
+will traverse the file hierarchy rooted in the directory that it
+references.
+In addition, if any symbolic links are encountered in any file tree that
+.Nm chown
+traverses, they will be treated in the same fashion as
+.Dq Li slink .
+.Pp
+As consistently as possible, you can specify the default behavior by
+specifying the
+.Fl P
+(for
+.Dq physical )
+flag.
+This flag is intended to make the entire name space look like the
+physical name space.
+.Pp
+For commands that do not by default do file tree traversals, the
+.Fl H ,
+.Fl L
+and
+.Fl P
+flags are ignored if the
+.Fl R
+flag is not also specified.
+In addition, you may specify the
+.Fl H ,
+.Fl L
+and
+.Fl P
+options more than once; the last one specified determines the
+command's behavior.
+This is intended to permit you to alias commands to behave one way
+or the other, and then override that behavior on the command line.
+.Pp
+The
+.Xr ls 1
+and
+.Xr rm 1
+commands have exceptions to these rules.
+The
+.Nm rm
+command operates on the symbolic link, and not the file it references,
+and therefore never follows a symbolic link.
+The
+.Nm rm
+command does not support the
+.Fl H ,
+.Fl L
+or
+.Fl P
+options.
+.Pp
+To maintain compatibility with historic systems,
+the
+.Nm ls
+command never follows symbolic links unless the
+.Fl L
+flag is specified.
+If the
+.Fl L
+flag is specified,
+.Nm ls
+follows all symbolic links,
+regardless of their type,
+whether specified on the command line or encountered in the tree walk.
+The
+.Nm ls
+command does not support the
+.Fl H
+or
+.Fl P
+options.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr chflags 1 ,
+.Xr chgrp 1 ,
+.Xr chmod 1 ,
+.Xr cp 1 ,
+.Xr du 1 ,
+.Xr find 1 ,
+.Xr ln 1 ,
+.Xr ls 1 ,
+.Xr mv 1 ,
+.Xr pax 1 ,
+.Xr rm 1 ,
+.Xr tar 1 ,
+.Xr lstat 2 ,
+.Xr readlink 2 ,
+.Xr rename 2 ,
+.Xr unlink 2 ,
+.Xr fts 3 ,
+.Xr remove 3 ,
+.Xr chown 8
diff --git a/bin/ls/Makefile b/bin/ls/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dd9036b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/2/93
+
+PROG= ls
+SRCS= cmp.c stat_flags.c ls.c print.c util.c
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/ls/cmp.c b/bin/ls/cmp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bad4888
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/cmp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Michael Fischbein.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cmp.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "ls.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+int
+namecmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (strcmp(a->fts_name, b->fts_name));
+}
+
+int
+revnamecmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (strcmp(b->fts_name, a->fts_name));
+}
+
+int
+modcmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (b->fts_statp->st_mtime - a->fts_statp->st_mtime);
+}
+
+int
+revmodcmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (a->fts_statp->st_mtime - b->fts_statp->st_mtime);
+}
+
+int
+acccmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (b->fts_statp->st_atime - a->fts_statp->st_atime);
+}
+
+int
+revacccmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (a->fts_statp->st_atime - b->fts_statp->st_atime);
+}
+
+int
+statcmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (b->fts_statp->st_ctime - a->fts_statp->st_ctime);
+}
+
+int
+revstatcmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT *a, *b;
+{
+ return (a->fts_statp->st_ctime - b->fts_statp->st_ctime);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ls/extern.h b/bin/ls/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f69e4b8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+int acccmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int revacccmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int modcmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int revmodcmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int namecmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int revnamecmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int statcmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+int revstatcmp __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+
+char *flags_to_string __P((u_long, char *));
+void prcopy __P((char *, char *, int));
+void printcol __P((DISPLAY *));
+void printlong __P((DISPLAY *));
+void printscol __P((DISPLAY *));
+void usage __P((void));
diff --git a/bin/ls/ls.1 b/bin/ls/ls.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cb45555
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/ls.1
@@ -0,0 +1,333 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1991, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)ls.1 8.6 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt LS 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm ls
+.Nd list directory contents
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm ls
+.Op Fl ACFLRTacdfiloqrstu1
+.Op Ar file ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+For each operand that names a
+.Ar file
+of a type other than
+directory,
+.Nm ls
+displays its name as well as any requested,
+associated information.
+For each operand that names a
+.Ar file
+of type directory,
+.Nm ls
+displays the names of files contained
+within that directory, as well as any requested, associated
+information.
+.Pp
+If no operands are given, the contents of the current
+directory are displayed.
+If more than one operand is given,
+non-directory operands are displayed first; directory
+and non-directory operands are sorted separately and in
+lexicographical order.
+.Pp
+The following options are available:
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It Fl A
+List all entries except for
+.Ql \&.
+and
+.Ql \&.. .
+Always set for the super-user.
+.It Fl C
+Force multi-column output; this is the default when output is to a terminal.
+.It Fl F
+Display a slash (/) immediately after each pathname
+that is a directory, an asterisk (*) after each that is
+executable,
+and an at sign (@) after each symbolic link.
+.\" and a vertical bar (|) after each that is a
+.\" .Tn FIFO .
+.It Fl L
+If argument is a symbolic link, list the file or directory the link references
+rather than the link itself.
+.It Fl R
+Recursively list subdirectories encountered.
+.It Fl T
+Display complete time information for the file, including
+month, day, hour, minute, second, and year.
+.It Fl a
+Include directory entries whose names begin with a
+dot (.).
+.It Fl c
+Use time when file status was last changed for sorting or printing.
+.It Fl d
+Directories are listed as plain files (not searched recursively) and
+symbolic links in the argument list are not indirected through.
+.It Fl f
+Output is not sorted.
+.It Fl i
+For each file, print the file's file serial number (inode number).
+.It Fl l
+(The lowercase letter ``ell.'') List in long format. (See below.)
+If the output is to a terminal, a total sum for all the file
+sizes is output on a line before the long listing.
+.It Fl o
+Include the file flags in a long
+.Pq Fl l
+output
+.It Fl q
+Force printing of non-graphic characters in file names as
+the character `?'; this is the default when output is to a terminal.
+.It Fl r
+Reverse the order of the sort to get reverse
+lexicographical order or the oldest entries first.
+.It Fl s
+Display the number of file system blocks actually used by each file, in units
+of 512 bytes, where partial units are rounded up to the next integer value.
+If the output is to a terminal, a total sum for all the file
+sizes is output on a line before the listing.
+.It Fl t
+Sort by time modified (most recently modified
+first) before sorting the operands by lexicographical
+order.
+.It Fl u
+Use time of last access,
+instead of last modification
+of the file for sorting
+.Pq Fl t
+or printing
+.Pq Fl l .
+.It Fl \&1
+(The numeric digit ``one.'') Force output to be
+one entry per line.
+This is the default when
+output is not to a terminal.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Fl 1 ,
+.Fl C ,
+and
+.Fl l
+options all override each other; the last one specified determines
+the format used.
+.Pp
+The
+.Fl c ,
+and
+.Fl u
+options override each other; the last one specified determines
+the file time used.
+.Pp
+By default,
+.Nm ls
+lists one entry per line to standard
+output; the exceptions are to terminals or when the
+.Fl C
+option is specified.
+.Pp
+File information is displayed with one or more
+<blank>s separating the information associated with the
+.Fl i ,
+.Fl s ,
+and
+.Fl l
+options.
+.Ss The Long Format
+If the
+.Fl l
+option is given, the following information
+is displayed for each file:
+file mode,
+number of links, owner name, group name,
+number of bytes in the file, abbreviated
+month, day-of-month file was last modified,
+hour file last modified, minute file last
+modified, and the pathname.
+In addition, for each directory whose contents are displayed, the total
+number of 512-byte blocks used by the files in the directory is displayed
+on a line by itself immediately before the information for the files in the
+directory.
+.Pp
+If the owner or group names are not a known user or group name
+the numeric ID's are displayed.
+.Pp
+If the file is a character special or block special file,
+the major and minor device numbers for the file are displayed
+in the size field. If the file is a symbolic link the pathname of the
+linked-to file is preceded by
+.Dq \-> .
+.Pp
+The file mode printed under the -l option consists of the
+entry type, owner permissions, and group permissions.
+The entry type character describes the type of file, as
+follows:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width 4n -offset indent -compact
+.It Sy b
+Block special file.
+.It Sy c
+Character special file.
+.It Sy d
+Directory.
+.It Sy l
+Symbolic link.
+.It Sy s
+Socket link.
+.\" .It Sy p
+.\" .Tn FIFO .
+.It Sy \-
+Regular file.
+.El
+.Pp
+The next three fields
+are three characters each:
+owner permissions,
+group permissions, and
+other permissions.
+Each field has three character positions:
+.Bl -enum -offset indent
+.It
+If
+.Sy r ,
+the file is readable; if
+.Sy \- ,
+it is not readable.
+.It
+If
+.Sy w ,
+the file is writable; if
+.Sy \- ,
+it is not writable.
+.It
+The first of the following that applies:
+.Bl -tag -width 4n -offset indent
+.It Sy S
+If in the owner permissions, the file is not executable and
+set-user-ID mode is set.
+If in the group permissions, the file is not executable
+and set-group-ID mode is set.
+.It Sy s
+If in the owner permissions, the file is executable
+and set-user-ID mode is set.
+If in the group permissions, the file is executable
+and setgroup-ID mode is set.
+.It Sy x
+The file is executable or the directory is
+searchable.
+.It Sy \-
+The file is neither readable, writeable, executable,
+nor set-user-ID nor set-group-ID mode, nor sticky. (See below.)
+.El
+.Pp
+These next two apply only to the third character in the last group
+(other permissions).
+.Bl -tag -width 4n -offset indent
+.It Sy T
+The sticky bit is set
+(mode
+.Li 1000 ) ,
+but not execute or search permission. (See
+.Xr chmod 1
+or
+.Xr sticky 8 . )
+.It Sy t
+The sticky bit is set (mode
+.Li 1000 ) ,
+and is searchable or executable.
+(See
+.Xr chmod 1
+or
+.Xr sticky 8 . )
+.El
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm ls
+utility exits 0 on success, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh ENVIRONMENTAL VARIABLES
+The following environment variables affect the execution of
+.Nm ls :
+.Bl -tag -width BLOCKSIZE
+.It Ev BLOCKSIZE
+If the environmental variable
+.Ev BLOCKSIZE
+is set, the block counts
+(see
+.Fl s )
+will be displayed in units of that size block.
+.It COLUMNS
+If this variable contains a string representing a
+decimal integer, it is used as the
+column position width for displaying
+multiple-text-column output.
+The
+.Nm ls
+utility calculates how
+many pathname text columns to display
+based on the width provided.
+(See
+.Fl C . )
+.It Ev TZ
+The timezone to use when displaying dates.
+See
+.Xr environ 7
+for more information.
+.El
+.Sh COMPATIBILITY
+The group field is now automatically included in the long listing for
+files in order to be compatible with the
+.St -p1003.2
+specification.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr chmod 1 ,
+.Xr symlink 7 ,
+.Xr sticky 8
+.Sh HISTORY
+An
+.Nm ls
+command appeared in
+.At v6 .
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm ls
+function is expected to be a superset of the
+.St -p1003.2
+specification.
diff --git a/bin/ls/ls.c b/bin/ls/ls.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1cea616
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/ls.c
@@ -0,0 +1,506 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Michael Fischbein.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)ls.c 8.5 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "ls.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void display __P((FTSENT *, FTSENT *));
+static int mastercmp __P((const FTSENT **, const FTSENT **));
+static void traverse __P((int, char **, int));
+
+static void (*printfcn) __P((DISPLAY *));
+static int (*sortfcn) __P((const FTSENT *, const FTSENT *));
+
+long blocksize; /* block size units */
+int termwidth = 80; /* default terminal width */
+
+/* flags */
+int f_accesstime; /* use time of last access */
+int f_column; /* columnated format */
+int f_flags; /* show flags associated with a file */
+int f_inode; /* print inode */
+int f_listdir; /* list actual directory, not contents */
+int f_listdot; /* list files beginning with . */
+int f_longform; /* long listing format */
+int f_newline; /* if precede with newline */
+int f_nonprint; /* show unprintables as ? */
+int f_nosort; /* don't sort output */
+int f_recursive; /* ls subdirectories also */
+int f_reversesort; /* reverse whatever sort is used */
+int f_sectime; /* print the real time for all files */
+int f_singlecol; /* use single column output */
+int f_size; /* list size in short listing */
+int f_statustime; /* use time of last mode change */
+int f_dirname; /* if precede with directory name */
+int f_timesort; /* sort by time vice name */
+int f_type; /* add type character for non-regular files */
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ static char dot[] = ".", *dotav[] = { dot, NULL };
+ struct winsize win;
+ int ch, fts_options, notused;
+ char *p;
+
+ /* Terminal defaults to -Cq, non-terminal defaults to -1. */
+ if (isatty(STDOUT_FILENO)) {
+ if (ioctl(STDOUT_FILENO, TIOCGWINSZ, &win) == -1 ||
+ !win.ws_col) {
+ if ((p = getenv("COLUMNS")) != NULL)
+ termwidth = atoi(p);
+ }
+ else
+ termwidth = win.ws_col;
+ f_column = f_nonprint = 1;
+ } else
+ f_singlecol = 1;
+
+ /* Root is -A automatically. */
+ if (!getuid())
+ f_listdot = 1;
+
+ fts_options = FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "1ACFLRTacdfgiloqrstu")) != EOF) {
+ switch (ch) {
+ /*
+ * The -1, -C and -l options all override each other so shell
+ * aliasing works right.
+ */
+ case '1':
+ f_singlecol = 1;
+ f_column = f_longform = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'C':
+ f_column = 1;
+ f_longform = f_singlecol = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'l':
+ f_longform = 1;
+ f_column = f_singlecol = 0;
+ break;
+ /* The -c and -u options override each other. */
+ case 'c':
+ f_statustime = 1;
+ f_accesstime = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'u':
+ f_accesstime = 1;
+ f_statustime = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'F':
+ f_type = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'L':
+ fts_options &= ~FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ fts_options |= FTS_LOGICAL;
+ break;
+ case 'R':
+ f_recursive = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'a':
+ fts_options |= FTS_SEEDOT;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 'A':
+ f_listdot = 1;
+ break;
+ /* The -d option turns off the -R option. */
+ case 'd':
+ f_listdir = 1;
+ f_recursive = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ f_nosort = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'g': /* Compatibility with 4.3BSD. */
+ break;
+ case 'i':
+ f_inode = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'o':
+ f_flags = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'q':
+ f_nonprint = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ f_reversesort = 1;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ f_size = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'T':
+ f_sectime = 1;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ f_timesort = 1;
+ break;
+ default:
+ case '?':
+ usage();
+ }
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ /*
+ * If not -F, -i, -l, -s or -t options, don't require stat
+ * information.
+ */
+ if (!f_inode && !f_longform && !f_size && !f_timesort && !f_type)
+ fts_options |= FTS_NOSTAT;
+
+ /*
+ * If not -F, -d or -l options, follow any symbolic links listed on
+ * the command line.
+ */
+ if (!f_longform && !f_listdir && !f_type)
+ fts_options |= FTS_COMFOLLOW;
+
+ /* If -l or -s, figure out block size. */
+ if (f_longform || f_size) {
+ (void)getbsize(&notused, &blocksize);
+ blocksize /= 512;
+ }
+
+ /* Select a sort function. */
+ if (f_reversesort) {
+ if (!f_timesort)
+ sortfcn = revnamecmp;
+ else if (f_accesstime)
+ sortfcn = revacccmp;
+ else if (f_statustime)
+ sortfcn = revstatcmp;
+ else /* Use modification time. */
+ sortfcn = revmodcmp;
+ } else {
+ if (!f_timesort)
+ sortfcn = namecmp;
+ else if (f_accesstime)
+ sortfcn = acccmp;
+ else if (f_statustime)
+ sortfcn = statcmp;
+ else /* Use modification time. */
+ sortfcn = modcmp;
+ }
+
+ /* Select a print function. */
+ if (f_singlecol)
+ printfcn = printscol;
+ else if (f_longform)
+ printfcn = printlong;
+ else
+ printfcn = printcol;
+
+ if (argc)
+ traverse(argc, argv, fts_options);
+ else
+ traverse(1, dotav, fts_options);
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+static int output; /* If anything output. */
+
+/*
+ * Traverse() walks the logical directory structure specified by the argv list
+ * in the order specified by the mastercmp() comparison function. During the
+ * traversal it passes linked lists of structures to display() which represent
+ * a superset (may be exact set) of the files to be displayed.
+ */
+static void
+traverse(argc, argv, options)
+ int argc, options;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ FTS *ftsp;
+ FTSENT *p, *chp;
+ int ch_options;
+
+ if ((ftsp =
+ fts_open(argv, options, f_nosort ? NULL : mastercmp)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+
+ display(NULL, fts_children(ftsp, 0));
+ if (f_listdir)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * If not recursing down this tree and don't need stat info, just get
+ * the names.
+ */
+ ch_options = !f_recursive && options & FTS_NOSTAT ? FTS_NAMEONLY : 0;
+
+ while ((p = fts_read(ftsp)) != NULL)
+ switch (p->fts_info) {
+ case FTS_DC:
+ warnx("%s: directory causes a cycle", p->fts_name);
+ break;
+ case FTS_DNR:
+ case FTS_ERR:
+ warnx("%s: %s", p->fts_name, strerror(p->fts_errno));
+ break;
+ case FTS_D:
+ if (p->fts_level != FTS_ROOTLEVEL &&
+ p->fts_name[0] == '.' && !f_listdot)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * If already output something, put out a newline as
+ * a separator. If multiple arguments, precede each
+ * directory with its name.
+ */
+ if (output)
+ (void)printf("\n%s:\n", p->fts_path);
+ else if (argc > 1) {
+ (void)printf("%s:\n", p->fts_path);
+ output = 1;
+ }
+
+ chp = fts_children(ftsp, ch_options);
+ display(p, chp);
+
+ if (!f_recursive && chp != NULL)
+ (void)fts_set(ftsp, p, FTS_SKIP);
+ break;
+ }
+ if (errno)
+ err(1, "fts_read");
+}
+
+/*
+ * Display() takes a linked list of FTSENT structures and passes the list
+ * along with any other necessary information to the print function. P
+ * points to the parent directory of the display list.
+ */
+static void
+display(p, list)
+ FTSENT *p, *list;
+{
+ struct stat *sp;
+ DISPLAY d;
+ FTSENT *cur;
+ NAMES *np;
+ u_quad_t maxsize;
+ u_long btotal, maxblock, maxinode, maxlen, maxnlink;
+ int bcfile, flen, glen, ulen, maxflags, maxgroup, maxuser;
+ int entries, needstats;
+ char *user, *group, *flags, buf[20]; /* 32 bits == 10 digits */
+
+ /*
+ * If list is NULL there are two possibilities: that the parent
+ * directory p has no children, or that fts_children() returned an
+ * error. We ignore the error case since it will be replicated
+ * on the next call to fts_read() on the post-order visit to the
+ * directory p, and will be signalled in traverse().
+ */
+ if (list == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ needstats = f_inode || f_longform || f_size;
+ flen = 0;
+ btotal = maxblock = maxinode = maxlen = maxnlink = 0;
+ bcfile = 0;
+ maxuser = maxgroup = maxflags = 0;
+ maxsize = 0;
+ for (cur = list, entries = 0; cur; cur = cur->fts_link) {
+ if (cur->fts_info == FTS_ERR || cur->fts_info == FTS_NS) {
+ warnx("%s: %s",
+ cur->fts_name, strerror(cur->fts_errno));
+ cur->fts_number = NO_PRINT;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * P is NULL if list is the argv list, to which different rules
+ * apply.
+ */
+ if (p == NULL) {
+ /* Directories will be displayed later. */
+ if (cur->fts_info == FTS_D && !f_listdir) {
+ cur->fts_number = NO_PRINT;
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else {
+ /* Only display dot file if -a/-A set. */
+ if (cur->fts_name[0] == '.' && !f_listdot) {
+ cur->fts_number = NO_PRINT;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ if (f_nonprint)
+ prcopy(cur->fts_name, cur->fts_name, cur->fts_namelen);
+ if (cur->fts_namelen > maxlen)
+ maxlen = cur->fts_namelen;
+ if (needstats) {
+ sp = cur->fts_statp;
+ if (sp->st_blocks > maxblock)
+ maxblock = sp->st_blocks;
+ if (sp->st_ino > maxinode)
+ maxinode = sp->st_ino;
+ if (sp->st_nlink > maxnlink)
+ maxnlink = sp->st_nlink;
+ if (sp->st_size > maxsize)
+ maxsize = sp->st_size;
+
+ btotal += sp->st_blocks;
+ if (f_longform) {
+ user = user_from_uid(sp->st_uid, 0);
+ if ((ulen = strlen(user)) > maxuser)
+ maxuser = ulen;
+ group = group_from_gid(sp->st_gid, 0);
+ if ((glen = strlen(group)) > maxgroup)
+ maxgroup = glen;
+ if (f_flags) {
+ flags =
+ flags_to_string(sp->st_flags, "-");
+ if ((flen = strlen(flags)) > maxflags)
+ maxflags = flen;
+ } else
+ flen = 0;
+
+ if ((np = malloc(sizeof(NAMES) +
+ ulen + glen + flen + 3)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+
+ np->user = &np->data[0];
+ (void)strcpy(np->user, user);
+ np->group = &np->data[ulen + 1];
+ (void)strcpy(np->group, group);
+
+ if (S_ISCHR(sp->st_mode) ||
+ S_ISBLK(sp->st_mode))
+ bcfile = 1;
+
+ if (f_flags) {
+ np->flags = &np->data[ulen + glen + 2];
+ (void)strcpy(np->flags, flags);
+ }
+ cur->fts_pointer = np;
+ }
+ }
+ ++entries;
+ }
+
+ if (!entries)
+ return;
+
+ d.list = list;
+ d.entries = entries;
+ d.maxlen = maxlen;
+ if (needstats) {
+ d.bcfile = bcfile;
+ d.btotal = btotal;
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%lu", maxblock);
+ d.s_block = strlen(buf);
+ d.s_flags = maxflags;
+ d.s_group = maxgroup;
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%lu", maxinode);
+ d.s_inode = strlen(buf);
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%lu", maxnlink);
+ d.s_nlink = strlen(buf);
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%qu", maxsize);
+ d.s_size = strlen(buf);
+ d.s_user = maxuser;
+ }
+
+ printfcn(&d);
+ output = 1;
+
+ if (f_longform)
+ for (cur = list; cur; cur = cur->fts_link)
+ free(cur->fts_pointer);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Ordering for mastercmp:
+ * If ordering the argv (fts_level = FTS_ROOTLEVEL) return non-directories
+ * as larger than directories. Within either group, use the sort function.
+ * All other levels use the sort function. Error entries remain unsorted.
+ */
+static int
+mastercmp(a, b)
+ const FTSENT **a, **b;
+{
+ int a_info, b_info;
+
+ a_info = (*a)->fts_info;
+ if (a_info == FTS_ERR)
+ return (0);
+ b_info = (*b)->fts_info;
+ if (b_info == FTS_ERR)
+ return (0);
+
+ if (a_info == FTS_NS || b_info == FTS_NS)
+ return (namecmp(*a, *b));
+
+ if (a_info == b_info)
+ return (sortfcn(*a, *b));
+
+ if ((*a)->fts_level == FTS_ROOTLEVEL)
+ if (a_info == FTS_D)
+ return (1);
+ else if (b_info == FTS_D)
+ return (-1);
+ else
+ return (sortfcn(*a, *b));
+ else
+ return (sortfcn(*a, *b));
+}
diff --git a/bin/ls/ls.h b/bin/ls/ls.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ab61480
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/ls.h
@@ -0,0 +1,72 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Michael Fischbein.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)ls.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#define NO_PRINT 1
+
+extern long blocksize; /* block size units */
+
+extern int f_accesstime; /* use time of last access */
+extern int f_flags; /* show flags associated with a file */
+extern int f_inode; /* print inode */
+extern int f_longform; /* long listing format */
+extern int f_sectime; /* print the real time for all files */
+extern int f_size; /* list size in short listing */
+extern int f_statustime; /* use time of last mode change */
+extern int f_type; /* add type character for non-regular files */
+
+typedef struct {
+ FTSENT *list;
+ u_long btotal;
+ int bcfile;
+ int entries;
+ int maxlen;
+ int s_block;
+ int s_flags;
+ int s_group;
+ int s_inode;
+ int s_nlink;
+ int s_size;
+ int s_user;
+} DISPLAY;
+
+typedef struct {
+ char *user;
+ char *group;
+ char *flags;
+ char data[1];
+} NAMES;
diff --git a/bin/ls/print.c b/bin/ls/print.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5c068e9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/print.c
@@ -0,0 +1,293 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Michael Fischbein.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)print.c 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/17/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <grp.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <time.h>
+#include <tzfile.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <utmp.h>
+
+#include "ls.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int printaname __P((FTSENT *, u_long, u_long));
+static void printlink __P((FTSENT *));
+static void printtime __P((time_t));
+static int printtype __P((u_int));
+
+#define IS_NOPRINT(p) ((p)->fts_number == NO_PRINT)
+
+void
+printscol(dp)
+ DISPLAY *dp;
+{
+ FTSENT *p;
+
+ for (p = dp->list; p; p = p->fts_link) {
+ if (IS_NOPRINT(p))
+ continue;
+ (void)printaname(p, dp->s_inode, dp->s_block);
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+ }
+}
+
+void
+printlong(dp)
+ DISPLAY *dp;
+{
+ struct stat *sp;
+ FTSENT *p;
+ NAMES *np;
+ char buf[20];
+
+ if (dp->list->fts_level != FTS_ROOTLEVEL && (f_longform || f_size))
+ (void)printf("total %lu\n", howmany(dp->btotal, blocksize));
+
+ for (p = dp->list; p; p = p->fts_link) {
+ if (IS_NOPRINT(p))
+ continue;
+ sp = p->fts_statp;
+ if (f_inode)
+ (void)printf("%*lu ", dp->s_inode, sp->st_ino);
+ if (f_size)
+ (void)printf("%*qd ",
+ dp->s_block, howmany(sp->st_blocks, blocksize));
+ (void)strmode(sp->st_mode, buf);
+ np = p->fts_pointer;
+ (void)printf("%s %*u %-*s %-*s ", buf, dp->s_nlink,
+ sp->st_nlink, dp->s_user, np->user, dp->s_group,
+ np->group);
+ if (f_flags)
+ (void)printf("%-*s ", dp->s_flags, np->flags);
+ if (S_ISCHR(sp->st_mode) || S_ISBLK(sp->st_mode))
+ (void)printf("%3d, %3d ",
+ major(sp->st_rdev), minor(sp->st_rdev));
+ else if (dp->bcfile)
+ (void)printf("%*s%*qd ",
+ 8 - dp->s_size, "", dp->s_size, sp->st_size);
+ else
+ (void)printf("%*qd ", dp->s_size, sp->st_size);
+ if (f_accesstime)
+ printtime(sp->st_atime);
+ else if (f_statustime)
+ printtime(sp->st_ctime);
+ else
+ printtime(sp->st_mtime);
+ (void)printf("%s", p->fts_name);
+ if (f_type)
+ (void)printtype(sp->st_mode);
+ if (S_ISLNK(sp->st_mode))
+ printlink(p);
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+ }
+}
+
+#define TAB 8
+
+void
+printcol(dp)
+ DISPLAY *dp;
+{
+ extern int termwidth;
+ static FTSENT **array;
+ static int lastentries = -1;
+ FTSENT *p;
+ int base, chcnt, cnt, col, colwidth, num;
+ int endcol, numcols, numrows, row;
+
+ /*
+ * Have to do random access in the linked list -- build a table
+ * of pointers.
+ */
+ if (dp->entries > lastentries) {
+ lastentries = dp->entries;
+ if ((array =
+ realloc(array, dp->entries * sizeof(FTSENT *))) == NULL) {
+ warn(NULL);
+ printscol(dp);
+ }
+ }
+ for (p = dp->list, num = 0; p; p = p->fts_link)
+ if (p->fts_number != NO_PRINT)
+ array[num++] = p;
+
+ colwidth = dp->maxlen;
+ if (f_inode)
+ colwidth += dp->s_inode + 1;
+ if (f_size)
+ colwidth += dp->s_block + 1;
+ if (f_type)
+ colwidth += 1;
+
+ colwidth = (colwidth + TAB) & ~(TAB - 1);
+ if (termwidth < 2 * colwidth) {
+ printscol(dp);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ numcols = termwidth / colwidth;
+ numrows = num / numcols;
+ if (num % numcols)
+ ++numrows;
+
+ if (dp->list->fts_level != FTS_ROOTLEVEL && (f_longform || f_size))
+ (void)printf("total %lu\n", howmany(dp->btotal, blocksize));
+ for (row = 0; row < numrows; ++row) {
+ endcol = colwidth;
+ for (base = row, chcnt = col = 0; col < numcols; ++col) {
+ chcnt += printaname(array[base], dp->s_inode,
+ dp->s_block);
+ if ((base += numrows) >= num)
+ break;
+ while ((cnt = (chcnt + TAB & ~(TAB - 1))) <= endcol) {
+ (void)putchar('\t');
+ chcnt = cnt;
+ }
+ endcol += colwidth;
+ }
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * print [inode] [size] name
+ * return # of characters printed, no trailing characters.
+ */
+static int
+printaname(p, inodefield, sizefield)
+ FTSENT *p;
+ u_long sizefield, inodefield;
+{
+ struct stat *sp;
+ int chcnt;
+
+ sp = p->fts_statp;
+ chcnt = 0;
+ if (f_inode)
+ chcnt += printf("%*lu ", (int)inodefield, sp->st_ino);
+ if (f_size)
+ chcnt += printf("%*qd ",
+ (int)sizefield, howmany(sp->st_blocks, blocksize));
+ chcnt += printf("%s", p->fts_name);
+ if (f_type)
+ chcnt += printtype(sp->st_mode);
+ return (chcnt);
+}
+
+static void
+printtime(ftime)
+ time_t ftime;
+{
+ int i;
+ char *longstring;
+
+ longstring = ctime(&ftime);
+ for (i = 4; i < 11; ++i)
+ (void)putchar(longstring[i]);
+
+#define SIXMONTHS ((DAYSPERNYEAR / 2) * SECSPERDAY)
+ if (f_sectime)
+ for (i = 11; i < 24; i++)
+ (void)putchar(longstring[i]);
+ else if (ftime + SIXMONTHS > time(NULL))
+ for (i = 11; i < 16; ++i)
+ (void)putchar(longstring[i]);
+ else {
+ (void)putchar(' ');
+ for (i = 20; i < 24; ++i)
+ (void)putchar(longstring[i]);
+ }
+ (void)putchar(' ');
+}
+
+static int
+printtype(mode)
+ u_int mode;
+{
+ switch (mode & S_IFMT) {
+ case S_IFDIR:
+ (void)putchar('/');
+ return (1);
+ case S_IFIFO:
+ (void)putchar('|');
+ return (1);
+ case S_IFLNK:
+ (void)putchar('@');
+ return (1);
+ case S_IFSOCK:
+ (void)putchar('=');
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (mode & (S_IXUSR | S_IXGRP | S_IXOTH)) {
+ (void)putchar('*');
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+static void
+printlink(p)
+ FTSENT *p;
+{
+ int lnklen;
+ char name[MAXPATHLEN + 1], path[MAXPATHLEN + 1];
+
+ if (p->fts_level == FTS_ROOTLEVEL)
+ (void)snprintf(name, sizeof(name), "%s", p->fts_name);
+ else
+ (void)snprintf(name, sizeof(name),
+ "%s/%s", p->fts_parent->fts_accpath, p->fts_name);
+ if ((lnklen = readlink(name, path, sizeof(path) - 1)) == -1) {
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "\nls: %s: %s\n", name, strerror(errno));
+ return;
+ }
+ path[lnklen] = '\0';
+ (void)printf(" -> %s", path);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ls/stat_flags.c b/bin/ls/stat_flags.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5bc4b85
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/stat_flags.c
@@ -0,0 +1,148 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)stat_flags.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#define SAPPEND(s) { \
+ if (prefix != NULL) \
+ (void)strcat(string, prefix); \
+ (void)strcat(string, s); \
+ prefix = ","; \
+}
+
+/*
+ * flags_to_string --
+ * Convert stat flags to a comma-separated string. If no flags
+ * are set, return the default string.
+ */
+char *
+flags_to_string(flags, def)
+ u_long flags;
+ char *def;
+{
+ static char string[128];
+ char *prefix;
+
+ string[0] = '\0';
+ prefix = NULL;
+ if (flags & UF_APPEND)
+ SAPPEND("uappnd");
+ if (flags & UF_IMMUTABLE)
+ SAPPEND("uchg");
+ if (flags & UF_NODUMP)
+ SAPPEND("nodump");
+ if (flags & SF_APPEND)
+ SAPPEND("sappnd");
+ if (flags & SF_ARCHIVED)
+ SAPPEND("arch");
+ if (flags & SF_IMMUTABLE)
+ SAPPEND("schg");
+ return (prefix == NULL && def != NULL ? def : string);
+}
+
+#define TEST(a, b, f) { \
+ if (!memcmp(a, b, sizeof(b))) { \
+ if (clear) { \
+ if (clrp) \
+ *clrp |= (f); \
+ } else if (setp) \
+ *setp |= (f); \
+ break; \
+ } \
+}
+
+/*
+ * string_to_flags --
+ * Take string of arguments and return stat flags. Return 0 on
+ * success, 1 on failure. On failure, stringp is set to point
+ * to the offending token.
+ */
+int
+string_to_flags(stringp, setp, clrp)
+ char **stringp;
+ u_long *setp, *clrp;
+{
+ int clear;
+ char *string, *p;
+
+ clear = 0;
+ if (setp)
+ *setp = 0;
+ if (clrp)
+ *clrp = 0;
+ string = *stringp;
+ while ((p = strsep(&string, "\t ,")) != NULL) {
+ *stringp = p;
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ continue;
+ if (p[0] == 'n' && p[1] == 'o') {
+ clear = 1;
+ p += 2;
+ }
+ switch (p[0]) {
+ case 'a':
+ TEST(p, "arch", SF_ARCHIVED);
+ TEST(p, "archived", SF_ARCHIVED);
+ return (1);
+ case 'd':
+ clear = !clear;
+ TEST(p, "dump", UF_NODUMP);
+ return (1);
+ case 's':
+ TEST(p, "sappnd", SF_APPEND);
+ TEST(p, "sappend", SF_APPEND);
+ TEST(p, "schg", SF_IMMUTABLE);
+ TEST(p, "schange", SF_IMMUTABLE);
+ TEST(p, "simmutable", SF_IMMUTABLE);
+ return (1);
+ case 'u':
+ TEST(p, "uappnd", UF_APPEND);
+ TEST(p, "uappend", UF_APPEND);
+ TEST(p, "uchg", UF_IMMUTABLE);
+ TEST(p, "uchange", UF_IMMUTABLE);
+ TEST(p, "uimmutable", UF_IMMUTABLE);
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ return (1);
+ }
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ls/util.c b/bin/ls/util.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4d1173d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ls/util.c
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Michael Fischbein.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)util.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "ls.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+void
+prcopy(src, dest, len)
+ char *src, *dest;
+ int len;
+{
+ int ch;
+
+ while (len--) {
+ ch = *src++;
+ *dest++ = isprint(ch) ? ch : '?';
+ }
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: ls [-1ACFLRTacdfiklqrstu] [file ...]\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/mkdir/Makefile b/bin/mkdir/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..88521b1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mkdir/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= mkdir
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/mkdir/mkdir.1 b/bin/mkdir/mkdir.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f38a5dc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mkdir/mkdir.1
@@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)mkdir.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 1/25/94
+.\"
+.Dd January 25, 1994
+.Dt MKDIR 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm mkdir
+.Nd make directories
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm mkdir
+.Op Fl p
+.Op Fl m Ar mode
+.Ar directory_name ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Mkdir
+creates the directories named as operands, in the order specified,
+using mode
+.Li rwxrwxrwx (\&0777)
+as modified by the current
+.Xr umask 2 .
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It Fl m
+Set the file permission bits of the final created directory to
+the specified mode.
+The mode argument can be in any of the formats specified to the
+.Xr chmod 1
+command.
+If a symbolic mode is specified, the operation characters
+.Dq +
+and
+.Dq -
+are interpreted relative to an initial mode of
+.Dq a=rwx .
+.It Fl p
+Create intermediate directories as required.
+If this option is not specified, the full path prefix of each
+operand must already exist.
+Intermediate directories are created with permission bits of
+.Li rwxrwxrwx (\&0777)
+as modified by the current umask, plus write and search
+permission for the owner.
+.El
+.Pp
+The user must have write permission in the parent directory.
+.Pp
+.Nm Mkdir
+exits 0 if successful, and >0 if an error occurred.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr rmdir 1
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm mkdir
+utility is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/mkdir/mkdir.c b/bin/mkdir/mkdir.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..32d45d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mkdir/mkdir.c
@@ -0,0 +1,169 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1983, 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1983, 1992, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mkdir.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 1/25/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+int build __P((char *));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int ch, exitval, oct, omode, pflag;
+ mode_t *set;
+ char *ep, *mode;
+
+ pflag = 0;
+ mode = NULL;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "m:p")) != EOF)
+ switch(ch) {
+ case 'p':
+ pflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ mode = optarg;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+ if (argv[0] == NULL)
+ usage();
+
+ if (mode == NULL) {
+ omode = S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO;
+ oct = 1;
+ } else if (*mode >= '0' && *mode <= '7') {
+ omode = (int)strtol(mode, &ep, 8);
+ if (omode < 0 || *ep)
+ errx(1, "invalid file mode: %s", mode);
+ oct = 1;
+ } else {
+ if ((set = setmode(mode)) == NULL)
+ errx(1, "invalid file mode: %s", mode);
+ oct = 0;
+ }
+
+ for (exitval = 0; *argv != NULL; ++argv) {
+ if (pflag && build(*argv)) {
+ exitval = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (mkdir(*argv, oct ?
+ omode : getmode(set, S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO)) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ exitval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ exit(exitval);
+}
+
+int
+build(path)
+ char *path;
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+ mode_t numask, oumask;
+ int first;
+ char *p;
+
+ p = path;
+ if (p[0] == '/') /* Skip leading '/'. */
+ ++p;
+ for (first = 1;; ++p) {
+ if (p[0] == '\0' || p[0] == '/' && p[1] == '\0')
+ break;
+ if (p[0] != '/')
+ continue;
+ *p = '\0';
+ if (first) {
+ /*
+ * POSIX 1003.2:
+ * For each dir operand that does not name an existing
+ * directory, effects equivalent to those cased by the
+ * following command shall occcur:
+ *
+ * mkdir -p -m $(umask -S),u+wx $(dirname dir) &&
+ * mkdir [-m mode] dir
+ *
+ * We change the user's umask and then restore it,
+ * instead of doing chmod's.
+ */
+ oumask = umask(0);
+ numask = oumask & ~(S_IWUSR | S_IXUSR);
+ (void)umask(numask);
+ first = 0;
+ }
+ if (stat(path, &sb)) {
+ if (errno != ENOENT ||
+ mkdir(path, S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", path);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ }
+ *p = '/';
+ }
+ if (!first)
+ (void)umask(oumask);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: mkdir [-p] [-m mode] directory ...\n");
+ exit (1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/mv/Makefile b/bin/mv/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..98563dd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mv/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/2/94
+
+PROG= mv
+
+DPADD= ${LIBUTIL}
+LDADD= -lutil
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/mv/mv.1 b/bin/mv/mv.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..48ab6a5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mv/mv.1
@@ -0,0 +1,129 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1989, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)mv.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt MV 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm mv
+.Nd move files
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm mv
+.Op Fl f | Fl i
+.Ar source target
+.Nm mv
+.Op Fl f | Fl i
+.Ar source ... source directory
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Pp
+In its first form, the
+.Nm mv
+utility renames the file named by the
+.Ar source
+operand to the destination path named by the
+.Ar target
+operand.
+This form is assumed when the last operand does not name an already
+existing directory.
+.Pp
+In its second form,
+.Nm mv
+moves each file named by a
+.Ar source
+operand to a destination file in the existing directory named by the
+.Ar directory
+operand.
+The destination path for each operand is the pathname produced by the
+concatenation of the last operand, a slash, and the final pathname
+component of the named file.
+.Pp
+The following options are available:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl f
+Do not prompt for confirmation before overwriting the destination
+path.
+(The
+.Fl i
+option is ignored if the
+.Fl f
+option is specified.)
+.It Fl i
+Causes
+.Nm mv
+to write a prompt to standard error before moving a file that would
+overwrite an existing file.
+If the response from the standard input begins with the character ``y'',
+the move is attempted.
+.El
+.Pp
+It is an error for either the
+.Ar source
+operand or the destination path to specify a directory unless both do.
+.Pp
+If the destination path does not have a mode which permits writing,
+.Nm mv
+prompts the user for confirmation as specified for the
+.Fl i
+option.
+.Pp
+As the
+.Xr rename 2
+call does not work across file systems,
+.Nm mv
+uses
+.Xr cp 1
+and
+.Xr rm 1
+to accomplish the move.
+The effect is equivalent to:
+.Bd -literal -offset indent
+rm -f destination_path && \e
+\tcp -pr source_file destination && \e
+\trm -rf source_file
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm mv
+utility exits 0 on success, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr cp 1 ,
+.Xr symlink 7
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm mv
+utility is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/mv/mv.c b/bin/mv/mv.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..01fbc90
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mv/mv.c
@@ -0,0 +1,300 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Ken Smith of The State University of New York at Buffalo.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1989, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mv.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/wait.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "pathnames.h"
+
+int fflg, iflg;
+
+int copy __P((char *, char *));
+int do_move __P((char *, char *));
+int fastcopy __P((char *, char *, struct stat *));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ register int baselen, len, rval;
+ register char *p, *endp;
+ struct stat sb;
+ int ch;
+ char path[MAXPATHLEN + 1];
+
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "-if")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'i':
+ iflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ fflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case '-': /* Undocumented; for compatibility. */
+ goto endarg;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+endarg: argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ usage();
+
+ /*
+ * If the stat on the target fails or the target isn't a directory,
+ * try the move. More than 2 arguments is an error in this case.
+ */
+ if (stat(argv[argc - 1], &sb) || !S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) {
+ if (argc > 2)
+ usage();
+ exit(do_move(argv[0], argv[1]));
+ }
+
+ /* It's a directory, move each file into it. */
+ (void)strcpy(path, argv[argc - 1]);
+ baselen = strlen(path);
+ endp = &path[baselen];
+ *endp++ = '/';
+ ++baselen;
+ for (rval = 0; --argc; ++argv) {
+ if ((p = strrchr(*argv, '/')) == NULL)
+ p = *argv;
+ else
+ ++p;
+ if ((baselen + (len = strlen(p))) >= MAXPATHLEN) {
+ warnx("%s: destination pathname too long", *argv);
+ rval = 1;
+ } else {
+ memmove(endp, p, len + 1);
+ if (do_move(*argv, path))
+ rval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+ exit(rval);
+}
+
+int
+do_move(from, to)
+ char *from, *to;
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+ int ask, ch;
+ char modep[15];
+
+ /*
+ * Check access. If interactive and file exists, ask user if it
+ * should be replaced. Otherwise if file exists but isn't writable
+ * make sure the user wants to clobber it.
+ */
+ if (!fflg && !access(to, F_OK)) {
+ ask = 0;
+ if (iflg) {
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "overwrite %s? ", to);
+ ask = 1;
+ } else if (access(to, W_OK) && !stat(to, &sb)) {
+ strmode(sb.st_mode, modep);
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "override %s%s%s/%s for %s? ",
+ modep + 1, modep[9] == ' ' ? "" : " ",
+ user_from_uid(sb.st_uid, 0),
+ group_from_gid(sb.st_gid, 0), to);
+ ask = 1;
+ }
+ if (ask) {
+ if ((ch = getchar()) != EOF && ch != '\n')
+ while (getchar() != '\n');
+ if (ch != 'y')
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+ if (!rename(from, to))
+ return (0);
+
+ if (errno != EXDEV) {
+ warn("rename %s to %s", from, to);
+ return (1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If rename fails because we're trying to cross devices, and
+ * it's a regular file, do the copy internally; otherwise, use
+ * cp and rm.
+ */
+ if (stat(from, &sb)) {
+ warn("%s", from);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (S_ISREG(sb.st_mode) ?
+ fastcopy(from, to, &sb) : copy(from, to));
+}
+
+int
+fastcopy(from, to, sbp)
+ char *from, *to;
+ struct stat *sbp;
+{
+ struct timeval tval[2];
+ static u_int blen;
+ static char *bp;
+ register int nread, from_fd, to_fd;
+
+ if ((from_fd = open(from, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", from);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if ((to_fd =
+ open(to, O_CREAT | O_TRUNC | O_WRONLY, sbp->st_mode)) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", to);
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (!blen && !(bp = malloc(blen = sbp->st_blksize))) {
+ warn(NULL);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ while ((nread = read(from_fd, bp, blen)) > 0)
+ if (write(to_fd, bp, nread) != nread) {
+ warn("%s", to);
+ goto err;
+ }
+ if (nread < 0) {
+ warn("%s", from);
+err: if (unlink(to))
+ warn("%s: remove", to);
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+ (void)close(to_fd);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ (void)close(from_fd);
+
+ if (fchown(to_fd, sbp->st_uid, sbp->st_gid))
+ warn("%s: set owner/group", to);
+ if (fchmod(to_fd, sbp->st_mode))
+ warn("%s: set mode", to);
+
+ tval[0].tv_sec = sbp->st_atime;
+ tval[1].tv_sec = sbp->st_mtime;
+ tval[0].tv_usec = tval[1].tv_usec = 0;
+ if (utimes(to, tval))
+ warn("%s: set times", to);
+
+ if (close(to_fd)) {
+ warn("%s", to);
+ return (1);
+ }
+
+ if (unlink(from)) {
+ warn("%s: remove", from);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+copy(from, to)
+ char *from, *to;
+{
+ int pid, status;
+
+ if ((pid = vfork()) == 0) {
+ execl(_PATH_CP, "mv", "-PRp", from, to, NULL);
+ warn("%s", _PATH_CP);
+ _exit(1);
+ }
+ if (waitpid(pid, &status, 0) == -1) {
+ warn("%s: waitpid", _PATH_CP);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (!WIFEXITED(status)) {
+ warn("%s: did not terminate normally", _PATH_CP);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (WEXITSTATUS(status)) {
+ warn("%s: terminated with %d (non-zero) status",
+ _PATH_CP, WEXITSTATUS(status));
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (!(pid = vfork())) {
+ execl(_PATH_RM, "mv", "-rf", from, NULL);
+ warn("%s", _PATH_RM);
+ _exit(1);
+ }
+ if (waitpid(pid, &status, 0) == -1) {
+ warn("%s: waitpid", _PATH_RM);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (!WIFEXITED(status)) {
+ warn("%s: did not terminate normally", _PATH_RM);
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (WEXITSTATUS(status)) {
+ warn("%s: terminated with %d (non-zero) status",
+ _PATH_RM, WEXITSTATUS(status));
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+"usage: mv [-if] src target;\n or: mv [-if] src1 ... srcN directory\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/mv/pathnames.h b/bin/mv/pathnames.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..23fae70
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/mv/pathnames.h
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)pathnames.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#define _PATH_RM "/bin/rm"
+#define _PATH_CP "/bin/cp"
diff --git a/bin/pax/Makefile b/bin/pax/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..578f65a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,32 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# To install on versions prior to BSD 4.4 the following may have to be
+# defined with CFLAGS +=
+#
+# -DNET2_STAT Use NET2 or older stat structure. The version of the
+# stat structure is easily determined by looking at the
+# basic type of an off_t (often defined in the file:
+# /usr/include/sys/types.h). If off_t is a long (and is
+# NOT A quad) then you must define NET2_STAT.
+# This define is important, as if you do have a quad_t
+# off_t and define NET2_STAT, pax will compile but will
+# NOT RUN PROPERLY.
+#
+# -DNET2_FTS Use the older NET2 fts. To identify the version,
+# examine the file: /usr/include/fts.h. If FTS_COMFOLLOW
+# is not defined then you must define NET2_FTS.
+# Pax may not compile if this not (un)defined properly.
+#
+# -DNET2_REGEX Use the older regexp.h not regex.h. The regex version
+# is determined by looking at the value returned by
+# regexec() (man 3 regexec). If regexec return a 1 for
+# success (and NOT a 0 for success) you have the older
+# regex routines and must define NET2_REGEX.
+# Pax may not compile if this not (un)defined properly.
+
+PROG= pax
+SRCS= ar_io.c ar_subs.c buf_subs.c cache.c cpio.c file_subs.c ftree.c\
+ gen_subs.c options.c pat_rep.c pax.c sel_subs.c tables.c tar.c\
+ tty_subs.c
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/pax/ar_io.c b/bin/pax/ar_io.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..07eb77f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/ar_io.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1288 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)ar_io.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/mtio.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Routines which deal directly with the archive I/O device/file.
+ */
+
+#define DMOD 0666 /* default mode of created archives */
+#define EXT_MODE O_RDONLY /* open mode for list/extract */
+#define AR_MODE (O_WRONLY | O_CREAT | O_TRUNC) /* mode for archive */
+#define APP_MODE O_RDWR /* mode for append */
+#define STDO "<STDOUT>" /* psuedo name for stdout */
+#define STDN "<STDIN>" /* psuedo name for stdin */
+static int arfd = -1; /* archive file descriptor */
+static int artyp = ISREG; /* archive type: file/FIFO/tape */
+static int arvol = 1; /* archive volume number */
+static int lstrval = -1; /* return value from last i/o */
+static int io_ok; /* i/o worked on volume after resync */
+static int did_io; /* did i/o ever occur on volume? */
+static int done; /* set via tty termination */
+static struct stat arsb; /* stat of archive device at open */
+static int invld_rec; /* tape has out of spec record size */
+static int wr_trail = 1; /* trailer was rewritten in append */
+static int can_unlnk = 0; /* do we unlink null archives? */
+char *arcname; /* printable name of archive */
+
+static int get_phys __P((void));
+extern sigset_t s_mask;
+
+/*
+ * ar_open()
+ * Opens the next archive volume. Determines the type of the device and
+ * sets up block sizes as required by the archive device and the format.
+ * Note: we may be called with name == NULL on the first open only.
+ * Return:
+ * -1 on failure, 0 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_open(char *name)
+#else
+int
+ar_open(name)
+ char *name;
+#endif
+{
+ struct mtget mb;
+
+ if (arfd != -1)
+ (void)close(arfd);
+ arfd = -1;
+ can_unlnk = did_io = io_ok = invld_rec = 0;
+ artyp = ISREG;
+ flcnt = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * open based on overall operation mode
+ */
+ switch (act) {
+ case LIST:
+ case EXTRACT:
+ if (name == NULL) {
+ arfd = STDIN_FILENO;
+ arcname = STDN;
+ } else if ((arfd = open(name, EXT_MODE, DMOD)) < 0)
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Failed open to read on %s", name);
+ break;
+ case ARCHIVE:
+ if (name == NULL) {
+ arfd = STDOUT_FILENO;
+ arcname = STDO;
+ } else if ((arfd = open(name, AR_MODE, DMOD)) < 0)
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Failed open to write on %s", name);
+ else
+ can_unlnk = 1;
+ break;
+ case APPND:
+ if (name == NULL) {
+ arfd = STDOUT_FILENO;
+ arcname = STDO;
+ } else if ((arfd = open(name, APP_MODE, DMOD)) < 0)
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Failed open to read/write on %s",
+ name);
+ break;
+ case COPY:
+ /*
+ * arfd not used in COPY mode
+ */
+ arcname = "<NONE>";
+ lstrval = 1;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ if (arfd < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * set up is based on device type
+ */
+ if (fstat(arfd, &arsb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Failed stat on %s", arcname);
+ (void)close(arfd);
+ arfd = -1;
+ can_unlnk = 0;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (S_ISDIR(arsb.st_mode)) {
+ warn(0, "Cannot write an archive on top of a directory %s",
+ arcname);
+ (void)close(arfd);
+ arfd = -1;
+ can_unlnk = 0;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if (S_ISCHR(arsb.st_mode))
+ artyp = ioctl(arfd, MTIOCGET, &mb) ? ISCHR : ISTAPE;
+ else if (S_ISBLK(arsb.st_mode))
+ artyp = ISBLK;
+ else if ((lseek(arfd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_CUR) == -1) && (errno == ESPIPE))
+ artyp = ISPIPE;
+ else
+ artyp = ISREG;
+
+ /*
+ * make sure we beyond any doubt that we only can unlink regular files
+ * we created
+ */
+ if (artyp != ISREG)
+ can_unlnk = 0;
+ /*
+ * if we are writing, we are done
+ */
+ if (act == ARCHIVE) {
+ blksz = rdblksz = wrblksz;
+ lstrval = 1;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * set default blksz on read. APPNDs writes rdblksz on the last volume
+ * On all new archive volumes, we shift to wrblksz (if the user
+ * specified one, otherwize we will continue to use rdblksz). We
+ * must to set blocksize based on what kind of device the archive is
+ * stored.
+ */
+ switch(artyp) {
+ case ISTAPE:
+ /*
+ * Tape drives come in at least two flavors. Those that support
+ * variable sized records and those that have fixed sized
+ * records. They must be treated differently. For tape drives
+ * that support variable sized records, we must make large
+ * reads to make sure we get the entire record, otherwise we
+ * will just get the first part of the record (up to size we
+ * asked). Tapes with fixed sized records may or may not return
+ * multiple records in a single read. We really do not care
+ * what the physical record size is UNLESS we are going to
+ * append. (We will need the physical block size to rewrite
+ * the trailer). Only when we are appending do we go to the
+ * effort to figure out the true PHYSICAL record size.
+ */
+ blksz = rdblksz = MAXBLK;
+ break;
+ case ISPIPE:
+ case ISBLK:
+ case ISCHR:
+ /*
+ * Blocksize is not a major issue with these devices (but must
+ * be kept a multiple of 512). If the user specified a write
+ * block size, we use that to read. Under append, we must
+ * always keep blksz == rdblksz. Otherwise we go ahead and use
+ * the device optimal blocksize as (and if) returned by stat
+ * and if it is within pax specs.
+ */
+ if ((act == APPND) && wrblksz) {
+ blksz = rdblksz = wrblksz;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if ((arsb.st_blksize > 0) && (arsb.st_blksize < MAXBLK) &&
+ ((arsb.st_blksize % BLKMULT) == 0))
+ rdblksz = arsb.st_blksize;
+ else
+ rdblksz = DEVBLK;
+ /*
+ * For performance go for large reads when we can without harm
+ */
+ if ((act == APPND) || (artyp == ISCHR))
+ blksz = rdblksz;
+ else
+ blksz = MAXBLK;
+ break;
+ case ISREG:
+ /*
+ * if the user specified wrblksz works, use it. Under appends
+ * we must always keep blksz == rdblksz
+ */
+ if ((act == APPND) && wrblksz && ((arsb.st_size%wrblksz)==0)){
+ blksz = rdblksz = wrblksz;
+ break;
+ }
+ /*
+ * See if we can find the blocking factor from the file size
+ */
+ for (rdblksz = MAXBLK; rdblksz > 0; rdblksz -= BLKMULT)
+ if ((arsb.st_size % rdblksz) == 0)
+ break;
+ /*
+ * When we cannont find a match, we may have a flawed archive.
+ */
+ if (rdblksz <= 0)
+ rdblksz = FILEBLK;
+ /*
+ * for performance go for large reads when we can
+ */
+ if (act == APPND)
+ blksz = rdblksz;
+ else
+ blksz = MAXBLK;
+ break;
+ default:
+ /*
+ * should never happen, worse case, slow...
+ */
+ blksz = rdblksz = BLKMULT;
+ break;
+ }
+ lstrval = 1;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_close()
+ * closes archive device, increments volume number, and prints i/o summary
+ */
+#if __STDC__
+void
+ar_close(void)
+#else
+void
+ar_close()
+#endif
+{
+ FILE *outf;
+
+ if (arfd < 0) {
+ did_io = io_ok = flcnt = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if (act == LIST)
+ outf = stdout;
+ else
+ outf = stderr;
+
+ /*
+ * Close archive file. This may take a LONG while on tapes (we may be
+ * forced to wait for the rewind to complete) so tell the user what is
+ * going on (this avoids the user hitting control-c thinking pax is
+ * broken).
+ */
+ if (vflag && (artyp == ISTAPE)) {
+ if (vfpart)
+ (void)putc('\n', outf);
+ (void)fprintf(outf,
+ "%s: Waiting for tape drive close to complete...",
+ argv0);
+ (void)fflush(outf);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if nothing was written to the archive (and we created it), we remove
+ * it
+ */
+ if (can_unlnk && (fstat(arfd, &arsb) == 0) && (S_ISREG(arsb.st_mode)) &&
+ (arsb.st_size == 0)) {
+ (void)unlink(arcname);
+ can_unlnk = 0;
+ }
+
+ (void)close(arfd);
+
+ if (vflag && (artyp == ISTAPE)) {
+ (void)fputs("done.\n", outf);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ (void)fflush(outf);
+ }
+ arfd = -1;
+
+ if (!io_ok && !did_io) {
+ flcnt = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+ did_io = io_ok = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * The volume number is only increased when the last device has data
+ * and we have already determined the archive format.
+ */
+ if (frmt != NULL)
+ ++arvol;
+
+ if (!vflag) {
+ flcnt = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Print out a summary of I/O for this archive volume.
+ */
+ if (vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', outf);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If we have not determined the format yet, we just say how many bytes
+ * we have skipped over looking for a header to id. there is no way we
+ * could have written anything yet.
+ */
+ if (frmt == NULL) {
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ (void)fprintf(outf, "%s: unknown format, %lu bytes skipped.\n",
+# else
+ (void)fprintf(outf, "%s: unknown format, %qu bytes skipped.\n",
+# endif
+ argv0, rdcnt);
+ (void)fflush(outf);
+ flcnt = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ (void)fprintf(outf,
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ "%s: %s vol %d, %lu files, %lu bytes read, %lu bytes written.\n",
+# else
+ "%s: %s vol %d, %lu files, %qu bytes read, %qu bytes written.\n",
+# endif
+ argv0, frmt->name, arvol-1, flcnt, rdcnt, wrcnt);
+ (void)fflush(outf);
+ flcnt = 0;
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_drain()
+ * drain any archive format independent padding from an archive read
+ * from a socket or a pipe. This is to prevent the process on the
+ * other side of the pipe from getting a SIGPIPE (pax will stop
+ * reading an archive once a format dependent trailer is detected).
+ */
+#if __STDC__
+void
+ar_drain(void)
+#else
+void
+ar_drain()
+#endif
+{
+ register int res;
+ char drbuf[MAXBLK];
+
+ /*
+ * we only drain from a pipe/socket. Other devices can be closed
+ * without reading up to end of file. We sure hope that pipe is closed
+ * on the other side so we will get an EOF.
+ */
+ if ((artyp != ISPIPE) || (lstrval <= 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * keep reading until pipe is drained
+ */
+ while ((res = read(arfd, drbuf, sizeof(drbuf))) > 0)
+ ;
+ lstrval = res;
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_set_wr()
+ * Set up device right before switching from read to write in an append.
+ * device dependent code (if required) to do this should be added here.
+ * For all archive devices we are already positioned at the place we want
+ * to start writing when this routine is called.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if all ready to write, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_set_wr(void)
+#else
+int
+ar_set_wr()
+#endif
+{
+ off_t cpos;
+
+ /*
+ * we must make sure the trailer is rewritten on append, ar_next()
+ * will stop us if the archive containing the trailer was not written
+ */
+ wr_trail = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * Add any device dependent code as required here
+ */
+ if (artyp != ISREG)
+ return(0);
+ /*
+ * Ok we have an archive in a regular file. If we were rewriting a
+ * file, we must get rid of all the stuff after the current offset
+ * (it was not written by pax).
+ */
+ if (((cpos = lseek(arfd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_CUR)) < 0) ||
+ (ftruncate(arfd, cpos) < 0)) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to truncate archive file");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_app_ok()
+ * check if the last volume in the archive allows appends. We cannot check
+ * this until we are ready to write since there is no spec that says all
+ * volumes in a single archive have to be of the same type...
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if we can append, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_app_ok(void)
+#else
+int
+ar_app_ok()
+#endif
+{
+ if (artyp == ISPIPE) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot append to an archive obtained from a pipe.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if (!invld_rec)
+ return(0);
+ warn(1,"Cannot append, device record size %d does not support %s spec",
+ rdblksz, argv0);
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_read()
+ * read up to a specified number of bytes from the archive into the
+ * supplied buffer. When dealing with tapes we may not always be able to
+ * read what we want.
+ * Return:
+ * Number of bytes in buffer. 0 for end of file, -1 for a read error.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_read(register char *buf, register int cnt)
+#else
+int
+ar_read(buf, cnt)
+ register char *buf;
+ register int cnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * if last i/o was in error, no more reads until reset or new volume
+ */
+ if (lstrval <= 0)
+ return(lstrval);
+
+ /*
+ * how we read must be based on device type
+ */
+ switch (artyp) {
+ case ISTAPE:
+ if ((res = read(arfd, buf, cnt)) > 0) {
+ /*
+ * CAUTION: tape systems may not always return the same
+ * sized records so we leave blksz == MAXBLK. The
+ * physical record size that a tape drive supports is
+ * very hard to determine in a uniform and portable
+ * manner.
+ */
+ io_ok = 1;
+ if (res != rdblksz) {
+ /*
+ * Record size changed. If this is happens on
+ * any record after the first, we probably have
+ * a tape drive which has a fixed record size
+ * we are getting multiple records in a single
+ * read). Watch out for record blocking that
+ * violates pax spec (must be a multiple of
+ * BLKMULT).
+ */
+ rdblksz = res;
+ if (rdblksz % BLKMULT)
+ invld_rec = 1;
+ }
+ return(res);
+ }
+ break;
+ case ISREG:
+ case ISBLK:
+ case ISCHR:
+ case ISPIPE:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * Files are so easy to deal with. These other things cannot
+ * be trusted at all. So when we are dealing with character
+ * devices and pipes we just take what they have ready for us
+ * and return. Trying to do anything else with them runs the
+ * risk of failure.
+ */
+ if ((res = read(arfd, buf, cnt)) > 0) {
+ io_ok = 1;
+ return(res);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * We are in trouble at this point, something is broken...
+ */
+ lstrval = res;
+ if (res < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed read on archive volume %d", arvol);
+ else
+ warn(0, "End of archive volume %d reached", arvol);
+ return(res);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_write()
+ * Write a specified number of bytes in supplied buffer to the archive
+ * device so it appears as a single "block". Deals with errors and tries
+ * to recover when faced with short writes.
+ * Return:
+ * Number of bytes written. 0 indicates end of volume reached and with no
+ * flaws (as best that can be detected). A -1 indicates an unrecoverable
+ * error in the archive occured.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_write(register char *buf, register int bsz)
+#else
+int
+ar_write(buf, bsz)
+ register char *buf;
+ register int bsz;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res;
+ off_t cpos;
+
+ /*
+ * do not allow pax to create a "bad" archive. Once a write fails on
+ * an archive volume prevent further writes to it.
+ */
+ if (lstrval <= 0)
+ return(lstrval);
+
+ if ((res = write(arfd, buf, bsz)) == bsz) {
+ wr_trail = 1;
+ io_ok = 1;
+ return(bsz);
+ }
+ /*
+ * write broke, see what we can do with it. We try to send any partial
+ * writes that may violate pax spec to the next archive volume.
+ */
+ if (res < 0)
+ lstrval = res;
+ else
+ lstrval = 0;
+
+ switch (artyp) {
+ case ISREG:
+ if ((res > 0) && (res % BLKMULT)) {
+ /*
+ * try to fix up partial writes which are not BLKMULT
+ * in size by forcing the runt record to next archive
+ * volume
+ */
+ if ((cpos = lseek(arfd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_CUR)) < 0)
+ break;
+ cpos -= (off_t)res;
+ if (ftruncate(arfd, cpos) < 0)
+ break;
+ res = lstrval = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (res >= 0)
+ break;
+ /*
+ * if file is out of space, handle it like a return of 0
+ */
+ if ((errno == ENOSPC) || (errno == EFBIG) || (errno == EDQUOT))
+ res = lstrval = 0;
+ break;
+ case ISTAPE:
+ case ISCHR:
+ case ISBLK:
+ if (res >= 0)
+ break;
+ if (errno == EACCES) {
+ warn(0, "Write failed, archive is write protected.");
+ res = lstrval = 0;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ /*
+ * see if we reached the end of media, if so force a change to
+ * the next volume
+ */
+ if ((errno == ENOSPC) || (errno == EIO) || (errno == ENXIO))
+ res = lstrval = 0;
+ break;
+ case ISPIPE:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * we cannot fix errors to these devices
+ */
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Better tell the user the bad news...
+ * if this is a block aligned archive format, we may have a bad archive
+ * if the format wants the header to start at a BLKMULT boundry. While
+ * we can deal with the mis-aligned data, it violates spec and other
+ * archive readers will likely fail. if the format is not block
+ * aligned, the user may be lucky (and the archive is ok).
+ */
+ if (res >= 0) {
+ if (res > 0)
+ wr_trail = 1;
+ io_ok = 1;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If we were trying to rewrite the trailer and it didn't work, we
+ * must quit right away.
+ */
+ if (!wr_trail && (res <= 0)) {
+ warn(1,"Unable to append, trailer re-write failed. Quitting.");
+ return(res);
+ }
+
+ if (res == 0)
+ warn(0, "End of archive volume %d reached", arvol);
+ else if (res < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed write to archive volume: %d", arvol);
+ else if (!frmt->blkalgn || ((res % frmt->blkalgn) == 0))
+ warn(0,"WARNING: partial archive write. Archive MAY BE FLAWED");
+ else
+ warn(1,"WARNING: partial archive write. Archive IS FLAWED");
+ return(res);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_rdsync()
+ * Try to move past a bad spot on a flawed archive as needed to continue
+ * I/O. Clears error flags to allow I/O to continue.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 when ok to try i/o again, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_rdsync(void)
+#else
+int
+ar_rdsync()
+#endif
+{
+ long fsbz;
+ off_t cpos;
+ off_t mpos;
+ struct mtop mb;
+
+ /*
+ * Fail resync attempts at user request (done) or this is going to be
+ * an update/append to a existing archive. if last i/o hit media end,
+ * we need to go to the next volume not try a resync
+ */
+ if ((done > 0) || (lstrval == 0))
+ return(-1);
+
+ if ((act == APPND) || (act == ARCHIVE)) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot allow updates to an archive with flaws.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (io_ok)
+ did_io = 1;
+
+ switch(artyp) {
+ case ISTAPE:
+ /*
+ * if the last i/o was a successful data transfer, we assume
+ * the fault is just a bad record on the tape that we are now
+ * past. If we did not get any data since the last resync try
+ * to move the tape foward one PHYSICAL record past any
+ * damaged tape section. Some tape drives are stubborn and need
+ * to be pushed.
+ */
+ if (io_ok) {
+ io_ok = 0;
+ lstrval = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ mb.mt_op = MTFSR;
+ mb.mt_count = 1;
+ if (ioctl(arfd, MTIOCTOP, &mb) < 0)
+ break;
+ lstrval = 1;
+ break;
+ case ISREG:
+ case ISCHR:
+ case ISBLK:
+ /*
+ * try to step over the bad part of the device.
+ */
+ io_ok = 0;
+ if (((fsbz = arsb.st_blksize) <= 0) || (artyp != ISREG))
+ fsbz = BLKMULT;
+ if ((cpos = lseek(arfd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_CUR)) < 0)
+ break;
+ mpos = fsbz - (cpos % (off_t)fsbz);
+ if (lseek(arfd, mpos, SEEK_CUR) < 0)
+ break;
+ lstrval = 1;
+ break;
+ case ISPIPE:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * cannot recover on these archive device types
+ */
+ io_ok = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (lstrval <= 0) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to recover from an archive read failure.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ warn(0, "Attempting to recover from an archive read failure.");
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_fow()
+ * Move the I/O position within the archive foward the specified number of
+ * bytes as supported by the device. If we cannot move the requested
+ * number of bytes, return the actual number of bytes moved in skipped.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if moved the requested distance, -1 on complete failure, 1 on
+ * partial move (the amount moved is in skipped)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_fow(off_t sksz, off_t *skipped)
+#else
+int
+ar_fow(sksz, skipped)
+ off_t sksz;
+ off_t *skipped;
+#endif
+{
+ off_t cpos;
+ off_t mpos;
+
+ *skipped = 0;
+ if (sksz <= 0)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * we cannot move foward at EOF or error
+ */
+ if (lstrval <= 0)
+ return(lstrval);
+
+ /*
+ * Safer to read forward on devices where it is hard to find the end of
+ * the media without reading to it. With tapes we cannot be sure of the
+ * number of physical blocks to skip (we do not know physical block
+ * size at this point), so we must only read foward on tapes!
+ */
+ if (artyp != ISREG)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * figure out where we are in the archive
+ */
+ if ((cpos = lseek(arfd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_CUR)) >= 0) {
+ /*
+ * we can be asked to move farther than there are bytes in this
+ * volume, if so, just go to file end and let normal buf_fill()
+ * deal with the end of file (it will go to next volume by
+ * itself)
+ */
+ if ((mpos = cpos + sksz) > arsb.st_size) {
+ *skipped = arsb.st_size - cpos;
+ mpos = arsb.st_size;
+ } else
+ *skipped = sksz;
+ if (lseek(arfd, mpos, SEEK_SET) >= 0)
+ return(0);
+ }
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Foward positioning operation on archive failed");
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_rev()
+ * move the i/o position within the archive backwards the specified byte
+ * count as supported by the device. With tapes drives we RESET rdblksz to
+ * the PHYSICAL blocksize.
+ * NOTE: We should only be called to move backwards so we can rewrite the
+ * last records (the trailer) of an archive (APPEND).
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if moved the requested distance, -1 on complete failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_rev(off_t sksz)
+#else
+int
+ar_rev(sksz)
+ off_t sksz;
+#endif
+{
+ off_t cpos;
+ struct mtop mb;
+ register int phyblk;
+
+ /*
+ * make sure we do not have try to reverse on a flawed archive
+ */
+ if (lstrval < 0)
+ return(lstrval);
+
+ switch(artyp) {
+ case ISPIPE:
+ if (sksz <= 0)
+ break;
+ /*
+ * cannot go backwards on these critters
+ */
+ warn(1, "Reverse positioning on pipes is not supported.");
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ case ISREG:
+ case ISBLK:
+ case ISCHR:
+ default:
+ if (sksz <= 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * For things other than files, backwards movement has a very
+ * high probability of failure as we really do not know the
+ * true attributes of the device we are talking to (the device
+ * may not even have the ability to lseek() in any direction).
+ * First we figure out where we are in the archive.
+ */
+ if ((cpos = lseek(arfd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_CUR)) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno,
+ "Unable to obtain current archive byte offset");
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we may try to go backwards past the start when the archive
+ * is only a single record. If this hapens and we are on a
+ * multi volume archive, we need to go to the end of the
+ * previous volume and continue our movement backwards from
+ * there.
+ */
+ if ((cpos -= sksz) < (off_t)0L) {
+ if (arvol > 1) {
+ /*
+ * this should never happen
+ */
+ warn(1,"Reverse position on previous volume.");
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ cpos = (off_t)0L;
+ }
+ if (lseek(arfd, cpos, SEEK_SET) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to seek archive backwards");
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case ISTAPE:
+ /*
+ * Calculate and move the proper number of PHYSICAL tape
+ * blocks. If the sksz is not an even multiple of the physical
+ * tape size, we cannot do the move (this should never happen).
+ * (We also cannot handler trailers spread over two vols).
+ * get_phys() also makes sure we are in front of the filemark.
+ */
+ if ((phyblk = get_phys()) <= 0) {
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * make sure future tape reads only go by physical tape block
+ * size (set rdblksz to the real size).
+ */
+ rdblksz = phyblk;
+
+ /*
+ * if no movement is required, just return (we must be after
+ * get_phys() so the physical blocksize is properly set)
+ */
+ if (sksz <= 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * ok we have to move. Make sure the tape drive can do it.
+ */
+ if (sksz % phyblk) {
+ warn(1,
+ "Tape drive unable to backspace requested amount");
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * move backwards the requested number of bytes
+ */
+ mb.mt_op = MTBSR;
+ mb.mt_count = sksz/phyblk;
+ if (ioctl(arfd, MTIOCTOP, &mb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1,errno, "Unable to backspace tape %d blocks.",
+ mb.mt_count);
+ lstrval = -1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ lstrval = 1;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * get_phys()
+ * Determine the physical block size on a tape drive. We need the physical
+ * block size so we know how many bytes we skip over when we move with
+ * mtio commands. We also make sure we are BEFORE THE TAPE FILEMARK when
+ * return.
+ * This is one really SLOW routine...
+ * Return:
+ * physical block size if ok (ok > 0), -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+get_phys(void)
+#else
+static int
+get_phys()
+#endif
+{
+ register int padsz = 0;
+ register int res;
+ register int phyblk;
+ struct mtop mb;
+ char scbuf[MAXBLK];
+
+ /*
+ * move to the file mark, and then back up one record and read it.
+ * this should tell us the physical record size the tape is using.
+ */
+ if (lstrval == 1) {
+ /*
+ * we know we are at file mark when we get back a 0 from
+ * read()
+ */
+ while ((res = read(arfd, scbuf, sizeof(scbuf))) > 0)
+ padsz += res;
+ if (res < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to locate tape filemark.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * move backwards over the file mark so we are at the end of the
+ * last record.
+ */
+ mb.mt_op = MTBSF;
+ mb.mt_count = 1;
+ if (ioctl(arfd, MTIOCTOP, &mb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to backspace over tape filemark.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * move backwards so we are in front of the last record and read it to
+ * get physical tape blocksize.
+ */
+ mb.mt_op = MTBSR;
+ mb.mt_count = 1;
+ if (ioctl(arfd, MTIOCTOP, &mb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to backspace over last tape block.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if ((phyblk = read(arfd, scbuf, sizeof(scbuf))) <= 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Cannot determine archive tape blocksize.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * read foward to the file mark, then back up in front of the filemark
+ * (this is a bit paranoid, but should be safe to do).
+ */
+ while ((res = read(arfd, scbuf, sizeof(scbuf))) > 0)
+ ;
+ if (res < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to locate tape filemark.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ mb.mt_op = MTBSF;
+ mb.mt_count = 1;
+ if (ioctl(arfd, MTIOCTOP, &mb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to backspace over tape filemark.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * set lstrval so we know that the filemark has not been seen
+ */
+ lstrval = 1;
+
+ /*
+ * return if there was no padding
+ */
+ if (padsz == 0)
+ return(phyblk);
+
+ /*
+ * make sure we can move backwards over the padding. (this should
+ * never fail).
+ */
+ if (padsz % phyblk) {
+ warn(1, "Tape drive unable to backspace requested amount");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * move backwards over the padding so the head is where it was when
+ * we were first called (if required).
+ */
+ mb.mt_op = MTBSR;
+ mb.mt_count = padsz/phyblk;
+ if (ioctl(arfd, MTIOCTOP, &mb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1,errno,"Unable to backspace tape over %d pad blocks",
+ mb.mt_count);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(phyblk);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ar_next()
+ * prompts the user for the next volume in this archive. For some devices
+ * we may allow the media to be changed. Otherwise a new archive is
+ * prompted for. By pax spec, if there is no controlling tty or an eof is
+ * read on tty input, we must quit pax.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 when ready to continue, -1 when all done
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ar_next(void)
+#else
+int
+ar_next()
+#endif
+{
+ char buf[PAXPATHLEN+2];
+ static int freeit = 0;
+ sigset_t o_mask;
+
+ /*
+ * WE MUST CLOSE THE DEVICE. A lot of devices must see last close, (so
+ * things like writing EOF etc will be done) (Watch out ar_close() can
+ * also be called via a signal handler, so we must prevent a race.
+ */
+ if (sigprocmask(SIG_BLOCK, &s_mask, &o_mask) < 0)
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Unable to set signal mask");
+ ar_close();
+ if (sigprocmask(SIG_SETMASK, &o_mask, (sigset_t *)NULL) < 0)
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Unable to restore signal mask");
+
+ if (done || !wr_trail)
+ return(-1);
+
+ tty_prnt("\nATTENTION! %s archive volume change required.\n", argv0);
+
+ /*
+ * if i/o is on stdin or stdout, we cannot reopen it (we do not know
+ * the name), the user will be forced to type it in.
+ */
+ if (strcmp(arcname, STDO) && strcmp(arcname, STDN) && (artyp != ISREG)
+ && (artyp != ISPIPE)) {
+ if (artyp == ISTAPE) {
+ tty_prnt("%s ready for archive tape volume: %d\n",
+ arcname, arvol);
+ tty_prnt("Load the NEXT TAPE on the tape drive");
+ } else {
+ tty_prnt("%s ready for archive volume: %d\n",
+ arcname, arvol);
+ tty_prnt("Load the NEXT STORAGE MEDIA (if required)");
+ }
+
+ if ((act == ARCHIVE) || (act == APPND))
+ tty_prnt(" and make sure it is WRITE ENABLED.\n");
+ else
+ tty_prnt("\n");
+
+ for(;;) {
+ tty_prnt("Type \"y\" to continue, \".\" to quit %s,",
+ argv0);
+ tty_prnt(" or \"s\" to switch to new device.\nIf you");
+ tty_prnt(" cannot change storage media, type \"s\"\n");
+ tty_prnt("Is the device ready and online? > ");
+
+ if ((tty_read(buf,sizeof(buf))<0) || !strcmp(buf,".")){
+ done = 1;
+ lstrval = -1;
+ tty_prnt("Quitting %s!\n", argv0);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if ((buf[0] == '\0') || (buf[1] != '\0')) {
+ tty_prnt("%s unknown command, try again\n",buf);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ switch (buf[0]) {
+ case 'y':
+ case 'Y':
+ /*
+ * we are to continue with the same device
+ */
+ if (ar_open(arcname) >= 0)
+ return(0);
+ tty_prnt("Cannot re-open %s, try again\n",
+ arcname);
+ continue;
+ case 's':
+ case 'S':
+ /*
+ * user wants to open a different device
+ */
+ tty_prnt("Switching to a different archive\n");
+ break;
+ default:
+ tty_prnt("%s unknown command, try again\n",buf);
+ continue;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ } else
+ tty_prnt("Ready for archive volume: %d\n", arvol);
+
+ /*
+ * have to go to a different archive
+ */
+ for (;;) {
+ tty_prnt("Input archive name or \".\" to quit %s.\n", argv0);
+ tty_prnt("Archive name > ");
+
+ if ((tty_read(buf, sizeof(buf)) < 0) || !strcmp(buf, ".")) {
+ done = 1;
+ lstrval = -1;
+ tty_prnt("Quitting %s!\n", argv0);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (buf[0] == '\0') {
+ tty_prnt("Empty file name, try again\n");
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (!strcmp(buf, "..")) {
+ tty_prnt("Illegal file name: .. try again\n");
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (strlen(buf) > PAXPATHLEN) {
+ tty_prnt("File name too long, try again\n");
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * try to open new archive
+ */
+ if (ar_open(buf) >= 0) {
+ if (freeit) {
+ (void)free(arcname);
+ freeit = 0;
+ }
+ if ((arcname = strdup(buf)) == NULL) {
+ done = 1;
+ lstrval = -1;
+ warn(0, "Cannot save archive name.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ freeit = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ tty_prnt("Cannot open %s, try again\n", buf);
+ continue;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/ar_subs.c b/bin/pax/ar_subs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5d6d3c6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/ar_subs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1238 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)ar_subs.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void wr_archive __P((register ARCHD *, int is_app));
+static int get_arc __P((void));
+static int next_head __P((register ARCHD *));
+extern sigset_t s_mask;
+
+/*
+ * Routines which control the overall operation modes of pax as specified by
+ * the user: list, append, read ...
+ */
+
+static char hdbuf[BLKMULT]; /* space for archive header on read */
+u_long flcnt; /* number of files processed */
+
+/*
+ * list()
+ * list the contents of an archive which match user supplied pattern(s)
+ * (no pattern matches all).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+list(void)
+#else
+void
+list()
+#endif
+{
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register int res;
+ ARCHD archd;
+ time_t now;
+
+ arcn = &archd;
+ /*
+ * figure out archive type; pass any format specific options to the
+ * archive option processing routine; call the format init routine. We
+ * also save current time for ls_list() so we do not make a system
+ * call for each file we need to print. If verbose (vflag) start up
+ * the name and group caches.
+ */
+ if ((get_arc() < 0) || ((*frmt->options)() < 0) ||
+ ((*frmt->st_rd)() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ if (vflag && ((uidtb_start() < 0) || (gidtb_start() < 0)))
+ return;
+
+ now = time((time_t *)NULL);
+
+ /*
+ * step through the archive until the format says it is done
+ */
+ while (next_head(arcn) == 0) {
+ /*
+ * check for pattern, and user specified options match.
+ * When all patterns are matched we are done.
+ */
+ if ((res = pat_match(arcn)) < 0)
+ break;
+
+ if ((res == 0) && (sel_chk(arcn) == 0)) {
+ /*
+ * pattern resulted in a selected file
+ */
+ if (pat_sel(arcn) < 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * modify the name as requested by the user if name
+ * survives modification, do a listing of the file
+ */
+ if ((res = mod_name(arcn)) < 0)
+ break;
+ if (res == 0)
+ ls_list(arcn, now);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * skip to next archive format header using values calculated
+ * by the format header read routine
+ */
+ if (rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad) == 1)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * all done, let format have a chance to cleanup, and make sure that
+ * the patterns supplied by the user were all matched
+ */
+ (void)(*frmt->end_rd)();
+ (void)sigprocmask(SIG_BLOCK, &s_mask, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+ ar_close();
+ pat_chk();
+}
+
+/*
+ * extract()
+ * extract the member(s) of an archive as specified by user supplied
+ * pattern(s) (no patterns extracts all members)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+extract(void)
+#else
+void
+extract()
+#endif
+{
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register int res;
+ off_t cnt;
+ ARCHD archd;
+ struct stat sb;
+ int fd;
+
+ arcn = &archd;
+ /*
+ * figure out archive type; pass any format specific options to the
+ * archive option processing routine; call the format init routine;
+ * start up the directory modification time and access mode database
+ */
+ if ((get_arc() < 0) || ((*frmt->options)() < 0) ||
+ ((*frmt->st_rd)() < 0) || (dir_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * When we are doing interactive rename, we store the mapping of names
+ * so we can fix up hard links files later in the archive.
+ */
+ if (iflag && (name_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * step through each entry on the archive until the format read routine
+ * says it is done
+ */
+ while (next_head(arcn) == 0) {
+
+ /*
+ * check for pattern, and user specified options match. When
+ * all the patterns are matched we are done
+ */
+ if ((res = pat_match(arcn)) < 0)
+ break;
+
+ if ((res > 0) || (sel_chk(arcn) != 0)) {
+ /*
+ * file is not selected. skip past any file data and
+ * padding and go back for the next archive member
+ */
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * with -u or -D only extract when the archive member is newer
+ * than the file with the same name in the file system (nos
+ * test of being the same type is required).
+ * NOTE: this test is done BEFORE name modifications as
+ * specified by pax. this operation can be confusing to the
+ * user who might expect the test to be done on an existing
+ * file AFTER the name mod. In honesty the pax spec is probably
+ * flawed in this respect.
+ */
+ if ((uflag || Dflag) && ((lstat(arcn->name, &sb) == 0))) {
+ if (uflag && Dflag) {
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime)) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if (Dflag) {
+ if (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * this archive member is now been selected. modify the name.
+ */
+ if ((pat_sel(arcn) < 0) || ((res = mod_name(arcn)) < 0))
+ break;
+ if (res > 0) {
+ /*
+ * a bad name mod, skip and purge name from link table
+ */
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Non standard -Y and -Z flag. When the exisiting file is
+ * same age or newer skip
+ */
+ if ((Yflag || Zflag) && ((lstat(arcn->name, &sb) == 0))) {
+ if (Yflag && Zflag) {
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime)) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if (Yflag) {
+ if (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ if (vflag) {
+ (void)fputs(arcn->name, stderr);
+ vfpart = 1;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * all ok, extract this member based on type
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type != PAX_REG) && (arcn->type != PAX_CTG)) {
+ /*
+ * process archive members that are not regular files.
+ * throw out padding and any data that might follow the
+ * header (as determined by the format).
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_HLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ res = lnk_creat(arcn);
+ else
+ res = node_creat(arcn);
+
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ if (res < 0)
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+ /*
+ * we have a file with data here. If we can not create it, skip
+ * over the data and purge the name from hard link table
+ */
+ if ((fd = file_creat(arcn)) < 0) {
+ (void)rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad);
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ continue;
+ }
+ /*
+ * extract the file from the archive and skip over padding and
+ * any unprocessed data
+ */
+ res = (*frmt->rd_data)(arcn, fd, &cnt);
+ file_close(arcn, fd);
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ if (!res)
+ (void)rd_skip(cnt + arcn->pad);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * all done, restore directory modes and times as required; make sure
+ * all patterns supplied by the user were matched; block off signals
+ * to avoid chance for multiple entry into the cleanup code.
+ */
+ (void)(*frmt->end_rd)();
+ (void)sigprocmask(SIG_BLOCK, &s_mask, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+ ar_close();
+ proc_dir();
+ pat_chk();
+}
+
+/*
+ * wr_archive()
+ * Write an archive. used in both creating a new archive and appends on
+ * previously written archive.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static void
+wr_archive(register ARCHD *arcn, int is_app)
+#else
+static void
+wr_archive(arcn, is_app)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ int is_app;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res;
+ register int hlk;
+ register int wr_one;
+ off_t cnt;
+ int (*wrf)();
+ int fd = -1;
+
+ /*
+ * if this format supports hard link storage, start up the database
+ * that detects them.
+ */
+ if (((hlk = frmt->hlk) == 1) && (lnk_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * start up the file traversal code and format specific write
+ */
+ if ((ftree_start() < 0) || ((*frmt->st_wr)() < 0))
+ return;
+ wrf = frmt->wr;
+
+ /*
+ * When we are doing interactive rename, we store the mapping of names
+ * so we can fix up hard links files later in the archive.
+ */
+ if (iflag && (name_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * if this not append, and there are no files, we do no write a trailer
+ */
+ wr_one = is_app;
+
+ /*
+ * while there are files to archive, process them one at at time
+ */
+ while (next_file(arcn) == 0) {
+ /*
+ * check if this file meets user specified options match.
+ */
+ if (sel_chk(arcn) != 0)
+ continue;
+ fd = -1;
+ if (uflag) {
+ /*
+ * only archive if this file is newer than a file with
+ * the same name that is already stored on the archive
+ */
+ if ((res = chk_ftime(arcn)) < 0)
+ break;
+ if (res > 0)
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * this file is considered selected now. see if this is a hard
+ * link to a file already stored
+ */
+ ftree_sel(arcn);
+ if (hlk && (chk_lnk(arcn) < 0))
+ break;
+
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_REG) || (arcn->type == PAX_HRG) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_CTG)) {
+ /*
+ * we will have to read this file. by opening it now we
+ * can avoid writing a header to the archive for a file
+ * we were later unable to read (we also purge it from
+ * the link table).
+ */
+ if ((fd = open(arcn->org_name, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1,errno, "Unable to open %s to read",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Now modify the name as requested by the user
+ */
+ if ((res = mod_name(arcn)) < 0) {
+ /*
+ * name modification says to skip this file, close the
+ * file and purge link table entry
+ */
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fd);
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if ((res > 0) || (docrc && (set_crc(arcn, fd) < 0))) {
+ /*
+ * unable to obtain the crc we need, close the file,
+ * purge link table entry
+ */
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fd);
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (vflag) {
+ (void)fputs(arcn->name, stderr);
+ vfpart = 1;
+ }
+ ++flcnt;
+
+ /*
+ * looks safe to store the file, have the format specific
+ * routine write routine store the file header on the archive
+ */
+ if ((res = (*wrf)(arcn)) < 0) {
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fd);
+ break;
+ }
+ wr_one = 1;
+ if (res > 0) {
+ /*
+ * format write says no file data needs to be stored
+ * so we are done messing with this file
+ */
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fd);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Add file data to the archive, quit on write error. if we
+ * cannot write the entire file contents to the archive we
+ * must pad the archive to replace the missing file data
+ * (otherwise during an extract the file header for the file
+ * which FOLLOWS this one will not be where we expect it to
+ * be).
+ */
+ res = (*frmt->wr_data)(arcn, fd, &cnt);
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fd);
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ if (res < 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * pad as required, cnt is number of bytes not written
+ */
+ if (((cnt > 0) && (wr_skip(cnt) < 0)) ||
+ ((arcn->pad > 0) && (wr_skip(arcn->pad) < 0)))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * tell format to write trailer; pad to block boundry; reset directory
+ * mode/access times, and check if all patterns supplied by the user
+ * were matched. block off signals to avoid chance for multiple entry
+ * into the cleanup code
+ */
+ if (wr_one) {
+ (*frmt->end_wr)();
+ wr_fin();
+ }
+ (void)sigprocmask(SIG_BLOCK, &s_mask, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+ ar_close();
+ if (tflag)
+ proc_dir();
+ ftree_chk();
+}
+
+/*
+ * append()
+ * Add file to previously written archive. Archive format specified by the
+ * user must agree with archive. The archive is read first to collect
+ * modification times (if -u) and locate the archive trailer. The archive
+ * is positioned in front of the record with the trailer and wr_archive()
+ * is called to add the new members.
+ * PAX IMPLEMENTATION DETAIL NOTE:
+ * -u is implemented by adding the new members to the end of the archive.
+ * Care is taken so that these do not end up as links to the older
+ * version of the same file already stored in the archive. It is expected
+ * when extraction occurs these newer versions will over-write the older
+ * ones stored "earlier" in the archive (this may be a bad assumption as
+ * it depends on the implementation of the program doing the extraction).
+ * It is really difficult to splice in members without either re-writing
+ * the entire archive (from the point were the old version was), or having
+ * assistance of the format specification in terms of a special update
+ * header that invalidates a previous archive record. The posix spec left
+ * the method used to implement -u unspecified. This pax is able to
+ * over write existing files that it creates.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+append(void)
+#else
+void
+append()
+#endif
+{
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register int res;
+ ARCHD archd;
+ FSUB *orgfrmt;
+ int udev;
+ off_t tlen;
+
+ arcn = &archd;
+ orgfrmt = frmt;
+
+ /*
+ * Do not allow an append operation if the actual archive is of a
+ * different format than the user specified foramt.
+ */
+ if (get_arc() < 0)
+ return;
+ if ((orgfrmt != NULL) && (orgfrmt != frmt)) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot mix current archive format %s with %s",
+ frmt->name, orgfrmt->name);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * pass the format any options and start up format
+ */
+ if (((*frmt->options)() < 0) || ((*frmt->st_rd)() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * if we only are adding members that are newer, we need to save the
+ * mod times for all files we see.
+ */
+ if (uflag && (ftime_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * some archive formats encode hard links by recording the device and
+ * file serial number (inode) but copy the file anyway (multiple times)
+ * to the archive. When we append, we run the risk that newly added
+ * files may have the same device and inode numbers as those recorded
+ * on the archive but during a previous run. If this happens, when the
+ * archive is extracted we get INCORRECT hard links. We avoid this by
+ * remapping the device numbers so that newly added files will never
+ * use the same device number as one found on the archive. remapping
+ * allows new members to safely have links among themselves. remapping
+ * also avoids problems with file inode (serial number) truncations
+ * when the inode number is larger than storage space in the archive
+ * header. See the remap routines for more details.
+ */
+ if ((udev = frmt->udev) && (dev_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * reading the archive may take a long time. If verbose tell the user
+ */
+ if (vflag) {
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "%s: Reading archive to position at the end...", argv0);
+ vfpart = 1;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * step through the archive until the format says it is done
+ */
+ while (next_head(arcn) == 0) {
+ /*
+ * check if this file meets user specified options.
+ */
+ if (sel_chk(arcn) != 0) {
+ if (rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad) == 1)
+ break;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (uflag) {
+ /*
+ * see if this is the newest version of this file has
+ * already been seen, if so skip.
+ */
+ if ((res = chk_ftime(arcn)) < 0)
+ break;
+ if (res > 0) {
+ if (rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad) == 1)
+ break;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Store this device number. Device numbers seen during the
+ * read phase of append will cause newly appended files with a
+ * device number seen in the old part of the archive to be
+ * remapped to an unused device number.
+ */
+ if ((udev && (add_dev(arcn) < 0)) ||
+ (rd_skip(arcn->skip + arcn->pad) == 1))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * done, finish up read and get the number of bytes to back up so we
+ * can add new members. The format might have used the hard link table,
+ * purge it.
+ */
+ tlen = (*frmt->end_rd)();
+ lnk_end();
+
+ /*
+ * try to postion for write, if this fails quit. if any error occurs,
+ * we will refuse to write
+ */
+ if (appnd_start(tlen) < 0)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * tell the user we are done reading.
+ */
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)fputs("done.\n", stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * go to the writing phase to add the new members
+ */
+ wr_archive(arcn, 1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * archive()
+ * write a new archive
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+archive(void)
+#else
+void
+archive()
+#endif
+{
+ ARCHD archd;
+
+ /*
+ * if we only are adding members that are newer, we need to save the
+ * mod times for all files; set up for writing; pass the format any
+ * options write the archive
+ */
+ if ((uflag && (ftime_start() < 0)) || (wr_start() < 0))
+ return;
+ if ((*frmt->options)() < 0)
+ return;
+
+ wr_archive(&archd, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * copy()
+ * copy files from one part of the file system to another. this does not
+ * use any archive storage. The EFFECT OF THE COPY IS THE SAME as if an
+ * archive was written and then extracted in the destination directory
+ * (except the files are forced to be under the destination directory).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+copy(void)
+#else
+void
+copy()
+#endif
+{
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register int res;
+ register int fddest;
+ register char *dest_pt;
+ register int dlen;
+ register int drem;
+ int fdsrc = -1;
+ struct stat sb;
+ ARCHD archd;
+ char dirbuf[PAXPATHLEN+1];
+
+ arcn = &archd;
+ /*
+ * set up the destination dir path and make sure it is a directory. We
+ * make sure we have a trailing / on the destination
+ */
+ dlen = l_strncpy(dirbuf, dirptr, PAXPATHLEN);
+ dest_pt = dirbuf + dlen;
+ if (*(dest_pt-1) != '/') {
+ *dest_pt++ = '/';
+ ++dlen;
+ }
+ *dest_pt = '\0';
+ drem = PAXPATHLEN - dlen;
+
+ if (stat(dirptr, &sb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Cannot access destination directory %s",
+ dirptr);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (!S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) {
+ warn(1, "Destination is not a directory %s", dirptr);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * start up the hard link table; file traversal routines and the
+ * modification time and access mode database
+ */
+ if ((lnk_start() < 0) || (ftree_start() < 0) || (dir_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * When we are doing interactive rename, we store the mapping of names
+ * so we can fix up hard links files later in the archive.
+ */
+ if (iflag && (name_start() < 0))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * set up to cp file trees
+ */
+ cp_start();
+
+ /*
+ * while there are files to archive, process them
+ */
+ while (next_file(arcn) == 0) {
+ fdsrc = -1;
+
+ /*
+ * check if this file meets user specified options
+ */
+ if (sel_chk(arcn) != 0)
+ continue;
+
+ /*
+ * if there is already a file in the destination directory with
+ * the same name and it is newer, skip the one stored on the
+ * archive.
+ * NOTE: this test is done BEFORE name modifications as
+ * specified by pax. this can be confusing to the user who
+ * might expect the test to be done on an existing file AFTER
+ * the name mod. In honesty the pax spec is probably flawed in
+ * this respect
+ */
+ if (uflag || Dflag) {
+ /*
+ * create the destination name
+ */
+ if (*(arcn->name) == '/')
+ res = 1;
+ else
+ res = 0;
+ if ((arcn->nlen - res) > drem) {
+ warn(1, "Destination pathname too long %s",
+ arcn->name);
+ continue;
+ }
+ (void)strncpy(dest_pt, arcn->name + res, drem);
+ dirbuf[PAXPATHLEN] = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * if existing file is same age or newer skip
+ */
+ res = lstat(dirbuf, &sb);
+ *dest_pt = '\0';
+
+ if (res == 0) {
+ if (uflag && Dflag) {
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_mtime<=sb.st_mtime) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime<=sb.st_ctime))
+ continue;
+ } else if (Dflag) {
+ if (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime)
+ continue;
+ } else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime)
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * this file is considered selected. See if this is a hard link
+ * to a previous file; modify the name as requested by the
+ * user; set the final destination.
+ */
+ ftree_sel(arcn);
+ if ((chk_lnk(arcn) < 0) || ((res = mod_name(arcn)) < 0))
+ break;
+ if ((res > 0) || (set_dest(arcn, dirbuf, dlen) < 0)) {
+ /*
+ * skip file, purge from link table
+ */
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Non standard -Y and -Z flag. When the exisiting file is
+ * same age or newer skip
+ */
+ if ((Yflag || Zflag) && ((lstat(arcn->name, &sb) == 0))) {
+ if (Yflag && Zflag) {
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime))
+ continue;
+ } else if (Yflag) {
+ if (arcn->sb.st_ctime <= sb.st_ctime)
+ continue;
+ } else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime <= sb.st_mtime)
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (vflag) {
+ (void)fputs(arcn->name, stderr);
+ vfpart = 1;
+ }
+ ++flcnt;
+
+ /*
+ * try to create a hard link to the src file if requested
+ * but make sure we are not trying to overwrite ourselves.
+ */
+ if (lflag)
+ res = cross_lnk(arcn);
+ else
+ res = chk_same(arcn);
+ if (res <= 0) {
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * have to create a new file
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type != PAX_REG) && (arcn->type != PAX_CTG)) {
+ /*
+ * create a link or special file
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_HLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ res = lnk_creat(arcn);
+ else
+ res = node_creat(arcn);
+ if (res < 0)
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * have to copy a regular file to the destination directory.
+ * first open source file and then create the destination file
+ */
+ if ((fdsrc = open(arcn->org_name, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to open %s to read",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if ((fddest = file_creat(arcn)) < 0) {
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fdsrc);
+ purg_lnk(arcn);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * copy source file data to the destination file
+ */
+ cp_file(arcn, fdsrc, fddest);
+ file_close(arcn, fddest);
+ rdfile_close(arcn, &fdsrc);
+
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * restore directory modes and times as required; make sure all
+ * patterns were selected block off signals to avoid chance for
+ * multiple entry into the cleanup code.
+ */
+ (void)sigprocmask(SIG_BLOCK, &s_mask, (sigset_t *)NULL);
+ ar_close();
+ proc_dir();
+ ftree_chk();
+}
+
+/*
+ * next_head()
+ * try to find a valid header in the archive. Uses format specific
+ * routines to extract the header and id the trailer. Trailers may be
+ * located within a valid header or in an invalid header (the location
+ * is format specific. The inhead field from the option table tells us
+ * where to look for the trailer).
+ * We keep reading (and resyncing) until we get enough contiguous data
+ * to check for a header. If we cannot find one, we shift by a byte
+ * add a new byte from the archive to the end of the buffer and try again.
+ * If we get a read error, we throw out what we have (as we must have
+ * contiguous data) and start over again.
+ * ASSUMED: headers fit within a BLKMULT header.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if we got a header, -1 if we are unable to ever find another one
+ * (we reached the end of input, or we reached the limit on retries. see
+ * the specs for rd_wrbuf() for more details)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+next_head(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+next_head(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register int ret;
+ register char *hdend;
+ register int res;
+ register int shftsz;
+ register int hsz;
+ register int in_resync = 0; /* set when we are in resync mode */
+ int cnt = 0; /* counter for trailer function */
+
+ /*
+ * set up initial conditions, we want a whole frmt->hsz block as we
+ * have no data yet.
+ */
+ res = hsz = frmt->hsz;
+ hdend = hdbuf;
+ shftsz = hsz - 1;
+ for(;;) {
+ /*
+ * keep looping until we get a contiguous FULL buffer
+ * (frmt->hsz is the proper size)
+ */
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((ret = rd_wrbuf(hdend, res)) == res)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * some kind of archive read problem, try to resync the
+ * storage device, better give the user the bad news.
+ */
+ if ((ret == 0) || (rd_sync() < 0)) {
+ warn(1,"Premature end of file on archive read");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (!in_resync) {
+ if (act == APPND) {
+ warn(1,
+ "Archive I/O error, cannot continue");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ warn(1,"Archive I/O error. Trying to recover.");
+ ++in_resync;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * oh well, throw it all out and start over
+ */
+ res = hsz;
+ hdend = hdbuf;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * ok we have a contiguous buffer of the right size. Call the
+ * format read routine. If this was not a valid header and this
+ * format stores trailers outside of the header, call the
+ * format specific trailer routine to check for a trailer. We
+ * have to watch out that we do not mis-identify file data or
+ * block padding as a header or trailer. Format specific
+ * trailer functions must NOT check for the trailer while we
+ * are running in resync mode. Some trailer functions may tell
+ * us that this block cannot contain a valid header either, so
+ * we then throw out the entire block and start over.
+ */
+ if ((*frmt->rd)(arcn, hdbuf) == 0)
+ break;
+
+ if (!frmt->inhead) {
+ /*
+ * this format has trailers outside of valid headers
+ */
+ if ((ret = (*frmt->trail)(hdbuf,in_resync,&cnt)) == 0){
+ /*
+ * valid trailer found, drain input as required
+ */
+ ar_drain();
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if (ret == 1) {
+ /*
+ * we are in resync and we were told to throw
+ * the whole block out because none of the
+ * bytes in this block can be used to form a
+ * valid header
+ */
+ res = hsz;
+ hdend = hdbuf;
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Brute force section.
+ * not a valid header. We may be able to find a header yet. So
+ * we shift over by one byte, and set up to read one byte at a
+ * time from the archive and place it at the end of the buffer.
+ * We will keep moving byte at a time until we find a header or
+ * get a read error and have to start over.
+ */
+ if (!in_resync) {
+ if (act == APPND) {
+ warn(1,"Unable to append, archive header flaw");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ warn(1,"Invalid header, starting valid header search.");
+ ++in_resync;
+ }
+ bcopy(hdbuf+1, hdbuf, shftsz);
+ res = 1;
+ hdend = hdbuf + shftsz;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * ok got a valid header, check for trailer if format encodes it in the
+ * the header. NOTE: the parameters are different than trailer routines
+ * which encode trailers outside of the header!
+ */
+ if (frmt->inhead && ((*frmt->trail)(arcn) == 0)) {
+ /*
+ * valid trailer found, drain input as required
+ */
+ ar_drain();
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ ++flcnt;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * get_arc()
+ * Figure out what format an archive is. Handles archive with flaws by
+ * brute force searches for a legal header in any supported format. The
+ * format id routines have to be careful to NOT mis-identify a format.
+ * ASSUMED: headers fit within a BLKMULT header.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if archive found -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+get_arc(void)
+#else
+static int
+get_arc()
+#endif
+{
+ register int i;
+ register int hdsz = 0;
+ register int res;
+ register int minhd = BLKMULT;
+ char *hdend;
+ int notice = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * find the smallest header size in all archive formats and then set up
+ * to read the archive.
+ */
+ for (i = 0; ford[i] >= 0; ++i) {
+ if (fsub[ford[i]].hsz < minhd)
+ minhd = fsub[ford[i]].hsz;
+ }
+ if (rd_start() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ res = BLKMULT;
+ hdsz = 0;
+ hdend = hdbuf;
+ for(;;) {
+ for (;;) {
+ /*
+ * fill the buffer with at least the smallest header
+ */
+ i = rd_wrbuf(hdend, res);
+ if (i > 0)
+ hdsz += i;
+ if (hdsz >= minhd)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * if we cannot recover from a read error quit
+ */
+ if ((i == 0) || (rd_sync() < 0))
+ goto out;
+
+ /*
+ * when we get an error none of the data we already
+ * have can be used to create a legal header (we just
+ * got an error in the middle), so we throw it all out
+ * and refill the buffer with fresh data.
+ */
+ res = BLKMULT;
+ hdsz = 0;
+ hdend = hdbuf;
+ if (!notice) {
+ if (act == APPND)
+ return(-1);
+ warn(1,"Cannot identify format. Searching...");
+ ++notice;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we have at least the size of the smallest header in any
+ * archive format. Look to see if we have a match. The array
+ * ford[] is used to specify the header id order to reduce the
+ * chance of incorrectly id'ing a valid header (some formats
+ * may be subsets of each other and the order would then be
+ * important).
+ */
+ for (i = 0; ford[i] >= 0; ++i) {
+ if ((*fsub[ford[i]].id)(hdbuf, hdsz) < 0)
+ continue;
+ frmt = &(fsub[ford[i]]);
+ /*
+ * yuck, to avoid slow special case code in the extract
+ * routines, just push this header back as if it was
+ * not seen. We have left extra space at start of the
+ * buffer for this purpose. This is a bit ugly, but
+ * adding all the special case code is far worse.
+ */
+ pback(hdbuf, hdsz);
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * We have a flawed archive, no match. we start searching, but
+ * we never allow additions to flawed archives
+ */
+ if (!notice) {
+ if (act == APPND)
+ return(-1);
+ warn(1, "Cannot identify format. Searching...");
+ ++notice;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * brute force search for a header that we can id.
+ * we shift through byte at a time. this is slow, but we cannot
+ * determine the nature of the flaw in the archive in a
+ * portable manner
+ */
+ if (--hdsz > 0) {
+ bcopy(hdbuf+1, hdbuf, hdsz);
+ res = BLKMULT - hdsz;
+ hdend = hdbuf + hdsz;
+ } else {
+ res = BLKMULT;
+ hdend = hdbuf;
+ hdsz = 0;
+ }
+ }
+
+ out:
+ /*
+ * we cannot find a header, bow, apologize and quit
+ */
+ warn(1, "Sorry, unable to determine archive format.");
+ return(-1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/buf_subs.c b/bin/pax/buf_subs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a4ec446
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/buf_subs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1083 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)buf_subs.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * routines which implement archive and file buffering
+ */
+
+#define MINFBSZ 512 /* default block size for hole detect */
+#define MAXFLT 10 /* default media read error limit */
+
+/*
+ * Need to change bufmem to dynamic allocation when the upper
+ * limit on blocking size is removed (though that will violate pax spec)
+ * MAXBLK define and tests will also need to be updated.
+ */
+static char bufmem[MAXBLK+BLKMULT]; /* i/o buffer + pushback id space */
+static char *buf; /* normal start of i/o buffer */
+static char *bufend; /* end or last char in i/o buffer */
+static char *bufpt; /* read/write point in i/o buffer */
+int blksz = MAXBLK; /* block input/output size in bytes */
+int wrblksz; /* user spec output size in bytes */
+int maxflt = MAXFLT; /* MAX consecutive media errors */
+int rdblksz; /* first read blksize (tapes only) */
+off_t wrlimit; /* # of bytes written per archive vol */
+off_t wrcnt; /* # of bytes written on current vol */
+off_t rdcnt; /* # of bytes read on current vol */
+
+/*
+ * wr_start()
+ * set up the buffering system to operate in a write mode
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 if the user specified write block size violates pax spec
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+wr_start(void)
+#else
+int
+wr_start()
+#endif
+{
+ buf = &(bufmem[BLKMULT]);
+ /*
+ * Check to make sure the write block size meets pax specs. If the user
+ * does not specify a blocksize, we use the format default blocksize.
+ * We must be picky on writes, so we do not allow the user to create an
+ * archive that might be hard to read elsewhere. If all ok, we then
+ * open the first archive volume
+ */
+ if (!wrblksz)
+ wrblksz = frmt->bsz;
+ if (wrblksz > MAXBLK) {
+ warn(1, "Write block size of %d too large, maximium is: %d",
+ wrblksz, MAXBLK);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (wrblksz % BLKMULT) {
+ warn(1, "Write block size of %d is not a %d byte multiple",
+ wrblksz, BLKMULT);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we only allow wrblksz to be used with all archive operations
+ */
+ blksz = rdblksz = wrblksz;
+ if ((ar_open(arcname) < 0) && (ar_next() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ wrcnt = 0;
+ bufend = buf + wrblksz;
+ bufpt = buf;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_start()
+ * set up buffering system to read an archive
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+rd_start(void)
+#else
+int
+rd_start()
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * leave space for the header pushback (see get_arc()). If we are
+ * going to append and user specified a write block size, check it
+ * right away
+ */
+ buf = &(bufmem[BLKMULT]);
+ if ((act == APPND) && wrblksz) {
+ if (wrblksz > MAXBLK) {
+ warn(1,"Write block size %d too large, maximium is: %d",
+ wrblksz, MAXBLK);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (wrblksz % BLKMULT) {
+ warn(1, "Write block size %d is not a %d byte multiple",
+ wrblksz, BLKMULT);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * open the archive
+ */
+ if ((ar_open(arcname) < 0) && (ar_next() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ bufend = buf + rdblksz;
+ bufpt = bufend;
+ rdcnt = 0;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * cp_start()
+ * set up buffer system for copying within the file system
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+cp_start(void)
+#else
+void
+cp_start()
+#endif
+{
+ buf = &(bufmem[BLKMULT]);
+ rdblksz = blksz = MAXBLK;
+}
+
+/*
+ * appnd_start()
+ * Set up the buffering system to append new members to an archive that
+ * was just read. The last block(s) of an archive may contain a format
+ * specific trailer. To append a new member, this trailer has to be
+ * removed from the archive. The first byte of the trailer is replaced by
+ * the start of the header of the first file added to the archive. The
+ * format specific end read function tells us how many bytes to move
+ * backwards in the archive to be positioned BEFORE the trailer. Two
+ * different postions have to be adjusted, the O.S. file offset (e.g. the
+ * position of the tape head) and the write point within the data we have
+ * stored in the read (soon to become write) buffer. We may have to move
+ * back several records (the number depends on the size of the archive
+ * record and the size of the format trailer) to read up the record where
+ * the first byte of the trailer is recorded. Trailers may span (and
+ * overlap) record boundries.
+ * We first calculate which record has the first byte of the trailer. We
+ * move the OS file offset back to the start of this record and read it
+ * up. We set the buffer write pointer to be at this byte (the byte where
+ * the trailer starts). We then move the OS file pointer back to the
+ * start of this record so a flush of this buffer will replace the record
+ * in the archive.
+ * A major problem is rewriting this last record. For archives stored
+ * on disk files, this is trival. However, many devices are really picky
+ * about the conditions under which they will allow a write to occur.
+ * Often devices restrict the conditions where writes can be made writes,
+ * so it may not be feasable to append archives stored on all types of
+ * devices.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 for success, -1 for failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+appnd_start(off_t skcnt)
+#else
+int
+appnd_start(skcnt)
+ off_t skcnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res;
+ off_t cnt;
+
+ if (exit_val != 0) {
+ warn(0, "Cannot append to an archive that may have flaws.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ /*
+ * if the user did not specify a write blocksize, inherit the size used
+ * in the last archive volume read. (If a is set we still use rdblksz
+ * until next volume, cannot shift sizes within a single volume).
+ */
+ if (!wrblksz)
+ wrblksz = blksz = rdblksz;
+ else
+ blksz = rdblksz;
+
+ /*
+ * make sure that this volume allows appends
+ */
+ if (ar_app_ok() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * Calculate bytes to move back and move in front of record where we
+ * need to start writing from. Remember we have to add in any padding
+ * that might be in the buffer after the trailer in the last block. We
+ * travel skcnt + padding ROUNDED UP to blksize.
+ */
+ skcnt += bufend - bufpt;
+ if ((cnt = (skcnt/blksz) * blksz) < skcnt)
+ cnt += blksz;
+ if (ar_rev((off_t)cnt) < 0)
+ goto out;
+
+ /*
+ * We may have gone too far if there is valid data in the block we are
+ * now in front of, read up the block and position the pointer after
+ * the valid data.
+ */
+ if ((cnt -= skcnt) > 0) {
+ /*
+ * watch out for stupid tape drives. ar_rev() will set rdblksz
+ * to be real physical blocksize so we must loop until we get
+ * the old rdblksz (now in blksz). If ar_rev() fouls up the
+ * determination of the physical block size, we will fail.
+ */
+ bufpt = buf;
+ bufend = buf + blksz;
+ while (bufpt < bufend) {
+ if ((res = ar_read(bufpt, rdblksz)) <= 0)
+ goto out;
+ bufpt += res;
+ }
+ if (ar_rev((off_t)(bufpt - buf)) < 0)
+ goto out;
+ bufpt = buf + cnt;
+ bufend = buf + blksz;
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * buffer is empty
+ */
+ bufend = buf + blksz;
+ bufpt = buf;
+ }
+ rdblksz = blksz;
+ rdcnt -= skcnt;
+ wrcnt = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * At this point we are ready to write. If the device requires special
+ * handling to write at a point were previously recorded data resides,
+ * that is handled in ar_set_wr(). From now on we operate under normal
+ * ARCHIVE mode (write) conditions
+ */
+ if (ar_set_wr() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ act = ARCHIVE;
+ return(0);
+
+ out:
+ warn(1, "Unable to rewrite archive trailer, cannot append.");
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_sync()
+ * A read error occurred on this archive volume. Resync the buffer and
+ * try to reset the device (if possible) so we can continue to read. Keep
+ * trying to do this until we get a valid read, or we reach the limit on
+ * consecutive read faults (at which point we give up). The user can
+ * adjust the read error limit through a command line option.
+ * Returns:
+ * 0 on success, and -1 on failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+rd_sync(void)
+#else
+int
+rd_sync()
+#endif
+{
+ register int errcnt = 0;
+ register int res;
+
+ /*
+ * if the user says bail out on first fault, we are out of here...
+ */
+ if (maxflt == 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (act == APPND) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to append when there are archive read errors.");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * poke at device and try to get past media error
+ */
+ if (ar_rdsync() < 0) {
+ if (ar_next() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ else
+ rdcnt = 0;
+ }
+
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((res = ar_read(buf, blksz)) > 0) {
+ /*
+ * All right! got some data, fill that buffer
+ */
+ bufpt = buf;
+ bufend = buf + res;
+ rdcnt += res;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Oh well, yet another failed read...
+ * if error limit reached, ditch. o.w. poke device to move past
+ * bad media and try again. if media is badly damaged, we ask
+ * the poor (and upset user at this point) for the next archive
+ * volume. remember the goal on reads is to get the most we
+ * can extract out of the archive.
+ */
+ if ((maxflt > 0) && (++errcnt > maxflt))
+ warn(0,"Archive read error limit (%d) reached",maxflt);
+ else if (ar_rdsync() == 0)
+ continue;
+ if (ar_next() < 0)
+ break;
+ rdcnt = 0;
+ errcnt = 0;
+ }
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pback()
+ * push the data used during the archive id phase back into the I/O
+ * buffer. This is required as we cannot be sure that the header does NOT
+ * overlap a block boundry (as in the case we are trying to recover a
+ * flawed archived). This was not designed to be used for any other
+ * purpose. (What software engineering, HA!)
+ * WARNING: do not even THINK of pback greater than BLKMULT, unless the
+ * pback space is increased.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+pback(char *pt, int cnt)
+#else
+void
+pback(pt, cnt)
+ char *pt;
+ int cnt;
+#endif
+{
+ bufpt -= cnt;
+ bcopy(pt, bufpt, cnt);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_skip()
+ * skip foward in the archive during a archive read. Used to get quickly
+ * past file data and padding for files the user did NOT select.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 failure, and 1 when EOF on the archive volume was detected.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+rd_skip(off_t skcnt)
+#else
+int
+rd_skip(skcnt)
+ off_t skcnt;
+#endif
+{
+ off_t res;
+ off_t cnt;
+ off_t skipped = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * consume what data we have in the buffer. If we have to move foward
+ * whole records, we call the low level skip function to see if we can
+ * move within the archive without doing the expensive reads on data we
+ * do not want.
+ */
+ if (skcnt == 0)
+ return(0);
+ res = MIN((bufend - bufpt), skcnt);
+ bufpt += res;
+ skcnt -= res;
+
+ /*
+ * if skcnt is now 0, then no additional i/o is needed
+ */
+ if (skcnt == 0)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * We have to read more, calculate complete and partial record reads
+ * based on rdblksz. we skip over "cnt" complete records
+ */
+ res = skcnt%rdblksz;
+ cnt = (skcnt/rdblksz) * rdblksz;
+
+ /*
+ * if the skip fails, we will have to resync. ar_fow will tell us
+ * how much it can skip over. We will have to read the rest.
+ */
+ if (ar_fow(cnt, &skipped) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ res += cnt - skipped;
+ rdcnt += skipped;
+
+ /*
+ * what is left we have to read (which may be the whole thing if
+ * ar_fow() told us the device can only read to skip records);
+ */
+ while (res > 0L) {
+ cnt = bufend - bufpt;
+ /*
+ * if the read fails, we will have to resync
+ */
+ if ((cnt <= 0) && ((cnt = buf_fill()) < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ if (cnt == 0)
+ return(1);
+ cnt = MIN(cnt, res);
+ bufpt += cnt;
+ res -= cnt;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * wr_fin()
+ * flush out any data (and pad if required) the last block. We always pad
+ * with zero (even though we do not have to). Padding with 0 makes it a
+ * lot easier to recover if the archive is damaged. zero paddding SHOULD
+ * BE a requirement....
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+wr_fin(void)
+#else
+void
+wr_fin()
+#endif
+{
+ if (bufpt > buf) {
+ bzero(bufpt, bufend - bufpt);
+ bufpt = bufend;
+ (void)buf_flush(blksz);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * wr_rdbuf()
+ * fill the write buffer from data passed to it in a buffer (usually used
+ * by format specific write routines to pass a file header). On failure we
+ * punt. We do not allow the user to continue to write flawed archives.
+ * We assume these headers are not very large (the memory copy we use is
+ * a bit expensive).
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if buffer was filled ok, -1 o.w. (buffer flush failure)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+wr_rdbuf(register char *out, register int outcnt)
+#else
+int
+wr_rdbuf(out, outcnt)
+ register char *out;
+ register int outcnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+
+ /*
+ * while there is data to copy copy into the write buffer. when the
+ * write buffer fills, flush it to the archive and continue
+ */
+ while (outcnt > 0) {
+ cnt = bufend - bufpt;
+ if ((cnt <= 0) && ((cnt = buf_flush(blksz)) < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ /*
+ * only move what we have space for
+ */
+ cnt = MIN(cnt, outcnt);
+ bcopy(out, bufpt, cnt);
+ bufpt += cnt;
+ out += cnt;
+ outcnt -= cnt;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_wrbuf()
+ * copy from the read buffer into a supplied buffer a specified number of
+ * bytes. If the read buffer is empty fill it and continue to copy.
+ * usually used to obtain a file header for processing by a format
+ * specific read routine.
+ * Return
+ * number of bytes copied to the buffer, 0 indicates EOF on archive volume,
+ * -1 is a read error
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+rd_wrbuf(register char *in, register int cpcnt)
+#else
+int
+rd_wrbuf(in, cpcnt)
+ register char *in;
+ register int cpcnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res;
+ register int cnt;
+ register int incnt = cpcnt;
+
+ /*
+ * loop until we fill the buffer with the requested number of bytes
+ */
+ while (incnt > 0) {
+ cnt = bufend - bufpt;
+ if ((cnt <= 0) && ((cnt = buf_fill()) <= 0)) {
+ /*
+ * read error, return what we got (or the error if
+ * no data was copied). The caller must know that an
+ * error occured and has the best knowledge what to
+ * do with it
+ */
+ if ((res = cpcnt - incnt) > 0)
+ return(res);
+ return(cnt);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * calculate how much data to copy based on whats left and
+ * state of buffer
+ */
+ cnt = MIN(cnt, incnt);
+ bcopy(bufpt, in, cnt);
+ bufpt += cnt;
+ incnt -= cnt;
+ in += cnt;
+ }
+ return(cpcnt);
+}
+
+/*
+ * wr_skip()
+ * skip foward during a write. In other words add padding to the file.
+ * we add zero filled padding as it makes flawed archives much easier to
+ * recover from. the caller tells us how many bytes of padding to add
+ * This routine was not designed to add HUGE amount of padding, just small
+ * amounts (a few 512 byte blocks at most)
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 if there was a buf_flush failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+wr_skip(off_t skcnt)
+#else
+int
+wr_skip(skcnt)
+ off_t skcnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+
+ /*
+ * loop while there is more padding to add
+ */
+ while (skcnt > 0L) {
+ cnt = bufend - bufpt;
+ if ((cnt <= 0) && ((cnt = buf_flush(blksz)) < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ cnt = MIN(cnt, skcnt);
+ bzero(bufpt, cnt);
+ bufpt += cnt;
+ skcnt -= cnt;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * wr_rdfile()
+ * fill write buffer with the contents of a file. We are passed an open
+ * file descriptor to the file an the archive structure that describes the
+ * file we are storing. The variable "left" is modified to contain the
+ * number of bytes of the file we were NOT able to write to the archive.
+ * it is important that we always write EXACTLY the number of bytes that
+ * the format specific write routine told us to. The file can also get
+ * bigger, so reading to the end of file would create an improper archive,
+ * we just detect this case and warn the user. We never create a bad
+ * archive if we can avoid it. Of course trying to archive files that are
+ * active is asking for trouble. It we fail, we pass back how much we
+ * could NOT copy and let the caller deal with it.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 ok, -1 if archive write failure. a short read of the file returns a
+ * 0, but "left" is set to be greater than zero.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+wr_rdfile(ARCHD *arcn, int ifd, off_t *left)
+#else
+int
+wr_rdfile(arcn, ifd, left)
+ ARCHD *arcn;
+ int ifd;
+ off_t *left;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+ register int res = 0;
+ register off_t size = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /*
+ * while there are more bytes to write
+ */
+ while (size > 0L) {
+ cnt = bufend - bufpt;
+ if ((cnt <= 0) && ((cnt = buf_flush(blksz)) < 0)) {
+ *left = size;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ cnt = MIN(cnt, size);
+ if ((res = read(ifd, bufpt, cnt)) <= 0)
+ break;
+ size -= res;
+ bufpt += res;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * better check the file did not change during this operation
+ * or the file read failed.
+ */
+ if (res < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Read fault on %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (size != 0L)
+ warn(1, "File changed size during read %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (fstat(ifd, &sb) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed stat on %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime != sb.st_mtime)
+ warn(1, "File %s was modified during copy to archive",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ *left = size;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_wrfile()
+ * extract the contents of a file from the archive. If we are unable to
+ * extract the entire file (due to failure to write the file) we return
+ * the numbers of bytes we did NOT process. This way the caller knows how
+ * many bytes to skip past to find the next archive header. If the failure
+ * was due to an archive read, we will catch that when we try to skip. If
+ * the format supplies a file data crc value, we calculate the actual crc
+ * so that it can be compared to the value stored in the header
+ * NOTE:
+ * We call a special function to write the file. This function attempts to
+ * restore file holes (blocks of zeros) into the file. When files are
+ * sparse this saves space, and is a LOT faster. For non sparse files
+ * the performance hit is small. As of this writing, no archive supports
+ * information on where the file holes are.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 ok, -1 if archive read failure. if we cannot write the entire file,
+ * we return a 0 but "left" is set to be the amount unwritten
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+rd_wrfile(ARCHD *arcn, int ofd, off_t *left)
+#else
+int
+rd_wrfile(arcn, ofd, left)
+ ARCHD *arcn;
+ int ofd;
+ off_t *left;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt = 0;
+ register off_t size = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ register int res = 0;
+ register char *fnm = arcn->name;
+ int isem = 1;
+ int rem;
+ int sz = MINFBSZ;
+ struct stat sb;
+ u_long crc = 0L;
+
+ /*
+ * pass the blocksize of the file being written to the write routine,
+ * if the size is zero, use the default MINFBSZ
+ */
+ if (fstat(ofd, &sb) == 0) {
+ if (sb.st_blksize > 0)
+ sz = (int)sb.st_blksize;
+ } else
+ syswarn(0,errno,"Unable to obtain block size for file %s",fnm);
+ rem = sz;
+ *left = 0L;
+
+ /*
+ * Copy the archive to the file the number of bytes specified. We have
+ * to assume that we want to recover file holes as none of the archive
+ * formats can record the location of file holes.
+ */
+ while (size > 0L) {
+ cnt = bufend - bufpt;
+ /*
+ * if we get a read error, we do not want to skip, as we may
+ * miss a header, so we do not set left, but if we get a write
+ * error, we do want to skip over the unprocessed data.
+ */
+ if ((cnt <= 0) && ((cnt = buf_fill()) <= 0))
+ break;
+ cnt = MIN(cnt, size);
+ if ((res = file_write(ofd,bufpt,cnt,&rem,&isem,sz,fnm)) <= 0) {
+ *left = size;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (docrc) {
+ /*
+ * update the actual crc value
+ */
+ cnt = res;
+ while (--cnt >= 0)
+ crc += *bufpt++ & 0xff;
+ } else
+ bufpt += res;
+ size -= res;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if the last block has a file hole (all zero), we must make sure this
+ * gets updated in the file. We force the last block of zeros to be
+ * written. just closing with the file offset moved foward may not put
+ * a hole at the end of the file.
+ */
+ if (isem && (arcn->sb.st_size > 0L))
+ file_flush(ofd, fnm, isem);
+
+ /*
+ * if we failed from archive read, we do not want to skip
+ */
+ if ((size > 0L) && (*left == 0L))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * some formats record a crc on file data. If so, then we compare the
+ * calculated crc to the crc stored in the archive
+ */
+ if (docrc && (size == 0L) && (arcn->crc != crc))
+ warn(1,"Actual crc does not match expected crc %s",arcn->name);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * cp_file()
+ * copy the contents of one file to another. used during -rw phase of pax
+ * just as in rd_wrfile() we use a special write function to write the
+ * destination file so we can properly copy files with holes.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+cp_file(ARCHD *arcn, int fd1, int fd2)
+#else
+void
+cp_file(arcn, fd1, fd2)
+ ARCHD *arcn;
+ int fd1;
+ int fd2;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+ register off_t cpcnt = 0L;
+ register int res = 0;
+ register char *fnm = arcn->name;
+ register int no_hole = 0;
+ int isem = 1;
+ int rem;
+ int sz = MINFBSZ;
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /*
+ * check for holes in the source file. If none, we will use regular
+ * write instead of file write.
+ */
+ if (((off_t)(arcn->sb.st_blocks * BLKMULT)) >= arcn->sb.st_size)
+ ++no_hole;
+
+ /*
+ * pass the blocksize of the file being written to the write routine,
+ * if the size is zero, use the default MINFBSZ
+ */
+ if (fstat(fd2, &sb) == 0) {
+ if (sb.st_blksize > 0)
+ sz = sb.st_blksize;
+ } else
+ syswarn(0,errno,"Unable to obtain block size for file %s",fnm);
+ rem = sz;
+
+ /*
+ * read the source file and copy to destination file until EOF
+ */
+ for(;;) {
+ if ((cnt = read(fd1, buf, blksz)) <= 0)
+ break;
+ if (no_hole)
+ res = write(fd2, buf, cnt);
+ else
+ res = file_write(fd2, buf, cnt, &rem, &isem, sz, fnm);
+ if (res != cnt)
+ break;
+ cpcnt += cnt;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * check to make sure the copy is valid.
+ */
+ if (res < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed write during copy of %s to %s",
+ arcn->org_name, arcn->name);
+ else if (cpcnt != arcn->sb.st_size)
+ warn(1, "File %s changed size during copy to %s",
+ arcn->org_name, arcn->name);
+ else if (fstat(fd1, &sb) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed stat of %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime != sb.st_mtime)
+ warn(1, "File %s was modified during copy to %s",
+ arcn->org_name, arcn->name);
+
+ /*
+ * if the last block has a file hole (all zero), we must make sure this
+ * gets updated in the file. We force the last block of zeros to be
+ * written. just closing with the file offset moved foward may not put
+ * a hole at the end of the file.
+ */
+ if (!no_hole && isem && (arcn->sb.st_size > 0L))
+ file_flush(fd2, fnm, isem);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * buf_fill()
+ * fill the read buffer with the next record (or what we can get) from
+ * the archive volume.
+ * Return:
+ * Number of bytes of data in the read buffer, -1 for read error, and
+ * 0 when finished (user specified termination in ar_next()).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+buf_fill(void)
+#else
+int
+buf_fill()
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+ static int fini = 0;
+
+ if (fini)
+ return(0);
+
+ for(;;) {
+ /*
+ * try to fill the buffer. on error the next archive volume is
+ * opened and we try again.
+ */
+ if ((cnt = ar_read(buf, blksz)) > 0) {
+ bufpt = buf;
+ bufend = buf + cnt;
+ rdcnt += cnt;
+ return(cnt);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * errors require resync, EOF goes to next archive
+ */
+ if (cnt < 0)
+ break;
+ if (ar_next() < 0) {
+ fini = 1;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ rdcnt = 0;
+ }
+ exit_val = 1;
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * buf_flush()
+ * force the write buffer to the archive. We are passed the number of
+ * bytes in the buffer at the point of the flush. When we change archives
+ * the record size might change. (either larger or smaller).
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if all is ok, -1 when a write error occurs.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+buf_flush(register int bufcnt)
+#else
+int
+buf_flush(bufcnt)
+ register int bufcnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+ register int push = 0;
+ register int totcnt = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * if we have reached the user specified byte count for each archive
+ * volume, prompt for the next volume. (The non-standrad -R flag).
+ * NOTE: If the wrlimit is smaller than wrcnt, we will always write
+ * at least one record. We always round limit UP to next blocksize.
+ */
+ if ((wrlimit > 0) && (wrcnt > wrlimit)) {
+ warn(0, "User specified archive volume byte limit reached.");
+ if (ar_next() < 0) {
+ wrcnt = 0;
+ exit_val = 1;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ wrcnt = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * The new archive volume might have changed the size of the
+ * write blocksize. if so we figure out if we need to write
+ * (one or more times), or if there is now free space left in
+ * the buffer (it is no longer full). bufcnt has the number of
+ * bytes in the buffer, (the blocksize, at the point we were
+ * CALLED). Push has the amount of "extra" data in the buffer
+ * if the block size has shrunk from a volume change.
+ */
+ bufend = buf + blksz;
+ if (blksz > bufcnt)
+ return(0);
+ if (blksz < bufcnt)
+ push = bufcnt - blksz;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * We have enough data to write at least one archive block
+ */
+ for (;;) {
+ /*
+ * write a block and check if it all went out ok
+ */
+ cnt = ar_write(buf, blksz);
+ if (cnt == blksz) {
+ /*
+ * the write went ok
+ */
+ wrcnt += cnt;
+ totcnt += cnt;
+ if (push > 0) {
+ /* we have extra data to push to the front.
+ * check for more than 1 block of push, and if
+ * so we loop back to write again
+ */
+ bcopy(bufend, buf, push);
+ bufpt = buf + push;
+ if (push >= blksz) {
+ push -= blksz;
+ continue;
+ }
+ } else
+ bufpt = buf;
+ return(totcnt);
+ } else if (cnt > 0) {
+ /*
+ * Oh drat we got a partial write!
+ * if format doesnt care about alignment let it go,
+ * we warned the user in ar_write().... but this means
+ * the last record on this volume violates pax spec....
+ */
+ totcnt += cnt;
+ wrcnt += cnt;
+ bufpt = buf + cnt;
+ cnt = bufcnt - cnt;
+ bcopy(bufpt, buf, cnt);
+ bufpt = buf + cnt;
+ if (!frmt->blkalgn || ((cnt % frmt->blkalgn) == 0))
+ return(totcnt);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * All done, go to next archive
+ */
+ wrcnt = 0;
+ if (ar_next() < 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * The new archive volume might also have changed the block
+ * size. if so, figure out if we have too much or too little
+ * data for using the new block size
+ */
+ bufend = buf + blksz;
+ if (blksz > bufcnt)
+ return(0);
+ if (blksz < bufcnt)
+ push = bufcnt - blksz;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * write failed, stop pax. we must not create a bad archive!
+ */
+ exit_val = 1;
+ return(-1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/cache.c b/bin/pax/cache.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2224e4d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/cache.c
@@ -0,0 +1,479 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cache.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+#include <grp.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "cache.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * routines that control user, group, uid and gid caches (for the archive
+ * member print routine).
+ * IMPORTANT:
+ * these routines cache BOTH hits and misses, a major performance improvement
+ */
+
+static int pwopn = 0; /* is password file open */
+static int gropn = 0; /* is group file open */
+static UIDC **uidtb = NULL; /* uid to name cache */
+static GIDC **gidtb = NULL; /* gid to name cache */
+static UIDC **usrtb = NULL; /* user name to uid cache */
+static GIDC **grptb = NULL; /* group name to gid cache */
+
+/*
+ * uidtb_start
+ * creates an an empty uidtb
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+uidtb_start(void)
+#else
+int
+uidtb_start()
+#endif
+{
+ static int fail = 0;
+
+ if (uidtb != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if (fail)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((uidtb = (UIDC **)calloc(UID_SZ, sizeof(UIDC *))) == NULL) {
+ ++fail;
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for user id cache table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * gidtb_start
+ * creates an an empty gidtb
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+gidtb_start(void)
+#else
+int
+gidtb_start()
+#endif
+{
+ static int fail = 0;
+
+ if (gidtb != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if (fail)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((gidtb = (GIDC **)calloc(GID_SZ, sizeof(GIDC *))) == NULL) {
+ ++fail;
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for group id cache table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * usrtb_start
+ * creates an an empty usrtb
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+usrtb_start(void)
+#else
+int
+usrtb_start()
+#endif
+{
+ static int fail = 0;
+
+ if (usrtb != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if (fail)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((usrtb = (UIDC **)calloc(UNM_SZ, sizeof(UIDC *))) == NULL) {
+ ++fail;
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for user name cache table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * grptb_start
+ * creates an an empty grptb
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+grptb_start(void)
+#else
+int
+grptb_start()
+#endif
+{
+ static int fail = 0;
+
+ if (grptb != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if (fail)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((grptb = (GIDC **)calloc(GNM_SZ, sizeof(GIDC *))) == NULL) {
+ ++fail;
+ warn(1,"Unable to allocate memory for group name cache table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * name_uid()
+ * caches the name (if any) for the uid. If frc set, we always return the
+ * the stored name (if valid or invalid match). We use a simple hash table.
+ * Return
+ * Pointer to stored name (or a empty string)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+char *
+name_uid(uid_t uid, int frc)
+#else
+char *
+name_uid(uid, frc)
+ uid_t uid;
+ int frc;
+#endif
+{
+ register struct passwd *pw;
+ register UIDC *ptr;
+
+ if ((uidtb == NULL) && (uidtb_start() < 0))
+ return("");
+
+ /*
+ * see if we have this uid cached
+ */
+ ptr = uidtb[uid % UID_SZ];
+ if ((ptr != NULL) && (ptr->valid > 0) && (ptr->uid == uid)) {
+ /*
+ * have an entry for this uid
+ */
+ if (frc || (ptr->valid == VALID))
+ return(ptr->name);
+ return("");
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * No entry for this uid, we will add it
+ */
+ if (!pwopn) {
+ setpassent(1);
+ ++pwopn;
+ }
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ ptr = (UIDC *)malloc(sizeof(UIDC));
+
+ if ((pw = getpwuid(uid)) == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * no match for this uid in the local password file
+ * a string that is the uid in numberic format
+ */
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ return("");
+ ptr->uid = uid;
+ ptr->valid = INVALID;
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ (void)sprintf(ptr->name, "%u", uid);
+# else
+ (void)sprintf(ptr->name, "%lu", uid);
+# endif
+ if (frc == 0)
+ return("");
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * there is an entry for this uid in the password file
+ */
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ return(pw->pw_name);
+ ptr->uid = uid;
+ (void)strncpy(ptr->name, pw->pw_name, UNMLEN);
+ ptr->name[UNMLEN-1] = '\0';
+ ptr->valid = VALID;
+ }
+ return(ptr->name);
+}
+
+/*
+ * name_gid()
+ * caches the name (if any) for the gid. If frc set, we always return the
+ * the stored name (if valid or invalid match). We use a simple hash table.
+ * Return
+ * Pointer to stored name (or a empty string)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+char *
+name_gid(gid_t gid, int frc)
+#else
+char *
+name_gid(gid, frc)
+ gid_t gid;
+ int frc;
+#endif
+{
+ register struct group *gr;
+ register GIDC *ptr;
+
+ if ((gidtb == NULL) && (gidtb_start() < 0))
+ return("");
+
+ /*
+ * see if we have this gid cached
+ */
+ ptr = gidtb[gid % GID_SZ];
+ if ((ptr != NULL) && (ptr->valid > 0) && (ptr->gid == gid)) {
+ /*
+ * have an entry for this gid
+ */
+ if (frc || (ptr->valid == VALID))
+ return(ptr->name);
+ return("");
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * No entry for this gid, we will add it
+ */
+ if (!gropn) {
+ setgroupent(1);
+ ++gropn;
+ }
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ ptr = (GIDC *)malloc(sizeof(GIDC));
+
+ if ((gr = getgrgid(gid)) == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * no match for this gid in the local group file, put in
+ * a string that is the gid in numberic format
+ */
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ return("");
+ ptr->gid = gid;
+ ptr->valid = INVALID;
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ (void)sprintf(ptr->name, "%u", gid);
+# else
+ (void)sprintf(ptr->name, "%lu", gid);
+# endif
+ if (frc == 0)
+ return("");
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * there is an entry for this group in the group file
+ */
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ return(gr->gr_name);
+ ptr->gid = gid;
+ (void)strncpy(ptr->name, gr->gr_name, GNMLEN);
+ ptr->name[GNMLEN-1] = '\0';
+ ptr->valid = VALID;
+ }
+ return(ptr->name);
+}
+
+/*
+ * uid_name()
+ * caches the uid for a given user name. We use a simple hash table.
+ * Return
+ * the uid (if any) for a user name, or a -1 if no match can be found
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+uid_name(char *name, uid_t *uid)
+#else
+int
+uid_name(name, uid)
+ char *name;
+ uid_t *uid;
+#endif
+{
+ register struct passwd *pw;
+ register UIDC *ptr;
+ register int namelen;
+
+ /*
+ * return -1 for mangled names
+ */
+ if (((namelen = strlen(name)) == 0) || (name[0] == '\0'))
+ return(-1);
+ if ((usrtb == NULL) && (usrtb_start() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * look up in hash table, if found and valid return the uid,
+ * if found and invalid, return a -1
+ */
+ ptr = usrtb[st_hash(name, namelen, UNM_SZ)];
+ if ((ptr != NULL) && (ptr->valid > 0) && !strcmp(name, ptr->name)) {
+ if (ptr->valid == INVALID)
+ return(-1);
+ *uid = ptr->uid;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ if (!pwopn) {
+ setpassent(1);
+ ++pwopn;
+ }
+
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ ptr = (UIDC *)malloc(sizeof(UIDC));
+
+ /*
+ * no match, look it up, if no match store it as an invalid entry,
+ * or store the matching uid
+ */
+ if (ptr == NULL) {
+ if ((pw = getpwnam(name)) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ *uid = pw->pw_uid;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ (void)strncpy(ptr->name, name, UNMLEN);
+ ptr->name[UNMLEN-1] = '\0';
+ if ((pw = getpwnam(name)) == NULL) {
+ ptr->valid = INVALID;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ ptr->valid = VALID;
+ *uid = ptr->uid = pw->pw_uid;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * gid_name()
+ * caches the gid for a given group name. We use a simple hash table.
+ * Return
+ * the gid (if any) for a group name, or a -1 if no match can be found
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+gid_name(char *name, gid_t *gid)
+#else
+int
+gid_name(name, gid)
+ char *name;
+ gid_t *gid;
+#endif
+{
+ register struct group *gr;
+ register GIDC *ptr;
+ register int namelen;
+
+ /*
+ * return -1 for mangled names
+ */
+ if (((namelen = strlen(name)) == 0) || (name[0] == '\0'))
+ return(-1);
+ if ((grptb == NULL) && (grptb_start() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * look up in hash table, if found and valid return the uid,
+ * if found and invalid, return a -1
+ */
+ ptr = grptb[st_hash(name, namelen, GID_SZ)];
+ if ((ptr != NULL) && (ptr->valid > 0) && !strcmp(name, ptr->name)) {
+ if (ptr->valid == INVALID)
+ return(-1);
+ *gid = ptr->gid;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ if (!gropn) {
+ setgroupent(1);
+ ++gropn;
+ }
+ if (ptr == NULL)
+ ptr = (GIDC *)malloc(sizeof(GIDC));
+
+ /*
+ * no match, look it up, if no match store it as an invalid entry,
+ * or store the matching gid
+ */
+ if (ptr == NULL) {
+ if ((gr = getgrnam(name)) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ *gid = gr->gr_gid;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ (void)strncpy(ptr->name, name, GNMLEN);
+ ptr->name[GNMLEN-1] = '\0';
+ if ((gr = getgrnam(name)) == NULL) {
+ ptr->valid = INVALID;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ ptr->valid = VALID;
+ *gid = ptr->gid = gr->gr_gid;
+ return(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/cache.h b/bin/pax/cache.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b4bac4f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/cache.h
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)cache.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Constants and data structures used to implement group and password file
+ * caches. Traditional passwd/group cache routines perform quite poorly with
+ * archives. The chances of hitting a valid lookup with an archive is quite a
+ * bit worse than with files already resident on the file system. These misses
+ * create a MAJOR performance cost. To adress this problem, these routines
+ * cache both hits and misses.
+ *
+ * NOTE: name lengths must be as large as those stored in ANY PROTOCOL and
+ * as stored in the passwd and group files. CACHE SIZES MUST BE PRIME
+ */
+#define UNMLEN 32 /* >= user name found in any protocol */
+#define GNMLEN 32 /* >= group name found in any protocol */
+#define UID_SZ 317 /* size of user_name/uid cache */
+#define UNM_SZ 317 /* size of user_name/uid cache */
+#define GID_SZ 251 /* size of gid cache */
+#define GNM_SZ 317 /* size of group name cache */
+#define VALID 1 /* entry and name are valid */
+#define INVALID 2 /* entry valid, name NOT valid */
+
+/*
+ * Node structures used in the user, group, uid, and gid caches.
+ */
+
+typedef struct uidc {
+ int valid; /* is this a valid or a miss entry */
+ char name[UNMLEN]; /* uid name */
+ uid_t uid; /* cached uid */
+} UIDC;
+
+typedef struct gidc {
+ int valid; /* is this a valid or a miss entry */
+ char name[GNMLEN]; /* gid name */
+ gid_t gid; /* cached gid */
+} GIDC;
diff --git a/bin/pax/cpio.c b/bin/pax/cpio.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d494c9a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/cpio.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1278 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cpio.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "cpio.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int rd_nm __P((register ARCHD *, int));
+static int rd_ln_nm __P((register ARCHD *));
+static int com_rd __P((register ARCHD *));
+
+/*
+ * Routines which support the different cpio versions
+ */
+
+static int swp_head; /* binary cpio header byte swap */
+
+/*
+ * Routines common to all versions of cpio
+ */
+
+/*
+ * cpio_strd()
+ * Fire up the hard link detection code
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok -1 otherwise (the return values of lnk_start())
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_strd(void)
+#else
+int
+cpio_strd()
+#endif
+{
+ return(lnk_start());
+}
+
+/*
+ * cpio_trail()
+ * Called to determine if a header block is a valid trailer. We are
+ * passed the block, the in_sync flag (which tells us we are in resync
+ * mode; looking for a valid header), and cnt (which starts at zero)
+ * which is used to count the number of empty blocks we have seen so far.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid trailer, -1 if not a valid trailer,
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_trail(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+cpio_trail(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * look for trailer id in file we are about to process
+ */
+ if ((strcmp(arcn->name, TRAILER) == 0) && (arcn->sb.st_size == 0))
+ return(0);
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * com_rd()
+ * operations common to all cpio read functions.
+ * Return:
+ * 0
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+com_rd(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+com_rd(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ arcn->skip = 0;
+ arcn->pat = NULL;
+ arcn->org_name = arcn->name;
+ switch(arcn->sb.st_mode & C_IFMT) {
+ case C_ISFIFO:
+ arcn->type = PAX_FIF;
+ break;
+ case C_ISDIR:
+ arcn->type = PAX_DIR;
+ break;
+ case C_ISBLK:
+ arcn->type = PAX_BLK;
+ break;
+ case C_ISCHR:
+ arcn->type = PAX_CHR;
+ break;
+ case C_ISLNK:
+ arcn->type = PAX_SLK;
+ break;
+ case C_ISOCK:
+ arcn->type = PAX_SCK;
+ break;
+ case C_ISCTG:
+ case C_ISREG:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * we have file data, set up skip (pad is set in the format
+ * specific sections)
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (arcn->sb.st_mode & 0xfff) | C_ISREG;
+ arcn->type = PAX_REG;
+ arcn->skip = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (chk_lnk(arcn) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * cpio_end_wr()
+ * write the special file with the name trailer in the proper format
+ * Return:
+ * result of the write of the trailer from the cpio specific write func
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_endwr(void)
+#else
+int
+cpio_endwr()
+#endif
+{
+ ARCHD last;
+
+ /*
+ * create a trailer request and call the proper format write function
+ */
+ bzero((char *)&last, sizeof(last));
+ last.nlen = sizeof(TRAILER) - 1;
+ last.type = PAX_REG;
+ last.sb.st_nlink = 1;
+ (void)strcpy(last.name, TRAILER);
+ return((*frmt->wr)(&last));
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_nam()
+ * read in the file name which follows the cpio header
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+rd_nm(register ARCHD *arcn, int nsz)
+#else
+static int
+rd_nm(arcn, nsz)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ int nsz;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * do not even try bogus values
+ */
+ if ((nsz == 0) || (nsz > sizeof(arcn->name))) {
+ warn(1, "Cpio file name length %d is out of range", nsz);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * read the name and make sure it is not empty and is \0 terminated
+ */
+ if ((rd_wrbuf(arcn->name,nsz) != nsz) || (arcn->name[nsz-1] != '\0') ||
+ (arcn->name[0] == '\0')) {
+ warn(1, "Cpio file name in header is corrupted");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * rd_ln_nm()
+ * read in the link name for a file with links. The link name is stored
+ * like file data (and is NOT \0 terminated!)
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+rd_ln_nm(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+rd_ln_nm(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * check the length specified for bogus values
+ */
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_size == 0) ||
+ (arcn->sb.st_size >= sizeof(arcn->ln_name))) {
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ warn(1, "Cpio link name length is invalid: %lu",
+ arcn->sb.st_size);
+# else
+ warn(1, "Cpio link name length is invalid: %qu",
+ arcn->sb.st_size);
+# endif
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * read in the link name and \0 terminate it
+ */
+ if (rd_wrbuf(arcn->ln_name, (int)arcn->sb.st_size) !=
+ (int)arcn->sb.st_size) {
+ warn(1, "Cpio link name read error");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ arcn->ln_nlen = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ arcn->ln_name[arcn->ln_nlen] = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * watch out for those empty link names
+ */
+ if (arcn->ln_name[0] == '\0') {
+ warn(1, "Cpio link name is corrupt");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Routines common to the extended byte oriented cpio format
+ */
+
+/*
+ * cpio_id()
+ * determine if a block given to us is a valid extended byte oriented
+ * cpio header
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_id(char *blk, int size)
+#else
+int
+cpio_id(blk, size)
+ char *blk;
+ int size;
+#endif
+{
+ if ((size < sizeof(HD_CPIO)) ||
+ (strncmp(blk, AMAGIC, sizeof(AMAGIC) - 1) != 0))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * cpio_rd()
+ * determine if a buffer is a byte oriented extended cpio archive entry.
+ * convert and store the values in the ARCHD parameter.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_rd(register ARCHD *arcn, register char *buf)
+#else
+int
+cpio_rd(arcn, buf)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register char *buf;
+#endif
+{
+ register int nsz;
+ register HD_CPIO *hd;
+
+ /*
+ * check that this is a valid header, if not return -1
+ */
+ if (cpio_id(buf, sizeof(HD_CPIO)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ hd = (HD_CPIO *)buf;
+
+ /*
+ * byte oriented cpio (posix) does not have padding! extract the octal
+ * ascii fields from the header
+ */
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ arcn->sb.st_dev = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->c_dev, sizeof(hd->c_dev), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_ino = (ino_t)asc_ul(hd->c_ino, sizeof(hd->c_ino), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (mode_t)asc_ul(hd->c_mode, sizeof(hd->c_mode), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_uid = (uid_t)asc_ul(hd->c_uid, sizeof(hd->c_uid), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_gid = (gid_t)asc_ul(hd->c_gid, sizeof(hd->c_gid), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = (nlink_t)asc_ul(hd->c_nlink, sizeof(hd->c_nlink),
+ OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->c_rdev, sizeof(hd->c_rdev), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (time_t)asc_ul(hd->c_mtime, sizeof(hd->c_mtime),
+ OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_ctime = arcn->sb.st_atime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (off_t)asc_ul(hd->c_filesize,sizeof(hd->c_filesize),
+ OCT);
+# else
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (off_t)asc_uqd(hd->c_filesize,sizeof(hd->c_filesize),
+ OCT);
+# endif
+
+ /*
+ * check name size and if valid, read in the name of this entry (name
+ * follows header in the archive)
+ */
+ if ((nsz = (int)asc_ul(hd->c_namesize,sizeof(hd->c_namesize),OCT)) < 2)
+ return(-1);
+ arcn->nlen = nsz - 1;
+ if (rd_nm(arcn, nsz) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ if (((arcn->sb.st_mode&C_IFMT) != C_ISLNK)||(arcn->sb.st_size == 0)) {
+ /*
+ * no link name to read for this file
+ */
+ arcn->ln_nlen = 0;
+ arcn->ln_name[0] = '\0';
+ return(com_rd(arcn));
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * check link name size and read in the link name. Link names are
+ * stored like file data.
+ */
+ if (rd_ln_nm(arcn) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * we have a valid header (with a link)
+ */
+ return(com_rd(arcn));
+}
+
+/*
+ * cpio_endrd()
+ * no cleanup needed here, just return size of the trailer (for append)
+ * Return:
+ * size of trailer header in this format
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+off_t
+cpio_endrd(void)
+#else
+off_t
+cpio_endrd()
+#endif
+{
+ return((off_t)(sizeof(HD_CPIO) + sizeof(TRAILER)));
+}
+
+/*
+ * cpio_stwr()
+ * start up the device mapping table
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise (what dev_start() returns)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_stwr(void)
+#else
+int
+cpio_stwr()
+#endif
+{
+ return(dev_start());
+}
+
+/*
+ * cpio_wr()
+ * copy the data in the ARCHD to buffer in extended byte oriented cpio
+ * format.
+ * Return
+ * 0 if file has data to be written after the header, 1 if file has NO
+ * data to write after the header, -1 if archive write failed
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cpio_wr(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+cpio_wr(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_CPIO *hd;
+ register int nsz;
+ char hdblk[sizeof(HD_CPIO)];
+
+ /*
+ * check and repair truncated device and inode fields in the header
+ */
+ if (map_dev(arcn, (u_long)CPIO_MASK, (u_long)CPIO_MASK) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ nsz = arcn->nlen + 1;
+ hd = (HD_CPIO *)hdblk;
+ if ((arcn->type != PAX_BLK) && (arcn->type != PAX_CHR))
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = 0;
+
+ switch(arcn->type) {
+ case PAX_CTG:
+ case PAX_REG:
+ case PAX_HRG:
+ /*
+ * set data size for file data
+ */
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), OCT)) {
+# else
+ if (uqd_asc((u_quad_t)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), OCT)) {
+# endif
+ warn(1,"File is too large for cpio format %s",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case PAX_SLK:
+ /*
+ * set data size to hold link name
+ */
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)arcn->ln_nlen, hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), OCT))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ default:
+ /*
+ * all other file types have no file data
+ */
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)0, hd->c_filesize, sizeof(hd->c_filesize),
+ OCT))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * copy the values to the header using octal ascii
+ */
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)MAGIC, hd->c_magic, sizeof(hd->c_magic), OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_dev, hd->c_dev, sizeof(hd->c_dev),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_ino, hd->c_ino, sizeof(hd->c_ino),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mode, hd->c_mode, sizeof(hd->c_mode),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_uid, hd->c_uid, sizeof(hd->c_uid),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_gid, hd->c_gid, sizeof(hd->c_gid),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_nlink, hd->c_nlink, sizeof(hd->c_nlink),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_rdev, hd->c_rdev, sizeof(hd->c_rdev),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mtime,hd->c_mtime,sizeof(hd->c_mtime),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)nsz, hd->c_namesize, sizeof(hd->c_namesize), OCT))
+ goto out;
+
+ /*
+ * write the file name to the archive
+ */
+ if ((wr_rdbuf(hdblk, (int)sizeof(HD_CPIO)) < 0) ||
+ (wr_rdbuf(arcn->name, nsz) < 0)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to write cpio header for %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if this file has data, we are done. The caller will write the file
+ * data, if we are link tell caller we are done, go to next file
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_CTG) || (arcn->type == PAX_REG) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ return(0);
+ if (arcn->type != PAX_SLK)
+ return(1);
+
+ /*
+ * write the link name to the archive, tell the caller to go to the
+ * next file as we are done.
+ */
+ if (wr_rdbuf(arcn->ln_name, arcn->ln_nlen) < 0) {
+ warn(1,"Unable to write cpio link name for %s",arcn->org_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(1);
+
+ out:
+ /*
+ * header field is out of range
+ */
+ warn(1, "Cpio header field is too small to store file %s",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Routines common to the system VR4 version of cpio (with/without file CRC)
+ */
+
+/*
+ * vcpio_id()
+ * determine if a block given to us is a valid system VR4 cpio header
+ * WITHOUT crc. WATCH it the magic cookies are in OCTAL, the header
+ * uses HEX
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+vcpio_id(char *blk, int size)
+#else
+int
+vcpio_id(blk, size)
+ char *blk;
+ int size;
+#endif
+{
+ if ((size < sizeof(HD_VCPIO)) ||
+ (strncmp(blk, AVMAGIC, sizeof(AVMAGIC) - 1) != 0))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * crc_id()
+ * determine if a block given to us is a valid system VR4 cpio header
+ * WITH crc. WATCH it the magic cookies are in OCTAL the header uses HEX
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+crc_id(char *blk, int size)
+#else
+int
+crc_id(blk, size)
+ char *blk;
+ int size;
+#endif
+{
+ if ((size < sizeof(HD_VCPIO)) ||
+ (strncmp(blk, AVCMAGIC, sizeof(AVCMAGIC) - 1) != 0))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * crc_strd()
+ w set file data CRC calculations. Fire up the hard link detection code
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok -1 otherwise (the return values of lnk_start())
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+crc_strd(void)
+#else
+int
+crc_strd()
+#endif
+{
+ docrc = 1;
+ return(lnk_start());
+}
+
+/*
+ * vcpio_rd()
+ * determine if a buffer is a system VR4 archive entry. (with/without CRC)
+ * convert and store the values in the ARCHD parameter.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+vcpio_rd(register ARCHD *arcn, register char *buf)
+#else
+int
+vcpio_rd(arcn, buf)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register char *buf;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_VCPIO *hd;
+ dev_t devminor;
+ dev_t devmajor;
+ register int nsz;
+
+ /*
+ * during the id phase it was determined if we were using CRC, use the
+ * proper id routine.
+ */
+ if (docrc) {
+ if (crc_id(buf, sizeof(HD_VCPIO)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ } else {
+ if (vcpio_id(buf, sizeof(HD_VCPIO)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ hd = (HD_VCPIO *)buf;
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+
+ /*
+ * extract the hex ascii fields from the header
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_ino = (ino_t)asc_ul(hd->c_ino, sizeof(hd->c_ino), HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (mode_t)asc_ul(hd->c_mode, sizeof(hd->c_mode), HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_uid = (uid_t)asc_ul(hd->c_uid, sizeof(hd->c_uid), HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_gid = (gid_t)asc_ul(hd->c_gid, sizeof(hd->c_gid), HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (time_t)asc_ul(hd->c_mtime,sizeof(hd->c_mtime),HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_ctime = arcn->sb.st_atime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (off_t)asc_ul(hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), HEX);
+# else
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (off_t)asc_uqd(hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), HEX);
+# endif
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = (nlink_t)asc_ul(hd->c_nlink, sizeof(hd->c_nlink),
+ HEX);
+ devmajor = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->c_maj, sizeof(hd->c_maj), HEX);
+ devminor = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->c_min, sizeof(hd->c_min), HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_dev = TODEV(devmajor, devminor);
+ devmajor = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->c_rmaj, sizeof(hd->c_maj), HEX);
+ devminor = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->c_rmin, sizeof(hd->c_min), HEX);
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = TODEV(devmajor, devminor);
+ arcn->crc = asc_ul(hd->c_chksum, sizeof(hd->c_chksum), HEX);
+
+ /*
+ * check the length of the file name, if ok read it in, return -1 if
+ * bogus
+ */
+ if ((nsz = (int)asc_ul(hd->c_namesize,sizeof(hd->c_namesize),HEX)) < 2)
+ return(-1);
+ arcn->nlen = nsz - 1;
+ if (rd_nm(arcn, nsz) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * skip padding. header + filename is aligned to 4 byte boundries
+ */
+ if (rd_skip((off_t)(VCPIO_PAD(sizeof(HD_VCPIO) + nsz))) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * if not a link (or a file with no data), calculate pad size (for
+ * padding which follows the file data), clear the link name and return
+ */
+ if (((arcn->sb.st_mode&C_IFMT) != C_ISLNK)||(arcn->sb.st_size == 0)) {
+ /*
+ * we have a valid header (not a link)
+ */
+ arcn->ln_nlen = 0;
+ arcn->ln_name[0] = '\0';
+ arcn->pad = VCPIO_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ return(com_rd(arcn));
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * read in the link name and skip over the padding
+ */
+ if ((rd_ln_nm(arcn) < 0) ||
+ (rd_skip((off_t)(VCPIO_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size))) < 0))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * we have a valid header (with a link)
+ */
+ return(com_rd(arcn));
+}
+
+/*
+ * vcpio_endrd()
+ * no cleanup needed here, just return size of the trailer (for append)
+ * Return:
+ * size of trailer header in this format
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+off_t
+vcpio_endrd(void)
+#else
+off_t
+vcpio_endrd()
+#endif
+{
+ return((off_t)(sizeof(HD_VCPIO) + sizeof(TRAILER) +
+ (VCPIO_PAD(sizeof(HD_VCPIO) + sizeof(TRAILER)))));
+}
+
+/*
+ * crc_stwr()
+ * start up the device mapping table, enable crc file calculation
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise (what dev_start() returns)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+crc_stwr(void)
+#else
+int
+crc_stwr()
+#endif
+{
+ docrc = 1;
+ return(dev_start());
+}
+
+/*
+ * vcpio_wr()
+ * copy the data in the ARCHD to buffer in system VR4 cpio
+ * (with/without crc) format.
+ * Return
+ * 0 if file has data to be written after the header, 1 if file has
+ * NO data to write after the header, -1 if archive write failed
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+vcpio_wr(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+vcpio_wr(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_VCPIO *hd;
+ unsigned int nsz;
+ char hdblk[sizeof(HD_VCPIO)];
+
+ /*
+ * check and repair truncated device and inode fields in the cpio
+ * header
+ */
+ if (map_dev(arcn, (u_long)VCPIO_MASK, (u_long)VCPIO_MASK) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ nsz = arcn->nlen + 1;
+ hd = (HD_VCPIO *)hdblk;
+ if ((arcn->type != PAX_BLK) && (arcn->type != PAX_CHR))
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * add the proper magic value depending whether we were asked for
+ * file data crc's, and the crc if needed.
+ */
+ if (docrc) {
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)VCMAGIC, hd->c_magic, sizeof(hd->c_magic),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->crc,hd->c_chksum,sizeof(hd->c_chksum),
+ HEX))
+ goto out;
+ } else {
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)VMAGIC, hd->c_magic, sizeof(hd->c_magic),
+ OCT) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)0L, hd->c_chksum, sizeof(hd->c_chksum),HEX))
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ switch(arcn->type) {
+ case PAX_CTG:
+ case PAX_REG:
+ case PAX_HRG:
+ /*
+ * caller will copy file data to the archive. tell him how
+ * much to pad.
+ */
+ arcn->pad = VCPIO_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), HEX)) {
+# else
+ if (uqd_asc((u_quad_t)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), HEX)) {
+# endif
+ warn(1,"File is too large for sv4cpio format %s",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case PAX_SLK:
+ /*
+ * no file data for the caller to process, the file data has
+ * the size of the link
+ */
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)arcn->ln_nlen, hd->c_filesize,
+ sizeof(hd->c_filesize), HEX))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ default:
+ /*
+ * no file data for the caller to process
+ */
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)0L, hd->c_filesize, sizeof(hd->c_filesize),
+ HEX))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * set the other fields in the header
+ */
+ if (ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_ino, hd->c_ino, sizeof(hd->c_ino),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mode, hd->c_mode, sizeof(hd->c_mode),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_uid, hd->c_uid, sizeof(hd->c_uid),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_gid, hd->c_gid, sizeof(hd->c_gid),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mtime, hd->c_mtime, sizeof(hd->c_mtime),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)arcn->sb.st_nlink, hd->c_nlink, sizeof(hd->c_nlink),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)MAJOR(arcn->sb.st_dev),hd->c_maj, sizeof(hd->c_maj),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)MINOR(arcn->sb.st_dev),hd->c_min, sizeof(hd->c_min),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)MAJOR(arcn->sb.st_rdev),hd->c_rmaj,sizeof(hd->c_maj),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)MINOR(arcn->sb.st_rdev),hd->c_rmin,sizeof(hd->c_min),
+ HEX) ||
+ ul_asc((u_long)nsz, hd->c_namesize, sizeof(hd->c_namesize), HEX))
+ goto out;
+
+ /*
+ * write the header, the file name and padding as required.
+ */
+ if ((wr_rdbuf(hdblk, (int)sizeof(HD_VCPIO)) < 0) ||
+ (wr_rdbuf(arcn->name, (int)nsz) < 0) ||
+ (wr_skip((off_t)(VCPIO_PAD(sizeof(HD_VCPIO) + nsz))) < 0)) {
+ warn(1,"Could not write sv4cpio header for %s",arcn->org_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if we have file data, tell the caller we are done, copy the file
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_CTG) || (arcn->type == PAX_REG) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * if we are not a link, tell the caller we are done, go to next file
+ */
+ if (arcn->type != PAX_SLK)
+ return(1);
+
+ /*
+ * write the link name, tell the caller we are done.
+ */
+ if ((wr_rdbuf(arcn->ln_name, arcn->ln_nlen) < 0) ||
+ (wr_skip((off_t)(VCPIO_PAD(arcn->ln_nlen))) < 0)) {
+ warn(1,"Could not write sv4cpio link name for %s",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(1);
+
+ out:
+ /*
+ * header field is out of range
+ */
+ warn(1,"Sv4cpio header field is too small for file %s",arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Routines common to the old binary header cpio
+ */
+
+/*
+ * bcpio_id()
+ * determine if a block given to us is a old binary cpio header
+ * (with/without header byte swapping)
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+bcpio_id(char *blk, int size)
+#else
+int
+bcpio_id(blk, size)
+ char *blk;
+ int size;
+#endif
+{
+ if (size < sizeof(HD_BCPIO))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * check both normal and byte swapped magic cookies
+ */
+ if (((u_short)SHRT_EXT(blk)) == MAGIC)
+ return(0);
+ if (((u_short)RSHRT_EXT(blk)) == MAGIC) {
+ if (!swp_head)
+ ++swp_head;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * bcpio_rd()
+ * determine if a buffer is a old binary archive entry. (it may have byte
+ * swapped header) convert and store the values in the ARCHD parameter.
+ * This is a very old header format and should not really be used.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid header, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+bcpio_rd(register ARCHD *arcn, register char *buf)
+#else
+int
+bcpio_rd(arcn, buf)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register char *buf;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_BCPIO *hd;
+ register int nsz;
+
+ /*
+ * check the header
+ */
+ if (bcpio_id(buf, sizeof(HD_BCPIO)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ hd = (HD_BCPIO *)buf;
+ if (swp_head) {
+ /*
+ * header has swapped bytes on 16 bit boundries
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_dev = (dev_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_dev));
+ arcn->sb.st_ino = (ino_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_ino));
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (mode_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_mode));
+ arcn->sb.st_uid = (uid_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_uid));
+ arcn->sb.st_gid = (gid_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_gid));
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = (nlink_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_nlink));
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = (dev_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_rdev));
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (time_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_mtime_1));
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (arcn->sb.st_mtime << 16) |
+ ((time_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_mtime_2)));
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (off_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_1));
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (arcn->sb.st_size << 16) |
+ ((off_t)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_2)));
+ nsz = (int)(RSHRT_EXT(hd->h_namesize));
+ } else {
+ arcn->sb.st_dev = (dev_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_dev));
+ arcn->sb.st_ino = (ino_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_ino));
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (mode_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_mode));
+ arcn->sb.st_uid = (uid_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_uid));
+ arcn->sb.st_gid = (gid_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_gid));
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = (nlink_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_nlink));
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = (dev_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_rdev));
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (time_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_mtime_1));
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (arcn->sb.st_mtime << 16) |
+ ((time_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_mtime_2)));
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (off_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_1));
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (arcn->sb.st_size << 16) |
+ ((off_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_2)));
+ nsz = (int)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_namesize));
+ }
+ arcn->sb.st_ctime = arcn->sb.st_atime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+
+ /*
+ * check the file name size, if bogus give up. otherwise read the file
+ * name
+ */
+ if (nsz < 2)
+ return(-1);
+ arcn->nlen = nsz - 1;
+ if (rd_nm(arcn, nsz) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * header + file name are aligned to 2 byte boundries, skip if needed
+ */
+ if (rd_skip((off_t)(BCPIO_PAD(sizeof(HD_BCPIO) + nsz))) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * if not a link (or a file with no data), calculate pad size (for
+ * padding which follows the file data), clear the link name and return
+ */
+ if (((arcn->sb.st_mode & C_IFMT) != C_ISLNK)||(arcn->sb.st_size == 0)){
+ /*
+ * we have a valid header (not a link)
+ */
+ arcn->ln_nlen = 0;
+ arcn->ln_name[0] = '\0';
+ arcn->pad = BCPIO_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ return(com_rd(arcn));
+ }
+
+ if ((rd_ln_nm(arcn) < 0) ||
+ (rd_skip((off_t)(BCPIO_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size))) < 0))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * we have a valid header (with a link)
+ */
+ return(com_rd(arcn));
+}
+
+/*
+ * bcpio_endrd()
+ * no cleanup needed here, just return size of the trailer (for append)
+ * Return:
+ * size of trailer header in this format
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+off_t
+bcpio_endrd(void)
+#else
+off_t
+bcpio_endrd()
+#endif
+{
+ return((off_t)(sizeof(HD_BCPIO) + sizeof(TRAILER) +
+ (BCPIO_PAD(sizeof(HD_BCPIO) + sizeof(TRAILER)))));
+}
+
+/*
+ * bcpio_wr()
+ * copy the data in the ARCHD to buffer in old binary cpio format
+ * There is a real chance of field overflow with this critter. So we
+ * always check the conversion is ok. nobody in his their right mind
+ * should write an achive in this format...
+ * Return
+ * 0 if file has data to be written after the header, 1 if file has NO
+ * data to write after the header, -1 if archive write failed
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+bcpio_wr(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+bcpio_wr(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_BCPIO *hd;
+ register int nsz;
+ char hdblk[sizeof(HD_BCPIO)];
+ off_t t_offt;
+ int t_int;
+ time_t t_timet;
+
+ /*
+ * check and repair truncated device and inode fields in the cpio
+ * header
+ */
+ if (map_dev(arcn, (u_long)BCPIO_MASK, (u_long)BCPIO_MASK) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ if ((arcn->type != PAX_BLK) && (arcn->type != PAX_CHR))
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = 0;
+ hd = (HD_BCPIO *)hdblk;
+
+ switch(arcn->type) {
+ case PAX_CTG:
+ case PAX_REG:
+ case PAX_HRG:
+ /*
+ * caller will copy file data to the archive. tell him how
+ * much to pad.
+ */
+ arcn->pad = BCPIO_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ hd->h_filesize_1[0] = CHR_WR_0(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ hd->h_filesize_1[1] = CHR_WR_1(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ hd->h_filesize_2[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ hd->h_filesize_2[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ t_offt = (off_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_1));
+ t_offt = (t_offt<<16) | ((off_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_2)));
+ if (arcn->sb.st_size != t_offt) {
+ warn(1,"File is too large for bcpio format %s",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case PAX_SLK:
+ /*
+ * no file data for the caller to process, the file data has
+ * the size of the link
+ */
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ hd->h_filesize_1[0] = CHR_WR_0(arcn->ln_nlen);
+ hd->h_filesize_1[1] = CHR_WR_1(arcn->ln_nlen);
+ hd->h_filesize_2[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->ln_nlen);
+ hd->h_filesize_2[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->ln_nlen);
+ t_int = (int)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_1));
+ t_int = (t_int << 16) | ((int)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_filesize_2)));
+ if (arcn->ln_nlen != t_int)
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ default:
+ /*
+ * no file data for the caller to process
+ */
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+ hd->h_filesize_1[0] = (char)0;
+ hd->h_filesize_1[1] = (char)0;
+ hd->h_filesize_2[0] = (char)0;
+ hd->h_filesize_2[1] = (char)0;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * build up the rest of the fields
+ */
+ hd->h_magic[0] = CHR_WR_2(MAGIC);
+ hd->h_magic[1] = CHR_WR_3(MAGIC);
+ hd->h_dev[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_dev);
+ hd->h_dev[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_dev);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_dev != (dev_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_dev)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_ino[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_ino);
+ hd->h_ino[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_ino);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_ino != (ino_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_ino)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_mode[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_mode);
+ hd->h_mode[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_mode);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_mode != (mode_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_mode)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_uid[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_uid);
+ hd->h_uid[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_uid);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_uid != (uid_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_uid)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_gid[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_gid);
+ hd->h_gid[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_gid);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_gid != (gid_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_gid)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_nlink[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_nlink);
+ hd->h_nlink[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_nlink);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_nlink != (nlink_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_nlink)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_rdev[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_rdev);
+ hd->h_rdev[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_rdev);
+ if (arcn->sb.st_rdev != (dev_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_rdev)))
+ goto out;
+ hd->h_mtime_1[0] = CHR_WR_0(arcn->sb.st_mtime);
+ hd->h_mtime_1[1] = CHR_WR_1(arcn->sb.st_mtime);
+ hd->h_mtime_2[0] = CHR_WR_2(arcn->sb.st_mtime);
+ hd->h_mtime_2[1] = CHR_WR_3(arcn->sb.st_mtime);
+ t_timet = (time_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_mtime_1));
+ t_timet = (t_timet << 16) | ((time_t)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_mtime_2)));
+ if (arcn->sb.st_mtime != t_timet)
+ goto out;
+ nsz = arcn->nlen + 1;
+ hd->h_namesize[0] = CHR_WR_2(nsz);
+ hd->h_namesize[1] = CHR_WR_3(nsz);
+ if (nsz != (int)(SHRT_EXT(hd->h_namesize)))
+ goto out;
+
+ /*
+ * write the header, the file name and padding as required.
+ */
+ if ((wr_rdbuf(hdblk, (int)sizeof(HD_BCPIO)) < 0) ||
+ (wr_rdbuf(arcn->name, nsz) < 0) ||
+ (wr_skip((off_t)(BCPIO_PAD(sizeof(HD_BCPIO) + nsz))) < 0)) {
+ warn(1, "Could not write bcpio header for %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if we have file data, tell the caller we are done
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_CTG) || (arcn->type == PAX_REG) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * if we are not a link, tell the caller we are done, go to next file
+ */
+ if (arcn->type != PAX_SLK)
+ return(1);
+
+ /*
+ * write the link name, tell the caller we are done.
+ */
+ if ((wr_rdbuf(arcn->ln_name, arcn->ln_nlen) < 0) ||
+ (wr_skip((off_t)(BCPIO_PAD(arcn->ln_nlen))) < 0)) {
+ warn(1,"Could not write bcpio link name for %s",arcn->org_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(1);
+
+ out:
+ /*
+ * header field is out of range
+ */
+ warn(1,"Bcpio header field is too small for file %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/cpio.h b/bin/pax/cpio.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..73429f9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/cpio.h
@@ -0,0 +1,151 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)cpio.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Defines common to all versions of cpio
+ */
+#define TRAILER "TRAILER!!!" /* name in last archive record */
+
+/*
+ * Header encoding of the different file types
+ */
+#define C_ISDIR 040000 /* Directory */
+#define C_ISFIFO 010000 /* FIFO */
+#define C_ISREG 0100000 /* Regular file */
+#define C_ISBLK 060000 /* Block special file */
+#define C_ISCHR 020000 /* Character special file */
+#define C_ISCTG 0110000 /* Reserved for contiguous files */
+#define C_ISLNK 0120000 /* Reserved for symbolic links */
+#define C_ISOCK 0140000 /* Reserved for sockets */
+#define C_IFMT 0170000 /* type of file */
+
+/*
+ * Data Interchange Format - Extended cpio header format - POSIX 1003.1-1990
+ */
+typedef struct {
+ char c_magic[6]; /* magic cookie */
+ char c_dev[6]; /* device number */
+ char c_ino[6]; /* inode number */
+ char c_mode[6]; /* file type/access */
+ char c_uid[6]; /* owners uid */
+ char c_gid[6]; /* owners gid */
+ char c_nlink[6]; /* # of links at archive creation */
+ char c_rdev[6]; /* block/char major/minor # */
+ char c_mtime[11]; /* modification time */
+ char c_namesize[6]; /* length of pathname */
+ char c_filesize[11]; /* length of file in bytes */
+} HD_CPIO;
+
+#define MAGIC 070707 /* transportable archive id */
+
+#ifdef _PAX_
+#define AMAGIC "070707" /* ascii equivalent string of MAGIC */
+#define CPIO_MASK 0x3ffff /* bits valid in the dev/ino fields */
+ /* used for dev/inode remaps */
+#endif /* _PAX_ */
+
+/*
+ * Binary cpio header structure
+ *
+ * CAUTION! CAUTION! CAUTION!
+ * Each field really represents a 16 bit short (NOT ASCII). Described as
+ * an array of chars in an attempt to improve portability!!
+ */
+typedef struct {
+ u_char h_magic[2];
+ u_char h_dev[2];
+ u_char h_ino[2];
+ u_char h_mode[2];
+ u_char h_uid[2];
+ u_char h_gid[2];
+ u_char h_nlink[2];
+ u_char h_rdev[2];
+ u_char h_mtime_1[2];
+ u_char h_mtime_2[2];
+ u_char h_namesize[2];
+ u_char h_filesize_1[2];
+ u_char h_filesize_2[2];
+} HD_BCPIO;
+
+#ifdef _PAX_
+/*
+ * extraction and creation macros for binary cpio
+ */
+#define SHRT_EXT(ch) ((((unsigned)(ch)[0])<<8) | (((unsigned)(ch)[1])&0xff))
+#define RSHRT_EXT(ch) ((((unsigned)(ch)[1])<<8) | (((unsigned)(ch)[0])&0xff))
+#define CHR_WR_0(val) ((char)(((val) >> 24) & 0xff))
+#define CHR_WR_1(val) ((char)(((val) >> 16) & 0xff))
+#define CHR_WR_2(val) ((char)(((val) >> 8) & 0xff))
+#define CHR_WR_3(val) ((char)((val) & 0xff))
+
+/*
+ * binary cpio masks and pads
+ */
+#define BCPIO_PAD(x) ((2 - ((x) & 1)) & 1) /* pad to next 2 byte word */
+#define BCPIO_MASK 0xffff /* mask for dev/ino fields */
+#endif /* _PAX_ */
+
+/*
+ * System VR4 cpio header structure (with/without file data crc)
+ */
+typedef struct {
+ char c_magic[6]; /* magic cookie */
+ char c_ino[8]; /* inode number */
+ char c_mode[8]; /* file type/access */
+ char c_uid[8]; /* owners uid */
+ char c_gid[8]; /* owners gid */
+ char c_nlink[8]; /* # of links at archive creation */
+ char c_mtime[8]; /* modification time */
+ char c_filesize[8]; /* length of file in bytes */
+ char c_maj[8]; /* block/char major # */
+ char c_min[8]; /* block/char minor # */
+ char c_rmaj[8]; /* special file major # */
+ char c_rmin[8]; /* special file minor # */
+ char c_namesize[8]; /* length of pathname */
+ char c_chksum[8]; /* 0 OR CRC of bytes of FILE data */
+} HD_VCPIO;
+
+#define VMAGIC 070701 /* sVr4 new portable archive id */
+#define VCMAGIC 070702 /* sVr4 new portable archive id CRC */
+#ifdef _PAX_
+#define AVMAGIC "070701" /* ascii string of above */
+#define AVCMAGIC "070702" /* ascii string of above */
+#define VCPIO_PAD(x) ((4 - ((x) & 3)) & 3) /* pad to next 4 byte word */
+#define VCPIO_MASK 0xffffffff /* mask for dev/ino fields */
+#endif /* _PAX_ */
diff --git a/bin/pax/extern.h b/bin/pax/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a1a10d0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,285 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+ */
+
+/*
+ * External references from each source file
+ */
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+
+/*
+ * ar_io.c
+ */
+extern char *arcname;
+int ar_open __P((char *));
+void ar_close __P((void));
+void ar_drain __P((void));
+int ar_set_wr __P((void));
+int ar_app_ok __P((void));
+int ar_read __P((register char *, register int));
+int ar_write __P((register char *, register int));
+int ar_rdsync __P((void));
+int ar_fow __P((off_t, off_t *));
+int ar_rev __P((off_t ));
+int ar_next __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * ar_subs.c
+ */
+extern u_long flcnt;
+void list __P((void));
+void extract __P((void));
+void append __P((void));
+void archive __P((void));
+void copy __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * buf_subs.c
+ */
+extern int blksz;
+extern int wrblksz;
+extern int maxflt;
+extern int rdblksz;
+extern off_t wrlimit;
+extern off_t rdcnt;
+extern off_t wrcnt;
+int wr_start __P((void));
+int rd_start __P((void));
+void cp_start __P((void));
+int appnd_start __P((off_t));
+int rd_sync __P((void));
+void pback __P((char *, int));
+int rd_skip __P((off_t));
+void wr_fin __P((void));
+int wr_rdbuf __P((register char *, register int));
+int rd_wrbuf __P((register char *, register int));
+int wr_skip __P((off_t));
+int wr_rdfile __P((ARCHD *, int, off_t *));
+int rd_wrfile __P((ARCHD *, int, off_t *));
+void cp_file __P((ARCHD *, int, int));
+int buf_fill __P((void));
+int buf_flush __P((register int));
+
+/*
+ * cache.c
+ */
+int uidtb_start __P((void));
+int gidtb_start __P((void));
+int usrtb_start __P((void));
+int grptb_start __P((void));
+char * name_uid __P((uid_t, int));
+char * name_gid __P((gid_t, int));
+int uid_name __P((char *, uid_t *));
+int gid_name __P((char *, gid_t *));
+
+/*
+ * cpio.c
+ */
+int cpio_strd __P((void));
+int cpio_trail __P((register ARCHD *));
+int cpio_endwr __P((void));
+int cpio_id __P((char *, int));
+int cpio_rd __P((register ARCHD *, register char *));
+off_t cpio_endrd __P((void));
+int cpio_stwr __P((void));
+int cpio_wr __P((register ARCHD *));
+int vcpio_id __P((char *, int));
+int crc_id __P((char *, int));
+int crc_strd __P((void));
+int vcpio_rd __P((register ARCHD *, register char *));
+off_t vcpio_endrd __P((void));
+int crc_stwr __P((void));
+int vcpio_wr __P((register ARCHD *));
+int bcpio_id __P((char *, int));
+int bcpio_rd __P((register ARCHD *, register char *));
+off_t bcpio_endrd __P((void));
+int bcpio_wr __P((register ARCHD *));
+
+/*
+ * file_subs.c
+ */
+int file_creat __P((register ARCHD *));
+void file_close __P((register ARCHD *, int));
+int lnk_creat __P((register ARCHD *));
+int cross_lnk __P((register ARCHD *));
+int chk_same __P((register ARCHD *));
+int node_creat __P((register ARCHD *));
+int unlnk_exist __P((register char *, register int));
+int chk_path __P((register char *, uid_t, gid_t));
+void set_ftime __P((char *fnm, time_t mtime, time_t atime, int frc));
+int set_ids __P((char *, uid_t, gid_t));
+void set_pmode __P((char *, mode_t));
+int file_write __P((int, char *, register int, int *, int *, int, char *));
+void file_flush __P((int, char *, int));
+void rdfile_close __P((register ARCHD *, register int *));
+int set_crc __P((register ARCHD *, register int));
+
+/*
+ * ftree.c
+ */
+int ftree_start __P((void));
+int ftree_add __P((register char *));
+void ftree_sel __P((register ARCHD *));
+void ftree_chk __P((void));
+int next_file __P((register ARCHD *));
+
+/*
+ * gen_subs.c
+ */
+void ls_list __P((register ARCHD *, time_t));
+void ls_tty __P((register ARCHD *));
+void zf_strncpy __P((register char *, register char *, int));
+int l_strncpy __P((register char *, register char *, int));
+u_long asc_ul __P((register char *, int, register int));
+int ul_asc __P((u_long, register char *, register int, register int));
+#ifndef NET2_STAT
+u_quad_t asc_uqd __P((register char *, int, register int));
+int uqd_asc __P((u_quad_t, register char *, register int, register int));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * options.c
+ */
+extern FSUB fsub[];
+extern int ford[];
+void options __P((register int, register char **));
+OPLIST * opt_next __P((void));
+int opt_add __P((register char *));
+int bad_opt __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * pat_rep.c
+ */
+int rep_add __P((register char *));
+int pat_add __P((char *));
+void pat_chk __P((void));
+int pat_sel __P((register ARCHD *));
+int pat_match __P((register ARCHD *));
+int mod_name __P((register ARCHD *));
+int set_dest __P((register ARCHD *, char *, int));
+
+/*
+ * pax.c
+ */
+extern int act;
+extern FSUB *frmt;
+extern int cflag;
+extern int dflag;
+extern int iflag;
+extern int kflag;
+extern int lflag;
+extern int nflag;
+extern int tflag;
+extern int uflag;
+extern int vflag;
+extern int Dflag;
+extern int Hflag;
+extern int Lflag;
+extern int Xflag;
+extern int Yflag;
+extern int Zflag;
+extern int vfpart;
+extern int patime;
+extern int pmtime;
+extern int pmode;
+extern int pids;
+extern int exit_val;
+extern int docrc;
+extern char *dirptr;
+extern char *ltmfrmt;
+extern char *argv0;
+int main __P((int, char **));
+void sig_cleanup __P((int));
+
+/*
+ * sel_subs.c
+ */
+int sel_chk __P((register ARCHD *));
+int grp_add __P((register char *));
+int usr_add __P((register char *));
+int trng_add __P((register char *));
+
+/*
+ * tables.c
+ */
+int lnk_start __P((void));
+int chk_lnk __P((register ARCHD *));
+void purg_lnk __P((register ARCHD *));
+void lnk_end __P((void));
+int ftime_start __P((void));
+int chk_ftime __P((register ARCHD *));
+int name_start __P((void));
+int add_name __P((register char *, int, char *));
+void sub_name __P((register char *, int *));
+int dev_start __P((void));
+int add_dev __P((register ARCHD *));
+int map_dev __P((register ARCHD *, u_long, u_long));
+int atdir_start __P((void));
+void atdir_end __P((void));
+void add_atdir __P((char *, dev_t, ino_t, time_t, time_t));
+int get_atdir __P((dev_t, ino_t, time_t *, time_t *));
+int dir_start __P((void));
+void add_dir __P((char *, int, struct stat *, int));
+void proc_dir __P((void));
+u_int st_hash __P((char *, int, int));
+
+/*
+ * tar.c
+ */
+int tar_endwr __P((void));
+off_t tar_endrd __P((void));
+int tar_trail __P((register char *, register int, register int *));
+int tar_id __P((register char *, int));
+int tar_opt __P((void));
+int tar_rd __P((register ARCHD *, register char *));
+int tar_wr __P((register ARCHD *));
+int ustar_strd __P((void));
+int ustar_stwr __P((void));
+int ustar_id __P((char *, int));
+int ustar_rd __P((register ARCHD *, register char *));
+int ustar_wr __P((register ARCHD *));
+
+/*
+ * tty_subs.c
+ */
+int tty_init __P((void));
+void tty_prnt __P((char *, ...));
+int tty_read __P((char *, int));
+void warn __P((int, char *, ...));
+void syswarn __P((int, int, char *, ...));
diff --git a/bin/pax/file_subs.c b/bin/pax/file_subs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f394707
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/file_subs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1055 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)file_subs.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <sys/uio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int
+mk_link __P((register char *,register struct stat *,register char *, int));
+
+/*
+ * routines that deal with file operations such as: creating, removing;
+ * and setting access modes, uid/gid and times of files
+ */
+
+#define FILEBITS (S_ISVTX | S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO)
+#define SETBITS (S_ISUID | S_ISGID)
+#define ABITS (FILEBITS | SETBITS)
+
+/*
+ * file_creat()
+ * Create and open a file.
+ * Return:
+ * file descriptor or -1 for failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+file_creat(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+file_creat(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ int fd = -1;
+ mode_t file_mode;
+ int oerrno;
+
+ /*
+ * assume file doesn't exist, so just try to create it, most times this
+ * works. We have to take special handling when the file does exist. To
+ * detect this, we use O_EXCL. For example when trying to create a
+ * file and a character device or fifo exists with the same name, we
+ * can accidently open the device by mistake (or block waiting to open)
+ * If we find that the open has failed, then figure spend the effore to
+ * figure out why. This strategy was found to have better average
+ * performance in common use than checking the file (and the path)
+ * first with lstat.
+ */
+ file_mode = arcn->sb.st_mode & FILEBITS;
+ if ((fd = open(arcn->name, O_WRONLY | O_CREAT | O_TRUNC | O_EXCL,
+ file_mode)) >= 0)
+ return(fd);
+
+ /*
+ * the file seems to exist. First we try to get rid of it (found to be
+ * the second most common failure when traced). If this fails, only
+ * then we go to the expense to check and create the path to the file
+ */
+ if (unlnk_exist(arcn->name, arcn->type) != 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ for (;;) {
+ /*
+ * try to open it again, if this fails, check all the nodes in
+ * the path and give it a final try. if chk_path() finds that
+ * it cannot fix anything, we will skip the last attempt
+ */
+ if ((fd = open(arcn->name, O_WRONLY | O_CREAT | O_TRUNC,
+ file_mode)) >= 0)
+ break;
+ oerrno = errno;
+ if (chk_path(arcn->name,arcn->sb.st_uid,arcn->sb.st_gid) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, oerrno, "Unable to create %s", arcn->name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ }
+ return(fd);
+}
+
+/*
+ * file_close()
+ * Close file descriptor to a file just created by pax. Sets modes,
+ * ownership and times as required.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 for success, -1 for failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+file_close(register ARCHD *arcn, int fd)
+#else
+void
+file_close(arcn, fd)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ int fd;
+#endif
+{
+ int res = 0;
+
+ if (fd < 0)
+ return;
+ if (close(fd) < 0)
+ syswarn(0, errno, "Unable to close file descriptor on %s",
+ arcn->name);
+
+ /*
+ * set owner/groups first as this may strip off mode bits we want
+ * then set file permission modes. Then set file access and
+ * modification times.
+ */
+ if (pids)
+ res = set_ids(arcn->name, arcn->sb.st_uid, arcn->sb.st_gid);
+
+ /*
+ * IMPORTANT SECURITY NOTE:
+ * if not preserving mode or we cannot set uid/gid, then PROHIBIT
+ * set uid/gid bits
+ */
+ if (!pmode || res)
+ arcn->sb.st_mode &= ~(SETBITS);
+ if (pmode)
+ set_pmode(arcn->name, arcn->sb.st_mode);
+ if (patime || pmtime)
+ set_ftime(arcn->name, arcn->sb.st_mtime, arcn->sb.st_atime, 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * lnk_creat()
+ * Create a hard link to arcn->ln_name from arcn->name. arcn->ln_name
+ * must exist;
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+lnk_creat(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+lnk_creat(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /*
+ * we may be running as root, so we have to be sure that link target
+ * is not a directory, so we lstat and check
+ */
+ if (lstat(arcn->ln_name, &sb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1,errno,"Unable to link to %s from %s", arcn->ln_name,
+ arcn->name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if (S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) {
+ warn(1, "A hard link to the directory %s is not allowed",
+ arcn->ln_name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ return(mk_link(arcn->ln_name, &sb, arcn->name, 0));
+}
+
+/*
+ * cross_lnk()
+ * Create a hard link to arcn->org_name from arcn->name. Only used in copy
+ * with the -l flag. No warning or error if this does not succeed (we will
+ * then just create the file)
+ * Return:
+ * 1 if copy() should try to create this file node
+ * 0 if cross_lnk() ok, -1 for fatal flaw (like linking to self).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+cross_lnk(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+cross_lnk(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * try to make a link to orginal file (-l flag in copy mode). make sure
+ * we do not try to link to directories in case we are running as root
+ * (and it might succeed).
+ */
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_DIR)
+ return(1);
+ return(mk_link(arcn->org_name, &(arcn->sb), arcn->name, 1));
+}
+
+/*
+ * chk_same()
+ * In copy mode if we are not trying to make hard links between the src
+ * and destinations, make sure we are not going to overwrite ourselves by
+ * accident. This slows things down a little, but we have to protect all
+ * those people who make typing errors.
+ * Return:
+ * 1 the target does not exist, go ahead and copy
+ * 0 skip it file exists (-k) or may be the same as source file
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+chk_same(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+chk_same(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /*
+ * if file does not exist, return. if file exists and -k, skip it
+ * quietly
+ */
+ if (lstat(arcn->name, &sb) < 0)
+ return(1);
+ if (kflag)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * better make sure the user does not have src == dest by mistake
+ */
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_dev == sb.st_dev) && (arcn->sb.st_ino == sb.st_ino)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to copy %s, file would overwrite itself",
+ arcn->name);
+ return(0);
+ }
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * mk_link()
+ * try to make a hard link between two files. if ign set, we do not
+ * complain.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if successful (or we are done with this file but no error, such as
+ * finding the from file exists and the user has set -k).
+ * 1 when ign was set to indicates we could not make the link but we
+ * should try to copy/extract the file as that might work (and is an
+ * allowed option). -1 an error occurred.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+mk_link(register char *to, register struct stat *to_sb, register char *from,
+ int ign)
+#else
+static int
+mk_link(to, to_sb, from, ign)
+ register char *to;
+ register struct stat *to_sb;
+ register char *from;
+ int ign;
+#endif
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+ int oerrno;
+
+ /*
+ * if from file exists, it has to be unlinked to make the link. If the
+ * file exists and -k is set, skip it quietly
+ */
+ if (lstat(from, &sb) == 0) {
+ if (kflag)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * make sure it is not the same file, protect the user
+ */
+ if ((to_sb->st_dev==sb.st_dev)&&(to_sb->st_ino == sb.st_ino)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to link file %s to itself", to);
+ return(-1);;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * try to get rid of the file, based on the type
+ */
+ if (S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) {
+ if (rmdir(from) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to remove %s", from);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ } else if (unlink(from) < 0) {
+ if (!ign) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to remove %s", from);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * from file is gone (or did not exist), try to make the hard link.
+ * if it fails, check the path and try it again (if chk_path() says to
+ * try again)
+ */
+ for (;;) {
+ if (link(to, from) == 0)
+ break;
+ oerrno = errno;
+ if (chk_path(from, to_sb->st_uid, to_sb->st_gid) == 0)
+ continue;
+ if (!ign) {
+ syswarn(1, oerrno, "Could not link to %s from %s", to,
+ from);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * all right the link was made
+ */
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * node_creat()
+ * create an entry in the file system (other than a file or hard link).
+ * If successful, sets uid/gid modes and times as required.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+node_creat(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+node_creat(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res;
+ register int ign = 0;
+ register int oerrno;
+ register int pass = 0;
+ mode_t file_mode;
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /*
+ * create node based on type, if that fails try to unlink the node and
+ * try again. finally check the path and try again. As noted in the
+ * file and link creation routines, this method seems to exhibit the
+ * best performance in general use workloads.
+ */
+ file_mode = arcn->sb.st_mode & FILEBITS;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ switch(arcn->type) {
+ case PAX_DIR:
+ res = mkdir(arcn->name, file_mode);
+ if (ign)
+ res = 0;
+ break;
+ case PAX_CHR:
+ file_mode |= S_IFCHR;
+ res = mknod(arcn->name, file_mode, arcn->sb.st_rdev);
+ break;
+ case PAX_BLK:
+ file_mode |= S_IFBLK;
+ res = mknod(arcn->name, file_mode, arcn->sb.st_rdev);
+ break;
+ case PAX_FIF:
+ res = mkfifo(arcn->name, file_mode);
+ break;
+ case PAX_SCK:
+ /*
+ * Skip sockets, operation has no meaning under BSD
+ */
+ warn(0,
+ "%s skipped. Sockets cannot be copied or extracted",
+ arcn->name);
+ return(-1);
+ case PAX_SLK:
+ if ((res = symlink(arcn->ln_name, arcn->name)) == 0)
+ return(0);
+ break;
+ case PAX_CTG:
+ case PAX_HLK:
+ case PAX_HRG:
+ case PAX_REG:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * we should never get here
+ */
+ warn(0, "%s has an unknown file type, skipping",
+ arcn->name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if we were able to create the node break out of the loop,
+ * otherwise try to unlink the node and try again. if that
+ * fails check the full path and try a final time.
+ */
+ if (res == 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * we failed to make the node
+ */
+ oerrno = errno;
+ if ((ign = unlnk_exist(arcn->name, arcn->type)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ if (++pass <= 1)
+ continue;
+
+ if (chk_path(arcn->name,arcn->sb.st_uid,arcn->sb.st_gid) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, oerrno, "Could not create: %s", arcn->name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we were able to create the node. set uid/gid, modes and times
+ */
+ if (pids)
+ res = set_ids(arcn->name, arcn->sb.st_uid, arcn->sb.st_gid);
+ else
+ res = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * IMPORTANT SECURITY NOTE:
+ * if not preserving mode or we cannot set uid/gid, then PROHIBIT any
+ * set uid/gid bits
+ */
+ if (!pmode || res)
+ arcn->sb.st_mode &= ~(SETBITS);
+ if (pmode)
+ set_pmode(arcn->name, arcn->sb.st_mode);
+
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_DIR) {
+ /*
+ * Dirs must be processed again at end of extract to set times
+ * and modes to agree with those stored in the archive. However
+ * to allow extract to continue, we may have to also set owner
+ * rights. This allows nodes in the archive that are children
+ * of this directory to be extracted without failure. Both time
+ * and modes will be fixed after the entire archive is read and
+ * before pax exits.
+ */
+ if (access(arcn->name, R_OK | W_OK | X_OK) < 0) {
+ if (lstat(arcn->name, &sb) < 0) {
+ syswarn(0, errno,"Could not access %s (stat)",
+ arcn->name);
+ set_pmode(arcn->name,file_mode | S_IRWXU);
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * We have to add rights to the dir, so we make
+ * sure to restore the mode. The mode must be
+ * restored AS CREATED and not as stored if
+ * pmode is not set.
+ */
+ set_pmode(arcn->name,
+ ((sb.st_mode & FILEBITS) | S_IRWXU));
+ if (!pmode)
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = sb.st_mode;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we have to force the mode to what was set here,
+ * since we changed it from the default as created.
+ */
+ add_dir(arcn->name, arcn->nlen, &(arcn->sb), 1);
+ } else if (pmode || patime || pmtime)
+ add_dir(arcn->name, arcn->nlen, &(arcn->sb), 0);
+ }
+
+ if (patime || pmtime)
+ set_ftime(arcn->name, arcn->sb.st_mtime, arcn->sb.st_atime, 0);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * unlnk_exist()
+ * Remove node from file system with the specified name. We pass the type
+ * of the node that is going to replace it. When we try to create a
+ * directory and find that it already exists, we allow processing to
+ * continue as proper modes etc will always be set for it later on.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 is ok to proceed, no file with the specified name exists
+ * -1 we were unable to remove the node, or we should not remove it (-k)
+ * 1 we found a directory and we were going to create a directory.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+unlnk_exist(register char *name, register int type)
+#else
+int
+unlnk_exist(name, type)
+ register char *name;
+ register int type;
+#endif
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ /*
+ * the file does not exist, or -k we are done
+ */
+ if (lstat(name, &sb) < 0)
+ return(0);
+ if (kflag)
+ return(-1);
+
+ if (S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode)) {
+ /*
+ * try to remove a directory, if it fails and we were going to
+ * create a directory anyway, tell the caller (return a 1)
+ */
+ if (rmdir(name) < 0) {
+ if (type == PAX_DIR)
+ return(1);
+ syswarn(1,errno,"Unable to remove directory %s", name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * try to get rid of all non-directory type nodes
+ */
+ if (unlink(name) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Could not unlink %s", name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * chk_path()
+ * We were trying to create some kind of node in the file system and it
+ * failed. chk_path() makes sure the path up to the node exists and is
+ * writeable. When we have to create a directory that is missing along the
+ * path somewhere, the directory we create will be set to the same
+ * uid/gid as the file has (when uid and gid are being preserved).
+ * NOTE: this routine is a real performance loss. It is only used as a
+ * last resort when trying to create entries in the file system.
+ * Return:
+ * -1 when it could find nothing it is allowed to fix.
+ * 0 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+chk_path( register char *name, uid_t st_uid, gid_t st_gid)
+#else
+int
+chk_path(name, st_uid, st_gid)
+ register char *name;
+ uid_t st_uid;
+ gid_t st_gid;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *spt = name;
+ struct stat sb;
+ int retval = -1;
+
+ /*
+ * watch out for paths with nodes stored directly in / (e.g. /bozo)
+ */
+ if (*spt == '/')
+ ++spt;
+
+ for(;;) {
+ /*
+ * work foward from the first / and check each part of the path
+ */
+ spt = strchr(spt, '/');
+ if (spt == NULL)
+ break;
+ *spt = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * if it exists we assume it is a directory, it is not within
+ * the spec (at least it seems to read that way) to alter the
+ * file system for nodes NOT EXPLICITLY stored on the archive.
+ * If that assumption is changed, you would test the node here
+ * and figure out how to get rid of it (probably like some
+ * recursive unlink()) or fix up the directory permissions if
+ * required (do an access()).
+ */
+ if (lstat(name, &sb) == 0) {
+ *(spt++) = '/';
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * the path fails at this point, see if we can create the
+ * needed directory and continue on
+ */
+ if (mkdir(name, S_IRWXU | S_IRWXG | S_IRWXO) < 0) {
+ *spt = '/';
+ retval = -1;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we were able to create the directory. We will tell the
+ * caller that we found something to fix, and it is ok to try
+ * and create the node again.
+ */
+ retval = 0;
+ if (pids)
+ (void)set_ids(name, st_uid, st_gid);
+
+ /*
+ * make sure the user doen't have some strange umask that
+ * causes this newly created directory to be unusable. We fix
+ * the modes and restore them back to the creation default at
+ * the end of pax
+ */
+ if ((access(name, R_OK | W_OK | X_OK) < 0) &&
+ (lstat(name, &sb) == 0)) {
+ set_pmode(name, ((sb.st_mode & FILEBITS) | S_IRWXU));
+ add_dir(name, spt - name, &sb, 1);
+ }
+ *(spt++) = '/';
+ continue;
+ }
+ return(retval);
+}
+
+/*
+ * set_ftime()
+ * Set the access time and modification time for a named file. If frc is
+ * non-zero we force these times to be set even if the the user did not
+ * request access and/or modification time preservation (this is also
+ * used by -t to reset access times).
+ * When ign is zero, only those times the user has asked for are set, the
+ * other ones are left alone. We do not assume the un-documented feature
+ * of many utimes() implementations that consider a 0 time value as a do
+ * not set request.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+set_ftime(char *fnm, time_t mtime, time_t atime, int frc)
+#else
+void
+set_ftime(fnm, mtime, atime, frc)
+ char *fnm;
+ time_t mtime;
+ time_t atime;
+ int frc;
+#endif
+{
+ static struct timeval tv[2] = {{0L, 0L}, {0L, 0L}};
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ tv[0].tv_sec = (long)atime;
+ tv[1].tv_sec = (long)mtime;
+ if (!frc && (!patime || !pmtime)) {
+ /*
+ * if we are not forcing, only set those times the user wants
+ * set. We get the current values of the times if we need them.
+ */
+ if (lstat(fnm, &sb) == 0) {
+ if (!patime)
+ tv[0].tv_sec = (long)sb.st_atime;
+ if (!pmtime)
+ tv[1].tv_sec = (long)sb.st_mtime;
+ } else
+ syswarn(0,errno,"Unable to obtain file stats %s", fnm);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * set the times
+ */
+ if (utimes(fnm, tv) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Access/modification time set failed on: %s",
+ fnm);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * set_ids()
+ * set the uid and gid of a file system node
+ * Return:
+ * 0 when set, -1 on failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+set_ids(char *fnm, uid_t uid, gid_t gid)
+#else
+int
+set_ids(fnm, uid, gid)
+ char *fnm;
+ uid_t uid;
+ gid_t gid;
+#endif
+{
+ if (chown(fnm, uid, gid) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to set file uid/gid of %s", fnm);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * set_pmode()
+ * Set file access mode
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+set_pmode(char *fnm, mode_t mode)
+#else
+void
+set_pmode(fnm, mode)
+ char *fnm;
+ mode_t mode;
+#endif
+{
+ mode &= ABITS;
+ if (chmod(fnm, mode) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Could not set permissions on %s", fnm);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * file_write()
+ * Write/copy a file (during copy or archive extract). This routine knows
+ * how to copy files with lseek holes in it. (Which are read as file
+ * blocks containing all 0's but do not have any file blocks associated
+ * with the data). Typical examples of these are files created by dbm
+ * variants (.pag files). While the file size of these files are huge, the
+ * actual storage is quite small (the files are sparse). The problem is
+ * the holes read as all zeros so are probably stored on the archive that
+ * way (there is no way to determine if the file block is really a hole,
+ * we only know that a file block of all zero's can be a hole).
+ * At this writing, no major archive format knows how to archive files
+ * with holes. However, on extraction (or during copy, -rw) we have to
+ * deal with these files. Without detecting the holes, the files can
+ * consume a lot of file space if just written to disk. This replacement
+ * for write when passed the basic allocation size of a file system block,
+ * uses lseek whenever it detects the input data is all 0 within that
+ * file block. In more detail, the strategy is as follows:
+ * While the input is all zero keep doing an lseek. Keep track of when we
+ * pass over file block boundries. Only write when we hit a non zero
+ * input. once we have written a file block, we continue to write it to
+ * the end (we stop looking at the input). When we reach the start of the
+ * next file block, start checking for zero blocks again. Working on file
+ * block boundries significantly reduces the overhead when copying files
+ * that are NOT very sparse. This overhead (when compared to a write) is
+ * almost below the measurement resolution on many systems. Without it,
+ * files with holes cannot be safely copied. It does has a side effect as
+ * it can put holes into files that did not have them before, but that is
+ * not a problem since the file contents are unchanged (in fact it saves
+ * file space). (Except on paging files for diskless clients. But since we
+ * cannot determine one of those file from here, we ignore them). If this
+ * ever ends up on a system where CTG files are supported and the holes
+ * are not desired, just do a conditional test in those routines that
+ * call file_write() and have it call write() instead. BEFORE CLOSING THE
+ * FILE, make sure to call file_flush() when the last write finishes with
+ * an empty block. A lot of file systems will not create an lseek hole at
+ * the end. In this case we drop a single 0 at the end to force the
+ * trailing 0's in the file.
+ * ---Parameters---
+ * rem: how many bytes left in this file system block
+ * isempt: have we written to the file block yet (is it empty)
+ * sz: basic file block allocation size
+ * cnt: number of bytes on this write
+ * str: buffer to write
+ * Return:
+ * number of bytes written, -1 on write (or lseek) error.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+file_write(int fd, char *str, register int cnt, int *rem, int *isempt, int sz,
+ char *name)
+#else
+int
+file_write(fd, str, cnt, rem, isempt, sz, name)
+ int fd;
+ char *str;
+ register int cnt;
+ int *rem;
+ int *isempt;
+ int sz;
+ char *name;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+ register char *end;
+ register int wcnt;
+ register char *st = str;
+
+ /*
+ * while we have data to process
+ */
+ while (cnt) {
+ if (!*rem) {
+ /*
+ * We are now at the start of file system block again
+ * (or what we think one is...). start looking for
+ * empty blocks again
+ */
+ *isempt = 1;
+ *rem = sz;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * only examine up to the end of the current file block or
+ * remaining characters to write, whatever is smaller
+ */
+ wcnt = MIN(cnt, *rem);
+ cnt -= wcnt;
+ *rem -= wcnt;
+ if (*isempt) {
+ /*
+ * have not written to this block yet, so we keep
+ * looking for zero's
+ */
+ pt = st;
+ end = st + wcnt;
+
+ /*
+ * look for a zero filled buffer
+ */
+ while ((pt < end) && (*pt == '\0'))
+ ++pt;
+
+ if (pt == end) {
+ /*
+ * skip, buf is empty so far
+ */
+ if (lseek(fd, (off_t)wcnt, SEEK_CUR) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1,errno,"File seek on %s",
+ name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ st = pt;
+ continue;
+ }
+ /*
+ * drat, the buf is not zero filled
+ */
+ *isempt = 0;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * have non-zero data in this file system block, have to write
+ */
+ if (write(fd, st, wcnt) != wcnt) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed write to file %s", name);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ st += wcnt;
+ }
+ return(st - str);
+}
+
+/*
+ * file_flush()
+ * when the last file block in a file is zero, many file systems will not
+ * let us create a hole at the end. To get the last block with zeros, we
+ * write the last BYTE with a zero (back up one byte and write a zero).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+file_flush(int fd, char *fname, int isempt)
+#else
+void
+file_flush(fd, fname, isempt)
+ int fd;
+ char *fname;
+ int isempt;
+#endif
+{
+ static char blnk[] = "\0";
+
+ /*
+ * silly test, but make sure we are only called when the last block is
+ * filled with all zeros.
+ */
+ if (!isempt)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * move back one byte and write a zero
+ */
+ if (lseek(fd, (off_t)-1, SEEK_CUR) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed seek on file %s", fname);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if (write(fd, blnk, 1) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed write to file %s", fname);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * rdfile_close()
+ * close a file we have beed reading (to copy or archive). If we have to
+ * reset access time (tflag) do so (the times are stored in arcn).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+rdfile_close(register ARCHD *arcn, register int *fd)
+#else
+void
+rdfile_close(arcn, fd)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register int *fd;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * make sure the file is open
+ */
+ if (*fd < 0)
+ return;
+
+ (void)close(*fd);
+ *fd = -1;
+ if (!tflag)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * user wants last access time reset
+ */
+ set_ftime(arcn->org_name, arcn->sb.st_mtime, arcn->sb.st_atime, 1);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * set_crc()
+ * read a file to calculate its crc. This is a real drag. Archive formats
+ * that have this, end up reading the file twice (we have to write the
+ * header WITH the crc before writing the file contents. Oh well...
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if was able to calculate the crc, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+set_crc(register ARCHD *arcn, register int fd)
+#else
+int
+set_crc(arcn, fd)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register int fd;
+#endif
+{
+ register int i;
+ register int res;
+ off_t cpcnt = 0L;
+ u_long size;
+ unsigned long crc = 0L;
+ char tbuf[FILEBLK];
+ struct stat sb;
+
+ if (fd < 0) {
+ /*
+ * hmm, no fd, should never happen. well no crc then.
+ */
+ arcn->crc = 0L;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ if ((size = (u_long)arcn->sb.st_blksize) > (u_long)sizeof(tbuf))
+ size = (u_long)sizeof(tbuf);
+
+ /*
+ * read all the bytes we think that there are in the file. If the user
+ * is trying to archive an active file, forget this file.
+ */
+ for(;;) {
+ if ((res = read(fd, tbuf, size)) <= 0)
+ break;
+ cpcnt += res;
+ for (i = 0; i < res; ++i)
+ crc += (tbuf[i] & 0xff);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * safety check. we want to avoid archiving files that are active as
+ * they can create inconsistant archive copies.
+ */
+ if (cpcnt != arcn->sb.st_size)
+ warn(1, "File changed size %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (fstat(fd, &sb) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed stat on %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (arcn->sb.st_mtime != sb.st_mtime)
+ warn(1, "File %s was modified during read", arcn->org_name);
+ else if (lseek(fd, (off_t)0L, SEEK_SET) < 0)
+ syswarn(1, errno, "File rewind failed on: %s", arcn->org_name);
+ else {
+ arcn->crc = crc;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ return(-1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/ftree.c b/bin/pax/ftree.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..62dd94d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/ftree.c
@@ -0,0 +1,543 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)ftree.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "ftree.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * routines to interface with the fts library function.
+ *
+ * file args supplied to pax are stored on a single linked list (of type FTREE)
+ * and given to fts to be processed one at a time. pax "selects" files from
+ * the expansion of each arg into the corresponding file tree (if the arg is a
+ * directory, otherwise the node itself is just passed to pax). The selection
+ * is modified by the -n and -u flags. The user is informed when a specific
+ * file arg does not generate any selected files. -n keeps expanding the file
+ * tree arg until one of its files is selected, then skips to the next file
+ * arg. when the user does not supply the file trees as command line args to
+ * pax, they are read from stdin
+ */
+
+static FTS *ftsp = NULL; /* curent FTS handle */
+static int ftsopts; /* options to be used on fts_open */
+static char *farray[2]; /* array for passing each arg to fts */
+static FTREE *fthead = NULL; /* head of linked list of file args */
+static FTREE *fttail = NULL; /* tail of linked list of file args */
+static FTREE *ftcur = NULL; /* current file arg being processed */
+static FTSENT *ftent = NULL; /* current file tree entry */
+static int ftree_skip; /* when set skip to next file arg */
+
+static int ftree_arg __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * ftree_start()
+ * initialize the options passed to fts_open() during this run of pax
+ * options are based on the selection of pax options by the user
+ * fts_start() also calls fts_arg() to open the first valid file arg. We
+ * also attempt to reset directory access times when -t (tflag) is set.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if there is at least one valid file arg to process, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ftree_start(void)
+#else
+int
+ftree_start()
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * set up the operation mode of fts, open the first file arg. We must
+ * use FTS_NOCHDIR, as the user may have to open multiple archives and
+ * if fts did a chdir off into the boondocks, we may create an archive
+ * volume in an place where the user did not expect to.
+ */
+ ftsopts = FTS_NOCHDIR;
+
+ /*
+ * optional user flags that effect file traversal
+ * -H command line symlink follow only (half follow)
+ * -L follow sylinks (logical)
+ * -P do not follow sylinks (physical). This is the default.
+ * -X do not cross over mount points
+ * -t preserve access times on files read.
+ * -n select only the first member of a file tree when a match is found
+ * -d do not extract subtrees rooted at a directory arg.
+ */
+ if (Lflag)
+ ftsopts |= FTS_LOGICAL;
+ else
+ ftsopts |= FTS_PHYSICAL;
+ if (Hflag)
+# ifdef NET2_FTS
+ warn(0, "The -H flag is not supported on this version");
+# else
+ ftsopts |= FTS_COMFOLLOW;
+# endif
+ if (Xflag)
+ ftsopts |= FTS_XDEV;
+
+ if ((fthead == NULL) && ((farray[0] = malloc(PAXPATHLEN+2)) == NULL)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for file name buffer");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if (ftree_arg() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (tflag && (atdir_start() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ftree_add()
+ * add the arg to the linked list of files to process. Each will be
+ * processed by fts one at a time
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if added to the linked list, -1 if failed
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ftree_add(register char *str)
+#else
+int
+ftree_add(str)
+ register char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register FTREE *ft;
+ register int len;
+
+ /*
+ * simple check for bad args
+ */
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0')) {
+ warn(0, "Invalid file name arguement");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * allocate FTREE node and add to the end of the linked list (args are
+ * processed in the same order they were passed to pax). Get rid of any
+ * trailing / the user may pass us. (watch out for / by itself).
+ */
+ if ((ft = (FTREE *)malloc(sizeof(FTREE))) == NULL) {
+ warn(0, "Unable to allocate memory for filename");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ if (((len = strlen(str) - 1) > 0) && (str[len] == '/'))
+ str[len] = '\0';
+ ft->fname = str;
+ ft->refcnt = 0;
+ ft->fow = NULL;
+ if (fthead == NULL) {
+ fttail = fthead = ft;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ fttail->fow = ft;
+ fttail = ft;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ftree_sel()
+ * this entry has been selected by pax. bump up reference count and handle
+ * -n and -d processing.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+ftree_sel(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+void
+ftree_sel(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * set reference bit for this pattern. This linked list is only used
+ * when file trees are supplied pax as args. The list is not used when
+ * the trees are read from stdin.
+ */
+ if (ftcur != NULL)
+ ftcur->refcnt = 1;
+
+ /*
+ * if -n we are done with this arg, force a skip to the next arg when
+ * pax asks for the next file in next_file().
+ * if -d we tell fts only to match the directory (if the arg is a dir)
+ * and not the entire file tree rooted at that point.
+ */
+ if (nflag)
+ ftree_skip = 1;
+
+ if (!dflag || (arcn->type != PAX_DIR))
+ return;
+
+ if (ftent != NULL)
+ (void)fts_set(ftsp, ftent, FTS_SKIP);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ftree_chk()
+ * called at end on pax execution. Prints all those file args that did not
+ * have a selected member (reference count still 0)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+ftree_chk(void)
+#else
+void
+ftree_chk()
+#endif
+{
+ register FTREE *ft;
+ register int wban = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * make sure all dir access times were reset.
+ */
+ if (tflag)
+ atdir_end();
+
+ /*
+ * walk down list and check reference count. Print out those members
+ * that never had a match
+ */
+ for (ft = fthead; ft != NULL; ft = ft->fow) {
+ if (ft->refcnt > 0)
+ continue;
+ if (wban == 0) {
+ warn(1,"WARNING! These file names were not selected:");
+ ++wban;
+ }
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", ft->fname);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * ftree_arg()
+ * Get the next file arg for fts to process. Can be from either the linked
+ * list or read from stdin when the user did not them as args to pax. Each
+ * arg is processed until the first successful fts_open().
+ * Return:
+ * 0 when the next arg is ready to go, -1 if out of file args (or EOF on
+ * stdin).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+ftree_arg(void)
+#else
+static int
+ftree_arg()
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * close off the current file tree
+ */
+ if (ftsp != NULL) {
+ (void)fts_close(ftsp);
+ ftsp = NULL;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * keep looping until we get a valid file tree to process. Stop when we
+ * reach the end of the list (or get an eof on stdin)
+ */
+ for(;;) {
+ if (fthead == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * the user didn't supply any args, get the file trees
+ * to process from stdin;
+ */
+ if (fgets(farray[0], PAXPATHLEN+1, stdin) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((pt = strchr(farray[0], '\n')) != NULL)
+ *pt = '\0';
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * the user supplied the file args as arguements to pax
+ */
+ if (ftcur == NULL)
+ ftcur = fthead;
+ else if ((ftcur = ftcur->fow) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ farray[0] = ftcur->fname;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * watch it, fts wants the file arg stored in a array of char
+ * ptrs, with the last one a null. we use a two element array
+ * and set farray[0] to point at the buffer with the file name
+ * in it. We cannnot pass all the file args to fts at one shot
+ * as we need to keep a handle on which file arg generates what
+ * files (the -n and -d flags need this). If the open is
+ * successful, return a 0.
+ */
+ if ((ftsp = fts_open(farray, ftsopts, NULL)) != NULL)
+ break;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * next_file()
+ * supplies the next file to process in the supplied archd structure.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 when contents of arcn have been set with the next file, -1 when done.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+next_file(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+next_file(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register int cnt;
+ time_t atime;
+ time_t mtime;
+
+ /*
+ * ftree_sel() might have set the ftree_skip flag if the user has the
+ * -n option and a file was selected from this file arg tree. (-n says
+ * only one member is matched for each pattern) ftree_skip being 1
+ * forces us to go to the next arg now.
+ */
+ if (ftree_skip) {
+ /*
+ * clear and go to next arg
+ */
+ ftree_skip = 0;
+ if (ftree_arg() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * loop until we get a valid file to process
+ */
+ for(;;) {
+ if ((ftent = fts_read(ftsp)) == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * out of files in this tree, go to next arg, if none
+ * we are done
+ */
+ if (ftree_arg() < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * handle each type of fts_read() flag
+ */
+ switch(ftent->fts_info) {
+ case FTS_D:
+ case FTS_DEFAULT:
+ case FTS_F:
+ case FTS_SL:
+ case FTS_SLNONE:
+ /*
+ * these are all ok
+ */
+ break;
+ case FTS_DP:
+ /*
+ * already saw this directory. If the user wants file
+ * access times reset, we use this to restore the
+ * access time for this directory since this is the
+ * last time we will see it in this file subtree
+ * remember to force the time (this is -t on a read
+ * directory, not a created directory).
+ */
+# ifdef NET2_FTS
+ if (!tflag || (get_atdir(ftent->fts_statb.st_dev,
+ ftent->fts_statb.st_ino, &mtime, &atime) < 0))
+# else
+ if (!tflag || (get_atdir(ftent->fts_statp->st_dev,
+ ftent->fts_statp->st_ino, &mtime, &atime) < 0))
+# endif
+ continue;
+ set_ftime(ftent->fts_path, mtime, atime, 1);
+ continue;
+ case FTS_DC:
+ /*
+ * fts claims a file system cycle
+ */
+ warn(1,"File system cycle found at %s",ftent->fts_path);
+ continue;
+ case FTS_DNR:
+# ifdef NET2_FTS
+ syswarn(1, errno,
+# else
+ syswarn(1, ftent->fts_errno,
+# endif
+ "Unable to read directory %s", ftent->fts_path);
+ continue;
+ case FTS_ERR:
+# ifdef NET2_FTS
+ syswarn(1, errno,
+# else
+ syswarn(1, ftent->fts_errno,
+# endif
+ "File system traversal error");
+ continue;
+ case FTS_NS:
+ case FTS_NSOK:
+# ifdef NET2_FTS
+ syswarn(1, errno,
+# else
+ syswarn(1, ftent->fts_errno,
+# endif
+ "Unable to access %s", ftent->fts_path);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * ok got a file tree node to process. copy info into arcn
+ * structure (initialize as required)
+ */
+ arcn->skip = 0;
+ arcn->pad = 0;
+ arcn->ln_nlen = 0;
+ arcn->ln_name[0] = '\0';
+# ifdef NET2_FTS
+ arcn->sb = ftent->fts_statb;
+# else
+ arcn->sb = *(ftent->fts_statp);
+# endif
+
+ /*
+ * file type based set up and copy into the arcn struct
+ * SIDE NOTE:
+ * we try to reset the access time on all files and directories
+ * we may read when the -t flag is specified. files are reset
+ * when we close them after copying. we reset the directories
+ * when we are done with their file tree (we also clean up at
+ * end in case we cut short a file tree traversal). However
+ * there is no way to reset access times on symlinks.
+ */
+ switch(S_IFMT & arcn->sb.st_mode) {
+ case S_IFDIR:
+ arcn->type = PAX_DIR;
+ if (!tflag)
+ break;
+ add_atdir(ftent->fts_path, arcn->sb.st_dev,
+ arcn->sb.st_ino, arcn->sb.st_mtime,
+ arcn->sb.st_atime);
+ break;
+ case S_IFCHR:
+ arcn->type = PAX_CHR;
+ break;
+ case S_IFBLK:
+ arcn->type = PAX_BLK;
+ break;
+ case S_IFREG:
+ /*
+ * only regular files with have data to store on the
+ * archive. all others will store a zero length skip.
+ * the skip field is used by pax for actual data it has
+ * to read (or skip over).
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_REG;
+ arcn->skip = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ break;
+ case S_IFLNK:
+ arcn->type = PAX_SLK;
+ /*
+ * have to read the symlink path from the file
+ */
+ if ((cnt = readlink(ftent->fts_path, arcn->ln_name,
+ PAXPATHLEN)) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to read symlink %s",
+ ftent->fts_path);
+ continue;
+ }
+ /*
+ * set link name length, watch out readlink does not
+ * allways null terminate the link path
+ */
+ arcn->ln_name[cnt] = '\0';
+ arcn->ln_nlen = cnt;
+ break;
+ case S_IFSOCK:
+ /*
+ * under BSD storing a socket is senseless but we will
+ * let the format specific write function make the
+ * decision of what to do with it.
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_SCK;
+ break;
+ case S_IFIFO:
+ arcn->type = PAX_FIF;
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * copy file name, set file name length
+ */
+ arcn->nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->name, ftent->fts_path, PAXPATHLEN+1);
+ arcn->name[arcn->nlen] = '\0';
+ arcn->org_name = ftent->fts_path;
+ return(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/ftree.h b/bin/pax/ftree.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f93eda6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/ftree.h
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)ftree.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Data structure used by the ftree.c routines to store the file args to be
+ * handed to fts(). It keeps a reference count of which args generated a
+ * "selected" member
+ */
+
+typedef struct ftree {
+ char *fname; /* file tree name */
+ int refcnt; /* has tree had a selected file? */
+ struct ftree *fow; /* pointer to next entry on list */
+} FTREE;
diff --git a/bin/pax/gen_subs.c b/bin/pax/gen_subs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..390e5bd
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/gen_subs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,487 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)gen_subs.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <tzfile.h>
+#include <utmp.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * a collection of general purpose subroutines used by pax
+ */
+
+/*
+ * constants used by ls_list() when printing out archive members
+ */
+#define MODELEN 20
+#define DATELEN 64
+#define SIXMONTHS ((DAYSPERNYEAR / 2) * SECSPERDAY)
+#define CURFRMT "%b %e %H:%M"
+#define OLDFRMT "%b %e %Y"
+#ifndef UT_NAMESIZE
+#define UT_NAMESIZE 8
+#endif
+#define UT_GRPSIZE 6
+
+/*
+ * ls_list()
+ * list the members of an archive in ls format
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+ls_list(register ARCHD *arcn, time_t now)
+#else
+void
+ls_list(arcn, now)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ time_t now;
+#endif
+{
+ register struct stat *sbp;
+ char f_mode[MODELEN];
+ char f_date[DATELEN];
+ char *timefrmt;
+
+ /*
+ * if not verbose, just print the file name
+ */
+ if (!vflag) {
+ (void)printf("%s\n", arcn->name);
+ (void)fflush(stdout);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * user wants long mode
+ */
+ sbp = &(arcn->sb);
+ strmode(sbp->st_mode, f_mode);
+
+ if (ltmfrmt == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * no locale specified format. time format based on age
+ * compared to the time pax was started.
+ */
+ if ((sbp->st_mtime + SIXMONTHS) <= now)
+ timefrmt = OLDFRMT;
+ else
+ timefrmt = CURFRMT;
+ } else
+ timefrmt = ltmfrmt;
+
+ /*
+ * print file mode, link count, uid, gid and time
+ */
+ if (strftime(f_date,DATELEN,timefrmt,localtime(&(sbp->st_mtime))) == 0)
+ f_date[0] = '\0';
+ (void)printf("%s%2u %-*s %-*s ", f_mode, sbp->st_nlink, UT_NAMESIZE,
+ name_uid(sbp->st_uid, 1), UT_GRPSIZE,
+ name_gid(sbp->st_gid, 1));
+
+ /*
+ * print device id's for devices, or sizes for other nodes
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_CHR) || (arcn->type == PAX_BLK))
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ (void)printf("%4u,%4u ", MAJOR(sbp->st_rdev),
+# else
+ (void)printf("%4lu,%4lu ", MAJOR(sbp->st_rdev),
+# endif
+ MINOR(sbp->st_rdev));
+ else {
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ (void)printf("%9lu ", sbp->st_size);
+# else
+ (void)printf("%9qu ", sbp->st_size);
+# endif
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * print name and link info for hard and soft links
+ */
+ (void)printf("%s %s", f_date, arcn->name);
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_HLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ (void)printf(" == %s\n", arcn->ln_name);
+ else if (arcn->type == PAX_SLK)
+ (void)printf(" => %s\n", arcn->ln_name);
+ else
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+ (void)fflush(stdout);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * tty_ls()
+ * print a short summary of file to tty.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+ls_tty(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+void
+ls_tty(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ char f_date[DATELEN];
+ char f_mode[MODELEN];
+ char *timefrmt;
+
+ if (ltmfrmt == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * no locale specified format
+ */
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_mtime + SIXMONTHS) <= time((time_t *)NULL))
+ timefrmt = OLDFRMT;
+ else
+ timefrmt = CURFRMT;
+ } else
+ timefrmt = ltmfrmt;
+
+ /*
+ * convert time to string, and print
+ */
+ if (strftime(f_date, DATELEN, timefrmt,
+ localtime(&(arcn->sb.st_mtime))) == 0)
+ f_date[0] = '\0';
+ strmode(arcn->sb.st_mode, f_mode);
+ tty_prnt("%s%s %s\n", f_mode, f_date, arcn->name);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * zf_strncpy()
+ * copy src to dest up to len chars (stopping at first '\0'), when src is
+ * shorter than len, pads to len with '\0'. big performance win (and
+ * a lot easier to code) over strncpy(), then a strlen() then a
+ * bzero(). (or doing the bzero() first).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+zf_strncpy(register char *dest, register char *src, int len)
+#else
+void
+zf_strncpy(dest, src, len)
+ register char *dest;
+ register char *src;
+ int len;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *stop;
+
+ stop = dest + len;
+ while ((dest < stop) && (*src != '\0'))
+ *dest++ = *src++;
+ while (dest < stop)
+ *dest++ = '\0';
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * l_strncpy()
+ * copy src to dest up to len chars (stopping at first '\0')
+ * Return:
+ * number of chars copied. (Note this is a real performance win over
+ * doing a strncpy() then a strlen()
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+l_strncpy(register char *dest, register char *src, int len)
+#else
+int
+l_strncpy(dest, src, len)
+ register char *dest;
+ register char *src;
+ int len;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *stop;
+ register char *start;
+
+ stop = dest + len;
+ start = dest;
+ while ((dest < stop) && (*src != '\0'))
+ *dest++ = *src++;
+ if (dest < stop)
+ *dest = '\0';
+ return(dest - start);
+}
+
+/*
+ * asc_ul()
+ * convert hex/octal character string into a u_long. We do not have to
+ * check for overflow! (the headers in all supported formats are not large
+ * enough to create an overflow).
+ * NOTE: strings passed to us are NOT TERMINATED.
+ * Return:
+ * unsigned long value
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+u_long
+asc_ul(register char *str, int len, register int base)
+#else
+u_long
+asc_ul(str, len, base)
+ register char *str;
+ int len;
+ register int base;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *stop;
+ u_long tval = 0;
+
+ stop = str + len;
+
+ /*
+ * skip over leading blanks and zeros
+ */
+ while ((str < stop) && ((*str == ' ') || (*str == '0')))
+ ++str;
+
+ /*
+ * for each valid digit, shift running value (tval) over to next digit
+ * and add next digit
+ */
+ if (base == HEX) {
+ while (str < stop) {
+ if ((*str >= '0') && (*str <= '9'))
+ tval = (tval << 4) + (*str++ - '0');
+ else if ((*str >= 'A') && (*str <= 'F'))
+ tval = (tval << 4) + 10 + (*str++ - 'A');
+ else if ((*str >= 'a') && (*str <= 'f'))
+ tval = (tval << 4) + 10 + (*str++ - 'a');
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ while ((str < stop) && (*str >= '0') && (*str <= '7'))
+ tval = (tval << 3) + (*str++ - '0');
+ }
+ return(tval);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ul_asc()
+ * convert an unsigned long into an hex/oct ascii string. pads with LEADING
+ * ascii 0's to fill string completely
+ * NOTE: the string created is NOT TERMINATED.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ul_asc(u_long val, register char *str, register int len, register int base)
+#else
+int
+ul_asc(val, str, len, base)
+ u_long val;
+ register char *str;
+ register int len;
+ register int base;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+ u_long digit;
+
+ /*
+ * WARNING str is not '\0' terminated by this routine
+ */
+ pt = str + len - 1;
+
+ /*
+ * do a tailwise conversion (start at right most end of string to place
+ * least significant digit). Keep shifting until conversion value goes
+ * to zero (all digits were converted)
+ */
+ if (base == HEX) {
+ while (pt >= str) {
+ if ((digit = (val & 0xf)) < 10)
+ *pt-- = '0' + (char)digit;
+ else
+ *pt-- = 'a' + (char)(digit - 10);
+ if ((val = (val >> 4)) == (u_long)0)
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ while (pt >= str) {
+ *pt-- = '0' + (char)(val & 0x7);
+ if ((val = (val >> 3)) == (u_long)0)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * pad with leading ascii ZEROS. We return -1 if we ran out of space.
+ */
+ while (pt >= str)
+ *pt-- = '0';
+ if (val != (u_long)0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+#ifndef NET2_STAT
+/*
+ * asc_uqd()
+ * convert hex/octal character string into a u_quad_t. We do not have to
+ * check for overflow! (the headers in all supported formats are not large
+ * enough to create an overflow).
+ * NOTE: strings passed to us are NOT TERMINATED.
+ * Return:
+ * u_quad_t value
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+u_quad_t
+asc_uqd(register char *str, int len, register int base)
+#else
+u_quad_t
+asc_uqd(str, len, base)
+ register char *str;
+ int len;
+ register int base;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *stop;
+ u_quad_t tval = 0;
+
+ stop = str + len;
+
+ /*
+ * skip over leading blanks and zeros
+ */
+ while ((str < stop) && ((*str == ' ') || (*str == '0')))
+ ++str;
+
+ /*
+ * for each valid digit, shift running value (tval) over to next digit
+ * and add next digit
+ */
+ if (base == HEX) {
+ while (str < stop) {
+ if ((*str >= '0') && (*str <= '9'))
+ tval = (tval << 4) + (*str++ - '0');
+ else if ((*str >= 'A') && (*str <= 'F'))
+ tval = (tval << 4) + 10 + (*str++ - 'A');
+ else if ((*str >= 'a') && (*str <= 'f'))
+ tval = (tval << 4) + 10 + (*str++ - 'a');
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ while ((str < stop) && (*str >= '0') && (*str <= '7'))
+ tval = (tval << 3) + (*str++ - '0');
+ }
+ return(tval);
+}
+
+/*
+ * uqd_asc()
+ * convert an u_quad_t into a hex/oct ascii string. pads with LEADING
+ * ascii 0's to fill string completely
+ * NOTE: the string created is NOT TERMINATED.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+uqd_asc(u_quad_t val, register char *str, register int len, register int base)
+#else
+int
+uqd_asc(val, str, len, base)
+ u_quad_t val;
+ register char *str;
+ register int len;
+ register int base;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+ u_quad_t digit;
+
+ /*
+ * WARNING str is not '\0' terminated by this routine
+ */
+ pt = str + len - 1;
+
+ /*
+ * do a tailwise conversion (start at right most end of string to place
+ * least significant digit). Keep shifting until conversion value goes
+ * to zero (all digits were converted)
+ */
+ if (base == HEX) {
+ while (pt >= str) {
+ if ((digit = (val & 0xf)) < 10)
+ *pt-- = '0' + (char)digit;
+ else
+ *pt-- = 'a' + (char)(digit - 10);
+ if ((val = (val >> 4)) == (u_quad_t)0)
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ while (pt >= str) {
+ *pt-- = '0' + (char)(val & 0x7);
+ if ((val = (val >> 3)) == (u_quad_t)0)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * pad with leading ascii ZEROS. We return -1 if we ran out of space.
+ */
+ while (pt >= str)
+ *pt-- = '0';
+ if (val != (u_quad_t)0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/pax/options.c b/bin/pax/options.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a7233fb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/options.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1140 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)options.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/mtio.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "cpio.h"
+#include "tar.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Routines which handle command line options
+ */
+
+static char flgch[] = FLGCH; /* list of all possible flags */
+static OPLIST *ophead = NULL; /* head for format specific options -x */
+static OPLIST *optail = NULL; /* option tail */
+
+static int no_op __P((void));
+static void printflg __P((unsigned int));
+static int c_frmt __P((const void *, const void *));
+static off_t str_offt __P((char *));
+static void pax_options __P((register int, register char **));
+static void pax_usage __P((void));
+static void tar_options __P((register int, register char **));
+static void tar_usage __P((void));
+#ifdef notdef
+static void cpio_options __P((register int, register char **));
+static void cpio_usage __P((void));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Format specific routine table - MUST BE IN SORTED ORDER BY NAME
+ * (see pax.h for description of each function)
+ *
+ * name, blksz, hdsz, udev, hlk, blkagn, inhead, id, st_read,
+ * read, end_read, st_write, write, end_write, trail,
+ * rd_data, wr_data, options
+ */
+
+FSUB fsub[] = {
+/* 0: OLD BINARY CPIO */
+ "bcpio", 5120, sizeof(HD_BCPIO), 1, 0, 0, 1, bcpio_id, cpio_strd,
+ bcpio_rd, bcpio_endrd, cpio_stwr, bcpio_wr, cpio_endwr, cpio_trail,
+ rd_wrfile, wr_rdfile, bad_opt,
+
+/* 1: OLD OCTAL CHARACTER CPIO */
+ "cpio", 5120, sizeof(HD_CPIO), 1, 0, 0, 1, cpio_id, cpio_strd,
+ cpio_rd, cpio_endrd, cpio_stwr, cpio_wr, cpio_endwr, cpio_trail,
+ rd_wrfile, wr_rdfile, bad_opt,
+
+/* 2: SVR4 HEX CPIO */
+ "sv4cpio", 5120, sizeof(HD_VCPIO), 1, 0, 0, 1, vcpio_id, cpio_strd,
+ vcpio_rd, vcpio_endrd, cpio_stwr, vcpio_wr, cpio_endwr, cpio_trail,
+ rd_wrfile, wr_rdfile, bad_opt,
+
+/* 3: SVR4 HEX CPIO WITH CRC */
+ "sv4crc", 5120, sizeof(HD_VCPIO), 1, 0, 0, 1, crc_id, crc_strd,
+ vcpio_rd, vcpio_endrd, crc_stwr, vcpio_wr, cpio_endwr, cpio_trail,
+ rd_wrfile, wr_rdfile, bad_opt,
+
+/* 4: OLD TAR */
+ "tar", 10240, BLKMULT, 0, 1, BLKMULT, 0, tar_id, no_op,
+ tar_rd, tar_endrd, no_op, tar_wr, tar_endwr, tar_trail,
+ rd_wrfile, wr_rdfile, tar_opt,
+
+/* 5: POSIX USTAR */
+ "ustar", 10240, BLKMULT, 0, 1, BLKMULT, 0, ustar_id, ustar_strd,
+ ustar_rd, tar_endrd, ustar_stwr, ustar_wr, tar_endwr, tar_trail,
+ rd_wrfile, wr_rdfile, bad_opt,
+};
+#define F_TAR 4 /* format when called as tar */
+#define DEFLT 5 /* default write format from list above */
+
+/*
+ * ford is the archive search order used by get_arc() to determine what kind
+ * of archive we are dealing with. This helps to properly id archive formats
+ * some formats may be subsets of others....
+ */
+int ford[] = {5, 4, 3, 2, 1, 0, -1 };
+
+/*
+ * options()
+ * figure out if we are pax, tar or cpio. Call the appropriate options
+ * parser
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+options(register int argc, register char **argv)
+#else
+void
+options(argc, argv)
+ register int argc;
+ register char **argv;
+#endif
+{
+
+ /*
+ * Are we acting like pax, tar or cpio (based on argv[0])
+ */
+ if ((argv0 = strrchr(argv[0], '/')) != NULL)
+ argv0++;
+ else
+ argv0 = argv[0];
+
+ if (strcmp(NM_TAR, argv0) == 0)
+ return(tar_options(argc, argv));
+# ifdef notdef
+ else if (strcmp(NM_CPIO, argv0) == 0)
+ return(cpio_options(argc, argv));
+# endif
+ /*
+ * assume pax as the default
+ */
+ argv0 = NM_PAX;
+ return(pax_options(argc, argv));
+}
+
+/*
+ * pax_options()
+ * look at the user specified flags. set globals as required and check if
+ * the user specified a legal set of flags. If not, complain and exit
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static void
+pax_options(register int argc, register char **argv)
+#else
+static void
+pax_options(argc, argv)
+ register int argc;
+ register char **argv;
+#endif
+{
+ register int c;
+ register int i;
+ unsigned int flg = 0;
+ unsigned int bflg = 0;
+ register char *pt;
+ FSUB tmp;
+ extern char *optarg;
+ extern int optind;
+
+ /*
+ * process option flags
+ */
+ while ((c=getopt(argc,argv,"ab:cdf:iklno:p:rs:tuvwx:B:DE:G:HLPT:U:XYZ"))
+ != EOF) {
+ switch (c) {
+ case 'a':
+ /*
+ * append
+ */
+ flg |= AF;
+ break;
+ case 'b':
+ /*
+ * specify blocksize
+ */
+ flg |= BF;
+ if ((wrblksz = (int)str_offt(optarg)) <= 0) {
+ warn(1, "Invalid block size %s", optarg);
+ pax_usage();
+ }
+ break;
+ case 'c':
+ /*
+ * inverse match on patterns
+ */
+ cflag = 1;
+ flg |= CF;
+ break;
+ case 'd':
+ /*
+ * match only dir on extract, not the subtree at dir
+ */
+ dflag = 1;
+ flg |= DF;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ /*
+ * filename where the archive is stored
+ */
+ arcname = optarg;
+ flg |= FF;
+ break;
+ case 'i':
+ /*
+ * interactive file rename
+ */
+ iflag = 1;
+ flg |= IF;
+ break;
+ case 'k':
+ /*
+ * do not clobber files that exist
+ */
+ kflag = 1;
+ flg |= KF;
+ break;
+ case 'l':
+ /*
+ * try to link src to dest with copy (-rw)
+ */
+ lflag = 1;
+ flg |= LF;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ /*
+ * select first match for a pattern only
+ */
+ nflag = 1;
+ flg |= NF;
+ break;
+ case 'o':
+ /*
+ * pass format specific options
+ */
+ flg |= OF;
+ if (opt_add(optarg) < 0)
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ /*
+ * specify file characteristic options
+ */
+ for (pt = optarg; *pt != '\0'; ++pt) {
+ switch(*pt) {
+ case 'a':
+ /*
+ * do not preserve access time
+ */
+ patime = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'e':
+ /*
+ * preserve user id, group id, file
+ * mode, access/modification times
+ */
+ pids = 1;
+ pmode = 1;
+ patime = 1;
+ pmtime = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ /*
+ * do not preserve modification time
+ */
+ pmtime = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'o':
+ /*
+ * preserve uid/gid
+ */
+ pids = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ /*
+ * preserver file mode bits
+ */
+ pmode = 1;
+ break;
+ default:
+ warn(1, "Invalid -p string: %c", *pt);
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ flg |= PF;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ /*
+ * read the archive
+ */
+ flg |= RF;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ /*
+ * file name substitution name pattern
+ */
+ if (rep_add(optarg) < 0) {
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ flg |= SF;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ /*
+ * preserve access time on filesystem nodes we read
+ */
+ tflag = 1;
+ flg |= TF;
+ break;
+ case 'u':
+ /*
+ * ignore those older files
+ */
+ uflag = 1;
+ flg |= UF;
+ break;
+ case 'v':
+ /*
+ * verbose operation mode
+ */
+ vflag = 1;
+ flg |= VF;
+ break;
+ case 'w':
+ /*
+ * write an archive
+ */
+ flg |= WF;
+ break;
+ case 'x':
+ /*
+ * specify an archive format on write
+ */
+ tmp.name = optarg;
+ if (frmt = (FSUB *)bsearch((void *)&tmp, (void *)fsub,
+ sizeof(fsub)/sizeof(FSUB), sizeof(FSUB), c_frmt)) {
+ flg |= XF;
+ break;
+ }
+ warn(1, "Unknown -x format: %s", optarg);
+ (void)fputs("pax: Known -x formats are:", stderr);
+ for (i = 0; i < (sizeof(fsub)/sizeof(FSUB)); ++i)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, " %s", fsub[i].name);
+ (void)fputs("\n\n", stderr);
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ case 'B':
+ /*
+ * non-standard option on number of bytes written on a
+ * single archive volume.
+ */
+ if ((wrlimit = str_offt(optarg)) <= 0) {
+ warn(1, "Invalid write limit %s", optarg);
+ pax_usage();
+ }
+ if (wrlimit % BLKMULT) {
+ warn(1, "Write limit is not a %d byte multiple",
+ BLKMULT);
+ pax_usage();
+ }
+ flg |= CBF;
+ break;
+ case 'D':
+ /*
+ * On extraction check file inode change time before the
+ * modification of the file name. Non standard option.
+ */
+ Dflag = 1;
+ flg |= CDF;
+ break;
+ case 'E':
+ /*
+ * non-standard limit on read faults
+ * 0 indicates stop after first error, values
+ * indicate a limit, "NONE" try forever
+ */
+ flg |= CEF;
+ if (strcmp(NONE, optarg) == 0)
+ maxflt = -1;
+ else if ((maxflt = atoi(optarg)) < 0) {
+ warn(1, "Error count value must be positive");
+ pax_usage();
+ }
+ break;
+ case 'G':
+ /*
+ * non-standard option for selecting files within an
+ * archive by group (gid or name)
+ */
+ if (grp_add(optarg) < 0) {
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ flg |= CGF;
+ break;
+ case 'H':
+ /*
+ * follow command line symlinks only
+ */
+ Hflag = 1;
+ flg |= CHF;
+ break;
+ case 'L':
+ /*
+ * follow symlinks
+ */
+ Lflag = 1;
+ flg |= CLF;
+ break;
+ case 'P':
+ /*
+ * do NOT follow symlinks (default)
+ */
+ Lflag = 0;
+ flg |= CPF;
+ break;
+ case 'T':
+ /*
+ * non-standard option for selecting files within an
+ * archive by modification time range (lower,upper)
+ */
+ if (trng_add(optarg) < 0) {
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ flg |= CTF;
+ break;
+ case 'U':
+ /*
+ * non-standard option for selecting files within an
+ * archive by user (uid or name)
+ */
+ if (usr_add(optarg) < 0) {
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ flg |= CUF;
+ break;
+ case 'X':
+ /*
+ * do not pass over mount points in the file system
+ */
+ Xflag = 1;
+ flg |= CXF;
+ break;
+ case 'Y':
+ /*
+ * On extraction check file inode change time after the
+ * modification of the file name. Non standard option.
+ */
+ Yflag = 1;
+ flg |= CYF;
+ break;
+ case 'Z':
+ /*
+ * On extraction check modification time after the
+ * modification of the file name. Non standard option.
+ */
+ Zflag = 1;
+ flg |= CZF;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * figure out the operation mode of pax read,write,extract,copy,append
+ * or list. check that we have not been given a bogus set of flags
+ * for the operation mode.
+ */
+ if (ISLIST(flg)) {
+ act = LIST;
+ bflg = flg & BDLIST;
+ } else if (ISEXTRACT(flg)) {
+ act = EXTRACT;
+ bflg = flg & BDEXTR;
+ } else if (ISARCHIVE(flg)) {
+ act = ARCHIVE;
+ bflg = flg & BDARCH;
+ } else if (ISAPPND(flg)) {
+ act = APPND;
+ bflg = flg & BDARCH;
+ } else if (ISCOPY(flg)) {
+ act = COPY;
+ bflg = flg & BDCOPY;
+ } else
+ pax_usage();
+ if (bflg) {
+ printflg(flg);
+ pax_usage();
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if we are writing (ARCHIVE) we use the default format if the user
+ * did not specify a format. when we write during an APPEND, we will
+ * adopt the format of the existing archive if none was supplied.
+ */
+ if (!(flg & XF) && (act == ARCHIVE))
+ frmt = &(fsub[DEFLT]);
+
+ /*
+ * process the args as they are interpreted by the operation mode
+ */
+ switch (act) {
+ case LIST:
+ case EXTRACT:
+ for (; optind < argc; optind++)
+ if (pat_add(argv[optind]) < 0)
+ pax_usage();
+ break;
+ case COPY:
+ if (optind >= argc) {
+ warn(0, "Destination directory was not supplied");
+ pax_usage();
+ }
+ --argc;
+ dirptr = argv[argc];
+ /* FALL THROUGH */
+ case ARCHIVE:
+ case APPND:
+ for (; optind < argc; optind++)
+ if (ftree_add(argv[optind]) < 0)
+ pax_usage();
+ /*
+ * no read errors allowed on updates/append operation!
+ */
+ maxflt = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * tar_options()
+ * look at the user specified flags. set globals as required and check if
+ * the user specified a legal set of flags. If not, complain and exit
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static void
+tar_options(register int argc, register char **argv)
+#else
+static void
+tar_options(argc, argv)
+ register int argc;
+ register char **argv;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *cp;
+ int fstdin = 0;
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ tar_usage();
+ /*
+ * process option flags
+ */
+ ++argv;
+ for (cp = *argv++; *cp != '\0'; ++cp) {
+ switch (*cp) {
+ case '-':
+ /*
+ * skip over -
+ */
+ break;
+ case 'b':
+ /*
+ * specify blocksize
+ */
+ if (*argv == (char *)NULL) {
+ warn(1,"blocksize must be specified with 'b'");
+ tar_usage();
+ }
+ if ((wrblksz = (int)str_offt(*argv)) <= 0) {
+ warn(1, "Invalid block size %s", *argv);
+ tar_usage();
+ }
+ ++argv;
+ break;
+ case 'c':
+ /*
+ * create an archive
+ */
+ act = ARCHIVE;
+ break;
+ case 'e':
+ /*
+ * stop after first error
+ */
+ maxflt = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ /*
+ * filename where the archive is stored
+ */
+ if (*argv == (char *)NULL) {
+ warn(1, "filename must be specified with 'f'");
+ tar_usage();
+ }
+ if ((argv[0][0] == '-') && (argv[0][1]== '\0')) {
+ /*
+ * treat a - as stdin
+ */
+ ++argv;
+ ++fstdin;
+ arcname = (char *)0;
+ break;
+ }
+ fstdin = 0;
+ arcname = *argv++;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ /*
+ * do not preserve modification time
+ */
+ pmtime = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'o':
+ if (opt_add("write_opt=nodir") < 0)
+ tar_usage();
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ /*
+ * preserve user id, group id, file
+ * mode, access/modification times
+ */
+ pids = 1;
+ pmode = 1;
+ patime = 1;
+ pmtime = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ case 'u':
+ /*
+ * append to the archive
+ */
+ act = APPND;
+ break;
+ case 't':
+ /*
+ * list contents of the tape
+ */
+ act = LIST;
+ break;
+ case 'v':
+ /*
+ * verbose operation mode
+ */
+ vflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'w':
+ /*
+ * interactive file rename
+ */
+ iflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'x':
+ /*
+ * write an archive
+ */
+ act = EXTRACT;
+ break;
+ case 'B':
+ /*
+ * Nothing to do here, this is pax default
+ */
+ break;
+ case 'H':
+ /*
+ * follow command line symlinks only
+ */
+ Hflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'L':
+ /*
+ * follow symlinks
+ */
+ Lflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'P':
+ /*
+ * do not follow symlinks
+ */
+ Lflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'X':
+ /*
+ * do not pass over mount points in the file system
+ */
+ Xflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '0':
+ arcname = DEV_0;
+ break;
+ case '1':
+ arcname = DEV_1;
+ break;
+ case '4':
+ arcname = DEV_4;
+ break;
+ case '5':
+ arcname = DEV_5;
+ break;
+ case '7':
+ arcname = DEV_7;
+ break;
+ case '8':
+ arcname = DEV_8;
+ break;
+ default:
+ tar_usage();
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if we are writing (ARCHIVE) specify tar, otherwise run like pax
+ */
+ if (act == ARCHIVE)
+ frmt = &(fsub[F_TAR]);
+
+ /*
+ * process the args as they are interpreted by the operation mode
+ */
+ switch (act) {
+ case LIST:
+ case EXTRACT:
+ default:
+ while (*argv != (char *)NULL)
+ if (pat_add(*argv++) < 0)
+ tar_usage();
+ break;
+ case ARCHIVE:
+ case APPND:
+ while (*argv != (char *)NULL)
+ if (ftree_add(*argv++) < 0)
+ tar_usage();
+ /*
+ * no read errors allowed on updates/append operation!
+ */
+ maxflt = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (!fstdin && ((arcname == (char *)NULL) || (*arcname == '\0'))) {
+ arcname = getenv("TAPE");
+ if ((arcname == (char *)NULL) || (*arcname == '\0'))
+ arcname = DEV_8;
+ }
+}
+
+#ifdef notdef
+/*
+ * cpio_options()
+ * look at the user specified flags. set globals as required and check if
+ * the user specified a legal set of flags. If not, complain and exit
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static void
+cpio_options(register int argc, register char **argv)
+#else
+static void
+cpio_options(argc, argv)
+ register int argc;
+ register char **argv;
+#endif
+{
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * printflg()
+ * print out those invalid flag sets found to the user
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static void
+printflg(unsigned int flg)
+#else
+static void
+printflg(flg)
+ unsigned int flg;
+#endif
+{
+ int nxt;
+ int pos = 0;
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,"%s: Invalid combination of options:", argv0);
+ while (nxt = ffs(flg)) {
+ flg = flg >> nxt;
+ pos += nxt;
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, " -%c", flgch[pos-1]);
+ }
+ (void)putc('\n', stderr);
+}
+
+/*
+ * c_frmt()
+ * comparison routine used by bsearch to find the format specified
+ * by the user
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+c_frmt(const void *a, const void *b)
+#else
+static int
+c_frmt(a, b)
+ void *a;
+ void *b;
+#endif
+{
+ return(strcmp(((FSUB *)a)->name, ((FSUB *)b)->name));
+}
+
+/*
+ * opt_next()
+ * called by format specific options routines to get each format specific
+ * flag and value specified with -o
+ * Return:
+ * pointer to next OPLIST entry or NULL (end of list).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+OPLIST *
+opt_next(void)
+#else
+OPLIST *
+opt_next()
+#endif
+{
+ OPLIST *opt;
+
+ if ((opt = ophead) != NULL)
+ ophead = ophead->fow;
+ return(opt);
+}
+
+/*
+ * bad_opt()
+ * generic routine used to complain about a format specific options
+ * when the format does not support options.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+bad_opt(void)
+#else
+int
+bad_opt()
+#endif
+{
+ register OPLIST *opt;
+
+ if (ophead == NULL)
+ return(0);
+ /*
+ * print all we were given
+ */
+ warn(1,"These format options are not supported");
+ while ((opt = opt_next()) != NULL)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "\t%s = %s\n", opt->name, opt->value);
+ pax_usage();
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * opt_add()
+ * breaks the value supplied to -o into a option name and value. options
+ * are given to -o in the form -o name-value,name=value
+ * mulltiple -o may be specified.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if format in name=value format, -1 if -o is passed junk
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+opt_add(register char *str)
+#else
+int
+opt_add(str)
+ register char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register OPLIST *opt;
+ register char *frpt;
+ register char *pt;
+ register char *endpt;
+
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0')) {
+ warn(0, "Invalid option name");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ frpt = endpt = str;
+
+ /*
+ * break into name and values pieces and stuff each one into a
+ * OPLIST structure. When we know the format, the format specific
+ * option function will go through this list
+ */
+ while ((frpt != NULL) && (*frpt != '\0')) {
+ if ((endpt = strchr(frpt, ',')) != NULL)
+ *endpt = '\0';
+ if ((pt = strchr(frpt, '=')) == NULL) {
+ warn(0, "Invalid options format");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if ((opt = (OPLIST *)malloc(sizeof(OPLIST))) == NULL) {
+ warn(0, "Unable to allocate space for option list");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ *pt++ = '\0';
+ opt->name = frpt;
+ opt->value = pt;
+ opt->fow = NULL;
+ if (endpt != NULL)
+ frpt = endpt + 1;
+ else
+ frpt = NULL;
+ if (ophead == NULL) {
+ optail = ophead = opt;
+ continue;
+ }
+ optail->fow = opt;
+ optail = opt;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * str_offt()
+ * Convert an expression of the following forms to an off_t > 0.
+ * 1) A positive decimal number.
+ * 2) A positive decimal number followed by a b (mult by 512).
+ * 3) A positive decimal number followed by a k (mult by 1024).
+ * 4) A positive decimal number followed by a m (mult by 512).
+ * 5) A positive decimal number followed by a w (mult by sizeof int)
+ * 6) Two or more positive decimal numbers (with/without k,b or w).
+ * seperated by x (also * for backwards compatibility), specifying
+ * the product of the indicated values.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 for an error, a positive value o.w.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static off_t
+str_offt(char *val)
+#else
+static off_t
+str_offt(val)
+ char *val;
+#endif
+{
+ char *expr;
+ off_t num, t;
+
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ num = strtol(val, &expr, 0);
+ if ((num == LONG_MAX) || (num <= 0) || (expr == val))
+# else
+ num = strtoq(val, &expr, 0);
+ if ((num == QUAD_MAX) || (num <= 0) || (expr == val))
+# endif
+ return(0);
+
+ switch(*expr) {
+ case 'b':
+ t = num;
+ num *= 512;
+ if (t > num)
+ return(0);
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ case 'k':
+ t = num;
+ num *= 1024;
+ if (t > num)
+ return(0);
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ t = num;
+ num *= 1048576;
+ if (t > num)
+ return(0);
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ case 'w':
+ t = num;
+ num *= sizeof(int);
+ if (t > num)
+ return(0);
+ ++expr;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ switch(*expr) {
+ case '\0':
+ break;
+ case '*':
+ case 'x':
+ t = num;
+ num *= str_offt(expr + 1);
+ if (t > num)
+ return(0);
+ break;
+ default:
+ return(0);
+ }
+ return(num);
+}
+
+/*
+ * no_op()
+ * for those option functions where the archive format has nothing to do.
+ * Return:
+ * 0
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+no_op(void)
+#else
+static int
+no_op()
+#endif
+{
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pax_usage()
+ * print the usage summary to the user
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+pax_usage(void)
+#else
+void
+pax_usage()
+#endif
+{
+ (void)fputs("usage: pax [-cdnv] [-E limit] [-f archive] ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-s replstr] ... [-U user] ...", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("\n [-G group] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-T [from_date][,to_date]] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[pattern ...]\n", stderr);
+ (void)fputs(" pax -r [-cdiknuvDYZ] [-E limit] ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-f archive] [-o options] ... \n", stderr);
+ (void)fputs(" [-p string] ... [-s replstr] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-U user] ... [-G group] ...\n ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-T [from_date][,to_date]] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs(" [pattern ...]\n", stderr);
+ (void)fputs(" pax -w [-dituvHLPX] [-b blocksize] ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[ [-a] [-f archive] ] [-x format] \n", stderr);
+ (void)fputs(" [-B bytes] [-s replstr] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-o options] ... [-U user] ...", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("\n [-G group] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-T [from_date][,to_date][/[c][m]]] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[file ...]\n", stderr);
+ (void)fputs(" pax -r -w [-diklntuvDHLPXYZ] ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-p string] ... [-s replstr] ...", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("\n [-U user] ... [-G group] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[-T [from_date][,to_date][/[c][m]]] ... ", stderr);
+ (void)fputs("\n [file ...] directory\n", stderr);
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * tar_usage()
+ * print the usage summary to the user
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+tar_usage(void)
+#else
+void
+tar_usage()
+#endif
+{
+ (void)fputs("usage: tar -{txru}[cevfbmopwBHLPX014578] [tapefile] ",
+ stderr);
+ (void)fputs("[blocksize] file1 file2...\n", stderr);
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+#ifdef notdef
+/*
+ * cpio_usage()
+ * print the usage summary to the user
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+cpio_usage(void)
+#else
+void
+cpio_usage()
+#endif
+{
+ exit(1);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/pax/options.h b/bin/pax/options.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5dc855b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/options.h
@@ -0,0 +1,113 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)options.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+ */
+
+/*
+ * argv[0] names. Used for tar and cpio emulation
+ */
+
+#define NM_TAR "tar"
+#define NM_CPIO "cpio"
+#define NM_PAX "pax"
+
+/*
+ * Constants used to specify the legal sets of flags in pax. For each major
+ * operation mode of pax, a set of illegal flags is defined. If any one of
+ * those illegal flags are found set, we scream and exit
+ */
+#define NONE "none"
+
+/*
+ * flags (one for each option).
+ */
+#define AF 0x00000001
+#define BF 0x00000002
+#define CF 0x00000004
+#define DF 0x00000008
+#define FF 0x00000010
+#define IF 0x00000020
+#define KF 0x00000040
+#define LF 0x00000080
+#define NF 0x00000100
+#define OF 0x00000200
+#define PF 0x00000400
+#define RF 0x00000800
+#define SF 0x00001000
+#define TF 0x00002000
+#define UF 0x00004000
+#define VF 0x00008000
+#define WF 0x00010000
+#define XF 0x00020000
+#define CBF 0x00040000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CDF 0x00080000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CEF 0x00100000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CGF 0x00200000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CHF 0x00400000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CLF 0x00800000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CPF 0x01000000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CTF 0x02000000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CUF 0x04000000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CXF 0x08000000
+#define CYF 0x10000000 /* nonstandard extension */
+#define CZF 0x20000000 /* nonstandard extension */
+
+/*
+ * ascii string indexed by bit position above (alter the above and you must
+ * alter this string) used to tell the user what flags caused us to complain
+ */
+#define FLGCH "abcdfiklnoprstuvwxBDEGHLPTUXYZ"
+
+/*
+ * legal pax operation bit patterns
+ */
+
+#define ISLIST(x) (((x) & (RF|WF)) == 0)
+#define ISEXTRACT(x) (((x) & (RF|WF)) == RF)
+#define ISARCHIVE(x) (((x) & (AF|RF|WF)) == WF)
+#define ISAPPND(x) (((x) & (AF|RF|WF)) == (AF|WF))
+#define ISCOPY(x) (((x) & (RF|WF)) == (RF|WF))
+#define ISWRITE(x) (((x) & (RF|WF)) == WF)
+
+/*
+ * Illegal option flag subsets based on pax operation
+ */
+
+#define BDEXTR (AF|BF|LF|TF|WF|XF|CBF|CHF|CLF|CPF|CXF)
+#define BDARCH (CF|KF|LF|NF|PF|RF|CDF|CEF|CYF|CZF)
+#define BDCOPY (AF|BF|FF|OF|XF|CBF|CEF)
+#define BDLIST (AF|BF|IF|KF|LF|OF|PF|RF|TF|UF|WF|XF|CBF|CDF|CHF|CLF|CPF|CXF|CYF|CZF)
diff --git a/bin/pax/pat_rep.c b/bin/pax/pat_rep.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2da5827
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/pat_rep.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1196 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)pat_rep.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#ifdef NET2_REGEX
+#include <regexp.h>
+#else
+#include <regex.h>
+#endif
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "pat_rep.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * routines to handle pattern matching, name modification (regular expression
+ * substitution and interactive renames), and destination name modification for
+ * copy (-rw). Both file name and link names are adjusted as required in these
+ * routines.
+ */
+
+#define MAXSUBEXP 10 /* max subexpressions, DO NOT CHANGE */
+static PATTERN *pathead = NULL; /* file pattern match list head */
+static PATTERN *pattail = NULL; /* file pattern match list tail */
+static REPLACE *rephead = NULL; /* replacement string list head */
+static REPLACE *reptail = NULL; /* replacement string list tail */
+
+static int rep_name __P((char *, int *, int));
+static int tty_rename __P((register ARCHD *));
+static int fix_path __P((char *, int *, char *, int));
+static int fn_match __P((register char *, register char *, char **));
+static char * range_match __P((register char *, register int));
+#ifdef NET2_REGEX
+static int resub __P((regexp *, char *, char *, register char *));
+#else
+static int resub __P((regex_t *, regmatch_t *, char *, char *, char *));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * rep_add()
+ * parses the -s replacement string; compiles the regular expression
+ * and stores the compiled value and it's replacement string together in
+ * replacement string list. Input to this function is of the form:
+ * /old/new/pg
+ * The first char in the string specifies the delimiter used by this
+ * replacement string. "Old" is a regular expression in "ed" format which
+ * is compiled by regcomp() and is applied to filenames. "new" is the
+ * substitution string; p and g are options flags for printing and global
+ * replacement (over the single filename)
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a proper replacement string and regular expression was added to
+ * the list of replacement patterns; -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+rep_add(register char *str)
+#else
+int
+rep_add(str)
+ register char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt1;
+ register char *pt2;
+ register REPLACE *rep;
+# ifndef NET2_REGEX
+ register int res;
+ char rebuf[BUFSIZ];
+# endif
+
+ /*
+ * throw out the bad parameters
+ */
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0')) {
+ warn(1, "Empty replacement string");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * first character in the string specifies what the delimiter is for
+ * this expression
+ */
+ if ((pt1 = strchr(str+1, *str)) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Invalid replacement string %s", str);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * allocate space for the node that handles this replacement pattern
+ * and split out the regular expression and try to compile it
+ */
+ if ((rep = (REPLACE *)malloc(sizeof(REPLACE))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for replacement string");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ *pt1 = '\0';
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ if ((rep->rcmp = regcomp(str+1)) == NULL) {
+# else
+ if ((res = regcomp(&(rep->rcmp), str+1, 0)) != 0) {
+ regerror(res, &(rep->rcmp), rebuf, sizeof(rebuf));
+ warn(1, "%s while compiling regular expression %s", rebuf, str);
+# endif
+ (void)free((char *)rep);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * put the delimiter back in case we need an error message and
+ * locate the delimiter at the end of the replacement string
+ * we then point the node at the new substitution string
+ */
+ *pt1++ = *str;
+ if ((pt2 = strchr(pt1, *str)) == NULL) {
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ (void)free((char *)rep->rcmp);
+# else
+ regfree(&(rep->rcmp));
+# endif
+ (void)free((char *)rep);
+ warn(1, "Invalid replacement string %s", str);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ *pt2 = '\0';
+ rep->nstr = pt1;
+ pt1 = pt2++;
+ rep->flgs = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * set the options if any
+ */
+ while (*pt2 != '\0') {
+ switch(*pt2) {
+ case 'g':
+ case 'G':
+ rep->flgs |= GLOB;
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ case 'P':
+ rep->flgs |= PRNT;
+ break;
+ default:
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ (void)free((char *)rep->rcmp);
+# else
+ regfree(&(rep->rcmp));
+# endif
+ (void)free((char *)rep);
+ *pt1 = *str;
+ warn(1, "Invalid replacement string option %s", str);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ ++pt2;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * all done, link it in at the end
+ */
+ rep->fow = NULL;
+ if (rephead == NULL) {
+ reptail = rephead = rep;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ reptail->fow = rep;
+ reptail = rep;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pat_add()
+ * add a pattern match to the pattern match list. Pattern matches are used
+ * to select which archive members are extracted. (They appear as
+ * arguments to pax in the list and read modes). If no patterns are
+ * supplied to pax, all members in the archive will be selected (and the
+ * pattern match list is empty).
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if the pattern was added to the list, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+pat_add(char *str)
+#else
+int
+pat_add(str)
+ char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register PATTERN *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * throw out the junk
+ */
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0')) {
+ warn(1, "Empty pattern string");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * allocate space for the pattern and store the pattern. the pattern is
+ * part of argv so do not bother to copy it, just point at it. Add the
+ * node to the end of the pattern list
+ */
+ if ((pt = (PATTERN *)malloc(sizeof(PATTERN))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for pattern string");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ pt->pstr = str;
+ pt->pend = NULL;
+ pt->plen = strlen(str);
+ pt->fow = NULL;
+ pt->flgs = 0;
+ if (pathead == NULL) {
+ pattail = pathead = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ pattail->fow = pt;
+ pattail = pt;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pat_chk()
+ * complain if any the user supplied pattern did not result in a match to
+ * a selected archive member.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+pat_chk(void)
+#else
+void
+pat_chk()
+#endif
+{
+ register PATTERN *pt;
+ register int wban = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * walk down the list checking the flags to make sure MTCH was set,
+ * if not complain
+ */
+ for (pt = pathead; pt != NULL; pt = pt->fow) {
+ if (pt->flgs & MTCH)
+ continue;
+ if (!wban) {
+ warn(1, "WARNING! These patterns were not matched:");
+ ++wban;
+ }
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", pt->pstr);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * pat_sel()
+ * the archive member which matches a pattern was selected. Mark the
+ * pattern as having selected an archive member. arcn->pat points at the
+ * pattern that was matched. arcn->pat is set in pat_match()
+ *
+ * NOTE: When the -c option is used, we are called when there was no match
+ * by pat_match() (that means we did match before the inverted sense of
+ * the logic). Now this seems really strange at first, but with -c we
+ * need to keep track of those patterns that cause a archive member to NOT
+ * be selected (it found an archive member with a specified pattern)
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if the pattern pointed at by arcn->pat was tagged as creating a
+ * match, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+pat_sel(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+pat_sel(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register PATTERN *pt;
+ register PATTERN **ppt;
+ register int len;
+
+ /*
+ * if no patterns just return
+ */
+ if ((pathead == NULL) || ((pt = arcn->pat) == NULL))
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * when we are NOT limited to a single match per pattern mark the
+ * pattern and return
+ */
+ if (!nflag) {
+ pt->flgs |= MTCH;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we reach this point only when we allow a single selected match per
+ * pattern, if the pattern matches a directory and we do not have -d
+ * (dflag) we are done with this pattern. We may also be handed a file
+ * in the subtree of a directory. in that case when we are operating
+ * with -d, this pattern was already selected and we are done
+ */
+ if (pt->flgs & DIR_MTCH)
+ return(0);
+
+ if (!dflag && ((pt->pend != NULL) || (arcn->type == PAX_DIR))) {
+ /*
+ * ok we matched a directory and we are allowing
+ * subtree matches but because of the -n only its children will
+ * match. This is tagged as a DIR_MTCH type.
+ * WATCH IT, the code assumes that pt->pend points
+ * into arcn->name and arcn->name has not been modified.
+ * If not we will have a big mess. Yup this is another kludge
+ */
+
+ /*
+ * if this was a prefix match, remove trailing part of path
+ * so we can copy it. Future matches will be exact prefix match
+ */
+ if (pt->pend != NULL)
+ *pt->pend = '\0';
+
+ if ((pt->pstr = strdup(arcn->name)) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Pattern select out of memory");
+ if (pt->pend != NULL)
+ *pt->pend = '/';
+ pt->pend = NULL;
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * put the trailing / back in the source string
+ */
+ if (pt->pend != NULL) {
+ *pt->pend = '/';
+ pt->pend = NULL;
+ }
+ pt->plen = strlen(pt->pstr);
+
+ /*
+ * strip off any trailing /, this should really never happen
+ */
+ len = pt->plen - 1;
+ if (*(pt->pstr + len) == '/') {
+ *(pt->pstr + len) = '\0';
+ pt->plen = len;
+ }
+ pt->flgs = DIR_MTCH | MTCH;
+ arcn->pat = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we are then done with this pattern, so we delete it from the list
+ * because it can never be used for another match.
+ * Seems kind of strange to do for a -c, but the pax spec is really
+ * vague on the interaction of -c -n and -d. We assume that when -c
+ * and the pattern rejects a member (i.e. it matched it) it is done.
+ * In effect we place the order of the flags as having -c last.
+ */
+ pt = pathead;
+ ppt = &pathead;
+ while ((pt != NULL) && (pt != arcn->pat)) {
+ ppt = &(pt->fow);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ if (pt == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * should never happen....
+ */
+ warn(1, "Pattern list inconsistant");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ *ppt = pt->fow;
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ arcn->pat = NULL;
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * pat_match()
+ * see if this archive member matches any supplied pattern, if a match
+ * is found, arcn->pat is set to point at the potential pattern. Later if
+ * this archive member is "selected" we process and mark the pattern as
+ * one which matched a selected archive member (see pat_sel())
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if this archive member should be processed, 1 if it should be
+ * skipped and -1 if we are done with all patterns (and pax should quit
+ * looking for more members)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+pat_match(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+pat_match(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register PATTERN *pt;
+
+ arcn->pat = NULL;
+
+ /*
+ * if there are no more patterns and we have -n (and not -c) we are
+ * done. otherwise with no patterns to match, matches all
+ */
+ if (pathead == NULL) {
+ if (nflag && !cflag)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * have to search down the list one at a time looking for a match.
+ */
+ pt = pathead;
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * check for a file name match unless we have DIR_MTCH set in
+ * this pattern then we want a prefix match
+ */
+ if (pt->flgs & DIR_MTCH) {
+ /*
+ * this pattern was matched before to a directory
+ * as we must have -n set for this (but not -d). We can
+ * only match CHILDREN of that directory so we must use
+ * an exact prefix match (no wildcards).
+ */
+ if ((arcn->name[pt->plen] == '/') &&
+ (strncmp(pt->pstr, arcn->name, pt->plen) == 0))
+ break;
+ } else if (fn_match(pt->pstr, arcn->name, &pt->pend) == 0)
+ break;
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * return the result, remember that cflag (-c) inverts the sense of a
+ * match
+ */
+ if (pt == NULL)
+ return(cflag ? 0 : 1);
+
+ /*
+ * we had a match, now when we invert the sense (-c) we reject this
+ * member. However we have to tag the pattern a being successful, (in a
+ * match, not in selecting a archive member) so we call pat_sel() here.
+ */
+ arcn->pat = pt;
+ if (!cflag)
+ return(0);
+
+ if (pat_sel(arcn) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ arcn->pat = NULL;
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * fn_match()
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if this archive member should be processed, 1 if it should be
+ * skipped and -1 if we are done with all patterns (and pax should quit
+ * looking for more members)
+ * Note: *pend may be changed to show where the prefix ends.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+fn_match(register char *pattern, register char *string, char **pend)
+#else
+static int
+fn_match(pattern, string, pend)
+ register char *pattern;
+ register char *string;
+ char **pend;
+#endif
+{
+ register char c;
+ char test;
+
+ *pend = NULL;
+ for (;;) {
+ switch (c = *pattern++) {
+ case '\0':
+ /*
+ * Ok we found an exact match
+ */
+ if (*string == '\0')
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * Check if it is a prefix match
+ */
+ if ((dflag == 1) || (*string != '/'))
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * It is a prefix match, remember where the trailing
+ * / is located
+ */
+ *pend = string;
+ return(0);
+ case '?':
+ if ((test = *string++) == '\0')
+ return (-1);
+ break;
+ case '*':
+ c = *pattern;
+ /*
+ * Collapse multiple *'s.
+ */
+ while (c == '*')
+ c = *++pattern;
+
+ /*
+ * Optimized hack for pattern with a * at the end
+ */
+ if (c == '\0')
+ return (0);
+
+ /*
+ * General case, use recursion.
+ */
+ while ((test = *string) != '\0') {
+ if (!fn_match(pattern, string, pend))
+ return (0);
+ ++string;
+ }
+ return (-1);
+ case '[':
+ /*
+ * range match
+ */
+ if (((test = *string++) == '\0') ||
+ ((pattern = range_match(pattern, test)) == NULL))
+ return (-1);
+ break;
+ case '\\':
+ default:
+ if (c != *string++)
+ return (-1);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+static char *
+range_match(register char *pattern, register int test)
+#else
+static char *
+range_match(pattern, test)
+ register char *pattern;
+ register int test;
+#endif
+{
+ register char c;
+ register char c2;
+ int negate;
+ int ok = 0;
+
+ if (negate = (*pattern == '!'))
+ ++pattern;
+
+ while ((c = *pattern++) != ']') {
+ /*
+ * Illegal pattern
+ */
+ if (c == '\0')
+ return (NULL);
+
+ if ((*pattern == '-') && ((c2 = pattern[1]) != '\0') &&
+ (c2 != ']')) {
+ if ((c <= test) && (test <= c2))
+ ok = 1;
+ pattern += 2;
+ } else if (c == test)
+ ok = 1;
+ }
+ return (ok == negate ? NULL : pattern);
+}
+
+/*
+ * mod_name()
+ * modify a selected file name. first attempt to apply replacement string
+ * expressions, then apply interactive file rename. We apply replacement
+ * string expressions to both filenames and file links (if we didn't the
+ * links would point to the wrong place, and we could never be able to
+ * move an archive that has a file link in it). When we rename files
+ * interactively, we store that mapping (old name to user input name) so
+ * if we spot any file links to the old file name in the future, we will
+ * know exactly how to fix the file link.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 continue to process file, 1 skip this file, -1 pax is finished
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+mod_name(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+mod_name(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register int res = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * IMPORTANT: We have a problem. what do we do with symlinks?
+ * Modifying a hard link name makes sense, as we know the file it
+ * points at should have been seen already in the archive (and if it
+ * wasn't seen because of a read error or a bad archive, we lose
+ * anyway). But there are no such requirements for symlinks. On one
+ * hand the symlink that refers to a file in the archive will have to
+ * be modified to so it will still work at its new location in the
+ * file system. On the other hand a symlink that points elsewhere (and
+ * should continue to do so) should not be modified. There is clearly
+ * no perfect solution here. So we handle them like hardlinks. Clearly
+ * a replacement made by the interactive rename mapping is very likely
+ * to be correct since it applies to a single file and is an exact
+ * match. The regular expression replacements are a little harder to
+ * justify though. We claim that the symlink name is only likely
+ * to be replaced when it points within the file tree being moved and
+ * in that case it should be modified. what we really need to do is to
+ * call an oracle here. :)
+ */
+ if (rephead != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * we have replacement strings, modify the name and the link
+ * name if any.
+ */
+ if ((res = rep_name(arcn->name, &(arcn->nlen), 1)) != 0)
+ return(res);
+
+ if (((arcn->type == PAX_SLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HLK) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HRG)) &&
+ ((res = rep_name(arcn->ln_name, &(arcn->ln_nlen), 0)) != 0))
+ return(res);
+ }
+
+ if (iflag) {
+ /*
+ * perform interactive file rename, then map the link if any
+ */
+ if ((res = tty_rename(arcn)) != 0)
+ return(res);
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_SLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HLK) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ sub_name(arcn->ln_name, &(arcn->ln_nlen));
+ }
+ return(res);
+}
+
+/*
+ * tty_rename()
+ * Prompt the user for a replacement file name. A "." keeps the old name,
+ * a empty line skips the file, and an EOF on reading the tty, will cause
+ * pax to stop processing and exit. Otherwise the file name input, replaces
+ * the old one.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 process this file, 1 skip this file, -1 we need to exit pax
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+tty_rename(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+tty_rename(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ char tmpname[PAXPATHLEN+2];
+ int res;
+
+ /*
+ * prompt user for the replacement name for a file, keep trying until
+ * we get some reasonable input. Archives may have more than one file
+ * on them with the same name (from updates etc). We print verbose info
+ * on the file so the user knows what is up.
+ */
+ tty_prnt("\nATTENTION: %s interactive file rename operation.\n", argv0);
+
+ for (;;) {
+ ls_tty(arcn);
+ tty_prnt("Input new name, or a \".\" to keep the old name, ");
+ tty_prnt("or a \"return\" to skip this file.\n");
+ tty_prnt("Input > ");
+ if (tty_read(tmpname, sizeof(tmpname)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (strcmp(tmpname, "..") == 0) {
+ tty_prnt("Try again, illegal file name: ..\n");
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (strlen(tmpname) > PAXPATHLEN) {
+ tty_prnt("Try again, file name too long\n");
+ continue;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * empty file name, skips this file. a "." leaves it alone
+ */
+ if (tmpname[0] == '\0') {
+ tty_prnt("Skipping file.\n");
+ return(1);
+ }
+ if ((tmpname[0] == '.') && (tmpname[1] == '\0')) {
+ tty_prnt("Processing continues, name unchanged.\n");
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * ok the name changed. We may run into links that point at this
+ * file later. we have to remember where the user sent the file
+ * in order to repair any links.
+ */
+ tty_prnt("Processing continues, name changed to: %s\n", tmpname);
+ res = add_name(arcn->name, arcn->nlen, tmpname);
+ arcn->nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->name, tmpname, PAXPATHLEN+1);
+ if (res < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * set_dest()
+ * fix up the file name and the link name (if any) so this file will land
+ * in the destination directory (used during copy() -rw).
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 if failure (name too long)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+set_dest(register ARCHD *arcn, char *dest_dir, int dir_len)
+#else
+int
+set_dest(arcn, dest_dir, dir_len)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ char *dest_dir;
+ int dir_len;
+#endif
+{
+ if (fix_path(arcn->name, &(arcn->nlen), dest_dir, dir_len) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * It is really hard to deal with symlinks here, we cannot be sure
+ * if the name they point was moved (or will be moved). It is best to
+ * leave them alone.
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type != PAX_HLK) && (arcn->type != PAX_HRG))
+ return(0);
+
+ if (fix_path(arcn->ln_name, &(arcn->ln_nlen), dest_dir, dir_len) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * fix_path
+ * concatenate dir_name and or_name and store the result in or_name (if
+ * it fits). This is one ugly function.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 if the final name is too long
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+fix_path( char *or_name, int *or_len, char *dir_name, int dir_len)
+#else
+static int
+fix_path(or_name, or_len, dir_name, dir_len)
+ char *or_name;
+ int *or_len;
+ char *dir_name;
+ int dir_len;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *src;
+ register char *dest;
+ register char *start;
+ int len;
+
+ /*
+ * we shift the or_name to the right enough to tack in the dir_name
+ * at the front. We make sure we have enough space for it all before
+ * we start. since dest always ends in a slash, we skip of or_name
+ * if it also starts with one.
+ */
+ start = or_name;
+ src = start + *or_len;
+ dest = src + dir_len;
+ if (*start == '/') {
+ ++start;
+ --dest;
+ }
+ if ((len = dest - or_name) > PAXPATHLEN) {
+ warn(1, "File name %s/%s, too long", dir_name, start);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ *or_len = len;
+
+ /*
+ * enough space, shift
+ */
+ while (src >= start)
+ *dest-- = *src--;
+ src = dir_name + dir_len - 1;
+
+ /*
+ * splice in the destination directory name
+ */
+ while (src >= dir_name)
+ *dest-- = *src--;
+
+ *(or_name + len) = '\0';
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * rep_name()
+ * walk down the list of replacement strings applying each one in order.
+ * when we find one with a successful substitution, we modify the name
+ * as specified. if required, we print the results. if the resulting name
+ * is empty, we will skip this archive member. We use the regexp(3)
+ * routines (regexp() ought to win a prize as having the most cryptic
+ * library function manual page).
+ * --Parameters--
+ * name is the file name we are going to apply the regular expressions to
+ * (and may be modified)
+ * nlen is the length of this name (and is modified to hold the length of
+ * the final string).
+ * prnt is a flag that says whether to print the final result.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if substitution was successful, 1 if we are to skip the file (the name
+ * ended up empty)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+rep_name(char *name, int *nlen, int prnt)
+#else
+static int
+rep_name(name, nlen, prnt)
+ char *name;
+ int *nlen;
+ int prnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register REPLACE *pt;
+ register char *inpt;
+ register char *outpt;
+ register char *endpt;
+ register char *rpt;
+ register int found = 0;
+ register int res;
+# ifndef NET2_REGEX
+ regmatch_t pm[MAXSUBEXP];
+# endif
+ char nname[PAXPATHLEN+1]; /* final result of all replacements */
+ char buf1[PAXPATHLEN+1]; /* where we work on the name */
+
+ /*
+ * copy the name into buf1, where we will work on it. We need to keep
+ * the orig string around so we can print out the result of the final
+ * replacement. We build up the final result in nname. inpt points at
+ * the string we apply the regular expression to. prnt is used to
+ * suppress printing when we handle replacements on the link field
+ * (the user already saw that substitution go by)
+ */
+ pt = rephead;
+ (void)strcpy(buf1, name);
+ inpt = buf1;
+ outpt = nname;
+ endpt = outpt + PAXPATHLEN;
+
+ /*
+ * try each replacement string in order
+ */
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ do {
+ /*
+ * check for a successful substitution, if not go to
+ * the next pattern, or cleanup if we were global
+ */
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ if (regexec(pt->rcmp, inpt) == 0)
+# else
+ if (regexec(&(pt->rcmp), inpt, MAXSUBEXP, pm, 0) != 0)
+# endif
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * ok we found one. We have three parts, the prefix
+ * which did not match, the section that did and the
+ * tail (that also did not match). Copy the prefix to
+ * the final output buffer (watching to make sure we
+ * do not create a string too long).
+ */
+ found = 1;
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ rpt = pt->rcmp->startp[0];
+# else
+ rpt = inpt + pm[0].rm_so;
+# endif
+
+ while ((inpt < rpt) && (outpt < endpt))
+ *outpt++ = *inpt++;
+ if (outpt == endpt)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * for the second part (which matched the regular
+ * expression) apply the substitution using the
+ * replacement string and place it the prefix in the
+ * final output. If we have problems, skip it.
+ */
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ if ((res = resub(pt->rcmp,pt->nstr,outpt,endpt)) < 0) {
+# else
+ if ((res = resub(&(pt->rcmp),pm,pt->nstr,outpt,endpt))
+ < 0) {
+# endif
+ if (prnt)
+ warn(1, "Replacement name error %s",
+ name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ outpt += res;
+
+ /*
+ * we set up to look again starting at the first
+ * character in the tail (of the input string right
+ * after the last character matched by the regular
+ * expression (inpt always points at the first char in
+ * the string to process). If we are not doing a global
+ * substitution, we will use inpt to copy the tail to
+ * the final result. Make sure we do not overrun the
+ * output buffer
+ */
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ inpt = pt->rcmp->endp[0];
+# else
+ inpt += pm[0].rm_eo;
+# endif
+
+ if ((outpt == endpt) || (*inpt == '\0'))
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * if the user wants global we keep trying to
+ * substitute until it fails, then we are done.
+ */
+ } while (pt->flgs & GLOB);
+
+ if (found)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * a successful substitution did NOT occur, try the next one
+ */
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ if (found) {
+ /*
+ * we had a substitution, copy the last tail piece (if there is
+ * room) to the final result
+ */
+ while ((outpt < endpt) && (*inpt != '\0'))
+ *outpt++ = *inpt++;
+
+ *outpt = '\0';
+ if ((outpt == endpt) && (*inpt != '\0')) {
+ if (prnt)
+ warn(1,"Replacement name too long %s >> %s",
+ name, nname);
+ return(1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * inform the user of the result if wanted
+ */
+ if (prnt && (pt->flgs & PRNT)) {
+ if (*nname == '\0')
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,"%s >> <empty string>\n",
+ name);
+ else
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,"%s >> %s\n", name, nname);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if empty inform the caller this file is to be skipped
+ * otherwise copy the new name over the orig name and return
+ */
+ if (*nname == '\0')
+ return(1);
+ *nlen = l_strncpy(name, nname, PAXPATHLEN + 1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+#ifdef NET2_REGEX
+/*
+ * resub()
+ * apply the replacement to the matched expression. expand out the old
+ * style ed(1) subexpression expansion.
+ * Return:
+ * -1 if error, or the number of characters added to the destination.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+resub(regexp *prog, char *src, char *dest, register char *destend)
+#else
+static int
+resub(prog, src, dest, destend)
+ regexp *prog;
+ char *src;
+ char *dest;
+ register char *destend;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *spt;
+ register char *dpt;
+ register char c;
+ register int no;
+ register int len;
+
+ spt = src;
+ dpt = dest;
+ while ((dpt < destend) && ((c = *spt++) != '\0')) {
+ if (c == '&')
+ no = 0;
+ else if ((c == '\\') && (*spt >= '0') && (*spt <= '9'))
+ no = *spt++ - '0';
+ else {
+ if ((c == '\\') && ((*spt == '\\') || (*spt == '&')))
+ c = *spt++;
+ *dpt++ = c;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if ((prog->startp[no] == NULL) || (prog->endp[no] == NULL) ||
+ ((len = prog->endp[no] - prog->startp[no]) <= 0))
+ continue;
+
+ /*
+ * copy the subexpression to the destination.
+ * fail if we run out of space or the match string is damaged
+ */
+ if (len > (destend - dpt))
+ len = destend - dpt;
+ if (l_strncpy(dpt, prog->startp[no], len) != len)
+ return(-1);
+ dpt += len;
+ }
+ return(dpt - dest);
+}
+
+#else
+
+/*
+ * resub()
+ * apply the replacement to the matched expression. expand out the old
+ * style ed(1) subexpression expansion.
+ * Return:
+ * -1 if error, or the number of characters added to the destination.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+resub(regex_t *rp, register regmatch_t *pm, char *src, char *dest,
+ register char *destend)
+#else
+static int
+resub(rp, pm, src, dest, destend)
+ regex_t *rp;
+ register regmatch_t *pm;
+ char *src;
+ char *dest;
+ register char *destend;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *spt;
+ register char *dpt;
+ register char c;
+ register regmatch_t *pmpt;
+ register int len;
+ int subexcnt;
+
+ spt = src;
+ dpt = dest;
+ subexcnt = rp->re_nsub;
+ while ((dpt < destend) && ((c = *spt++) != '\0')) {
+ /*
+ * see if we just have an ordinary replacement character
+ * or we refer to a subexpression.
+ */
+ if (c == '&') {
+ pmpt = pm;
+ } else if ((c == '\\') && (*spt >= '0') && (*spt <= '9')) {
+ /*
+ * make sure there is a subexpression as specified
+ */
+ if ((len = *spt++ - '0') > subexcnt)
+ return(-1);
+ pmpt = pm + len;
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * Ordinary character, just copy it
+ */
+ if ((c == '\\') && ((*spt == '\\') || (*spt == '&')))
+ c = *spt++;
+ *dpt++ = c;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * continue if the subexpression is bogus
+ */
+ if ((pmpt->rm_so < 0) || (pmpt->rm_eo < 0) ||
+ ((len = pmpt->rm_eo - pmpt->rm_so) <= 0))
+ continue;
+
+ /*
+ * copy the subexpression to the destination.
+ * fail if we run out of space or the match string is damaged
+ */
+ if (len > (destend - dpt))
+ len = destend - dpt;
+ if (l_strncpy(dpt, src + pmpt->rm_so, len) != len)
+ return(-1);
+ dpt += len;
+ }
+ return(dpt - dest);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/pax/pat_rep.h b/bin/pax/pat_rep.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8d22cf0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/pat_rep.h
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)pat_rep.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * data structure for storing user supplied replacement strings (-s)
+ */
+typedef struct replace {
+ char *nstr; /* the new string we will substitute with */
+# ifdef NET2_REGEX
+ regexp *rcmp; /* compiled regular expression used to match */
+# else
+ regex_t rcmp; /* compiled regular expression used to match */
+# endif
+ int flgs; /* print conversions? global in operation? */
+#define PRNT 0x1
+#define GLOB 0x2
+ struct replace *fow; /* pointer to next pattern */
+} REPLACE;
diff --git a/bin/pax/pax.1 b/bin/pax/pax.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a1d7565
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/pax.1
@@ -0,0 +1,1169 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+.\" Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)pax.1 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt PAX 1
+.Os BSD 4.4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm pax
+.Nd read and write file archives and copy directory hierarchies
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm pax
+.Op Fl cdnv
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl f Ar archive
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl s Ar replstr
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl U Ar user
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl G Ar group
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Oo
+.Fl T
+.Op Ar from_date
+.Op Ar ,to_date
+.Oc
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Op Ar pattern ...
+.Nm pax
+.Fl r
+.Op Fl cdiknuvDYZ
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl f Ar archive
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl o Ar options
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl p Ar string
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl s Ar replstr
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Op Fl E Ar limit
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl U Ar user
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl G Ar group
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Oo
+.Fl T
+.Op Ar from_date
+.Op Ar ,to_date
+.Oc
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Op Ar pattern ...
+.Nm pax
+.Fl w
+.Op Fl dituvHLPX
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl b Ar blocksize
+.Ek
+.Oo
+.Op Fl a
+.Op Fl f Ar archive
+.Oc
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl x Ar format
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl s Ar replstr
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl o Ar options
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl U Ar user
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl G Ar group
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl B Ar bytes
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Oo
+.Fl T
+.Op Ar from_date
+.Op Ar ,to_date
+.Op Ar /[c][m]
+.Oc
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Op Ar file ...
+.Nm pax
+.Fl r
+.Fl w
+.Op Fl diklntuvDHLPXYZ
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl p Ar string
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl s Ar replstr
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl U Ar user
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Op Fl G Ar group
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Bk -words
+.Oo
+.Fl T
+.Op Ar from_date
+.Op Ar ,to_date
+.Op Ar /[c][m]
+.Oc
+.Ar ...
+.Ek
+.Op Ar file ...
+.Ar directory
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Pax
+will read, write, and list the members of an archive file,
+and will copy directory hierarchies.
+.Nm Pax
+operation is independent of the specific archive format,
+and supports a wide variety of different archive formats.
+A list of supported archive formats can be found under the description of the
+.Fl x
+option.
+.Pp
+The presence of the
+.Fl r
+and the
+.Fl w
+options specifies which of the following functional modes
+.Nm pax
+will operate under:
+.Em list , read , write ,
+and
+.Em copy.
+.Bl -tag -width 6n
+.It <none>
+.Em List .
+.Nm Pax
+will write to
+.Dv standard output
+a table of contents of the members of the archive file read from
+.Dv standard input ,
+whose pathnames match the specified
+.Ar patterns.
+The table of contents contains one filename per line
+and is written using single line buffering.
+.It Fl r
+.Em Read .
+.Nm Pax
+extracts the members of the archive file read from the
+.Dv standard input ,
+with pathnames matching the specified
+.Ar patterns.
+The archive format and blocking is automatically determined on input.
+When an extracted file is a directory, the entire file hierarchy
+rooted at that directory is extracted.
+All extracted files are created relative to the current file hierarchy.
+The setting of ownership, access and modification times, and file mode of
+the extracted files are discussed in more detail under the
+.Fl p
+option.
+.It Fl w
+.Em Write .
+.Nm Pax
+writes an archive containing the
+.Ar file
+operands to
+.Dv standard output
+using the specified archive format.
+When no
+.Ar file
+operands are specified, a list of files to copy with one per line is read from
+.Dv standard input .
+When a
+.Ar file
+operand is also a directory, the entire file hierarchy rooted
+at that directory will be included.
+.It Fl r Fl w
+.Em Copy .
+.Nm Pax
+copies the
+.Ar file
+operands to the destination
+.Ar directory .
+When no
+.Ar file
+operands are specified, a list of files to copy with one per line is read from
+the
+.Dv standard input .
+When a
+.Ar file
+operand is also a directory the entire file
+hierarchy rooted at that directory will be included.
+The effect of the
+.Em copy
+is as if the copied files were written to an archive file and then
+subsequently extracted, except that there may be hard links between
+the original and the copied files (see the
+.Fl l
+option below).
+.Pp
+.Em Warning :
+The destination
+.Ar directory
+must not be one of the
+.Ar file
+operands or a member of a file hierarchy rooted at one of the
+.Ar file
+operands.
+The result of a
+.Em copy
+under these conditions is unpredictable.
+.El
+.Pp
+While processing a damaged archive during a
+.Em read
+or
+.Em list
+operation,
+.Nm pax
+will attempt to recover from media defects and will search through the archive
+to locate and process the largest number of archive members possible (see the
+.Fl E
+option for more details on error handling).
+.Sh OPERANDS
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar directory
+operand specifies a destination directory pathname.
+If the
+.Ar directory
+operand does not exist, or it is not writable by the user,
+or it is not of type directory,
+.Nm Pax
+will exit with a non-zero exit status.
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar pattern
+operand is used to select one or more pathnames of archive members.
+Archive members are selected using the pattern matching notation described
+by
+.Xr fnmatch 3 .
+When the
+.Ar pattern
+operand is not supplied, all members of the archive will be selected.
+When a
+.Ar pattern
+matches a directory, the entire file hierarchy rooted at that directory will
+be selected.
+When a
+.Ar pattern
+operand does not select at least one archive member,
+.Nm pax
+will write these
+.Ar pattern
+operands in a diagnostic message to
+.Dv standard error
+and then exit with a non-zero exit status.
+.Pp
+The
+.Ar file
+operand specifies the pathname of a file to be copied or archived.
+When a
+.Ar file
+operand does not select at least one archive member,
+.Nm pax
+will write these
+.Ar file
+operand pathnames in a diagnostic message to
+.Dv standard error
+and then exit with a non-zero exit status.
+.Sh OPTIONS
+.Pp
+The following options are supported:
+.Bl -tag -width 4n
+.It Fl r
+Read an archive file from
+.Dv standard input
+and extract the specified
+.Ar files .
+If any intermediate directories are needed in order to extract an archive
+member, these directories will be created as if
+.Xr mkdir 2
+was called with the bitwise inclusive
+.Dv OR
+of
+.Dv S_IRWXU , S_IRWXG ,
+and
+.Dv S_IRWXO
+as the mode argument.
+When the selected archive format supports the specification of linked
+files and these files cannot be linked while the archive is being extracted,
+.Nm pax
+will write a diagnostic message to
+.Dv standard error
+and exit with a non-zero exit status at the completion of operation.
+.It Fl w
+Write files to the
+.Dv standard output
+in the specified archive format.
+When no
+.Ar file
+operands are specified,
+.Dv standard input
+is read for a list of pathnames with one per line without any leading or
+trailing
+.Aq blanks .
+.It Fl a
+Append
+.Ar files
+to the end of an archive that was previously written.
+If an archive format is not specified with a
+.Fl x
+option, the format currently being used in the archive will be selected.
+Any attempt to append to an archive in a format different from the
+format already used in the archive will cause
+.Nm pax
+to exit immediately
+with a non-zero exit status.
+The blocking size used in the archive volume where writing starts
+will continue to be used for the remainder of that archive volume.
+.Pp
+.Em Warning :
+Many storage devices are not able to support the operations necessary
+to perform an append operation.
+Any attempt to append to an archive stored on such a device may damage the
+archive or have other unpredictable results.
+Tape drives in particular are more likely to not support an append operation.
+An archive stored in a regular file system file or on a disk device will
+usually support an append operation.
+.It Fl b Ar blocksize
+When
+.Em writing
+an archive,
+block the output at a positive decimal integer number of
+bytes per write to the archive file.
+The
+.Ar blocksize
+must be a multiple of 512 bytes with a maximum of 32256 bytes.
+A
+.Ar blocksize
+can end with
+.Li k
+or
+.Li b
+to specify multiplication by 1024 (1K) or 512, respectively.
+A pair of
+.Ar blocksizes
+can be separated by
+.Li x
+to indicate a product.
+A specific archive device may impose additional restrictions on the size
+of blocking it will support.
+When blocking is not specified, the default
+.Ar blocksize
+is dependent on the specific archive format being used (see the
+.Fl x
+option).
+.It Fl c
+Match all file or archive members
+.Em except
+those specified by the
+.Ar pattern
+and
+.Ar file
+operands.
+.It Fl d
+Cause files of type directory being copied or archived, or archive members of
+type directory being extracted, to match only the directory file or archive
+member and not the file hierarchy rooted at the directory.
+.It Fl f Ar archive
+Specify
+.Ar archive
+as the pathname of the input or output archive, overriding the default
+.Dv standard input
+(for
+.Em list
+and
+.Em read )
+or
+.Dv standard output
+(for
+.Em write ) .
+A single archive may span multiple files and different archive devices.
+When required,
+.Nm pax
+will prompt for the pathname of the file or device of the next volume in the
+archive.
+.It Fl i
+Interactively rename files or archive members.
+For each archive member matching a
+.Ar pattern
+operand or each file matching a
+.Ar file
+operand,
+.Nm pax
+will prompt to
+.Pa /dev/tty
+giving the name of the file, its file mode and its modification time.
+.Nm Pax
+will then read a line from
+.Pa /dev/tty .
+If this line is blank, the file or archive member is skipped.
+If this line consists of a single period, the
+file or archive member is processed with no modification to its name.
+Otherwise, its name is replaced with the contents of the line.
+.Nm Pax
+will immediately exit with a non-zero exit status if
+.Dv <EOF>
+is encountered when reading a response or if
+.Pa /dev/tty
+cannot be opened for reading and writing.
+.It Fl k
+Do not overwrite existing files.
+.It Fl l
+Link files. (The letter ell).
+In the
+.Em copy
+mode (
+.Fl r
+.Fl w ) ,
+hard links are made between the source and destination file hierarchies
+whenever possible.
+.It Fl n
+Select the first archive member that matches each
+.Ar pattern
+operand.
+No more than one archive member is matched for each
+.Ar pattern .
+When members of type directory are matched, the file hierarchy rooted at that
+directory is also matched (unless
+.Fl d
+is also specified).
+.It Fl o Ar options
+Information to modify the algorithm for extracting or writing archive files
+which is specific to the archive format specified by
+.Fl x .
+In general,
+.Ar options
+take the form:
+.Cm name=value
+.It Fl p Ar string
+Specify one or more file characteristic options (privileges).
+The
+.Ar string
+option-argument is a string specifying file characteristics to be retained or
+discarded on extraction.
+The string consists of the specification characters
+.Cm a , e , m , o ,
+and
+.Cm p .
+Multiple characteristics can be concatenated within the same string
+and multiple
+.Fl p
+options can be specified.
+The meaning of the specification characters are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width 2n
+.It Cm a
+Do not preserve file access times.
+By default, file access times are preserved whenever possible.
+.It Cm e
+.Sq Preserve everything ,
+the user ID, group ID, file mode bits,
+file access time, and file modification time.
+This is intended to be used by
+.Em root ,
+someone with all the appropriate privileges, in order to preserve all
+aspects of the files as they are recorded in the archive.
+The
+.Cm e
+flag is the sum of the
+.Cm o
+and
+.Cm p
+flags.
+.It Cm m
+Do not preserve file modification times.
+By default, file modification times are preserved whenever possible.
+.It Cm o
+Preserve the user ID and group ID.
+.It Cm p
+.Sq Preserve
+the file mode bits.
+This intended to be used by a
+.Em user
+with regular privileges who wants to preserve all aspects of the file other
+than the ownership.
+The file times are preserved by default, but two other flags are offered to
+disable this and use the time of extraction instead.
+.El
+.Pp
+In the preceding list,
+.Sq preserve
+indicates that an attribute stored in the archive is given to the
+extracted file, subject to the permissions of the invoking
+process.
+Otherwise the attribute of the extracted file is determined as
+part of the normal file creation action.
+If neither the
+.Cm e
+nor the
+.Cm o
+specification character is specified, or the user ID and group ID are not
+preserved for any reason,
+.Nm pax
+will not set the
+.Dv S_ISUID
+.Em ( setuid )
+and
+.Dv S_ISGID
+.Em ( setgid )
+bits of the file mode.
+If the preservation of any of these items fails for any reason,
+.Nm pax
+will write a diagnostic message to
+.Dv standard error .
+Failure to preserve these items will affect the final exit status,
+but will not cause the extracted file to be deleted.
+If the file characteristic letters in any of the string option-arguments are
+duplicated or conflict with each other, the one(s) given last will take
+precedence.
+For example, if
+.Dl Fl p Ar eme
+is specified, file modification times are still preserved.
+.It Fl s Ar replstr
+Modify the file or archive member names specified by the
+.Ar pattern
+or
+.Ar file
+operands according to the substitution expression
+.Ar replstr ,
+using the syntax of the
+.Xr ed 1
+utility regular expressions.
+The format of these regular expressions are:
+.Dl /old/new/[gp]
+As in
+.Xr ed 1 ,
+.Cm old
+is a basic regular expression and
+.Cm new
+can contain an ampersand (&), \\n (where n is a digit) back-references,
+or subexpression matching.
+The
+.Cm old
+string may also contain
+.Dv <newline>
+characters.
+Any non-null character can be used as a delimiter (/ is shown here).
+Multiple
+.Fl s
+expressions can be specified.
+The expressions are applied in the order they are specified on the
+command line, terminating with the first successful substitution.
+The optional trailing
+.Cm g
+continues to apply the substitution expression to the pathname substring
+which starts with the first character following the end of the last successful
+substitution. The first unsuccessful substitution stops the operation of the
+.Cm g
+option.
+The optional trailing
+.Cm p
+will cause the final result of a successful substitution to be written to
+.Dv standard error
+in the following format:
+.Dl <original pathname> >> <new pathname>
+File or archive member names that substitute to the empty string
+are not selected and will be skipped.
+.It Fl t
+Reset the access times of any file or directory read or accessed by
+.Nm pax
+to be the same as they were before being read or accessed by
+.Nm pax .
+.It Fl u
+Ignore files that are older (having a less recent file modification time)
+than a pre-existing file or archive member with the same name.
+During
+.Em read ,
+an archive member with the same name as a file in the file system will be
+extracted if the archive member is newer than the file.
+During
+.Em write ,
+a file system member with the same name as an archive member will be
+written to the archive if it is newer than the archive member.
+During
+.Em copy ,
+the file in the destination hierarchy is replaced by the file in the source
+hierarchy or by a link to the file in the source hierarchy if the file in
+the source hierarchy is newer.
+.It Fl v
+During a
+.Em list
+operation, produce a verbose table of contents using the format of the
+.Xr ls 1
+utility with the
+.Fl l
+option.
+For pathnames representing a hard link to a previous member of the archive,
+the output has the format:
+.Dl <ls -l listing> == <link name>
+For pathnames representing a symbolic link, the output has the format:
+.Dl <ls -l listing> => <link name>
+Where <ls -l listing> is the output format specified by the
+.Xr ls 1
+utility when used with the
+.Fl l
+option.
+Otherwise for all the other operational modes (
+.Em read , write ,
+and
+.Em copy ) ,
+pathnames are written and flushed to
+.Dv standard error
+without a trailing
+.Dv <newline>
+as soon as processing begins on that file or
+archive member.
+The trailing
+.Dv <newline> ,
+is not buffered, and is written only after the file has been read or written.
+.It Fl x Ar format
+Specify the output archive format, with the default format being
+.Ar ustar .
+.Nm Pax
+currently supports the following formats:
+.Bl -tag -width "sv4cpio"
+.It Ar cpio
+The extended cpio interchange format specified in the
+.St -p1003.2
+standard.
+The default blocksize for this format is 5120 bytes.
+Inode and device information about a file (used for detecting file hard links
+by this format) which may be truncated by this format is detected by
+.Nm pax
+and is repaired.
+.It Ar bcpio
+The old binary cpio format.
+The default blocksize for this format is 5120 bytes.
+This format is not very portable and should not be used when other formats
+are available.
+Inode and device information about a file (used for detecting file hard links
+by this format) which may be truncated by this format is detected by
+.Nm pax
+and is repaired.
+.It Ar sv4cpio
+The System V release 4 cpio.
+The default blocksize for this format is 5120 bytes.
+Inode and device information about a file (used for detecting file hard links
+by this format) which may be truncated by this format is detected by
+.Nm pax
+and is repaired.
+.It Ar sv4crc
+The System V release 4 cpio with file crc checksums.
+The default blocksize for this format is 5120 bytes.
+Inode and device information about a file (used for detecting file hard links
+by this format) which may be truncated by this format is detected by
+.Nm pax
+and is repaired.
+.It Ar tar
+The old BSD tar format as found in BSD4.3.
+The default blocksize for this format is 10240 bytes.
+Pathnames stored by this format must be 100 characters or less in length.
+Only
+.Em regular
+files,
+.Em hard links , soft links ,
+and
+.Em directories
+will be archived (other file system types are not supported).
+For backwards compatibility with even older tar formats, a
+.Fl o
+option can be used when writing an archive to omit the storage of directories.
+This option takes the form:
+.Dl Fl o Cm write_opt=nodir
+.It Ar ustar
+The extended tar interchange format specified in the
+.St -p1003.2
+standard.
+The default blocksize for this format is 10240 bytes.
+Pathnames stored by this format must be 250 characters or less in length.
+.El
+.Pp
+.Nm Pax
+will detect and report any file that it is unable to store or extract
+as the result of any specific archive format restrictions.
+The individual archive formats may impose additional restrictions on use.
+Typical archive format restrictions include (but are not limited to):
+file pathname length, file size, link pathname length and the type of the file.
+.It Fl B Ar bytes
+Limit the number of bytes written to a single archive volume to
+.Ar bytes .
+The
+.Ar bytes
+limit can end with
+.Li m ,
+.Li k ,
+or
+.Li b
+to specify multiplication by 1048576 (1M), 1024 (1K) or 512, respectively.
+A pair of
+.Ar bytes
+limits can be separated by
+.Li x
+to indicate a product.
+.Pp
+.Em Warning :
+Only use this option when writing an archive to a device which supports
+an end of file read condition based on last (or largest) write offset
+(such as a regular file or a tape drive).
+The use of this option with a floppy or hard disk is not recommended.
+.It Fl D
+This option is the same as the
+.Fl u
+option, except that the file inode change time is checked instead of the
+file modification time.
+The file inode change time can be used to select files whose inode information
+(e.g. uid, gid, etc.) is newer than a copy of the file in the destination
+.Ar directory .
+.It Fl E Ar limit
+Limit the number of consecutive read faults while trying to read a flawed
+archives to
+.Ar limit .
+With a positive
+.Ar limit ,
+.Nm pax
+will attempt to recover from an archive read error and will
+continue processing starting with the next file stored in the archive.
+A
+.Ar limit
+of 0 will cause
+.Nm pax
+to stop operation after the first read error is detected on an archive volume.
+A
+.Ar limit
+of
+.Li NONE
+will cause
+.Nm pax
+to attempt to recover from read errors forever.
+The default
+.Ar limit
+is a small positive number of retries.
+.Pp
+.Em Warning:
+Using this option with
+.Li NONE
+should be used with extreme caution as
+.Nm pax
+may get stuck in an infinite loop on a very badly flawed archive.
+.It Fl G Ar group
+Select a file based on its
+.Ar group
+name, or when starting with a
+.Cm # ,
+a numeric gid.
+A '\\' can be used to escape the
+.Cm # .
+Multiple
+.Fl G
+options may be supplied and checking stops with the first match.
+.It Fl H
+Follow only command line symbolic links while performing a physical file
+system traversal.
+.It Fl L
+Follow all symbolic links to perform a logical file system traversal.
+.It Fl P
+Do not follow symbolic links, perform a physical file system traversal.
+This is the default mode.
+.It Fl T Ar [from_date][,to_date][/[c][m]]
+Allow files to be selected based on a file modification or inode change
+time falling within a specified time range of
+.Ar from_date
+to
+.Ar to_date
+(the dates are inclusive).
+If only a
+.Ar from_date
+is supplied, all files with a modification or inode change time
+equal to or younger are selected.
+If only a
+.Ar to_date
+is supplied, all files with a modification or inode change time
+equal to or older will be selected.
+When the
+.Ar from_date
+is equal to the
+.Ar to_date ,
+only files with a modification or inode change time of exactly that
+time will be selected.
+.Pp
+When
+.Nm pax
+is in the
+.Em write
+or
+.Em copy
+mode, the optional trailing field
+.Ar [c][m]
+can be used to determine which file time (inode change, file modification or
+both) are used in the comparison.
+If neither is specified, the default is to use file modification time only.
+The
+.Ar m
+specifies the comparison of file modification time (the time when
+the file was last written).
+The
+.Ar c
+specifies the comparison of inode change time (the time when the file
+inode was last changed; e.g. a change of owner, group, mode, etc).
+When
+.Ar c
+and
+.Ar m
+are both specified, then the modification and inode change times are
+both compared.
+The inode change time comparison is useful in selecting files whose
+attributes were recently changed or selecting files which were recently
+created and had their modification time reset to an older time (as what
+happens when a file is extracted from an archive and the modification time
+is preserved).
+Time comparisons using both file times is useful when
+.Nm pax
+is used to create a time based incremental archive (only files that were
+changed during a specified time range will be archived).
+.Pp
+A time range is made up of six different fields and each field must contain two
+digits.
+The format is:
+.Dl [yy[mm[dd[hh]]]]mm[.ss]
+Where
+.Cm yy
+is the last two digits of the year,
+the first
+.Cm mm
+is the month (from 01 to 12),
+.Cm dd
+is the day of the month (from 01 to 31),
+.Cm hh
+is the hour of the day (from 00 to 23),
+the second
+.Cm mm
+is the minute (from 00 to 59),
+and
+.Cm ss
+is the seconds (from 00 to 59).
+The minute field
+.Cm mm
+is required, while the other fields are optional and must be added in the
+following order:
+.Dl Cm hh , dd , mm , yy .
+The
+.Cm ss
+field may be added independently of the other fields.
+Time ranges are relative to the current time, so
+.Dl Fl T Ar 1234/cm
+would select all files with a modification or inode change time
+of 12:34 PM today or later.
+Multiple
+.Fl T
+time range can be supplied and checking stops with the first match.
+.It Fl U Ar user
+Select a file based on its
+.Ar user
+name, or when starting with a
+.Cm # ,
+a numeric uid.
+A '\\' can be used to escape the
+.Cm # .
+Multiple
+.Fl U
+options may be supplied and checking stops with the first match.
+.It Fl X
+When traversing the file hierarchy specified by a pathname,
+do not descend into directories that have a different device ID.
+See the
+.Li st_dev
+field as described in
+.Xr stat 2
+for more information about device ID's.
+.It Fl Y
+This option is the same as the
+.Fl D
+option, except that the inode change time is checked using the
+pathname created after all the file name modifications have completed.
+.It Fl Z
+This option is the same as the
+.Fl u
+option, except that the modification time is checked using the
+pathname created after all the file name modifications have completed.
+.El
+.Pp
+The options that operate on the names of files or archive members (
+.Fl c ,
+.Fl i ,
+.Fl n ,
+.Fl s ,
+.Fl u ,
+.Fl v ,
+.Fl D ,
+.Fl G ,
+.Fl T ,
+.Fl U ,
+.Fl Y ,
+and
+.Fl Z )
+interact as follows.
+.Pp
+When extracting files during a
+.Em read
+operation, archive members are
+.Sq selected ,
+based only on the user specified pattern operands as modified by the
+.Fl c ,
+.Fl n ,
+.Fl u ,
+.Fl D ,
+.Fl G ,
+.Fl T ,
+.Fl U
+options.
+Then any
+.Fl s
+and
+.Fl i
+options will modify in that order, the names of these selected files.
+Then the
+.Fl Y
+and
+.Fl Z
+options will be applied based on the final pathname.
+Finally the
+.Fl v
+option will write the names resulting from these modifications.
+.Pp
+When archiving files during a
+.Em write
+operation, or copying files during a
+.Em copy
+operation, archive members are
+.Sq selected ,
+based only on the user specified pathnames as modified by the
+.Fl n ,
+.Fl u ,
+.Fl D ,
+.Fl G ,
+.Fl T ,
+and
+.Fl U
+options (the
+.Fl D
+option only applies during a copy operation).
+Then any
+.Fl s
+and
+.Fl i
+options will modify in that order, the names of these selected files.
+Then during a
+.Em copy
+operation the
+.Fl Y
+and the
+.Fl Z
+options will be applied based on the final pathname.
+Finally the
+.Fl v
+option will write the names resulting from these modifications.
+.Pp
+When one or both of the
+.Fl u
+or
+.Fl D
+options are specified along with the
+.Fl n
+option, a file is not considered selected unless it is newer
+than the file to which it is compared.
+.Sh EXAMPLES
+The command:
+.Dl pax -w -f /dev/rst0 .\
+copies the contents of the current directory to the device
+.Pa /dev/rst0 .
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Dl pax -r -v -f filename
+gives the verbose table of contents for an archive stored in
+.Pa filename .
+.Pp
+The following commands:
+.Dl mkdir newdir
+.Dl cd olddir
+.Dl pax -rw .\ newdir
+will copy the entire
+.Pa olddir
+directory hierarchy to
+.Pa newdir .
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Dl pax -r -s ',^//*usr//*,,' -f a.pax
+reads the archive
+.Pa a.pax ,
+with all files rooted in ``/usr'' into the archive extracted relative to the
+current directory.
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Dl pax -rw -i .\ dest_dir
+can be used to interactively select the files to copy from the current
+directory to
+.Pa dest_dir .
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Dl pax -r -pe -U root -G bin -f a.pax
+will extract all files from the archive
+.Pa a.pax
+which are owned by
+.Em root
+with group
+.Em bin
+and will preserve all file permissions.
+.Pp
+The command:
+.Dl pax -r -w -v -Y -Z home /backup
+will update (and list) only those files in the destination directory
+.Pa /backup
+which are older (less recent inode change or file modification times) than
+files with the same name found in the source file tree
+.Pa home .
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm pax
+utility is a superset of the
+.St -p1003.2
+standard.
+The options
+.Fl B ,
+.Fl D ,
+.Fl E ,
+.Fl G ,
+.Fl H ,
+.Fl L ,
+.Fl P ,
+.Fl T ,
+.Fl U ,
+.Fl Y ,
+.Fl Z ,
+the archive formats
+.Ar bcpio ,
+.Ar sv4cpio ,
+.Ar sv4crc ,
+.Ar tar ,
+and the flawed archive handling during
+.Ar list
+and
+.Ar read
+operations are extensions to the
+.Tn POSIX
+standard.
+.Sh AUTHOR
+Keith Muller at the University of California, San Diego
+.Sh ERRORS
+.Nm pax
+will exit with one of the following values:
+.Bl -tag -width 2n
+.It 0
+All files were processed successfully.
+.It 1
+An error occurred.
+.El
+.Pp
+Whenever
+.Nm pax
+cannot create a file or a link when reading an archive or cannot
+find a file when writing an archive, or cannot preserve the user ID,
+group ID, or file mode when the
+.Fl p
+option is specified, a diagnostic message is written to
+.Dv standard error
+and a non-zero exit status will be returned, but processing will continue.
+In the case where pax cannot create a link to a file,
+.Nm pax
+will not create a second copy of the file.
+.Pp
+If the extraction of a file from an archive is prematurely terminated by
+a signal or error,
+.Nm pax
+may have only partially extracted a file the user wanted.
+Additionally, the file modes of extracted files and directories
+may have incorrect file bits, and the modification and access times may be
+wrong.
+.Pp
+If the creation of an archive is prematurely terminated by a signal or error,
+.Nm pax
+may have only partially created the archive which may violate the specific
+archive format specification.
+.Pp
+If while doing a
+.Em copy ,
+.Nm pax
+detects a file is about to overwrite itself, the file is not copied,
+a diagnostic message is written to
+.Dv standard error
+and when
+.Nm pax
+completes it will exit with a non-zero exit status.
diff --git a/bin/pax/pax.c b/bin/pax/pax.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e8b6626
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/pax.c
@@ -0,0 +1,405 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1992, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)pax.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+static int gen_init __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * PAX main routines, general globals and some simple start up routines
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Variables that can be accessed by any routine within pax
+ */
+int act = DEFOP; /* read/write/append/copy */
+FSUB *frmt = NULL; /* archive format type */
+int cflag; /* match all EXCEPT pattern/file */
+int dflag; /* directory member match only */
+int iflag; /* interactive file/archive rename */
+int kflag; /* do not overwrite existing files */
+int lflag; /* use hard links when possible */
+int nflag; /* select first archive member match */
+int tflag; /* restore access time after read */
+int uflag; /* ignore older modification time files */
+int vflag; /* produce verbose output */
+int Dflag; /* same as uflag except inode change time */
+int Hflag; /* follow command line symlinks (write only) */
+int Lflag; /* follow symlinks when writing */
+int Xflag; /* archive files with same device id only */
+int Yflag; /* same as Dflg except after name mode */
+int Zflag; /* same as uflg except after name mode */
+int vfpart; /* is partial verbose output in progress */
+int patime = 1; /* preserve file access time */
+int pmtime = 1; /* preserve file modification times */
+int pmode; /* preserve file mode bits */
+int pids; /* preserve file uid/gid */
+int exit_val; /* exit value */
+int docrc; /* check/create file crc */
+char *dirptr; /* destination dir in a copy */
+char *ltmfrmt; /* -v locale time format (if any) */
+char *argv0; /* root of argv[0] */
+sigset_t s_mask; /* signal mask for cleanup critical sect */
+
+/*
+ * PAX - Portable Archive Interchange
+ *
+ * A utility to read, write, and write lists of the members of archive
+ * files and copy directory hierarchies. A variety of archive formats
+ * are supported (some are described in POSIX 1003.1 10.1):
+ *
+ * ustar - 10.1.1 extended tar interchange format
+ * cpio - 10.1.2 extended cpio interchange format
+ * tar - old BSD 4.3 tar format
+ * binary cpio - old cpio with binary header format
+ * sysVR4 cpio - with and without CRC
+ *
+ * This version is a superset of IEEE Std 1003.2b-d3
+ *
+ * Summary of Extensions to the IEEE Standard:
+ *
+ * 1 READ ENHANCEMENTS
+ * 1.1 Operations which read archives will continue to operate even when
+ * processing archives which may be damaged, truncated, or fail to meet
+ * format specs in several different ways. Damaged sections of archives
+ * are detected and avoided if possible. Attempts will be made to resync
+ * archive read operations even with badly damaged media.
+ * 1.2 Blocksize requirements are not strictly enforced on archive read.
+ * Tapes which have variable sized records can be read without errors.
+ * 1.3 The user can specify via the non-standard option flag -E if error
+ * resync operation should stop on a media error, try a specified number
+ * of times to correct, or try to correct forever.
+ * 1.4 Sparse files (lseek holes) stored on the archive (but stored with blocks
+ * of all zeros will be restored with holes appropriate for the target
+ * filesystem
+ * 1.5 The user is notified whenever something is found during archive
+ * read operations which violates spec (but the read will continue).
+ * 1.6 Multiple archive volumes can be read and may span over different
+ * archive devices
+ * 1.7 Rigidly restores all file attributes exactly as they are stored on the
+ * archive.
+ * 1.8 Modification change time ranges can be specified via multiple -T
+ * options. These allow a user to select files whose modification time
+ * lies within a specific time range.
+ * 1.9 Files can be selected based on owner (user name or uid) via one or more
+ * -U options.
+ * 1.10 Files can be selected based on group (group name or gid) via one o
+ * more -G options.
+ * 1.11 File modification time can be checked against exisiting file after
+ * name modification (-Z)
+ *
+ * 2 WRITE ENHANCEMENTS
+ * 2.1 Write operation will stop instead of allowing a user to create a flawed
+ * flawed archive (due to any problem).
+ * 2.2 Archives writtens by pax are forced to strictly conform to both the
+ * archive and pax the spceific format specifications.
+ * 2.3 Blocking size and format is rigidly enforced on writes.
+ * 2.4 Formats which may exhibit header overflow problems (they have fields
+ * too small for large file systems, such as inode number storage), use
+ * routines designed to repair this problem. These techniques still
+ * conform to both pax and format specifications, but no longer truncate
+ * these fields. This removes any restrictions on using these archive
+ * formats on large file systems.
+ * 2.5 Multiple archive volumes can be written and may span over different
+ * archive devices
+ * 2.6 A archive volume record limit allows the user to specify the number
+ * of bytes stored on an archive volume. When reached the user is
+ * prompted for the next archive volume. This is specified with the
+ * non-standard -B flag. THe limit is rounded up to the next blocksize.
+ * 2.7 All archive padding during write use zero filled sections. This makes
+ * it much easier to pull data out of flawed archive during read
+ * operations.
+ * 2.8 Access time reset with the -t applies to all file nodes (including
+ * directories).
+ * 2.9 Symbolic links can be followed with -L (optional in the spec).
+ * 2.10 Modification or inode change time ranges can be specified via
+ * multiple -T options. These allow a user to select files whose
+ * modification or inode change time lies within a specific time range.
+ * 2.11 Files can be selected based on owner (user name or uid) via one or more
+ * -U options.
+ * 2.12 Files can be selected based on group (group name or gid) via one o
+ * more -G options.
+ * 2.13 Symlinks which appear on the command line can be followed (without
+ * following other symlinks; -H flag)
+ *
+ * 3 COPY ENHANCEMENTS
+ * 3.1 Sparse files (lseek holes) can be copied without expanding the holes
+ * into zero filled blocks. The file copy is created with holes which are
+ * appropriate for the target filesystem
+ * 3.2 Access time as well as modification time on copied file trees can be
+ * preserved with the appropriate -p options.
+ * 3.3 Access time reset with the -t applies to all file nodes (including
+ * directories).
+ * 3.4 Symbolic links can be followed with -L (optional in the spec).
+ * 3.5 Modification or inode change time ranges can be specified via
+ * multiple -T options. These allow a user to select files whose
+ * modification or inode change time lies within a specific time range.
+ * 3.6 Files can be selected based on owner (user name or uid) via one or more
+ * -U options.
+ * 3.7 Files can be selected based on group (group name or gid) via one o
+ * more -G options.
+ * 3.8 Symlinks which appear on the command line can be followed (without
+ * following other symlinks; -H flag)
+ * 3.9 File inode change time can be checked against exisiting file before
+ * name modification (-D)
+ * 3.10 File inode change time can be checked against exisiting file after
+ * name modification (-Y)
+ * 3.11 File modification time can be checked against exisiting file after
+ * name modification (-Z)
+ *
+ * 4 GENERAL ENHANCEMENTS
+ * 4.1 Internal structure is designed to isolate format dependent and
+ * independent functions. Formats are selected via a format driver table.
+ * This encourages the addition of new archive formats by only having to
+ * write those routines which id, read and write the archive header.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * main()
+ * parse options, set up and operate as specified by the user.
+ * any operational flaw will set exit_val to non-zero
+ * Return: 0 if ok, 1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+main(int argc, char **argv)
+#else
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char **argv;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * parse options, determine operational mode, general init
+ */
+ options(argc, argv);
+ if ((gen_init() < 0) || (tty_init() < 0))
+ return(exit_val);
+
+ /*
+ * select a primary operation mode
+ */
+ switch(act) {
+ case EXTRACT:
+ extract();
+ break;
+ case ARCHIVE:
+ archive();
+ break;
+ case APPND:
+ append();
+ break;
+ case COPY:
+ copy();
+ break;
+ default:
+ case LIST:
+ list();
+ break;
+ }
+ return(exit_val);
+}
+
+/*
+ * sig_cleanup()
+ * when interrupted we try to do whatever delayed processing we can.
+ * This is not critical, but we really ought to limit our damage when we
+ * are aborted by the user.
+ * Return:
+ * never....
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+sig_cleanup(int which_sig)
+#else
+void
+sig_cleanup(which_sig)
+ int which_sig;
+#endif
+{
+ /*
+ * restore modes and times for any dirs we may have created
+ * or any dirs we may have read. Set vflag and vfpart so the user
+ * will clearly see the message on a line by itself.
+ */
+ vflag = vfpart = 1;
+ if (which_sig == SIGXCPU)
+ warn(0, "Cpu time limit reached, cleaning up.");
+ else
+ warn(0, "Signal caught, cleaning up.");
+
+ ar_close();
+ proc_dir();
+ if (tflag)
+ atdir_end();
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * gen_init()
+ * general setup routines. Not all are required, but they really help
+ * when dealing with a medium to large sized archives.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+gen_init(void)
+#else
+static int
+gen_init()
+#endif
+{
+ struct rlimit reslimit;
+ struct sigaction n_hand;
+ struct sigaction o_hand;
+
+ /*
+ * Really needed to handle large archives. We can run out of memory for
+ * internal tables really fast when we have a whole lot of files...
+ */
+ if (getrlimit(RLIMIT_DATA , &reslimit) == 0){
+ reslimit.rlim_cur = reslimit.rlim_max;
+ (void)setrlimit(RLIMIT_DATA , &reslimit);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * should file size limits be waived? if the os limits us, this is
+ * needed if we want to write a large archive
+ */
+ if (getrlimit(RLIMIT_FSIZE , &reslimit) == 0){
+ reslimit.rlim_cur = reslimit.rlim_max;
+ (void)setrlimit(RLIMIT_FSIZE , &reslimit);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * increase the size the stack can grow to
+ */
+ if (getrlimit(RLIMIT_STACK , &reslimit) == 0){
+ reslimit.rlim_cur = reslimit.rlim_max;
+ (void)setrlimit(RLIMIT_STACK , &reslimit);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * not really needed, but doesn't hurt
+ */
+ if (getrlimit(RLIMIT_RSS , &reslimit) == 0){
+ reslimit.rlim_cur = reslimit.rlim_max;
+ (void)setrlimit(RLIMIT_RSS , &reslimit);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Handle posix locale
+ *
+ * set user defines time printing format for -v option
+ */
+ ltmfrmt = getenv("LC_TIME");
+
+ /*
+ * signal handling to reset stored directory times and modes. Since
+ * we deal with broken pipes via failed writes we ignore it. We also
+ * deal with any file size limit thorugh failed writes. Cpu time
+ * limits are caught and a cleanup is forced.
+ */
+ if ((sigemptyset(&s_mask) < 0) || (sigaddset(&s_mask, SIGTERM) < 0) ||
+ (sigaddset(&s_mask,SIGINT) < 0)||(sigaddset(&s_mask,SIGHUP) < 0) ||
+ (sigaddset(&s_mask,SIGPIPE) < 0)||(sigaddset(&s_mask,SIGQUIT)<0) ||
+ (sigaddset(&s_mask,SIGXCPU) < 0)||(sigaddset(&s_mask,SIGXFSZ)<0)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to set up signal mask");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ n_hand.sa_mask = s_mask;
+ n_hand.sa_flags = 0;
+ n_hand.sa_handler = sig_cleanup;
+
+ if ((sigaction(SIGHUP, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0) &&
+ (o_hand.sa_handler == SIG_IGN) &&
+ (sigaction(SIGHUP, &o_hand, &o_hand) < 0))
+ goto out;
+
+ if ((sigaction(SIGTERM, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0) &&
+ (o_hand.sa_handler == SIG_IGN) &&
+ (sigaction(SIGTERM, &o_hand, &o_hand) < 0))
+ goto out;
+
+ if ((sigaction(SIGINT, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0) &&
+ (o_hand.sa_handler == SIG_IGN) &&
+ (sigaction(SIGINT, &o_hand, &o_hand) < 0))
+ goto out;
+
+ if ((sigaction(SIGQUIT, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0) &&
+ (o_hand.sa_handler == SIG_IGN) &&
+ (sigaction(SIGQUIT, &o_hand, &o_hand) < 0))
+ goto out;
+
+ if ((sigaction(SIGXCPU, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0) &&
+ (o_hand.sa_handler == SIG_IGN) &&
+ (sigaction(SIGXCPU, &o_hand, &o_hand) < 0))
+ goto out;
+
+ n_hand.sa_handler = SIG_IGN;
+ if ((sigaction(SIGPIPE, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0) ||
+ (sigaction(SIGXFSZ, &n_hand, &o_hand) < 0))
+ goto out;
+ return(0);
+
+ out:
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to set up signal handler");
+ return(-1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/pax.h b/bin/pax/pax.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5658d76
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/pax.h
@@ -0,0 +1,238 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)pax.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+ */
+
+/*
+ * BSD PAX global data structures and constants.
+ */
+
+#define MAXBLK 32256 /* MAX blocksize supported (posix SPEC) */
+ /* WARNING: increasing MAXBLK past 32256 */
+ /* will violate posix spec. */
+#define BLKMULT 512 /* blocksize must be even mult of 512 bytes */
+ /* Don't even think of changing this */
+#define DEVBLK 8192 /* default read blksize for devices */
+#define FILEBLK 10240 /* default read blksize for files */
+#define PAXPATHLEN 3072 /* maximium path length for pax. MUST be */
+ /* longer than the system MAXPATHLEN */
+
+/*
+ * Pax modes of operation
+ */
+#define LIST 0 /* List the file in an archive */
+#define EXTRACT 1 /* extract the files in an archive */
+#define ARCHIVE 2 /* write a new archive */
+#define APPND 3 /* append to the end of an archive */
+#define COPY 4 /* copy files to destination dir */
+#define DEFOP LIST /* if no flags default is to LIST */
+
+/*
+ * Device type of the current archive volume
+ */
+#define ISREG 0 /* regular file */
+#define ISCHR 1 /* character device */
+#define ISBLK 2 /* block device */
+#define ISTAPE 3 /* tape drive */
+#define ISPIPE 4 /* pipe/socket */
+
+/*
+ * Format Specific Routine Table
+ *
+ * The format specific routine table allows new archive formats to be quickly
+ * added. Overall pax operation is independent of the actual format used to
+ * form the archive. Only those routines which deal directly with the archive
+ * are tailored to the oddities of the specifc format. All other routines are
+ * independent of the archive format. Data flow in and out of the format
+ * dependent routines pass pointers to ARCHD structure (described below).
+ */
+typedef struct {
+ char *name; /* name of format, this is the name the user */
+ /* gives to -x option to select it. */
+ int bsz; /* default block size. used when the user */
+ /* does not specify a blocksize for writing */
+ /* Appends continue to with the blocksize */
+ /* the archive is currently using.*/
+ int hsz; /* Header size in bytes. this is the size of */
+ /* the smallest header this format supports. */
+ /* Headers are assumed to fit in a BLKMULT. */
+ /* If they are bigger, get_head() and */
+ /* get_arc() must be adjusted */
+ int udev; /* does append require unique dev/ino? some */
+ /* formats use the device and inode fields */
+ /* to specify hard links. when members in */
+ /* the archive have the same inode/dev they */
+ /* are assumed to be hard links. During */
+ /* append we may have to generate unique ids */
+ /* to avoid creating incorrect hard links */
+ int hlk; /* does archive store hard links info? if */
+ /* not, we do not bother to look for them */
+ /* during archive write operations */
+ int blkalgn; /* writes must be aligned to blkalgn boundry */
+ int inhead; /* is the trailer encoded in a valid header? */
+ /* if not, trailers are assumed to be found */
+ /* in invalid headers (i.e like tar) */
+ int (*id)(); /* checks if a buffer is a valid header */
+ /* returns 1 if it is, o.w. returns a 0 */
+ int (*st_rd)(); /* initialize routine for read. so format */
+ /* can set up tables etc before it starts */
+ /* reading an archive */
+ int (*rd)(); /* read header routine. passed a pointer to */
+ /* ARCHD. It must extract the info from the */
+ /* format and store it in the ARCHD struct. */
+ /* This routine is expected to fill all the */
+ /* fields in the ARCHD (including stat buf) */
+ /* 0 is returned when a valid header is */
+ /* found. -1 when not valid. This routine */
+ /* set the skip and pad fields so the format */
+ /* independent routines know the amount of */
+ /* padding and the number of bytes of data */
+ /* which follow the header. This info is */
+ /* used skip to the next file header */
+ off_t (*end_rd)(); /* read cleanup. Allows format to clean up */
+ /* and MUST RETURN THE LENGTH OF THE TRAILER */
+ /* RECORD (so append knows how many bytes */
+ /* to move back to rewrite the trailer) */
+ int (*st_wr)(); /* initialize routine for write operations */
+ int (*wr)(); /* write archive header. Passed an ARCHD */
+ /* filled with the specs on the next file to */
+ /* archived. Returns a 1 if no file data is */
+ /* is to be stored; 0 if file data is to be */
+ /* added. A -1 is returned if a write */
+ /* operation to the archive failed. this */
+ /* function sets the skip and pad fields so */
+ /* the proper padding can be added after */
+ /* file data. This routine must NEVER write */
+ /* a flawed archive header. */
+ int (*end_wr)(); /* end write. write the trailer and do any */
+ /* other format specific functions needed */
+ /* at the ecnd of a archive write */
+ int (*trail)(); /* returns 0 if a valid trailer, -1 if not */
+ /* For formats which encode the trailer */
+ /* outside of a valid header, a return value */
+ /* of 1 indicates that the block passed to */
+ /* it can never contain a valid header (skip */
+ /* this block, no point in looking at it) */
+ /* CAUTION: parameters to this function are */
+ /* different for trailers inside or outside */
+ /* of headers. See get_head() for details */
+ int (*rd_data)(); /* read/process file data from the archive */
+ int (*wr_data)(); /* write/process file data to the archive */
+ int (*options)(); /* process format specific options (-o) */
+} FSUB;
+
+/*
+ * Pattern matching structure
+ *
+ * Used to store command line patterns
+ */
+typedef struct pattern {
+ char *pstr; /* pattern to match, user supplied */
+ char *pend; /* end of a prefix match */
+ int plen; /* length of pstr */
+ int flgs; /* processing/state flags */
+#define MTCH 0x1 /* pattern has been matched */
+#define DIR_MTCH 0x2 /* pattern matched a directory */
+ struct pattern *fow; /* next pattern */
+} PATTERN;
+
+/*
+ * General Archive Structure (used internal to pax)
+ *
+ * This structure is used to pass information about archive members between
+ * the format independent routines and the format specific routines. When
+ * new archive formats are added, they must accept requests and supply info
+ * encoded in a structure of this type. The name fields are declared statically
+ * here, as there is only ONE of these floating around, size is not a major
+ * consideration. Eventually converting the name fields to a dynamic length
+ * may be required if and when the supporting operating system removes all
+ * restrictions on the length of pathnames it will resolve.
+ */
+typedef struct {
+ int nlen; /* file name length */
+ char name[PAXPATHLEN+1]; /* file name */
+ int ln_nlen; /* link name length */
+ char ln_name[PAXPATHLEN+1]; /* name to link to (if any) */
+ char *org_name; /* orig name in file system */
+ PATTERN *pat; /* ptr to pattern match (if any) */
+ struct stat sb; /* stat buffer see stat(2) */
+ off_t pad; /* bytes of padding after file xfer */
+ off_t skip; /* bytes of real data after header */
+ /* IMPORTANT. The st_size field does */
+ /* not always indicate the amount of */
+ /* data following the header. */
+ u_long crc; /* file crc */
+ int type; /* type of file node */
+#define PAX_DIR 1 /* directory */
+#define PAX_CHR 2 /* character device */
+#define PAX_BLK 3 /* block device */
+#define PAX_REG 4 /* regular file */
+#define PAX_SLK 5 /* symbolic link */
+#define PAX_SCK 6 /* socket */
+#define PAX_FIF 7 /* fifo */
+#define PAX_HLK 8 /* hard link */
+#define PAX_HRG 9 /* hard link to a regular file */
+#define PAX_CTG 10 /* high performance file */
+} ARCHD;
+
+/*
+ * Format Specific Options List
+ *
+ * Used to pass format options to the format options handler
+ */
+typedef struct oplist {
+ char *name; /* option variable name e.g. name= */
+ char *value; /* value for option variable */
+ struct oplist *fow; /* next option */
+} OPLIST;
+
+/*
+ * General Macros
+ */
+#ifndef MIN
+#define MIN(a,b) (((a)<(b))?(a):(b))
+#endif
+#define MAJOR(x) (((unsigned)(x) >> 8) & 0xff)
+#define MINOR(x) ((x) & 0xff)
+#define TODEV(x, y) (((unsigned)(x) << 8) | ((unsigned)(y)))
+
+/*
+ * General Defines
+ */
+#define HEX 16
+#define OCT 8
+#define _PAX_ 1
diff --git a/bin/pax/sel_subs.c b/bin/pax/sel_subs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fa7cb85
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/sel_subs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,657 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)sel_subs.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+#include <grp.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <strings.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "sel_subs.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static int str_sec __P((register char *, time_t *));
+static int usr_match __P((register ARCHD *));
+static int grp_match __P((register ARCHD *));
+static int trng_match __P((register ARCHD *));
+
+static TIME_RNG *trhead = NULL; /* time range list head */
+static TIME_RNG *trtail = NULL; /* time range list tail */
+static USRT **usrtb = NULL; /* user selection table */
+static GRPT **grptb = NULL; /* group selection table */
+
+/*
+ * Routines for selection of archive members
+ */
+
+/*
+ * sel_chk()
+ * check if this file matches a specfied uid, gid or time range
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if this archive member should be processed, 1 if it should be skipped
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+sel_chk(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+sel_chk(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ if (((usrtb != NULL) && usr_match(arcn)) ||
+ ((grptb != NULL) && grp_match(arcn)) ||
+ ((trhead != NULL) && trng_match(arcn)))
+ return(1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * User/group selection routines
+ *
+ * Routines to handle user selection of files based on the file uid/gid. To
+ * add an entry, the user supplies either then name or the uid/gid starting with
+ * a # on the command line. A \# will eascape the #.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * usr_add()
+ * add a user match to the user match hash table
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if added ok, -1 otherwise;
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+usr_add(register char *str)
+#else
+int
+usr_add(str)
+ register char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register u_int indx;
+ register USRT *pt;
+ register struct passwd *pw;
+ register uid_t uid;
+
+ /*
+ * create the table if it doesn't exist
+ */
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0'))
+ return(-1);
+ if ((usrtb == NULL) &&
+ ((usrtb = (USRT **)calloc(USR_TB_SZ, sizeof(USRT *))) == NULL)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for user selection table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * figure out user spec
+ */
+ if (str[0] != '#') {
+ /*
+ * it is a user name, \# escapes # as first char in user name
+ */
+ if ((str[0] == '\\') && (str[1] == '#'))
+ ++str;
+ if ((pw = getpwnam(str)) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to find uid for user: %s", str);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ uid = (uid_t)pw->pw_uid;
+ } else
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ uid = (uid_t)atoi(str+1);
+# else
+ uid = (uid_t)strtoul(str+1, (char **)NULL, 10);
+# endif
+ endpwent();
+
+ /*
+ * hash it and go down the hash chain (if any) looking for it
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)uid) % USR_TB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = usrtb[indx]) != NULL) {
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if (pt->uid == uid)
+ return(0);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * uid is not yet in the table, add it to the front of the chain
+ */
+ if ((pt = (USRT *)malloc(sizeof(USRT))) != NULL) {
+ pt->uid = uid;
+ pt->fow = usrtb[indx];
+ usrtb[indx] = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ warn(1, "User selection table out of memory");
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * usr_match()
+ * check if this files uid matches a selected uid.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if this archive member should be processed, 1 if it should be skipped
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+usr_match(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+usr_match(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register USRT *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * hash and look for it in the table
+ */
+ pt = usrtb[((unsigned)arcn->sb.st_uid) % USR_TB_SZ];
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if (pt->uid == arcn->sb.st_uid)
+ return(0);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * not found
+ */
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * grp_add()
+ * add a group match to the group match hash table
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if added ok, -1 otherwise;
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+grp_add(register char *str)
+#else
+int
+grp_add(str)
+ register char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register u_int indx;
+ register GRPT *pt;
+ register struct group *gr;
+ register gid_t gid;
+
+ /*
+ * create the table if it doesn't exist
+ */
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0'))
+ return(-1);
+ if ((grptb == NULL) &&
+ ((grptb = (GRPT **)calloc(GRP_TB_SZ, sizeof(GRPT *))) == NULL)) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory fo group selection table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * figure out user spec
+ */
+ if (str[0] != '#') {
+ /*
+ * it is a group name, \# escapes # as first char in group name
+ */
+ if ((str[0] == '\\') && (str[1] == '#'))
+ ++str;
+ if ((gr = getgrnam(str)) == NULL) {
+ warn(1,"Cannot determine gid for group name: %s", str);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ gid = (gid_t)gr->gr_gid;
+ } else
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ gid = (gid_t)atoi(str+1);
+# else
+ gid = (gid_t)strtoul(str+1, (char **)NULL, 10);
+# endif
+ endgrent();
+
+ /*
+ * hash it and go down the hash chain (if any) looking for it
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)gid) % GRP_TB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = grptb[indx]) != NULL) {
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if (pt->gid == gid)
+ return(0);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * gid not in the table, add it to the front of the chain
+ */
+ if ((pt = (GRPT *)malloc(sizeof(GRPT))) != NULL) {
+ pt->gid = gid;
+ pt->fow = grptb[indx];
+ grptb[indx] = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ warn(1, "Group selection table out of memory");
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * grp_match()
+ * check if this files gid matches a selected gid.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if this archive member should be processed, 1 if it should be skipped
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+grp_match(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+grp_match(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register GRPT *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * hash and look for it in the table
+ */
+ pt = grptb[((unsigned)arcn->sb.st_gid) % GRP_TB_SZ];
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if (pt->gid == arcn->sb.st_gid)
+ return(0);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * not found
+ */
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Time range selection routines
+ *
+ * Routines to handle user selection of files based on the modification and/or
+ * inode change time falling within a specified time range (the non-standard
+ * -T flag). The user may specify any number of different file time ranges.
+ * Time ranges are checked one at a time until a match is found (if at all).
+ * If the file has a mtime (and/or ctime) which lies within one of the time
+ * ranges, the file is selected. Time ranges may have a lower and/or a upper
+ * value. These ranges are inclusive. When no time ranges are supplied to pax
+ * with the -T option, all members in the archive will be selected by the time
+ * range routines. When only a lower range is supplied, only files with a
+ * mtime (and/or ctime) equal to or younger are selected. When only a upper
+ * range is supplied, only files with a mtime (and/or ctime) equal to or older
+ * are selected. When the lower time range is equal to the upper time range,
+ * only files with a mtime (or ctime) of exactly that time are selected.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * trng_add()
+ * add a time range match to the time range list.
+ * This is a non-standard pax option. Lower and upper ranges are in the
+ * format: [yy[mm[dd[hh]]]]mm[.ss] and are comma separated.
+ * Time ranges are based on current time, so 1234 would specify a time of
+ * 12:34 today.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if the time range was added to the list, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+trng_add(register char *str)
+#else
+int
+trng_add(str)
+ register char *str;
+#endif
+{
+ register TIME_RNG *pt;
+ register char *up_pt = NULL;
+ register char *stpt;
+ register char *flgpt;
+ register int dot = 0;
+
+ /*
+ * throw out the badly formed time ranges
+ */
+ if ((str == NULL) || (*str == '\0')) {
+ warn(1, "Empty time range string");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * locate optional flags suffix /{cm}.
+ */
+ if ((flgpt = rindex(str, '/')) != NULL)
+ *flgpt++ = '\0';
+
+ for (stpt = str; *stpt != '\0'; ++stpt) {
+ if ((*stpt >= '0') && (*stpt <= '9'))
+ continue;
+ if ((*stpt == ',') && (up_pt == NULL)) {
+ *stpt = '\0';
+ up_pt = stpt + 1;
+ dot = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * allow only one dot per range (secs)
+ */
+ if ((*stpt == '.') && (!dot)) {
+ ++dot;
+ continue;
+ }
+ warn(1, "Improperly specified time range: %s", str);
+ goto out;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * allocate space for the time range and store the limits
+ */
+ if ((pt = (TIME_RNG *)malloc(sizeof(TIME_RNG))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Unable to allocate memory for time range");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * by default we only will check file mtime, but usee can specify
+ * mtime, ctime (inode change time) or both.
+ */
+ if ((flgpt == NULL) || (*flgpt == '\0'))
+ pt->flgs = CMPMTME;
+ else {
+ pt->flgs = 0;
+ while (*flgpt != '\0') {
+ switch(*flgpt) {
+ case 'M':
+ case 'm':
+ pt->flgs |= CMPMTME;
+ break;
+ case 'C':
+ case 'c':
+ pt->flgs |= CMPCTME;
+ break;
+ default:
+ warn(1, "Bad option %c with time range %s",
+ *flgpt, str);
+ goto out;
+ }
+ ++flgpt;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * start off with the current time
+ */
+ pt->low_time = pt->high_time = time((time_t *)NULL);
+ if (*str != '\0') {
+ /*
+ * add lower limit
+ */
+ if (str_sec(str, &(pt->low_time)) < 0) {
+ warn(1, "Illegal lower time range %s", str);
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ goto out;
+ }
+ pt->flgs |= HASLOW;
+ }
+
+ if ((up_pt != NULL) && (*up_pt != '\0')) {
+ /*
+ * add upper limit
+ */
+ if (str_sec(up_pt, &(pt->high_time)) < 0) {
+ warn(1, "Illegal upper time range %s", up_pt);
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ goto out;
+ }
+ pt->flgs |= HASHIGH;
+
+ /*
+ * check that the upper and lower do not overlap
+ */
+ if (pt->flgs & HASLOW) {
+ if (pt->low_time > pt->high_time) {
+ warn(1, "Upper %s and lower %s time overlap",
+ up_pt, str);
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ pt->fow = NULL;
+ if (trhead == NULL) {
+ trtail = trhead = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ trtail->fow = pt;
+ trtail = pt;
+ return(0);
+
+ out:
+ warn(1, "Time range format is: [yy[mm[dd[hh]]]]mm[.ss][/[c][m]]");
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * trng_match()
+ * check if this files mtime/ctime falls within any supplied time range.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if this archive member should be processed, 1 if it should be skipped
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+trng_match(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+static int
+trng_match(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register TIME_RNG *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * have to search down the list one at a time looking for a match.
+ * remember time range limits are inclusive.
+ */
+ pt = trhead;
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ switch(pt->flgs & CMPBOTH) {
+ case CMPBOTH:
+ /*
+ * user wants both mtime and ctime checked for this
+ * time range
+ */
+ if (((pt->flgs & HASLOW) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_mtime < pt->low_time) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime < pt->low_time)) ||
+ ((pt->flgs & HASHIGH) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_mtime > pt->high_time) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime > pt->high_time))) {
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ continue;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CMPCTME:
+ /*
+ * user wants only ctime checked for this time range
+ */
+ if (((pt->flgs & HASLOW) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime < pt->low_time)) ||
+ ((pt->flgs & HASHIGH) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_ctime > pt->high_time))) {
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ continue;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CMPMTME:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * user wants only mtime checked for this time range
+ */
+ if (((pt->flgs & HASLOW) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_mtime < pt->low_time)) ||
+ ((pt->flgs & HASHIGH) &&
+ (arcn->sb.st_mtime > pt->high_time))) {
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ continue;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (pt == NULL)
+ return(1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * str_sec()
+ * Convert a time string in the format of [yy[mm[dd[hh]]]]mm[.ss] to gmt
+ * seconds. Tval already has current time loaded into it at entry.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if converted ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+str_sec(register char *str, time_t *tval)
+#else
+static int
+str_sec(str, tval)
+ register char *str;
+ time_t *tval;
+#endif
+{
+ register struct tm *lt;
+ register char *dot = NULL;
+
+ lt = localtime(tval);
+ if ((dot = index(str, '.')) != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * seconds (.ss)
+ */
+ *dot++ = '\0';
+ if (strlen(dot) != 2)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((lt->tm_sec = ATOI2(dot)) > 61)
+ return(-1);
+ } else
+ lt->tm_sec = 0;
+
+ switch (strlen(str)) {
+ case 10:
+ /*
+ * year (yy)
+ * watch out for year 2000
+ */
+ if ((lt->tm_year = ATOI2(str)) < 69)
+ lt->tm_year += 100;
+ str += 2;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 8:
+ /*
+ * month (mm)
+ * watch out months are from 0 - 11 internally
+ */
+ if ((lt->tm_mon = ATOI2(str)) > 12)
+ return(-1);
+ --lt->tm_mon;
+ str += 2;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 6:
+ /*
+ * day (dd)
+ */
+ if ((lt->tm_mday = ATOI2(str)) > 31)
+ return(-1);
+ str += 2;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 4:
+ /*
+ * hour (hh)
+ */
+ if ((lt->tm_hour = ATOI2(str)) > 23)
+ return(-1);
+ str += 2;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 2:
+ /*
+ * minute (mm)
+ */
+ if ((lt->tm_min = ATOI2(str)) > 59)
+ return(-1);
+ break;
+ default:
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ /*
+ * convert broken-down time to GMT clock time seconds
+ */
+ if ((*tval = mktime(lt)) == -1)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/sel_subs.h b/bin/pax/sel_subs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5040c73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/sel_subs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)sel_subs.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * data structure for storing uid/grp selects (-U, -G non standard options)
+ */
+
+#define USR_TB_SZ 317 /* user selection table size */
+#define GRP_TB_SZ 317 /* user selection table size */
+
+typedef struct usrt {
+ uid_t uid;
+ struct usrt *fow; /* next uid */
+} USRT;
+
+typedef struct grpt {
+ gid_t gid;
+ struct grpt *fow; /* next gid */
+} GRPT;
+
+/*
+ * data structure for storing user supplied time ranges (-T option)
+ */
+
+#define ATOI2(s) ((((s)[0] - '0') * 10) + ((s)[1] - '0'))
+
+typedef struct time_rng {
+ time_t low_time; /* lower inclusive time limit */
+ time_t high_time; /* higher inclusive time limit */
+ int flgs; /* option flags */
+#define HASLOW 0x01 /* has lower time limit */
+#define HASHIGH 0x02 /* has higher time limit */
+#define CMPMTME 0x04 /* compare file modification time */
+#define CMPCTME 0x08 /* compare inode change time */
+#define CMPBOTH (CMPMTME|CMPCTME) /* compare inode and mod time */
+ struct time_rng *fow; /* next pattern */
+} TIME_RNG;
diff --git a/bin/pax/tables.c b/bin/pax/tables.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3ac1c41
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/tables.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1426 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)tables.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "tables.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Routines for controlling the contents of all the different databases pax
+ * keeps. Tables are dynamically created only when they are needed. The
+ * goal was speed and the ability to work with HUGE archives. The databases
+ * were kept simple, but do have complex rules for when the contents change.
+ * As of this writing, the posix library functions were more complex than
+ * needed for this application (pax databases have very short lifetimes and
+ * do not survive after pax is finished). Pax is required to handle very
+ * large archives. These database routines carefully combine memory usage and
+ * temporary file storage in ways which will not significantly impact runtime
+ * performance while allowing the largest possible archives to be handled.
+ * Trying to force the fit to the posix databases routines was not considered
+ * time well spent.
+ */
+
+static HRDLNK **ltab = NULL; /* hard link table for detecting hard links */
+static FTM **ftab = NULL; /* file time table for updating arch */
+static NAMT **ntab = NULL; /* interactive rename storage table */
+static DEVT **dtab = NULL; /* device/inode mapping tables */
+static ATDIR **atab = NULL; /* file tree directory time reset table */
+static int dirfd = -1; /* storage for setting created dir time/mode */
+static u_long dircnt; /* entries in dir time/mode storage */
+static int ffd = -1; /* tmp file for file time table name storage */
+
+static DEVT *chk_dev __P((dev_t, int));
+
+/*
+ * hard link table routines
+ *
+ * The hard link table tries to detect hard links to files using the device and
+ * inode values. We do this when writing an archive, so we can tell the format
+ * write routine that this file is a hard link to another file. The format
+ * write routine then can store this file in whatever way it wants (as a hard
+ * link if the format supports that like tar, or ignore this info like cpio).
+ * (Actually a field in the format driver table tells us if the format wants
+ * hard link info. if not, we do not waste time looking for them). We also use
+ * the same table when reading an archive. In that situation, this table is
+ * used by the format read routine to detect hard links from stored dev and
+ * inode numbers (like cpio). This will allow pax to create a link when one
+ * can be detected by the archive format.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * lnk_start
+ * Creates the hard link table.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if created, -1 if failure
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+lnk_start(void)
+#else
+int
+lnk_start()
+#endif
+{
+ if (ltab != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if ((ltab = (HRDLNK **)calloc(L_TAB_SZ, sizeof(HRDLNK *))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot allocate memory for hard link table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * chk_lnk()
+ * Looks up entry in hard link hash table. If found, it copies the name
+ * of the file it is linked to (we already saw that file) into ln_name.
+ * lnkcnt is decremented and if goes to 1 the node is deleted from the
+ * database. (We have seen all the links to this file). If not found,
+ * we add the file to the database if it has the potential for having
+ * hard links to other files we may process (it has a link count > 1)
+ * Return:
+ * if found returns 1; if not found returns 0; -1 on error
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+chk_lnk(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+chk_lnk(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HRDLNK *pt;
+ register HRDLNK **ppt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (ltab == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ /*
+ * ignore those nodes that cannot have hard links
+ */
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_DIR) || (arcn->sb.st_nlink <= 1))
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * hash inode number and look for this file
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)arcn->sb.st_ino) % L_TAB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = ltab[indx]) != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * it's hash chain in not empty, walk down looking for it
+ */
+ ppt = &(ltab[indx]);
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->ino == arcn->sb.st_ino) &&
+ (pt->dev == arcn->sb.st_dev))
+ break;
+ ppt = &(pt->fow);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ if (pt != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * found a link. set the node type and copy in the
+ * name of the file it is to link to. we need to
+ * handle hardlinks to regular files differently than
+ * other links.
+ */
+ arcn->ln_nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->ln_name, pt->name,
+ PAXPATHLEN+1);
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_REG)
+ arcn->type = PAX_HRG;
+ else
+ arcn->type = PAX_HLK;
+
+ /*
+ * if we have found all the links to this file, remove
+ * it from the database
+ */
+ if (--pt->nlink <= 1) {
+ *ppt = pt->fow;
+ (void)free((char *)pt->name);
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ }
+ return(1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we never saw this file before. It has links so we add it to the
+ * front of this hash chain
+ */
+ if ((pt = (HRDLNK *)malloc(sizeof(HRDLNK))) != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->name = strdup(arcn->name)) != NULL) {
+ pt->dev = arcn->sb.st_dev;
+ pt->ino = arcn->sb.st_ino;
+ pt->nlink = arcn->sb.st_nlink;
+ pt->fow = ltab[indx];
+ ltab[indx] = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ }
+
+ warn(1, "Hard link table out of memory");
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * purg_lnk
+ * remove reference for a file that we may have added to the data base as
+ * a potential source for hard links. We ended up not using the file, so
+ * we do not want to accidently point another file at it later on.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+purg_lnk(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+void
+purg_lnk(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HRDLNK *pt;
+ register HRDLNK **ppt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (ltab == NULL)
+ return;
+ /*
+ * do not bother to look if it could not be in the database
+ */
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_nlink <= 1) || (arcn->type == PAX_DIR) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HRG))
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * find the hash chain for this inode value, if empty return
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)arcn->sb.st_ino) % L_TAB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = ltab[indx]) == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * walk down the list looking for the inode/dev pair, unlink and
+ * free if found
+ */
+ ppt = &(ltab[indx]);
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->ino == arcn->sb.st_ino) &&
+ (pt->dev == arcn->sb.st_dev))
+ break;
+ ppt = &(pt->fow);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+ if (pt == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * remove and free it
+ */
+ *ppt = pt->fow;
+ (void)free((char *)pt->name);
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+}
+
+/*
+ * lnk_end()
+ * pull apart a existing link table so we can reuse it. We do this between
+ * read and write phases of append with update. (The format may have
+ * used the link table, and we need to start with a fresh table for the
+ * write phase
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+lnk_end(void)
+#else
+void
+lnk_end()
+#endif
+{
+ register int i;
+ register HRDLNK *pt;
+ register HRDLNK *ppt;
+
+ if (ltab == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < L_TAB_SZ; ++i) {
+ if (ltab[i] == NULL)
+ continue;
+ pt = ltab[i];
+ ltab[i] = NULL;
+
+ /*
+ * free up each entry on this chain
+ */
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ ppt = pt;
+ pt = ppt->fow;
+ (void)free((char *)ppt->name);
+ (void)free((char *)ppt);
+ }
+ }
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * modification time table routines
+ *
+ * The modification time table keeps track of last modification times for all
+ * files stored in an archive during a write phase when -u is set. We only
+ * add a file to the archive if it is newer than a file with the same name
+ * already stored on the archive (if there is no other file with the same
+ * name on the archive it is added). This applies to writes and appends.
+ * An append with an -u must read the archive and store the modification time
+ * for every file on that archive before starting the write phase. It is clear
+ * that this is one HUGE database. To save memory space, the actual file names
+ * are stored in a scatch file and indexed by an in memory hash table. The
+ * hash table is indexed by hashing the file path. The nodes in the table store
+ * the length of the filename and the lseek offset within the scratch file
+ * where the actual name is stored. Since there are never any deletions to this
+ * table, fragmentation of the scratch file is never a issue. Lookups seem to
+ * not exhibit any locality at all (files in the database are rarely
+ * looked up more than once...). So caching is just a waste of memory. The
+ * only limitation is the amount of scatch file space available to store the
+ * path names.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * ftime_start()
+ * create the file time hash table and open for read/write the scratch
+ * file. (after created it is unlinked, so when we exit we leave
+ * no witnesses).
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if the table and file was created ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ftime_start(void)
+#else
+int
+ftime_start()
+#endif
+{
+ char *pt;
+
+ if (ftab != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if ((ftab = (FTM **)calloc(F_TAB_SZ, sizeof(FTM *))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot allocate memory for file time table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * get random name and create temporary scratch file, unlink name
+ * so it will get removed on exit
+ */
+ if ((pt = tempnam((char *)NULL, (char *)NULL)) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ (void)unlink(pt);
+
+ if ((ffd = open(pt, O_RDWR | O_CREAT, S_IRWXU)) < 0) {
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Unable to open temporary file: %s", pt);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ (void)unlink(pt);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * chk_ftime()
+ * looks up entry in file time hash table. If not found, the file is
+ * added to the hash table and the file named stored in the scratch file.
+ * If a file with the same name is found, the file times are compared and
+ * the most recent file time is retained. If the new file was younger (or
+ * was not in the database) the new file is selected for storage.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if file should be added to the archive, 1 if it should be skipped,
+ * -1 on error
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+chk_ftime(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+chk_ftime(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register FTM *pt;
+ register int namelen;
+ register u_int indx;
+ char ckname[PAXPATHLEN+1];
+
+ /*
+ * no info, go ahead and add to archive
+ */
+ if (ftab == NULL)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * hash the pathname and look up in table
+ */
+ namelen = arcn->nlen;
+ indx = st_hash(arcn->name, namelen, F_TAB_SZ);
+ if ((pt = ftab[indx]) != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * the hash chain is not empty, walk down looking for match
+ * only read up the path names if the lengths match, speeds
+ * up the search a lot
+ */
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if (pt->namelen == namelen) {
+ /*
+ * potential match, have to read the name
+ * from the scratch file.
+ */
+ if (lseek(ffd,pt->seek,SEEK_SET) != pt->seek) {
+ syswarn(1, errno,
+ "Failed ftime table seek");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ if (read(ffd, ckname, namelen) != namelen) {
+ syswarn(1, errno,
+ "Failed ftime table read");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if the names match, we are done
+ */
+ if (!strncmp(ckname, arcn->name, namelen))
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * try the next entry on the chain
+ */
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ if (pt != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * found the file, compare the times, save the newer
+ */
+ if (arcn->sb.st_mtime > pt->mtime) {
+ /*
+ * file is newer
+ */
+ pt->mtime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ /*
+ * file is older
+ */
+ return(1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * not in table, add it
+ */
+ if ((pt = (FTM *)malloc(sizeof(FTM))) != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * add the name at the end of the scratch file, saving the
+ * offset. add the file to the head of the hash chain
+ */
+ if ((pt->seek = lseek(ffd, (off_t)0, SEEK_END)) >= 0) {
+ if (write(ffd, arcn->name, namelen) == namelen) {
+ pt->mtime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+ pt->namelen = namelen;
+ pt->fow = ftab[indx];
+ ftab[indx] = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed write to file time table");
+ } else
+ syswarn(1, errno, "Failed seek on file time table");
+ } else
+ warn(1, "File time table ran out of memory");
+
+ if (pt != NULL)
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Interactive rename table routines
+ *
+ * The interactive rename table keeps track of the new names that the user
+ * assignes to files from tty input. Since this map is unique for each file
+ * we must store it in case there is a reference to the file later in archive
+ * (a link). Otherwise we will be unable to find the file we know was
+ * extracted. The remapping of these files is stored in a memory based hash
+ * table (it is assumed since input must come from /dev/tty, it is unlikely to
+ * be a very large table).
+ */
+
+/*
+ * name_start()
+ * create the interactive rename table
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if successful, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+name_start(void)
+#else
+int
+name_start()
+#endif
+{
+ if (ntab != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if ((ntab = (NAMT **)calloc(N_TAB_SZ, sizeof(NAMT *))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot allocate memory for interactive rename table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * add_name()
+ * add the new name to old name mapping just created by the user.
+ * If an old name mapping is found (there may be duplicate names on an
+ * archive) only the most recent is kept.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if added, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+add_name(register char *oname, int onamelen, char *nname)
+#else
+int
+add_name(oname, onamelen, nname)
+ register char *oname;
+ int onamelen;
+ char *nname;
+#endif
+{
+ register NAMT *pt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (ntab == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * should never happen
+ */
+ warn(0, "No interactive rename table, links may fail\n");
+ return(0);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * look to see if we have already mapped this file, if so we
+ * will update it
+ */
+ indx = st_hash(oname, onamelen, N_TAB_SZ);
+ if ((pt = ntab[indx]) != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * look down the has chain for the file
+ */
+ while ((pt != NULL) && (strcmp(oname, pt->oname) != 0))
+ pt = pt->fow;
+
+ if (pt != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * found an old mapping, replace it with the new one
+ * the user just input (if it is different)
+ */
+ if (strcmp(nname, pt->nname) == 0)
+ return(0);
+
+ (void)free((char *)pt->nname);
+ if ((pt->nname = strdup(nname)) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot update rename table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * this is a new mapping, add it to the table
+ */
+ if ((pt = (NAMT *)malloc(sizeof(NAMT))) != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->oname = strdup(oname)) != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->nname = strdup(nname)) != NULL) {
+ pt->fow = ntab[indx];
+ ntab[indx] = pt;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ (void)free((char *)pt->oname);
+ }
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ }
+ warn(1, "Interactive rename table out of memory");
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * sub_name()
+ * look up a link name to see if it points at a file that has been
+ * remapped by the user. If found, the link is adjusted to contain the
+ * new name (oname is the link to name)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+sub_name(register char *oname, int *onamelen)
+#else
+void
+sub_name(oname, onamelen)
+ register char *oname;
+ int *onamelen;
+#endif
+{
+ register NAMT *pt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (ntab == NULL)
+ return;
+ /*
+ * look the name up in the hash table
+ */
+ indx = st_hash(oname, *onamelen, N_TAB_SZ);
+ if ((pt = ntab[indx]) == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * walk down the hash cahin looking for a match
+ */
+ if (strcmp(oname, pt->oname) == 0) {
+ /*
+ * found it, replace it with the new name
+ * and return (we know that oname has enough space)
+ */
+ *onamelen = l_strncpy(oname, pt->nname, PAXPATHLEN+1);
+ return;
+ }
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * no match, just return
+ */
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * device/inode mapping table routines
+ * (used with formats that store device and inodes fields)
+ *
+ * device/inode mapping tables remap the device field in a archive header. The
+ * device/inode fields are used to determine when files are hard links to each
+ * other. However these values have very little meaning outside of that. This
+ * database is used to solve one of two different problems.
+ *
+ * 1) when files are appended to an archive, while the new files may have hard
+ * links to each other, you cannot determine if they have hard links to any
+ * file already stored on the archive from a prior run of pax. We must assume
+ * that these inode/device pairs are unique only within a SINGLE run of pax
+ * (which adds a set of files to an archive). So we have to make sure the
+ * inode/dev pairs we add each time are always unique. We do this by observing
+ * while the inode field is very dense, the use of the dev field is fairly
+ * sparse. Within each run of pax, we remap any device number of a new archive
+ * member that has a device number used in a prior run and already stored in a
+ * file on the archive. During the read phase of the append, we store the
+ * device numbers used and mark them to not be used by any file during the
+ * write phase. If during write we go to use one of those old device numbers,
+ * we remap it to a new value.
+ *
+ * 2) Often the fields in the archive header used to store these values are
+ * too small to store the entire value. The result is an inode or device value
+ * which can be truncated. This really can foul up an archive. With truncation
+ * we end up creating links between files that are really not links (after
+ * truncation the inodes are the same value). We address that by detecting
+ * truncation and forcing a remap of the device field to split truncated
+ * inodes away from each other. Each truncation creates a pattern of bits that
+ * are removed. We use this pattern of truncated bits to partition the inodes
+ * on a single device to many different devices (each one represented by the
+ * truncated bit pattern). All inodes on the same device that have the same
+ * truncation pattern are mapped to the same new device. Two inodes that
+ * truncate to the same value clearly will always have different truncation
+ * bit patterns, so they will be split from away each other. When we spot
+ * device truncation we remap the device number to a non truncated value.
+ * (for more info see table.h for the data structures involved).
+ */
+
+/*
+ * dev_start()
+ * create the device mapping table
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if successful, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+dev_start(void)
+#else
+int
+dev_start()
+#endif
+{
+ if (dtab != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if ((dtab = (DEVT **)calloc(D_TAB_SZ, sizeof(DEVT *))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Cannot allocate memory for device mapping table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * add_dev()
+ * add a device number to the table. this will force the device to be
+ * remapped to a new value if it be used during a write phase. This
+ * function is called during the read phase of an append to prohibit the
+ * use of any device number already in the archive.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if added ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+add_dev(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+add_dev(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ if (chk_dev(arcn->sb.st_dev, 1) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * chk_dev()
+ * check for a device value in the device table. If not found and the add
+ * flag is set, it is added. This does NOT assign any mapping values, just
+ * adds the device number as one that need to be remapped. If this device
+ * is alread mapped, just return with a pointer to that entry.
+ * Return:
+ * pointer to the entry for this device in the device map table. Null
+ * if the add flag is not set and the device is not in the table (it is
+ * not been seen yet). If add is set and the device cannot be added, null
+ * is returned (indicates an error).
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static DEVT *
+chk_dev(dev_t dev, int add)
+#else
+static DEVT *
+chk_dev(dev, add)
+ dev_t dev;
+ int add;
+#endif
+{
+ register DEVT *pt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (dtab == NULL)
+ return(NULL);
+ /*
+ * look to see if this device is already in the table
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)dev) % D_TAB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = dtab[indx]) != NULL) {
+ while ((pt != NULL) && (pt->dev != dev))
+ pt = pt->fow;
+
+ /*
+ * found it, return a pointer to it
+ */
+ if (pt != NULL)
+ return(pt);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * not in table, we add it only if told to as this may just be a check
+ * to see if a device number is being used.
+ */
+ if (add == 0)
+ return(NULL);
+
+ /*
+ * allocate a node for this device and add it to the front of the hash
+ * chain. Note we do not assign remaps values here, so the pt->list
+ * list must be NULL.
+ */
+ if ((pt = (DEVT *)malloc(sizeof(DEVT))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "Device map table out of memory");
+ return(NULL);
+ }
+ pt->dev = dev;
+ pt->list = NULL;
+ pt->fow = dtab[indx];
+ dtab[indx] = pt;
+ return(pt);
+}
+/*
+ * map_dev()
+ * given an inode and device storage mask (the mask has a 1 for each bit
+ * the archive format is able to store in a header), we check for inode
+ * and device truncation and remap the device as required. Device mapping
+ * can also occur when during the read phase of append a device number was
+ * seen (and was marked as do not use during the write phase). WE ASSUME
+ * that unsigned longs are the same size or bigger than the fields used
+ * for ino_t and dev_t. If not the types will have to be changed.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if all ok, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+map_dev(register ARCHD *arcn, u_long dev_mask, u_long ino_mask)
+#else
+int
+map_dev(arcn, dev_mask, ino_mask)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ u_long dev_mask;
+ u_long ino_mask;
+#endif
+{
+ register DEVT *pt;
+ register DLIST *dpt;
+ static dev_t lastdev = 0; /* next device number to try */
+ int trc_ino = 0;
+ int trc_dev = 0;
+ ino_t trunc_bits = 0;
+ ino_t nino;
+
+ if (dtab == NULL)
+ return(0);
+ /*
+ * check for device and inode truncation, and extract the truncated
+ * bit pattern.
+ */
+ if ((arcn->sb.st_dev & (dev_t)dev_mask) != arcn->sb.st_dev)
+ ++trc_dev;
+ if ((nino = arcn->sb.st_ino & (ino_t)ino_mask) != arcn->sb.st_ino) {
+ ++trc_ino;
+ trunc_bits = arcn->sb.st_ino & (ino_t)(~ino_mask);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * see if this device is already being mapped, look up the device
+ * then find the truncation bit pattern which applies
+ */
+ if ((pt = chk_dev(arcn->sb.st_dev, 0)) != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * this device is already marked to be remapped
+ */
+ for (dpt = pt->list; dpt != NULL; dpt = dpt->fow)
+ if (dpt->trunc_bits == trunc_bits)
+ break;
+
+ if (dpt != NULL) {
+ /*
+ * we are being remapped for this device and pattern
+ * change the device number to be stored and return
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_dev = dpt->dev;
+ arcn->sb.st_ino = nino;
+ return(0);
+ }
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * this device is not being remapped YET. if we do not have any
+ * form of truncation, we do not need a remap
+ */
+ if (!trc_ino && !trc_dev)
+ return(0);
+
+ /*
+ * we have truncation, have to add this as a device to remap
+ */
+ if ((pt = chk_dev(arcn->sb.st_dev, 1)) == NULL)
+ goto bad;
+
+ /*
+ * if we just have a truncated inode, we have to make sure that
+ * all future inodes that do not truncate (they have the
+ * truncation pattern of all 0's) continue to map to the same
+ * device number. We probably have already written inodes with
+ * this device number to the archive with the truncation
+ * pattern of all 0's. So we add the mapping for all 0's to the
+ * same device number.
+ */
+ if (!trc_dev && (trunc_bits != 0)) {
+ if ((dpt = (DLIST *)malloc(sizeof(DLIST))) == NULL)
+ goto bad;
+ dpt->trunc_bits = 0;
+ dpt->dev = arcn->sb.st_dev;
+ dpt->fow = pt->list;
+ pt->list = dpt;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * look for a device number not being used. We must watch for wrap
+ * around on lastdev (so we do not get stuck looking forever!)
+ */
+ while (++lastdev > 0) {
+ if (chk_dev(lastdev, 0) != NULL)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * found an unused value. If we have reached truncation point
+ * for this format we are hosed, so we give up. Otherwise we
+ * mark it as being used.
+ */
+ if (((lastdev & ((dev_t)dev_mask)) != lastdev) ||
+ (chk_dev(lastdev, 1) == NULL))
+ goto bad;
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if ((lastdev <= 0) || ((dpt = (DLIST *)malloc(sizeof(DLIST))) == NULL))
+ goto bad;
+
+ /*
+ * got a new device number, store it under this truncation pattern.
+ * change the device number this file is being stored with.
+ */
+ dpt->trunc_bits = trunc_bits;
+ dpt->dev = lastdev;
+ dpt->fow = pt->list;
+ pt->list = dpt;
+ arcn->sb.st_dev = lastdev;
+ arcn->sb.st_ino = nino;
+ return(0);
+
+ bad:
+ warn(1, "Unable to fix truncated inode/device field when storing %s",
+ arcn->name);
+ warn(0, "Archive may create improper hard links when extracted");
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * directory access/mod time reset table routines (for directories READ by pax)
+ *
+ * The pax -t flag requires that access times of archive files to be the same
+ * before being read by pax. For regular files, access time is restored after
+ * the file has been copied. This database provides the same functionality for
+ * directories read during file tree traversal. Restoring directory access time
+ * is more complex than files since directories may be read several times until
+ * all the descendants in their subtree are visited by fts. Directory access
+ * and modification times are stored during the fts pre-order visit (done
+ * before any descendants in the subtree is visited) and restored after the
+ * fts post-order visit (after all the descendants have been visited). In the
+ * case of premature exit from a subtree (like from the effects of -n), any
+ * directory entries left in this database are reset during final cleanup
+ * operations of pax. Entries are hashed by inode number for fast lookup.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * atdir_start()
+ * create the directory access time database for directories READ by pax.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 is created ok, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+atdir_start(void)
+#else
+int
+atdir_start()
+#endif
+{
+ if (atab != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ if ((atab = (ATDIR **)calloc(A_TAB_SZ, sizeof(ATDIR *))) == NULL) {
+ warn(1,"Cannot allocate space for directory access time table");
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * atdir_end()
+ * walk through the directory access time table and reset the access time
+ * of any directory who still has an entry left in the database. These
+ * entries are for directories READ by pax
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+atdir_end(void)
+#else
+void
+atdir_end()
+#endif
+{
+ register ATDIR *pt;
+ register int i;
+
+ if (atab == NULL)
+ return;
+ /*
+ * for each non-empty hash table entry reset all the directories
+ * chained there.
+ */
+ for (i = 0; i < A_TAB_SZ; ++i) {
+ if ((pt = atab[i]) == NULL)
+ continue;
+ /*
+ * remember to force the times, set_ftime() looks at pmtime
+ * and patime, which only applies to things CREATED by pax,
+ * not read by pax. Read time reset is controlled by -t.
+ */
+ for (; pt != NULL; pt = pt->fow)
+ set_ftime(pt->name, pt->mtime, pt->atime, 1);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * add_atdir()
+ * add a directory to the directory access time table. Table is hashed
+ * and chained by inode number. This is for directories READ by pax
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+add_atdir(char *fname, dev_t dev, ino_t ino, time_t mtime, time_t atime)
+#else
+void
+add_atdir(fname, dev, ino, mtime, atime)
+ char *fname;
+ dev_t dev;
+ ino_t ino;
+ time_t mtime;
+ time_t atime;
+#endif
+{
+ register ATDIR *pt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (atab == NULL)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * make sure this directory is not already in the table, if so just
+ * return (the older entry always has the correct time). The only
+ * way this will happen is when the same subtree can be traversed by
+ * different args to pax and the -n option is aborting fts out of a
+ * subtree before all the post-order visits have been made).
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)ino) % A_TAB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = atab[indx]) != NULL) {
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->ino == ino) && (pt->dev == dev))
+ break;
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * oops, already there. Leave it alone.
+ */
+ if (pt != NULL)
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * add it to the front of the hash chain
+ */
+ if ((pt = (ATDIR *)malloc(sizeof(ATDIR))) != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->name = strdup(fname)) != NULL) {
+ pt->dev = dev;
+ pt->ino = ino;
+ pt->mtime = mtime;
+ pt->atime = atime;
+ pt->fow = atab[indx];
+ atab[indx] = pt;
+ return;
+ }
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ }
+
+ warn(1, "Directory access time reset table ran out of memory");
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * get_atdir()
+ * look up a directory by inode and device number to obtain the access
+ * and modification time you want to set to. If found, the modification
+ * and access time parameters are set and the entry is removed from the
+ * table (as it is no longer needed). These are for directories READ by
+ * pax
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if found, -1 if not found.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+get_atdir(dev_t dev, ino_t ino, time_t *mtime, time_t *atime)
+#else
+int
+get_atdir(dev, ino, mtime, atime)
+ dev_t dev;
+ ino_t ino;
+ time_t *mtime;
+ time_t *atime;
+#endif
+{
+ register ATDIR *pt;
+ register ATDIR **ppt;
+ register u_int indx;
+
+ if (atab == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+ /*
+ * hash by inode and search the chain for an inode and device match
+ */
+ indx = ((unsigned)ino) % A_TAB_SZ;
+ if ((pt = atab[indx]) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+
+ ppt = &(atab[indx]);
+ while (pt != NULL) {
+ if ((pt->ino == ino) && (pt->dev == dev))
+ break;
+ /*
+ * no match, go to next one
+ */
+ ppt = &(pt->fow);
+ pt = pt->fow;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * return if we did not find it.
+ */
+ if (pt == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * found it. return the times and remove the entry from the table.
+ */
+ *ppt = pt->fow;
+ *mtime = pt->mtime;
+ *atime = pt->atime;
+ (void)free((char *)pt->name);
+ (void)free((char *)pt);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * directory access mode and time storage routines (for directories CREATED
+ * by pax).
+ *
+ * Pax requires that extracted directories, by default, have their access/mod
+ * times and permissions set to the values specified in the archive. During the
+ * actions of extracting (and creating the destination subtree during -rw copy)
+ * directories extracted may be modified after being created. Even worse is
+ * that these directories may have been created with file permissions which
+ * prohibits any descendants of these directories from being extracted. When
+ * directories are created by pax, access rights may be added to permit the
+ * creation of files in their subtree. Every time pax creates a directory, the
+ * times and file permissions specified by the archive are stored. After all
+ * files have been extracted (or copied), these directories have their times
+ * and file modes reset to the stored values. The directory info is restored in
+ * reverse order as entries were added to the data file from root to leaf. To
+ * restore atime properly, we must go backwards. The data file consists of
+ * records with two parts, the file name followed by a DIRDATA trailer. The
+ * fixed sized trailer contains the size of the name plus the off_t location in
+ * the file. To restore we work backwards through the file reading the trailer
+ * then the file name.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * dir_start()
+ * set up the directory time and file mode storage for directories CREATED
+ * by pax.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+dir_start(void)
+#else
+int
+dir_start()
+#endif
+{
+ char *pt;
+
+ if (dirfd != -1)
+ return(0);
+ if ((pt = tempnam((char *)NULL, (char *)NULL)) == NULL)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * unlink the file so it goes away at termination by itself
+ */
+ (void)unlink(pt);
+ if ((dirfd = open(pt, O_RDWR|O_CREAT, 0600)) >= 0) {
+ (void)unlink(pt);
+ return(0);
+ }
+ warn(1, "Unable to create temporary file for directory times: %s", pt);
+ return(-1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * add_dir()
+ * add the mode and times for a newly CREATED directory
+ * name is name of the directory, psb the stat buffer with the data in it,
+ * frc_mode is a flag that says whether to force the setting of the mode
+ * (ignoring the user set values for preserving file mode). Frc_mode is
+ * for the case where we created a file and found that the resulting
+ * directory was not writeable and the user asked for file modes to NOT
+ * be preserved. (we have to preserve what was created by default, so we
+ * have to force the setting at the end. this is stated explicitly in the
+ * pax spec)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+add_dir(char *name, int nlen, struct stat *psb, int frc_mode)
+#else
+void
+add_dir(name, nlen, psb, frc_mode)
+ char *name;
+ int nlen;
+ struct stat *psb;
+ int frc_mode;
+#endif
+{
+ DIRDATA dblk;
+
+ if (dirfd < 0)
+ return;
+
+ /*
+ * get current position (where file name will start) so we can store it
+ * in the trailer
+ */
+ if ((dblk.npos = lseek(dirfd, 0L, SEEK_CUR)) < 0) {
+ warn(1,"Unable to store mode and times for directory: %s",name);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * write the file name followed by the trailer
+ */
+ dblk.nlen = nlen + 1;
+ dblk.mode = psb->st_mode & 0xffff;
+ dblk.mtime = psb->st_mtime;
+ dblk.atime = psb->st_atime;
+ dblk.frc_mode = frc_mode;
+ if ((write(dirfd, name, dblk.nlen) == dblk.nlen) &&
+ (write(dirfd, (char *)&dblk, sizeof(dblk)) == sizeof(dblk))) {
+ ++dircnt;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ warn(1,"Unable to store mode and times for created directory: %s",name);
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * proc_dir()
+ * process all file modes and times stored for directories CREATED
+ * by pax
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+proc_dir(void)
+#else
+void
+proc_dir()
+#endif
+{
+ char name[PAXPATHLEN+1];
+ DIRDATA dblk;
+ u_long cnt;
+
+ if (dirfd < 0)
+ return;
+ /*
+ * read backwards through the file and process each directory
+ */
+ for (cnt = 0; cnt < dircnt; ++cnt) {
+ /*
+ * read the trailer, then the file name, if this fails
+ * just give up.
+ */
+ if (lseek(dirfd, -((off_t)sizeof(dblk)), SEEK_CUR) < 0)
+ break;
+ if (read(dirfd,(char *)&dblk, sizeof(dblk)) != sizeof(dblk))
+ break;
+ if (lseek(dirfd, dblk.npos, SEEK_SET) < 0)
+ break;
+ if (read(dirfd, name, dblk.nlen) != dblk.nlen)
+ break;
+ if (lseek(dirfd, dblk.npos, SEEK_SET) < 0)
+ break;
+
+ /*
+ * frc_mode set, make sure we set the file modes even if
+ * the user didn't ask for it (see file_subs.c for more info)
+ */
+ if (pmode || dblk.frc_mode)
+ set_pmode(name, dblk.mode);
+ if (patime || pmtime)
+ set_ftime(name, dblk.mtime, dblk.atime, 0);
+ }
+
+ (void)close(dirfd);
+ dirfd = -1;
+ if (cnt != dircnt)
+ warn(1,"Unable to set mode and times for created directories");
+ return;
+}
+
+/*
+ * database independent routines
+ */
+
+/*
+ * st_hash()
+ * hashes filenames to a u_int for hashing into a table. Looks at the tail
+ * end of file, as this provides far better distribution than any other
+ * part of the name. For performance reasons we only care about the last
+ * MAXKEYLEN chars (should be at LEAST large enough to pick off the file
+ * name). Was tested on 500,000 name file tree traversal from the root
+ * and gave almost a perfectly uniform distribution of keys when used with
+ * prime sized tables (MAXKEYLEN was 128 in test). Hashes (sizeof int)
+ * chars at a time and pads with 0 for last addition.
+ * Return:
+ * the hash value of the string MOD (%) the table size.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+u_int
+st_hash(char *name, int len, int tabsz)
+#else
+u_int
+st_hash(name, len, tabsz)
+ char *name;
+ int len;
+ int tabsz;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+ register char *dest;
+ register char *end;
+ register int i;
+ register u_int key = 0;
+ register int steps;
+ register int res;
+ u_int val;
+
+ /*
+ * only look at the tail up to MAXKEYLEN, we do not need to waste
+ * time here (remember these are pathnames, the tail is what will
+ * spread out the keys)
+ */
+ if (len > MAXKEYLEN) {
+ pt = &(name[len - MAXKEYLEN]);
+ len = MAXKEYLEN;
+ } else
+ pt = name;
+
+ /*
+ * calculate the number of u_int size steps in the string and if
+ * there is a runt to deal with
+ */
+ steps = len/sizeof(u_int);
+ res = len % sizeof(u_int);
+
+ /*
+ * add up the value of the string in unsigned integer sized pieces
+ * too bad we cannot have unsigned int aligned strings, then we
+ * could avoid the expensive copy.
+ */
+ for (i = 0; i < steps; ++i) {
+ end = pt + sizeof(u_int);
+ dest = (char *)&val;
+ while (pt < end)
+ *dest++ = *pt++;
+ key += val;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * add in the runt padded with zero to the right
+ */
+ if (res) {
+ val = 0;
+ end = pt + res;
+ dest = (char *)&val;
+ while (pt < end)
+ *dest++ = *pt++;
+ key += val;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * return the result mod the table size
+ */
+ return(key % tabsz);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/tables.h b/bin/pax/tables.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a992613
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/tables.h
@@ -0,0 +1,172 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)tables.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * data structures and constants used by the different databases kept by pax
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Hash Table Sizes MUST BE PRIME, if set too small performance suffers.
+ * Probably safe to expect 500000 inodes per tape. Assuming good key
+ * distribution (inodes) chains of under 50 long (worse case) is ok.
+ */
+#define L_TAB_SZ 2503 /* hard link hash table size */
+#define F_TAB_SZ 50503 /* file time hash table size */
+#define N_TAB_SZ 541 /* interactive rename hash table */
+#define D_TAB_SZ 317 /* unique device mapping table */
+#define A_TAB_SZ 317 /* ftree dir access time reset table */
+#define MAXKEYLEN 64 /* max number of chars for hash */
+
+/*
+ * file hard link structure (hashed by dev/ino and chained) used to find the
+ * hard links in a file system or with some archive formats (cpio)
+ */
+typedef struct hrdlnk {
+ char *name; /* name of first file seen with this ino/dev */
+ dev_t dev; /* files device number */
+ ino_t ino; /* files inode number */
+ u_long nlink; /* expected link count */
+ struct hrdlnk *fow;
+} HRDLNK;
+
+/*
+ * Archive write update file time table (the -u, -C flag), hashed by filename.
+ * Filenames are stored in a scratch file at seek offset into the file. The
+ * file time (mod time) and the file name length (for a quick check) are
+ * stored in a hash table node. We were forced to use a scratch file because
+ * with -u, the mtime for every node in the archive must always be available
+ * to compare against (and this data can get REALLY large with big archives).
+ * By being careful to read only when we have a good chance of a match, the
+ * performance loss is not measurable (and the size of the archive we can
+ * handle is greatly increased).
+ */
+typedef struct ftm {
+ int namelen; /* file name length */
+ time_t mtime; /* files last modification time */
+ off_t seek; /* loacation in scratch file */
+ struct ftm *fow;
+} FTM;
+
+/*
+ * Interactive rename table (-i flag), hashed by orig filename.
+ * We assume this will not be a large table as this mapping data can only be
+ * obtained through interactive input by the user. Nobody is going to type in
+ * changes for 500000 files? We use chaining to resolve collisions.
+ */
+
+typedef struct namt {
+ char *oname; /* old name */
+ char *nname; /* new name typed in by the user */
+ struct namt *fow;
+} NAMT;
+
+/*
+ * Unique device mapping tables. Some protocols (e.g. cpio) require that the
+ * <c_dev,c_ino> pair will uniquely identify a file in an archive unless they
+ * are links to the same file. Appending to archives can break this. For those
+ * protocols that have this requirement we map c_dev to a unique value not seen
+ * in the archive when we append. We also try to handle inode truncation with
+ * this table. (When the inode field in the archive header are too small, we
+ * remap the dev on writes to remove accidental collisions).
+ *
+ * The list is hashed by device number using chain collision resolution. Off of
+ * each DEVT are linked the various remaps for this device based on those bits
+ * in the inode which were truncated. For example if we are just remapping to
+ * avoid a device number during an update append, off the DEVT we would have
+ * only a single DLIST that has a truncation id of 0 (no inode bits were
+ * stripped for this device so far). When we spot inode truncation we create
+ * a new mapping based on the set of bits in the inode which were stripped off.
+ * so if the top four bits of the inode are stripped and they have a pattern of
+ * 0110...... (where . are those bits not truncated) we would have a mapping
+ * assigned for all inodes that has the same 0110.... pattern (with this dev
+ * number of course). This keeps the mapping sparse and should be able to store
+ * close to the limit of files which can be represented by the optimal
+ * combination of dev and inode bits, and without creating a fouled up archive.
+ * Note we also remap truncated devs in the same way (an exercise for the
+ * dedicated reader; always wanted to say that...:)
+ */
+
+typedef struct devt {
+ dev_t dev; /* the orig device number we now have to map */
+ struct devt *fow; /* new device map list */
+ struct dlist *list; /* map list based on inode truncation bits */
+} DEVT;
+
+typedef struct dlist {
+ ino_t trunc_bits; /* truncation pattern for a specific map */
+ dev_t dev; /* the new device id we use */
+ struct dlist *fow;
+} DLIST;
+
+/*
+ * ftree directory access time reset table. When we are done with with a
+ * subtree we reset the access and mod time of the directory when the tflag is
+ * set. Not really explicitly specified in the pax spec, but easy and fast to
+ * do (and this may have even been intended in the spec, it is not clear).
+ * table is hashed by inode with chaining.
+ */
+
+typedef struct atdir {
+ char *name; /* name of directory to reset */
+ dev_t dev; /* dev and inode for fast lookup */
+ ino_t ino;
+ time_t mtime; /* access and mod time to reset to */
+ time_t atime;
+ struct atdir *fow;
+} ATDIR;
+
+/*
+ * created directory time and mode storage entry. After pax is finished during
+ * extraction or copy, we must reset directory access modes and times that
+ * may have been modified after creation (they no longer have the specified
+ * times and/or modes). We must reset time in the reverse order of creation,
+ * because entries are added from the top of the file tree to the bottom.
+ * We MUST reset times from leaf to root (it will not work the other
+ * direction). Entries are recorded into a spool file to make reverse
+ * reading faster.
+ */
+
+typedef struct dirdata {
+ int nlen; /* length of the directory name (includes \0) */
+ off_t npos; /* position in file where this dir name starts */
+ mode_t mode; /* file mode to restore */
+ time_t mtime; /* mtime to set */
+ time_t atime; /* atime to set */
+ int frc_mode; /* do we force mode settings? */
+} DIRDATA;
diff --git a/bin/pax/tar.c b/bin/pax/tar.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..246ae8e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/tar.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1192 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)tar.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+#include "tar.h"
+
+/*
+ * Routines for reading, writing and header identify of various versions of tar
+ */
+
+static u_long tar_chksm __P((register char *, register int));
+static char *name_split __P((register char *, register int));
+static int ul_oct __P((u_long, register char *, register int, int));
+#ifndef NET2_STAT
+static int uqd_oct __P((u_quad_t, register char *, register int, int));
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Routines common to all versions of tar
+ */
+
+static int tar_nodir; /* do not write dirs under old tar */
+
+/*
+ * tar_endwr()
+ * add the tar trailer of two null blocks
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise (what wr_skip returns)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tar_endwr(void)
+#else
+int
+tar_endwr()
+#endif
+{
+ return(wr_skip((off_t)(NULLCNT*BLKMULT)));
+}
+
+/*
+ * tar_endrd()
+ * no cleanup needed here, just return size of trailer (for append)
+ * Return:
+ * size of trailer (2 * BLKMULT)
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+off_t
+tar_endrd(void)
+#else
+off_t
+tar_endrd()
+#endif
+{
+ return((off_t)(NULLCNT*BLKMULT));
+}
+
+/*
+ * tar_trail()
+ * Called to determine if a header block is a valid trailer. We are passed
+ * the block, the in_sync flag (which tells us we are in resync mode;
+ * looking for a valid header), and cnt (which starts at zero) which is
+ * used to count the number of empty blocks we have seen so far.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a valid trailer, -1 if not a valid trailer, or 1 if the block
+ * could never contain a header.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tar_trail(register char *buf, register int in_resync, register int *cnt)
+#else
+int
+tar_trail(buf, in_resync, cnt)
+ register char *buf;
+ register int in_resync;
+ register int *cnt;
+#endif
+{
+ register int i;
+
+ /*
+ * look for all zero, trailer is two consecutive blocks of zero
+ */
+ for (i = 0; i < BLKMULT; ++i) {
+ if (buf[i] != '\0')
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * if not all zero it is not a trailer, but MIGHT be a header.
+ */
+ if (i != BLKMULT)
+ return(-1);
+
+ /*
+ * When given a zero block, we must be careful!
+ * If we are not in resync mode, check for the trailer. Have to watch
+ * out that we do not mis-identify file data as the trailer, so we do
+ * NOT try to id a trailer during resync mode. During resync mode we
+ * might as well throw this block out since a valid header can NEVER be
+ * a block of all 0 (we must have a valid file name).
+ */
+ if (!in_resync && (++*cnt >= NULLCNT))
+ return(0);
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ul_oct()
+ * convert an unsigned long to an octal string. many oddball field
+ * termination characters are used by the various versions of tar in the
+ * different fields. term selects which kind to use. str is BLANK padded
+ * at the front to len. we are unable to use only one format as many old
+ * tar readers are very cranky about this.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if the number fit into the string, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+ul_oct(u_long val, register char *str, register int len, int term)
+#else
+static int
+ul_oct(val, str, len, term)
+ u_long val;
+ register char *str;
+ register int len;
+ int term;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * term selects the appropriate character(s) for the end of the string
+ */
+ pt = str + len - 1;
+ switch(term) {
+ case 3:
+ *pt-- = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 2:
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ *pt-- = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ break;
+ case 0:
+ default:
+ *pt-- = '\0';
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * convert and blank pad if there is space
+ */
+ while (pt >= str) {
+ *pt-- = '0' + (char)(val & 0x7);
+ if ((val = val >> 3) == (u_long)0)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ while (pt >= str)
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ if (val != (u_long)0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+#ifndef NET2_STAT
+/*
+ * uqd_oct()
+ * convert an u_quad_t to an octal string. one of many oddball field
+ * termination characters are used by the various versions of tar in the
+ * different fields. term selects which kind to use. str is BLANK padded
+ * at the front to len. we are unable to use only one format as many old
+ * tar readers are very cranky about this.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if the number fit into the string, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static int
+uqd_oct(u_quad_t val, register char *str, register int len, int term)
+#else
+static int
+uqd_oct(val, str, len, term)
+ u_quad_t val;
+ register char *str;
+ register int len;
+ int term;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * term selects the appropriate character(s) for the end of the string
+ */
+ pt = str + len - 1;
+ switch(term) {
+ case 3:
+ *pt-- = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 2:
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ *pt-- = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ break;
+ case 0:
+ default:
+ *pt-- = '\0';
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * convert and blank pad if there is space
+ */
+ while (pt >= str) {
+ *pt-- = '0' + (char)(val & 0x7);
+ if ((val = val >> 3) == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+
+ while (pt >= str)
+ *pt-- = ' ';
+ if (val != (u_quad_t)0)
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * tar_chksm()
+ * calculate the checksum for a tar block counting the checksum field as
+ * all blanks (BLNKSUM is that value pre-calculated, the sume of 8 blanks).
+ * NOTE: we use len to short circuit summing 0's on write since we ALWAYS
+ * pad headers with 0.
+ * Return:
+ * unsigned long checksum
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static u_long
+tar_chksm(register char *blk, register int len)
+#else
+static u_long
+tar_chksm(blk, len)
+ register char *blk;
+ register int len;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *stop;
+ register char *pt;
+ u_long chksm = BLNKSUM; /* inital value is checksum field sum */
+
+ /*
+ * add the part of the block before the checksum field
+ */
+ pt = blk;
+ stop = blk + CHK_OFFSET;
+ while (pt < stop)
+ chksm += (u_long)(*pt++ & 0xff);
+ /*
+ * move past the checksum field and keep going, spec counts the
+ * checksum field as the sum of 8 blanks (which is pre-computed as
+ * BLNKSUM).
+ * ASSUMED: len is greater than CHK_OFFSET. (len is where our 0 padding
+ * starts, no point in summing zero's)
+ */
+ pt += CHK_LEN;
+ stop = blk + len;
+ while (pt < stop)
+ chksm += (u_long)(*pt++ & 0xff);
+ return(chksm);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Routines for old BSD style tar (also made portable to sysV tar)
+ */
+
+/*
+ * tar_id()
+ * determine if a block given to us is a valid tar header (and not a USTAR
+ * header). We have to be on the lookout for those pesky blocks of all
+ * zero's.
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a tar header, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tar_id(register char *blk, int size)
+#else
+int
+tar_id(blk, size)
+ register char *blk;
+ int size;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_TAR *hd;
+ register HD_USTAR *uhd;
+
+ if (size < BLKMULT)
+ return(-1);
+ hd = (HD_TAR *)blk;
+ uhd = (HD_USTAR *)blk;
+
+ /*
+ * check for block of zero's first, a simple and fast test, then make
+ * sure this is not a ustar header by looking for the ustar magic
+ * cookie. We should use TMAGLEN, but some USTAR archive programs are
+ * wrong and create archives missing the \0. Last we check the
+ * checksum. If this is ok we have to assume it is a valid header.
+ */
+ if (hd->name[0] == '\0')
+ return(-1);
+ if (strncmp(uhd->magic, TMAGIC, TMAGLEN - 1) == 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (asc_ul(hd->chksum,sizeof(hd->chksum),OCT) != tar_chksm(blk,BLKMULT))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * tar_opt()
+ * handle tar format specific -o options
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tar_opt(void)
+#else
+int
+tar_opt()
+#endif
+{
+ OPLIST *opt;
+
+ while ((opt = opt_next()) != NULL) {
+ if (strcmp(opt->name, TAR_OPTION) ||
+ strcmp(opt->value, TAR_NODIR)) {
+ warn(1, "Unknown tar format -o option/value pair %s=%s",
+ opt->name, opt->value);
+ warn(1,"%s=%s is the only supported tar format option",
+ TAR_OPTION, TAR_NODIR);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * we only support one option, and only when writing
+ */
+ if ((act != APPND) && (act != ARCHIVE)) {
+ warn(1, "%s=%s is only supported when writing.",
+ opt->name, opt->value);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ tar_nodir = 1;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * tar_rd()
+ * extract the values out of block already determined to be a tar header.
+ * store the values in the ARCHD parameter.
+ * Return:
+ * 0
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tar_rd(register ARCHD *arcn, register char *buf)
+#else
+int
+tar_rd(arcn, buf)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register char *buf;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_TAR *hd;
+ register char *pt;
+
+ /*
+ * we only get proper sized buffers passed to us
+ */
+ if (tar_id(buf, BLKMULT) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ arcn->org_name = arcn->name;
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = 1;
+ arcn->pat = NULL;
+
+ /*
+ * copy out the name and values in the stat buffer
+ */
+ hd = (HD_TAR *)buf;
+ arcn->nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->name, hd->name, sizeof(hd->name));
+ arcn->name[arcn->nlen] = '\0';
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (mode_t)(asc_ul(hd->mode,sizeof(hd->mode),OCT) &
+ 0xfff);
+ arcn->sb.st_uid = (uid_t)asc_ul(hd->uid, sizeof(hd->uid), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_gid = (gid_t)asc_ul(hd->gid, sizeof(hd->gid), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (size_t)asc_ul(hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (time_t)asc_ul(hd->mtime, sizeof(hd->mtime), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_ctime = arcn->sb.st_atime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+
+ /*
+ * have to look at the last character, it may be a '/' and that is used
+ * to encode this as a directory
+ */
+ pt = &(arcn->name[arcn->nlen - 1]);
+ arcn->pad = 0;
+ arcn->skip = 0;
+ switch(hd->linkflag) {
+ case SYMTYPE:
+ /*
+ * symbolic link, need to get the link name and set the type in
+ * the st_mode so -v printing will look correct.
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_SLK;
+ arcn->ln_nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->ln_name, hd->linkname,
+ sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ arcn->ln_name[arcn->ln_nlen] = '\0';
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFLNK;
+ break;
+ case LNKTYPE:
+ /*
+ * hard link, need to get the link name, set the type in the
+ * st_mode and st_nlink so -v printing will look better.
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_HLK;
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = 2;
+ arcn->ln_nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->ln_name, hd->linkname,
+ sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ arcn->ln_name[arcn->ln_nlen] = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * no idea of what type this thing really points at, but
+ * we set something for printing only.
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFREG;
+ break;
+ case AREGTYPE:
+ case REGTYPE:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * If we have a trailing / this is a directory and NOT a file.
+ */
+ arcn->ln_name[0] = '\0';
+ arcn->ln_nlen = 0;
+ if (*pt == '/') {
+ /*
+ * it is a directory, set the mode for -v printing
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_DIR;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFDIR;
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = 2;
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * have a file that will be followed by data. Set the
+ * skip value to the size field and caluculate the size
+ * of the padding.
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_REG;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFREG;
+ arcn->pad = TAR_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ arcn->skip = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * strip off any trailing slash.
+ */
+ if (*pt == '/') {
+ *pt = '\0';
+ --arcn->nlen;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * tar_wr()
+ * write a tar header for the file specified in the ARCHD to the archive.
+ * Have to check for file types that cannot be stored and file names that
+ * are too long. Be careful of the term (last arg) to ul_oct, each field
+ * of tar has it own spec for the termination character(s).
+ * ASSUMED: space after header in header block is zero filled
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if file has data to be written after the header, 1 if file has NO
+ * data to write after the header, -1 if archive write failed
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tar_wr(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+tar_wr(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_TAR *hd;
+ int len;
+ char hdblk[sizeof(HD_TAR)];
+
+ /*
+ * check for those file system types which tar cannot store
+ */
+ switch(arcn->type) {
+ case PAX_DIR:
+ /*
+ * user asked that dirs not be written to the archive
+ */
+ if (tar_nodir)
+ return(1);
+ break;
+ case PAX_CHR:
+ warn(1, "Tar cannot archive a character device %s",
+ arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ case PAX_BLK:
+ warn(1, "Tar cannot archive a block device %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ case PAX_SCK:
+ warn(1, "Tar cannot archive a socket %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ case PAX_FIF:
+ warn(1, "Tar cannot archive a fifo %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ case PAX_SLK:
+ case PAX_HLK:
+ case PAX_HRG:
+ if (arcn->ln_nlen > sizeof(hd->linkname)) {
+ warn(1,"Link name too long for tar %s", arcn->ln_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ break;
+ case PAX_REG:
+ case PAX_CTG:
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * check file name len, remember extra char for dirs (the / at the end)
+ */
+ len = arcn->nlen;
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_DIR)
+ ++len;
+ if (len > sizeof(hd->name)) {
+ warn(1, "File name too long for tar %s", arcn->name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * copy the data out of the ARCHD into the tar header based on the type
+ * of the file. Remember many tar readers want the unused fields to be
+ * padded with zero. We set the linkflag field (type), the linkname
+ * (or zero if not used),the size, and set the padding (if any) to be
+ * added after the file data (0 for all other types, as they only have
+ * a header)
+ */
+ hd = (HD_TAR *)hdblk;
+ zf_strncpy(hd->name, arcn->name, sizeof(hd->name));
+ arcn->pad = 0;
+
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_DIR) {
+ /*
+ * directories are the same as files, except have a filename
+ * that ends with a /, we add the slash here. No data follows,
+ * dirs, so no pad.
+ */
+ hd->linkflag = AREGTYPE;
+ bzero(hd->linkname, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ hd->name[len-1] = '/';
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 1))
+ goto out;
+ } else if (arcn->type == PAX_SLK) {
+ /*
+ * no data follows this file, so no pad
+ */
+ hd->linkflag = SYMTYPE;
+ zf_strncpy(hd->linkname,arcn->ln_name, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 1))
+ goto out;
+ } else if ((arcn->type == PAX_HLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HRG)) {
+ /*
+ * no data follows this file, so no pad
+ */
+ hd->linkflag = LNKTYPE;
+ zf_strncpy(hd->linkname,arcn->ln_name, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 1))
+ goto out;
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * data follows this file, so set the pad
+ */
+ hd->linkflag = AREGTYPE;
+ bzero(hd->linkname, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->size,
+ sizeof(hd->size), 1)) {
+# else
+ if (uqd_oct((u_quad_t)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->size,
+ sizeof(hd->size), 1)) {
+# endif
+ warn(1,"File is too large for tar %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ arcn->pad = TAR_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * copy those fields that are independent of the type
+ */
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mode, hd->mode, sizeof(hd->mode), 0) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_uid, hd->uid, sizeof(hd->uid), 0) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_gid, hd->gid, sizeof(hd->gid), 0) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mtime, hd->mtime, sizeof(hd->mtime), 1))
+ goto out;
+
+ /*
+ * calculate and add the checksum, then write the header. A return of
+ * 0 tells the caller to now write the file data, 1 says no data needs
+ * to be written
+ */
+ if (ul_oct(tar_chksm(hdblk, sizeof(HD_TAR)), hd->chksum,
+ sizeof(hd->chksum), 2))
+ goto out;
+ if (wr_rdbuf(hdblk, sizeof(HD_TAR)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (wr_skip((off_t)(BLKMULT - sizeof(HD_TAR))) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_CTG) || (arcn->type == PAX_REG))
+ return(0);
+ return(1);
+
+ out:
+ /*
+ * header field is out of range
+ */
+ warn(1, "Tar header field is too small for %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Routines for POSIX ustar
+ */
+
+/*
+ * ustar_strd()
+ * initialization for ustar read
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ustar_strd(void)
+#else
+int
+ustar_strd()
+#endif
+{
+ if ((usrtb_start() < 0) || (grptb_start() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ustar_stwr()
+ * initialization for ustar write
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if ok, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ustar_stwr(void)
+#else
+int
+ustar_stwr()
+#endif
+{
+ if ((uidtb_start() < 0) || (gidtb_start() < 0))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ustar_id()
+ * determine if a block given to us is a valid ustar header. We have to
+ * be on the lookout for those pesky blocks of all zero's
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if a ustar header, -1 otherwise
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ustar_id(char *blk, int size)
+#else
+int
+ustar_id(blk, size)
+ char *blk;
+ int size;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_USTAR *hd;
+
+ if (size < BLKMULT)
+ return(-1);
+ hd = (HD_USTAR *)blk;
+
+ /*
+ * check for block of zero's first, a simple and fast test then check
+ * ustar magic cookie. We should use TMAGLEN, but some USTAR archive
+ * programs are fouled up and create archives missing the \0. Last we
+ * check the checksum. If ok we have to assume it is a valid header.
+ */
+ if (hd->name[0] == '\0')
+ return(-1);
+ if (strncmp(hd->magic, TMAGIC, TMAGLEN - 1) != 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (asc_ul(hd->chksum,sizeof(hd->chksum),OCT) != tar_chksm(blk,BLKMULT))
+ return(-1);
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ustar_rd()
+ * extract the values out of block already determined to be a ustar header.
+ * store the values in the ARCHD parameter.
+ * Return:
+ * 0
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ustar_rd(register ARCHD *arcn, register char *buf)
+#else
+int
+ustar_rd(arcn, buf)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+ register char *buf;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_USTAR *hd;
+ register char *dest;
+ register int cnt = 0;
+ dev_t devmajor;
+ dev_t devminor;
+
+ /*
+ * we only get proper sized buffers
+ */
+ if (ustar_id(buf, BLKMULT) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ arcn->org_name = arcn->name;
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = 1;
+ arcn->pat = NULL;
+ hd = (HD_USTAR *)buf;
+
+ /*
+ * see if the filename is split into two parts. if, so joint the parts.
+ * we copy the prefix first and add a / between the prefix and name.
+ */
+ dest = arcn->name;
+ if (*(hd->prefix) != '\0') {
+ cnt = l_strncpy(arcn->name, hd->prefix, sizeof(hd->prefix));
+ dest = arcn->name + arcn->nlen;
+ *dest++ = '/';
+ }
+ arcn->nlen = l_strncpy(dest, hd->name, sizeof(hd->name));
+ arcn->nlen += cnt;
+ arcn->name[arcn->nlen] = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * follow the spec to the letter. we should only have mode bits, strip
+ * off all other crud we may be passed.
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_mode = (mode_t)(asc_ul(hd->mode, sizeof(hd->mode), OCT) &
+ 0xfff);
+ arcn->sb.st_size = (size_t)asc_ul(hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_mtime = (time_t)asc_ul(hd->mtime, sizeof(hd->mtime), OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_ctime = arcn->sb.st_atime = arcn->sb.st_mtime;
+
+ /*
+ * If we can find the ascii names for gname and uname in the password
+ * and group files we will use the uid's and gid they bind. Otherwise
+ * we use the uid and gid values stored in the header. (This is what
+ * the posix spec wants).
+ */
+ hd->gname[sizeof(hd->gname) - 1] = '\0';
+ if (gid_name(hd->gname, &(arcn->sb.st_gid)) < 0)
+ arcn->sb.st_gid = (gid_t)asc_ul(hd->gid, sizeof(hd->gid), OCT);
+ hd->uname[sizeof(hd->uname) - 1] = '\0';
+ if (uid_name(hd->uname, &(arcn->sb.st_uid)) < 0)
+ arcn->sb.st_uid = (uid_t)asc_ul(hd->uid, sizeof(hd->uid), OCT);
+
+ /*
+ * set the defaults, these may be changed depending on the file type
+ */
+ arcn->ln_name[0] = '\0';
+ arcn->ln_nlen = 0;
+ arcn->pad = 0;
+ arcn->skip = 0;
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = (dev_t)0;
+
+ /*
+ * set the mode and PAX type according to the typeflag in the header
+ */
+ switch(hd->typeflag) {
+ case FIFOTYPE:
+ arcn->type = PAX_FIF;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFIFO;
+ break;
+ case DIRTYPE:
+ arcn->type = PAX_DIR;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFDIR;
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = 2;
+
+ /*
+ * Some programs that create ustar archives append a '/'
+ * to the pathname for directories. This clearly violates
+ * ustar specs, but we will silently strip it off anyway.
+ */
+ if (arcn->name[arcn->nlen - 1] == '/')
+ arcn->name[--arcn->nlen] = '\0';
+ break;
+ case BLKTYPE:
+ case CHRTYPE:
+ /*
+ * this type requires the rdev field to be set.
+ */
+ if (hd->typeflag == BLKTYPE) {
+ arcn->type = PAX_BLK;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFBLK;
+ } else {
+ arcn->type = PAX_CHR;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFCHR;
+ }
+ devmajor = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->devmajor,sizeof(hd->devmajor),OCT);
+ devminor = (dev_t)asc_ul(hd->devminor,sizeof(hd->devminor),OCT);
+ arcn->sb.st_rdev = TODEV(devmajor, devminor);
+ break;
+ case SYMTYPE:
+ case LNKTYPE:
+ if (hd->typeflag == SYMTYPE) {
+ arcn->type = PAX_SLK;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFLNK;
+ } else {
+ arcn->type = PAX_HLK;
+ /*
+ * so printing looks better
+ */
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFREG;
+ arcn->sb.st_nlink = 2;
+ }
+ /*
+ * copy the link name
+ */
+ arcn->ln_nlen = l_strncpy(arcn->ln_name, hd->linkname,
+ sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ arcn->ln_name[arcn->ln_nlen] = '\0';
+ break;
+ case CONTTYPE:
+ case AREGTYPE:
+ case REGTYPE:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * these types have file data that follows. Set the skip and
+ * pad fields.
+ */
+ arcn->type = PAX_REG;
+ arcn->pad = TAR_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+ arcn->skip = arcn->sb.st_size;
+ arcn->sb.st_mode |= S_IFREG;
+ break;
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ustar_wr()
+ * write a ustar header for the file specified in the ARCHD to the archive
+ * Have to check for file types that cannot be stored and file names that
+ * are too long. Be careful of the term (last arg) to ul_oct, we only use
+ * '\0' for the termination character (this is different than picky tar)
+ * ASSUMED: space after header in header block is zero filled
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if file has data to be written after the header, 1 if file has NO
+ * data to write after the header, -1 if archive write failed
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+ustar_wr(register ARCHD *arcn)
+#else
+int
+ustar_wr(arcn)
+ register ARCHD *arcn;
+#endif
+{
+ register HD_USTAR *hd;
+ register char *pt;
+ char hdblk[sizeof(HD_USTAR)];
+
+ /*
+ * check for those file system types ustar cannot store
+ */
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_SCK) {
+ warn(1, "Ustar cannot archive a socket %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * check the length of the linkname
+ */
+ if (((arcn->type == PAX_SLK) || (arcn->type == PAX_HLK) ||
+ (arcn->type == PAX_HRG)) && (arcn->ln_nlen > sizeof(hd->linkname))){
+ warn(1, "Link name too long for ustar %s", arcn->ln_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * split the path name into prefix and name fields (if needed). if
+ * pt != arcn->name, the name has to be split
+ */
+ if ((pt = name_split(arcn->name, arcn->nlen)) == NULL) {
+ warn(1, "File name too long for ustar %s", arcn->name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ hd = (HD_USTAR *)hdblk;
+ arcn->pad = 0L;
+
+ /*
+ * split the name, or zero out the prefix
+ */
+ if (pt != arcn->name) {
+ /*
+ * name was split, pt points at the / where the split is to
+ * occur, we remove the / and copy the first part to the prefix
+ */
+ *pt = '\0';
+ zf_strncpy(hd->prefix, arcn->name, sizeof(hd->prefix));
+ *pt++ = '/';
+ } else
+ bzero(hd->prefix, sizeof(hd->prefix));
+
+ /*
+ * copy the name part. this may be the whole path or the part after
+ * the prefix
+ */
+ zf_strncpy(hd->name, pt, sizeof(hd->name));
+
+ /*
+ * set the fields in the header that are type dependent
+ */
+ switch(arcn->type) {
+ case PAX_DIR:
+ hd->typeflag = DIRTYPE;
+ bzero(hd->linkname, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ bzero(hd->devmajor, sizeof(hd->devmajor));
+ bzero(hd->devminor, sizeof(hd->devminor));
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 3))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ case PAX_CHR:
+ case PAX_BLK:
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_CHR)
+ hd->typeflag = CHRTYPE;
+ else
+ hd->typeflag = BLKTYPE;
+ bzero(hd->linkname, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)MAJOR(arcn->sb.st_rdev), hd->devmajor,
+ sizeof(hd->devmajor), 3) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)MINOR(arcn->sb.st_rdev), hd->devminor,
+ sizeof(hd->devminor), 3) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 3))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ case PAX_FIF:
+ hd->typeflag = FIFOTYPE;
+ bzero(hd->linkname, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ bzero(hd->devmajor, sizeof(hd->devmajor));
+ bzero(hd->devminor, sizeof(hd->devminor));
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 3))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ case PAX_SLK:
+ case PAX_HLK:
+ case PAX_HRG:
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_SLK)
+ hd->typeflag = SYMTYPE;
+ else
+ hd->typeflag = LNKTYPE;
+ zf_strncpy(hd->linkname,arcn->ln_name, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ bzero(hd->devmajor, sizeof(hd->devmajor));
+ bzero(hd->devminor, sizeof(hd->devminor));
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)0L, hd->size, sizeof(hd->size), 3))
+ goto out;
+ break;
+ case PAX_REG:
+ case PAX_CTG:
+ default:
+ /*
+ * file data with this type, set the padding
+ */
+ if (arcn->type == PAX_CTG)
+ hd->typeflag = CONTTYPE;
+ else
+ hd->typeflag = REGTYPE;
+ bzero(hd->linkname, sizeof(hd->linkname));
+ bzero(hd->devmajor, sizeof(hd->devmajor));
+ bzero(hd->devminor, sizeof(hd->devminor));
+ arcn->pad = TAR_PAD(arcn->sb.st_size);
+# ifdef NET2_STAT
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->size,
+ sizeof(hd->size), 3)) {
+# else
+ if (uqd_oct((u_quad_t)arcn->sb.st_size, hd->size,
+ sizeof(hd->size), 3)) {
+# endif
+ warn(1,"File is too long for ustar %s",arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+
+ zf_strncpy(hd->magic, TMAGIC, TMAGLEN);
+ zf_strncpy(hd->version, TVERSION, TVERSLEN);
+
+ /*
+ * set the remaining fields. Some versions want all 16 bits of mode
+ * we better humor them (they really do not meet spec though)....
+ */
+ if (ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mode, hd->mode, sizeof(hd->mode), 3) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_uid, hd->uid, sizeof(hd->uid), 3) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_gid, hd->gid, sizeof(hd->gid), 3) ||
+ ul_oct((u_long)arcn->sb.st_mtime,hd->mtime,sizeof(hd->mtime),3))
+ goto out;
+ zf_strncpy(hd->uname,name_uid(arcn->sb.st_uid, 0),sizeof(hd->uname));
+ zf_strncpy(hd->gname,name_gid(arcn->sb.st_gid, 0),sizeof(hd->gname));
+
+ /*
+ * calculate and store the checksum write the header to the archive
+ * return 0 tells the caller to now write the file data, 1 says no data
+ * needs to be written
+ */
+ if (ul_oct(tar_chksm(hdblk, sizeof(HD_USTAR)), hd->chksum,
+ sizeof(hd->chksum), 3))
+ goto out;
+ if (wr_rdbuf(hdblk, sizeof(HD_USTAR)) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if (wr_skip((off_t)(BLKMULT - sizeof(HD_USTAR))) < 0)
+ return(-1);
+ if ((arcn->type == PAX_CTG) || (arcn->type == PAX_REG))
+ return(0);
+ return(1);
+
+ out:
+ /*
+ * header field is out of range
+ */
+ warn(1, "Ustar header field is too small for %s", arcn->org_name);
+ return(1);
+}
+
+/*
+ * name_split()
+ * see if the name has to be split for storage in a ustar header. We try
+ * to fit the entire name in the name field without splitting if we can.
+ * The split point is always at a /
+ * Return
+ * character pointer to split point (always the / that is to be removed
+ * if the split is not needed, the points is set to the start of the file
+ * name (it would violate the spec to split there). A NULL is returned if
+ * the file name is too long
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+static char *
+name_split(register char *name, register int len)
+#else
+static char *
+name_split(name, len)
+ register char *name;
+ register int len;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *start;
+
+ /*
+ * check to see if the file name is small enough to fit in the name
+ * field. if so just return a pointer to the name.
+ */
+ if (len <= TNMSZ)
+ return(name);
+ if (len > (TPFSZ + TNMSZ + 1))
+ return(NULL);
+
+ /*
+ * we start looking at the biggest sized piece that fits in the name
+ * field. We walk foward looking for a slash to split at. The idea is
+ * to find the biggest piece to fit in the name field (or the smallest
+ * prefix we can find) (the -1 is correct the biggest piece would
+ * include the slash between the two parts that gets thrown away)
+ */
+ start = name + len - TNMSZ - 1;
+ while ((*start != '\0') && (*start != '/'))
+ ++start;
+
+ /*
+ * if we hit the end of the string, this name cannot be split, so we
+ * cannot store this file.
+ */
+ if (*start == '\0')
+ return(NULL);
+ len = start - name;
+
+ /*
+ * NOTE: /str where the length of str == TNMSZ can not be stored under
+ * the p1003.1-1990 spec for ustar. We could force a prefix of / and
+ * the file would then expand on extract to //str. The len == 0 below
+ * makes this special case follow the spec to the letter.
+ */
+ if ((len > TPFSZ) || (len == 0))
+ return(NULL);
+
+ /*
+ * ok have a split point, return it to the caller
+ */
+ return(start);
+}
diff --git a/bin/pax/tar.h b/bin/pax/tar.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dad2d77
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/tar.h
@@ -0,0 +1,148 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)tar.h 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+ */
+
+/*
+ * defines and data structures common to all tar formats
+ */
+#define CHK_LEN 8 /* length of checksum field */
+#define TNMSZ 100 /* size of name field */
+#ifdef _PAX_
+#define NULLCNT 2 /* number of null blocks in trailer */
+#define CHK_OFFSET 148 /* start of chksum field */
+#define BLNKSUM 256L /* sum of checksum field using ' ' */
+#endif /* _PAX_ */
+
+/*
+ * Values used in typeflag field in all tar formats
+ * (only REGTYPE, LNKTYPE and SYMTYPE are used in old bsd tar headers)
+ */
+#define REGTYPE '0' /* Regular File */
+#define AREGTYPE '\0' /* Regular File */
+#define LNKTYPE '1' /* Link */
+#define SYMTYPE '2' /* Symlink */
+#define CHRTYPE '3' /* Character Special File */
+#define BLKTYPE '4' /* Block Special File */
+#define DIRTYPE '5' /* Directory */
+#define FIFOTYPE '6' /* FIFO */
+#define CONTTYPE '7' /* high perf file */
+
+/*
+ * Mode field encoding of the different file types - values in octal
+ */
+#define TSUID 04000 /* Set UID on execution */
+#define TSGID 02000 /* Set GID on execution */
+#define TSVTX 01000 /* Reserved */
+#define TUREAD 00400 /* Read by owner */
+#define TUWRITE 00200 /* Write by owner */
+#define TUEXEC 00100 /* Execute/Search by owner */
+#define TGREAD 00040 /* Read by group */
+#define TGWRITE 00020 /* Write by group */
+#define TGEXEC 00010 /* Execute/Search by group */
+#define TOREAD 00004 /* Read by other */
+#define TOWRITE 00002 /* Write by other */
+#define TOEXEC 00001 /* Execute/Search by other */
+
+#ifdef _PAX_
+/*
+ * Pad with a bit mask, much faster than doing a mod but only works on powers
+ * of 2. Macro below is for block of 512 bytes.
+ */
+#define TAR_PAD(x) ((512 - ((x) & 511)) & 511)
+#endif /* _PAX_ */
+
+/*
+ * structure of an old tar header as it appeared in BSD releases
+ */
+typedef struct {
+ char name[TNMSZ]; /* name of entry */
+ char mode[8]; /* mode */
+ char uid[8]; /* uid */
+ char gid[8]; /* gid */
+ char size[12]; /* size */
+ char mtime[12]; /* modification time */
+ char chksum[CHK_LEN]; /* checksum */
+ char linkflag; /* norm, hard, or sym. */
+ char linkname[TNMSZ]; /* linked to name */
+} HD_TAR;
+
+#ifdef _PAX_
+/*
+ * -o options for BSD tar to not write directories to the archive
+ */
+#define TAR_NODIR "nodir"
+#define TAR_OPTION "write_opt"
+
+/*
+ * default device names
+ */
+#define DEV_0 "/dev/rmt0"
+#define DEV_1 "/dev/rmt1"
+#define DEV_4 "/dev/rmt4"
+#define DEV_5 "/dev/rmt5"
+#define DEV_7 "/dev/rmt7"
+#define DEV_8 "/dev/rmt8"
+#endif /* _PAX_ */
+
+/*
+ * Data Interchange Format - Extended tar header format - POSIX 1003.1-1990
+ */
+#define TPFSZ 155
+#define TMAGIC "ustar" /* ustar and a null */
+#define TMAGLEN 6
+#define TVERSION "00" /* 00 and no null */
+#define TVERSLEN 2
+
+typedef struct {
+ char name[TNMSZ]; /* name of entry */
+ char mode[8]; /* mode */
+ char uid[8]; /* uid */
+ char gid[8]; /* gid */
+ char size[12]; /* size */
+ char mtime[12]; /* modification time */
+ char chksum[CHK_LEN]; /* checksum */
+ char typeflag; /* type of file. */
+ char linkname[TNMSZ]; /* linked to name */
+ char magic[TMAGLEN]; /* magic cookie */
+ char version[TVERSLEN]; /* version */
+ char uname[32]; /* ascii owner name */
+ char gname[32]; /* ascii group name */
+ char devmajor[8]; /* major device number */
+ char devminor[8]; /* minor device number */
+ char prefix[TPFSZ]; /* linked to name */
+} HD_USTAR;
diff --git a/bin/pax/tty_subs.c b/bin/pax/tty_subs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0c7e80d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pax/tty_subs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,245 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992 Keith Muller.
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Keith Muller of the University of California, San Diego.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)tty_subs.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include "pax.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+#if __STDC__
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+#include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * routines that deal with I/O to and from the user
+ */
+
+#define DEVTTY "/dev/tty" /* device for interactive i/o */
+static FILE *ttyoutf = NULL; /* output pointing at control tty */
+static FILE *ttyinf = NULL; /* input pointing at control tty */
+
+/*
+ * tty_init()
+ * try to open the controlling termina (if any) for this process. if the
+ * open fails, future ops that require user input will get an EOF
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tty_init(void)
+#else
+int
+tty_init()
+#endif
+{
+ int ttyfd;
+
+ if ((ttyfd = open(DEVTTY, O_RDWR)) >= 0) {
+ if ((ttyoutf = fdopen(ttyfd, "w")) != NULL) {
+ if ((ttyinf = fdopen(ttyfd, "r")) != NULL)
+ return(0);
+ (void)fclose(ttyoutf);
+ }
+ (void)close(ttyfd);
+ }
+
+ if (iflag) {
+ warn(1, "Fatal error, cannot open %s", DEVTTY);
+ return(-1);
+ }
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * tty_prnt()
+ * print a message using the specified format to the controlling tty
+ * if there is no controlling terminal, just return.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+tty_prnt(char *fmt, ...)
+#else
+void
+tty_prnt(fmt, va_alist)
+ char *fmt;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list ap;
+# if __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+# else
+ va_start(ap);
+# endif
+ if (ttyoutf == NULL)
+ return;
+ (void)vfprintf(ttyoutf, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ (void)fflush(ttyoutf);
+}
+
+/*
+ * tty_read()
+ * read a string from the controlling terminal if it is open into the
+ * supplied buffer
+ * Return:
+ * 0 if data was read, -1 otherwise.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+int
+tty_read(char *str, int len)
+#else
+int
+tty_read(str, len)
+ char *str;
+ int len;
+#endif
+{
+ register char *pt;
+
+ if ((--len <= 0) || (ttyinf == NULL) || (fgets(str,len,ttyinf) == NULL))
+ return(-1);
+ *(str + len) = '\0';
+
+ /*
+ * strip off that trailing newline
+ */
+ if ((pt = strchr(str, '\n')) != NULL)
+ *pt = '\0';
+ return(0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * warn()
+ * write a warning message to stderr. if "set" the exit value of pax
+ * will be non-zero.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+warn(int set, char *fmt, ...)
+#else
+void
+warn(set, fmt, va_alist)
+ int set;
+ char *fmt;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list ap;
+# if __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+# else
+ va_start(ap);
+# endif
+ if (set)
+ exit_val = 1;
+ /*
+ * when vflag we better ship out an extra \n to get this message on a
+ * line by itself
+ */
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)fputc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s: ", argv0);
+ (void)vfprintf(stderr, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ (void)fputc('\n', stderr);
+}
+
+/*
+ * syswarn()
+ * write a warning message to stderr. if "set" the exit value of pax
+ * will be non-zero.
+ */
+
+#if __STDC__
+void
+syswarn(int set, int errnum, char *fmt, ...)
+#else
+void
+syswarn(set, errnum, fmt, va_alist)
+ int set;
+ int errnum;
+ char *fmt;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list ap;
+# if __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+# else
+ va_start(ap);
+# endif
+ if (set)
+ exit_val = 1;
+ /*
+ * when vflag we better ship out an extra \n to get this message on a
+ * line by itself
+ */
+ if (vflag && vfpart) {
+ (void)fputc('\n', stderr);
+ vfpart = 0;
+ }
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s: ", argv0);
+ (void)vfprintf(stderr, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+
+ /*
+ * format and print the errno
+ */
+ if (errnum > 0)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, " <%s>", sys_errlist[errnum]);
+ (void)fputc('\n', stderr);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/Makefile b/bin/ps/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b98abc2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,11 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/2/93
+
+PROG= ps
+SRCS= fmt.c keyword.c nlist.c print.c ps.c
+CFLAGS+=-I/sys
+DPADD= ${LIBMATH} ${LIBKVM}
+LDADD= -lm -lkvm
+BINGRP= kmem
+BINMODE=2555
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/ps/devname.c b/bin/ps/devname.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..df94b91
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/devname.c
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#if defined(LIBC_SCCS) && !defined(lint)
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)devname.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* LIBC_SCCS and not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <db.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <paths.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+char *
+devname(dev, type)
+ dev_t dev;
+ mode_t type;
+{
+ struct {
+ mode_t type;
+ dev_t dev;
+ } bkey;
+ static DB *db;
+ static int failure;
+ DBT data, key;
+
+ if (!db && !failure &&
+ !(db = dbopen(_PATH_DEVDB, O_RDONLY, 0, DB_HASH, NULL))) {
+ warn("warning: %s", _PATH_DEVDB);
+ failure = 1;
+ }
+ if (failure)
+ return ("??");
+
+ /*
+ * Keys are a mode_t followed by a dev_t. The former is the type of
+ * the file (mode & S_IFMT), the latter is the st_rdev field. Be
+ * sure to clear any padding that may be found in bkey.
+ */
+ memset(&bkey, 0, sizeof(bkey));
+ bkey.dev = dev;
+ bkey.type = type;
+ key.data = &bkey;
+ key.size = sizeof(bkey);
+ return ((db->get)(db, &key, &data, 0) ? "??" : (char *)data.data);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/extern.h b/bin/ps/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a23f3ec
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,85 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94
+ */
+
+struct kinfo;
+struct nlist;
+struct var;
+struct varent;
+
+extern fixpt_t ccpu;
+extern int eval, fscale, mempages, nlistread, rawcpu;
+extern int sumrusage, termwidth, totwidth;
+extern VAR var[];
+extern VARENT *vhead;
+
+__BEGIN_DECLS
+void command __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void cputime __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+int donlist __P((void));
+void evar __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+char *fmt_argv __P((char **, char *, int));
+double getpcpu __P((KINFO *));
+double getpmem __P((KINFO *));
+void logname __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void longtname __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void lstarted __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void maxrss __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void nlisterr __P((struct nlist *));
+void p_rssize __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void pagein __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void parsefmt __P((char *));
+void pcpu __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void pmem __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void pri __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void printheader __P((void));
+void pvar __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void rssize __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void runame __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void rvar __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void showkey __P((void));
+void started __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void state __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void tdev __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void tname __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+#ifndef NEWVM
+void trss __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+#endif
+void tsize __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void ucomm __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void uname __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void uvar __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void vsize __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+void wchan __P((KINFO *, VARENT *));
+__END_DECLS
diff --git a/bin/ps/fmt.c b/bin/ps/fmt.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3b6a1ec
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/fmt.c
@@ -0,0 +1,115 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)fmt.c 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/15/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <vis.h>
+#include "ps.h"
+
+static char *cmdpart __P((char *));
+static char *shquote __P((char **));
+
+/*
+ * XXX
+ * This is a stub until marc does the real one.
+ */
+static char *
+shquote(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char **p, *dst, *src;
+ static char buf[4096]; /* XXX */
+
+ if (*argv == 0) {
+ buf[0] = 0;
+ return (buf);
+ }
+ dst = buf;
+ for (p = argv; (src = *p++) != 0; ) {
+ if (*src == 0)
+ continue;
+ strvis(dst, src, VIS_NL | VIS_CSTYLE);
+ while (*dst)
+ dst++;
+ *dst++ = ' ';
+ }
+ *dst = '\0';
+ return (buf);
+}
+
+static char *
+cmdpart(arg0)
+ char *arg0;
+{
+ char *cp;
+
+ return ((cp = strrchr(arg0, '/')) != NULL ? cp + 1 : arg0);
+}
+
+char *
+fmt_argv(argv, cmd, maxlen)
+ char **argv;
+ char *cmd;
+ int maxlen;
+{
+ int len;
+ char *ap, *cp;
+
+ if (argv == 0 || argv[0] == 0) {
+ if (cmd == NULL)
+ return ("");
+ ap = NULL;
+ len = maxlen + 3;
+ } else {
+ ap = shquote(argv);
+ len = strlen(ap) + maxlen + 4;
+ }
+ if ((cp = malloc(len)) == NULL)
+ return (NULL);
+ if (ap == NULL)
+ sprintf(cp, "(%.*s)", maxlen, cmd);
+ else if (strncmp(cmdpart(argv[0]), cmd, maxlen) != 0)
+ sprintf(cp, "%s (%.*s)", ap, maxlen, cmd);
+ else
+ (void) strcpy(cp, ap);
+ return (cp);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/keyword.c b/bin/ps/keyword.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fb1133b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/keyword.c
@@ -0,0 +1,354 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)keyword.c 8.5 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#include <sys/proc.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "ps.h"
+
+#ifdef P_PPWAIT
+#define NEWVM
+#endif
+
+#ifdef NEWVM
+#include <sys/ucred.h>
+#include <sys/sysctl.h>
+#endif
+
+static VAR *findvar __P((char *));
+static int vcmp __P((const void *, const void *));
+
+#ifdef NOTINUSE
+int utime(), stime(), ixrss(), idrss(), isrss();
+ {{"utime"}, "UTIME", USER, utime, 4},
+ {{"stime"}, "STIME", USER, stime, 4},
+ {{"ixrss"}, "IXRSS", USER, ixrss, 4},
+ {{"idrss"}, "IDRSS", USER, idrss, 4},
+ {{"isrss"}, "ISRSS", USER, isrss, 4},
+#endif
+
+/* Compute offset in common structures. */
+#define POFF(x) offsetof(struct proc, x)
+#define EOFF(x) offsetof(struct eproc, x)
+#define UOFF(x) offsetof(struct usave, x)
+#define ROFF(x) offsetof(struct rusage, x)
+
+#define UIDFMT "u"
+#define UIDLEN 5
+#define PIDFMT "d"
+#define PIDLEN 5
+#define USERLEN 8
+
+VAR var[] = {
+#ifdef NEWVM
+ {"%cpu", "%CPU", NULL, 0, pcpu, 4},
+ {"%mem", "%MEM", NULL, 0, pmem, 4},
+ {"acflag", "ACFLG", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_acflag), USHORT, "x"},
+ {"acflg", "", "acflag"},
+ {"blocked", "", "sigmask"},
+ {"caught", "", "sigcatch"},
+ {"command", "COMMAND", NULL, COMM|LJUST|USER, command, 16},
+ {"cpu", "CPU", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_estcpu), ULONG, "d"},
+ {"cputime", "", "time"},
+ {"f", "F", NULL, 0, pvar, 7, POFF(p_flag), LONG, "x"},
+ {"flags", "", "f"},
+ {"ignored", "", "sigignore"},
+ {"inblk", "INBLK", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_inblock), LONG, "d"},
+ {"inblock", "", "inblk"},
+ {"jobc", "JOBC", NULL, 0, evar, 4, EOFF(e_jobc), SHORT, "d"},
+ {"ktrace", "KTRACE", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_traceflag), LONG, "x"},
+ {"ktracep", "KTRACEP", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_tracep), LONG, "x"},
+ {"lim", "LIM", NULL, 0, maxrss, 5},
+ {"login", "LOGIN", NULL, LJUST, logname, MAXLOGNAME},
+ {"logname", "", "login"},
+ {"lstart", "STARTED", NULL, LJUST|USER, lstarted, 28},
+ {"majflt", "MAJFLT", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_majflt), LONG, "d"},
+ {"minflt", "MINFLT", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_minflt), LONG, "d"},
+ {"msgrcv", "MSGRCV", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_msgrcv), LONG, "d"},
+ {"msgsnd", "MSGSND", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_msgsnd), LONG, "d"},
+ {"ni", "", "nice"},
+ {"nice", "NI", NULL, 0, pvar, 2, POFF(p_nice), CHAR, "d"},
+ {"nivcsw", "NIVCSW", NULL, USER, rvar, 5, ROFF(ru_nivcsw), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nsignals", "", "nsigs"},
+ {"nsigs", "NSIGS", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_nsignals), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nswap", "NSWAP", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_nswap), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nvcsw", "NVCSW", NULL, USER, rvar, 5, ROFF(ru_nvcsw), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nwchan", "WCHAN", NULL, 0, pvar, 6, POFF(p_wchan), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"oublk", "OUBLK", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_oublock), LONG, "d"},
+ {"oublock", "", "oublk"},
+ {"p_ru", "P_RU", NULL, 0, pvar, 6, POFF(p_ru), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"paddr", "PADDR", NULL, 0, evar, 6, EOFF(e_paddr), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"pagein", "PAGEIN", NULL, USER, pagein, 6},
+ {"pcpu", "", "%cpu"},
+ {"pending", "", "sig"},
+ {"pgid", "PGID", NULL, 0, evar, PIDLEN, EOFF(e_pgid), ULONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"pid", "PID", NULL, 0, pvar, PIDLEN, POFF(p_pid), LONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"pmem", "", "%mem"},
+ {"ppid", "PPID", NULL, 0, evar, PIDLEN, EOFF(e_ppid), LONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"pri", "PRI", NULL, 0, pri, 3},
+ {"re", "RE", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_swtime), ULONG, "d"},
+ {"rgid", "RGID", NULL, 0, evar, UIDLEN, EOFF(e_pcred.p_rgid),
+ ULONG, UIDFMT},
+ {"rlink", "RLINK", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_back), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"rss", "RSS", NULL, 0, p_rssize, 4},
+ {"rssize", "", "rsz"},
+ {"rsz", "RSZ", NULL, 0, rssize, 4},
+ {"ruid", "RUID", NULL, 0, evar, UIDLEN, EOFF(e_pcred.p_ruid),
+ ULONG, UIDFMT},
+ {"ruser", "RUSER", NULL, LJUST, runame, USERLEN},
+ {"sess", "SESS", NULL, 0, evar, 6, EOFF(e_sess), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"sig", "PENDING", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_siglist), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sigcatch", "CAUGHT", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sigcatch), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sigignore", "IGNORED",
+ NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sigignore), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sigmask", "BLOCKED", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sigmask), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sl", "SL", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_slptime), ULONG, "d"},
+ {"start", "STARTED", NULL, LJUST|USER, started, 8},
+ {"stat", "", "state"},
+ {"state", "STAT", NULL, 0, state, 4},
+ {"svgid", "SVGID",
+ NULL, 0, evar, UIDLEN, EOFF(e_pcred.p_svgid), ULONG, UIDFMT},
+ {"svuid", "SVUID",
+ NULL, 0, evar, UIDLEN, EOFF(e_pcred.p_svuid), ULONG, UIDFMT},
+ {"tdev", "TDEV", NULL, 0, tdev, 4},
+ {"time", "TIME", NULL, USER, cputime, 9},
+ {"tpgid", "TPGID", NULL, 0, evar, 4, EOFF(e_tpgid), ULONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"tsess", "TSESS", NULL, 0, evar, 6, EOFF(e_tsess), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"tsiz", "TSIZ", NULL, 0, tsize, 4},
+ {"tt", "TT", NULL, LJUST, tname, 3},
+ {"tty", "TTY", NULL, LJUST, longtname, 8},
+ {"ucomm", "UCOMM", NULL, LJUST, ucomm, MAXCOMLEN},
+ {"uid", "UID", NULL, 0, evar, UIDLEN, EOFF(e_ucred.cr_uid),
+ ULONG, UIDFMT},
+ {"upr", "UPR", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_usrpri), CHAR, "d"},
+ {"user", "USER", NULL, LJUST, uname, USERLEN},
+ {"usrpri", "", "upr"},
+ {"vsize", "", "vsz"},
+ {"vsz", "VSZ", NULL, 0, vsize, 5},
+ {"wchan", "WCHAN", NULL, LJUST, wchan, 6},
+ {"xstat", "XSTAT", NULL, 0, pvar, 4, POFF(p_xstat), USHORT, "x"},
+#else
+ {"%cpu", "%CPU", NULL, 0, pcpu, 4},
+ {"%mem", "%MEM", NULL, 0, pmem, 4},
+ {"acflag", "ACFLG", NULL, USER, uvar, 3, UOFF(u_acflag), SHORT, "x"},
+ {"acflg", "", "acflag"},
+ {"blocked", "", "sigmask"},
+ {"caught", "", "sigcatch"},
+ {"command", "COMMAND", NULL, COMM|LJUST|USER, command, 16},
+ {"cpu", "CPU", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_cpu), ULONG, "d"},
+ {"cputime", "", "time"},
+ {"f", "F", NULL, 0, pvar, 7, POFF(p_flag), LONG, "x"},
+ {"flags", "", "f"},
+ {"ignored", "", "sigignore"},
+ {"inblk", "INBLK", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_inblock), LONG, "d"},
+ {"inblock", "", "inblk"},
+ {"jobc", "JOBC", NULL, 0, evar, 4, EOFF(e_jobc), SHORT, "d"},
+ {"ktrace", "KTRACE", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_traceflag), LONG, "x"},
+ {"ktracep", "KTRACEP", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_tracep), LONG, "x"},
+ {"lim", "LIM", NULL, 0, maxrss, 5},
+ {"logname", "LOGNAME", NULL, LJUST, logname, MAXLOGNAME},
+ {"lstart", "STARTED", NULL, LJUST|USER, lstarted, 28},
+ {"majflt", "MAJFLT", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_majflt), LONG, "d"},
+ {"minflt", "MINFLT", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_minflt), LONG, "d"},
+ {"msgrcv", "MSGRCV", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_msgrcv), LONG, "d"},
+ {"msgsnd", "MSGSND", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_msgsnd), LONG, "d"},
+ {"ni", "", "nice"},
+ {"nice", "NI", NULL, 0, pvar, 2, POFF(p_nice), CHAR, "d"},
+ {"nivcsw", "NIVCSW", NULL, USER, rvar, 5, ROFF(ru_nivcsw), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nsignals", "", "nsigs"},
+ {"nsigs", "NSIGS", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_nsignals), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nswap", "NSWAP", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_nswap), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nvcsw", "NVCSW", NULL, USER, rvar, 5, ROFF(ru_nvcsw), LONG, "d"},
+ {"nwchan", "WCHAN", NULL, 0, pvar, 6, POFF(p_wchan), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"oublk", "OUBLK", NULL, USER, rvar, 4, ROFF(ru_oublock), LONG, "d"},
+ {"oublock", "", "oublk"},
+ {"p_ru", "P_RU", NULL, 0, pvar, 6, POFF(p_ru), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"paddr", "PADDR", NULL, 0, evar, 6, EOFF(e_paddr), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"pagein", "PAGEIN", NULL, USER, pagein, 6},
+ {"pcpu", "", "%cpu"},
+ {"pending", "", "sig"},
+ {"pgid", "PGID", NULL, 0, evar, PIDLEN, EOFF(e_pgid), ULONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"pid", "PID", NULL, 0, pvar, PIDLEN, POFF(p_pid), LONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"pmem", "", "%mem"},
+ {"poip", "POIP", NULL, 0, pvar, 4, POFF(p_poip), SHORT, "d"},
+ {"ppid", "PPID", NULL, 0, pvar, PIDLEN, POFF(p_ppid), LONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"pri", "PRI", NULL, 0, pri, 3},
+ {"re", "RE", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_swtime), ULONG, "d"},
+ {"rgid", "RGID", NULL, 0, pvar, UIDLEN, POFF(p_rgid), USHORT, UIDFMT},
+ {"rlink", "RLINK", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_rlink), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"rss", "RSS", NULL, 0, p_rssize, 4},
+ {"rssize", "", "rsz"},
+ {"rsz", "RSZ", NULL, 0, rssize, 4},
+ {"ruid", "RUID", NULL, 0, pvar, UIDLEN, POFF(p_ruid), USHORT, UIDFMT},
+ {"ruser", "RUSER", NULL, LJUST, runame, USERLEN},
+ {"sess", "SESS", NULL, 0, evar, 6, EOFF(e_sess), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"sig", "PENDING", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sig), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sigcatch", "CAUGHT", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sigcatch), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sigignore", "IGNORED",
+ NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sigignore), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sigmask", "BLOCKED", NULL, 0, pvar, 8, POFF(p_sigmask), LONG, "x"},
+ {"sl", "SL", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_slptime), ULONG, "d"},
+ {"start", "STARTED", NULL, LJUST|USER, started, 8},
+ {"stat", "", "state"},
+ {"state", "STAT", NULL, 0, state, 4},
+ {"svgid", "SVGID",
+ NULL, 0, pvar, UIDLEN, POFF(p_svgid), USHORT, UIDFMT},
+ {"svuid", "SVUID",
+ NULL, 0, pvar, UIDLEN, POFF(p_svuid), USHORT, UIDFMT},
+ {"tdev", "TDEV", NULL, 0, tdev, 4},
+ {"time", "TIME", NULL, USER, cputime, 9},
+ {"tpgid", "TPGID", NULL, 0, evar, 4, EOFF(e_tpgid), ULONG, PIDFMT},
+ {"trs", "TRS", NULL, 0, trss, 3},
+ {"tsess", "TSESS", NULL, 0, evar, 6, EOFF(e_tsess), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"tsiz", "TSIZ", NULL, 0, tsize, 4},
+ {"tt", "TT", NULL, LJUST, tname, 3},
+ {"tty", "TTY", NULL, LJUST, longtname, 8},
+ {"ucomm", "UCOMM", NULL, LJUST, ucomm, MAXCOMLEN},
+ {"uid", "UID", NULL, 0, pvar, UIDLEN, POFF(p_uid),USHORT, UIDFMT},
+ {"upr", "UPR", NULL, 0, pvar, 3, POFF(p_usrpri), CHAR, "d"},
+ {"uprocp", "UPROCP", NULL, USER, uvar, 6, UOFF(u_procp), KPTR, "x"},
+ {"user", "USER", NULL, LJUST, uname, USERLEN},
+ {"usrpri", "", "upr"},
+ {"vsize", "", "vsz"},
+ {"vsz", "VSZ", NULL, 0, vsize, 5},
+ {"wchan", "WCHAN", NULL, LJUST, wchan, 6},
+ {"xstat", "XSTAT", NULL, 0, pvar, 4, POFF(p_xstat), USHORT, "x"},
+#endif
+ {""},
+};
+
+void
+showkey()
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ int i;
+ char *p, *sep;
+
+ i = 0;
+ sep = "";
+ for (v = var; *(p = v->name); ++v) {
+ int len = strlen(p);
+ if (termwidth && (i += len + 1) > termwidth) {
+ i = len;
+ sep = "\n";
+ }
+ (void) printf("%s%s", sep, p);
+ sep = " ";
+ }
+ (void) printf("\n");
+}
+
+void
+parsefmt(p)
+ char *p;
+{
+ static struct varent *vtail;
+
+#define FMTSEP " \t,\n"
+ while (p && *p) {
+ char *cp;
+ VAR *v;
+ struct varent *vent;
+
+ while ((cp = strsep(&p, FMTSEP)) != NULL && *cp == '\0')
+ /* void */;
+ if (!(v = findvar(cp)))
+ continue;
+ if ((vent = malloc(sizeof(struct varent))) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ vent->var = v;
+ vent->next = NULL;
+ if (vhead == NULL)
+ vhead = vtail = vent;
+ else {
+ vtail->next = vent;
+ vtail = vent;
+ }
+ }
+ if (!vhead)
+ errx(1, "no valid keywords");
+}
+
+static VAR *
+findvar(p)
+ char *p;
+{
+ VAR *v, key;
+ char *hp;
+ int vcmp();
+
+ key.name = p;
+
+ hp = strchr(p, '=');
+ if (hp)
+ *hp++ = '\0';
+
+ key.name = p;
+ v = bsearch(&key, var, sizeof(var)/sizeof(VAR) - 1, sizeof(VAR), vcmp);
+
+ if (v && v->alias) {
+ if (hp) {
+ warnx("%s: illegal keyword specification", p);
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ parsefmt(v->alias);
+ return ((VAR *)NULL);
+ }
+ if (!v) {
+ warnx("%s: keyword not found", p);
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ if (hp)
+ v->header = hp;
+ return (v);
+}
+
+static int
+vcmp(a, b)
+ const void *a, *b;
+{
+ return (strcmp(((VAR *)a)->name, ((VAR *)b)->name));
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/nlist.c b/bin/ps/nlist.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..11199ca
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/nlist.c
@@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)nlist.c 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/proc.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <kvm.h>
+#include <nlist.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "ps.h"
+
+#ifdef P_PPWAIT
+#define NEWVM
+#endif
+
+struct nlist psnl[] = {
+ {"_fscale"},
+#define X_FSCALE 0
+ {"_ccpu"},
+#define X_CCPU 1
+#ifdef NEWVM
+ {"_avail_start"},
+#define X_AVAILSTART 2
+ {"_avail_end"},
+#define X_AVAILEND 3
+#else
+ {"_ecmx"},
+#define X_ECMX 2
+#endif
+ {NULL}
+};
+
+fixpt_t ccpu; /* kernel _ccpu variable */
+int nlistread; /* if nlist already read. */
+int mempages; /* number of pages of phys. memory */
+int fscale; /* kernel _fscale variable */
+
+extern kvm_t *kd;
+
+#define kread(x, v) \
+ kvm_read(kd, psnl[x].n_value, (char *)&v, sizeof v) != sizeof(v)
+
+int
+donlist()
+{
+ int rval;
+#ifdef NEWVM
+ int tmp;
+#endif
+
+ rval = 0;
+ nlistread = 1;
+ if (kvm_nlist(kd, psnl)) {
+ nlisterr(psnl);
+ eval = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ if (kread(X_FSCALE, fscale)) {
+ warnx("fscale: %s", kvm_geterr(kd));
+ eval = rval = 1;
+ }
+#ifdef NEWVM
+ if (kread(X_AVAILEND, mempages)) {
+ warnx("avail_start: %s", kvm_geterr(kd));
+ eval = rval = 1;
+ }
+ if (kread(X_AVAILSTART, tmp)) {
+ warnx("avail_end: %s", kvm_geterr(kd));
+ eval = rval = 1;
+ }
+ mempages -= tmp;
+#else
+ if (kread(X_ECMX, mempages)) {
+ warnx("ecmx: %s", kvm_geterr(kd));
+ eval = rval = 1;
+ }
+#endif
+ if (kread(X_CCPU, ccpu)) {
+ warnx("ccpu: %s", kvm_geterr(kd));
+ eval = rval = 1;
+ }
+ return (rval);
+}
+
+void
+nlisterr(nl)
+ struct nlist nl[];
+{
+ int i;
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "ps: nlist: can't find following symbols:");
+ for (i = 0; nl[i].n_name != NULL; i++)
+ if (nl[i].n_value == 0)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, " %s", nl[i].n_name);
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "\n");
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/print.c b/bin/ps/print.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1208efa
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/print.c
@@ -0,0 +1,741 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)print.c 8.6 (Berkeley) 4/16/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#include <sys/proc.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#ifdef P_PPWAIT
+#define NEWVM
+#endif
+
+#ifdef NEWVM
+#include <sys/ucred.h>
+#include <sys/sysctl.h>
+#include <vm/vm.h>
+#else
+#include <machine/pte.h>
+#include <sys/vmparam.h>
+#include <sys/vm.h>
+#endif
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <math.h>
+#include <nlist.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <vis.h>
+#include <tzfile.h>
+
+#include "ps.h"
+
+void
+printheader()
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ struct varent *vent;
+
+ for (vent = vhead; vent; vent = vent->next) {
+ v = vent->var;
+ if (v->flag & LJUST) {
+ if (vent->next == NULL) /* last one */
+ (void)printf("%s", v->header);
+ else
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, v->header);
+ } else
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, v->header);
+ if (vent->next != NULL)
+ (void)putchar(' ');
+ }
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+}
+
+void
+command(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ int left;
+ char *cp, *vis_env, *vis_args;
+
+ if ((vis_args = malloc(strlen(k->ki_args) * 4 + 1)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ strvis(vis_args, k->ki_args, VIS_TAB | VIS_NL | VIS_NOSLASH);
+ if (k->ki_env) {
+ if ((vis_env = malloc(strlen(k->ki_env) * 4 + 1)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ strvis(vis_env, k->ki_env, VIS_TAB | VIS_NL | VIS_NOSLASH);
+ } else
+ vis_env = NULL;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (ve->next == NULL) {
+ /* last field */
+ if (termwidth == UNLIMITED) {
+ if (vis_env)
+ (void)printf("%s ", vis_env);
+ (void)printf("%s", vis_args);
+ } else {
+ left = termwidth - (totwidth - v->width);
+ if (left < 1) /* already wrapped, just use std width */
+ left = v->width;
+ if ((cp = vis_env) != NULL) {
+ while (--left >= 0 && *cp)
+ (void)putchar(*cp++);
+ if (--left >= 0)
+ putchar(' ');
+ }
+ for (cp = vis_args; --left >= 0 && *cp != '\0';)
+ (void)putchar(*cp++);
+ }
+ } else
+ /* XXX env? */
+ (void)printf("%-*.*s", v->width, v->width, vis_args);
+ free(vis_args);
+ if (vis_env != NULL)
+ free(vis_env);
+}
+
+void
+ucomm(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, KI_PROC(k)->p_comm);
+}
+
+void
+logname(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, KI_PROC(k)->p_logname);
+#else
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, KI_EPROC(k)->e_login);
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+state(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ struct proc *p;
+ int flag;
+ char *cp;
+ VAR *v;
+ char buf[16];
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ p = KI_PROC(k);
+ flag = p->p_flag;
+ cp = buf;
+
+ switch (p->p_stat) {
+
+ case SSTOP:
+ *cp = 'T';
+ break;
+
+ case SSLEEP:
+ if (flag & P_SINTR) /* interuptable (long) */
+ *cp = p->p_slptime >= MAXSLP ? 'I' : 'S';
+ else
+ *cp = 'D';
+ break;
+
+ case SRUN:
+ case SIDL:
+ *cp = 'R';
+ break;
+
+ case SZOMB:
+ *cp = 'Z';
+ break;
+
+ default:
+ *cp = '?';
+ }
+ cp++;
+ if (flag & P_INMEM) {
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ if (p->p_rssize > p->p_maxrss)
+ *cp++ = '>';
+#endif
+ } else
+ *cp++ = 'W';
+ if (p->p_nice < NZERO)
+ *cp++ = '<';
+ else if (p->p_nice > NZERO)
+ *cp++ = 'N';
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ if (flag & SUANOM)
+ *cp++ = 'A';
+ else if (flag & SSEQL)
+ *cp++ = 'S';
+#endif
+ if (flag & P_TRACED)
+ *cp++ = 'X';
+ if (flag & P_WEXIT && p->p_stat != SZOMB)
+ *cp++ = 'E';
+#ifdef NEWVM
+ if (flag & P_PPWAIT)
+#else
+ if (flag & SVFORK)
+#endif
+ *cp++ = 'V';
+#ifdef NEWVM
+ if (flag & (P_SYSTEM | P_NOSWAP | P_PHYSIO))
+#else
+ if (flag & (SSYS|SLOCK|SULOCK|SKEEP|SPHYSIO))
+#endif
+ *cp++ = 'L';
+ if (KI_EPROC(k)->e_flag & EPROC_SLEADER)
+ *cp++ = 's';
+ if ((flag & P_CONTROLT) && KI_EPROC(k)->e_pgid == KI_EPROC(k)->e_tpgid)
+ *cp++ = '+';
+ *cp = '\0';
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, buf);
+}
+
+void
+pri(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, KI_PROC(k)->p_priority - PZERO);
+}
+
+void
+uname(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ (void)printf("%-*s",
+ (int)v->width, user_from_uid(KI_PROC(k)->p_uid, 0));
+#else
+ (void)printf("%-*s",
+ (int)v->width, user_from_uid(KI_EPROC(k)->e_ucred.cr_uid, 0));
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+runame(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ (void)printf("%-*s",
+ (int)v->width, user_from_uid(KI_PROC(k)->p_ruid, 0));
+#else
+ (void)printf("%-*s",
+ (int)v->width, user_from_uid(KI_EPROC(k)->e_pcred.p_ruid, 0));
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+tdev(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ dev_t dev;
+ char buff[16];
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ dev = KI_EPROC(k)->e_tdev;
+ if (dev == NODEV)
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, "??");
+ else {
+ (void)snprintf(buff, sizeof(buff),
+ "%d/%d", major(dev), minor(dev));
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, buff);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+tname(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ dev_t dev;
+ char *ttname;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ dev = KI_EPROC(k)->e_tdev;
+ if (dev == NODEV || (ttname = devname(dev, S_IFCHR)) == NULL)
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, "??");
+ else {
+ if (strncmp(ttname, "tty", 3) == 0)
+ ttname += 3;
+ (void)printf("%*.*s%c", v->width-1, v->width-1, ttname,
+ KI_EPROC(k)->e_flag & EPROC_CTTY ? ' ' : '-');
+ }
+}
+
+void
+longtname(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ dev_t dev;
+ char *ttname;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ dev = KI_EPROC(k)->e_tdev;
+ if (dev == NODEV || (ttname = devname(dev, S_IFCHR)) == NULL)
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, "??");
+ else
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, ttname);
+}
+
+void
+started(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ static time_t now;
+ struct tm *tp;
+ char buf[100];
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (!k->ki_u.u_valid) {
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, "-");
+ return;
+ }
+
+ tp = localtime(&k->ki_u.u_start.tv_sec);
+ if (!now)
+ (void)time(&now);
+ if (now - k->ki_u.u_start.tv_sec < 24 * SECSPERHOUR) {
+ /* I *hate* SCCS... */
+ static char fmt[] = __CONCAT("%l:%", "M%p");
+ (void)strftime(buf, sizeof(buf) - 1, fmt, tp);
+ } else if (now - k->ki_u.u_start.tv_sec < 7 * SECSPERDAY) {
+ /* I *hate* SCCS... */
+ static char fmt[] = __CONCAT("%a%", "I%p");
+ (void)strftime(buf, sizeof(buf) - 1, fmt, tp);
+ } else
+ (void)strftime(buf, sizeof(buf) - 1, "%e%b%y", tp);
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, buf);
+}
+
+void
+lstarted(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ char buf[100];
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (!k->ki_u.u_valid) {
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, "-");
+ return;
+ }
+ (void)strftime(buf, sizeof(buf) -1, "%C",
+ localtime(&k->ki_u.u_start.tv_sec));
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, buf);
+}
+
+void
+wchan(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (KI_PROC(k)->p_wchan) {
+ if (KI_PROC(k)->p_wmesg)
+ (void)printf("%-*.*s", v->width, v->width,
+ KI_EPROC(k)->e_wmesg);
+ else
+ (void)printf("%-*x", v->width,
+ (int)KI_PROC(k)->p_wchan &~ KERNBASE);
+ } else
+ (void)printf("%-*s", v->width, "-");
+}
+
+#define pgtok(a) (((a)*NBPG)/1024)
+
+void
+vsize(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width,
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ pgtok(KI_PROC(k)->p_dsize +
+ KI_PROC(k)->p_ssize + KI_EPROC(k)->e_xsize));
+#else
+ pgtok(KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_dsize + KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_ssize +
+ KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_tsize));
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+rssize(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width,
+ pgtok(KI_PROC(k)->p_rssize + (KI_EPROC(k)->e_xccount ?
+ (KI_EPROC(k)->e_xrssize / KI_EPROC(k)->e_xccount) : 0)));
+#else
+ /* XXX don't have info about shared */
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_rssize));
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+p_rssize(k, ve) /* doesn't account for text */
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_PROC(k)->p_rssize));
+#else
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_rssize));
+#endif
+}
+
+void
+cputime(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+ long secs;
+ long psecs; /* "parts" of a second. first micro, then centi */
+ char obuff[128];
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (KI_PROC(k)->p_stat == SZOMB || !k->ki_u.u_valid) {
+ secs = 0;
+ psecs = 0;
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * This counts time spent handling interrupts. We could
+ * fix this, but it is not 100% trivial (and interrupt
+ * time fractions only work on the sparc anyway). XXX
+ */
+ secs = KI_PROC(k)->p_rtime.tv_sec;
+ psecs = KI_PROC(k)->p_rtime.tv_usec;
+ if (sumrusage) {
+ secs += k->ki_u.u_cru.ru_utime.tv_sec +
+ k->ki_u.u_cru.ru_stime.tv_sec;
+ psecs += k->ki_u.u_cru.ru_utime.tv_usec +
+ k->ki_u.u_cru.ru_stime.tv_usec;
+ }
+ /*
+ * round and scale to 100's
+ */
+ psecs = (psecs + 5000) / 10000;
+ secs += psecs / 100;
+ psecs = psecs % 100;
+ }
+ (void)snprintf(obuff, sizeof(obuff),
+ "%3ld:%02ld.%02ld", secs/60, secs%60, psecs);
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, obuff);
+}
+
+double
+getpcpu(k)
+ KINFO *k;
+{
+ struct proc *p;
+ static int failure;
+
+ if (!nlistread)
+ failure = donlist();
+ if (failure)
+ return (0.0);
+
+ p = KI_PROC(k);
+#define fxtofl(fixpt) ((double)(fixpt) / fscale)
+
+ /* XXX - I don't like this */
+ if (p->p_swtime == 0 || (p->p_flag & P_INMEM) == 0)
+ return (0.0);
+ if (rawcpu)
+ return (100.0 * fxtofl(p->p_pctcpu));
+ return (100.0 * fxtofl(p->p_pctcpu) /
+ (1.0 - exp(p->p_swtime * log(fxtofl(ccpu)))));
+}
+
+void
+pcpu(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%*.1f", v->width, getpcpu(k));
+}
+
+double
+getpmem(k)
+ KINFO *k;
+{
+ static int failure;
+ struct proc *p;
+ struct eproc *e;
+ double fracmem;
+ int szptudot;
+
+ if (!nlistread)
+ failure = donlist();
+ if (failure)
+ return (0.0);
+
+ p = KI_PROC(k);
+ e = KI_EPROC(k);
+ if ((p->p_flag & P_INMEM) == 0)
+ return (0.0);
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ szptudot = UPAGES + clrnd(ctopt(p->p_dsize + p->p_ssize + e->e_xsize));
+ fracmem = ((float)p->p_rssize + szptudot)/CLSIZE/mempages;
+ if (p->p_textp && e->e_xccount)
+ fracmem += ((float)e->e_xrssize)/CLSIZE/e->e_xccount/mempages;
+#else
+ /* XXX want pmap ptpages, segtab, etc. (per architecture) */
+ szptudot = UPAGES;
+ /* XXX don't have info about shared */
+ fracmem = ((float)e->e_vm.vm_rssize + szptudot)/CLSIZE/mempages;
+#endif
+ return (100.0 * fracmem);
+}
+
+void
+pmem(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%*.1f", v->width, getpmem(k));
+}
+
+void
+pagein(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width,
+ k->ki_u.u_valid ? k->ki_u.u_ru.ru_majflt : 0);
+}
+
+void
+maxrss(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM /* not yet */
+ if (KI_PROC(k)->p_maxrss != (RLIM_INFINITY/NBPG))
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_PROC(k)->p_maxrss));
+ else
+#endif
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, "-");
+}
+
+void
+tsize(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+#ifndef NEWVM
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_EPROC(k)->e_xsize));
+#else
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_tsize));
+#endif
+}
+
+#ifndef NEWVM
+void
+trss(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ (void)printf("%*d", v->width, pgtok(KI_EPROC(k)->e_xrssize));
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Generic output routines. Print fields from various prototype
+ * structures.
+ */
+static void
+printval(bp, v)
+ char *bp;
+ VAR *v;
+{
+ static char ofmt[32] = "%";
+ char *fcp, *cp;
+
+ cp = ofmt + 1;
+ fcp = v->fmt;
+ if (v->flag & LJUST)
+ *cp++ = '-';
+ *cp++ = '*';
+ while (*cp++ = *fcp++);
+
+ switch (v->type) {
+ case CHAR:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(char *)bp);
+ break;
+ case UCHAR:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(u_char *)bp);
+ break;
+ case SHORT:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(short *)bp);
+ break;
+ case USHORT:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(u_short *)bp);
+ break;
+ case LONG:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(long *)bp);
+ break;
+ case ULONG:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(u_long *)bp);
+ break;
+ case KPTR:
+ (void)printf(ofmt, v->width, *(u_long *)bp &~ KERNBASE);
+ break;
+ default:
+ errx(1, "unknown type %d", v->type);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+pvar(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ printval((char *)((char *)KI_PROC(k) + v->off), v);
+}
+
+void
+evar(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ printval((char *)((char *)KI_EPROC(k) + v->off), v);
+}
+
+void
+uvar(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (k->ki_u.u_valid)
+ printval((char *)((char *)&k->ki_u + v->off), v);
+ else
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, "-");
+}
+
+void
+rvar(k, ve)
+ KINFO *k;
+ VARENT *ve;
+{
+ VAR *v;
+
+ v = ve->var;
+ if (k->ki_u.u_valid)
+ printval((char *)((char *)(&k->ki_u.u_ru) + v->off), v);
+ else
+ (void)printf("%*s", v->width, "-");
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/ps.1 b/bin/ps/ps.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b0345f7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/ps.1
@@ -0,0 +1,502 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1990, 1991, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)ps.1 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt PS 1
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm \&ps
+.Nd process status
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm \&ps
+.Op Fl aCehjlmrSTuvwx
+.Op Fl M Ar core
+.Op Fl N Ar system
+.Op Fl O Ar fmt
+.Op Fl o Ar fmt
+.Op Fl p Ar pid
+.Op Fl t Ar tty
+.Op Fl W Ar swap
+.Nm ps
+.Op Fl L
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm \&Ps
+displays a header line followed by lines containing information about your
+processes that have controlling terminals.
+This information is sorted by process
+.Tn ID .
+.Pp
+The information displayed is selected based on a set of keywords (see the
+.Fl L
+.Fl O
+and
+.Fl o
+options).
+The default output format includes, for each process, the process'
+.Tn ID ,
+controlling terminal, cpu time (including both user and system time),
+state, and associated command.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It Fl a
+Display information about other users' processes as well as your own.
+.It Fl C
+Change the way the cpu percentage is calculated by using a ``raw''
+cpu calculation that ignores ``resident'' time (this normally has
+no effect).
+.It Fl e
+Display the environment as well.
+.It Fl h
+Repeat the information header as often as necessary to guarantee one
+header per page of information.
+.It Fl j
+Print information associated with the following keywords:
+user, pid, ppid, pgid, sess, jobc, state, tt, time and command.
+.It Fl L
+List the set of available keywords.
+.It Fl l
+Display information associated with the following keywords:
+uid, pid, ppid, cpu, pri, nice, vsz, rss, wchan, state, tt, time
+and command.
+.It Fl M
+Extract values associated with the name list from the specified core
+instead of the default
+.Dq Pa /dev/kmem .
+.It Fl m
+Sort by memory usage, instead of by process
+.Tn ID .
+.It Fl N
+Extract the name list from the specified system instead of the default
+.Dq Pa /vmunix .
+.It Fl O
+Add the information associated with the space or comma separated list
+of keywords specified, after the process
+.Tn ID ,
+in the default information
+display.
+Keywords may be appended with an equals (``='') sign and a string.
+This causes the printed header to use the specified string instead of
+the standard header.
+.It Fl o
+Display information associated with the space or comma separated list
+of keywords specified.
+Keywords may be appended with an equals (``='') sign and a string.
+This causes the printed header to use the specified string instead of
+the standard header.
+.It Fl p
+Display information associated with the specified process
+.Tn ID .
+.It Fl r
+Sort by current cpu usage, instead of by process
+.Tn ID .
+.It Fl S
+Change the way the process time is calculated by summing all exited
+children to their parent process.
+.It Fl T
+Display information about processes attached to the device associated
+with the standard input.
+.It Fl t
+Display information about processes attached to the specified terminal
+device.
+.It Fl u
+Display information associated with the following keywords:
+user, pid, %cpu, %mem, vsz, rss, tt, state, start, time and command.
+The
+.Fl u
+option implies the
+.Fl r
+option.
+.It Fl v
+Display information associated with the following keywords:
+pid, state, time, sl, re, pagein, vsz, rss, lim, tsiz,
+%cpu, %mem and command.
+The
+.Fl v
+option implies the
+.Fl m
+option.
+.It Fl W
+Extract swap information from the specified file instead of the
+default
+.Dq Pa /dev/swap .
+.It Fl w
+Use 132 columns to display information, instead of the default which
+is your window size.
+If the
+.Fl w
+option is specified more than once,
+.Nm \&ps
+will use as many columns as necessary without regard for your window size.
+.It Fl x
+Display information about processes without controlling terminals.
+.El
+.Pp
+A complete list of the available keywords are listed below.
+Some of these keywords are further specified as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It %cpu
+The cpu utilization of the process; this is a decaying average over up to
+a minute of previous (real) time.
+Since the time base over which this is computed varies (since processes may
+be very young) it is possible for the sum of all
+.Tn \&%CPU
+fields to exceed 100%.
+.It %mem
+The percentage of real memory used by this process.
+.It flags
+The flags (in hexadecimal) associated with the process as in
+the include file
+.Aq Pa sys/proc.h :
+.Bl -column SNOCLDSTOP SNOCLDSTOP
+.It Dv "SLOAD" Ta No "0x0000001 in core"
+.It Dv "SSYS" Ta No "0x0000002 swapper or pager process"
+.It Dv "SLOCK" Ta No "0x0000004 process being swapped out"
+.It Dv "SSWAP" Ta No "0x0000008 save area flag"
+.It Dv "STRC" Ta No "0x0000010 process is being traced"
+.It Dv "SWTED" Ta No "0x0000020 another tracing flag"
+.It Dv "SSINTR" Ta No "0x0000040 sleep is interruptible"
+.It Dv "SKEEP" Ta No "0x0000100 another flag to prevent swap out"
+.It Dv "SOMASK" Ta No "0x0000200 restore old mask after taking signal"
+.It Dv "SWEXIT" Ta No "0x0000400 working on exiting"
+.It Dv "SPHYSIO" Ta No "0x0000800 doing physical"
+.Tn I/O
+.It Dv "SVFORK" Ta No "0x0001000 process resulted from"
+.Xr vfork 2
+.It Dv "SVFDONE" Ta No "0x0002000 another"
+.Xr vfork
+flag
+.It Dv "SNOVM" Ta No "0x0004000 no vm, parent in a"
+.Xr vfork
+.It Dv "SPAGV" Ta No "0x0008000 init data space on demand, from vnode"
+.It Dv "SSEQL" Ta No "0x0010000 user warned of sequential vm behavior"
+.It Dv "SUANOM" Ta No "0x0020000 user warned of random vm behavior"
+.It Dv "STIMO" Ta No "0x0040000 timing out during sleep"
+.It Dv "SNOCLDSTOP" Ta No "0x0080000 no"
+.Dv SIGCHLD
+when children stop
+.It Dv "SCTTY" Ta No "0x0100000 has a controlling terminal"
+.It Dv "SOWEUPC" Ta No "0x0200000 owe process an addupc() call at next ast"
+.\" the routine addupc is not documented in the man pages
+.It Dv "SSEL" Ta No "0x0400000 selecting; wakeup/waiting danger"
+.It Dv "SEXEC" Ta No "0x0800000 process called"
+.Xr exec 2
+.It Dv "SHPUX" Ta No "0x1000000 \\*(tNHP-UX\\*(sP process
+.Pq Dv HPUXCOMPAT
+.It Dv "SULOCK" Ta No "0x2000000 locked in core after swap error"
+.It Dv "SPTECHG" Ta No "0x4000000 pte's for process have changed"
+.El
+.It lim
+The soft limit on memory used, specified via a call to
+.Xr setrlimit 2 .
+.It lstart
+The exact time the command started, using the ``%C'' format described in
+.Xr strftime 3 .
+.It nice
+The process scheduling increment (see
+.Xr setpriority 2 ) .
+.It rss
+the real memory (resident set) size of the process (in 1024 byte units).
+.It start
+The time the command started.
+If the command started less than 24 hours ago, the start time is
+displayed using the ``%l:ps.1p'' format described in
+.Xr strftime 3 .
+If the command started less than 7 days ago, the start time is
+displayed using the ``%a6.15p'' format.
+Otherwise, the start time is displayed using the ``%e%b%y'' format.
+.It state
+The state is given by a sequence of letters, for example,
+.Dq Tn RWNA .
+The first letter indicates the run state of the process:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
+.It D
+Marks a process in disk (or other short term, uninterruptible) wait.
+.It I
+Marks a process that is idle (sleeping for longer than about 20 seconds).
+.It R
+Marks a runnable process.
+.It S
+Marks a process that is sleeping for less than about 20 seconds.
+.It T
+Marks a stopped process.
+.It Z
+Marks a dead process (a ``zombie'').
+.El
+.Pp
+Additional characters after these, if any, indicate additional state
+information:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width indent -compact
+.It +
+The process is in the foreground process group of its control terminal.
+.It <
+The process has raised
+.Tn CPU
+scheduling priority.
+.It >
+The process has specified a soft limit on memory requirements and is
+currently exceeding that limit; such a process is (necessarily) not
+swapped.
+.It A
+the process has asked for random page replacement
+.Pf ( Dv VA_ANOM ,
+from
+.Xr vadvise 2 ,
+for example,
+.Xr lisp 1
+in a garbage collect).
+.It E
+The process is trying to exit.
+.It L
+The process has pages locked in core (for example, for raw
+.Tn I/O ) .
+.It N
+The process has reduced
+.Tn CPU
+scheduling priority (see
+.Xr setpriority 2 ) .
+.It S
+The process has asked for
+.Tn FIFO
+page replacement
+.Pf ( Dv VA_SEQL ,
+from
+.Xr vadvise 2 ,
+for example, a large image processing program using virtual memory to
+sequentially address voluminous data).
+.It s
+The process is a session leader.
+.It V
+The process is suspended during a
+.Xr vfork .
+.It W
+The process is swapped out.
+.It X
+The process is being traced or debugged.
+.El
+.It tt
+An abbreviation for the pathname of the controlling terminal, if any.
+The abbreviation consists of the two letters following
+.Dq Pa /dev/tty ,
+or, for the console, ``co''.
+This is followed by a ``-'' if the process can no longer reach that
+controlling terminal (i.e., it has been revoked).
+.It wchan
+The event (an address in the system) on which a process waits.
+When printed numerically, the initial part of the address is
+trimmed off and the result is printed in hex, for example, 0x80324000 prints
+as 324000.
+.El
+.Pp
+When printing using the command keyword, a process that has exited and
+has a parent that has not yet waited for the process (in other words, a zombie)
+is listed as ``<defunct>'', and a process which is blocked while trying
+to exit is listed as ``<exiting>''.
+.Nm \&Ps
+makes an educated guess as to the file name and arguments given when the
+process was created by examining memory or the swap area.
+The method is inherently somewhat unreliable and in any event a process
+is entitled to destroy this information, so the names cannot be depended
+on too much.
+The ucomm (accounting) keyword can, however, be depended on.
+.Sh KEYWORDS
+The following is a complete list of the available keywords and their
+meanings.
+Several of them have aliases (keywords which are synonyms).
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width sigignore -compact
+.It %cpu
+percentage cpu usage (alias pcpu)
+.It %mem
+percentage memory usage (alias pmem)
+.It acflag
+accounting flag (alias acflg)
+.It command
+command and arguments
+.It cpu
+short-term cpu usage factor (for scheduling)
+.It flags
+the process flags, in hexadecimal (alias f)
+.It inblk
+total blocks read (alias inblock)
+.It jobc
+job control count
+.It ktrace
+tracing flags
+.It ktracep
+tracing vnode
+.It lim
+memoryuse limit
+.It logname
+login name of user who started the process
+.It lstart
+time started
+.It majflt
+total page faults
+.It minflt
+total page reclaims
+.It msgrcv
+total messages received (reads from pipes/sockets)
+.It msgsnd
+total messages sent (writes on pipes/sockets)
+.It nice
+nice value (alias ni)
+.It nivcsw
+total involuntary context switches
+.It nsigs
+total signals taken (alias nsignals)
+.It nswap
+total swaps in/out
+.It nvcsw
+total voluntary context switches
+.It nwchan
+wait channel (as an address)
+.It oublk
+total blocks written (alias oublock)
+.It p_ru
+resource usage (valid only for zombie)
+.It paddr
+swap address
+.It pagein
+pageins (same as majflt)
+.It pgid
+process group number
+.It pid
+process
+.Tn ID
+.It poip
+pageouts in progress
+.It ppid
+parent process
+.Tn ID
+.It pri
+scheduling priority
+.It re
+core residency time (in seconds; 127 = infinity)
+.It rgid
+real group
+.Tn ID
+.It rlink
+reverse link on run queue, or 0
+.It rss
+resident set size
+.It rsz
+resident set size + (text size / text use count) (alias rssize)
+.It ruid
+real user
+.Tn ID
+.It ruser
+user name (from ruid)
+.It sess
+session pointer
+.It sig
+pending signals (alias pending)
+.It sigcatch
+caught signals (alias caught)
+.It sigignore
+ignored signals (alias ignored)
+.It sigmask
+blocked signals (alias blocked)
+.It sl
+sleep time (in seconds; 127 = infinity)
+.It start
+time started
+.It state
+symbolic process state (alias stat)
+.It svgid
+saved gid from a setgid executable
+.It svuid
+saved uid from a setuid executable
+.It tdev
+control terminal device number
+.It time
+accumulated cpu time, user + system (alias cputime)
+.It tpgid
+control terminal process group
+.Tn ID
+.\".It trss
+.\"text resident set size (in Kbytes)
+.It tsess
+control terminal session pointer
+.It tsiz
+text size (in Kbytes)
+.It tt
+control terminal name (two letter abbreviation)
+.It tty
+full name of control terminal
+.It uprocp
+process pointer
+.It ucomm
+name to be used for accounting
+.It uid
+effective user
+.Tn ID
+.It upr
+scheduling priority on return from system call (alias usrpri)
+.It user
+user name (from uid)
+.It vsz
+virtual size in Kbytes (alias vsize)
+.It wchan
+wait channel (as a symbolic name)
+.It xstat
+exit or stop status (valid only for stopped or zombie process)
+.El
+.Sh FILES
+.Bl -tag -width /var/run/kvm_vmunix.db -compact
+.It Pa /dev
+special files and device names
+.It Pa /dev/drum
+default swap device
+.It Pa /dev/kmem
+default kernel memory
+.It Pa /var/run/dev.db
+/dev name database
+.It Pa /var/run/kvm_vmunix.db
+system namelist database
+.It Pa /vmunix
+default system namelist
+.El
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr kill 1 ,
+.Xr w 1 ,
+.Xr kvm 3 ,
+.Xr strftime 3 ,
+.Xr pstat 8
+.Sh BUGS
+Since
+.Nm \&ps
+cannot run faster than the system and is run as any other scheduled
+process, the information it displays can never be exact.
diff --git a/bin/ps/ps.c b/bin/ps/ps.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..06d1d5f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/ps.c
@@ -0,0 +1,504 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)ps.c 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/user.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#include <sys/proc.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <sys/sysctl.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <kvm.h>
+#include <nlist.h>
+#include <paths.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "ps.h"
+
+#ifdef P_PPWAIT
+#define NEWVM
+#endif
+
+KINFO *kinfo;
+struct varent *vhead, *vtail;
+
+int eval; /* exit value */
+int rawcpu; /* -C */
+int sumrusage; /* -S */
+int termwidth; /* width of screen (0 == infinity) */
+int totwidth; /* calculated width of requested variables */
+
+static int needuser, needcomm, needenv;
+
+enum sort { DEFAULT, SORTMEM, SORTCPU } sortby = DEFAULT;
+
+static char *fmt __P((char **(*)(kvm_t *, const struct kinfo_proc *, int),
+ KINFO *, char *, int));
+static char *kludge_oldps_options __P((char *));
+static int pscomp __P((const void *, const void *));
+static void saveuser __P((KINFO *));
+static void scanvars __P((void));
+static void usage __P((void));
+
+char dfmt[] = "pid tt state time command";
+char jfmt[] = "user pid ppid pgid sess jobc state tt time command";
+char lfmt[] = "uid pid ppid cpu pri nice vsz rss wchan state tt time command";
+char o1[] = "pid";
+char o2[] = "tt state time command";
+char ufmt[] = "user pid %cpu %mem vsz rss tt state start time command";
+char vfmt[] = "pid state time sl re pagein vsz rss lim tsiz %cpu %mem command";
+
+kvm_t *kd;
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct kinfo_proc *kp;
+ struct varent *vent;
+ struct winsize ws;
+ dev_t ttydev;
+ pid_t pid;
+ uid_t uid;
+ int all, ch, flag, i, fmt, lineno, nentries;
+ int prtheader, wflag, what, xflg;
+ char *nlistf, *memf, *swapf, errbuf[256];
+
+ if ((ioctl(STDOUT_FILENO, TIOCGWINSZ, (char *)&ws) == -1 &&
+ ioctl(STDERR_FILENO, TIOCGWINSZ, (char *)&ws) == -1 &&
+ ioctl(STDIN_FILENO, TIOCGWINSZ, (char *)&ws) == -1) ||
+ ws.ws_col == 0)
+ termwidth = 79;
+ else
+ termwidth = ws.ws_col - 1;
+
+ if (argc > 1)
+ argv[1] = kludge_oldps_options(argv[1]);
+
+ all = fmt = prtheader = wflag = xflg = 0;
+ pid = -1;
+ uid = (uid_t) -1;
+ ttydev = NODEV;
+ memf = nlistf = swapf = NULL;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv,
+ "aCeghjLlM:mN:O:o:p:rSTt:uvW:wx")) != EOF)
+ switch((char)ch) {
+ case 'a':
+ all = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'e': /* XXX set ufmt */
+ needenv = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'C':
+ rawcpu = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'g':
+ break; /* no-op */
+ case 'h':
+ prtheader = ws.ws_row > 5 ? ws.ws_row : 22;
+ break;
+ case 'j':
+ parsefmt(jfmt);
+ fmt = 1;
+ jfmt[0] = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 'L':
+ showkey();
+ exit(0);
+ case 'l':
+ parsefmt(lfmt);
+ fmt = 1;
+ lfmt[0] = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 'M':
+ memf = optarg;
+ break;
+ case 'm':
+ sortby = SORTMEM;
+ break;
+ case 'N':
+ nlistf = optarg;
+ break;
+ case 'O':
+ parsefmt(o1);
+ parsefmt(optarg);
+ parsefmt(o2);
+ o1[0] = o2[0] = '\0';
+ fmt = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'o':
+ parsefmt(optarg);
+ fmt = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'p':
+ pid = atol(optarg);
+ xflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ sortby = SORTCPU;
+ break;
+ case 'S':
+ sumrusage = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'T':
+ if ((optarg = ttyname(STDIN_FILENO)) == NULL)
+ errx(1, "stdin: not a terminal");
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 't': {
+ struct stat sb;
+ char *ttypath, pathbuf[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ if (strcmp(optarg, "co") == 0)
+ ttypath = _PATH_CONSOLE;
+ else if (*optarg != '/')
+ (void)snprintf(ttypath = pathbuf,
+ sizeof(pathbuf), "%s%s", _PATH_TTY, optarg);
+ else
+ ttypath = optarg;
+ if (stat(ttypath, &sb) == -1)
+ err(1, "%s", ttypath);
+ if (!S_ISCHR(sb.st_mode))
+ errx(1, "%s: not a terminal", ttypath);
+ ttydev = sb.st_rdev;
+ break;
+ }
+ case 'u':
+ parsefmt(ufmt);
+ sortby = SORTCPU;
+ fmt = 1;
+ ufmt[0] = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 'v':
+ parsefmt(vfmt);
+ sortby = SORTMEM;
+ fmt = 1;
+ vfmt[0] = '\0';
+ break;
+ case 'W':
+ swapf = optarg;
+ break;
+ case 'w':
+ if (wflag)
+ termwidth = UNLIMITED;
+ else if (termwidth < 131)
+ termwidth = 131;
+ wflag++;
+ break;
+ case 'x':
+ xflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+#define BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY
+#ifdef BACKWARD_COMPATIBILITY
+ if (*argv) {
+ nlistf = *argv;
+ if (*++argv) {
+ memf = *argv;
+ if (*++argv)
+ swapf = *argv;
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ /*
+ * Discard setgid privileges if not the running kernel so that bad
+ * guys can't print interesting stuff from kernel memory.
+ */
+ if (nlistf != NULL || memf != NULL || swapf != NULL)
+ setgid(getgid());
+
+ kd = kvm_openfiles(nlistf, memf, swapf, O_RDONLY, errbuf);
+ if (kd == 0)
+ errx(1, "%s", errbuf);
+
+ if (!fmt)
+ parsefmt(dfmt);
+
+ if (!all && ttydev == NODEV && pid == -1) /* XXX - should be cleaner */
+ uid = getuid();
+
+ /*
+ * scan requested variables, noting what structures are needed,
+ * and adjusting header widths as appropiate.
+ */
+ scanvars();
+ /*
+ * get proc list
+ */
+ if (uid != (uid_t) -1) {
+ what = KERN_PROC_UID;
+ flag = uid;
+ } else if (ttydev != NODEV) {
+ what = KERN_PROC_TTY;
+ flag = ttydev;
+ } else if (pid != -1) {
+ what = KERN_PROC_PID;
+ flag = pid;
+ } else {
+ what = KERN_PROC_ALL;
+ flag = 0;
+ }
+ /*
+ * select procs
+ */
+ if ((kp = kvm_getprocs(kd, what, flag, &nentries)) == 0)
+ errx(1, "%s", kvm_geterr(kd));
+ if ((kinfo = malloc(nentries * sizeof(*kinfo))) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ for (i = nentries; --i >= 0; ++kp) {
+ kinfo[i].ki_p = kp;
+ if (needuser)
+ saveuser(&kinfo[i]);
+ }
+ /*
+ * print header
+ */
+ printheader();
+ if (nentries == 0)
+ exit(0);
+ /*
+ * sort proc list
+ */
+ qsort(kinfo, nentries, sizeof(KINFO), pscomp);
+ /*
+ * for each proc, call each variable output function.
+ */
+ for (i = lineno = 0; i < nentries; i++) {
+ if (xflg == 0 && (KI_EPROC(&kinfo[i])->e_tdev == NODEV ||
+ (KI_PROC(&kinfo[i])->p_flag & P_CONTROLT ) == 0))
+ continue;
+ for (vent = vhead; vent; vent = vent->next) {
+ (vent->var->oproc)(&kinfo[i], vent);
+ if (vent->next != NULL)
+ (void)putchar(' ');
+ }
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+ if (prtheader && lineno++ == prtheader - 4) {
+ (void)putchar('\n');
+ printheader();
+ lineno = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ exit(eval);
+}
+
+static void
+scanvars()
+{
+ struct varent *vent;
+ VAR *v;
+ int i;
+
+ for (vent = vhead; vent; vent = vent->next) {
+ v = vent->var;
+ i = strlen(v->header);
+ if (v->width < i)
+ v->width = i;
+ totwidth += v->width + 1; /* +1 for space */
+ if (v->flag & USER)
+ needuser = 1;
+ if (v->flag & COMM)
+ needcomm = 1;
+ }
+ totwidth--;
+}
+
+static char *
+fmt(fn, ki, comm, maxlen)
+ char **(*fn) __P((kvm_t *, const struct kinfo_proc *, int));
+ KINFO *ki;
+ char *comm;
+ int maxlen;
+{
+ char *s;
+
+ if ((s =
+ fmt_argv((*fn)(kd, ki->ki_p, termwidth), comm, maxlen)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ return (s);
+}
+
+static void
+saveuser(ki)
+ KINFO *ki;
+{
+ struct pstats pstats;
+ struct usave *usp;
+
+ usp = &ki->ki_u;
+ if (kvm_read(kd, (u_long)&KI_PROC(ki)->p_addr->u_stats,
+ (char *)&pstats, sizeof(pstats)) == sizeof(pstats)) {
+ /*
+ * The u-area might be swapped out, and we can't get
+ * at it because we have a crashdump and no swap.
+ * If it's here fill in these fields, otherwise, just
+ * leave them 0.
+ */
+ usp->u_start = pstats.p_start;
+ usp->u_ru = pstats.p_ru;
+ usp->u_cru = pstats.p_cru;
+ usp->u_valid = 1;
+ } else
+ usp->u_valid = 0;
+ /*
+ * save arguments if needed
+ */
+ if (needcomm)
+ ki->ki_args = fmt(kvm_getargv, ki, KI_PROC(ki)->p_comm,
+ MAXCOMLEN);
+ else
+ ki->ki_args = NULL;
+ if (needenv)
+ ki->ki_env = fmt(kvm_getenvv, ki, (char *)NULL, 0);
+ else
+ ki->ki_env = NULL;
+}
+
+static int
+pscomp(a, b)
+ const void *a, *b;
+{
+ int i;
+#ifdef NEWVM
+#define VSIZE(k) (KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_dsize + KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_ssize + \
+ KI_EPROC(k)->e_vm.vm_tsize)
+#else
+#define VSIZE(k) ((k)->ki_p->p_dsize + (k)->ki_p->p_ssize + (k)->ki_e->e_xsize)
+#endif
+
+ if (sortby == SORTCPU)
+ return (getpcpu((KINFO *)b) - getpcpu((KINFO *)a));
+ if (sortby == SORTMEM)
+ return (VSIZE((KINFO *)b) - VSIZE((KINFO *)a));
+ i = KI_EPROC((KINFO *)a)->e_tdev - KI_EPROC((KINFO *)b)->e_tdev;
+ if (i == 0)
+ i = KI_PROC((KINFO *)a)->p_pid - KI_PROC((KINFO *)b)->p_pid;
+ return (i);
+}
+
+/*
+ * ICK (all for getopt), would rather hide the ugliness
+ * here than taint the main code.
+ *
+ * ps foo -> ps -foo
+ * ps 34 -> ps -p34
+ *
+ * The old convention that 't' with no trailing tty arg means the users
+ * tty, is only supported if argv[1] doesn't begin with a '-'. This same
+ * feature is available with the option 'T', which takes no argument.
+ */
+static char *
+kludge_oldps_options(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ size_t len;
+ char *newopts, *ns, *cp;
+
+ len = strlen(s);
+ if ((newopts = ns = malloc(len + 2)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ /*
+ * options begin with '-'
+ */
+ if (*s != '-')
+ *ns++ = '-'; /* add option flag */
+ /*
+ * gaze to end of argv[1]
+ */
+ cp = s + len - 1;
+ /*
+ * if last letter is a 't' flag with no argument (in the context
+ * of the oldps options -- option string NOT starting with a '-' --
+ * then convert to 'T' (meaning *this* terminal, i.e. ttyname(0)).
+ */
+ if (*cp == 't' && *s != '-')
+ *cp = 'T';
+ else {
+ /*
+ * otherwise check for trailing number, which *may* be a
+ * pid.
+ */
+ while (cp >= s && isdigit(*cp))
+ --cp;
+ }
+ cp++;
+ memmove(ns, s, (size_t)(cp - s)); /* copy up to trailing number */
+ ns += cp - s;
+ /*
+ * if there's a trailing number, and not a preceding 'p' (pid) or
+ * 't' (tty) flag, then assume it's a pid and insert a 'p' flag.
+ */
+ if (isdigit(*cp) && (cp == s || cp[-1] != 't' && cp[-1] != 'p' &&
+ (cp - 1 == s || cp[-2] != 't')))
+ *ns++ = 'p';
+ (void)strcpy(ns, cp); /* and append the number */
+
+ return (newopts);
+}
+
+static void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage:\t%s\n\t %s\n\t%s\n",
+ "ps [-aChjlmrSTuvwx] [-O|o fmt] [-p pid] [-t tty]",
+ "[-M core] [-N system] [-W swap]",
+ "ps [-L]");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/ps/ps.h b/bin/ps/ps.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fe2513e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/ps/ps.h
@@ -0,0 +1,88 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)ps.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#define UNLIMITED 0 /* unlimited terminal width */
+enum type { CHAR, UCHAR, SHORT, USHORT, LONG, ULONG, KPTR };
+
+struct usave {
+ struct timeval u_start;
+ struct rusage u_ru;
+ struct rusage u_cru;
+ char u_acflag;
+ char u_valid;
+};
+
+#define KI_PROC(ki) (&(ki)->ki_p->kp_proc)
+#define KI_EPROC(ki) (&(ki)->ki_p->kp_eproc)
+
+typedef struct kinfo {
+ struct kinfo_proc *ki_p; /* proc structure */
+ struct usave ki_u; /* interesting parts of user */
+ char *ki_args; /* exec args */
+ char *ki_env; /* environment */
+} KINFO;
+
+/* Variables. */
+typedef struct varent {
+ struct varent *next;
+ struct var *var;
+} VARENT;
+
+typedef struct var {
+ char *name; /* name(s) of variable */
+ char *header; /* default header */
+ char *alias; /* aliases */
+#define COMM 0x01 /* needs exec arguments and environment (XXX) */
+#define LJUST 0x02 /* left adjust on output (trailing blanks) */
+#define USER 0x04 /* needs user structure */
+ u_int flag;
+ /* output routine */
+ void (*oproc) __P((struct kinfo *, struct varent *));
+ short width; /* printing width */
+ /*
+ * The following (optional) elements are hooks for passing information
+ * to the generic output routines: pvar, evar, uvar (those which print
+ * simple elements from well known structures: proc, eproc, usave)
+ */
+ int off; /* offset in structure */
+ enum type type; /* type of element */
+ char *fmt; /* printf format */
+ char *time; /* time format */
+ /*
+ * glue to link selected fields together
+ */
+} VAR;
+
+#include "extern.h"
diff --git a/bin/pwd/Makefile b/bin/pwd/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..06a1218
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pwd/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= pwd
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/pwd/pwd.1 b/bin/pwd/pwd.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b0d6ee3
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pwd/pwd.1
@@ -0,0 +1,68 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)pwd.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt PWD 1
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm pwd
+.Nd return working directory name
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm pwd
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Pwd
+writes the absolute pathname of the current working directory to
+the standard output.
+.Pp
+The pwd utility exits 0 on success, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm pwd
+command is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible .
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr cd 1 ,
+.Xr csh 1 ,
+.Xr getwd 3
+.Sh BUGS
+In
+.Xr csh 1
+the command
+.Ic dirs
+is always faster (although it can give a different answer in the rare case
+that the current directory or a containing directory was moved after
+the shell descended into it).
diff --git a/bin/pwd/pwd.c b/bin/pwd/pwd.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5f330c0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/pwd/pwd.c
@@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)pwd.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/1/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int ch;
+ char *p;
+
+ /*
+ * Flags for pwd are a bit strange. The POSIX 1003.2B/D9 document
+ * has an optional -P flag for physical, which is what this program
+ * will produce by default. The logical flag, -L, should fail, as
+ * there's no way to display a logical path after forking. We don't
+ * document either flag, only adding -P for future portability.
+ */
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "P")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'P':
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc != 0)
+ usage();
+
+ if ((p = getcwd(NULL, 0)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ (void)printf("%s\n", p);
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: pwd\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/rcp/Makefile b/bin/rcp/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..898f9a7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rcp/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,13 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 7/19/93
+
+PROG= rcp
+SRCS= rcp.c krcmd.c kcmd.c util.c
+CFLAGS+=-DKERBEROS -DCRYPT
+DPADD= ${LIBKRB} ${LIBDES}
+LDADD= -lkrb -ldes
+BINOWN= root
+BINMODE=4555
+INSTALLFLAGS=-fschg
+.PATH: ${.CURDIR}/../../usr.bin/rlogin
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/rcp/extern.h b/bin/rcp/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..de49dc6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rcp/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,50 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+typedef struct {
+ int cnt;
+ char *buf;
+} BUF;
+
+extern int iamremote;
+
+BUF *allocbuf __P((BUF *, int, int));
+char *colon __P((char *));
+void lostconn __P((int));
+void nospace __P((void));
+int okname __P((char *));
+void run_err __P((const char *, ...));
+int susystem __P((char *, int));
+void verifydir __P((char *));
diff --git a/bin/rcp/pathnames.h b/bin/rcp/pathnames.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c150e95
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rcp/pathnames.h
@@ -0,0 +1,39 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)pathnames.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#include <paths.h>
+
+#define _PATH_CP "/bin/cp"
+#define _PATH_RSH "/usr/bin/rsh"
diff --git a/bin/rcp/rcp.1 b/bin/rcp/rcp.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bff0a01
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rcp/rcp.1
@@ -0,0 +1,159 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1983, 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)rcp.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt RCP 1
+.Os BSD 4.3r
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm rcp
+.Nd remote file copy
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm rcp
+.Op Fl Kpx
+.Op Fl k Ar realm
+.Ar file1 file2
+.Nm rcp
+.Op Fl Kprx
+.Op Fl k Ar realm
+.Ar file ...
+.Ar directory
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Rcp
+copies files between machines. Each
+.Ar file
+or
+.Ar directory
+argument is either a remote file name of the
+form ``rname@rhost:path'', or a local file name (containing no `:' characters,
+or a `/' before any `:'s).
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl K
+The
+.Fl K
+option turns off all Kerberos authentication.
+.It Fl k
+The
+.Fl k
+option requests
+.Nm rcp
+to obtain tickets
+for the remote host in realm
+.Ar realm
+instead of the remote host's realm as determined by
+.Xr krb_realmofhost 3 .
+.It Fl p
+The
+.Fl p
+option causes
+.Nm rcp
+to attempt to preserve (duplicate) in its copies the modification
+times and modes of the source files, ignoring the
+.Ar umask .
+By default, the mode and owner of
+.Ar file2
+are preserved if it already existed; otherwise the mode of the source file
+modified by the
+.Xr umask 2
+on the destination host is used.
+.It Fl r
+If any of the source files are directories,
+.Nm rcp
+copies each subtree rooted at that name; in this case
+the destination must be a directory.
+.It Fl x
+The
+.Fl x
+option turns on
+.Tn DES
+encryption for all data passed by
+.Nm rcp .
+This may impact response time and
+.Tn CPU
+utilization, but provides
+increased security.
+.El
+.Pp
+If
+.Ar path
+is not a full path name, it is interpreted relative to
+the login directory of the specified user
+.Ar ruser
+on
+.Ar rhost ,
+or your current user name if no other remote user name is specified.
+A
+.Ar path
+on a remote host may be quoted (using \e, ", or \(aa)
+so that the metacharacters are interpreted remotely.
+.Pp
+.Nm Rcp
+does not prompt for passwords; it performs remote execution
+via
+.Xr rsh 1 ,
+and requires the same authorization.
+.Pp
+.Nm Rcp
+handles third party copies, where neither source nor target files
+are on the current machine.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr cp 1 ,
+.Xr ftp 1 ,
+.Xr rsh 1 ,
+.Xr rlogin 1
+.Sh HISTORY
+The
+.Nm rcp
+command appeared in
+.Bx 4.2 .
+The version of
+.Nm rcp
+described here
+has been reimplemented with Kerberos in
+.Bx 4.3 Reno .
+.Sh BUGS
+Doesn't detect all cases where the target of a copy might
+be a file in cases where only a directory should be legal.
+.Pp
+Is confused by any output generated by commands in a
+.Pa \&.login ,
+.Pa \&.profile ,
+or
+.Pa \&.cshrc
+file on the remote host.
+.Pp
+The destination user and hostname may have to be specified as
+``rhost.rname'' when the destination machine is running the
+.Bx 4.2
+version of
+.Nm rcp .
diff --git a/bin/rcp/rcp.c b/bin/rcp/rcp.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fc593a5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rcp/rcp.c
@@ -0,0 +1,924 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1983, 1990, 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1983, 1990, 1992, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)rcp.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/socket.h>
+#include <netinet/in.h>
+#include <netinet/in_systm.h>
+#include <netinet/ip.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <netdb.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "pathnames.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+#include <kerberosIV/des.h>
+#include <kerberosIV/krb.h>
+
+char dst_realm_buf[REALM_SZ];
+char *dest_realm = NULL;
+int use_kerberos = 1;
+CREDENTIALS cred;
+Key_schedule schedule;
+extern char *krb_realmofhost();
+#ifdef CRYPT
+int doencrypt = 0;
+#define OPTIONS "dfKk:prtx"
+#else
+#define OPTIONS "dfKk:prt"
+#endif
+#else
+#define OPTIONS "dfprt"
+#endif
+
+struct passwd *pwd;
+u_short port;
+uid_t userid;
+int errs, rem;
+int pflag, iamremote, iamrecursive, targetshouldbedirectory;
+
+#define CMDNEEDS 64
+char cmd[CMDNEEDS]; /* must hold "rcp -r -p -d\0" */
+
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+int kerberos __P((char **, char *, char *, char *));
+void oldw __P((const char *, ...));
+#endif
+int response __P((void));
+void rsource __P((char *, struct stat *));
+void sink __P((int, char *[]));
+void source __P((int, char *[]));
+void tolocal __P((int, char *[]));
+void toremote __P((char *, int, char *[]));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct servent *sp;
+ int ch, fflag, tflag;
+ char *targ, *shell;
+
+ fflag = tflag = 0;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, OPTIONS)) != EOF)
+ switch(ch) { /* User-visible flags. */
+ case 'K':
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+ use_kerberos = 0;
+#endif
+ break;
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+ case 'k':
+ dest_realm = dst_realm_buf;
+ (void)strncpy(dst_realm_buf, optarg, REALM_SZ);
+ break;
+#ifdef CRYPT
+ case 'x':
+ doencrypt = 1;
+ /* des_set_key(cred.session, schedule); */
+ break;
+#endif
+#endif
+ case 'p':
+ pflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ iamrecursive = 1;
+ break;
+ /* Server options. */
+ case 'd':
+ targetshouldbedirectory = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'f': /* "from" */
+ iamremote = 1;
+ fflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 't': /* "to" */
+ iamremote = 1;
+ tflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+ if (use_kerberos) {
+#ifdef CRYPT
+ shell = doencrypt ? "ekshell" : "kshell";
+#else
+ shell = "kshell";
+#endif
+ if ((sp = getservbyname(shell, "tcp")) == NULL) {
+ use_kerberos = 0;
+ oldw("can't get entry for %s/tcp service", shell);
+ sp = getservbyname(shell = "shell", "tcp");
+ }
+ } else
+ sp = getservbyname(shell = "shell", "tcp");
+#else
+ sp = getservbyname(shell = "shell", "tcp");
+#endif
+ if (sp == NULL)
+ errx(1, "%s/tcp: unknown service", shell);
+ port = sp->s_port;
+
+ if ((pwd = getpwuid(userid = getuid())) == NULL)
+ errx(1, "unknown user %d", (int)userid);
+
+ rem = STDIN_FILENO; /* XXX */
+
+ if (fflag) { /* Follow "protocol", send data. */
+ (void)response();
+ (void)setuid(userid);
+ source(argc, argv);
+ exit(errs);
+ }
+
+ if (tflag) { /* Receive data. */
+ (void)setuid(userid);
+ sink(argc, argv);
+ exit(errs);
+ }
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ usage();
+ if (argc > 2)
+ targetshouldbedirectory = 1;
+
+ rem = -1;
+ /* Command to be executed on remote system using "rsh". */
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+ (void)snprintf(cmd, sizeof(cmd),
+ "rcp%s%s%s%s", iamrecursive ? " -r" : "",
+#ifdef CRYPT
+ (doencrypt && use_kerberos ? " -x" : ""),
+#else
+ "",
+#endif
+ pflag ? " -p" : "", targetshouldbedirectory ? " -d" : "");
+#else
+ (void)snprintf(cmd, sizeof(cmd), "rcp%s%s%s",
+ iamrecursive ? " -r" : "", pflag ? " -p" : "",
+ targetshouldbedirectory ? " -d" : "");
+#endif
+
+ (void)signal(SIGPIPE, lostconn);
+
+ if (targ = colon(argv[argc - 1])) /* Dest is remote host. */
+ toremote(targ, argc, argv);
+ else {
+ tolocal(argc, argv); /* Dest is local host. */
+ if (targetshouldbedirectory)
+ verifydir(argv[argc - 1]);
+ }
+ exit(errs);
+}
+
+void
+toremote(targ, argc, argv)
+ char *targ, *argv[];
+ int argc;
+{
+ int i, len, tos;
+ char *bp, *host, *src, *suser, *thost, *tuser;
+
+ *targ++ = 0;
+ if (*targ == 0)
+ targ = ".";
+
+ if (thost = strchr(argv[argc - 1], '@')) {
+ /* user@host */
+ *thost++ = 0;
+ tuser = argv[argc - 1];
+ if (*tuser == '\0')
+ tuser = NULL;
+ else if (!okname(tuser))
+ exit(1);
+ } else {
+ thost = argv[argc - 1];
+ tuser = NULL;
+ }
+
+ for (i = 0; i < argc - 1; i++) {
+ src = colon(argv[i]);
+ if (src) { /* remote to remote */
+ *src++ = 0;
+ if (*src == 0)
+ src = ".";
+ host = strchr(argv[i], '@');
+ len = strlen(_PATH_RSH) + strlen(argv[i]) +
+ strlen(src) + (tuser ? strlen(tuser) : 0) +
+ strlen(thost) + strlen(targ) + CMDNEEDS + 20;
+ if (!(bp = malloc(len)))
+ err(1, NULL);
+ if (host) {
+ *host++ = 0;
+ suser = argv[i];
+ if (*suser == '\0')
+ suser = pwd->pw_name;
+ else if (!okname(suser))
+ continue;
+ (void)snprintf(bp, len,
+ "%s %s -l %s -n %s %s '%s%s%s:%s'",
+ _PATH_RSH, host, suser, cmd, src,
+ tuser ? tuser : "", tuser ? "@" : "",
+ thost, targ);
+ } else
+ (void)snprintf(bp, len,
+ "exec %s %s -n %s %s '%s%s%s:%s'",
+ _PATH_RSH, argv[i], cmd, src,
+ tuser ? tuser : "", tuser ? "@" : "",
+ thost, targ);
+ (void)susystem(bp, userid);
+ (void)free(bp);
+ } else { /* local to remote */
+ if (rem == -1) {
+ len = strlen(targ) + CMDNEEDS + 20;
+ if (!(bp = malloc(len)))
+ err(1, NULL);
+ (void)snprintf(bp, len, "%s -t %s", cmd, targ);
+ host = thost;
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+ if (use_kerberos)
+ rem = kerberos(&host, bp,
+ pwd->pw_name,
+ tuser ? tuser : pwd->pw_name);
+ else
+#endif
+ rem = rcmd(&host, port, pwd->pw_name,
+ tuser ? tuser : pwd->pw_name,
+ bp, 0);
+ if (rem < 0)
+ exit(1);
+ tos = IPTOS_THROUGHPUT;
+ if (setsockopt(rem, IPPROTO_IP, IP_TOS,
+ &tos, sizeof(int)) < 0)
+ warn("TOS (ignored)");
+ if (response() < 0)
+ exit(1);
+ (void)free(bp);
+ (void)setuid(userid);
+ }
+ source(1, argv+i);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+void
+tolocal(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int i, len, tos;
+ char *bp, *host, *src, *suser;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < argc - 1; i++) {
+ if (!(src = colon(argv[i]))) { /* Local to local. */
+ len = strlen(_PATH_CP) + strlen(argv[i]) +
+ strlen(argv[argc - 1]) + 20;
+ if (!(bp = malloc(len)))
+ err(1, NULL);
+ (void)snprintf(bp, len, "exec %s%s%s %s %s", _PATH_CP,
+ iamrecursive ? " -r" : "", pflag ? " -p" : "",
+ argv[i], argv[argc - 1]);
+ if (susystem(bp, userid))
+ ++errs;
+ (void)free(bp);
+ continue;
+ }
+ *src++ = 0;
+ if (*src == 0)
+ src = ".";
+ if ((host = strchr(argv[i], '@')) == NULL) {
+ host = argv[i];
+ suser = pwd->pw_name;
+ } else {
+ *host++ = 0;
+ suser = argv[i];
+ if (*suser == '\0')
+ suser = pwd->pw_name;
+ else if (!okname(suser))
+ continue;
+ }
+ len = strlen(src) + CMDNEEDS + 20;
+ if ((bp = malloc(len)) == NULL)
+ err(1, NULL);
+ (void)snprintf(bp, len, "%s -f %s", cmd, src);
+ rem =
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+ use_kerberos ?
+ kerberos(&host, bp, pwd->pw_name, suser) :
+#endif
+ rcmd(&host, port, pwd->pw_name, suser, bp, 0);
+ (void)free(bp);
+ if (rem < 0) {
+ ++errs;
+ continue;
+ }
+ (void)seteuid(userid);
+ tos = IPTOS_THROUGHPUT;
+ if (setsockopt(rem, IPPROTO_IP, IP_TOS, &tos, sizeof(int)) < 0)
+ warn("TOS (ignored)");
+ sink(1, argv + argc - 1);
+ (void)seteuid(0);
+ (void)close(rem);
+ rem = -1;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+source(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct stat stb;
+ static BUF buffer;
+ BUF *bp;
+ off_t i;
+ int amt, fd, haderr, indx, result;
+ char *last, *name, buf[BUFSIZ];
+
+ for (indx = 0; indx < argc; ++indx) {
+ name = argv[indx];
+ if ((fd = open(name, O_RDONLY, 0)) < 0)
+ goto syserr;
+ if (fstat(fd, &stb)) {
+syserr: run_err("%s: %s", name, strerror(errno));
+ goto next;
+ }
+ switch (stb.st_mode & S_IFMT) {
+ case S_IFREG:
+ break;
+ case S_IFDIR:
+ if (iamrecursive) {
+ rsource(name, &stb);
+ goto next;
+ }
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ default:
+ run_err("%s: not a regular file", name);
+ goto next;
+ }
+ if ((last = strrchr(name, '/')) == NULL)
+ last = name;
+ else
+ ++last;
+ if (pflag) {
+ /*
+ * Make it compatible with possible future
+ * versions expecting microseconds.
+ */
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "T%ld 0 %ld 0\n",
+ stb.st_mtimespec.ts_sec, stb.st_atimespec.ts_sec);
+ (void)write(rem, buf, strlen(buf));
+ if (response() < 0)
+ goto next;
+ }
+#define MODEMASK (S_ISUID|S_ISGID|S_ISTXT|S_IRWXU|S_IRWXG|S_IRWXO)
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "C%04o %qd %s\n",
+ stb.st_mode & MODEMASK, stb.st_size, last);
+ (void)write(rem, buf, strlen(buf));
+ if (response() < 0)
+ goto next;
+ if ((bp = allocbuf(&buffer, fd, BUFSIZ)) == NULL) {
+next: (void)close(fd);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ /* Keep writing after an error so that we stay sync'd up. */
+ for (haderr = i = 0; i < stb.st_size; i += bp->cnt) {
+ amt = bp->cnt;
+ if (i + amt > stb.st_size)
+ amt = stb.st_size - i;
+ if (!haderr) {
+ result = read(fd, bp->buf, amt);
+ if (result != amt)
+ haderr = result >= 0 ? EIO : errno;
+ }
+ if (haderr)
+ (void)write(rem, bp->buf, amt);
+ else {
+ result = write(rem, bp->buf, amt);
+ if (result != amt)
+ haderr = result >= 0 ? EIO : errno;
+ }
+ }
+ if (close(fd) && !haderr)
+ haderr = errno;
+ if (!haderr)
+ (void)write(rem, "", 1);
+ else
+ run_err("%s: %s", name, strerror(haderr));
+ (void)response();
+ }
+}
+
+void
+rsource(name, statp)
+ char *name;
+ struct stat *statp;
+{
+ DIR *dirp;
+ struct dirent *dp;
+ char *last, *vect[1], path[MAXPATHLEN];
+
+ if (!(dirp = opendir(name))) {
+ run_err("%s: %s", name, strerror(errno));
+ return;
+ }
+ last = strrchr(name, '/');
+ if (last == 0)
+ last = name;
+ else
+ last++;
+ if (pflag) {
+ (void)snprintf(path, sizeof(path), "T%ld 0 %ld 0\n",
+ statp->st_mtimespec.ts_sec, statp->st_atimespec.ts_sec);
+ (void)write(rem, path, strlen(path));
+ if (response() < 0) {
+ closedir(dirp);
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ (void)snprintf(path, sizeof(path),
+ "D%04o %d %s\n", statp->st_mode & MODEMASK, 0, last);
+ (void)write(rem, path, strlen(path));
+ if (response() < 0) {
+ closedir(dirp);
+ return;
+ }
+ while (dp = readdir(dirp)) {
+ if (dp->d_ino == 0)
+ continue;
+ if (!strcmp(dp->d_name, ".") || !strcmp(dp->d_name, ".."))
+ continue;
+ if (strlen(name) + 1 + strlen(dp->d_name) >= MAXPATHLEN - 1) {
+ run_err("%s/%s: name too long", name, dp->d_name);
+ continue;
+ }
+ (void)snprintf(path, sizeof(path), "%s/%s", name, dp->d_name);
+ vect[0] = path;
+ source(1, vect);
+ }
+ (void)closedir(dirp);
+ (void)write(rem, "E\n", 2);
+ (void)response();
+}
+
+void
+sink(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ static BUF buffer;
+ struct stat stb;
+ struct timeval tv[2];
+ enum { YES, NO, DISPLAYED } wrerr;
+ BUF *bp;
+ off_t i, j;
+ int amt, count, exists, first, mask, mode, ofd, omode;
+ int setimes, size, targisdir, wrerrno;
+ char ch, *cp, *np, *targ, *why, *vect[1], buf[BUFSIZ];
+
+#define atime tv[0]
+#define mtime tv[1]
+#define SCREWUP(str) { why = str; goto screwup; }
+
+ setimes = targisdir = 0;
+ mask = umask(0);
+ if (!pflag)
+ (void)umask(mask);
+ if (argc != 1) {
+ run_err("ambiguous target");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ targ = *argv;
+ if (targetshouldbedirectory)
+ verifydir(targ);
+ (void)write(rem, "", 1);
+ if (stat(targ, &stb) == 0 && S_ISDIR(stb.st_mode))
+ targisdir = 1;
+ for (first = 1;; first = 0) {
+ cp = buf;
+ if (read(rem, cp, 1) <= 0)
+ return;
+ if (*cp++ == '\n')
+ SCREWUP("unexpected <newline>");
+ do {
+ if (read(rem, &ch, sizeof(ch)) != sizeof(ch))
+ SCREWUP("lost connection");
+ *cp++ = ch;
+ } while (cp < &buf[BUFSIZ - 1] && ch != '\n');
+ *cp = 0;
+
+ if (buf[0] == '\01' || buf[0] == '\02') {
+ if (iamremote == 0)
+ (void)write(STDERR_FILENO,
+ buf + 1, strlen(buf + 1));
+ if (buf[0] == '\02')
+ exit(1);
+ ++errs;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (buf[0] == 'E') {
+ (void)write(rem, "", 1);
+ return;
+ }
+
+ if (ch == '\n')
+ *--cp = 0;
+
+#define getnum(t) (t) = 0; while (isdigit(*cp)) (t) = (t) * 10 + (*cp++ - '0');
+ cp = buf;
+ if (*cp == 'T') {
+ setimes++;
+ cp++;
+ getnum(mtime.tv_sec);
+ if (*cp++ != ' ')
+ SCREWUP("mtime.sec not delimited");
+ getnum(mtime.tv_usec);
+ if (*cp++ != ' ')
+ SCREWUP("mtime.usec not delimited");
+ getnum(atime.tv_sec);
+ if (*cp++ != ' ')
+ SCREWUP("atime.sec not delimited");
+ getnum(atime.tv_usec);
+ if (*cp++ != '\0')
+ SCREWUP("atime.usec not delimited");
+ (void)write(rem, "", 1);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (*cp != 'C' && *cp != 'D') {
+ /*
+ * Check for the case "rcp remote:foo\* local:bar".
+ * In this case, the line "No match." can be returned
+ * by the shell before the rcp command on the remote is
+ * executed so the ^Aerror_message convention isn't
+ * followed.
+ */
+ if (first) {
+ run_err("%s", cp);
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ SCREWUP("expected control record");
+ }
+ mode = 0;
+ for (++cp; cp < buf + 5; cp++) {
+ if (*cp < '0' || *cp > '7')
+ SCREWUP("bad mode");
+ mode = (mode << 3) | (*cp - '0');
+ }
+ if (*cp++ != ' ')
+ SCREWUP("mode not delimited");
+
+ for (size = 0; isdigit(*cp);)
+ size = size * 10 + (*cp++ - '0');
+ if (*cp++ != ' ')
+ SCREWUP("size not delimited");
+ if (targisdir) {
+ static char *namebuf;
+ static int cursize;
+ size_t need;
+
+ need = strlen(targ) + strlen(cp) + 250;
+ if (need > cursize) {
+ if (!(namebuf = malloc(need)))
+ run_err("%s", strerror(errno));
+ }
+ (void)snprintf(namebuf, need, "%s%s%s", targ,
+ *targ ? "/" : "", cp);
+ np = namebuf;
+ } else
+ np = targ;
+ exists = stat(np, &stb) == 0;
+ if (buf[0] == 'D') {
+ int mod_flag = pflag;
+ if (exists) {
+ if (!S_ISDIR(stb.st_mode)) {
+ errno = ENOTDIR;
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ if (pflag)
+ (void)chmod(np, mode);
+ } else {
+ /* Handle copying from a read-only directory */
+ mod_flag = 1;
+ if (mkdir(np, mode | S_IRWXU) < 0)
+ goto bad;
+ }
+ vect[0] = np;
+ sink(1, vect);
+ if (setimes) {
+ setimes = 0;
+ if (utimes(np, tv) < 0)
+ run_err("%s: set times: %s",
+ np, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ if (mod_flag)
+ (void)chmod(np, mode);
+ continue;
+ }
+ omode = mode;
+ mode |= S_IWRITE;
+ if ((ofd = open(np, O_WRONLY|O_CREAT, mode)) < 0) {
+bad: run_err("%s: %s", np, strerror(errno));
+ continue;
+ }
+ (void)write(rem, "", 1);
+ if ((bp = allocbuf(&buffer, ofd, BUFSIZ)) == NULL) {
+ (void)close(ofd);
+ continue;
+ }
+ cp = bp->buf;
+ wrerr = NO;
+ for (count = i = 0; i < size; i += BUFSIZ) {
+ amt = BUFSIZ;
+ if (i + amt > size)
+ amt = size - i;
+ count += amt;
+ do {
+ j = read(rem, cp, amt);
+ if (j <= 0) {
+ run_err("%s", j ? strerror(errno) :
+ "dropped connection");
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ amt -= j;
+ cp += j;
+ } while (amt > 0);
+ if (count == bp->cnt) {
+ /* Keep reading so we stay sync'd up. */
+ if (wrerr == NO) {
+ j = write(ofd, bp->buf, count);
+ if (j != count) {
+ wrerr = YES;
+ wrerrno = j >= 0 ? EIO : errno;
+ }
+ }
+ count = 0;
+ cp = bp->buf;
+ }
+ }
+ if (count != 0 && wrerr == NO &&
+ (j = write(ofd, bp->buf, count)) != count) {
+ wrerr = YES;
+ wrerrno = j >= 0 ? EIO : errno;
+ }
+ if (ftruncate(ofd, size)) {
+ run_err("%s: truncate: %s", np, strerror(errno));
+ wrerr = DISPLAYED;
+ }
+ if (pflag) {
+ if (exists || omode != mode)
+ if (fchmod(ofd, omode))
+ run_err("%s: set mode: %s",
+ np, strerror(errno));
+ } else {
+ if (!exists && omode != mode)
+ if (fchmod(ofd, omode & ~mask))
+ run_err("%s: set mode: %s",
+ np, strerror(errno));
+ }
+ (void)close(ofd);
+ (void)response();
+ if (setimes && wrerr == NO) {
+ setimes = 0;
+ if (utimes(np, tv) < 0) {
+ run_err("%s: set times: %s",
+ np, strerror(errno));
+ wrerr = DISPLAYED;
+ }
+ }
+ switch(wrerr) {
+ case YES:
+ run_err("%s: %s", np, strerror(wrerrno));
+ break;
+ case NO:
+ (void)write(rem, "", 1);
+ break;
+ case DISPLAYED:
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+screwup:
+ run_err("protocol error: %s", why);
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+int
+kerberos(host, bp, locuser, user)
+ char **host, *bp, *locuser, *user;
+{
+ struct servent *sp;
+
+again:
+ if (use_kerberos) {
+ rem = KSUCCESS;
+ errno = 0;
+ if (dest_realm == NULL)
+ dest_realm = krb_realmofhost(*host);
+ rem =
+#ifdef CRYPT
+ doencrypt ?
+ krcmd_mutual(host,
+ port, user, bp, 0, dest_realm, &cred, schedule) :
+#endif
+ krcmd(host, port, user, bp, 0, dest_realm);
+
+ if (rem < 0) {
+ use_kerberos = 0;
+ if ((sp = getservbyname("shell", "tcp")) == NULL)
+ errx(1, "unknown service shell/tcp");
+ if (errno == ECONNREFUSED)
+ oldw("remote host doesn't support Kerberos");
+ else if (errno == ENOENT)
+ oldw("can't provide Kerberos authentication data");
+ port = sp->s_port;
+ goto again;
+ }
+ } else {
+#ifdef CRYPT
+ if (doencrypt)
+ errx(1,
+ "the -x option requires Kerberos authentication");
+#endif
+ rem = rcmd(host, port, locuser, user, bp, 0);
+ }
+ return (rem);
+}
+#endif /* KERBEROS */
+
+int
+response()
+{
+ char ch, *cp, resp, rbuf[BUFSIZ];
+
+ if (read(rem, &resp, sizeof(resp)) != sizeof(resp))
+ lostconn(0);
+
+ cp = rbuf;
+ switch(resp) {
+ case 0: /* ok */
+ return (0);
+ default:
+ *cp++ = resp;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case 1: /* error, followed by error msg */
+ case 2: /* fatal error, "" */
+ do {
+ if (read(rem, &ch, sizeof(ch)) != sizeof(ch))
+ lostconn(0);
+ *cp++ = ch;
+ } while (cp < &rbuf[BUFSIZ] && ch != '\n');
+
+ if (!iamremote)
+ (void)write(STDERR_FILENO, rbuf, cp - rbuf);
+ ++errs;
+ if (resp == 1)
+ return (-1);
+ exit(1);
+ }
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+#ifdef CRYPT
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s\n\t%s\n",
+ "usage: rcp [-Kpx] [-k realm] f1 f2",
+ "or: rcp [-Kprx] [-k realm] f1 ... fn directory");
+#else
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "%s\n\t%s\n",
+ "usage: rcp [-Kp] [-k realm] f1 f2",
+ "or: rcp [-Kpr] [-k realm] f1 ... fn directory");
+#endif
+#else
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "usage: rcp [-p] f1 f2; or: rcp [-pr] f1 ... fn directory\n");
+#endif
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+#if __STDC__
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+#include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+#ifdef KERBEROS
+void
+#if __STDC__
+oldw(const char *fmt, ...)
+#else
+oldw(fmt, va_alist)
+ char *fmt;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list ap;
+#if __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+#else
+ va_start(ap);
+#endif
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "rcp: ");
+ (void)vfprintf(stderr, fmt, ap);
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, ", using standard rcp\n");
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+#endif
+
+void
+#if __STDC__
+run_err(const char *fmt, ...)
+#else
+run_err(fmt, va_alist)
+ char *fmt;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ static FILE *fp;
+ va_list ap;
+#if __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+#else
+ va_start(ap);
+#endif
+
+ ++errs;
+ if (fp == NULL && !(fp = fdopen(rem, "w")))
+ return;
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "%c", 0x01);
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "rcp: ");
+ (void)vfprintf(fp, fmt, ap);
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "\n");
+ (void)fflush(fp);
+
+ if (!iamremote)
+ vwarnx(fmt, ap);
+
+ va_end(ap);
+}
diff --git a/bin/rcp/util.c b/bin/rcp/util.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..239a9cb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rcp/util.c
@@ -0,0 +1,167 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)util.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/wait.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <paths.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "extern.h"
+
+char *
+colon(cp)
+ char *cp;
+{
+ if (*cp == ':') /* Leading colon is part of file name. */
+ return (0);
+
+ for (; *cp; ++cp) {
+ if (*cp == ':')
+ return (cp);
+ if (*cp == '/')
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+void
+verifydir(cp)
+ char *cp;
+{
+ struct stat stb;
+
+ if (!stat(cp, &stb)) {
+ if (S_ISDIR(stb.st_mode))
+ return;
+ errno = ENOTDIR;
+ }
+ run_err("%s: %s", cp, strerror(errno));
+ exit(1);
+}
+
+int
+okname(cp0)
+ char *cp0;
+{
+ int c;
+ char *cp;
+
+ cp = cp0;
+ do {
+ c = *cp;
+ if (c & 0200)
+ goto bad;
+ if (!isalpha(c) && !isdigit(c) && c != '_' && c != '-')
+ goto bad;
+ } while (*++cp);
+ return (1);
+
+bad: warnx("%s: invalid user name", cp0);
+ return (0);
+}
+
+int
+susystem(s, userid)
+ int userid;
+ char *s;
+{
+ sig_t istat, qstat;
+ int status, w;
+ pid_t pid;
+
+ pid = vfork();
+ switch (pid) {
+ case -1:
+ return (127);
+
+ case 0:
+ (void)setuid(userid);
+ execl(_PATH_BSHELL, "sh", "-c", s, NULL);
+ _exit(127);
+ }
+ istat = signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ qstat = signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ if (waitpid(pid, &status, 0) < 0)
+ status = -1;
+ (void)signal(SIGINT, istat);
+ (void)signal(SIGQUIT, qstat);
+ return (status);
+}
+
+BUF *
+allocbuf(bp, fd, blksize)
+ BUF *bp;
+ int fd, blksize;
+{
+ struct stat stb;
+ size_t size;
+
+ if (fstat(fd, &stb) < 0) {
+ run_err("fstat: %s", strerror(errno));
+ return (0);
+ }
+ size = roundup(stb.st_blksize, blksize);
+ if (size == 0)
+ size = blksize;
+ if (bp->cnt >= size)
+ return (bp);
+ if ((bp->buf = realloc(bp->buf, size)) == NULL) {
+ bp->cnt = 0;
+ run_err("%s", strerror(errno));
+ return (0);
+ }
+ bp->cnt = size;
+ return (bp);
+}
+
+void
+lostconn(signo)
+ int signo;
+{
+ if (!iamremote)
+ warnx("lost connection");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/rm/Makefile b/bin/rm/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e3c2624
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rm/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= rm
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/rm/rm.1 b/bin/rm/rm.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..6316d35
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rm/rm.1
@@ -0,0 +1,150 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)rm.1 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt RM 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm rm
+.Nd remove directory entries
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm rm
+.Op Fl f | Fl i
+.Op Fl dPRr
+.Ar file ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm rm
+utility attempts to remove the non-directory type files specified on the
+command line.
+If the permissions of the file do not permit writing, and the standard
+input device is a terminal, the user is prompted (on the standard error
+output) for confirmation.
+.Pp
+The options are as follows:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Fl d
+Attempt to remove directories as well as other types of files.
+.It Fl f
+Attempt to remove the files without prompting for confirmation,
+regardless of the file's permissions.
+If the file does not exist, do not display a diagnostic message or modify
+the exit status to reflect an error.
+The
+.Fl f
+option overrides any previous
+.Fl i
+options.
+.It Fl i
+Request confirmation before attempting to remove each file, regardless of
+the file's permissions, or whether or not the standard input device is a
+terminal.
+The
+.Fl i
+option overrides any previous
+.Fl f
+options.
+.It Fl P
+Overwrite regular files before deleting them.
+Files are overwritten three times, first with the byte pattern 0xff,
+then 0x00, and then 0xff again, before they are deleted.
+.It Fl R
+Attempt to remove the file hierarchy rooted in each file argument.
+The
+.Fl R
+option implies the
+.Fl d
+option.
+If the
+.Fl i
+option is specified, the user is prompted for confirmation before
+each directory's contents are processed (as well as before the attempt
+is made to remove the directory).
+If the user does not respond affirmatively, the file hierarchy rooted in
+that directory is skipped.
+.Pp
+.It Fl r
+Equivalent to
+.Fl R .
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm rm
+utility removes symbolic links, not the files referenced by the links.
+.Pp
+It is an error to attempt to remove the files ``.'' and ``..''.
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm rm
+utility exits 0 if all of the named files or file hierarchies were removed,
+or if the
+.Fl f
+option was specified and all of the existing files or file hierarchies were
+removed.
+If an error occurs,
+.Nm rm
+exits with a value >0.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr rmdir 1 ,
+.Xr unlink 2 ,
+.Xr fts 3 ,
+.Xr symlink 7
+.Sh BUGS
+The
+.Fl P
+option assumes that the underlying file system is a fixed-block file
+system.
+UFS is a fixed-block file system, LFS is not.
+In addition, only regular files are overwritten, other types of files
+are not.
+.Sh COMPATIBILITY
+The
+.Nm rm
+utility differs from historical implementations in that the
+.Fl f
+option only masks attempts to remove non-existent files instead of
+masking a large variety of errors.
+.Pp
+Also, historical
+.Bx
+implementations prompted on the standard output,
+not the standard error output.
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm rm
+command is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/rm/rm.c b/bin/rm/rm.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4cdf055
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rm/rm.c
@@ -0,0 +1,378 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)rm.c 8.5 (Berkeley) 4/18/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <fts.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+int dflag, eval, fflag, iflag, Pflag, stdin_ok;
+
+int check __P((char *, char *, struct stat *));
+void checkdot __P((char **));
+void rm_file __P((char **));
+void rm_overwrite __P((char *, struct stat *));
+void rm_tree __P((char **));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+/*
+ * rm --
+ * This rm is different from historic rm's, but is expected to match
+ * POSIX 1003.2 behavior. The most visible difference is that -f
+ * has two specific effects now, ignore non-existent files and force
+ * file removal.
+ */
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int ch, rflag;
+
+ Pflag = rflag = 0;
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "dfiPRr")) != EOF)
+ switch(ch) {
+ case 'd':
+ dflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ fflag = 1;
+ iflag = 0;
+ break;
+ case 'i':
+ fflag = 0;
+ iflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'P':
+ Pflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'R':
+ case 'r': /* Compatibility. */
+ rflag = 1;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc < 1)
+ usage();
+
+ checkdot(argv);
+ if (!*argv)
+ exit (eval);
+
+ stdin_ok = isatty(STDIN_FILENO);
+
+ if (rflag)
+ rm_tree(argv);
+ else
+ rm_file(argv);
+ exit (eval);
+}
+
+void
+rm_tree(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ FTS *fts;
+ FTSENT *p;
+ int needstat;
+
+ /*
+ * Remove a file hierarchy. If forcing removal (-f), or interactive
+ * (-i) or can't ask anyway (stdin_ok), don't stat the file.
+ */
+ needstat = !fflag && !iflag && stdin_ok;
+
+ /*
+ * If the -i option is specified, the user can skip on the pre-order
+ * visit. The fts_number field flags skipped directories.
+ */
+#define SKIPPED 1
+
+ if (!(fts = fts_open(argv,
+ needstat ? FTS_PHYSICAL : FTS_PHYSICAL|FTS_NOSTAT,
+ (int (*)())NULL)))
+ err(1, NULL);
+ while ((p = fts_read(fts)) != NULL) {
+ switch (p->fts_info) {
+ case FTS_DNR:
+ if (!fflag || p->fts_errno != ENOENT) {
+ warnx("%s: %s",
+ p->fts_path, strerror(p->fts_errno));
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ continue;
+ case FTS_ERR:
+ errx(1, "%s: %s", p->fts_path, strerror(p->fts_errno));
+ case FTS_NS:
+ /*
+ * FTS_NS: assume that if can't stat the file, it
+ * can't be unlinked.
+ */
+ if (!needstat)
+ break;
+ if (!fflag || p->fts_errno != ENOENT) {
+ warnx("%s: %s",
+ p->fts_path, strerror(p->fts_errno));
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ continue;
+ case FTS_D:
+ /* Pre-order: give user chance to skip. */
+ if (iflag && !check(p->fts_path, p->fts_accpath,
+ p->fts_statp)) {
+ (void)fts_set(fts, p, FTS_SKIP);
+ p->fts_number = SKIPPED;
+ }
+ continue;
+ case FTS_DP:
+ /* Post-order: see if user skipped. */
+ if (p->fts_number == SKIPPED)
+ continue;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (!fflag &&
+ !check(p->fts_path, p->fts_accpath, p->fts_statp))
+ continue;
+
+ /*
+ * If we can't read or search the directory, may still be
+ * able to remove it. Don't print out the un{read,search}able
+ * message unless the remove fails.
+ */
+ if (p->fts_info == FTS_DP || p->fts_info == FTS_DNR) {
+ if (!rmdir(p->fts_accpath))
+ continue;
+ if (errno == ENOENT) {
+ if (fflag)
+ continue;
+ } else if (p->fts_info != FTS_DP)
+ warnx("%s: unable to read", p->fts_path);
+ } else {
+ if (Pflag)
+ rm_overwrite(p->fts_accpath, NULL);
+ if (!unlink(p->fts_accpath) || fflag && errno == ENOENT)
+ continue;
+ }
+ warn("%s", p->fts_path);
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ if (errno)
+ err(1, "fts_read");
+}
+
+void
+rm_file(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+ int df, rval;
+ char *f;
+
+ df = dflag;
+ /*
+ * Remove a file. POSIX 1003.2 states that, by default, attempting
+ * to remove a directory is an error, so must always stat the file.
+ */
+ while ((f = *argv++) != NULL) {
+ /* Assume if can't stat the file, can't unlink it. */
+ if (lstat(f, &sb)) {
+ if (!fflag || errno != ENOENT) {
+ warn("%s", f);
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode) && !df) {
+ warnx("%s: is a directory", f);
+ eval = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (!fflag && !check(f, f, &sb))
+ continue;
+ if (S_ISDIR(sb.st_mode))
+ rval = rmdir(f);
+ else {
+ if (Pflag)
+ rm_overwrite(f, &sb);
+ rval = unlink(f);
+ }
+ if (rval && (!fflag || errno != ENOENT)) {
+ warn("%s", f);
+ eval = 1;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * rm_overwrite --
+ * Overwrite the file 3 times with varying bit patterns.
+ *
+ * XXX
+ * This is a cheap way to *really* delete files. Note that only regular
+ * files are deleted, directories (and therefore names) will remain.
+ * Also, this assumes a fixed-block file system (like FFS, or a V7 or a
+ * System V file system). In a logging file system, you'll have to have
+ * kernel support.
+ */
+void
+rm_overwrite(file, sbp)
+ char *file;
+ struct stat *sbp;
+{
+ struct stat sb;
+ off_t len;
+ int fd, wlen;
+ char buf[8 * 1024];
+
+ fd = -1;
+ if (sbp == NULL) {
+ if (lstat(file, &sb))
+ goto err;
+ sbp = &sb;
+ }
+ if (!S_ISREG(sbp->st_mode))
+ return;
+ if ((fd = open(file, O_WRONLY, 0)) == -1)
+ goto err;
+
+#define PASS(byte) { \
+ memset(buf, byte, sizeof(buf)); \
+ for (len = sbp->st_size; len > 0; len -= wlen) { \
+ wlen = len < sizeof(buf) ? len : sizeof(buf); \
+ if (write(fd, buf, wlen) != wlen) \
+ goto err; \
+ } \
+}
+ PASS(0xff);
+ if (fsync(fd) || lseek(fd, (off_t)0, SEEK_SET))
+ goto err;
+ PASS(0x00);
+ if (fsync(fd) || lseek(fd, (off_t)0, SEEK_SET))
+ goto err;
+ PASS(0xff);
+ if (!fsync(fd) && !close(fd))
+ return;
+
+err: eval = 1;
+ warn("%s", file);
+}
+
+
+int
+check(path, name, sp)
+ char *path, *name;
+ struct stat *sp;
+{
+ int ch, first;
+ char modep[15];
+
+ /* Check -i first. */
+ if (iflag)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "remove %s? ", path);
+ else {
+ /*
+ * If it's not a symbolic link and it's unwritable and we're
+ * talking to a terminal, ask. Symbolic links are excluded
+ * because their permissions are meaningless. Check stdin_ok
+ * first because we may not have stat'ed the file.
+ */
+ if (!stdin_ok || S_ISLNK(sp->st_mode) || !access(name, W_OK))
+ return (1);
+ strmode(sp->st_mode, modep);
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "override %s%s%s/%s for %s? ",
+ modep + 1, modep[9] == ' ' ? "" : " ",
+ user_from_uid(sp->st_uid, 0),
+ group_from_gid(sp->st_gid, 0), path);
+ }
+ (void)fflush(stderr);
+
+ first = ch = getchar();
+ while (ch != '\n' && ch != EOF)
+ ch = getchar();
+ return (first == 'y');
+}
+
+#define ISDOT(a) ((a)[0] == '.' && (!(a)[1] || (a)[1] == '.' && !(a)[2]))
+void
+checkdot(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *p, **save, **t;
+ int complained;
+
+ complained = 0;
+ for (t = argv; *t;) {
+ if ((p = strrchr(*t, '/')) != NULL)
+ ++p;
+ else
+ p = *t;
+ if (ISDOT(p)) {
+ if (!complained++)
+ warnx("\".\" and \"..\" may not be removed");
+ eval = 1;
+ for (save = t; (t[0] = t[1]) != NULL; ++t);
+ t = save;
+ } else
+ ++t;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: rm [-dfiRr] file ...\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/rmail/Makefile b/bin/rmail/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..eb2fb48
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rmail/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= rmail
+MAN8= rmail.0
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/rmail/rmail.8 b/bin/rmail/rmail.8
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2079d4e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rmail/rmail.8
@@ -0,0 +1,71 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1983, 1990 The Regents of the University of California.
+.\" All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)rmail.8 6.10 (Berkeley) 4/29/93
+.\"
+.Dd April 29, 1993
+.Dt RMAIL 8
+.Os BSD 4.2
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm rmail
+.Nd handle remote mail received via uucp
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm rmail
+.Ar user ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Rmail
+interprets incoming mail received via
+.Xr uucp 1 ,
+collapsing ``From'' lines in the form generated
+by
+.Xr mail.local 8
+into a single line of the form ``return-path!sender'',
+and passing the processed mail on to
+.Xr sendmail 8 .
+.Pp
+.Nm Rmail
+is explicitly designed for use with
+.Xr uucp
+and
+.Xr sendmail .
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr uucp 1 ,
+.Xr mail.local 8 ,
+.Xr sendmail 8
+.Sh HISTORY
+The
+.Nm rmail
+program appeared in
+.Bx 4.2 .
+.Sh BUGS
+.Nm Rmail
+should not reside in
+.Pa /bin .
diff --git a/bin/rmail/rmail.c b/bin/rmail/rmail.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..aac400a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rmail/rmail.c
@@ -0,0 +1,359 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1988, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)rmail.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * RMAIL -- UUCP mail server.
+ *
+ * This program reads the >From ... remote from ... lines that UUCP is so
+ * fond of and turns them into something reasonable. It then execs sendmail
+ * with various options built from these lines.
+ *
+ * The expected syntax is:
+ *
+ * <user> := [-a-z0-9]+
+ * <date> := ctime format
+ * <site> := [-a-z0-9!]+
+ * <blank line> := "^\n$"
+ * <from> := "From" <space> <user> <space> <date>
+ * [<space> "remote from" <space> <site>]
+ * <forward> := ">" <from>
+ * msg := <from> <forward>* <blank-line> <body>
+ *
+ * The output of rmail(8) compresses the <forward> lines into a single
+ * from path.
+ *
+ * The err(3) routine is included here deliberately to make this code
+ * a bit more portable.
+ */
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <sys/wait.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <paths.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <sysexits.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+void err __P((int, const char *, ...));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ extern char *optarg;
+ extern int errno, optind;
+ FILE *fp;
+ struct stat sb;
+ size_t fplen, fptlen, len;
+ off_t offset;
+ int ch, debug, i, pdes[2], pid, status;
+ char *addrp, *domain, *p, *t;
+ char *from_path, *from_sys, *from_user;
+ char *args[100], buf[2048], lbuf[2048];
+
+ debug = 0;
+ domain = "UUCP"; /* Default "domain". */
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "D:T")) != EOF)
+ switch (ch) {
+ case 'T':
+ debug = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'D':
+ domain = optarg;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc < 1)
+ usage();
+
+ from_path = from_sys = from_user = NULL;
+ for (offset = 0;;) {
+
+ /* Get and nul-terminate the line. */
+ if (fgets(lbuf, sizeof(lbuf), stdin) == NULL)
+ exit (EX_DATAERR);
+ if ((p = strchr(lbuf, '\n')) == NULL)
+ err(EX_DATAERR, "line too long");
+ *p = '\0';
+
+ /* Parse lines until reach a non-"From" line. */
+ if (!strncmp(lbuf, "From ", 5))
+ addrp = lbuf + 5;
+ else if (!strncmp(lbuf, ">From ", 6))
+ addrp = lbuf + 6;
+ else if (offset == 0)
+ err(EX_DATAERR,
+ "missing or empty From line: %s", lbuf);
+ else {
+ *p = '\n';
+ break;
+ }
+
+ if (*addrp == '\0')
+ err(EX_DATAERR, "corrupted From line: %s", lbuf);
+
+ /* Use the "remote from" if it exists. */
+ for (p = addrp; (p = strchr(p + 1, 'r')) != NULL;)
+ if (!strncmp(p, "remote from ", 12)) {
+ for (t = p += 12; *t && !isspace(*t); ++t);
+ *t = '\0';
+ if (debug)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "remote from: %s\n", p);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /* Else use the string up to the last bang. */
+ if (p == NULL)
+ if (*addrp == '!')
+ err(EX_DATAERR,
+ "bang starts address: %s", addrp);
+ else if ((t = strrchr(addrp, '!')) != NULL) {
+ *t = '\0';
+ p = addrp;
+ addrp = t + 1;
+ if (*addrp == '\0')
+ err(EX_DATAERR,
+ "corrupted From line: %s", lbuf);
+ if (debug)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "bang: %s\n", p);
+ }
+
+ /* 'p' now points to any system string from this line. */
+ if (p != NULL) {
+ /* Nul terminate it as necessary. */
+ for (t = p; *t && !isspace(*t); ++t);
+ *t = '\0';
+
+ /* If the first system, copy to the from_sys string. */
+ if (from_sys == NULL) {
+ if ((from_sys = strdup(p)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+ if (debug)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "from_sys: %s\n", from_sys);
+ }
+
+ /* Concatenate to the path string. */
+ len = t - p;
+ if (from_path == NULL) {
+ fplen = 0;
+ if ((from_path = malloc(fptlen = 256)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+ }
+ if (fplen + len + 2 > fptlen) {
+ fptlen += MAX(fplen + len + 2, 256);
+ if ((from_path =
+ realloc(from_path, fptlen)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+ }
+ memmove(from_path + fplen, p, len);
+ fplen += len;
+ from_path[fplen++] = '!';
+ from_path[fplen] = '\0';
+ }
+
+ /* Save off from user's address; the last one wins. */
+ for (p = addrp; *p && !isspace(*p); ++p);
+ *p = '\0';
+ if (from_user != NULL)
+ free(from_user);
+ if ((from_user = strdup(addrp)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+
+ if (debug) {
+ if (from_path != NULL)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr,
+ "from_path: %s\n", from_path);
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "from_user: %s\n", from_user);
+ }
+
+ if (offset != -1)
+ offset = (off_t)ftell(stdin);
+ }
+
+ i = 0;
+ args[i++] = _PATH_SENDMAIL; /* Build sendmail's argument list. */
+ args[i++] = "-oee"; /* No errors, just status. */
+ args[i++] = "-odq"; /* Queue it, don't try to deliver. */
+ args[i++] = "-oi"; /* Ignore '.' on a line by itself. */
+
+ if (from_sys != NULL) { /* Set sender's host name. */
+ if (strchr(from_sys, '.') == NULL)
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf),
+ "-oMs%s.%s", from_sys, domain);
+ else
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "-oMs%s", from_sys);
+ if ((args[i++] = strdup(buf)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+ }
+ /* Set protocol used. */
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "-oMr%s", domain);
+ if ((args[i++] = strdup(buf)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+
+ /* Set name of ``from'' person. */
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "-f%s%s",
+ from_path ? from_path : "", from_user);
+ if ((args[i++] = strdup(buf)) == NULL)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, NULL);
+
+ /*
+ * Don't copy arguments beginning with - as they will be
+ * passed to sendmail and could be interpreted as flags.
+ */
+ do {
+ if (*argv && **argv == '-')
+ err(EX_USAGE, "dash precedes argument: %s", *argv);
+ } while ((args[i++] = *argv++) != NULL);
+
+ if (debug) {
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "Sendmail arguments:\n");
+ for (i = 0; args[i]; i++)
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "\t%s\n", args[i]);
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If called with a regular file as standard input, seek to the right
+ * position in the file and just exec sendmail. Could probably skip
+ * skip the stat, but it's not unreasonable to believe that a failed
+ * seek will cause future reads to fail.
+ */
+ if (!fstat(STDIN_FILENO, &sb) && S_ISREG(sb.st_mode)) {
+ if (lseek(STDIN_FILENO, offset, SEEK_SET) != offset)
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, "stdin seek");
+ execv(_PATH_SENDMAIL, args);
+ err(EX_OSERR, "%s", _PATH_SENDMAIL);
+ }
+
+ if (pipe(pdes) < 0)
+ err(EX_OSERR, NULL);
+
+ switch (pid = vfork()) {
+ case -1: /* Err. */
+ err(EX_OSERR, NULL);
+ case 0: /* Child. */
+ if (pdes[0] != STDIN_FILENO) {
+ (void)dup2(pdes[0], STDIN_FILENO);
+ (void)close(pdes[0]);
+ }
+ (void)close(pdes[1]);
+ execv(_PATH_SENDMAIL, args);
+ _exit(127);
+ /* NOTREACHED */
+ }
+
+ if ((fp = fdopen(pdes[1], "w")) == NULL)
+ err(EX_OSERR, NULL);
+ (void)close(pdes[0]);
+
+ /* Copy the file down the pipe. */
+ do {
+ (void)fprintf(fp, "%s", lbuf);
+ } while (fgets(lbuf, sizeof(lbuf), stdin) != NULL);
+
+ if (ferror(stdin))
+ err(EX_TEMPFAIL, "stdin: %s", strerror(errno));
+
+ if (fclose(fp))
+ err(EX_OSERR, NULL);
+
+ if ((waitpid(pid, &status, 0)) == -1)
+ err(EX_OSERR, "%s", _PATH_SENDMAIL);
+
+ if (!WIFEXITED(status))
+ err(EX_OSERR,
+ "%s: did not terminate normally", _PATH_SENDMAIL);
+
+ if (WEXITSTATUS(status))
+ err(status, "%s: terminated with %d (non-zero) status",
+ _PATH_SENDMAIL, WEXITSTATUS(status));
+ exit(EX_OK);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: rmail [-T] [-D domain] user ...\n");
+ exit(EX_USAGE);
+}
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+#include <stdarg.h>
+#else
+#include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+
+void
+#ifdef __STDC__
+err(int eval, const char *fmt, ...)
+#else
+err(eval, fmt, va_alist)
+ int eval;
+ const char *fmt;
+ va_dcl
+#endif
+{
+ va_list ap;
+#if __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+#else
+ va_start(ap);
+#endif
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "rmail: ");
+ (void)vfprintf(stderr, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "\n");
+ exit(eval);
+}
diff --git a/bin/rmdir/Makefile b/bin/rmdir/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..12e7120
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rmdir/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= rmdir
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/rmdir/rmdir.1 b/bin/rmdir/rmdir.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7649882
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rmdir/rmdir.1
@@ -0,0 +1,92 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)rmdir.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt RMDIR 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm rmdir
+.Nd remove directories
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm rmdir
+.\" .Op Fl p
+.Ar directory ...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The rmdir utility removes the directory entry specified by
+each
+.Ar directory
+argument, provided it is empty.
+.Pp
+Arguments are processed in the order given.
+In order to remove both a parent directory and a subdirectory
+of that parent, the subdirectory
+must be specified first so the parent directory
+is empty when
+.Nm rmdir
+tries to remove it.
+.\" .Pp
+.\" The following option is available:
+.\" .Bl -tag -width Ds
+.\" .It Fl p
+.\" Each
+.\" .Ar directory
+.\" argument is treated as a pathname of which all
+.\" components will be removed, if they are empty,
+.\" starting with the last most component.
+.\" (See
+.\" .Xr rm 1
+.\" for fully non-discriminant recursive removal).
+.\" .El
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm rmdir
+utility exits with one of the following values:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Li \&0
+Each directory entry specified by a dir operand
+referred to an empty directory and was removed
+successfully.
+.It Li \&>\&0
+An error occurred.
+.El
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr rm 1
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm rmdir
+command is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/rmdir/rmdir.c b/bin/rmdir/rmdir.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f093a70
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/rmdir/rmdir.c
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1992, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)rmdir.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int ch, errors;
+
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "")) != EOF)
+ switch(ch) {
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc == 0)
+ usage();
+
+ for (errors = 0; *argv; ++argv)
+ if (rmdir(*argv) < 0) {
+ warn("%s", *argv);
+ errors = 1;
+ }
+ exit(errors);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: rmdir directory ...\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/Makefile b/bin/sh/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3114da6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 6/8/93
+
+PROG= sh
+SRCS= alias.c builtins.c cd.c echo.c error.c eval.c exec.c expand.c \
+ histedit.c input.c jobs.c mail.c main.c memalloc.c miscbltin.c \
+ mystring.c nodes.c options.c parser.c printf.c redir.c show.c \
+ signames.c syntax.c trap.c output.c var.c
+OBJS+= init.o arith.o arith_lex.o
+LDADD= -ll -ledit -ltermcap -lcompat
+LFLAGS= -8 # 8-bit lex scanner for arithmetic
+CFLAGS+=-DSHELL -I. -I${.CURDIR}
+.PATH: ${.CURDIR}/bltin ${.CURDIR}/../../usr.bin/printf
+CLEANFILES+=\
+ builtins.c builtins.h init.c mkinit mknodes mksignames mksyntax \
+ nodes.c nodes.h signames.c signames.h syntax.c syntax.h token.def \
+ y.tab.h
+
+.depend parser.o: token.def
+token.def: mktokens
+ sh ${.CURDIR}/mktokens
+
+builtins.h builtins.c: ${.CURDIR}/mkbuiltins ${.CURDIR}/builtins
+ cd ${.CURDIR}; sh mkbuiltins
+
+init.c: mkinit ${SRCS}
+ ./mkinit '${CC} -c ${CFLAGS} init.c' ${.ALLSRC}
+
+mkinit: ${.CURDIR}/mkinit.c
+ ${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${.CURDIR}/mkinit.c -o $@
+
+nodes.c nodes.h: mknodes ${.CURDIR}/nodetypes ${.CURDIR}/nodes.c.pat
+ ./mknodes ${.CURDIR}/nodetypes ${.CURDIR}/nodes.c.pat
+
+mknodes: ${.CURDIR}/mknodes.c
+ ${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${.CURDIR}/mknodes.c -o $@
+
+signames.c signames.h: mksignames
+ ./mksignames
+
+mksignames: ${.CURDIR}/mksignames.c
+ ${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${.CURDIR}/mksignames.c -o $@
+
+syntax.c syntax.h: mksyntax
+ ./mksyntax
+
+mksyntax: ${.CURDIR}/mksyntax.c ${.CURDIR}/parser.h
+ ${CC} ${CFLAGS} ${.CURDIR}/mksyntax.c -o $@
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/sh/TOUR b/bin/sh/TOUR
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3514a4e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/TOUR
@@ -0,0 +1,356 @@
+# @(#)TOUR 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+NOTE -- This is the original TOUR paper distributed with ash and
+does not represent the current state of the shell. It is provided anyway
+since it provides helpful information for how the shell is structured,
+but be warned that things have changed -- the current shell is
+still under development.
+
+================================================================
+
+ A Tour through Ash
+
+ Copyright 1989 by Kenneth Almquist.
+
+
+DIRECTORIES: The subdirectory bltin contains commands which can
+be compiled stand-alone. The rest of the source is in the main
+ash directory.
+
+SOURCE CODE GENERATORS: Files whose names begin with "mk" are
+programs that generate source code. A complete list of these
+programs is:
+
+ program intput files generates
+ ------- ------------ ---------
+ mkbuiltins builtins builtins.h builtins.c
+ mkinit *.c init.c
+ mknodes nodetypes nodes.h nodes.c
+ mksignames - signames.h signames.c
+ mksyntax - syntax.h syntax.c
+ mktokens - token.def
+ bltin/mkexpr unary_op binary_op operators.h operators.c
+
+There are undoubtedly too many of these. Mkinit searches all the
+C source files for entries looking like:
+
+ INIT {
+ x = 1; /* executed during initialization */
+ }
+
+ RESET {
+ x = 2; /* executed when the shell does a longjmp
+ back to the main command loop */
+ }
+
+ SHELLPROC {
+ x = 3; /* executed when the shell runs a shell procedure */
+ }
+
+It pulls this code out into routines which are when particular
+events occur. The intent is to improve modularity by isolating
+the information about which modules need to be explicitly
+initialized/reset within the modules themselves.
+
+Mkinit recognizes several constructs for placing declarations in
+the init.c file.
+ INCLUDE "file.h"
+includes a file. The storage class MKINIT makes a declaration
+available in the init.c file, for example:
+ MKINIT int funcnest; /* depth of function calls */
+MKINIT alone on a line introduces a structure or union declara-
+tion:
+ MKINIT
+ struct redirtab {
+ short renamed[10];
+ };
+Preprocessor #define statements are copied to init.c without any
+special action to request this.
+
+INDENTATION: The ash source is indented in multiples of six
+spaces. The only study that I have heard of on the subject con-
+cluded that the optimal amount to indent is in the range of four
+to six spaces. I use six spaces since it is not too big a jump
+from the widely used eight spaces. If you really hate six space
+indentation, use the adjind (source included) program to change
+it to something else.
+
+EXCEPTIONS: Code for dealing with exceptions appears in
+exceptions.c. The C language doesn't include exception handling,
+so I implement it using setjmp and longjmp. The global variable
+exception contains the type of exception. EXERROR is raised by
+calling error. EXINT is an interrupt. EXSHELLPROC is an excep-
+tion which is raised when a shell procedure is invoked. The pur-
+pose of EXSHELLPROC is to perform the cleanup actions associated
+with other exceptions. After these cleanup actions, the shell
+can interpret a shell procedure itself without exec'ing a new
+copy of the shell.
+
+INTERRUPTS: In an interactive shell, an interrupt will cause an
+EXINT exception to return to the main command loop. (Exception:
+EXINT is not raised if the user traps interrupts using the trap
+command.) The INTOFF and INTON macros (defined in exception.h)
+provide uninterruptable critical sections. Between the execution
+of INTOFF and the execution of INTON, interrupt signals will be
+held for later delivery. INTOFF and INTON can be nested.
+
+MEMALLOC.C: Memalloc.c defines versions of malloc and realloc
+which call error when there is no memory left. It also defines a
+stack oriented memory allocation scheme. Allocating off a stack
+is probably more efficient than allocation using malloc, but the
+big advantage is that when an exception occurs all we have to do
+to free up the memory in use at the time of the exception is to
+restore the stack pointer. The stack is implemented using a
+linked list of blocks.
+
+STPUTC: If the stack were contiguous, it would be easy to store
+strings on the stack without knowing in advance how long the
+string was going to be:
+ p = stackptr;
+ *p++ = c; /* repeated as many times as needed */
+ stackptr = p;
+The folloing three macros (defined in memalloc.h) perform these
+operations, but grow the stack if you run off the end:
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+ STPUTC(c, p); /* repeated as many times as needed */
+ grabstackstr(p);
+
+We now start a top-down look at the code:
+
+MAIN.C: The main routine performs some initialization, executes
+the user's profile if necessary, and calls cmdloop. Cmdloop is
+repeatedly parses and executes commands.
+
+OPTIONS.C: This file contains the option processing code. It is
+called from main to parse the shell arguments when the shell is
+invoked, and it also contains the set builtin. The -i and -j op-
+tions (the latter turns on job control) require changes in signal
+handling. The routines setjobctl (in jobs.c) and setinteractive
+(in trap.c) are called to handle changes to these options.
+
+PARSING: The parser code is all in parser.c. A recursive des-
+cent parser is used. Syntax tables (generated by mksyntax) are
+used to classify characters during lexical analysis. There are
+three tables: one for normal use, one for use when inside single
+quotes, and one for use when inside double quotes. The tables
+are machine dependent because they are indexed by character vari-
+ables and the range of a char varies from machine to machine.
+
+PARSE OUTPUT: The output of the parser consists of a tree of
+nodes. The various types of nodes are defined in the file node-
+types.
+
+Nodes of type NARG are used to represent both words and the con-
+tents of here documents. An early version of ash kept the con-
+tents of here documents in temporary files, but keeping here do-
+cuments in memory typically results in significantly better per-
+formance. It would have been nice to make it an option to use
+temporary files for here documents, for the benefit of small
+machines, but the code to keep track of when to delete the tem-
+porary files was complex and I never fixed all the bugs in it.
+(AT&T has been maintaining the Bourne shell for more than ten
+years, and to the best of my knowledge they still haven't gotten
+it to handle temporary files correctly in obscure cases.)
+
+The text field of a NARG structure points to the text of the
+word. The text consists of ordinary characters and a number of
+special codes defined in parser.h. The special codes are:
+
+ CTLVAR Variable substitution
+ CTLENDVAR End of variable substitution
+ CTLBACKQ Command substitution
+ CTLBACKQ|CTLQUOTE Command substitution inside double quotes
+ CTLESC Escape next character
+
+A variable substitution contains the following elements:
+
+ CTLVAR type name '=' [ alternative-text CTLENDVAR ]
+
+The type field is a single character specifying the type of sub-
+stitution. The possible types are:
+
+ VSNORMAL $var
+ VSMINUS ${var-text}
+ VSMINUS|VSNUL ${var:-text}
+ VSPLUS ${var+text}
+ VSPLUS|VSNUL ${var:+text}
+ VSQUESTION ${var?text}
+ VSQUESTION|VSNUL ${var:?text}
+ VSASSIGN ${var=text}
+ VSASSIGN|VSNUL ${var=text}
+
+In addition, the type field will have the VSQUOTE flag set if the
+variable is enclosed in double quotes. The name of the variable
+comes next, terminated by an equals sign. If the type is not
+VSNORMAL, then the text field in the substitution follows, ter-
+minated by a CTLENDVAR byte.
+
+Commands in back quotes are parsed and stored in a linked list.
+The locations of these commands in the string are indicated by
+CTLBACKQ and CTLBACKQ+CTLQUOTE characters, depending upon whether
+the back quotes were enclosed in double quotes.
+
+The character CTLESC escapes the next character, so that in case
+any of the CTL characters mentioned above appear in the input,
+they can be passed through transparently. CTLESC is also used to
+escape '*', '?', '[', and '!' characters which were quoted by the
+user and thus should not be used for file name generation.
+
+CTLESC characters have proved to be particularly tricky to get
+right. In the case of here documents which are not subject to
+variable and command substitution, the parser doesn't insert any
+CTLESC characters to begin with (so the contents of the text
+field can be written without any processing). Other here docu-
+ments, and words which are not subject to splitting and file name
+generation, have the CTLESC characters removed during the vari-
+able and command substitution phase. Words which are subject
+splitting and file name generation have the CTLESC characters re-
+moved as part of the file name phase.
+
+EXECUTION: Command execution is handled by the following files:
+ eval.c The top level routines.
+ redir.c Code to handle redirection of input and output.
+ jobs.c Code to handle forking, waiting, and job control.
+ exec.c Code to to path searches and the actual exec sys call.
+ expand.c Code to evaluate arguments.
+ var.c Maintains the variable symbol table. Called from expand.c.
+
+EVAL.C: Evaltree recursively executes a parse tree. The exit
+status is returned in the global variable exitstatus. The alter-
+native entry evalbackcmd is called to evaluate commands in back
+quotes. It saves the result in memory if the command is a buil-
+tin; otherwise it forks off a child to execute the command and
+connects the standard output of the child to a pipe.
+
+JOBS.C: To create a process, you call makejob to return a job
+structure, and then call forkshell (passing the job structure as
+an argument) to create the process. Waitforjob waits for a job
+to complete. These routines take care of process groups if job
+control is defined.
+
+REDIR.C: Ash allows file descriptors to be redirected and then
+restored without forking off a child process. This is accom-
+plished by duplicating the original file descriptors. The redir-
+tab structure records where the file descriptors have be dupli-
+cated to.
+
+EXEC.C: The routine find_command locates a command, and enters
+the command in the hash table if it is not already there. The
+third argument specifies whether it is to print an error message
+if the command is not found. (When a pipeline is set up,
+find_command is called for all the commands in the pipeline be-
+fore any forking is done, so to get the commands into the hash
+table of the parent process. But to make command hashing as
+transparent as possible, we silently ignore errors at that point
+and only print error messages if the command cannot be found
+later.)
+
+The routine shellexec is the interface to the exec system call.
+
+EXPAND.C: Arguments are processed in three passes. The first
+(performed by the routine argstr) performs variable and command
+substitution. The second (ifsbreakup) performs word splitting
+and the third (expandmeta) performs file name generation. If the
+"/u" directory is simulated, then when "/u/username" is replaced
+by the user's home directory, the flag "didudir" is set. This
+tells the cd command that it should print out the directory name,
+just as it would if the "/u" directory were implemented using
+symbolic links.
+
+VAR.C: Variables are stored in a hash table. Probably we should
+switch to extensible hashing. The variable name is stored in the
+same string as the value (using the format "name=value") so that
+no string copying is needed to create the environment of a com-
+mand. Variables which the shell references internally are preal-
+located so that the shell can reference the values of these vari-
+ables without doing a lookup.
+
+When a program is run, the code in eval.c sticks any environment
+variables which precede the command (as in "PATH=xxx command") in
+the variable table as the simplest way to strip duplicates, and
+then calls "environment" to get the value of the environment.
+There are two consequences of this. First, if an assignment to
+PATH precedes the command, the value of PATH before the assign-
+ment must be remembered and passed to shellexec. Second, if the
+program turns out to be a shell procedure, the strings from the
+environment variables which preceded the command must be pulled
+out of the table and replaced with strings obtained from malloc,
+since the former will automatically be freed when the stack (see
+the entry on memalloc.c) is emptied.
+
+BUILTIN COMMANDS: The procedures for handling these are scat-
+tered throughout the code, depending on which location appears
+most appropriate. They can be recognized because their names al-
+ways end in "cmd". The mapping from names to procedures is
+specified in the file builtins, which is processed by the mkbuil-
+tins command.
+
+A builtin command is invoked with argc and argv set up like a
+normal program. A builtin command is allowed to overwrite its
+arguments. Builtin routines can call nextopt to do option pars-
+ing. This is kind of like getopt, but you don't pass argc and
+argv to it. Builtin routines can also call error. This routine
+normally terminates the shell (or returns to the main command
+loop if the shell is interactive), but when called from a builtin
+command it causes the builtin command to terminate with an exit
+status of 2.
+
+The directory bltins contains commands which can be compiled in-
+dependently but can also be built into the shell for efficiency
+reasons. The makefile in this directory compiles these programs
+in the normal fashion (so that they can be run regardless of
+whether the invoker is ash), but also creates a library named
+bltinlib.a which can be linked with ash. The header file bltin.h
+takes care of most of the differences between the ash and the
+stand-alone environment. The user should call the main routine
+"main", and #define main to be the name of the routine to use
+when the program is linked into ash. This #define should appear
+before bltin.h is included; bltin.h will #undef main if the pro-
+gram is to be compiled stand-alone.
+
+CD.C: This file defines the cd and pwd builtins. The pwd com-
+mand runs /bin/pwd the first time it is invoked (unless the user
+has already done a cd to an absolute pathname), but then
+remembers the current directory and updates it when the cd com-
+mand is run, so subsequent pwd commands run very fast. The main
+complication in the cd command is in the docd command, which
+resolves symbolic links into actual names and informs the user
+where the user ended up if he crossed a symbolic link.
+
+SIGNALS: Trap.c implements the trap command. The routine set-
+signal figures out what action should be taken when a signal is
+received and invokes the signal system call to set the signal ac-
+tion appropriately. When a signal that a user has set a trap for
+is caught, the routine "onsig" sets a flag. The routine dotrap
+is called at appropriate points to actually handle the signal.
+When an interrupt is caught and no trap has been set for that
+signal, the routine "onint" in error.c is called.
+
+OUTPUT: Ash uses it's own output routines. There are three out-
+put structures allocated. "Output" represents the standard out-
+put, "errout" the standard error, and "memout" contains output
+which is to be stored in memory. This last is used when a buil-
+tin command appears in backquotes, to allow its output to be col-
+lected without doing any I/O through the UNIX operating system.
+The variables out1 and out2 normally point to output and errout,
+respectively, but they are set to point to memout when appropri-
+ate inside backquotes.
+
+INPUT: The basic input routine is pgetc, which reads from the
+current input file. There is a stack of input files; the current
+input file is the top file on this stack. The code allows the
+input to come from a string rather than a file. (This is for the
+-c option and the "." and eval builtin commands.) The global
+variable plinno is saved and restored when files are pushed and
+popped from the stack. The parser routines store the number of
+the current line in this variable.
+
+DEBUGGING: If DEBUG is defined in shell.h, then the shell will
+write debugging information to the file $HOME/trace. Most of
+this is done using the TRACE macro, which takes a set of printf
+arguments inside two sets of parenthesis. Example:
+"TRACE(("n=%d0, n))". The double parenthesis are necessary be-
+cause the preprocessor can't handle functions with a variable
+number of arguments. Defining DEBUG also causes the shell to
+generate a core dump if it is sent a quit signal. The tracing
+code is in show.c.
diff --git a/bin/sh/alias.c b/bin/sh/alias.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3cf38a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/alias.c
@@ -0,0 +1,251 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)alias.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "options.h" /* XXX for argptr (should remove?) */
+
+#define ATABSIZE 39
+
+struct alias *atab[ATABSIZE];
+
+STATIC struct alias **hashalias __P((char *));
+
+STATIC
+setalias(name, val)
+ char *name, *val;
+ {
+ struct alias *ap, **app;
+
+ app = hashalias(name);
+ for (ap = *app; ap; ap = ap->next) {
+ if (equal(name, ap->name)) {
+ INTOFF;
+ ckfree(ap->val);
+ ap->val = savestr(val);
+ INTON;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ /* not found */
+ INTOFF;
+ ap = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct alias));
+ ap->name = savestr(name);
+ /*
+ * XXX - HACK: in order that the parser will not finish reading the
+ * alias value off the input before processing the next alias, we
+ * dummy up an extra space at the end of the alias. This is a crock
+ * and should be re-thought. The idea (if you feel inclined to help)
+ * is to avoid alias recursions. The mechanism used is: when
+ * expanding an alias, the value of the alias is pushed back on the
+ * input as a string and a pointer to the alias is stored with the
+ * string. The alias is marked as being in use. When the input
+ * routine finishes reading the string, it markes the alias not
+ * in use. The problem is synchronization with the parser. Since
+ * it reads ahead, the alias is marked not in use before the
+ * resulting token(s) is next checked for further alias sub. The
+ * H A C K is that we add a little fluff after the alias value
+ * so that the string will not be exhausted. This is a good
+ * idea ------- ***NOT***
+ */
+#ifdef notyet
+ ap->val = savestr(val);
+#else /* hack */
+ {
+ int len = strlen(val);
+ ap->val = ckmalloc(len + 2);
+ bcopy(val, ap->val, len);
+ ap->val[len] = ' '; /* fluff */
+ ap->val[len+1] = '\0';
+ }
+#endif
+ ap->next = *app;
+ *app = ap;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+STATIC int
+unalias(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ struct alias *ap, **app;
+
+ app = hashalias(name);
+
+ for (ap = *app; ap; app = &(ap->next), ap = ap->next) {
+ if (equal(name, ap->name)) {
+ /*
+ * if the alias is currently in use (i.e. its
+ * buffer is being used by the input routine) we
+ * just null out the name instead of freeing it.
+ * We could clear it out later, but this situation
+ * is so rare that it hardly seems worth it.
+ */
+ if (ap->flag & ALIASINUSE)
+ *ap->name = '\0';
+ else {
+ INTOFF;
+ *app = ap->next;
+ ckfree(ap->name);
+ ckfree(ap->val);
+ ckfree(ap);
+ INTON;
+ }
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (1);
+}
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+MKINIT void rmaliases();
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ rmaliases();
+}
+#endif
+
+void
+rmaliases() {
+ struct alias *ap, *tmp;
+ int i;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (i = 0; i < ATABSIZE; i++) {
+ ap = atab[i];
+ atab[i] = NULL;
+ while (ap) {
+ ckfree(ap->name);
+ ckfree(ap->val);
+ tmp = ap;
+ ap = ap->next;
+ ckfree(tmp);
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+struct alias *
+lookupalias(name, check)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ struct alias *ap = *hashalias(name);
+
+ for (; ap; ap = ap->next) {
+ if (equal(name, ap->name)) {
+ if (check && (ap->flag & ALIASINUSE))
+ return (NULL);
+ return (ap);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (NULL);
+}
+
+/*
+ * TODO - sort output
+ */
+aliascmd(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+ {
+ char *n, *v;
+ int ret = 0;
+ struct alias *ap;
+
+ if (argc == 1) {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < ATABSIZE; i++)
+ for (ap = atab[i]; ap; ap = ap->next) {
+ if (*ap->name != '\0')
+ out1fmt("alias %s=%s\n", ap->name, ap->val);
+ }
+ return (0);
+ }
+ while (n = *++argv) {
+ if ((v = strchr(n+1, '=')) == NULL) /* n+1: funny ksh stuff */
+ if ((ap = lookupalias(n, 0)) == NULL) {
+ outfmt(out2, "alias: %s not found\n", n);
+ ret = 1;
+ } else
+ out1fmt("alias %s=%s\n", n, ap->val);
+ else {
+ *v++ = '\0';
+ setalias(n, v);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (ret);
+}
+
+unaliascmd(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+ {
+ int i;
+
+ while ((i = nextopt("a")) != '\0') {
+ if (i == 'a') {
+ rmaliases();
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+ for (i = 0; *argptr; argptr++)
+ i = unalias(*argptr);
+
+ return (i);
+}
+
+STATIC struct alias **
+hashalias(p)
+ register char *p;
+ {
+ unsigned int hashval;
+
+ hashval = *p << 4;
+ while (*p)
+ hashval+= *p++;
+ return &atab[hashval % ATABSIZE];
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/alias.h b/bin/sh/alias.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..adc56a9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/alias.h
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)alias.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#define ALIASINUSE 1
+
+struct alias {
+ struct alias *next;
+ char *name;
+ char *val;
+ int flag;
+};
+
+struct alias *lookupalias();
diff --git a/bin/sh/arith.y b/bin/sh/arith.y
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4b2e78f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/arith.y
@@ -0,0 +1,169 @@
+%token ARITH_OR ARITH_AND ARITH_ADD ARITH_SUBT ARITH_MULT ARITH_DIV ARITH_REM ARITH_EQ ARITH_GT ARITH_GEQ ARITH_LT ARITH_LEQ ARITH_NEQ
+%token ARITH_NUM ARITH_LPAREN ARITH_RPAREN ARITH_NOT ARITH_UNARYMINUS
+
+%left ARITH_OR
+%left ARITH_AND
+%left ARITH_EQ ARITH_NEQ
+%left ARITH_LT ARITH_GT ARITH_GEQ ARITH_LEQ
+%left ARITH_ADD ARITH_SUBT
+%left ARITH_MULT ARITH_DIV ARITH_REM
+%left ARITH_UNARYMINUS ARITH_NOT
+%%
+
+exp: expr = {
+ return ($1);
+ }
+ ;
+
+
+expr: ARITH_LPAREN expr ARITH_RPAREN = { $$ = $2; }
+ | expr ARITH_OR expr = { $$ = $1 ? $1 : $3 ? $3 : 0; }
+ | expr ARITH_AND expr = { $$ = $1 ? ( $3 ? $3 : 0 ) : 0; }
+ | expr ARITH_EQ expr = { $$ = $1 == $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_GT expr = { $$ = $1 > $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_GEQ expr = { $$ = $1 >= $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_LT expr = { $$ = $1 < $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_LEQ expr = { $$ = $1 <= $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_NEQ expr = { $$ = $1 != $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_ADD expr = { $$ = $1 + $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_SUBT expr = { $$ = $1 - $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_MULT expr = { $$ = $1 * $3; }
+ | expr ARITH_DIV expr = {
+ if ($3 == 0)
+ yyerror("division by zero");
+ $$ = $1 / $3;
+ }
+ | expr ARITH_REM expr = { $$ = $1 % $3; }
+ | ARITH_NOT expr = { $$ = !($2); }
+ | ARITH_UNARYMINUS expr = { $$ = -($2); }
+ | ARITH_NUM
+ ;
+%%
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)arith.y 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+
+char *arith_buf, *arith_startbuf;
+
+arith(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ extern arith_wasoper;
+ long result;
+
+ arith_wasoper = 1;
+ arith_buf = arith_startbuf = s;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ result = yyparse();
+ arith_lex_reset(); /* reprime lex */
+ INTON;
+
+ return (result);
+}
+
+yyerror(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ extern yytext, yylval;
+
+ yyerrok;
+ yyclearin;
+ arith_lex_reset(); /* reprime lex */
+ error("arithmetic expression: %s: \"%s\"", s, arith_startbuf);
+}
+
+/*
+ * The exp(1) builtin.
+ */
+expcmd(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *p;
+ char *concat;
+ char **ap;
+ long i;
+
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ p = argv[1];
+ if (argc > 2) {
+ /*
+ * concatenate arguments
+ */
+ STARTSTACKSTR(concat);
+ ap = argv + 2;
+ for (;;) {
+ while (*p)
+ STPUTC(*p++, concat);
+ if ((p = *ap++) == NULL)
+ break;
+ STPUTC(' ', concat);
+ }
+ STPUTC('\0', concat);
+ p = grabstackstr(concat);
+ }
+ } else
+ p = "";
+
+ i = arith(p);
+
+ out1fmt("%d\n", i);
+ return (! i);
+}
+
+/*************************/
+#ifdef TEST_ARITH
+#include <stdio.h>
+main(argc, argv)
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ printf("%d\n", exp(argv[1]));
+}
+error(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ fprintf(stderr, "exp: %s\n", s);
+ exit(1);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/arith_lex.l b/bin/sh/arith_lex.l
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0fb1c7b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/arith_lex.l
@@ -0,0 +1,86 @@
+%{
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)arith_lex.l 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "y.tab.h"
+
+extern yylval;
+extern char *arith_buf, *arith_startbuf;
+int arith_wasoper;
+#undef YY_INPUT
+#define YY_INPUT(buf,result,max) \
+ result = (*buf = *arith_buf++) ? 1 : YY_NULL;
+%}
+
+%%
+[ \t\n] { ; }
+[0-9]+ { arith_wasoper = 0; yylval = atol(yytext); return(ARITH_NUM); }
+"(" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_LPAREN); }
+")" { arith_wasoper = 0; return(ARITH_RPAREN); }
+"||" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_OR); }
+"&&" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_AND); }
+"==" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_EQ); }
+">" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_GT); }
+">=" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_GEQ); }
+"<" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_LT); }
+"<=" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_LEQ); }
+"!=" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_NEQ); }
+"*" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_MULT); }
+"/" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_DIV); }
+"%" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_REM); }
+"+" { if (!arith_wasoper) { /* ignore unary plus */
+ arith_wasoper = 1;
+ return(ARITH_ADD);
+ }
+ }
+"-" { if (arith_wasoper) {
+ return(ARITH_UNARYMINUS);
+ } else {
+ arith_wasoper = 1;
+ return(ARITH_SUBT);
+ }
+ }
+"!" { arith_wasoper = 1; return(ARITH_NOT); }
+. { error("arith: syntax error: \"%s\"\n", arith_startbuf); }
+%%
+
+arith_lex_reset() {
+ YY_NEW_FILE;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/bltin/bltin.h b/bin/sh/bltin/bltin.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c8bf8d5
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/bltin/bltin.h
@@ -0,0 +1,74 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)bltin.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * This file is included by programs which are optionally built into the
+ * shell. If SHELL is defined, we try to map the standard UNIX library
+ * routines to ash routines using defines.
+ */
+
+#include "../shell.h"
+#include "../mystring.h"
+#ifdef SHELL
+#include "../output.h"
+#define stdout out1
+#define stderr out2
+#define printf out1fmt
+#define putc(c, file) outc(c, file)
+#define putchar(c) out1c(c)
+#define fprintf outfmt
+#define fputs outstr
+#define fflush flushout
+#define INITARGS(argv)
+#else
+#undef NULL
+#include <stdio.h>
+#undef main
+#define INITARGS(argv) if ((commandname = argv[0]) == NULL) {fputs("Argc is zero\n", stderr); exit(2);} else
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+pointer stalloc(int);
+void error(char *, ...);
+#else
+pointer stalloc();
+void error();
+#endif
+
+
+extern char *commandname;
diff --git a/bin/sh/bltin/echo.1 b/bin/sh/bltin/echo.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d2cb8d1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/bltin/echo.1
@@ -0,0 +1,111 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" Kenneth Almquist.
+.\" Copyright 1989 by Kenneth Almquist
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)echo.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt ECHO 1
+.Os BSD 4.4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm echo
+.Nd produce message in a shell script
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm echo
+.Op Fl n | Fl e
+.Ar args...
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Echo
+prints its arguments on the standard output, separated by spaces.
+Unless the
+.Fl n
+option is present, a newline is output following the arguments.
+The
+.Fl e
+option causes
+.Nm echo
+to treat the escape sequences specially, as described in the following
+paragraph.
+The
+.Fl e
+option is the default, and is provided solely for compatibility with
+other systems.
+Only one of the options
+.Fl n
+and
+.Fl e
+may be given.
+.Pp
+If any of the following sequences of characters is encountered during
+output, the sequence is not output. Instead, the specified action is
+performed:
+.Bl -tag -width indent
+.It Li \eb
+A backspace character is output.
+.It Li \ec
+Subsequent output is suppressed. This is normally used at the end of the
+last argument to suppress the trailing newline that
+.Nm echo
+would otherwise output.
+.It Li \ef
+Output a form feed.
+.It Li \en
+Output a newline character.
+.It Li \er
+Output a carriage return.
+.It Li \et
+Output a (horizontal) tab character.
+.It Li \ev
+Output a vertical tab.
+.It Li \e0 Ns Ar digits
+Output the character whose value is given by zero to three digits.
+If there are zero digits, a nul character is output.
+.It Li \e\e
+Output a backslash.
+.El
+.Sh HINTS
+Remember that backslash is special to the shell and needs to be escaped.
+To output a message to standard error, say
+.Pp
+.D1 echo message >&2
+.Sh BUGS
+The octal character escape mechanism
+.Pq Li \e0 Ns Ar digits
+differs from the
+C language mechanism.
+.Pp
+There is no way to force
+.Nm echo
+to treat its arguments literally, rather than interpreting them as
+options and escape sequences.
diff --git a/bin/sh/bltin/echo.c b/bin/sh/bltin/echo.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c1d8970
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/bltin/echo.c
@@ -0,0 +1,104 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)echo.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Echo command.
+ */
+
+#define main echocmd
+
+#include "bltin.h"
+
+/* #define eflag 1 */
+
+main(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ register char **ap;
+ register char *p;
+ register char c;
+ int count;
+ int nflag = 0;
+#ifndef eflag
+ int eflag = 0;
+#endif
+
+ ap = argv;
+ if (argc)
+ ap++;
+ if ((p = *ap) != NULL) {
+ if (equal(p, "-n")) {
+ nflag++;
+ ap++;
+ } else if (equal(p, "-e")) {
+#ifndef eflag
+ eflag++;
+#endif
+ ap++;
+ }
+ }
+ while ((p = *ap++) != NULL) {
+ while ((c = *p++) != '\0') {
+ if (c == '\\' && eflag) {
+ switch (*p++) {
+ case 'b': c = '\b'; break;
+ case 'c': return 0; /* exit */
+ case 'f': c = '\f'; break;
+ case 'n': c = '\n'; break;
+ case 'r': c = '\r'; break;
+ case 't': c = '\t'; break;
+ case 'v': c = '\v'; break;
+ case '\\': break; /* c = '\\' */
+ case '0':
+ c = 0;
+ count = 3;
+ while (--count >= 0 && (unsigned)(*p - '0') < 8)
+ c = (c << 3) + (*p++ - '0');
+ break;
+ default:
+ p--;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ putchar(c);
+ }
+ if (*ap)
+ putchar(' ');
+ }
+ if (! nflag)
+ putchar('\n');
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/builtins b/bin/sh/builtins
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..57409b1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/builtins
@@ -0,0 +1,90 @@
+#!/bin/sh -
+#
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)builtins 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+#
+# This file lists all the builtin commands. The first column is the name
+# of a C routine. The -j flag, if present, specifies that this command
+# is to be excluded from systems without job control. The rest of the line
+# specifies the command name or names used to run the command. The entry
+# for bltincmd, which is run when the user does not specify a command, must
+# come first.
+#
+# Copyright (C) 1989 by Kenneth Almquist. All rights reserved.
+# This file is part of ash, which is distributed under the terms specified
+# by the Ash General Public License. See the file named LICENSE.
+#
+# NOTE: bltincmd must come first!
+
+bltincmd command
+#alloccmd alloc
+bgcmd -j bg
+breakcmd break continue
+#catfcmd catf
+cdcmd cd chdir
+dotcmd .
+echocmd echo
+evalcmd eval
+execcmd exec
+exitcmd exit
+expcmd exp let
+exportcmd export readonly
+#exprcmd expr test [
+histcmd fc
+fgcmd -j fg
+getoptscmd getopts
+hashcmd hash
+jobidcmd jobid
+jobscmd jobs
+#linecmd line
+localcmd local
+#nlechocmd nlecho
+printfcmd printf
+pwdcmd pwd
+readcmd read
+returncmd return
+setcmd set
+setvarcmd setvar
+shiftcmd shift
+trapcmd trap
+truecmd : true
+umaskcmd umask
+unaliascmd unalias
+unsetcmd unset
+waitcmd wait
+#foocmd foo
+aliascmd alias
diff --git a/bin/sh/cd.c b/bin/sh/cd.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d1984d9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/cd.c
@@ -0,0 +1,372 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cd.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * The cd and pwd commands.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "nodes.h" /* for jobs.h */
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC int docd(char *, int);
+STATIC void updatepwd(char *);
+STATIC void getpwd(void);
+STATIC char *getcomponent(void);
+#else
+STATIC int docd();
+STATIC void updatepwd();
+STATIC void getpwd();
+STATIC char *getcomponent();
+#endif
+
+
+char *curdir; /* current working directory */
+char *prevdir; /* previous working directory */
+STATIC char *cdcomppath;
+
+int
+cdcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ char *dest;
+ char *path;
+ char *p;
+ struct stat statb;
+ char *padvance();
+ int print = 0;
+
+ nextopt(nullstr);
+ if ((dest = *argptr) == NULL && (dest = bltinlookup("HOME", 1)) == NULL)
+ error("HOME not set");
+ if (dest[0] == '-' && dest[1] == '\0') {
+ dest = prevdir ? prevdir : curdir;
+ print = 1;
+ }
+ if (*dest == '/' || (path = bltinlookup("CDPATH", 1)) == NULL)
+ path = nullstr;
+ while ((p = padvance(&path, dest)) != NULL) {
+ if (stat(p, &statb) >= 0
+ && (statb.st_mode & S_IFMT) == S_IFDIR) {
+ if (!print) {
+ /*
+ * XXX - rethink
+ */
+ if (p[0] == '.' && p[1] == '/')
+ p += 2;
+ print = strcmp(p, dest);
+ }
+ if (docd(p, print) >= 0)
+ return 0;
+
+ }
+ }
+ error("can't cd to %s", dest);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Actually do the chdir. If the name refers to symbolic links, we
+ * compute the actual directory name before doing the cd. In an
+ * interactive shell, print the directory name if "print" is nonzero
+ * or if the name refers to a symbolic link. We also print the name
+ * if "/u/logname" was expanded in it, since this is similar to a
+ * symbolic link. (The check for this breaks if the user gives the
+ * cd command some additional, unused arguments.)
+ */
+
+#if SYMLINKS == 0
+STATIC int
+docd(dest, print)
+ char *dest;
+ {
+ INTOFF;
+ if (chdir(dest) < 0) {
+ INTON;
+ return -1;
+ }
+ updatepwd(dest);
+ INTON;
+ if (print && iflag)
+ out1fmt("%s\n", stackblock());
+ return 0;
+}
+
+#else
+
+
+
+STATIC int
+docd(dest, print)
+ char *dest;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+ register char *q;
+ char *symlink;
+ char *component;
+ struct stat statb;
+ int first;
+ int i;
+
+ TRACE(("docd(\"%s\", %d) called\n", dest, print));
+
+top:
+ cdcomppath = dest;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+ if (*dest == '/') {
+ STPUTC('/', p);
+ cdcomppath++;
+ }
+ first = 1;
+ while ((q = getcomponent()) != NULL) {
+ if (q[0] == '\0' || q[0] == '.' && q[1] == '\0')
+ continue;
+ if (! first)
+ STPUTC('/', p);
+ first = 0;
+ component = q;
+ while (*q)
+ STPUTC(*q++, p);
+ if (equal(component, ".."))
+ continue;
+ STACKSTRNUL(p);
+ if (lstat(stackblock(), &statb) < 0)
+ error("lstat %s failed", stackblock());
+ if ((statb.st_mode & S_IFMT) != S_IFLNK)
+ continue;
+
+ /* Hit a symbolic link. We have to start all over again. */
+ print = 1;
+ STPUTC('\0', p);
+ symlink = grabstackstr(p);
+ i = (int)statb.st_size + 2; /* 2 for '/' and '\0' */
+ if (cdcomppath != NULL)
+ i += strlen(cdcomppath);
+ p = stalloc(i);
+ if (readlink(symlink, p, (int)statb.st_size) < 0) {
+ error("readlink %s failed", stackblock());
+ }
+ if (cdcomppath != NULL) {
+ p[(int)statb.st_size] = '/';
+ scopy(cdcomppath, p + (int)statb.st_size + 1);
+ } else {
+ p[(int)statb.st_size] = '\0';
+ }
+ if (p[0] != '/') { /* relative path name */
+ char *r;
+ q = r = symlink;
+ while (*q) {
+ if (*q++ == '/')
+ r = q;
+ }
+ *r = '\0';
+ dest = stalloc(strlen(symlink) + strlen(p) + 1);
+ scopy(symlink, dest);
+ strcat(dest, p);
+ } else {
+ dest = p;
+ }
+ goto top;
+ }
+ STPUTC('\0', p);
+ p = grabstackstr(p);
+ INTOFF;
+ if (chdir(p) < 0) {
+ INTON;
+ return -1;
+ }
+ updatepwd(p);
+ INTON;
+ if (print && iflag)
+ out1fmt("%s\n", p);
+ return 0;
+}
+#endif /* SYMLINKS */
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Get the next component of the path name pointed to by cdcomppath.
+ * This routine overwrites the string pointed to by cdcomppath.
+ */
+
+STATIC char *
+getcomponent() {
+ register char *p;
+ char *start;
+
+ if ((p = cdcomppath) == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+ start = cdcomppath;
+ while (*p != '/' && *p != '\0')
+ p++;
+ if (*p == '\0') {
+ cdcomppath = NULL;
+ } else {
+ *p++ = '\0';
+ cdcomppath = p;
+ }
+ return start;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Update curdir (the name of the current directory) in response to a
+ * cd command. We also call hashcd to let the routines in exec.c know
+ * that the current directory has changed.
+ */
+
+void hashcd();
+
+STATIC void
+updatepwd(dir)
+ char *dir;
+ {
+ char *new;
+ char *p;
+
+ hashcd(); /* update command hash table */
+ cdcomppath = stalloc(strlen(dir) + 1);
+ scopy(dir, cdcomppath);
+ STARTSTACKSTR(new);
+ if (*dir != '/') {
+ if (curdir == NULL)
+ return;
+ p = curdir;
+ while (*p)
+ STPUTC(*p++, new);
+ if (p[-1] == '/')
+ STUNPUTC(new);
+ }
+ while ((p = getcomponent()) != NULL) {
+ if (equal(p, "..")) {
+ while (new > stackblock() && (STUNPUTC(new), *new) != '/');
+ } else if (*p != '\0' && ! equal(p, ".")) {
+ STPUTC('/', new);
+ while (*p)
+ STPUTC(*p++, new);
+ }
+ }
+ if (new == stackblock())
+ STPUTC('/', new);
+ STACKSTRNUL(new);
+ INTOFF;
+ if (prevdir)
+ ckfree(prevdir);
+ prevdir = curdir;
+ curdir = savestr(stackblock());
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+int
+pwdcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ getpwd();
+ out1str(curdir);
+ out1c('\n');
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Run /bin/pwd to find out what the current directory is. We suppress
+ * interrupts throughout most of this, but the user can still break out
+ * of it by killing the pwd program. If we already know the current
+ * directory, this routine returns immediately.
+ */
+
+#define MAXPWD 256
+
+STATIC void
+getpwd() {
+ char buf[MAXPWD];
+ char *p;
+ int i;
+ int status;
+ struct job *jp;
+ int pip[2];
+
+ if (curdir)
+ return;
+ INTOFF;
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0)
+ error("Pipe call failed");
+ jp = makejob((union node *)NULL, 1);
+ if (forkshell(jp, (union node *)NULL, FORK_NOJOB) == 0) {
+ close(pip[0]);
+ if (pip[1] != 1) {
+ close(1);
+ copyfd(pip[1], 1);
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ execl("/bin/pwd", "pwd", (char *)0);
+ error("Cannot exec /bin/pwd");
+ }
+ close(pip[1]);
+ pip[1] = -1;
+ p = buf;
+ while ((i = read(pip[0], p, buf + MAXPWD - p)) > 0
+ || i == -1 && errno == EINTR) {
+ if (i > 0)
+ p += i;
+ }
+ close(pip[0]);
+ pip[0] = -1;
+ status = waitforjob(jp);
+ if (status != 0)
+ error((char *)0);
+ if (i < 0 || p == buf || p[-1] != '\n')
+ error("pwd command failed");
+ p[-1] = '\0';
+ curdir = savestr(buf);
+ INTON;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/errmsg.c b/bin/sh/errmsg.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2a0303b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/errmsg.c
@@ -0,0 +1,127 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)errmsg.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "errmsg.h"
+#include <errno.h>
+
+
+#define ALL (E_OPEN|E_CREAT|E_EXEC)
+
+
+struct errname {
+ short errcode; /* error number */
+ short action; /* operation which encountered the error */
+ char *msg; /* text describing the error */
+};
+
+
+STATIC const struct errname errormsg[] = {
+ EINTR, ALL, "interrupted",
+ EACCES, ALL, "permission denied",
+ EIO, ALL, "I/O error",
+ ENOENT, E_OPEN, "no such file",
+ ENOENT, E_CREAT, "directory nonexistent",
+ ENOENT, E_EXEC, "not found",
+ ENOTDIR, E_OPEN, "no such file",
+ ENOTDIR, E_CREAT, "directory nonexistent",
+ ENOTDIR, E_EXEC, "not found",
+ EISDIR, ALL, "is a directory",
+/* EMFILE, ALL, "too many open files", */
+ ENFILE, ALL, "file table overflow",
+ ENOSPC, ALL, "file system full",
+#ifdef EDQUOT
+ EDQUOT, ALL, "disk quota exceeded",
+#endif
+#ifdef ENOSR
+ ENOSR, ALL, "no streams resources",
+#endif
+ ENXIO, ALL, "no such device or address",
+ EROFS, ALL, "read-only file system",
+ ETXTBSY, ALL, "text busy",
+#ifdef SYSV
+ EAGAIN, E_EXEC, "not enough memory",
+#endif
+ ENOMEM, ALL, "not enough memory",
+#ifdef ENOLINK
+ ENOLINK, ALL, "remote access failed"
+#endif
+#ifdef EMULTIHOP
+ EMULTIHOP, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ECOMM
+ ECOMM, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ESTALE
+ ESTALE, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ETIMEDOUT
+ ETIMEDOUT, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ELOOP
+ ELOOP, ALL, "symbolic link loop",
+#endif
+ E2BIG, E_EXEC, "argument list too long",
+#ifdef ELIBACC
+ ELIBACC, E_EXEC, "shared library missing",
+#endif
+ 0, 0, NULL
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * Return a string describing an error. The returned string may be a
+ * pointer to a static buffer that will be overwritten on the next call.
+ * Action describes the operation that got the error.
+ */
+
+char *
+errmsg(e, action) {
+ struct errname const *ep;
+ static char buf[12];
+
+ for (ep = errormsg ; ep->errcode ; ep++) {
+ if (ep->errcode == e && (ep->action & action) != 0)
+ return ep->msg;
+ }
+ fmtstr(buf, sizeof buf, "error %d", e);
+ return buf;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/errmsg.h b/bin/sh/errmsg.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..03cb605
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/errmsg.h
@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)errmsg.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#define E_OPEN 01
+#define E_CREAT 02
+#define E_EXEC 04
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+char *errmsg(int, int);
+#else
+char *errmsg();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/error.c b/bin/sh/error.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b6853b6
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/error.c
@@ -0,0 +1,249 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)error.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Errors and exceptions.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include <signal.h>
+#ifdef __STDC__
+#include "stdarg.h"
+#else
+#include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+#include <errno.h>
+
+
+/*
+ * Code to handle exceptions in C.
+ */
+
+struct jmploc *handler;
+int exception;
+volatile int suppressint;
+volatile int intpending;
+char *commandname;
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to raise an exception. Since C doesn't include exceptions, we
+ * just do a longjmp to the exception handler. The type of exception is
+ * stored in the global variable "exception".
+ */
+
+void
+exraise(e) {
+ if (handler == NULL)
+ abort();
+ exception = e;
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called from trap.c when a SIGINT is received. (If the user specifies
+ * that SIGINT is to be trapped or ignored using the trap builtin, then
+ * this routine is not called.) Suppressint is nonzero when interrupts
+ * are held using the INTOFF macro. The call to _exit is necessary because
+ * there is a short period after a fork before the signal handlers are
+ * set to the appropriate value for the child. (The test for iflag is
+ * just defensive programming.)
+ */
+
+void
+onint() {
+ if (suppressint) {
+ intpending++;
+ return;
+ }
+ intpending = 0;
+#ifdef BSD
+ sigsetmask(0);
+#endif
+ if (rootshell && iflag)
+ exraise(EXINT);
+ else
+ _exit(128 + SIGINT);
+}
+
+
+
+void
+error2(a, b)
+ char *a, *b;
+ {
+ error("%s: %s", a, b);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Error is called to raise the error exception. If the first argument
+ * is not NULL then error prints an error message using printf style
+ * formatting. It then raises the error exception.
+ */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void
+error(char *msg, ...) {
+#else
+void
+error(va_alist)
+ va_dcl
+ {
+ char *msg;
+#endif
+ va_list ap;
+
+ CLEAR_PENDING_INT;
+ INTOFF;
+#ifdef __STDC__
+ va_start(ap, msg);
+#else
+ va_start(ap);
+ msg = va_arg(ap, char *);
+#endif
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (msg)
+ TRACE(("error(\"%s\") pid=%d\n", msg, getpid()));
+ else
+ TRACE(("error(NULL) pid=%d\n", getpid()));
+#endif
+ if (msg) {
+ if (commandname)
+ outfmt(&errout, "%s: ", commandname);
+ doformat(&errout, msg, ap);
+ out2c('\n');
+ }
+ va_end(ap);
+ flushall();
+ exraise(EXERROR);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Table of error messages.
+ */
+
+struct errname {
+ short errcode; /* error number */
+ short action; /* operation which encountered the error */
+ char *msg; /* text describing the error */
+};
+
+
+#define ALL (E_OPEN|E_CREAT|E_EXEC)
+
+STATIC const struct errname errormsg[] = {
+ EINTR, ALL, "interrupted",
+ EACCES, ALL, "permission denied",
+ EIO, ALL, "I/O error",
+ ENOENT, E_OPEN, "no such file",
+ ENOENT, E_CREAT, "directory nonexistent",
+ ENOENT, E_EXEC, "not found",
+ ENOTDIR, E_OPEN, "no such file",
+ ENOTDIR, E_CREAT, "directory nonexistent",
+ ENOTDIR, E_EXEC, "not found",
+ EISDIR, ALL, "is a directory",
+/* EMFILE, ALL, "too many open files", */
+ ENFILE, ALL, "file table overflow",
+ ENOSPC, ALL, "file system full",
+#ifdef EDQUOT
+ EDQUOT, ALL, "disk quota exceeded",
+#endif
+#ifdef ENOSR
+ ENOSR, ALL, "no streams resources",
+#endif
+ ENXIO, ALL, "no such device or address",
+ EROFS, ALL, "read-only file system",
+ ETXTBSY, ALL, "text busy",
+#ifdef SYSV
+ EAGAIN, E_EXEC, "not enough memory",
+#endif
+ ENOMEM, ALL, "not enough memory",
+#ifdef ENOLINK
+ ENOLINK, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef EMULTIHOP
+ EMULTIHOP, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ECOMM
+ ECOMM, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ESTALE
+ ESTALE, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ETIMEDOUT
+ ETIMEDOUT, ALL, "remote access failed",
+#endif
+#ifdef ELOOP
+ ELOOP, ALL, "symbolic link loop",
+#endif
+ E2BIG, E_EXEC, "argument list too long",
+#ifdef ELIBACC
+ ELIBACC, E_EXEC, "shared library missing",
+#endif
+ 0, 0, NULL
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * Return a string describing an error. The returned string may be a
+ * pointer to a static buffer that will be overwritten on the next call.
+ * Action describes the operation that got the error.
+ */
+
+char *
+errmsg(e, action) {
+ struct errname const *ep;
+ static char buf[12];
+
+ for (ep = errormsg ; ep->errcode ; ep++) {
+ if (ep->errcode == e && (ep->action & action) != 0)
+ return ep->msg;
+ }
+ fmtstr(buf, sizeof buf, "error %d", e);
+ return buf;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/error.h b/bin/sh/error.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8f87caf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/error.h
@@ -0,0 +1,113 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)error.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Types of operations (passed to the errmsg routine).
+ */
+
+#define E_OPEN 01 /* opening a file */
+#define E_CREAT 02 /* creating a file */
+#define E_EXEC 04 /* executing a program */
+
+
+/*
+ * We enclose jmp_buf in a structure so that we can declare pointers to
+ * jump locations. The global variable handler contains the location to
+ * jump to when an exception occurs, and the global variable exception
+ * contains a code identifying the exeception. To implement nested
+ * exception handlers, the user should save the value of handler on entry
+ * to an inner scope, set handler to point to a jmploc structure for the
+ * inner scope, and restore handler on exit from the scope.
+ */
+
+#include <setjmp.h>
+
+struct jmploc {
+ jmp_buf loc;
+};
+
+extern struct jmploc *handler;
+extern int exception;
+
+/* exceptions */
+#define EXINT 0 /* SIGINT received */
+#define EXERROR 1 /* a generic error */
+#define EXSHELLPROC 2 /* execute a shell procedure */
+
+
+/*
+ * These macros allow the user to suspend the handling of interrupt signals
+ * over a period of time. This is similar to SIGHOLD to or sigblock, but
+ * much more efficient and portable. (But hacking the kernel is so much
+ * more fun than worrying about efficiency and portability. :-))
+ */
+
+extern volatile int suppressint;
+extern volatile int intpending;
+extern char *commandname; /* name of command--printed on error */
+
+#define INTOFF suppressint++
+#define INTON if (--suppressint == 0 && intpending) onint(); else
+#define FORCEINTON {suppressint = 0; if (intpending) onint();}
+#define CLEAR_PENDING_INT intpending = 0
+#define int_pending() intpending
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void exraise(int);
+void onint(void);
+void error2(char *, char *);
+void error(char *, ...);
+char *errmsg(int, int);
+#else
+void exraise();
+void onint();
+void error2();
+void error();
+char *errmsg();
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * BSD setjmp saves the signal mask, which violates ANSI C and takes time,
+ * so we use _setjmp instead.
+ */
+
+#ifdef BSD
+#define setjmp(jmploc) _setjmp(jmploc)
+#define longjmp(jmploc, val) _longjmp(jmploc, val)
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/eval.c b/bin/sh/eval.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..48a9f99
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/eval.c
@@ -0,0 +1,933 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)eval.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Evaluate a command.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+#include <signal.h>
+
+
+/* flags in argument to evaltree */
+#define EV_EXIT 01 /* exit after evaluating tree */
+#define EV_TESTED 02 /* exit status is checked; ignore -e flag */
+#define EV_BACKCMD 04 /* command executing within back quotes */
+
+
+/* reasons for skipping commands (see comment on breakcmd routine) */
+#define SKIPBREAK 1
+#define SKIPCONT 2
+#define SKIPFUNC 3
+
+MKINIT int evalskip; /* set if we are skipping commands */
+STATIC int skipcount; /* number of levels to skip */
+MKINIT int loopnest; /* current loop nesting level */
+int funcnest; /* depth of function calls */
+
+
+char *commandname;
+struct strlist *cmdenviron;
+int exitstatus; /* exit status of last command */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void evalloop(union node *);
+STATIC void evalfor(union node *);
+STATIC void evalcase(union node *, int);
+STATIC void evalsubshell(union node *, int);
+STATIC void expredir(union node *);
+STATIC void evalpipe(union node *);
+STATIC void evalcommand(union node *, int, struct backcmd *);
+STATIC void prehash(union node *);
+#else
+STATIC void evalloop();
+STATIC void evalfor();
+STATIC void evalcase();
+STATIC void evalsubshell();
+STATIC void expredir();
+STATIC void evalpipe();
+STATIC void evalcommand();
+STATIC void prehash();
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to reset things after an exception.
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "eval.h"
+
+RESET {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ loopnest = 0;
+ funcnest = 0;
+}
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ exitstatus = 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The eval commmand.
+ */
+
+evalcmd(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ char *p;
+ char *concat;
+ char **ap;
+
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ p = argv[1];
+ if (argc > 2) {
+ STARTSTACKSTR(concat);
+ ap = argv + 2;
+ for (;;) {
+ while (*p)
+ STPUTC(*p++, concat);
+ if ((p = *ap++) == NULL)
+ break;
+ STPUTC(' ', concat);
+ }
+ STPUTC('\0', concat);
+ p = grabstackstr(concat);
+ }
+ evalstring(p);
+ }
+ return exitstatus;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute a command or commands contained in a string.
+ */
+
+void
+evalstring(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ union node *n;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ setinputstring(s, 1);
+ while ((n = parsecmd(0)) != NEOF) {
+ evaltree(n, 0);
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ }
+ popfile();
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Evaluate a parse tree. The value is left in the global variable
+ * exitstatus.
+ */
+
+void
+evaltree(n, flags)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ if (n == NULL) {
+ TRACE(("evaltree(NULL) called\n"));
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ goto out;
+ }
+ displayhist = 1; /* show history substitutions done with fc */
+ TRACE(("evaltree(0x%x: %d) called\n", (int)n, n->type));
+ switch (n->type) {
+ case NSEMI:
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch1, 0);
+ if (evalskip)
+ goto out;
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch2, flags);
+ break;
+ case NAND:
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch1, EV_TESTED);
+ if (evalskip || exitstatus != 0)
+ goto out;
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch2, flags);
+ break;
+ case NOR:
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch1, EV_TESTED);
+ if (evalskip || exitstatus == 0)
+ goto out;
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch2, flags);
+ break;
+ case NREDIR:
+ expredir(n->nredir.redirect);
+ redirect(n->nredir.redirect, REDIR_PUSH);
+ evaltree(n->nredir.n, flags);
+ popredir();
+ break;
+ case NSUBSHELL:
+ evalsubshell(n, flags);
+ break;
+ case NBACKGND:
+ evalsubshell(n, flags);
+ break;
+ case NIF: {
+ int status = 0;
+
+ evaltree(n->nif.test, EV_TESTED);
+ if (evalskip)
+ goto out;
+ if (exitstatus == 0) {
+ evaltree(n->nif.ifpart, flags);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ } else if (n->nif.elsepart) {
+ evaltree(n->nif.elsepart, flags);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ }
+ exitstatus = status;
+ break;
+ }
+ case NWHILE:
+ case NUNTIL:
+ evalloop(n);
+ break;
+ case NFOR:
+ evalfor(n);
+ break;
+ case NCASE:
+ evalcase(n, flags);
+ break;
+ case NDEFUN:
+ defun(n->narg.text, n->narg.next);
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ break;
+ case NNOT:
+ evaltree(n->nnot.com, EV_TESTED);
+ exitstatus = !exitstatus;
+ break;
+
+ case NPIPE:
+ evalpipe(n);
+ break;
+ case NCMD:
+ evalcommand(n, flags, (struct backcmd *)NULL);
+ break;
+ default:
+ out1fmt("Node type = %d\n", n->type);
+ flushout(&output);
+ break;
+ }
+out:
+ if (pendingsigs)
+ dotrap();
+ if ((flags & EV_EXIT) || (eflag && exitstatus && !(flags & EV_TESTED)))
+ exitshell(exitstatus);
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+evalloop(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ int status;
+
+ loopnest++;
+ status = 0;
+ for (;;) {
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch1, EV_TESTED);
+ if (evalskip) {
+skipping: if (evalskip == SKIPCONT && --skipcount <= 0) {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (evalskip == SKIPBREAK && --skipcount <= 0)
+ evalskip = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (n->type == NWHILE) {
+ if (exitstatus != 0)
+ break;
+ } else {
+ if (exitstatus == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ evaltree(n->nbinary.ch2, 0);
+ status = exitstatus;
+ if (evalskip)
+ goto skipping;
+ }
+ loopnest--;
+ exitstatus = status;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+evalfor(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ union node *argp;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+ for (argp = n->nfor.args ; argp ; argp = argp->narg.next) {
+ expandarg(argp, &arglist, EXP_FULL | EXP_TILDE);
+ if (evalskip)
+ goto out;
+ }
+ *arglist.lastp = NULL;
+
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ loopnest++;
+ for (sp = arglist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ setvar(n->nfor.var, sp->text, 0);
+ evaltree(n->nfor.body, 0);
+ if (evalskip) {
+ if (evalskip == SKIPCONT && --skipcount <= 0) {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (evalskip == SKIPBREAK && --skipcount <= 0)
+ evalskip = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ loopnest--;
+out:
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+evalcase(n, flags)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ union node *cp;
+ union node *patp;
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+ expandarg(n->ncase.expr, &arglist, EXP_TILDE);
+ for (cp = n->ncase.cases ; cp && evalskip == 0 ; cp = cp->nclist.next) {
+ for (patp = cp->nclist.pattern ; patp ; patp = patp->narg.next) {
+ if (casematch(patp, arglist.list->text)) {
+ if (evalskip == 0) {
+ evaltree(cp->nclist.body, flags);
+ }
+ goto out;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Kick off a subshell to evaluate a tree.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+evalsubshell(n, flags)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ struct job *jp;
+ int backgnd = (n->type == NBACKGND);
+
+ expredir(n->nredir.redirect);
+ jp = makejob(n, 1);
+ if (forkshell(jp, n, backgnd) == 0) {
+ if (backgnd)
+ flags &=~ EV_TESTED;
+ redirect(n->nredir.redirect, 0);
+ evaltree(n->nredir.n, flags | EV_EXIT); /* never returns */
+ }
+ if (! backgnd) {
+ INTOFF;
+ exitstatus = waitforjob(jp);
+ INTON;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Compute the names of the files in a redirection list.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+expredir(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ register union node *redir;
+
+ for (redir = n ; redir ; redir = redir->nfile.next) {
+ if (redir->type == NFROM
+ || redir->type == NTO
+ || redir->type == NAPPEND) {
+ struct arglist fn;
+ fn.lastp = &fn.list;
+ expandarg(redir->nfile.fname, &fn, EXP_TILDE | EXP_REDIR);
+ redir->nfile.expfname = fn.list->text;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Evaluate a pipeline. All the processes in the pipeline are children
+ * of the process creating the pipeline. (This differs from some versions
+ * of the shell, which make the last process in a pipeline the parent
+ * of all the rest.)
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+evalpipe(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ int pipelen;
+ int prevfd;
+ int pip[2];
+
+ TRACE(("evalpipe(0x%x) called\n", (int)n));
+ pipelen = 0;
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next)
+ pipelen++;
+ INTOFF;
+ jp = makejob(n, pipelen);
+ prevfd = -1;
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next) {
+ prehash(lp->n);
+ pip[1] = -1;
+ if (lp->next) {
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0) {
+ close(prevfd);
+ error("Pipe call failed");
+ }
+ }
+ if (forkshell(jp, lp->n, n->npipe.backgnd) == 0) {
+ INTON;
+ if (prevfd > 0) {
+ close(0);
+ copyfd(prevfd, 0);
+ close(prevfd);
+ }
+ if (pip[1] >= 0) {
+ close(pip[0]);
+ if (pip[1] != 1) {
+ close(1);
+ copyfd(pip[1], 1);
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ }
+ evaltree(lp->n, EV_EXIT);
+ }
+ if (prevfd >= 0)
+ close(prevfd);
+ prevfd = pip[0];
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ INTON;
+ if (n->npipe.backgnd == 0) {
+ INTOFF;
+ exitstatus = waitforjob(jp);
+ TRACE(("evalpipe: job done exit status %d\n", exitstatus));
+ INTON;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute a command inside back quotes. If it's a builtin command, we
+ * want to save its output in a block obtained from malloc. Otherwise
+ * we fork off a subprocess and get the output of the command via a pipe.
+ * Should be called with interrupts off.
+ */
+
+void
+evalbackcmd(n, result)
+ union node *n;
+ struct backcmd *result;
+ {
+ int pip[2];
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct stackmark smark; /* unnecessary */
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ result->fd = -1;
+ result->buf = NULL;
+ result->nleft = 0;
+ result->jp = NULL;
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ if (n == NULL)
+ goto out;
+ if (n->type == NCMD) {
+ evalcommand(n, EV_BACKCMD, result);
+ } else {
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0)
+ error("Pipe call failed");
+ jp = makejob(n, 1);
+ if (forkshell(jp, n, FORK_NOJOB) == 0) {
+ FORCEINTON;
+ close(pip[0]);
+ if (pip[1] != 1) {
+ close(1);
+ copyfd(pip[1], 1);
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ evaltree(n, EV_EXIT);
+ }
+ close(pip[1]);
+ result->fd = pip[0];
+ result->jp = jp;
+ }
+out:
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ TRACE(("evalbackcmd done: fd=%d buf=0x%x nleft=%d jp=0x%x\n",
+ result->fd, result->buf, result->nleft, result->jp));
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute a simple command.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+evalcommand(cmd, flags, backcmd)
+ union node *cmd;
+ struct backcmd *backcmd;
+ {
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ union node *argp;
+ struct arglist arglist;
+ struct arglist varlist;
+ char **argv;
+ int argc;
+ char **envp;
+ int varflag;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ register char *p;
+ int mode;
+ int pip[2];
+ struct cmdentry cmdentry;
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler;
+ char *volatile savecmdname;
+ volatile struct shparam saveparam;
+ struct localvar *volatile savelocalvars;
+ volatile int e;
+ char *lastarg;
+
+ /* First expand the arguments. */
+ TRACE(("evalcommand(0x%x, %d) called\n", (int)cmd, flags));
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ arglist.lastp = &arglist.list;
+ varlist.lastp = &varlist.list;
+ varflag = 1;
+ for (argp = cmd->ncmd.args ; argp ; argp = argp->narg.next) {
+ p = argp->narg.text;
+ if (varflag && is_name(*p)) {
+ do {
+ p++;
+ } while (is_in_name(*p));
+ if (*p == '=') {
+ expandarg(argp, &varlist, EXP_VARTILDE);
+ continue;
+ }
+ }
+ expandarg(argp, &arglist, EXP_FULL | EXP_TILDE);
+ varflag = 0;
+ }
+ *arglist.lastp = NULL;
+ *varlist.lastp = NULL;
+ expredir(cmd->ncmd.redirect);
+ argc = 0;
+ for (sp = arglist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next)
+ argc++;
+ argv = stalloc(sizeof (char *) * (argc + 1));
+
+ for (sp = arglist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ TRACE(("evalcommand arg: %s\n", sp->text));
+ *argv++ = sp->text;
+ }
+ *argv = NULL;
+ lastarg = NULL;
+ if (iflag && funcnest == 0 && argc > 0)
+ lastarg = argv[-1];
+ argv -= argc;
+
+ /* Print the command if xflag is set. */
+ if (xflag) {
+ outc('+', &errout);
+ for (sp = varlist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ outc(' ', &errout);
+ out2str(sp->text);
+ }
+ for (sp = arglist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ outc(' ', &errout);
+ out2str(sp->text);
+ }
+ outc('\n', &errout);
+ flushout(&errout);
+ }
+
+ /* Now locate the command. */
+ if (argc == 0) {
+ cmdentry.cmdtype = CMDBUILTIN;
+ cmdentry.u.index = BLTINCMD;
+ } else {
+ find_command(argv[0], &cmdentry, 1);
+ if (cmdentry.cmdtype == CMDUNKNOWN) { /* command not found */
+ exitstatus = 2;
+ flushout(&errout);
+ return;
+ }
+ /* implement the bltin builtin here */
+ if (cmdentry.cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN && cmdentry.u.index == BLTINCMD) {
+ for (;;) {
+ argv++;
+ if (--argc == 0)
+ break;
+ if ((cmdentry.u.index = find_builtin(*argv)) < 0) {
+ outfmt(&errout, "%s: not found\n", *argv);
+ exitstatus = 2;
+ flushout(&errout);
+ return;
+ }
+ if (cmdentry.u.index != BLTINCMD)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Fork off a child process if necessary. */
+ if (cmd->ncmd.backgnd
+ || cmdentry.cmdtype == CMDNORMAL && (flags & EV_EXIT) == 0
+ || (flags & EV_BACKCMD) != 0
+ && (cmdentry.cmdtype != CMDBUILTIN
+ || cmdentry.u.index == DOTCMD
+ || cmdentry.u.index == EVALCMD)) {
+ jp = makejob(cmd, 1);
+ mode = cmd->ncmd.backgnd;
+ if (flags & EV_BACKCMD) {
+ mode = FORK_NOJOB;
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0)
+ error("Pipe call failed");
+ }
+ if (forkshell(jp, cmd, mode) != 0)
+ goto parent; /* at end of routine */
+ if (flags & EV_BACKCMD) {
+ FORCEINTON;
+ close(pip[0]);
+ if (pip[1] != 1) {
+ close(1);
+ copyfd(pip[1], 1);
+ close(pip[1]);
+ }
+ }
+ flags |= EV_EXIT;
+ }
+
+ /* This is the child process if a fork occurred. */
+ /* Execute the command. */
+ if (cmdentry.cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION) {
+ trputs("Shell function: "); trargs(argv);
+ redirect(cmd->ncmd.redirect, REDIR_PUSH);
+ saveparam = shellparam;
+ shellparam.malloc = 0;
+ shellparam.nparam = argc - 1;
+ shellparam.p = argv + 1;
+ shellparam.optnext = NULL;
+ INTOFF;
+ savelocalvars = localvars;
+ localvars = NULL;
+ INTON;
+ if (setjmp(jmploc.loc)) {
+ if (exception == EXSHELLPROC)
+ freeparam((struct shparam *)&saveparam);
+ else {
+ freeparam(&shellparam);
+ shellparam = saveparam;
+ }
+ poplocalvars();
+ localvars = savelocalvars;
+ handler = savehandler;
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+ }
+ savehandler = handler;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ for (sp = varlist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next)
+ mklocal(sp->text);
+ funcnest++;
+ evaltree(cmdentry.u.func, 0);
+ funcnest--;
+ INTOFF;
+ poplocalvars();
+ localvars = savelocalvars;
+ freeparam(&shellparam);
+ shellparam = saveparam;
+ handler = savehandler;
+ popredir();
+ INTON;
+ if (evalskip == SKIPFUNC) {
+ evalskip = 0;
+ skipcount = 0;
+ }
+ if (flags & EV_EXIT)
+ exitshell(exitstatus);
+ } else if (cmdentry.cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN) {
+ trputs("builtin command: "); trargs(argv);
+ mode = (cmdentry.u.index == EXECCMD)? 0 : REDIR_PUSH;
+ if (flags == EV_BACKCMD) {
+ memout.nleft = 0;
+ memout.nextc = memout.buf;
+ memout.bufsize = 64;
+ mode |= REDIR_BACKQ;
+ }
+ redirect(cmd->ncmd.redirect, mode);
+ savecmdname = commandname;
+ cmdenviron = varlist.list;
+ e = -1;
+ if (setjmp(jmploc.loc)) {
+ e = exception;
+ exitstatus = (e == EXINT)? SIGINT+128 : 2;
+ goto cmddone;
+ }
+ savehandler = handler;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ commandname = argv[0];
+ argptr = argv + 1;
+ optptr = NULL; /* initialize nextopt */
+ exitstatus = (*builtinfunc[cmdentry.u.index])(argc, argv);
+ flushall();
+cmddone:
+ out1 = &output;
+ out2 = &errout;
+ freestdout();
+ if (e != EXSHELLPROC) {
+ commandname = savecmdname;
+ if (flags & EV_EXIT) {
+ exitshell(exitstatus);
+ }
+ }
+ handler = savehandler;
+ if (e != -1) {
+ if (e != EXERROR || cmdentry.u.index == BLTINCMD
+ || cmdentry.u.index == DOTCMD
+ || cmdentry.u.index == EVALCMD
+ || cmdentry.u.index == HISTCMD
+ || cmdentry.u.index == EXECCMD)
+ exraise(e);
+ FORCEINTON;
+ }
+ if (cmdentry.u.index != EXECCMD)
+ popredir();
+ if (flags == EV_BACKCMD) {
+ backcmd->buf = memout.buf;
+ backcmd->nleft = memout.nextc - memout.buf;
+ memout.buf = NULL;
+ }
+ } else {
+ trputs("normal command: "); trargs(argv);
+ clearredir();
+ redirect(cmd->ncmd.redirect, 0);
+ if (varlist.list) {
+ p = stalloc(strlen(pathval()) + 1);
+ scopy(pathval(), p);
+ } else {
+ p = pathval();
+ }
+ for (sp = varlist.list ; sp ; sp = sp->next)
+ setvareq(sp->text, VEXPORT|VSTACK);
+ envp = environment();
+ shellexec(argv, envp, p, cmdentry.u.index);
+ /*NOTREACHED*/
+ }
+ goto out;
+
+parent: /* parent process gets here (if we forked) */
+ if (mode == 0) { /* argument to fork */
+ INTOFF;
+ exitstatus = waitforjob(jp);
+ INTON;
+ } else if (mode == 2) {
+ backcmd->fd = pip[0];
+ close(pip[1]);
+ backcmd->jp = jp;
+ }
+
+out:
+ if (lastarg)
+ setvar("_", lastarg, 0);
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Search for a command. This is called before we fork so that the
+ * location of the command will be available in the parent as well as
+ * the child. The check for "goodname" is an overly conservative
+ * check that the name will not be subject to expansion.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+prehash(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+
+ if (n->type == NCMD && goodname(n->ncmd.args->narg.text))
+ find_command(n->ncmd.args->narg.text, &entry, 0);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Builtin commands. Builtin commands whose functions are closely
+ * tied to evaluation are implemented here.
+ */
+
+/*
+ * No command given, or a bltin command with no arguments. Set the
+ * specified variables.
+ */
+
+bltincmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ listsetvar(cmdenviron);
+ return exitstatus;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Handle break and continue commands. Break, continue, and return are
+ * all handled by setting the evalskip flag. The evaluation routines
+ * above all check this flag, and if it is set they start skipping
+ * commands rather than executing them. The variable skipcount is
+ * the number of loops to break/continue, or the number of function
+ * levels to return. (The latter is always 1.) It should probably
+ * be an error to break out of more loops than exist, but it isn't
+ * in the standard shell so we don't make it one here.
+ */
+
+breakcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ int n;
+
+ n = 1;
+ if (argc > 1)
+ n = number(argv[1]);
+ if (n > loopnest)
+ n = loopnest;
+ if (n > 0) {
+ evalskip = (**argv == 'c')? SKIPCONT : SKIPBREAK;
+ skipcount = n;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The return command.
+ */
+
+returncmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ int ret;
+
+ ret = exitstatus;
+ if (argc > 1)
+ ret = number(argv[1]);
+ if (funcnest) {
+ evalskip = SKIPFUNC;
+ skipcount = 1;
+ }
+ return ret;
+}
+
+
+truecmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+execcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ iflag = 0; /* exit on error */
+ mflag = 0;
+ optschanged();
+ shellexec(argv + 1, environment(), pathval(), 0);
+
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/eval.h b/bin/sh/eval.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5789bcb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/eval.h
@@ -0,0 +1,65 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)eval.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+extern char *commandname; /* currently executing command */
+extern int exitstatus; /* exit status of last command */
+extern struct strlist *cmdenviron; /* environment for builtin command */
+
+
+struct backcmd { /* result of evalbackcmd */
+ int fd; /* file descriptor to read from */
+ char *buf; /* buffer */
+ int nleft; /* number of chars in buffer */
+ struct job *jp; /* job structure for command */
+};
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void evalstring(char *);
+union node; /* BLETCH for ansi C */
+void evaltree(union node *, int);
+void evalbackcmd(union node *, struct backcmd *);
+#else
+void evalstring();
+void evaltree();
+void evalbackcmd();
+#endif
+
+/* in_function returns nonzero if we are currently evaluating a function */
+#define in_function() funcnest
+extern int funcnest;
diff --git a/bin/sh/exec.c b/bin/sh/exec.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..30c7f73
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/exec.c
@@ -0,0 +1,828 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)exec.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * When commands are first encountered, they are entered in a hash table.
+ * This ensures that a full path search will not have to be done for them
+ * on each invocation.
+ *
+ * We should investigate converting to a linear search, even though that
+ * would make the command name "hash" a misnomer.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "init.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+
+
+#define CMDTABLESIZE 31 /* should be prime */
+#define ARB 1 /* actual size determined at run time */
+
+
+
+struct tblentry {
+ struct tblentry *next; /* next entry in hash chain */
+ union param param; /* definition of builtin function */
+ short cmdtype; /* index identifying command */
+ char rehash; /* if set, cd done since entry created */
+ char cmdname[ARB]; /* name of command */
+};
+
+
+STATIC struct tblentry *cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE];
+STATIC int builtinloc = -1; /* index in path of %builtin, or -1 */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void tryexec(char *, char **, char **);
+STATIC void execinterp(char **, char **);
+STATIC void printentry(struct tblentry *, int);
+STATIC void clearcmdentry(int);
+STATIC struct tblentry *cmdlookup(char *, int);
+STATIC void delete_cmd_entry(void);
+#else
+STATIC void tryexec();
+STATIC void execinterp();
+STATIC void printentry();
+STATIC void clearcmdentry();
+STATIC struct tblentry *cmdlookup();
+STATIC void delete_cmd_entry();
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Exec a program. Never returns. If you change this routine, you may
+ * have to change the find_command routine as well.
+ */
+
+void
+shellexec(argv, envp, path, index)
+ char **argv, **envp;
+ char *path;
+ {
+ char *cmdname;
+ int e;
+
+ if (strchr(argv[0], '/') != NULL) {
+ tryexec(argv[0], argv, envp);
+ e = errno;
+ } else {
+ e = ENOENT;
+ while ((cmdname = padvance(&path, argv[0])) != NULL) {
+ if (--index < 0 && pathopt == NULL) {
+ tryexec(cmdname, argv, envp);
+ if (errno != ENOENT && errno != ENOTDIR)
+ e = errno;
+ }
+ stunalloc(cmdname);
+ }
+ }
+ error2(argv[0], errmsg(e, E_EXEC));
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+tryexec(cmd, argv, envp)
+ char *cmd;
+ char **argv;
+ char **envp;
+ {
+ int e;
+ char *p;
+
+#ifdef SYSV
+ do {
+ execve(cmd, argv, envp);
+ } while (errno == EINTR);
+#else
+ execve(cmd, argv, envp);
+#endif
+ e = errno;
+ if (e == ENOEXEC) {
+ initshellproc();
+ setinputfile(cmd, 0);
+ commandname = arg0 = savestr(argv[0]);
+#ifndef BSD
+ pgetc(); pungetc(); /* fill up input buffer */
+ p = parsenextc;
+ if (parsenleft > 2 && p[0] == '#' && p[1] == '!') {
+ argv[0] = cmd;
+ execinterp(argv, envp);
+ }
+#endif
+ setparam(argv + 1);
+ exraise(EXSHELLPROC);
+ /*NOTREACHED*/
+ }
+ errno = e;
+}
+
+
+#ifndef BSD
+/*
+ * Execute an interpreter introduced by "#!", for systems where this
+ * feature has not been built into the kernel. If the interpreter is
+ * the shell, return (effectively ignoring the "#!"). If the execution
+ * of the interpreter fails, exit.
+ *
+ * This code peeks inside the input buffer in order to avoid actually
+ * reading any input. It would benefit from a rewrite.
+ */
+
+#define NEWARGS 5
+
+STATIC void
+execinterp(argv, envp)
+ char **argv, **envp;
+ {
+ int n;
+ char *inp;
+ char *outp;
+ char c;
+ char *p;
+ char **ap;
+ char *newargs[NEWARGS];
+ int i;
+ char **ap2;
+ char **new;
+
+ n = parsenleft - 2;
+ inp = parsenextc + 2;
+ ap = newargs;
+ for (;;) {
+ while (--n >= 0 && (*inp == ' ' || *inp == '\t'))
+ inp++;
+ if (n < 0)
+ goto bad;
+ if ((c = *inp++) == '\n')
+ break;
+ if (ap == &newargs[NEWARGS])
+bad: error("Bad #! line");
+ STARTSTACKSTR(outp);
+ do {
+ STPUTC(c, outp);
+ } while (--n >= 0 && (c = *inp++) != ' ' && c != '\t' && c != '\n');
+ STPUTC('\0', outp);
+ n++, inp--;
+ *ap++ = grabstackstr(outp);
+ }
+ if (ap == newargs + 1) { /* if no args, maybe no exec is needed */
+ p = newargs[0];
+ for (;;) {
+ if (equal(p, "sh") || equal(p, "ash")) {
+ return;
+ }
+ while (*p != '/') {
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ goto break2;
+ p++;
+ }
+ p++;
+ }
+break2:;
+ }
+ i = (char *)ap - (char *)newargs; /* size in bytes */
+ if (i == 0)
+ error("Bad #! line");
+ for (ap2 = argv ; *ap2++ != NULL ; );
+ new = ckmalloc(i + ((char *)ap2 - (char *)argv));
+ ap = newargs, ap2 = new;
+ while ((i -= sizeof (char **)) >= 0)
+ *ap2++ = *ap++;
+ ap = argv;
+ while (*ap2++ = *ap++);
+ shellexec(new, envp, pathval(), 0);
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Do a path search. The variable path (passed by reference) should be
+ * set to the start of the path before the first call; padvance will update
+ * this value as it proceeds. Successive calls to padvance will return
+ * the possible path expansions in sequence. If an option (indicated by
+ * a percent sign) appears in the path entry then the global variable
+ * pathopt will be set to point to it; otherwise pathopt will be set to
+ * NULL.
+ */
+
+char *pathopt;
+
+char *
+padvance(path, name)
+ char **path;
+ char *name;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+ char *start;
+ int len;
+
+ if (*path == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+ start = *path;
+ for (p = start ; *p && *p != ':' && *p != '%' ; p++);
+ len = p - start + strlen(name) + 2; /* "2" is for '/' and '\0' */
+ while (stackblocksize() < len)
+ growstackblock();
+ q = stackblock();
+ if (p != start) {
+ bcopy(start, q, p - start);
+ q += p - start;
+ *q++ = '/';
+ }
+ strcpy(q, name);
+ pathopt = NULL;
+ if (*p == '%') {
+ pathopt = ++p;
+ while (*p && *p != ':') p++;
+ }
+ if (*p == ':')
+ *path = p + 1;
+ else
+ *path = NULL;
+ return stalloc(len);
+}
+
+
+
+/*** Command hashing code ***/
+
+
+hashcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ int c;
+ int verbose;
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+ char *name;
+
+ verbose = 0;
+ while ((c = nextopt("rv")) != '\0') {
+ if (c == 'r') {
+ clearcmdentry(0);
+ } else if (c == 'v') {
+ verbose++;
+ }
+ }
+ if (*argptr == NULL) {
+ for (pp = cmdtable ; pp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; pp++) {
+ for (cmdp = *pp ; cmdp ; cmdp = cmdp->next) {
+ printentry(cmdp, verbose);
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+ while ((name = *argptr) != NULL) {
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) != NULL
+ && (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL
+ || cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN && builtinloc >= 0))
+ delete_cmd_entry();
+ find_command(name, &entry, 1);
+ if (verbose) {
+ if (entry.cmdtype != CMDUNKNOWN) { /* if no error msg */
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0);
+ printentry(cmdp, verbose);
+ }
+ flushall();
+ }
+ argptr++;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+printentry(cmdp, verbose)
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ int verbose;
+ {
+ int index;
+ char *path;
+ char *name;
+
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL) {
+ index = cmdp->param.index;
+ path = pathval();
+ do {
+ name = padvance(&path, cmdp->cmdname);
+ stunalloc(name);
+ } while (--index >= 0);
+ out1str(name);
+ } else if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN) {
+ out1fmt("builtin %s", cmdp->cmdname);
+ } else if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION) {
+ out1fmt("function %s", cmdp->cmdname);
+ if (verbose) {
+ INTOFF;
+ name = commandtext(cmdp->param.func);
+ out1c(' ');
+ out1str(name);
+ ckfree(name);
+ INTON;
+ }
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ } else {
+ error("internal error: cmdtype %d", cmdp->cmdtype);
+#endif
+ }
+ if (cmdp->rehash)
+ out1c('*');
+ out1c('\n');
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Resolve a command name. If you change this routine, you may have to
+ * change the shellexec routine as well.
+ */
+
+void
+find_command(name, entry, printerr)
+ char *name;
+ struct cmdentry *entry;
+ {
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ int index;
+ int prev;
+ char *path;
+ char *fullname;
+ struct stat statb;
+ int e;
+ int i;
+
+ /* If name contains a slash, don't use the hash table */
+ if (strchr(name, '/') != NULL) {
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDNORMAL;
+ entry->u.index = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+
+ /* If name is in the table, and not invalidated by cd, we're done */
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) != NULL && cmdp->rehash == 0)
+ goto success;
+
+ /* If %builtin not in path, check for builtin next */
+ if (builtinloc < 0 && (i = find_builtin(name)) >= 0) {
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDBUILTIN;
+ cmdp->param.index = i;
+ INTON;
+ goto success;
+ }
+
+ /* We have to search path. */
+ prev = -1; /* where to start */
+ if (cmdp) { /* doing a rehash */
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN)
+ prev = builtinloc;
+ else
+ prev = cmdp->param.index;
+ }
+
+ path = pathval();
+ e = ENOENT;
+ index = -1;
+loop:
+ while ((fullname = padvance(&path, name)) != NULL) {
+ stunalloc(fullname);
+ index++;
+ if (pathopt) {
+ if (prefix("builtin", pathopt)) {
+ if ((i = find_builtin(name)) < 0)
+ goto loop;
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDBUILTIN;
+ cmdp->param.index = i;
+ INTON;
+ goto success;
+ } else if (prefix("func", pathopt)) {
+ /* handled below */
+ } else {
+ goto loop; /* ignore unimplemented options */
+ }
+ }
+ /* if rehash, don't redo absolute path names */
+ if (fullname[0] == '/' && index <= prev) {
+ if (index < prev)
+ goto loop;
+ TRACE(("searchexec \"%s\": no change\n", name));
+ goto success;
+ }
+ while (stat(fullname, &statb) < 0) {
+#ifdef SYSV
+ if (errno == EINTR)
+ continue;
+#endif
+ if (errno != ENOENT && errno != ENOTDIR)
+ e = errno;
+ goto loop;
+ }
+ e = EACCES; /* if we fail, this will be the error */
+ if ((statb.st_mode & S_IFMT) != S_IFREG)
+ goto loop;
+ if (pathopt) { /* this is a %func directory */
+ stalloc(strlen(fullname) + 1);
+ readcmdfile(fullname);
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) == NULL || cmdp->cmdtype != CMDFUNCTION)
+ error("%s not defined in %s", name, fullname);
+ stunalloc(fullname);
+ goto success;
+ }
+#ifdef notdef
+ if (statb.st_uid == geteuid()) {
+ if ((statb.st_mode & 0100) == 0)
+ goto loop;
+ } else if (statb.st_gid == getegid()) {
+ if ((statb.st_mode & 010) == 0)
+ goto loop;
+ } else {
+ if ((statb.st_mode & 01) == 0)
+ goto loop;
+ }
+#endif
+ TRACE(("searchexec \"%s\" returns \"%s\"\n", name, fullname));
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDNORMAL;
+ cmdp->param.index = index;
+ INTON;
+ goto success;
+ }
+
+ /* We failed. If there was an entry for this command, delete it */
+ if (cmdp)
+ delete_cmd_entry();
+ if (printerr)
+ outfmt(out2, "%s: %s\n", name, errmsg(e, E_EXEC));
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ return;
+
+success:
+ cmdp->rehash = 0;
+ entry->cmdtype = cmdp->cmdtype;
+ entry->u = cmdp->param;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Search the table of builtin commands.
+ */
+
+int
+find_builtin(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ const register struct builtincmd *bp;
+
+ for (bp = builtincmd ; bp->name ; bp++) {
+ if (*bp->name == *name && equal(bp->name, name))
+ return bp->code;
+ }
+ return -1;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called when a cd is done. Marks all commands so the next time they
+ * are executed they will be rehashed.
+ */
+
+void
+hashcd() {
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ for (pp = cmdtable ; pp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; pp++) {
+ for (cmdp = *pp ; cmdp ; cmdp = cmdp->next) {
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL
+ || cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN && builtinloc >= 0)
+ cmdp->rehash = 1;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called before PATH is changed. The argument is the new value of PATH;
+ * pathval() still returns the old value at this point. Called with
+ * interrupts off.
+ */
+
+void
+changepath(newval)
+ char *newval;
+ {
+ char *old, *new;
+ int index;
+ int firstchange;
+ int bltin;
+ int hasdot;
+
+ old = pathval();
+ new = newval;
+ firstchange = 9999; /* assume no change */
+ index = hasdot = 0;
+ bltin = -1;
+ if (*new == ':')
+ hasdot++;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*old != *new) {
+ firstchange = index;
+ if (*old == '\0' && *new == ':'
+ || *old == ':' && *new == '\0')
+ firstchange++;
+ old = new; /* ignore subsequent differences */
+ }
+ if (*new == '\0')
+ break;
+ if (*new == '%' && bltin < 0 && prefix("builtin", new + 1))
+ bltin = index;
+ if (*new == ':') {
+ char c = *(new+1);
+
+ index++;
+ if (c == ':' || c == '\0' || (c == '.' &&
+ ((c = *(new+2)) == ':' || c == '\0')))
+ hasdot++;
+ }
+ new++, old++;
+ }
+ if (hasdot && geteuid() == 0)
+ out2str("sh: warning: running as root with dot in PATH\n");
+ if (builtinloc < 0 && bltin >= 0)
+ builtinloc = bltin; /* zap builtins */
+ if (builtinloc >= 0 && bltin < 0)
+ firstchange = 0;
+ clearcmdentry(firstchange);
+ builtinloc = bltin;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Clear out command entries. The argument specifies the first entry in
+ * PATH which has changed.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+clearcmdentry(firstchange) {
+ struct tblentry **tblp;
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (tblp = cmdtable ; tblp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; tblp++) {
+ pp = tblp;
+ while ((cmdp = *pp) != NULL) {
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDNORMAL && cmdp->param.index >= firstchange
+ || cmdp->cmdtype == CMDBUILTIN && builtinloc >= firstchange) {
+ *pp = cmdp->next;
+ ckfree(cmdp);
+ } else {
+ pp = &cmdp->next;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Delete all functions.
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+MKINIT void deletefuncs();
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ deletefuncs();
+}
+#endif
+
+void
+deletefuncs() {
+ struct tblentry **tblp;
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (tblp = cmdtable ; tblp < &cmdtable[CMDTABLESIZE] ; tblp++) {
+ pp = tblp;
+ while ((cmdp = *pp) != NULL) {
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION) {
+ *pp = cmdp->next;
+ freefunc(cmdp->param.func);
+ ckfree(cmdp);
+ } else {
+ pp = &cmdp->next;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Locate a command in the command hash table. If "add" is nonzero,
+ * add the command to the table if it is not already present. The
+ * variable "lastcmdentry" is set to point to the address of the link
+ * pointing to the entry, so that delete_cmd_entry can delete the
+ * entry.
+ */
+
+struct tblentry **lastcmdentry;
+
+
+STATIC struct tblentry *
+cmdlookup(name, add)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ int hashval;
+ register char *p;
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+ struct tblentry **pp;
+
+ p = name;
+ hashval = *p << 4;
+ while (*p)
+ hashval += *p++;
+ hashval &= 0x7FFF;
+ pp = &cmdtable[hashval % CMDTABLESIZE];
+ for (cmdp = *pp ; cmdp ; cmdp = cmdp->next) {
+ if (equal(cmdp->cmdname, name))
+ break;
+ pp = &cmdp->next;
+ }
+ if (add && cmdp == NULL) {
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = *pp = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct tblentry) - ARB
+ + strlen(name) + 1);
+ cmdp->next = NULL;
+ cmdp->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ cmdp->rehash = 0;
+ strcpy(cmdp->cmdname, name);
+ INTON;
+ }
+ lastcmdentry = pp;
+ return cmdp;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Delete the command entry returned on the last lookup.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+delete_cmd_entry() {
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = *lastcmdentry;
+ *lastcmdentry = cmdp->next;
+ ckfree(cmdp);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+#ifdef notdef
+void
+getcmdentry(name, entry)
+ char *name;
+ struct cmdentry *entry;
+ {
+ struct tblentry *cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0);
+
+ if (cmdp) {
+ entry->u = cmdp->param;
+ entry->cmdtype = cmdp->cmdtype;
+ } else {
+ entry->cmdtype = CMDUNKNOWN;
+ entry->u.index = 0;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Add a new command entry, replacing any existing command entry for
+ * the same name.
+ */
+
+void
+addcmdentry(name, entry)
+ char *name;
+ struct cmdentry *entry;
+ {
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 1);
+ if (cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION) {
+ freefunc(cmdp->param.func);
+ }
+ cmdp->cmdtype = entry->cmdtype;
+ cmdp->param = entry->u;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Define a shell function.
+ */
+
+void
+defun(name, func)
+ char *name;
+ union node *func;
+ {
+ struct cmdentry entry;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ entry.cmdtype = CMDFUNCTION;
+ entry.u.func = copyfunc(func);
+ addcmdentry(name, &entry);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Delete a function if it exists.
+ */
+
+int
+unsetfunc(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ struct tblentry *cmdp;
+
+ if ((cmdp = cmdlookup(name, 0)) != NULL && cmdp->cmdtype == CMDFUNCTION) {
+ freefunc(cmdp->param.func);
+ delete_cmd_entry();
+ return (0);
+ }
+ return (1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/exec.h b/bin/sh/exec.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a82b0d1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/exec.h
@@ -0,0 +1,75 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)exec.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/* values of cmdtype */
+#define CMDUNKNOWN -1 /* no entry in table for command */
+#define CMDNORMAL 0 /* command is an executable program */
+#define CMDBUILTIN 1 /* command is a shell builtin */
+#define CMDFUNCTION 2 /* command is a shell function */
+
+
+struct cmdentry {
+ int cmdtype;
+ union param {
+ int index;
+ union node *func;
+ } u;
+};
+
+
+extern char *pathopt; /* set by padvance */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void shellexec(char **, char **, char *, int);
+char *padvance(char **, char *);
+void find_command(char *, struct cmdentry *, int);
+int find_builtin(char *);
+void hashcd(void);
+void changepath(char *);
+void defun(char *, union node *);
+int unsetfunc(char *);
+#else
+void shellexec();
+char *padvance();
+void find_command();
+int find_builtin();
+void hashcd();
+void changepath();
+void defun();
+int unsetfunc();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/expand.c b/bin/sh/expand.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..edee495
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/expand.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1160 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)expand.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 10/22/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Routines to expand arguments to commands. We have to deal with
+ * backquotes, shell variables, and file metacharacters.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <dirent.h>
+#include <pwd.h>
+
+/*
+ * Structure specifying which parts of the string should be searched
+ * for IFS characters.
+ */
+
+struct ifsregion {
+ struct ifsregion *next; /* next region in list */
+ int begoff; /* offset of start of region */
+ int endoff; /* offset of end of region */
+ int nulonly; /* search for nul bytes only */
+};
+
+
+char *expdest; /* output of current string */
+struct nodelist *argbackq; /* list of back quote expressions */
+struct ifsregion ifsfirst; /* first struct in list of ifs regions */
+struct ifsregion *ifslastp; /* last struct in list */
+struct arglist exparg; /* holds expanded arg list */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void argstr(char *, int);
+STATIC void expbackq(union node *, int, int);
+STATIC char *evalvar(char *, int);
+STATIC int varisset(int);
+STATIC void varvalue(int, int, int);
+STATIC void recordregion(int, int, int);
+STATIC void ifsbreakup(char *, struct arglist *);
+STATIC void expandmeta(struct strlist *, int);
+STATIC void expmeta(char *, char *);
+STATIC void expari(int);
+STATIC void addfname(char *);
+STATIC struct strlist *expsort(struct strlist *);
+STATIC struct strlist *msort(struct strlist *, int);
+STATIC int pmatch(char *, char *);
+STATIC char *exptilde(char *, int);
+#else
+STATIC void argstr();
+STATIC void expbackq();
+STATIC char *evalvar();
+STATIC int varisset();
+STATIC void varvalue();
+STATIC void recordregion();
+STATIC void ifsbreakup();
+STATIC void expandmeta();
+STATIC void expmeta();
+STATIC void expari();
+STATIC void addfname();
+STATIC struct strlist *expsort();
+STATIC struct strlist *msort();
+STATIC int pmatch();
+STATIC char *exptilde();
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Expand shell variables and backquotes inside a here document.
+ */
+
+void
+expandhere(arg, fd)
+ union node *arg; /* the document */
+ int fd; /* where to write the expanded version */
+ {
+ herefd = fd;
+ expandarg(arg, (struct arglist *)NULL, 0);
+ xwrite(fd, stackblock(), expdest - stackblock());
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Perform variable substitution and command substitution on an argument,
+ * placing the resulting list of arguments in arglist. If EXP_FULL is true,
+ * perform splitting and file name expansion. When arglist is NULL, perform
+ * here document expansion.
+ */
+
+void
+expandarg(arg, arglist, flag)
+ union node *arg;
+ struct arglist *arglist;
+ {
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ char *p;
+
+ argbackq = arg->narg.backquote;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(expdest);
+ ifsfirst.next = NULL;
+ ifslastp = NULL;
+ argstr(arg->narg.text, flag);
+ if (arglist == NULL) {
+ return; /* here document expanded */
+ }
+ STPUTC('\0', expdest);
+ p = grabstackstr(expdest);
+ exparg.lastp = &exparg.list;
+ /*
+ * TODO - EXP_REDIR
+ */
+ if (flag & EXP_FULL) {
+ ifsbreakup(p, &exparg);
+ *exparg.lastp = NULL;
+ exparg.lastp = &exparg.list;
+ expandmeta(exparg.list, flag);
+ } else {
+ if (flag & EXP_REDIR) /*XXX - for now, just remove escapes */
+ rmescapes(p);
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct strlist));
+ sp->text = p;
+ *exparg.lastp = sp;
+ exparg.lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+ while (ifsfirst.next != NULL) {
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+ INTOFF;
+ ifsp = ifsfirst.next->next;
+ ckfree(ifsfirst.next);
+ ifsfirst.next = ifsp;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ *exparg.lastp = NULL;
+ if (exparg.list) {
+ *arglist->lastp = exparg.list;
+ arglist->lastp = exparg.lastp;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Perform variable and command substitution. If EXP_FULL is set, output CTLESC
+ * characters to allow for further processing. Otherwise treat
+ * $@ like $* since no splitting will be performed.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+argstr(p, flag)
+ register char *p;
+ {
+ register char c;
+ int quotes = flag & (EXP_FULL | EXP_CASE); /* do CTLESC */
+ int firsteq = 1;
+
+ if (*p == '~' && (flag & (EXP_TILDE | EXP_VARTILDE)))
+ p = exptilde(p, flag);
+ for (;;) {
+ switch (c = *p++) {
+ case '\0':
+ case CTLENDVAR: /* ??? */
+ goto breakloop;
+ case CTLESC:
+ if (quotes)
+ STPUTC(c, expdest);
+ c = *p++;
+ STPUTC(c, expdest);
+ break;
+ case CTLVAR:
+ p = evalvar(p, flag);
+ break;
+ case CTLBACKQ:
+ case CTLBACKQ|CTLQUOTE:
+ expbackq(argbackq->n, c & CTLQUOTE, flag);
+ argbackq = argbackq->next;
+ break;
+ case CTLENDARI:
+ expari(flag);
+ break;
+ case ':':
+ case '=':
+ /*
+ * sort of a hack - expand tildes in variable
+ * assignments (after the first '=' and after ':'s).
+ */
+ STPUTC(c, expdest);
+ if (flag & EXP_VARTILDE && *p == '~') {
+ if (c == '=') {
+ if (firsteq)
+ firsteq = 0;
+ else
+ break;
+ }
+ p = exptilde(p, flag);
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ STPUTC(c, expdest);
+ }
+ }
+breakloop:;
+}
+
+STATIC char *
+exptilde(p, flag)
+ char *p;
+ {
+ char c, *startp = p;
+ struct passwd *pw;
+ char *home;
+ int quotes = flag & (EXP_FULL | EXP_CASE);
+
+ while (c = *p) {
+ switch(c) {
+ case CTLESC:
+ return (startp);
+ case ':':
+ if (flag & EXP_VARTILDE)
+ goto done;
+ break;
+ case '/':
+ goto done;
+ }
+ p++;
+ }
+done:
+ *p = '\0';
+ if (*(startp+1) == '\0') {
+ if ((home = lookupvar("HOME")) == NULL)
+ goto lose;
+ } else {
+ if ((pw = getpwnam(startp+1)) == NULL)
+ goto lose;
+ home = pw->pw_dir;
+ }
+ if (*home == '\0')
+ goto lose;
+ *p = c;
+ while (c = *home++) {
+ if (quotes && SQSYNTAX[c] == CCTL)
+ STPUTC(CTLESC, expdest);
+ STPUTC(c, expdest);
+ }
+ return (p);
+lose:
+ *p = c;
+ return (startp);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand arithmetic expression. Backup to start of expression,
+ * evaluate, place result in (backed up) result, adjust string position.
+ */
+void
+expari(flag)
+ {
+ char *p, *start;
+ int result;
+ int quotes = flag & (EXP_FULL | EXP_CASE);
+
+ /*
+ * This routine is slightly over-compilcated for
+ * efficiency. First we make sure there is
+ * enough space for the result, which may be bigger
+ * than the expression if we add exponentation. Next we
+ * scan backwards looking for the start of arithmetic. If the
+ * next previous character is a CTLESC character, then we
+ * have to rescan starting from the beginning since CTLESC
+ * characters have to be processed left to right.
+ */
+ CHECKSTRSPACE(8, expdest);
+ USTPUTC('\0', expdest);
+ start = stackblock();
+ p = expdest;
+ while (*p != CTLARI && p >= start)
+ --p;
+ if (*p != CTLARI)
+ error("missing CTLARI (shouldn't happen)");
+ if (p > start && *(p-1) == CTLESC)
+ for (p = start; *p != CTLARI; p++)
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (quotes)
+ rmescapes(p+1);
+ result = arith(p+1);
+ fmtstr(p, 10, "%d", result);
+ while (*p++)
+ ;
+ result = expdest - p + 1;
+ STADJUST(-result, expdest);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand stuff in backwards quotes.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+expbackq(cmd, quoted, flag)
+ union node *cmd;
+ {
+ struct backcmd in;
+ int i;
+ char buf[128];
+ char *p;
+ char *dest = expdest;
+ struct ifsregion saveifs, *savelastp;
+ struct nodelist *saveargbackq;
+ char lastc;
+ int startloc = dest - stackblock();
+ char const *syntax = quoted? DQSYNTAX : BASESYNTAX;
+ int saveherefd;
+ int quotes = flag & (EXP_FULL | EXP_CASE);
+
+ INTOFF;
+ saveifs = ifsfirst;
+ savelastp = ifslastp;
+ saveargbackq = argbackq;
+ saveherefd = herefd;
+ herefd = -1;
+ p = grabstackstr(dest);
+ evalbackcmd(cmd, &in);
+ ungrabstackstr(p, dest);
+ ifsfirst = saveifs;
+ ifslastp = savelastp;
+ argbackq = saveargbackq;
+ herefd = saveherefd;
+
+ p = in.buf;
+ lastc = '\0';
+ for (;;) {
+ if (--in.nleft < 0) {
+ if (in.fd < 0)
+ break;
+ while ((i = read(in.fd, buf, sizeof buf)) < 0 && errno == EINTR);
+ TRACE(("expbackq: read returns %d\n", i));
+ if (i <= 0)
+ break;
+ p = buf;
+ in.nleft = i - 1;
+ }
+ lastc = *p++;
+ if (lastc != '\0') {
+ if (quotes && syntax[lastc] == CCTL)
+ STPUTC(CTLESC, dest);
+ STPUTC(lastc, dest);
+ }
+ }
+ if (lastc == '\n') {
+ STUNPUTC(dest);
+ }
+ if (in.fd >= 0)
+ close(in.fd);
+ if (in.buf)
+ ckfree(in.buf);
+ if (in.jp)
+ exitstatus = waitforjob(in.jp);
+ if (quoted == 0)
+ recordregion(startloc, dest - stackblock(), 0);
+ TRACE(("evalbackq: size=%d: \"%.*s\"\n",
+ (dest - stackblock()) - startloc,
+ (dest - stackblock()) - startloc,
+ stackblock() + startloc));
+ expdest = dest;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand a variable, and return a pointer to the next character in the
+ * input string.
+ */
+
+STATIC char *
+evalvar(p, flag)
+ char *p;
+ {
+ int subtype;
+ int varflags;
+ char *var;
+ char *val;
+ int c;
+ int set;
+ int special;
+ int startloc;
+ int quotes = flag & (EXP_FULL | EXP_CASE);
+
+ varflags = *p++;
+ subtype = varflags & VSTYPE;
+ var = p;
+ special = 0;
+ if (! is_name(*p))
+ special = 1;
+ p = strchr(p, '=') + 1;
+again: /* jump here after setting a variable with ${var=text} */
+ if (special) {
+ set = varisset(*var);
+ val = NULL;
+ } else {
+ val = lookupvar(var);
+ if (val == NULL || (varflags & VSNUL) && val[0] == '\0') {
+ val = NULL;
+ set = 0;
+ } else
+ set = 1;
+ }
+ startloc = expdest - stackblock();
+ if (set && subtype != VSPLUS) {
+ /* insert the value of the variable */
+ if (special) {
+ varvalue(*var, varflags & VSQUOTE, flag & EXP_FULL);
+ } else {
+ char const *syntax = (varflags & VSQUOTE)? DQSYNTAX : BASESYNTAX;
+
+ while (*val) {
+ if (quotes && syntax[*val] == CCTL)
+ STPUTC(CTLESC, expdest);
+ STPUTC(*val++, expdest);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if (subtype == VSPLUS)
+ set = ! set;
+ if (((varflags & VSQUOTE) == 0 || (*var == '@' && shellparam.nparam != 1))
+ && (set || subtype == VSNORMAL))
+ recordregion(startloc, expdest - stackblock(), varflags & VSQUOTE);
+ if (! set && subtype != VSNORMAL) {
+ if (subtype == VSPLUS || subtype == VSMINUS) {
+ argstr(p, flag);
+ } else {
+ char *startp;
+ int saveherefd = herefd;
+ struct nodelist *saveargbackq = argbackq;
+ herefd = -1;
+ argstr(p, 0);
+ STACKSTRNUL(expdest);
+ herefd = saveherefd;
+ argbackq = saveargbackq;
+ startp = stackblock() + startloc;
+ if (subtype == VSASSIGN) {
+ setvar(var, startp, 0);
+ STADJUST(startp - expdest, expdest);
+ varflags &=~ VSNUL;
+ goto again;
+ }
+ /* subtype == VSQUESTION */
+ if (*p != CTLENDVAR) {
+ outfmt(&errout, "%s\n", startp);
+ error((char *)NULL);
+ }
+ error("%.*s: parameter %snot set", p - var - 1,
+ var, (varflags & VSNUL)? "null or " : nullstr);
+ }
+ }
+ if (subtype != VSNORMAL) { /* skip to end of alternative */
+ int nesting = 1;
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((c = *p++) == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ else if (c == CTLBACKQ || c == (CTLBACKQ|CTLQUOTE)) {
+ if (set)
+ argbackq = argbackq->next;
+ } else if (c == CTLVAR) {
+ if ((*p++ & VSTYPE) != VSNORMAL)
+ nesting++;
+ } else if (c == CTLENDVAR) {
+ if (--nesting == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Test whether a specialized variable is set.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+varisset(name)
+ char name;
+ {
+ char **ap;
+
+ if (name == '!') {
+ if (backgndpid == -1)
+ return 0;
+ } else if (name == '@' || name == '*') {
+ if (*shellparam.p == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ } else if ((unsigned)(name -= '1') <= '9' - '1') {
+ ap = shellparam.p;
+ do {
+ if (*ap++ == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ } while (--name >= 0);
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Add the value of a specialized variable to the stack string.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+varvalue(name, quoted, allow_split)
+ char name;
+ {
+ int num;
+ char temp[32];
+ char *p;
+ int i;
+ extern int exitstatus;
+ char sep;
+ char **ap;
+ char const *syntax;
+
+#define STRTODEST(p) \
+ do {\
+ if (allow_split) { \
+ syntax = quoted? DQSYNTAX : BASESYNTAX; \
+ while (*p) { \
+ if (syntax[*p] == CCTL) \
+ STPUTC(CTLESC, expdest); \
+ STPUTC(*p++, expdest); \
+ } \
+ } else \
+ while (*p) \
+ STPUTC(*p++, expdest); \
+ } while (0)
+
+
+ switch (name) {
+ case '$':
+ num = rootpid;
+ goto numvar;
+ case '?':
+ num = exitstatus;
+ goto numvar;
+ case '#':
+ num = shellparam.nparam;
+ goto numvar;
+ case '!':
+ num = backgndpid;
+numvar:
+ p = temp + 31;
+ temp[31] = '\0';
+ do {
+ *--p = num % 10 + '0';
+ } while ((num /= 10) != 0);
+ while (*p)
+ STPUTC(*p++, expdest);
+ break;
+ case '-':
+ for (i = 0 ; i < NOPTS ; i++) {
+ if (optlist[i].val)
+ STPUTC(optlist[i].letter, expdest);
+ }
+ break;
+ case '@':
+ if (allow_split) {
+ sep = '\0';
+ goto allargs;
+ }
+ /* fall through */
+ case '*':
+ sep = ' ';
+allargs:
+ for (ap = shellparam.p ; (p = *ap++) != NULL ; ) {
+ STRTODEST(p);
+ if (*ap)
+ STPUTC(sep, expdest);
+ }
+ break;
+ case '0':
+ p = arg0;
+ STRTODEST(p);
+ break;
+ default:
+ if ((unsigned)(name -= '1') <= '9' - '1') {
+ p = shellparam.p[name];
+ STRTODEST(p);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Record the the fact that we have to scan this region of the
+ * string for IFS characters.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+recordregion(start, end, nulonly) {
+ register struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+
+ if (ifslastp == NULL) {
+ ifsp = &ifsfirst;
+ } else {
+ ifsp = (struct ifsregion *)ckmalloc(sizeof (struct ifsregion));
+ ifslastp->next = ifsp;
+ }
+ ifslastp = ifsp;
+ ifslastp->next = NULL;
+ ifslastp->begoff = start;
+ ifslastp->endoff = end;
+ ifslastp->nulonly = nulonly;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Break the argument string into pieces based upon IFS and add the
+ * strings to the argument list. The regions of the string to be
+ * searched for IFS characters have been stored by recordregion.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+ifsbreakup(string, arglist)
+ char *string;
+ struct arglist *arglist;
+ {
+ struct ifsregion *ifsp;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ char *start;
+ register char *p;
+ char *q;
+ char *ifs;
+
+ start = string;
+ if (ifslastp != NULL) {
+ ifsp = &ifsfirst;
+ do {
+ p = string + ifsp->begoff;
+ ifs = ifsp->nulonly? nullstr : ifsval();
+ while (p < string + ifsp->endoff) {
+ q = p;
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (strchr(ifs, *p++)) {
+ if (q > start || *ifs != ' ') {
+ *q = '\0';
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = start;
+ *arglist->lastp = sp;
+ arglist->lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+ if (*ifs == ' ') {
+ for (;;) {
+ if (p >= string + ifsp->endoff)
+ break;
+ q = p;
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (strchr(ifs, *p++) == NULL) {
+ p = q;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ start = p;
+ }
+ }
+ } while ((ifsp = ifsp->next) != NULL);
+ if (*start || (*ifs != ' ' && start > string)) {
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = start;
+ *arglist->lastp = sp;
+ arglist->lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+ } else {
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = start;
+ *arglist->lastp = sp;
+ arglist->lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Expand shell metacharacters. At this point, the only control characters
+ * should be escapes. The results are stored in the list exparg.
+ */
+
+char *expdir;
+
+
+STATIC void
+expandmeta(str, flag)
+ struct strlist *str;
+ {
+ char *p;
+ struct strlist **savelastp;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ char c;
+ /* TODO - EXP_REDIR */
+
+ while (str) {
+ if (fflag)
+ goto nometa;
+ p = str->text;
+ for (;;) { /* fast check for meta chars */
+ if ((c = *p++) == '\0')
+ goto nometa;
+ if (c == '*' || c == '?' || c == '[' || c == '!')
+ break;
+ }
+ savelastp = exparg.lastp;
+ INTOFF;
+ if (expdir == NULL) {
+ int i = strlen(str->text);
+ expdir = ckmalloc(i < 2048 ? 2048 : i); /* XXX */
+ }
+
+ expmeta(expdir, str->text);
+ ckfree(expdir);
+ expdir = NULL;
+ INTON;
+ if (exparg.lastp == savelastp) {
+ /*
+ * no matches
+ */
+nometa:
+ *exparg.lastp = str;
+ rmescapes(str->text);
+ exparg.lastp = &str->next;
+ } else {
+ *exparg.lastp = NULL;
+ *savelastp = sp = expsort(*savelastp);
+ while (sp->next != NULL)
+ sp = sp->next;
+ exparg.lastp = &sp->next;
+ }
+ str = str->next;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Do metacharacter (i.e. *, ?, [...]) expansion.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+expmeta(enddir, name)
+ char *enddir;
+ char *name;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+ char *q;
+ char *start;
+ char *endname;
+ int metaflag;
+ struct stat statb;
+ DIR *dirp;
+ struct dirent *dp;
+ int atend;
+ int matchdot;
+
+ metaflag = 0;
+ start = name;
+ for (p = name ; ; p++) {
+ if (*p == '*' || *p == '?')
+ metaflag = 1;
+ else if (*p == '[') {
+ q = p + 1;
+ if (*q == '!')
+ q++;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*q == CTLESC)
+ q++;
+ if (*q == '/' || *q == '\0')
+ break;
+ if (*++q == ']') {
+ metaflag = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ } else if (*p == '!' && p[1] == '!' && (p == name || p[-1] == '/')) {
+ metaflag = 1;
+ } else if (*p == '\0')
+ break;
+ else if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (*p == '/') {
+ if (metaflag)
+ break;
+ start = p + 1;
+ }
+ }
+ if (metaflag == 0) { /* we've reached the end of the file name */
+ if (enddir != expdir)
+ metaflag++;
+ for (p = name ; ; p++) {
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ *enddir++ = *p;
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ break;
+ }
+ if (metaflag == 0 || stat(expdir, &statb) >= 0)
+ addfname(expdir);
+ return;
+ }
+ endname = p;
+ if (start != name) {
+ p = name;
+ while (p < start) {
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ *enddir++ = *p++;
+ }
+ }
+ if (enddir == expdir) {
+ p = ".";
+ } else if (enddir == expdir + 1 && *expdir == '/') {
+ p = "/";
+ } else {
+ p = expdir;
+ enddir[-1] = '\0';
+ }
+ if ((dirp = opendir(p)) == NULL)
+ return;
+ if (enddir != expdir)
+ enddir[-1] = '/';
+ if (*endname == 0) {
+ atend = 1;
+ } else {
+ atend = 0;
+ *endname++ = '\0';
+ }
+ matchdot = 0;
+ if (start[0] == '.' || start[0] == CTLESC && start[1] == '.')
+ matchdot++;
+ while (! int_pending() && (dp = readdir(dirp)) != NULL) {
+ if (dp->d_name[0] == '.' && ! matchdot)
+ continue;
+ if (patmatch(start, dp->d_name)) {
+ if (atend) {
+ scopy(dp->d_name, enddir);
+ addfname(expdir);
+ } else {
+ char *q;
+ for (p = enddir, q = dp->d_name ; *p++ = *q++ ;);
+ p[-1] = '/';
+ expmeta(p, endname);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ closedir(dirp);
+ if (! atend)
+ endname[-1] = '/';
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Add a file name to the list.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+addfname(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ char *p;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+
+ p = stalloc(strlen(name) + 1);
+ scopy(name, p);
+ sp = (struct strlist *)stalloc(sizeof *sp);
+ sp->text = p;
+ *exparg.lastp = sp;
+ exparg.lastp = &sp->next;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Sort the results of file name expansion. It calculates the number of
+ * strings to sort and then calls msort (short for merge sort) to do the
+ * work.
+ */
+
+STATIC struct strlist *
+expsort(str)
+ struct strlist *str;
+ {
+ int len;
+ struct strlist *sp;
+
+ len = 0;
+ for (sp = str ; sp ; sp = sp->next)
+ len++;
+ return msort(str, len);
+}
+
+
+STATIC struct strlist *
+msort(list, len)
+ struct strlist *list;
+ {
+ struct strlist *p, *q;
+ struct strlist **lpp;
+ int half;
+ int n;
+
+ if (len <= 1)
+ return list;
+ half = len >> 1;
+ p = list;
+ for (n = half ; --n >= 0 ; ) {
+ q = p;
+ p = p->next;
+ }
+ q->next = NULL; /* terminate first half of list */
+ q = msort(list, half); /* sort first half of list */
+ p = msort(p, len - half); /* sort second half */
+ lpp = &list;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (strcmp(p->text, q->text) < 0) {
+ *lpp = p;
+ lpp = &p->next;
+ if ((p = *lpp) == NULL) {
+ *lpp = q;
+ break;
+ }
+ } else {
+ *lpp = q;
+ lpp = &q->next;
+ if ((q = *lpp) == NULL) {
+ *lpp = p;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return list;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Returns true if the pattern matches the string.
+ */
+
+int
+patmatch(pattern, string)
+ char *pattern;
+ char *string;
+ {
+#ifdef notdef
+ if (pattern[0] == '!' && pattern[1] == '!')
+ return 1 - pmatch(pattern + 2, string);
+ else
+#endif
+ return pmatch(pattern, string);
+}
+
+
+STATIC int
+pmatch(pattern, string)
+ char *pattern;
+ char *string;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+ register char c;
+
+ p = pattern;
+ q = string;
+ for (;;) {
+ switch (c = *p++) {
+ case '\0':
+ goto breakloop;
+ case CTLESC:
+ if (*q++ != *p++)
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ if (*q++ == '\0')
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ case '*':
+ c = *p;
+ if (c != CTLESC && c != '?' && c != '*' && c != '[') {
+ while (*q != c) {
+ if (*q == '\0')
+ return 0;
+ q++;
+ }
+ }
+ do {
+ if (pmatch(p, q))
+ return 1;
+ } while (*q++ != '\0');
+ return 0;
+ case '[': {
+ char *endp;
+ int invert, found;
+ char chr;
+
+ endp = p;
+ if (*endp == '!')
+ endp++;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*endp == '\0')
+ goto dft; /* no matching ] */
+ if (*endp == CTLESC)
+ endp++;
+ if (*++endp == ']')
+ break;
+ }
+ invert = 0;
+ if (*p == '!') {
+ invert++;
+ p++;
+ }
+ found = 0;
+ chr = *q++;
+ c = *p++;
+ do {
+ if (c == CTLESC)
+ c = *p++;
+ if (*p == '-' && p[1] != ']') {
+ p++;
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ if (chr >= c && chr <= *p)
+ found = 1;
+ p++;
+ } else {
+ if (chr == c)
+ found = 1;
+ }
+ } while ((c = *p++) != ']');
+ if (found == invert)
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ }
+dft: default:
+ if (*q++ != c)
+ return 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+breakloop:
+ if (*q != '\0')
+ return 0;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Remove any CTLESC characters from a string.
+ */
+
+void
+rmescapes(str)
+ char *str;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+
+ p = str;
+ while (*p != CTLESC) {
+ if (*p++ == '\0')
+ return;
+ }
+ q = p;
+ while (*p) {
+ if (*p == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ }
+ *q = '\0';
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * See if a pattern matches in a case statement.
+ */
+
+int
+casematch(pattern, val)
+ union node *pattern;
+ char *val;
+ {
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int result;
+ char *p;
+
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ argbackq = pattern->narg.backquote;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(expdest);
+ ifslastp = NULL;
+ argstr(pattern->narg.text, EXP_TILDE | EXP_CASE);
+ STPUTC('\0', expdest);
+ p = grabstackstr(expdest);
+ result = patmatch(p, val);
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ return result;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/expand.h b/bin/sh/expand.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5c6758f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/expand.h
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)expand.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+struct strlist {
+ struct strlist *next;
+ char *text;
+};
+
+
+struct arglist {
+ struct strlist *list;
+ struct strlist **lastp;
+};
+
+/*
+ * expandarg() flags
+ */
+#define EXP_FULL 0x1 /* perform word splitting & file globbing */
+#define EXP_TILDE 0x2 /* do normal tilde expansion */
+#define EXP_VARTILDE 0x4 /* expand tildes in an assignment */
+#define EXP_REDIR 0x8 /* file glob for a redirection (1 match only) */
+#define EXP_CASE 0x10 /* keeps quotes around for CASE pattern */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+union node;
+void expandarg(union node *, struct arglist *, int);
+void expandhere(union node *, int);
+int patmatch(char *, char *);
+void rmescapes(char *);
+int casematch(union node *, char *);
+#else
+void expandarg();
+void expandhere();
+int patmatch();
+void rmescapes();
+int casematch();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/cmv b/bin/sh/funcs/cmv
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a0921ef
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/cmv
@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)cmv 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# Conditional move--don't replace an existing file.
+
+cmv() {
+ if test $# != 2
+ then echo "cmv: arg count"
+ return 2
+ fi
+ if test -f "$2" -o -w "$2"
+ then echo "$2 exists"
+ return 2
+ fi
+ /bin/mv "$1" "$2"
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/dirs b/bin/sh/funcs/dirs
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..04b7fe1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/dirs
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)dirs 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# pushd, popd, and dirs --- written by Chris Bertin
+# Pixel Computer Inc. ...!wjh12!pixel!pixutl!chris
+# as modified by Patrick Elam of GTRI and Kenneth Almquist at UW
+
+pushd () {
+ SAVE=`pwd`
+ if [ "$1" = "" ]
+ then if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "pushd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1 || return
+ shift 1
+ DSTACK="$*"
+ else cd $1 > /dev/null || return
+ fi
+ DSTACK="$SAVE $DSTACK"
+ dirs
+}
+
+popd () {
+ if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "popd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1
+ shift
+ DSTACK=$*
+ dirs
+}
+
+dirs () {
+ echo "`pwd` $DSTACK"
+ return 0
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/kill b/bin/sh/funcs/kill
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..da670e9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/kill
@@ -0,0 +1,49 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)kill 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# Convert job names to process ids and then run /bin/kill.
+
+kill() {
+ local args x
+ args=
+ for x in "$@"
+ do case $x in
+ %*) x=`jobid "$x"` ;;
+ esac
+ args="$args $x"
+ done
+ /bin/kill $args
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/login b/bin/sh/funcs/login
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d8e9d6f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/login
@@ -0,0 +1,38 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)login 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# replaces the login builtin in the BSD shell
+login () exec login "$@"
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/newgrp b/bin/sh/funcs/newgrp
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d5aa63e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/newgrp
@@ -0,0 +1,37 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)newgrp 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+newgrp() exec newgrp "$@"
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/popd b/bin/sh/funcs/popd
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2f4de3a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/popd
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)popd 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# pushd, popd, and dirs --- written by Chris Bertin
+# Pixel Computer Inc. ...!wjh12!pixel!pixutl!chris
+# as modified by Patrick Elam of GTRI and Kenneth Almquist at UW
+
+pushd () {
+ SAVE=`pwd`
+ if [ "$1" = "" ]
+ then if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "pushd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1 || return
+ shift 1
+ DSTACK="$*"
+ else cd $1 > /dev/null || return
+ fi
+ DSTACK="$SAVE $DSTACK"
+ dirs
+}
+
+popd () {
+ if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "popd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1
+ shift
+ DSTACK=$*
+ dirs
+}
+
+dirs () {
+ echo "`pwd` $DSTACK"
+ return 0
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/pushd b/bin/sh/funcs/pushd
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0c50353
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/pushd
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)pushd 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# pushd, popd, and dirs --- written by Chris Bertin
+# Pixel Computer Inc. ...!wjh12!pixel!pixutl!chris
+# as modified by Patrick Elam of GTRI and Kenneth Almquist at UW
+
+pushd () {
+ SAVE=`pwd`
+ if [ "$1" = "" ]
+ then if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "pushd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1 || return
+ shift 1
+ DSTACK="$*"
+ else cd $1 > /dev/null || return
+ fi
+ DSTACK="$SAVE $DSTACK"
+ dirs
+}
+
+popd () {
+ if [ "$DSTACK" = "" ]
+ then echo "popd: directory stack empty."
+ return 1
+ fi
+ set $DSTACK
+ cd $1
+ shift
+ DSTACK=$*
+ dirs
+}
+
+dirs () {
+ echo "`pwd` $DSTACK"
+ return 0
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/funcs/suspend b/bin/sh/funcs/suspend
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4483965
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/funcs/suspend
@@ -0,0 +1,41 @@
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)suspend 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+suspend() {
+ local -
+ set +j
+ kill -TSTP 0
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/histedit.c b/bin/sh/histedit.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0093c17
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/histedit.c
@@ -0,0 +1,442 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)histedit.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Editline and history functions (and glue).
+ */
+#include <sys/param.h>
+#include <paths.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "histedit.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+
+#define MAXHISTLOOPS 4 /* max recursions through fc */
+#define DEFEDITOR "ed" /* default editor *should* be $EDITOR */
+
+History *hist; /* history cookie */
+EditLine *el; /* editline cookie */
+int displayhist;
+static FILE *el_in, *el_out;
+
+STATIC char *fc_replace __P((const char *, char *, char *));
+
+/*
+ * Set history and editing status. Called whenever the status may
+ * have changed (figures out what to do).
+ */
+histedit() {
+
+#define editing (Eflag || Vflag)
+
+ if (iflag) {
+ if (!hist) {
+ /*
+ * turn history on
+ */
+ INTOFF;
+ hist = history_init();
+ INTON;
+
+ if (hist != NULL)
+ sethistsize();
+ else
+ out2str("sh: can't initialize history\n");
+ }
+ if (editing && !el && isatty(0)) { /* && isatty(2) ??? */
+ /*
+ * turn editing on
+ */
+ INTOFF;
+ if (el_in == NULL)
+ el_in = fdopen(0, "r");
+ if (el_out == NULL)
+ el_out = fdopen(2, "w");
+ if (el_in == NULL || el_out == NULL)
+ goto bad;
+ el = el_init(arg0, el_in, el_out);
+ if (el != NULL) {
+ if (hist)
+ el_set(el, EL_HIST, history, hist);
+ el_set(el, EL_PROMPT, getprompt);
+ } else {
+bad:
+ out2str("sh: can't initialize editing\n");
+ }
+ INTON;
+ } else if (!editing && el) {
+ INTOFF;
+ el_end(el);
+ el = NULL;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ if (el) {
+ if (Vflag)
+ el_set(el, EL_EDITOR, "vi");
+ else if (Eflag)
+ el_set(el, EL_EDITOR, "emacs");
+ }
+ } else {
+ INTOFF;
+ if (el) { /* no editing if not interactive */
+ el_end(el);
+ el = NULL;
+ }
+ if (hist) {
+ history_end(hist);
+ hist = NULL;
+ }
+ INTON;
+ }
+}
+
+sethistsize() {
+ char *cp;
+ int histsize;
+
+ if (hist != NULL) {
+ cp = lookupvar("HISTSIZE");
+ if (cp == NULL || *cp == '\0' ||
+ (histsize = atoi(cp)) < 0)
+ histsize = 100;
+ history(hist, H_EVENT, histsize);
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * This command is provided since POSIX decided to standardize
+ * the Korn shell fc command. Oh well...
+ */
+histcmd(argc, argv)
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ extern char *optarg;
+ extern int optind, optopt, optreset;
+ int ch;
+ char *editor = NULL;
+ const HistEvent *he;
+ int lflg = 0, nflg = 0, rflg = 0, sflg = 0;
+ int i;
+ char *firststr, *laststr;
+ int first, last, direction;
+ char *pat = NULL, *repl; /* ksh "fc old=new" crap */
+ static int active = 0;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler;
+ char editfile[MAXPATHLEN + 1];
+ FILE *efp;
+
+ if (hist == NULL)
+ error("history not active");
+
+ if (argc == 1)
+ error("missing history argument");
+
+ optreset = 1; optind = 1; /* initialize getopt */
+ while (not_fcnumber(argv[optind]) &&
+ (ch = getopt(argc, argv, ":e:lnrs")) != EOF)
+ switch ((char)ch) {
+ case 'e':
+ editor = optarg;
+ break;
+ case 'l':
+ lflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'n':
+ nflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 'r':
+ rflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ sflg = 1;
+ break;
+ case ':':
+ error("option -%c expects argument", optopt);
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ error("unknown option: -%c", optopt);
+ }
+ argc -= optind, argv += optind;
+
+ /*
+ * If executing...
+ */
+ if (lflg == 0 || editor || sflg) {
+ lflg = 0; /* ignore */
+ editfile[0] = '\0';
+ /*
+ * Catch interrupts to reset active counter and
+ * cleanup temp files.
+ */
+ if (setjmp(jmploc.loc)) {
+ active = 0;
+ if (*editfile)
+ unlink(editfile);
+ handler = savehandler;
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+ }
+ savehandler = handler;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ if (++active > MAXHISTLOOPS) {
+ active = 0;
+ displayhist = 0;
+ error("called recursively too many times");
+ }
+ /*
+ * Set editor.
+ */
+ if (sflg == 0) {
+ if (editor == NULL &&
+ (editor = bltinlookup("FCEDIT", 1)) == NULL &&
+ (editor = bltinlookup("EDITOR", 1)) == NULL)
+ editor = DEFEDITOR;
+ if (editor[0] == '-' && editor[1] == '\0') {
+ sflg = 1; /* no edit */
+ editor = NULL;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * If executing, parse [old=new] now
+ */
+ if (lflg == 0 && argc > 0 &&
+ ((repl = strchr(argv[0], '=')) != NULL)) {
+ pat = argv[0];
+ *repl++ = '\0';
+ argc--, argv++;
+ }
+ /*
+ * determine [first] and [last]
+ */
+ switch (argc) {
+ case 0:
+ firststr = lflg ? "-16" : "-1";
+ laststr = "-1";
+ break;
+ case 1:
+ firststr = argv[0];
+ laststr = lflg ? "-1" : argv[0];
+ break;
+ case 2:
+ firststr = argv[0];
+ laststr = argv[1];
+ break;
+ default:
+ error("too many args");
+ }
+ /*
+ * Turn into event numbers.
+ */
+ first = str_to_event(firststr, 0);
+ last = str_to_event(laststr, 1);
+
+ if (rflg) {
+ i = last;
+ last = first;
+ first = i;
+ }
+ /*
+ * XXX - this should not depend on the event numbers
+ * always increasing. Add sequence numbers or offset
+ * to the history element in next (diskbased) release.
+ */
+ direction = first < last ? H_PREV : H_NEXT;
+
+ /*
+ * If editing, grab a temp file.
+ */
+ if (editor) {
+ int fd;
+ INTOFF; /* easier */
+ sprintf(editfile, "%s/_shXXXXXX", _PATH_TMP);
+ if ((fd = mkstemp(editfile)) < 0)
+ error("can't create temporary file %s", editfile);
+ if ((efp = fdopen(fd, "w")) == NULL) {
+ close(fd);
+ error("can't allocate stdio buffer for temp\n");
+ }
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * Loop through selected history events. If listing or executing,
+ * do it now. Otherwise, put into temp file and call the editor
+ * after.
+ *
+ * The history interface needs rethinking, as the following
+ * convolutions will demonstrate.
+ */
+ history(hist, H_FIRST);
+ he = history(hist, H_NEXT_EVENT, first);
+ for (;he != NULL; he = history(hist, direction)) {
+ if (lflg) {
+ if (!nflg)
+ out1fmt("%5d ", he->num);
+ out1str(he->str);
+ } else {
+ char *s = pat ?
+ fc_replace(he->str, pat, repl) : (char *)he->str;
+
+ if (sflg) {
+ if (displayhist) {
+ out2str(s);
+ }
+ evalstring(s);
+ if (displayhist && hist) {
+ /*
+ * XXX what about recursive and
+ * relative histnums.
+ */
+ history(hist, H_ENTER, s);
+ }
+ } else
+ fputs(s, efp);
+ }
+ /*
+ * At end? (if we were to loose last, we'd sure be
+ * messed up).
+ */
+ if (he->num == last)
+ break;
+ }
+ if (editor) {
+ char *editcmd;
+
+ fclose(efp);
+ editcmd = stalloc(strlen(editor) + strlen(editfile) + 2);
+ sprintf(editcmd, "%s %s", editor, editfile);
+ evalstring(editcmd); /* XXX - should use no JC command */
+ INTON;
+ readcmdfile(editfile); /* XXX - should read back - quick tst */
+ unlink(editfile);
+ }
+
+ if (lflg == 0 && active > 0)
+ --active;
+ if (displayhist)
+ displayhist = 0;
+}
+
+STATIC char *
+fc_replace(s, p, r)
+ const char *s;
+ char *p, *r;
+{
+ char *dest;
+ int plen = strlen(p);
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(dest);
+ while (*s) {
+ if (*s == *p && strncmp(s, p, plen) == 0) {
+ while (*r)
+ STPUTC(*r++, dest);
+ s += plen;
+ *p = '\0'; /* so no more matches */
+ } else
+ STPUTC(*s++, dest);
+ }
+ STACKSTRNUL(dest);
+ dest = grabstackstr(dest);
+
+ return (dest);
+}
+
+not_fcnumber(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ if (*s == '-')
+ s++;
+ return (!is_number(s));
+}
+
+str_to_event(str, last)
+ char *str;
+ int last;
+{
+ const HistEvent *he;
+ char *s = str;
+ int relative = 0;
+ int i, j;
+
+ he = history(hist, H_FIRST);
+ switch (*s) {
+ case '-':
+ relative = 1;
+ /*FALLTHROUGH*/
+ case '+':
+ s++;
+ }
+ if (is_number(s)) {
+ i = atoi(s);
+ if (relative) {
+ while (he != NULL && i--) {
+ he = history(hist, H_NEXT);
+ }
+ if (he == NULL)
+ he = history(hist, H_LAST);
+ } else {
+ he = history(hist, H_NEXT_EVENT, i);
+ if (he == NULL) {
+ /*
+ * the notion of first and last is
+ * backwards to that of the history package
+ */
+ he = history(hist, last ? H_FIRST : H_LAST);
+ }
+ }
+ if (he == NULL)
+ error("history number %s not found (internal error)",
+ str);
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * pattern
+ */
+ he = history(hist, H_PREV_STR, str);
+ if (he == NULL)
+ error("history pattern not found: %s", str);
+ }
+ return (he->num);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/init.h b/bin/sh/init.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b184361
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/init.h
@@ -0,0 +1,47 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)init.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void init(void);
+void reset(void);
+void initshellproc(void);
+#else
+void init();
+void reset();
+void initshellproc();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/input.c b/bin/sh/input.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d1d84e1
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/input.c
@@ -0,0 +1,474 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)input.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * This file implements the input routines used by the parser.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* defines BUFSIZ */
+#include "shell.h"
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+
+#define EOF_NLEFT -99 /* value of parsenleft when EOF pushed back */
+
+MKINIT
+struct strpush {
+ struct strpush *prev; /* preceding string on stack */
+ char *prevstring;
+ int prevnleft;
+ struct alias *ap; /* if push was associated with an alias */
+};
+
+/*
+ * The parsefile structure pointed to by the global variable parsefile
+ * contains information about the current file being read.
+ */
+
+MKINIT
+struct parsefile {
+ struct parsefile *prev; /* preceding file on stack */
+ int linno; /* current line */
+ int fd; /* file descriptor (or -1 if string) */
+ int nleft; /* number of chars left in buffer */
+ char *nextc; /* next char in buffer */
+ char *buf; /* input buffer */
+ struct strpush *strpush; /* for pushing strings at this level */
+ struct strpush basestrpush; /* so pushing one is fast */
+};
+
+
+int plinno = 1; /* input line number */
+MKINIT int parsenleft; /* copy of parsefile->nleft */
+char *parsenextc; /* copy of parsefile->nextc */
+MKINIT struct parsefile basepf; /* top level input file */
+char basebuf[BUFSIZ]; /* buffer for top level input file */
+struct parsefile *parsefile = &basepf; /* current input file */
+char *pushedstring; /* copy of parsenextc when text pushed back */
+int pushednleft; /* copy of parsenleft when text pushed back */
+int init_editline = 0; /* editline library initialized? */
+int whichprompt; /* 1 == PS1, 2 == PS2 */
+
+EditLine *el; /* cookie for editline package */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void pushfile(void);
+#else
+STATIC void pushfile();
+#endif
+
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "input.h"
+INCLUDE "error.h"
+
+INIT {
+ extern char basebuf[];
+
+ basepf.nextc = basepf.buf = basebuf;
+}
+
+RESET {
+ if (exception != EXSHELLPROC)
+ parsenleft = 0; /* clear input buffer */
+ popallfiles();
+}
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ popallfiles();
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Read a line from the script.
+ */
+
+char *
+pfgets(line, len)
+ char *line;
+ {
+ register char *p = line;
+ int nleft = len;
+ int c;
+
+ while (--nleft > 0) {
+ c = pgetc_macro();
+ if (c == PEOF) {
+ if (p == line)
+ return NULL;
+ break;
+ }
+ *p++ = c;
+ if (c == '\n')
+ break;
+ }
+ *p = '\0';
+ return line;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Read a character from the script, returning PEOF on end of file.
+ * Nul characters in the input are silently discarded.
+ */
+
+int
+pgetc() {
+ return pgetc_macro();
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Refill the input buffer and return the next input character:
+ *
+ * 1) If a string was pushed back on the input, pop it;
+ * 2) If an EOF was pushed back (parsenleft == EOF_NLEFT) or we are reading
+ * from a string so we can't refill the buffer, return EOF.
+ * 3) Call read to read in the characters.
+ * 4) Delete all nul characters from the buffer.
+ */
+
+int
+preadbuffer() {
+ register char *p, *q;
+ register int i;
+ register int something;
+ extern EditLine *el;
+
+ if (parsefile->strpush) {
+ popstring();
+ if (--parsenleft >= 0)
+ return (*parsenextc++);
+ }
+ if (parsenleft == EOF_NLEFT || parsefile->buf == NULL)
+ return PEOF;
+ flushout(&output);
+ flushout(&errout);
+retry:
+ p = parsenextc = parsefile->buf;
+ if (parsefile->fd == 0 && el) {
+ const char *rl_cp;
+ int len;
+
+ rl_cp = el_gets(el, &len);
+ if (rl_cp == NULL) {
+ i = 0;
+ goto eof;
+ }
+ strcpy(p, rl_cp); /* XXX - BUFSIZE should redesign so not necessary */
+ i = len;
+
+ } else {
+regular_read:
+ i = read(parsefile->fd, p, BUFSIZ - 1);
+ }
+eof:
+ if (i <= 0) {
+ if (i < 0) {
+ if (errno == EINTR)
+ goto retry;
+ if (parsefile->fd == 0 && errno == EWOULDBLOCK) {
+ int flags = fcntl(0, F_GETFL, 0);
+ if (flags >= 0 && flags & O_NONBLOCK) {
+ flags &=~ O_NONBLOCK;
+ if (fcntl(0, F_SETFL, flags) >= 0) {
+ out2str("sh: turning off NDELAY mode\n");
+ goto retry;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ parsenleft = EOF_NLEFT;
+ return PEOF;
+ }
+ parsenleft = i - 1; /* we're returning one char in this call */
+
+ /* delete nul characters */
+ something = 0;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ break;
+ if (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t' && *p != '\n')
+ something = 1;
+ p++;
+ if (--i <= 0) {
+ *p = '\0';
+ goto done; /* no nul characters */
+ }
+ }
+ /*
+ * remove nuls
+ */
+ q = p++;
+ while (--i > 0) {
+ if (*p != '\0')
+ *q++ = *p;
+ p++;
+ }
+ *q = '\0';
+ if (q == parsefile->buf)
+ goto retry; /* buffer contained nothing but nuls */
+ parsenleft = q - parsefile->buf - 1;
+
+done:
+ if (parsefile->fd == 0 && hist && something) {
+ INTOFF;
+ history(hist, whichprompt == 1 ? H_ENTER : H_ADD,
+ parsefile->buf);
+ INTON;
+ }
+ if (vflag) {
+ /*
+ * This isn't right. Most shells coordinate it with
+ * reading a line at a time. I honestly don't know if its
+ * worth it.
+ */
+ i = parsenleft + 1;
+ p = parsefile->buf;
+ for (; i--; p++)
+ out2c(*p)
+ flushout(out2);
+ }
+ return *parsenextc++;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Undo the last call to pgetc. Only one character may be pushed back.
+ * PEOF may be pushed back.
+ */
+
+void
+pungetc() {
+ parsenleft++;
+ parsenextc--;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Push a string back onto the input at this current parsefile level.
+ * We handle aliases this way.
+ */
+void
+pushstring(s, len, ap)
+ char *s;
+ int len;
+ void *ap;
+ {
+ struct strpush *sp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+/*dprintf("*** calling pushstring: %s, %d\n", s, len);*/
+ if (parsefile->strpush) {
+ sp = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct strpush));
+ sp->prev = parsefile->strpush;
+ parsefile->strpush = sp;
+ } else
+ sp = parsefile->strpush = &(parsefile->basestrpush);
+ sp->prevstring = parsenextc;
+ sp->prevnleft = parsenleft;
+ sp->ap = (struct alias *)ap;
+ if (ap)
+ ((struct alias *)ap)->flag |= ALIASINUSE;
+ parsenextc = s;
+ parsenleft = len;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+popstring()
+{
+ struct strpush *sp = parsefile->strpush;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ parsenextc = sp->prevstring;
+ parsenleft = sp->prevnleft;
+/*dprintf("*** calling popstring: restoring to '%s'\n", parsenextc);*/
+ if (sp->ap)
+ sp->ap->flag &= ~ALIASINUSE;
+ parsefile->strpush = sp->prev;
+ if (sp != &(parsefile->basestrpush))
+ ckfree(sp);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Set the input to take input from a file. If push is set, push the
+ * old input onto the stack first.
+ */
+
+void
+setinputfile(fname, push)
+ char *fname;
+ {
+ int fd;
+ int fd2;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if ((fd = open(fname, O_RDONLY)) < 0)
+ error("Can't open %s", fname);
+ if (fd < 10) {
+ fd2 = copyfd(fd, 10);
+ close(fd);
+ if (fd2 < 0)
+ error("Out of file descriptors");
+ fd = fd2;
+ }
+ setinputfd(fd, push);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Like setinputfile, but takes an open file descriptor. Call this with
+ * interrupts off.
+ */
+
+void
+setinputfd(fd, push) {
+ if (push) {
+ pushfile();
+ parsefile->buf = ckmalloc(BUFSIZ);
+ }
+ if (parsefile->fd > 0)
+ close(parsefile->fd);
+ parsefile->fd = fd;
+ if (parsefile->buf == NULL)
+ parsefile->buf = ckmalloc(BUFSIZ);
+ parsenleft = 0;
+ plinno = 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Like setinputfile, but takes input from a string.
+ */
+
+void
+setinputstring(string, push)
+ char *string;
+ {
+ INTOFF;
+ if (push)
+ pushfile();
+ parsenextc = string;
+ parsenleft = strlen(string);
+ parsefile->buf = NULL;
+ plinno = 1;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * To handle the "." command, a stack of input files is used. Pushfile
+ * adds a new entry to the stack and popfile restores the previous level.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+pushfile() {
+ struct parsefile *pf;
+
+ parsefile->nleft = parsenleft;
+ parsefile->nextc = parsenextc;
+ parsefile->linno = plinno;
+ pf = (struct parsefile *)ckmalloc(sizeof (struct parsefile));
+ pf->prev = parsefile;
+ pf->fd = -1;
+ pf->strpush = NULL;
+ pf->basestrpush.prev = NULL;
+ parsefile = pf;
+}
+
+
+void
+popfile() {
+ struct parsefile *pf = parsefile;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if (pf->fd >= 0)
+ close(pf->fd);
+ if (pf->buf)
+ ckfree(pf->buf);
+ while (pf->strpush)
+ popstring();
+ parsefile = pf->prev;
+ ckfree(pf);
+ parsenleft = parsefile->nleft;
+ parsenextc = parsefile->nextc;
+ plinno = parsefile->linno;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Return to top level.
+ */
+
+void
+popallfiles() {
+ while (parsefile != &basepf)
+ popfile();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Close the file(s) that the shell is reading commands from. Called
+ * after a fork is done.
+ */
+
+void
+closescript() {
+ popallfiles();
+ if (parsefile->fd > 0) {
+ close(parsefile->fd);
+ parsefile->fd = 0;
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/input.h b/bin/sh/input.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..754eda0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/input.h
@@ -0,0 +1,78 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)input.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/* PEOF (the end of file marker) is defined in syntax.h */
+
+/*
+ * The input line number. Input.c just defines this variable, and saves
+ * and restores it when files are pushed and popped. The user of this
+ * package must set its value.
+ */
+extern int plinno;
+extern int parsenleft; /* number of characters left in input buffer */
+extern char *parsenextc; /* next character in input buffer */
+extern int init_editline; /* 0 == not setup, 1 == OK, -1 == failed */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+char *pfgets(char *, int);
+int pgetc(void);
+int preadbuffer(void);
+void pungetc(void);
+void pushstring(char *, int, void *);
+void setinputfile(char *, int);
+void setinputfd(int, int);
+void setinputstring(char *, int);
+void popfile(void);
+void popallfiles(void);
+void closescript(void);
+#else
+char *pfgets();
+int pgetc();
+int preadbuffer();
+void pungetc();
+void setinputfile();
+void setinputfd();
+void setinputstring();
+void popfile();
+void popallfiles();
+void pushstring();
+void closescript();
+#endif
+
+#define pgetc_macro() (--parsenleft >= 0? *parsenextc++ : preadbuffer())
diff --git a/bin/sh/jobs.c b/bin/sh/jobs.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..60f66ed
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/jobs.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1046 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)jobs.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#if JOBS
+#include "sgtty.h"
+#undef CEOF /* syntax.h redefines this */
+#endif
+#include "main.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "signames.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#ifdef BSD
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/wait.h>
+#include <sys/time.h>
+#include <sys/resource.h>
+#endif
+
+
+
+struct job *jobtab; /* array of jobs */
+int njobs; /* size of array */
+MKINIT short backgndpid = -1; /* pid of last background process */
+#if JOBS
+int initialpgrp; /* pgrp of shell on invocation */
+short curjob; /* current job */
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void restartjob(struct job *);
+STATIC struct job *getjob(char *);
+STATIC void freejob(struct job *);
+STATIC int procrunning(int);
+STATIC int dowait(int, struct job *);
+STATIC int waitproc(int, int *);
+#else
+STATIC void restartjob();
+STATIC struct job *getjob();
+STATIC void freejob();
+STATIC int procrunning();
+STATIC int dowait();
+STATIC int waitproc();
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Turn job control on and off.
+ *
+ * Note: This code assumes that the third arg to ioctl is a character
+ * pointer, which is true on Berkeley systems but not System V. Since
+ * System V doesn't have job control yet, this isn't a problem now.
+ */
+
+MKINIT int jobctl;
+
+void
+setjobctl(on) {
+#ifdef OLD_TTY_DRIVER
+ int ldisc;
+#endif
+
+ if (on == jobctl || rootshell == 0)
+ return;
+ if (on) {
+ do { /* while we are in the background */
+ if (ioctl(2, TIOCGPGRP, (char *)&initialpgrp) < 0) {
+ out2str("sh: can't access tty; job control turned off\n");
+ mflag = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+ if (initialpgrp == -1)
+ initialpgrp = getpgrp(0);
+ else if (initialpgrp != getpgrp(0)) {
+ killpg(initialpgrp, SIGTTIN);
+ continue;
+ }
+ } while (0);
+#ifdef OLD_TTY_DRIVER
+ if (ioctl(2, TIOCGETD, (char *)&ldisc) < 0 || ldisc != NTTYDISC) {
+ out2str("sh: need new tty driver to run job control; job control turned off\n");
+ mflag = 0;
+ return;
+ }
+#endif
+ setsignal(SIGTSTP);
+ setsignal(SIGTTOU);
+ setsignal(SIGTTIN);
+ setpgrp(0, rootpid);
+ ioctl(2, TIOCSPGRP, (char *)&rootpid);
+ } else { /* turning job control off */
+ setpgrp(0, initialpgrp);
+ ioctl(2, TIOCSPGRP, (char *)&initialpgrp);
+ setsignal(SIGTSTP);
+ setsignal(SIGTTOU);
+ setsignal(SIGTTIN);
+ }
+ jobctl = on;
+}
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ backgndpid = -1;
+#if JOBS
+ jobctl = 0;
+#endif
+}
+
+#endif
+
+
+
+#if JOBS
+fgcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct job *jp;
+ int pgrp;
+ int status;
+
+ jp = getjob(argv[1]);
+ if (jp->jobctl == 0)
+ error("job not created under job control");
+ pgrp = jp->ps[0].pid;
+ ioctl(2, TIOCSPGRP, (char *)&pgrp);
+ restartjob(jp);
+ INTOFF;
+ status = waitforjob(jp);
+ INTON;
+ return status;
+}
+
+
+bgcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ do {
+ jp = getjob(*++argv);
+ if (jp->jobctl == 0)
+ error("job not created under job control");
+ restartjob(jp);
+ } while (--argc > 1);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+restartjob(jp)
+ struct job *jp;
+ {
+ struct procstat *ps;
+ int i;
+
+ if (jp->state == JOBDONE)
+ return;
+ INTOFF;
+ killpg(jp->ps[0].pid, SIGCONT);
+ for (ps = jp->ps, i = jp->nprocs ; --i >= 0 ; ps++) {
+ if ((ps->status & 0377) == 0177) {
+ ps->status = -1;
+ jp->state = 0;
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+int
+jobscmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ showjobs(0);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Print a list of jobs. If "change" is nonzero, only print jobs whose
+ * statuses have changed since the last call to showjobs.
+ *
+ * If the shell is interrupted in the process of creating a job, the
+ * result may be a job structure containing zero processes. Such structures
+ * will be freed here.
+ */
+
+void
+showjobs(change) {
+ int jobno;
+ int procno;
+ int i;
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct procstat *ps;
+ int col;
+ char s[64];
+
+ TRACE(("showjobs(%d) called\n", change));
+ while (dowait(0, (struct job *)NULL) > 0);
+ for (jobno = 1, jp = jobtab ; jobno <= njobs ; jobno++, jp++) {
+ if (! jp->used)
+ continue;
+ if (jp->nprocs == 0) {
+ freejob(jp);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (change && ! jp->changed)
+ continue;
+ procno = jp->nprocs;
+ for (ps = jp->ps ; ; ps++) { /* for each process */
+ if (ps == jp->ps)
+ fmtstr(s, 64, "[%d] %d ", jobno, ps->pid);
+ else
+ fmtstr(s, 64, " %d ", ps->pid);
+ out1str(s);
+ col = strlen(s);
+ s[0] = '\0';
+ if (ps->status == -1) {
+ /* don't print anything */
+ } else if ((ps->status & 0xFF) == 0) {
+ fmtstr(s, 64, "Exit %d", ps->status >> 8);
+ } else {
+ i = ps->status;
+#if JOBS
+ if ((i & 0xFF) == 0177)
+ i >>= 8;
+#endif
+ if ((i & 0x7F) <= MAXSIG && sigmesg[i & 0x7F])
+ scopy(sigmesg[i & 0x7F], s);
+ else
+ fmtstr(s, 64, "Signal %d", i & 0x7F);
+ if (i & 0x80)
+ strcat(s, " (core dumped)");
+ }
+ out1str(s);
+ col += strlen(s);
+ do {
+ out1c(' ');
+ col++;
+ } while (col < 30);
+ out1str(ps->cmd);
+ out1c('\n');
+ if (--procno <= 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ jp->changed = 0;
+ if (jp->state == JOBDONE) {
+ freejob(jp);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Mark a job structure as unused.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+freejob(jp)
+ struct job *jp;
+ {
+ struct procstat *ps;
+ int i;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (i = jp->nprocs, ps = jp->ps ; --i >= 0 ; ps++) {
+ if (ps->cmd != nullstr)
+ ckfree(ps->cmd);
+ }
+ if (jp->ps != &jp->ps0)
+ ckfree(jp->ps);
+ jp->used = 0;
+#if JOBS
+ if (curjob == jp - jobtab + 1)
+ curjob = 0;
+#endif
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+int
+waitcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct job *job;
+ int status;
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ job = getjob(argv[1]);
+ } else {
+ job = NULL;
+ }
+ for (;;) { /* loop until process terminated or stopped */
+ if (job != NULL) {
+ if (job->state) {
+ status = job->ps[job->nprocs - 1].status;
+ if ((status & 0xFF) == 0)
+ status = status >> 8 & 0xFF;
+#if JOBS
+ else if ((status & 0xFF) == 0177)
+ status = (status >> 8 & 0x7F) + 128;
+#endif
+ else
+ status = (status & 0x7F) + 128;
+ if (! iflag)
+ freejob(job);
+ return status;
+ }
+ } else {
+ for (jp = jobtab ; ; jp++) {
+ if (jp >= jobtab + njobs) { /* no running procs */
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if (jp->used && jp->state == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ dowait(1, (struct job *)NULL);
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+jobidcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct job *jp;
+ int i;
+
+ jp = getjob(argv[1]);
+ for (i = 0 ; i < jp->nprocs ; ) {
+ out1fmt("%d", jp->ps[i].pid);
+ out1c(++i < jp->nprocs? ' ' : '\n');
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Convert a job name to a job structure.
+ */
+
+STATIC struct job *
+getjob(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ int jobno;
+ register struct job *jp;
+ int pid;
+ int i;
+
+ if (name == NULL) {
+#if JOBS
+currentjob:
+ if ((jobno = curjob) == 0 || jobtab[jobno - 1].used == 0)
+ error("No current job");
+ return &jobtab[jobno - 1];
+#else
+ error("No current job");
+#endif
+ } else if (name[0] == '%') {
+ if (is_digit(name[1])) {
+ jobno = number(name + 1);
+ if (jobno > 0 && jobno <= njobs
+ && jobtab[jobno - 1].used != 0)
+ return &jobtab[jobno - 1];
+#if JOBS
+ } else if (name[1] == '%' && name[2] == '\0') {
+ goto currentjob;
+#endif
+ } else {
+ register struct job *found = NULL;
+ for (jp = jobtab, i = njobs ; --i >= 0 ; jp++) {
+ if (jp->used && jp->nprocs > 0
+ && prefix(name + 1, jp->ps[0].cmd)) {
+ if (found)
+ error("%s: ambiguous", name);
+ found = jp;
+ }
+ }
+ if (found)
+ return found;
+ }
+ } else if (is_number(name)) {
+ pid = number(name);
+ for (jp = jobtab, i = njobs ; --i >= 0 ; jp++) {
+ if (jp->used && jp->nprocs > 0
+ && jp->ps[jp->nprocs - 1].pid == pid)
+ return jp;
+ }
+ }
+ error("No such job: %s", name);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Return a new job structure,
+ */
+
+struct job *
+makejob(node, nprocs)
+ union node *node;
+ {
+ int i;
+ struct job *jp;
+
+ for (i = njobs, jp = jobtab ; ; jp++) {
+ if (--i < 0) {
+ INTOFF;
+ if (njobs == 0) {
+ jobtab = ckmalloc(4 * sizeof jobtab[0]);
+ } else {
+ jp = ckmalloc((njobs + 4) * sizeof jobtab[0]);
+ bcopy(jobtab, jp, njobs * sizeof jp[0]);
+ ckfree(jobtab);
+ jobtab = jp;
+ }
+ jp = jobtab + njobs;
+ for (i = 4 ; --i >= 0 ; jobtab[njobs++].used = 0);
+ INTON;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (jp->used == 0)
+ break;
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ jp->state = 0;
+ jp->used = 1;
+ jp->changed = 0;
+ jp->nprocs = 0;
+#if JOBS
+ jp->jobctl = jobctl;
+#endif
+ if (nprocs > 1) {
+ jp->ps = ckmalloc(nprocs * sizeof (struct procstat));
+ } else {
+ jp->ps = &jp->ps0;
+ }
+ INTON;
+ TRACE(("makejob(0x%x, %d) returns %%%d\n", (int)node, nprocs, jp - jobtab + 1));
+ return jp;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Fork of a subshell. If we are doing job control, give the subshell its
+ * own process group. Jp is a job structure that the job is to be added to.
+ * N is the command that will be evaluated by the child. Both jp and n may
+ * be NULL. The mode parameter can be one of the following:
+ * FORK_FG - Fork off a foreground process.
+ * FORK_BG - Fork off a background process.
+ * FORK_NOJOB - Like FORK_FG, but don't give the process its own
+ * process group even if job control is on.
+ *
+ * When job control is turned off, background processes have their standard
+ * input redirected to /dev/null (except for the second and later processes
+ * in a pipeline).
+ */
+
+int
+forkshell(jp, n, mode)
+ union node *n;
+ struct job *jp;
+ {
+ int pid;
+ int pgrp;
+
+ TRACE(("forkshell(%%%d, 0x%x, %d) called\n", jp - jobtab, (int)n, mode));
+ INTOFF;
+ pid = fork();
+ if (pid == -1) {
+ TRACE(("Fork failed, errno=%d\n", errno));
+ INTON;
+ error("Cannot fork");
+ }
+ if (pid == 0) {
+ struct job *p;
+ int wasroot;
+ int i;
+
+ TRACE(("Child shell %d\n", getpid()));
+ wasroot = rootshell;
+ rootshell = 0;
+ for (i = njobs, p = jobtab ; --i >= 0 ; p++)
+ if (p->used)
+ freejob(p);
+ closescript();
+ INTON;
+ clear_traps();
+#if JOBS
+ jobctl = 0; /* do job control only in root shell */
+ if (wasroot && mode != FORK_NOJOB && mflag) {
+ if (jp == NULL || jp->nprocs == 0)
+ pgrp = getpid();
+ else
+ pgrp = jp->ps[0].pid;
+ setpgrp(0, pgrp);
+ if (mode == FORK_FG) {
+ /*** this causes superfluous TIOCSPGRPS ***/
+ if (ioctl(2, TIOCSPGRP, (char *)&pgrp) < 0)
+ error("TIOCSPGRP failed, errno=%d\n", errno);
+ }
+ setsignal(SIGTSTP);
+ setsignal(SIGTTOU);
+ } else if (mode == FORK_BG) {
+ ignoresig(SIGINT);
+ ignoresig(SIGQUIT);
+ if ((jp == NULL || jp->nprocs == 0) &&
+ ! fd0_redirected_p ()) {
+ close(0);
+ if (open("/dev/null", O_RDONLY) != 0)
+ error("Can't open /dev/null");
+ }
+ }
+#else
+ if (mode == FORK_BG) {
+ ignoresig(SIGINT);
+ ignoresig(SIGQUIT);
+ if ((jp == NULL || jp->nprocs == 0) &&
+ ! fd0_redirected_p ()) {
+ close(0);
+ if (open("/dev/null", O_RDONLY) != 0)
+ error("Can't open /dev/null");
+ }
+ }
+#endif
+ if (wasroot && iflag) {
+ setsignal(SIGINT);
+ setsignal(SIGQUIT);
+ setsignal(SIGTERM);
+ }
+ return pid;
+ }
+ if (rootshell && mode != FORK_NOJOB && mflag) {
+ if (jp == NULL || jp->nprocs == 0)
+ pgrp = pid;
+ else
+ pgrp = jp->ps[0].pid;
+ setpgrp(pid, pgrp);
+ }
+ if (mode == FORK_BG)
+ backgndpid = pid; /* set $! */
+ if (jp) {
+ struct procstat *ps = &jp->ps[jp->nprocs++];
+ ps->pid = pid;
+ ps->status = -1;
+ ps->cmd = nullstr;
+ if (iflag && rootshell && n)
+ ps->cmd = commandtext(n);
+ }
+ INTON;
+ TRACE(("In parent shell: child = %d\n", pid));
+ return pid;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Wait for job to finish.
+ *
+ * Under job control we have the problem that while a child process is
+ * running interrupts generated by the user are sent to the child but not
+ * to the shell. This means that an infinite loop started by an inter-
+ * active user may be hard to kill. With job control turned off, an
+ * interactive user may place an interactive program inside a loop. If
+ * the interactive program catches interrupts, the user doesn't want
+ * these interrupts to also abort the loop. The approach we take here
+ * is to have the shell ignore interrupt signals while waiting for a
+ * forground process to terminate, and then send itself an interrupt
+ * signal if the child process was terminated by an interrupt signal.
+ * Unfortunately, some programs want to do a bit of cleanup and then
+ * exit on interrupt; unless these processes terminate themselves by
+ * sending a signal to themselves (instead of calling exit) they will
+ * confuse this approach.
+ */
+
+int
+waitforjob(jp)
+ register struct job *jp;
+ {
+#if JOBS
+ int mypgrp = getpgrp(0);
+#endif
+ int status;
+ int st;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ TRACE(("waitforjob(%%%d) called\n", jp - jobtab + 1));
+ while (jp->state == 0) {
+ dowait(1, jp);
+ }
+#if JOBS
+ if (jp->jobctl) {
+ if (ioctl(2, TIOCSPGRP, (char *)&mypgrp) < 0)
+ error("TIOCSPGRP failed, errno=%d\n", errno);
+ }
+ if (jp->state == JOBSTOPPED)
+ curjob = jp - jobtab + 1;
+#endif
+ status = jp->ps[jp->nprocs - 1].status;
+ /* convert to 8 bits */
+ if ((status & 0xFF) == 0)
+ st = status >> 8 & 0xFF;
+#if JOBS
+ else if ((status & 0xFF) == 0177)
+ st = (status >> 8 & 0x7F) + 128;
+#endif
+ else
+ st = (status & 0x7F) + 128;
+ if (! JOBS || jp->state == JOBDONE)
+ freejob(jp);
+ CLEAR_PENDING_INT;
+ if ((status & 0x7F) == SIGINT)
+ kill(getpid(), SIGINT);
+ INTON;
+ return st;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Wait for a process to terminate.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+dowait(block, job)
+ struct job *job;
+ {
+ int pid;
+ int status;
+ struct procstat *sp;
+ struct job *jp;
+ struct job *thisjob;
+ int done;
+ int stopped;
+ int core;
+
+ TRACE(("dowait(%d) called\n", block));
+ do {
+ pid = waitproc(block, &status);
+ TRACE(("wait returns %d, status=%d\n", pid, status));
+ } while (pid == -1 && errno == EINTR);
+ if (pid <= 0)
+ return pid;
+ INTOFF;
+ thisjob = NULL;
+ for (jp = jobtab ; jp < jobtab + njobs ; jp++) {
+ if (jp->used) {
+ done = 1;
+ stopped = 1;
+ for (sp = jp->ps ; sp < jp->ps + jp->nprocs ; sp++) {
+ if (sp->pid == -1)
+ continue;
+ if (sp->pid == pid) {
+ TRACE(("Changin status of proc %d from 0x%x to 0x%x\n", pid, sp->status, status));
+ sp->status = status;
+ thisjob = jp;
+ }
+ if (sp->status == -1)
+ stopped = 0;
+ else if ((sp->status & 0377) == 0177)
+ done = 0;
+ }
+ if (stopped) { /* stopped or done */
+ int state = done? JOBDONE : JOBSTOPPED;
+ if (jp->state != state) {
+ TRACE(("Job %d: changing state from %d to %d\n", jp - jobtab + 1, jp->state, state));
+ jp->state = state;
+#if JOBS
+ if (done && curjob == jp - jobtab + 1)
+ curjob = 0; /* no current job */
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ INTON;
+ if (! rootshell || ! iflag || (job && thisjob == job)) {
+#if JOBS
+ if ((status & 0xFF) == 0177)
+ status >>= 8;
+#endif
+ core = status & 0x80;
+ status &= 0x7F;
+ if (status != 0 && status != SIGINT && status != SIGPIPE) {
+ if (thisjob != job)
+ outfmt(out2, "%d: ", pid);
+#if JOBS
+ if (status == SIGTSTP && rootshell && iflag)
+ outfmt(out2, "%%%d ", job - jobtab + 1);
+#endif
+ if (status <= MAXSIG && sigmesg[status])
+ out2str(sigmesg[status]);
+ else
+ outfmt(out2, "Signal %d", status);
+ if (core)
+ out2str(" - core dumped");
+ out2c('\n');
+ flushout(&errout);
+ } else {
+ TRACE(("Not printing status: status=%d\n", status));
+ }
+ } else {
+ TRACE(("Not printing status, rootshell=%d, job=0x%x\n", rootshell, job));
+ if (thisjob)
+ thisjob->changed = 1;
+ }
+ return pid;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Do a wait system call. If job control is compiled in, we accept
+ * stopped processes. If block is zero, we return a value of zero
+ * rather than blocking.
+ *
+ * System V doesn't have a non-blocking wait system call. It does
+ * have a SIGCLD signal that is sent to a process when one of it's
+ * children dies. The obvious way to use SIGCLD would be to install
+ * a handler for SIGCLD which simply bumped a counter when a SIGCLD
+ * was received, and have waitproc bump another counter when it got
+ * the status of a process. Waitproc would then know that a wait
+ * system call would not block if the two counters were different.
+ * This approach doesn't work because if a process has children that
+ * have not been waited for, System V will send it a SIGCLD when it
+ * installs a signal handler for SIGCLD. What this means is that when
+ * a child exits, the shell will be sent SIGCLD signals continuously
+ * until is runs out of stack space, unless it does a wait call before
+ * restoring the signal handler. The code below takes advantage of
+ * this (mis)feature by installing a signal handler for SIGCLD and
+ * then checking to see whether it was called. If there are any
+ * children to be waited for, it will be.
+ *
+ * If neither SYSV nor BSD is defined, we don't implement nonblocking
+ * waits at all. In this case, the user will not be informed when
+ * a background process until the next time she runs a real program
+ * (as opposed to running a builtin command or just typing return),
+ * and the jobs command may give out of date information.
+ */
+
+#ifdef SYSV
+STATIC int gotsigchild;
+
+STATIC int onsigchild() {
+ gotsigchild = 1;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+STATIC int
+waitproc(block, status)
+ int *status;
+ {
+#ifdef BSD
+ int flags;
+
+#if JOBS
+ flags = WUNTRACED;
+#else
+ flags = 0;
+#endif
+ if (block == 0)
+ flags |= WNOHANG;
+ return wait3(status, flags, (struct rusage *)NULL);
+#else
+#ifdef SYSV
+ int (*save)();
+
+ if (block == 0) {
+ gotsigchild = 0;
+ save = signal(SIGCLD, onsigchild);
+ signal(SIGCLD, save);
+ if (gotsigchild == 0)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return wait(status);
+#else
+ if (block == 0)
+ return 0;
+ return wait(status);
+#endif
+#endif
+}
+
+/*
+ * return 1 if there are stopped jobs, otherwise 0
+ */
+int job_warning = 0;
+int
+stoppedjobs()
+{
+ register int jobno;
+ register struct job *jp;
+
+ if (job_warning)
+ return (0);
+ for (jobno = 1, jp = jobtab; jobno <= njobs; jobno++, jp++) {
+ if (jp->used == 0)
+ continue;
+ if (jp->state == JOBSTOPPED) {
+ out2str("You have stopped jobs.\n");
+ job_warning = 2;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Return a string identifying a command (to be printed by the
+ * jobs command.
+ */
+
+STATIC char *cmdnextc;
+STATIC int cmdnleft;
+STATIC void cmdtxt(), cmdputs();
+#define MAXCMDTEXT 200
+
+char *
+commandtext(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ char *name;
+
+ cmdnextc = name = ckmalloc(MAXCMDTEXT);
+ cmdnleft = MAXCMDTEXT - 4;
+ cmdtxt(n);
+ *cmdnextc = '\0';
+ return name;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+cmdtxt(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ union node *np;
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ char *p;
+ int i;
+ char s[2];
+
+ if (n == NULL)
+ return;
+ switch (n->type) {
+ case NSEMI:
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch1);
+ cmdputs("; ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch2);
+ break;
+ case NAND:
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch1);
+ cmdputs(" && ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch2);
+ break;
+ case NOR:
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch1);
+ cmdputs(" || ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch2);
+ break;
+ case NPIPE:
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next) {
+ cmdtxt(lp->n);
+ if (lp->next)
+ cmdputs(" | ");
+ }
+ break;
+ case NSUBSHELL:
+ cmdputs("(");
+ cmdtxt(n->nredir.n);
+ cmdputs(")");
+ break;
+ case NREDIR:
+ case NBACKGND:
+ cmdtxt(n->nredir.n);
+ break;
+ case NIF:
+ cmdputs("if ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nif.test);
+ cmdputs("; then ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nif.ifpart);
+ cmdputs("...");
+ break;
+ case NWHILE:
+ cmdputs("while ");
+ goto until;
+ case NUNTIL:
+ cmdputs("until ");
+until:
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch1);
+ cmdputs("; do ");
+ cmdtxt(n->nbinary.ch2);
+ cmdputs("; done");
+ break;
+ case NFOR:
+ cmdputs("for ");
+ cmdputs(n->nfor.var);
+ cmdputs(" in ...");
+ break;
+ case NCASE:
+ cmdputs("case ");
+ cmdputs(n->ncase.expr->narg.text);
+ cmdputs(" in ...");
+ break;
+ case NDEFUN:
+ cmdputs(n->narg.text);
+ cmdputs("() ...");
+ break;
+ case NCMD:
+ for (np = n->ncmd.args ; np ; np = np->narg.next) {
+ cmdtxt(np);
+ if (np->narg.next)
+ cmdputs(" ");
+ }
+ for (np = n->ncmd.redirect ; np ; np = np->nfile.next) {
+ cmdputs(" ");
+ cmdtxt(np);
+ }
+ break;
+ case NARG:
+ cmdputs(n->narg.text);
+ break;
+ case NTO:
+ p = ">"; i = 1; goto redir;
+ case NAPPEND:
+ p = ">>"; i = 1; goto redir;
+ case NTOFD:
+ p = ">&"; i = 1; goto redir;
+ case NFROM:
+ p = "<"; i = 0; goto redir;
+ case NFROMFD:
+ p = "<&"; i = 0; goto redir;
+redir:
+ if (n->nfile.fd != i) {
+ s[0] = n->nfile.fd + '0';
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ cmdputs(s);
+ }
+ cmdputs(p);
+ if (n->type == NTOFD || n->type == NFROMFD) {
+ s[0] = n->ndup.dupfd + '0';
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ cmdputs(s);
+ } else {
+ cmdtxt(n->nfile.fname);
+ }
+ break;
+ case NHERE:
+ case NXHERE:
+ cmdputs("<<...");
+ break;
+ default:
+ cmdputs("???");
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+cmdputs(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+ register char c;
+ int subtype = 0;
+
+ if (cmdnleft <= 0)
+ return;
+ p = s;
+ q = cmdnextc;
+ while ((c = *p++) != '\0') {
+ if (c == CTLESC)
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ else if (c == CTLVAR) {
+ *q++ = '$';
+ if (--cmdnleft > 0)
+ *q++ = '{';
+ subtype = *p++;
+ } else if (c == '=' && subtype != 0) {
+ *q++ = "}-+?="[(subtype & VSTYPE) - VSNORMAL];
+ subtype = 0;
+ } else if (c == CTLENDVAR) {
+ *q++ = '}';
+ } else if (c == CTLBACKQ | c == CTLBACKQ+CTLQUOTE)
+ cmdnleft++; /* ignore it */
+ else
+ *q++ = c;
+ if (--cmdnleft <= 0) {
+ *q++ = '.';
+ *q++ = '.';
+ *q++ = '.';
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ cmdnextc = q;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/jobs.h b/bin/sh/jobs.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2464850
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/jobs.h
@@ -0,0 +1,99 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)jobs.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/* Mode argument to forkshell. Don't change FORK_FG or FORK_BG. */
+#define FORK_FG 0
+#define FORK_BG 1
+#define FORK_NOJOB 2
+
+
+/*
+ * A job structure contains information about a job. A job is either a
+ * single process or a set of processes contained in a pipeline. In the
+ * latter case, pidlist will be non-NULL, and will point to a -1 terminated
+ * array of pids.
+ */
+
+struct procstat {
+ short pid; /* process id */
+ short status; /* status flags (defined above) */
+ char *cmd; /* text of command being run */
+};
+
+
+/* states */
+#define JOBSTOPPED 1 /* all procs are stopped */
+#define JOBDONE 2 /* all procs are completed */
+
+
+struct job {
+ struct procstat ps0; /* status of process */
+ struct procstat *ps; /* status or processes when more than one */
+ short nprocs; /* number of processes */
+ short pgrp; /* process group of this job */
+ char state; /* true if job is finished */
+ char used; /* true if this entry is in used */
+ char changed; /* true if status has changed */
+#if JOBS
+ char jobctl; /* job running under job control */
+#endif
+};
+
+extern short backgndpid; /* pid of last background process */
+extern int job_warning; /* user was warned about stopped jobs */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void setjobctl(int);
+void showjobs(int);
+struct job *makejob(union node *, int);
+int forkshell(struct job *, union node *, int);
+int waitforjob(struct job *);
+char *commandtext(union node *);
+#else
+void setjobctl();
+void showjobs();
+struct job *makejob();
+int forkshell();
+int waitforjob();
+char *commandtext();
+#endif
+
+#if ! JOBS
+#define setjobctl(on) /* do nothing */
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/machdep.h b/bin/sh/machdep.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1d50dfb
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/machdep.h
@@ -0,0 +1,51 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)machdep.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Most machines require the value returned from malloc to be aligned
+ * in some way. The following macro will get this right on many machines.
+ */
+
+#ifndef ALIGN
+union align {
+ int i;
+ char *cp;
+};
+
+#define ALIGN(nbytes) ((nbytes) + sizeof(union align) - 1 &~ (sizeof(union align) - 1))
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/mail.c b/bin/sh/mail.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0f74ad8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mail.c
@@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mail.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Routines to check for mail. (Perhaps make part of main.c?)
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "exec.h" /* defines padvance() */
+#include "var.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+
+#define MAXMBOXES 10
+
+
+STATIC int nmboxes; /* number of mailboxes */
+STATIC time_t mailtime[MAXMBOXES]; /* times of mailboxes */
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Print appropriate message(s) if mail has arrived. If the argument is
+ * nozero, then the value of MAIL has changed, so we just update the
+ * values.
+ */
+
+void
+chkmail(silent) {
+ register int i;
+ char *mpath;
+ char *p;
+ register char *q;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ struct stat statb;
+
+ if (silent)
+ nmboxes = 10;
+ if (nmboxes == 0)
+ return;
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ mpath = mpathset()? mpathval() : mailval();
+ for (i = 0 ; i < nmboxes ; i++) {
+ p = padvance(&mpath, nullstr);
+ if (p == NULL)
+ break;
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ continue;
+ for (q = p ; *q ; q++);
+ if (q[-1] != '/')
+ abort();
+ q[-1] = '\0'; /* delete trailing '/' */
+#ifdef notdef /* this is what the System V shell claims to do (it lies) */
+ if (stat(p, &statb) < 0)
+ statb.st_mtime = 0;
+ if (statb.st_mtime > mailtime[i] && ! silent) {
+ out2str(pathopt? pathopt : "you have mail");
+ out2c('\n');
+ }
+ mailtime[i] = statb.st_mtime;
+#else /* this is what it should do */
+ if (stat(p, &statb) < 0)
+ statb.st_size = 0;
+ if (statb.st_size > mailtime[i] && ! silent) {
+ out2str(pathopt? pathopt : "you have mail");
+ out2c('\n');
+ }
+ mailtime[i] = statb.st_size;
+#endif
+ }
+ nmboxes = i;
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mail.h b/bin/sh/mail.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d859e53
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mail.h
@@ -0,0 +1,43 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)mail.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void chkmail(int);
+#else
+void chkmail();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/main.c b/bin/sh/main.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dab9e64
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/main.c
@@ -0,0 +1,304 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)main.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "mail.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "init.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+#define PROFILE 0
+
+int rootpid;
+int rootshell;
+STATIC union node *curcmd;
+STATIC union node *prevcmd;
+extern int errno;
+#if PROFILE
+short profile_buf[16384];
+extern int etext();
+#endif
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void read_profile(char *);
+char *getenv(char *);
+#else
+STATIC void read_profile();
+char *getenv();
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Main routine. We initialize things, parse the arguments, execute
+ * profiles if we're a login shell, and then call cmdloop to execute
+ * commands. The setjmp call sets up the location to jump to when an
+ * exception occurs. When an exception occurs the variable "state"
+ * is used to figure out how far we had gotten.
+ */
+
+main(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ volatile int state;
+ char *shinit;
+
+#if PROFILE
+ monitor(4, etext, profile_buf, sizeof profile_buf, 50);
+#endif
+ state = 0;
+ if (setjmp(jmploc.loc)) {
+ /*
+ * When a shell procedure is executed, we raise the
+ * exception EXSHELLPROC to clean up before executing
+ * the shell procedure.
+ */
+ if (exception == EXSHELLPROC) {
+ rootpid = getpid();
+ rootshell = 1;
+ minusc = NULL;
+ state = 3;
+ } else if (state == 0 || iflag == 0 || ! rootshell)
+ exitshell(2);
+ reset();
+ if (exception == EXINT
+#if ATTY
+ && (! attyset() || equal(termval(), "emacs"))
+#endif
+ ) {
+ out2c('\n');
+ flushout(&errout);
+ }
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ FORCEINTON; /* enable interrupts */
+ if (state == 1)
+ goto state1;
+ else if (state == 2)
+ goto state2;
+ else if (state == 3)
+ goto state3;
+ else
+ goto state4;
+ }
+ handler = &jmploc;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ opentrace();
+ trputs("Shell args: "); trargs(argv);
+#endif
+ rootpid = getpid();
+ rootshell = 1;
+ init();
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ procargs(argc, argv);
+ if (argv[0] && argv[0][0] == '-') {
+ state = 1;
+ read_profile("/etc/profile");
+state1:
+ state = 2;
+ read_profile(".profile");
+ }
+state2:
+ state = 3;
+ if ((shinit = lookupvar("ENV")) != NULL &&
+ *shinit != '\0') {
+ state = 3;
+ read_profile(shinit);
+ }
+state3:
+ state = 4;
+ if (minusc) {
+ evalstring(minusc);
+ }
+ if (sflag || minusc == NULL) {
+state4: /* XXX ??? - why isn't this before the "if" statement */
+ cmdloop(1);
+ }
+#if PROFILE
+ monitor(0);
+#endif
+ exitshell(exitstatus);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Read and execute commands. "Top" is nonzero for the top level command
+ * loop; it turns on prompting if the shell is interactive.
+ */
+
+void
+cmdloop(top) {
+ union node *n;
+ struct stackmark smark;
+ int inter;
+ int numeof = 0;
+
+ TRACE(("cmdloop(%d) called\n", top));
+ setstackmark(&smark);
+ for (;;) {
+ if (pendingsigs)
+ dotrap();
+ inter = 0;
+ if (iflag && top) {
+ inter++;
+ showjobs(1);
+ chkmail(0);
+ flushout(&output);
+ }
+ n = parsecmd(inter);
+ /* showtree(n); DEBUG */
+ if (n == NEOF) {
+ if (!top || numeof >= 50)
+ break;
+ if (!stoppedjobs()) {
+ if (!Iflag)
+ break;
+ out2str("\nUse \"exit\" to leave shell.\n");
+ }
+ numeof++;
+ } else if (n != NULL && nflag == 0) {
+ job_warning = (job_warning == 2) ? 1 : 0;
+ numeof = 0;
+ evaltree(n, 0);
+ }
+ popstackmark(&smark);
+ }
+ popstackmark(&smark); /* unnecessary */
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Read /etc/profile or .profile. Return on error.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+read_profile(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ int fd;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if ((fd = open(name, O_RDONLY)) >= 0)
+ setinputfd(fd, 1);
+ INTON;
+ if (fd < 0)
+ return;
+ cmdloop(0);
+ popfile();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Read a file containing shell functions.
+ */
+
+void
+readcmdfile(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ int fd;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ if ((fd = open(name, O_RDONLY)) >= 0)
+ setinputfd(fd, 1);
+ else
+ error("Can't open %s", name);
+ INTON;
+ cmdloop(0);
+ popfile();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Take commands from a file. To be compatable we should do a path
+ * search for the file, but a path search doesn't make any sense.
+ */
+
+dotcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ exitstatus = 0;
+ if (argc >= 2) { /* That's what SVR2 does */
+ setinputfile(argv[1], 1);
+ commandname = argv[1];
+ cmdloop(0);
+ popfile();
+ }
+ return exitstatus;
+}
+
+
+exitcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ if (stoppedjobs())
+ return;
+ if (argc > 1)
+ exitstatus = number(argv[1]);
+ exitshell(exitstatus);
+}
+
+
+#ifdef notdef
+/*
+ * Should never be called.
+ */
+
+void
+exit(exitstatus) {
+ _exit(exitstatus);
+}
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/main.h b/bin/sh/main.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b403b2c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/main.h
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)main.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+extern int rootpid; /* pid of main shell */
+extern int rootshell; /* true if we aren't a child of the main shell */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void readcmdfile(char *);
+void cmdloop(int);
+#else
+void readcmdfile();
+void cmdloop();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/memalloc.c b/bin/sh/memalloc.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5fa246a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/memalloc.c
@@ -0,0 +1,292 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)memalloc.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "machdep.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+/*
+ * Like malloc, but returns an error when out of space.
+ */
+
+pointer
+ckmalloc(nbytes) {
+ register pointer p;
+ pointer malloc();
+
+ if ((p = malloc(nbytes)) == NULL)
+ error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Same for realloc.
+ */
+
+pointer
+ckrealloc(p, nbytes)
+ register pointer p;
+ {
+ pointer realloc();
+
+ if ((p = realloc(p, nbytes)) == NULL)
+ error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Make a copy of a string in safe storage.
+ */
+
+char *
+savestr(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+
+ p = ckmalloc(strlen(s) + 1);
+ scopy(s, p);
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse trees for commands are allocated in lifo order, so we use a stack
+ * to make this more efficient, and also to avoid all sorts of exception
+ * handling code to handle interrupts in the middle of a parse.
+ *
+ * The size 504 was chosen because the Ultrix malloc handles that size
+ * well.
+ */
+
+#define MINSIZE 504 /* minimum size of a block */
+
+
+struct stack_block {
+ struct stack_block *prev;
+ char space[MINSIZE];
+};
+
+struct stack_block stackbase;
+struct stack_block *stackp = &stackbase;
+char *stacknxt = stackbase.space;
+int stacknleft = MINSIZE;
+int sstrnleft;
+int herefd = -1;
+
+
+
+pointer
+stalloc(nbytes) {
+ register char *p;
+
+ nbytes = ALIGN(nbytes);
+ if (nbytes > stacknleft) {
+ int blocksize;
+ struct stack_block *sp;
+
+ blocksize = nbytes;
+ if (blocksize < MINSIZE)
+ blocksize = MINSIZE;
+ INTOFF;
+ sp = ckmalloc(sizeof(struct stack_block) - MINSIZE + blocksize);
+ sp->prev = stackp;
+ stacknxt = sp->space;
+ stacknleft = blocksize;
+ stackp = sp;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ p = stacknxt;
+ stacknxt += nbytes;
+ stacknleft -= nbytes;
+ return p;
+}
+
+
+void
+stunalloc(p)
+ pointer p;
+ {
+ if (p == NULL) { /*DEBUG */
+ write(2, "stunalloc\n", 10);
+ abort();
+ }
+ stacknleft += stacknxt - (char *)p;
+ stacknxt = p;
+}
+
+
+
+void
+setstackmark(mark)
+ struct stackmark *mark;
+ {
+ mark->stackp = stackp;
+ mark->stacknxt = stacknxt;
+ mark->stacknleft = stacknleft;
+}
+
+
+void
+popstackmark(mark)
+ struct stackmark *mark;
+ {
+ struct stack_block *sp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ while (stackp != mark->stackp) {
+ sp = stackp;
+ stackp = sp->prev;
+ ckfree(sp);
+ }
+ stacknxt = mark->stacknxt;
+ stacknleft = mark->stacknleft;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * When the parser reads in a string, it wants to stick the string on the
+ * stack and only adjust the stack pointer when it knows how big the
+ * string is. Stackblock (defined in stack.h) returns a pointer to a block
+ * of space on top of the stack and stackblocklen returns the length of
+ * this block. Growstackblock will grow this space by at least one byte,
+ * possibly moving it (like realloc). Grabstackblock actually allocates the
+ * part of the block that has been used.
+ */
+
+void
+growstackblock() {
+ char *p;
+ int newlen = stacknleft * 2 + 100;
+ char *oldspace = stacknxt;
+ int oldlen = stacknleft;
+ struct stack_block *sp;
+
+ if (stacknxt == stackp->space && stackp != &stackbase) {
+ INTOFF;
+ sp = stackp;
+ stackp = sp->prev;
+ sp = ckrealloc((pointer)sp, sizeof(struct stack_block) - MINSIZE + newlen);
+ sp->prev = stackp;
+ stackp = sp;
+ stacknxt = sp->space;
+ stacknleft = newlen;
+ INTON;
+ } else {
+ p = stalloc(newlen);
+ bcopy(oldspace, p, oldlen);
+ stacknxt = p; /* free the space */
+ stacknleft += newlen; /* we just allocated */
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+void
+grabstackblock(len) {
+ len = ALIGN(len);
+ stacknxt += len;
+ stacknleft -= len;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The following routines are somewhat easier to use that the above.
+ * The user declares a variable of type STACKSTR, which may be declared
+ * to be a register. The macro STARTSTACKSTR initializes things. Then
+ * the user uses the macro STPUTC to add characters to the string. In
+ * effect, STPUTC(c, p) is the same as *p++ = c except that the stack is
+ * grown as necessary. When the user is done, she can just leave the
+ * string there and refer to it using stackblock(). Or she can allocate
+ * the space for it using grabstackstr(). If it is necessary to allow
+ * someone else to use the stack temporarily and then continue to grow
+ * the string, the user should use grabstack to allocate the space, and
+ * then call ungrabstr(p) to return to the previous mode of operation.
+ *
+ * USTPUTC is like STPUTC except that it doesn't check for overflow.
+ * CHECKSTACKSPACE can be called before USTPUTC to ensure that there
+ * is space for at least one character.
+ */
+
+
+char *
+growstackstr() {
+ int len = stackblocksize();
+ if (herefd >= 0 && len >= 1024) {
+ xwrite(herefd, stackblock(), len);
+ sstrnleft = len - 1;
+ return stackblock();
+ }
+ growstackblock();
+ sstrnleft = stackblocksize() - len - 1;
+ return stackblock() + len;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called from CHECKSTRSPACE.
+ */
+
+char *
+makestrspace() {
+ int len = stackblocksize() - sstrnleft;
+ growstackblock();
+ sstrnleft = stackblocksize() - len;
+ return stackblock() + len;
+}
+
+
+
+void
+ungrabstackstr(s, p)
+ char *s;
+ char *p;
+ {
+ stacknleft += stacknxt - s;
+ stacknxt = s;
+ sstrnleft = stacknleft - (p - s);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/memalloc.h b/bin/sh/memalloc.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..3f2c800
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/memalloc.h
@@ -0,0 +1,95 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)memalloc.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+struct stackmark {
+ struct stack_block *stackp;
+ char *stacknxt;
+ int stacknleft;
+};
+
+
+extern char *stacknxt;
+extern int stacknleft;
+extern int sstrnleft;
+extern int herefd;
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+pointer ckmalloc(int);
+pointer ckrealloc(pointer, int);
+void free(pointer); /* defined in C library */
+char *savestr(char *);
+pointer stalloc(int);
+void stunalloc(pointer);
+void setstackmark(struct stackmark *);
+void popstackmark(struct stackmark *);
+void growstackblock(void);
+void grabstackblock(int);
+char *growstackstr(void);
+char *makestrspace(void);
+void ungrabstackstr(char *, char *);
+#else
+pointer ckmalloc();
+pointer ckrealloc();
+void free(); /* defined in C library */
+char *savestr();
+pointer stalloc();
+void stunalloc();
+void setstackmark();
+void popstackmark();
+void growstackblock();
+void grabstackblock();
+char *growstackstr();
+char *makestrspace();
+void ungrabstackstr();
+#endif
+
+
+
+#define stackblock() stacknxt
+#define stackblocksize() stacknleft
+#define STARTSTACKSTR(p) p = stackblock(), sstrnleft = stackblocksize()
+#define STPUTC(c, p) (--sstrnleft >= 0? (*p++ = (c)) : (p = growstackstr(), *p++ = (c)))
+#define CHECKSTRSPACE(n, p) if (sstrnleft < n) p = makestrspace(); else
+#define USTPUTC(c, p) (--sstrnleft, *p++ = (c))
+#define STACKSTRNUL(p) (sstrnleft == 0? (p = growstackstr(), *p = '\0') : (*p = '\0'))
+#define STUNPUTC(p) (++sstrnleft, --p)
+#define STTOPC(p) p[-1]
+#define STADJUST(amount, p) (p += (amount), sstrnleft -= (amount))
+#define grabstackstr(p) stalloc(stackblocksize() - sstrnleft)
+
+#define ckfree(p) free((pointer)(p))
diff --git a/bin/sh/miscbltin.c b/bin/sh/miscbltin.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4ea3a4c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/miscbltin.c
@@ -0,0 +1,166 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)miscbltin.c 8.2 (Berkeley) 4/16/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Miscelaneous builtins.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+#undef eflag
+
+extern char **argptr; /* argument list for builtin command */
+
+
+/*
+ * The read builtin. The -e option causes backslashes to escape the
+ * following character.
+ *
+ * This uses unbuffered input, which may be avoidable in some cases.
+ */
+
+readcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ char **ap;
+ int backslash;
+ char c;
+ int eflag;
+ char *prompt;
+ char *ifs;
+ char *p;
+ int startword;
+ int status;
+ int i;
+
+ eflag = 0;
+ prompt = NULL;
+ while ((i = nextopt("ep:")) != '\0') {
+ if (i == 'p')
+ prompt = optarg;
+ else
+ eflag = 1;
+ }
+ if (prompt && isatty(0)) {
+ out2str(prompt);
+ flushall();
+ }
+ if (*(ap = argptr) == NULL)
+ error("arg count");
+ if ((ifs = bltinlookup("IFS", 1)) == NULL)
+ ifs = nullstr;
+ status = 0;
+ startword = 1;
+ backslash = 0;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+ for (;;) {
+ if (read(0, &c, 1) != 1) {
+ status = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (c == '\0')
+ continue;
+ if (backslash) {
+ backslash = 0;
+ if (c != '\n')
+ STPUTC(c, p);
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (eflag && c == '\\') {
+ backslash++;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (c == '\n')
+ break;
+ if (startword && *ifs == ' ' && strchr(ifs, c)) {
+ continue;
+ }
+ startword = 0;
+ if (backslash && c == '\\') {
+ if (read(0, &c, 1) != 1) {
+ status = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ STPUTC(c, p);
+ } else if (ap[1] != NULL && strchr(ifs, c) != NULL) {
+ STACKSTRNUL(p);
+ setvar(*ap, stackblock(), 0);
+ ap++;
+ startword = 1;
+ STARTSTACKSTR(p);
+ } else {
+ STPUTC(c, p);
+ }
+ }
+ STACKSTRNUL(p);
+ setvar(*ap, stackblock(), 0);
+ while (*++ap != NULL)
+ setvar(*ap, nullstr, 0);
+ return status;
+}
+
+
+
+umaskcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ int mask;
+ char *p;
+ int i;
+
+ if ((p = argv[1]) == NULL) {
+ INTOFF;
+ mask = umask(0);
+ umask(mask);
+ INTON;
+ out1fmt("%.4o\n", mask); /* %#o might be better */
+ } else {
+ mask = 0;
+ do {
+ if ((unsigned)(i = *p - '0') >= 8)
+ error("Illegal number: %s", argv[1]);
+ mask = (mask << 3) + i;
+ } while (*++p != '\0');
+ umask(mask);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mkbuiltins b/bin/sh/mkbuiltins
new file mode 100755
index 0000000..48fc572
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mkbuiltins
@@ -0,0 +1,87 @@
+#!/bin/sh -
+#
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)mkbuiltins 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+temp=/tmp/ka$$
+havejobs=0
+if grep '^#define JOBS[ ]*1' shell.h > /dev/null
+then havejobs=1
+fi
+exec > obj/builtins.c
+cat <<\!
+/*
+ * This file was generated by the mkbuiltins program.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "builtins.h"
+
+!
+awk '/^[^#]/ {if('$havejobs' || $2 != "-j") print $0}' builtins |
+ sed 's/-j//' > $temp
+awk '{ printf "int %s();\n", $1}' $temp
+echo '
+int (*const builtinfunc[])() = {'
+awk '/^[^#]/ { printf "\t%s,\n", $1}' $temp
+echo '};
+
+const struct builtincmd builtincmd[] = {'
+awk '{ for (i = 2 ; i <= NF ; i++) {
+ printf "\t\"%s\", %d,\n", $i, NR-1
+ }}' $temp
+echo ' NULL, 0
+};'
+
+exec > obj/builtins.h
+cat <<\!
+/*
+ * This file was generated by the mkbuiltins program.
+ */
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+!
+tr abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyz ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUVWXYZ < $temp |
+ awk '{ printf "#define %s %d\n", $1, NR-1}'
+echo '
+struct builtincmd {
+ char *name;
+ int code;
+};
+
+extern int (*const builtinfunc[])();
+extern const struct builtincmd builtincmd[];'
+rm -f $temp
diff --git a/bin/sh/mkinit.c b/bin/sh/mkinit.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..eac0374
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mkinit.c
@@ -0,0 +1,547 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mkinit.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * This program scans all the source files for code to handle various
+ * special events and combines this code into one file. This (allegedly)
+ * improves the structure of the program since there is no need for
+ * anyone outside of a module to know that that module performs special
+ * operations on particular events. The command is executed iff init.c
+ * is actually changed.
+ *
+ * Usage: mkinit command sourcefile...
+ */
+
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+
+/*
+ * OUTFILE is the name of the output file. Output is initially written
+ * to the file OUTTEMP, which is then moved to OUTFILE if OUTTEMP and
+ * OUTFILE are different.
+ */
+
+#define OUTFILE "init.c"
+#define OUTTEMP "init.c.new"
+#define OUTOBJ "init.o"
+
+
+/*
+ * A text structure is basicly just a string that grows as more characters
+ * are added onto the end of it. It is implemented as a linked list of
+ * blocks of characters. The routines addstr and addchar append a string
+ * or a single character, respectively, to a text structure. Writetext
+ * writes the contents of a text structure to a file.
+ */
+
+#define BLOCKSIZE 512
+
+struct text {
+ char *nextc;
+ int nleft;
+ struct block *start;
+ struct block *last;
+};
+
+struct block {
+ struct block *next;
+ char text[BLOCKSIZE];
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * There is one event structure for each event that mkinit handles.
+ */
+
+struct event {
+ char *name; /* name of event (e.g. INIT) */
+ char *routine; /* name of routine called on event */
+ char *comment; /* comment describing routine */
+ struct text code; /* code for handling event */
+};
+
+
+char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mkinit program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+char init[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * Initialization code.\n\
+ */\n";
+
+char reset[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This routine is called when an error or an interrupt occurs in an\n\
+ * interactive shell and control is returned to the main command loop.\n\
+ */\n";
+
+char shellproc[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This routine is called to initialize the shell to run a shell procedure.\n\
+ */\n";
+
+
+struct event event[] = {
+ {"INIT", "init", init},
+ {"RESET", "reset", reset},
+ {"SHELLPROC", "initshellproc", shellproc},
+ {NULL, NULL}
+};
+
+
+char *curfile; /* current file */
+int linno; /* current line */
+char *header_files[200]; /* list of header files */
+struct text defines; /* #define statements */
+struct text decls; /* declarations */
+int amiddecls; /* for formatting */
+
+
+void readfile(), doevent(), doinclude(), dodecl(), output();
+void addstr(), addchar(), writetext();
+
+#define equal(s1, s2) (strcmp(s1, s2) == 0)
+
+FILE *ckfopen();
+char *savestr();
+void *ckmalloc __P((int));
+void error();
+
+main(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+ {
+ char **ap;
+ int fd;
+ char c;
+
+ if (argc < 2)
+ error("Usage: mkinit command file...");
+ header_files[0] = "\"shell.h\"";
+ header_files[1] = "\"mystring.h\"";
+ for (ap = argv + 2 ; *ap ; ap++)
+ readfile(*ap);
+ output();
+ if (file_changed()) {
+ unlink(OUTFILE);
+ link(OUTTEMP, OUTFILE);
+ unlink(OUTTEMP);
+ } else {
+ unlink(OUTTEMP);
+ if (touch(OUTOBJ))
+ exit(0); /* no compilation necessary */
+ }
+ printf("%s\n", argv[1]);
+ execl("/bin/sh", "sh", "-c", argv[1], (char *)0);
+ error("Can't exec shell");
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse an input file.
+ */
+
+void
+readfile(fname)
+ char *fname;
+ {
+ FILE *fp;
+ char line[1024];
+ struct event *ep;
+
+ fp = ckfopen(fname, "r");
+ curfile = fname;
+ linno = 0;
+ amiddecls = 0;
+ while (fgets(line, sizeof line, fp) != NULL) {
+ linno++;
+ for (ep = event ; ep->name ; ep++) {
+ if (line[0] == ep->name[0] && match(ep->name, line)) {
+ doevent(ep, fp, fname);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ if (line[0] == 'I' && match("INCLUDE", line))
+ doinclude(line);
+ if (line[0] == 'M' && match("MKINIT", line))
+ dodecl(line, fp);
+ if (line[0] == '#' && gooddefine(line))
+ addstr(line, &defines);
+ }
+ fclose(fp);
+}
+
+
+int
+match(name, line)
+ char *name;
+ char *line;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+
+ p = name, q = line;
+ while (*p) {
+ if (*p++ != *q++)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ if (*q != '{' && *q != ' ' && *q != '\t' && *q != '\n')
+ return 0;
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+int
+gooddefine(line)
+ char *line;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+
+ if (! match("#define", line))
+ return 0; /* not a define */
+ p = line + 7;
+ while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
+ p++;
+ while (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t') {
+ if (*p == '(')
+ return 0; /* macro definition */
+ p++;
+ }
+ while (*p != '\n' && *p != '\0')
+ p++;
+ if (p[-1] == '\\')
+ return 0; /* multi-line definition */
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+void
+doevent(ep, fp, fname)
+ register struct event *ep;
+ FILE *fp;
+ char *fname;
+ {
+ char line[1024];
+ int indent;
+ char *p;
+
+ sprintf(line, "\n /* from %s: */\n", fname);
+ addstr(line, &ep->code);
+ addstr(" {\n", &ep->code);
+ for (;;) {
+ linno++;
+ if (fgets(line, sizeof line, fp) == NULL)
+ error("Unexpected EOF");
+ if (equal(line, "}\n"))
+ break;
+ indent = 6;
+ for (p = line ; *p == '\t' ; p++)
+ indent += 8;
+ for ( ; *p == ' ' ; p++)
+ indent++;
+ if (*p == '\n' || *p == '#')
+ indent = 0;
+ while (indent >= 8) {
+ addchar('\t', &ep->code);
+ indent -= 8;
+ }
+ while (indent > 0) {
+ addchar(' ', &ep->code);
+ indent--;
+ }
+ addstr(p, &ep->code);
+ }
+ addstr(" }\n", &ep->code);
+}
+
+
+void
+doinclude(line)
+ char *line;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+ char *name;
+ register char **pp;
+
+ for (p = line ; *p != '"' && *p != '<' && *p != '\0' ; p++);
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ error("Expecting '\"' or '<'");
+ name = p;
+ while (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t' && *p != '\n')
+ p++;
+ if (p[-1] != '"' && p[-1] != '>')
+ error("Missing terminator");
+ *p = '\0';
+
+ /* name now contains the name of the include file */
+ for (pp = header_files ; *pp && ! equal(*pp, name) ; pp++);
+ if (*pp == NULL)
+ *pp = savestr(name);
+}
+
+
+void
+dodecl(line1, fp)
+ char *line1;
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ char line[1024];
+ register char *p, *q;
+
+ if (strcmp(line1, "MKINIT\n") == 0) { /* start of struct/union decl */
+ addchar('\n', &decls);
+ do {
+ linno++;
+ if (fgets(line, sizeof line, fp) == NULL)
+ error("Unterminated structure declaration");
+ addstr(line, &decls);
+ } while (line[0] != '}');
+ amiddecls = 0;
+ } else {
+ if (! amiddecls)
+ addchar('\n', &decls);
+ q = NULL;
+ for (p = line1 + 6 ; *p != '=' && *p != '/' ; p++);
+ if (*p == '=') { /* eliminate initialization */
+ for (q = p ; *q && *q != ';' ; q++);
+ if (*q == '\0')
+ q = NULL;
+ else {
+ while (p[-1] == ' ')
+ p--;
+ *p = '\0';
+ }
+ }
+ addstr("extern", &decls);
+ addstr(line1 + 6, &decls);
+ if (q != NULL)
+ addstr(q, &decls);
+ amiddecls = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Write the output to the file OUTTEMP.
+ */
+
+void
+output() {
+ FILE *fp;
+ char **pp;
+ struct event *ep;
+
+ fp = ckfopen(OUTTEMP, "w");
+ fputs(writer, fp);
+ for (pp = header_files ; *pp ; pp++)
+ fprintf(fp, "#include %s\n", *pp);
+ fputs("\n\n\n", fp);
+ writetext(&defines, fp);
+ fputs("\n\n", fp);
+ writetext(&decls, fp);
+ for (ep = event ; ep->name ; ep++) {
+ fputs("\n\n\n", fp);
+ fputs(ep->comment, fp);
+ fprintf(fp, "\nvoid\n%s() {\n", ep->routine);
+ writetext(&ep->code, fp);
+ fprintf(fp, "}\n");
+ }
+ fclose(fp);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Return true if the new output file is different from the old one.
+ */
+
+int
+file_changed() {
+ register FILE *f1, *f2;
+ register int c;
+
+ if ((f1 = fopen(OUTFILE, "r")) == NULL
+ || (f2 = fopen(OUTTEMP, "r")) == NULL)
+ return 1;
+ while ((c = getc(f1)) == getc(f2)) {
+ if (c == EOF)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Touch a file. Returns 0 on failure, 1 on success.
+ */
+
+int
+touch(file)
+ char *file;
+ {
+ int fd;
+ char c;
+
+ if ((fd = open(file, O_RDWR)) < 0)
+ return 0;
+ if (read(fd, &c, 1) != 1) {
+ close(fd);
+ return 0;
+ }
+ lseek(fd, (off_t)0, 0);
+ write(fd, &c, 1);
+ close(fd);
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * A text structure is simply a block of text that is kept in memory.
+ * Addstr appends a string to the text struct, and addchar appends a single
+ * character.
+ */
+
+void
+addstr(s, text)
+ register char *s;
+ register struct text *text;
+ {
+ while (*s) {
+ if (--text->nleft < 0)
+ addchar(*s++, text);
+ else
+ *text->nextc++ = *s++;
+ }
+}
+
+
+void
+addchar(c, text)
+ register struct text *text;
+ {
+ struct block *bp;
+
+ if (--text->nleft < 0) {
+ bp = ckmalloc(sizeof *bp);
+ if (text->start == NULL)
+ text->start = bp;
+ else
+ text->last->next = bp;
+ text->last = bp;
+ text->nextc = bp->text;
+ text->nleft = BLOCKSIZE - 1;
+ }
+ *text->nextc++ = c;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Write the contents of a text structure to a file.
+ */
+void
+writetext(text, fp)
+ struct text *text;
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ struct block *bp;
+
+ if (text->start != NULL) {
+ for (bp = text->start ; bp != text->last ; bp = bp->next)
+ fwrite(bp->text, sizeof (char), BLOCKSIZE, fp);
+ fwrite(bp->text, sizeof (char), BLOCKSIZE - text->nleft, fp);
+ }
+}
+
+FILE *
+ckfopen(file, mode)
+ char *file;
+ char *mode;
+ {
+ FILE *fp;
+
+ if ((fp = fopen(file, mode)) == NULL) {
+ fprintf(stderr, "Can't open %s\n", file);
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ return fp;
+}
+
+void *
+ckmalloc(nbytes) {
+ register char *p;
+ char *malloc();
+
+ if ((p = malloc(nbytes)) == NULL)
+ error("Out of space");
+ return p;
+}
+
+char *
+savestr(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+
+ p = ckmalloc(strlen(s) + 1);
+ strcpy(p, s);
+ return p;
+}
+
+void
+error(msg)
+ char *msg;
+ {
+ if (curfile != NULL)
+ fprintf(stderr, "%s:%d: ", curfile, linno);
+ fprintf(stderr, "%s\n", msg);
+ exit(2);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mknodes.c b/bin/sh/mknodes.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d93ebc0
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mknodes.c
@@ -0,0 +1,431 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mknodes.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * This program reads the nodetypes file and nodes.c.pat file. It generates
+ * the files nodes.h and nodes.c.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+
+#define MAXTYPES 50 /* max number of node types */
+#define MAXFIELDS 20 /* max fields in a structure */
+#define BUFLEN 100 /* size of character buffers */
+
+/* field types */
+#define T_NODE 1 /* union node *field */
+#define T_NODELIST 2 /* struct nodelist *field */
+#define T_STRING 3
+#define T_INT 4 /* int field */
+#define T_OTHER 5 /* other */
+#define T_TEMP 6 /* don't copy this field */
+
+
+struct field { /* a structure field */
+ char *name; /* name of field */
+ int type; /* type of field */
+ char *decl; /* declaration of field */
+};
+
+
+struct str { /* struct representing a node structure */
+ char *tag; /* structure tag */
+ int nfields; /* number of fields in the structure */
+ struct field field[MAXFIELDS]; /* the fields of the structure */
+ int done; /* set if fully parsed */
+};
+
+
+int ntypes; /* number of node types */
+char *nodename[MAXTYPES]; /* names of the nodes */
+struct str *nodestr[MAXTYPES]; /* type of structure used by the node */
+int nstr; /* number of structures */
+struct str str[MAXTYPES]; /* the structures */
+struct str *curstr; /* current structure */
+
+
+FILE *infp = stdin;
+char line[1024];
+int linno;
+char *linep;
+
+
+char *savestr();
+#define equal(s1, s2) (strcmp(s1, s2) == 0)
+
+
+main(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+ {
+ if (argc != 3)
+ error("usage: mknodes file\n");
+ if ((infp = fopen(argv[1], "r")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't open %s", argv[1]);
+ while (readline()) {
+ if (line[0] == ' ' || line[0] == '\t')
+ parsefield();
+ else if (line[0] != '\0')
+ parsenode();
+ }
+ output(argv[2]);
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+
+
+parsenode() {
+ char name[BUFLEN];
+ char tag[BUFLEN];
+ struct str *sp;
+
+ if (curstr && curstr->nfields > 0)
+ curstr->done = 1;
+ nextfield(name);
+ if (! nextfield(tag))
+ error("Tag expected");
+ if (*linep != '\0')
+ error("Garbage at end of line");
+ nodename[ntypes] = savestr(name);
+ for (sp = str ; sp < str + nstr ; sp++) {
+ if (equal(sp->tag, tag))
+ break;
+ }
+ if (sp >= str + nstr) {
+ sp->tag = savestr(tag);
+ sp->nfields = 0;
+ curstr = sp;
+ nstr++;
+ }
+ nodestr[ntypes] = sp;
+ ntypes++;
+}
+
+
+parsefield() {
+ char name[BUFLEN];
+ char type[BUFLEN];
+ char decl[2 * BUFLEN];
+ struct field *fp;
+
+ if (curstr == NULL || curstr->done)
+ error("No current structure to add field to");
+ if (! nextfield(name))
+ error("No field name");
+ if (! nextfield(type))
+ error("No field type");
+ fp = &curstr->field[curstr->nfields];
+ fp->name = savestr(name);
+ if (equal(type, "nodeptr")) {
+ fp->type = T_NODE;
+ sprintf(decl, "union node *%s", name);
+ } else if (equal(type, "nodelist")) {
+ fp->type = T_NODELIST;
+ sprintf(decl, "struct nodelist *%s", name);
+ } else if (equal(type, "string")) {
+ fp->type = T_STRING;
+ sprintf(decl, "char *%s", name);
+ } else if (equal(type, "int")) {
+ fp->type = T_INT;
+ sprintf(decl, "int %s", name);
+ } else if (equal(type, "other")) {
+ fp->type = T_OTHER;
+ } else if (equal(type, "temp")) {
+ fp->type = T_TEMP;
+ } else {
+ error("Unknown type %s", type);
+ }
+ if (fp->type == T_OTHER || fp->type == T_TEMP) {
+ skipbl();
+ fp->decl = savestr(linep);
+ } else {
+ if (*linep)
+ error("Garbage at end of line");
+ fp->decl = savestr(decl);
+ }
+ curstr->nfields++;
+}
+
+
+char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mknodes program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+output(file)
+ char *file;
+ {
+ FILE *hfile;
+ FILE *cfile;
+ FILE *patfile;
+ int i;
+ struct str *sp;
+ struct field *fp;
+ char *p;
+
+ if ((patfile = fopen(file, "r")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't open %s", file);
+ if ((hfile = fopen("nodes.h", "w")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't create nodes.h");
+ if ((cfile = fopen("nodes.c", "w")) == NULL)
+ error("Can't create nodes.c");
+ fputs(writer, hfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; i < ntypes ; i++)
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define %s %d\n", nodename[i], i);
+ fputs("\n\n\n", hfile);
+ for (sp = str ; sp < &str[nstr] ; sp++) {
+ fprintf(hfile, "struct %s {\n", sp->tag);
+ for (i = sp->nfields, fp = sp->field ; --i >= 0 ; fp++) {
+ fprintf(hfile, " %s;\n", fp->decl);
+ }
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ }
+ fputs("union node {\n", hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, " int type;\n");
+ for (sp = str ; sp < &str[nstr] ; sp++) {
+ fprintf(hfile, " struct %s %s;\n", sp->tag, sp->tag);
+ }
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ fputs("struct nodelist {\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\tstruct nodelist *next;\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\tunion node *n;\n", hfile);
+ fputs("};\n\n\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#ifdef __STDC__\n", hfile);
+ fputs("union node *copyfunc(union node *);\n", hfile);
+ fputs("void freefunc(union node *);\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#else\n", hfile);
+ fputs("union node *copyfunc();\n", hfile);
+ fputs("void freefunc();\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#endif\n", hfile);
+
+ fputs(writer, cfile);
+ while (fgets(line, sizeof line, patfile) != NULL) {
+ for (p = line ; *p == ' ' || *p == '\t' ; p++);
+ if (equal(p, "%SIZES\n"))
+ outsizes(cfile);
+ else if (equal(p, "%CALCSIZE\n"))
+ outfunc(cfile, 1);
+ else if (equal(p, "%COPY\n"))
+ outfunc(cfile, 0);
+ else
+ fputs(line, cfile);
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+outsizes(cfile)
+ FILE *cfile;
+ {
+ int i;
+
+ fprintf(cfile, "static const short nodesize[%d] = {\n", ntypes);
+ for (i = 0 ; i < ntypes ; i++) {
+ fprintf(cfile, " ALIGN(sizeof (struct %s)),\n", nodestr[i]->tag);
+ }
+ fprintf(cfile, "};\n");
+}
+
+
+outfunc(cfile, calcsize)
+ FILE *cfile;
+ {
+ struct str *sp;
+ struct field *fp;
+ int i;
+
+ fputs(" if (n == NULL)\n", cfile);
+ if (calcsize)
+ fputs(" return;\n", cfile);
+ else
+ fputs(" return NULL;\n", cfile);
+ if (calcsize)
+ fputs(" funcblocksize += nodesize[n->type];\n", cfile);
+ else {
+ fputs(" new = funcblock;\n", cfile);
+ fputs(" funcblock += nodesize[n->type];\n", cfile);
+ }
+ fputs(" switch (n->type) {\n", cfile);
+ for (sp = str ; sp < &str[nstr] ; sp++) {
+ for (i = 0 ; i < ntypes ; i++) {
+ if (nodestr[i] == sp)
+ fprintf(cfile, " case %s:\n", nodename[i]);
+ }
+ for (i = sp->nfields ; --i >= 1 ; ) {
+ fp = &sp->field[i];
+ switch (fp->type) {
+ case T_NODE:
+ if (calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "calcsize(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name);
+ } else {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = copynode(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ case T_NODELIST:
+ if (calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "sizenodelist(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name);
+ } else {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = copynodelist(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ case T_STRING:
+ if (calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "funcstringsize += strlen(n->%s.%s) + 1;\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name);
+ } else {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = nodesavestr(n->%s.%s);\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ case T_INT:
+ case T_OTHER:
+ if (! calcsize) {
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "new->%s.%s = n->%s.%s;\n",
+ sp->tag, fp->name, sp->tag, fp->name);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ indent(12, cfile);
+ fputs("break;\n", cfile);
+ }
+ fputs(" };\n", cfile);
+ if (! calcsize)
+ fputs(" new->type = n->type;\n", cfile);
+}
+
+
+indent(amount, fp)
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ while (amount >= 8) {
+ putc('\t', fp);
+ amount -= 8;
+ }
+ while (--amount >= 0) {
+ putc(' ', fp);
+ }
+}
+
+
+int
+nextfield(buf)
+ char *buf;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+
+ p = linep;
+ while (*p == ' ' || *p == '\t')
+ p++;
+ q = buf;
+ while (*p != ' ' && *p != '\t' && *p != '\0')
+ *q++ = *p++;
+ *q = '\0';
+ linep = p;
+ return (q > buf);
+}
+
+
+skipbl() {
+ while (*linep == ' ' || *linep == '\t')
+ linep++;
+}
+
+
+int
+readline() {
+ register char *p;
+
+ if (fgets(line, 1024, infp) == NULL)
+ return 0;
+ for (p = line ; *p != '#' && *p != '\n' && *p != '\0' ; p++);
+ while (p > line && (p[-1] == ' ' || p[-1] == '\t'))
+ p--;
+ *p = '\0';
+ linep = line;
+ linno++;
+ if (p - line > BUFLEN)
+ error("Line too long");
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+
+error(msg, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6)
+ char *msg;
+ {
+ fprintf(stderr, "line %d: ", linno);
+ fprintf(stderr, msg, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6);
+ putc('\n', stderr);
+ exit(2);
+}
+
+
+
+char *
+savestr(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+ char *malloc();
+
+ if ((p = malloc(strlen(s) + 1)) == NULL)
+ error("Out of space");
+ strcpy(p, s);
+ return p;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mksignames.c b/bin/sh/mksignames.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..fddbe1c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mksignames.c
@@ -0,0 +1,197 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mksignames.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * This program generates the signames.h and signames.c files.
+ */
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+
+
+
+struct sig {
+ int signo; /* signal number */
+ char *name; /* signal name (without leading "SIG") */
+ char *mesg; /* description */
+};
+
+
+struct sig sigtab[] = {
+ SIGHUP, "HUP", "Hangup",
+ SIGINT, "INT", "Interrupt", /* normally don't print message */
+ SIGQUIT, "QUIT", "Quit",
+ SIGILL, "ILL", "Illegal instruction",
+ SIGTRAP, "TRAP", "Trace/BPT trap",
+#ifdef SIGABRT
+ SIGABRT, "ABRT", "abort",
+#endif
+#if defined(SIGIOT) && (! defined(SIGABRT) || SIGABRT != SIGIOT)
+ SIGIOT, "IOT", "abort",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGEMT
+ SIGEMT, "EMT", "EMT trap",
+#endif
+ SIGFPE, "FPE", "Floating exception",
+ SIGKILL, "KILL", "Killed",
+ SIGBUS, "BUS", "Bus error",
+ SIGSEGV, "SEGV", "Memory fault",
+ SIGSYS, "SYS", "Bad system call",
+ SIGPIPE, "PIPE", "Broken pipe", /* normally don't print message */
+ SIGALRM, "ALRM", "Alarm call",
+ SIGTERM, "TERM", "Terminated",
+#ifdef SIGUSR1
+ SIGUSR1, "USR1", "User signal 1",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGUSR2
+ SIGUSR2, "USR2", "User signal 2",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGCLD
+ SIGCLD, "CLD", NULL,
+#endif
+#if defined(SIGCHLD) && ! defined(SIGCLD)
+ SIGCHLD, "CLD", NULL,
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGPWR
+ SIGPWR, "PWR", "Power fail",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGPOLL
+ SIGPOLL, "POLL", "Poll",
+#endif
+ /* Now for the BSD signals */
+#ifdef SIGURG
+ SIGURG, "URG", NULL,
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGSTOP
+ SIGSTOP, "STOP", "Stopped",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGTSTP
+ SIGTSTP, "TSTP", "Stopped",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGCONT
+ SIGCONT, "CONT", NULL,
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGTTIN
+ SIGTTIN, "TTIN", "Stopped (input)",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGTTOU
+ SIGTTOU, "TTOU", "Stopped (output)",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGIO
+ SIGIO, "IO", NULL,
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGXCPU
+ SIGXCPU, "XCPU", "Time limit exceeded",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGXFSZ
+ SIGXFSZ, "XFSZ", NULL,
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGVTALARM
+ SIGVTALARM, "VTALARM", "Virtual alarm",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGPROF
+ SIGPROF, "PROF", "Profiling alarm",
+#endif
+#ifdef SIGWINCH
+ SIGWINCH, "WINCH", NULL,
+#endif
+ 0, NULL, NULL
+};
+
+
+#define MAXSIG 64
+
+
+char *sigmesg[MAXSIG + 1];
+
+
+char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mksignames program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+
+
+main(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ FILE *cfile, *hfile;
+ struct sig *sigp;
+ int maxsig;
+ int i;
+
+ if ((cfile = fopen("signames.c", "w")) == NULL) {
+ fputs("Can't create signames.c\n", stderr);
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ if ((hfile = fopen("signames.h", "w")) == NULL) {
+ fputs("Can't create signames.h\n", stderr);
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ maxsig = 0;
+ for (sigp = sigtab ; sigp->signo != 0 ; sigp++) {
+ if (sigp->signo < 0 || sigp->signo > MAXSIG)
+ continue;
+ sigmesg[sigp->signo] = sigp->mesg;
+ if (maxsig < sigp->signo)
+ maxsig = sigp->signo;
+ }
+
+ fputs(writer, hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define MAXSIG %d\n\n", maxsig);
+ fprintf(hfile, "extern char *const sigmesg[MAXSIG+1];\n");
+
+ fputs(writer, cfile);
+ fprintf(cfile, "#include \"shell.h\"\n\n");
+ fprintf(cfile, "char *const sigmesg[%d] = {\n", maxsig + 1);
+ for (i = 0 ; i <= maxsig ; i++) {
+ if (sigmesg[i] == NULL) {
+ fprintf(cfile, " 0,\n");
+ } else {
+ fprintf(cfile, " \"%s\",\n", sigmesg[i]);
+ }
+ }
+ fprintf(cfile, "};\n");
+ exit(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mksyntax.c b/bin/sh/mksyntax.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1ab323d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mksyntax.c
@@ -0,0 +1,373 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1991, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mksyntax.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * This program creates syntax.h and syntax.c.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include "parser.h"
+
+
+struct synclass {
+ char *name;
+ char *comment;
+};
+
+/* Syntax classes */
+struct synclass synclass[] = {
+ "CWORD", "character is nothing special",
+ "CNL", "newline character",
+ "CBACK", "a backslash character",
+ "CSQUOTE", "single quote",
+ "CDQUOTE", "double quote",
+ "CENDQUOTE", "a terminating quote",
+ "CBQUOTE", "backwards single quote",
+ "CVAR", "a dollar sign",
+ "CENDVAR", "a '}' character",
+ "CLP", "a left paren in arithmetic",
+ "CRP", "a right paren in arithmetic",
+ "CEOF", "end of file",
+ "CCTL", "like CWORD, except it must be escaped",
+ "CSPCL", "these terminate a word",
+ NULL, NULL
+};
+
+
+/*
+ * Syntax classes for is_ functions. Warning: if you add new classes
+ * you may have to change the definition of the is_in_name macro.
+ */
+struct synclass is_entry[] = {
+ "ISDIGIT", "a digit",
+ "ISUPPER", "an upper case letter",
+ "ISLOWER", "a lower case letter",
+ "ISUNDER", "an underscore",
+ "ISSPECL", "the name of a special parameter",
+ NULL, NULL,
+};
+
+char writer[] = "\
+/*\n\
+ * This file was generated by the mksyntax program.\n\
+ */\n\
+\n";
+
+
+FILE *cfile;
+FILE *hfile;
+char *syntax[513];
+int base;
+int size; /* number of values which a char variable can have */
+int nbits; /* number of bits in a character */
+int digit_contig; /* true if digits are contiguous */
+
+
+main() {
+ char c;
+ char d;
+ int sign;
+ int i;
+ char buf[80];
+ int pos;
+ static char digit[] = "0123456789";
+
+ /* Create output files */
+ if ((cfile = fopen("syntax.c", "w")) == NULL) {
+ perror("syntax.c");
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ if ((hfile = fopen("syntax.h", "w")) == NULL) {
+ perror("syntax.h");
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ fputs(writer, hfile);
+ fputs(writer, cfile);
+
+ /* Determine the characteristics of chars. */
+ c = -1;
+ if (c < 0)
+ sign = 1;
+ else
+ sign = 0;
+ for (nbits = 1 ; ; nbits++) {
+ d = (1 << nbits) - 1;
+ if (d == c)
+ break;
+ }
+ printf("%s %d bit chars\n", sign? "signed" : "unsigned", nbits);
+ if (nbits > 9) {
+ fputs("Characters can't have more than 9 bits\n", stderr);
+ exit(2);
+ }
+ size = (1 << nbits) + 1;
+ base = 1;
+ if (sign)
+ base += 1 << (nbits - 1);
+ digit_contig = 1;
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 10 ; i++) {
+ if (digit[i] != '0' + i)
+ digit_contig = 0;
+ }
+
+ fputs("#include <sys/cdefs.h>\n", hfile);
+
+ /* Generate the #define statements in the header file */
+ fputs("/* Syntax classes */\n", hfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; synclass[i].name ; i++) {
+ sprintf(buf, "#define %s %d", synclass[i].name, i);
+ fputs(buf, hfile);
+ for (pos = strlen(buf) ; pos < 32 ; pos = pos + 8 &~ 07)
+ putc('\t', hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "/* %s */\n", synclass[i].comment);
+ }
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ fputs("/* Syntax classes for is_ functions */\n", hfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; is_entry[i].name ; i++) {
+ sprintf(buf, "#define %s %#o", is_entry[i].name, 1 << i);
+ fputs(buf, hfile);
+ for (pos = strlen(buf) ; pos < 32 ; pos = pos + 8 &~ 07)
+ putc('\t', hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "/* %s */\n", is_entry[i].comment);
+ }
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define SYNBASE %d\n", base);
+ fprintf(hfile, "#define PEOF %d\n\n", -base);
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ fputs("#define BASESYNTAX (basesyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#define DQSYNTAX (dqsyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#define SQSYNTAX (sqsyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ fputs("#define ARISYNTAX (arisyntax + SYNBASE)\n", hfile);
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+ output_type_macros(); /* is_digit, etc. */
+ putc('\n', hfile);
+
+ /* Generate the syntax tables. */
+ fputs("#include \"shell.h\"\n", cfile);
+ fputs("#include \"syntax.h\"\n\n", cfile);
+ init();
+ fputs("/* syntax table used when not in quotes */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("\\", "CBACK");
+ add("'", "CSQUOTE");
+ add("\"", "CDQUOTE");
+ add("`", "CBQUOTE");
+ add("$", "CVAR");
+ add("}", "CENDVAR");
+ add("<>();&| \t", "CSPCL");
+ print("basesyntax");
+ init();
+ fputs("\n/* syntax table used when in double quotes */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("\\", "CBACK");
+ add("\"", "CENDQUOTE");
+ add("`", "CBQUOTE");
+ add("$", "CVAR");
+ add("}", "CENDVAR");
+ add("!*?[=~:/", "CCTL"); /* ':/' for tilde - yuck */
+ print("dqsyntax");
+ init();
+ fputs("\n/* syntax table used when in single quotes */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("'", "CENDQUOTE");
+ add("!*?[=~:/", "CCTL"); /* ':/' for tilde - yuck */
+ print("sqsyntax");
+ init();
+ fputs("\n/* syntax table used when in arithmetic */\n", cfile);
+ add("\n", "CNL");
+ add("\\", "CBACK");
+ add("`", "CBQUOTE");
+ add("'", "CSQUOTE");
+ add("\"", "CDQUOTE");
+ add("$", "CVAR");
+ add("}", "CENDVAR");
+ add("(", "CLP");
+ add(")", "CRP");
+ print("arisyntax");
+ filltable("0");
+ fputs("\n/* character classification table */\n", cfile);
+ add("0123456789", "ISDIGIT");
+ add("abcdefghijklmnopqrstucvwxyz", "ISLOWER");
+ add("ABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQRSTUCVWXYZ", "ISUPPER");
+ add("_", "ISUNDER");
+ add("#?$!-*@", "ISSPECL");
+ print("is_type");
+ if (! digit_contig)
+ digit_convert();
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Clear the syntax table.
+ */
+
+filltable(dftval)
+ char *dftval;
+ {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0 ; i < size ; i++)
+ syntax[i] = dftval;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Initialize the syntax table with default values.
+ */
+
+init() {
+ filltable("CWORD");
+ syntax[0] = "CEOF";
+ syntax[base + CTLESC] = "CCTL";
+ syntax[base + CTLVAR] = "CCTL";
+ syntax[base + CTLENDVAR] = "CCTL";
+ syntax[base + CTLBACKQ] = "CCTL";
+ syntax[base + CTLBACKQ + CTLQUOTE] = "CCTL";
+ syntax[base + CTLARI] = "CCTL";
+ syntax[base + CTLENDARI] = "CCTL";
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Add entries to the syntax table.
+ */
+
+add(p, type)
+ char *p, *type;
+ {
+ while (*p)
+ syntax[*p++ + base] = type;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Output the syntax table.
+ */
+
+print(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ int i;
+ int col;
+
+ fprintf(hfile, "extern const char %s[];\n", name);
+ fprintf(cfile, "const char %s[%d] = {\n", name, size);
+ col = 0;
+ for (i = 0 ; i < size ; i++) {
+ if (i == 0) {
+ fputs(" ", cfile);
+ } else if ((i & 03) == 0) {
+ fputs(",\n ", cfile);
+ col = 0;
+ } else {
+ putc(',', cfile);
+ while (++col < 9 * (i & 03))
+ putc(' ', cfile);
+ }
+ fputs(syntax[i], cfile);
+ col += strlen(syntax[i]);
+ }
+ fputs("\n};\n", cfile);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Output character classification macros (e.g. is_digit). If digits are
+ * contiguous, we can test for them quickly.
+ */
+
+char *macro[] = {
+ "#define is_digit(c)\t((is_type+SYNBASE)[c] & ISDIGIT)",
+ "#define is_alpha(c)\t((is_type+SYNBASE)[c] & (ISUPPER|ISLOWER))",
+ "#define is_name(c)\t((is_type+SYNBASE)[c] & (ISUPPER|ISLOWER|ISUNDER))",
+ "#define is_in_name(c)\t((is_type+SYNBASE)[c] & (ISUPPER|ISLOWER|ISUNDER|ISDIGIT))",
+ "#define is_special(c)\t((is_type+SYNBASE)[c] & (ISSPECL|ISDIGIT))",
+ NULL
+};
+
+output_type_macros() {
+ char **pp;
+
+ if (digit_contig)
+ macro[0] = "#define is_digit(c)\t((unsigned)((c) - '0') <= 9)";
+ for (pp = macro ; *pp ; pp++)
+ fprintf(hfile, "%s\n", *pp);
+ if (digit_contig)
+ fputs("#define digit_val(c)\t((c) - '0')\n", hfile);
+ else
+ fputs("#define digit_val(c)\t(digit_value[c])\n", hfile);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Output digit conversion table (if digits are not contiguous).
+ */
+
+digit_convert() {
+ int maxdigit;
+ static char digit[] = "0123456789";
+ char *p;
+ int i;
+
+ maxdigit = 0;
+ for (p = digit ; *p ; p++)
+ if (*p > maxdigit)
+ maxdigit = *p;
+ fputs("extern const char digit_value[];\n", hfile);
+ fputs("\n\nconst char digit_value[] = {\n", cfile);
+ for (i = 0 ; i <= maxdigit ; i++) {
+ for (p = digit ; *p && *p != i ; p++);
+ if (*p == '\0')
+ p = digit;
+ fprintf(cfile, " %d,\n", p - digit);
+ }
+ fputs("};\n", cfile);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mktokens b/bin/sh/mktokens
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..41c0145
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mktokens
@@ -0,0 +1,94 @@
+#!/bin/sh -
+#
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)mktokens 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# The following is a list of tokens. The second column is nonzero if the
+# token marks the end of a list. The third column is the name to print in
+# error messages.
+
+cat > /tmp/ka$$ <<\!
+TEOF 1 end of file
+TNL 0 newline
+TSEMI 0 ";"
+TBACKGND 0 "&"
+TAND 0 "&&"
+TOR 0 "||"
+TPIPE 0 "|"
+TLP 0 "("
+TRP 1 ")"
+TENDCASE 1 ";;"
+TENDBQUOTE 1 "`"
+TREDIR 0 redirection
+TWORD 0 word
+TIF 0 "if"
+TTHEN 1 "then"
+TELSE 1 "else"
+TELIF 1 "elif"
+TFI 1 "fi"
+TWHILE 0 "while"
+TUNTIL 0 "until"
+TFOR 0 "for"
+TDO 1 "do"
+TDONE 1 "done"
+TBEGIN 0 "{"
+TEND 1 "}"
+TCASE 0 "case"
+TESAC 1 "esac"
+TNOT 0 "!"
+!
+nl=`wc -l /tmp/ka$$`
+exec > token.def
+awk '{print "#define " $1 " " NR-1}' /tmp/ka$$
+echo '
+/* Array indicating which tokens mark the end of a list */
+const char tokendlist[] = {'
+awk '{print "\t" $2 ","}' /tmp/ka$$
+echo '};
+
+char *const tokname[] = {'
+sed -e 's/"/\\"/g' \
+ -e 's/[^ ]*[ ][ ]*[^ ]*[ ][ ]*\(.*\)/ "\1",/' \
+ /tmp/ka$$
+echo '};
+'
+sed 's/"//g' /tmp/ka$$ | awk '
+/TIF/{print "#define KWDOFFSET " NR-1; print ""; print "char *const parsekwd[] = {"}
+/TIF/,/neverfound/{print " \"" $3 "\","}'
+echo ' 0
+};'
+
+rm /tmp/ka$$
diff --git a/bin/sh/myhistedit.h b/bin/sh/myhistedit.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..bfa4c11
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/myhistedit.h
@@ -0,0 +1,40 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)myhistedit.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#include <histedit.h>
+
+extern History *hist;
+extern EditLine *el;
+extern int displayhist;
diff --git a/bin/sh/mystring.c b/bin/sh/mystring.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..1b9eeea
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mystring.c
@@ -0,0 +1,136 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)mystring.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * String functions.
+ *
+ * equal(s1, s2) Return true if strings are equal.
+ * scopy(from, to) Copy a string.
+ * scopyn(from, to, n) Like scopy, but checks for overflow.
+ * number(s) Convert a string of digits to an integer.
+ * is_number(s) Return true if s is a string of digits.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+
+char nullstr[1]; /* zero length string */
+
+/*
+ * equal - #defined in mystring.h
+ */
+
+/*
+ * scopy - #defined in mystring.h
+ */
+
+
+/*
+ * scopyn - copy a string from "from" to "to", truncating the string
+ * if necessary. "To" is always nul terminated, even if
+ * truncation is performed. "Size" is the size of "to".
+ */
+
+void
+scopyn(from, to, size)
+ register char const *from;
+ register char *to;
+ register int size;
+ {
+
+ while (--size > 0) {
+ if ((*to++ = *from++) == '\0')
+ return;
+ }
+ *to = '\0';
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * prefix -- see if pfx is a prefix of string.
+ */
+
+int
+prefix(pfx, string)
+ register char const *pfx;
+ register char const *string;
+ {
+ while (*pfx) {
+ if (*pfx++ != *string++)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Convert a string of digits to an integer, printing an error message on
+ * failure.
+ */
+
+int
+number(s)
+ const char *s;
+ {
+
+ if (! is_number(s))
+ error2("Illegal number", (char *)s);
+ return atoi(s);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Check for a valid number. This should be elsewhere.
+ */
+
+int
+is_number(p)
+ register const char *p;
+ {
+ do {
+ if (! is_digit(*p))
+ return 0;
+ } while (*++p != '\0');
+ return 1;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/mystring.h b/bin/sh/mystring.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..27ec4ed
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/mystring.h
@@ -0,0 +1,54 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)mystring.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#include <string.h>
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void scopyn(const char *, char *, int);
+int prefix(const char *, const char *);
+int number(const char *);
+int is_number(const char *);
+#else
+void scopyn();
+int prefix();
+int number();
+int is_number();
+#endif
+
+#define equal(s1, s2) (strcmp(s1, s2) == 0)
+#define scopy(s1, s2) ((void)strcpy(s2, s1))
diff --git a/bin/sh/nodes.c.pat b/bin/sh/nodes.c.pat
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..81c96bf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/nodes.c.pat
@@ -0,0 +1,177 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)nodes.c.pat 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Routine for dealing with parsed shell commands.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "machdep.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+
+int funcblocksize; /* size of structures in function */
+int funcstringsize; /* size of strings in node */
+#ifdef __STDC__
+pointer funcblock; /* block to allocate function from */
+#else
+char *funcblock; /* block to allocate function from */
+#endif
+char *funcstring; /* block to allocate strings from */
+
+%SIZES
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void calcsize(union node *);
+STATIC void sizenodelist(struct nodelist *);
+STATIC union node *copynode(union node *);
+STATIC struct nodelist *copynodelist(struct nodelist *);
+STATIC char *nodesavestr(char *);
+#else
+STATIC void calcsize();
+STATIC void sizenodelist();
+STATIC union node *copynode();
+STATIC struct nodelist *copynodelist();
+STATIC char *nodesavestr();
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Make a copy of a parse tree.
+ */
+
+union node *
+copyfunc(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ if (n == NULL)
+ return NULL;
+ funcblocksize = 0;
+ funcstringsize = 0;
+ calcsize(n);
+ funcblock = ckmalloc(funcblocksize + funcstringsize);
+ funcstring = funcblock + funcblocksize;
+ return copynode(n);
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+calcsize(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ %CALCSIZE
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC void
+sizenodelist(lp)
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ {
+ while (lp) {
+ funcblocksize += ALIGN(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ calcsize(lp->n);
+ lp = lp->next;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+copynode(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ union node *new;
+
+ %COPY
+ return new;
+}
+
+
+STATIC struct nodelist *
+copynodelist(lp)
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ {
+ struct nodelist *start;
+ struct nodelist **lpp;
+
+ lpp = &start;
+ while (lp) {
+ *lpp = funcblock;
+ funcblock += ALIGN(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ (*lpp)->n = copynode(lp->n);
+ lp = lp->next;
+ lpp = &(*lpp)->next;
+ }
+ *lpp = NULL;
+ return start;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC char *
+nodesavestr(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ register char *p = s;
+ register char *q = funcstring;
+ char *rtn = funcstring;
+
+ while (*q++ = *p++);
+ funcstring = q;
+ return rtn;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Free a parse tree.
+ */
+
+void
+freefunc(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ if (n)
+ ckfree(n);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/nodetypes b/bin/sh/nodetypes
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d60e769
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/nodetypes
@@ -0,0 +1,143 @@
+#
+# Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+# The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+#
+# This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+# Kenneth Almquist.
+#
+# Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+# modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+# are met:
+# 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+# 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+# notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+# documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+# 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+# must display the following acknowledgement:
+# This product includes software developed by the University of
+# California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+# 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+# may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+# without specific prior written permission.
+#
+# THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+# ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+# IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+# ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+# FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+# DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+# OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+# HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+# LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+# OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+# SUCH DAMAGE.
+#
+# @(#)nodetypes 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+# This file describes the nodes used in parse trees. Unindented lines
+# contain a node type followed by a structure tag. Subsequent indented
+# lines specify the fields of the structure. Several node types can share
+# the same structure, in which case the fields of the structure should be
+# specified only once.
+#
+# A field of a structure is described by the name of the field followed
+# by a type. The currently implemented types are:
+# nodeptr - a pointer to a node
+# nodelist - a pointer to a list of nodes
+# string - a pointer to a nul terminated string
+# int - an integer
+# other - any type that can be copied by assignment
+# temp - a field that doesn't have to be copied when the node is copied
+# The last two types should be followed by the text of a C declaration for
+# the field.
+
+NSEMI nbinary # two commands separated by a semicolon
+ type int
+ ch1 nodeptr # the first child
+ ch2 nodeptr # the second child
+
+NCMD ncmd # a simple command
+ type int
+ backgnd int # set to run command in background
+ args nodeptr # the arguments
+ redirect nodeptr # list of file redirections
+
+NPIPE npipe # a pipeline
+ type int
+ backgnd int # set to run pipeline in background
+ cmdlist nodelist # the commands in the pipeline
+
+NREDIR nredir # redirection (of a compex command)
+ type int
+ n nodeptr # the command
+ redirect nodeptr # list of file redirections
+
+NBACKGND nredir # run command in background
+NSUBSHELL nredir # run command in a subshell
+
+NAND nbinary # the && operator
+NOR nbinary # the || operator
+
+NIF nif # the if statement. Elif clauses are handled
+ type int # using multiple if nodes.
+ test nodeptr # if test
+ ifpart nodeptr # then ifpart
+ elsepart nodeptr # else elsepart
+
+NWHILE nbinary # the while statement. First child is the test
+NUNTIL nbinary # the until statement
+
+NFOR nfor # the for statement
+ type int
+ args nodeptr # for var in args
+ body nodeptr # do body; done
+ var string # the for variable
+
+NCASE ncase # a case statement
+ type int
+ expr nodeptr # the word to switch on
+ cases nodeptr # the list of cases (NCLIST nodes)
+
+NCLIST nclist # a case
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # the next case in list
+ pattern nodeptr # list of patterns for this case
+ body nodeptr # code to execute for this case
+
+
+NDEFUN narg # define a function. The "next" field contains
+ # the body of the function.
+
+NARG narg # represents a word
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next word in list
+ text string # the text of the word
+ backquote nodelist # list of commands in back quotes
+
+NTO nfile # fd> fname
+NFROM nfile # fd< fname
+NAPPEND nfile # fd>> fname
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next redirection in list
+ fd int # file descriptor being redirected
+ fname nodeptr # file name, in a NARG node
+ expfname temp char *expfname # actual file name
+
+NTOFD ndup # fd<&dupfd
+NFROMFD ndup # fd>&dupfd
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next redirection in list
+ fd int # file descriptor being redirected
+ dupfd int # file descriptor to duplicate
+
+NHERE nhere # fd<<\!
+NXHERE nhere # fd<<!
+ type int
+ next nodeptr # next redirection in list
+ fd int # file descriptor being redirected
+ doc nodeptr # input to command (NARG node)
+
+NNOT nnot # ! command (actually pipeline)
+ type int
+ com nodeptr
diff --git a/bin/sh/options.c b/bin/sh/options.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9363e62
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/options.c
@@ -0,0 +1,433 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)options.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#define DEFINE_OPTIONS
+#include "options.h"
+#undef DEFINE_OPTIONS
+#include "nodes.h" /* for other header files */
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+char *arg0; /* value of $0 */
+struct shparam shellparam; /* current positional parameters */
+char **argptr; /* argument list for builtin commands */
+char *optarg; /* set by nextopt (like getopt) */
+char *optptr; /* used by nextopt */
+
+char *minusc; /* argument to -c option */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void options(int);
+STATIC void setoption(int, int);
+STATIC void minus_o(char *, int);
+#else
+STATIC void options();
+STATIC void setoption();
+STATIC void minus_o();
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Process the shell command line arguments.
+ */
+
+void
+procargs(argc, argv)
+ char **argv;
+ {
+ int i;
+
+ argptr = argv;
+ if (argc > 0)
+ argptr++;
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ optlist[i].val = 2;
+ options(1);
+ if (*argptr == NULL && minusc == NULL)
+ sflag = 1;
+ if (iflag == 2 && sflag == 1 && isatty(0) && isatty(1))
+ iflag = 1;
+ if (mflag == 2)
+ mflag = iflag;
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ if (optlist[i].val == 2)
+ optlist[i].val = 0;
+ arg0 = argv[0];
+ if (sflag == 0 && minusc == NULL) {
+ commandname = arg0 = *argptr++;
+ setinputfile(commandname, 0);
+ }
+ shellparam.p = argptr;
+ /* assert(shellparam.malloc == 0 && shellparam.nparam == 0); */
+ while (*argptr) {
+ shellparam.nparam++;
+ argptr++;
+ }
+ optschanged();
+}
+
+
+optschanged() {
+ setinteractive(iflag);
+ histedit();
+ setjobctl(mflag);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Process shell options. The global variable argptr contains a pointer
+ * to the argument list; we advance it past the options.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+options(cmdline) {
+ register char *p;
+ int val;
+ int c;
+
+ if (cmdline)
+ minusc = NULL;
+ while ((p = *argptr) != NULL) {
+ argptr++;
+ if ((c = *p++) == '-') {
+ val = 1;
+ if (p[0] == '\0' || p[0] == '-' && p[1] == '\0') {
+ if (!cmdline) {
+ /* "-" means turn off -x and -v */
+ if (p[0] == '\0')
+ xflag = vflag = 0;
+ /* "--" means reset params */
+ else if (*argptr == NULL)
+ setparam(argptr);
+ }
+ break; /* "-" or "--" terminates options */
+ }
+ } else if (c == '+') {
+ val = 0;
+ } else {
+ argptr--;
+ break;
+ }
+ while ((c = *p++) != '\0') {
+ if (c == 'c' && cmdline) {
+ char *q;
+#ifdef NOHACK /* removing this code allows sh -ce 'foo' for compat */
+ if (*p == '\0')
+#endif
+ q = *argptr++;
+ if (q == NULL || minusc != NULL)
+ error("Bad -c option");
+ minusc = q;
+#ifdef NOHACK
+ break;
+#endif
+ } else if (c == 'o') {
+ minus_o(*argptr, val);
+ if (*argptr)
+ argptr++;
+ } else {
+ setoption(c, val);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC void
+minus_o(name, val)
+ char *name;
+ int val;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ if (name == NULL) {
+ out1str("Current option settings\n");
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ out1fmt("%-16s%s\n", optlist[i].name,
+ optlist[i].val ? "on" : "off");
+ } else {
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ if (equal(name, optlist[i].name)) {
+ setoption(optlist[i].letter, val);
+ return;
+ }
+ error("Illegal option -o %s", name);
+ }
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+setoption(flag, val)
+ char flag;
+ int val;
+ {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ if (optlist[i].letter == flag) {
+ optlist[i].val = val;
+ if (val) {
+ /* #%$ hack for ksh semantics */
+ if (flag == 'V')
+ Eflag = 0;
+ else if (flag == 'E')
+ Vflag = 0;
+ }
+ return;
+ }
+ error("Illegal option -%c", flag);
+}
+
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "options.h"
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0; i < NOPTS; i++)
+ optlist[i].val = 0;
+ optschanged();
+
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * Set the shell parameters.
+ */
+
+void
+setparam(argv)
+ char **argv;
+ {
+ char **newparam;
+ char **ap;
+ int nparam;
+
+ for (nparam = 0 ; argv[nparam] ; nparam++);
+ ap = newparam = ckmalloc((nparam + 1) * sizeof *ap);
+ while (*argv) {
+ *ap++ = savestr(*argv++);
+ }
+ *ap = NULL;
+ freeparam(&shellparam);
+ shellparam.malloc = 1;
+ shellparam.nparam = nparam;
+ shellparam.p = newparam;
+ shellparam.optnext = NULL;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Free the list of positional parameters.
+ */
+
+void
+freeparam(param)
+ struct shparam *param;
+ {
+ char **ap;
+
+ if (param->malloc) {
+ for (ap = param->p ; *ap ; ap++)
+ ckfree(*ap);
+ ckfree(param->p);
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The shift builtin command.
+ */
+
+shiftcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ int n;
+ char **ap1, **ap2;
+
+ n = 1;
+ if (argc > 1)
+ n = number(argv[1]);
+ if (n > shellparam.nparam)
+ error("can't shift that many");
+ INTOFF;
+ shellparam.nparam -= n;
+ for (ap1 = shellparam.p ; --n >= 0 ; ap1++) {
+ if (shellparam.malloc)
+ ckfree(*ap1);
+ }
+ ap2 = shellparam.p;
+ while ((*ap2++ = *ap1++) != NULL);
+ shellparam.optnext = NULL;
+ INTON;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The set command builtin.
+ */
+
+setcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ if (argc == 1)
+ return showvarscmd(argc, argv);
+ INTOFF;
+ options(0);
+ optschanged();
+ if (*argptr != NULL) {
+ setparam(argptr);
+ }
+ INTON;
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The getopts builtin. Shellparam.optnext points to the next argument
+ * to be processed. Shellparam.optptr points to the next character to
+ * be processed in the current argument. If shellparam.optnext is NULL,
+ * then it's the first time getopts has been called.
+ */
+
+getoptscmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ register char *p, *q;
+ char c;
+ char s[10];
+
+ if (argc != 3)
+ error("Usage: getopts optstring var");
+ if (shellparam.optnext == NULL) {
+ shellparam.optnext = shellparam.p;
+ shellparam.optptr = NULL;
+ }
+ if ((p = shellparam.optptr) == NULL || *p == '\0') {
+ p = *shellparam.optnext;
+ if (p == NULL || *p != '-' || *++p == '\0') {
+atend:
+ fmtstr(s, 10, "%d", shellparam.optnext - shellparam.p + 1);
+ setvar("OPTIND", s, 0);
+ shellparam.optnext = NULL;
+ return 1;
+ }
+ shellparam.optnext++;
+ if (p[0] == '-' && p[1] == '\0') /* check for "--" */
+ goto atend;
+ }
+ c = *p++;
+ for (q = argv[1] ; *q != c ; ) {
+ if (*q == '\0') {
+ out1fmt("Illegal option -%c\n", c);
+ c = '?';
+ goto out;
+ }
+ if (*++q == ':')
+ q++;
+ }
+ if (*++q == ':') {
+ if (*p == '\0' && (p = *shellparam.optnext) == NULL) {
+ out1fmt("No arg for -%c option\n", c);
+ c = '?';
+ goto out;
+ }
+ shellparam.optnext++;
+ setvar("OPTARG", p, 0);
+ p = NULL;
+ }
+out:
+ shellparam.optptr = p;
+ s[0] = c;
+ s[1] = '\0';
+ setvar(argv[2], s, 0);
+ return 0;
+}
+
+/*
+ * XXX - should get rid of. have all builtins use getopt(3). the
+ * library getopt must have the BSD extension static variable "optreset"
+ * otherwise it can't be used within the shell safely.
+ *
+ * Standard option processing (a la getopt) for builtin routines. The
+ * only argument that is passed to nextopt is the option string; the
+ * other arguments are unnecessary. It return the character, or '\0' on
+ * end of input.
+ */
+
+int
+nextopt(optstring)
+ char *optstring;
+ {
+ register char *p, *q;
+ char c;
+
+ if ((p = optptr) == NULL || *p == '\0') {
+ p = *argptr;
+ if (p == NULL || *p != '-' || *++p == '\0')
+ return '\0';
+ argptr++;
+ if (p[0] == '-' && p[1] == '\0') /* check for "--" */
+ return '\0';
+ }
+ c = *p++;
+ for (q = optstring ; *q != c ; ) {
+ if (*q == '\0')
+ error("Illegal option -%c", c);
+ if (*++q == ':')
+ q++;
+ }
+ if (*++q == ':') {
+ if (*p == '\0' && (p = *argptr++) == NULL)
+ error("No arg for -%c option", c);
+ optarg = p;
+ p = NULL;
+ }
+ optptr = p;
+ return c;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/options.h b/bin/sh/options.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..7d00f55
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/options.h
@@ -0,0 +1,114 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)options.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+struct shparam {
+ int nparam; /* number of positional parameters (without $0) */
+ char malloc; /* true if parameter list dynamicly allocated */
+ char **p; /* parameter list */
+ char **optnext; /* next parameter to be processed by getopts */
+ char *optptr; /* used by getopts */
+};
+
+
+
+#define eflag optlist[0].val
+#define fflag optlist[1].val
+#define Iflag optlist[2].val
+#define iflag optlist[3].val
+#define mflag optlist[4].val
+#define nflag optlist[5].val
+#define sflag optlist[6].val
+#define xflag optlist[7].val
+#define vflag optlist[8].val
+#define Vflag optlist[9].val
+#define Eflag optlist[10].val
+#define Cflag optlist[11].val
+#define aflag optlist[12].val
+#define bflag optlist[13].val
+#define uflag optlist[14].val
+
+#define NOPTS 15
+
+struct optent {
+ const char *name;
+ const char letter;
+ char val;
+};
+
+#ifdef DEFINE_OPTIONS
+struct optent optlist[NOPTS] = {
+ "errexit", 'e', 0,
+ "noglob", 'f', 0,
+ "ignoreeof", 'I', 0,
+ "interactive", 'i', 0,
+ "monitor", 'm', 0,
+ "noexec", 'n', 0,
+ "stdin", 's', 0,
+ "xtrace", 'x', 0,
+ "verbose", 'v', 0,
+ "vi", 'V', 0,
+ "emacs", 'E', 0,
+ "noclobber", 'C', 0,
+ "allexport", 'a', 0,
+ "notify", 'b', 0,
+ "nounset", 'u', 0,
+};
+#else
+extern struct optent optlist[NOPTS];
+#endif
+
+
+extern char *minusc; /* argument to -c option */
+extern char *arg0; /* $0 */
+extern struct shparam shellparam; /* $@ */
+extern char **argptr; /* argument list for builtin commands */
+extern char *optarg; /* set by nextopt */
+extern char *optptr; /* used by nextopt */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void procargs(int, char **);
+void setparam(char **);
+void freeparam(struct shparam *);
+int nextopt(char *);
+#else
+void procargs();
+void setparam();
+void freeparam();
+int nextopt();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/output.c b/bin/sh/output.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..88ef764
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/output.c
@@ -0,0 +1,554 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)output.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Shell output routines. We use our own output routines because:
+ * When a builtin command is interrupted we have to discard
+ * any pending output.
+ * When a builtin command appears in back quotes, we want to
+ * save the output of the command in a region obtained
+ * via malloc, rather than doing a fork and reading the
+ * output of the command via a pipe.
+ * Our output routines may be smaller than the stdio routines.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h> /* defines BUFSIZ */
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#ifdef __STDC__
+#include "stdarg.h"
+#else
+#include <varargs.h>
+#endif
+#include <errno.h>
+
+
+#define OUTBUFSIZ BUFSIZ
+#define BLOCK_OUT -2 /* output to a fixed block of memory */
+#define MEM_OUT -3 /* output to dynamically allocated memory */
+#define OUTPUT_ERR 01 /* error occurred on output */
+
+
+struct output output = {NULL, 0, NULL, OUTBUFSIZ, 1, 0};
+struct output errout = {NULL, 0, NULL, 100, 2, 0};;
+struct output memout = {NULL, 0, NULL, 0, MEM_OUT, 0};
+struct output *out1 = &output;
+struct output *out2 = &errout;
+
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+
+INCLUDE "output.h"
+INCLUDE "memalloc.h"
+
+RESET {
+ out1 = &output;
+ out2 = &errout;
+ if (memout.buf != NULL) {
+ ckfree(memout.buf);
+ memout.buf = NULL;
+ }
+}
+
+#endif
+
+
+#ifdef notdef /* no longer used */
+/*
+ * Set up an output file to write to memory rather than a file.
+ */
+
+void
+open_mem(block, length, file)
+ char *block;
+ int length;
+ struct output *file;
+ {
+ file->nextc = block;
+ file->nleft = --length;
+ file->fd = BLOCK_OUT;
+ file->flags = 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+
+void
+out1str(p)
+ char *p;
+ {
+ outstr(p, out1);
+}
+
+
+void
+out2str(p)
+ char *p;
+ {
+ outstr(p, out2);
+}
+
+
+void
+outstr(p, file)
+ register char *p;
+ register struct output *file;
+ {
+ while (*p)
+ outc(*p++, file);
+ if (file == out2)
+ flushout(file);
+}
+
+
+char out_junk[16];
+
+
+void
+emptyoutbuf(dest)
+ struct output *dest;
+ {
+ int offset;
+
+ if (dest->fd == BLOCK_OUT) {
+ dest->nextc = out_junk;
+ dest->nleft = sizeof out_junk;
+ dest->flags |= OUTPUT_ERR;
+ } else if (dest->buf == NULL) {
+ INTOFF;
+ dest->buf = ckmalloc(dest->bufsize);
+ dest->nextc = dest->buf;
+ dest->nleft = dest->bufsize;
+ INTON;
+ } else if (dest->fd == MEM_OUT) {
+ offset = dest->bufsize;
+ INTOFF;
+ dest->bufsize <<= 1;
+ dest->buf = ckrealloc(dest->buf, dest->bufsize);
+ dest->nleft = dest->bufsize - offset;
+ dest->nextc = dest->buf + offset;
+ INTON;
+ } else {
+ flushout(dest);
+ }
+ dest->nleft--;
+}
+
+
+void
+flushall() {
+ flushout(&output);
+ flushout(&errout);
+}
+
+
+void
+flushout(dest)
+ struct output *dest;
+ {
+
+ if (dest->buf == NULL || dest->nextc == dest->buf || dest->fd < 0)
+ return;
+ if (xwrite(dest->fd, dest->buf, dest->nextc - dest->buf) < 0)
+ dest->flags |= OUTPUT_ERR;
+ dest->nextc = dest->buf;
+ dest->nleft = dest->bufsize;
+}
+
+
+void
+freestdout() {
+ INTOFF;
+ if (output.buf) {
+ ckfree(output.buf);
+ output.buf = NULL;
+ output.nleft = 0;
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void
+outfmt(struct output *file, char *fmt, ...) {
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ doformat(file, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+
+void
+out1fmt(char *fmt, ...) {
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ doformat(out1, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+void
+dprintf(char *fmt, ...) {
+ va_list ap;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ doformat(out2, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ flushout(out2);
+}
+
+void
+fmtstr(char *outbuf, int length, char *fmt, ...) {
+ va_list ap;
+ struct output strout;
+
+ va_start(ap, fmt);
+ strout.nextc = outbuf;
+ strout.nleft = length;
+ strout.fd = BLOCK_OUT;
+ strout.flags = 0;
+ doformat(&strout, fmt, ap);
+ outc('\0', &strout);
+ if (strout.flags & OUTPUT_ERR)
+ outbuf[length - 1] = '\0';
+}
+
+#else /* not __STDC__ */
+
+void
+outfmt(va_alist)
+ va_dcl
+ {
+ va_list ap;
+ struct output *file;
+ char *fmt;
+
+ va_start(ap);
+ file = va_arg(ap, struct output *);
+ fmt = va_arg(ap, char *);
+ doformat(file, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+
+void
+out1fmt(va_alist)
+ va_dcl
+ {
+ va_list ap;
+ char *fmt;
+
+ va_start(ap);
+ fmt = va_arg(ap, char *);
+ doformat(out1, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+}
+
+void
+dprintf(va_alist)
+ va_dcl
+ {
+ va_list ap;
+ char *fmt;
+
+ va_start(ap);
+ fmt = va_arg(ap, char *);
+ doformat(out2, fmt, ap);
+ va_end(ap);
+ flushout(out2);
+}
+
+void
+fmtstr(va_alist)
+ va_dcl
+ {
+ va_list ap;
+ struct output strout;
+ char *outbuf;
+ int length;
+ char *fmt;
+
+ va_start(ap);
+ outbuf = va_arg(ap, char *);
+ length = va_arg(ap, int);
+ fmt = va_arg(ap, char *);
+ strout.nextc = outbuf;
+ strout.nleft = length;
+ strout.fd = BLOCK_OUT;
+ strout.flags = 0;
+ doformat(&strout, fmt, ap);
+ outc('\0', &strout);
+ if (strout.flags & OUTPUT_ERR)
+ outbuf[length - 1] = '\0';
+}
+#endif /* __STDC__ */
+
+
+/*
+ * Formatted output. This routine handles a subset of the printf formats:
+ * - Formats supported: d, u, o, X, s, and c.
+ * - The x format is also accepted but is treated like X.
+ * - The l modifier is accepted.
+ * - The - and # flags are accepted; # only works with the o format.
+ * - Width and precision may be specified with any format except c.
+ * - An * may be given for the width or precision.
+ * - The obsolete practice of preceding the width with a zero to get
+ * zero padding is not supported; use the precision field.
+ * - A % may be printed by writing %% in the format string.
+ */
+
+#define TEMPSIZE 24
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+static const char digit[16] = "0123456789ABCDEF";
+#else
+static const char digit[17] = "0123456789ABCDEF";
+#endif
+
+
+void
+doformat(dest, f, ap)
+ register struct output *dest;
+ register char *f; /* format string */
+ va_list ap;
+ {
+ register char c;
+ char temp[TEMPSIZE];
+ int flushleft;
+ int sharp;
+ int width;
+ int prec;
+ int islong;
+ char *p;
+ int sign;
+ long l;
+ unsigned long num;
+ unsigned base;
+ int len;
+ int size;
+ int pad;
+
+ while ((c = *f++) != '\0') {
+ if (c != '%') {
+ outc(c, dest);
+ continue;
+ }
+ flushleft = 0;
+ sharp = 0;
+ width = 0;
+ prec = -1;
+ islong = 0;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (*f == '-')
+ flushleft++;
+ else if (*f == '#')
+ sharp++;
+ else
+ break;
+ f++;
+ }
+ if (*f == '*') {
+ width = va_arg(ap, int);
+ f++;
+ } else {
+ while (is_digit(*f)) {
+ width = 10 * width + digit_val(*f++);
+ }
+ }
+ if (*f == '.') {
+ if (*++f == '*') {
+ prec = va_arg(ap, int);
+ f++;
+ } else {
+ prec = 0;
+ while (is_digit(*f)) {
+ prec = 10 * prec + digit_val(*f++);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ if (*f == 'l') {
+ islong++;
+ f++;
+ }
+ switch (*f) {
+ case 'd':
+ if (islong)
+ l = va_arg(ap, long);
+ else
+ l = va_arg(ap, int);
+ sign = 0;
+ num = l;
+ if (l < 0) {
+ num = -l;
+ sign = 1;
+ }
+ base = 10;
+ goto number;
+ case 'u':
+ base = 10;
+ goto uns_number;
+ case 'o':
+ base = 8;
+ goto uns_number;
+ case 'x':
+ /* we don't implement 'x'; treat like 'X' */
+ case 'X':
+ base = 16;
+uns_number: /* an unsigned number */
+ sign = 0;
+ if (islong)
+ num = va_arg(ap, unsigned long);
+ else
+ num = va_arg(ap, unsigned int);
+number: /* process a number */
+ p = temp + TEMPSIZE - 1;
+ *p = '\0';
+ while (num) {
+ *--p = digit[num % base];
+ num /= base;
+ }
+ len = (temp + TEMPSIZE - 1) - p;
+ if (prec < 0)
+ prec = 1;
+ if (sharp && *f == 'o' && prec <= len)
+ prec = len + 1;
+ pad = 0;
+ if (width) {
+ size = len;
+ if (size < prec)
+ size = prec;
+ size += sign;
+ pad = width - size;
+ if (flushleft == 0) {
+ while (--pad >= 0)
+ outc(' ', dest);
+ }
+ }
+ if (sign)
+ outc('-', dest);
+ prec -= len;
+ while (--prec >= 0)
+ outc('0', dest);
+ while (*p)
+ outc(*p++, dest);
+ while (--pad >= 0)
+ outc(' ', dest);
+ break;
+ case 's':
+ p = va_arg(ap, char *);
+ pad = 0;
+ if (width) {
+ len = strlen(p);
+ if (prec >= 0 && len > prec)
+ len = prec;
+ pad = width - len;
+ if (flushleft == 0) {
+ while (--pad >= 0)
+ outc(' ', dest);
+ }
+ }
+ prec++;
+ while (--prec != 0 && *p)
+ outc(*p++, dest);
+ while (--pad >= 0)
+ outc(' ', dest);
+ break;
+ case 'c':
+ c = va_arg(ap, int);
+ outc(c, dest);
+ break;
+ default:
+ outc(*f, dest);
+ break;
+ }
+ f++;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Version of write which resumes after a signal is caught.
+ */
+
+int
+xwrite(fd, buf, nbytes)
+ int fd;
+ char *buf;
+ int nbytes;
+ {
+ int ntry;
+ int i;
+ int n;
+
+ n = nbytes;
+ ntry = 0;
+ for (;;) {
+ i = write(fd, buf, n);
+ if (i > 0) {
+ if ((n -= i) <= 0)
+ return nbytes;
+ buf += i;
+ ntry = 0;
+ } else if (i == 0) {
+ if (++ntry > 10)
+ return nbytes - n;
+ } else if (errno != EINTR) {
+ return -1;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Version of ioctl that retries after a signal is caught.
+ */
+
+int
+xioctl(fd, request, arg) {
+ int i;
+
+ while ((i = ioctl(fd, request, arg)) == -1 && errno == EINTR);
+ return i;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/output.h b/bin/sh/output.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..5b4764c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/output.h
@@ -0,0 +1,94 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)output.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#ifndef OUTPUT_INCL
+
+struct output {
+ char *nextc;
+ int nleft;
+ char *buf;
+ int bufsize;
+ short fd;
+ short flags;
+};
+
+extern struct output output;
+extern struct output errout;
+extern struct output memout;
+extern struct output *out1;
+extern struct output *out2;
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void outstr(char *, struct output *);
+void out1str(char *);
+void out2str(char *);
+void outfmt(struct output *, char *, ...);
+void out1fmt(char *, ...);
+void fmtstr(char *, int, char *, ...);
+/* void doformat(struct output *, char *, va_list); */
+void doformat();
+void emptyoutbuf(struct output *);
+void flushall(void);
+void flushout(struct output *);
+void freestdout(void);
+int xwrite(int, char *, int);
+int xioctl(int, int, int);
+#else
+void outstr();
+void out1str();
+void out2str();
+void outfmt();
+void out1fmt();
+void fmtstr();
+/* void doformat(); */
+void doformat();
+void emptyoutbuf();
+void flushall();
+void flushout();
+void freestdout();
+int xwrite();
+int xioctl();
+#endif
+
+#define outc(c, file) (--(file)->nleft < 0? (emptyoutbuf(file), *(file)->nextc++ = (c)) : (*(file)->nextc++ = (c)))
+#define out1c(c) outc(c, out1);
+#define out2c(c) outc(c, out2);
+
+#define OUTPUT_INCL
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/parser.c b/bin/sh/parser.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..898349f
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/parser.c
@@ -0,0 +1,1363 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)parser.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "expand.h" /* defines rmescapes() */
+#include "redir.h" /* defines copyfd() */
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "input.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include "alias.h"
+#include "myhistedit.h"
+
+
+/*
+ * Shell command parser.
+ */
+
+#define EOFMARKLEN 79
+
+/* values returned by readtoken */
+#include "token.def"
+
+
+
+struct heredoc {
+ struct heredoc *next; /* next here document in list */
+ union node *here; /* redirection node */
+ char *eofmark; /* string indicating end of input */
+ int striptabs; /* if set, strip leading tabs */
+};
+
+
+
+struct heredoc *heredoclist; /* list of here documents to read */
+int parsebackquote; /* nonzero if we are inside backquotes */
+int doprompt; /* if set, prompt the user */
+int needprompt; /* true if interactive and at start of line */
+int lasttoken; /* last token read */
+MKINIT int tokpushback; /* last token pushed back */
+char *wordtext; /* text of last word returned by readtoken */
+MKINIT int checkkwd; /* 1 == check for kwds, 2 == also eat newlines */
+struct nodelist *backquotelist;
+union node *redirnode;
+struct heredoc *heredoc;
+int quoteflag; /* set if (part of) last token was quoted */
+int startlinno; /* line # where last token started */
+
+
+#define GDB_HACK 1 /* avoid local declarations which gdb can't handle */
+#ifdef GDB_HACK
+static const char argvars[5] = {CTLVAR, VSNORMAL|VSQUOTE, '@', '=', '\0'};
+static const char types[] = "}-+?=";
+#endif
+
+
+STATIC union node *list __P((int));
+STATIC union node *andor __P((void));
+STATIC union node *pipeline __P((void));
+STATIC union node *command __P((void));
+STATIC union node *simplecmd __P((union node **, union node *));
+STATIC void parsefname __P((void));
+STATIC void parseheredoc __P((void));
+STATIC int readtoken __P((void));
+STATIC int readtoken1 __P((int, char const *, char *, int));
+STATIC void attyline __P((void));
+STATIC int noexpand __P((char *));
+STATIC void synexpect __P((int));
+STATIC void synerror __P((char *));
+STATIC void setprompt __P((int));
+
+/*
+ * Read and parse a command. Returns NEOF on end of file. (NULL is a
+ * valid parse tree indicating a blank line.)
+ */
+
+union node *
+parsecmd(interact) {
+ int t;
+
+ doprompt = interact;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(1);
+ else
+ setprompt(0);
+ needprompt = 0;
+ t = readtoken();
+ if (t == TEOF)
+ return NEOF;
+ if (t == TNL)
+ return NULL;
+ tokpushback++;
+ return list(1);
+}
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+list(nlflag) {
+ union node *n1, *n2, *n3;
+
+ checkkwd = 2;
+ if (nlflag == 0 && tokendlist[peektoken()])
+ return NULL;
+ n1 = andor();
+ for (;;) {
+ switch (readtoken()) {
+ case TBACKGND:
+ if (n1->type == NCMD || n1->type == NPIPE) {
+ n1->ncmd.backgnd = 1;
+ } else if (n1->type == NREDIR) {
+ n1->type = NBACKGND;
+ } else {
+ n3 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nredir));
+ n3->type = NBACKGND;
+ n3->nredir.n = n1;
+ n3->nredir.redirect = NULL;
+ n1 = n3;
+ }
+ goto tsemi;
+ case TNL:
+ tokpushback++;
+ /* fall through */
+tsemi: case TSEMI:
+ if (readtoken() == TNL) {
+ parseheredoc();
+ if (nlflag)
+ return n1;
+ } else {
+ tokpushback++;
+ }
+ checkkwd = 2;
+ if (tokendlist[peektoken()])
+ return n1;
+ n2 = andor();
+ n3 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nbinary));
+ n3->type = NSEMI;
+ n3->nbinary.ch1 = n1;
+ n3->nbinary.ch2 = n2;
+ n1 = n3;
+ break;
+ case TEOF:
+ if (heredoclist)
+ parseheredoc();
+ else
+ pungetc(); /* push back EOF on input */
+ return n1;
+ default:
+ if (nlflag)
+ synexpect(-1);
+ tokpushback++;
+ return n1;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+andor() {
+ union node *n1, *n2, *n3;
+ int t;
+
+ n1 = pipeline();
+ for (;;) {
+ if ((t = readtoken()) == TAND) {
+ t = NAND;
+ } else if (t == TOR) {
+ t = NOR;
+ } else {
+ tokpushback++;
+ return n1;
+ }
+ n2 = pipeline();
+ n3 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nbinary));
+ n3->type = t;
+ n3->nbinary.ch1 = n1;
+ n3->nbinary.ch2 = n2;
+ n1 = n3;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+pipeline() {
+ union node *n1, *pipenode, *notnode;
+ struct nodelist *lp, *prev;
+ int negate = 0;
+
+ TRACE(("pipeline: entered\n"));
+ while (readtoken() == TNOT) {
+ TRACE(("pipeline: TNOT recognized\n"));
+ negate = !negate;
+ }
+ tokpushback++;
+ n1 = command();
+ if (readtoken() == TPIPE) {
+ pipenode = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct npipe));
+ pipenode->type = NPIPE;
+ pipenode->npipe.backgnd = 0;
+ lp = (struct nodelist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ pipenode->npipe.cmdlist = lp;
+ lp->n = n1;
+ do {
+ prev = lp;
+ lp = (struct nodelist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ lp->n = command();
+ prev->next = lp;
+ } while (readtoken() == TPIPE);
+ lp->next = NULL;
+ n1 = pipenode;
+ }
+ tokpushback++;
+ if (negate) {
+ notnode = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nnot));
+ notnode->type = NNOT;
+ notnode->nnot.com = n1;
+ n1 = notnode;
+ }
+ return n1;
+}
+
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+command() {
+ union node *n1, *n2;
+ union node *ap, **app;
+ union node *cp, **cpp;
+ union node *redir, **rpp;
+ int t;
+
+ checkkwd = 2;
+ redir = 0;
+ rpp = &redir;
+ /* Check for redirection which may precede command */
+ while (readtoken() == TREDIR) {
+ *rpp = n2 = redirnode;
+ rpp = &n2->nfile.next;
+ parsefname();
+ }
+ tokpushback++;
+
+ switch (readtoken()) {
+ case TIF:
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nif));
+ n1->type = NIF;
+ n1->nif.test = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != TTHEN)
+ synexpect(TTHEN);
+ n1->nif.ifpart = list(0);
+ n2 = n1;
+ while (readtoken() == TELIF) {
+ n2->nif.elsepart = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nif));
+ n2 = n2->nif.elsepart;
+ n2->type = NIF;
+ n2->nif.test = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != TTHEN)
+ synexpect(TTHEN);
+ n2->nif.ifpart = list(0);
+ }
+ if (lasttoken == TELSE)
+ n2->nif.elsepart = list(0);
+ else {
+ n2->nif.elsepart = NULL;
+ tokpushback++;
+ }
+ if (readtoken() != TFI)
+ synexpect(TFI);
+ checkkwd = 1;
+ break;
+ case TWHILE:
+ case TUNTIL: {
+ int got;
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nbinary));
+ n1->type = (lasttoken == TWHILE)? NWHILE : NUNTIL;
+ n1->nbinary.ch1 = list(0);
+ if ((got=readtoken()) != TDO) {
+TRACE(("expecting DO got %s %s\n", tokname[got], got == TWORD ? wordtext : ""));
+ synexpect(TDO);
+ }
+ n1->nbinary.ch2 = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != TDONE)
+ synexpect(TDONE);
+ checkkwd = 1;
+ break;
+ }
+ case TFOR:
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD || quoteflag || ! goodname(wordtext))
+ synerror("Bad for loop variable");
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nfor));
+ n1->type = NFOR;
+ n1->nfor.var = wordtext;
+ if (readtoken() == TWORD && ! quoteflag && equal(wordtext, "in")) {
+ app = &ap;
+ while (readtoken() == TWORD) {
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n2->type = NARG;
+ n2->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n2->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ *app = n2;
+ app = &n2->narg.next;
+ }
+ *app = NULL;
+ n1->nfor.args = ap;
+ if (lasttoken != TNL && lasttoken != TSEMI)
+ synexpect(-1);
+ } else {
+#ifndef GDB_HACK
+ static const char argvars[5] = {CTLVAR, VSNORMAL|VSQUOTE,
+ '@', '=', '\0'};
+#endif
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n2->type = NARG;
+ n2->narg.text = (char *)argvars;
+ n2->narg.backquote = NULL;
+ n2->narg.next = NULL;
+ n1->nfor.args = n2;
+ /*
+ * Newline or semicolon here is optional (but note
+ * that the original Bourne shell only allowed NL).
+ */
+ if (lasttoken != TNL && lasttoken != TSEMI)
+ tokpushback++;
+ }
+ checkkwd = 2;
+ if ((t = readtoken()) == TDO)
+ t = TDONE;
+ else if (t == TBEGIN)
+ t = TEND;
+ else
+ synexpect(-1);
+ n1->nfor.body = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != t)
+ synexpect(t);
+ checkkwd = 1;
+ break;
+ case TCASE:
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct ncase));
+ n1->type = NCASE;
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD)
+ synexpect(TWORD);
+ n1->ncase.expr = n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n2->type = NARG;
+ n2->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n2->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ n2->narg.next = NULL;
+ while (readtoken() == TNL);
+ if (lasttoken != TWORD || ! equal(wordtext, "in"))
+ synerror("expecting \"in\"");
+ cpp = &n1->ncase.cases;
+ while (checkkwd = 2, readtoken() == TWORD) {
+ *cpp = cp = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nclist));
+ cp->type = NCLIST;
+ app = &cp->nclist.pattern;
+ for (;;) {
+ *app = ap = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ ap->type = NARG;
+ ap->narg.text = wordtext;
+ ap->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ if (readtoken() != TPIPE)
+ break;
+ app = &ap->narg.next;
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD)
+ synexpect(TWORD);
+ }
+ ap->narg.next = NULL;
+ if (lasttoken != TRP)
+ synexpect(TRP);
+ cp->nclist.body = list(0);
+ if ((t = readtoken()) == TESAC)
+ tokpushback++;
+ else if (t != TENDCASE)
+ synexpect(TENDCASE);
+ cpp = &cp->nclist.next;
+ }
+ *cpp = NULL;
+ if (lasttoken != TESAC)
+ synexpect(TESAC);
+ checkkwd = 1;
+ break;
+ case TLP:
+ n1 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nredir));
+ n1->type = NSUBSHELL;
+ n1->nredir.n = list(0);
+ n1->nredir.redirect = NULL;
+ if (readtoken() != TRP)
+ synexpect(TRP);
+ checkkwd = 1;
+ break;
+ case TBEGIN:
+ n1 = list(0);
+ if (readtoken() != TEND)
+ synexpect(TEND);
+ checkkwd = 1;
+ break;
+ /* Handle an empty command like other simple commands. */
+ case TNL:
+ case TWORD:
+ tokpushback++;
+ return simplecmd(rpp, redir);
+ default:
+ synexpect(-1);
+ }
+
+ /* Now check for redirection which may follow command */
+ while (readtoken() == TREDIR) {
+ *rpp = n2 = redirnode;
+ rpp = &n2->nfile.next;
+ parsefname();
+ }
+ tokpushback++;
+ *rpp = NULL;
+ if (redir) {
+ if (n1->type != NSUBSHELL) {
+ n2 = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nredir));
+ n2->type = NREDIR;
+ n2->nredir.n = n1;
+ n1 = n2;
+ }
+ n1->nredir.redirect = redir;
+ }
+ return n1;
+}
+
+
+STATIC union node *
+simplecmd(rpp, redir)
+ union node **rpp, *redir;
+ {
+ union node *args, **app;
+ union node **orig_rpp = rpp;
+ union node *n;
+
+ /* If we don't have any redirections already, then we must reset */
+ /* rpp to be the address of the local redir variable. */
+ if (redir == 0)
+ rpp = &redir;
+
+ args = NULL;
+ app = &args;
+ /*
+ * We save the incoming value, because we need this for shell
+ * functions. There can not be a redirect or an argument between
+ * the function name and the open parenthesis.
+ */
+ orig_rpp = rpp;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ if (readtoken() == TWORD) {
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n->type = NARG;
+ n->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ *app = n;
+ app = &n->narg.next;
+ } else if (lasttoken == TREDIR) {
+ *rpp = n = redirnode;
+ rpp = &n->nfile.next;
+ parsefname(); /* read name of redirection file */
+ } else if (lasttoken == TLP && app == &args->narg.next
+ && rpp == orig_rpp) {
+ /* We have a function */
+ if (readtoken() != TRP)
+ synexpect(TRP);
+#ifdef notdef
+ if (! goodname(n->narg.text))
+ synerror("Bad function name");
+#endif
+ n->type = NDEFUN;
+ n->narg.next = command();
+ return n;
+ } else {
+ tokpushback++;
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ *app = NULL;
+ *rpp = NULL;
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct ncmd));
+ n->type = NCMD;
+ n->ncmd.backgnd = 0;
+ n->ncmd.args = args;
+ n->ncmd.redirect = redir;
+ return n;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+parsefname() {
+ union node *n = redirnode;
+
+ if (readtoken() != TWORD)
+ synexpect(-1);
+ if (n->type == NHERE) {
+ struct heredoc *here = heredoc;
+ struct heredoc *p;
+ int i;
+
+ if (quoteflag == 0)
+ n->type = NXHERE;
+ TRACE(("Here document %d\n", n->type));
+ if (here->striptabs) {
+ while (*wordtext == '\t')
+ wordtext++;
+ }
+ if (! noexpand(wordtext) || (i = strlen(wordtext)) == 0 || i > EOFMARKLEN)
+ synerror("Illegal eof marker for << redirection");
+ rmescapes(wordtext);
+ here->eofmark = wordtext;
+ here->next = NULL;
+ if (heredoclist == NULL)
+ heredoclist = here;
+ else {
+ for (p = heredoclist ; p->next ; p = p->next);
+ p->next = here;
+ }
+ } else if (n->type == NTOFD || n->type == NFROMFD) {
+ if (is_digit(wordtext[0]))
+ n->ndup.dupfd = digit_val(wordtext[0]);
+ else if (wordtext[0] == '-')
+ n->ndup.dupfd = -1;
+ else
+ goto bad;
+ if (wordtext[1] != '\0') {
+bad:
+ synerror("Bad fd number");
+ }
+ } else {
+ n->nfile.fname = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n = n->nfile.fname;
+ n->type = NARG;
+ n->narg.next = NULL;
+ n->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ }
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Input any here documents.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+parseheredoc() {
+ struct heredoc *here;
+ union node *n;
+
+ while (heredoclist) {
+ here = heredoclist;
+ heredoclist = here->next;
+ if (needprompt) {
+ setprompt(2);
+ needprompt = 0;
+ }
+ readtoken1(pgetc(), here->here->type == NHERE? SQSYNTAX : DQSYNTAX,
+ here->eofmark, here->striptabs);
+ n = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct narg));
+ n->narg.type = NARG;
+ n->narg.next = NULL;
+ n->narg.text = wordtext;
+ n->narg.backquote = backquotelist;
+ here->here->nhere.doc = n;
+ }
+}
+
+STATIC int
+peektoken() {
+ int t;
+
+ t = readtoken();
+ tokpushback++;
+ return (t);
+}
+
+STATIC int xxreadtoken();
+
+STATIC int
+readtoken() {
+ int t;
+ int savecheckkwd = checkkwd;
+ struct alias *ap;
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ int alreadyseen = tokpushback;
+#endif
+
+ top:
+ t = xxreadtoken();
+
+ if (checkkwd) {
+ /*
+ * eat newlines
+ */
+ if (checkkwd == 2) {
+ checkkwd = 0;
+ while (t == TNL) {
+ parseheredoc();
+ t = xxreadtoken();
+ }
+ } else
+ checkkwd = 0;
+ /*
+ * check for keywords and aliases
+ */
+ if (t == TWORD && !quoteflag) {
+ register char * const *pp, *s;
+
+ for (pp = (char **)parsekwd; *pp; pp++) {
+ if (**pp == *wordtext && equal(*pp, wordtext)) {
+ lasttoken = t = pp - parsekwd + KWDOFFSET;
+ TRACE(("keyword %s recognized\n", tokname[t]));
+ goto out;
+ }
+ }
+ if (ap = lookupalias(wordtext, 1)) {
+ pushstring(ap->val, strlen(ap->val), ap);
+ checkkwd = savecheckkwd;
+ goto top;
+ }
+ }
+out:
+ checkkwd = 0;
+ }
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (!alreadyseen)
+ TRACE(("token %s %s\n", tokname[t], t == TWORD ? wordtext : ""));
+ else
+ TRACE(("reread token %s %s\n", tokname[t], t == TWORD ? wordtext : ""));
+#endif
+ return (t);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Read the next input token.
+ * If the token is a word, we set backquotelist to the list of cmds in
+ * backquotes. We set quoteflag to true if any part of the word was
+ * quoted.
+ * If the token is TREDIR, then we set redirnode to a structure containing
+ * the redirection.
+ * In all cases, the variable startlinno is set to the number of the line
+ * on which the token starts.
+ *
+ * [Change comment: here documents and internal procedures]
+ * [Readtoken shouldn't have any arguments. Perhaps we should make the
+ * word parsing code into a separate routine. In this case, readtoken
+ * doesn't need to have any internal procedures, but parseword does.
+ * We could also make parseoperator in essence the main routine, and
+ * have parseword (readtoken1?) handle both words and redirection.]
+ */
+
+#define RETURN(token) return lasttoken = token
+
+STATIC int
+xxreadtoken() {
+ register c;
+
+ if (tokpushback) {
+ tokpushback = 0;
+ return lasttoken;
+ }
+ if (needprompt) {
+ setprompt(2);
+ needprompt = 0;
+ }
+ startlinno = plinno;
+ for (;;) { /* until token or start of word found */
+ c = pgetc_macro();
+ if (c == ' ' || c == '\t')
+ continue; /* quick check for white space first */
+ switch (c) {
+ case ' ': case '\t':
+ continue;
+ case '#':
+ while ((c = pgetc()) != '\n' && c != PEOF);
+ pungetc();
+ continue;
+ case '\\':
+ if (pgetc() == '\n') {
+ startlinno = ++plinno;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ else
+ setprompt(0);
+ continue;
+ }
+ pungetc();
+ goto breakloop;
+ case '\n':
+ plinno++;
+ needprompt = doprompt;
+ RETURN(TNL);
+ case PEOF:
+ RETURN(TEOF);
+ case '&':
+ if (pgetc() == '&')
+ RETURN(TAND);
+ pungetc();
+ RETURN(TBACKGND);
+ case '|':
+ if (pgetc() == '|')
+ RETURN(TOR);
+ pungetc();
+ RETURN(TPIPE);
+ case ';':
+ if (pgetc() == ';')
+ RETURN(TENDCASE);
+ pungetc();
+ RETURN(TSEMI);
+ case '(':
+ RETURN(TLP);
+ case ')':
+ RETURN(TRP);
+ default:
+ goto breakloop;
+ }
+ }
+breakloop:
+ return readtoken1(c, BASESYNTAX, (char *)NULL, 0);
+#undef RETURN
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * If eofmark is NULL, read a word or a redirection symbol. If eofmark
+ * is not NULL, read a here document. In the latter case, eofmark is the
+ * word which marks the end of the document and striptabs is true if
+ * leading tabs should be stripped from the document. The argument firstc
+ * is the first character of the input token or document.
+ *
+ * Because C does not have internal subroutines, I have simulated them
+ * using goto's to implement the subroutine linkage. The following macros
+ * will run code that appears at the end of readtoken1.
+ */
+
+#define CHECKEND() {goto checkend; checkend_return:;}
+#define PARSEREDIR() {goto parseredir; parseredir_return:;}
+#define PARSESUB() {goto parsesub; parsesub_return:;}
+#define PARSEBACKQOLD() {oldstyle = 1; goto parsebackq; parsebackq_oldreturn:;}
+#define PARSEBACKQNEW() {oldstyle = 0; goto parsebackq; parsebackq_newreturn:;}
+#define PARSEARITH() {goto parsearith; parsearith_return:;}
+
+STATIC int
+readtoken1(firstc, syntax, eofmark, striptabs)
+ int firstc;
+ char const *syntax;
+ char *eofmark;
+ int striptabs;
+ {
+ register c = firstc;
+ register char *out;
+ int len;
+ char line[EOFMARKLEN + 1];
+ struct nodelist *bqlist;
+ int quotef;
+ int dblquote;
+ int varnest; /* levels of variables expansion */
+ int arinest; /* levels of arithmetic expansion */
+ int parenlevel; /* levels of parens in arithmetic */
+ int oldstyle;
+ char const *prevsyntax; /* syntax before arithmetic */
+
+ startlinno = plinno;
+ dblquote = 0;
+ if (syntax == DQSYNTAX)
+ dblquote = 1;
+ quotef = 0;
+ bqlist = NULL;
+ varnest = 0;
+ arinest = 0;
+ parenlevel = 0;
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(out);
+ loop: { /* for each line, until end of word */
+#if ATTY
+ if (c == '\034' && doprompt
+ && attyset() && ! equal(termval(), "emacs")) {
+ attyline();
+ if (syntax == BASESYNTAX)
+ return readtoken();
+ c = pgetc();
+ goto loop;
+ }
+#endif
+ CHECKEND(); /* set c to PEOF if at end of here document */
+ for (;;) { /* until end of line or end of word */
+ CHECKSTRSPACE(3, out); /* permit 3 calls to USTPUTC */
+ if (parsebackquote && c == '\\') {
+ c = pgetc(); /* XXX - compat with old /bin/sh */
+ if (c != '\\' && c != '`' && c != '$') {
+ pungetc();
+ c = '\\';
+ }
+ }
+ switch(syntax[c]) {
+ case CNL: /* '\n' */
+ if (syntax == BASESYNTAX)
+ goto endword; /* exit outer loop */
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ plinno++;
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ else
+ setprompt(0);
+ c = pgetc();
+ goto loop; /* continue outer loop */
+ case CWORD:
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ break;
+ case CCTL:
+ if (eofmark == NULL || dblquote)
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, out);
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ break;
+ case CBACK: /* backslash */
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (c == PEOF) {
+ USTPUTC('\\', out);
+ pungetc();
+ } else if (c == '\n') {
+ if (doprompt)
+ setprompt(2);
+ else
+ setprompt(0);
+ } else {
+ if (dblquote && c != '\\' && c != '`' && c != '$'
+ && (c != '"' || eofmark != NULL))
+ USTPUTC('\\', out);
+ if (SQSYNTAX[c] == CCTL)
+ USTPUTC(CTLESC, out);
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ quotef++;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CSQUOTE:
+ syntax = SQSYNTAX;
+ break;
+ case CDQUOTE:
+ syntax = DQSYNTAX;
+ dblquote = 1;
+ break;
+ case CENDQUOTE:
+ if (eofmark) {
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ } else {
+ if (arinest)
+ syntax = ARISYNTAX;
+ else
+ syntax = BASESYNTAX;
+ quotef++;
+ dblquote = 0;
+ }
+ break;
+ case CVAR: /* '$' */
+ PARSESUB(); /* parse substitution */
+ break;
+ case CENDVAR: /* '}' */
+ if (varnest > 0) {
+ varnest--;
+ USTPUTC(CTLENDVAR, out);
+ } else {
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ }
+ break;
+ case CLP: /* '(' in arithmetic */
+ parenlevel++;
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ break;
+ case CRP: /* ')' in arithmetic */
+ if (parenlevel > 0) {
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ --parenlevel;
+ } else {
+ if (pgetc() == ')') {
+ if (--arinest == 0) {
+ USTPUTC(CTLENDARI, out);
+ syntax = prevsyntax;
+ } else
+ USTPUTC(')', out);
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * unbalanced parens
+ * (don't 2nd guess - no error)
+ */
+ pungetc();
+ USTPUTC(')', out);
+ }
+ }
+ break;
+ case CBQUOTE: /* '`' */
+ PARSEBACKQOLD();
+ break;
+ case CEOF:
+ goto endword; /* exit outer loop */
+ default:
+ if (varnest == 0)
+ goto endword; /* exit outer loop */
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ }
+ c = pgetc_macro();
+ }
+ }
+endword:
+ if (syntax == ARISYNTAX)
+ synerror("Missing '))'");
+ if (syntax != BASESYNTAX && ! parsebackquote && eofmark == NULL)
+ synerror("Unterminated quoted string");
+ if (varnest != 0) {
+ startlinno = plinno;
+ synerror("Missing '}'");
+ }
+ USTPUTC('\0', out);
+ len = out - stackblock();
+ out = stackblock();
+ if (eofmark == NULL) {
+ if ((c == '>' || c == '<')
+ && quotef == 0
+ && len <= 2
+ && (*out == '\0' || is_digit(*out))) {
+ PARSEREDIR();
+ return lasttoken = TREDIR;
+ } else {
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ }
+ quoteflag = quotef;
+ backquotelist = bqlist;
+ grabstackblock(len);
+ wordtext = out;
+ return lasttoken = TWORD;
+/* end of readtoken routine */
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Check to see whether we are at the end of the here document. When this
+ * is called, c is set to the first character of the next input line. If
+ * we are at the end of the here document, this routine sets the c to PEOF.
+ */
+
+checkend: {
+ if (eofmark) {
+ if (striptabs) {
+ while (c == '\t')
+ c = pgetc();
+ }
+ if (c == *eofmark) {
+ if (pfgets(line, sizeof line) != NULL) {
+ register char *p, *q;
+
+ p = line;
+ for (q = eofmark + 1 ; *q && *p == *q ; p++, q++);
+ if (*p == '\n' && *q == '\0') {
+ c = PEOF;
+ plinno++;
+ needprompt = doprompt;
+ } else {
+ pushstring(line, strlen(line), NULL);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ goto checkend_return;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse a redirection operator. The variable "out" points to a string
+ * specifying the fd to be redirected. The variable "c" contains the
+ * first character of the redirection operator.
+ */
+
+parseredir: {
+ char fd = *out;
+ union node *np;
+
+ np = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nfile));
+ if (c == '>') {
+ np->nfile.fd = 1;
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (c == '>')
+ np->type = NAPPEND;
+ else if (c == '&')
+ np->type = NTOFD;
+ else {
+ np->type = NTO;
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ } else { /* c == '<' */
+ np->nfile.fd = 0;
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (c == '<') {
+ if (sizeof (struct nfile) != sizeof (struct nhere)) {
+ np = (union node *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nhere));
+ np->nfile.fd = 0;
+ }
+ np->type = NHERE;
+ heredoc = (struct heredoc *)stalloc(sizeof (struct heredoc));
+ heredoc->here = np;
+ if ((c = pgetc()) == '-') {
+ heredoc->striptabs = 1;
+ } else {
+ heredoc->striptabs = 0;
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ } else if (c == '&')
+ np->type = NFROMFD;
+ else {
+ np->type = NFROM;
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ }
+ if (fd != '\0')
+ np->nfile.fd = digit_val(fd);
+ redirnode = np;
+ goto parseredir_return;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Parse a substitution. At this point, we have read the dollar sign
+ * and nothing else.
+ */
+
+parsesub: {
+ int subtype;
+ int typeloc;
+ int flags;
+ char *p;
+#ifndef GDB_HACK
+ static const char types[] = "}-+?=";
+#endif
+
+ c = pgetc();
+ if (c != '(' && c != '{' && !is_name(c) && !is_special(c)) {
+ USTPUTC('$', out);
+ pungetc();
+ } else if (c == '(') { /* $(command) or $((arith)) */
+ if (pgetc() == '(') {
+ PARSEARITH();
+ } else {
+ pungetc();
+ PARSEBACKQNEW();
+ }
+ } else {
+ USTPUTC(CTLVAR, out);
+ typeloc = out - stackblock();
+ USTPUTC(VSNORMAL, out);
+ subtype = VSNORMAL;
+ if (c == '{') {
+ c = pgetc();
+ subtype = 0;
+ }
+ if (is_name(c)) {
+ do {
+ STPUTC(c, out);
+ c = pgetc();
+ } while (is_in_name(c));
+ } else {
+ if (! is_special(c))
+badsub: synerror("Bad substitution");
+ USTPUTC(c, out);
+ c = pgetc();
+ }
+ STPUTC('=', out);
+ flags = 0;
+ if (subtype == 0) {
+ if (c == ':') {
+ flags = VSNUL;
+ c = pgetc();
+ }
+ p = strchr(types, c);
+ if (p == NULL)
+ goto badsub;
+ subtype = p - types + VSNORMAL;
+ } else {
+ pungetc();
+ }
+ if (dblquote || arinest)
+ flags |= VSQUOTE;
+ *(stackblock() + typeloc) = subtype | flags;
+ if (subtype != VSNORMAL)
+ varnest++;
+ }
+ goto parsesub_return;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to parse command substitutions. Newstyle is set if the command
+ * is enclosed inside $(...); nlpp is a pointer to the head of the linked
+ * list of commands (passed by reference), and savelen is the number of
+ * characters on the top of the stack which must be preserved.
+ */
+
+parsebackq: {
+ struct nodelist **nlpp;
+ int savepbq;
+ union node *n;
+ char *volatile str;
+ struct jmploc jmploc;
+ struct jmploc *volatile savehandler;
+ int savelen;
+
+ savepbq = parsebackquote;
+ if (setjmp(jmploc.loc)) {
+ if (str)
+ ckfree(str);
+ parsebackquote = 0;
+ handler = savehandler;
+ longjmp(handler->loc, 1);
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ str = NULL;
+ savelen = out - stackblock();
+ if (savelen > 0) {
+ str = ckmalloc(savelen);
+ bcopy(stackblock(), str, savelen);
+ }
+ savehandler = handler;
+ handler = &jmploc;
+ INTON;
+ if (oldstyle) {
+ /* We must read until the closing backquote, giving special
+ treatment to some slashes, and then push the string and
+ reread it as input, interpreting it normally. */
+ register char *out;
+ register c;
+ int savelen;
+ char *str;
+
+ STARTSTACKSTR(out);
+ while ((c = pgetc ()) != '`') {
+ if (c == '\\') {
+ c = pgetc ();
+ if (c != '\\' && c != '`' && c != '$'
+ && (!dblquote || c != '"'))
+ STPUTC('\\', out);
+ }
+ STPUTC(c, out);
+ }
+ STPUTC('\0', out);
+ savelen = out - stackblock();
+ if (savelen > 0) {
+ str = ckmalloc(savelen);
+ bcopy(stackblock(), str, savelen);
+ }
+ setinputstring(str, 1);
+ }
+ nlpp = &bqlist;
+ while (*nlpp)
+ nlpp = &(*nlpp)->next;
+ *nlpp = (struct nodelist *)stalloc(sizeof (struct nodelist));
+ (*nlpp)->next = NULL;
+ parsebackquote = oldstyle;
+ n = list(0);
+ if (!oldstyle && (readtoken() != TRP))
+ synexpect(TRP);
+ (*nlpp)->n = n;
+ /* Start reading from old file again. */
+ if (oldstyle)
+ popfile();
+ while (stackblocksize() <= savelen)
+ growstackblock();
+ STARTSTACKSTR(out);
+ if (str) {
+ bcopy(str, out, savelen);
+ STADJUST(savelen, out);
+ INTOFF;
+ ckfree(str);
+ str = NULL;
+ INTON;
+ }
+ parsebackquote = savepbq;
+ handler = savehandler;
+ if (arinest || dblquote)
+ USTPUTC(CTLBACKQ | CTLQUOTE, out);
+ else
+ USTPUTC(CTLBACKQ, out);
+ if (oldstyle)
+ goto parsebackq_oldreturn;
+ else
+ goto parsebackq_newreturn;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Parse an arithmetic expansion (indicate start of one and set state)
+ */
+parsearith: {
+
+ if (++arinest == 1) {
+ prevsyntax = syntax;
+ syntax = ARISYNTAX;
+ USTPUTC(CTLARI, out);
+ } else {
+ /*
+ * we collapse embedded arithmetic expansion to
+ * parenthesis, which should be equivalent
+ */
+ USTPUTC('(', out);
+ }
+ goto parsearith_return;
+}
+
+} /* end of readtoken */
+
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+RESET {
+ tokpushback = 0;
+ checkkwd = 0;
+}
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * Returns true if the text contains nothing to expand (no dollar signs
+ * or backquotes).
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+noexpand(text)
+ char *text;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+ register char c;
+
+ p = text;
+ while ((c = *p++) != '\0') {
+ if (c == CTLESC)
+ p++;
+ else if (BASESYNTAX[c] == CCTL)
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Return true if the argument is a legal variable name (a letter or
+ * underscore followed by zero or more letters, underscores, and digits).
+ */
+
+int
+goodname(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+
+ p = name;
+ if (! is_name(*p))
+ return 0;
+ while (*++p) {
+ if (! is_in_name(*p))
+ return 0;
+ }
+ return 1;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called when an unexpected token is read during the parse. The argument
+ * is the token that is expected, or -1 if more than one type of token can
+ * occur at this point.
+ */
+
+STATIC void
+synexpect(token) {
+ char msg[64];
+
+ if (token >= 0) {
+ fmtstr(msg, 64, "%s unexpected (expecting %s)",
+ tokname[lasttoken], tokname[token]);
+ } else {
+ fmtstr(msg, 64, "%s unexpected", tokname[lasttoken]);
+ }
+ synerror(msg);
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+synerror(msg)
+ char *msg;
+ {
+ if (commandname)
+ outfmt(&errout, "%s: %d: ", commandname, startlinno);
+ outfmt(&errout, "Syntax error: %s\n", msg);
+ error((char *)NULL);
+}
+
+STATIC void
+setprompt(which)
+ int which;
+ {
+ whichprompt = which;
+
+ if (!el)
+ out2str(getprompt(NULL));
+}
+
+/*
+ * called by editline -- any expansions to the prompt
+ * should be added here.
+ */
+char *
+getprompt(unused)
+ void *unused;
+ {
+ switch (whichprompt) {
+ case 0:
+ return "";
+ case 1:
+ return ps1val();
+ case 2:
+ return ps2val();
+ default:
+ return "<internal prompt error>";
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/parser.h b/bin/sh/parser.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e1c3c23
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/parser.h
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)parser.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/* control characters in argument strings */
+#define CTLESC '\201'
+#define CTLVAR '\202'
+#define CTLENDVAR '\203'
+#define CTLBACKQ '\204'
+#define CTLQUOTE 01 /* ored with CTLBACKQ code if in quotes */
+/* CTLBACKQ | CTLQUOTE == '\205' */
+#define CTLARI '\206'
+#define CTLENDARI '\207'
+
+/* variable substitution byte (follows CTLVAR) */
+#define VSTYPE 07 /* type of variable substitution */
+#define VSNUL 040 /* colon--treat the empty string as unset */
+#define VSQUOTE 0100 /* inside double quotes--suppress splitting */
+
+/* values of VSTYPE field */
+#define VSNORMAL 1 /* normal variable: $var or ${var} */
+#define VSMINUS 2 /* ${var-text} */
+#define VSPLUS 3 /* ${var+text} */
+#define VSQUESTION 4 /* ${var?message} */
+#define VSASSIGN 5 /* ${var=text} */
+
+
+/*
+ * NEOF is returned by parsecmd when it encounters an end of file. It
+ * must be distinct from NULL, so we use the address of a variable that
+ * happens to be handy.
+ */
+extern int tokpushback;
+#define NEOF ((union node *)&tokpushback)
+extern int whichprompt; /* 1 == PS1, 2 == PS2 */
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+union node *parsecmd(int);
+int goodname(char *);
+char *getprompt(void *);
+#else
+union node *parsecmd();
+int goodname();
+char *getprompt();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/redir.c b/bin/sh/redir.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b91ce5a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/redir.c
@@ -0,0 +1,343 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)redir.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Code for dealing with input/output redirection.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "redir.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <signal.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+
+#define EMPTY -2 /* marks an unused slot in redirtab */
+#define PIPESIZE 4096 /* amount of buffering in a pipe */
+
+
+MKINIT
+struct redirtab {
+ struct redirtab *next;
+ short renamed[10];
+};
+
+
+MKINIT struct redirtab *redirlist;
+
+/*
+ * We keep track of whether or not fd0 has been redirected. This is for
+ * background commands, where we want to redirect fd0 to /dev/null only
+ * if it hasn't already been redirected.
+*/
+int fd0_redirected = 0;
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+STATIC void openredirect(union node *, char *);
+STATIC int openhere(union node *);
+#else
+STATIC void openredirect();
+STATIC int openhere();
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Process a list of redirection commands. If the REDIR_PUSH flag is set,
+ * old file descriptors are stashed away so that the redirection can be
+ * undone by calling popredir. If the REDIR_BACKQ flag is set, then the
+ * standard output, and the standard error if it becomes a duplicate of
+ * stdout, is saved in memory.
+ */
+
+void
+redirect(redir, flags)
+ union node *redir;
+ int flags;
+ {
+ union node *n;
+ struct redirtab *sv;
+ int i;
+ int fd;
+ char memory[10]; /* file descriptors to write to memory */
+
+ for (i = 10 ; --i >= 0 ; )
+ memory[i] = 0;
+ memory[1] = flags & REDIR_BACKQ;
+ if (flags & REDIR_PUSH) {
+ sv = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct redirtab));
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 10 ; i++)
+ sv->renamed[i] = EMPTY;
+ sv->next = redirlist;
+ redirlist = sv;
+ }
+ for (n = redir ; n ; n = n->nfile.next) {
+ fd = n->nfile.fd;
+ if ((flags & REDIR_PUSH) && sv->renamed[fd] == EMPTY) {
+ INTOFF;
+ if ((i = copyfd(fd, 10)) != EMPTY) {
+ sv->renamed[fd] = i;
+ close(fd);
+ }
+ INTON;
+ if (i == EMPTY)
+ error("Out of file descriptors");
+ } else {
+ close(fd);
+ }
+ if (fd == 0)
+ fd0_redirected++;
+ openredirect(n, memory);
+ }
+ if (memory[1])
+ out1 = &memout;
+ if (memory[2])
+ out2 = &memout;
+}
+
+
+STATIC void
+openredirect(redir, memory)
+ union node *redir;
+ char memory[10];
+ {
+ int fd = redir->nfile.fd;
+ char *fname;
+ int f;
+
+ /*
+ * We suppress interrupts so that we won't leave open file
+ * descriptors around. This may not be such a good idea because
+ * an open of a device or a fifo can block indefinitely.
+ */
+ INTOFF;
+ memory[fd] = 0;
+ switch (redir->nfile.type) {
+ case NFROM:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+ if ((f = open(fname, O_RDONLY)) < 0)
+ error("cannot open %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_OPEN));
+movefd:
+ if (f != fd) {
+ copyfd(f, fd);
+ close(f);
+ }
+ break;
+ case NTO:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+#ifdef O_CREAT
+ if ((f = open(fname, O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_TRUNC, 0666)) < 0)
+ error("cannot create %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_CREAT));
+#else
+ if ((f = creat(fname, 0666)) < 0)
+ error("cannot create %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_CREAT));
+#endif
+ goto movefd;
+ case NAPPEND:
+ fname = redir->nfile.expfname;
+#ifdef O_APPEND
+ if ((f = open(fname, O_WRONLY|O_CREAT|O_APPEND, 0666)) < 0)
+ error("cannot create %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_CREAT));
+#else
+ if ((f = open(fname, O_WRONLY)) < 0
+ && (f = creat(fname, 0666)) < 0)
+ error("cannot create %s: %s", fname, errmsg(errno, E_CREAT));
+ lseek(f, (off_t)0, 2);
+#endif
+ goto movefd;
+ case NTOFD:
+ case NFROMFD:
+ if (redir->ndup.dupfd >= 0) { /* if not ">&-" */
+ if (memory[redir->ndup.dupfd])
+ memory[fd] = 1;
+ else
+ copyfd(redir->ndup.dupfd, fd);
+ }
+ break;
+ case NHERE:
+ case NXHERE:
+ f = openhere(redir);
+ goto movefd;
+ default:
+ abort();
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Handle here documents. Normally we fork off a process to write the
+ * data to a pipe. If the document is short, we can stuff the data in
+ * the pipe without forking.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+openhere(redir)
+ union node *redir;
+ {
+ int pip[2];
+ int len;
+
+ if (pipe(pip) < 0)
+ error("Pipe call failed");
+ if (redir->type == NHERE) {
+ len = strlen(redir->nhere.doc->narg.text);
+ if (len <= PIPESIZE) {
+ xwrite(pip[1], redir->nhere.doc->narg.text, len);
+ goto out;
+ }
+ }
+ if (forkshell((struct job *)NULL, (union node *)NULL, FORK_NOJOB) == 0) {
+ close(pip[0]);
+ signal(SIGINT, SIG_IGN);
+ signal(SIGQUIT, SIG_IGN);
+ signal(SIGHUP, SIG_IGN);
+#ifdef SIGTSTP
+ signal(SIGTSTP, SIG_IGN);
+#endif
+ signal(SIGPIPE, SIG_DFL);
+ if (redir->type == NHERE)
+ xwrite(pip[1], redir->nhere.doc->narg.text, len);
+ else
+ expandhere(redir->nhere.doc, pip[1]);
+ _exit(0);
+ }
+out:
+ close(pip[1]);
+ return pip[0];
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Undo the effects of the last redirection.
+ */
+
+void
+popredir() {
+ register struct redirtab *rp = redirlist;
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 10 ; i++) {
+ if (rp->renamed[i] != EMPTY) {
+ if (i == 0)
+ fd0_redirected--;
+ close(i);
+ if (rp->renamed[i] >= 0) {
+ copyfd(rp->renamed[i], i);
+ close(rp->renamed[i]);
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ redirlist = rp->next;
+ ckfree(rp);
+ INTON;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Undo all redirections. Called on error or interrupt.
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+
+INCLUDE "redir.h"
+
+RESET {
+ while (redirlist)
+ popredir();
+}
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ clearredir();
+}
+
+#endif
+
+/* Return true if fd 0 has already been redirected at least once. */
+int
+fd0_redirected_p () {
+ return fd0_redirected != 0;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Discard all saved file descriptors.
+ */
+
+void
+clearredir() {
+ register struct redirtab *rp;
+ int i;
+
+ for (rp = redirlist ; rp ; rp = rp->next) {
+ for (i = 0 ; i < 10 ; i++) {
+ if (rp->renamed[i] >= 0) {
+ close(rp->renamed[i]);
+ }
+ rp->renamed[i] = EMPTY;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Copy a file descriptor to be >= to. Returns -1
+ * if the source file descriptor is closed, EMPTY if there are no unused
+ * file descriptors left.
+ */
+
+int
+copyfd(from, to) {
+ int newfd;
+
+ newfd = fcntl(from, F_DUPFD, to);
+ if (newfd < 0 && errno == EMFILE)
+ return EMPTY;
+ return newfd;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/redir.h b/bin/sh/redir.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..81cc760
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/redir.h
@@ -0,0 +1,56 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)redir.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/* flags passed to redirect */
+#define REDIR_PUSH 01 /* save previous values of file descriptors */
+#define REDIR_BACKQ 02 /* save the command output in memory */
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+union node;
+void redirect(union node *, int);
+void popredir(void);
+void clearredir(void);
+int copyfd(int, int);
+int fd0_redirected_p(void);
+#else
+void redirect();
+void popredir();
+void clearredir();
+int copyfd();
+int fd0_redirected_p();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/sh.1 b/bin/sh/sh.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..8bec2e7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/sh.1
@@ -0,0 +1,1307 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" Kenneth Almquist.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)sh.1 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.na
+.TH SH 1
+.SH NAME
+sh \- command interpreter (shell)
+.SH SYNOPSIS
+sh [-/+aCefnuvxIimsVEb] [-/+o longname] [arg ...]
+.SH DESCRIPTION
+.LP
+Sh is the standard command interpreter for the system.
+The current version of sh is in the process of being changed to
+conform with the POSIX 1003.2 and 1003.2a specifications for
+the shell. This version has many features which make it appear
+similar in some respects to the Korn shell, but it is not a Korn
+shell clone (run GNU's bash if you want that). Only features
+designated by POSIX, plus a few Berkeley extensions, are being
+incorporated into this shell. We expect POSIX conformance by the
+time 4.4 BSD is released.
+This man page is not intended to be a tutorial or a complete
+specification of the shell.
+.sp 2
+.B Overview
+.sp
+.LP
+The shell is a command that reads lines from
+either a file or the terminal, interprets them, and
+generally executes other commands. It is the program that is running
+when a user logs into the system (although a user can select
+a different shell with the chsh(1) command).
+The shell
+implements a language that has flow control constructs,
+a macro facility that provides a variety of features in
+addition to data storage, along with built in history and line
+editing capabilities. It incorporates many features to
+aid interactive use and has the advantage that the interpretative
+language is common to both interactive and non-interactive
+use (shell scripts). That is, commands can be typed directly
+to the running shell or can be put into a file and the file
+can be executed directly by the shell.
+.sp 2
+.B Invocation
+.sp
+.LP
+If no args are present and if the standard input of the shell
+is connected to a terminal (or if the -i flag is set), the shell
+is considered an interactive shell. An interactive shell
+generally prompts before each command and handles programming
+and command errors differently (as described below).
+When first starting, the shell inspects argument 0, and
+if it begins with a dash '-', the shell is also considered
+a login shell. This is normally done automatically by the system
+when the user first logs in. A login shell first reads commands
+from the files /etc/profile and .profile if they exist.
+If the environment variable ENV is set on entry to a shell,
+or is set in the .profile of a login shell, the shell next reads
+commands from the file named in ENV. Therefore, a user should
+place commands that are to be executed only at login time in
+the .profile file, and commands that are executed for every
+shell inside the ENV file. To set the ENV variable to some
+file, place the following line in your .profile of your home
+directory
+.nf
+
+ ENV=$HOME/.shinit; export ENV
+
+.fi
+substituting for ``.shinit'' any filename you wish.
+Since the ENV file is read for
+every invocation of the shell, including shell scripts and
+non-interactive shells, the following paradigm is useful
+for restricting commands in the ENV file to interactive invocations.
+Place commands within the ``case'' and ``esac'' below (these
+commands are described later):
+.nf
+
+ case $- in *i*)
+ # commands for interactive use only
+ ...
+ esac
+
+.fi
+If command line arguments besides the options have been
+specified, then the shell treats the first argument as the
+name of a file from which to read commands (a shell script), and
+the remaining arguments are set as the positional parameters
+of the shell ($1, $2, etc). Otherwise, the shell reads commands
+from its standard input.
+.sp 2
+.B Argument List Processing
+.sp
+.LP
+All of the single letter options have a corresponding name
+that can be used as an argument to the '-o' option. The
+set -o name is provided next to the single letter option in
+the description below.
+Specifying a dash ``-'' turns the option on, while using a plus ``+''
+disables the option.
+The following options can be set from the command line or
+with the set(1) builtin (described later).
+.TP
+-a allexport
+Export all variables assigned to.
+(UNIMPLEMENTED for 4.4alpha)
+.TP
+-C noclobber
+Don't overwrite existing files with ``>''.
+(UNIMPLEMENTED for 4.4alpha)
+.TP
+-e errexit
+If not interactive, exit immediately if any
+untested command fails.
+The exit status of a command is considered to be
+explicitly tested if the command is used to control
+an if, elif, while, or until; or if the command is the left
+hand operand of an ``&&'' or ``||'' operator.
+
+.TP
+-f noglob
+Disable pathname expansion.
+.TP
+-n noexec
+If not interactive, read commands but do not
+execute them. This is useful for checking the
+syntax of shell scripts.
+.TP
+-u nounset
+Write a message to standard error when attempting
+to expand a variable that is not set, and if the
+shell is not interactive, exit immediately.
+(UNIMPLEMENTED for 4.4alpha)
+.TP
+-v verbose
+The shell writes its input to standard error
+as it is read. Useful for debugging.
+.TP
+-x xtrace
+Write each command to standard error (preceded
+by a '+ ') before it is executed. Useful for
+debugging.
+.TP
+-I ignoreeof
+Ignore EOF's from input when interactive.
+.TP
+-i interactive
+Force the shell to behave interactively.
+.TP
+-m monitor
+Turn on job control (set automatically when
+interactive).
+.TP
+-s stdin
+Read commands from standard input (set automatically
+if no file arguments are present). This option has
+no effect when set after the shell has already started
+running (i.e. with set(1)).
+.TP
+-V vi
+Enable the builtin vi(1) command line editor (disables
+-E if it has been set).
+.TP
+-E emacs
+Enable the builtin emacs(1) command line editor (disables
+-V if it has been set).
+.TP
+-b notify
+Enable asynchronous notification of background job
+completion.
+(UNIMPLEMENTED for 4.4alpha)
+.LP
+.sp 2
+.B Lexical Structure
+.sp
+.LP
+The shell reads input in terms of lines from a file and breaks
+it up into words at whitespace (blanks and tabs), and at
+certain sequences of
+characters that are special to the shell called ``operators''.
+There are two types of operators: control operators and
+redirection operators (their meaning is discussed later).
+Following is a list of operators:
+.nf
+.sp
+Control operators: & && ( ) ; ;; | || <newline>
+.sp
+Redirection operator: < > >| << >> <& >& <<- <>
+.sp
+.fi
+.sp 2
+.B Quoting
+.sp
+.LP
+Quoting is used to remove the special meaning of certain characters
+or words to the shell, such as operators, whitespace, or
+keywords. There are three types of quoting: matched single quotes,
+matched double quotes, and backslash.
+.sp 2
+.B Backslash
+.sp
+.LP
+A backslash preserves the literal meaning of the following
+character, with the exception of <newline>. A backslash preceding
+a <newline> is treated as a line continuation.
+.sp 2
+.B Single Quotes
+.sp
+.LP
+Enclosing characters in single quotes preserves the literal
+meaning of all the characters.
+.sp 2
+.B Double Quotes
+.sp
+.LP
+Enclosing characters within double quotes preserves the literal
+meaning of all characters except dollarsign ($), backquote (`),
+and backslash (\\). The backslash inside double quotes is
+historically weird, and serves to quote only the following
+characters: $ ` " \\ <newline>.
+Otherwise it remains literal.
+.sp 2
+.B Reserved Words
+.sp
+.LP
+Reserved words are words that have special meaning to the
+shell and are recognized at the beginning of a line and
+after a control operator. The following are reserved words:
+.nf
+
+ ! elif fi while case
+ else for then { }
+ do done until if esac
+
+.fi
+Their meaning is discussed later.
+.sp 2
+.B Aliases
+.sp
+.LP
+An alias is a name and corresponding value set using the alias(1)
+builtin command. Whenever a reserved word may occur (see above),
+and after checking for reserved words, the shell
+checks the word to see if it matches an alias. If it does,
+it replaces it in the input stream with its value. For example,
+if there is an alias called ``lf'' with the value ``ls -F'',
+then the input
+.nf
+
+ lf foobar <return>
+
+ would become
+
+ ls -F foobar <return>
+
+.fi
+.LP
+Aliases provide a convenient way for naive users to
+create shorthands for commands without having to learn how
+to create functions with arguments. They can also be
+used to create lexically obscure code. This use is discouraged.
+.sp 2
+.B Commands
+.sp
+.LP
+The shell interprets the words it reads according to a
+language, the specification of which is outside the scope
+of this man page (refer to the BNF in the POSIX 1003.2
+document). Essentially though, a line is read and if
+the first word of the line (or after a control operator)
+is not a reserved word, then the shell has recognized a
+simple command. Otherwise, a complex command or some
+other special construct may have been recognized.
+.sp 2
+.B Simple Commands
+.sp
+.LP
+If a simple command has been recognized, the shell performs
+the following actions:
+.sp
+1) Leading words of the form ``name=value'' are
+stripped off and assigned to the environment of
+the simple command. Redirection operators and
+their arguments (as described below) are stripped
+off and saved for processing.
+.sp
+2) The remaining words are expanded as described in
+the section called ``Expansions'', and the
+first remaining word is considered the command
+name and the command is located. The remaining
+words are considered the arguments of the command.
+If no command name resulted, then the ``name=value''
+variable assignments recognized in 1) affect the
+current shell.
+.sp
+3) Redirections are performed as described in
+the next section.
+.sp 2
+.B Redirections
+.sp
+.LP
+Redirections are used to change where a command reads its input
+or sends its output. In general, redirections open, close, or
+duplicate an existing reference to a file. The overall format
+used for redirection is:
+.nf
+
+ [n] redir-op file
+
+.fi
+where redir-op is one of the redirection operators mentioned
+previously. Following is a list of the possible redirections.
+The [n] is an optional number, as in '3' (not '[3]'), that
+refers to a file descriptor.
+.TP
+[n]> file
+Redirect standard output (or n) to file.
+.TP
+[n]>| file
+Same, but override the -C option.
+.TP
+[n]>> file
+Append standard output (or n) to file.
+.TP
+[n]< file
+Redirect standard input (or n) from file.
+.TP
+[n1]<&n2
+Duplicate standard input (or n1) from
+file descriptor n2.
+.TP
+[n]<&-
+Close standard input (or n).
+.TP
+[n1]>&n2
+Duplicate standard output (or n) from
+n2.
+.TP
+[n]>&-
+Close standard output (or n).
+.TP
+[n]<> file
+Open file for reading and writing on
+standard input (or n).
+.LP
+The following redirection is often called a ``here-document''.
+.nf
+
+ [n]<< delimiter
+ here-doc-text...
+ delimiter
+
+.fi
+All the text on successive lines up to the delimiter is
+saved away and made available to the command on standard
+input, or file descriptor n if it is specified. If the delimiter
+as specified on the initial line is quoted, then the here-doc-text
+is treated literally, otherwise the text is subjected to
+parameter expansion, command substitution, and arithmetic
+expansion (as described in the section on ``Expansions''). If
+the operator is ``<<-'' instead of ``<<'', then leading tabs
+in the here-doc-text are stripped.
+.sp 2
+.B Search and Execution
+.sp
+.LP
+There are three types of commands: shell functions, builtin commands, and normal programs -- and the
+command is searched for (by name) in that order. They
+each are executed in a different way.
+.LP
+When a shell function is executed, all of the shell positional parameters (except $0, which remains unchanged) are
+set to the arguments of the shell function.
+The variables which are explicitly placed in the environment of
+the command (by placing assignments to them before the
+function name) are made local to the function and are set
+to the values given. Then the command given in the function
+definition is executed. The positional parameters are
+restored to their original values when the command completes.
+.LP
+Shell builtins are executed internally to the shell, without spawning a new process.
+.LP
+Otherwise, if the command name doesn't match a function
+or builtin, the command is searched for as a normal
+program in the filesystem (as described in the next section).
+When a normal program is executed, the shell runs the program,
+passing the arguments and the environment to the
+program. If the program is a shell procedure, the shell
+will interpret the program in a subshell. The shell will
+reinitialize itself in this case, so that the effect will
+be as if a new shell had been invoked to handle the shell
+procedure, except that the location of commands located in
+the parent shell will be remembered by the child.
+.sp 2
+.B Path Search
+.sp
+.LP
+When locating a command, the shell first looks to see if
+it has a shell function by that name. Then it looks for a
+builtin command by that name.
+Finally, it searches each
+entry in PATH in turn for the command.
+.LP
+The value of the PATH variable should be a series of
+entries separated by colons. Each entry consists of a
+directory name.
+The current directory
+may be indicated by an empty directory name.
+.LP
+Command names containing a slash are simply executed without performing any of the above searches.
+.sp 2
+.B Command Exit Status
+.sp
+.LP
+Each command has an exit status that can influence the behavior
+of other shell commands. The paradigm is that a command exits
+with zero for normal or success, and non-zero for failure,
+error, or a false indication. The man page for each command
+should indicate the various exit codes and what they mean.
+Additionally, the builtin commands return exit codes, as does
+an executed function.
+.sp 2
+.B Complex Commands
+.sp
+.LP
+Complex commands are combinations of simple commands
+with control operators or reserved words, together creating a larger complex
+command. More generally, a command is one of the following:
+.nf
+
+ - simple command
+
+ - pipeline
+
+ - list or compound-list
+
+ - compound command
+
+ - function definition
+
+.fi
+.LP
+Unless otherwise stated, the exit status of a command is
+that of the last simple command executed by the command.
+.sp 2
+.B Pipeline
+.sp
+.LP
+A pipeline is a sequence of one or more commands separated
+by the control operator |. The standard output of all but
+the last command is connected to the standard input
+of the next command.
+.LP
+The format for a pipeline is:
+.nf
+
+[!] command1 [ | command2 ...]
+
+.fi
+.LP
+The standard output of command1 is connected to the standard
+input of command2. The standard input, standard output, or
+both of a command is considered to be assigned by the
+pipeline before any redirection specified by redirection
+operators that are part of the command.
+.LP
+If the pipeline is not in the background (discussed later),
+the shell waits for all commands to complete.
+.LP
+If the reserved word ! does not precede the pipeline, the
+exit status is the exit status of the last command specified
+in the pipeline. Otherwise, the exit status is the logical
+NOT of the exit status of the last command. That is, if
+the last command returns zero, the exit status is 1; if
+the last command returns greater than zero, the exit status
+is zero.
+.LP
+Because pipeline assignment of standard input or standard
+output or both takes place before redirection, it can be
+modified by redirection. For example:
+.nf
+
+$ command1 2>&1 | command2
+
+.fi
+sends both the standard output and standard error of command1
+to the standard input of command2.
+.LP
+A ; or <newline> terminator causes the preceding
+AND-OR-list (described next) to be executed sequentially; a & causes
+asynchronous execution of the preceding AND-OR-list.
+.sp 2
+.B Background Commands -- &
+.sp
+.LP
+If a command is terminated by the control operator ampersand
+(&), the shell executes the command asynchronously -- that is,
+the shell does not wait for
+the command to finish before executing the next command.
+.LP
+The format for running a command in background is:
+.nf
+
+command1 & [command2 & ...]
+
+.fi
+If the shell is not interactive, the standard input of an
+asynchronous command is set to /dev/null.
+.sp 2
+.B Lists -- Generally Speaking
+.sp
+.LP
+A list is a sequence of zero or more commands separated by
+newlines, semicolons, or ampersands,
+and optionally terminated by one of these three characters.
+The commands in a
+list are executed in the order they are written.
+If command is followed by an ampersand, the shell starts the
+command and immediately proceed onto the next command;
+otherwise it waits for the command to terminate before
+proceeding to the next one.
+.LP
+``&&'' and ``||'' are AND-OR list operators. ``&&'' executes
+the first command, and then executes the second command
+iff the exit status of the first command is zero. ``||''
+is similar, but executes the second command iff the exit
+status of the first command is nonzero. ``&&'' and ``||''
+both have the same priority.
+.LP
+The syntax of the if command is
+.nf
+
+ if list
+ then list
+ [ elif list
+ then list ] ...
+ [ else list ]
+ fi
+
+.fi
+The syntax of the while command is
+.nf
+
+ while list
+ do list
+ done
+
+.fi
+The two lists are executed repeatedly while the exit status of the first list is zero. The until command is similar, but has the word until in place of while
+repeat until the exit status of the first list is zero.
+.LP
+The syntax of the for command is
+.nf
+
+ for variable in word...
+ do list
+ done
+
+.fi
+The words are expanded, and then the list is executed
+repeatedly with the variable set to each word in turn. do
+and done may be replaced with ``{'' and ``}''.
+.LP
+The syntax of the break and continue command is
+.nf
+
+ break [ num ]
+ continue [ num ]
+
+.fi
+Break terminates the num innermost for or while loops.
+Continue continues with the next iteration of the innermost loop. These are implemented as builtin commands.
+.LP
+The syntax of the case command is
+.nf
+
+ case word in
+ pattern) list ;;
+ ...
+ esac
+
+.fi
+.LP
+The pattern can actually be one or more patterns (see Shell
+Patterns described later), separated by ``|'' characters.
+
+.LP
+Commands may be grouped by writing either
+.nf
+
+ (list)
+
+.fi
+or
+.nf
+
+ { list; }
+
+.fi
+The first of these executes the commands in a subshell.
+.sp 2
+.B Functions
+.sp
+.LP
+The syntax of a function definition is
+.nf
+
+ name ( ) command
+
+.fi
+.LP
+A function definition is an executable statement; when
+executed it installs a function named name and returns an
+exit status of zero. The command is normally a list
+enclosed between ``{'' and ``}''.
+.LP
+Variables may be declared to be local to a function by
+using a local command. This should appear as the first
+statement of a function, and the syntax is
+.nf
+
+ local [ variable | - ] ...
+
+.fi
+Local is implemented as a builtin command.
+.LP
+When a variable is made local, it inherits the initial
+value and exported and readonly flags from the variable
+with the same name in the surrounding scope, if there is
+one. Otherwise, the variable is initially unset. The shell
+uses dynamic scoping, so that if you make the variable x
+local to function f, which then calls function g, references to the variable x made inside g will refer to the
+variable x declared inside f, not to the global variable
+named x.
+.LP
+The only special parameter than can be made local is
+``-''. Making ``-'' local any shell options that are
+changed via the set command inside the function to be
+restored to their original values when the function
+returns.
+.LP
+The syntax of the return command is
+.nf
+
+ return [ exitstatus ]
+
+.fi
+It terminates the currently executing function. Return is
+implemented as a builtin command.
+.sp 2
+.B Variables and Parameters
+.sp
+.LP
+The shell maintains a set of parameters. A parameter
+denoted by a name is called a variable. When starting up,
+the shell turns all the environment variables into shell
+variables. New variables can be set using the form
+.nf
+
+ name=value
+
+.fi
+.LP
+Variables set by the user must have a name consisting solely
+of alphabetics, numerics, and underscores - the first of which
+must not be numeric. A parameter can also be denoted by a number
+or a special character as explained below.
+.sp 2
+.B Positional Parameters
+.sp
+.LP
+A positional parameter is a parameter denoted by a number (n > 0).
+The shell sets these initially to the values of its command
+line arguments that follow the name of the shell script.
+The set(1) builtin can also be used to set or reset them.
+.sp 2
+.B Special Parameters
+.sp
+.LP
+A special parameter is a parameter denoted by one of the following
+special characters. The value of the parameter is listed
+next to its character.
+.TP
+*
+Expands to the positional parameters, starting from one. When
+the expansion occurs within a double-quoted string
+it expands to a single field with the value of each parameter
+separated by the first character of the IFS variable, or by a
+<space> if IFS is unset.
+.TP
+@
+Expands to the positional parameters, starting from one. When
+the expansion occurs within double-quotes, each positional
+parameter expands as a separate argument.
+If there are no positional parameters, the
+expansion of @ generates zero arguments, even when @ is
+double-quoted. What this basically means, for example, is
+if $1 is ``abc'' and $2 is ``def ghi'', then "$@" expands to
+the two arguments:
+
+"abc" "def ghi"
+.TP
+#
+Expands to the number of positional parameters.
+.TP
+?
+Expands to the exit status of the most recent pipeline.
+.TP
+- (Hyphen)
+Expands to the current option flags (the single-letter
+option names concatenated into a string) as specified on
+invocation, by the set builtin command, or implicitly
+by the shell.
+.TP
+$
+Expands to the process ID of the invoked shell. A subshell
+retains the same value of $ as its parent.
+.TP
+!
+Expands to the process ID of the most recent background
+command executed from the current shell. For a
+pipeline, the process ID is that of the last command in the
+pipeline.
+.TP
+0 (Zero.)
+Expands to the name of the shell or shell script.
+.LP
+.sp 2
+.B Word Expansions
+.sp
+.LP
+This clause describes the various expansions that are
+performed on words. Not all expansions are performed on
+every word, as explained later.
+.LP
+Tilde expansions, parameter expansions, command substitutions,
+arithmetic expansions, and quote removals that occur within
+a single word expand to a single field. It is only field
+splitting or pathname expansion that can create multiple
+fields from a single word. The single exception to this
+rule is the expansion of the special parameter @ within
+double-quotes, as was described above.
+.LP
+The order of word expansion is:
+.LP
+(1) Tilde Expansion, Parameter Expansion, Command Substitution,
+Arithmetic Expansion (these all occur at the same time).
+.LP
+(2) Field Splitting is performed on fields
+generated by step (1) unless the IFS variable is null.
+.LP
+(3) Pathname Expansion (unless set -f is in effect).
+.LP
+(4) Quote Removal.
+.LP
+The $ character is used to introduce parameter expansion, command
+substitution, or arithmetic evaluation.
+.sp 2
+.B Tilde Expansion (substituting a user's home directory)
+.sp
+.LP
+A word beginning with an unquoted tilde character (~) is
+subjected to tilde expansion. All the characters up to
+a slash (/) or the end of the word are treated as a username
+and are replaced with the user's home directory. If the
+username is missing (as in ~/foobar), the tilde is replaced
+with the value of the HOME variable (the current user's
+home directory).
+
+.sp 2
+.B Parameter Expansion
+.sp
+.LP
+The format for parameter expansion is as follows:
+.nf
+
+ ${expression}
+
+.fi
+where expression consists of all characters until the matching }. Any }
+escaped by a backslash or within a quoted string, and characters in
+embedded arithmetic expansions, command substitutions, and variable
+expansions, are not examined in determining the matching }.
+.LP
+The simplest form for parameter expansion is:
+.nf
+
+ ${parameter}
+
+.fi
+The value, if any, of parameter is substituted.
+.LP
+The parameter name or symbol can be enclosed in braces, which are
+optional except for positional parameters with more than one digit or
+when parameter is followed by a character that could be interpreted as
+part of the name.
+If a parameter expansion occurs inside
+double-quotes:
+.LP
+1) Pathname expansion is not performed on the results of the
+expansion.
+.LP
+2) Field splitting is not performed on the results of the
+expansion, with the exception of @.
+.LP
+In addition, a parameter expansion can be modified by using one of the
+following formats.
+.sp
+.TP
+${parameter:-word}
+Use Default Values. If parameter is unset or
+null, the expansion of word is
+substituted; otherwise, the value of
+parameter is substituted.
+.TP
+${parameter:=word}
+Assign Default Values. If parameter is unset
+or null, the expansion of word is
+assigned to parameter. In all cases, the
+final value of parameter is
+substituted. Only variables, not positional
+parameters or special parameters, can be
+assigned in this way.
+.TP
+${parameter:?[word]}
+Indicate Error if Null or Unset. If
+parameter is unset or null, the expansion of
+word (or a message indicating it is unset if
+word is omitted) is written to standard
+error and the shell exits with a nonzero
+exit status. Otherwise, the value of
+parameter is substituted. An
+interactive shell need not exit.
+.TP
+${parameter:+word}
+Use Alternate Value. If parameter is unset
+or null, null is substituted;
+otherwise, the expansion of word is
+substituted.
+.LP
+In the parameter expansions shown previously, use of the colon in the
+format results in a test for a parameter that is unset or null; omission
+of the colon results in a test for a parameter that is only unset.
+.TP
+${#parameter}
+String Length. The length in characters of
+the value of parameter.
+.LP
+The following four varieties of parameter expansion provide for substring
+processing. In each case, pattern matching notation (see Shell Patterns), rather
+than regular expression notation, is used to evaluate the patterns.
+If parameter is * or @, the result of the expansion is unspecified.
+Enclosing the full parameter expansion string in double-quotes does not
+cause the following four varieties of pattern characters to be quoted,
+whereas quoting characters within the braces has this effect.
+(UNIMPLEMENTED IN 4.4alpha)
+.TP
+${parameter%word}
+Remove Smallest Suffix Pattern. The word
+is expanded to produce a pattern. The
+parameter expansion then results in
+parameter, with the smallest portion of the
+suffix matched by the pattern deleted.
+
+.TP
+${parameter%%word}
+Remove Largest Suffix Pattern. The word
+is expanded to produce a pattern. The
+parameter expansion then results in
+parameter, with the largest portion of the
+suffix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.TP
+${parameter#word}
+Remove Smallest Prefix Pattern. The word
+is expanded to produce a pattern. The
+parameter expansion then results in
+parameter, with the smallest portion of the
+prefix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.TP
+${parameter##word}
+Remove Largest Prefix Pattern. The word
+is expanded to produce a pattern. The
+parameter expansion then results in
+parameter, with the largest portion of the
+prefix matched by the pattern deleted.
+.LP
+.sp 2
+.B Command Substitution
+.sp
+.LP
+Command substitution allows the output of a command to be substituted in
+place of the command name itself. Command substitution occurs when
+the command is enclosed as follows:
+.nf
+
+ $(command)
+
+.fi
+or (``backquoted'' version):
+.nf
+
+ `command`
+
+.fi
+.LP
+The shell expands the command substitution by executing command in a
+subshell environment and replacing the command substitution
+with the
+standard output of the command, removing sequences of one or more
+<newline>s at the end of the substitution. (Embedded <newline>s before
+the end of the output are not removed; however, during field
+splitting, they may be translated into <space>s, depending on the value
+of IFS and quoting that is in effect.)
+
+.sp 2
+.B Arithmetic Expansion
+.sp
+.LP
+Arithmetic expansion provides a mechanism for evaluating an arithmetic
+expression and substituting its value. The format for arithmetic
+expansion is as follows:
+.nf
+
+ $((expression))
+
+.fi
+The expression is treated as if it were in double-quotes, except
+that a double-quote inside the expression is not treated specially. The
+shell expands all tokens in the expression for parameter expansion,
+command substitution, and quote removal.
+.LP
+Next, the shell treats this as an arithmetic expression and
+substitutes the value of the expression.
+
+.sp 2
+.B White Space Splitting (Field Splitting)
+.sp
+.LP
+After parameter expansion, command substitution, and
+arithmetic expansion the shell scans the results of
+expansions and substitutions that did not occur in double-quotes for
+field splitting and multiple fields can result.
+.LP
+The shell treats each character of the IFS as a delimiter and use
+the delimiters to split the results of parameter expansion and command
+substitution into fields.
+
+.sp 2
+.B Pathname Expansion (File Name Generation)
+.sp
+.LP
+Unless the -f flag is set, file name generation is performed after word splitting is complete. Each word is
+viewed as a series of patterns, separated by slashes. The
+process of expansion replaces the word with the names of
+all existing files whose names can be formed by replacing
+each pattern with a string that matches the specified pattern.
+There are two restrictions on this: first, a pattern cannot match a string containing a slash, and second,
+a pattern cannot match a string starting with a period
+unless the first character of the pattern is a period.
+The next section describes the patterns used for both
+Pathname Expansion and the case(1) command.
+
+.sp 2
+.B Shell Patterns
+.sp
+.LP
+A pattern consists of normal characters, which match themselves, and meta-characters. The meta-characters are
+``!'', ``*'', ``?'', and ``[''. These characters lose
+there special meanings if they are quoted. When command
+or variable substitution is performed and the dollar sign
+or back quotes are not double quoted, the value of the
+variable or the output of the command is scanned for these
+characters and they are turned into meta-characters.
+.LP
+An asterisk (``*'') matches any string of characters. A
+question mark matches any single character. A left
+bracket (``['') introduces a character class. The end of
+the character class is indicated by a ``]''; if the ``]''
+is missing then the ``['' matches a ``['' rather than
+introducing a character class. A character class matches
+any of the characters between the square brackets. A
+range of characters may be specified using a minus sign.
+The character class may be complemented by making an
+exclamation point the first character of the character
+class.
+.LP
+To include a ``]'' in a character class, make it the first
+character listed (after the ``!'', if any). To include a
+minus sign, make it the first or last character listed
+
+.sp 2
+.B Builtins
+.sp
+.LP
+This section lists the builtin commands which
+are builtin because they need to perform some operation
+that can't be performed by a separate process. In addition to these, there are several other commands that may
+be builtin for efficiency (e.g. printf(1), echo(1), test(1),
+etc).
+.TP
+alias [ name[=string] ... ]
+If name=string is specified, the shell defines the
+alias ``name'' with value ``string''. If just ``name''
+is specified, the value of the alias ``name'' is printed.
+With no arguments, the alias builtin prints the
+names and values of all defined aliases (see unalias).
+.TP
+bg [ job ] ...
+Continue the specified jobs (or the current job if no
+jobs are given) in the background.
+.TP
+command command arg...
+Execute the specified builtin command. (This is useful when you have a shell function with the same name
+as a builtin command.)
+.TP
+cd [ directory ]
+Switch to the specified directory (default $HOME).
+If the an entry for CDPATH appears in the environment
+of the cd command or the shell variable CDPATH is set
+and the directory name does not begin with a slash,
+then the directories listed in CDPATH will be
+searched for the specified directory. The format of
+CDPATH is the same as that of PATH. In an interactive shell, the cd command will print out the name of
+the directory that it actually switched to if this is
+different from the name that the user gave. These
+may be different either because the CDPATH mechanism
+was used or because a symbolic link was crossed.
+.TP
+\&. file
+The commands in the specified file are read and executed by the shell.
+.TP
+eval string...
+Concatenate all the arguments with spaces. Then
+re-parse and execute the command.
+.TP
+exec [ command arg... ]
+Unless command is omitted, the shell process is
+replaced with the specified program (which must be a
+real program, not a shell builtin or function). Any
+redirections on the exec command are marked as permanent, so that they are not undone when the exec command finishes.
+.TP
+exit [ exitstatus ]
+Terminate the shell process. If exitstatus is given
+it is used as the exit status of the shell; otherwise
+the exit status of the preceding command is used.
+.TP
+export name...
+The specified names are exported so that they will
+appear in the environment of subsequent commands.
+The only way to un-export a variable is to unset it.
+The shell allows the value of a variable to be set at the
+same time it is exported by writing
+.nf
+
+ export name=value
+
+.fi
+With no arguments the export command lists the names
+of all exported variables.
+.TP
+fc [-e editor] [first [last]]
+.TP
+fc -l [-nr] [first [last]]
+.TP
+fc -s [old=new] [first]
+The fc builtin lists, or edits and re-executes, commands
+previously entered to an interactive shell.
+.RS +.5i
+.TP 2
+-e editor
+Use the editor named by editor to edit the commands. The
+editor string is a command name, subject to search via the
+PATH variable. The value in the FCEDIT variable
+is used as a default when -e is not specified. If
+FCEDIT is null or unset, the value of the EDITOR
+variable is used. If EDITOR is null or unset,
+ed(1) is used as the editor.
+.TP 2
+-l (ell)
+List the commands rather than invoking
+an editor on them. The commands are written in the
+sequence indicated by the first and last operands, as
+affected by -r, with each command preceded by the command
+number.
+.TP 2
+-n
+Suppress command numbers when listing with -l.
+.TP 2
+-r
+Reverse the order of the commands listed (with -l) or
+edited (with neither -l nor -s).
+.TP 2
+-s
+Re-execute the command without invoking an editor.
+.TP 2
+first
+.TP 2
+last
+Select the commands to list or edit. The number of
+previous commands that can be accessed are determined
+by the value of the HISTSIZE variable. The value of first
+or last or both are one of the following:
+.TP 2
+[+]number
+A positive number representing a command
+number; command numbers can be displayed
+with the -l option.
+.TP 2
+-number
+A negative decimal number representing the
+command that was executed number of
+commands previously. For example, -1 is
+the immediately previous command.
+.TP 2
+string
+A string indicating the most recently
+entered command that begins with that
+string. If the old=new operand is not also
+specified with -s, the string form of the
+first operand cannot contain an embedded
+equal sign.
+.TP
+The following environment variables affect the execution of fc:
+.TP 2
+FCEDIT
+Name of the editor to use.
+.TP 2
+HISTSIZE
+The number of previous commands that are accessable.
+.RE
+.TP
+fg [ job ]
+Move the specified job or the current job to the
+foreground.
+.TP
+getopts optstring var
+The POSIX getopts command.
+.TP
+hash -rv command...
+The shell maintains a hash table which remembers the
+locations of commands. With no arguments whatsoever,
+the hash command prints out the contents of this
+table. Entries which have not been looked at since
+the last cd command are marked with an asterisk; it
+is possible for these entries to be invalid.
+.sp
+With arguments, the hash command removes the specified commands from the hash table (unless they are
+functions) and then locates them. With the -v
+option, hash prints the locations of the commands as
+it finds them. The -r option causes the hash command
+to delete all the entries in the hash table except
+for functions.
+.TP
+jobid [ job ]
+Print the process id's of the processes in the job.
+If the job argument is omitted, use the current job.
+.TP
+jobs
+This command lists out all the background processes
+which are children of the current shell process.
+.TP
+pwd
+Print the current directory. The builtin command may
+differ from the program of the same name because the
+builtin command remembers what the current directory
+is rather than recomputing it each time. This makes
+it faster. However, if the current directory is
+renamed, the builtin version of pwd will continue to
+print the old name for the directory.
+.TP
+read [ -p prompt ] [ -e ] variable...
+The prompt is printed if the -p option is specified
+and the standard input is a terminal. Then a line is
+read from the standard input. The trailing newline
+is deleted from the line and the line is split as
+described in the section on word splitting above, and
+the pieces are assigned to the variables in order.
+If there are more pieces than variables, the remaining pieces (along with the characters in IFS that
+separated them) are assigned to the last variable.
+If there are more variables than pieces, the remaining variables are assigned the null string.
+.sp
+The -e option causes any backslashes in the input to
+be treated specially. If a backslash is followed by
+a newline, the backslash and the newline will be
+deleted. If a backslash is followed by any other
+character, the backslash will be deleted and the following character will be treated as though it were
+not in IFS, even if it is.
+.TP
+readonly name...
+The specified names are marked as read only, so that
+they cannot be subsequently modified or unset. The shell
+allows the value of a variable to be set at the same
+time it is marked read only by writing
+.TP
+readonly name=value
+With no arguments the readonly command lists the
+names of all read only variables.
+.TP
+set [ { -options | +options | -- } ] arg...
+The set command performs three different functions.
+.sp
+With no arguments, it lists the values of all shell
+variables.
+.sp
+If options are given, it sets the specified option
+flags, or clears them as described in the section
+called ``Argument List Processing''.
+.sp
+The third use of the set command is to set the values
+of the shell's positional parameters to the specified
+args. To change the positional parameters without
+changing any options, use ``--'' as the first argument to set. If no args are present, the set command
+will clear all the positional parameters (equivalent
+to executing ``shift $#''.
+.TP
+setvar variable value
+Assigns value to variable. (In general it is better
+to write variable=value rather than using setvar.
+Setvar is intended to be used in functions that
+assign values to variables whose names are passed as
+parameters.)
+.TP
+shift [ n ]
+Shift the positional parameters n times. A shift
+sets the value of $1 to the value of $2, the value of
+$2 to the value of $3, and so on, decreasing the
+value of $# by one. If there are zero positional
+parameters, shifting doesn't do anything.
+.TP
+trap [ action ] signal...
+Cause the shell to parse and execute action when any
+of the specified signals are received. The signals
+are specified by signal number. Action may be null
+or omitted; the former causes the specified signal to
+be ignored and the latter causes the default action
+to be taken. When the shell forks off a subshell, it
+resets trapped (but not ignored) signals to the
+default action. The trap command has no effect on
+signals that were ignored on entry to the shell.
+.TP
+umask [ mask ]
+Set the value of umask (see umask(2)) to the specified octal value.
+If the argument is omitted, the
+umask value is printed.
+.TP
+unalias [-a] [name]
+If ``name'' is specified, the shell removes that alias.
+If ``-a'' is specified, all aliases are removed.
+.TP
+unset name...
+The specified variables and functions are unset and
+unexported. If a given name corresponds to both a
+variable and a function, both the variable and the
+function are unset.
+.TP
+wait [ job ]
+Wait for the specified job to complete and return the
+exit status of the last process in the job. If the
+argument is omitted, wait for all jobs to complete
+and the return an exit status of zero.
+.LP
+.sp 2
+.B Command Line Editing
+.sp
+.LP
+When sh is being used interactively from a terminal, the current command
+and the command history (see fc in Builtins) can be edited using vi-mode
+command-line editing. This mode uses commands, described below, similar
+to a subset of those described in the vi man page.
+The command set -o vi enables vi-mode editing and place sh into vi
+insert mode.
+With vi-mode enabled, sh can be switched between insert mode and command
+mode. The editor is not described in full here, but will be in a later
+document. It's similar to vi: typing <ESC> will throw you into
+command VI command mode. Hitting <return> while in command mode
+will pass the line to the shell.
diff --git a/bin/sh/shell.h b/bin/sh/shell.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..87f4795
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/shell.h
@@ -0,0 +1,84 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)shell.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * The follow should be set to reflect the type of system you have:
+ * JOBS -> 1 if you have Berkeley job control, 0 otherwise.
+ * SYMLINKS -> 1 if your system includes symbolic links, 0 otherwise.
+ * SHORTNAMES -> 1 if your linker cannot handle long names.
+ * define BSD if you are running 4.2 BSD or later.
+ * define SYSV if you are running under System V.
+ * define DEBUG=1 to compile in debugging (set global "debug" to turn on)
+ * define DEBUG=2 to compile in and turn on debugging.
+ *
+ * When debugging is on, debugging info will be written to $HOME/trace and
+ * a quit signal will generate a core dump.
+ */
+
+
+#define JOBS 1
+#define SYMLINKS 1
+#ifndef BSD
+#define BSD 1
+#endif
+#define DEBUG 1
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+typedef void *pointer;
+#ifndef NULL
+#define NULL (void *)0
+#endif
+#else /* not __STDC__ */
+typedef char *pointer;
+#ifndef NULL
+#define NULL 0
+#endif
+#endif /* not __STDC__ */
+#define STATIC /* empty */
+#define MKINIT /* empty */
+
+#include <sys/cdefs.h>
+
+extern char nullstr[1]; /* null string */
+
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+#define TRACE(param) trace param
+#else
+#define TRACE(param)
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/show.c b/bin/sh/show.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..9807c99
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/show.c
@@ -0,0 +1,378 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)show.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "parser.h"
+#include "nodes.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+static shtree(), shcmd(), sharg(), indent();
+
+
+showtree(n)
+ union node *n;
+ {
+ trputs("showtree called\n");
+ shtree(n, 1, NULL, stdout);
+}
+
+
+static
+shtree(n, ind, pfx, fp)
+ union node *n;
+ char *pfx;
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ struct nodelist *lp;
+ char *s;
+
+ indent(ind, pfx, fp);
+ switch(n->type) {
+ case NSEMI:
+ s = "; ";
+ goto binop;
+ case NAND:
+ s = " && ";
+ goto binop;
+ case NOR:
+ s = " || ";
+binop:
+ shtree(n->nbinary.ch1, ind, NULL, fp);
+ /* if (ind < 0) */
+ fputs(s, fp);
+ shtree(n->nbinary.ch2, ind, NULL, fp);
+ break;
+ case NCMD:
+ shcmd(n, fp);
+ if (ind >= 0)
+ putc('\n', fp);
+ break;
+ case NPIPE:
+ for (lp = n->npipe.cmdlist ; lp ; lp = lp->next) {
+ shcmd(lp->n, fp);
+ if (lp->next)
+ fputs(" | ", fp);
+ }
+ if (n->npipe.backgnd)
+ fputs(" &", fp);
+ if (ind >= 0)
+ putc('\n', fp);
+ break;
+ default:
+ fprintf(fp, "<node type %d>", n->type);
+ if (ind >= 0)
+ putc('\n', fp);
+ break;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+static
+shcmd(cmd, fp)
+ union node *cmd;
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ union node *np;
+ int first;
+ char *s;
+ int dftfd;
+
+ first = 1;
+ for (np = cmd->ncmd.args ; np ; np = np->narg.next) {
+ if (! first)
+ putchar(' ');
+ sharg(np, fp);
+ first = 0;
+ }
+ for (np = cmd->ncmd.redirect ; np ; np = np->nfile.next) {
+ if (! first)
+ putchar(' ');
+ switch (np->nfile.type) {
+ case NTO: s = ">"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NAPPEND: s = ">>"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NTOFD: s = ">&"; dftfd = 1; break;
+ case NFROM: s = "<"; dftfd = 0; break;
+ case NFROMFD: s = "<&"; dftfd = 0; break;
+ }
+ if (np->nfile.fd != dftfd)
+ fprintf(fp, "%d", np->nfile.fd);
+ fputs(s, fp);
+ if (np->nfile.type == NTOFD || np->nfile.type == NFROMFD) {
+ fprintf(fp, "%d", np->ndup.dupfd);
+ } else {
+ sharg(np->nfile.fname, fp);
+ }
+ first = 0;
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+static
+sharg(arg, fp)
+ union node *arg;
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ char *p;
+ struct nodelist *bqlist;
+ int subtype;
+
+ if (arg->type != NARG) {
+ printf("<node type %d>\n", arg->type);
+ fflush(stdout);
+ abort();
+ }
+ bqlist = arg->narg.backquote;
+ for (p = arg->narg.text ; *p ; p++) {
+ switch (*p) {
+ case CTLESC:
+ putc(*++p, fp);
+ break;
+ case CTLVAR:
+ putc('$', fp);
+ putc('{', fp);
+ subtype = *++p;
+ while (*p != '=')
+ putc(*p++, fp);
+ if (subtype & VSNUL)
+ putc(':', fp);
+ switch (subtype & VSTYPE) {
+ case VSNORMAL:
+ putc('}', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSMINUS:
+ putc('-', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSPLUS:
+ putc('+', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSQUESTION:
+ putc('?', fp);
+ break;
+ case VSASSIGN:
+ putc('=', fp);
+ break;
+ default:
+ printf("<subtype %d>", subtype);
+ }
+ break;
+ case CTLENDVAR:
+ putc('}', fp);
+ break;
+ case CTLBACKQ:
+ case CTLBACKQ|CTLQUOTE:
+ putc('$', fp);
+ putc('(', fp);
+ shtree(bqlist->n, -1, NULL, fp);
+ putc(')', fp);
+ break;
+ default:
+ putc(*p, fp);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+static
+indent(amount, pfx, fp)
+ char *pfx;
+ FILE *fp;
+ {
+ int i;
+
+ for (i = 0 ; i < amount ; i++) {
+ if (pfx && i == amount - 1)
+ fputs(pfx, fp);
+ putc('\t', fp);
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Debugging stuff.
+ */
+
+
+FILE *tracefile;
+
+#if DEBUG == 2
+int debug = 1;
+#else
+int debug = 0;
+#endif
+
+
+trputc(c) {
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (tracefile == NULL)
+ return;
+ putc(c, tracefile);
+ if (c == '\n')
+ fflush(tracefile);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+trace(fmt, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8)
+ char *fmt;
+ {
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (tracefile == NULL)
+ return;
+ fprintf(tracefile, fmt, a1, a2, a3, a4, a5, a6, a7, a8);
+ if (strchr(fmt, '\n'))
+ fflush(tracefile);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+trputs(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (tracefile == NULL)
+ return;
+ fputs(s, tracefile);
+ if (strchr(s, '\n'))
+ fflush(tracefile);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+trstring(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ register char *p;
+ char c;
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (tracefile == NULL)
+ return;
+ putc('"', tracefile);
+ for (p = s ; *p ; p++) {
+ switch (*p) {
+ case '\n': c = 'n'; goto backslash;
+ case '\t': c = 't'; goto backslash;
+ case '\r': c = 'r'; goto backslash;
+ case '"': c = '"'; goto backslash;
+ case '\\': c = '\\'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLESC: c = 'e'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLVAR: c = 'v'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLVAR+CTLQUOTE: c = 'V'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLBACKQ: c = 'q'; goto backslash;
+ case CTLBACKQ+CTLQUOTE: c = 'Q'; goto backslash;
+backslash: putc('\\', tracefile);
+ putc(c, tracefile);
+ break;
+ default:
+ if (*p >= ' ' && *p <= '~')
+ putc(*p, tracefile);
+ else {
+ putc('\\', tracefile);
+ putc(*p >> 6 & 03, tracefile);
+ putc(*p >> 3 & 07, tracefile);
+ putc(*p & 07, tracefile);
+ }
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+ putc('"', tracefile);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+trargs(ap)
+ char **ap;
+ {
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (tracefile == NULL)
+ return;
+ while (*ap) {
+ trstring(*ap++);
+ if (*ap)
+ putc(' ', tracefile);
+ else
+ putc('\n', tracefile);
+ }
+ fflush(tracefile);
+#endif
+}
+
+
+opentrace() {
+ char s[100];
+ char *p;
+ char *getenv();
+ int flags;
+
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ if (!debug)
+ return;
+#ifdef not_this_way
+ if ((p = getenv("HOME")) == NULL) {
+ if (geteuid() == 0)
+ p = "/";
+ else
+ p = "/tmp";
+ }
+ scopy(p, s);
+ strcat(s, "/trace");
+#else
+ scopy("./trace", s);
+#endif /* not_this_way */
+ if ((tracefile = fopen(s, "a")) == NULL) {
+ fprintf(stderr, "Can't open %s\n", s);
+ return;
+ }
+#ifdef O_APPEND
+ if ((flags = fcntl(fileno(tracefile), F_GETFL, 0)) >= 0)
+ fcntl(fileno(tracefile), F_SETFL, flags | O_APPEND);
+#endif
+ fputs("\nTracing started.\n", tracefile);
+ fflush(tracefile);
+#endif /* DEBUG */
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/trap.c b/bin/sh/trap.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dde6dbc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/trap.c
@@ -0,0 +1,348 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)trap.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "main.h"
+#include "nodes.h" /* for other headers */
+#include "eval.h"
+#include "jobs.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "signames.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "trap.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+#include <signal.h>
+
+
+/*
+ * Sigmode records the current value of the signal handlers for the various
+ * modes. A value of zero means that the current handler is not known.
+ * S_HARD_IGN indicates that the signal was ignored on entry to the shell,
+ */
+
+#define S_DFL 1 /* default signal handling (SIG_DFL) */
+#define S_CATCH 2 /* signal is caught */
+#define S_IGN 3 /* signal is ignored (SIG_IGN) */
+#define S_HARD_IGN 4 /* signal is ignored permenantly */
+#define S_RESET 5 /* temporary - to reset a hard ignored sig */
+
+
+extern char nullstr[1]; /* null string */
+
+char *trap[MAXSIG+1]; /* trap handler commands */
+MKINIT char sigmode[MAXSIG]; /* current value of signal */
+char gotsig[MAXSIG]; /* indicates specified signal received */
+int pendingsigs; /* indicates some signal received */
+
+/*
+ * The trap builtin.
+ */
+
+trapcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ char *action;
+ char **ap;
+ int signo;
+
+ if (argc <= 1) {
+ for (signo = 0 ; signo <= MAXSIG ; signo++) {
+ if (trap[signo] != NULL)
+ out1fmt("%d: %s\n", signo, trap[signo]);
+ }
+ return 0;
+ }
+ ap = argv + 1;
+ if (is_number(*ap))
+ action = NULL;
+ else
+ action = *ap++;
+ while (*ap) {
+ if ((signo = number(*ap)) < 0 || signo > MAXSIG)
+ error("%s: bad trap", *ap);
+ INTOFF;
+ if (action)
+ action = savestr(action);
+ if (trap[signo])
+ ckfree(trap[signo]);
+ trap[signo] = action;
+ if (signo != 0)
+ setsignal(signo);
+ INTON;
+ ap++;
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Clear traps on a fork.
+ */
+
+void
+clear_traps() {
+ char **tp;
+
+ for (tp = trap ; tp <= &trap[MAXSIG] ; tp++) {
+ if (*tp && **tp) { /* trap not NULL or SIG_IGN */
+ INTOFF;
+ ckfree(*tp);
+ *tp = NULL;
+ if (tp != &trap[0])
+ setsignal(tp - trap);
+ INTON;
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Set the signal handler for the specified signal. The routine figures
+ * out what it should be set to.
+ */
+
+int
+setsignal(signo) {
+ int action;
+ sig_t sigact;
+ char *t;
+ extern void onsig();
+ extern sig_t getsigaction();
+
+ if ((t = trap[signo]) == NULL)
+ action = S_DFL;
+ else if (*t != '\0')
+ action = S_CATCH;
+ else
+ action = S_IGN;
+ if (rootshell && action == S_DFL) {
+ switch (signo) {
+ case SIGINT:
+ if (iflag)
+ action = S_CATCH;
+ break;
+ case SIGQUIT:
+#ifdef DEBUG
+ {
+ extern int debug;
+
+ if (debug)
+ break;
+ }
+#endif
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case SIGTERM:
+ if (iflag)
+ action = S_IGN;
+ break;
+#if JOBS
+ case SIGTSTP:
+ case SIGTTOU:
+ if (mflag)
+ action = S_IGN;
+ break;
+#endif
+ }
+ }
+ t = &sigmode[signo - 1];
+ if (*t == 0) {
+ /*
+ * current setting unknown
+ */
+ sigact = getsigaction(signo);
+ if (sigact == SIG_IGN) {
+ if (mflag && (signo == SIGTSTP ||
+ signo == SIGTTIN || signo == SIGTTOU)) {
+ *t = S_IGN; /* don't hard ignore these */
+ } else
+ *t = S_HARD_IGN;
+ } else {
+ *t = S_RESET; /* force to be set */
+ }
+ }
+ if (*t == S_HARD_IGN || *t == action)
+ return 0;
+ switch (action) {
+ case S_DFL: sigact = SIG_DFL; break;
+ case S_CATCH: sigact = onsig; break;
+ case S_IGN: sigact = SIG_IGN; break;
+ }
+ *t = action;
+ return (int)signal(signo, sigact);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Return the current setting for sig w/o changing it.
+ */
+sig_t
+getsigaction(signo) {
+ struct sigaction sa;
+
+ if (sigaction(signo, (struct sigaction *)0, &sa) == -1)
+ error("Sigaction system call failed");
+
+ return sa.sa_handler;
+}
+
+/*
+ * Ignore a signal.
+ */
+
+void
+ignoresig(signo) {
+ if (sigmode[signo - 1] != S_IGN && sigmode[signo - 1] != S_HARD_IGN) {
+ signal(signo, SIG_IGN);
+ }
+ sigmode[signo - 1] = S_HARD_IGN;
+}
+
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "signames.h"
+INCLUDE "trap.h"
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ char *sm;
+
+ clear_traps();
+ for (sm = sigmode ; sm < sigmode + MAXSIG ; sm++) {
+ if (*sm == S_IGN)
+ *sm = S_HARD_IGN;
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Signal handler.
+ */
+
+void
+onsig(signo) {
+ signal(signo, onsig);
+ if (signo == SIGINT && trap[SIGINT] == NULL) {
+ onint();
+ return;
+ }
+ gotsig[signo - 1] = 1;
+ pendingsigs++;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to execute a trap. Perhaps we should avoid entering new trap
+ * handlers while we are executing a trap handler.
+ */
+
+void
+dotrap() {
+ int i;
+ int savestatus;
+
+ for (;;) {
+ for (i = 1 ; ; i++) {
+ if (gotsig[i - 1])
+ break;
+ if (i >= MAXSIG)
+ goto done;
+ }
+ gotsig[i - 1] = 0;
+ savestatus=exitstatus;
+ evalstring(trap[i]);
+ exitstatus=savestatus;
+ }
+done:
+ pendingsigs = 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Controls whether the shell is interactive or not.
+ */
+
+
+void
+setinteractive(on) {
+ static int is_interactive;
+
+ if (on == is_interactive)
+ return;
+ setsignal(SIGINT);
+ setsignal(SIGQUIT);
+ setsignal(SIGTERM);
+ is_interactive = on;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Called to exit the shell.
+ */
+
+void
+exitshell(status) {
+ struct jmploc loc1, loc2;
+ char *p;
+
+ TRACE(("exitshell(%d) pid=%d\n", status, getpid()));
+ if (setjmp(loc1.loc)) {
+ goto l1;
+ }
+ if (setjmp(loc2.loc)) {
+ goto l2;
+ }
+ handler = &loc1;
+ if ((p = trap[0]) != NULL && *p != '\0') {
+ trap[0] = NULL;
+ evalstring(p);
+ }
+l1: handler = &loc2; /* probably unnecessary */
+ flushall();
+#if JOBS
+ setjobctl(0);
+#endif
+l2: _exit(status);
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/trap.h b/bin/sh/trap.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d59ee60
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/trap.h
@@ -0,0 +1,55 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)trap.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+extern int pendingsigs;
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void clear_traps(void);
+int setsignal(int);
+void ignoresig(int);
+void dotrap(void);
+void setinteractive(int);
+void exitshell(int);
+#else
+void clear_traps();
+int setsignal();
+void ignoresig();
+void dotrap();
+void setinteractive();
+void exitshell();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sh/var.c b/bin/sh/var.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..0629de8
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/var.c
@@ -0,0 +1,670 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)var.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Shell variables.
+ */
+
+#include "shell.h"
+#include "output.h"
+#include "expand.h"
+#include "nodes.h" /* for other headers */
+#include "eval.h" /* defines cmdenviron */
+#include "exec.h"
+#include "syntax.h"
+#include "options.h"
+#include "mail.h"
+#include "var.h"
+#include "memalloc.h"
+#include "error.h"
+#include "mystring.h"
+
+
+#define VTABSIZE 39
+
+
+struct varinit {
+ struct var *var;
+ int flags;
+ char *text;
+};
+
+
+#if ATTY
+struct var vatty;
+#endif
+struct var vhistsize;
+struct var vifs;
+struct var vmail;
+struct var vmpath;
+struct var vpath;
+struct var vps1;
+struct var vps2;
+struct var vvers;
+#if ATTY
+struct var vterm;
+#endif
+
+const struct varinit varinit[] = {
+#if ATTY
+ {&vatty, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "ATTY="},
+#endif
+ {&vhistsize, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "HISTSIZE="},
+ {&vifs, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "IFS= \t\n"},
+ {&vmail, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "MAIL="},
+ {&vmpath, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "MAILPATH="},
+ {&vpath, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "PATH=:/bin:/usr/bin"},
+ /*
+ * vps1 depends on uid
+ */
+ {&vps2, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED, "PS2=> "},
+#if ATTY
+ {&vterm, VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED|VUNSET, "TERM="},
+#endif
+ {NULL, 0, NULL}
+};
+
+struct var *vartab[VTABSIZE];
+
+STATIC int unsetvar __P((char *));
+STATIC struct var **hashvar __P((char *));
+STATIC int varequal __P((char *, char *));
+
+/*
+ * Initialize the varable symbol tables and import the environment
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+INCLUDE "var.h"
+INIT {
+ char **envp;
+ extern char **environ;
+
+ initvar();
+ for (envp = environ ; *envp ; envp++) {
+ if (strchr(*envp, '=')) {
+ setvareq(*envp, VEXPORT|VTEXTFIXED);
+ }
+ }
+}
+#endif
+
+
+/*
+ * This routine initializes the builtin variables. It is called when the
+ * shell is initialized and again when a shell procedure is spawned.
+ */
+
+void
+initvar() {
+ const struct varinit *ip;
+ struct var *vp;
+ struct var **vpp;
+
+ for (ip = varinit ; (vp = ip->var) != NULL ; ip++) {
+ if ((vp->flags & VEXPORT) == 0) {
+ vpp = hashvar(ip->text);
+ vp->next = *vpp;
+ *vpp = vp;
+ vp->text = ip->text;
+ vp->flags = ip->flags;
+ }
+ }
+ /*
+ * PS1 depends on uid
+ */
+ if ((vps1.flags & VEXPORT) == 0) {
+ vpp = hashvar("PS1=");
+ vps1.next = *vpp;
+ *vpp = &vps1;
+ vps1.text = geteuid() ? "PS1=$ " : "PS1=# ";
+ vps1.flags = VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED;
+ }
+}
+
+/*
+ * Set the value of a variable. The flags argument is ored with the
+ * flags of the variable. If val is NULL, the variable is unset.
+ */
+
+void
+setvar(name, val, flags)
+ char *name, *val;
+ {
+ char *p, *q;
+ int len;
+ int namelen;
+ char *nameeq;
+ int isbad;
+
+ isbad = 0;
+ p = name;
+ if (! is_name(*p++))
+ isbad = 1;
+ for (;;) {
+ if (! is_in_name(*p)) {
+ if (*p == '\0' || *p == '=')
+ break;
+ isbad = 1;
+ }
+ p++;
+ }
+ namelen = p - name;
+ if (isbad)
+ error("%.*s: bad variable name", namelen, name);
+ len = namelen + 2; /* 2 is space for '=' and '\0' */
+ if (val == NULL) {
+ flags |= VUNSET;
+ } else {
+ len += strlen(val);
+ }
+ p = nameeq = ckmalloc(len);
+ q = name;
+ while (--namelen >= 0)
+ *p++ = *q++;
+ *p++ = '=';
+ *p = '\0';
+ if (val)
+ scopy(val, p);
+ setvareq(nameeq, flags);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Same as setvar except that the variable and value are passed in
+ * the first argument as name=value. Since the first argument will
+ * be actually stored in the table, it should not be a string that
+ * will go away.
+ */
+
+void
+setvareq(s, flags)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ struct var *vp, **vpp;
+
+ vpp = hashvar(s);
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next) {
+ if (varequal(s, vp->text)) {
+ if (vp->flags & VREADONLY) {
+ int len = strchr(s, '=') - s;
+ error("%.*s: is read only", len, s);
+ }
+ INTOFF;
+ if (vp == &vpath)
+ changepath(s + 5); /* 5 = strlen("PATH=") */
+ if ((vp->flags & (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK)) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp->text);
+ vp->flags &=~ (VTEXTFIXED|VSTACK|VUNSET);
+ vp->flags |= flags;
+ vp->text = s;
+ if (vp == &vmpath || (vp == &vmail && ! mpathset()))
+ chkmail(1);
+ if (vp == &vhistsize)
+ sethistsize();
+ INTON;
+ return;
+ }
+ }
+ /* not found */
+ vp = ckmalloc(sizeof (*vp));
+ vp->flags = flags;
+ vp->text = s;
+ vp->next = *vpp;
+ *vpp = vp;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Process a linked list of variable assignments.
+ */
+
+void
+listsetvar(list)
+ struct strlist *list;
+ {
+ struct strlist *lp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ for (lp = list ; lp ; lp = lp->next) {
+ setvareq(savestr(lp->text), 0);
+ }
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Find the value of a variable. Returns NULL if not set.
+ */
+
+char *
+lookupvar(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ struct var *v;
+
+ for (v = *hashvar(name) ; v ; v = v->next) {
+ if (varequal(v->text, name)) {
+ if (v->flags & VUNSET)
+ return NULL;
+ return strchr(v->text, '=') + 1;
+ }
+ }
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Search the environment of a builtin command. If the second argument
+ * is nonzero, return the value of a variable even if it hasn't been
+ * exported.
+ */
+
+char *
+bltinlookup(name, doall)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ struct strlist *sp;
+ struct var *v;
+
+ for (sp = cmdenviron ; sp ; sp = sp->next) {
+ if (varequal(sp->text, name))
+ return strchr(sp->text, '=') + 1;
+ }
+ for (v = *hashvar(name) ; v ; v = v->next) {
+ if (varequal(v->text, name)) {
+ if (v->flags & VUNSET
+ || ! doall && (v->flags & VEXPORT) == 0)
+ return NULL;
+ return strchr(v->text, '=') + 1;
+ }
+ }
+ return NULL;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Generate a list of exported variables. This routine is used to construct
+ * the third argument to execve when executing a program.
+ */
+
+char **
+environment() {
+ int nenv;
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+ char **env, **ep;
+
+ nenv = 0;
+ for (vpp = vartab ; vpp < vartab + VTABSIZE ; vpp++) {
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next)
+ if (vp->flags & VEXPORT)
+ nenv++;
+ }
+ ep = env = stalloc((nenv + 1) * sizeof *env);
+ for (vpp = vartab ; vpp < vartab + VTABSIZE ; vpp++) {
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next)
+ if (vp->flags & VEXPORT)
+ *ep++ = vp->text;
+ }
+ *ep = NULL;
+ return env;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called when a shell procedure is invoked to clear out nonexported
+ * variables. It is also necessary to reallocate variables of with
+ * VSTACK set since these are currently allocated on the stack.
+ */
+
+#ifdef mkinit
+MKINIT void shprocvar();
+
+SHELLPROC {
+ shprocvar();
+}
+#endif
+
+void
+shprocvar() {
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp, **prev;
+
+ for (vpp = vartab ; vpp < vartab + VTABSIZE ; vpp++) {
+ for (prev = vpp ; (vp = *prev) != NULL ; ) {
+ if ((vp->flags & VEXPORT) == 0) {
+ *prev = vp->next;
+ if ((vp->flags & VTEXTFIXED) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp->text);
+ if ((vp->flags & VSTRFIXED) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp);
+ } else {
+ if (vp->flags & VSTACK) {
+ vp->text = savestr(vp->text);
+ vp->flags &=~ VSTACK;
+ }
+ prev = &vp->next;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ initvar();
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Command to list all variables which are set. Currently this command
+ * is invoked from the set command when the set command is called without
+ * any variables.
+ */
+
+int
+showvarscmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ for (vpp = vartab ; vpp < vartab + VTABSIZE ; vpp++) {
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next) {
+ if ((vp->flags & VUNSET) == 0)
+ out1fmt("%s\n", vp->text);
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * The export and readonly commands.
+ */
+
+int
+exportcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+ char *name;
+ char *p;
+ int flag = argv[0][0] == 'r'? VREADONLY : VEXPORT;
+
+ listsetvar(cmdenviron);
+ if (argc > 1) {
+ while ((name = *argptr++) != NULL) {
+ if ((p = strchr(name, '=')) != NULL) {
+ p++;
+ } else {
+ vpp = hashvar(name);
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next) {
+ if (varequal(vp->text, name)) {
+ vp->flags |= flag;
+ goto found;
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ setvar(name, p, flag);
+found:;
+ }
+ } else {
+ for (vpp = vartab ; vpp < vartab + VTABSIZE ; vpp++) {
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vp = vp->next) {
+ if (vp->flags & flag) {
+ for (p = vp->text ; *p != '=' ; p++)
+ out1c(*p);
+ out1c('\n');
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The "local" command.
+ */
+
+localcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ char *name;
+
+ if (! in_function())
+ error("Not in a function");
+ while ((name = *argptr++) != NULL) {
+ mklocal(name);
+ }
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Make a variable a local variable. When a variable is made local, it's
+ * value and flags are saved in a localvar structure. The saved values
+ * will be restored when the shell function returns. We handle the name
+ * "-" as a special case.
+ */
+
+void
+mklocal(name)
+ char *name;
+ {
+ struct localvar *lvp;
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ INTOFF;
+ lvp = ckmalloc(sizeof (struct localvar));
+ if (name[0] == '-' && name[1] == '\0') {
+ lvp->text = ckmalloc(sizeof optlist);
+ bcopy(optlist, lvp->text, sizeof optlist);
+ vp = NULL;
+ } else {
+ vpp = hashvar(name);
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp && ! varequal(vp->text, name) ; vp = vp->next);
+ if (vp == NULL) {
+ if (strchr(name, '='))
+ setvareq(savestr(name), VSTRFIXED);
+ else
+ setvar(name, NULL, VSTRFIXED);
+ vp = *vpp; /* the new variable */
+ lvp->text = NULL;
+ lvp->flags = VUNSET;
+ } else {
+ lvp->text = vp->text;
+ lvp->flags = vp->flags;
+ vp->flags |= VSTRFIXED|VTEXTFIXED;
+ if (strchr(name, '='))
+ setvareq(savestr(name), 0);
+ }
+ }
+ lvp->vp = vp;
+ lvp->next = localvars;
+ localvars = lvp;
+ INTON;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Called after a function returns.
+ */
+
+void
+poplocalvars() {
+ struct localvar *lvp;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ while ((lvp = localvars) != NULL) {
+ localvars = lvp->next;
+ vp = lvp->vp;
+ if (vp == NULL) { /* $- saved */
+ bcopy(lvp->text, optlist, sizeof optlist);
+ ckfree(lvp->text);
+ } else if ((lvp->flags & (VUNSET|VSTRFIXED)) == VUNSET) {
+ (void)unsetvar(vp->text);
+ } else {
+ if ((vp->flags & VTEXTFIXED) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp->text);
+ vp->flags = lvp->flags;
+ vp->text = lvp->text;
+ }
+ ckfree(lvp);
+ }
+}
+
+
+setvarcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ if (argc <= 2)
+ return unsetcmd(argc, argv);
+ else if (argc == 3)
+ setvar(argv[1], argv[2], 0);
+ else
+ error("List assignment not implemented");
+ return 0;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * The unset builtin command. We unset the function before we unset the
+ * variable to allow a function to be unset when there is a readonly variable
+ * with the same name.
+ */
+
+unsetcmd(argc, argv) char **argv; {
+ char **ap;
+ int i;
+ int flg_func = 0;
+ int flg_var = 0;
+ int ret = 0;
+
+ while ((i = nextopt("vf")) != '\0') {
+ if (i == 'f')
+ flg_func = 1;
+ else
+ flg_var = 1;
+ }
+ if (flg_func == 0 && flg_var == 0)
+ flg_var = 1;
+
+ for (ap = argptr; *ap ; ap++) {
+ if (flg_func)
+ ret |= unsetfunc(*ap);
+ if (flg_var)
+ ret |= unsetvar(*ap);
+ }
+ return ret;
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Unset the specified variable.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+unsetvar(s)
+ char *s;
+ {
+ struct var **vpp;
+ struct var *vp;
+
+ vpp = hashvar(s);
+ for (vp = *vpp ; vp ; vpp = &vp->next, vp = *vpp) {
+ if (varequal(vp->text, s)) {
+ if (vp->flags & VREADONLY)
+ return (1);
+ INTOFF;
+ if (*(strchr(vp->text, '=') + 1) != '\0')
+ setvar(s, nullstr, 0);
+ vp->flags &=~ VEXPORT;
+ vp->flags |= VUNSET;
+ if ((vp->flags & VSTRFIXED) == 0) {
+ if ((vp->flags & VTEXTFIXED) == 0)
+ ckfree(vp->text);
+ *vpp = vp->next;
+ ckfree(vp);
+ }
+ INTON;
+ return (0);
+ }
+ }
+
+ return (1);
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Find the appropriate entry in the hash table from the name.
+ */
+
+STATIC struct var **
+hashvar(p)
+ register char *p;
+ {
+ unsigned int hashval;
+
+ hashval = *p << 4;
+ while (*p && *p != '=')
+ hashval += *p++;
+ return &vartab[hashval % VTABSIZE];
+}
+
+
+
+/*
+ * Returns true if the two strings specify the same varable. The first
+ * variable name is terminated by '='; the second may be terminated by
+ * either '=' or '\0'.
+ */
+
+STATIC int
+varequal(p, q)
+ register char *p, *q;
+ {
+ while (*p == *q++) {
+ if (*p++ == '=')
+ return 1;
+ }
+ if (*p == '=' && *(q - 1) == '\0')
+ return 1;
+ return 0;
+}
diff --git a/bin/sh/var.h b/bin/sh/var.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..92b4d0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sh/var.h
@@ -0,0 +1,127 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)var.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+/*
+ * Shell variables.
+ */
+
+/* flags */
+#define VEXPORT 01 /* variable is exported */
+#define VREADONLY 02 /* variable cannot be modified */
+#define VSTRFIXED 04 /* variable struct is staticly allocated */
+#define VTEXTFIXED 010 /* text is staticly allocated */
+#define VSTACK 020 /* text is allocated on the stack */
+#define VUNSET 040 /* the variable is not set */
+
+
+struct var {
+ struct var *next; /* next entry in hash list */
+ int flags; /* flags are defined above */
+ char *text; /* name=value */
+};
+
+
+struct localvar {
+ struct localvar *next; /* next local variable in list */
+ struct var *vp; /* the variable that was made local */
+ int flags; /* saved flags */
+ char *text; /* saved text */
+};
+
+
+struct localvar *localvars;
+
+#if ATTY
+extern struct var vatty;
+#endif
+extern struct var vifs;
+extern struct var vmail;
+extern struct var vmpath;
+extern struct var vpath;
+extern struct var vps1;
+extern struct var vps2;
+#if ATTY
+extern struct var vterm;
+#endif
+
+/*
+ * The following macros access the values of the above variables.
+ * They have to skip over the name. They return the null string
+ * for unset variables.
+ */
+
+#define ifsval() (vifs.text + 4)
+#define mailval() (vmail.text + 5)
+#define mpathval() (vmpath.text + 9)
+#define pathval() (vpath.text + 5)
+#define ps1val() (vps1.text + 4)
+#define ps2val() (vps2.text + 4)
+#if ATTY
+#define termval() (vterm.text + 5)
+#endif
+
+#if ATTY
+#define attyset() ((vatty.flags & VUNSET) == 0)
+#endif
+#define mpathset() ((vmpath.flags & VUNSET) == 0)
+
+
+#ifdef __STDC__
+void initvar();
+void setvar(char *, char *, int);
+void setvareq(char *, int);
+struct strlist;
+void listsetvar(struct strlist *);
+char *lookupvar(char *);
+char *bltinlookup(char *, int);
+char **environment();
+int showvarscmd(int, char **);
+void mklocal(char *);
+void poplocalvars(void);
+#else
+void initvar();
+void setvar();
+void setvareq();
+void listsetvar();
+char *lookupvar();
+char *bltinlookup();
+char **environment();
+int showvarscmd();
+void mklocal();
+void poplocalvars();
+#endif
diff --git a/bin/sleep/Makefile b/bin/sleep/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..c31f19c
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sleep/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,5 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= sleep
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/sleep/sleep.1 b/bin/sleep/sleep.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..2148b7a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sleep/sleep.1
@@ -0,0 +1,116 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)sleep.1 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt SLEEP 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm sleep
+.Nd suspend execution for an interval of time
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm sleep
+.Ar seconds
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm sleep
+command
+suspends execution for a minimum of
+.Ar seconds .
+.Nm Sleep
+is used to schedule the execution of other commands (see
+.Sx EXAMPLES
+below).
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm Sleep
+utility exits with one of the following values:
+.Bl -tag -width flag
+.It Li \&0
+On successful completion, or if the signal
+.Dv SIGALRM
+was received.
+.It Li \&>\&0
+An error occurred.
+.El
+.Sh EXAMPLES
+To schedule the execution of a command for
+.Va x
+number seconds later:
+.Pp
+.Dl (sleep 1800; sh command_file >& errors)&
+.Pp
+This incantation would wait a half hour before
+running the script command_file. (See the
+.Xr at 1
+utility.)
+.Pp
+To reiteratively run a command (with the
+.Xr csh 1 ) :
+.Pp
+.Bd -literal -offset indent -compact
+while (1)
+ if (! -r zzz.rawdata) then
+ sleep 300
+ else
+ foreach i (`ls *.rawdata`)
+ sleep 70
+ awk -f collapse_data $i >> results
+ end
+ break
+ endif
+end
+.Ed
+.Pp
+The scenario for a script such as this might be: a program currently
+running is taking longer than expected to process a series of
+files, and it would be nice to have
+another program start processing the files created by the first
+program as soon as it is finished (when zzz.rawdata is created).
+The script checks every five minutes for the file zzz.rawdata,
+when the file is found, then another portion processing
+is done courteously by sleeping for 70 seconds in between each
+awk job.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr setitimer 2 ,
+.Xr alarm 3 ,
+.Xr sleep 3 ,
+.Xr at 1
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm sleep
+command is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/sleep/sleep.c b/bin/sleep/sleep.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..365d39e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sleep/sleep.c
@@ -0,0 +1,80 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1988, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1988, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)sleep.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+void usage __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ int ch, secs;
+
+ while ((ch = getopt(argc, argv, "")) != EOF)
+ switch(ch) {
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ usage();
+ }
+ argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (argc != 1)
+ usage();
+
+ if ((secs = atoi(*argv)) > 0)
+ (void)sleep(secs);
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: sleep seconds\n");
+ exit(1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/Makefile b/bin/stty/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..69bda05
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= stty
+SRCS= cchar.c gfmt.c key.c modes.c print.c stty.c util.c
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/stty/cchar.c b/bin/stty/cchar.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..79cb90a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/cchar.c
@@ -0,0 +1,145 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)cchar.c 8.5 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "stty.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Special control characters.
+ *
+ * Cchars1 are the standard names, cchars2 are the old aliases.
+ * The first are displayed, but both are recognized on the
+ * command line.
+ */
+struct cchar cchars1[] = {
+ { "discard", VDISCARD, CDISCARD },
+ { "dsusp", VDSUSP, CDSUSP },
+ { "eof", VEOF, CEOF },
+ { "eol", VEOL, CEOL },
+ { "eol2", VEOL2, CEOL },
+ { "erase", VERASE, CERASE },
+ { "intr", VINTR, CINTR },
+ { "kill", VKILL, CKILL },
+ { "lnext", VLNEXT, CLNEXT },
+ { "min", VMIN, CMIN },
+ { "quit", VQUIT, CQUIT },
+ { "reprint", VREPRINT, CREPRINT },
+ { "start", VSTART, CSTART },
+ { "status", VSTATUS, CSTATUS },
+ { "stop", VSTOP, CSTOP },
+ { "susp", VSUSP, CSUSP },
+ { "time", VTIME, CTIME },
+ { "werase", VWERASE, CWERASE },
+ { NULL },
+};
+
+struct cchar cchars2[] = {
+ { "brk", VEOL, CEOL },
+ { "flush", VDISCARD, CDISCARD },
+ { "rprnt", VREPRINT, CREPRINT },
+ { NULL },
+};
+
+static int
+c_cchar(a, b)
+ const void *a, *b;
+{
+
+ return (strcmp(((struct cchar *)a)->name, ((struct cchar *)b)->name));
+}
+
+int
+csearch(argvp, ip)
+ char ***argvp;
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+ struct cchar *cp, tmp;
+ long val;
+ char *arg, *ep, *name;
+
+ name = **argvp;
+
+ tmp.name = name;
+ if (!(cp = (struct cchar *)bsearch(&tmp, cchars1,
+ sizeof(cchars1)/sizeof(struct cchar) - 1, sizeof(struct cchar),
+ c_cchar)) && !(cp = (struct cchar *)bsearch(&tmp, cchars1,
+ sizeof(cchars1)/sizeof(struct cchar) - 1, sizeof(struct cchar),
+ c_cchar)))
+ return (0);
+
+ arg = *++*argvp;
+ if (!arg) {
+ warnx("option requires an argument -- %s", name);
+ usage();
+ }
+
+#define CHK(s) (*arg == s[0] && !strcmp(arg, s))
+ if (CHK("undef") || CHK("<undef>"))
+ ip->t.c_cc[cp->sub] = _POSIX_VDISABLE;
+ else if (cp->sub == VMIN || cp->sub == VTIME) {
+ val = strtol(arg, &ep, 10);
+ if (val == _POSIX_VDISABLE) {
+ warnx("value of %ld would disable the option -- %s",
+ val, name);
+ usage();
+ }
+ if (val > UCHAR_MAX) {
+ warnx("maximum option value is %d -- %s",
+ UCHAR_MAX, name);
+ usage();
+ }
+ if (*ep != '\0') {
+ warnx("option requires a numeric argument -- %s", name);
+ usage();
+ }
+ ip->t.c_cc[cp->sub] = val;
+ } else if (arg[0] == '^')
+ ip->t.c_cc[cp->sub] = (arg[1] == '?') ? 0177 :
+ (arg[1] == '-') ? _POSIX_VDISABLE : arg[1] & 037;
+ else
+ ip->t.c_cc[cp->sub] = arg[0];
+ ip->set = 1;
+ return (1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/extern.h b/bin/stty/extern.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..a600ca9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/extern.h
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)extern.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+int c_cchars __P((const void *, const void *));
+int c_modes __P((const void *, const void *));
+int csearch __P((char ***, struct info *));
+void checkredirect __P((void));
+void gprint __P((struct termios *, struct winsize *, int));
+void gread __P((struct termios *, char *));
+int ksearch __P((char ***, struct info *));
+int msearch __P((char ***, struct info *));
+void optlist __P((void));
+void print __P((struct termios *, struct winsize *, int, enum FMT));
+void usage __P((void));
+
+extern struct cchar cchars1[], cchars2[];
diff --git a/bin/stty/gfmt.c b/bin/stty/gfmt.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..97f980a
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/gfmt.c
@@ -0,0 +1,129 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)gfmt.c 8.6 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "stty.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void
+gerr(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+ if (s)
+ errx(1, "illegal gfmt1 option -- %s", s);
+ else
+ errx(1, "illegal gfmt1 option");
+}
+
+void
+gprint(tp, wp, ldisc)
+ struct termios *tp;
+ struct winsize *wp;
+ int ldisc;
+{
+ struct cchar *cp;
+
+ (void)printf("gfmt1:cflag=%x:iflag=%x:lflag=%x:oflag=%x:",
+ tp->c_cflag, tp->c_iflag, tp->c_lflag, tp->c_oflag);
+ for (cp = cchars1; cp->name; ++cp)
+ (void)printf("%s=%x:", cp->name, tp->c_cc[cp->sub]);
+ (void)printf("ispeed=%d:ospeed=%d\n", cfgetispeed(tp), cfgetospeed(tp));
+}
+
+void
+gread(tp, s)
+ struct termios *tp;
+ char *s;
+{
+ struct cchar *cp;
+ char *ep, *p;
+ long tmp;
+
+ if ((s = strchr(s, ':')) == NULL)
+ gerr(NULL);
+ for (++s; s != NULL;) {
+ p = strsep(&s, ":\0");
+ if (!p || !*p)
+ break;
+ if (!(ep = strchr(p, '=')))
+ gerr(p);
+ *ep++ = '\0';
+ (void)sscanf(ep, "%lx", &tmp);
+
+#define CHK(s) (*p == s[0] && !strcmp(p, s))
+ if (CHK("cflag")) {
+ tp->c_cflag = tmp;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (CHK("iflag")) {
+ tp->c_iflag = tmp;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (CHK("ispeed")) {
+ (void)sscanf(ep, "%ld", &tmp);
+ tp->c_ispeed = tmp;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (CHK("lflag")) {
+ tp->c_lflag = tmp;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (CHK("oflag")) {
+ tp->c_oflag = tmp;
+ continue;
+ }
+ if (CHK("ospeed")) {
+ (void)sscanf(ep, "%ld", &tmp);
+ tp->c_ospeed = tmp;
+ continue;
+ }
+ for (cp = cchars1; cp->name != NULL; ++cp)
+ if (CHK(cp->name)) {
+ if (cp->sub == VMIN || cp->sub == VTIME)
+ (void)sscanf(ep, "%ld", &tmp);
+ tp->c_cc[cp->sub] = tmp;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (cp->name == NULL)
+ gerr(p);
+ }
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/key.c b/bin/stty/key.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..cf4fde4
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/key.c
@@ -0,0 +1,299 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)key.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "stty.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+__BEGIN_DECLS
+void f_all __P((struct info *));
+void f_cbreak __P((struct info *));
+void f_columns __P((struct info *));
+void f_dec __P((struct info *));
+void f_everything __P((struct info *));
+void f_extproc __P((struct info *));
+void f_ispeed __P((struct info *));
+void f_nl __P((struct info *));
+void f_ospeed __P((struct info *));
+void f_raw __P((struct info *));
+void f_rows __P((struct info *));
+void f_sane __P((struct info *));
+void f_size __P((struct info *));
+void f_speed __P((struct info *));
+void f_tty __P((struct info *));
+__END_DECLS
+
+static struct key {
+ char *name; /* name */
+ void (*f) __P((struct info *)); /* function */
+#define F_NEEDARG 0x01 /* needs an argument */
+#define F_OFFOK 0x02 /* can turn off */
+ int flags;
+} keys[] = {
+ { "all", f_all, 0 },
+ { "cbreak", f_cbreak, F_OFFOK },
+ { "cols", f_columns, F_NEEDARG },
+ { "columns", f_columns, F_NEEDARG },
+ { "cooked", f_sane, 0 },
+ { "dec", f_dec, 0 },
+ { "everything", f_everything, 0 },
+ { "extproc", f_extproc, F_OFFOK },
+ { "ispeed", f_ispeed, F_NEEDARG },
+ { "new", f_tty, 0 },
+ { "nl", f_nl, F_OFFOK },
+ { "old", f_tty, 0 },
+ { "ospeed", f_ospeed, F_NEEDARG },
+ { "raw", f_raw, F_OFFOK },
+ { "rows", f_rows, F_NEEDARG },
+ { "sane", f_sane, 0 },
+ { "size", f_size, 0 },
+ { "speed", f_speed, 0 },
+ { "tty", f_tty, 0 },
+};
+
+static int
+c_key(a, b)
+ const void *a, *b;
+{
+
+ return (strcmp(((struct key *)a)->name, ((struct key *)b)->name));
+}
+
+int
+ksearch(argvp, ip)
+ char ***argvp;
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+ char *name;
+ struct key *kp, tmp;
+
+ name = **argvp;
+ if (*name == '-') {
+ ip->off = 1;
+ ++name;
+ } else
+ ip->off = 0;
+
+ tmp.name = name;
+ if (!(kp = (struct key *)bsearch(&tmp, keys,
+ sizeof(keys)/sizeof(struct key), sizeof(struct key), c_key)))
+ return (0);
+ if (!(kp->flags & F_OFFOK) && ip->off) {
+ errx(1, "illegal option -- %s", name);
+ usage();
+ }
+ if (kp->flags & F_NEEDARG && !(ip->arg = *++*argvp)) {
+ errx(1, "option requires an argument -- %s", name);
+ usage();
+ }
+ kp->f(ip);
+ return (1);
+}
+
+void
+f_all(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+ print(&ip->t, &ip->win, ip->ldisc, BSD);
+}
+
+void
+f_cbreak(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ if (ip->off)
+ f_sane(ip);
+ else {
+ ip->t.c_iflag |= BRKINT|IXON|IMAXBEL;
+ ip->t.c_oflag |= OPOST;
+ ip->t.c_lflag |= ISIG|IEXTEN;
+ ip->t.c_lflag &= ~ICANON;
+ ip->set = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+f_columns(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ ip->win.ws_col = atoi(ip->arg);
+ ip->wset = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_dec(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ ip->t.c_cc[VERASE] = (u_char)0177;
+ ip->t.c_cc[VKILL] = CTRL('u');
+ ip->t.c_cc[VINTR] = CTRL('c');
+ ip->t.c_lflag &= ~ECHOPRT;
+ ip->t.c_lflag |= ECHOE|ECHOKE|ECHOCTL;
+ ip->t.c_iflag &= ~IXANY;
+ ip->set = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_everything(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ print(&ip->t, &ip->win, ip->ldisc, BSD);
+}
+
+void
+f_extproc(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ if (ip->set) {
+ int tmp = 1;
+ (void)ioctl(ip->fd, TIOCEXT, &tmp);
+ } else {
+ int tmp = 0;
+ (void)ioctl(ip->fd, TIOCEXT, &tmp);
+ }
+}
+
+void
+f_ispeed(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ cfsetispeed(&ip->t, atoi(ip->arg));
+ ip->set = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_nl(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ if (ip->off) {
+ ip->t.c_iflag |= ICRNL;
+ ip->t.c_oflag |= ONLCR;
+ } else {
+ ip->t.c_iflag &= ~ICRNL;
+ ip->t.c_oflag &= ~ONLCR;
+ }
+ ip->set = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_ospeed(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ cfsetospeed(&ip->t, atoi(ip->arg));
+ ip->set = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_raw(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ if (ip->off)
+ f_sane(ip);
+ else {
+ cfmakeraw(&ip->t);
+ ip->t.c_cflag &= ~(CSIZE|PARENB);
+ ip->t.c_cflag |= CS8;
+ ip->set = 1;
+ }
+}
+
+void
+f_rows(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ ip->win.ws_row = atoi(ip->arg);
+ ip->wset = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_sane(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ ip->t.c_cflag = TTYDEF_CFLAG | (ip->t.c_cflag & CLOCAL);
+ ip->t.c_iflag = TTYDEF_IFLAG;
+ ip->t.c_iflag |= ICRNL;
+ /* preserve user-preference flags in lflag */
+#define LKEEP (ECHOKE|ECHOE|ECHOK|ECHOPRT|ECHOCTL|ALTWERASE|TOSTOP|NOFLSH)
+ ip->t.c_lflag = TTYDEF_LFLAG | (ip->t.c_lflag & LKEEP);
+ ip->t.c_oflag = TTYDEF_OFLAG;
+ ip->set = 1;
+}
+
+void
+f_size(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ (void)printf("%d %d\n", ip->win.ws_row, ip->win.ws_col);
+}
+
+void
+f_speed(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+
+ (void)printf("%d\n", cfgetospeed(&ip->t));
+}
+
+void
+f_tty(ip)
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+ int tmp;
+
+ tmp = TTYDISC;
+ if (ioctl(0, TIOCSETD, &tmp) < 0)
+ err(1, "TIOCSETD");
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/modes.c b/bin/stty/modes.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..d900da9
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/modes.c
@@ -0,0 +1,230 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)modes.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include "stty.h"
+
+struct modes {
+ char *name;
+ long set;
+ long unset;
+};
+
+/*
+ * The code in optlist() depends on minus options following regular
+ * options, i.e. "foo" must immediately precede "-foo".
+ */
+struct modes cmodes[] = {
+ { "cs5", CS5, CSIZE },
+ { "cs6", CS6, CSIZE },
+ { "cs7", CS7, CSIZE },
+ { "cs8", CS8, CSIZE },
+ { "cstopb", CSTOPB, 0 },
+ { "-cstopb", 0, CSTOPB },
+ { "cread", CREAD, 0 },
+ { "-cread", 0, CREAD },
+ { "parenb", PARENB, 0 },
+ { "-parenb", 0, PARENB },
+ { "parodd", PARODD, 0 },
+ { "-parodd", 0, PARODD },
+ { "parity", PARENB | CS7, PARODD | CSIZE },
+ { "-parity", CS8, PARODD | PARENB | CSIZE },
+ { "evenp", PARENB | CS7, PARODD | CSIZE },
+ { "-evenp", CS8, PARODD | PARENB | CSIZE },
+ { "oddp", PARENB | CS7 | PARODD, CSIZE },
+ { "-oddp", CS8, PARODD | PARENB | CSIZE },
+ { "pass8", CS8, PARODD | PARENB | CSIZE },
+ { "-pass8", PARENB | CS7, PARODD | CSIZE },
+ { "hupcl", HUPCL, 0 },
+ { "-hupcl", 0, HUPCL },
+ { "hup", HUPCL, 0 },
+ { "-hup", 0, HUPCL },
+ { "clocal", CLOCAL, 0 },
+ { "-clocal", 0, CLOCAL },
+ { "crtscts", CRTSCTS, 0 },
+ { "-crtscts", 0, CRTSCTS },
+ { "mdmbuf", MDMBUF, 0 },
+ { "-mdmbuf", 0, MDMBUF },
+ { NULL },
+};
+
+struct modes imodes[] = {
+ { "ignbrk", IGNBRK, 0 },
+ { "-ignbrk", 0, IGNBRK },
+ { "brkint", BRKINT, 0 },
+ { "-brkint", 0, BRKINT },
+ { "ignpar", IGNPAR, 0 },
+ { "-ignpar", 0, IGNPAR },
+ { "parmrk", PARMRK, 0 },
+ { "-parmrk", 0, PARMRK },
+ { "inpck", INPCK, 0 },
+ { "-inpck", 0, INPCK },
+ { "istrip", ISTRIP, 0 },
+ { "-istrip", 0, ISTRIP },
+ { "inlcr", INLCR, 0 },
+ { "-inlcr", 0, INLCR },
+ { "igncr", IGNCR, 0 },
+ { "-igncr", 0, IGNCR },
+ { "icrnl", ICRNL, 0 },
+ { "-icrnl", 0, ICRNL },
+ { "ixon", IXON, 0 },
+ { "-ixon", 0, IXON },
+ { "flow", IXON, 0 },
+ { "-flow", 0, IXON },
+ { "ixoff", IXOFF, 0 },
+ { "-ixoff", 0, IXOFF },
+ { "tandem", IXOFF, 0 },
+ { "-tandem", 0, IXOFF },
+ { "ixany", IXANY, 0 },
+ { "-ixany", 0, IXANY },
+ { "decctlq", 0, IXANY },
+ { "-decctlq", IXANY, 0 },
+ { "imaxbel", IMAXBEL, 0 },
+ { "-imaxbel", 0, IMAXBEL },
+ { NULL },
+};
+
+struct modes lmodes[] = {
+ { "echo", ECHO, 0 },
+ { "-echo", 0, ECHO },
+ { "echoe", ECHOE, 0 },
+ { "-echoe", 0, ECHOE },
+ { "crterase", ECHOE, 0 },
+ { "-crterase", 0, ECHOE },
+ { "crtbs", ECHOE, 0 }, /* crtbs not supported, close enough */
+ { "-crtbs", 0, ECHOE },
+ { "echok", ECHOK, 0 },
+ { "-echok", 0, ECHOK },
+ { "echoke", ECHOKE, 0 },
+ { "-echoke", 0, ECHOKE },
+ { "crtkill", ECHOKE, 0 },
+ { "-crtkill", 0, ECHOKE },
+ { "altwerase", ALTWERASE, 0 },
+ { "-altwerase", 0, ALTWERASE },
+ { "iexten", IEXTEN, 0 },
+ { "-iexten", 0, IEXTEN },
+ { "echonl", ECHONL, 0 },
+ { "-echonl", 0, ECHONL },
+ { "echoctl", ECHOCTL, 0 },
+ { "-echoctl", 0, ECHOCTL },
+ { "ctlecho", ECHOCTL, 0 },
+ { "-ctlecho", 0, ECHOCTL },
+ { "echoprt", ECHOPRT, 0 },
+ { "-echoprt", 0, ECHOPRT },
+ { "prterase", ECHOPRT, 0 },
+ { "-prterase", 0, ECHOPRT },
+ { "isig", ISIG, 0 },
+ { "-isig", 0, ISIG },
+ { "icanon", ICANON, 0 },
+ { "-icanon", 0, ICANON },
+ { "noflsh", NOFLSH, 0 },
+ { "-noflsh", 0, NOFLSH },
+ { "tostop", TOSTOP, 0 },
+ { "-tostop", 0, TOSTOP },
+ { "flusho", FLUSHO, 0 },
+ { "-flusho", 0, FLUSHO },
+ { "pendin", PENDIN, 0 },
+ { "-pendin", 0, PENDIN },
+ { "crt", ECHOE|ECHOKE|ECHOCTL, ECHOK|ECHOPRT },
+ { "-crt", ECHOK, ECHOE|ECHOKE|ECHOCTL },
+ { "newcrt", ECHOE|ECHOKE|ECHOCTL, ECHOK|ECHOPRT },
+ { "-newcrt", ECHOK, ECHOE|ECHOKE|ECHOCTL },
+ { "nokerninfo", NOKERNINFO, 0 },
+ { "-nokerninfo",0, NOKERNINFO },
+ { "kerninfo", 0, NOKERNINFO },
+ { "-kerninfo", NOKERNINFO, 0 },
+ { NULL },
+};
+
+struct modes omodes[] = {
+ { "opost", OPOST, 0 },
+ { "-opost", 0, OPOST },
+ { "litout", 0, OPOST },
+ { "-litout", OPOST, 0 },
+ { "onlcr", ONLCR, 0 },
+ { "-onlcr", 0, ONLCR },
+ { "tabs", 0, OXTABS }, /* "preserve" tabs */
+ { "-tabs", OXTABS, 0 },
+ { "oxtabs", OXTABS, 0 },
+ { "-oxtabs", 0, OXTABS },
+ { NULL },
+};
+
+#define CHK(s) (*name == s[0] && !strcmp(name, s))
+
+int
+msearch(argvp, ip)
+ char ***argvp;
+ struct info *ip;
+{
+ struct modes *mp;
+ char *name;
+
+ name = **argvp;
+
+ for (mp = cmodes; mp->name; ++mp)
+ if (CHK(mp->name)) {
+ ip->t.c_cflag &= ~mp->unset;
+ ip->t.c_cflag |= mp->set;
+ ip->set = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ for (mp = imodes; mp->name; ++mp)
+ if (CHK(mp->name)) {
+ ip->t.c_iflag &= ~mp->unset;
+ ip->t.c_iflag |= mp->set;
+ ip->set = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ for (mp = lmodes; mp->name; ++mp)
+ if (CHK(mp->name)) {
+ ip->t.c_lflag &= ~mp->unset;
+ ip->t.c_lflag |= mp->set;
+ ip->set = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ for (mp = omodes; mp->name; ++mp)
+ if (CHK(mp->name)) {
+ ip->t.c_oflag &= ~mp->unset;
+ ip->t.c_oflag |= mp->set;
+ ip->set = 1;
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/print.c b/bin/stty/print.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..21f5379
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/print.c
@@ -0,0 +1,266 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)print.c 8.6 (Berkeley) 4/16/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <stddef.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <string.h>
+
+#include "stty.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+static void binit __P((char *));
+static void bput __P((char *));
+static char *ccval __P((struct cchar *, int));
+
+void
+print(tp, wp, ldisc, fmt)
+ struct termios *tp;
+ struct winsize *wp;
+ int ldisc;
+ enum FMT fmt;
+{
+ struct cchar *p;
+ long tmp;
+ u_char *cc;
+ int cnt, ispeed, ospeed;
+ char buf1[100], buf2[100];
+
+ cnt = 0;
+
+ /* Line discipline. */
+ if (ldisc != TTYDISC) {
+ switch(ldisc) {
+ case TABLDISC:
+ cnt += printf("tablet disc; ");
+ break;
+ case SLIPDISC:
+ cnt += printf("slip disc; ");
+ break;
+ default:
+ cnt += printf("#%d disc; ", ldisc);
+ break;
+ }
+ }
+
+ /* Line speed. */
+ ispeed = cfgetispeed(tp);
+ ospeed = cfgetospeed(tp);
+ if (ispeed != ospeed)
+ cnt +=
+ printf("ispeed %d baud; ospeed %d baud;", ispeed, ospeed);
+ else
+ cnt += printf("speed %d baud;", ispeed);
+ if (fmt >= BSD)
+ cnt += printf(" %d rows; %d columns;", wp->ws_row, wp->ws_col);
+ if (cnt)
+ (void)printf("\n");
+
+#define on(f) ((tmp&f) != 0)
+#define put(n, f, d) \
+ if (fmt >= BSD || on(f) != d) \
+ bput(n + on(f));
+
+ /* "local" flags */
+ tmp = tp->c_lflag;
+ binit("lflags");
+ put("-icanon", ICANON, 1);
+ put("-isig", ISIG, 1);
+ put("-iexten", IEXTEN, 1);
+ put("-echo", ECHO, 1);
+ put("-echoe", ECHOE, 0);
+ put("-echok", ECHOK, 0);
+ put("-echoke", ECHOKE, 0);
+ put("-echonl", ECHONL, 0);
+ put("-echoctl", ECHOCTL, 0);
+ put("-echoprt", ECHOPRT, 0);
+ put("-altwerase", ALTWERASE, 0);
+ put("-noflsh", NOFLSH, 0);
+ put("-tostop", TOSTOP, 0);
+ put("-flusho", FLUSHO, 0);
+ put("-pendin", PENDIN, 0);
+ put("-nokerninfo", NOKERNINFO, 0);
+ put("-extproc", EXTPROC, 0);
+
+ /* input flags */
+ tmp = tp->c_iflag;
+ binit("iflags");
+ put("-istrip", ISTRIP, 0);
+ put("-icrnl", ICRNL, 1);
+ put("-inlcr", INLCR, 0);
+ put("-igncr", IGNCR, 0);
+ put("-ixon", IXON, 1);
+ put("-ixoff", IXOFF, 0);
+ put("-ixany", IXANY, 1);
+ put("-imaxbel", IMAXBEL, 1);
+ put("-ignbrk", IGNBRK, 0);
+ put("-brkint", BRKINT, 1);
+ put("-inpck", INPCK, 0);
+ put("-ignpar", IGNPAR, 0);
+ put("-parmrk", PARMRK, 0);
+
+ /* output flags */
+ tmp = tp->c_oflag;
+ binit("oflags");
+ put("-opost", OPOST, 1);
+ put("-onlcr", ONLCR, 1);
+ put("-oxtabs", OXTABS, 1);
+
+ /* control flags (hardware state) */
+ tmp = tp->c_cflag;
+ binit("cflags");
+ put("-cread", CREAD, 1);
+ switch(tmp&CSIZE) {
+ case CS5:
+ bput("cs5");
+ break;
+ case CS6:
+ bput("cs6");
+ break;
+ case CS7:
+ bput("cs7");
+ break;
+ case CS8:
+ bput("cs8");
+ break;
+ }
+ bput("-parenb" + on(PARENB));
+ put("-parodd", PARODD, 0);
+ put("-hupcl", HUPCL, 1);
+ put("-clocal", CLOCAL, 0);
+ put("-cstopb", CSTOPB, 0);
+ put("-crtscts", CRTSCTS, 0);
+ put("-mdmbuf", MDMBUF, 0);
+
+ /* special control characters */
+ cc = tp->c_cc;
+ if (fmt == POSIX) {
+ binit("cchars");
+ for (p = cchars1; p->name; ++p) {
+ (void)snprintf(buf1, sizeof(buf1), "%s = %s;",
+ p->name, ccval(p, cc[p->sub]));
+ bput(buf1);
+ }
+ binit(NULL);
+ } else {
+ binit(NULL);
+ for (p = cchars1, cnt = 0; p->name; ++p) {
+ if (fmt != BSD && cc[p->sub] == p->def)
+ continue;
+#define WD "%-8s"
+ (void)sprintf(buf1 + cnt * 8, WD, p->name);
+ (void)sprintf(buf2 + cnt * 8, WD, ccval(p, cc[p->sub]));
+ if (++cnt == LINELENGTH / 8) {
+ cnt = 0;
+ (void)printf("%s\n", buf1);
+ (void)printf("%s\n", buf2);
+ }
+ }
+ if (cnt) {
+ (void)printf("%s\n", buf1);
+ (void)printf("%s\n", buf2);
+ }
+ }
+}
+
+static int col;
+static char *label;
+
+static void
+binit(lb)
+ char *lb;
+{
+
+ if (col) {
+ (void)printf("\n");
+ col = 0;
+ }
+ label = lb;
+}
+
+static void
+bput(s)
+ char *s;
+{
+
+ if (col == 0) {
+ col = printf("%s: %s", label, s);
+ return;
+ }
+ if ((col + strlen(s)) > LINELENGTH) {
+ (void)printf("\n\t");
+ col = printf("%s", s) + 8;
+ return;
+ }
+ col += printf(" %s", s);
+}
+
+static char *
+ccval(p, c)
+ struct cchar *p;
+ int c;
+{
+ static char buf[5];
+ char *bp;
+
+ if (c == _POSIX_VDISABLE)
+ return ("<undef>");
+
+ if (p->sub == VMIN || p->sub == VTIME) {
+ (void)snprintf(buf, sizeof(buf), "%d", c);
+ return (buf);
+ }
+ bp = buf;
+ if (c & 0200) {
+ *bp++ = 'M';
+ *bp++ = '-';
+ c &= 0177;
+ }
+ if (c == 0177) {
+ *bp++ = '^';
+ *bp++ = '?';
+ }
+ else if (c < 040) {
+ *bp++ = '^';
+ *bp++ = c + '@';
+ }
+ else
+ *bp++ = c;
+ *bp = '\0';
+ return (buf);
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/stty.1 b/bin/stty/stty.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e9665d7
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/stty.1
@@ -0,0 +1,580 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1990, 1993, 1994
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)stty.1 8.4 (Berkeley) 4/18/94
+.\"
+.Dd April 18, 1994
+.Dt STTY 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm stty
+.Nd set the options for a terminal device interface
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm stty
+.Op Fl a | Fl e | Fl g
+.Op Fl f Ar file
+.Op operands
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm stty
+utility sets or reports on terminal
+characteristics for the device that is its standard input.
+If no options or operands are specified, it reports the settings of a subset
+of characteristics as well as additional ones if they differ from their
+default values.
+Otherwise it modifies
+the terminal state according to the specified arguments.
+Some combinations of arguments are mutually
+exclusive on some terminal types.
+.Pp
+The following options are available:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It Fl a
+Display all the current settings for the terminal to standard output
+as per
+.St -p1003.2 .
+.It Fl e
+Display all the current settings for the terminal to standard output
+in the traditional
+.Tn BSD
+``all'' and ``everything'' formats.
+.It Fl f
+Open and use the terminal named by
+.Ar file
+rather than using standard input. The file is opened
+using the
+.Dv O_NONBLOCK
+flag of
+.Fn open ,
+making it possible to
+set or display settings on a terminal that might otherwise
+block on the open.
+.It Fl g
+Display all the current settings for the terminal to standard output
+in a form that may be used as an argument to a subsequent invocation of
+.Nm stty
+to restore the current terminal state as per
+.St -p1003.2 .
+.El
+.Pp
+The following arguments are available to set the terminal
+characteristics:
+.Ss Control Modes:
+.Pp
+Control mode flags affect hardware characteristics associated with the
+terminal. This corresponds to the c_cflag in the termios structure.
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm parenb Pq Fl parenb
+Enable (disable) parity generation
+and detection.
+.It Cm parodd Pq Fl parodd
+Select odd (even) parity.
+.It Cm cs5 cs6 cs7 cs8
+Select character size, if possible.
+.It Ar number
+Set terminal baud rate to the
+number given, if possible.
+If the
+baud rate is set to zero, modem
+control is no longer
+asserted.
+.It Cm ispeed Ar number
+Set terminal input baud rate to the
+number given, if possible.
+If the
+input baud rate is set to zero, the
+input baud rate is set to the
+value of the output baud
+rate.
+.It Cm ospeed Ar number
+Set terminal output baud rate to
+the number given, if possible.
+If
+the output baud rate is set to
+zero, modem control is
+no longer asserted.
+.It Cm speed Ar number
+This sets both
+.Cm ispeed
+and
+.Cm ospeed
+to
+.Ar number .
+.It Cm hupcl Pq Fl hupcl
+Stop asserting modem control
+(do not stop asserting modem control) on last close.
+.It Cm hup Pq Fl hup
+Same as hupcl
+.Pq Fl hupcl .
+.It Cm cstopb Pq Fl cstopb
+Use two (one) stop bits per character.
+.It Cm cread Pq Fl cread
+Enable (disable) the receiver.
+.It Cm clocal Pq Fl clocal
+Assume a line without (with) modem
+control.
+.It Cm crtscts Pq Fl crtscts
+Enable RTS/CTS flow control.
+.El
+.Ss Input Modes:
+This corresponds to the c_iflag in the termios structure.
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm ignbrk Pq Fl ignbrk
+Ignore (do not ignore) break on
+input.
+.It Cm brkint Pq Fl brkint
+Signal (do not signal)
+.Dv INTR
+on
+break.
+.It Cm ignpar Pq Fl ignpar
+Ignore (do not ignore) parity
+errors.
+.It Cm parmrk Pq Fl parmrk
+Mark (do not mark) parity errors.
+.It Cm inpck Pq Fl inpck
+Enable (disable) input parity
+checking.
+.It Cm istrip Pq Fl istrip
+Strip (do not strip) input characters
+to seven bits.
+.It Cm inlcr Pq Fl inlcr
+Map (do not map)
+.Dv NL
+to
+.Dv CR
+on input.
+.It Cm igncr Pq Fl igncr
+Ignore (do not ignore)
+.Dv CR
+on input.
+.It Cm icrnl Pq Fl icrnl
+Map (do not map)
+.Dv CR
+to
+.Dv NL
+on input.
+.It Cm ixon Pq Fl ixon
+Enable (disable)
+.Dv START/STOP
+output
+control.
+Output from the system is
+stopped when the system receives
+.Dv STOP
+and started when the system
+receives
+.Dv START ,
+or if
+.Cm ixany
+is set, any character restarts output.
+.It Cm ixoff Pq Fl ixoff
+Request that the system send (not
+send)
+.Dv START/STOP
+characters when
+the input queue is nearly
+empty/full.
+.It Cm ixany Pq Fl ixany
+Allow any character (allow only
+.Dv START )
+to restart output.
+.It Cm imaxbel Pq Fl imaxbel
+The system imposes a limit of
+.Dv MAX_INPUT
+(currently 255) characters in the input queue. If
+.Cm imaxbel
+is set and the input queue limit has been reached,
+subsequent input causes the system to send an ASCII BEL
+character to the output queue (the terminal beeps at you). Otherwise,
+if
+.Cm imaxbel
+is unset and the input queue is full, the next input character causes
+the entire input and output queues to be discarded.
+.El
+.Ss Output Modes:
+This corresponds to the c_oflag of the termios structure.
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm opost Pq Fl opost
+Post-process output (do not
+post-process output; ignore all other
+output modes).
+.It Cm onlcr Pq Fl onlcr
+Map (do not map)
+.Dv NL
+to
+.DV CR-NL
+on output.
+.It Cm oxtabs Pq Fl oxtabs
+Expand (do not expand) tabs to spaces on output.
+.El
+.Ss Local Modes:
+.Pp
+Local mode flags (lflags) affect various and sundry characteristics of terminal
+processing.
+Historically the term "local" pertained to new job control features
+implemented by Jim Kulp on a
+.Tn Pdp 11/70
+at
+.Tn IIASA .
+Later the driver ran on the first
+.Tn VAX
+at Evans Hall, UC Berkeley, where the job control details
+were greatly modified but the structure definitions and names
+remained essentially unchanged.
+The second interpretation of the 'l' in lflag
+is ``line discipline flag'' which corresponds to the
+.Ar c_lflag
+of the
+.Ar termios
+structure.
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm isig Pq Fl isig
+Enable (disable) the checking of
+characters against the special control
+characters
+.Dv INTR , QUIT ,
+and
+.Dv SUSP .
+.It Cm icanon Pq Fl icanon
+Enable (disable) canonical input
+.Pf ( Dv ERASE
+and
+.Dv KILL
+processing).
+.It Cm iexten Pq Fl iexten
+Enable (disable) any implementation
+defined special control characters
+not currently controlled by icanon,
+isig, or ixon.
+.It Cm echo Pq Fl echo
+Echo back (do not echo back) every
+character typed.
+.It Cm echoe Pq Fl echoe
+The
+.Dv ERASE
+character shall (shall
+not) visually erase the last character
+in the current line from the
+display, if possible.
+.It Cm echok Pq Fl echok
+Echo (do not echo)
+.Dv NL
+after
+.Dv KILL
+character.
+.It Cm echoke Pq Fl echoke
+The
+.Dv KILL
+character shall (shall
+not) visually erase the
+the current line from the
+display, if possible.
+.It Cm echonl Pq Fl echonl
+Echo (do not echo)
+.Dv NL ,
+even if echo
+is disabled.
+.It Cm echoctl Pq Fl echoctl
+If
+.Cm echoctl
+is set, echo control characters as ^X. Otherwise control characters
+echo as themselves.
+.It Cm echoprt Pq Fl echoprt
+For printing terminals. If set, echo erased characters backwards within ``\\''
+and ``/''. Otherwise, disable this feature.
+.It Cm noflsh Pq Fl noflsh
+Disable (enable) flush after
+.Dv INTR , QUIT , SUSP .
+.It Cm tostop Pq Fl tostop
+Send (do not send)
+.Dv SIGTTOU
+for background output. This causes background jobs to stop if they attempt
+terminal output.
+.It Cm altwerase Pq Fl altwerase
+Use (do not use) an alternate word erase algorithm when processing
+.Dv WERASE
+characters.
+This alternate algorithm considers sequences of
+alphanumeric/underscores as words.
+It also skips the first preceding character in its classification
+(as a convenience since the one preceding character could have been
+erased with simply an
+.Dv ERASE
+character.)
+.It Cm mdmbuf Pq Fl mdmbuf
+If set, flow control output based on condition of Carrier Detect. Otherwise
+writes return an error if Carrier Detect is low (and Carrier is not being
+ignored with the
+.Dv CLOCAL
+flag.)
+.It Cm flusho Pq Fl flusho
+Indicates output is (is not) being discarded.
+.It Cm pendin Pq Fl pendin
+Indicates input is (is not) pending after a switch from non-canonical
+to canonical mode and will be re-input when a read becomes pending
+or more input arrives.
+.El
+.Ss Control Characters:
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Ar control-character Ar string
+Set
+.Ar control-character
+to
+.Ar string .
+If string is a single character,
+the control character is set to
+that character.
+If string is the
+two character sequence "^-" or the
+string "undef" the control character
+is disabled (i.e. set to
+.Pf { Dv _POSIX_VDISABLE Ns } . )
+.Pp
+Recognized control-characters:
+.Bd -ragged -offset indent
+.Bl -column character Subscript
+.It control-
+.It character Subscript Description
+.It _________ _________ _______________
+.It eof Ta Tn VEOF EOF No character
+.It eol Ta Tn VEOL EOL No character
+.It eol2 Ta Tn VEOL2 EOL2 No character
+.It erase Ta Tn VERASE ERASE No character
+.It werase Ta Tn VWERASE WERASE No character
+.It intr Ta Tn VINTR INTR No character
+.It kill Ta Tn VKILL KILL No character
+.It quit Ta Tn VQUIT QUIT No character
+.It susp Ta Tn VSUSP SUSP No character
+.It start Ta Tn VSTART START No character
+.It stop Ta Tn VSTOP STOP No character
+.It dsusp Ta Tn VDSUSP DSUSP No character
+.It lnext Ta Tn VLNEXT LNEXT No character
+.It reprint Ta Tn VREPRINT REPRINT No character
+.It status Ta Tn VSTATUS STATUS No character
+.El
+.Ed
+.It Cm min Ar number
+.It Cm time Ar number
+Set the value of min or time to
+number.
+.Dv MIN
+and
+.Dv TIME
+are used in
+Non-Canonical mode input processing
+(-icanon).
+.El
+.Ss Combination Modes:
+.Pp
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Ar saved settings
+Set the current terminal
+characteristics to the saved settings
+produced by the
+.Fl g
+option.
+.It Cm evenp No or Cm parity
+Enable parenb and cs7; disable
+parodd.
+.It Cm oddp
+Enable parenb, cs7, and parodd.
+.It Fl parity , evenp , oddp
+Disable parenb, and set cs8.
+.It Cm \&nl Pq Fl \&nl
+Enable (disable) icrnl.
+In addition
+-nl unsets inlcr and igncr.
+.It Cm ek
+Reset
+.Dv ERASE
+and
+.Dv KILL
+characters
+back to system defaults.
+.It Cm sane
+Resets all modes to reasonable values for interactive terminal use.
+.It Cm tty
+Set the line discipline to the standard terminal line discipline
+.Dv TTYDISC .
+.It Cm crt Pq Fl crt
+Set (disable) all modes suitable for a CRT display device.
+.It Cm kerninfo Pq Fl kerninfo
+Enable (disable) the system generated status line associated with
+processing a
+.Dv STATUS
+character (usually set to ^T). The status line consists of the
+system load average, the current command name, its process ID, the
+event the process is waiting on (or the status of the process), the user
+and system times, percent cpu, and current memory usage.
+.It Cm columns Ar number
+The terminal size is recorded as having
+.Ar number
+columns.
+.It Cm cols Ar number
+is an alias for
+.Cm columns.
+.It Cm rows Ar number
+The terminal size is recorded as having
+.Ar number
+rows.
+.It Cm dec
+Set modes suitable for users of Digital Equipment Corporation systems (
+.Dv ERASE ,
+.Dv KILL ,
+and
+.Dv INTR
+characters are set to ^?, ^U, and ^C;
+.Dv ixany
+is disabled, and
+.Dv crt
+is enabled.)
+.It Cm extproc Pq Fl extproc
+If set, this flag indicates that some amount of terminal processing is being
+performed by either the terminal hardware or by the remote side connected
+to a pty.
+.It Cm raw Pq Fl raw
+If set, change the modes of the terminal so that no input or output processing
+is performed. If unset, change the modes of the terminal to some reasonable
+state that performs input and output processing. Note that since the
+terminal driver no longer has a single
+.Dv RAW
+bit, it is not possible to intuit what flags were set prior to setting
+.Cm raw .
+This means that unsetting
+.Cm raw
+may not put back all the setting that were previously in effect.
+To set the terminal into a raw state and then accurately restore it, the following
+shell code is recommended:
+.nf
+
+save_state=$(stty -g)
+stty raw
+\&...
+stty "$save_state"
+
+.fi
+.It Cm size
+The size of the terminal is printed as two numbers on a single line,
+first rows, then columns.
+.El
+.Ss Compatibility Modes:
+.Pp
+These modes remain for compatibility with the previous version of
+the stty command.
+.Bl -tag -width Fl
+.It Cm all
+Reports all the terminal modes as with
+.Cm stty Fl a
+except that the control characters are printed in a columnar format.
+.It Cm everything
+Same as
+.Cm all .
+.It Cm cooked
+Same as
+.Cm sane .
+.It Cm cbreak
+If set, enables
+.Cm brkint , ixon , imaxbel , opost ,
+.Cm isig , iexten ,
+and
+.Cm Fl icanon .
+If unset, same as
+.Cm sane .
+.It Cm new
+Same as
+.Cm tty .
+.It Cm old
+Same as
+.Cm tty .
+.It Cm newcrt Pq Fl newcrt
+Same as
+.Cm crt .
+.It Cm pass8
+The converse of
+.Cm parity .
+.It Cm tandem Pq Fl tandem
+Same as
+.Cm ixoff .
+.It Cm decctlq Pq Fl decctlq
+The converse of
+.Cm ixany .
+.It Cm crterase Pq Fl crterase
+Same as
+.Cm echoe .
+.It Cm crtbs Pq Fl crtbs
+Same as
+.Cm echoe .
+.It Cm crtkill Pq Fl crtkill
+Same as
+.Cm echoke .
+.It Cm ctlecho Pq Fl ctlecho
+Same as
+.Cm echoctl .
+.It Cm prterase Pq Fl prterase
+Same as
+.Cm echoprt .
+.It Cm litout Pq Fl litout
+The converse of
+.Cm opost .
+.It Cm tabs Pq Fl tabs
+The converse of
+.Cm tabs .
+.It Cm brk Ar value
+Same as the control character
+.Cm eol .
+.It Cm flush Ar value
+Same as the control character
+.Cm discard .
+.It Cm rprnt Ar value
+Same as the control character
+.Cm reprint .
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Nm stty
+utility exits with a value of 0 if successful, and >0 if an error occurs.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr termios 4
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm stty
+function is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible. The flags
+.Fl e
+and
+.Fl f
+are
+extensions to the standard.
diff --git a/bin/stty/stty.c b/bin/stty/stty.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..4a840c2
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/stty.c
@@ -0,0 +1,161 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1989, 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1989, 1991, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)stty.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <fcntl.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "stty.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct info i;
+ enum FMT fmt;
+ int ch;
+
+ fmt = NOTSET;
+ i.fd = STDIN_FILENO;
+
+ opterr = 0;
+ while (optind < argc &&
+ strspn(argv[optind], "-aefg") == strlen(argv[optind]) &&
+ (ch = getopt(argc, argv, "aef:g")) != EOF)
+ switch(ch) {
+ case 'a': /* undocumented: POSIX compatibility */
+ fmt = POSIX;
+ break;
+ case 'e':
+ fmt = BSD;
+ break;
+ case 'f':
+ if ((i.fd = open(optarg, O_RDONLY | O_NONBLOCK)) < 0)
+ err(1, "%s", optarg);
+ break;
+ case 'g':
+ fmt = GFLAG;
+ break;
+ case '?':
+ default:
+ goto args;
+ }
+
+args: argc -= optind;
+ argv += optind;
+
+ if (ioctl(i.fd, TIOCGETD, &i.ldisc) < 0)
+ err(1, "TIOCGETD");
+ if (tcgetattr(i.fd, &i.t) < 0)
+ err(1, "tcgetattr");
+ if (ioctl(i.fd, TIOCGWINSZ, &i.win) < 0)
+ warn("TIOCGWINSZ: %s\n", strerror(errno));
+
+ checkredirect(); /* conversion aid */
+
+ switch(fmt) {
+ case NOTSET:
+ if (*argv)
+ break;
+ /* FALLTHROUGH */
+ case BSD:
+ case POSIX:
+ print(&i.t, &i.win, i.ldisc, fmt);
+ break;
+ case GFLAG:
+ gprint(&i.t, &i.win, i.ldisc);
+ break;
+ }
+
+ for (i.set = i.wset = 0; *argv; ++argv) {
+ if (ksearch(&argv, &i))
+ continue;
+
+ if (csearch(&argv, &i))
+ continue;
+
+ if (msearch(&argv, &i))
+ continue;
+
+ if (isdigit(**argv)) {
+ int speed;
+
+ speed = atoi(*argv);
+ cfsetospeed(&i.t, speed);
+ cfsetispeed(&i.t, speed);
+ i.set = 1;
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ if (!strncmp(*argv, "gfmt1", sizeof("gfmt1") - 1)) {
+ gread(&i.t, *argv + sizeof("gfmt1") - 1);
+ continue;
+ }
+
+ warnx("illegal option -- %s", *argv);
+ usage();
+ }
+
+ if (i.set && tcsetattr(i.fd, 0, &i.t) < 0)
+ err(1, "tcsetattr");
+ if (i.wset && ioctl(i.fd, TIOCSWINSZ, &i.win) < 0)
+ warn("TIOCSWINSZ");
+ exit(0);
+}
+
+void
+usage()
+{
+
+ (void)fprintf(stderr, "usage: stty: [-a|-e|-g] [-f file] [options]\n");
+ exit (1);
+}
diff --git a/bin/stty/stty.h b/bin/stty/stty.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..92cffcc
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/stty.h
@@ -0,0 +1,58 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)stty.h 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+ */
+
+#include <sys/ioctl.h>
+#include <termios.h>
+
+struct info {
+ int fd; /* file descriptor */
+ int ldisc; /* line discipline */
+ int off; /* turn off */
+ int set; /* need set */
+ int wset; /* need window set */
+ char *arg; /* argument */
+ struct termios t; /* terminal info */
+ struct winsize win; /* window info */
+};
+
+struct cchar {
+ char *name;
+ int sub;
+ u_char def;
+};
+
+enum FMT { NOTSET, GFLAG, BSD, POSIX };
+
+#define LINELENGTH 72
diff --git a/bin/stty/util.c b/bin/stty/util.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..95bea15
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/stty/util.c
@@ -0,0 +1,64 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1991, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)util.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <err.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "stty.h"
+#include "extern.h"
+
+/*
+ * Gross, but since we're changing the control descriptor from 1 to 0, most
+ * users will be probably be doing "stty > /dev/sometty" by accident. If 1
+ * and 2 are both ttys, but not the same, assume that 1 was incorrectly
+ * redirected.
+ */
+void
+checkredirect()
+{
+ struct stat sb1, sb2;
+
+ if (isatty(STDOUT_FILENO) && isatty(STDERR_FILENO) &&
+ !fstat(STDOUT_FILENO, &sb1) && !fstat(STDERR_FILENO, &sb2) &&
+ (sb1.st_rdev != sb2.st_rdev))
+warn("stdout appears redirected, but stdin is the control descriptor");
+}
diff --git a/bin/sync/Makefile b/bin/sync/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b3f08be
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sync/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,6 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= sync
+MAN8= sync.0
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/sync/sync.8 b/bin/sync/sync.8
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..049007e
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sync/sync.8
@@ -0,0 +1,73 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1980, 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)sync.8 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt SYNC 8
+.Os BSD 4
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm sync
+.Nd force completion of pending disk writes (flush cache)
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm sync
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+.Nm Sync
+can be called to insure that all disk writes have been completed before the
+processor is halted in a way not suitably done by
+.Xr reboot 8
+or
+.Xr halt 8 .
+Generally, it is preferable to use
+.Xr reboot
+or
+.Xr halt
+to shut down the system,
+as they may perform additional actions
+such as resynchronizing the hardware clock
+and flushing internal caches before performing a final
+.Nm sync .
+.Pp
+.Nm Sync
+utilizes the
+.Xr sync 2
+function call.
+.Sh SEE ALSO
+.Xr sync 2 ,
+.Xr fsync 2 ,
+.Xr halt 8 ,
+.Xr reboot 8 ,
+.Xr update 8
+.Sh HISTORY
+A
+.Nm sync
+command appeared in
+.At v6 .
diff --git a/bin/sync/sync.c b/bin/sync/sync.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..dd58649
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/sync/sync.c
@@ -0,0 +1,48 @@
+/*
+ * Copyright (c) 1987, 1993
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1987, 1993\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)sync.c 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+main()
+{
+ sync();
+ exit(0);
+}
diff --git a/bin/test/Makefile b/bin/test/Makefile
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..ccd6089
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/test/Makefile
@@ -0,0 +1,8 @@
+# @(#)Makefile 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+
+PROG= test
+SRCS= test.c operators.c
+LINKS= ${BINDIR}/test ${BINDIR}/[
+MLINKS= test.1 '[.1'
+
+.include <bsd.prog.mk>
diff --git a/bin/test/TEST.csh b/bin/test/TEST.csh
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..e5b9652
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/test/TEST.csh
@@ -0,0 +1,137 @@
+# @(#)TEST.csh 5.2 (Berkeley) 4/30/93
+
+#alias t '/usr/src/bin/test/obj/test \!*; echo $status'
+alias t '/bin/test \!*; echo $status'
+
+echo 't -b /dev/ttyp2'
+t -b /dev/ttyp2
+echo 't -b /dev/jb1a'
+t -b /dev/jb1a
+
+echo 't -c test.c'
+t -c test.c
+echo 't -c /dev/tty'
+t -c /dev/tty
+
+echo 't -d test.c'
+t -d test.c
+echo 't -d /etc'
+t -d /etc
+
+echo 't -e noexist'
+t -e noexist
+echo 't -e test.c'
+t -e test.c
+
+echo 't -f noexist'
+t -f noexist
+echo 't -f /dev/tty'
+t -f /dev/tty
+echo 't -f test.c'
+t -f test.c
+
+echo 't -g test.c'
+t -g test.c
+echo 't -g /bin/ps'
+t -g /bin/ps
+
+echo 't -n ""'
+t -n ""
+echo 't -n "hello"'
+t -n "hello"
+
+echo 't -p test.c'
+t -p test.c
+
+echo 't -r noexist'
+t -r noexist
+echo 't -r /etc/master.passwd'
+t -r /etc/master.passwd
+echo 't -r test.c'
+t -r test.c
+
+echo 't -s noexist'
+t -s noexist
+echo 't -s /dev/null'
+t -s /dev/null
+echo 't -s test.c'
+t -s test.c
+
+echo 't -t 20'
+t -t 20
+echo 't -t 0'
+t -t 0
+
+echo 't -u test.c'
+t -u test.c
+echo 't -u /bin/rcp'
+t -u /bin/rcp
+
+echo 't -w noexist'
+t -w noexist
+echo 't -w /etc/master.passwd'
+t -w /etc/master.passwd
+echo 't -w /dev/null'
+t -w /dev/null
+
+echo 't -x noexist'
+t -x noexist
+echo 't -x /bin/ps'
+t -x /bin/ps
+echo 't -x /etc/motd'
+t -x /etc/motd
+
+echo 't -z ""'
+t -z ""
+echo 't -z "foo"'
+t -z "foo"
+
+echo 't "foo"'
+t "foo"
+echo 't ""'
+t ""
+
+echo 't "hello" = "hello"'
+t "hello" = "hello"
+echo 't "hello" = "goodbye"'
+t "hello" = "goodbye"
+
+echo 't "hello" != "hello"'
+t "hello" != "hello"
+echo 't "hello" != "goodbye"'
+t "hello" != "goodbye"
+
+echo 't 200 -eq 200'
+t 200 -eq 200
+echo 't 34 -eq 222'
+t 34 -eq 222
+
+echo 't 200 -ne 200'
+t 200 -ne 200
+echo 't 34 -ne 222'
+t 34 -ne 222
+
+echo 't 200 -gt 200'
+t 200 -gt 200
+echo 't 340 -gt 222'
+t 340 -gt 222
+
+echo 't 200 -ge 200'
+t 200 -ge 200
+echo 't 34 -ge 222'
+t 34 -ge 222
+
+echo 't 200 -lt 200'
+t 200 -lt 200
+echo 't 34 -lt 222'
+t 34 -lt 222
+
+echo 't 200 -le 200'
+t 200 -le 200
+echo 't 340 -le 222'
+t 340 -le 222
+
+echo 't 700 -le 1000 -a -n "1" -a "20" = "20"'
+t 700 -le 1000 -a -n "1" -a "20" = "20"
+echo 't ! \( 700 -le 1000 -a -n "1" -a "20" = "20" \)'
+t ! \( 700 -le 1000 -a -n "1" -a "20" = "20" \)
diff --git a/bin/test/operators.c b/bin/test/operators.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..335223b
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/test/operators.c
@@ -0,0 +1,148 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)operators.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+/*
+ * Operators used in the test command.
+ */
+
+#include <stdio.h>
+
+#include "operators.h"
+
+const char *const unary_op[] = {
+ "!",
+ "-b",
+ "-c",
+ "-d",
+ "-e",
+ "-f",
+ "-g",
+ "-h",
+ "-k",
+ "-n",
+ "-p",
+ "-r",
+ "-s",
+ "-t",
+ "-u",
+ "-w",
+ "-x",
+ "-z",
+ NULL
+};
+
+const char *const binary_op[] = {
+ "-o",
+ "|",
+ "-a",
+ "&",
+ "=",
+ "!=",
+ "-eq",
+ "-ne",
+ "-gt",
+ "-lt",
+ "-le",
+ "-ge",
+ NULL
+};
+
+const char op_priority[] = {
+ 3,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 12,
+ 1,
+ 1,
+ 2,
+ 2,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+ 4,
+};
+
+const char op_argflag[] = {
+ 0,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_STRING,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_INT,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_FILE,
+ OP_STRING,
+ 0,
+ 0,
+ 0,
+ 0,
+ OP_STRING,
+ OP_STRING,
+ OP_INT,
+ OP_INT,
+ OP_INT,
+ OP_INT,
+ OP_INT,
+ OP_INT,
+};
diff --git a/bin/test/operators.h b/bin/test/operators.h
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..f8746df
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/test/operators.h
@@ -0,0 +1,77 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ *
+ * @(#)operators.h 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94
+ */
+
+#define NOT 0
+#define ISBLOCK 1
+#define ISCHAR 2
+#define ISDIR 3
+#define ISEXIST 4
+#define ISFILE 5
+#define ISSETGID 6
+#define ISSYMLINK 7
+#define ISSTICKY 8
+#define STRLEN 9
+#define ISFIFO 10
+#define ISREAD 11
+#define ISSIZE 12
+#define ISTTY 13
+#define ISSETUID 14
+#define ISWRITE 15
+#define ISEXEC 16
+#define NULSTR 17
+
+#define FIRST_BINARY_OP 18
+#define OR1 18
+#define OR2 19
+#define AND1 20
+#define AND2 21
+#define STREQ 22
+#define STRNE 23
+#define EQ 24
+#define NE 25
+#define GT 26
+#define LT 27
+#define LE 28
+#define GE 29
+
+
+#define OP_INT 1 /* arguments to operator are integer */
+#define OP_STRING 2 /* arguments to operator are string */
+#define OP_FILE 3 /* argument is a file name */
+
+extern const char *const unary_op[];
+extern const char *const binary_op[];
+extern const char op_priority[];
+extern const char op_argflag[];
diff --git a/bin/test/test.1 b/bin/test/test.1
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b4eaf0d
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/test/test.1
@@ -0,0 +1,255 @@
+.\" Copyright (c) 1991, 1993
+.\" The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+.\"
+.\" This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+.\" the Institute of Electrical and Electronics Engineers, Inc.
+.\"
+.\" Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+.\" modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+.\" are met:
+.\" 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+.\" 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+.\" notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+.\" documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+.\" 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+.\" must display the following acknowledgement:
+.\" This product includes software developed by the University of
+.\" California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+.\" 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+.\" may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+.\" without specific prior written permission.
+.\"
+.\" THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+.\" ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+.\" IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+.\" ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+.\" FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+.\" DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+.\" OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+.\" HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+.\" LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+.\" OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+.\" SUCH DAMAGE.
+.\"
+.\" @(#)test.1 8.1 (Berkeley) 5/31/93
+.\"
+.Dd May 31, 1993
+.Dt TEST 1
+.Os
+.Sh NAME
+.Nm test
+.Nd condition evaluation utility
+.Sh SYNOPSIS
+.Nm test
+.Ar expression
+.Sh DESCRIPTION
+The
+.Nm test
+utility evaluates the expression and, if it evaluates
+to true, returns a zero (true) exit status; otherwise
+it returns 1 (false).
+If there is no expression, test also
+returns 1 (false).
+.Pp
+All operators and flags are separate arguments to the
+.Nm test
+utility.
+.Pp
+The following primaries are used to construct expression:
+.Bl -tag -width Ar
+.It Fl b Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a block special
+file.
+.It Fl c Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a character
+special file.
+.It Fl d Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a directory.
+.It Fl e Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists (regardless of type).
+.It Fl f Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a regular file.
+.It Fl g Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its set group ID flag
+is set.
+.It Fl h Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is a symbolic link.
+.It Fl n Ar string
+True if the length of
+.Ar string
+is nonzero.
+.It Fl p Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+is a named pipe
+.Po Tn FIFO Pc .
+.It Fl r Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file exists and is readable.
+.It Fl s Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and has a size greater
+than zero.
+.It Fl t Ar [file_descriptor]
+True if the file whose file descriptor number
+is
+.Ar file_descriptor
+(default 1) is open and is
+associated with a terminal.
+.It Fl u Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and its set user ID flag
+is set.
+.It Fl w Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is writable.
+True
+indicates only that the write flag is on.
+The file is not writable on a read-only file
+system even if this test indicates true.
+.It Fl x Ar file
+True if
+.Ar file
+exists and is executable.
+True
+indicates only that the execute flag is on.
+If
+.Ar file
+is a directory, true indicates that
+.Ar file
+can be searched.
+.It Fl z Ar string
+True if the length of
+.Ar string
+is zero.
+.It Ar string
+True if
+.Ar string
+is not the null
+string.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&= Ar \&s\&2
+True if the strings
+.Ar \&s\&1
+and
+.Ar \&s\&2
+are identical.
+.It Ar \&s\&1 Cm \&!= Ar \&s\&2
+True if the strings
+.Ar \&s\&1
+and
+.Ar \&s\&2
+are not identical.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&eq Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integers
+.Ar \&n\&1
+and
+.Ar \&n\&2
+are algebraically
+equal.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&ne Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integers
+.Ar \&n\&1
+and
+.Ar \&n\&2
+are not
+algebraically equal.
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&gt Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically
+greater than the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&ge Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically
+greater than or equal to the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&lt Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically less
+than the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.It Ar \&n\&1 Fl \&le Ar \&n\&2
+True if the integer
+.Ar \&n\&1
+is algebraically less
+than or equal to the integer
+.Ar \&n\&2 .
+.El
+.Pp
+These primaries can be combined with the following operators:
+.Bl -tag -width Ar
+.It Cm \&! Ar expression
+True if
+.Ar expression
+is false.
+.It Ar expression1 Fl a Ar expression2
+True if both
+.Ar expression1
+and
+.Ar expression2
+are true.
+.It Ar expression1 Fl o Ar expression2
+True if either
+.Ar expression1
+or
+.Ar expression2
+are true.
+.It Cm \&( Ns Ar expression Ns Cm \&)
+True if expression is true.
+.El
+.Pp
+The
+.Fl a
+operator has higher precedence than the
+.Fl o
+operator.
+.Sh GRAMMAR AMBIGUITY
+The
+.Nm test
+grammar is inherently ambiguous. In order to assure a degree of consistency,
+the cases described in the
+.St -p1003.2 ,
+section D11.2/4.62.4, standard
+are evaluated consistently according to the rules specified in the
+standards document. All other cases are subject to the ambiguity in the
+command semantics.
+.Sh RETURN VALUES
+The
+.Nm test
+utility exits with one of the following values:
+.Bl -tag -width Ds
+.It 0
+expression evaluated to true.
+.It 1
+expression evaluated to false or expression was
+missing.
+.It >1
+An error occurred.
+.El
+.Sh STANDARDS
+The
+.Nm test
+function is expected to be
+.St -p1003.2
+compatible.
diff --git a/bin/test/test.c b/bin/test/test.c
new file mode 100644
index 0000000..b9a8ebf
--- /dev/null
+++ b/bin/test/test.c
@@ -0,0 +1,560 @@
+/*-
+ * Copyright (c) 1992, 1993, 1994
+ * The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.
+ *
+ * This code is derived from software contributed to Berkeley by
+ * Kenneth Almquist.
+ *
+ * Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
+ * modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
+ * are met:
+ * 1. Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
+ * 2. Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
+ * notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in the
+ * documentation and/or other materials provided with the distribution.
+ * 3. All advertising materials mentioning features or use of this software
+ * must display the following acknowledgement:
+ * This product includes software developed by the University of
+ * California, Berkeley and its contributors.
+ * 4. Neither the name of the University nor the names of its contributors
+ * may be used to endorse or promote products derived from this software
+ * without specific prior written permission.
+ *
+ * THIS SOFTWARE IS PROVIDED BY THE REGENTS AND CONTRIBUTORS ``AS IS'' AND
+ * ANY EXPRESS OR IMPLIED WARRANTIES, INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, THE
+ * IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE
+ * ARE DISCLAIMED. IN NO EVENT SHALL THE REGENTS OR CONTRIBUTORS BE LIABLE
+ * FOR ANY DIRECT, INDIRECT, INCIDENTAL, SPECIAL, EXEMPLARY, OR CONSEQUENTIAL
+ * DAMAGES (INCLUDING, BUT NOT LIMITED TO, PROCUREMENT OF SUBSTITUTE GOODS
+ * OR SERVICES; LOSS OF USE, DATA, OR PROFITS; OR BUSINESS INTERRUPTION)
+ * HOWEVER CAUSED AND ON ANY THEORY OF LIABILITY, WHETHER IN CONTRACT, STRICT
+ * LIABILITY, OR TORT (INCLUDING NEGLIGENCE OR OTHERWISE) ARISING IN ANY WAY
+ * OUT OF THE USE OF THIS SOFTWARE, EVEN IF ADVISED OF THE POSSIBILITY OF
+ * SUCH DAMAGE.
+ */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char copyright[] =
+"@(#) Copyright (c) 1992, 1993, 1994\n\
+ The Regents of the University of California. All rights reserved.\n";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#ifndef lint
+static char sccsid[] = "@(#)test.c 8.3 (Berkeley) 4/2/94";
+#endif /* not lint */
+
+#include <sys/types.h>
+#include <sys/stat.h>
+
+#include <ctype.h>
+#include <err.h>
+#include <errno.h>
+#include <limits.h>
+#include <stdio.h>
+#include <stdlib.h>
+#include <string.h>
+#include <unistd.h>
+
+#include "operators.h"
+
+#define STACKSIZE 12
+#define NESTINCR 16
+
+/* data types */
+#define STRING 0
+#define INTEGER 1
+#define BOOLEAN 2
+
+#define IS_BANG(s) (s[0] == '!' && s[1] == '\0')
+
+/*
+ * This structure hold a value. The type keyword specifies the type of
+ * the value, and the union u holds the value. The value of a boolean
+ * is stored in u.num (1 = TRUE, 0 = FALSE).
+ */
+struct value {
+ int type;
+ union {
+ char *string;
+ long num;
+ } u;
+};
+
+struct operator {
+ short op; /* Which operator. */
+ short pri; /* Priority of operator. */
+};
+
+struct filestat {
+ char *name; /* Name of file. */
+ int rcode; /* Return code from stat. */
+ struct stat stat; /* Status info on file. */
+};
+
+static int expr_is_false __P((struct value *));
+static void expr_operator __P((int, struct value *, struct filestat *));
+static void get_int __P((char *, long *));
+static int lookup_op __P((char *, const char *const *));
+static void overflow __P((void));
+static int posix_binary_op __P((char **));
+static int posix_unary_op __P((char **));
+static void syntax __P((void));
+
+int
+main(argc, argv)
+ int argc;
+ char *argv[];
+{
+ struct operator opstack[STACKSIZE];
+ struct operator *opsp;
+ struct value valstack[STACKSIZE + 1];
+ struct value *valsp;
+ struct filestat fs;
+ char c, **ap, *opname, *p;
+ int binary, nest, op, pri, ret_val, skipping;
+
+ if ((p = argv[0]) == NULL)
+ errx(2, "test: argc is zero");
+
+ if (*p != '\0' && p[strlen(p) - 1] == '[') {
+ if (strcmp(argv[--argc], "]"))
+ errx(2, "missing ]");
+ argv[argc] = NULL;
+ }
+ ap = argv + 1;
+ fs.name = NULL;
+
+ /*
+ * Test(1) implements an inherently ambiguous grammer. In order to
+ * assure some degree of consistency, we special case the POSIX 1003.2
+ * requirements to assure correct evaluation for POSIX scripts. The
+ * following special cases comply with POSIX P1003.2/D11.2 Section
+ * 4.62.4.
+ */
+ switch(argc - 1) {
+ case 0: /* % test */
+ return (1);
+ break;
+ case 1: /* % test arg */
+ return (argv[1] == NULL || *argv[1] == '\0') ? 1 : 0;
+ break;
+ case 2: /* % test op arg */
+ opname = argv[1];
+ if (IS_BANG(opname))
+ return (*argv[2] == '\0') ? 0 : 1;
+ else {
+ ret_val = posix_unary_op(&argv[1]);
+ if (ret_val >= 0)
+ return (ret_val);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 3: /* % test arg1 op arg2 */
+ if (IS_BANG(argv[1])) {
+ ret_val = posix_unary_op(&argv[1]);
+ if (ret_val >= 0)
+ return (!ret_val);
+ } else {
+ ret_val = posix_binary_op(&argv[1]);
+ if (ret_val >= 0)
+ return (ret_val);
+ }
+ break;
+ case 4: /* % test ! arg1 op arg2 */
+ if (IS_BANG(argv[1])) {
+ ret_val = posix_binary_op(&argv[2]);
+ if (ret_val >= 0)
+ return (!ret_val);
+ }
+ break;
+ default:
+ break;
+ }
+
+ /*
+ * We use operator precedence parsing, evaluating the expression as
+ * we parse it. Parentheses are handled by bumping up the priority
+ * of operators using the variable "nest." We use the variable
+ * "skipping" to turn off evaluation temporarily for the short
+ * circuit boolean operators. (It is important do the short circuit
+ * evaluation because under NFS a stat operation can take infinitely
+ * long.)
+ */
+ opsp = opstack + STACKSIZE;
+ valsp = valstack;
+ nest = skipping = 0;
+ if (*ap == NULL) {
+ valstack[0].type = BOOLEAN;
+ valstack[0].u.num = 0;
+ goto done;
+ }
+ for (;;) {
+ opname = *ap++;
+ if (opname == NULL)
+ syntax();
+ if (opname[0] == '(' && opname[1] == '\0') {
+ nest += NESTINCR;
+ continue;
+ } else if (*ap && (op = lookup_op(opname, unary_op)) >= 0) {
+ if (opsp == &opstack[0])
+ overflow();
+ --opsp;
+ opsp->op = op;
+ opsp->pri = op_priority[op] + nest;
+ continue;
+ } else {
+ valsp->type = STRING;
+ valsp->u.string = opname;
+ valsp++;
+ }
+ for (;;) {
+ opname = *ap++;
+ if (opname == NULL) {
+ if (nest != 0)
+ syntax();
+ pri = 0;
+ break;
+ }
+ if (opname[0] != ')' || opname[1] != '\0') {
+ if ((op = lookup_op(opname, binary_op)) < 0)
+ syntax();
+ op += FIRST_BINARY_OP;
+ pri = op_priority[op] + nest;
+ break;
+ }
+ if ((nest -= NESTINCR) < 0)
+ syntax();
+ }
+ while (opsp < &opstack[STACKSIZE] && opsp->pri >= pri) {
+ binary = opsp->op;
+ for (;;) {
+ valsp--;
+ c = op_argflag[opsp->op];
+ if (c == OP_INT) {
+ if (valsp->type == STRING)
+ get_int(valsp->u.string,
+ &valsp->u.num);
+ valsp->type = INTEGER;
+ } else if (c >= OP_STRING) {
+ /* OP_STRING or OP_FILE */
+ if (valsp->type == INTEGER) {
+ if ((p = malloc(32)) == NULL)
+ err(2, NULL);
+#ifdef SHELL
+ fmtstr(p, 32, "%d",
+ valsp->u.num);
+#else
+ (void)sprintf(p,
+ "%d", valsp->u.num);
+#endif
+ valsp->u.string = p;
+ } else if (valsp->type == BOOLEAN) {
+ if (valsp->u.num)
+ valsp->u.string =
+ "true";
+ else
+ valsp->u.string = "";
+ }
+ valsp->type = STRING;
+ if (c == OP_FILE && (fs.name == NULL ||
+ strcmp(fs.name, valsp->u.string))) {
+ fs.name = valsp->u.string;
+ fs.rcode =
+ stat(valsp->u.string,
+ &fs.stat);
+ }
+ }
+ if (binary < FIRST_BINARY_OP)
+ break;
+ binary = 0;
+ }
+ if (!skipping)
+ expr_operator(opsp->op, valsp, &fs);
+ else if (opsp->op == AND1 || opsp->op == OR1)
+ skipping--;
+ valsp++; /* push value */
+ opsp++; /* pop operator */
+ }
+ if (opname == NULL)
+ break;
+ if (opsp == &opstack[0])
+ overflow();
+ if (op == AND1 || op == AND2) {
+ op = AND1;
+ if (skipping || expr_is_false(valsp - 1))
+ skipping++;
+ }
+ if (op == OR1 || op == OR2) {
+ op = OR1;
+ if (skipping || !expr_is_false(valsp - 1))
+ skipping++;
+ }
+ opsp--;
+ opsp->op = op;
+ opsp->pri = pri;
+ }
+done: return (expr_is_false(&valstack[0]));
+}
+
+static int
+expr_is_false(val)
+ struct value *val;
+{
+
+ if (val->type == STRING) {
+ if (val->u.string[0] == '\0')
+ return (1);
+ } else { /* INTEGER or BOOLEAN */
+ if (val->u.num == 0)
+ return (1);
+ }
+ return (0);
+}
+
+
+/*
+ * Execute an operator. Op is the operator. Sp is the stack pointer;
+ * sp[0] refers to the first operand, sp[1] refers to the second operand
+ * (if any), and the result is placed in sp[0]. The operands are converted
+ * to the type expected by the operator before expr_operator is called.
+ * Fs is a pointer to a structure which holds the value of the last call
+ * to stat, to avoid repeated stat calls on the same file.
+ */
+static void
+expr_operator(op, sp, fs)
+ int op;
+ struct value *sp;
+ struct filestat *fs;
+{
+ int i;
+
+ switch (op) {
+ case NOT:
+ sp->u.num = expr_is_false(sp);
+ sp->type = BOOLEAN;
+ break;
+ case ISEXIST:
+ if (fs == NULL || fs->rcode == -1)
+ goto false;
+ else
+ goto true;
+ case ISREAD:
+ i = S_IROTH;
+ goto permission;
+ case ISWRITE:
+ i = S_IWOTH;
+ goto permission;
+ case ISEXEC:
+ i = S_IXOTH;
+permission: if (fs->stat.st_uid == geteuid())
+ i <<= 6;
+ else if (fs->stat.st_gid == getegid())
+ i <<= 3;
+ goto filebit; /* true if (stat.st_mode & i) != 0 */
+ case ISFILE:
+ i = S_IFREG;
+ goto filetype;
+ case ISDIR:
+ i = S_IFDIR;
+ goto filetype;
+ case ISCHAR:
+ i = S_IFCHR;
+ goto filetype;
+ case ISBLOCK:
+ i = S_IFBLK;
+ goto filetype;
+ case ISSYMLINK:
+ i = S_IFLNK;
+ (void)lstat(sp->u.string, &fs->stat);
+ goto filetype;
+ case ISFIFO:
+ i = S_IFIFO;
+ goto filetype;
+filetype: if ((fs->stat.st_mode & S_IFMT) == i && fs->rcode >= 0)
+true: sp->u.num = 1;
+ else
+false: sp->u.num = 0;
+ sp->type = BOOLEAN;
+ break;
+ case ISSETUID:
+ i = S_ISUID;
+ goto filebit;
+ case ISSETGID:
+ i = S_ISGID;
+ goto filebit;
+ case ISSTICKY:
+ i = S_ISVTX;
+filebit: if (fs->stat.st_mode & i && fs->rcode >= 0)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case ISSIZE:
+ sp->u.num = fs->rcode >= 0 ? fs->stat.st_size : 0L;
+ sp->type = INTEGER;
+ break;
+ case ISTTY:
+ sp->u.num = isatty(sp->u.num);
+ sp->type = BOOLEAN;
+ break;
+ case NULSTR:
+ if (sp->u.string[0] == '\0')
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case STRLEN:
+ sp->u.num = strlen(sp->u.string);
+ sp->type = INTEGER;
+ break;
+ case OR1:
+ case AND1:
+ /*
+ * These operators are mostly handled by the parser. If we
+ * get here it means that both operands were evaluated, so
+ * the value is the value of the second operand.
+ */
+ *sp = *(sp + 1);
+ break;
+ case STREQ:
+ case STRNE:
+ i = 0;
+ if (!strcmp(sp->u.string, (sp + 1)->u.string))
+ i++;
+ if (op == STRNE)
+ i = 1 - i;
+ sp->u.num = i;
+ sp->type = BOOLEAN;
+ break;
+ case EQ:
+ if (sp->u.num == (sp + 1)->u.num)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case NE:
+ if (sp->u.num != (sp + 1)->u.num)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case GT:
+ if (sp->u.num > (sp + 1)->u.num)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case LT:
+ if (sp->u.num < (sp + 1)->u.num)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case LE:
+ if (sp->u.num <= (sp + 1)->u.num)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+ case GE:
+ if (sp->u.num >= (sp + 1)->u.num)
+ goto true;
+ goto false;
+
+ }
+}
+
+static int
+lookup_op(name, table)
+ char *name;
+ const char *const * table;
+{
+ const char *const * tp;
+ const char *p;
+ char c;
+
+ c = name[1];
+ for (tp = table; (p = *tp) != NULL; tp++)
+ if (p[1] == c && !strcmp(p, name))
+ return (tp - table);
+ return (-1);
+}
+
+static int
+posix_unary_op(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ struct filestat fs;
+ struct value valp;
+ int op, c;
+ char *opname;
+
+ opname = *argv;
+ if ((op = lookup_op(opname, unary_op)) < 0)
+ return (-1);
+ c = op_argflag[op];
+ opname = argv[1];
+ valp.u.string = opname;
+ if (c == OP_FILE) {
+ fs.name = opname;
+ fs.rcode = stat(opname, &fs.stat);
+ } else if (c != OP_STRING)
+ return (-1);
+
+ expr_operator(op, &valp, &fs);
+ return (valp.u.num == 0);
+}
+
+static int
+posix_binary_op(argv)
+ char **argv;
+{
+ struct value v[2];
+ int op, c;
+ char *opname;
+
+ opname = argv[1];
+ if ((op = lookup_op(opname, binary_op)) < 0)
+ return (-1);
+ op += FIRST_BINARY_OP;
+ c = op_argflag[op];
+
+ if (c == OP_INT) {
+ get_int(argv[0], &v[0].u.num);
+ get_int(argv[2], &v[1].u.num);
+ } else {
+ v[0].u.string = argv[0];
+ v[1].u.string = argv[2];
+ }
+ expr_operator(op, v, NULL);
+ return (v[0].u.num == 0);
+}
+
+/*
+ * Integer type checking.
+ */
+static void
+get_int(v, lp)
+ char *v;
+ long *lp;
+{
+ long val;
+ char *ep;
+
+ for (; *v && isspace(*v); ++v);
+ if (isdigit(*v)) {
+ errno = 0;
+ val = strtol(v, &ep, 10);
+ if (*ep != '\0')
+ errx(2, "%s: trailing non-numeric characters", v);
+ if (errno == ERANGE) {
+ if (val == LONG_MIN)
+ errx(2, "%s: underflow", v);
+ if (val == LONG_MAX)
+ errx(2, "%s: overflow", v);
+ }
+ *lp = val;
+ return;
+ }
+ errx(2, "%s: expected integer", v);
+}
+
+static void
+syntax()
+{
+
+ err(2, "syntax error");
+}
+
+static void
+overflow()
+{
+
+ err(2, "expression is too complex");
+}
OpenPOWER on IntegriCloud